]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/calc.texi
Merge from emacs-24; up to 117689
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / calc.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @comment %**start of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
3 @c smallbook
4 @setfilename ../../info/calc.info
5 @c [title]
6 @settitle GNU Emacs Calc Manual
7 @documentencoding UTF-8
8 @setchapternewpage odd
9 @comment %**end of header (This is for running Texinfo on a region.)
10
11 @include emacsver.texi
12
13 @c The following macros are used for conditional output for single lines.
14 @c @texline foo
15 @c `foo' will appear only in TeX output
16 @c @infoline foo
17 @c `foo' will appear only in non-TeX output
18
19 @c @expr{expr} will typeset an expression;
20 @c $x$ in TeX, @samp{x} otherwise.
21
22 @iftex
23 @macro texline
24 @end macro
25 @alias infoline=comment
26 @alias expr=math
27 @alias tfn=code
28 @alias mathit=expr
29 @alias summarykey=key
30 @macro cpi{}
31 @math{@pi{}}
32 @end macro
33 @macro cpiover{den}
34 @math{@pi/\den\}
35 @end macro
36 @end iftex
37
38 @ifnottex
39 @alias texline=comment
40 @macro infoline{stuff}
41 \stuff\
42 @end macro
43 @alias expr=samp
44 @alias tfn=t
45 @alias mathit=i
46 @macro summarykey{ky}
47 \ky\
48 @end macro
49 @macro cpi{}
50 @expr{pi}
51 @end macro
52 @macro cpiover{den}
53 @expr{pi/\den\}
54 @end macro
55 @end ifnottex
56
57
58 @tex
59 % Suggested by Karl Berry <karl@@freefriends.org>
60 \gdef\!{\mskip-\thinmuskip}
61 @end tex
62
63 @c Fix some other things specifically for this manual.
64 @iftex
65 @finalout
66 @mathcode`@:=`@: @c Make Calc fractions come out right in math mode
67 @tex
68 \gdef\coloneq{\mathrel{\mathord:\mathord=}}
69
70 \gdef\beforedisplay{\vskip-10pt}
71 \gdef\afterdisplay{\vskip-5pt}
72 \gdef\beforedisplayh{\vskip-25pt}
73 \gdef\afterdisplayh{\vskip-10pt}
74 @end tex
75 @newdimen@kyvpos @kyvpos=0pt
76 @newdimen@kyhpos @kyhpos=0pt
77 @newcount@calcclubpenalty @calcclubpenalty=1000
78 @ignore
79 @newcount@calcpageno
80 @newtoks@calcoldeverypar @calcoldeverypar=@everypar
81 @everypar={@calceverypar@the@calcoldeverypar}
82 @ifx@ninett@undefinedzzz@font@ninett=cmtt9@fi
83 @catcode`@\=0 \catcode`\@=11
84 \r@ggedbottomtrue
85 \catcode`\@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
86 @end ignore
87 @end iftex
88
89 @copying
90 @ifinfo
91 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator.
92 @end ifinfo
93 @ifnotinfo
94 This file documents Calc, the GNU Emacs calculator, included with
95 GNU Emacs @value{EMACSVER}.
96 @end ifnotinfo
97
98 Copyright @copyright{} 1990--1991, 2001--2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
99
100 @quotation
101 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
102 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
103 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
104 Invariant Sections being just ``GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE'', with the
105 Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,'' and with the Back-Cover
106 Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license is included in the section
107 entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
108
109 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
110 modify this GNU manual.''
111 @end quotation
112 @end copying
113
114 @dircategory Emacs misc features
115 @direntry
116 * Calc: (calc). Advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool.
117 @end direntry
118
119 @titlepage
120 @sp 6
121 @center @titlefont{Calc Manual}
122 @sp 4
123 @center GNU Emacs Calc
124 @c [volume]
125 @sp 5
126 @center Dave Gillespie
127 @center daveg@@synaptics.com
128 @page
129
130 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
131 @insertcopying
132 @end titlepage
133
134
135 @summarycontents
136
137 @c [end]
138
139 @contents
140
141 @c [begin]
142 @ifnottex
143 @node Top, Getting Started, (dir), (dir)
144 @top The GNU Emacs Calculator
145
146 @noindent
147 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced desk calculator and mathematical tool
148 written by Dave Gillespie that runs as part of the GNU Emacs environment.
149
150 This manual, also written (mostly) by Dave Gillespie, is divided into
151 three major parts: ``Getting Started,'' the ``Calc Tutorial,'' and the
152 ``Calc Reference.'' The Tutorial introduces all the major aspects of
153 Calculator use in an easy, hands-on way. The remainder of the manual is
154 a complete reference to the features of the Calculator.
155 @end ifnottex
156
157 @ifinfo
158 For help in the Emacs Info system (which you are using to read this
159 file), type @kbd{?}. (You can also type @kbd{h} to run through a
160 longer Info tutorial.)
161 @end ifinfo
162
163 @insertcopying
164
165 @menu
166 * Getting Started:: General description and overview.
167 @ifinfo
168 * Interactive Tutorial::
169 @end ifinfo
170 * Tutorial:: A step-by-step introduction for beginners.
171
172 * Introduction:: Introduction to the Calc reference manual.
173 * Data Types:: Types of objects manipulated by Calc.
174 * Stack and Trail:: Manipulating the stack and trail buffers.
175 * Mode Settings:: Adjusting display format and other modes.
176 * Arithmetic:: Basic arithmetic functions.
177 * Scientific Functions:: Transcendentals and other scientific functions.
178 * Matrix Functions:: Operations on vectors and matrices.
179 * Algebra:: Manipulating expressions algebraically.
180 * Units:: Operations on numbers with units.
181 * Store and Recall:: Storing and recalling variables.
182 * Graphics:: Commands for making graphs of data.
183 * Kill and Yank:: Moving data into and out of Calc.
184 * Keypad Mode:: Operating Calc from a keypad.
185 * Embedded Mode:: Working with formulas embedded in a file.
186 * Programming:: Calc as a programmable calculator.
187
188 * Copying:: How you can copy and share Calc.
189 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
190 * Customizing Calc:: Customizing Calc.
191 * Reporting Bugs:: How to report bugs and make suggestions.
192
193 * Summary:: Summary of Calc commands and functions.
194
195 * Key Index:: The standard Calc key sequences.
196 * Command Index:: The interactive Calc commands.
197 * Function Index:: Functions (in algebraic formulas).
198 * Concept Index:: General concepts.
199 * Variable Index:: Variables used by Calc (both user and internal).
200 * Lisp Function Index:: Internal Lisp math functions.
201 @end menu
202
203 @ifinfo
204 @node Getting Started, Interactive Tutorial, Top, Top
205 @end ifinfo
206 @ifnotinfo
207 @node Getting Started, Tutorial, Top, Top
208 @end ifnotinfo
209 @chapter Getting Started
210 @noindent
211 This chapter provides a general overview of Calc, the GNU Emacs
212 Calculator: What it is, how to start it and how to exit from it,
213 and what are the various ways that it can be used.
214
215 @menu
216 * What is Calc::
217 * About This Manual::
218 * Notations Used in This Manual::
219 * Demonstration of Calc::
220 * Using Calc::
221 * History and Acknowledgments::
222 @end menu
223
224 @node What is Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started, Getting Started
225 @section What is Calc?
226
227 @noindent
228 @dfn{Calc} is an advanced calculator and mathematical tool that runs as
229 part of the GNU Emacs environment. Very roughly based on the HP-28/48
230 series of calculators, its many features include:
231
232 @itemize @bullet
233 @item
234 Choice of algebraic or RPN (stack-based) entry of calculations.
235
236 @item
237 Arbitrary precision integers and floating-point numbers.
238
239 @item
240 Arithmetic on rational numbers, complex numbers (rectangular and polar),
241 error forms with standard deviations, open and closed intervals, vectors
242 and matrices, dates and times, infinities, sets, quantities with units,
243 and algebraic formulas.
244
245 @item
246 Mathematical operations such as logarithms and trigonometric functions.
247
248 @item
249 Programmer's features (bitwise operations, non-decimal numbers).
250
251 @item
252 Financial functions such as future value and internal rate of return.
253
254 @item
255 Number theoretical features such as prime factorization and arithmetic
256 modulo @var{m} for any @var{m}.
257
258 @item
259 Algebraic manipulation features, including symbolic calculus.
260
261 @item
262 Moving data to and from regular editing buffers.
263
264 @item
265 Embedded mode for manipulating Calc formulas and data directly
266 inside any editing buffer.
267
268 @item
269 Graphics using GNUPLOT, a versatile (and free) plotting program.
270
271 @item
272 Easy programming using keyboard macros, algebraic formulas,
273 algebraic rewrite rules, or extended Emacs Lisp.
274 @end itemize
275
276 Calc tries to include a little something for everyone; as a result it is
277 large and might be intimidating to the first-time user. If you plan to
278 use Calc only as a traditional desk calculator, all you really need to
279 read is the ``Getting Started'' chapter of this manual and possibly the
280 first few sections of the tutorial. As you become more comfortable with
281 the program you can learn its additional features. Calc does not
282 have the scope and depth of a fully-functional symbolic math package,
283 but Calc has the advantages of convenience, portability, and freedom.
284
285 @node About This Manual, Notations Used in This Manual, What is Calc, Getting Started
286 @section About This Manual
287
288 @noindent
289 This document serves as a complete description of the GNU Emacs
290 Calculator. It works both as an introduction for novices and as
291 a reference for experienced users. While it helps to have some
292 experience with GNU Emacs in order to get the most out of Calc,
293 this manual ought to be readable even if you don't know or use Emacs
294 regularly.
295
296 This manual is divided into three major parts: the ``Getting
297 Started'' chapter you are reading now, the Calc tutorial, and the Calc
298 reference manual.
299 @c [when-split]
300 @c This manual has been printed in two volumes, the @dfn{Tutorial} and the
301 @c @dfn{Reference}. Both volumes include a copy of the ``Getting Started''
302 @c chapter.
303
304 If you are in a hurry to use Calc, there is a brief ``demonstration''
305 below which illustrates the major features of Calc in just a couple of
306 pages. If you don't have time to go through the full tutorial, this
307 will show you everything you need to know to begin.
308 @xref{Demonstration of Calc}.
309
310 The tutorial chapter walks you through the various parts of Calc
311 with lots of hands-on examples and explanations. If you are new
312 to Calc and you have some time, try going through at least the
313 beginning of the tutorial. The tutorial includes about 70 exercises
314 with answers. These exercises give you some guided practice with
315 Calc, as well as pointing out some interesting and unusual ways
316 to use its features.
317
318 The reference section discusses Calc in complete depth. You can read
319 the reference from start to finish if you want to learn every aspect
320 of Calc. Or, you can look in the table of contents or the Concept
321 Index to find the parts of the manual that discuss the things you
322 need to know.
323
324 @c @cindex Marginal notes
325 Every Calc keyboard command is listed in the Calc Summary, and also
326 in the Key Index. Algebraic functions, @kbd{M-x} commands, and
327 variables also have their own indices.
328 @c @texline Each
329 @c @infoline In the printed manual, each
330 @c paragraph that is referenced in the Key or Function Index is marked
331 @c in the margin with its index entry.
332
333 @c [fix-ref Help Commands]
334 You can access this manual on-line at any time within Calc by pressing
335 the @kbd{h i} key sequence. Outside of the Calc window, you can press
336 @kbd{C-x * i} to read the manual on-line. From within Calc the command
337 @kbd{h t} will jump directly to the Tutorial; from outside of Calc the
338 command @kbd{C-x * t} will jump to the Tutorial and start Calc if
339 necessary. Pressing @kbd{h s} or @kbd{C-x * s} will take you directly
340 to the Calc Summary. Within Calc, you can also go to the part of the
341 manual describing any Calc key, function, or variable using
342 @w{@kbd{h k}}, @kbd{h f}, or @kbd{h v}, respectively. @xref{Help Commands}.
343
344 @ifnottex
345 The Calc manual can be printed, but because the manual is so large, you
346 should only make a printed copy if you really need it. To print the
347 manual, you will need the @TeX{} typesetting program (this is a free
348 program by Donald Knuth at Stanford University) as well as the
349 @file{texindex} program and @file{texinfo.tex} file, both of which can
350 be obtained from the FSF as part of the @code{texinfo} package.
351 To print the Calc manual in one huge tome, you will need the
352 source code to this manual, @file{calc.texi}, available as part of the
353 Emacs source. Once you have this file, type @kbd{texi2dvi calc.texi}.
354 Alternatively, change to the @file{man} subdirectory of the Emacs
355 source distribution, and type @kbd{make calc.dvi}. (Don't worry if you
356 get some ``overfull box'' warnings while @TeX{} runs.)
357 The result will be a device-independent output file called
358 @file{calc.dvi}, which you must print in whatever way is right
359 for your system. On many systems, the command is
360
361 @example
362 lpr -d calc.dvi
363 @end example
364
365 @noindent
366 or
367
368 @example
369 dvips calc.dvi
370 @end example
371 @end ifnottex
372 @c Printed copies of this manual are also available from the Free Software
373 @c Foundation.
374
375 @node Notations Used in This Manual, Demonstration of Calc, About This Manual, Getting Started
376 @section Notations Used in This Manual
377
378 @noindent
379 This section describes the various notations that are used
380 throughout the Calc manual.
381
382 In keystroke sequences, uppercase letters mean you must hold down
383 the shift key while typing the letter. Keys pressed with Control
384 held down are shown as @kbd{C-x}. Keys pressed with Meta held down
385 are shown as @kbd{M-x}. Other notations are @key{RET} for the
386 Return key, @key{SPC} for the space bar, @key{TAB} for the Tab key,
387 @key{DEL} for the Delete key, and @key{LFD} for the Line-Feed key.
388 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards, it is
389 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
390 regularly using Emacs.
391
392 (If you don't have the @key{LFD} or @key{TAB} keys on your keyboard,
393 the @kbd{C-j} and @kbd{C-i} keys are equivalent to them, respectively.
394 If you don't have a Meta key, look for Alt or Extend Char. You can
395 also press @key{ESC} or @kbd{C-[} first to get the same effect, so
396 that @kbd{M-x}, @kbd{@key{ESC} x}, and @kbd{C-[ x} are all equivalent.)
397
398 Sometimes the @key{RET} key is not shown when it is ``obvious''
399 that you must press @key{RET} to proceed. For example, the @key{RET}
400 is usually omitted in key sequences like @kbd{M-x calc-keypad @key{RET}}.
401
402 Commands are generally shown like this: @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision})
403 or @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}). This means that the command is
404 normally used by pressing the @kbd{p} key or @kbd{C-x * k} key sequence,
405 but it also has the full-name equivalent shown, e.g., @kbd{M-x calc-precision}.
406
407 Commands that correspond to functions in algebraic notation
408 are written: @kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}]. This means
409 the @kbd{C} key is equivalent to @kbd{M-x calc-cos}, and that
410 the corresponding function in an algebraic-style formula would
411 be @samp{cos(@var{x})}.
412
413 A few commands don't have key equivalents: @code{calc-sincos}
414 [@code{sincos}].
415
416 @node Demonstration of Calc, Using Calc, Notations Used in This Manual, Getting Started
417 @section A Demonstration of Calc
418
419 @noindent
420 @cindex Demonstration of Calc
421 This section will show some typical small problems being solved with
422 Calc. The focus is more on demonstration than explanation, but
423 everything you see here will be covered more thoroughly in the
424 Tutorial.
425
426 To begin, start Emacs if necessary (usually the command @code{emacs}
427 does this), and type @kbd{C-x * c} to start the
428 Calculator. (You can also use @kbd{M-x calc} if this doesn't work.
429 @xref{Starting Calc}, for various ways of starting the Calculator.)
430
431 Be sure to type all the sample input exactly, especially noting the
432 difference between lower-case and upper-case letters. Remember,
433 @key{RET}, @key{TAB}, @key{DEL}, and @key{SPC} are the Return, Tab,
434 Delete, and Space keys.
435
436 @strong{RPN calculation.} In RPN, you type the input number(s) first,
437 then the command to operate on the numbers.
438
439 @noindent
440 Type @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + Q} to compute
441 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3} = 2.2360679775}.
442 @infoline the square root of 2+3, which is 2.2360679775.
443
444 @noindent
445 Type @kbd{P 2 ^} to compute
446 @texline @math{\pi^2 = 9.86960440109}.
447 @infoline the value of `pi' squared, 9.86960440109.
448
449 @noindent
450 Type @key{TAB} to exchange the order of these two results.
451
452 @noindent
453 Type @kbd{- I H S} to subtract these results and compute the Inverse
454 Hyperbolic sine of the difference, 2.72996136574.
455
456 @noindent
457 Type @key{DEL} to erase this result.
458
459 @strong{Algebraic calculation.} You can also enter calculations using
460 conventional ``algebraic'' notation. To enter an algebraic formula,
461 use the apostrophe key.
462
463 @noindent
464 Type @kbd{' sqrt(2+3) @key{RET}} to compute
465 @texline @math{\sqrt{2+3}}.
466 @infoline the square root of 2+3.
467
468 @noindent
469 Type @kbd{' pi^2 @key{RET}} to enter
470 @texline @math{\pi^2}.
471 @infoline `pi' squared.
472 To evaluate this symbolic formula as a number, type @kbd{=}.
473
474 @noindent
475 Type @kbd{' arcsinh($ - $$) @key{RET}} to subtract the second-most-recent
476 result from the most-recent and compute the Inverse Hyperbolic sine.
477
478 @strong{Keypad mode.} If you are using the X window system, press
479 @w{@kbd{C-x * k}} to get Keypad mode. (If you don't use X, skip to
480 the next section.)
481
482 @noindent
483 Click on the @key{2}, @key{ENTER}, @key{3}, @key{+}, and @key{SQRT}
484 ``buttons'' using your left mouse button.
485
486 @noindent
487 Click on @key{PI}, @key{2}, and @tfn{y^x}.
488
489 @noindent
490 Click on @key{INV}, then @key{ENTER} to swap the two results.
491
492 @noindent
493 Click on @key{-}, @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, and @key{SIN}.
494
495 @noindent
496 Click on @key{<-} to erase the result, then click @key{OFF} to turn
497 the Keypad Calculator off.
498
499 @strong{Grabbing data.} Type @kbd{C-x * x} if necessary to exit Calc.
500 Now select the following numbers as an Emacs region: ``Mark'' the
501 front of the list by typing @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or @kbd{C-@@} there,
502 then move to the other end of the list. (Either get this list from
503 the on-line copy of this manual, accessed by @w{@kbd{C-x * i}}, or just
504 type these numbers into a scratch file.) Now type @kbd{C-x * g} to
505 ``grab'' these numbers into Calc.
506
507 @example
508 @group
509 1.23 1.97
510 1.6 2
511 1.19 1.08
512 @end group
513 @end example
514
515 @noindent
516 The result @samp{[1.23, 1.97, 1.6, 2, 1.19, 1.08]} is a Calc ``vector.''
517 Type @w{@kbd{V R +}} to compute the sum of these numbers.
518
519 @noindent
520 Type @kbd{U} to Undo this command, then type @kbd{V R *} to compute
521 the product of the numbers.
522
523 @noindent
524 You can also grab data as a rectangular matrix. Place the cursor on
525 the upper-leftmost @samp{1} and set the mark, then move to just after
526 the lower-right @samp{8} and press @kbd{C-x * r}.
527
528 @noindent
529 Type @kbd{v t} to transpose this
530 @texline @math{3\times2}
531 @infoline 3x2
532 matrix into a
533 @texline @math{2\times3}
534 @infoline 2x3
535 matrix. Type @w{@kbd{v u}} to unpack the rows into two separate
536 vectors. Now type @w{@kbd{V R + @key{TAB} V R +}} to compute the sums
537 of the two original columns. (There is also a special
538 grab-and-sum-columns command, @kbd{C-x * :}.)
539
540 @strong{Units conversion.} Units are entered algebraically.
541 Type @w{@kbd{' 43 mi/hr @key{RET}}} to enter the quantity 43 miles-per-hour.
542 Type @w{@kbd{u c km/hr @key{RET}}}. Type @w{@kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}}}.
543
544 @strong{Date arithmetic.} Type @kbd{t N} to get the current date and
545 time. Type @kbd{90 +} to find the date 90 days from now. Type
546 @kbd{' <25 dec 87> @key{RET}} to enter a date, then @kbd{- 7 /} to see how
547 many weeks have passed since then.
548
549 @strong{Algebra.} Algebraic entries can also include formulas
550 or equations involving variables. Type @kbd{@w{' [x + y} = a, x y = 1] @key{RET}}
551 to enter a pair of equations involving three variables.
552 (Note the leading apostrophe in this example; also, note that the space
553 in @samp{x y} is required.) Type @w{@kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}}} to solve
554 these equations for the variables @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
555
556 @noindent
557 Type @kbd{d B} to view the solutions in more readable notation.
558 Type @w{@kbd{d C}} to view them in C language notation, @kbd{d T}
559 to view them in the notation for the @TeX{} typesetting system,
560 and @kbd{d L} to view them in the notation for the @LaTeX{} typesetting
561 system. Type @kbd{d N} to return to normal notation.
562
563 @noindent
564 Type @kbd{7.5}, then @kbd{s l a @key{RET}} to let @expr{a = 7.5} in these formulas.
565 (That's the letter @kbd{l}, not the numeral @kbd{1}.)
566
567 @ifnotinfo
568 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
569 manual. Type @kbd{C-x * c} to return to Calc after each of these
570 commands: @kbd{h k t N} to read about the @kbd{t N} command,
571 @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the @code{sqrt} function, and
572 @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
573 @end ifnotinfo
574 @ifinfo
575 @strong{Help functions.} You can read about any command in the on-line
576 manual. Remember to type the letter @kbd{l}, then @kbd{C-x * c}, to
577 return here after each of these commands: @w{@kbd{h k t N}} to read
578 about the @w{@kbd{t N}} command, @kbd{h f sqrt @key{RET}} to read about the
579 @code{sqrt} function, and @kbd{h s} to read the Calc summary.
580 @end ifinfo
581
582 Press @key{DEL} repeatedly to remove any leftover results from the stack.
583 To exit from Calc, press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again.
584
585 @node Using Calc, History and Acknowledgments, Demonstration of Calc, Getting Started
586 @section Using Calc
587
588 @noindent
589 Calc has several user interfaces that are specialized for
590 different kinds of tasks. As well as Calc's standard interface,
591 there are Quick mode, Keypad mode, and Embedded mode.
592
593 @menu
594 * Starting Calc::
595 * The Standard Interface::
596 * Quick Mode Overview::
597 * Keypad Mode Overview::
598 * Standalone Operation::
599 * Embedded Mode Overview::
600 * Other C-x * Commands::
601 @end menu
602
603 @node Starting Calc, The Standard Interface, Using Calc, Using Calc
604 @subsection Starting Calc
605
606 @noindent
607 On most systems, you can type @kbd{C-x *} to start the Calculator.
608 The key sequence @kbd{C-x *} is bound to the command @code{calc-dispatch},
609 which can be rebound if convenient (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
610
611 When you press @kbd{C-x *}, Emacs waits for you to press a second key to
612 complete the command. In this case, you will follow @kbd{C-x *} with a
613 letter (upper- or lower-case, it doesn't matter for @kbd{C-x *}) that says
614 which Calc interface you want to use.
615
616 To get Calc's standard interface, type @kbd{C-x * c}. To get
617 Keypad mode, type @kbd{C-x * k}. Type @kbd{C-x * ?} to get a brief
618 list of the available options, and type a second @kbd{?} to get
619 a complete list.
620
621 To ease typing, @kbd{C-x * *} also works to start Calc. It starts the
622 same interface (either @kbd{C-x * c} or @w{@kbd{C-x * k}}) that you last
623 used, selecting the @kbd{C-x * c} interface by default.
624
625 If @kbd{C-x *} doesn't work for you, you can always type explicit
626 commands like @kbd{M-x calc} (for the standard user interface) or
627 @w{@kbd{M-x calc-keypad}} (for Keypad mode). First type @kbd{M-x}
628 (that's Meta with the letter @kbd{x}), then, at the prompt,
629 type the full command (like @kbd{calc-keypad}) and press Return.
630
631 The same commands (like @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}) that start
632 the Calculator also turn it off if it is already on.
633
634 @node The Standard Interface, Quick Mode Overview, Starting Calc, Using Calc
635 @subsection The Standard Calc Interface
636
637 @noindent
638 @cindex Standard user interface
639 Calc's standard interface acts like a traditional RPN calculator,
640 operated by the normal Emacs keyboard. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}
641 to start the Calculator, the Emacs screen splits into two windows
642 with the file you were editing on top and Calc on the bottom.
643
644 @smallexample
645 @group
646
647 ...
648 --**-Emacs: myfile (Fundamental)----All----------------------
649 --- Emacs Calculator Mode --- |Emacs Calculator Trail
650 2: 17.3 | 17.3
651 1: -5 | 3
652 . | 2
653 | 4
654 | * 8
655 | ->-5
656 |
657 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All----- --%*- *Calc Trail*
658 @end group
659 @end smallexample
660
661 In this figure, the mode-line for @file{myfile} has moved up and the
662 ``Calculator'' window has appeared below it. As you can see, Calc
663 actually makes two windows side-by-side. The lefthand one is
664 called the @dfn{stack window} and the righthand one is called the
665 @dfn{trail window.} The stack holds the numbers involved in the
666 calculation you are currently performing. The trail holds a complete
667 record of all calculations you have done. In a desk calculator with
668 a printer, the trail corresponds to the paper tape that records what
669 you do.
670
671 In this case, the trail shows that four numbers (17.3, 3, 2, and 4)
672 were first entered into the Calculator, then the 2 and 4 were
673 multiplied to get 8, then the 3 and 8 were subtracted to get @mathit{-5}.
674 (The @samp{>} symbol shows that this was the most recent calculation.)
675 The net result is the two numbers 17.3 and @mathit{-5} sitting on the stack.
676
677 Most Calculator commands deal explicitly with the stack only, but
678 there is a set of commands that allow you to search back through
679 the trail and retrieve any previous result.
680
681 Calc commands use the digits, letters, and punctuation keys.
682 Shifted (i.e., upper-case) letters are different from lowercase
683 letters. Some letters are @dfn{prefix} keys that begin two-letter
684 commands. For example, @kbd{e} means ``enter exponent'' and shifted
685 @kbd{E} means @expr{e^x}. With the @kbd{d} (``display modes'') prefix
686 the letter ``e'' takes on very different meanings: @kbd{d e} means
687 ``engineering notation'' and @kbd{d E} means ``@dfn{eqn} language mode.''
688
689 There is nothing stopping you from switching out of the Calc
690 window and back into your editing window, say by using the Emacs
691 @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window}) command. When the cursor is
692 inside a regular window, Emacs acts just like normal. When the
693 cursor is in the Calc stack or trail windows, keys are interpreted
694 as Calc commands.
695
696 When you quit by pressing @kbd{C-x * c} a second time, the Calculator
697 windows go away but the actual Stack and Trail are not gone, just
698 hidden. When you press @kbd{C-x * c} once again you will get the
699 same stack and trail contents you had when you last used the
700 Calculator.
701
702 The Calculator does not remember its state between Emacs sessions.
703 Thus if you quit Emacs and start it again, @kbd{C-x * c} will give you
704 a fresh stack and trail. There is a command (@kbd{m m}) that lets
705 you save your favorite mode settings between sessions, though.
706 One of the things it saves is which user interface (standard or
707 Keypad) you last used; otherwise, a freshly started Emacs will
708 always treat @kbd{C-x * *} the same as @kbd{C-x * c}.
709
710 The @kbd{q} key is another equivalent way to turn the Calculator off.
711
712 If you type @kbd{C-x * b} first and then @kbd{C-x * c}, you get a
713 full-screen version of Calc (@code{full-calc}) in which the stack and
714 trail windows are still side-by-side but are now as tall as the whole
715 Emacs screen. When you press @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} again to quit,
716 the file you were editing before reappears. The @kbd{C-x * b} key
717 switches back and forth between ``big'' full-screen mode and the
718 normal partial-screen mode.
719
720 Finally, @kbd{C-x * o} (@code{calc-other-window}) is like @kbd{C-x * c}
721 except that the Calc window is not selected. The buffer you were
722 editing before remains selected instead. If you are in a Calc window,
723 then @kbd{C-x * o} will switch you out of it, being careful not to
724 switch you to the Calc Trail window. So @kbd{C-x * o} is a handy
725 way to switch out of Calc momentarily to edit your file; you can then
726 type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch back into Calc when you are done.
727
728 @node Quick Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, The Standard Interface, Using Calc
729 @subsection Quick Mode (Overview)
730
731 @noindent
732 @dfn{Quick mode} is a quick way to use Calc when you don't need the
733 full complexity of the stack and trail. To use it, type @kbd{C-x * q}
734 (@code{quick-calc}) in any regular editing buffer.
735
736 Quick mode is very simple: It prompts you to type any formula in
737 standard algebraic notation (like @samp{4 - 2/3}) and then displays
738 the result at the bottom of the Emacs screen (@mathit{3.33333333333}
739 in this case). You are then back in the same editing buffer you
740 were in before, ready to continue editing or to type @kbd{C-x * q}
741 again to do another quick calculation. The result of the calculation
742 will also be in the Emacs ``kill ring'' so that a @kbd{C-y} command
743 at this point will yank the result into your editing buffer.
744
745 Calc mode settings affect Quick mode, too, though you will have to
746 go into regular Calc (with @kbd{C-x * c}) to change the mode settings.
747
748 @c [fix-ref Quick Calculator mode]
749 @xref{Quick Calculator}, for further information.
750
751 @node Keypad Mode Overview, Standalone Operation, Quick Mode Overview, Using Calc
752 @subsection Keypad Mode (Overview)
753
754 @noindent
755 @dfn{Keypad mode} is a mouse-based interface to the Calculator.
756 It is designed for use with terminals that support a mouse. If you
757 don't have a mouse, you will have to operate Keypad mode with your
758 arrow keys (which is probably more trouble than it's worth).
759
760 Type @kbd{C-x * k} to turn Keypad mode on or off. Once again you
761 get two new windows, this time on the righthand side of the screen
762 instead of at the bottom. The upper window is the familiar Calc
763 Stack; the lower window is a picture of a typical calculator keypad.
764
765 @tex
766 \dimen0=\pagetotal%
767 \advance \dimen0 by 24\baselineskip%
768 \ifdim \dimen0>\pagegoal \vfill\eject \fi%
769 \medskip
770 @end tex
771 @smallexample
772 @group
773 |--- Emacs Calculator Mode ---
774 |2: 17.3
775 |1: -5
776 | .
777 |--%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calcul
778 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
779 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
780 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
781 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
782 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
783 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
784 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
785 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
786 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
787 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
788 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
789 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
790 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
791 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
792 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
793 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
794 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
795 @end group
796 @end smallexample
797
798 Keypad mode is much easier for beginners to learn, because there
799 is no need to memorize lots of obscure key sequences. But not all
800 commands in regular Calc are available on the Keypad. You can
801 always switch the cursor into the Calc stack window to use
802 standard Calc commands if you need. Serious Calc users, though,
803 often find they prefer the standard interface over Keypad mode.
804
805 To operate the Calculator, just click on the ``buttons'' of the
806 keypad using your left mouse button. To enter the two numbers
807 shown here you would click @w{@kbd{1 7 .@: 3 ENTER 5 +/- ENTER}}; to
808 add them together you would then click @kbd{+} (to get 12.3 on
809 the stack).
810
811 If you click the right mouse button, the top three rows of the
812 keypad change to show other sets of commands, such as advanced
813 math functions, vector operations, and operations on binary
814 numbers.
815
816 Because Keypad mode doesn't use the regular keyboard, Calc leaves
817 the cursor in your original editing buffer. You can type in
818 this buffer in the usual way while also clicking on the Calculator
819 keypad. One advantage of Keypad mode is that you don't need an
820 explicit command to switch between editing and calculating.
821
822 If you press @kbd{C-x * b} first, you get a full-screen Keypad mode
823 (@code{full-calc-keypad}) with three windows: The keypad in the lower
824 left, the stack in the lower right, and the trail on top.
825
826 @c [fix-ref Keypad Mode]
827 @xref{Keypad Mode}, for further information.
828
829 @node Standalone Operation, Embedded Mode Overview, Keypad Mode Overview, Using Calc
830 @subsection Standalone Operation
831
832 @noindent
833 @cindex Standalone Operation
834 If you are not in Emacs at the moment but you wish to use Calc,
835 you must start Emacs first. If all you want is to run Calc, you
836 can give the commands:
837
838 @example
839 emacs -f full-calc
840 @end example
841
842 @noindent
843 or
844
845 @example
846 emacs -f full-calc-keypad
847 @end example
848
849 @noindent
850 which run a full-screen Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * c}) or
851 a full-screen X-based Calculator (as if by @kbd{C-x * b C-x * k}).
852 In standalone operation, quitting the Calculator (by pressing
853 @kbd{q} or clicking on the keypad @key{EXIT} button) quits Emacs
854 itself.
855
856 @node Embedded Mode Overview, Other C-x * Commands, Standalone Operation, Using Calc
857 @subsection Embedded Mode (Overview)
858
859 @noindent
860 @dfn{Embedded mode} is a way to use Calc directly from inside an
861 editing buffer. Suppose you have a formula written as part of a
862 document like this:
863
864 @smallexample
865 @group
866 The derivative of
867
868 ln(ln(x))
869
870 is
871 @end group
872 @end smallexample
873
874 @noindent
875 and you wish to have Calc compute and format the derivative for
876 you and store this derivative in the buffer automatically. To
877 do this with Embedded mode, first copy the formula down to where
878 you want the result to be, leaving a blank line before and after the
879 formula:
880
881 @smallexample
882 @group
883 The derivative of
884
885 ln(ln(x))
886
887 is
888
889 ln(ln(x))
890 @end group
891 @end smallexample
892
893 Now, move the cursor onto this new formula and press @kbd{C-x * e}.
894 Calc will read the formula (using the surrounding blank lines to tell
895 how much text to read), then push this formula (invisibly) onto the Calc
896 stack. The cursor will stay on the formula in the editing buffer, but
897 the line with the formula will now appear as it would on the Calc stack
898 (in this case, it will be left-aligned) and the buffer's mode line will
899 change to look like the Calc mode line (with mode indicators like
900 @samp{12 Deg} and so on). Even though you are still in your editing
901 buffer, the keyboard now acts like the Calc keyboard, and any new result
902 you get is copied from the stack back into the buffer. To take the
903 derivative, you would type @kbd{a d x @key{RET}}.
904
905 @smallexample
906 @group
907 The derivative of
908
909 ln(ln(x))
910
911 is
912
913 1 / x ln(x)
914 @end group
915 @end smallexample
916
917 (Note that by default, Calc gives division lower precedence than multiplication,
918 so that @samp{1 / x ln(x)} is equivalent to @samp{1 / (x ln(x))}.)
919
920 To make this look nicer, you might want to press @kbd{d =} to center
921 the formula, and even @kbd{d B} to use Big display mode.
922
923 @smallexample
924 @group
925 The derivative of
926
927 ln(ln(x))
928
929 is
930 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
931 % [calc-mode: language: big]
932
933 1
934 -------
935 x ln(x)
936 @end group
937 @end smallexample
938
939 Calc has added annotations to the file to help it remember the modes
940 that were used for this formula. They are formatted like comments
941 in the @TeX{} typesetting language, just in case you are using @TeX{} or
942 @LaTeX{}. (In this example @TeX{} is not being used, so you might want
943 to move these comments up to the top of the file or otherwise put them
944 out of the way.)
945
946 As an extra flourish, we can add an equation number using a
947 righthand label: Type @kbd{d @} (1) @key{RET}}.
948
949 @smallexample
950 @group
951 % [calc-mode: justify: center]
952 % [calc-mode: language: big]
953 % [calc-mode: right-label: " (1)"]
954
955 1
956 ------- (1)
957 ln(x) x
958 @end group
959 @end smallexample
960
961 To leave Embedded mode, type @kbd{C-x * e} again. The mode line
962 and keyboard will revert to the way they were before.
963
964 The related command @kbd{C-x * w} operates on a single word, which
965 generally means a single number, inside text. It searches for an
966 expression which ``looks'' like a number containing the point.
967 Here's an example of its use (before you try this, remove the Calc
968 annotations or use a new buffer so that the extra settings in the
969 annotations don't take effect):
970
971 @smallexample
972 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 1 degrees.
973 @end smallexample
974
975 Place the cursor on the @samp{1}, then type @kbd{C-x * w} to enable
976 Embedded mode on that number. Now type @kbd{3 /} (to get one-third),
977 and @kbd{I T} (the Inverse Tangent converts a slope into an angle),
978 then @w{@kbd{C-x * w}} again to exit Embedded mode.
979
980 @smallexample
981 A slope of one-third corresponds to an angle of 18.4349488229 degrees.
982 @end smallexample
983
984 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
985 @xref{Embedded Mode}, for full details.
986
987 @node Other C-x * Commands, , Embedded Mode Overview, Using Calc
988 @subsection Other @kbd{C-x *} Commands
989
990 @noindent
991 Two more Calc-related commands are @kbd{C-x * g} and @kbd{C-x * r},
992 which ``grab'' data from a selected region of a buffer into the
993 Calculator. The region is defined in the usual Emacs way, by
994 a ``mark'' placed at one end of the region, and the Emacs
995 cursor or ``point'' placed at the other.
996
997 The @kbd{C-x * g} command reads the region in the usual left-to-right,
998 top-to-bottom order. The result is packaged into a Calc vector
999 of numbers and placed on the stack. Calc (in its standard
1000 user interface) is then started. Type @kbd{v u} if you want
1001 to unpack this vector into separate numbers on the stack. Also,
1002 @kbd{C-u C-x * g} interprets the region as a single number or
1003 formula.
1004
1005 The @kbd{C-x * r} command reads a rectangle, with the point and
1006 mark defining opposite corners of the rectangle. The result
1007 is a matrix of numbers on the Calculator stack.
1008
1009 Complementary to these is @kbd{C-x * y}, which ``yanks'' the
1010 value at the top of the Calc stack back into an editing buffer.
1011 If you type @w{@kbd{C-x * y}} while in such a buffer, the value is
1012 yanked at the current position. If you type @kbd{C-x * y} while
1013 in the Calc buffer, Calc makes an educated guess as to which
1014 editing buffer you want to use. The Calc window does not have
1015 to be visible in order to use this command, as long as there
1016 is something on the Calc stack.
1017
1018 Here, for reference, is the complete list of @kbd{C-x *} commands.
1019 The shift, control, and meta keys are ignored for the keystroke
1020 following @kbd{C-x *}.
1021
1022 @noindent
1023 Commands for turning Calc on and off:
1024
1025 @table @kbd
1026 @item *
1027 Turn Calc on or off, employing the same user interface as last time.
1028
1029 @item =, +, -, /, \, &, #
1030 Alternatives for @kbd{*}.
1031
1032 @item C
1033 Turn Calc on or off using its standard bottom-of-the-screen
1034 interface. If Calc is already turned on but the cursor is not
1035 in the Calc window, move the cursor into the window.
1036
1037 @item O
1038 Same as @kbd{C}, but don't select the new Calc window. If
1039 Calc is already turned on and the cursor is in the Calc window,
1040 move it out of that window.
1041
1042 @item B
1043 Control whether @kbd{C-x * c} and @kbd{C-x * k} use the full screen.
1044
1045 @item Q
1046 Use Quick mode for a single short calculation.
1047
1048 @item K
1049 Turn Calc Keypad mode on or off.
1050
1051 @item E
1052 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current formula.
1053
1054 @item J
1055 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off, select the interesting part.
1056
1057 @item W
1058 Turn Calc Embedded mode on or off at the current word (number).
1059
1060 @item Z
1061 Turn Calc on in a user-defined way, as defined by a @kbd{Z I} command.
1062
1063 @item X
1064 Quit Calc; turn off standard, Keypad, or Embedded mode if on.
1065 (This is like @kbd{q} or @key{OFF} inside of Calc.)
1066 @end table
1067 @iftex
1068 @sp 2
1069 @end iftex
1070
1071 @noindent
1072 Commands for moving data into and out of the Calculator:
1073
1074 @table @kbd
1075 @item G
1076 Grab the region into the Calculator as a vector.
1077
1078 @item R
1079 Grab the rectangular region into the Calculator as a matrix.
1080
1081 @item :
1082 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its columns.
1083
1084 @item _
1085 Grab the rectangular region and compute the sums of its rows.
1086
1087 @item Y
1088 Yank a value from the Calculator into the current editing buffer.
1089 @end table
1090 @iftex
1091 @sp 2
1092 @end iftex
1093
1094 @noindent
1095 Commands for use with Embedded mode:
1096
1097 @table @kbd
1098 @item A
1099 ``Activate'' the current buffer. Locate all formulas that
1100 contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols and record their locations
1101 so that they can be updated automatically as variables are changed.
1102
1103 @item D
1104 Duplicate the current formula immediately below and select
1105 the duplicate.
1106
1107 @item F
1108 Insert a new formula at the current point.
1109
1110 @item N
1111 Move the cursor to the next active formula in the buffer.
1112
1113 @item P
1114 Move the cursor to the previous active formula in the buffer.
1115
1116 @item U
1117 Update (i.e., as if by the @kbd{=} key) the formula at the current point.
1118
1119 @item `
1120 Edit (as if by @code{calc-edit}) the formula at the current point.
1121 @end table
1122 @iftex
1123 @sp 2
1124 @end iftex
1125
1126 @noindent
1127 Miscellaneous commands:
1128
1129 @table @kbd
1130 @item I
1131 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc manual.
1132 (This is the same as @kbd{h i} inside of Calc.)
1133
1134 @item T
1135 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Tutorial.
1136
1137 @item S
1138 Run the Emacs Info system to read the Calc Summary.
1139
1140 @item L
1141 Load Calc entirely into memory. (Normally the various parts
1142 are loaded only as they are needed.)
1143
1144 @item M
1145 Read a region of written keystroke names (like @kbd{C-n a b c @key{RET}})
1146 and record them as the current keyboard macro.
1147
1148 @item 0
1149 (This is the ``zero'' digit key.) Reset the Calculator to
1150 its initial state: Empty stack, and initial mode settings.
1151 @end table
1152
1153 @node History and Acknowledgments, , Using Calc, Getting Started
1154 @section History and Acknowledgments
1155
1156 @noindent
1157 Calc was originally started as a two-week project to occupy a lull
1158 in the author's schedule. Basically, a friend asked if I remembered
1159 the value of
1160 @texline @math{2^{32}}.
1161 @infoline @expr{2^32}.
1162 I didn't offhand, but I said, ``that's easy, just call up an
1163 @code{xcalc}.'' @code{Xcalc} duly reported that the answer to our
1164 question was @samp{4.294967e+09}---with no way to see the full ten
1165 digits even though we knew they were there in the program's memory! I
1166 was so annoyed, I vowed to write a calculator of my own, once and for
1167 all.
1168
1169 I chose Emacs Lisp, a) because I had always been curious about it
1170 and b) because, being only a text editor extension language after
1171 all, Emacs Lisp would surely reach its limits long before the project
1172 got too far out of hand.
1173
1174 To make a long story short, Emacs Lisp turned out to be a distressingly
1175 solid implementation of Lisp, and the humble task of calculating
1176 turned out to be more open-ended than one might have expected.
1177
1178 Emacs Lisp didn't have built-in floating point math (now it does), so
1179 this had to be simulated in software. In fact, Emacs integers would
1180 only comfortably fit six decimal digits or so (at the time)---not
1181 enough for a decent calculator. So I had to write my own
1182 high-precision integer code as well, and once I had this I figured
1183 that arbitrary-size integers were just as easy as large integers.
1184 Arbitrary floating-point precision was the logical next step. Also,
1185 since the large integer arithmetic was there anyway it seemed only
1186 fair to give the user direct access to it, which in turn made it
1187 practical to support fractions as well as floats. All these features
1188 inspired me to look around for other data types that might be worth
1189 having.
1190
1191 Around this time, my friend Rick Koshi showed me his nifty new HP-28
1192 calculator. It allowed the user to manipulate formulas as well as
1193 numerical quantities, and it could also operate on matrices. I
1194 decided that these would be good for Calc to have, too. And once
1195 things had gone this far, I figured I might as well take a look at
1196 serious algebra systems for further ideas. Since these systems did
1197 far more than I could ever hope to implement, I decided to focus on
1198 rewrite rules and other programming features so that users could
1199 implement what they needed for themselves.
1200
1201 Rick complained that matrices were hard to read, so I put in code to
1202 format them in a 2D style. Once these routines were in place, Big mode
1203 was obligatory. Gee, what other language modes would be useful?
1204
1205 Scott Hemphill and Allen Knutson, two friends with a strong mathematical
1206 bent, contributed ideas and algorithms for a number of Calc features
1207 including modulo forms, primality testing, and float-to-fraction conversion.
1208
1209 Units were added at the eager insistence of Mass Sivilotti. Later,
1210 Ulrich Mueller at CERN and Przemek Klosowski at NIST provided invaluable
1211 expert assistance with the units table. As far as I can remember, the
1212 idea of using algebraic formulas and variables to represent units dates
1213 back to an ancient article in Byte magazine about muMath, an early
1214 algebra system for microcomputers.
1215
1216 Many people have contributed to Calc by reporting bugs and suggesting
1217 features, large and small. A few deserve special mention: Tim Peters,
1218 who helped develop the ideas that led to the selection commands, rewrite
1219 rules, and many other algebra features;
1220 @texline Fran\c{c}ois
1221 @infoline Francois
1222 Pinard, who contributed an early prototype of the Calc Summary appendix
1223 as well as providing valuable suggestions in many other areas of Calc;
1224 Carl Witty, whose eagle eyes discovered many typographical and factual
1225 errors in the Calc manual; Tim Kay, who drove the development of
1226 Embedded mode; Ove Ewerlid, who made many suggestions relating to the
1227 algebra commands and contributed some code for polynomial operations;
1228 Randal Schwartz, who suggested the @code{calc-eval} function; Juha
1229 Sarlin, who first worked out how to split Calc into quickly-loading
1230 parts; Bob Weiner, who helped immensely with the Lucid Emacs port; and
1231 Robert J. Chassell, who suggested the Calc Tutorial and exercises as
1232 well as many other things.
1233
1234 @cindex Bibliography
1235 @cindex Knuth, Art of Computer Programming
1236 @cindex Numerical Recipes
1237 @c Should these be expanded into more complete references?
1238 Among the books used in the development of Calc were Knuth's @emph{Art
1239 of Computer Programming} (especially volume II, @emph{Seminumerical
1240 Algorithms}); @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky,
1241 and Vetterling; Bevington's @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis
1242 for the Physical Sciences}; @emph{Concrete Mathematics} by Graham,
1243 Knuth, and Patashnik; Steele's @emph{Common Lisp, the Language}; the
1244 @emph{CRC Standard Math Tables} (William H. Beyer, ed.); and
1245 Abramowitz and Stegun's venerable @emph{Handbook of Mathematical
1246 Functions}. Also, of course, Calc could not have been written without
1247 the excellent @emph{GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual}, by Bil Lewis and
1248 Dan LaLiberte.
1249
1250 Final thanks go to Richard Stallman, without whose fine implementations
1251 of the Emacs editor, language, and environment, Calc would have been
1252 finished in two weeks.
1253
1254 @c [tutorial]
1255
1256 @ifinfo
1257 @c This node is accessed by the `C-x * t' command.
1258 @node Interactive Tutorial, Tutorial, Getting Started, Top
1259 @chapter Tutorial
1260
1261 @noindent
1262 Some brief instructions on using the Emacs Info system for this tutorial:
1263
1264 Press the space bar and Delete keys to go forward and backward in a
1265 section by screenfuls (or use the regular Emacs scrolling commands
1266 for this).
1267
1268 Press @kbd{n} or @kbd{p} to go to the Next or Previous section.
1269 If the section has a @dfn{menu}, press a digit key like @kbd{1}
1270 or @kbd{2} to go to a sub-section from the menu. Press @kbd{u} to
1271 go back up from a sub-section to the menu it is part of.
1272
1273 Exercises in the tutorial all have cross-references to the
1274 appropriate page of the ``answers'' section. Press @kbd{f}, then
1275 the exercise number, to see the answer to an exercise. After
1276 you have followed a cross-reference, you can press the letter
1277 @kbd{l} to return to where you were before.
1278
1279 You can press @kbd{?} at any time for a brief summary of Info commands.
1280
1281 Press the number @kbd{1} now to enter the first section of the Tutorial.
1282
1283 @menu
1284 * Tutorial::
1285 @end menu
1286
1287 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Interactive Tutorial, Top
1288 @end ifinfo
1289 @ifnotinfo
1290 @node Tutorial, Introduction, Getting Started, Top
1291 @end ifnotinfo
1292 @chapter Tutorial
1293
1294 @noindent
1295 This chapter explains how to use Calc and its many features, in
1296 a step-by-step, tutorial way. You are encouraged to run Calc and
1297 work along with the examples as you read (@pxref{Starting Calc}).
1298 If you are already familiar with advanced calculators, you may wish
1299 @c [not-split]
1300 to skip on to the rest of this manual.
1301 @c [when-split]
1302 @c to skip on to volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}.
1303
1304 @c [fix-ref Embedded Mode]
1305 This tutorial describes the standard user interface of Calc only.
1306 The Quick mode and Keypad mode interfaces are fairly
1307 self-explanatory. @xref{Embedded Mode}, for a description of
1308 the Embedded mode interface.
1309
1310 The easiest way to read this tutorial on-line is to have two windows on
1311 your Emacs screen, one with Calc and one with the Info system. Press
1312 @kbd{C-x * t} to set this up; the on-line tutorial will be opened in the
1313 current window and Calc will be started in another window. From the
1314 Info window, the command @kbd{C-x * c} can be used to switch to the Calc
1315 window and @kbd{C-x * o} can be used to switch back to the Info window.
1316 (If you have a printed copy of the manual you can use that instead; in
1317 that case you only need to press @kbd{C-x * c} to start Calc.)
1318
1319 This tutorial is designed to be done in sequence. But the rest of this
1320 manual does not assume you have gone through the tutorial. The tutorial
1321 does not cover everything in the Calculator, but it touches on most
1322 general areas.
1323
1324 @ifnottex
1325 You may wish to print out a copy of the Calc Summary and keep notes on
1326 it as you learn Calc. @xref{About This Manual}, to see how to make a
1327 printed summary. @xref{Summary}.
1328 @end ifnottex
1329 @iftex
1330 The Calc Summary at the end of the reference manual includes some blank
1331 space for your own use. You may wish to keep notes there as you learn
1332 Calc.
1333 @end iftex
1334
1335 @menu
1336 * Basic Tutorial::
1337 * Arithmetic Tutorial::
1338 * Vector/Matrix Tutorial::
1339 * Types Tutorial::
1340 * Algebra Tutorial::
1341 * Programming Tutorial::
1342
1343 * Answers to Exercises::
1344 @end menu
1345
1346 @node Basic Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial, Tutorial
1347 @section Basic Tutorial
1348
1349 @noindent
1350 In this section, we learn how RPN and algebraic-style calculations
1351 work, how to undo and redo an operation done by mistake, and how
1352 to control various modes of the Calculator.
1353
1354 @menu
1355 * RPN Tutorial:: Basic operations with the stack.
1356 * Algebraic Tutorial:: Algebraic entry; variables.
1357 * Undo Tutorial:: If you make a mistake: Undo and the trail.
1358 * Modes Tutorial:: Common mode-setting commands.
1359 @end menu
1360
1361 @node RPN Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1362 @subsection RPN Calculations and the Stack
1363
1364 @cindex RPN notation
1365 @noindent
1366 @ifnottex
1367 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1368 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1369 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1370 Jan Lukasiewicz.)
1371 @end ifnottex
1372 @tex
1373 Calc normally uses RPN notation. You may be familiar with the RPN
1374 system from Hewlett-Packard calculators, FORTH, or PostScript.
1375 (Reverse Polish Notation, RPN, is named after the Polish mathematician
1376 Jan \L ukasiewicz.)
1377 @end tex
1378
1379 The central component of an RPN calculator is the @dfn{stack}. A
1380 calculator stack is like a stack of dishes. New dishes (numbers) are
1381 added at the top of the stack, and numbers are normally only removed
1382 from the top of the stack.
1383
1384 @cindex Operators
1385 @cindex Operands
1386 In an operation like @expr{2+3}, the 2 and 3 are called the @dfn{operands}
1387 and the @expr{+} is the @dfn{operator}. In an RPN calculator you always
1388 enter the operands first, then the operator. Each time you type a
1389 number, Calc adds or @dfn{pushes} it onto the top of the Stack.
1390 When you press an operator key like @kbd{+}, Calc @dfn{pops} the appropriate
1391 number of operands from the stack and pushes back the result.
1392
1393 Thus we could add the numbers 2 and 3 in an RPN calculator by typing:
1394 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} +}. (The @key{RET} key, Return, corresponds to
1395 the @key{ENTER} key on traditional RPN calculators.) Try this now if
1396 you wish; type @kbd{C-x * c} to switch into the Calc window (you can type
1397 @kbd{C-x * c} again or @kbd{C-x * o} to switch back to the Tutorial window).
1398 The first four keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 2 and 3 onto the stack.
1399 The @kbd{+} key ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
1400 and pushes the result (5) back onto the stack. Here's how the stack
1401 will look at various points throughout the calculation:
1402
1403 @smallexample
1404 @group
1405 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1406 . 1: 3 .
1407 .
1408
1409 C-x * c 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} + @key{DEL}
1410 @end group
1411 @end smallexample
1412
1413 The @samp{.} symbol is a marker that represents the top of the stack.
1414 Note that the ``top'' of the stack is really shown at the bottom of
1415 the Stack window. This may seem backwards, but it turns out to be
1416 less distracting in regular use.
1417
1418 @cindex Stack levels
1419 @cindex Levels of stack
1420 The numbers @samp{1:} and @samp{2:} on the left are @dfn{stack level
1421 numbers}. Old RPN calculators always had four stack levels called
1422 @expr{x}, @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and @expr{t}. Calc's stack can grow
1423 as large as you like, so it uses numbers instead of letters. Some
1424 stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric argument that says
1425 which stack level to work on. Normal commands like @kbd{+} always
1426 work on the top few levels of the stack.
1427
1428 @c [fix-ref Truncating the Stack]
1429 The Stack buffer is just an Emacs buffer, and you can move around in
1430 it using the regular Emacs motion commands. But no matter where the
1431 cursor is, even if you have scrolled the @samp{.} marker out of
1432 view, most Calc commands always move the cursor back down to level 1
1433 before doing anything. It is possible to move the @samp{.} marker
1434 upwards through the stack, temporarily ``hiding'' some numbers from
1435 commands like @kbd{+}. This is called @dfn{stack truncation} and
1436 we will not cover it in this tutorial; @pxref{Truncating the Stack},
1437 if you are interested.
1438
1439 You don't really need the second @key{RET} in @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3
1440 @key{RET} +}. That's because if you type any operator name or
1441 other non-numeric key when you are entering a number, the Calculator
1442 automatically enters that number and then does the requested command.
1443 Thus @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +} will work just as well.
1444
1445 Examples in this tutorial will often omit @key{RET} even when the
1446 stack displays shown would only happen if you did press @key{RET}:
1447
1448 @smallexample
1449 @group
1450 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5
1451 . 1: 3 .
1452 .
1453
1454 2 @key{RET} 3 +
1455 @end group
1456 @end smallexample
1457
1458 @noindent
1459 Here, after pressing @kbd{3} the stack would really show @samp{1: 2}
1460 with @samp{Calc:@: 3} in the minibuffer. In these situations, you can
1461 press the optional @key{RET} to see the stack as the figure shows.
1462
1463 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} (This tutorial will include exercises
1464 at various points. Try them if you wish. Answers to all the exercises
1465 are located at the end of the Tutorial chapter. Each exercise will
1466 include a cross-reference to its particular answer. If you are
1467 reading with the Emacs Info system, press @kbd{f} and the
1468 exercise number to go to the answer, then the letter @kbd{l} to
1469 return to where you were.)
1470
1471 @noindent
1472 Here's the first exercise: What will the keystrokes @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2
1473 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -} compute? (@samp{*} is the symbol for
1474 multiplication.) Figure it out by hand, then try it with Calc to see
1475 if you're right. @xref{RPN Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1476
1477 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Compute
1478 @texline @math{(2\times4) + (7\times9.5) + {5\over4}}
1479 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4}
1480 using the stack. @xref{RPN Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
1481
1482 The @key{DEL} key is called Backspace on some keyboards. It is
1483 whatever key you would use to correct a simple typing error when
1484 regularly using Emacs. The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the
1485 top value on the stack. (You can still get that value back from
1486 the Trail if you should need it later on.) There are many places
1487 in this tutorial where we assume you have used @key{DEL} to erase the
1488 results of the previous example at the beginning of a new example.
1489 In the few places where it is really important to use @key{DEL} to
1490 clear away old results, the text will remind you to do so.
1491
1492 (It won't hurt to let things accumulate on the stack, except that
1493 whenever you give a display-mode-changing command Calc will have to
1494 spend a long time reformatting such a large stack.)
1495
1496 Since the @kbd{-} key is also an operator (it subtracts the top two
1497 stack elements), how does one enter a negative number? Calc uses
1498 the @kbd{_} (underscore) key to act like the minus sign in a number.
1499 So, typing @kbd{-5 @key{RET}} won't work because the @kbd{-} key
1500 will try to do a subtraction, but @kbd{_5 @key{RET}} works just fine.
1501
1502 You can also press @kbd{n}, which means ``change sign.'' It changes
1503 the number at the top of the stack (or the number being entered)
1504 from positive to negative or vice-versa: @kbd{5 n @key{RET}}.
1505
1506 @cindex Duplicating a stack entry
1507 If you press @key{RET} when you're not entering a number, the effect
1508 is to duplicate the top number on the stack. Consider this calculation:
1509
1510 @smallexample
1511 @group
1512 1: 3 2: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 81
1513 . 1: 3 . 1: 9 .
1514 . .
1515
1516 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * @key{RET} *
1517 @end group
1518 @end smallexample
1519
1520 @noindent
1521 (Of course, an easier way to do this would be @kbd{3 @key{RET} 4 ^},
1522 to raise 3 to the fourth power.)
1523
1524 The space-bar key (denoted @key{SPC} here) performs the same function
1525 as @key{RET}; you could replace all three occurrences of @key{RET} in
1526 the above example with @key{SPC} and the effect would be the same.
1527
1528 @cindex Exchanging stack entries
1529 Another stack manipulation key is @key{TAB}. This exchanges the top
1530 two stack entries. Suppose you have computed @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +}
1531 to get 5, and then you realize what you really wanted to compute
1532 was @expr{20 / (2+3)}.
1533
1534 @smallexample
1535 @group
1536 1: 5 2: 5 2: 20 1: 4
1537 . 1: 20 1: 5 .
1538 . .
1539
1540 2 @key{RET} 3 + 20 @key{TAB} /
1541 @end group
1542 @end smallexample
1543
1544 @noindent
1545 Planning ahead, the calculation would have gone like this:
1546
1547 @smallexample
1548 @group
1549 1: 20 2: 20 3: 20 2: 20 1: 4
1550 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 5 .
1551 . 1: 3 .
1552 .
1553
1554 20 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 + /
1555 @end group
1556 @end smallexample
1557
1558 A related stack command is @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (hold @key{META} and type
1559 @key{TAB}). It rotates the top three elements of the stack upward,
1560 bringing the object in level 3 to the top.
1561
1562 @smallexample
1563 @group
1564 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 20 3: 30
1565 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 30 2: 10
1566 . 1: 30 1: 10 1: 20
1567 . . .
1568
1569 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
1570 @end group
1571 @end smallexample
1572
1573 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Suppose the numbers 10, 20, and 30 are
1574 on the stack. Figure out how to add one to the number in level 2
1575 without affecting the rest of the stack. Also figure out how to add
1576 one to the number in level 3. @xref{RPN Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
1577
1578 Operations like @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/}, and @kbd{^} pop two
1579 arguments from the stack and push a result. Operations like @kbd{n} and
1580 @kbd{Q} (square root) pop a single number and push the result. You can
1581 think of them as simply operating on the top element of the stack.
1582
1583 @smallexample
1584 @group
1585 1: 3 1: 9 2: 9 1: 25 1: 5
1586 . . 1: 16 . .
1587 .
1588
1589 3 @key{RET} @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} @key{RET} * + Q
1590 @end group
1591 @end smallexample
1592
1593 @noindent
1594 (Note that capital @kbd{Q} means to hold down the Shift key while
1595 typing @kbd{q}. Remember, plain unshifted @kbd{q} is the Quit command.)
1596
1597 @cindex Pythagorean Theorem
1598 Here we've used the Pythagorean Theorem to determine the hypotenuse of a
1599 right triangle. Calc actually has a built-in command for that called
1600 @kbd{f h}, but let's suppose we can't remember the necessary keystrokes.
1601 We can still enter it by its full name using @kbd{M-x} notation:
1602
1603 @smallexample
1604 @group
1605 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1606 . 1: 4 .
1607 .
1608
1609 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} M-x calc-hypot
1610 @end group
1611 @end smallexample
1612
1613 All Calculator commands begin with the word @samp{calc-}. Since it
1614 gets tiring to type this, Calc provides an @kbd{x} key which is just
1615 like the regular Emacs @kbd{M-x} key except that it types the @samp{calc-}
1616 prefix for you:
1617
1618 @smallexample
1619 @group
1620 1: 3 2: 3 1: 5
1621 . 1: 4 .
1622 .
1623
1624 3 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET} x hypot
1625 @end group
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 What happens if you take the square root of a negative number?
1629
1630 @smallexample
1631 @group
1632 1: 4 1: -4 1: (0, 2)
1633 . . .
1634
1635 4 @key{RET} n Q
1636 @end group
1637 @end smallexample
1638
1639 @noindent
1640 The notation @expr{(a, b)} represents a complex number.
1641 Complex numbers are more traditionally written @expr{a + b i};
1642 Calc can display in this format, too, but for now we'll stick to the
1643 @expr{(a, b)} notation.
1644
1645 If you don't know how complex numbers work, you can safely ignore this
1646 feature. Complex numbers only arise from operations that would be
1647 errors in a calculator that didn't have complex numbers. (For example,
1648 taking the square root or logarithm of a negative number produces a
1649 complex result.)
1650
1651 Complex numbers are entered in the notation shown. The @kbd{(} and
1652 @kbd{,} and @kbd{)} keys manipulate ``incomplete complex numbers.''
1653
1654 @smallexample
1655 @group
1656 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
1657 . 1: 2 . 3 .
1658 . .
1659
1660 ( 2 , 3 )
1661 @end group
1662 @end smallexample
1663
1664 You can perform calculations while entering parts of incomplete objects.
1665 However, an incomplete object cannot actually participate in a calculation:
1666
1667 @smallexample
1668 @group
1669 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 3: ( ... 1: ( ... 1: ( ...
1670 . 1: 2 2: 2 5 5
1671 . 1: 3 . .
1672 .
1673 (error)
1674 ( 2 @key{RET} 3 + +
1675 @end group
1676 @end smallexample
1677
1678 @noindent
1679 Adding 5 to an incomplete object makes no sense, so the last command
1680 produces an error message and leaves the stack the same.
1681
1682 Incomplete objects can't participate in arithmetic, but they can be
1683 moved around by the regular stack commands.
1684
1685 @smallexample
1686 @group
1687 2: 2 3: 2 3: 3 1: ( ... 1: (2, 3)
1688 1: 3 2: 3 2: ( ... 2 .
1689 . 1: ( ... 1: 2 3
1690 . . .
1691
1692 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} ( M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} )
1693 @end group
1694 @end smallexample
1695
1696 @noindent
1697 Note that the @kbd{,} (comma) key did not have to be used here.
1698 When you press @kbd{)} all the stack entries between the incomplete
1699 entry and the top are collected, so there's never really a reason
1700 to use the comma. It's up to you.
1701
1702 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} To enter the complex number @expr{(2, 3)},
1703 your friend Joe typed @kbd{( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )}. What happened?
1704 (Joe thought of a clever way to correct his mistake in only two
1705 keystrokes, but it didn't quite work. Try it to find out why.)
1706 @xref{RPN Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
1707
1708 Vectors are entered the same way as complex numbers, but with square
1709 brackets in place of parentheses. We'll meet vectors again later in
1710 the tutorial.
1711
1712 Any Emacs command can be given a @dfn{numeric prefix argument} by
1713 typing a series of @key{META}-digits beforehand. If @key{META} is
1714 awkward for you, you can instead type @kbd{C-u} followed by the
1715 necessary digits. Numeric prefix arguments can be negative, as in
1716 @kbd{M-- M-3 M-5} or @w{@kbd{C-u - 3 5}}. Calc commands use numeric
1717 prefix arguments in a variety of ways. For example, a numeric prefix
1718 on the @kbd{+} operator adds any number of stack entries at once:
1719
1720 @smallexample
1721 @group
1722 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 1: 60
1723 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 .
1724 . 1: 30 1: 30
1725 . .
1726
1727 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u 3 +
1728 @end group
1729 @end smallexample
1730
1731 For stack manipulation commands like @key{RET}, a positive numeric
1732 prefix argument operates on the top @var{n} stack entries at once. A
1733 negative argument operates on the entry in level @var{n} only. An
1734 argument of zero operates on the entire stack. In this example, we copy
1735 the second-to-top element of the stack:
1736
1737 @smallexample
1738 @group
1739 1: 10 2: 10 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10
1740 . 1: 20 2: 20 2: 20 3: 20
1741 . 1: 30 1: 30 2: 30
1742 . . 1: 20
1743 .
1744
1745 10 @key{RET} 20 @key{RET} 30 @key{RET} C-u -2 @key{RET}
1746 @end group
1747 @end smallexample
1748
1749 @cindex Clearing the stack
1750 @cindex Emptying the stack
1751 Another common idiom is @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}, which clears the stack.
1752 (The @kbd{M-0} numeric prefix tells @key{DEL} to operate on the
1753 entire stack.)
1754
1755 @node Algebraic Tutorial, Undo Tutorial, RPN Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
1756 @subsection Algebraic-Style Calculations
1757
1758 @noindent
1759 If you are not used to RPN notation, you may prefer to operate the
1760 Calculator in Algebraic mode, which is closer to the way
1761 non-RPN calculators work. In Algebraic mode, you enter formulas
1762 in traditional @expr{2+3} notation.
1763
1764 @strong{Notice:} Calc gives @samp{/} lower precedence than @samp{*}, so
1765 that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}; this is not
1766 standard across all computer languages. See below for details.
1767
1768 You don't really need any special ``mode'' to enter algebraic formulas.
1769 You can enter a formula at any time by pressing the apostrophe (@kbd{'})
1770 key. Answer the prompt with the desired formula, then press @key{RET}.
1771 The formula is evaluated and the result is pushed onto the RPN stack.
1772 If you don't want to think in RPN at all, you can enter your whole
1773 computation as a formula, read the result from the stack, then press
1774 @key{DEL} to delete it from the stack.
1775
1776 Try pressing the apostrophe key, then @kbd{2+3+4}, then @key{RET}.
1777 The result should be the number 9.
1778
1779 Algebraic formulas use the operators @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*},
1780 @samp{/}, and @samp{^}. You can use parentheses to make the order
1781 of evaluation clear. In the absence of parentheses, @samp{^} is
1782 evaluated first, then @samp{*}, then @samp{/}, then finally
1783 @samp{+} and @samp{-}. For example, the expression
1784
1785 @example
1786 2 + 3*4*5 / 6*7^8 - 9
1787 @end example
1788
1789 @noindent
1790 is equivalent to
1791
1792 @example
1793 2 + ((3*4*5) / (6*(7^8)) - 9
1794 @end example
1795
1796 @noindent
1797 or, in large mathematical notation,
1798
1799 @ifnottex
1800 @example
1801 @group
1802 3 * 4 * 5
1803 2 + --------- - 9
1804 8
1805 6 * 7
1806 @end group
1807 @end example
1808 @end ifnottex
1809 @tex
1810 \beforedisplay
1811 $$ 2 + { 3 \times 4 \times 5 \over 6 \times 7^8 } - 9 $$
1812 \afterdisplay
1813 @end tex
1814
1815 @noindent
1816 The result of this expression will be the number @mathit{-6.99999826533}.
1817
1818 Calc's order of evaluation is the same as for most computer languages,
1819 except that @samp{*} binds more strongly than @samp{/}, as the above
1820 example shows. As in normal mathematical notation, the @samp{*} symbol
1821 can often be omitted: @samp{2 a} is the same as @samp{2*a}.
1822
1823 Operators at the same level are evaluated from left to right, except
1824 that @samp{^} is evaluated from right to left. Thus, @samp{2-3-4} is
1825 equivalent to @samp{(2-3)-4} or @mathit{-5}, whereas @samp{2^3^4} is equivalent
1826 to @samp{2^(3^4)} (a very large integer; try it!).
1827
1828 If you tire of typing the apostrophe all the time, there is
1829 Algebraic mode, where Calc automatically senses
1830 when you are about to type an algebraic expression. To enter this
1831 mode, press the two letters @w{@kbd{m a}}. (An @samp{Alg} indicator
1832 should appear in the Calc window's mode line.)
1833
1834 Press @kbd{m a}, then @kbd{2+3+4} with no apostrophe, then @key{RET}.
1835
1836 In Algebraic mode, when you press any key that would normally begin
1837 entering a number (such as a digit, a decimal point, or the @kbd{_}
1838 key), or if you press @kbd{(} or @kbd{[}, Calc automatically begins
1839 an algebraic entry.
1840
1841 Functions which do not have operator symbols like @samp{+} and @samp{*}
1842 must be entered in formulas using function-call notation. For example,
1843 the function name corresponding to the square-root key @kbd{Q} is
1844 @code{sqrt}. To compute a square root in a formula, you would use
1845 the notation @samp{sqrt(@var{x})}.
1846
1847 Press the apostrophe, then type @kbd{sqrt(5*2) - 3}. The result should
1848 be @expr{0.16227766017}.
1849
1850 Note that if the formula begins with a function name, you need to use
1851 the apostrophe even if you are in Algebraic mode. If you type @kbd{arcsin}
1852 out of the blue, the @kbd{a r} will be taken as an Algebraic Rewrite
1853 command, and the @kbd{csin} will be taken as the name of the rewrite
1854 rule to use!
1855
1856 Some people prefer to enter complex numbers and vectors in algebraic
1857 form because they find RPN entry with incomplete objects to be too
1858 distracting, even though they otherwise use Calc as an RPN calculator.
1859
1860 Still in Algebraic mode, type:
1861
1862 @smallexample
1863 @group
1864 1: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (8, -1) 2: (8, -1) 1: (9, -1)
1865 . 1: (1, -2) . 1: 1 .
1866 . .
1867
1868 (2,3) @key{RET} (1,-2) @key{RET} * 1 @key{RET} +
1869 @end group
1870 @end smallexample
1871
1872 Algebraic mode allows us to enter complex numbers without pressing
1873 an apostrophe first, but it also means we need to press @key{RET}
1874 after every entry, even for a simple number like @expr{1}.
1875
1876 (You can type @kbd{C-u m a} to enable a special Incomplete Algebraic
1877 mode in which the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys use algebraic entry even
1878 though regular numeric keys still use RPN numeric entry. There is also
1879 Total Algebraic mode, started by typing @kbd{m t}, in which all
1880 normal keys begin algebraic entry. You must then use the @key{META} key
1881 to type Calc commands: @kbd{M-m t} to get back out of Total Algebraic
1882 mode, @kbd{M-q} to quit, etc.)
1883
1884 If you're still in Algebraic mode, press @kbd{m a} again to turn it off.
1885
1886 Actual non-RPN calculators use a mixture of algebraic and RPN styles.
1887 In general, operators of two numbers (like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*})
1888 use algebraic form, but operators of one number (like @kbd{n} and @kbd{Q})
1889 use RPN form. Also, a non-RPN calculator allows you to see the
1890 intermediate results of a calculation as you go along. You can
1891 accomplish this in Calc by performing your calculation as a series
1892 of algebraic entries, using the @kbd{$} sign to tie them together.
1893 In an algebraic formula, @kbd{$} represents the number on the top
1894 of the stack. Here, we perform the calculation
1895 @texline @math{\sqrt{2\times4+1}},
1896 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2*4+1)},
1897 which on a traditional calculator would be done by pressing
1898 @kbd{2 * 4 + 1 =} and then the square-root key.
1899
1900 @smallexample
1901 @group
1902 1: 8 1: 9 1: 3
1903 . . .
1904
1905 ' 2*4 @key{RET} $+1 @key{RET} Q
1906 @end group
1907 @end smallexample
1908
1909 @noindent
1910 Notice that we didn't need to press an apostrophe for the @kbd{$+1},
1911 because the dollar sign always begins an algebraic entry.
1912
1913 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} How could you get the same effect as
1914 pressing @kbd{Q} but using an algebraic entry instead? How about
1915 if the @kbd{Q} key on your keyboard were broken?
1916 @xref{Algebraic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
1917
1918 The notations @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on stand for higher stack
1919 entries. For example, @kbd{' $$+$ @key{RET}} is just like typing @kbd{+}.
1920
1921 Algebraic formulas can include @dfn{variables}. To store in a
1922 variable, press @kbd{s s}, then type the variable name, then press
1923 @key{RET}. (There are actually two flavors of store command:
1924 @kbd{s s} stores a number in a variable but also leaves the number
1925 on the stack, while @w{@kbd{s t}} removes a number from the stack and
1926 stores it in the variable.) A variable name should consist of one
1927 or more letters or digits, beginning with a letter.
1928
1929 @smallexample
1930 @group
1931 1: 17 . 1: a + a^2 1: 306
1932 . . .
1933
1934 17 s t a @key{RET} ' a+a^2 @key{RET} =
1935 @end group
1936 @end smallexample
1937
1938 @noindent
1939 The @kbd{=} key @dfn{evaluates} a formula by replacing all its
1940 variables by the values that were stored in them.
1941
1942 For RPN calculations, you can recall a variable's value on the
1943 stack either by entering its name as a formula and pressing @kbd{=},
1944 or by using the @kbd{s r} command.
1945
1946 @smallexample
1947 @group
1948 1: 17 2: 17 3: 17 2: 17 1: 306
1949 . 1: 17 2: 17 1: 289 .
1950 . 1: 2 .
1951 .
1952
1953 s r a @key{RET} ' a @key{RET} = 2 ^ +
1954 @end group
1955 @end smallexample
1956
1957 If you press a single digit for a variable name (as in @kbd{s t 3}, you
1958 get one of ten @dfn{quick variables} @code{q0} through @code{q9}.
1959 They are ``quick'' simply because you don't have to type the letter
1960 @code{q} or the @key{RET} after their names. In fact, you can type
1961 simply @kbd{s 3} as a shorthand for @kbd{s s 3}, and likewise for
1962 @kbd{t 3} and @w{@kbd{r 3}}.
1963
1964 Any variables in an algebraic formula for which you have not stored
1965 values are left alone, even when you evaluate the formula.
1966
1967 @smallexample
1968 @group
1969 1: 2 a + 2 b 1: 2 b + 34
1970 . .
1971
1972 ' 2a+2b @key{RET} =
1973 @end group
1974 @end smallexample
1975
1976 Calls to function names which are undefined in Calc are also left
1977 alone, as are calls for which the value is undefined.
1978
1979 @smallexample
1980 @group
1981 1: log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5, 6) + foo(3) + 2
1982 .
1983
1984 ' log10(100) + log10(0) + log10(x) + log10(5,6) + foo(3) @key{RET}
1985 @end group
1986 @end smallexample
1987
1988 @noindent
1989 In this example, the first call to @code{log10} works, but the other
1990 calls are not evaluated. In the second call, the logarithm is
1991 undefined for that value of the argument; in the third, the argument
1992 is symbolic, and in the fourth, there are too many arguments. In the
1993 fifth case, there is no function called @code{foo}. You will see a
1994 ``Wrong number of arguments'' message referring to @samp{log10(5,6)}.
1995 Press the @kbd{w} (``why'') key to see any other messages that may
1996 have arisen from the last calculation. In this case you will get
1997 ``logarithm of zero,'' then ``number expected: @code{x}''. Calc
1998 automatically displays the first message only if the message is
1999 sufficiently important; for example, Calc considers ``wrong number
2000 of arguments'' and ``logarithm of zero'' to be important enough to
2001 report automatically, while a message like ``number expected: @code{x}''
2002 will only show up if you explicitly press the @kbd{w} key.
2003
2004 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Joe entered the formula @samp{2 x y},
2005 stored 5 in @code{x}, pressed @kbd{=}, and got the expected result,
2006 @samp{10 y}. He then tried the same for the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)},
2007 expecting @samp{10 (1+y)}, but it didn't work. Why not?
2008 @xref{Algebraic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2009
2010 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} What result would you expect
2011 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} to give? What if you then type @kbd{0 *}?
2012 @xref{Algebraic Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2013
2014 One interesting way to work with variables is to use the
2015 @dfn{evaluates-to} (@samp{=>}) operator. It works like this:
2016 Enter a formula algebraically in the usual way, but follow
2017 the formula with an @samp{=>} symbol. (There is also an @kbd{s =}
2018 command which builds an @samp{=>} formula using the stack.) On
2019 the stack, you will see two copies of the formula with an @samp{=>}
2020 between them. The lefthand formula is exactly like you typed it;
2021 the righthand formula has been evaluated as if by typing @kbd{=}.
2022
2023 @smallexample
2024 @group
2025 2: 2 + 3 => 5 2: 2 + 3 => 5
2026 1: 2 a + 2 b => 34 + 2 b 1: 2 a + 2 b => 20 + 2 b
2027 . .
2028
2029 ' 2+3 => @key{RET} ' 2a+2b @key{RET} s = 10 s t a @key{RET}
2030 @end group
2031 @end smallexample
2032
2033 @noindent
2034 Notice that the instant we stored a new value in @code{a}, all
2035 @samp{=>} operators already on the stack that referred to @expr{a}
2036 were updated to use the new value. With @samp{=>}, you can push a
2037 set of formulas on the stack, then change the variables experimentally
2038 to see the effects on the formulas' values.
2039
2040 You can also ``unstore'' a variable when you are through with it:
2041
2042 @smallexample
2043 @group
2044 2: 2 + 5 => 5
2045 1: 2 a + 2 b => 2 a + 2 b
2046 .
2047
2048 s u a @key{RET}
2049 @end group
2050 @end smallexample
2051
2052 We will encounter formulas involving variables and functions again
2053 when we discuss the algebra and calculus features of the Calculator.
2054
2055 @node Undo Tutorial, Modes Tutorial, Algebraic Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2056 @subsection Undo and Redo
2057
2058 @noindent
2059 If you make a mistake, you can usually correct it by pressing shift-@kbd{U},
2060 the ``undo'' command. First, clear the stack (@kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}}) and exit
2061 and restart Calc (@kbd{C-x * * C-x * *}) to make sure things start off
2062 with a clean slate. Now:
2063
2064 @smallexample
2065 @group
2066 1: 2 2: 2 1: 8 2: 2 1: 6
2067 . 1: 3 . 1: 3 .
2068 . .
2069
2070 2 @key{RET} 3 ^ U *
2071 @end group
2072 @end smallexample
2073
2074 You can undo any number of times. Calc keeps a complete record of
2075 all you have done since you last opened the Calc window. After the
2076 above example, you could type:
2077
2078 @smallexample
2079 @group
2080 1: 6 2: 2 1: 2 . .
2081 . 1: 3 .
2082 .
2083 (error)
2084 U U U U
2085 @end group
2086 @end smallexample
2087
2088 You can also type @kbd{D} to ``redo'' a command that you have undone
2089 mistakenly.
2090
2091 @smallexample
2092 @group
2093 . 1: 2 2: 2 1: 6 1: 6
2094 . 1: 3 . .
2095 .
2096 (error)
2097 D D D D
2098 @end group
2099 @end smallexample
2100
2101 @noindent
2102 It was not possible to redo past the @expr{6}, since that was placed there
2103 by something other than an undo command.
2104
2105 @cindex Time travel
2106 You can think of undo and redo as a sort of ``time machine.'' Press
2107 @kbd{U} to go backward in time, @kbd{D} to go forward. If you go
2108 backward and do something (like @kbd{*}) then, as any science fiction
2109 reader knows, you have changed your future and you cannot go forward
2110 again. Thus, the inability to redo past the @expr{6} even though there
2111 was an earlier undo command.
2112
2113 You can always recall an earlier result using the Trail. We've ignored
2114 the trail so far, but it has been faithfully recording everything we
2115 did since we loaded the Calculator. If the Trail is not displayed,
2116 press @kbd{t d} now to turn it on.
2117
2118 Let's try grabbing an earlier result. The @expr{8} we computed was
2119 undone by a @kbd{U} command, and was lost even to Redo when we pressed
2120 @kbd{*}, but it's still there in the trail. There should be a little
2121 @samp{>} arrow (the @dfn{trail pointer}) resting on the last trail
2122 entry. If there isn't, press @kbd{t ]} to reset the trail pointer.
2123 Now, press @w{@kbd{t p}} to move the arrow onto the line containing
2124 @expr{8}, and press @w{@kbd{t y}} to ``yank'' that number back onto the
2125 stack.
2126
2127 If you press @kbd{t ]} again, you will see that even our Yank command
2128 went into the trail.
2129
2130 Let's go further back in time. Earlier in the tutorial we computed
2131 a huge integer using the formula @samp{2^3^4}. We don't remember
2132 what it was, but the first digits were ``241''. Press @kbd{t r}
2133 (which stands for trail-search-reverse), then type @kbd{241}.
2134 The trail cursor will jump back to the next previous occurrence of
2135 the string ``241'' in the trail. This is just a regular Emacs
2136 incremental search; you can now press @kbd{C-s} or @kbd{C-r} to
2137 continue the search forwards or backwards as you like.
2138
2139 To finish the search, press @key{RET}. This halts the incremental
2140 search and leaves the trail pointer at the thing we found. Now we
2141 can type @kbd{t y} to yank that number onto the stack. If we hadn't
2142 remembered the ``241'', we could simply have searched for @kbd{2^3^4},
2143 then pressed @kbd{@key{RET} t n} to halt and then move to the next item.
2144
2145 You may have noticed that all the trail-related commands begin with
2146 the letter @kbd{t}. (The store-and-recall commands, on the other hand,
2147 all began with @kbd{s}.) Calc has so many commands that there aren't
2148 enough keys for all of them, so various commands are grouped into
2149 two-letter sequences where the first letter is called the @dfn{prefix}
2150 key. If you type a prefix key by accident, you can press @kbd{C-g}
2151 to cancel it. (In fact, you can press @kbd{C-g} to cancel almost
2152 anything in Emacs.) To get help on a prefix key, press that key
2153 followed by @kbd{?}. Some prefixes have several lines of help,
2154 so you need to press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see them all.
2155 You can also type @kbd{h h} to see all the help at once.
2156
2157 Try pressing @kbd{t ?} now. You will see a line of the form,
2158
2159 @smallexample
2160 trail/time: Display; Fwd, Back; Next, Prev, Here, [, ]; Yank: [MORE] t-
2161 @end smallexample
2162
2163 @noindent
2164 The word ``trail'' indicates that the @kbd{t} prefix key contains
2165 trail-related commands. Each entry on the line shows one command,
2166 with a single capital letter showing which letter you press to get
2167 that command. We have used @kbd{t n}, @kbd{t p}, @kbd{t ]}, and
2168 @kbd{t y} so far. The @samp{[MORE]} means you can press @kbd{?}
2169 again to see more @kbd{t}-prefix commands. Notice that the commands
2170 are roughly divided (by semicolons) into related groups.
2171
2172 When you are in the help display for a prefix key, the prefix is
2173 still active. If you press another key, like @kbd{y} for example,
2174 it will be interpreted as a @kbd{t y} command. If all you wanted
2175 was to look at the help messages, press @kbd{C-g} afterwards to cancel
2176 the prefix.
2177
2178 One more way to correct an error is by editing the stack entries.
2179 The actual Stack buffer is marked read-only and must not be edited
2180 directly, but you can press @kbd{`} (the backquote or accent grave)
2181 to edit a stack entry.
2182
2183 Try entering @samp{3.141439} now. If this is supposed to represent
2184 @cpi{}, it's got several errors. Press @kbd{`} to edit this number.
2185 Now use the normal Emacs cursor motion and editing keys to change
2186 the second 4 to a 5, and to transpose the 3 and the 9. When you
2187 press @key{RET}, the number on the stack will be replaced by your
2188 new number. This works for formulas, vectors, and all other types
2189 of values you can put on the stack. The @kbd{`} key also works
2190 during entry of a number or algebraic formula.
2191
2192 @node Modes Tutorial, , Undo Tutorial, Basic Tutorial
2193 @subsection Mode-Setting Commands
2194
2195 @noindent
2196 Calc has many types of @dfn{modes} that affect the way it interprets
2197 your commands or the way it displays data. We have already seen one
2198 mode, namely Algebraic mode. There are many others, too; we'll
2199 try some of the most common ones here.
2200
2201 Perhaps the most fundamental mode in Calc is the current @dfn{precision}.
2202 Notice the @samp{12} on the Calc window's mode line:
2203
2204 @smallexample
2205 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg (Calculator)----All------
2206 @end smallexample
2207
2208 @noindent
2209 Most of the symbols there are Emacs things you don't need to worry
2210 about, but the @samp{12} and the @samp{Deg} are mode indicators.
2211 The @samp{12} means that calculations should always be carried to
2212 12 significant figures. That is why, when we type @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /},
2213 we get @expr{0.142857142857} with exactly 12 digits, not counting
2214 leading and trailing zeros.
2215
2216 You can set the precision to anything you like by pressing @kbd{p},
2217 then entering a suitable number. Try pressing @kbd{p 30 @key{RET}},
2218 then doing @kbd{1 @key{RET} 7 /} again:
2219
2220 @smallexample
2221 @group
2222 1: 0.142857142857
2223 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2224 .
2225 @end group
2226 @end smallexample
2227
2228 Although the precision can be set arbitrarily high, Calc always
2229 has to have @emph{some} value for the current precision. After
2230 all, the true value @expr{1/7} is an infinitely repeating decimal;
2231 Calc has to stop somewhere.
2232
2233 Of course, calculations are slower the more digits you request.
2234 Press @w{@kbd{p 12}} now to set the precision back down to the default.
2235
2236 Calculations always use the current precision. For example, even
2237 though we have a 30-digit value for @expr{1/7} on the stack, if
2238 we use it in a calculation in 12-digit mode it will be rounded
2239 down to 12 digits before it is used. Try it; press @key{RET} to
2240 duplicate the number, then @w{@kbd{1 +}}. Notice that the @key{RET}
2241 key didn't round the number, because it doesn't do any calculation.
2242 But the instant we pressed @kbd{+}, the number was rounded down.
2243
2244 @smallexample
2245 @group
2246 1: 0.142857142857
2247 2: 0.142857142857142857142857142857
2248 3: 1.14285714286
2249 .
2250 @end group
2251 @end smallexample
2252
2253 @noindent
2254 In fact, since we added a digit on the left, we had to lose one
2255 digit on the right from even the 12-digit value of @expr{1/7}.
2256
2257 How did we get more than 12 digits when we computed @samp{2^3^4}? The
2258 answer is that Calc makes a distinction between @dfn{integers} and
2259 @dfn{floating-point} numbers, or @dfn{floats}. An integer is a number
2260 that does not contain a decimal point. There is no such thing as an
2261 ``infinitely repeating fraction integer,'' so Calc doesn't have to limit
2262 itself. If you asked for @samp{2^10000} (don't try this!), you would
2263 have to wait a long time but you would eventually get an exact answer.
2264 If you ask for @samp{2.^10000}, you will quickly get an answer which is
2265 correct only to 12 places. The decimal point tells Calc that it should
2266 use floating-point arithmetic to get the answer, not exact integer
2267 arithmetic.
2268
2269 You can use the @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) command to convert a
2270 floating-point value to an integer, and @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float})
2271 to convert an integer to floating-point form.
2272
2273 Let's try entering that last calculation:
2274
2275 @smallexample
2276 @group
2277 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311689e3010
2278 . 1: 10000 .
2279 .
2280
2281 2.0 @key{RET} 10000 @key{RET} ^
2282 @end group
2283 @end smallexample
2284
2285 @noindent
2286 @cindex Scientific notation, entry of
2287 Notice the letter @samp{e} in there. It represents ``times ten to the
2288 power of,'' and is used by Calc automatically whenever writing the
2289 number out fully would introduce more extra zeros than you probably
2290 want to see. You can enter numbers in this notation, too.
2291
2292 @smallexample
2293 @group
2294 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.99506311678e3010
2295 . 1: 10000. .
2296 .
2297
2298 2.0 @key{RET} 1e4 @key{RET} ^
2299 @end group
2300 @end smallexample
2301
2302 @cindex Round-off errors
2303 @noindent
2304 Hey, the answer is different! Look closely at the middle columns
2305 of the two examples. In the first, the stack contained the
2306 exact integer @expr{10000}, but in the second it contained
2307 a floating-point value with a decimal point. When you raise a
2308 number to an integer power, Calc uses repeated squaring and
2309 multiplication to get the answer. When you use a floating-point
2310 power, Calc uses logarithms and exponentials. As you can see,
2311 a slight error crept in during one of these methods. Which
2312 one should we trust? Let's raise the precision a bit and find
2313 out:
2314
2315 @smallexample
2316 @group
2317 . 1: 2. 2: 2. 1: 1.995063116880828e3010
2318 . 1: 10000. .
2319 .
2320
2321 p 16 @key{RET} 2. @key{RET} 1e4 ^ p 12 @key{RET}
2322 @end group
2323 @end smallexample
2324
2325 @noindent
2326 @cindex Guard digits
2327 Presumably, it doesn't matter whether we do this higher-precision
2328 calculation using an integer or floating-point power, since we
2329 have added enough ``guard digits'' to trust the first 12 digits
2330 no matter what. And the verdict is@dots{} Integer powers were more
2331 accurate; in fact, the result was only off by one unit in the
2332 last place.
2333
2334 @cindex Guard digits
2335 Calc does many of its internal calculations to a slightly higher
2336 precision, but it doesn't always bump the precision up enough.
2337 In each case, Calc added about two digits of precision during
2338 its calculation and then rounded back down to 12 digits
2339 afterward. In one case, it was enough; in the other, it
2340 wasn't. If you really need @var{x} digits of precision, it
2341 never hurts to do the calculation with a few extra guard digits.
2342
2343 What if we want guard digits but don't want to look at them?
2344 We can set the @dfn{float format}. Calc supports four major
2345 formats for floating-point numbers, called @dfn{normal},
2346 @dfn{fixed-point}, @dfn{scientific notation}, and @dfn{engineering
2347 notation}. You get them by pressing @w{@kbd{d n}}, @kbd{d f},
2348 @kbd{d s}, and @kbd{d e}, respectively. In each case, you can
2349 supply a numeric prefix argument which says how many digits
2350 should be displayed. As an example, let's put a few numbers
2351 onto the stack and try some different display modes. First,
2352 use @kbd{M-0 @key{DEL}} to clear the stack, then enter the four
2353 numbers shown here:
2354
2355 @smallexample
2356 @group
2357 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2358 3: 12345. 3: 12300. 3: 1.2345e4 3: 1.23e4 3: 12345.000
2359 2: 123.45 2: 123. 2: 1.2345e2 2: 1.23e2 2: 123.450
2360 1: 12.345 1: 12.3 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.23e1 1: 12.345
2361 . . . . .
2362
2363 d n M-3 d n d s M-3 d s M-3 d f
2364 @end group
2365 @end smallexample
2366
2367 @noindent
2368 Notice that when we typed @kbd{M-3 d n}, the numbers were rounded down
2369 to three significant digits, but then when we typed @kbd{d s} all
2370 five significant figures reappeared. The float format does not
2371 affect how numbers are stored, it only affects how they are
2372 displayed. Only the current precision governs the actual rounding
2373 of numbers in the Calculator's memory.
2374
2375 Engineering notation, not shown here, is like scientific notation
2376 except the exponent (the power-of-ten part) is always adjusted to be
2377 a multiple of three (as in ``kilo,'' ``micro,'' etc.). As a result
2378 there will be one, two, or three digits before the decimal point.
2379
2380 Whenever you change a display-related mode, Calc redraws everything
2381 in the stack. This may be slow if there are many things on the stack,
2382 so Calc allows you to type shift-@kbd{H} before any mode command to
2383 prevent it from updating the stack. Anything Calc displays after the
2384 mode-changing command will appear in the new format.
2385
2386 @smallexample
2387 @group
2388 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345 4: 12345
2389 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 12345.000 3: 1.2345e4 3: 12345.
2390 2: 123.450 2: 123.450 2: 1.2345e1 2: 1.2345e1 2: 123.45
2391 1: 12.345 1: 1.2345e1 1: 1.2345e2 1: 1.2345e2 1: 12.345
2392 . . . . .
2393
2394 H d s @key{DEL} U @key{TAB} d @key{SPC} d n
2395 @end group
2396 @end smallexample
2397
2398 @noindent
2399 Here the @kbd{H d s} command changes to scientific notation but without
2400 updating the screen. Deleting the top stack entry and undoing it back
2401 causes it to show up in the new format; swapping the top two stack
2402 entries reformats both entries. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command refreshes the
2403 whole stack. The @kbd{d n} command changes back to the normal float
2404 format; since it doesn't have an @kbd{H} prefix, it also updates all
2405 the stack entries to be in @kbd{d n} format.
2406
2407 Notice that the integer @expr{12345} was not affected by any
2408 of the float formats. Integers are integers, and are always
2409 displayed exactly.
2410
2411 @cindex Large numbers, readability
2412 Large integers have their own problems. Let's look back at
2413 the result of @kbd{2^3^4}.
2414
2415 @example
2416 2417851639229258349412352
2417 @end example
2418
2419 @noindent
2420 Quick---how many digits does this have? Try typing @kbd{d g}:
2421
2422 @example
2423 2,417,851,639,229,258,349,412,352
2424 @end example
2425
2426 @noindent
2427 Now how many digits does this have? It's much easier to tell!
2428 We can actually group digits into clumps of any size. Some
2429 people prefer @kbd{M-5 d g}:
2430
2431 @example
2432 24178,51639,22925,83494,12352
2433 @end example
2434
2435 Let's see what happens to floating-point numbers when they are grouped.
2436 First, type @kbd{p 25 @key{RET}} to make sure we have enough precision
2437 to get ourselves into trouble. Now, type @kbd{1e13 /}:
2438
2439 @example
2440 24,17851,63922.9258349412352
2441 @end example
2442
2443 @noindent
2444 The integer part is grouped but the fractional part isn't. Now try
2445 @kbd{M-- M-5 d g} (that's meta-minus-sign, meta-five):
2446
2447 @example
2448 24,17851,63922.92583,49412,352
2449 @end example
2450
2451 If you find it hard to tell the decimal point from the commas, try
2452 changing the grouping character to a space with @kbd{d , @key{SPC}}:
2453
2454 @example
2455 24 17851 63922.92583 49412 352
2456 @end example
2457
2458 Type @kbd{d , ,} to restore the normal grouping character, then
2459 @kbd{d g} again to turn grouping off. Also, press @kbd{p 12} to
2460 restore the default precision.
2461
2462 Press @kbd{U} enough times to get the original big integer back.
2463 (Notice that @kbd{U} does not undo each mode-setting command; if
2464 you want to undo a mode-setting command, you have to do it yourself.)
2465 Now, type @kbd{d r 16 @key{RET}}:
2466
2467 @example
2468 16#200000000000000000000
2469 @end example
2470
2471 @noindent
2472 The number is now displayed in @dfn{hexadecimal}, or ``base-16'' form.
2473 Suddenly it looks pretty simple; this should be no surprise, since we
2474 got this number by computing a power of two, and 16 is a power of 2.
2475 In fact, we can use @w{@kbd{d r 2 @key{RET}}} to see it in actual binary
2476 form:
2477
2478 @example
2479 2#1000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000000 @dots{}
2480 @end example
2481
2482 @noindent
2483 We don't have enough space here to show all the zeros! They won't
2484 fit on a typical screen, either, so you will have to use horizontal
2485 scrolling to see them all. Press @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} to scroll the
2486 stack window left and right by half its width. Another way to view
2487 something large is to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the top of
2488 stack in a separate window. (Press @kbd{C-c C-c} when you are done.)
2489
2490 You can enter non-decimal numbers using the @kbd{#} symbol, too.
2491 Let's see what the hexadecimal number @samp{5FE} looks like in
2492 binary. Type @kbd{16#5FE} (the letters can be typed in upper or
2493 lower case; they will always appear in upper case). It will also
2494 help to turn grouping on with @kbd{d g}:
2495
2496 @example
2497 2#101,1111,1110
2498 @end example
2499
2500 Notice that @kbd{d g} groups by fours by default if the display radix
2501 is binary or hexadecimal, but by threes if it is decimal, octal, or any
2502 other radix.
2503
2504 Now let's see that number in decimal; type @kbd{d r 10}:
2505
2506 @example
2507 1,534
2508 @end example
2509
2510 Numbers are not @emph{stored} with any particular radix attached. They're
2511 just numbers; they can be entered in any radix, and are always displayed
2512 in whatever radix you've chosen with @kbd{d r}. The current radix applies
2513 to integers, fractions, and floats.
2514
2515 @cindex Roundoff errors, in non-decimal numbers
2516 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Your friend Joe tried to enter one-third
2517 as @samp{3#0.1} in @kbd{d r 3} mode with a precision of 12. He got
2518 @samp{3#0.0222222...} (with 25 2's) in the display. When he multiplied
2519 that by three, he got @samp{3#0.222222...} instead of the expected
2520 @samp{3#1}. Next, Joe entered @samp{3#0.2} and, to his great relief,
2521 saw @samp{3#0.2} on the screen. But when he typed @kbd{2 /}, he got
2522 @samp{3#0.10000001} (some zeros omitted). What's going on here?
2523 @xref{Modes Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2524
2525 @cindex Scientific notation, in non-decimal numbers
2526 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Scientific notation works in non-decimal
2527 modes in the natural way (the exponent is a power of the radix instead of
2528 a power of ten, although the exponent itself is always written in decimal).
2529 Thus @samp{8#1.23e3 = 8#1230.0}. Suppose we have the hexadecimal number
2530 @samp{f.e8f} times 16 to the 15th power: We write @samp{16#f.e8fe15}.
2531 What is wrong with this picture? What could we write instead that would
2532 work better? @xref{Modes Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2533
2534 The @kbd{m} prefix key has another set of modes, relating to the way
2535 Calc interprets your inputs and does computations. Whereas @kbd{d}-prefix
2536 modes generally affect the way things look, @kbd{m}-prefix modes affect
2537 the way they are actually computed.
2538
2539 The most popular @kbd{m}-prefix mode is the @dfn{angular mode}. Notice
2540 the @samp{Deg} indicator in the mode line. This means that if you use
2541 a command that interprets a number as an angle, it will assume the
2542 angle is measured in degrees. For example,
2543
2544 @smallexample
2545 @group
2546 1: 45 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001 1: 0.5
2547 . . . .
2548
2549 45 S 2 ^ c 1
2550 @end group
2551 @end smallexample
2552
2553 @noindent
2554 The shift-@kbd{S} command computes the sine of an angle. The sine
2555 of 45 degrees is
2556 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2};
2557 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2};
2558 squaring this yields @expr{2/4 = 0.5}. However, there has been a slight
2559 roundoff error because the representation of
2560 @texline @math{\sqrt{2}/2}
2561 @infoline @expr{sqrt(2)/2}
2562 wasn't exact. The @kbd{c 1} command is a handy way to clean up numbers
2563 in this case; it temporarily reduces the precision by one digit while it
2564 re-rounds the number on the top of the stack.
2565
2566 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2567 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe computed the sine
2568 of 45 degrees as shown above, then, hoping to avoid an inexact
2569 result, he increased the precision to 16 digits before squaring.
2570 What happened? @xref{Modes Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
2571
2572 To do this calculation in radians, we would type @kbd{m r} first.
2573 (The indicator changes to @samp{Rad}.) 45 degrees corresponds to
2574 @cpiover{4} radians. To get @cpi{}, press the @kbd{P} key. (Once
2575 again, this is a shifted capital @kbd{P}. Remember, unshifted
2576 @kbd{p} sets the precision.)
2577
2578 @smallexample
2579 @group
2580 1: 3.14159265359 1: 0.785398163398 1: 0.707106781187
2581 . . .
2582
2583 P 4 / m r S
2584 @end group
2585 @end smallexample
2586
2587 Likewise, inverse trigonometric functions generate results in
2588 either radians or degrees, depending on the current angular mode.
2589
2590 @smallexample
2591 @group
2592 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.785398163398 1: 45.
2593 . . .
2594
2595 .5 Q m r I S m d U I S
2596 @end group
2597 @end smallexample
2598
2599 @noindent
2600 Here we compute the Inverse Sine of
2601 @texline @math{\sqrt{0.5}},
2602 @infoline @expr{sqrt(0.5)},
2603 first in radians, then in degrees.
2604
2605 Use @kbd{c d} and @kbd{c r} to convert a number from radians to degrees
2606 and vice-versa.
2607
2608 @smallexample
2609 @group
2610 1: 45 1: 0.785398163397 1: 45.
2611 . . .
2612
2613 45 c r c d
2614 @end group
2615 @end smallexample
2616
2617 Another interesting mode is @dfn{Fraction mode}. Normally,
2618 dividing two integers produces a floating-point result if the
2619 quotient can't be expressed as an exact integer. Fraction mode
2620 causes integer division to produce a fraction, i.e., a rational
2621 number, instead.
2622
2623 @smallexample
2624 @group
2625 2: 12 1: 1.33333333333 1: 4:3
2626 1: 9 . .
2627 .
2628
2629 12 @key{RET} 9 / m f U / m f
2630 @end group
2631 @end smallexample
2632
2633 @noindent
2634 In the first case, we get an approximate floating-point result.
2635 In the second case, we get an exact fractional result (four-thirds).
2636
2637 You can enter a fraction at any time using @kbd{:} notation.
2638 (Calc uses @kbd{:} instead of @kbd{/} as the fraction separator
2639 because @kbd{/} is already used to divide the top two stack
2640 elements.) Calculations involving fractions will always
2641 produce exact fractional results; Fraction mode only says
2642 what to do when dividing two integers.
2643
2644 @cindex Fractions vs. floats
2645 @cindex Floats vs. fractions
2646 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} If fractional arithmetic is exact,
2647 why would you ever use floating-point numbers instead?
2648 @xref{Modes Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
2649
2650 Typing @kbd{m f} doesn't change any existing values in the stack.
2651 In the above example, we had to Undo the division and do it over
2652 again when we changed to Fraction mode. But if you use the
2653 evaluates-to operator you can get commands like @kbd{m f} to
2654 recompute for you.
2655
2656 @smallexample
2657 @group
2658 1: 12 / 9 => 1.33333333333 1: 12 / 9 => 1.333 1: 12 / 9 => 4:3
2659 . . .
2660
2661 ' 12/9 => @key{RET} p 4 @key{RET} m f
2662 @end group
2663 @end smallexample
2664
2665 @noindent
2666 In this example, the righthand side of the @samp{=>} operator
2667 on the stack is recomputed when we change the precision, then
2668 again when we change to Fraction mode. All @samp{=>} expressions
2669 on the stack are recomputed every time you change any mode that
2670 might affect their values.
2671
2672 @node Arithmetic Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Basic Tutorial, Tutorial
2673 @section Arithmetic Tutorial
2674
2675 @noindent
2676 In this section, we explore the arithmetic and scientific functions
2677 available in the Calculator.
2678
2679 The standard arithmetic commands are @kbd{+}, @kbd{-}, @kbd{*}, @kbd{/},
2680 and @kbd{^}. Each normally takes two numbers from the top of the stack
2681 and pushes back a result. The @kbd{n} and @kbd{&} keys perform
2682 change-sign and reciprocal operations, respectively.
2683
2684 @smallexample
2685 @group
2686 1: 5 1: 0.2 1: 5. 1: -5. 1: 5.
2687 . . . . .
2688
2689 5 & & n n
2690 @end group
2691 @end smallexample
2692
2693 @cindex Binary operators
2694 You can apply a ``binary operator'' like @kbd{+} across any number of
2695 stack entries by giving it a numeric prefix. You can also apply it
2696 pairwise to several stack elements along with the top one if you use
2697 a negative prefix.
2698
2699 @smallexample
2700 @group
2701 3: 2 1: 9 3: 2 4: 2 3: 12
2702 2: 3 . 2: 3 3: 3 2: 13
2703 1: 4 1: 4 2: 4 1: 14
2704 . . 1: 10 .
2705 .
2706
2707 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 + U 10 M-- M-3 +
2708 @end group
2709 @end smallexample
2710
2711 @cindex Unary operators
2712 You can apply a ``unary operator'' like @kbd{&} to the top @var{n}
2713 stack entries with a numeric prefix, too.
2714
2715 @smallexample
2716 @group
2717 3: 2 3: 0.5 3: 0.5
2718 2: 3 2: 0.333333333333 2: 3.
2719 1: 4 1: 0.25 1: 4.
2720 . . .
2721
2722 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 M-3 & M-2 &
2723 @end group
2724 @end smallexample
2725
2726 Notice that the results here are left in floating-point form.
2727 We can convert them back to integers by pressing @kbd{F}, the
2728 ``floor'' function. This function rounds down to the next lower
2729 integer. There is also @kbd{R}, which rounds to the nearest
2730 integer.
2731
2732 @smallexample
2733 @group
2734 7: 2. 7: 2 7: 2
2735 6: 2.4 6: 2 6: 2
2736 5: 2.5 5: 2 5: 3
2737 4: 2.6 4: 2 4: 3
2738 3: -2. 3: -2 3: -2
2739 2: -2.4 2: -3 2: -2
2740 1: -2.6 1: -3 1: -3
2741 . . .
2742
2743 M-7 F U M-7 R
2744 @end group
2745 @end smallexample
2746
2747 Since dividing-and-flooring (i.e., ``integer quotient'') is such a
2748 common operation, Calc provides a special command for that purpose, the
2749 backslash @kbd{\}. Another common arithmetic operator is @kbd{%}, which
2750 computes the remainder that would arise from a @kbd{\} operation, i.e.,
2751 the ``modulo'' of two numbers. For example,
2752
2753 @smallexample
2754 @group
2755 2: 1234 1: 12 2: 1234 1: 34
2756 1: 100 . 1: 100 .
2757 . .
2758
2759 1234 @key{RET} 100 \ U %
2760 @end group
2761 @end smallexample
2762
2763 These commands actually work for any real numbers, not just integers.
2764
2765 @smallexample
2766 @group
2767 2: 3.1415 1: 3 2: 3.1415 1: 0.1415
2768 1: 1 . 1: 1 .
2769 . .
2770
2771 3.1415 @key{RET} 1 \ U %
2772 @end group
2773 @end smallexample
2774
2775 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The @kbd{\} command would appear to be a
2776 frill, since you could always do the same thing with @kbd{/ F}. Think
2777 of a situation where this is not true---@kbd{/ F} would be inadequate.
2778 Now think of a way you could get around the problem if Calc didn't
2779 provide a @kbd{\} command. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
2780
2781 We've already seen the @kbd{Q} (square root) and @kbd{S} (sine)
2782 commands. Other commands along those lines are @kbd{C} (cosine),
2783 @kbd{T} (tangent), @kbd{E} (@expr{e^x}) and @kbd{L} (natural
2784 logarithm). These can be modified by the @kbd{I} (inverse) and
2785 @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix keys.
2786
2787 Let's compute the sine and cosine of an angle, and verify the
2788 identity
2789 @texline @math{\sin^2x + \cos^2x = 1}.
2790 @infoline @expr{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 = 1}.
2791 We'll arbitrarily pick @mathit{-64} degrees as a good value for @expr{x}.
2792 With the angular mode set to degrees (type @w{@kbd{m d}}), do:
2793
2794 @smallexample
2795 @group
2796 2: -64 2: -64 2: -0.89879 2: -0.89879 1: 1.
2797 1: -64 1: -0.89879 1: -64 1: 0.43837 .
2798 . . . .
2799
2800 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} S @key{TAB} C f h
2801 @end group
2802 @end smallexample
2803
2804 @noindent
2805 (For brevity, we're showing only five digits of the results here.
2806 You can of course do these calculations to any precision you like.)
2807
2808 Remember, @kbd{f h} is the @code{calc-hypot}, or square-root of sum
2809 of squares, command.
2810
2811 Another identity is
2812 @texline @math{\displaystyle\tan x = {\sin x \over \cos x}}.
2813 @infoline @expr{tan(x) = sin(x) / cos(x)}.
2814 @smallexample
2815 @group
2816
2817 2: -0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2818 1: 0.43837 . .
2819 .
2820
2821 U / I T
2822 @end group
2823 @end smallexample
2824
2825 A physical interpretation of this calculation is that if you move
2826 @expr{0.89879} units downward and @expr{0.43837} units to the right,
2827 your direction of motion is @mathit{-64} degrees from horizontal. Suppose
2828 we move in the opposite direction, up and to the left:
2829
2830 @smallexample
2831 @group
2832 2: -0.89879 2: 0.89879 1: -2.0503 1: -64.
2833 1: 0.43837 1: -0.43837 . .
2834 . .
2835
2836 U U M-2 n / I T
2837 @end group
2838 @end smallexample
2839
2840 @noindent
2841 How can the angle be the same? The answer is that the @kbd{/} operation
2842 loses information about the signs of its inputs. Because the quotient
2843 is negative, we know exactly one of the inputs was negative, but we
2844 can't tell which one. There is an @kbd{f T} [@code{arctan2}] function which
2845 computes the inverse tangent of the quotient of a pair of numbers.
2846 Since you feed it the two original numbers, it has enough information
2847 to give you a full 360-degree answer.
2848
2849 @smallexample
2850 @group
2851 2: 0.89879 1: 116. 3: 116. 2: 116. 1: 180.
2852 1: -0.43837 . 2: -0.89879 1: -64. .
2853 . 1: 0.43837 .
2854 .
2855
2856 U U f T M-@key{RET} M-2 n f T -
2857 @end group
2858 @end smallexample
2859
2860 @noindent
2861 The resulting angles differ by 180 degrees; in other words, they
2862 point in opposite directions, just as we would expect.
2863
2864 The @key{META}-@key{RET} we used in the third step is the
2865 ``last-arguments'' command. It is sort of like Undo, except that it
2866 restores the arguments of the last command to the stack without removing
2867 the command's result. It is useful in situations like this one,
2868 where we need to do several operations on the same inputs. We could
2869 have accomplished the same thing by using @kbd{M-2 @key{RET}} to duplicate
2870 the top two stack elements right after the @kbd{U U}, then a pair of
2871 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} commands to cycle the 116 up around the duplicates.
2872
2873 A similar identity is supposed to hold for hyperbolic sines and cosines,
2874 except that it is the @emph{difference}
2875 @texline @math{\cosh^2x - \sinh^2x}
2876 @infoline @expr{cosh(x)^2 - sinh(x)^2}
2877 that always equals one. Let's try to verify this identity.
2878
2879 @smallexample
2880 @group
2881 2: -64 2: -64 2: -64 2: 9.7192e54 2: 9.7192e54
2882 1: -64 1: -3.1175e27 1: 9.7192e54 1: -64 1: 9.7192e54
2883 . . . . .
2884
2885 64 n @key{RET} @key{RET} H C 2 ^ @key{TAB} H S 2 ^
2886 @end group
2887 @end smallexample
2888
2889 @noindent
2890 @cindex Roundoff errors, examples
2891 Something's obviously wrong, because when we subtract these numbers
2892 the answer will clearly be zero! But if you think about it, if these
2893 numbers @emph{did} differ by one, it would be in the 55th decimal
2894 place. The difference we seek has been lost entirely to roundoff
2895 error.
2896
2897 We could verify this hypothesis by doing the actual calculation with,
2898 say, 60 decimal places of precision. This will be slow, but not
2899 enormously so. Try it if you wish; sure enough, the answer is
2900 0.99999, reasonably close to 1.
2901
2902 Of course, a more reasonable way to verify the identity is to use
2903 a more reasonable value for @expr{x}!
2904
2905 @cindex Common logarithm
2906 Some Calculator commands use the Hyperbolic prefix for other purposes.
2907 The logarithm and exponential functions, for example, work to the base
2908 @expr{e} normally but use base-10 instead if you use the Hyperbolic
2909 prefix.
2910
2911 @smallexample
2912 @group
2913 1: 1000 1: 6.9077 1: 1000 1: 3
2914 . . . .
2915
2916 1000 L U H L
2917 @end group
2918 @end smallexample
2919
2920 @noindent
2921 First, we mistakenly compute a natural logarithm. Then we undo
2922 and compute a common logarithm instead.
2923
2924 The @kbd{B} key computes a general base-@var{b} logarithm for any
2925 value of @var{b}.
2926
2927 @smallexample
2928 @group
2929 2: 1000 1: 3 1: 1000. 2: 1000. 1: 6.9077
2930 1: 10 . . 1: 2.71828 .
2931 . .
2932
2933 1000 @key{RET} 10 B H E H P B
2934 @end group
2935 @end smallexample
2936
2937 @noindent
2938 Here we first use @kbd{B} to compute the base-10 logarithm, then use
2939 the ``hyperbolic'' exponential as a cheap hack to recover the number
2940 1000, then use @kbd{B} again to compute the natural logarithm. Note
2941 that @kbd{P} with the hyperbolic prefix pushes the constant @expr{e}
2942 onto the stack.
2943
2944 You may have noticed that both times we took the base-10 logarithm
2945 of 1000, we got an exact integer result. Calc always tries to give
2946 an exact rational result for calculations involving rational numbers
2947 where possible. But when we used @kbd{H E}, the result was a
2948 floating-point number for no apparent reason. In fact, if we had
2949 computed @kbd{10 @key{RET} 3 ^} we @emph{would} have gotten an
2950 exact integer 1000. But the @kbd{H E} command is rigged to generate
2951 a floating-point result all of the time so that @kbd{1000 H E} will
2952 not waste time computing a thousand-digit integer when all you
2953 probably wanted was @samp{1e1000}.
2954
2955 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Find a pair of integer inputs to
2956 the @kbd{B} command for which Calc could find an exact rational
2957 result but doesn't. @xref{Arithmetic Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
2958
2959 The Calculator also has a set of functions relating to combinatorics
2960 and statistics. You may be familiar with the @dfn{factorial} function,
2961 which computes the product of all the integers up to a given number.
2962
2963 @smallexample
2964 @group
2965 1: 100 1: 93326215443... 1: 100. 1: 9.3326e157
2966 . . . .
2967
2968 100 ! U c f !
2969 @end group
2970 @end smallexample
2971
2972 @noindent
2973 Recall, the @kbd{c f} command converts the integer or fraction at the
2974 top of the stack to floating-point format. If you take the factorial
2975 of a floating-point number, you get a floating-point result
2976 accurate to the current precision. But if you give @kbd{!} an
2977 exact integer, you get an exact integer result (158 digits long
2978 in this case).
2979
2980 If you take the factorial of a non-integer, Calc uses a generalized
2981 factorial function defined in terms of Euler's Gamma function
2982 @texline @math{\Gamma(n)}
2983 @infoline @expr{gamma(n)}
2984 (which is itself available as the @kbd{f g} command).
2985
2986 @smallexample
2987 @group
2988 3: 4. 3: 24. 1: 5.5 1: 52.342777847
2989 2: 4.5 2: 52.3427777847 . .
2990 1: 5. 1: 120.
2991 . .
2992
2993 M-3 ! M-0 @key{DEL} 5.5 f g
2994 @end group
2995 @end smallexample
2996
2997 @noindent
2998 Here we verify the identity
2999 @texline @math{n! = \Gamma(n+1)}.
3000 @infoline @expr{@var{n}!@: = gamma(@var{n}+1)}.
3001
3002 The binomial coefficient @var{n}-choose-@var{m}
3003 @texline or @math{\displaystyle {n \choose m}}
3004 is defined by
3005 @texline @math{\displaystyle {n! \over m! \, (n-m)!}}
3006 @infoline @expr{n!@: / m!@: (n-m)!}
3007 for all reals @expr{n} and @expr{m}. The intermediate results in this
3008 formula can become quite large even if the final result is small; the
3009 @kbd{k c} command computes a binomial coefficient in a way that avoids
3010 large intermediate values.
3011
3012 The @kbd{k} prefix key defines several common functions out of
3013 combinatorics and number theory. Here we compute the binomial
3014 coefficient 30-choose-20, then determine its prime factorization.
3015
3016 @smallexample
3017 @group
3018 2: 30 1: 30045015 1: [3, 3, 5, 7, 11, 13, 23, 29]
3019 1: 20 . .
3020 .
3021
3022 30 @key{RET} 20 k c k f
3023 @end group
3024 @end smallexample
3025
3026 @noindent
3027 You can verify these prime factors by using @kbd{V R *} to multiply
3028 together the elements of this vector. The result is the original
3029 number, 30045015.
3030
3031 @cindex Hash tables
3032 Suppose a program you are writing needs a hash table with at least
3033 10000 entries. It's best to use a prime number as the actual size
3034 of a hash table. Calc can compute the next prime number after 10000:
3035
3036 @smallexample
3037 @group
3038 1: 10000 1: 10007 1: 9973
3039 . . .
3040
3041 10000 k n I k n
3042 @end group
3043 @end smallexample
3044
3045 @noindent
3046 Just for kicks we've also computed the next prime @emph{less} than
3047 10000.
3048
3049 @c [fix-ref Financial Functions]
3050 @xref{Financial Functions}, for a description of the Calculator
3051 commands that deal with business and financial calculations (functions
3052 like @code{pv}, @code{rate}, and @code{sln}).
3053
3054 @c [fix-ref Binary Number Functions]
3055 @xref{Binary Functions}, to read about the commands for operating
3056 on binary numbers (like @code{and}, @code{xor}, and @code{lsh}).
3057
3058 @node Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Arithmetic Tutorial, Tutorial
3059 @section Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3060
3061 @noindent
3062 A @dfn{vector} is a list of numbers or other Calc data objects.
3063 Calc provides a large set of commands that operate on vectors. Some
3064 are familiar operations from vector analysis. Others simply treat
3065 a vector as a list of objects.
3066
3067 @menu
3068 * Vector Analysis Tutorial::
3069 * Matrix Tutorial::
3070 * List Tutorial::
3071 @end menu
3072
3073 @node Vector Analysis Tutorial, Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3074 @subsection Vector Analysis
3075
3076 @noindent
3077 If you add two vectors, the result is a vector of the sums of the
3078 elements, taken pairwise.
3079
3080 @smallexample
3081 @group
3082 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [8, 8, 3]
3083 . 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3084 .
3085
3086 [1,2,3] s 1 [7 6 0] s 2 +
3087 @end group
3088 @end smallexample
3089
3090 @noindent
3091 Note that we can separate the vector elements with either commas or
3092 spaces. This is true whether we are using incomplete vectors or
3093 algebraic entry. The @kbd{s 1} and @kbd{s 2} commands save these
3094 vectors so we can easily reuse them later.
3095
3096 If you multiply two vectors, the result is the sum of the products
3097 of the elements taken pairwise. This is called the @dfn{dot product}
3098 of the vectors.
3099
3100 @smallexample
3101 @group
3102 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 19
3103 1: [7, 6, 0] .
3104 .
3105
3106 r 1 r 2 *
3107 @end group
3108 @end smallexample
3109
3110 @cindex Dot product
3111 The dot product of two vectors is equal to the product of their
3112 lengths times the cosine of the angle between them. (Here the vector
3113 is interpreted as a line from the origin @expr{(0,0,0)} to the
3114 specified point in three-dimensional space.) The @kbd{A}
3115 (absolute value) command can be used to compute the length of a
3116 vector.
3117
3118 @smallexample
3119 @group
3120 3: 19 3: 19 1: 0.550782 1: 56.579
3121 2: [1, 2, 3] 2: 3.741657 . .
3122 1: [7, 6, 0] 1: 9.219544
3123 . .
3124
3125 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / I C
3126 @end group
3127 @end smallexample
3128
3129 @noindent
3130 First we recall the arguments to the dot product command, then
3131 we compute the absolute values of the top two stack entries to
3132 obtain the lengths of the vectors, then we divide the dot product
3133 by the product of the lengths to get the cosine of the angle.
3134 The inverse cosine finds that the angle between the vectors
3135 is about 56 degrees.
3136
3137 @cindex Cross product
3138 @cindex Perpendicular vectors
3139 The @dfn{cross product} of two vectors is a vector whose length
3140 is the product of the lengths of the inputs times the sine of the
3141 angle between them, and whose direction is perpendicular to both
3142 input vectors. Unlike the dot product, the cross product is
3143 defined only for three-dimensional vectors. Let's double-check
3144 our computation of the angle using the cross product.
3145
3146 @smallexample
3147 @group
3148 2: [1, 2, 3] 3: [-18, 21, -8] 1: [-0.52, 0.61, -0.23] 1: 56.579
3149 1: [7, 6, 0] 2: [1, 2, 3] . .
3150 . 1: [7, 6, 0]
3151 .
3152
3153 r 1 r 2 V C s 3 M-@key{RET} M-2 A * / A I S
3154 @end group
3155 @end smallexample
3156
3157 @noindent
3158 First we recall the original vectors and compute their cross product,
3159 which we also store for later reference. Now we divide the vector
3160 by the product of the lengths of the original vectors. The length of
3161 this vector should be the sine of the angle; sure enough, it is!
3162
3163 @c [fix-ref General Mode Commands]
3164 Vector-related commands generally begin with the @kbd{v} prefix key.
3165 Some are uppercase letters and some are lowercase. To make it easier
3166 to type these commands, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix key acts the same as
3167 the @kbd{v} key. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to make all
3168 prefix keys have this property.)
3169
3170 If we take the dot product of two perpendicular vectors we expect
3171 to get zero, since the cosine of 90 degrees is zero. Let's check
3172 that the cross product is indeed perpendicular to both inputs:
3173
3174 @smallexample
3175 @group
3176 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: 0 2: [7, 6, 0] 1: 0
3177 1: [-18, 21, -8] . 1: [-18, 21, -8] .
3178 . .
3179
3180 r 1 r 3 * @key{DEL} r 2 r 3 *
3181 @end group
3182 @end smallexample
3183
3184 @cindex Normalizing a vector
3185 @cindex Unit vectors
3186 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Given a vector on the top of the
3187 stack, what keystrokes would you use to @dfn{normalize} the
3188 vector, i.e., to reduce its length to one without changing its
3189 direction? @xref{Vector Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3190
3191 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Suppose a certain particle can be
3192 at any of several positions along a ruler. You have a list of
3193 those positions in the form of a vector, and another list of the
3194 probabilities for the particle to be at the corresponding positions.
3195 Find the average position of the particle.
3196 @xref{Vector Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3197
3198 @node Matrix Tutorial, List Tutorial, Vector Analysis Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3199 @subsection Matrices
3200
3201 @noindent
3202 A @dfn{matrix} is just a vector of vectors, all the same length.
3203 This means you can enter a matrix using nested brackets. You can
3204 also use the semicolon character to enter a matrix. We'll show
3205 both methods here:
3206
3207 @smallexample
3208 @group
3209 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3210 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3211 . .
3212
3213 [[1 2 3] [4 5 6]] ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6] @key{RET}
3214 @end group
3215 @end smallexample
3216
3217 @noindent
3218 We'll be using this matrix again, so type @kbd{s 4} to save it now.
3219
3220 Note that semicolons work with incomplete vectors, but they work
3221 better in algebraic entry. That's why we use the apostrophe in
3222 the second example.
3223
3224 When two matrices are multiplied, the lefthand matrix must have
3225 the same number of columns as the righthand matrix has rows.
3226 Row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of the result is effectively the
3227 dot product of row @expr{i} of the left matrix by column @expr{j}
3228 of the right matrix.
3229
3230 If we try to duplicate this matrix and multiply it by itself,
3231 the dimensions are wrong and the multiplication cannot take place:
3232
3233 @smallexample
3234 @group
3235 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] * [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3236 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3237 .
3238
3239 @key{RET} *
3240 @end group
3241 @end smallexample
3242
3243 @noindent
3244 Though rather hard to read, this is a formula which shows the product
3245 of two matrices. The @samp{*} function, having invalid arguments, has
3246 been left in symbolic form.
3247
3248 We can multiply the matrices if we @dfn{transpose} one of them first.
3249
3250 @smallexample
3251 @group
3252 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 14, 32 ] 1: [ [ 17, 22, 27 ]
3253 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 32, 77 ] ] [ 22, 29, 36 ]
3254 1: [ [ 1, 4 ] . [ 27, 36, 45 ] ]
3255 [ 2, 5 ] .
3256 [ 3, 6 ] ]
3257 .
3258
3259 U v t * U @key{TAB} *
3260 @end group
3261 @end smallexample
3262
3263 Matrix multiplication is not commutative; indeed, switching the
3264 order of the operands can even change the dimensions of the result
3265 matrix, as happened here!
3266
3267 If you multiply a plain vector by a matrix, it is treated as a
3268 single row or column depending on which side of the matrix it is
3269 on. The result is a plain vector which should also be interpreted
3270 as a row or column as appropriate.
3271
3272 @smallexample
3273 @group
3274 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [14, 32]
3275 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] .
3276 1: [1, 2, 3]
3277 .
3278
3279 r 4 r 1 *
3280 @end group
3281 @end smallexample
3282
3283 Multiplying in the other order wouldn't work because the number of
3284 rows in the matrix is different from the number of elements in the
3285 vector.
3286
3287 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Use @samp{*} to sum along the rows
3288 of the above
3289 @texline @math{2\times3}
3290 @infoline 2x3
3291 matrix to get @expr{[6, 15]}. Now use @samp{*} to sum along the columns
3292 to get @expr{[5, 7, 9]}.
3293 @xref{Matrix Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3294
3295 @cindex Identity matrix
3296 An @dfn{identity matrix} is a square matrix with ones along the
3297 diagonal and zeros elsewhere. It has the property that multiplication
3298 by an identity matrix, on the left or on the right, always produces
3299 the original matrix.
3300
3301 @smallexample
3302 @group
3303 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ]
3304 [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ] [ 4, 5, 6 ] ]
3305 . 1: [ [ 1, 0, 0 ] .
3306 [ 0, 1, 0 ]
3307 [ 0, 0, 1 ] ]
3308 .
3309
3310 r 4 v i 3 @key{RET} *
3311 @end group
3312 @end smallexample
3313
3314 If a matrix is square, it is often possible to find its @dfn{inverse},
3315 that is, a matrix which, when multiplied by the original matrix, yields
3316 an identity matrix. The @kbd{&} (reciprocal) key also computes the
3317 inverse of a matrix.
3318
3319 @smallexample
3320 @group
3321 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [ [ -2.4, 1.2, -0.2 ]
3322 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2.8, -1.4, 0.4 ]
3323 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ -0.73333, 0.53333, -0.2 ] ]
3324 . .
3325
3326 r 4 r 2 | s 5 &
3327 @end group
3328 @end smallexample
3329
3330 @noindent
3331 The vertical bar @kbd{|} @dfn{concatenates} numbers, vectors, and
3332 matrices together. Here we have used it to add a new row onto
3333 our matrix to make it square.
3334
3335 We can multiply these two matrices in either order to get an identity.
3336
3337 @smallexample
3338 @group
3339 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ] 1: [ [ 1., 0., 0. ]
3340 [ 0., 1., 0. ] [ 0., 1., 0. ]
3341 [ 0., 0., 1. ] ] [ 0., 0., 1. ] ]
3342 . .
3343
3344 M-@key{RET} * U @key{TAB} *
3345 @end group
3346 @end smallexample
3347
3348 @cindex Systems of linear equations
3349 @cindex Linear equations, systems of
3350 Matrix inverses are related to systems of linear equations in algebra.
3351 Suppose we had the following set of equations:
3352
3353 @ifnottex
3354 @group
3355 @example
3356 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3357 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3358 7a + 6b = 3
3359 @end example
3360 @end group
3361 @end ifnottex
3362 @tex
3363 \beforedisplayh
3364 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3365 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3366 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3367 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3368 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3369 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3370 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3371 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr}
3372 $$
3373 \afterdisplayh
3374 @end tex
3375
3376 @noindent
3377 This can be cast into the matrix equation,
3378
3379 @ifnottex
3380 @group
3381 @example
3382 [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] [ [ a ] [ [ 6 ]
3383 [ 4, 5, 6 ] * [ b ] = [ 2 ]
3384 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ] [ c ] ] [ 3 ] ]
3385 @end example
3386 @end group
3387 @end ifnottex
3388 @tex
3389 \beforedisplay
3390 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 \cr 4 & 5 & 6 \cr 7 & 6 & 0 }
3391 \times
3392 \pmatrix{ a \cr b \cr c } = \pmatrix{ 6 \cr 2 \cr 3 }
3393 $$
3394 \afterdisplay
3395 @end tex
3396
3397 We can solve this system of equations by multiplying both sides by the
3398 inverse of the matrix. Calc can do this all in one step:
3399
3400 @smallexample
3401 @group
3402 2: [6, 2, 3] 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3403 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
3404 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
3405 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3406 .
3407
3408 [6,2,3] r 5 /
3409 @end group
3410 @end smallexample
3411
3412 @noindent
3413 The result is the @expr{[a, b, c]} vector that solves the equations.
3414 (Dividing by a square matrix is equivalent to multiplying by its
3415 inverse.)
3416
3417 Let's verify this solution:
3418
3419 @smallexample
3420 @group
3421 2: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 1: [6., 2., 3.]
3422 [ 4, 5, 6 ] .
3423 [ 7, 6, 0 ] ]
3424 1: [-12.6, 15.2, -3.93333]
3425 .
3426
3427 r 5 @key{TAB} *
3428 @end group
3429 @end smallexample
3430
3431 @noindent
3432 Note that we had to be careful about the order in which we multiplied
3433 the matrix and vector. If we multiplied in the other order, Calc would
3434 assume the vector was a row vector in order to make the dimensions
3435 come out right, and the answer would be incorrect. If you
3436 don't feel safe letting Calc take either interpretation of your
3437 vectors, use explicit
3438 @texline @math{N\times1}
3439 @infoline Nx1
3440 or
3441 @texline @math{1\times N}
3442 @infoline 1xN
3443 matrices instead. In this case, you would enter the original column
3444 vector as @samp{[[6], [2], [3]]} or @samp{[6; 2; 3]}.
3445
3446 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Algebraic entry allows you to make
3447 vectors and matrices that include variables. Solve the following
3448 system of equations to get expressions for @expr{x} and @expr{y}
3449 in terms of @expr{a} and @expr{b}.
3450
3451 @ifnottex
3452 @group
3453 @example
3454 x + a y = 6
3455 x + b y = 10
3456 @end example
3457 @end group
3458 @end ifnottex
3459 @tex
3460 \beforedisplay
3461 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
3462 x &+ b y = 10}
3463 $$
3464 \afterdisplay
3465 @end tex
3466
3467 @noindent
3468 @xref{Matrix Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3469
3470 @cindex Least-squares for over-determined systems
3471 @cindex Over-determined systems of equations
3472 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} A system of equations is ``over-determined''
3473 if it has more equations than variables. It is often the case that
3474 there are no values for the variables that will satisfy all the
3475 equations at once, but it is still useful to find a set of values
3476 which ``nearly'' satisfy all the equations. In terms of matrix equations,
3477 you can't solve @expr{A X = B} directly because the matrix @expr{A}
3478 is not square for an over-determined system. Matrix inversion works
3479 only for square matrices. One common trick is to multiply both sides
3480 on the left by the transpose of @expr{A}:
3481 @ifnottex
3482 @samp{trn(A)*A*X = trn(A)*B}.
3483 @end ifnottex
3484 @tex
3485 $A^T A \, X = A^T B$, where $A^T$ is the transpose \samp{trn(A)}.
3486 @end tex
3487 Now
3488 @texline @math{A^T A}
3489 @infoline @expr{trn(A)*A}
3490 is a square matrix so a solution is possible. It turns out that the
3491 @expr{X} vector you compute in this way will be a ``least-squares''
3492 solution, which can be regarded as the ``closest'' solution to the set
3493 of equations. Use Calc to solve the following over-determined
3494 system:
3495
3496 @ifnottex
3497 @group
3498 @example
3499 a + 2b + 3c = 6
3500 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
3501 7a + 6b = 3
3502 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
3503 @end example
3504 @end group
3505 @end ifnottex
3506 @tex
3507 \beforedisplayh
3508 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
3509 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
3510 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3511 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
3512 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
3513 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
3514 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
3515 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
3516 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
3517 $$
3518 \afterdisplayh
3519 @end tex
3520
3521 @noindent
3522 @xref{Matrix Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
3523
3524 @node List Tutorial, , Matrix Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial
3525 @subsection Vectors as Lists
3526
3527 @noindent
3528 @cindex Lists
3529 Although Calc has a number of features for manipulating vectors and
3530 matrices as mathematical objects, you can also treat vectors as
3531 simple lists of values. For example, we saw that the @kbd{k f}
3532 command returns a vector which is a list of the prime factors of a
3533 number.
3534
3535 You can pack and unpack stack entries into vectors:
3536
3537 @smallexample
3538 @group
3539 3: 10 1: [10, 20, 30] 3: 10
3540 2: 20 . 2: 20
3541 1: 30 1: 30
3542 . .
3543
3544 M-3 v p v u
3545 @end group
3546 @end smallexample
3547
3548 You can also build vectors out of consecutive integers, or out
3549 of many copies of a given value:
3550
3551 @smallexample
3552 @group
3553 1: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4] 2: [1, 2, 3, 4]
3554 . 1: 17 1: [17, 17, 17, 17]
3555 . .
3556
3557 v x 4 @key{RET} 17 v b 4 @key{RET}
3558 @end group
3559 @end smallexample
3560
3561 You can apply an operator to every element of a vector using the
3562 @dfn{map} command.
3563
3564 @smallexample
3565 @group
3566 1: [17, 34, 51, 68] 1: [289, 1156, 2601, 4624] 1: [17, 34, 51, 68]
3567 . . .
3568
3569 V M * 2 V M ^ V M Q
3570 @end group
3571 @end smallexample
3572
3573 @noindent
3574 In the first step, we multiply the vector of integers by the vector
3575 of 17's elementwise. In the second step, we raise each element to
3576 the power two. (The general rule is that both operands must be
3577 vectors of the same length, or else one must be a vector and the
3578 other a plain number.) In the final step, we take the square root
3579 of each element.
3580
3581 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Compute a vector of powers of two
3582 from
3583 @texline @math{2^{-4}}
3584 @infoline @expr{2^-4}
3585 to @expr{2^4}. @xref{List Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
3586
3587 You can also @dfn{reduce} a binary operator across a vector.
3588 For example, reducing @samp{*} computes the product of all the
3589 elements in the vector:
3590
3591 @smallexample
3592 @group
3593 1: 123123 1: [3, 7, 11, 13, 41] 1: 123123
3594 . . .
3595
3596 123123 k f V R *
3597 @end group
3598 @end smallexample
3599
3600 @noindent
3601 In this example, we decompose 123123 into its prime factors, then
3602 multiply those factors together again to yield the original number.
3603
3604 We could compute a dot product ``by hand'' using mapping and
3605 reduction:
3606
3607 @smallexample
3608 @group
3609 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [7, 12, 0] 1: 19
3610 1: [7, 6, 0] . .
3611 .
3612
3613 r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
3614 @end group
3615 @end smallexample
3616
3617 @noindent
3618 Recalling two vectors from the previous section, we compute the
3619 sum of pairwise products of the elements to get the same answer
3620 for the dot product as before.
3621
3622 A slight variant of vector reduction is the @dfn{accumulate} operation,
3623 @kbd{V U}. This produces a vector of the intermediate results from
3624 a corresponding reduction. Here we compute a table of factorials:
3625
3626 @smallexample
3627 @group
3628 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] 1: [1, 2, 6, 24, 120, 720]
3629 . .
3630
3631 v x 6 @key{RET} V U *
3632 @end group
3633 @end smallexample
3634
3635 Calc allows vectors to grow as large as you like, although it gets
3636 rather slow if vectors have more than about a hundred elements.
3637 Actually, most of the time is spent formatting these large vectors
3638 for display, not calculating on them. Try the following experiment
3639 (if your computer is very fast you may need to substitute a larger
3640 vector size).
3641
3642 @smallexample
3643 @group
3644 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ... 1: [2, 3, 4, 5, ...
3645 . .
3646
3647 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3648 @end group
3649 @end smallexample
3650
3651 Now press @kbd{v .} (the letter @kbd{v}, then a period) and try the
3652 experiment again. In @kbd{v .} mode, long vectors are displayed
3653 ``abbreviated'' like this:
3654
3655 @smallexample
3656 @group
3657 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 500] 1: [2, 3, 4, ..., 501]
3658 . .
3659
3660 v x 500 @key{RET} 1 V M +
3661 @end group
3662 @end smallexample
3663
3664 @noindent
3665 (where now the @samp{...} is actually part of the Calc display).
3666 You will find both operations are now much faster. But notice that
3667 even in @w{@kbd{v .}} mode, the full vectors are still shown in the Trail.
3668 Type @w{@kbd{t .}} to cause the trail to abbreviate as well, and try the
3669 experiment one more time. Operations on long vectors are now quite
3670 fast! (But of course if you use @kbd{t .} you will lose the ability
3671 to get old vectors back using the @kbd{t y} command.)
3672
3673 An easy way to view a full vector when @kbd{v .} mode is active is
3674 to press @kbd{`} (back-quote) to edit the vector; editing always works
3675 with the full, unabbreviated value.
3676
3677 @cindex Least-squares for fitting a straight line
3678 @cindex Fitting data to a line
3679 @cindex Line, fitting data to
3680 @cindex Data, extracting from buffers
3681 @cindex Columns of data, extracting
3682 As a larger example, let's try to fit a straight line to some data,
3683 using the method of least squares. (Calc has a built-in command for
3684 least-squares curve fitting, but we'll do it by hand here just to
3685 practice working with vectors.) Suppose we have the following list
3686 of values in a file we have loaded into Emacs:
3687
3688 @smallexample
3689 x y
3690 --- ---
3691 1.34 0.234
3692 1.41 0.298
3693 1.49 0.402
3694 1.56 0.412
3695 1.64 0.466
3696 1.73 0.473
3697 1.82 0.601
3698 1.91 0.519
3699 2.01 0.603
3700 2.11 0.637
3701 2.22 0.645
3702 2.33 0.705
3703 2.45 0.917
3704 2.58 1.009
3705 2.71 0.971
3706 2.85 1.062
3707 3.00 1.148
3708 3.15 1.157
3709 3.32 1.354
3710 @end smallexample
3711
3712 @noindent
3713 If you are reading this tutorial in printed form, you will find it
3714 easiest to press @kbd{C-x * i} to enter the on-line Info version of
3715 the manual and find this table there. (Press @kbd{g}, then type
3716 @kbd{List Tutorial}, to jump straight to this section.)
3717
3718 Position the cursor at the upper-left corner of this table, just
3719 to the left of the @expr{1.34}. Press @kbd{C-@@} to set the mark.
3720 (On your system this may be @kbd{C-2}, @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}, or @kbd{NUL}.)
3721 Now position the cursor to the lower-right, just after the @expr{1.354}.
3722 You have now defined this region as an Emacs ``rectangle.'' Still
3723 in the Info buffer, type @kbd{C-x * r}. This command
3724 (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) will pop you back into the Calculator, with
3725 the contents of the rectangle you specified in the form of a matrix.
3726
3727 @smallexample
3728 @group
3729 1: [ [ 1.34, 0.234 ]
3730 [ 1.41, 0.298 ]
3731 @dots{}
3732 @end group
3733 @end smallexample
3734
3735 @noindent
3736 (You may wish to use @kbd{v .} mode to abbreviate the display of this
3737 large matrix.)
3738
3739 We want to treat this as a pair of lists. The first step is to
3740 transpose this matrix into a pair of rows. Remember, a matrix is
3741 just a vector of vectors. So we can unpack the matrix into a pair
3742 of row vectors on the stack.
3743
3744 @smallexample
3745 @group
3746 1: [ [ 1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3747 [ 0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ] ] 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3748 . .
3749
3750 v t v u
3751 @end group
3752 @end smallexample
3753
3754 @noindent
3755 Let's store these in quick variables 1 and 2, respectively.
3756
3757 @smallexample
3758 @group
3759 1: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] .
3760 .
3761
3762 t 2 t 1
3763 @end group
3764 @end smallexample
3765
3766 @noindent
3767 (Recall that @kbd{t 2} is a variant of @kbd{s 2} that removes the
3768 stored value from the stack.)
3769
3770 In a least squares fit, the slope @expr{m} is given by the formula
3771
3772 @ifnottex
3773 @example
3774 m = (N sum(x y) - sum(x) sum(y)) / (N sum(x^2) - sum(x)^2)
3775 @end example
3776 @end ifnottex
3777 @tex
3778 \beforedisplay
3779 $$ m = {N \sum x y - \sum x \sum y \over
3780 N \sum x^2 - \left( \sum x \right)^2} $$
3781 \afterdisplay
3782 @end tex
3783
3784 @noindent
3785 where
3786 @texline @math{\sum x}
3787 @infoline @expr{sum(x)}
3788 represents the sum of all the values of @expr{x}. While there is an
3789 actual @code{sum} function in Calc, it's easier to sum a vector using a
3790 simple reduction. First, let's compute the four different sums that
3791 this formula uses.
3792
3793 @smallexample
3794 @group
3795 1: 41.63 1: 98.0003
3796 . .
3797
3798 r 1 V R + t 3 r 1 2 V M ^ V R + t 4
3799
3800 @end group
3801 @end smallexample
3802 @noindent
3803 @smallexample
3804 @group
3805 1: 13.613 1: 33.36554
3806 . .
3807
3808 r 2 V R + t 5 r 1 r 2 V M * V R + t 6
3809 @end group
3810 @end smallexample
3811
3812 @ifnottex
3813 @noindent
3814 These are @samp{sum(x)}, @samp{sum(x^2)}, @samp{sum(y)}, and @samp{sum(x y)},
3815 respectively. (We could have used @kbd{*} to compute @samp{sum(x^2)} and
3816 @samp{sum(x y)}.)
3817 @end ifnottex
3818 @tex
3819 These are $\sum x$, $\sum x^2$, $\sum y$, and $\sum x y$,
3820 respectively. (We could have used \kbd{*} to compute $\sum x^2$ and
3821 $\sum x y$.)
3822 @end tex
3823
3824 Finally, we also need @expr{N}, the number of data points. This is just
3825 the length of either of our lists.
3826
3827 @smallexample
3828 @group
3829 1: 19
3830 .
3831
3832 r 1 v l t 7
3833 @end group
3834 @end smallexample
3835
3836 @noindent
3837 (That's @kbd{v} followed by a lower-case @kbd{l}.)
3838
3839 Now we grind through the formula:
3840
3841 @smallexample
3842 @group
3843 1: 633.94526 2: 633.94526 1: 67.23607
3844 . 1: 566.70919 .
3845 .
3846
3847 r 7 r 6 * r 3 r 5 * -
3848
3849 @end group
3850 @end smallexample
3851 @noindent
3852 @smallexample
3853 @group
3854 2: 67.23607 3: 67.23607 2: 67.23607 1: 0.52141679
3855 1: 1862.0057 2: 1862.0057 1: 128.9488 .
3856 . 1: 1733.0569 .
3857 .
3858
3859 r 7 r 4 * r 3 2 ^ - / t 8
3860 @end group
3861 @end smallexample
3862
3863 That gives us the slope @expr{m}. The y-intercept @expr{b} can now
3864 be found with the simple formula,
3865
3866 @ifnottex
3867 @example
3868 b = (sum(y) - m sum(x)) / N
3869 @end example
3870 @end ifnottex
3871 @tex
3872 \beforedisplay
3873 $$ b = {\sum y - m \sum x \over N} $$
3874 \afterdisplay
3875 \vskip10pt
3876 @end tex
3877
3878 @smallexample
3879 @group
3880 1: 13.613 2: 13.613 1: -8.09358 1: -0.425978
3881 . 1: 21.70658 . .
3882 .
3883
3884 r 5 r 8 r 3 * - r 7 / t 9
3885 @end group
3886 @end smallexample
3887
3888 Let's ``plot'' this straight line approximation,
3889 @texline @math{y \approx m x + b},
3890 @infoline @expr{m x + b},
3891 and compare it with the original data.
3892
3893 @smallexample
3894 @group
3895 1: [0.699, 0.735, ... ] 1: [0.273, 0.309, ... ]
3896 . .
3897
3898 r 1 r 8 * r 9 + s 0
3899 @end group
3900 @end smallexample
3901
3902 @noindent
3903 Notice that multiplying a vector by a constant, and adding a constant
3904 to a vector, can be done without mapping commands since these are
3905 common operations from vector algebra. As far as Calc is concerned,
3906 we've just been doing geometry in 19-dimensional space!
3907
3908 We can subtract this vector from our original @expr{y} vector to get
3909 a feel for the error of our fit. Let's find the maximum error:
3910
3911 @smallexample
3912 @group
3913 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: [0.0387, 0.0112, ... ] 1: 0.0897
3914 . . .
3915
3916 r 2 - V M A V R X
3917 @end group
3918 @end smallexample
3919
3920 @noindent
3921 First we compute a vector of differences, then we take the absolute
3922 values of these differences, then we reduce the @code{max} function
3923 across the vector. (The @code{max} function is on the two-key sequence
3924 @kbd{f x}; because it is so common to use @code{max} in a vector
3925 operation, the letters @kbd{X} and @kbd{N} are also accepted for
3926 @code{max} and @code{min} in this context. In general, you answer
3927 the @kbd{V M} or @kbd{V R} prompt with the actual key sequence that
3928 invokes the function you want. You could have typed @kbd{V R f x} or
3929 even @kbd{V R x max @key{RET}} if you had preferred.)
3930
3931 If your system has the GNUPLOT program, you can see graphs of your
3932 data and your straight line to see how well they match. (If you have
3933 GNUPLOT 3.0 or higher, the following instructions will work regardless
3934 of the kind of display you have. Some GNUPLOT 2.0, non-X-windows systems
3935 may require additional steps to view the graphs.)
3936
3937 Let's start by plotting the original data. Recall the ``@var{x}'' and ``@var{y}''
3938 vectors onto the stack and press @kbd{g f}. This ``fast'' graphing
3939 command does everything you need to do for simple, straightforward
3940 plotting of data.
3941
3942 @smallexample
3943 @group
3944 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3945 1: [0.234, 0.298, 0.402, ... ]
3946 .
3947
3948 r 1 r 2 g f
3949 @end group
3950 @end smallexample
3951
3952 If all goes well, you will shortly get a new window containing a graph
3953 of the data. (If not, contact your GNUPLOT or Calc installer to find
3954 out what went wrong.) In the X window system, this will be a separate
3955 graphics window. For other kinds of displays, the default is to
3956 display the graph in Emacs itself using rough character graphics.
3957 Press @kbd{q} when you are done viewing the character graphics.
3958
3959 Next, let's add the line we got from our least-squares fit.
3960 @ifinfo
3961 (If you are reading this tutorial on-line while running Calc, typing
3962 @kbd{g a} may cause the tutorial to disappear from its window and be
3963 replaced by a buffer named @file{*Gnuplot Commands*}. The tutorial
3964 will reappear when you terminate GNUPLOT by typing @kbd{g q}.)
3965 @end ifinfo
3966
3967 @smallexample
3968 @group
3969 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ]
3970 1: [0.273, 0.309, 0.351, ... ]
3971 .
3972
3973 @key{DEL} r 0 g a g p
3974 @end group
3975 @end smallexample
3976
3977 It's not very useful to get symbols to mark the data points on this
3978 second curve; you can type @kbd{g S g p} to remove them. Type @kbd{g q}
3979 when you are done to remove the X graphics window and terminate GNUPLOT.
3980
3981 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} An earlier exercise showed how to do
3982 least squares fitting to a general system of equations. Our 19 data
3983 points are really 19 equations of the form @expr{y_i = m x_i + b} for
3984 different pairs of @expr{(x_i,y_i)}. Use the matrix-transpose method
3985 to solve for @expr{m} and @expr{b}, duplicating the above result.
3986 @xref{List Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
3987
3988 @cindex Geometric mean
3989 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} If the input data do not form a
3990 rectangle, you can use @w{@kbd{C-x * g}} (@code{calc-grab-region})
3991 to grab the data the way Emacs normally works with regions---it reads
3992 left-to-right, top-to-bottom, treating line breaks the same as spaces.
3993 Use this command to find the geometric mean of the following numbers.
3994 (The geometric mean is the @var{n}th root of the product of @var{n} numbers.)
3995
3996 @example
3997 2.3 6 22 15.1 7
3998 15 14 7.5
3999 2.5
4000 @end example
4001
4002 @noindent
4003 The @kbd{C-x * g} command accepts numbers separated by spaces or commas,
4004 with or without surrounding vector brackets.
4005 @xref{List Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4006
4007 @ifnottex
4008 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4009 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4010 @var{n}-choose-0 minus @var{n}-choose-1 plus @var{n}-choose-2, and so
4011 on up to @var{n}-choose-@var{n},
4012 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4013 for @expr{n=6}.
4014 @end ifnottex
4015 @tex
4016 As another example, a theorem about binomial coefficients tells
4017 us that the alternating sum of binomial coefficients
4018 ${n \choose 0} - {n \choose 1} + {n \choose 2} - \cdots \pm {n \choose n}$
4019 always comes out to zero. Let's verify this
4020 for \cite{n=6}.
4021 @end tex
4022
4023 @smallexample
4024 @group
4025 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7] 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
4026 . .
4027
4028 v x 7 @key{RET} 1 -
4029
4030 @end group
4031 @end smallexample
4032 @noindent
4033 @smallexample
4034 @group
4035 1: [1, -6, 15, -20, 15, -6, 1] 1: 0
4036 . .
4037
4038 V M ' (-1)^$ choose(6,$) @key{RET} V R +
4039 @end group
4040 @end smallexample
4041
4042 The @kbd{V M '} command prompts you to enter any algebraic expression
4043 to define the function to map over the vector. The symbol @samp{$}
4044 inside this expression represents the argument to the function.
4045 The Calculator applies this formula to each element of the vector,
4046 substituting each element's value for the @samp{$} sign(s) in turn.
4047
4048 To define a two-argument function, use @samp{$$} for the first
4049 argument and @samp{$} for the second: @kbd{V M ' $$-$ @key{RET}} is
4050 equivalent to @kbd{V M -}. This is analogous to regular algebraic
4051 entry, where @samp{$$} would refer to the next-to-top stack entry
4052 and @samp{$} would refer to the top stack entry, and @kbd{' $$-$ @key{RET}}
4053 would act exactly like @kbd{-}.
4054
4055 Notice that the @kbd{V M '} command has recorded two things in the
4056 trail: The result, as usual, and also a funny-looking thing marked
4057 @samp{oper} that represents the operator function you typed in.
4058 The function is enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets, and the argument is
4059 denoted by a @samp{#} sign. If there were several arguments, they
4060 would be shown as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on. (For example,
4061 @kbd{V M ' $$-$} will put the function @samp{<#1 - #2>} on the
4062 trail.) This object is a ``nameless function''; you can use nameless
4063 @w{@samp{< >}} notation to answer the @kbd{V M '} prompt if you like.
4064 Nameless function notation has the interesting, occasionally useful
4065 property that a nameless function is not actually evaluated until
4066 it is used. For example, @kbd{V M ' $+random(2.0)} evaluates
4067 @samp{random(2.0)} once and adds that random number to all elements
4068 of the vector, but @kbd{V M ' <#+random(2.0)>} evaluates the
4069 @samp{random(2.0)} separately for each vector element.
4070
4071 Another group of operators that are often useful with @kbd{V M} are
4072 the relational operators: @kbd{a =}, for example, compares two numbers
4073 and gives the result 1 if they are equal, or 0 if not. Similarly,
4074 @w{@kbd{a <}} checks for one number being less than another.
4075
4076 Other useful vector operations include @kbd{v v}, to reverse a
4077 vector end-for-end; @kbd{V S}, to sort the elements of a vector
4078 into increasing order; and @kbd{v r} and @w{@kbd{v c}}, to extract
4079 one row or column of a matrix, or (in both cases) to extract one
4080 element of a plain vector. With a negative argument, @kbd{v r}
4081 and @kbd{v c} instead delete one row, column, or vector element.
4082
4083 @cindex Divisor functions
4084 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The @expr{k}th @dfn{divisor function}
4085 @tex
4086 $\sigma_k(n)$
4087 @end tex
4088 is the sum of the @expr{k}th powers of all the divisors of an
4089 integer @expr{n}. Figure out a method for computing the divisor
4090 function for reasonably small values of @expr{n}. As a test,
4091 the 0th and 1st divisor functions of 30 are 8 and 72, respectively.
4092 @xref{List Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4093
4094 @cindex Square-free numbers
4095 @cindex Duplicate values in a list
4096 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @kbd{k f} command produces a
4097 list of prime factors for a number. Sometimes it is important to
4098 know that a number is @dfn{square-free}, i.e., that no prime occurs
4099 more than once in its list of prime factors. Find a sequence of
4100 keystrokes to tell if a number is square-free; your method should
4101 leave 1 on the stack if it is, or 0 if it isn't.
4102 @xref{List Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4103
4104 @cindex Triangular lists
4105 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Build a list of lists that looks
4106 like the following diagram. (You may wish to use the @kbd{v /}
4107 command to enable multi-line display of vectors.)
4108
4109 @smallexample
4110 @group
4111 1: [ [1],
4112 [1, 2],
4113 [1, 2, 3],
4114 [1, 2, 3, 4],
4115 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5],
4116 [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] ]
4117 @end group
4118 @end smallexample
4119
4120 @noindent
4121 @xref{List Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4122
4123 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Build the following list of lists.
4124
4125 @smallexample
4126 @group
4127 1: [ [0],
4128 [1, 2],
4129 [3, 4, 5],
4130 [6, 7, 8, 9],
4131 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
4132 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
4133 @end group
4134 @end smallexample
4135
4136 @noindent
4137 @xref{List Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4138
4139 @cindex Maximizing a function over a list of values
4140 @c [fix-ref Numerical Solutions]
4141 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} Compute a list of values of Bessel's
4142 @texline @math{J_1(x)}
4143 @infoline @expr{J1}
4144 function @samp{besJ(1,x)} for @expr{x} from 0 to 5 in steps of 0.25.
4145 Find the value of @expr{x} (from among the above set of values) for
4146 which @samp{besJ(1,x)} is a maximum. Use an ``automatic'' method,
4147 i.e., just reading along the list by hand to find the largest value
4148 is not allowed! (There is an @kbd{a X} command which does this kind
4149 of thing automatically; @pxref{Numerical Solutions}.)
4150 @xref{List Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4151
4152 @cindex Digits, vectors of
4153 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} You are given an integer in the range
4154 @texline @math{0 \le N < 10^m}
4155 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < 10^m}
4156 for @expr{m=12} (i.e., an integer of less than
4157 twelve digits). Convert this integer into a vector of @expr{m}
4158 digits, each in the range from 0 to 9. In vector-of-digits notation,
4159 add one to this integer to produce a vector of @expr{m+1} digits
4160 (since there could be a carry out of the most significant digit).
4161 Convert this vector back into a regular integer. A good integer
4162 to try is 25129925999. @xref{List Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4163
4164 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Your friend Joe tried to use
4165 @kbd{V R a =} to test if all numbers in a list were equal. What
4166 happened? How would you do this test? @xref{List Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4167
4168 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The area of a circle of radius one
4169 is @cpi{}. The area of the
4170 @texline @math{2\times2}
4171 @infoline 2x2
4172 square that encloses that circle is 4. So if we throw @var{n} darts at
4173 random points in the square, about @cpiover{4} of them will land inside
4174 the circle. This gives us an entertaining way to estimate the value of
4175 @cpi{}. The @w{@kbd{k r}}
4176 command picks a random number between zero and the value on the stack.
4177 We could get a random floating-point number between @mathit{-1} and 1 by typing
4178 @w{@kbd{2.0 k r 1 -}}. Build a vector of 100 random @expr{(x,y)} points in
4179 this square, then use vector mapping and reduction to count how many
4180 points lie inside the unit circle. Hint: Use the @kbd{v b} command.
4181 @xref{List Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4182
4183 @cindex Matchstick problem
4184 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} The @dfn{matchstick problem} provides
4185 another way to calculate @cpi{}. Say you have an infinite field
4186 of vertical lines with a spacing of one inch. Toss a one-inch matchstick
4187 onto the field. The probability that the matchstick will land crossing
4188 a line turns out to be
4189 @texline @math{2/\pi}.
4190 @infoline @expr{2/pi}.
4191 Toss 100 matchsticks to estimate @cpi{}. (If you want still more fun,
4192 the probability that the GCD (@w{@kbd{k g}}) of two large integers is
4193 one turns out to be
4194 @texline @math{6/\pi^2}.
4195 @infoline @expr{6/pi^2}.
4196 That provides yet another way to estimate @cpi{}.)
4197 @xref{List Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4198
4199 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} An algebraic entry of a string in
4200 double-quote marks, @samp{"hello"}, creates a vector of the numerical
4201 (ASCII) codes of the characters (here, @expr{[104, 101, 108, 108, 111]}).
4202 Sometimes it is convenient to compute a @dfn{hash code} of a string,
4203 which is just an integer that represents the value of that string.
4204 Two equal strings have the same hash code; two different strings
4205 @dfn{probably} have different hash codes. (For example, Calc has
4206 over 400 function names, but Emacs can quickly find the definition for
4207 any given name because it has sorted the functions into ``buckets'' by
4208 their hash codes. Sometimes a few names will hash into the same bucket,
4209 but it is easier to search among a few names than among all the names.)
4210 One popular hash function is computed as follows: First set @expr{h = 0}.
4211 Then, for each character from the string in turn, set @expr{h = 3h + c_i}
4212 where @expr{c_i} is the character's ASCII code. If we have 511 buckets,
4213 we then take the hash code modulo 511 to get the bucket number. Develop a
4214 simple command or commands for converting string vectors into hash codes.
4215 The hash code for @samp{"Testing, 1, 2, 3"} is 1960915098, which modulo
4216 511 is 121. @xref{List Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4217
4218 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} The @kbd{H V R} and @kbd{H V U}
4219 commands do nested function evaluations. @kbd{H V U} takes a starting
4220 value and a number of steps @var{n} from the stack; it then applies the
4221 function you give to the starting value 0, 1, 2, up to @var{n} times
4222 and returns a vector of the results. Use this command to create a
4223 ``random walk'' of 50 steps. Start with the two-dimensional point
4224 @expr{(0,0)}; then take one step a random distance between @mathit{-1} and 1
4225 in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}; then take another step, and so on. Use the
4226 @kbd{g f} command to display this random walk. Now modify your random
4227 walk to walk a unit distance, but in a random direction, at each step.
4228 (Hint: The @code{sincos} function returns a vector of the cosine and
4229 sine of an angle.) @xref{List Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4230
4231 @node Types Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Vector/Matrix Tutorial, Tutorial
4232 @section Types Tutorial
4233
4234 @noindent
4235 Calc understands a variety of data types as well as simple numbers.
4236 In this section, we'll experiment with each of these types in turn.
4237
4238 The numbers we've been using so far have mainly been either @dfn{integers}
4239 or @dfn{floats}. We saw that floats are usually a good approximation to
4240 the mathematical concept of real numbers, but they are only approximations
4241 and are susceptible to roundoff error. Calc also supports @dfn{fractions},
4242 which can exactly represent any rational number.
4243
4244 @smallexample
4245 @group
4246 1: 3628800 2: 3628800 1: 518400:7 1: 518414:7 1: 7:518414
4247 . 1: 49 . . .
4248 .
4249
4250 10 ! 49 @key{RET} : 2 + &
4251 @end group
4252 @end smallexample
4253
4254 @noindent
4255 The @kbd{:} command divides two integers to get a fraction; @kbd{/}
4256 would normally divide integers to get a floating-point result.
4257 Notice we had to type @key{RET} between the @kbd{49} and the @kbd{:}
4258 since the @kbd{:} would otherwise be interpreted as part of a
4259 fraction beginning with 49.
4260
4261 You can convert between floating-point and fractional format using
4262 @kbd{c f} and @kbd{c F}:
4263
4264 @smallexample
4265 @group
4266 1: 1.35027217629e-5 1: 7:518414
4267 . .
4268
4269 c f c F
4270 @end group
4271 @end smallexample
4272
4273 The @kbd{c F} command replaces a floating-point number with the
4274 ``simplest'' fraction whose floating-point representation is the
4275 same, to within the current precision.
4276
4277 @smallexample
4278 @group
4279 1: 3.14159265359 1: 1146408:364913 1: 3.1416 1: 355:113
4280 . . . .
4281
4282 P c F @key{DEL} p 5 @key{RET} P c F
4283 @end group
4284 @end smallexample
4285
4286 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} A calculation has produced the
4287 result 1.26508260337. You suspect it is the square root of the
4288 product of @cpi{} and some rational number. Is it? (Be sure
4289 to allow for roundoff error!) @xref{Types Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4290
4291 @dfn{Complex numbers} can be stored in both rectangular and polar form.
4292
4293 @smallexample
4294 @group
4295 1: -9 1: (0, 3) 1: (3; 90.) 1: (6; 90.) 1: (2.4495; 45.)
4296 . . . . .
4297
4298 9 n Q c p 2 * Q
4299 @end group
4300 @end smallexample
4301
4302 @noindent
4303 The square root of @mathit{-9} is by default rendered in rectangular form
4304 (@w{@expr{0 + 3i}}), but we can convert it to polar form (3 with a
4305 phase angle of 90 degrees). All the usual arithmetic and scientific
4306 operations are defined on both types of complex numbers.
4307
4308 Another generalized kind of number is @dfn{infinity}. Infinity
4309 isn't really a number, but it can sometimes be treated like one.
4310 Calc uses the symbol @code{inf} to represent positive infinity,
4311 i.e., a value greater than any real number. Naturally, you can
4312 also write @samp{-inf} for minus infinity, a value less than any
4313 real number. The word @code{inf} can only be input using
4314 algebraic entry.
4315
4316 @smallexample
4317 @group
4318 2: inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 2: -inf 1: nan
4319 1: -17 1: -inf 1: -inf 1: inf .
4320 . . . .
4321
4322 ' inf @key{RET} 17 n * @key{RET} 72 + A +
4323 @end group
4324 @end smallexample
4325
4326 @noindent
4327 Since infinity is infinitely large, multiplying it by any finite
4328 number (like @mathit{-17}) has no effect, except that since @mathit{-17}
4329 is negative, it changes a plus infinity to a minus infinity.
4330 (``A huge positive number, multiplied by @mathit{-17}, yields a huge
4331 negative number.'') Adding any finite number to infinity also
4332 leaves it unchanged. Taking an absolute value gives us plus
4333 infinity again. Finally, we add this plus infinity to the minus
4334 infinity we had earlier. If you work it out, you might expect
4335 the answer to be @mathit{-72} for this. But the 72 has been completely
4336 lost next to the infinities; by the time we compute @w{@samp{inf - inf}}
4337 the finite difference between them, if any, is undetectable.
4338 So we say the result is @dfn{indeterminate}, which Calc writes
4339 with the symbol @code{nan} (for Not A Number).
4340
4341 Dividing by zero is normally treated as an error, but you can get
4342 Calc to write an answer in terms of infinity by pressing @kbd{m i}
4343 to turn on Infinite mode.
4344
4345 @smallexample
4346 @group
4347 3: nan 2: nan 2: nan 2: nan 1: nan
4348 2: 1 1: 1 / 0 1: uinf 1: uinf .
4349 1: 0 . . .
4350 .
4351
4352 1 @key{RET} 0 / m i U / 17 n * +
4353 @end group
4354 @end smallexample
4355
4356 @noindent
4357 Dividing by zero normally is left unevaluated, but after @kbd{m i}
4358 it instead gives an infinite result. The answer is actually
4359 @code{uinf}, ``undirected infinity.'' If you look at a graph of
4360 @expr{1 / x} around @w{@expr{x = 0}}, you'll see that it goes toward
4361 plus infinity as you approach zero from above, but toward minus
4362 infinity as you approach from below. Since we said only @expr{1 / 0},
4363 Calc knows that the answer is infinite but not in which direction.
4364 That's what @code{uinf} means. Notice that multiplying @code{uinf}
4365 by a negative number still leaves plain @code{uinf}; there's no
4366 point in saying @samp{-uinf} because the sign of @code{uinf} is
4367 unknown anyway. Finally, we add @code{uinf} to our @code{nan},
4368 yielding @code{nan} again. It's easy to see that, because
4369 @code{nan} means ``totally unknown'' while @code{uinf} means
4370 ``unknown sign but known to be infinite,'' the more mysterious
4371 @code{nan} wins out when it is combined with @code{uinf}, or, for
4372 that matter, with anything else.
4373
4374 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Predict what Calc will answer
4375 for each of these formulas: @samp{inf / inf}, @samp{exp(inf)},
4376 @samp{exp(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(-inf)}, @samp{sqrt(uinf)},
4377 @samp{abs(uinf)}, @samp{ln(0)}.
4378 @xref{Types Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4379
4380 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} We saw that @samp{inf - inf = nan},
4381 which stands for an unknown value. Can @code{nan} stand for
4382 a complex number? Can it stand for infinity?
4383 @xref{Types Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
4384
4385 @dfn{HMS forms} represent a value in terms of hours, minutes, and
4386 seconds.
4387
4388 @smallexample
4389 @group
4390 1: 2@@ 30' 0" 1: 3@@ 30' 0" 2: 3@@ 30' 0" 1: 2.
4391 . . 1: 1@@ 45' 0." .
4392 .
4393
4394 2@@ 30' @key{RET} 1 + @key{RET} 2 / /
4395 @end group
4396 @end smallexample
4397
4398 HMS forms can also be used to hold angles in degrees, minutes, and
4399 seconds.
4400
4401 @smallexample
4402 @group
4403 1: 0.5 1: 26.56505 1: 26@@ 33' 54.18" 1: 0.44721
4404 . . . .
4405
4406 0.5 I T c h S
4407 @end group
4408 @end smallexample
4409
4410 @noindent
4411 First we convert the inverse tangent of 0.5 to degrees-minutes-seconds
4412 form, then we take the sine of that angle. Note that the trigonometric
4413 functions will accept HMS forms directly as input.
4414
4415 @cindex Beatles
4416 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} The Beatles' @emph{Abbey Road} is
4417 47 minutes and 26 seconds long, and contains 17 songs. What is the
4418 average length of a song on @emph{Abbey Road}? If the Extended Disco
4419 Version of @emph{Abbey Road} added 20 seconds to the length of each
4420 song, how long would the album be? @xref{Types Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
4421
4422 A @dfn{date form} represents a date, or a date and time. Dates must
4423 be entered using algebraic entry. Date forms are surrounded by
4424 @samp{< >} symbols; most standard formats for dates are recognized.
4425
4426 @smallexample
4427 @group
4428 2: <Sun Jan 13, 1991> 1: 2.25
4429 1: <6:00pm Thu Jan 10, 1991> .
4430 .
4431
4432 ' <13 Jan 1991>, <1/10/91, 6pm> @key{RET} -
4433 @end group
4434 @end smallexample
4435
4436 @noindent
4437 In this example, we enter two dates, then subtract to find the
4438 number of days between them. It is also possible to add an
4439 HMS form or a number (of days) to a date form to get another
4440 date form.
4441
4442 @smallexample
4443 @group
4444 1: <4:45:59pm Mon Jan 14, 1991> 1: <2:50:59am Thu Jan 17, 1991>
4445 . .
4446
4447 t N 2 + 10@@ 5' +
4448 @end group
4449 @end smallexample
4450
4451 @c [fix-ref Date Arithmetic]
4452 @noindent
4453 The @kbd{t N} (``now'') command pushes the current date and time on the
4454 stack; then we add two days, ten hours and five minutes to the date and
4455 time. Other date-and-time related commands include @kbd{t J}, which
4456 does Julian day conversions, @kbd{t W}, which finds the beginning of
4457 the week in which a date form lies, and @kbd{t I}, which increments a
4458 date by one or several months. @xref{Date Arithmetic}, for more.
4459
4460 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} How many days until the next
4461 Friday the 13th? @xref{Types Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
4462
4463 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} How many leap years will there be
4464 between now and the year 10001 AD@? @xref{Types Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
4465
4466 @cindex Slope and angle of a line
4467 @cindex Angle and slope of a line
4468 An @dfn{error form} represents a mean value with an attached standard
4469 deviation, or error estimate. Suppose our measurements indicate that
4470 a certain telephone pole is about 30 meters away, with an estimated
4471 error of 1 meter, and 8 meters tall, with an estimated error of 0.2
4472 meters. What is the slope of a line from here to the top of the
4473 pole, and what is the equivalent angle in degrees?
4474
4475 @smallexample
4476 @group
4477 1: 8 +/- 0.2 2: 8 +/- 0.2 1: 0.266 +/- 0.011 1: 14.93 +/- 0.594
4478 . 1: 30 +/- 1 . .
4479 .
4480
4481 8 p .2 @key{RET} 30 p 1 / I T
4482 @end group
4483 @end smallexample
4484
4485 @noindent
4486 This means that the angle is about 15 degrees, and, assuming our
4487 original error estimates were valid standard deviations, there is about
4488 a 60% chance that the result is correct within 0.59 degrees.
4489
4490 @cindex Torus, volume of
4491 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} The volume of a torus (a donut shape) is
4492 @texline @math{2 \pi^2 R r^2}
4493 @infoline @w{@expr{2 pi^2 R r^2}}
4494 where @expr{R} is the radius of the circle that
4495 defines the center of the tube and @expr{r} is the radius of the tube
4496 itself. Suppose @expr{R} is 20 cm and @expr{r} is 4 cm, each known to
4497 within 5 percent. What is the volume and the relative uncertainty of
4498 the volume? @xref{Types Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
4499
4500 An @dfn{interval form} represents a range of values. While an
4501 error form is best for making statistical estimates, intervals give
4502 you exact bounds on an answer. Suppose we additionally know that
4503 our telephone pole is definitely between 28 and 31 meters away,
4504 and that it is between 7.7 and 8.1 meters tall.
4505
4506 @smallexample
4507 @group
4508 1: [7.7 .. 8.1] 2: [7.7 .. 8.1] 1: [0.24 .. 0.28] 1: [13.9 .. 16.1]
4509 . 1: [28 .. 31] . .
4510 .
4511
4512 [ 7.7 .. 8.1 ] [ 28 .. 31 ] / I T
4513 @end group
4514 @end smallexample
4515
4516 @noindent
4517 If our bounds were correct, then the angle to the top of the pole
4518 is sure to lie in the range shown.
4519
4520 The square brackets around these intervals indicate that the endpoints
4521 themselves are allowable values. In other words, the distance to the
4522 telephone pole is between 28 and 31, @emph{inclusive}. You can also
4523 make an interval that is exclusive of its endpoints by writing
4524 parentheses instead of square brackets. You can even make an interval
4525 which is inclusive (``closed'') on one end and exclusive (``open'') on
4526 the other.
4527
4528 @smallexample
4529 @group
4530 1: [1 .. 10) 1: (0.1 .. 1] 2: (0.1 .. 1] 1: (0.2 .. 3)
4531 . . 1: [2 .. 3) .
4532 .
4533
4534 [ 1 .. 10 ) & [ 2 .. 3 ) *
4535 @end group
4536 @end smallexample
4537
4538 @noindent
4539 The Calculator automatically keeps track of which end values should
4540 be open and which should be closed. You can also make infinite or
4541 semi-infinite intervals by using @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} for one
4542 or both endpoints.
4543
4544 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} What answer would you expect from
4545 @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(0 .. 10)}}? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 0)}}? What
4546 about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{[0 .. 10]}} (where the interval actually includes
4547 zero)? What about @samp{@w{1 /} @w{(-10 .. 10)}}?
4548 @xref{Types Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
4549
4550 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} Two easy ways of squaring a number
4551 are @kbd{@key{RET} *} and @w{@kbd{2 ^}}. Normally these produce the same
4552 answer. Would you expect this still to hold true for interval forms?
4553 If not, which of these will result in a larger interval?
4554 @xref{Types Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
4555
4556 A @dfn{modulo form} is used for performing arithmetic modulo @var{m}.
4557 For example, arithmetic involving time is generally done modulo 12
4558 or 24 hours.
4559
4560 @smallexample
4561 @group
4562 1: 17 mod 24 1: 3 mod 24 1: 21 mod 24 1: 9 mod 24
4563 . . . .
4564
4565 17 M 24 @key{RET} 10 + n 5 /
4566 @end group
4567 @end smallexample
4568
4569 @noindent
4570 In this last step, Calc has divided by 5 modulo 24; i.e., it has found a
4571 new number which, when multiplied by 5 modulo 24, produces the original
4572 number, 21. If @var{m} is prime and the divisor is not a multiple of
4573 @var{m}, it is always possible to find such a number. For non-prime
4574 @var{m} like 24, it is only sometimes possible.
4575
4576 @smallexample
4577 @group
4578 1: 10 mod 24 1: 16 mod 24 1: 1000000... 1: 16
4579 . . . .
4580
4581 10 M 24 @key{RET} 100 ^ 10 @key{RET} 100 ^ 24 %
4582 @end group
4583 @end smallexample
4584
4585 @noindent
4586 These two calculations get the same answer, but the first one is
4587 much more efficient because it avoids the huge intermediate value
4588 that arises in the second one.
4589
4590 @cindex Fermat, primality test of
4591 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} A theorem of Pierre de Fermat
4592 says that
4593 @texline @math{x^{n-1} \bmod n = 1}
4594 @infoline @expr{x^(n-1) mod n = 1}
4595 if @expr{n} is a prime number and @expr{x} is an integer less than
4596 @expr{n}. If @expr{n} is @emph{not} a prime number, this will
4597 @emph{not} be true for most values of @expr{x}. Thus we can test
4598 informally if a number is prime by trying this formula for several
4599 values of @expr{x}. Use this test to tell whether the following numbers
4600 are prime: 811749613, 15485863. @xref{Types Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
4601
4602 It is possible to use HMS forms as parts of error forms, intervals,
4603 modulo forms, or as the phase part of a polar complex number.
4604 For example, the @code{calc-time} command pushes the current time
4605 of day on the stack as an HMS/modulo form.
4606
4607 @smallexample
4608 @group
4609 1: 17@@ 34' 45" mod 24@@ 0' 0" 1: 6@@ 22' 15" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
4610 . .
4611
4612 x time @key{RET} n
4613 @end group
4614 @end smallexample
4615
4616 @noindent
4617 This calculation tells me it is six hours and 22 minutes until midnight.
4618
4619 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} A rule of thumb is that one year
4620 is about
4621 @texline @math{\pi \times 10^7}
4622 @infoline @w{@expr{pi * 10^7}}
4623 seconds. What time will it be that many seconds from right now?
4624 @xref{Types Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
4625
4626 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} You are preparing to order packaging
4627 for the CD release of the Extended Disco Version of @emph{Abbey Road}.
4628 You are told that the songs will actually be anywhere from 20 to 60
4629 seconds longer than the originals. One CD can hold about 75 minutes
4630 of music. Should you order single or double packages?
4631 @xref{Types Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
4632
4633 Another kind of data the Calculator can manipulate is numbers with
4634 @dfn{units}. This isn't strictly a new data type; it's simply an
4635 application of algebraic expressions, where we use variables with
4636 suggestive names like @samp{cm} and @samp{in} to represent units
4637 like centimeters and inches.
4638
4639 @smallexample
4640 @group
4641 1: 2 in 1: 5.08 cm 1: 0.027778 fath 1: 0.0508 m
4642 . . . .
4643
4644 ' 2in @key{RET} u c cm @key{RET} u c fath @key{RET} u b
4645 @end group
4646 @end smallexample
4647
4648 @noindent
4649 We enter the quantity ``2 inches'' (actually an algebraic expression
4650 which means two times the variable @samp{in}), then we convert it
4651 first to centimeters, then to fathoms, then finally to ``base'' units,
4652 which in this case means meters.
4653
4654 @smallexample
4655 @group
4656 1: 9 acre 1: 3 sqrt(acre) 1: 190.84 m 1: 190.84 m + 30 cm
4657 . . . .
4658
4659 ' 9 acre @key{RET} Q u s ' $+30 cm @key{RET}
4660
4661 @end group
4662 @end smallexample
4663 @noindent
4664 @smallexample
4665 @group
4666 1: 191.14 m 1: 36536.3046 m^2 1: 365363046 cm^2
4667 . . .
4668
4669 u s 2 ^ u c cgs
4670 @end group
4671 @end smallexample
4672
4673 @noindent
4674 Since units expressions are really just formulas, taking the square
4675 root of @samp{acre} is undefined. After all, @code{acre} might be an
4676 algebraic variable that you will someday assign a value. We use the
4677 ``units-simplify'' command to simplify the expression with variables
4678 being interpreted as unit names.
4679
4680 In the final step, we have converted not to a particular unit, but to a
4681 units system. The ``cgs'' system uses centimeters instead of meters
4682 as its standard unit of length.
4683
4684 There is a wide variety of units defined in the Calculator.
4685
4686 @smallexample
4687 @group
4688 1: 55 mph 1: 88.5139 kph 1: 88.5139 km / hr 1: 8.201407e-8 c
4689 . . . .
4690
4691 ' 55 mph @key{RET} u c kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} u c c @key{RET}
4692 @end group
4693 @end smallexample
4694
4695 @noindent
4696 We express a speed first in miles per hour, then in kilometers per
4697 hour, then again using a slightly more explicit notation, then
4698 finally in terms of fractions of the speed of light.
4699
4700 Temperature conversions are a bit more tricky. There are two ways to
4701 interpret ``20 degrees Fahrenheit''---it could mean an actual
4702 temperature, or it could mean a change in temperature. For normal
4703 units there is no difference, but temperature units have an offset
4704 as well as a scale factor and so there must be two explicit commands
4705 for them.
4706
4707 @smallexample
4708 @group
4709 1: 20 degF 1: 11.1111 degC 1: -6.666 degC
4710 . . . .
4711
4712 ' 20 degF @key{RET} u c degC @key{RET} U u t degC @key{RET}
4713 @end group
4714 @end smallexample
4715
4716 @noindent
4717 First we convert a change of 20 degrees Fahrenheit into an equivalent
4718 change in degrees Celsius (or Centigrade). Then, we convert the
4719 absolute temperature 20 degrees Fahrenheit into Celsius.
4720
4721 For simple unit conversions, you can put a plain number on the stack.
4722 Then @kbd{u c} and @kbd{u t} will prompt for both old and new units.
4723 When you use this method, you're responsible for remembering which
4724 numbers are in which units:
4725
4726 @smallexample
4727 @group
4728 1: 55 1: 88.5139 1: 8.201407e-8
4729 . . .
4730
4731 55 u c mph @key{RET} kph @key{RET} u c km/hr @key{RET} c @key{RET}
4732 @end group
4733 @end smallexample
4734
4735 To see a complete list of built-in units, type @kbd{u v}. Press
4736 @w{@kbd{C-x * c}} again to re-enter the Calculator when you're done looking
4737 at the units table.
4738
4739 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 13.} How many seconds are there really
4740 in a year? @xref{Types Answer 13, 13}. (@bullet{})
4741
4742 @cindex Speed of light
4743 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 14.} Supercomputer designs are limited by
4744 the speed of light (and of electricity, which is nearly as fast).
4745 Suppose a computer has a 4.1 ns (nanosecond) clock cycle, and its
4746 cabinet is one meter across. Is speed of light going to be a
4747 significant factor in its design? @xref{Types Answer 14, 14}. (@bullet{})
4748
4749 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 15.} Sam the Slug normally travels about
4750 five yards in an hour. He has obtained a supply of Power Pills; each
4751 Power Pill he eats doubles his speed. How many Power Pills can he
4752 swallow and still travel legally on most US highways?
4753 @xref{Types Answer 15, 15}. (@bullet{})
4754
4755 @node Algebra Tutorial, Programming Tutorial, Types Tutorial, Tutorial
4756 @section Algebra and Calculus Tutorial
4757
4758 @noindent
4759 This section shows how to use Calc's algebra facilities to solve
4760 equations, do simple calculus problems, and manipulate algebraic
4761 formulas.
4762
4763 @menu
4764 * Basic Algebra Tutorial::
4765 * Rewrites Tutorial::
4766 @end menu
4767
4768 @node Basic Algebra Tutorial, Rewrites Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
4769 @subsection Basic Algebra
4770
4771 @noindent
4772 If you enter a formula in Algebraic mode that refers to variables,
4773 the formula itself is pushed onto the stack. You can manipulate
4774 formulas as regular data objects.
4775
4776 @smallexample
4777 @group
4778 1: 2 x^2 - 6 1: 6 - 2 x^2 1: (3 x^2 + y) (6 - 2 x^2)
4779 . . .
4780
4781 ' 2x^2-6 @key{RET} n ' 3x^2+y @key{RET} *
4782 @end group
4783 @end smallexample
4784
4785 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Do @kbd{' x @key{RET} Q 2 ^} and
4786 @kbd{' x @key{RET} 2 ^ Q} both wind up with the same result (@samp{x})?
4787 Why or why not? @xref{Algebra Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
4788
4789 There are also commands for doing common algebraic operations on
4790 formulas. Continuing with the formula from the last example,
4791
4792 @smallexample
4793 @group
4794 1: 18 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y - 2 y x^2 1: (18 - 2 y) x^2 - 6 x^4 + 6 y
4795 . .
4796
4797 a x a c x @key{RET}
4798 @end group
4799 @end smallexample
4800
4801 @noindent
4802 First we ``expand'' using the distributive law, then we ``collect''
4803 terms involving like powers of @expr{x}.
4804
4805 Let's find the value of this expression when @expr{x} is 2 and @expr{y}
4806 is one-half.
4807
4808 @smallexample
4809 @group
4810 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: -25
4811 . .
4812
4813 1:2 s l y @key{RET} 2 s l x @key{RET}
4814 @end group
4815 @end smallexample
4816
4817 @noindent
4818 The @kbd{s l} command means ``let''; it takes a number from the top of
4819 the stack and temporarily assigns it as the value of the variable
4820 you specify. It then evaluates (as if by the @kbd{=} key) the
4821 next expression on the stack. After this command, the variable goes
4822 back to its original value, if any.
4823
4824 (An earlier exercise in this tutorial involved storing a value in the
4825 variable @code{x}; if this value is still there, you will have to
4826 unstore it with @kbd{s u x @key{RET}} before the above example will work
4827 properly.)
4828
4829 @cindex Maximum of a function using Calculus
4830 Let's find the maximum value of our original expression when @expr{y}
4831 is one-half and @expr{x} ranges over all possible values. We can
4832 do this by taking the derivative with respect to @expr{x} and examining
4833 values of @expr{x} for which the derivative is zero. If the second
4834 derivative of the function at that value of @expr{x} is negative,
4835 the function has a local maximum there.
4836
4837 @smallexample
4838 @group
4839 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
4840 . .
4841
4842 U @key{DEL} s 1 a d x @key{RET} s 2
4843 @end group
4844 @end smallexample
4845
4846 @noindent
4847 Well, the derivative is clearly zero when @expr{x} is zero. To find
4848 the other root(s), let's divide through by @expr{x} and then solve:
4849
4850 @smallexample
4851 @group
4852 1: (34 x - 24 x^3) / x 1: 34 - 24 x^2
4853 . .
4854
4855 ' x @key{RET} / a x
4856
4857 @end group
4858 @end smallexample
4859 @noindent
4860 @smallexample
4861 @group
4862 1: 0.70588 x^2 = 1 1: x = 1.19023
4863 . .
4864
4865 0 a = s 3 a S x @key{RET}
4866 @end group
4867 @end smallexample
4868
4869 @noindent
4870 Now we compute the second derivative and plug in our values of @expr{x}:
4871
4872 @smallexample
4873 @group
4874 1: 1.19023 2: 1.19023 2: 1.19023
4875 . 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: 34 - 72 x^2
4876 . .
4877
4878 a . r 2 a d x @key{RET} s 4
4879 @end group
4880 @end smallexample
4881
4882 @noindent
4883 (The @kbd{a .} command extracts just the righthand side of an equation.
4884 Another method would have been to use @kbd{v u} to unpack the equation
4885 @w{@samp{x = 1.19}} to @samp{x} and @samp{1.19}, then use @kbd{M-- M-2 @key{DEL}}
4886 to delete the @samp{x}.)
4887
4888 @smallexample
4889 @group
4890 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: -68. 2: 34 - 72 x^2 1: 34
4891 1: 1.19023 . 1: 0 .
4892 . .
4893
4894 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET} U @key{DEL} 0 s l x @key{RET}
4895 @end group
4896 @end smallexample
4897
4898 @noindent
4899 The first of these second derivatives is negative, so we know the function
4900 has a maximum value at @expr{x = 1.19023}. (The function also has a
4901 local @emph{minimum} at @expr{x = 0}.)
4902
4903 When we solved for @expr{x}, we got only one value even though
4904 @expr{0.70588 x^2 = 1} is a quadratic equation that ought to have
4905 two solutions. The reason is that @w{@kbd{a S}} normally returns a
4906 single ``principal'' solution. If it needs to come up with an
4907 arbitrary sign (as occurs in the quadratic formula) it picks @expr{+}.
4908 If it needs an arbitrary integer, it picks zero. We can get a full
4909 solution by pressing @kbd{H} (the Hyperbolic flag) before @kbd{a S}.
4910
4911 @smallexample
4912 @group
4913 1: 0.70588 x^2 = 1 1: x = 1.19023 s1 1: x = -1.19023
4914 . . .
4915
4916 r 3 H a S x @key{RET} s 5 1 n s l s1 @key{RET}
4917 @end group
4918 @end smallexample
4919
4920 @noindent
4921 Calc has invented the variable @samp{s1} to represent an unknown sign;
4922 it is supposed to be either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}. Here we have used
4923 the ``let'' command to evaluate the expression when the sign is negative.
4924 If we plugged this into our second derivative we would get the same,
4925 negative, answer, so @expr{x = -1.19023} is also a maximum.
4926
4927 To find the actual maximum value, we must plug our two values of @expr{x}
4928 into the original formula.
4929
4930 @smallexample
4931 @group
4932 2: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 24.08333 s1^2 - 12.04166 s1^4 + 3
4933 1: x = 1.19023 s1 .
4934 .
4935
4936 r 1 r 5 s l @key{RET}
4937 @end group
4938 @end smallexample
4939
4940 @noindent
4941 (Here we see another way to use @kbd{s l}; if its input is an equation
4942 with a variable on the lefthand side, then @kbd{s l} treats the equation
4943 like an assignment to that variable if you don't give a variable name.)
4944
4945 It's clear that this will have the same value for either sign of
4946 @code{s1}, but let's work it out anyway, just for the exercise:
4947
4948 @smallexample
4949 @group
4950 2: [-1, 1] 1: [15.04166, 15.04166]
4951 1: 24.08333 s1^2 ... .
4952 .
4953
4954 [ 1 n , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
4955 @end group
4956 @end smallexample
4957
4958 @noindent
4959 Here we have used a vector mapping operation to evaluate the function
4960 at several values of @samp{s1} at once. @kbd{V M $} is like @kbd{V M '}
4961 except that it takes the formula from the top of the stack. The
4962 formula is interpreted as a function to apply across the vector at the
4963 next-to-top stack level. Since a formula on the stack can't contain
4964 @samp{$} signs, Calc assumes the variables in the formula stand for
4965 different arguments. It prompts you for an @dfn{argument list}, giving
4966 the list of all variables in the formula in alphabetical order as the
4967 default list. In this case the default is @samp{(s1)}, which is just
4968 what we want so we simply press @key{RET} at the prompt.
4969
4970 If there had been several different values, we could have used
4971 @w{@kbd{V R X}} to find the global maximum.
4972
4973 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a P} command that solves an equation using
4974 @w{@kbd{H a S}} and returns a vector of all the solutions. It simply
4975 automates the job we just did by hand. Applied to our original
4976 cubic polynomial, it would produce the vector of solutions
4977 @expr{[1.19023, -1.19023, 0]}. (There is also an @kbd{a X} command
4978 which finds a local maximum of a function. It uses a numerical search
4979 method rather than examining the derivatives, and thus requires you
4980 to provide some kind of initial guess to show it where to look.)
4981
4982 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Given a vector of the roots of a
4983 polynomial (such as the output of an @kbd{a P} command), what
4984 sequence of commands would you use to reconstruct the original
4985 polynomial? (The answer will be unique to within a constant
4986 multiple; choose the solution where the leading coefficient is one.)
4987 @xref{Algebra Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
4988
4989 The @kbd{m s} command enables Symbolic mode, in which formulas
4990 like @samp{sqrt(5)} that can't be evaluated exactly are left in
4991 symbolic form rather than giving a floating-point approximate answer.
4992 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}) is also useful when doing algebra.
4993
4994 @smallexample
4995 @group
4996 2: 34 x - 24 x^3 2: 34 x - 24 x^3
4997 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0]
4998 . .
4999
5000 r 2 @key{RET} m s m f a P x @key{RET}
5001 @end group
5002 @end smallexample
5003
5004 One more mode that makes reading formulas easier is Big mode.
5005
5006 @smallexample
5007 @group
5008 3
5009 2: 34 x - 24 x
5010
5011 ____ ____
5012 V 51 V 51
5013 1: [-----, -----, 0]
5014 6 -6
5015
5016 .
5017
5018 d B
5019 @end group
5020 @end smallexample
5021
5022 Here things like powers, square roots, and quotients and fractions
5023 are displayed in a two-dimensional pictorial form. Calc has other
5024 language modes as well, such as C mode, FORTRAN mode, @TeX{} mode
5025 and @LaTeX{} mode.
5026
5027 @smallexample
5028 @group
5029 2: 34*x - 24*pow(x, 3) 2: 34*x - 24*x**3
5030 1: @{sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0@} 1: /sqrt(51) / 6, sqrt(51) / -6, 0/
5031 . .
5032
5033 d C d F
5034
5035 @end group
5036 @end smallexample
5037 @noindent
5038 @smallexample
5039 @group
5040 3: 34 x - 24 x^3
5041 2: [@{\sqrt@{51@} \over 6@}, @{\sqrt@{51@} \over -6@}, 0]
5042 1: @{2 \over 3@} \sqrt@{5@}
5043 .
5044
5045 d T ' 2 \sqrt@{5@} \over 3 @key{RET}
5046 @end group
5047 @end smallexample
5048
5049 @noindent
5050 As you can see, language modes affect both entry and display of
5051 formulas. They affect such things as the names used for built-in
5052 functions, the set of arithmetic operators and their precedences,
5053 and notations for vectors and matrices.
5054
5055 Notice that @samp{sqrt(51)} may cause problems with older
5056 implementations of C and FORTRAN, which would require something more
5057 like @samp{sqrt(51.0)}. It is always wise to check over the formulas
5058 produced by the various language modes to make sure they are fully
5059 correct.
5060
5061 Type @kbd{m s}, @kbd{m f}, and @kbd{d N} to reset these modes. (You
5062 may prefer to remain in Big mode, but all the examples in the tutorial
5063 are shown in normal mode.)
5064
5065 @cindex Area under a curve
5066 What is the area under the portion of this curve from @expr{x = 1} to @expr{2}?
5067 This is simply the integral of the function:
5068
5069 @smallexample
5070 @group
5071 1: 17 x^2 - 6 x^4 + 3 1: 5.6666 x^3 - 1.2 x^5 + 3 x
5072 . .
5073
5074 r 1 a i x
5075 @end group
5076 @end smallexample
5077
5078 @noindent
5079 We want to evaluate this at our two values for @expr{x} and subtract.
5080 One way to do it is again with vector mapping and reduction:
5081
5082 @smallexample
5083 @group
5084 2: [2, 1] 1: [12.93333, 7.46666] 1: 5.46666
5085 1: 5.6666 x^3 ... . .
5086
5087 [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5088 @end group
5089 @end smallexample
5090
5091 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Find the integral from 1 to @expr{y}
5092 of
5093 @texline @math{x \sin \pi x}
5094 @infoline @w{@expr{x sin(pi x)}}
5095 (where the sine is calculated in radians). Find the values of the
5096 integral for integers @expr{y} from 1 to 5. @xref{Algebra Answer 3,
5097 3}. (@bullet{})
5098
5099 Calc's integrator can do many simple integrals symbolically, but many
5100 others are beyond its capabilities. Suppose we wish to find the area
5101 under the curve
5102 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5103 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5104 over the same range of @expr{x}. If you entered this formula and typed
5105 @kbd{a i x @key{RET}} (don't bother to try this), Calc would work for a
5106 long time but would be unable to find a solution. In fact, there is no
5107 closed-form solution to this integral. Now what do we do?
5108
5109 @cindex Integration, numerical
5110 @cindex Numerical integration
5111 One approach would be to do the integral numerically. It is not hard
5112 to do this by hand using vector mapping and reduction. It is rather
5113 slow, though, since the sine and logarithm functions take a long time.
5114 We can save some time by reducing the working precision.
5115
5116 @smallexample
5117 @group
5118 3: 10 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9]
5119 2: 1 .
5120 1: 0.1
5121 .
5122
5123 10 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
5124 @end group
5125 @end smallexample
5126
5127 @noindent
5128 (Note that we have used the extended version of @kbd{v x}; we could
5129 also have used plain @kbd{v x} as follows: @kbd{v x 10 @key{RET} 9 + .1 *}.)
5130
5131 @smallexample
5132 @group
5133 2: [1, 1.1, ... ] 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
5134 1: ln(x) sin(x) .
5135 .
5136
5137 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} s 1 m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
5138
5139 @end group
5140 @end smallexample
5141 @noindent
5142 @smallexample
5143 @group
5144 1: 3.4195 0.34195
5145 . .
5146
5147 V R + 0.1 *
5148 @end group
5149 @end smallexample
5150
5151 @noindent
5152 (If you got wildly different results, did you remember to switch
5153 to Radians mode?)
5154
5155 Here we have divided the curve into ten segments of equal width;
5156 approximating these segments as rectangular boxes (i.e., assuming
5157 the curve is nearly flat at that resolution), we compute the areas
5158 of the boxes (height times width), then sum the areas. (It is
5159 faster to sum first, then multiply by the width, since the width
5160 is the same for every box.)
5161
5162 The true value of this integral turns out to be about 0.374, so
5163 we're not doing too well. Let's try another approach.
5164
5165 @smallexample
5166 @group
5167 1: ln(x) sin(x) 1: 0.84147 x + 0.11957 (x - 1)^2 - ...
5168 . .
5169
5170 r 1 a t x=1 @key{RET} 4 @key{RET}
5171 @end group
5172 @end smallexample
5173
5174 @noindent
5175 Here we have computed the Taylor series expansion of the function
5176 about the point @expr{x=1}. We can now integrate this polynomial
5177 approximation, since polynomials are easy to integrate.
5178
5179 @smallexample
5180 @group
5181 1: 0.42074 x^2 + ... 1: [-0.0446, -0.42073] 1: 0.3761
5182 . . .
5183
5184 a i x @key{RET} [ 2 , 1 ] @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET} V R -
5185 @end group
5186 @end smallexample
5187
5188 @noindent
5189 Better! By increasing the precision and/or asking for more terms
5190 in the Taylor series, we can get a result as accurate as we like.
5191 (Taylor series converge better away from singularities in the
5192 function such as the one at @code{ln(0)}, so it would also help to
5193 expand the series about the points @expr{x=2} or @expr{x=1.5} instead
5194 of @expr{x=1}.)
5195
5196 @cindex Simpson's rule
5197 @cindex Integration by Simpson's rule
5198 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Our first method approximated the
5199 curve by stairsteps of width 0.1; the total area was then the sum
5200 of the areas of the rectangles under these stairsteps. Our second
5201 method approximated the function by a polynomial, which turned out
5202 to be a better approximation than stairsteps. A third method is
5203 @dfn{Simpson's rule}, which is like the stairstep method except
5204 that the steps are not required to be flat. Simpson's rule boils
5205 down to the formula,
5206
5207 @ifnottex
5208 @example
5209 (h/3) * (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + ...
5210 + 2 f(a+(n-2)*h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)*h) + f(a+n*h))
5211 @end example
5212 @end ifnottex
5213 @tex
5214 \beforedisplay
5215 $$ \displaylines{
5216 \qquad {h \over 3} (f(a) + 4 f(a+h) + 2 f(a+2h) + 4 f(a+3h) + \cdots
5217 \hfill \cr \hfill {} + 2 f(a+(n-2)h) + 4 f(a+(n-1)h) + f(a+n h)) \qquad
5218 } $$
5219 \afterdisplay
5220 @end tex
5221
5222 @noindent
5223 where @expr{n} (which must be even) is the number of slices and @expr{h}
5224 is the width of each slice. These are 10 and 0.1 in our example.
5225 For reference, here is the corresponding formula for the stairstep
5226 method:
5227
5228 @ifnottex
5229 @example
5230 h * (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + ...
5231 + f(a+(n-2)*h) + f(a+(n-1)*h))
5232 @end example
5233 @end ifnottex
5234 @tex
5235 \beforedisplay
5236 $$ h (f(a) + f(a+h) + f(a+2h) + f(a+3h) + \cdots
5237 + f(a+(n-2)h) + f(a+(n-1)h)) $$
5238 \afterdisplay
5239 @end tex
5240
5241 Compute the integral from 1 to 2 of
5242 @texline @math{\sin x \ln x}
5243 @infoline @expr{sin(x) ln(x)}
5244 using Simpson's rule with 10 slices.
5245 @xref{Algebra Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5246
5247 Calc has a built-in @kbd{a I} command for doing numerical integration.
5248 It uses @dfn{Romberg's method}, which is a more sophisticated cousin
5249 of Simpson's rule. In particular, it knows how to keep refining the
5250 result until the current precision is satisfied.
5251
5252 @c [fix-ref Selecting Sub-Formulas]
5253 Aside from the commands we've seen so far, Calc also provides a
5254 large set of commands for operating on parts of formulas. You
5255 indicate the desired sub-formula by placing the cursor on any part
5256 of the formula before giving a @dfn{selection} command. Selections won't
5257 be covered in the tutorial; @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}, for
5258 details and examples.
5259
5260 @c hard exercise: simplify (2^(n r) - 2^(r*(n - 1))) / (2^r - 1) 2^(n - 1)
5261 @c to 2^((n-1)*(r-1)).
5262
5263 @node Rewrites Tutorial, , Basic Algebra Tutorial, Algebra Tutorial
5264 @subsection Rewrite Rules
5265
5266 @noindent
5267 No matter how many built-in commands Calc provided for doing algebra,
5268 there would always be something you wanted to do that Calc didn't have
5269 in its repertoire. So Calc also provides a @dfn{rewrite rule} system
5270 that you can use to define your own algebraic manipulations.
5271
5272 Suppose we want to simplify this trigonometric formula:
5273
5274 @smallexample
5275 @group
5276 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2
5277 .
5278
5279 ' 2sec(x)^2/tan(x)^2 - 2/tan(x)^2 @key{RET} s 1
5280 @end group
5281 @end smallexample
5282
5283 @noindent
5284 If we were simplifying this by hand, we'd probably combine over the common
5285 denominator. The @kbd{a n} algebra command will do this, but we'll do
5286 it with a rewrite rule just for practice.
5287
5288 Rewrite rules are written with the @samp{:=} symbol.
5289
5290 @smallexample
5291 @group
5292 1: (2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2
5293 .
5294
5295 a r a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET}
5296 @end group
5297 @end smallexample
5298
5299 @noindent
5300 (The ``assignment operator'' @samp{:=} has several uses in Calc. All
5301 by itself the formula @samp{a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x} doesn't do anything,
5302 but when it is given to the @kbd{a r} command, that command interprets
5303 it as a rewrite rule.)
5304
5305 The lefthand side, @samp{a/x + b/x}, is called the @dfn{pattern} of the
5306 rewrite rule. Calc searches the formula on the stack for parts that
5307 match the pattern. Variables in a rewrite pattern are called
5308 @dfn{meta-variables}, and when matching the pattern each meta-variable
5309 can match any sub-formula. Here, the meta-variable @samp{a} matched
5310 the expression @samp{2 sec(x)^2}, the meta-variable @samp{b} matched
5311 the constant @samp{-2} and the meta-variable @samp{x} matched
5312 the expression @samp{tan(x)^2}.
5313
5314 This rule points out several interesting features of rewrite patterns.
5315 First, if a meta-variable appears several times in a pattern, it must
5316 match the same thing everywhere. This rule detects common denominators
5317 because the same meta-variable @samp{x} is used in both of the
5318 denominators.
5319
5320 Second, meta-variable names are independent from variables in the
5321 target formula. Notice that the meta-variable @samp{x} here matches
5322 the subformula @samp{tan(x)^2}; Calc never confuses the two meanings of
5323 @samp{x}.
5324
5325 And third, rewrite patterns know a little bit about the algebraic
5326 properties of formulas. The pattern called for a sum of two quotients;
5327 Calc was able to match a difference of two quotients by matching
5328 @samp{a = 2 sec(x)^2}, @samp{b = -2}, and @samp{x = tan(x)^2}.
5329
5330 When the pattern part of a rewrite rule matches a part of the formula,
5331 that part is replaced by the righthand side with all the meta-variables
5332 substituted with the things they matched. So the result is
5333 @samp{(2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2}.
5334
5335 @c [fix-ref Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules]
5336 We could just as easily have written @samp{a/x - b/x := (a-b)/x} for
5337 the rule. It would have worked just the same in all cases. (If we
5338 really wanted the rule to apply only to @samp{+} or only to @samp{-},
5339 we could have used the @code{plain} symbol. @xref{Algebraic Properties
5340 of Rewrite Rules}, for some examples of this.)
5341
5342 One more rewrite will complete the job. We want to use the identity
5343 @samp{tan(x)^2 + 1 = sec(x)^2}, but of course we must first rearrange
5344 the identity in a way that matches our formula. The obvious rule
5345 would be @samp{@w{2 sec(x)^2 - 2} := 2 tan(x)^2}, but a little thought shows
5346 that the rule @samp{sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2} will also work. The
5347 latter rule has a more general pattern so it will work in many other
5348 situations, too.
5349
5350 @smallexample
5351 @group
5352 1: 2
5353 .
5354
5355 a r sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2 @key{RET}
5356 @end group
5357 @end smallexample
5358
5359 You may ask, what's the point of using the most general rule if you
5360 have to type it in every time anyway? The answer is that Calc allows
5361 you to store a rewrite rule in a variable, then give the variable
5362 name in the @kbd{a r} command. In fact, this is the preferred way to
5363 use rewrites. For one, if you need a rule once you'll most likely
5364 need it again later. Also, if the rule doesn't work quite right you
5365 can simply Undo, edit the variable, and run the rule again without
5366 having to retype it.
5367
5368 @smallexample
5369 @group
5370 ' a/x + b/x := (a+b)/x @key{RET} s t merge @key{RET}
5371 ' sec(x)^2 := 1 + tan(x)^2 @key{RET} s t secsqr @key{RET}
5372
5373 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5374 . .
5375
5376 r 1 a r merge @key{RET} a r secsqr @key{RET}
5377 @end group
5378 @end smallexample
5379
5380 To edit a variable, type @kbd{s e} and the variable name, use regular
5381 Emacs editing commands as necessary, then type @kbd{C-c C-c} to store
5382 the edited value back into the variable.
5383 You can also use @w{@kbd{s e}} to create a new variable if you wish.
5384
5385 Notice that the first time you use each rule, Calc puts up a ``compiling''
5386 message briefly. The pattern matcher converts rules into a special
5387 optimized pattern-matching language rather than using them directly.
5388 This allows @kbd{a r} to apply even rather complicated rules very
5389 efficiently. If the rule is stored in a variable, Calc compiles it
5390 only once and stores the compiled form along with the variable. That's
5391 another good reason to store your rules in variables rather than
5392 entering them on the fly.
5393
5394 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} Type @kbd{m s} to get Symbolic
5395 mode, then enter the formula @samp{@w{(2 + sqrt(2))} / @w{(1 + sqrt(2))}}.
5396 Using a rewrite rule, simplify this formula by multiplying the top and
5397 bottom by the conjugate @w{@samp{1 - sqrt(2)}}. The result will have
5398 to be expanded by the distributive law; do this with another
5399 rewrite. @xref{Rewrites Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5400
5401 The @kbd{a r} command can also accept a vector of rewrite rules, or
5402 a variable containing a vector of rules.
5403
5404 @smallexample
5405 @group
5406 1: [merge, secsqr] 1: [a/x + b/x := (a + b)/x, ... ]
5407 . .
5408
5409 ' [merge,sinsqr] @key{RET} =
5410
5411 @end group
5412 @end smallexample
5413 @noindent
5414 @smallexample
5415 @group
5416 1: 2 sec(x)^2 / tan(x)^2 - 2 / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5417 . .
5418
5419 s t trig @key{RET} r 1 a r trig @key{RET}
5420 @end group
5421 @end smallexample
5422
5423 @c [fix-ref Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules]
5424 Calc tries all the rules you give against all parts of the formula,
5425 repeating until no further change is possible. (The exact order in
5426 which things are tried is rather complex, but for simple rules like
5427 the ones we've used here the order doesn't really matter.
5428 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.)
5429
5430 Calc actually repeats only up to 100 times, just in case your rule set
5431 has gotten into an infinite loop. You can give a numeric prefix argument
5432 to @kbd{a r} to specify any limit. In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} does
5433 only one rewrite at a time.
5434
5435 @smallexample
5436 @group
5437 1: (2 sec(x)^2 - 2) / tan(x)^2 1: 2
5438 . .
5439
5440 r 1 M-1 a r trig @key{RET} M-1 a r trig @key{RET}
5441 @end group
5442 @end smallexample
5443
5444 You can type @kbd{M-0 a r} if you want no limit at all on the number
5445 of rewrites that occur.
5446
5447 Rewrite rules can also be @dfn{conditional}. Simply follow the rule
5448 with a @samp{::} symbol and the desired condition. For example,
5449
5450 @smallexample
5451 @group
5452 1: sin(x + 2 pi) + sin(x + 3 pi) + sin(x + 4 pi)
5453 .
5454
5455 ' sin(x+2pi) + sin(x+3pi) + sin(x+4pi) @key{RET}
5456
5457 @end group
5458 @end smallexample
5459 @noindent
5460 @smallexample
5461 @group
5462 1: sin(x + 3 pi) + 2 sin(x)
5463 .
5464
5465 a r sin(a + k pi) := sin(a) :: k % 2 = 0 @key{RET}
5466 @end group
5467 @end smallexample
5468
5469 @noindent
5470 (Recall, @samp{k % 2} is the remainder from dividing @samp{k} by 2,
5471 which will be zero only when @samp{k} is an even integer.)
5472
5473 An interesting point is that the variable @samp{pi} was matched
5474 literally rather than acting as a meta-variable.
5475 This is because it is a special-constant variable. The special
5476 constants @samp{e}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and so on also match literally.
5477 A common error with rewrite
5478 rules is to write, say, @samp{f(a,b,c,d,e) := g(a+b+c+d+e)}, expecting
5479 to match any @samp{f} with five arguments but in fact matching
5480 only when the fifth argument is literally @samp{e}!
5481
5482 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5483 @ignore
5484 @starindex
5485 @end ignore
5486 @tindex fib
5487 Rewrite rules provide an interesting way to define your own functions.
5488 Suppose we want to define @samp{fib(n)} to produce the @var{n}th
5489 Fibonacci number. The first two Fibonacci numbers are each 1;
5490 later numbers are formed by summing the two preceding numbers in
5491 the sequence. This is easy to express in a set of three rules:
5492
5493 @smallexample
5494 @group
5495 ' [fib(1) := 1, fib(2) := 1, fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2)] @key{RET} s t fib
5496
5497 1: fib(7) 1: 13
5498 . .
5499
5500 ' fib(7) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5501 @end group
5502 @end smallexample
5503
5504 One thing that is guaranteed about the order that rewrites are tried
5505 is that, for any given subformula, earlier rules in the rule set will
5506 be tried for that subformula before later ones. So even though the
5507 first and third rules both match @samp{fib(1)}, we know the first will
5508 be used preferentially.
5509
5510 This rule set has one dangerous bug: Suppose we apply it to the
5511 formula @samp{fib(x)}? (Don't actually try this.) The third rule
5512 will match @samp{fib(x)} and replace it with @w{@samp{fib(x-1) + fib(x-2)}}.
5513 Each of these will then be replaced to get @samp{fib(x-2) + 2 fib(x-3) +
5514 fib(x-4)}, and so on, expanding forever. What we really want is to apply
5515 the third rule only when @samp{n} is an integer greater than two. Type
5516 @w{@kbd{s e fib @key{RET}}}, then edit the third rule to:
5517
5518 @smallexample
5519 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2
5520 @end smallexample
5521
5522 @noindent
5523 Now:
5524
5525 @smallexample
5526 @group
5527 1: fib(6) + fib(x) + fib(0) 1: fib(x) + fib(0) + 8
5528 . .
5529
5530 ' fib(6)+fib(x)+fib(0) @key{RET} a r fib @key{RET}
5531 @end group
5532 @end smallexample
5533
5534 @noindent
5535 We've created a new function, @code{fib}, and a new command,
5536 @w{@kbd{a r fib @key{RET}}}, which means ``evaluate all @code{fib} calls in
5537 this formula.'' To make things easier still, we can tell Calc to
5538 apply these rules automatically by storing them in the special
5539 variable @code{EvalRules}.
5540
5541 @smallexample
5542 @group
5543 1: [fib(1) := ...] . 1: [8, 13]
5544 . .
5545
5546 s r fib @key{RET} s t EvalRules @key{RET} ' [fib(6), fib(7)] @key{RET}
5547 @end group
5548 @end smallexample
5549
5550 It turns out that this rule set has the problem that it does far
5551 more work than it needs to when @samp{n} is large. Consider the
5552 first few steps of the computation of @samp{fib(6)}:
5553
5554 @smallexample
5555 @group
5556 fib(6) =
5557 fib(5) + fib(4) =
5558 fib(4) + fib(3) + fib(3) + fib(2) =
5559 fib(3) + fib(2) + fib(2) + fib(1) + fib(2) + fib(1) + 1 = ...
5560 @end group
5561 @end smallexample
5562
5563 @noindent
5564 Note that @samp{fib(3)} appears three times here. Unless Calc's
5565 algebraic simplifier notices the multiple @samp{fib(3)}s and combines
5566 them (and, as it happens, it doesn't), this rule set does lots of
5567 needless recomputation. To cure the problem, type @code{s e EvalRules}
5568 to edit the rules (or just @kbd{s E}, a shorthand command for editing
5569 @code{EvalRules}) and add another condition:
5570
5571 @smallexample
5572 fib(n) := fib(n-1) + fib(n-2) :: integer(n) :: n > 2 :: remember
5573 @end smallexample
5574
5575 @noindent
5576 If a @samp{:: remember} condition appears anywhere in a rule, then if
5577 that rule succeeds Calc will add another rule that describes that match
5578 to the front of the rule set. (Remembering works in any rule set, but
5579 for technical reasons it is most effective in @code{EvalRules}.) For
5580 example, if the rule rewrites @samp{fib(7)} to something that evaluates
5581 to 13, then the rule @samp{fib(7) := 13} will be added to the rule set.
5582
5583 Type @kbd{' fib(8) @key{RET}} to compute the eighth Fibonacci number, then
5584 type @kbd{s E} again to see what has happened to the rule set.
5585
5586 With the @code{remember} feature, our rule set can now compute
5587 @samp{fib(@var{n})} in just @var{n} steps. In the process it builds
5588 up a table of all Fibonacci numbers up to @var{n}. After we have
5589 computed the result for a particular @var{n}, we can get it back
5590 (and the results for all smaller @var{n}) later in just one step.
5591
5592 All Calc operations will run somewhat slower whenever @code{EvalRules}
5593 contains any rules. You should type @kbd{s u EvalRules @key{RET}} now to
5594 un-store the variable.
5595
5596 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Sometimes it is possible to reformulate
5597 a problem to reduce the amount of recursion necessary to solve it.
5598 Create a rule that, in about @var{n} simple steps and without recourse
5599 to the @code{remember} option, replaces @samp{fib(@var{n}, 1, 1)} with
5600 @samp{fib(1, @var{x}, @var{y})} where @var{x} and @var{y} are the
5601 @var{n}th and @var{n+1}st Fibonacci numbers, respectively. This rule is
5602 rather clunky to use, so add a couple more rules to make the ``user
5603 interface'' the same as for our first version: enter @samp{fib(@var{n})},
5604 get back a plain number. @xref{Rewrites Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5605
5606 There are many more things that rewrites can do. For example, there
5607 are @samp{&&&} and @samp{|||} pattern operators that create ``and''
5608 and ``or'' combinations of rules. As one really simple example, we
5609 could combine our first two Fibonacci rules thusly:
5610
5611 @example
5612 [fib(1 ||| 2) := 1, fib(n) := ... ]
5613 @end example
5614
5615 @noindent
5616 That means ``@code{fib} of something matching either 1 or 2 rewrites
5617 to 1.''
5618
5619 You can also make meta-variables optional by enclosing them in @code{opt}.
5620 For example, the pattern @samp{a + b x} matches @samp{2 + 3 x} but not
5621 @samp{2 + x} or @samp{3 x} or @samp{x}. The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x}
5622 matches all of these forms, filling in a default of zero for @samp{a}
5623 and one for @samp{b}.
5624
5625 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Your friend Joe had @samp{2 + 3 x}
5626 on the stack and tried to use the rule
5627 @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x := f(a, b, x)}. What happened?
5628 @xref{Rewrites Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5629
5630 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Starting with a positive integer @expr{a},
5631 divide @expr{a} by two if it is even, otherwise compute @expr{3 a + 1}.
5632 Now repeat this step over and over. A famous unproved conjecture
5633 is that for any starting @expr{a}, the sequence always eventually
5634 reaches 1. Given the formula @samp{seq(@var{a}, 0)}, write a set of
5635 rules that convert this into @samp{seq(1, @var{n})} where @var{n}
5636 is the number of steps it took the sequence to reach the value 1.
5637 Now enhance the rules to accept @samp{seq(@var{a})} as a starting
5638 configuration, and to stop with just the number @var{n} by itself.
5639 Now make the result be a vector of values in the sequence, from @var{a}
5640 to 1. (The formula @samp{@var{x}|@var{y}} appends the vectors @var{x}
5641 and @var{y}.) For example, rewriting @samp{seq(6)} should yield the
5642 vector @expr{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
5643 @xref{Rewrites Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5644
5645 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} Define, using rewrite rules, a function
5646 @samp{nterms(@var{x})} that returns the number of terms in the sum
5647 @var{x}, or 1 if @var{x} is not a sum. (A @dfn{sum} for our purposes
5648 is one or more non-sum terms separated by @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
5649 so that @expr{2 - 3 (x + y) + x y} is a sum of three terms.)
5650 @xref{Rewrites Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5651
5652 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} A Taylor series for a function is an
5653 infinite series that exactly equals the value of that function at
5654 values of @expr{x} near zero.
5655
5656 @ifnottex
5657 @example
5658 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + x^4 / 4! - x^6 / 6! + ...
5659 @end example
5660 @end ifnottex
5661 @tex
5662 \beforedisplay
5663 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + {x^4 \over 4!} - {x^6 \over 6!} + \cdots $$
5664 \afterdisplay
5665 @end tex
5666
5667 The @kbd{a t} command produces a @dfn{truncated Taylor series} which
5668 is obtained by dropping all the terms higher than, say, @expr{x^2}.
5669 Calc represents the truncated Taylor series as a polynomial in @expr{x}.
5670 Mathematicians often write a truncated series using a ``big-O'' notation
5671 that records what was the lowest term that was truncated.
5672
5673 @ifnottex
5674 @example
5675 cos(x) = 1 - x^2 / 2! + O(x^3)
5676 @end example
5677 @end ifnottex
5678 @tex
5679 \beforedisplay
5680 $$ \cos x = 1 - {x^2 \over 2!} + O(x^3) $$
5681 \afterdisplay
5682 @end tex
5683
5684 @noindent
5685 The meaning of @expr{O(x^3)} is ``a quantity which is negligibly small
5686 if @expr{x^3} is considered negligibly small as @expr{x} goes to zero.''
5687
5688 The exercise is to create rewrite rules that simplify sums and products of
5689 power series represented as @samp{@var{polynomial} + O(@var{var}^@var{n})}.
5690 For example, given @samp{1 - x^2 / 2 + O(x^3)} and @samp{x - x^3 / 6 + O(x^4)}
5691 on the stack, we want to be able to type @kbd{*} and get the result
5692 @samp{x - 2:3 x^3 + O(x^4)}. Don't worry if the terms of the sum are
5693 rearranged. (This one is rather tricky; the solution at the end of
5694 this chapter uses 6 rewrite rules. Hint: The @samp{constant(x)}
5695 condition tests whether @samp{x} is a number.) @xref{Rewrites Answer
5696 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5697
5698 Just for kicks, try adding the rule @code{2+3 := 6} to @code{EvalRules}.
5699 What happens? (Be sure to remove this rule afterward, or you might get
5700 a nasty surprise when you use Calc to balance your checkbook!)
5701
5702 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for the whole story on rewrite rules.
5703
5704 @node Programming Tutorial, Answers to Exercises, Algebra Tutorial, Tutorial
5705 @section Programming Tutorial
5706
5707 @noindent
5708 The Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, a highly extensible
5709 language. If you know Lisp, you can program the Calculator to do
5710 anything you like. Rewrite rules also work as a powerful programming
5711 system. But Lisp and rewrite rules take a while to master, and often
5712 all you want to do is define a new function or repeat a command a few
5713 times. Calc has features that allow you to do these things easily.
5714
5715 One very limited form of programming is defining your own functions.
5716 Calc's @kbd{Z F} command allows you to define a function name and
5717 key sequence to correspond to any formula. Programming commands use
5718 the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix; the user commands they create use the lower
5719 case @kbd{z} prefix.
5720
5721 @smallexample
5722 @group
5723 1: x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 + 1 1: x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 + 1
5724 . .
5725
5726 ' 1 + x + x^2/2! + x^3/3! @key{RET} Z F e myexp @key{RET} @key{RET} @key{RET} y
5727 @end group
5728 @end smallexample
5729
5730 This polynomial is a Taylor series approximation to @samp{exp(x)}.
5731 The @kbd{Z F} command asks a number of questions. The above answers
5732 say that the key sequence for our function should be @kbd{z e}; the
5733 @kbd{M-x} equivalent should be @code{calc-myexp}; the name of the
5734 function in algebraic formulas should also be @code{myexp}; the
5735 default argument list @samp{(x)} is acceptable; and finally @kbd{y}
5736 answers the question ``leave it in symbolic form for non-constant
5737 arguments?''
5738
5739 @smallexample
5740 @group
5741 1: 1.3495 2: 1.3495 3: 1.3495
5742 . 1: 1.34986 2: 1.34986
5743 . 1: myexp(a + 1)
5744 .
5745
5746 .3 z e .3 E ' a+1 @key{RET} z e
5747 @end group
5748 @end smallexample
5749
5750 @noindent
5751 First we call our new @code{exp} approximation with 0.3 as an
5752 argument, and compare it with the true @code{exp} function. Then
5753 we note that, as requested, if we try to give @kbd{z e} an
5754 argument that isn't a plain number, it leaves the @code{myexp}
5755 function call in symbolic form. If we had answered @kbd{n} to the
5756 final question, @samp{myexp(a + 1)} would have evaluated by plugging
5757 in @samp{a + 1} for @samp{x} in the defining formula.
5758
5759 @cindex Sine integral Si(x)
5760 @ignore
5761 @starindex
5762 @end ignore
5763 @tindex Si
5764 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 1.} The ``sine integral'' function
5765 @texline @math{{\rm Si}(x)}
5766 @infoline @expr{Si(x)}
5767 is defined as the integral of @samp{sin(t)/t} for
5768 @expr{t = 0} to @expr{x} in radians. (It was invented because this
5769 integral has no solution in terms of basic functions; if you give it
5770 to Calc's @kbd{a i} command, it will ponder it for a long time and then
5771 give up.) We can use the numerical integration command, however,
5772 which in algebraic notation is written like @samp{ninteg(f(t), t, 0, x)}
5773 with any integrand @samp{f(t)}. Define a @kbd{z s} command and
5774 @code{Si} function that implement this. You will need to edit the
5775 default argument list a bit. As a test, @samp{Si(1)} should return
5776 0.946083. (If you don't get this answer, you might want to check that
5777 Calc is in Radians mode. Also, @code{ninteg} will run a lot faster if
5778 you reduce the precision to, say, six digits beforehand.)
5779 @xref{Programming Answer 1, 1}. (@bullet{})
5780
5781 The simplest way to do real ``programming'' of Emacs is to define a
5782 @dfn{keyboard macro}. A keyboard macro is simply a sequence of
5783 keystrokes which Emacs has stored away and can play back on demand.
5784 For example, if you find yourself typing @kbd{H a S x @key{RET}} often,
5785 you may wish to program a keyboard macro to type this for you.
5786
5787 @smallexample
5788 @group
5789 1: y = sqrt(x) 1: x = y^2
5790 . .
5791
5792 ' y=sqrt(x) @key{RET} C-x ( H a S x @key{RET} C-x )
5793
5794 1: y = cos(x) 1: x = s1 arccos(y) + 2 n1 pi
5795 . .
5796
5797 ' y=cos(x) @key{RET} X
5798 @end group
5799 @end smallexample
5800
5801 @noindent
5802 When you type @kbd{C-x (}, Emacs begins recording. But it is also
5803 still ready to execute your keystrokes, so you're really ``training''
5804 Emacs by walking it through the procedure once. When you type
5805 @w{@kbd{C-x )}}, the macro is recorded. You can now type @kbd{X} to
5806 re-execute the same keystrokes.
5807
5808 You can give a name to your macro by typing @kbd{Z K}.
5809
5810 @smallexample
5811 @group
5812 1: . 1: y = x^4 1: x = s2 sqrt(s1 sqrt(y))
5813 . .
5814
5815 Z K x @key{RET} ' y=x^4 @key{RET} z x
5816 @end group
5817 @end smallexample
5818
5819 @noindent
5820 Notice that we use shift-@kbd{Z} to define the command, and lower-case
5821 @kbd{z} to call it up.
5822
5823 Keyboard macros can call other macros.
5824
5825 @smallexample
5826 @group
5827 1: abs(x) 1: x = s1 y 1: 2 / x 1: x = 2 / y
5828 . . . .
5829
5830 ' abs(x) @key{RET} C-x ( ' y @key{RET} a = z x C-x ) ' 2/x @key{RET} X
5831 @end group
5832 @end smallexample
5833
5834 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 2.} Define a keyboard macro to negate
5835 the item in level 3 of the stack, without disturbing the rest of
5836 the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 2, 2}. (@bullet{})
5837
5838 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 3.} Define keyboard macros to compute
5839 the following functions:
5840
5841 @enumerate
5842 @item
5843 Compute
5844 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}},
5845 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x},
5846 where @expr{x} is the number on the top of the stack.
5847
5848 @item
5849 Compute the base-@expr{b} logarithm, just like the @kbd{B} key except
5850 the arguments are taken in the opposite order.
5851
5852 @item
5853 Produce a vector of integers from 1 to the integer on the top of
5854 the stack.
5855 @end enumerate
5856 @noindent
5857 @xref{Programming Answer 3, 3}. (@bullet{})
5858
5859 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 4.} Define a keyboard macro to compute
5860 the average (mean) value of a list of numbers.
5861 @xref{Programming Answer 4, 4}. (@bullet{})
5862
5863 In many programs, some of the steps must execute several times.
5864 Calc has @dfn{looping} commands that allow this. Loops are useful
5865 inside keyboard macros, but actually work at any time.
5866
5867 @smallexample
5868 @group
5869 1: x^6 2: x^6 1: 360 x^2
5870 . 1: 4 .
5871 .
5872
5873 ' x^6 @key{RET} 4 Z < a d x @key{RET} Z >
5874 @end group
5875 @end smallexample
5876
5877 @noindent
5878 Here we have computed the fourth derivative of @expr{x^6} by
5879 enclosing a derivative command in a ``repeat loop'' structure.
5880 This structure pops a repeat count from the stack, then
5881 executes the body of the loop that many times.
5882
5883 If you make a mistake while entering the body of the loop,
5884 type @w{@kbd{Z C-g}} to cancel the loop command.
5885
5886 @cindex Fibonacci numbers
5887 Here's another example:
5888
5889 @smallexample
5890 @group
5891 3: 1 2: 10946
5892 2: 1 1: 17711
5893 1: 20 .
5894 .
5895
5896 1 @key{RET} @key{RET} 20 Z < @key{TAB} C-j + Z >
5897 @end group
5898 @end smallexample
5899
5900 @noindent
5901 The numbers in levels 2 and 1 should be the 21st and 22nd Fibonacci
5902 numbers, respectively. (To see what's going on, try a few repetitions
5903 of the loop body by hand; @kbd{C-j}, also on the Line-Feed or @key{LFD}
5904 key if you have one, makes a copy of the number in level 2.)
5905
5906 @cindex Golden ratio
5907 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
5908 A fascinating property of the Fibonacci numbers is that the @expr{n}th
5909 Fibonacci number can be found directly by computing
5910 @texline @math{\phi^n / \sqrt{5}}
5911 @infoline @expr{phi^n / sqrt(5)}
5912 and then rounding to the nearest integer, where
5913 @texline @math{\phi} (``phi''),
5914 @infoline @expr{phi},
5915 the ``golden ratio,'' is
5916 @texline @math{(1 + \sqrt{5}) / 2}.
5917 @infoline @expr{(1 + sqrt(5)) / 2}.
5918 (For convenience, this constant is available from the @code{phi}
5919 variable, or the @kbd{I H P} command.)
5920
5921 @smallexample
5922 @group
5923 1: 1.61803 1: 24476.0000409 1: 10945.9999817 1: 10946
5924 . . . .
5925
5926 I H P 21 ^ 5 Q / R
5927 @end group
5928 @end smallexample
5929
5930 @cindex Continued fractions
5931 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 5.} The @dfn{continued fraction}
5932 representation of
5933 @texline @math{\phi}
5934 @infoline @expr{phi}
5935 is
5936 @texline @math{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( \ldots )))}.
5937 @infoline @expr{1 + 1/(1 + 1/(1 + 1/( ...@: )))}.
5938 We can compute an approximate value by carrying this however far
5939 and then replacing the innermost
5940 @texline @math{1/( \ldots )}
5941 @infoline @expr{1/( ...@: )}
5942 by 1. Approximate
5943 @texline @math{\phi}
5944 @infoline @expr{phi}
5945 using a twenty-term continued fraction.
5946 @xref{Programming Answer 5, 5}. (@bullet{})
5947
5948 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 6.} Linear recurrences like the one for
5949 Fibonacci numbers can be expressed in terms of matrices. Given a
5950 vector @w{@expr{[a, b]}} determine a matrix which, when multiplied by this
5951 vector, produces the vector @expr{[b, c]}, where @expr{a}, @expr{b} and
5952 @expr{c} are three successive Fibonacci numbers. Now write a program
5953 that, given an integer @expr{n}, computes the @expr{n}th Fibonacci number
5954 using matrix arithmetic. @xref{Programming Answer 6, 6}. (@bullet{})
5955
5956 @cindex Harmonic numbers
5957 A more sophisticated kind of loop is the @dfn{for} loop. Suppose
5958 we wish to compute the 20th ``harmonic'' number, which is equal to
5959 the sum of the reciprocals of the integers from 1 to 20.
5960
5961 @smallexample
5962 @group
5963 3: 0 1: 3.597739
5964 2: 1 .
5965 1: 20
5966 .
5967
5968 0 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & + 1 Z )
5969 @end group
5970 @end smallexample
5971
5972 @noindent
5973 The ``for'' loop pops two numbers, the lower and upper limits, then
5974 repeats the body of the loop as an internal counter increases from
5975 the lower limit to the upper one. Just before executing the loop
5976 body, it pushes the current loop counter. When the loop body
5977 finishes, it pops the ``step,'' i.e., the amount by which to
5978 increment the loop counter. As you can see, our loop always
5979 uses a step of one.
5980
5981 This harmonic number function uses the stack to hold the running
5982 total as well as for the various loop housekeeping functions. If
5983 you find this disorienting, you can sum in a variable instead:
5984
5985 @smallexample
5986 @group
5987 1: 0 2: 1 . 1: 3.597739
5988 . 1: 20 .
5989 .
5990
5991 0 t 7 1 @key{RET} 20 Z ( & s + 7 1 Z ) r 7
5992 @end group
5993 @end smallexample
5994
5995 @noindent
5996 The @kbd{s +} command adds the top-of-stack into the value in a
5997 variable (and removes that value from the stack).
5998
5999 It's worth noting that many jobs that call for a ``for'' loop can
6000 also be done more easily by Calc's high-level operations. Two
6001 other ways to compute harmonic numbers are to use vector mapping
6002 and reduction (@kbd{v x 20}, then @w{@kbd{V M &}}, then @kbd{V R +}),
6003 or to use the summation command @kbd{a +}. Both of these are
6004 probably easier than using loops. However, there are some
6005 situations where loops really are the way to go:
6006
6007 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 7.} Use a ``for'' loop to find the first
6008 harmonic number which is greater than 4.0.
6009 @xref{Programming Answer 7, 7}. (@bullet{})
6010
6011 Of course, if we're going to be using variables in our programs,
6012 we have to worry about the programs clobbering values that the
6013 caller was keeping in those same variables. This is easy to
6014 fix, though:
6015
6016 @smallexample
6017 @group
6018 . 1: 0.6667 1: 0.6667 3: 0.6667
6019 . . 2: 3.597739
6020 1: 0.6667
6021 .
6022
6023 Z ` p 4 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 / s 7 s s a @key{RET} Z ' r 7 s r a @key{RET}
6024 @end group
6025 @end smallexample
6026
6027 @noindent
6028 When we type @kbd{Z `} (that's a back-quote character), Calc saves
6029 its mode settings and the contents of the ten ``quick variables''
6030 for later reference. When we type @kbd{Z '} (that's an apostrophe
6031 now), Calc restores those saved values. Thus the @kbd{p 4} and
6032 @kbd{s 7} commands have no effect outside this sequence. Wrapping
6033 this around the body of a keyboard macro ensures that it doesn't
6034 interfere with what the user of the macro was doing. Notice that
6035 the contents of the stack, and the values of named variables,
6036 survive past the @kbd{Z '} command.
6037
6038 @cindex Bernoulli numbers, approximate
6039 The @dfn{Bernoulli numbers} are a sequence with the interesting
6040 property that all of the odd Bernoulli numbers are zero, and the
6041 even ones, while difficult to compute, can be roughly approximated
6042 by the formula
6043 @texline @math{\displaystyle{2 n! \over (2 \pi)^n}}.
6044 @infoline @expr{2 n!@: / (2 pi)^n}.
6045 Let's write a keyboard macro to compute (approximate) Bernoulli numbers.
6046 (Calc has a command, @kbd{k b}, to compute exact Bernoulli numbers, but
6047 this command is very slow for large @expr{n} since the higher Bernoulli
6048 numbers are very large fractions.)
6049
6050 @smallexample
6051 @group
6052 1: 10 1: 0.0756823
6053 . .
6054
6055 10 C-x ( @key{RET} 2 % Z [ @key{DEL} 0 Z : ' 2 $! / (2 pi)^$ @key{RET} = Z ] C-x )
6056 @end group
6057 @end smallexample
6058
6059 @noindent
6060 You can read @kbd{Z [} as ``then,'' @kbd{Z :} as ``else,'' and
6061 @kbd{Z ]} as ``end-if.'' There is no need for an explicit ``if''
6062 command. For the purposes of @w{@kbd{Z [}}, the condition is ``true''
6063 if the value it pops from the stack is a nonzero number, or ``false''
6064 if it pops zero or something that is not a number (like a formula).
6065 Here we take our integer argument modulo 2; this will be nonzero
6066 if we're asking for an odd Bernoulli number.
6067
6068 The actual tenth Bernoulli number is @expr{5/66}.
6069
6070 @smallexample
6071 @group
6072 3: 0.0756823 1: 0 1: 0.25305 1: 0 1: 1.16659
6073 2: 5:66 . . . .
6074 1: 0.0757575
6075 .
6076
6077 10 k b @key{RET} c f M-0 @key{DEL} 11 X @key{DEL} 12 X @key{DEL} 13 X @key{DEL} 14 X
6078 @end group
6079 @end smallexample
6080
6081 Just to exercise loops a bit more, let's compute a table of even
6082 Bernoulli numbers.
6083
6084 @smallexample
6085 @group
6086 3: [] 1: [0.10132, 0.03079, 0.02340, 0.033197, ...]
6087 2: 2 .
6088 1: 30
6089 .
6090
6091 [ ] 2 @key{RET} 30 Z ( X | 2 Z )
6092 @end group
6093 @end smallexample
6094
6095 @noindent
6096 The vertical-bar @kbd{|} is the vector-concatenation command. When
6097 we execute it, the list we are building will be in stack level 2
6098 (initially this is an empty list), and the next Bernoulli number
6099 will be in level 1. The effect is to append the Bernoulli number
6100 onto the end of the list. (To create a table of exact fractional
6101 Bernoulli numbers, just replace @kbd{X} with @kbd{k b} in the above
6102 sequence of keystrokes.)
6103
6104 With loops and conditionals, you can program essentially anything
6105 in Calc. One other command that makes looping easier is @kbd{Z /},
6106 which takes a condition from the stack and breaks out of the enclosing
6107 loop if the condition is true (non-zero). You can use this to make
6108 ``while'' and ``until'' style loops.
6109
6110 If you make a mistake when entering a keyboard macro, you can edit
6111 it using @kbd{Z E}. First, you must attach it to a key with @kbd{Z K}.
6112 One technique is to enter a throwaway dummy definition for the macro,
6113 then enter the real one in the edit command.
6114
6115 @smallexample
6116 @group
6117 1: 3 1: 3 Calc Macro Edit Mode.
6118 . . Original keys: 1 <return> 2 +
6119
6120 1 ;; calc digits
6121 RET ;; calc-enter
6122 2 ;; calc digits
6123 + ;; calc-plus
6124
6125 C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 2 + C-x ) Z K h @key{RET} Z E h
6126 @end group
6127 @end smallexample
6128
6129 @noindent
6130 A keyboard macro is stored as a pure keystroke sequence. The
6131 @file{edmacro} package (invoked by @kbd{Z E}) scans along the
6132 macro and tries to decode it back into human-readable steps.
6133 Descriptions of the keystrokes are given as comments, which begin with
6134 @samp{;;}, and which are ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6135 Spaces and line breaks are also ignored when the edited macro is saved.
6136 To enter a space into the macro, type @code{SPC}. All the special
6137 characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC}, @code{DEL},
6138 and @code{NUL} must be written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes
6139 @code{C-} and @code{M-}.
6140
6141 Let's edit in a new definition, for computing harmonic numbers.
6142 First, erase the four lines of the old definition. Then, type
6143 in the new definition (or use Emacs @kbd{M-w} and @kbd{C-y} commands
6144 to copy it from this page of the Info file; you can of course skip
6145 typing the comments, which begin with @samp{;;}).
6146
6147 @smallexample
6148 Z` ;; calc-kbd-push (Save local values)
6149 0 ;; calc digits (Push a zero onto the stack)
6150 st ;; calc-store-into (Store it in the following variable)
6151 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6152 1 ;; calc digits (Initial value for the loop)
6153 TAB ;; calc-roll-down (Swap initial and final)
6154 Z( ;; calc-kbd-for (Begin the "for" loop)
6155 & ;; calc-inv (Take the reciprocal)
6156 s+ ;; calc-store-plus (Add to the following variable)
6157 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6158 1 ;; calc digits (The loop step is 1)
6159 Z) ;; calc-kbd-end-for (End the "for" loop)
6160 sr ;; calc-recall (Recall the final accumulated value)
6161 1 ;; calc quick variable (Quick variable q1)
6162 Z' ;; calc-kbd-pop (Restore values)
6163 @end smallexample
6164
6165 @noindent
6166 Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and return to the Calculator.
6167
6168 @smallexample
6169 @group
6170 1: 20 1: 3.597739
6171 . .
6172
6173 20 z h
6174 @end group
6175 @end smallexample
6176
6177 The @file{edmacro} package defines a handy @code{read-kbd-macro} command
6178 which reads the current region of the current buffer as a sequence of
6179 keystroke names, and defines that sequence on the @kbd{X}
6180 (and @kbd{C-x e}) key. Because this is so useful, Calc puts this
6181 command on the @kbd{C-x * m} key. Try reading in this macro in the
6182 following form: Press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}}) at
6183 one end of the text below, then type @kbd{C-x * m} at the other.
6184
6185 @example
6186 @group
6187 Z ` 0 t 1
6188 1 TAB
6189 Z ( & s + 1 1 Z )
6190 r 1
6191 Z '
6192 @end group
6193 @end example
6194
6195 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 8.} A general algorithm for solving
6196 equations numerically is @dfn{Newton's Method}. Given the equation
6197 @expr{f(x) = 0} for any function @expr{f}, and an initial guess
6198 @expr{x_0} which is reasonably close to the desired solution, apply
6199 this formula over and over:
6200
6201 @ifnottex
6202 @example
6203 new_x = x - f(x)/f'(x)
6204 @end example
6205 @end ifnottex
6206 @tex
6207 \beforedisplay
6208 $$ x_{\rm new} = x - {f(x) \over f^{\prime}(x)} $$
6209 \afterdisplay
6210 @end tex
6211
6212 @noindent
6213 where @expr{f'(x)} is the derivative of @expr{f}. The @expr{x}
6214 values will quickly converge to a solution, i.e., eventually
6215 @texline @math{x_{\rm new}}
6216 @infoline @expr{new_x}
6217 and @expr{x} will be equal to within the limits
6218 of the current precision. Write a program which takes a formula
6219 involving the variable @expr{x}, and an initial guess @expr{x_0},
6220 on the stack, and produces a value of @expr{x} for which the formula
6221 is zero. Use it to find a solution of
6222 @texline @math{\sin(\cos x) = 0.5}
6223 @infoline @expr{sin(cos(x)) = 0.5}
6224 near @expr{x = 4.5}. (Use angles measured in radians.) Note that
6225 the built-in @w{@kbd{a R}} (@code{calc-find-root}) command uses Newton's
6226 method when it is able. @xref{Programming Answer 8, 8}. (@bullet{})
6227
6228 @cindex Digamma function
6229 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
6230 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
6231 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 9.} The @dfn{digamma} function
6232 @texline @math{\psi(z) (``psi'')}
6233 @infoline @expr{psi(z)}
6234 is defined as the derivative of
6235 @texline @math{\ln \Gamma(z)}.
6236 @infoline @expr{ln(gamma(z))}.
6237 For large values of @expr{z}, it can be approximated by the infinite sum
6238
6239 @ifnottex
6240 @example
6241 psi(z) ~= ln(z) - 1/2z - sum(bern(2 n) / 2 n z^(2 n), n, 1, inf)
6242 @end example
6243 @end ifnottex
6244 @tex
6245 \beforedisplay
6246 $$ \psi(z) \approx \ln z - {1\over2z} -
6247 \sum_{n=1}^\infty {\code{bern}(2 n) \over 2 n z^{2n}}
6248 $$
6249 \afterdisplay
6250 @end tex
6251
6252 @noindent
6253 where
6254 @texline @math{\sum}
6255 @infoline @expr{sum}
6256 represents the sum over @expr{n} from 1 to infinity
6257 (or to some limit high enough to give the desired accuracy), and
6258 the @code{bern} function produces (exact) Bernoulli numbers.
6259 While this sum is not guaranteed to converge, in practice it is safe.
6260 An interesting mathematical constant is Euler's gamma, which is equal
6261 to about 0.5772. One way to compute it is by the formula,
6262 @texline @math{\gamma = -\psi(1)}.
6263 @infoline @expr{gamma = -psi(1)}.
6264 Unfortunately, 1 isn't a large enough argument
6265 for the above formula to work (5 is a much safer value for @expr{z}).
6266 Fortunately, we can compute
6267 @texline @math{\psi(1)}
6268 @infoline @expr{psi(1)}
6269 from
6270 @texline @math{\psi(5)}
6271 @infoline @expr{psi(5)}
6272 using the recurrence
6273 @texline @math{\psi(z+1) = \psi(z) + {1 \over z}}.
6274 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1) = psi(z) + 1/z}.
6275 Your task: Develop a program to compute
6276 @texline @math{\psi(z)};
6277 @infoline @expr{psi(z)};
6278 it should ``pump up'' @expr{z}
6279 if necessary to be greater than 5, then use the above summation
6280 formula. Use looping commands to compute the sum. Use your function
6281 to compute
6282 @texline @math{\gamma}
6283 @infoline @expr{gamma}
6284 to twelve decimal places. (Calc has a built-in command
6285 for Euler's constant, @kbd{I P}, which you can use to check your answer.)
6286 @xref{Programming Answer 9, 9}. (@bullet{})
6287
6288 @cindex Polynomial, list of coefficients
6289 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 10.} Given a polynomial in @expr{x} and
6290 a number @expr{m} on the stack, where the polynomial is of degree
6291 @expr{m} or less (i.e., does not have any terms higher than @expr{x^m}),
6292 write a program to convert the polynomial into a list-of-coefficients
6293 notation. For example, @expr{5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2} with @expr{m = 6}
6294 should produce the list @expr{[1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]}. Also develop
6295 a way to convert from this form back to the standard algebraic form.
6296 @xref{Programming Answer 10, 10}. (@bullet{})
6297
6298 @cindex Recursion
6299 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 11.} The @dfn{Stirling numbers of the
6300 first kind} are defined by the recurrences,
6301
6302 @ifnottex
6303 @example
6304 s(n,n) = 1 for n >= 0,
6305 s(n,0) = 0 for n > 0,
6306 s(n+1,m) = s(n,m-1) - n s(n,m) for n >= m >= 1.
6307 @end example
6308 @end ifnottex
6309 @tex
6310 \beforedisplay
6311 $$ \eqalign{ s(n,n) &= 1 \qquad \hbox{for } n \ge 0, \cr
6312 s(n,0) &= 0 \qquad \hbox{for } n > 0, \cr
6313 s(n+1,m) &= s(n,m-1) - n \, s(n,m) \qquad
6314 \hbox{for } n \ge m \ge 1.}
6315 $$
6316 \afterdisplay
6317 \vskip5pt
6318 (These numbers are also sometimes written $\displaystyle{n \brack m}$.)
6319 @end tex
6320
6321 This can be implemented using a @dfn{recursive} program in Calc; the
6322 program must invoke itself in order to calculate the two righthand
6323 terms in the general formula. Since it always invokes itself with
6324 ``simpler'' arguments, it's easy to see that it must eventually finish
6325 the computation. Recursion is a little difficult with Emacs keyboard
6326 macros since the macro is executed before its definition is complete.
6327 So here's the recommended strategy: Create a ``dummy macro'' and assign
6328 it to a key with, e.g., @kbd{Z K s}. Now enter the true definition,
6329 using the @kbd{z s} command to call itself recursively, then assign it
6330 to the same key with @kbd{Z K s}. Now the @kbd{z s} command will run
6331 the complete recursive program. (Another way is to use @w{@kbd{Z E}}
6332 or @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the whole macro at once,
6333 thus avoiding the ``training'' phase.) The task: Write a program
6334 that computes Stirling numbers of the first kind, given @expr{n} and
6335 @expr{m} on the stack. Test it with @emph{small} inputs like
6336 @expr{s(4,2)}. (There is a built-in command for Stirling numbers,
6337 @kbd{k s}, which you can use to check your answers.)
6338 @xref{Programming Answer 11, 11}. (@bullet{})
6339
6340 The programming commands we've seen in this part of the tutorial
6341 are low-level, general-purpose operations. Often you will find
6342 that a higher-level function, such as vector mapping or rewrite
6343 rules, will do the job much more easily than a detailed, step-by-step
6344 program can:
6345
6346 (@bullet{}) @strong{Exercise 12.} Write another program for
6347 computing Stirling numbers of the first kind, this time using
6348 rewrite rules. Once again, @expr{n} and @expr{m} should be taken
6349 from the stack. @xref{Programming Answer 12, 12}. (@bullet{})
6350
6351 @example
6352
6353 @end example
6354 This ends the tutorial section of the Calc manual. Now you know enough
6355 about Calc to use it effectively for many kinds of calculations. But
6356 Calc has many features that were not even touched upon in this tutorial.
6357 @c [not-split]
6358 The rest of this manual tells the whole story.
6359 @c [when-split]
6360 @c Volume II of this manual, the @dfn{Calc Reference}, tells the whole story.
6361
6362 @page
6363 @node Answers to Exercises, , Programming Tutorial, Tutorial
6364 @section Answers to Exercises
6365
6366 @noindent
6367 This section includes answers to all the exercises in the Calc tutorial.
6368
6369 @menu
6370 * RPN Answer 1:: 1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -
6371 * RPN Answer 2:: 2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4
6372 * RPN Answer 3:: Operating on levels 2 and 3
6373 * RPN Answer 4:: Joe's complex problems
6374 * Algebraic Answer 1:: Simulating Q command
6375 * Algebraic Answer 2:: Joe's algebraic woes
6376 * Algebraic Answer 3:: 1 / 0
6377 * Modes Answer 1:: 3#0.1 = 3#0.0222222?
6378 * Modes Answer 2:: 16#f.e8fe15
6379 * Modes Answer 3:: Joe's rounding bug
6380 * Modes Answer 4:: Why floating point?
6381 * Arithmetic Answer 1:: Why the \ command?
6382 * Arithmetic Answer 2:: Tripping up the B command
6383 * Vector Answer 1:: Normalizing a vector
6384 * Vector Answer 2:: Average position
6385 * Matrix Answer 1:: Row and column sums
6386 * Matrix Answer 2:: Symbolic system of equations
6387 * Matrix Answer 3:: Over-determined system
6388 * List Answer 1:: Powers of two
6389 * List Answer 2:: Least-squares fit with matrices
6390 * List Answer 3:: Geometric mean
6391 * List Answer 4:: Divisor function
6392 * List Answer 5:: Duplicate factors
6393 * List Answer 6:: Triangular list
6394 * List Answer 7:: Another triangular list
6395 * List Answer 8:: Maximum of Bessel function
6396 * List Answer 9:: Integers the hard way
6397 * List Answer 10:: All elements equal
6398 * List Answer 11:: Estimating pi with darts
6399 * List Answer 12:: Estimating pi with matchsticks
6400 * List Answer 13:: Hash codes
6401 * List Answer 14:: Random walk
6402 * Types Answer 1:: Square root of pi times rational
6403 * Types Answer 2:: Infinities
6404 * Types Answer 3:: What can "nan" be?
6405 * Types Answer 4:: Abbey Road
6406 * Types Answer 5:: Friday the 13th
6407 * Types Answer 6:: Leap years
6408 * Types Answer 7:: Erroneous donut
6409 * Types Answer 8:: Dividing intervals
6410 * Types Answer 9:: Squaring intervals
6411 * Types Answer 10:: Fermat's primality test
6412 * Types Answer 11:: pi * 10^7 seconds
6413 * Types Answer 12:: Abbey Road on CD
6414 * Types Answer 13:: Not quite pi * 10^7 seconds
6415 * Types Answer 14:: Supercomputers and c
6416 * Types Answer 15:: Sam the Slug
6417 * Algebra Answer 1:: Squares and square roots
6418 * Algebra Answer 2:: Building polynomial from roots
6419 * Algebra Answer 3:: Integral of x sin(pi x)
6420 * Algebra Answer 4:: Simpson's rule
6421 * Rewrites Answer 1:: Multiplying by conjugate
6422 * Rewrites Answer 2:: Alternative fib rule
6423 * Rewrites Answer 3:: Rewriting opt(a) + opt(b) x
6424 * Rewrites Answer 4:: Sequence of integers
6425 * Rewrites Answer 5:: Number of terms in sum
6426 * Rewrites Answer 6:: Truncated Taylor series
6427 * Programming Answer 1:: Fresnel's C(x)
6428 * Programming Answer 2:: Negate third stack element
6429 * Programming Answer 3:: Compute sin(x) / x, etc.
6430 * Programming Answer 4:: Average value of a list
6431 * Programming Answer 5:: Continued fraction phi
6432 * Programming Answer 6:: Matrix Fibonacci numbers
6433 * Programming Answer 7:: Harmonic number greater than 4
6434 * Programming Answer 8:: Newton's method
6435 * Programming Answer 9:: Digamma function
6436 * Programming Answer 10:: Unpacking a polynomial
6437 * Programming Answer 11:: Recursive Stirling numbers
6438 * Programming Answer 12:: Stirling numbers with rewrites
6439 @end menu
6440
6441 @c The following kludgery prevents the individual answers from
6442 @c being entered on the table of contents.
6443 @tex
6444 \global\let\oldwrite=\write
6445 \gdef\skipwrite#1#2{\let\write=\oldwrite}
6446 \global\let\oldchapternofonts=\chapternofonts
6447 \gdef\chapternofonts{\let\write=\skipwrite\oldchapternofonts}
6448 @end tex
6449
6450 @node RPN Answer 1, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises, Answers to Exercises
6451 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 1
6452
6453 @noindent
6454 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 4 + * -}
6455
6456 The result is
6457 @texline @math{1 - (2 \times (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6458 @infoline @expr{1 - (2 * (3 + 4)) = -13}.
6459
6460 @node RPN Answer 2, RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6461 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 2
6462
6463 @noindent
6464 @texline @math{2\times4 + 7\times9.5 + {5\over4} = 75.75}
6465 @infoline @expr{2*4 + 7*9.5 + 5/4 = 75.75}
6466
6467 After computing the intermediate term
6468 @texline @math{2\times4 = 8},
6469 @infoline @expr{2*4 = 8},
6470 you can leave that result on the stack while you compute the second
6471 term. With both of these results waiting on the stack you can then
6472 compute the final term, then press @kbd{+ +} to add everything up.
6473
6474 @smallexample
6475 @group
6476 2: 2 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8
6477 1: 4 . 2: 7 1: 66.5
6478 . 1: 9.5 .
6479 .
6480
6481 2 @key{RET} 4 * 7 @key{RET} 9.5 *
6482
6483 @end group
6484 @end smallexample
6485 @noindent
6486 @smallexample
6487 @group
6488 4: 8 3: 8 2: 8 1: 75.75
6489 3: 66.5 2: 66.5 1: 67.75 .
6490 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6491 1: 4 .
6492 .
6493
6494 5 @key{RET} 4 / + +
6495 @end group
6496 @end smallexample
6497
6498 Alternatively, you could add the first two terms before going on
6499 with the third term.
6500
6501 @smallexample
6502 @group
6503 2: 8 1: 74.5 3: 74.5 2: 74.5 1: 75.75
6504 1: 66.5 . 2: 5 1: 1.25 .
6505 . 1: 4 .
6506 .
6507
6508 ... + 5 @key{RET} 4 / +
6509 @end group
6510 @end smallexample
6511
6512 On an old-style RPN calculator this second method would have the
6513 advantage of using only three stack levels. But since Calc's stack
6514 can grow arbitrarily large this isn't really an issue. Which method
6515 you choose is purely a matter of taste.
6516
6517 @node RPN Answer 3, RPN Answer 4, RPN Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6518 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 3
6519
6520 @noindent
6521 The @key{TAB} key provides a way to operate on the number in level 2.
6522
6523 @smallexample
6524 @group
6525 3: 10 3: 10 4: 10 3: 10 3: 10
6526 2: 20 2: 30 3: 30 2: 30 2: 21
6527 1: 30 1: 20 2: 20 1: 21 1: 30
6528 . . 1: 1 . .
6529 .
6530
6531 @key{TAB} 1 + @key{TAB}
6532 @end group
6533 @end smallexample
6534
6535 Similarly, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} gives you access to the number in level 3.
6536
6537 @smallexample
6538 @group
6539 3: 10 3: 21 3: 21 3: 30 3: 11
6540 2: 21 2: 30 2: 30 2: 11 2: 21
6541 1: 30 1: 10 1: 11 1: 21 1: 30
6542 . . . . .
6543
6544 M-@key{TAB} 1 + M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB}
6545 @end group
6546 @end smallexample
6547
6548 @node RPN Answer 4, Algebraic Answer 1, RPN Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6549 @subsection RPN Tutorial Exercise 4
6550
6551 @noindent
6552 Either @kbd{( 2 , 3 )} or @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )} would have worked,
6553 but using both the comma and the space at once yields:
6554
6555 @smallexample
6556 @group
6557 1: ( ... 2: ( ... 1: (2, ... 2: (2, ... 2: (2, ...
6558 . 1: 2 . 1: (2, ... 1: (2, 3)
6559 . . .
6560
6561 ( 2 , @key{SPC} 3 )
6562 @end group
6563 @end smallexample
6564
6565 Joe probably tried to type @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}} to swap the
6566 extra incomplete object to the top of the stack and delete it.
6567 But a feature of Calc is that @key{DEL} on an incomplete object
6568 deletes just one component out of that object, so he had to press
6569 @key{DEL} twice to finish the job.
6570
6571 @smallexample
6572 @group
6573 2: (2, ... 2: (2, 3) 2: (2, 3) 1: (2, 3)
6574 1: (2, 3) 1: (2, ... 1: ( ... .
6575 . . .
6576
6577 @key{TAB} @key{DEL} @key{DEL}
6578 @end group
6579 @end smallexample
6580
6581 (As it turns out, deleting the second-to-top stack entry happens often
6582 enough that Calc provides a special key, @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, to do just that.
6583 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} is just like @kbd{@key{TAB} @key{DEL}}, except that it doesn't exhibit
6584 the ``feature'' that tripped poor Joe.)
6585
6586 @node Algebraic Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, RPN Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6587 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 1
6588
6589 @noindent
6590 Type @kbd{' sqrt($) @key{RET}}.
6591
6592 If the @kbd{Q} key is broken, you could use @kbd{' $^0.5 @key{RET}}.
6593 Or, RPN style, @kbd{0.5 ^}.
6594
6595 (Actually, @samp{$^1:2}, using the fraction one-half as the power, is
6596 a closer equivalent, since @samp{9^0.5} yields @expr{3.0} whereas
6597 @samp{sqrt(9)} and @samp{9^1:2} yield the exact integer @expr{3}.)
6598
6599 @node Algebraic Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Algebraic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6600 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 2
6601
6602 @noindent
6603 In the formula @samp{2 x (1+y)}, @samp{x} was interpreted as a function
6604 name with @samp{1+y} as its argument. Assigning a value to a variable
6605 has no relation to a function by the same name. Joe needed to use an
6606 explicit @samp{*} symbol here: @samp{2 x*(1+y)}.
6607
6608 @node Algebraic Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Algebraic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6609 @subsection Algebraic Entry Tutorial Exercise 3
6610
6611 @noindent
6612 The result from @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} will be the formula @expr{1 / 0}.
6613 The ``function'' @samp{/} cannot be evaluated when its second argument
6614 is zero, so it is left in symbolic form. When you now type @kbd{0 *},
6615 the result will be zero because Calc uses the general rule that ``zero
6616 times anything is zero.''
6617
6618 @c [fix-ref Infinities]
6619 The @kbd{m i} command enables an @dfn{Infinite mode} in which @expr{1 / 0}
6620 results in a special symbol that represents ``infinity.'' If you
6621 multiply infinity by zero, Calc uses another special new symbol to
6622 show that the answer is ``indeterminate.'' @xref{Infinities}, for
6623 further discussion of infinite and indeterminate values.
6624
6625 @node Modes Answer 1, Modes Answer 2, Algebraic Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6626 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 1
6627
6628 @noindent
6629 Calc always stores its numbers in decimal, so even though one-third has
6630 an exact base-3 representation (@samp{3#0.1}), it is still stored as
6631 0.3333333 (chopped off after 12 or however many decimal digits) inside
6632 the calculator's memory. When this inexact number is converted back
6633 to base 3 for display, it may still be slightly inexact. When we
6634 multiply this number by 3, we get 0.999999, also an inexact value.
6635
6636 When Calc displays a number in base 3, it has to decide how many digits
6637 to show. If the current precision is 12 (decimal) digits, that corresponds
6638 to @samp{12 / log10(3) = 25.15} base-3 digits. Because 25.15 is not an
6639 exact integer, Calc shows only 25 digits, with the result that stored
6640 numbers carry a little bit of extra information that may not show up on
6641 the screen. When Joe entered @samp{3#0.2}, the stored number 0.666666
6642 happened to round to a pleasing value when it lost that last 0.15 of a
6643 digit, but it was still inexact in Calc's memory. When he divided by 2,
6644 he still got the dreaded inexact value 0.333333. (Actually, he divided
6645 0.666667 by 2 to get 0.333334, which is why he got something a little
6646 higher than @code{3#0.1} instead of a little lower.)
6647
6648 If Joe didn't want to be bothered with all this, he could have typed
6649 @kbd{M-24 d n} to display with one less digit than the default. (If
6650 you give @kbd{d n} a negative argument, it uses default-minus-that,
6651 so @kbd{M-- d n} would be an easier way to get the same effect.) Those
6652 inexact results would still be lurking there, but they would now be
6653 rounded to nice, natural-looking values for display purposes. (Remember,
6654 @samp{0.022222} in base 3 is like @samp{0.099999} in base 10; rounding
6655 off one digit will round the number up to @samp{0.1}.) Depending on the
6656 nature of your work, this hiding of the inexactness may be a benefit or
6657 a danger. With the @kbd{d n} command, Calc gives you the choice.
6658
6659 Incidentally, another consequence of all this is that if you type
6660 @kbd{M-30 d n} to display more digits than are ``really there,''
6661 you'll see garbage digits at the end of the number. (In decimal
6662 display mode, with decimally-stored numbers, these garbage digits are
6663 always zero so they vanish and you don't notice them.) Because Calc
6664 rounds off that 0.15 digit, there is the danger that two numbers could
6665 be slightly different internally but still look the same. If you feel
6666 uneasy about this, set the @kbd{d n} precision to be a little higher
6667 than normal; you'll get ugly garbage digits, but you'll always be able
6668 to tell two distinct numbers apart.
6669
6670 An interesting side note is that most computers store their
6671 floating-point numbers in binary, and convert to decimal for display.
6672 Thus everyday programs have the same problem: Decimal 0.1 cannot be
6673 represented exactly in binary (try it: @kbd{0.1 d 2}), so @samp{0.1 * 10}
6674 comes out as an inexact approximation to 1 on some machines (though
6675 they generally arrange to hide it from you by rounding off one digit as
6676 we did above). Because Calc works in decimal instead of binary, you can
6677 be sure that numbers that look exact @emph{are} exact as long as you stay
6678 in decimal display mode.
6679
6680 It's not hard to show that any number that can be represented exactly
6681 in binary, octal, or hexadecimal is also exact in decimal, so the kinds
6682 of problems we saw in this exercise are likely to be severe only when
6683 you use a relatively unusual radix like 3.
6684
6685 @node Modes Answer 2, Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6686 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 2
6687
6688 If the radix is 15 or higher, we can't use the letter @samp{e} to mark
6689 the exponent because @samp{e} is interpreted as a digit. When Calc
6690 needs to display scientific notation in a high radix, it writes
6691 @samp{16#F.E8F*16.^15}. You can enter a number like this as an
6692 algebraic entry. Also, pressing @kbd{e} without any digits before it
6693 normally types @kbd{1e}, but in a high radix it types @kbd{16.^} and
6694 puts you in algebraic entry: @kbd{16#f.e8f @key{RET} e 15 @key{RET} *} is another
6695 way to enter this number.
6696
6697 The reason Calc puts a decimal point in the @samp{16.^} is to prevent
6698 huge integers from being generated if the exponent is large (consider
6699 @samp{16#1.23*16^1000}, where we compute @samp{16^1000} as a giant
6700 exact integer and then throw away most of the digits when we multiply
6701 it by the floating-point @samp{16#1.23}). While this wouldn't normally
6702 matter for display purposes, it could give you a nasty surprise if you
6703 copied that number into a file and later moved it back into Calc.
6704
6705 @node Modes Answer 3, Modes Answer 4, Modes Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6706 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 3
6707
6708 @noindent
6709 The answer he got was @expr{0.5000000000006399}.
6710
6711 The problem is not that the square operation is inexact, but that the
6712 sine of 45 that was already on the stack was accurate to only 12 places.
6713 Arbitrary-precision calculations still only give answers as good as
6714 their inputs.
6715
6716 The real problem is that there is no 12-digit number which, when
6717 squared, comes out to 0.5 exactly. The @kbd{f [} and @kbd{f ]}
6718 commands decrease or increase a number by one unit in the last
6719 place (according to the current precision). They are useful for
6720 determining facts like this.
6721
6722 @smallexample
6723 @group
6724 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.500000000001
6725 . .
6726
6727 45 S 2 ^
6728
6729 @end group
6730 @end smallexample
6731 @noindent
6732 @smallexample
6733 @group
6734 1: 0.707106781187 1: 0.707106781186 1: 0.499999999999
6735 . . .
6736
6737 U @key{DEL} f [ 2 ^
6738 @end group
6739 @end smallexample
6740
6741 A high-precision calculation must be carried out in high precision
6742 all the way. The only number in the original problem which was known
6743 exactly was the quantity 45 degrees, so the precision must be raised
6744 before anything is done after the number 45 has been entered in order
6745 for the higher precision to be meaningful.
6746
6747 @node Modes Answer 4, Arithmetic Answer 1, Modes Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
6748 @subsection Modes Tutorial Exercise 4
6749
6750 @noindent
6751 Many calculations involve real-world quantities, like the width and
6752 height of a piece of wood or the volume of a jar. Such quantities
6753 can't be measured exactly anyway, and if the data that is input to
6754 a calculation is inexact, doing exact arithmetic on it is a waste
6755 of time.
6756
6757 Fractions become unwieldy after too many calculations have been
6758 done with them. For example, the sum of the reciprocals of the
6759 integers from 1 to 10 is 7381:2520. The sum from 1 to 30 is
6760 9304682830147:2329089562800. After a point it will take a long
6761 time to add even one more term to this sum, but a floating-point
6762 calculation of the sum will not have this problem.
6763
6764 Also, rational numbers cannot express the results of all calculations.
6765 There is no fractional form for the square root of two, so if you type
6766 @w{@kbd{2 Q}}, Calc has no choice but to give you a floating-point answer.
6767
6768 @node Arithmetic Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 2, Modes Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
6769 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 1
6770
6771 @noindent
6772 Dividing two integers that are larger than the current precision may
6773 give a floating-point result that is inaccurate even when rounded
6774 down to an integer. Consider @expr{123456789 / 2} when the current
6775 precision is 6 digits. The true answer is @expr{61728394.5}, but
6776 with a precision of 6 this will be rounded to
6777 @texline @math{12345700.0/2.0 = 61728500.0}.
6778 @infoline @expr{12345700.@: / 2.@: = 61728500.}.
6779 The result, when converted to an integer, will be off by 106.
6780
6781 Here are two solutions: Raise the precision enough that the
6782 floating-point round-off error is strictly to the right of the
6783 decimal point. Or, convert to Fraction mode so that @expr{123456789 / 2}
6784 produces the exact fraction @expr{123456789:2}, which can be rounded
6785 down by the @kbd{F} command without ever switching to floating-point
6786 format.
6787
6788 @node Arithmetic Answer 2, Vector Answer 1, Arithmetic Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6789 @subsection Arithmetic Tutorial Exercise 2
6790
6791 @noindent
6792 @kbd{27 @key{RET} 9 B} could give the exact result @expr{3:2}, but it
6793 does a floating-point calculation instead and produces @expr{1.5}.
6794
6795 Calc will find an exact result for a logarithm if the result is an integer
6796 or (when in Fraction mode) the reciprocal of an integer. But there is
6797 no efficient way to search the space of all possible rational numbers
6798 for an exact answer, so Calc doesn't try.
6799
6800 @node Vector Answer 1, Vector Answer 2, Arithmetic Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6801 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 1
6802
6803 @noindent
6804 Duplicate the vector, compute its length, then divide the vector
6805 by its length: @kbd{@key{RET} A /}.
6806
6807 @smallexample
6808 @group
6809 1: [1, 2, 3] 2: [1, 2, 3] 1: [0.27, 0.53, 0.80] 1: 1.
6810 . 1: 3.74165738677 . .
6811 .
6812
6813 r 1 @key{RET} A / A
6814 @end group
6815 @end smallexample
6816
6817 The final @kbd{A} command shows that the normalized vector does
6818 indeed have unit length.
6819
6820 @node Vector Answer 2, Matrix Answer 1, Vector Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6821 @subsection Vector Tutorial Exercise 2
6822
6823 @noindent
6824 The average position is equal to the sum of the products of the
6825 positions times their corresponding probabilities. This is the
6826 definition of the dot product operation. So all you need to do
6827 is to put the two vectors on the stack and press @kbd{*}.
6828
6829 @node Matrix Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Vector Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6830 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 1
6831
6832 @noindent
6833 The trick is to multiply by a vector of ones. Use @kbd{r 4 [1 1 1] *} to
6834 get the row sum. Similarly, use @kbd{[1 1] r 4 *} to get the column sum.
6835
6836 @node Matrix Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Matrix Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
6837 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 2
6838
6839 @ifnottex
6840 @example
6841 @group
6842 x + a y = 6
6843 x + b y = 10
6844 @end group
6845 @end example
6846 @end ifnottex
6847 @tex
6848 \beforedisplay
6849 $$ \eqalign{ x &+ a y = 6 \cr
6850 x &+ b y = 10}
6851 $$
6852 \afterdisplay
6853 @end tex
6854
6855 Just enter the righthand side vector, then divide by the lefthand side
6856 matrix as usual.
6857
6858 @smallexample
6859 @group
6860 1: [6, 10] 2: [6, 10] 1: [4 a / (a - b) + 6, 4 / (b - a) ]
6861 . 1: [ [ 1, a ] .
6862 [ 1, b ] ]
6863 .
6864
6865 ' [6 10] @key{RET} ' [1 a; 1 b] @key{RET} /
6866 @end group
6867 @end smallexample
6868
6869 This can be made more readable using @kbd{d B} to enable Big display
6870 mode:
6871
6872 @smallexample
6873 @group
6874 4 a 4
6875 1: [----- + 6, -----]
6876 a - b b - a
6877 @end group
6878 @end smallexample
6879
6880 Type @kbd{d N} to return to Normal display mode afterwards.
6881
6882 @node Matrix Answer 3, List Answer 1, Matrix Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
6883 @subsection Matrix Tutorial Exercise 3
6884
6885 @noindent
6886 To solve
6887 @texline @math{A^T A \, X = A^T B},
6888 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A * X = trn(A) * B},
6889 first we compute
6890 @texline @math{A' = A^T A}
6891 @infoline @expr{A2 = trn(A) * A}
6892 and
6893 @texline @math{B' = A^T B};
6894 @infoline @expr{B2 = trn(A) * B};
6895 now, we have a system
6896 @texline @math{A' X = B'}
6897 @infoline @expr{A2 * X = B2}
6898 which we can solve using Calc's @samp{/} command.
6899
6900 @ifnottex
6901 @example
6902 @group
6903 a + 2b + 3c = 6
6904 4a + 5b + 6c = 2
6905 7a + 6b = 3
6906 2a + 4b + 6c = 11
6907 @end group
6908 @end example
6909 @end ifnottex
6910 @tex
6911 \beforedisplayh
6912 $$ \openup1\jot \tabskip=0pt plus1fil
6913 \halign to\displaywidth{\tabskip=0pt
6914 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6915 $\hfil#$&$\hfil{}#{}$&
6916 $\hfil#$&${}#\hfil$\tabskip=0pt plus1fil\cr
6917 a&+&2b&+&3c&=6 \cr
6918 4a&+&5b&+&6c&=2 \cr
6919 7a&+&6b& & &=3 \cr
6920 2a&+&4b&+&6c&=11 \cr}
6921 $$
6922 \afterdisplayh
6923 @end tex
6924
6925 The first step is to enter the coefficient matrix. We'll store it in
6926 quick variable number 7 for later reference. Next, we compute the
6927 @texline @math{B'}
6928 @infoline @expr{B2}
6929 vector.
6930
6931 @smallexample
6932 @group
6933 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] 2: [ [ 1, 4, 7, 2 ] 1: [57, 84, 96]
6934 [ 4, 5, 6 ] [ 2, 5, 6, 4 ] .
6935 [ 7, 6, 0 ] [ 3, 6, 0, 6 ] ]
6936 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ] 1: [6, 2, 3, 11]
6937 . .
6938
6939 ' [1 2 3; 4 5 6; 7 6 0; 2 4 6] @key{RET} s 7 v t [6 2 3 11] *
6940 @end group
6941 @end smallexample
6942
6943 @noindent
6944 Now we compute the matrix
6945 @texline @math{A'}
6946 @infoline @expr{A2}
6947 and divide.
6948
6949 @smallexample
6950 @group
6951 2: [57, 84, 96] 1: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64]
6952 1: [ [ 70, 72, 39 ] .
6953 [ 72, 81, 60 ]
6954 [ 39, 60, 81 ] ]
6955 .
6956
6957 r 7 v t r 7 * /
6958 @end group
6959 @end smallexample
6960
6961 @noindent
6962 (The actual computed answer will be slightly inexact due to
6963 round-off error.)
6964
6965 Notice that the answers are similar to those for the
6966 @texline @math{3\times3}
6967 @infoline 3x3
6968 system solved in the text. That's because the fourth equation that was
6969 added to the system is almost identical to the first one multiplied
6970 by two. (If it were identical, we would have gotten the exact same
6971 answer since the
6972 @texline @math{4\times3}
6973 @infoline 4x3
6974 system would be equivalent to the original
6975 @texline @math{3\times3}
6976 @infoline 3x3
6977 system.)
6978
6979 Since the first and fourth equations aren't quite equivalent, they
6980 can't both be satisfied at once. Let's plug our answers back into
6981 the original system of equations to see how well they match.
6982
6983 @smallexample
6984 @group
6985 2: [-11.64, 14.08, -3.64] 1: [5.6, 2., 3., 11.2]
6986 1: [ [ 1, 2, 3 ] .
6987 [ 4, 5, 6 ]
6988 [ 7, 6, 0 ]
6989 [ 2, 4, 6 ] ]
6990 .
6991
6992 r 7 @key{TAB} *
6993 @end group
6994 @end smallexample
6995
6996 @noindent
6997 This is reasonably close to our original @expr{B} vector,
6998 @expr{[6, 2, 3, 11]}.
6999
7000 @node List Answer 1, List Answer 2, Matrix Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7001 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 1
7002
7003 @noindent
7004 We can use @kbd{v x} to build a vector of integers. This needs to be
7005 adjusted to get the range of integers we desire. Mapping @samp{-}
7006 across the vector will accomplish this, although it turns out the
7007 plain @samp{-} key will work just as well.
7008
7009 @smallexample
7010 @group
7011 2: 2 2: 2
7012 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9] 1: [-4, -3, -2, -1, 0, 1, 2, 3, 4]
7013 . .
7014
7015 2 v x 9 @key{RET} 5 V M - or 5 -
7016 @end group
7017 @end smallexample
7018
7019 @noindent
7020 Now we use @kbd{V M ^} to map the exponentiation operator across the
7021 vector.
7022
7023 @smallexample
7024 @group
7025 1: [0.0625, 0.125, 0.25, 0.5, 1, 2, 4, 8, 16]
7026 .
7027
7028 V M ^
7029 @end group
7030 @end smallexample
7031
7032 @node List Answer 2, List Answer 3, List Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7033 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 2
7034
7035 @noindent
7036 Given @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors in quick variables 1 and 2 as before,
7037 the first job is to form the matrix that describes the problem.
7038
7039 @ifnottex
7040 @example
7041 m*x + b*1 = y
7042 @end example
7043 @end ifnottex
7044 @tex
7045 \beforedisplay
7046 $$ m \times x + b \times 1 = y $$
7047 \afterdisplay
7048 @end tex
7049
7050 Thus we want a
7051 @texline @math{19\times2}
7052 @infoline 19x2
7053 matrix with our @expr{x} vector as one column and
7054 ones as the other column. So, first we build the column of ones, then
7055 we combine the two columns to form our @expr{A} matrix.
7056
7057 @smallexample
7058 @group
7059 2: [1.34, 1.41, 1.49, ... ] 1: [ [ 1.34, 1 ]
7060 1: [1, 1, 1, ...] [ 1.41, 1 ]
7061 . [ 1.49, 1 ]
7062 @dots{}
7063
7064 r 1 1 v b 19 @key{RET} M-2 v p v t s 3
7065 @end group
7066 @end smallexample
7067
7068 @noindent
7069 Now we compute
7070 @texline @math{A^T y}
7071 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * y}
7072 and
7073 @texline @math{A^T A}
7074 @infoline @expr{trn(A) * A}
7075 and divide.
7076
7077 @smallexample
7078 @group
7079 1: [33.36554, 13.613] 2: [33.36554, 13.613]
7080 . 1: [ [ 98.0003, 41.63 ]
7081 [ 41.63, 19 ] ]
7082 .
7083
7084 v t r 2 * r 3 v t r 3 *
7085 @end group
7086 @end smallexample
7087
7088 @noindent
7089 (Hey, those numbers look familiar!)
7090
7091 @smallexample
7092 @group
7093 1: [0.52141679, -0.425978]
7094 .
7095
7096 /
7097 @end group
7098 @end smallexample
7099
7100 Since we were solving equations of the form
7101 @texline @math{m \times x + b \times 1 = y},
7102 @infoline @expr{m*x + b*1 = y},
7103 these numbers should be @expr{m} and @expr{b}, respectively. Sure
7104 enough, they agree exactly with the result computed using @kbd{V M} and
7105 @kbd{V R}!
7106
7107 The moral of this story: @kbd{V M} and @kbd{V R} will probably solve
7108 your problem, but there is often an easier way using the higher-level
7109 arithmetic functions!
7110
7111 @c [fix-ref Curve Fitting]
7112 In fact, there is a built-in @kbd{a F} command that does least-squares
7113 fits. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
7114
7115 @node List Answer 3, List Answer 4, List Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
7116 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 3
7117
7118 @noindent
7119 Move to one end of the list and press @kbd{C-@@} (or @kbd{C-@key{SPC}} or
7120 whatever) to set the mark, then move to the other end of the list
7121 and type @w{@kbd{C-x * g}}.
7122
7123 @smallexample
7124 @group
7125 1: [2.3, 6, 22, 15.1, 7, 15, 14, 7.5, 2.5]
7126 .
7127 @end group
7128 @end smallexample
7129
7130 To make things interesting, let's assume we don't know at a glance
7131 how many numbers are in this list. Then we could type:
7132
7133 @smallexample
7134 @group
7135 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 2: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ]
7136 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 126356422.5
7137 . .
7138
7139 @key{RET} V R *
7140
7141 @end group
7142 @end smallexample
7143 @noindent
7144 @smallexample
7145 @group
7146 2: 126356422.5 2: 126356422.5 1: 7.94652913734
7147 1: [2.3, 6, 22, ... ] 1: 9 .
7148 . .
7149
7150 @key{TAB} v l I ^
7151 @end group
7152 @end smallexample
7153
7154 @noindent
7155 (The @kbd{I ^} command computes the @var{n}th root of a number.
7156 You could also type @kbd{& ^} to take the reciprocal of 9 and
7157 then raise the number to that power.)
7158
7159 @node List Answer 4, List Answer 5, List Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
7160 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 4
7161
7162 @noindent
7163 A number @expr{j} is a divisor of @expr{n} if
7164 @texline @math{n \mathbin{\hbox{\code{\%}}} j = 0}.
7165 @infoline @samp{n % j = 0}.
7166 The first step is to get a vector that identifies the divisors.
7167
7168 @smallexample
7169 @group
7170 2: 30 2: [0, 0, 0, 2, ...] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...]
7171 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: 0 .
7172 . .
7173
7174 30 @key{RET} v x 30 @key{RET} s 1 V M % 0 V M a = s 2
7175 @end group
7176 @end smallexample
7177
7178 @noindent
7179 This vector has 1's marking divisors of 30 and 0's marking non-divisors.
7180
7181 The zeroth divisor function is just the total number of divisors.
7182 The first divisor function is the sum of the divisors.
7183
7184 @smallexample
7185 @group
7186 1: 8 3: 8 2: 8 2: 8
7187 2: [1, 2, 3, 4, ...] 1: [1, 2, 3, 0, ...] 1: 72
7188 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, ...] . .
7189 .
7190
7191 V R + r 1 r 2 V M * V R +
7192 @end group
7193 @end smallexample
7194
7195 @noindent
7196 Once again, the last two steps just compute a dot product for which
7197 a simple @kbd{*} would have worked equally well.
7198
7199 @node List Answer 5, List Answer 6, List Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
7200 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 5
7201
7202 @noindent
7203 The obvious first step is to obtain the list of factors with @kbd{k f}.
7204 This list will always be in sorted order, so if there are duplicates
7205 they will be right next to each other. A suitable method is to compare
7206 the list with a copy of itself shifted over by one.
7207
7208 @smallexample
7209 @group
7210 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19] 2: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0]
7211 . 1: [3, 7, 7, 7, 19, 0] 1: [0, 3, 7, 7, 7, 19]
7212 . .
7213
7214 19551 k f @key{RET} 0 | @key{TAB} 0 @key{TAB} |
7215
7216 @end group
7217 @end smallexample
7218 @noindent
7219 @smallexample
7220 @group
7221 1: [0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0] 1: 2 1: 0
7222 . . .
7223
7224 V M a = V R + 0 a =
7225 @end group
7226 @end smallexample
7227
7228 @noindent
7229 Note that we have to arrange for both vectors to have the same length
7230 so that the mapping operation works; no prime factor will ever be
7231 zero, so adding zeros on the left and right is safe. From then on
7232 the job is pretty straightforward.
7233
7234 Incidentally, Calc provides the
7235 @texline @dfn{M@"obius} @math{\mu}
7236 @infoline @dfn{Moebius mu}
7237 function which is zero if and only if its argument is square-free. It
7238 would be a much more convenient way to do the above test in practice.
7239
7240 @node List Answer 6, List Answer 7, List Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
7241 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 6
7242
7243 @noindent
7244 First use @kbd{v x 6 @key{RET}} to get a list of integers, then @kbd{V M v x}
7245 to get a list of lists of integers!
7246
7247 @node List Answer 7, List Answer 8, List Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
7248 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 7
7249
7250 @noindent
7251 Here's one solution. First, compute the triangular list from the previous
7252 exercise and type @kbd{1 -} to subtract one from all the elements.
7253
7254 @smallexample
7255 @group
7256 1: [ [0],
7257 [0, 1],
7258 [0, 1, 2],
7259 @dots{}
7260
7261 1 -
7262 @end group
7263 @end smallexample
7264
7265 The numbers down the lefthand edge of the list we desire are called
7266 the ``triangular numbers'' (now you know why!). The @expr{n}th
7267 triangular number is the sum of the integers from 1 to @expr{n}, and
7268 can be computed directly by the formula
7269 @texline @math{n (n+1) \over 2}.
7270 @infoline @expr{n * (n+1) / 2}.
7271
7272 @smallexample
7273 @group
7274 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7275 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7276 . .
7277
7278 v x 6 @key{RET} 1 - V M ' $ ($+1)/2 @key{RET}
7279 @end group
7280 @end smallexample
7281
7282 @noindent
7283 Adding this list to the above list of lists produces the desired
7284 result:
7285
7286 @smallexample
7287 @group
7288 1: [ [0],
7289 [1, 2],
7290 [3, 4, 5],
7291 [6, 7, 8, 9],
7292 [10, 11, 12, 13, 14],
7293 [15, 16, 17, 18, 19, 20] ]
7294 .
7295
7296 V M +
7297 @end group
7298 @end smallexample
7299
7300 If we did not know the formula for triangular numbers, we could have
7301 computed them using a @kbd{V U +} command. We could also have
7302 gotten them the hard way by mapping a reduction across the original
7303 triangular list.
7304
7305 @smallexample
7306 @group
7307 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 2: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ]
7308 1: [ [0], [0, 1], ... ] 1: [0, 1, 3, 6, 10, 15]
7309 . .
7310
7311 @key{RET} V M V R +
7312 @end group
7313 @end smallexample
7314
7315 @noindent
7316 (This means ``map a @kbd{V R +} command across the vector,'' and
7317 since each element of the main vector is itself a small vector,
7318 @kbd{V R +} computes the sum of its elements.)
7319
7320 @node List Answer 8, List Answer 9, List Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
7321 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 8
7322
7323 @noindent
7324 The first step is to build a list of values of @expr{x}.
7325
7326 @smallexample
7327 @group
7328 1: [1, 2, 3, ..., 21] 1: [0, 1, 2, ..., 20] 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ..., 5]
7329 . . .
7330
7331 v x 21 @key{RET} 1 - 4 / s 1
7332 @end group
7333 @end smallexample
7334
7335 Next, we compute the Bessel function values.
7336
7337 @smallexample
7338 @group
7339 1: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ..., -0.328]
7340 .
7341
7342 V M ' besJ(1,$) @key{RET}
7343 @end group
7344 @end smallexample
7345
7346 @noindent
7347 (Another way to do this would be @kbd{1 @key{TAB} V M f j}.)
7348
7349 A way to isolate the maximum value is to compute the maximum using
7350 @kbd{V R X}, then compare all the Bessel values with that maximum.
7351
7352 @smallexample
7353 @group
7354 2: [0., 0.124, 0.242, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ]
7355 1: 0.5801562 . 1: 1
7356 . .
7357
7358 @key{RET} V R X V M a = @key{RET} V R + @key{DEL}
7359 @end group
7360 @end smallexample
7361
7362 @noindent
7363 It's a good idea to verify, as in the last step above, that only
7364 one value is equal to the maximum. (After all, a plot of
7365 @texline @math{\sin x}
7366 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
7367 might have many points all equal to the maximum value, 1.)
7368
7369 The vector we have now has a single 1 in the position that indicates
7370 the maximum value of @expr{x}. Now it is a simple matter to convert
7371 this back into the corresponding value itself.
7372
7373 @smallexample
7374 @group
7375 2: [0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0., 0., ... ] 1: 1.75
7376 1: [0, 0.25, 0.5, ... ] . .
7377 .
7378
7379 r 1 V M * V R +
7380 @end group
7381 @end smallexample
7382
7383 If @kbd{a =} had produced more than one @expr{1} value, this method
7384 would have given the sum of all maximum @expr{x} values; not very
7385 useful! In this case we could have used @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector})
7386 instead. This command deletes all elements of a ``data'' vector that
7387 correspond to zeros in a ``mask'' vector, leaving us with, in this
7388 example, a vector of maximum @expr{x} values.
7389
7390 The built-in @kbd{a X} command maximizes a function using more
7391 efficient methods. Just for illustration, let's use @kbd{a X}
7392 to maximize @samp{besJ(1,x)} over this same interval.
7393
7394 @smallexample
7395 @group
7396 2: besJ(1, x) 1: [1.84115, 0.581865]
7397 1: [0 .. 5] .
7398 .
7399
7400 ' besJ(1,x), [0..5] @key{RET} a X x @key{RET}
7401 @end group
7402 @end smallexample
7403
7404 @noindent
7405 The output from @kbd{a X} is a vector containing the value of @expr{x}
7406 that maximizes the function, and the function's value at that maximum.
7407 As you can see, our simple search got quite close to the right answer.
7408
7409 @node List Answer 9, List Answer 10, List Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
7410 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 9
7411
7412 @noindent
7413 Step one is to convert our integer into vector notation.
7414
7415 @smallexample
7416 @group
7417 1: 25129925999 3: 25129925999
7418 . 2: 10
7419 1: [11, 10, 9, ..., 1, 0]
7420 .
7421
7422 25129925999 @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 12 @key{RET} v x 12 @key{RET} -
7423
7424 @end group
7425 @end smallexample
7426 @noindent
7427 @smallexample
7428 @group
7429 1: 25129925999 1: [0, 2, 25, 251, 2512, ... ]
7430 2: [100000000000, ... ] .
7431 .
7432
7433 V M ^ s 1 V M \
7434 @end group
7435 @end smallexample
7436
7437 @noindent
7438 (Recall, the @kbd{\} command computes an integer quotient.)
7439
7440 @smallexample
7441 @group
7442 1: [0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 5, 9, 9, 9]
7443 .
7444
7445 10 V M % s 2
7446 @end group
7447 @end smallexample
7448
7449 Next we must increment this number. This involves adding one to
7450 the last digit, plus handling carries. There is a carry to the
7451 left out of a digit if that digit is a nine and all the digits to
7452 the right of it are nines.
7453
7454 @smallexample
7455 @group
7456 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1] 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 1, ... ]
7457 . .
7458
7459 9 V M a = v v
7460
7461 @end group
7462 @end smallexample
7463 @noindent
7464 @smallexample
7465 @group
7466 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 0, 1, 1, 1, 1]
7467 . .
7468
7469 V U * v v 1 |
7470 @end group
7471 @end smallexample
7472
7473 @noindent
7474 Accumulating @kbd{*} across a vector of ones and zeros will preserve
7475 only the initial run of ones. These are the carries into all digits
7476 except the rightmost digit. Concatenating a one on the right takes
7477 care of aligning the carries properly, and also adding one to the
7478 rightmost digit.
7479
7480 @smallexample
7481 @group
7482 2: [0, 0, 0, 0, ... ] 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, 1, 2, 9, 9, 2, 6, 0, 0, 0]
7483 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] .
7484 .
7485
7486 0 r 2 | V M + 10 V M %
7487 @end group
7488 @end smallexample
7489
7490 @noindent
7491 Here we have concatenated 0 to the @emph{left} of the original number;
7492 this takes care of shifting the carries by one with respect to the
7493 digits that generated them.
7494
7495 Finally, we must convert this list back into an integer.
7496
7497 @smallexample
7498 @group
7499 3: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 2: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ]
7500 2: 1000000000000 1: [1000000000000, 100000000000, ... ]
7501 1: [100000000000, ... ] .
7502 .
7503
7504 10 @key{RET} 12 ^ r 1 |
7505
7506 @end group
7507 @end smallexample
7508 @noindent
7509 @smallexample
7510 @group
7511 1: [0, 0, 20000000000, 5000000000, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7512 . .
7513
7514 V M * V R +
7515 @end group
7516 @end smallexample
7517
7518 @noindent
7519 Another way to do this final step would be to reduce the formula
7520 @w{@samp{10 $$ + $}} across the vector of digits.
7521
7522 @smallexample
7523 @group
7524 1: [0, 0, 2, 5, ... ] 1: 25129926000
7525 . .
7526
7527 V R ' 10 $$ + $ @key{RET}
7528 @end group
7529 @end smallexample
7530
7531 @node List Answer 10, List Answer 11, List Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
7532 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 10
7533
7534 @noindent
7535 For the list @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, the result is @expr{((a = b) = c) = d},
7536 which will compare @expr{a} and @expr{b} to produce a 1 or 0, which is
7537 then compared with @expr{c} to produce another 1 or 0, which is then
7538 compared with @expr{d}. This is not at all what Joe wanted.
7539
7540 Here's a more correct method:
7541
7542 @smallexample
7543 @group
7544 1: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7] 2: [7, 7, 7, 8, 7]
7545 . 1: 7
7546 .
7547
7548 ' [7,7,7,8,7] @key{RET} @key{RET} v r 1 @key{RET}
7549
7550 @end group
7551 @end smallexample
7552 @noindent
7553 @smallexample
7554 @group
7555 1: [1, 1, 1, 0, 1] 1: 0
7556 . .
7557
7558 V M a = V R *
7559 @end group
7560 @end smallexample
7561
7562 @node List Answer 11, List Answer 12, List Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
7563 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 11
7564
7565 @noindent
7566 The circle of unit radius consists of those points @expr{(x,y)} for which
7567 @expr{x^2 + y^2 < 1}. We start by generating a vector of @expr{x^2}
7568 and a vector of @expr{y^2}.
7569
7570 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7571 commands.
7572
7573 @smallexample
7574 @group
7575 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.]
7576 1: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [1.16, 1.98, ..., 0.81]
7577 . .
7578
7579 v . t . 2. v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r
7580
7581 @end group
7582 @end smallexample
7583 @noindent
7584 @smallexample
7585 @group
7586 2: [2., 2., ..., 2.] 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036]
7587 1: [0.026, 0.96, ..., 0.036] 2: [0.53, 0.81, ..., 0.094]
7588 . .
7589
7590 1 - 2 V M ^ @key{TAB} V M k r 1 - 2 V M ^
7591 @end group
7592 @end smallexample
7593
7594 Now we sum the @expr{x^2} and @expr{y^2} values, compare with 1 to
7595 get a vector of 1/0 truth values, then sum the truth values.
7596
7597 @smallexample
7598 @group
7599 1: [0.56, 1.78, ..., 0.13] 1: [1, 0, ..., 1] 1: 84
7600 . . .
7601
7602 + 1 V M a < V R +
7603 @end group
7604 @end smallexample
7605
7606 @noindent
7607 The ratio @expr{84/100} should approximate the ratio @cpiover{4}.
7608
7609 @smallexample
7610 @group
7611 1: 0.84 1: 3.36 2: 3.36 1: 1.0695
7612 . . 1: 3.14159 .
7613
7614 100 / 4 * P /
7615 @end group
7616 @end smallexample
7617
7618 @noindent
7619 Our estimate, 3.36, is off by about 7%. We could get a better estimate
7620 by taking more points (say, 1000), but it's clear that this method is
7621 not very efficient!
7622
7623 (Naturally, since this example uses random numbers your own answer
7624 will be slightly different from the one shown here!)
7625
7626 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7627 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7628
7629 @node List Answer 12, List Answer 13, List Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
7630 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 12
7631
7632 @noindent
7633 This problem can be made a lot easier by taking advantage of some
7634 symmetries. First of all, after some thought it's clear that the
7635 @expr{y} axis can be ignored altogether. Just pick a random @expr{x}
7636 component for one end of the match, pick a random direction
7637 @texline @math{\theta},
7638 @infoline @expr{theta},
7639 and see if @expr{x} and
7640 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta}
7641 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)}
7642 (which is the @expr{x} coordinate of the other endpoint) cross a line.
7643 The lines are at integer coordinates, so this happens when the two
7644 numbers surround an integer.
7645
7646 Since the two endpoints are equivalent, we may as well choose the leftmost
7647 of the two endpoints as @expr{x}. Then @expr{theta} is an angle pointing
7648 to the right, in the range -90 to 90 degrees. (We could use radians, but
7649 it would feel like cheating to refer to @cpiover{2} radians while trying
7650 to estimate @cpi{}!)
7651
7652 In fact, since the field of lines is infinite we can choose the
7653 coordinates 0 and 1 for the lines on either side of the leftmost
7654 endpoint. The rightmost endpoint will be between 0 and 1 if the
7655 match does not cross a line, or between 1 and 2 if it does. So:
7656 Pick random @expr{x} and
7657 @texline @math{\theta},
7658 @infoline @expr{theta},
7659 compute
7660 @texline @math{x + \cos \theta},
7661 @infoline @expr{x + cos(theta)},
7662 and count how many of the results are greater than one. Simple!
7663
7664 We can make this go a bit faster by using the @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .}
7665 commands.
7666
7667 @smallexample
7668 @group
7669 1: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72]
7670 . 1: [78.4, 64.5, ..., -42.9]
7671 .
7672
7673 v . t . 1. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 180. v b 100 @key{RET} V M k r 90 -
7674 @end group
7675 @end smallexample
7676
7677 @noindent
7678 (The next step may be slow, depending on the speed of your computer.)
7679
7680 @smallexample
7681 @group
7682 2: [0.52, 0.71, ..., 0.72] 1: [0.72, 1.14, ..., 1.45]
7683 1: [0.20, 0.43, ..., 0.73] .
7684 .
7685
7686 m d V M C +
7687
7688 @end group
7689 @end smallexample
7690 @noindent
7691 @smallexample
7692 @group
7693 1: [0, 1, ..., 1] 1: 0.64 1: 3.125
7694 . . .
7695
7696 1 V M a > V R + 100 / 2 @key{TAB} /
7697 @end group
7698 @end smallexample
7699
7700 Let's try the third method, too. We'll use random integers up to
7701 one million. The @kbd{k r} command with an integer argument picks
7702 a random integer.
7703
7704 @smallexample
7705 @group
7706 2: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 2: [78489, 527587, ..., 814975]
7707 1: [1000000, 1000000, ..., 1000000] 1: [324014, 358783, ..., 955450]
7708 . .
7709
7710 1000000 v b 100 @key{RET} @key{RET} V M k r @key{TAB} V M k r
7711
7712 @end group
7713 @end smallexample
7714 @noindent
7715 @smallexample
7716 @group
7717 1: [1, 1, ..., 25] 1: [1, 1, ..., 0] 1: 0.56
7718 . . .
7719
7720 V M k g 1 V M a = V R + 100 /
7721
7722 @end group
7723 @end smallexample
7724 @noindent
7725 @smallexample
7726 @group
7727 1: 10.714 1: 3.273
7728 . .
7729
7730 6 @key{TAB} / Q
7731 @end group
7732 @end smallexample
7733
7734 For a proof of this property of the GCD function, see section 4.5.2,
7735 exercise 10, of Knuth's @emph{Art of Computer Programming}, volume II.
7736
7737 If you typed @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} before, type them again to
7738 return to full-sized display of vectors.
7739
7740 @node List Answer 13, List Answer 14, List Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
7741 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 13
7742
7743 @noindent
7744 First, we put the string on the stack as a vector of ASCII codes.
7745
7746 @smallexample
7747 @group
7748 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7749 .
7750
7751 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET}
7752 @end group
7753 @end smallexample
7754
7755 @noindent
7756 Note that the @kbd{"} key, like @kbd{$}, initiates algebraic entry so
7757 there was no need to type an apostrophe. Also, Calc didn't mind that
7758 we omitted the closing @kbd{"}. (The same goes for all closing delimiters
7759 like @kbd{)} and @kbd{]} at the end of a formula.
7760
7761 We'll show two different approaches here. In the first, we note that
7762 if the input vector is @expr{[a, b, c, d]}, then the hash code is
7763 @expr{3 (3 (3a + b) + c) + d = 27a + 9b + 3c + d}. In other words,
7764 it's a sum of descending powers of three times the ASCII codes.
7765
7766 @smallexample
7767 @group
7768 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51]
7769 1: 16 1: [15, 14, 13, ..., 0]
7770 . .
7771
7772 @key{RET} v l v x 16 @key{RET} -
7773
7774 @end group
7775 @end smallexample
7776 @noindent
7777 @smallexample
7778 @group
7779 2: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098 1: 121
7780 1: [14348907, ..., 1] . .
7781 .
7782
7783 3 @key{TAB} V M ^ * 511 %
7784 @end group
7785 @end smallexample
7786
7787 @noindent
7788 Once again, @kbd{*} elegantly summarizes most of the computation.
7789 But there's an even more elegant approach: Reduce the formula
7790 @kbd{3 $$ + $} across the vector. Recall that this represents a
7791 function of two arguments that computes its first argument times three
7792 plus its second argument.
7793
7794 @smallexample
7795 @group
7796 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 1960915098
7797 . .
7798
7799 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' 3$$+$ @key{RET}
7800 @end group
7801 @end smallexample
7802
7803 @noindent
7804 If you did the decimal arithmetic exercise, this will be familiar.
7805 Basically, we're turning a base-3 vector of digits into an integer,
7806 except that our ``digits'' are much larger than real digits.
7807
7808 Instead of typing @kbd{511 %} again to reduce the result, we can be
7809 cleverer still and notice that rather than computing a huge integer
7810 and taking the modulo at the end, we can take the modulo at each step
7811 without affecting the result. While this means there are more
7812 arithmetic operations, the numbers we operate on remain small so
7813 the operations are faster.
7814
7815 @smallexample
7816 @group
7817 1: [84, 101, 115, ..., 51] 1: 121
7818 . .
7819
7820 "Testing, 1, 2, 3 @key{RET} V R ' (3$$+$)%511 @key{RET}
7821 @end group
7822 @end smallexample
7823
7824 Why does this work? Think about a two-step computation:
7825 @w{@expr{3 (3a + b) + c}}. Taking a result modulo 511 basically means
7826 subtracting off enough 511's to put the result in the desired range.
7827 So the result when we take the modulo after every step is,
7828
7829 @ifnottex
7830 @example
7831 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n
7832 @end example
7833 @end ifnottex
7834 @tex
7835 \beforedisplay
7836 $$ 3 (3 a + b - 511 m) + c - 511 n $$
7837 \afterdisplay
7838 @end tex
7839
7840 @noindent
7841 for some suitable integers @expr{m} and @expr{n}. Expanding out by
7842 the distributive law yields
7843
7844 @ifnottex
7845 @example
7846 9 a + 3 b + c - 511*3 m - 511 n
7847 @end example
7848 @end ifnottex
7849 @tex
7850 \beforedisplay
7851 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511\times3 m - 511 n $$
7852 \afterdisplay
7853 @end tex
7854
7855 @noindent
7856 The @expr{m} term in the latter formula is redundant because any
7857 contribution it makes could just as easily be made by the @expr{n}
7858 term. So we can take it out to get an equivalent formula with
7859 @expr{n' = 3m + n},
7860
7861 @ifnottex
7862 @example
7863 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n'
7864 @end example
7865 @end ifnottex
7866 @tex
7867 \beforedisplay
7868 $$ 9 a + 3 b + c - 511 n^{\prime} $$
7869 \afterdisplay
7870 @end tex
7871
7872 @noindent
7873 which is just the formula for taking the modulo only at the end of
7874 the calculation. Therefore the two methods are essentially the same.
7875
7876 Later in the tutorial we will encounter @dfn{modulo forms}, which
7877 basically automate the idea of reducing every intermediate result
7878 modulo some value @var{m}.
7879
7880 @node List Answer 14, Types Answer 1, List Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
7881 @subsection List Tutorial Exercise 14
7882
7883 We want to use @kbd{H V U} to nest a function which adds a random
7884 step to an @expr{(x,y)} coordinate. The function is a bit long, but
7885 otherwise the problem is quite straightforward.
7886
7887 @smallexample
7888 @group
7889 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7890 1: 50 [ 0.4288, -0.1695 ]
7891 . [ -0.4787, -0.9027 ]
7892 ...
7893
7894 [0,0] 50 H V U ' <# + [random(2.0)-1, random(2.0)-1]> @key{RET}
7895 @end group
7896 @end smallexample
7897
7898 Just as the text recommended, we used @samp{< >} nameless function
7899 notation to keep the two @code{random} calls from being evaluated
7900 before nesting even begins.
7901
7902 We now have a vector of @expr{[x, y]} sub-vectors, which by Calc's
7903 rules acts like a matrix. We can transpose this matrix and unpack
7904 to get a pair of vectors, @expr{x} and @expr{y}, suitable for graphing.
7905
7906 @smallexample
7907 @group
7908 2: [ 0, 0.4288, -0.4787, ... ]
7909 1: [ 0, -0.1696, -0.9027, ... ]
7910 .
7911
7912 v t v u g f
7913 @end group
7914 @end smallexample
7915
7916 Incidentally, because the @expr{x} and @expr{y} are completely
7917 independent in this case, we could have done two separate commands
7918 to create our @expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers directly.
7919
7920 To make a random walk of unit steps, we note that @code{sincos} of
7921 a random direction exactly gives us an @expr{[x, y]} step of unit
7922 length; in fact, the new nesting function is even briefer, though
7923 we might want to lower the precision a bit for it.
7924
7925 @smallexample
7926 @group
7927 2: [0, 0] 1: [ [ 0, 0 ]
7928 1: 50 [ 0.1318, 0.9912 ]
7929 . [ -0.5965, 0.3061 ]
7930 ...
7931
7932 [0,0] 50 m d p 6 @key{RET} H V U ' <# + sincos(random(360.0))> @key{RET}
7933 @end group
7934 @end smallexample
7935
7936 Another @kbd{v t v u g f} sequence will graph this new random walk.
7937
7938 An interesting twist on these random walk functions would be to use
7939 complex numbers instead of 2-vectors to represent points on the plane.
7940 In the first example, we'd use something like @samp{random + random*(0,1)},
7941 and in the second we could use polar complex numbers with random phase
7942 angles. (This exercise was first suggested in this form by Randal
7943 Schwartz.)
7944
7945 @node Types Answer 1, Types Answer 2, List Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
7946 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 1
7947
7948 @noindent
7949 If the number is the square root of @cpi{} times a rational number,
7950 then its square, divided by @cpi{}, should be a rational number.
7951
7952 @smallexample
7953 @group
7954 1: 1.26508260337 1: 0.509433962268 1: 2486645810:4881193627
7955 . . .
7956
7957 2 ^ P / c F
7958 @end group
7959 @end smallexample
7960
7961 @noindent
7962 Technically speaking this is a rational number, but not one that is
7963 likely to have arisen in the original problem. More likely, it just
7964 happens to be the fraction which most closely represents some
7965 irrational number to within 12 digits.
7966
7967 But perhaps our result was not quite exact. Let's reduce the
7968 precision slightly and try again:
7969
7970 @smallexample
7971 @group
7972 1: 0.509433962268 1: 27:53
7973 . .
7974
7975 U p 10 @key{RET} c F
7976 @end group
7977 @end smallexample
7978
7979 @noindent
7980 Aha! It's unlikely that an irrational number would equal a fraction
7981 this simple to within ten digits, so our original number was probably
7982 @texline @math{\sqrt{27 \pi / 53}}.
7983 @infoline @expr{sqrt(27 pi / 53)}.
7984
7985 Notice that we didn't need to re-round the number when we reduced the
7986 precision. Remember, arithmetic operations always round their inputs
7987 to the current precision before they begin.
7988
7989 @node Types Answer 2, Types Answer 3, Types Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
7990 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 2
7991
7992 @noindent
7993 @samp{inf / inf = nan}. Perhaps @samp{1} is the ``obvious'' answer.
7994 But if @w{@samp{17 inf = inf}}, then @samp{17 inf / inf = inf / inf = 17}, too.
7995
7996 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}. It's tempting to say that the exponential
7997 of infinity must be ``bigger'' than ``regular'' infinity, but as
7998 far as Calc is concerned all infinities are the same size.
7999 In other words, as @expr{x} goes to infinity, @expr{e^x} also goes
8000 to infinity, but the fact the @expr{e^x} grows much faster than
8001 @expr{x} is not relevant here.
8002
8003 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. Here we have a finite answer even though
8004 the input is infinite.
8005
8006 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = (0, 1) inf}. Remember that @expr{(0, 1)}
8007 represents the imaginary number @expr{i}. Here's a derivation:
8008 @samp{sqrt(-inf) = @w{sqrt((-1) * inf)} = sqrt(-1) * sqrt(inf)}.
8009 The first part is, by definition, @expr{i}; the second is @code{inf}
8010 because, once again, all infinities are the same size.
8011
8012 @samp{sqrt(uinf) = uinf}. In fact, we do know something about the
8013 direction because @code{sqrt} is defined to return a value in the
8014 right half of the complex plane. But Calc has no notation for this,
8015 so it settles for the conservative answer @code{uinf}.
8016
8017 @samp{abs(uinf) = inf}. No matter which direction @expr{x} points,
8018 @samp{abs(x)} always points along the positive real axis.
8019
8020 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}. Here we have an infinite answer to a finite
8021 input. As in the @expr{1 / 0} case, Calc will only use infinities
8022 here if you have turned on Infinite mode. Otherwise, it will
8023 treat @samp{ln(0)} as an error.
8024
8025 @node Types Answer 3, Types Answer 4, Types Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8026 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 3
8027
8028 @noindent
8029 We can make @samp{inf - inf} be any real number we like, say,
8030 @expr{a}, just by claiming that we added @expr{a} to the first
8031 infinity but not to the second. This is just as true for complex
8032 values of @expr{a}, so @code{nan} can stand for a complex number.
8033 (And, similarly, @code{uinf} can stand for an infinity that points
8034 in any direction in the complex plane, such as @samp{(0, 1) inf}).
8035
8036 In fact, we can multiply the first @code{inf} by two. Surely
8037 @w{@samp{2 inf - inf = inf}}, but also @samp{2 inf - inf = inf - inf = nan}.
8038 So @code{nan} can even stand for infinity. Obviously it's just
8039 as easy to make it stand for minus infinity as for plus infinity.
8040
8041 The moral of this story is that ``infinity'' is a slippery fish
8042 indeed, and Calc tries to handle it by having a very simple model
8043 for infinities (only the direction counts, not the ``size''); but
8044 Calc is careful to write @code{nan} any time this simple model is
8045 unable to tell what the true answer is.
8046
8047 @node Types Answer 4, Types Answer 5, Types Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8048 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 4
8049
8050 @smallexample
8051 @group
8052 2: 0@@ 47' 26" 1: 0@@ 2' 47.411765"
8053 1: 17 .
8054 .
8055
8056 0@@ 47' 26" @key{RET} 17 /
8057 @end group
8058 @end smallexample
8059
8060 @noindent
8061 The average song length is two minutes and 47.4 seconds.
8062
8063 @smallexample
8064 @group
8065 2: 0@@ 2' 47.411765" 1: 0@@ 3' 7.411765" 1: 0@@ 53' 6.000005"
8066 1: 0@@ 0' 20" . .
8067 .
8068
8069 20" + 17 *
8070 @end group
8071 @end smallexample
8072
8073 @noindent
8074 The album would be 53 minutes and 6 seconds long.
8075
8076 @node Types Answer 5, Types Answer 6, Types Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8077 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 5
8078
8079 @noindent
8080 Let's suppose it's January 14, 1991. The easiest thing to do is
8081 to keep trying 13ths of months until Calc reports a Friday.
8082 We can do this by manually entering dates, or by using @kbd{t I}:
8083
8084 @smallexample
8085 @group
8086 1: <Wed Feb 13, 1991> 1: <Wed Mar 13, 1991> 1: <Sat Apr 13, 1991>
8087 . . .
8088
8089 ' <2/13> @key{RET} @key{DEL} ' <3/13> @key{RET} t I
8090 @end group
8091 @end smallexample
8092
8093 @noindent
8094 (Calc assumes the current year if you don't say otherwise.)
8095
8096 This is getting tedious---we can keep advancing the date by typing
8097 @kbd{t I} over and over again, but let's automate the job by using
8098 vector mapping. The @kbd{t I} command actually takes a second
8099 ``how-many-months'' argument, which defaults to one. This
8100 argument is exactly what we want to map over:
8101
8102 @smallexample
8103 @group
8104 2: <Sat Apr 13, 1991> 1: [<Mon May 13, 1991>, <Thu Jun 13, 1991>,
8105 1: [1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6] <Sat Jul 13, 1991>, <Tue Aug 13, 1991>,
8106 . <Fri Sep 13, 1991>, <Sun Oct 13, 1991>]
8107 .
8108
8109 v x 6 @key{RET} V M t I
8110 @end group
8111 @end smallexample
8112
8113 @noindent
8114 Et voil@`a, September 13, 1991 is a Friday.
8115
8116 @smallexample
8117 @group
8118 1: 242
8119 .
8120
8121 ' <sep 13> - <jan 14> @key{RET}
8122 @end group
8123 @end smallexample
8124
8125 @noindent
8126 And the answer to our original question: 242 days to go.
8127
8128 @node Types Answer 6, Types Answer 7, Types Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8129 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 6
8130
8131 @noindent
8132 The full rule for leap years is that they occur in every year divisible
8133 by four, except that they don't occur in years divisible by 100, except
8134 that they @emph{do} in years divisible by 400. We could work out the
8135 answer by carefully counting the years divisible by four and the
8136 exceptions, but there is a much simpler way that works even if we
8137 don't know the leap year rule.
8138
8139 Let's assume the present year is 1991. Years have 365 days, except
8140 that leap years (whenever they occur) have 366 days. So let's count
8141 the number of days between now and then, and compare that to the
8142 number of years times 365. The number of extra days we find must be
8143 equal to the number of leap years there were.
8144
8145 @smallexample
8146 @group
8147 1: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 2: <Mon Jan 1, 10001> 1: 2925593
8148 . 1: <Tue Jan 1, 1991> .
8149 .
8150
8151 ' <jan 1 10001> @key{RET} ' <jan 1 1991> @key{RET} -
8152
8153 @end group
8154 @end smallexample
8155 @noindent
8156 @smallexample
8157 @group
8158 3: 2925593 2: 2925593 2: 2925593 1: 1943
8159 2: 10001 1: 8010 1: 2923650 .
8160 1: 1991 . .
8161 .
8162
8163 10001 @key{RET} 1991 - 365 * -
8164 @end group
8165 @end smallexample
8166
8167 @c [fix-ref Date Forms]
8168 @noindent
8169 There will be 1943 leap years before the year 10001. (Assuming,
8170 of course, that the algorithm for computing leap years remains
8171 unchanged for that long. @xref{Date Forms}, for some interesting
8172 background information in that regard.)
8173
8174 @node Types Answer 7, Types Answer 8, Types Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8175 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 7
8176
8177 @noindent
8178 The relative errors must be converted to absolute errors so that
8179 @samp{+/-} notation may be used.
8180
8181 @smallexample
8182 @group
8183 1: 1. 2: 1.
8184 . 1: 0.2
8185 .
8186
8187 20 @key{RET} .05 * 4 @key{RET} .05 *
8188 @end group
8189 @end smallexample
8190
8191 Now we simply chug through the formula.
8192
8193 @smallexample
8194 @group
8195 1: 19.7392088022 1: 394.78 +/- 19.739 1: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8196 . . .
8197
8198 2 P 2 ^ * 20 p 1 * 4 p .2 @key{RET} 2 ^ *
8199 @end group
8200 @end smallexample
8201
8202 It turns out the @kbd{v u} command will unpack an error form as
8203 well as a vector. This saves us some retyping of numbers.
8204
8205 @smallexample
8206 @group
8207 3: 6316.5 +/- 706.21 2: 6316.5 +/- 706.21
8208 2: 6316.5 1: 0.1118
8209 1: 706.21 .
8210 .
8211
8212 @key{RET} v u @key{TAB} /
8213 @end group
8214 @end smallexample
8215
8216 @noindent
8217 Thus the volume is 6316 cubic centimeters, within about 11 percent.
8218
8219 @node Types Answer 8, Types Answer 9, Types Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
8220 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 8
8221
8222 @noindent
8223 The first answer is pretty simple: @samp{1 / (0 .. 10) = (0.1 .. inf)}.
8224 Since a number in the interval @samp{(0 .. 10)} can get arbitrarily
8225 close to zero, its reciprocal can get arbitrarily large, so the answer
8226 is an interval that effectively means, ``any number greater than 0.1''
8227 but with no upper bound.
8228
8229 The second answer, similarly, is @samp{1 / (-10 .. 0) = (-inf .. -0.1)}.
8230
8231 Calc normally treats division by zero as an error, so that the formula
8232 @w{@samp{1 / 0}} is left unsimplified. Our third problem,
8233 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 10]}}, also (potentially) divides by zero because zero
8234 is now a member of the interval. So Calc leaves this one unevaluated, too.
8235
8236 If you turn on Infinite mode by pressing @kbd{m i}, you will
8237 instead get the answer @samp{[0.1 .. inf]}, which includes infinity
8238 as a possible value.
8239
8240 The fourth calculation, @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}, has the same problem.
8241 Zero is buried inside the interval, but it's still a possible value.
8242 It's not hard to see that the actual result of @samp{1 / (-10 .. 10)}
8243 will be either greater than @mathit{0.1}, or less than @mathit{-0.1}. Thus
8244 the interval goes from minus infinity to plus infinity, with a ``hole''
8245 in it from @mathit{-0.1} to @mathit{0.1}. Calc doesn't have any way to
8246 represent this, so it just reports @samp{[-inf .. inf]} as the answer.
8247 It may be disappointing to hear ``the answer lies somewhere between
8248 minus infinity and plus infinity, inclusive,'' but that's the best
8249 that interval arithmetic can do in this case.
8250
8251 @node Types Answer 9, Types Answer 10, Types Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
8252 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 9
8253
8254 @smallexample
8255 @group
8256 1: [-3 .. 3] 2: [-3 .. 3] 2: [0 .. 9]
8257 . 1: [0 .. 9] 1: [-9 .. 9]
8258 . .
8259
8260 [ 3 n .. 3 ] @key{RET} 2 ^ @key{TAB} @key{RET} *
8261 @end group
8262 @end smallexample
8263
8264 @noindent
8265 In the first case the result says, ``if a number is between @mathit{-3} and
8266 3, its square is between 0 and 9.'' The second case says, ``the product
8267 of two numbers each between @mathit{-3} and 3 is between @mathit{-9} and 9.''
8268
8269 An interval form is not a number; it is a symbol that can stand for
8270 many different numbers. Two identical-looking interval forms can stand
8271 for different numbers.
8272
8273 The same issue arises when you try to square an error form.
8274
8275 @node Types Answer 10, Types Answer 11, Types Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
8276 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 10
8277
8278 @noindent
8279 Testing the first number, we might arbitrarily choose 17 for @expr{x}.
8280
8281 @smallexample
8282 @group
8283 1: 17 mod 811749613 2: 17 mod 811749613 1: 533694123 mod 811749613
8284 . 811749612 .
8285 .
8286
8287 17 M 811749613 @key{RET} 811749612 ^
8288 @end group
8289 @end smallexample
8290
8291 @noindent
8292 Since 533694123 is (considerably) different from 1, the number 811749613
8293 must not be prime.
8294
8295 It's awkward to type the number in twice as we did above. There are
8296 various ways to avoid this, and algebraic entry is one. In fact, using
8297 a vector mapping operation we can perform several tests at once. Let's
8298 use this method to test the second number.
8299
8300 @smallexample
8301 @group
8302 2: [17, 42, 100000] 1: [1 mod 15485863, 1 mod ... ]
8303 1: 15485863 .
8304 .
8305
8306 [17 42 100000] 15485863 @key{RET} V M ' ($$ mod $)^($-1) @key{RET}
8307 @end group
8308 @end smallexample
8309
8310 @noindent
8311 The result is three ones (modulo @expr{n}), so it's very probable that
8312 15485863 is prime. (In fact, this number is the millionth prime.)
8313
8314 Note that the functions @samp{($$^($-1)) mod $} or @samp{$$^($-1) % $}
8315 would have been hopelessly inefficient, since they would have calculated
8316 the power using full integer arithmetic.
8317
8318 Calc has a @kbd{k p} command that does primality testing. For small
8319 numbers it does an exact test; for large numbers it uses a variant
8320 of the Fermat test we used here. You can use @kbd{k p} repeatedly
8321 to prove that a large integer is prime with any desired probability.
8322
8323 @node Types Answer 11, Types Answer 12, Types Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
8324 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 11
8325
8326 @noindent
8327 There are several ways to insert a calculated number into an HMS form.
8328 One way to convert a number of seconds to an HMS form is simply to
8329 multiply the number by an HMS form representing one second:
8330
8331 @smallexample
8332 @group
8333 1: 31415926.5359 2: 31415926.5359 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8334 . 1: 0@@ 0' 1" .
8335 .
8336
8337 P 1e7 * 0@@ 0' 1" *
8338
8339 @end group
8340 @end smallexample
8341 @noindent
8342 @smallexample
8343 @group
8344 2: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359" 1: 6@@ 6' 2.5359" mod 24@@ 0' 0"
8345 1: 15@@ 27' 16" mod 24@@ 0' 0" .
8346 .
8347
8348 x time @key{RET} +
8349 @end group
8350 @end smallexample
8351
8352 @noindent
8353 It will be just after six in the morning.
8354
8355 The algebraic @code{hms} function can also be used to build an
8356 HMS form:
8357
8358 @smallexample
8359 @group
8360 1: hms(0, 0, 10000000. pi) 1: 8726@@ 38' 46.5359"
8361 . .
8362
8363 ' hms(0, 0, 1e7 pi) @key{RET} =
8364 @end group
8365 @end smallexample
8366
8367 @noindent
8368 The @kbd{=} key is necessary to evaluate the symbol @samp{pi} to
8369 the actual number 3.14159...
8370
8371 @node Types Answer 12, Types Answer 13, Types Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
8372 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 12
8373
8374 @noindent
8375 As we recall, there are 17 songs of about 2 minutes and 47 seconds
8376 each.
8377
8378 @smallexample
8379 @group
8380 2: 0@@ 2' 47" 1: [0@@ 3' 7" .. 0@@ 3' 47"]
8381 1: [0@@ 0' 20" .. 0@@ 1' 0"] .
8382 .
8383
8384 [ 0@@ 20" .. 0@@ 1' ] +
8385
8386 @end group
8387 @end smallexample
8388 @noindent
8389 @smallexample
8390 @group
8391 1: [0@@ 52' 59." .. 1@@ 4' 19."]
8392 .
8393
8394 17 *
8395 @end group
8396 @end smallexample
8397
8398 @noindent
8399 No matter how long it is, the album will fit nicely on one CD.
8400
8401 @node Types Answer 13, Types Answer 14, Types Answer 12, Answers to Exercises
8402 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 13
8403
8404 @noindent
8405 Type @kbd{' 1 yr @key{RET} u c s @key{RET}}. The answer is 31557600 seconds.
8406
8407 @node Types Answer 14, Types Answer 15, Types Answer 13, Answers to Exercises
8408 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 14
8409
8410 @noindent
8411 How long will it take for a signal to get from one end of the computer
8412 to the other?
8413
8414 @smallexample
8415 @group
8416 1: m / c 1: 3.3356 ns
8417 . .
8418
8419 ' 1 m / c @key{RET} u c ns @key{RET}
8420 @end group
8421 @end smallexample
8422
8423 @noindent
8424 (Recall, @samp{c} is a ``unit'' corresponding to the speed of light.)
8425
8426 @smallexample
8427 @group
8428 1: 3.3356 ns 1: 0.81356
8429 2: 4.1 ns .
8430 .
8431
8432 ' 4.1 ns @key{RET} /
8433 @end group
8434 @end smallexample
8435
8436 @noindent
8437 Thus a signal could take up to 81 percent of a clock cycle just to
8438 go from one place to another inside the computer, assuming the signal
8439 could actually attain the full speed of light. Pretty tight!
8440
8441 @node Types Answer 15, Algebra Answer 1, Types Answer 14, Answers to Exercises
8442 @subsection Types Tutorial Exercise 15
8443
8444 @noindent
8445 The speed limit is 55 miles per hour on most highways. We want to
8446 find the ratio of Sam's speed to the US speed limit.
8447
8448 @smallexample
8449 @group
8450 1: 55 mph 2: 55 mph 3: 11 hr mph / yd
8451 . 1: 5 yd / hr .
8452 .
8453
8454 ' 55 mph @key{RET} ' 5 yd/hr @key{RET} /
8455 @end group
8456 @end smallexample
8457
8458 The @kbd{u s} command cancels out these units to get a plain
8459 number. Now we take the logarithm base two to find the final
8460 answer, assuming that each successive pill doubles his speed.
8461
8462 @smallexample
8463 @group
8464 1: 19360. 2: 19360. 1: 14.24
8465 . 1: 2 .
8466 .
8467
8468 u s 2 B
8469 @end group
8470 @end smallexample
8471
8472 @noindent
8473 Thus Sam can take up to 14 pills without a worry.
8474
8475 @node Algebra Answer 1, Algebra Answer 2, Types Answer 15, Answers to Exercises
8476 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 1
8477
8478 @noindent
8479 @c [fix-ref Declarations]
8480 The result @samp{sqrt(x)^2} is simplified back to @expr{x} by the
8481 Calculator, but @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is not. (Consider what happens
8482 if @w{@expr{x = -4}}.) If @expr{x} is real, this formula could be
8483 simplified to @samp{abs(x)}, but for general complex arguments even
8484 that is not safe. (@xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell Calc
8485 that @expr{x} is known to be real.)
8486
8487 @node Algebra Answer 2, Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8488 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 2
8489
8490 @noindent
8491 Suppose our roots are @expr{[a, b, c]}. We want a polynomial which
8492 is zero when @expr{x} is any of these values. The trivial polynomial
8493 @expr{x-a} is zero when @expr{x=a}, so the product @expr{(x-a)(x-b)(x-c)}
8494 will do the job. We can use @kbd{a c x} to write this in a more
8495 familiar form.
8496
8497 @smallexample
8498 @group
8499 1: 34 x - 24 x^3 1: [1.19023, -1.19023, 0]
8500 . .
8501
8502 r 2 a P x @key{RET}
8503
8504 @end group
8505 @end smallexample
8506 @noindent
8507 @smallexample
8508 @group
8509 1: [x - 1.19023, x + 1.19023, x] 1: x*(x + 1.19023) (x - 1.19023)
8510 . .
8511
8512 V M ' x-$ @key{RET} V R *
8513
8514 @end group
8515 @end smallexample
8516 @noindent
8517 @smallexample
8518 @group
8519 1: x^3 - 1.41666 x 1: 34 x - 24 x^3
8520 . .
8521
8522 a c x @key{RET} 24 n * a x
8523 @end group
8524 @end smallexample
8525
8526 @noindent
8527 Sure enough, our answer (multiplied by a suitable constant) is the
8528 same as the original polynomial.
8529
8530 @node Algebra Answer 3, Algebra Answer 4, Algebra Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8531 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 3
8532
8533 @smallexample
8534 @group
8535 1: x sin(pi x) 1: sin(pi x) / pi^2 - x cos(pi x) / pi
8536 . .
8537
8538 ' x sin(pi x) @key{RET} m r a i x @key{RET}
8539
8540 @end group
8541 @end smallexample
8542 @noindent
8543 @smallexample
8544 @group
8545 1: [y, 1]
8546 2: sin(pi x) / pi^2 - x cos(pi x) / pi
8547 .
8548
8549 ' [y,1] @key{RET} @key{TAB}
8550
8551 @end group
8552 @end smallexample
8553 @noindent
8554 @smallexample
8555 @group
8556 1: [sin(pi y) / pi^2 - y cos(pi y) / pi, 1 / pi]
8557 .
8558
8559 V M $ @key{RET}
8560
8561 @end group
8562 @end smallexample
8563 @noindent
8564 @smallexample
8565 @group
8566 1: sin(pi y) / pi^2 - y cos(pi y) / pi - 1 / pi
8567 .
8568
8569 V R -
8570
8571 @end group
8572 @end smallexample
8573 @noindent
8574 @smallexample
8575 @group
8576 1: sin(3.14159 y) / 9.8696 - y cos(3.14159 y) / 3.14159 - 0.3183
8577 .
8578
8579 =
8580
8581 @end group
8582 @end smallexample
8583 @noindent
8584 @smallexample
8585 @group
8586 1: [0., -0.95493, 0.63662, -1.5915, 1.2732]
8587 .
8588
8589 v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}
8590 @end group
8591 @end smallexample
8592
8593 @node Algebra Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 1, Algebra Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8594 @subsection Algebra Tutorial Exercise 4
8595
8596 @noindent
8597 The hard part is that @kbd{V R +} is no longer sufficient to add up all
8598 the contributions from the slices, since the slices have varying
8599 coefficients. So first we must come up with a vector of these
8600 coefficients. Here's one way:
8601
8602 @smallexample
8603 @group
8604 2: -1 2: 3 1: [4, 2, ..., 4]
8605 1: [1, 2, ..., 9] 1: [-1, 1, ..., -1] .
8606 . .
8607
8608 1 n v x 9 @key{RET} V M ^ 3 @key{TAB} -
8609
8610 @end group
8611 @end smallexample
8612 @noindent
8613 @smallexample
8614 @group
8615 1: [4, 2, ..., 4, 1] 1: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8616 . .
8617
8618 1 | 1 @key{TAB} |
8619 @end group
8620 @end smallexample
8621
8622 @noindent
8623 Now we compute the function values. Note that for this method we need
8624 eleven values, including both endpoints of the desired interval.
8625
8626 @smallexample
8627 @group
8628 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8629 1: [1, 1.1, 1.2, ... , 1.8, 1.9, 2.]
8630 .
8631
8632 11 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} .1 @key{RET} C-u v x
8633
8634 @end group
8635 @end smallexample
8636 @noindent
8637 @smallexample
8638 @group
8639 2: [1, 4, 2, ..., 4, 1]
8640 1: [0., 0.084941, 0.16993, ... ]
8641 .
8642
8643 ' sin(x) ln(x) @key{RET} m r p 5 @key{RET} V M $ @key{RET}
8644 @end group
8645 @end smallexample
8646
8647 @noindent
8648 Once again this calls for @kbd{V M * V R +}; a simple @kbd{*} does the
8649 same thing.
8650
8651 @smallexample
8652 @group
8653 1: 11.22 1: 1.122 1: 0.374
8654 . . .
8655
8656 * .1 * 3 /
8657 @end group
8658 @end smallexample
8659
8660 @noindent
8661 Wow! That's even better than the result from the Taylor series method.
8662
8663 @node Rewrites Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 2, Algebra Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8664 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 1
8665
8666 @noindent
8667 We'll use Big mode to make the formulas more readable.
8668
8669 @smallexample
8670 @group
8671 ___
8672 V 2 + 2
8673 1: (2 + sqrt(2)) / (1 + sqrt(2)) 1: ---------
8674 . ___
8675 V 2 + 1
8676
8677 .
8678
8679 ' (2+sqrt(2)) / (1+sqrt(2)) @key{RET} d B
8680 @end group
8681 @end smallexample
8682
8683 @noindent
8684 Multiplying by the conjugate helps because @expr{(a+b) (a-b) = a^2 - b^2}.
8685
8686 @smallexample
8687 @group
8688 ___ ___
8689 1: (2 + V 2 ) (V 2 - 1)
8690 .
8691
8692 a r a/(b+c) := a*(b-c) / (b^2-c^2) @key{RET}
8693
8694 @end group
8695 @end smallexample
8696 @noindent
8697 @smallexample
8698 @group
8699 ___
8700 1: V 2
8701 .
8702
8703 a r a*(b+c) := a*b + a*c
8704 @end group
8705 @end smallexample
8706
8707 @noindent
8708 (We could have used @kbd{a x} instead of a rewrite rule for the
8709 second step.)
8710
8711 The multiply-by-conjugate rule turns out to be useful in many
8712 different circumstances, such as when the denominator involves
8713 sines and cosines or the imaginary constant @code{i}.
8714
8715 @node Rewrites Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8716 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 2
8717
8718 @noindent
8719 Here is the rule set:
8720
8721 @smallexample
8722 @group
8723 [ fib(n) := fib(n, 1, 1) :: integer(n) :: n >= 1,
8724 fib(1, x, y) := x,
8725 fib(n, x, y) := fib(n-1, y, x+y) ]
8726 @end group
8727 @end smallexample
8728
8729 @noindent
8730 The first rule turns a one-argument @code{fib} that people like to write
8731 into a three-argument @code{fib} that makes computation easier. The
8732 second rule converts back from three-argument form once the computation
8733 is done. The third rule does the computation itself. It basically
8734 says that if @expr{x} and @expr{y} are two consecutive Fibonacci numbers,
8735 then @expr{y} and @expr{x+y} are the next (overlapping) pair of Fibonacci
8736 numbers.
8737
8738 Notice that because the number @expr{n} was ``validated'' by the
8739 conditions on the first rule, there is no need to put conditions on
8740 the other rules because the rule set would never get that far unless
8741 the input were valid. That further speeds computation, since no
8742 extra conditions need to be checked at every step.
8743
8744 Actually, a user with a nasty sense of humor could enter a bad
8745 three-argument @code{fib} call directly, say, @samp{fib(0, 1, 1)},
8746 which would get the rules into an infinite loop. One thing that would
8747 help keep this from happening by accident would be to use something like
8748 @samp{ZzFib} instead of @code{fib} as the name of the three-argument
8749 function.
8750
8751 @node Rewrites Answer 3, Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8752 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 3
8753
8754 @noindent
8755 He got an infinite loop. First, Calc did as expected and rewrote
8756 @w{@samp{2 + 3 x}} to @samp{f(2, 3, x)}. Then it looked for ways to
8757 apply the rule again, and found that @samp{f(2, 3, x)} looks like
8758 @samp{a + b x} with @w{@samp{a = 0}} and @samp{b = 1}, so it rewrote to
8759 @samp{f(0, 1, f(2, 3, x))}. It then wrapped another @samp{f(0, 1, ...)}
8760 around that, and so on, ad infinitum. Joe should have used @kbd{M-1 a r}
8761 to make sure the rule applied only once.
8762
8763 (Actually, even the first step didn't work as he expected. What Calc
8764 really gives for @kbd{M-1 a r} in this situation is @samp{f(3 x, 1, 2)},
8765 treating 2 as the ``variable,'' and @samp{3 x} as a constant being added
8766 to it. While this may seem odd, it's just as valid a solution as the
8767 ``obvious'' one. One way to fix this would be to add the condition
8768 @samp{:: variable(x)} to the rule, to make sure the thing that matches
8769 @samp{x} is indeed a variable, or to change @samp{x} to @samp{quote(x)}
8770 on the lefthand side, so that the rule matches the actual variable
8771 @samp{x} rather than letting @samp{x} stand for something else.)
8772
8773 @node Rewrites Answer 4, Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
8774 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 4
8775
8776 @noindent
8777 @ignore
8778 @starindex
8779 @end ignore
8780 @tindex seq
8781 Here is a suitable set of rules to solve the first part of the problem:
8782
8783 @smallexample
8784 @group
8785 [ seq(n, c) := seq(n/2, c+1) :: n%2 = 0,
8786 seq(n, c) := seq(3n+1, c+1) :: n%2 = 1 :: n > 1 ]
8787 @end group
8788 @end smallexample
8789
8790 Given the initial formula @samp{seq(6, 0)}, application of these
8791 rules produces the following sequence of formulas:
8792
8793 @example
8794 seq( 3, 1)
8795 seq(10, 2)
8796 seq( 5, 3)
8797 seq(16, 4)
8798 seq( 8, 5)
8799 seq( 4, 6)
8800 seq( 2, 7)
8801 seq( 1, 8)
8802 @end example
8803
8804 @noindent
8805 whereupon neither of the rules match, and rewriting stops.
8806
8807 We can pretty this up a bit with a couple more rules:
8808
8809 @smallexample
8810 @group
8811 [ seq(n) := seq(n, 0),
8812 seq(1, c) := c,
8813 ... ]
8814 @end group
8815 @end smallexample
8816
8817 @noindent
8818 Now, given @samp{seq(6)} as the starting configuration, we get 8
8819 as the result.
8820
8821 The change to return a vector is quite simple:
8822
8823 @smallexample
8824 @group
8825 [ seq(n) := seq(n, []) :: integer(n) :: n > 0,
8826 seq(1, v) := v | 1,
8827 seq(n, v) := seq(n/2, v | n) :: n%2 = 0,
8828 seq(n, v) := seq(3n+1, v | n) :: n%2 = 1 ]
8829 @end group
8830 @end smallexample
8831
8832 @noindent
8833 Given @samp{seq(6)}, the result is @samp{[6, 3, 10, 5, 16, 8, 4, 2, 1]}.
8834
8835 Notice that the @expr{n > 1} guard is no longer necessary on the last
8836 rule since the @expr{n = 1} case is now detected by another rule.
8837 But a guard has been added to the initial rule to make sure the
8838 initial value is suitable before the computation begins.
8839
8840 While still a good idea, this guard is not as vitally important as it
8841 was for the @code{fib} function, since calling, say, @samp{seq(x, [])}
8842 will not get into an infinite loop. Calc will not be able to prove
8843 the symbol @samp{x} is either even or odd, so none of the rules will
8844 apply and the rewrites will stop right away.
8845
8846 @node Rewrites Answer 5, Rewrites Answer 6, Rewrites Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
8847 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 5
8848
8849 @noindent
8850 @ignore
8851 @starindex
8852 @end ignore
8853 @tindex nterms
8854 If @expr{x} is the sum @expr{a + b}, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' must
8855 be `@tfn{nterms(}@var{a}@tfn{)}' plus `@tfn{nterms(}@var{b}@tfn{)}'. If @expr{x}
8856 is not a sum, then `@tfn{nterms(}@var{x}@tfn{)}' = 1.
8857
8858 @smallexample
8859 @group
8860 [ nterms(a + b) := nterms(a) + nterms(b),
8861 nterms(x) := 1 ]
8862 @end group
8863 @end smallexample
8864
8865 @noindent
8866 Here we have taken advantage of the fact that earlier rules always
8867 match before later rules; @samp{nterms(x)} will only be tried if we
8868 already know that @samp{x} is not a sum.
8869
8870 @node Rewrites Answer 6, Programming Answer 1, Rewrites Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
8871 @subsection Rewrites Tutorial Exercise 6
8872
8873 @noindent
8874 Here is a rule set that will do the job:
8875
8876 @smallexample
8877 @group
8878 [ a*(b + c) := a*b + a*c,
8879 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) O(x^m) := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8880 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8881 opt(a) O(x^n) + opt(b) x^m := O(x^n) :: n <= m
8882 :: constant(a) :: constant(b),
8883 a O(x^n) := O(x^n) :: constant(a),
8884 x^opt(m) O(x^n) := O(x^(n+m)),
8885 O(x^n) O(x^m) := O(x^(n+m)) ]
8886 @end group
8887 @end smallexample
8888
8889 If we really want the @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} keys to operate naturally
8890 on power series, we should put these rules in @code{EvalRules}. For
8891 testing purposes, it is better to put them in a different variable,
8892 say, @code{O}, first.
8893
8894 The first rule just expands products of sums so that the rest of the
8895 rules can assume they have an expanded-out polynomial to work with.
8896 Note that this rule does not mention @samp{O} at all, so it will
8897 apply to any product-of-sum it encounters---this rule may surprise
8898 you if you put it into @code{EvalRules}!
8899
8900 In the second rule, the sum of two O's is changed to the smaller O@.
8901 The optional constant coefficients are there mostly so that
8902 @samp{O(x^2) - O(x^3)} and @samp{O(x^3) - O(x^2)} are handled
8903 as well as @samp{O(x^2) + O(x^3)}.
8904
8905 The third rule absorbs higher powers of @samp{x} into O's.
8906
8907 The fourth rule says that a constant times a negligible quantity
8908 is still negligible. (This rule will also match @samp{O(x^3) / 4},
8909 with @samp{a = 1/4}.)
8910
8911 The fifth rule rewrites, for example, @samp{x^2 O(x^3)} to @samp{O(x^5)}.
8912 (It is easy to see that if one of these forms is negligible, the other
8913 is, too.) Notice the @samp{x^opt(m)} to pick up terms like
8914 @w{@samp{x O(x^3)}}. Optional powers will match @samp{x} as @samp{x^1}
8915 but not 1 as @samp{x^0}. This turns out to be exactly what we want here.
8916
8917 The sixth rule is the corresponding rule for products of two O's.
8918
8919 Another way to solve this problem would be to create a new ``data type''
8920 that represents truncated power series. We might represent these as
8921 function calls @samp{series(@var{coefs}, @var{x})} where @var{coefs} is
8922 a vector of coefficients for @expr{x^0}, @expr{x^1}, @expr{x^2}, and so
8923 on. Rules would exist for sums and products of such @code{series}
8924 objects, and as an optional convenience could also know how to combine a
8925 @code{series} object with a normal polynomial. (With this, and with a
8926 rule that rewrites @samp{O(x^n)} to the equivalent @code{series} form,
8927 you could still enter power series in exactly the same notation as
8928 before.) Operations on such objects would probably be more efficient,
8929 although the objects would be a bit harder to read.
8930
8931 @c [fix-ref Compositions]
8932 Some other symbolic math programs provide a power series data type
8933 similar to this. Mathematica, for example, has an object that looks
8934 like @samp{PowerSeries[@var{x}, @var{x0}, @var{coefs}, @var{nmin},
8935 @var{nmax}, @var{den}]}, where @var{x0} is the point about which the
8936 power series is taken (we've been assuming this was always zero),
8937 and @var{nmin}, @var{nmax}, and @var{den} allow pseudo-power-series
8938 with fractional or negative powers. Also, the @code{PowerSeries}
8939 objects have a special display format that makes them look like
8940 @samp{2 x^2 + O(x^4)} when they are printed out. (@xref{Compositions},
8941 for a way to do this in Calc, although for something as involved as
8942 this it would probably be better to write the formatting routine
8943 in Lisp.)
8944
8945 @node Programming Answer 1, Programming Answer 2, Rewrites Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
8946 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 1
8947
8948 @noindent
8949 Just enter the formula @samp{ninteg(sin(t)/t, t, 0, x)}, type
8950 @kbd{Z F}, and answer the questions. Since this formula contains two
8951 variables, the default argument list will be @samp{(t x)}. We want to
8952 change this to @samp{(x)} since @expr{t} is really a dummy variable
8953 to be used within @code{ninteg}.
8954
8955 The exact keystrokes are @kbd{Z F s Si @key{RET} @key{RET} C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL} @key{RET} y}.
8956 (The @kbd{C-b C-b @key{DEL} @key{DEL}} are what fix the argument list.)
8957
8958 @node Programming Answer 2, Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 1, Answers to Exercises
8959 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 2
8960
8961 @noindent
8962 One way is to move the number to the top of the stack, operate on
8963 it, then move it back: @kbd{C-x ( M-@key{TAB} n M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} C-x )}.
8964
8965 Another way is to negate the top three stack entries, then negate
8966 again the top two stack entries: @kbd{C-x ( M-3 n M-2 n C-x )}.
8967
8968 Finally, it turns out that a negative prefix argument causes a
8969 command like @kbd{n} to operate on the specified stack entry only,
8970 which is just what we want: @kbd{C-x ( M-- 3 n C-x )}.
8971
8972 Just for kicks, let's also do it algebraically:
8973 @w{@kbd{C-x ( ' -$$$, $$, $ @key{RET} C-x )}}.
8974
8975 @node Programming Answer 3, Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 2, Answers to Exercises
8976 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 3
8977
8978 @noindent
8979 Each of these functions can be computed using the stack, or using
8980 algebraic entry, whichever way you prefer:
8981
8982 @noindent
8983 Computing
8984 @texline @math{\displaystyle{\sin x \over x}}:
8985 @infoline @expr{sin(x) / x}:
8986
8987 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} S @key{TAB} / C-x )}.
8988
8989 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' sin($)/$ @key{RET} C-x )}.
8990
8991 @noindent
8992 Computing the logarithm:
8993
8994 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( @key{TAB} B C-x )}
8995
8996 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' log($,$$) @key{RET} C-x )}.
8997
8998 @noindent
8999 Computing the vector of integers:
9000
9001 Using the stack: @kbd{C-x ( 1 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x C-x )}. (Recall that
9002 @kbd{C-u v x} takes the vector size, starting value, and increment
9003 from the stack.)
9004
9005 Alternatively: @kbd{C-x ( ~ v x C-x )}. (The @kbd{~} key pops a
9006 number from the stack and uses it as the prefix argument for the
9007 next command.)
9008
9009 Using algebraic entry: @kbd{C-x ( ' index($) @key{RET} C-x )}.
9010
9011 @node Programming Answer 4, Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 3, Answers to Exercises
9012 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 4
9013
9014 @noindent
9015 Here's one way: @kbd{C-x ( @key{RET} V R + @key{TAB} v l / C-x )}.
9016
9017 @node Programming Answer 5, Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 4, Answers to Exercises
9018 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 5
9019
9020 @smallexample
9021 @group
9022 2: 1 1: 1.61803398502 2: 1.61803398502
9023 1: 20 . 1: 1.61803398875
9024 . .
9025
9026 1 @key{RET} 20 Z < & 1 + Z > I H P
9027 @end group
9028 @end smallexample
9029
9030 @noindent
9031 This answer is quite accurate.
9032
9033 @node Programming Answer 6, Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 5, Answers to Exercises
9034 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 6
9035
9036 @noindent
9037 Here is the matrix:
9038
9039 @example
9040 [ [ 0, 1 ] * [a, b] = [b, a + b]
9041 [ 1, 1 ] ]
9042 @end example
9043
9044 @noindent
9045 Thus @samp{[0, 1; 1, 1]^n * [1, 1]} computes Fibonacci numbers @expr{n+1}
9046 and @expr{n+2}. Here's one program that does the job:
9047
9048 @example
9049 C-x ( ' [0, 1; 1, 1] ^ ($-1) * [1, 1] @key{RET} v u @key{DEL} C-x )
9050 @end example
9051
9052 @noindent
9053 This program is quite efficient because Calc knows how to raise a
9054 matrix (or other value) to the power @expr{n} in only
9055 @texline @math{\log_2 n}
9056 @infoline @expr{log(n,2)}
9057 steps. For example, this program can compute the 1000th Fibonacci
9058 number (a 209-digit integer!) in about 10 steps; even though the
9059 @kbd{Z < ... Z >} solution had much simpler steps, it would have
9060 required so many steps that it would not have been practical.
9061
9062 @node Programming Answer 7, Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 6, Answers to Exercises
9063 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 7
9064
9065 @noindent
9066 The trick here is to compute the harmonic numbers differently, so that
9067 the loop counter itself accumulates the sum of reciprocals. We use
9068 a separate variable to hold the integer counter.
9069
9070 @smallexample
9071 @group
9072 1: 1 2: 1 1: .
9073 . 1: 4
9074 .
9075
9076 1 t 1 1 @key{RET} 4 Z ( t 2 r 1 1 + s 1 & Z )
9077 @end group
9078 @end smallexample
9079
9080 @noindent
9081 The body of the loop goes as follows: First save the harmonic sum
9082 so far in variable 2. Then delete it from the stack; the for loop
9083 itself will take care of remembering it for us. Next, recall the
9084 count from variable 1, add one to it, and feed its reciprocal to
9085 the for loop to use as the step value. The for loop will increase
9086 the ``loop counter'' by that amount and keep going until the
9087 loop counter exceeds 4.
9088
9089 @smallexample
9090 @group
9091 2: 31 3: 31
9092 1: 3.99498713092 2: 3.99498713092
9093 . 1: 4.02724519544
9094 .
9095
9096 r 1 r 2 @key{RET} 31 & +
9097 @end group
9098 @end smallexample
9099
9100 Thus we find that the 30th harmonic number is 3.99, and the 31st
9101 harmonic number is 4.02.
9102
9103 @node Programming Answer 8, Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 7, Answers to Exercises
9104 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 8
9105
9106 @noindent
9107 The first step is to compute the derivative @expr{f'(x)} and thus
9108 the formula
9109 @texline @math{\displaystyle{x - {f(x) \over f'(x)}}}.
9110 @infoline @expr{x - f(x)/f'(x)}.
9111
9112 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9113 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9114 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9115 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9116 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9117 just for purposes of illustration.)
9118
9119 @smallexample
9120 @group
9121 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5 3: 4.5
9122 1: 4.5 2: sin(cos(x)) - 0.5
9123 . 1: -(sin(x) cos(cos(x)))
9124 .
9125
9126 ' sin(cos(x))-0.5 @key{RET} 4.5 m r C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET}
9127
9128 @end group
9129 @end smallexample
9130 @noindent
9131 @smallexample
9132 @group
9133 2: 4.5
9134 1: x + (sin(cos(x)) - 0.5) / sin(x) cos(cos(x))
9135 .
9136
9137 / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9138 @end group
9139 @end smallexample
9140
9141 Now, we enter the loop. We'll use a repeat loop with a 20-repetition
9142 limit just in case the method fails to converge for some reason.
9143 (Normally, the @w{@kbd{Z /}} command will stop the loop before all 20
9144 repetitions are done.)
9145
9146 @smallexample
9147 @group
9148 1: 4.5 3: 4.5 2: 4.5
9149 . 2: x + (sin(cos(x)) ... 1: 5.24196456928
9150 1: 4.5 .
9151 .
9152
9153 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9154 @end group
9155 @end smallexample
9156
9157 This is the new guess for @expr{x}. Now we compare it with the
9158 old one to see if we've converged.
9159
9160 @smallexample
9161 @group
9162 3: 5.24196 2: 5.24196 1: 5.24196 1: 5.26345856348
9163 2: 5.24196 1: 0 . .
9164 1: 4.5 .
9165 .
9166
9167 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / Z > Z ' C-x )
9168 @end group
9169 @end smallexample
9170
9171 The loop converges in just a few steps to this value. To check
9172 the result, we can simply substitute it back into the equation.
9173
9174 @smallexample
9175 @group
9176 2: 5.26345856348
9177 1: 0.499999999997
9178 .
9179
9180 @key{RET} ' sin(cos($)) @key{RET}
9181 @end group
9182 @end smallexample
9183
9184 Let's test the new definition again:
9185
9186 @smallexample
9187 @group
9188 2: x^2 - 9 1: 3.
9189 1: 1 .
9190 .
9191
9192 ' x^2-9 @key{RET} 1 X
9193 @end group
9194 @end smallexample
9195
9196 Once again, here's the full Newton's Method definition:
9197
9198 @example
9199 @group
9200 C-x ( Z ` @key{TAB} @key{RET} a d x @key{RET} / ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} - t 1
9201 20 Z < @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} s l x @key{RET}
9202 @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9203 Z >
9204 Z '
9205 C-x )
9206 @end group
9207 @end example
9208
9209 @c [fix-ref Nesting and Fixed Points]
9210 It turns out that Calc has a built-in command for applying a formula
9211 repeatedly until it converges to a number. @xref{Nesting and Fixed Points},
9212 to see how to use it.
9213
9214 @c [fix-ref Root Finding]
9215 Also, of course, @kbd{a R} is a built-in command that uses Newton's
9216 method (among others) to look for numerical solutions to any equation.
9217 @xref{Root Finding}.
9218
9219 @node Programming Answer 9, Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 8, Answers to Exercises
9220 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 9
9221
9222 @noindent
9223 The first step is to adjust @expr{z} to be greater than 5. A simple
9224 ``for'' loop will do the job here. If @expr{z} is less than 5, we
9225 reduce the problem using
9226 @texline @math{\psi(z) = \psi(z+1) - 1/z}.
9227 @infoline @expr{psi(z) = psi(z+1) - 1/z}. We go
9228 on to compute
9229 @texline @math{\psi(z+1)},
9230 @infoline @expr{psi(z+1)},
9231 and remember to add back a factor of @expr{-1/z} when we're done. This
9232 step is repeated until @expr{z > 5}.
9233
9234 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9235 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9236 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9237 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9238 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9239 just for purposes of illustration.)
9240
9241 @smallexample
9242 @group
9243 1: 1. 1: 1.
9244 . .
9245
9246 1.0 @key{RET} C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9247 @end group
9248 @end smallexample
9249
9250 Here, variable 1 holds @expr{z} and variable 2 holds the adjustment
9251 factor. If @expr{z < 5}, we use a loop to increase it.
9252
9253 (By the way, we started with @samp{1.0} instead of the integer 1 because
9254 otherwise the calculation below will try to do exact fractional arithmetic,
9255 and will never converge because fractions compare equal only if they
9256 are exactly equal, not just equal to within the current precision.)
9257
9258 @smallexample
9259 @group
9260 3: 1. 2: 1. 1: 6.
9261 2: 1. 1: 1 .
9262 1: 5 .
9263 .
9264
9265 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9266 @end group
9267 @end smallexample
9268
9269 Now we compute the initial part of the sum:
9270 @texline @math{\ln z - {1 \over 2z}}
9271 @infoline @expr{ln(z) - 1/2z}
9272 minus the adjustment factor.
9273
9274 @smallexample
9275 @group
9276 2: 1.79175946923 2: 1.7084261359 1: -0.57490719743
9277 1: 0.0833333333333 1: 2.28333333333 .
9278 . .
9279
9280 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9281 @end group
9282 @end smallexample
9283
9284 Now we evaluate the series. We'll use another ``for'' loop counting
9285 up the value of @expr{2 n}. (Calc does have a summation command,
9286 @kbd{a +}, but we'll use loops just to get more practice with them.)
9287
9288 @smallexample
9289 @group
9290 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5749 4: -0.5749 2: -0.5749
9291 2: 2 2: 1:6 3: 1:6 1: 2.3148e-3
9292 1: 40 1: 2 2: 2 .
9293 . . 1: 36.
9294 .
9295
9296 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9297
9298 @end group
9299 @end smallexample
9300 @noindent
9301 @smallexample
9302 @group
9303 3: -0.5749 3: -0.5772 2: -0.5772 1: -0.577215664892
9304 2: -0.5749 2: -0.5772 1: 0 .
9305 1: 2.3148e-3 1: -0.5749 .
9306 . .
9307
9308 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z / 2 Z ) Z ' C-x )
9309 @end group
9310 @end smallexample
9311
9312 This is the value of
9313 @texline @math{-\gamma},
9314 @infoline @expr{- gamma},
9315 with a slight bit of roundoff error. To get a full 12 digits, let's use
9316 a higher precision:
9317
9318 @smallexample
9319 @group
9320 2: -0.577215664892 2: -0.577215664892
9321 1: 1. 1: -0.577215664901532
9322
9323 1. @key{RET} p 16 @key{RET} X
9324 @end group
9325 @end smallexample
9326
9327 Here's the complete sequence of keystrokes:
9328
9329 @example
9330 @group
9331 C-x ( Z ` s 1 0 t 2
9332 @key{RET} 5 a < Z [ 5 Z ( & s + 2 1 s + 1 1 Z ) r 1 Z ]
9333 L r 1 2 * & - r 2 -
9334 2 @key{RET} 40 Z ( @key{RET} k b @key{TAB} @key{RET} r 1 @key{TAB} ^ * /
9335 @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} - @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} a = Z /
9336 2 Z )
9337 Z '
9338 C-x )
9339 @end group
9340 @end example
9341
9342 @node Programming Answer 10, Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 9, Answers to Exercises
9343 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 10
9344
9345 @noindent
9346 Taking the derivative of a term of the form @expr{x^n} will produce
9347 a term like
9348 @texline @math{n x^{n-1}}.
9349 @infoline @expr{n x^(n-1)}.
9350 Taking the derivative of a constant
9351 produces zero. From this it is easy to see that the @expr{n}th
9352 derivative of a polynomial, evaluated at @expr{x = 0}, will equal the
9353 coefficient on the @expr{x^n} term times @expr{n!}.
9354
9355 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9356 below. You can use @w{@kbd{C-x * m}} to load it from there. While you are
9357 entering a @kbd{Z ` Z '} body in a macro, Calc simply collects
9358 keystrokes without executing them. In the following diagrams we'll
9359 pretend Calc actually executed the keystrokes as you typed them,
9360 just for purposes of illustration.)
9361
9362 @smallexample
9363 @group
9364 2: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2 3: 5 x^4 + (x + 1)^2
9365 1: 6 2: 0
9366 . 1: 6
9367 .
9368
9369 ' 5 x^4 + (x+1)^2 @key{RET} 6 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9370 @end group
9371 @end smallexample
9372
9373 @noindent
9374 Variable 1 will accumulate the vector of coefficients.
9375
9376 @smallexample
9377 @group
9378 2: 0 3: 0 2: 5 x^4 + ...
9379 1: 5 x^4 + ... 2: 5 x^4 + ... 1: 1
9380 . 1: 1 .
9381 .
9382
9383 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9384 @end group
9385 @end smallexample
9386
9387 @noindent
9388 Note that @kbd{s | 1} appends the top-of-stack value to the vector
9389 in a variable; it is completely analogous to @kbd{s + 1}. We could
9390 have written instead, @kbd{r 1 @key{TAB} | t 1}.
9391
9392 @smallexample
9393 @group
9394 1: 20 x^3 + 2 x + 2 1: 0 1: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9395 . . .
9396
9397 a d x @key{RET} 1 Z ) @key{DEL} r 1 Z ' C-x )
9398 @end group
9399 @end smallexample
9400
9401 To convert back, a simple method is just to map the coefficients
9402 against a table of powers of @expr{x}.
9403
9404 @smallexample
9405 @group
9406 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0]
9407 1: 6 1: [0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6]
9408 . .
9409
9410 6 @key{RET} 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x
9411
9412 @end group
9413 @end smallexample
9414 @noindent
9415 @smallexample
9416 @group
9417 2: [1, 2, 1, 0, 5, 0, 0] 2: 1 + 2 x + x^2 + 5 x^4
9418 1: [1, x, x^2, x^3, ... ] .
9419 .
9420
9421 ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ *
9422 @end group
9423 @end smallexample
9424
9425 Once again, here are the whole polynomial to/from vector programs:
9426
9427 @example
9428 @group
9429 C-x ( Z ` [ ] t 1 0 @key{TAB}
9430 Z ( @key{TAB} @key{RET} 0 s l x @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} ! / s | 1
9431 a d x @key{RET}
9432 1 Z ) r 1
9433 Z '
9434 C-x )
9435
9436 C-x ( 1 + 0 @key{RET} 1 C-u v x ' x @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M ^ * C-x )
9437 @end group
9438 @end example
9439
9440 @node Programming Answer 11, Programming Answer 12, Programming Answer 10, Answers to Exercises
9441 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 11
9442
9443 @noindent
9444 First we define a dummy program to go on the @kbd{z s} key. The true
9445 @w{@kbd{z s}} key is supposed to take two numbers from the stack and
9446 return one number, so @key{DEL} as a dummy definition will make
9447 sure the stack comes out right.
9448
9449 @smallexample
9450 @group
9451 2: 4 1: 4 2: 4
9452 1: 2 . 1: 2
9453 . .
9454
9455 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( @key{DEL} C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} 2
9456 @end group
9457 @end smallexample
9458
9459 The last step replaces the 2 that was eaten during the creation
9460 of the dummy @kbd{z s} command. Now we move on to the real
9461 definition. The recurrence needs to be rewritten slightly,
9462 to the form @expr{s(n,m) = s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m)}.
9463
9464 (Because this definition is long, it will be repeated in concise form
9465 below. You can use @kbd{C-x * m} to load it from there.)
9466
9467 @smallexample
9468 @group
9469 2: 4 4: 4 3: 4 2: 4
9470 1: 2 3: 2 2: 2 1: 2
9471 . 2: 4 1: 0 .
9472 1: 2 .
9473 .
9474
9475 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1 Z :
9476
9477 @end group
9478 @end smallexample
9479 @noindent
9480 @smallexample
9481 @group
9482 4: 4 2: 4 2: 3 4: 3 4: 3 3: 3
9483 3: 2 1: 2 1: 2 3: 2 3: 2 2: 2
9484 2: 2 . . 2: 3 2: 3 1: 3
9485 1: 0 1: 2 1: 1 .
9486 . . .
9487
9488 @key{RET} 0 a = Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9489 @end group
9490 @end smallexample
9491
9492 @noindent
9493 (Note that the value 3 that our dummy @kbd{z s} produces is not correct;
9494 it is merely a placeholder that will do just as well for now.)
9495
9496 @smallexample
9497 @group
9498 3: 3 4: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: -6
9499 2: 3 3: 3 2: 3 1: 9 .
9500 1: 2 2: 3 1: 3 .
9501 . 1: 2 .
9502 .
9503
9504 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9505
9506 @end group
9507 @end smallexample
9508 @noindent
9509 @smallexample
9510 @group
9511 1: -6 2: 4 1: 11 2: 11
9512 . 1: 2 . 1: 11
9513 . .
9514
9515 Z ] Z ] C-x ) Z K s @key{RET} @key{DEL} 4 @key{RET} 2 z s M-@key{RET} k s
9516 @end group
9517 @end smallexample
9518
9519 Even though the result that we got during the definition was highly
9520 bogus, once the definition is complete the @kbd{z s} command gets
9521 the right answers.
9522
9523 Here's the full program once again:
9524
9525 @example
9526 @group
9527 C-x ( M-2 @key{RET} a =
9528 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 1
9529 Z : @key{RET} 0 a =
9530 Z [ @key{DEL} @key{DEL} 0
9531 Z : @key{TAB} 1 - @key{TAB} M-2 @key{RET} 1 - z s
9532 M-@key{TAB} M-@key{TAB} @key{TAB} @key{RET} M-@key{TAB} z s * -
9533 Z ]
9534 Z ]
9535 C-x )
9536 @end group
9537 @end example
9538
9539 You can read this definition using @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro})
9540 followed by @kbd{Z K s}, without having to make a dummy definition
9541 first, because @code{read-kbd-macro} doesn't need to execute the
9542 definition as it reads it in. For this reason, @code{C-x * m} is often
9543 the easiest way to create recursive programs in Calc.
9544
9545 @node Programming Answer 12, , Programming Answer 11, Answers to Exercises
9546 @subsection Programming Tutorial Exercise 12
9547
9548 @noindent
9549 This turns out to be a much easier way to solve the problem. Let's
9550 denote Stirling numbers as calls of the function @samp{s}.
9551
9552 First, we store the rewrite rules corresponding to the definition of
9553 Stirling numbers in a convenient variable:
9554
9555 @smallexample
9556 s e StirlingRules @key{RET}
9557 [ s(n,n) := 1 :: n >= 0,
9558 s(n,0) := 0 :: n > 0,
9559 s(n,m) := s(n-1,m-1) - (n-1) s(n-1,m) :: n >= m :: m >= 1 ]
9560 C-c C-c
9561 @end smallexample
9562
9563 Now, it's just a matter of applying the rules:
9564
9565 @smallexample
9566 @group
9567 2: 4 1: s(4, 2) 1: 11
9568 1: 2 . .
9569 .
9570
9571 4 @key{RET} 2 C-x ( ' s($$,$) @key{RET} a r StirlingRules @key{RET} C-x )
9572 @end group
9573 @end smallexample
9574
9575 As in the case of the @code{fib} rules, it would be useful to put these
9576 rules in @code{EvalRules} and to add a @samp{:: remember} condition to
9577 the last rule.
9578
9579 @c This ends the table-of-contents kludge from above:
9580 @tex
9581 \global\let\chapternofonts=\oldchapternofonts
9582 @end tex
9583
9584 @c [reference]
9585
9586 @node Introduction, Data Types, Tutorial, Top
9587 @chapter Introduction
9588
9589 @noindent
9590 This chapter is the beginning of the Calc reference manual.
9591 It covers basic concepts such as the stack, algebraic and
9592 numeric entry, undo, numeric prefix arguments, etc.
9593
9594 @c [when-split]
9595 @c (Chapter 2, the Tutorial, has been printed in a separate volume.)
9596
9597 @menu
9598 * Basic Commands::
9599 * Help Commands::
9600 * Stack Basics::
9601 * Numeric Entry::
9602 * Algebraic Entry::
9603 * Quick Calculator::
9604 * Prefix Arguments::
9605 * Undo::
9606 * Error Messages::
9607 * Multiple Calculators::
9608 * Troubleshooting Commands::
9609 @end menu
9610
9611 @node Basic Commands, Help Commands, Introduction, Introduction
9612 @section Basic Commands
9613
9614 @noindent
9615 @pindex calc
9616 @pindex calc-mode
9617 @cindex Starting the Calculator
9618 @cindex Running the Calculator
9619 To start the Calculator in its standard interface, type @kbd{M-x calc}.
9620 By default this creates a pair of small windows, @file{*Calculator*}
9621 and @file{*Calc Trail*}. The former displays the contents of the
9622 Calculator stack and is manipulated exclusively through Calc commands.
9623 It is possible (though not usually necessary) to create several Calc
9624 mode buffers each of which has an independent stack, undo list, and
9625 mode settings. There is exactly one Calc Trail buffer; it records a
9626 list of the results of all calculations that have been done. The
9627 Calc Trail buffer uses a variant of Calc mode, so Calculator commands
9628 still work when the trail buffer's window is selected. It is possible
9629 to turn the trail window off, but the @file{*Calc Trail*} buffer itself
9630 still exists and is updated silently. @xref{Trail Commands}.
9631
9632 @kindex C-x * c
9633 @kindex C-x * *
9634 @ignore
9635 @mindex @null
9636 @end ignore
9637 In most installations, the @kbd{C-x * c} key sequence is a more
9638 convenient way to start the Calculator. Also, @kbd{C-x * *}
9639 is a synonym for @kbd{C-x * c} unless you last used Calc
9640 in its Keypad mode.
9641
9642 @kindex x
9643 @kindex M-x
9644 @pindex calc-execute-extended-command
9645 Most Calc commands use one or two keystrokes. Lower- and upper-case
9646 letters are distinct. Commands may also be entered in full @kbd{M-x} form;
9647 for some commands this is the only form. As a convenience, the @kbd{x}
9648 key (@code{calc-execute-extended-command})
9649 is like @kbd{M-x} except that it enters the initial string @samp{calc-}
9650 for you. For example, the following key sequences are equivalent:
9651 @kbd{S}, @kbd{M-x calc-sin @key{RET}}, @kbd{x sin @key{RET}}.
9652
9653 Although Calc is designed to be used from the keyboard, some of
9654 Calc's more common commands are available from a menu. In the menu, the
9655 arguments to the functions are given by referring to their stack level
9656 numbers.
9657
9658 @cindex Extensions module
9659 @cindex @file{calc-ext} module
9660 The Calculator exists in many parts. When you type @kbd{C-x * c}, the
9661 Emacs ``auto-load'' mechanism will bring in only the first part, which
9662 contains the basic arithmetic functions. The other parts will be
9663 auto-loaded the first time you use the more advanced commands like trig
9664 functions or matrix operations. This is done to improve the response time
9665 of the Calculator in the common case when all you need to do is a
9666 little arithmetic. If for some reason the Calculator fails to load an
9667 extension module automatically, you can force it to load all the
9668 extensions by using the @kbd{C-x * L} (@code{calc-load-everything})
9669 command. @xref{Mode Settings}.
9670
9671 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} or @kbd{C-x * c} with any numeric prefix argument,
9672 the Calculator is loaded if necessary, but it is not actually started.
9673 If the argument is positive, the @file{calc-ext} extensions are also
9674 loaded if necessary. User-written Lisp code that wishes to make use
9675 of Calc's arithmetic routines can use @samp{(calc 0)} or @samp{(calc 1)}
9676 to auto-load the Calculator.
9677
9678 @kindex C-x * b
9679 @pindex full-calc
9680 If you type @kbd{C-x * b}, then next time you use @kbd{C-x * c} you
9681 will get a Calculator that uses the full height of the Emacs screen.
9682 When full-screen mode is on, @kbd{C-x * c} runs the @code{full-calc}
9683 command instead of @code{calc}. From the Unix shell you can type
9684 @samp{emacs -f full-calc} to start a new Emacs specifically for use
9685 as a calculator. When Calc is started from the Emacs command line
9686 like this, Calc's normal ``quit'' commands actually quit Emacs itself.
9687
9688 @kindex C-x * o
9689 @pindex calc-other-window
9690 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is like @kbd{C-x * c} except that the Calc
9691 window is not actually selected. If you are already in the Calc
9692 window, @kbd{C-x * o} switches you out of it. (The regular Emacs
9693 @kbd{C-x o} command would also work for this, but it has a
9694 tendency to drop you into the Calc Trail window instead, which
9695 @kbd{C-x * o} takes care not to do.)
9696
9697 @ignore
9698 @mindex C-x * q
9699 @end ignore
9700 For one quick calculation, you can type @kbd{C-x * q} (@code{quick-calc})
9701 which prompts you for a formula (like @samp{2+3/4}). The result is
9702 displayed at the bottom of the Emacs screen without ever creating
9703 any special Calculator windows. @xref{Quick Calculator}.
9704
9705 @ignore
9706 @mindex C-x * k
9707 @end ignore
9708 Finally, if you are using the X window system you may want to try
9709 @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) which runs Calc with a
9710 ``calculator keypad'' picture as well as a stack display. Click on
9711 the keys with the mouse to operate the calculator. @xref{Keypad Mode}.
9712
9713 @kindex q
9714 @pindex calc-quit
9715 @cindex Quitting the Calculator
9716 @cindex Exiting the Calculator
9717 The @kbd{q} key (@code{calc-quit}) exits Calc mode and closes the
9718 Calculator's window(s). It does not delete the Calculator buffers.
9719 If you type @kbd{M-x calc} again, the Calculator will reappear with the
9720 contents of the stack intact. Typing @kbd{C-x * c} or @kbd{C-x * *}
9721 again from inside the Calculator buffer is equivalent to executing
9722 @code{calc-quit}; you can think of @kbd{C-x * *} as toggling the
9723 Calculator on and off.
9724
9725 @kindex C-x * x
9726 The @kbd{C-x * x} command also turns the Calculator off, no matter which
9727 user interface (standard, Keypad, or Embedded) is currently active.
9728 It also cancels @code{calc-edit} mode if used from there.
9729
9730 @kindex d @key{SPC}
9731 @pindex calc-refresh
9732 @cindex Refreshing a garbled display
9733 @cindex Garbled displays, refreshing
9734 The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} key sequence (@code{calc-refresh}) redraws the contents
9735 of the Calculator buffer from memory. Use this if the contents of the
9736 buffer have been damaged somehow.
9737
9738 @ignore
9739 @mindex o
9740 @end ignore
9741 The @kbd{o} key (@code{calc-realign}) moves the cursor back to its
9742 ``home'' position at the bottom of the Calculator buffer.
9743
9744 @kindex <
9745 @kindex >
9746 @pindex calc-scroll-left
9747 @pindex calc-scroll-right
9748 @cindex Horizontal scrolling
9749 @cindex Scrolling
9750 @cindex Wide text, scrolling
9751 The @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-left} and
9752 @code{calc-scroll-right}. These are just like the normal horizontal
9753 scrolling commands except that they scroll one half-screen at a time by
9754 default. (Calc formats its output to fit within the bounds of the
9755 window whenever it can.)
9756
9757 @kindex @{
9758 @kindex @}
9759 @pindex calc-scroll-down
9760 @pindex calc-scroll-up
9761 @cindex Vertical scrolling
9762 The @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} keys are bound to @code{calc-scroll-down}
9763 and @code{calc-scroll-up}. They scroll up or down by one-half the
9764 height of the Calc window.
9765
9766 @kindex C-x * 0
9767 @pindex calc-reset
9768 The @kbd{C-x * 0} command (@code{calc-reset}; that's @kbd{C-x *} followed
9769 by a zero) resets the Calculator to its initial state. This clears
9770 the stack, resets all the modes to their initial values (the values
9771 that were saved with @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})), clears the
9772 caches (@pxref{Caches}), and so on. (It does @emph{not} erase the
9773 values of any variables.) With an argument of 0, Calc will be reset to
9774 its default state; namely, the modes will be given their default values.
9775 With a positive prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of
9776 the stack but resets everything else to its initial state; with a
9777 negative prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * 0} preserves the contents of the
9778 stack but resets everything else to its default state.
9779
9780 @node Help Commands, Stack Basics, Basic Commands, Introduction
9781 @section Help Commands
9782
9783 @noindent
9784 @cindex Help commands
9785 @kindex ?
9786 @kindex a ?
9787 @kindex b ?
9788 @kindex c ?
9789 @kindex d ?
9790 @kindex f ?
9791 @kindex g ?
9792 @kindex j ?
9793 @kindex k ?
9794 @kindex m ?
9795 @kindex r ?
9796 @kindex s ?
9797 @kindex t ?
9798 @kindex u ?
9799 @kindex v ?
9800 @kindex V ?
9801 @kindex z ?
9802 @kindex Z ?
9803 @pindex calc-help
9804 The @kbd{?} key (@code{calc-help}) displays a series of brief help messages.
9805 Some keys (such as @kbd{b} and @kbd{d}) are prefix keys, like Emacs's
9806 @key{ESC} and @kbd{C-x} prefixes. You can type
9807 @kbd{?} after a prefix to see a list of commands beginning with that
9808 prefix. (If the message includes @samp{[MORE]}, press @kbd{?} again
9809 to see additional commands for that prefix.)
9810
9811 @kindex h h
9812 @pindex calc-full-help
9813 The @kbd{h h} (@code{calc-full-help}) command displays all the @kbd{?}
9814 responses at once. When printed, this makes a nice, compact (three pages)
9815 summary of Calc keystrokes.
9816
9817 In general, the @kbd{h} key prefix introduces various commands that
9818 provide help within Calc. Many of the @kbd{h} key functions are
9819 Calc-specific analogues to the @kbd{C-h} functions for Emacs help.
9820
9821 @kindex h i
9822 @kindex C-x * i
9823 @kindex i
9824 @pindex calc-info
9825 The @kbd{h i} (@code{calc-info}) command runs the Emacs Info system
9826 to read this manual on-line. This is basically the same as typing
9827 @kbd{C-h i} (the regular way to run the Info system), then, if Info
9828 is not already in the Calc manual, selecting the beginning of the
9829 manual. The @kbd{C-x * i} command is another way to read the Calc
9830 manual; it is different from @kbd{h i} in that it works any time,
9831 not just inside Calc. The plain @kbd{i} key is also equivalent to
9832 @kbd{h i}, though this key is obsolete and may be replaced with a
9833 different command in a future version of Calc.
9834
9835 @kindex h t
9836 @kindex C-x * t
9837 @pindex calc-tutorial
9838 The @kbd{h t} (@code{calc-tutorial}) command runs the Info system on
9839 the Tutorial section of the Calc manual. It is like @kbd{h i},
9840 except that it selects the starting node of the tutorial rather
9841 than the beginning of the whole manual. (It actually selects the
9842 node ``Interactive Tutorial'' which tells a few things about
9843 using the Info system before going on to the actual tutorial.)
9844 The @kbd{C-x * t} key is equivalent to @kbd{h t} (but it works at
9845 all times).
9846
9847 @kindex h s
9848 @kindex C-x * s
9849 @pindex calc-info-summary
9850 The @kbd{h s} (@code{calc-info-summary}) command runs the Info system
9851 on the Summary node of the Calc manual. @xref{Summary}. The @kbd{C-x * s}
9852 key is equivalent to @kbd{h s}.
9853
9854 @kindex h k
9855 @pindex calc-describe-key
9856 The @kbd{h k} (@code{calc-describe-key}) command looks up a key
9857 sequence in the Calc manual. For example, @kbd{h k H a S} looks
9858 up the documentation on the @kbd{H a S} (@code{calc-solve-for})
9859 command. This works by looking up the textual description of
9860 the key(s) in the Key Index of the manual, then jumping to the
9861 node indicated by the index.
9862
9863 Most Calc commands do not have traditional Emacs documentation
9864 strings, since the @kbd{h k} command is both more convenient and
9865 more instructive. This means the regular Emacs @kbd{C-h k}
9866 (@code{describe-key}) command will not be useful for Calc keystrokes.
9867
9868 @kindex h c
9869 @pindex calc-describe-key-briefly
9870 The @kbd{h c} (@code{calc-describe-key-briefly}) command reads a
9871 key sequence and displays a brief one-line description of it at
9872 the bottom of the screen. It looks for the key sequence in the
9873 Summary node of the Calc manual; if it doesn't find the sequence
9874 there, it acts just like its regular Emacs counterpart @kbd{C-h c}
9875 (@code{describe-key-briefly}). For example, @kbd{h c H a S}
9876 gives the description:
9877
9878 @smallexample
9879 H a S runs calc-solve-for: a `H a S' v => fsolve(a,v) (?=notes)
9880 @end smallexample
9881
9882 @noindent
9883 which means the command @kbd{H a S} or @kbd{H M-x calc-solve-for}
9884 takes a value @expr{a} from the stack, prompts for a value @expr{v},
9885 then applies the algebraic function @code{fsolve} to these values.
9886 The @samp{?=notes} message means you can now type @kbd{?} to see
9887 additional notes from the summary that apply to this command.
9888
9889 @kindex h f
9890 @pindex calc-describe-function
9891 The @kbd{h f} (@code{calc-describe-function}) command looks up an
9892 algebraic function or a command name in the Calc manual. Enter an
9893 algebraic function name to look up that function in the Function
9894 Index or enter a command name beginning with @samp{calc-} to look it
9895 up in the Command Index. This command will also look up operator
9896 symbols that can appear in algebraic formulas, like @samp{%} and
9897 @samp{=>}.
9898
9899 @kindex h v
9900 @pindex calc-describe-variable
9901 The @kbd{h v} (@code{calc-describe-variable}) command looks up a
9902 variable in the Calc manual. Enter a variable name like @code{pi} or
9903 @code{PlotRejects}.
9904
9905 @kindex h b
9906 @pindex describe-bindings
9907 The @kbd{h b} (@code{calc-describe-bindings}) command is just like
9908 @kbd{C-h b}, except that only local (Calc-related) key bindings are
9909 listed.
9910
9911 @kindex h n
9912 The @kbd{h n} or @kbd{h C-n} (@code{calc-view-news}) command displays
9913 the ``news'' or change history of Emacs, and jumps to the most recent
9914 portion concerning Calc (if present). For older history, see the file
9915 @file{etc/CALC-NEWS} in the Emacs distribution.
9916
9917 @kindex h C-c
9918 @kindex h C-d
9919 @kindex h C-w
9920 The @kbd{h C-c}, @kbd{h C-d}, and @kbd{h C-w} keys display copying,
9921 distribution, and warranty information about Calc. These work by
9922 pulling up the appropriate parts of the ``Copying'' or ``Reporting
9923 Bugs'' sections of the manual.
9924
9925 @node Stack Basics, Numeric Entry, Help Commands, Introduction
9926 @section Stack Basics
9927
9928 @noindent
9929 @cindex Stack basics
9930 @c [fix-tut RPN Calculations and the Stack]
9931 Calc uses RPN notation. If you are not familiar with RPN, @pxref{RPN
9932 Tutorial}.
9933
9934 To add the numbers 1 and 2 in Calc you would type the keys:
9935 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 +}.
9936 (@key{RET} corresponds to the @key{ENTER} key on most calculators.)
9937 The first three keystrokes ``push'' the numbers 1 and 2 onto the stack. The
9938 @kbd{+} key always ``pops'' the top two numbers from the stack, adds them,
9939 and pushes the result (3) back onto the stack. This number is ready for
9940 further calculations: @kbd{5 -} pushes 5 onto the stack, then pops the
9941 3 and 5, subtracts them, and pushes the result (@mathit{-2}).
9942
9943 Note that the ``top'' of the stack actually appears at the @emph{bottom}
9944 of the buffer. A line containing a single @samp{.} character signifies
9945 the end of the buffer; Calculator commands operate on the number(s)
9946 directly above this line. The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack})
9947 command allows you to move the @samp{.} marker up and down in the stack;
9948 @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
9949
9950 @kindex d l
9951 @pindex calc-line-numbering
9952 Stack elements are numbered consecutively, with number 1 being the top of
9953 the stack. These line numbers are ordinarily displayed on the lefthand side
9954 of the window. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) command controls
9955 whether these numbers appear. (Line numbers may be turned off since they
9956 slow the Calculator down a bit and also clutter the display.)
9957
9958 @kindex o
9959 @pindex calc-realign
9960 The unshifted letter @kbd{o} (@code{calc-realign}) command repositions
9961 the cursor to its top-of-stack ``home'' position. It also undoes any
9962 horizontal scrolling in the window. If you give it a numeric prefix
9963 argument, it instead moves the cursor to the specified stack element.
9964
9965 The @key{RET} (or equivalent @key{SPC}) key is only required to separate
9966 two consecutive numbers.
9967 (After all, if you typed @kbd{1 2} by themselves the Calculator
9968 would enter the number 12.) If you press @key{RET} or @key{SPC} @emph{not}
9969 right after typing a number, the key duplicates the number on the top of
9970 the stack. @kbd{@key{RET} *} is thus a handy way to square a number.
9971
9972 The @key{DEL} key pops and throws away the top number on the stack.
9973 The @key{TAB} key swaps the top two objects on the stack.
9974 @xref{Stack and Trail}, for descriptions of these and other stack-related
9975 commands.
9976
9977 @node Numeric Entry, Algebraic Entry, Stack Basics, Introduction
9978 @section Numeric Entry
9979
9980 @noindent
9981 @kindex 0-9
9982 @kindex .
9983 @kindex e
9984 @cindex Numeric entry
9985 @cindex Entering numbers
9986 Pressing a digit or other numeric key begins numeric entry using the
9987 minibuffer. The number is pushed on the stack when you press the @key{RET}
9988 or @key{SPC} keys. If you press any other non-numeric key, the number is
9989 pushed onto the stack and the appropriate operation is performed. If
9990 you press a numeric key which is not valid, the key is ignored.
9991
9992 @cindex Minus signs
9993 @cindex Negative numbers, entering
9994 @kindex _
9995 There are three different concepts corresponding to the word ``minus,''
9996 typified by @expr{a-b} (subtraction), @expr{-x}
9997 (change-sign), and @expr{-5} (negative number). Calc uses three
9998 different keys for these operations, respectively:
9999 @kbd{-}, @kbd{n}, and @kbd{_} (the underscore). The @kbd{-} key subtracts
10000 the two numbers on the top of the stack. The @kbd{n} key changes the sign
10001 of the number on the top of the stack or the number currently being entered.
10002 The @kbd{_} key begins entry of a negative number or changes the sign of
10003 the number currently being entered. The following sequences all enter the
10004 number @mathit{-5} onto the stack: @kbd{0 @key{RET} 5 -}, @kbd{5 n @key{RET}},
10005 @kbd{5 @key{RET} n}, @kbd{_ 5 @key{RET}}, @kbd{5 _ @key{RET}}.
10006
10007 Some other keys are active during numeric entry, such as @kbd{#} for
10008 non-decimal numbers, @kbd{:} for fractions, and @kbd{@@} for HMS forms.
10009 These notations are described later in this manual with the corresponding
10010 data types. @xref{Data Types}.
10011
10012 During numeric entry, the only editing key available is @key{DEL}.
10013
10014 @node Algebraic Entry, Quick Calculator, Numeric Entry, Introduction
10015 @section Algebraic Entry
10016
10017 @noindent
10018 @kindex '
10019 @pindex calc-algebraic-entry
10020 @cindex Algebraic notation
10021 @cindex Formulas, entering
10022 The @kbd{'} (@code{calc-algebraic-entry}) command can be used to enter
10023 calculations in algebraic form. This is accomplished by typing the
10024 apostrophe key, ', followed by the expression in standard format:
10025
10026 @example
10027 ' 2+3*4 @key{RET}.
10028 @end example
10029
10030 @noindent
10031 This will compute
10032 @texline @math{2+(3\times4) = 14}
10033 @infoline @expr{2+(3*4) = 14}
10034 and push it on the stack. If you wish you can
10035 ignore the RPN aspect of Calc altogether and simply enter algebraic
10036 expressions in this way. You may want to use @key{DEL} every so often to
10037 clear previous results off the stack.
10038
10039 You can press the apostrophe key during normal numeric entry to switch
10040 the half-entered number into Algebraic entry mode. One reason to do
10041 this would be to fix a typo, as the full Emacs cursor motion and editing
10042 keys are available during algebraic entry but not during numeric entry.
10043
10044 In the same vein, during either numeric or algebraic entry you can
10045 press @kbd{`} (backquote) to switch to @code{calc-edit} mode, where
10046 you complete your half-finished entry in a separate buffer.
10047 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}.
10048
10049 @kindex m a
10050 @pindex calc-algebraic-mode
10051 @cindex Algebraic Mode
10052 If you prefer algebraic entry, you can use the command @kbd{m a}
10053 (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) to set Algebraic mode. In this mode,
10054 digits and other keys that would normally start numeric entry instead
10055 start full algebraic entry; as long as your formula begins with a digit
10056 you can omit the apostrophe. Open parentheses and square brackets also
10057 begin algebraic entry. You can still do RPN calculations in this mode,
10058 but you will have to press @key{RET} to terminate every number:
10059 @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} * 4 @key{RET} +} would accomplish the same
10060 thing as @kbd{2*3+4 @key{RET}}.
10061
10062 @cindex Incomplete Algebraic Mode
10063 If you give a numeric prefix argument like @kbd{C-u} to the @kbd{m a}
10064 command, it enables Incomplete Algebraic mode; this is like regular
10065 Algebraic mode except that it applies to the @kbd{(} and @kbd{[} keys
10066 only. Numeric keys still begin a numeric entry in this mode.
10067
10068 @kindex m t
10069 @pindex calc-total-algebraic-mode
10070 @cindex Total Algebraic Mode
10071 The @kbd{m t} (@code{calc-total-algebraic-mode}) gives you an even
10072 stronger algebraic-entry mode, in which @emph{all} regular letter and
10073 punctuation keys begin algebraic entry. Use this if you prefer typing
10074 @w{@kbd{sqrt( )}} instead of @kbd{Q}, @w{@kbd{factor( )}} instead of
10075 @kbd{a f}, and so on. To type regular Calc commands when you are in
10076 Total Algebraic mode, hold down the @key{META} key. Thus @kbd{M-q}
10077 is the command to quit Calc, @kbd{M-p} sets the precision, and
10078 @kbd{M-m t} (or @kbd{M-m M-t}, if you prefer) turns Total Algebraic
10079 mode back off again. Meta keys also terminate algebraic entry, so
10080 that @kbd{2+3 M-S} is equivalent to @kbd{2+3 @key{RET} M-S}. The symbol
10081 @samp{Alg*} will appear in the mode line whenever you are in this mode.
10082
10083 Pressing @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) a second time re-enters the previous
10084 algebraic formula. You can then use the normal Emacs editing keys to
10085 modify this formula to your liking before pressing @key{RET}.
10086
10087 @kindex $
10088 @cindex Formulas, referring to stack
10089 Within a formula entered from the keyboard, the symbol @kbd{$}
10090 represents the number on the top of the stack. If an entered formula
10091 contains any @kbd{$} characters, the Calculator replaces the top of
10092 stack with that formula rather than simply pushing the formula onto the
10093 stack. Thus, @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3 on the stack, and @kbd{$*2
10094 @key{RET}} replaces it with 6. Note that the @kbd{$} key always
10095 initiates algebraic entry; the @kbd{'} is unnecessary if @kbd{$} is the
10096 first character in the new formula.
10097
10098 Higher stack elements can be accessed from an entered formula with the
10099 symbols @kbd{$$}, @kbd{$$$}, and so on. The number of stack elements
10100 removed (to be replaced by the entered values) equals the number of dollar
10101 signs in the longest such symbol in the formula. For example, @samp{$$+$$$}
10102 adds the second and third stack elements, replacing the top three elements
10103 with the answer. (All information about the top stack element is thus lost
10104 since no single @samp{$} appears in this formula.)
10105
10106 A slightly different way to refer to stack elements is with a dollar
10107 sign followed by a number: @samp{$1}, @samp{$2}, and so on are much
10108 like @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, etc., except that stack entries referred
10109 to numerically are not replaced by the algebraic entry. That is, while
10110 @samp{$+1} replaces 5 on the stack with 6, @samp{$1+1} leaves the 5
10111 on the stack and pushes an additional 6.
10112
10113 If a sequence of formulas are entered separated by commas, each formula
10114 is pushed onto the stack in turn. For example, @samp{1,2,3} pushes
10115 those three numbers onto the stack (leaving the 3 at the top), and
10116 @samp{$+1,$-1} replaces a 5 on the stack with 4 followed by 6. Also,
10117 @samp{$,$$} exchanges the top two elements of the stack, just like the
10118 @key{TAB} key.
10119
10120 You can finish an algebraic entry with @kbd{M-=} or @kbd{M-@key{RET}} instead
10121 of @key{RET}. This uses @kbd{=} to evaluate the variables in each
10122 formula that goes onto the stack. (Thus @kbd{' pi @key{RET}} pushes
10123 the variable @samp{pi}, but @kbd{' pi M-@key{RET}} pushes 3.1415.)
10124
10125 If you finish your algebraic entry by pressing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j})
10126 instead of @key{RET}, Calc disables simplification
10127 (as if by @kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}) while the entry
10128 is being pushed on the stack. Thus @kbd{' 1+2 @key{RET}} pushes 3
10129 on the stack, but @kbd{' 1+2 @key{LFD}} pushes the formula @expr{1+2};
10130 you might then press @kbd{=} when it is time to evaluate this formula.
10131
10132 @node Quick Calculator, Prefix Arguments, Algebraic Entry, Introduction
10133 @section ``Quick Calculator'' Mode
10134
10135 @noindent
10136 @kindex C-x * q
10137 @pindex quick-calc
10138 @cindex Quick Calculator
10139 There is another way to invoke the Calculator if all you need to do
10140 is make one or two quick calculations. Type @kbd{C-x * q} (or
10141 @kbd{M-x quick-calc}), then type any formula as an algebraic entry.
10142 The Calculator will compute the result and display it in the echo
10143 area, without ever actually putting up a Calc window.
10144
10145 You can use the @kbd{$} character in a Quick Calculator formula to
10146 refer to the previous Quick Calculator result. Older results are
10147 not retained; the Quick Calculator has no effect on the full
10148 Calculator's stack or trail. If you compute a result and then
10149 forget what it was, just run @code{C-x * q} again and enter
10150 @samp{$} as the formula.
10151
10152 If this is the first time you have used the Calculator in this Emacs
10153 session, the @kbd{C-x * q} command will create the @file{*Calculator*}
10154 buffer and perform all the usual initializations; it simply will
10155 refrain from putting that buffer up in a new window. The Quick
10156 Calculator refers to the @file{*Calculator*} buffer for all mode
10157 settings. Thus, for example, to set the precision that the Quick
10158 Calculator uses, simply run the full Calculator momentarily and use
10159 the regular @kbd{p} command.
10160
10161 If you use @code{C-x * q} from inside the Calculator buffer, the
10162 effect is the same as pressing the apostrophe key (algebraic entry).
10163
10164 The result of a Quick calculation is placed in the Emacs ``kill ring''
10165 as well as being displayed. A subsequent @kbd{C-y} command will
10166 yank the result into the editing buffer. You can also use this
10167 to yank the result into the next @kbd{C-x * q} input line as a more
10168 explicit alternative to @kbd{$} notation, or to yank the result
10169 into the Calculator stack after typing @kbd{C-x * c}.
10170
10171 If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-x * q} or finish your formula
10172 by typing @key{LFD} (or @kbd{C-j}) instead of @key{RET}, the result is
10173 inserted immediately into the current buffer rather than going into
10174 the kill ring.
10175
10176 Quick Calculator results are actually evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
10177 key (which replaces variable names by their stored values, if any).
10178 If the formula you enter is an assignment to a variable using the
10179 @samp{:=} operator, say, @samp{foo := 2 + 3} or @samp{foo := foo + 1},
10180 then the result of the evaluation is stored in that Calc variable.
10181 @xref{Store and Recall}.
10182
10183 If the result is an integer and the current display radix is decimal,
10184 the number will also be displayed in hex, octal and binary formats. If
10185 the integer is in the range from 1 to 126, it will also be displayed as
10186 an ASCII character.
10187
10188 For example, the quoted character @samp{"x"} produces the vector
10189 result @samp{[120]} (because 120 is the ASCII code of the lower-case
10190 `x'; @pxref{Strings}). Since this is a vector, not an integer, it
10191 is displayed only according to the current mode settings. But
10192 running Quick Calc again and entering @samp{120} will produce the
10193 result @samp{120 (16#78, 8#170, x)} which shows the number in its
10194 decimal, hexadecimal, octal, and ASCII forms.
10195
10196 Please note that the Quick Calculator is not any faster at loading
10197 or computing the answer than the full Calculator; the name ``quick''
10198 merely refers to the fact that it's much less hassle to use for
10199 small calculations.
10200
10201 @node Prefix Arguments, Undo, Quick Calculator, Introduction
10202 @section Numeric Prefix Arguments
10203
10204 @noindent
10205 Many Calculator commands use numeric prefix arguments. Some, such as
10206 @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}), set a parameter to the value of
10207 the prefix argument or use a default if you don't use a prefix.
10208 Others (like @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation})) require an argument
10209 and prompt for a number if you don't give one as a prefix.
10210
10211 As a rule, stack-manipulation commands accept a numeric prefix argument
10212 which is interpreted as an index into the stack. A positive argument
10213 operates on the top @var{n} stack entries; a negative argument operates
10214 on the @var{n}th stack entry in isolation; and a zero argument operates
10215 on the entire stack.
10216
10217 Most commands that perform computations (such as the arithmetic and
10218 scientific functions) accept a numeric prefix argument that allows the
10219 operation to be applied across many stack elements. For unary operations
10220 (that is, functions of one argument like absolute value or complex
10221 conjugate), a positive prefix argument applies that function to the top
10222 @var{n} stack entries simultaneously, and a negative argument applies it
10223 to the @var{n}th stack entry only. For binary operations (functions of
10224 two arguments like addition, GCD, and vector concatenation), a positive
10225 prefix argument ``reduces'' the function across the top @var{n}
10226 stack elements (for example, @kbd{C-u 5 +} sums the top 5 stack entries;
10227 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}), and a negative argument maps the next-to-top
10228 @var{n} stack elements with the top stack element as a second argument
10229 (for example, @kbd{7 c-u -5 +} adds 7 to the top 5 stack elements).
10230 This feature is not available for operations which use the numeric prefix
10231 argument for some other purpose.
10232
10233 Numeric prefixes are specified the same way as always in Emacs: Press
10234 a sequence of @key{META}-digits, or press @key{ESC} followed by digits,
10235 or press @kbd{C-u} followed by digits. Some commands treat plain
10236 @kbd{C-u} (without any actual digits) specially.
10237
10238 @kindex ~
10239 @pindex calc-num-prefix
10240 You can type @kbd{~} (@code{calc-num-prefix}) to pop an integer from the
10241 top of the stack and enter it as the numeric prefix for the next command.
10242 For example, @kbd{C-u 16 p} sets the precision to 16 digits; an alternate
10243 (silly) way to do this would be @kbd{2 @key{RET} 4 ^ ~ p}, i.e., compute 2
10244 to the fourth power and set the precision to that value.
10245
10246 Conversely, if you have typed a numeric prefix argument the @kbd{~} key
10247 pushes it onto the stack in the form of an integer.
10248
10249 @node Undo, Error Messages, Prefix Arguments, Introduction
10250 @section Undoing Mistakes
10251
10252 @noindent
10253 @kindex U
10254 @kindex C-_
10255 @pindex calc-undo
10256 @cindex Mistakes, undoing
10257 @cindex Undoing mistakes
10258 @cindex Errors, undoing
10259 The shift-@kbd{U} key (@code{calc-undo}) undoes the most recent operation.
10260 If that operation added or dropped objects from the stack, those objects
10261 are removed or restored. If it was a ``store'' operation, you are
10262 queried whether or not to restore the variable to its original value.
10263 The @kbd{U} key may be pressed any number of times to undo successively
10264 farther back in time; with a numeric prefix argument it undoes a
10265 specified number of operations. When the Calculator is quit, as with
10266 the @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command, the undo history will be
10267 truncated to the length of the customizable variable
10268 @code{calc-undo-length} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), which by default
10269 is @expr{100}. (Recall that @kbd{C-x * c} is synonymous with
10270 @code{calc-quit} while inside the Calculator; this also truncates the
10271 undo history.)
10272
10273 Currently the mode-setting commands (like @code{calc-precision}) are not
10274 undoable. You can undo past a point where you changed a mode, but you
10275 will need to reset the mode yourself.
10276
10277 @kindex D
10278 @pindex calc-redo
10279 @cindex Redoing after an Undo
10280 The shift-@kbd{D} key (@code{calc-redo}) redoes an operation that was
10281 mistakenly undone. Pressing @kbd{U} with a negative prefix argument is
10282 equivalent to executing @code{calc-redo}. You can redo any number of
10283 times, up to the number of recent consecutive undo commands. Redo
10284 information is cleared whenever you give any command that adds new undo
10285 information, i.e., if you undo, then enter a number on the stack or make
10286 any other change, then it will be too late to redo.
10287
10288 @kindex M-@key{RET}
10289 @pindex calc-last-args
10290 @cindex Last-arguments feature
10291 @cindex Arguments, restoring
10292 The @kbd{M-@key{RET}} key (@code{calc-last-args}) is like undo in that
10293 it restores the arguments of the most recent command onto the stack;
10294 however, it does not remove the result of that command. Given a numeric
10295 prefix argument, this command applies to the @expr{n}th most recent
10296 command which removed items from the stack; it pushes those items back
10297 onto the stack.
10298
10299 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command provides a related function
10300 to @kbd{M-@key{RET}}. @xref{Stack and Trail}.
10301
10302 It is also possible to recall previous results or inputs using the trail.
10303 @xref{Trail Commands}.
10304
10305 The standard Emacs @kbd{C-_} undo key is recognized as a synonym for @kbd{U}.
10306
10307 @node Error Messages, Multiple Calculators, Undo, Introduction
10308 @section Error Messages
10309
10310 @noindent
10311 @kindex w
10312 @pindex calc-why
10313 @cindex Errors, messages
10314 @cindex Why did an error occur?
10315 Many situations that would produce an error message in other calculators
10316 simply create unsimplified formulas in the Emacs Calculator. For example,
10317 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 0 /} pushes the formula @expr{1 / 0}; @w{@kbd{0 L}} pushes
10318 the formula @samp{ln(0)}. Floating-point overflow and underflow are also
10319 reasons for this to happen.
10320
10321 When a function call must be left in symbolic form, Calc usually
10322 produces a message explaining why. Messages that are probably
10323 surprising or indicative of user errors are displayed automatically.
10324 Other messages are simply kept in Calc's memory and are displayed only
10325 if you type @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why}). You can also press @kbd{w} if
10326 the same computation results in several messages. (The first message
10327 will end with @samp{[w=more]} in this case.)
10328
10329 @kindex d w
10330 @pindex calc-auto-why
10331 The @kbd{d w} (@code{calc-auto-why}) command controls when error messages
10332 are displayed automatically. (Calc effectively presses @kbd{w} for you
10333 after your computation finishes.) By default, this occurs only for
10334 ``important'' messages. The other possible modes are to report
10335 @emph{all} messages automatically, or to report none automatically (so
10336 that you must always press @kbd{w} yourself to see the messages).
10337
10338 @node Multiple Calculators, Troubleshooting Commands, Error Messages, Introduction
10339 @section Multiple Calculators
10340
10341 @noindent
10342 @pindex another-calc
10343 It is possible to have any number of Calc mode buffers at once.
10344 Usually this is done by executing @kbd{M-x another-calc}, which
10345 is similar to @kbd{C-x * c} except that if a @file{*Calculator*}
10346 buffer already exists, a new, independent one with a name of the
10347 form @file{*Calculator*<@var{n}>} is created. You can also use the
10348 command @code{calc-mode} to put any buffer into Calculator mode, but
10349 this would ordinarily never be done.
10350
10351 The @kbd{q} (@code{calc-quit}) command does not destroy a Calculator buffer;
10352 it only closes its window. Use @kbd{M-x kill-buffer} to destroy a
10353 Calculator buffer.
10354
10355 Each Calculator buffer keeps its own stack, undo list, and mode settings
10356 such as precision, angular mode, and display formats. In Emacs terms,
10357 variables such as @code{calc-stack} are buffer-local variables. The
10358 global default values of these variables are used only when a new
10359 Calculator buffer is created. The @code{calc-quit} command saves
10360 the stack and mode settings of the buffer being quit as the new defaults.
10361
10362 There is only one trail buffer, @file{*Calc Trail*}, used by all
10363 Calculator buffers.
10364
10365 @node Troubleshooting Commands, , Multiple Calculators, Introduction
10366 @section Troubleshooting Commands
10367
10368 @noindent
10369 This section describes commands you can use in case a computation
10370 incorrectly fails or gives the wrong answer.
10371
10372 @xref{Reporting Bugs}, if you find a problem that appears to be due
10373 to a bug or deficiency in Calc.
10374
10375 @menu
10376 * Autoloading Problems::
10377 * Recursion Depth::
10378 * Caches::
10379 * Debugging Calc::
10380 @end menu
10381
10382 @node Autoloading Problems, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands, Troubleshooting Commands
10383 @subsection Autoloading Problems
10384
10385 @noindent
10386 The Calc program is split into many component files; components are
10387 loaded automatically as you use various commands that require them.
10388 Occasionally Calc may lose track of when a certain component is
10389 necessary; typically this means you will type a command and it won't
10390 work because some function you've never heard of was undefined.
10391
10392 @kindex C-x * L
10393 @pindex calc-load-everything
10394 If this happens, the easiest workaround is to type @kbd{C-x * L}
10395 (@code{calc-load-everything}) to force all the parts of Calc to be
10396 loaded right away. This will cause Emacs to take up a lot more
10397 memory than it would otherwise, but it's guaranteed to fix the problem.
10398
10399 @node Recursion Depth, Caches, Autoloading Problems, Troubleshooting Commands
10400 @subsection Recursion Depth
10401
10402 @noindent
10403 @kindex M
10404 @kindex I M
10405 @pindex calc-more-recursion-depth
10406 @pindex calc-less-recursion-depth
10407 @cindex Recursion depth
10408 @cindex ``Computation got stuck'' message
10409 @cindex @code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10410 @cindex @code{max-specpdl-size}
10411 Calc uses recursion in many of its calculations. Emacs Lisp keeps a
10412 variable @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} which limits the amount of recursion
10413 possible in an attempt to recover from program bugs. If a calculation
10414 ever halts incorrectly with the message ``Computation got stuck or
10415 ran too long,'' use the @kbd{M} command (@code{calc-more-recursion-depth})
10416 to increase this limit. (Of course, this will not help if the
10417 calculation really did get stuck due to some problem inside Calc.)
10418
10419 The limit is always increased (multiplied) by a factor of two. There
10420 is also an @kbd{I M} (@code{calc-less-recursion-depth}) command which
10421 decreases this limit by a factor of two, down to a minimum value of 200.
10422 The default value is 1000.
10423
10424 These commands also double or halve @code{max-specpdl-size}, another
10425 internal Lisp recursion limit. The minimum value for this limit is 600.
10426
10427 @node Caches, Debugging Calc, Recursion Depth, Troubleshooting Commands
10428 @subsection Caches
10429
10430 @noindent
10431 @cindex Caches
10432 @cindex Flushing caches
10433 Calc saves certain values after they have been computed once. For
10434 example, the @kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}) command initially ``knows'' the
10435 constant @cpi{} to about 20 decimal places; if the current precision
10436 is greater than this, it will recompute @cpi{} using a series
10437 approximation. This value will not need to be recomputed ever again
10438 unless you raise the precision still further. Many operations such as
10439 logarithms and sines make use of similarly cached values such as
10440 @cpiover{4} and
10441 @texline @math{\ln 2}.
10442 @infoline @expr{ln(2)}.
10443 The visible effect of caching is that
10444 high-precision computations may seem to do extra work the first time.
10445 Other things cached include powers of two (for the binary arithmetic
10446 functions), matrix inverses and determinants, symbolic integrals, and
10447 data points computed by the graphing commands.
10448
10449 @pindex calc-flush-caches
10450 If you suspect a Calculator cache has become corrupt, you can use the
10451 @code{calc-flush-caches} command to reset all caches to the empty state.
10452 (This should only be necessary in the event of bugs in the Calculator.)
10453 The @kbd{C-x * 0} (with the zero key) command also resets caches along
10454 with all other aspects of the Calculator's state.
10455
10456 @node Debugging Calc, , Caches, Troubleshooting Commands
10457 @subsection Debugging Calc
10458
10459 @noindent
10460 A few commands exist to help in the debugging of Calc commands.
10461 @xref{Programming}, to see the various ways that you can write
10462 your own Calc commands.
10463
10464 @kindex Z T
10465 @pindex calc-timing
10466 The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing}) command turns on and off a mode
10467 in which the timing of slow commands is reported in the Trail.
10468 Any Calc command that takes two seconds or longer writes a line
10469 to the Trail showing how many seconds it took. This value is
10470 accurate only to within one second.
10471
10472 All steps of executing a command are included; in particular, time
10473 taken to format the result for display in the stack and trail is
10474 counted. Some prompts also count time taken waiting for them to
10475 be answered, while others do not; this depends on the exact
10476 implementation of the command. For best results, if you are timing
10477 a sequence that includes prompts or multiple commands, define a
10478 keyboard macro to run the whole sequence at once. Calc's @kbd{X}
10479 command (@pxref{Keyboard Macros}) will then report the time taken
10480 to execute the whole macro.
10481
10482 Another advantage of the @kbd{X} command is that while it is
10483 executing, the stack and trail are not updated from step to step.
10484 So if you expect the output of your test sequence to leave a result
10485 that may take a long time to format and you don't wish to count
10486 this formatting time, end your sequence with a @key{DEL} keystroke
10487 to clear the result from the stack. When you run the sequence with
10488 @kbd{X}, Calc will never bother to format the large result.
10489
10490 Another thing @kbd{Z T} does is to increase the Emacs variable
10491 @code{gc-cons-threshold} to a much higher value (two million; the
10492 usual default in Calc is 250,000) for the duration of each command.
10493 This generally prevents garbage collection during the timing of
10494 the command, though it may cause your Emacs process to grow
10495 abnormally large. (Garbage collection time is a major unpredictable
10496 factor in the timing of Emacs operations.)
10497
10498 Another command that is useful when debugging your own Lisp
10499 extensions to Calc is @kbd{M-x calc-pass-errors}, which disables
10500 the error handler that changes the ``@code{max-lisp-eval-depth}
10501 exceeded'' message to the much more friendly ``Computation got
10502 stuck or ran too long.'' This handler interferes with the Emacs
10503 Lisp debugger's @code{debug-on-error} mode. Errors are reported
10504 in the handler itself rather than at the true location of the
10505 error. After you have executed @code{calc-pass-errors}, Lisp
10506 errors will be reported correctly but the user-friendly message
10507 will be lost.
10508
10509 @node Data Types, Stack and Trail, Introduction, Top
10510 @chapter Data Types
10511
10512 @noindent
10513 This chapter discusses the various types of objects that can be placed
10514 on the Calculator stack, how they are displayed, and how they are
10515 entered. (@xref{Data Type Formats}, for information on how these data
10516 types are represented as underlying Lisp objects.)
10517
10518 Integers, fractions, and floats are various ways of describing real
10519 numbers. HMS forms also for many purposes act as real numbers. These
10520 types can be combined to form complex numbers, modulo forms, error forms,
10521 or interval forms. (But these last four types cannot be combined
10522 arbitrarily: error forms may not contain modulo forms, for example.)
10523 Finally, all these types of numbers may be combined into vectors,
10524 matrices, or algebraic formulas.
10525
10526 @menu
10527 * Integers:: The most basic data type.
10528 * Fractions:: This and above are called @dfn{rationals}.
10529 * Floats:: This and above are called @dfn{reals}.
10530 * Complex Numbers:: This and above are called @dfn{numbers}.
10531 * Infinities::
10532 * Vectors and Matrices::
10533 * Strings::
10534 * HMS Forms::
10535 * Date Forms::
10536 * Modulo Forms::
10537 * Error Forms::
10538 * Interval Forms::
10539 * Incomplete Objects::
10540 * Variables::
10541 * Formulas::
10542 @end menu
10543
10544 @node Integers, Fractions, Data Types, Data Types
10545 @section Integers
10546
10547 @noindent
10548 @cindex Integers
10549 The Calculator stores integers to arbitrary precision. Addition,
10550 subtraction, and multiplication of integers always yields an exact
10551 integer result. (If the result of a division or exponentiation of
10552 integers is not an integer, it is expressed in fractional or
10553 floating-point form according to the current Fraction mode.
10554 @xref{Fraction Mode}.)
10555
10556 A decimal integer is represented as an optional sign followed by a
10557 sequence of digits. Grouping (@pxref{Grouping Digits}) can be used to
10558 insert a comma at every third digit for display purposes, but you
10559 must not type commas during the entry of numbers.
10560
10561 @kindex #
10562 A non-decimal integer is represented as an optional sign, a radix
10563 between 2 and 36, a @samp{#} symbol, and one or more digits. For radix 11
10564 and above, the letters A through Z (upper- or lower-case) count as
10565 digits and do not terminate numeric entry mode. @xref{Radix Modes}, for how
10566 to set the default radix for display of integers. Numbers of any radix
10567 may be entered at any time. If you press @kbd{#} at the beginning of a
10568 number, the current display radix is used.
10569
10570 @node Fractions, Floats, Integers, Data Types
10571 @section Fractions
10572
10573 @noindent
10574 @cindex Fractions
10575 A @dfn{fraction} is a ratio of two integers. Fractions are traditionally
10576 written ``2/3'' but Calc uses the notation @samp{2:3}. (The @kbd{/} key
10577 performs RPN division; the following two sequences push the number
10578 @samp{2:3} on the stack: @kbd{2 :@: 3 @key{RET}}, or @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 /}
10579 assuming Fraction mode has been enabled.)
10580 When the Calculator produces a fractional result it always reduces it to
10581 simplest form, which may in fact be an integer.
10582
10583 Fractions may also be entered in a three-part form, where @samp{2:3:4}
10584 represents two-and-three-quarters. @xref{Fraction Formats}, for fraction
10585 display formats.
10586
10587 Non-decimal fractions are entered and displayed as
10588 @samp{@var{radix}#@var{num}:@var{denom}} (or in the analogous three-part
10589 form). The numerator and denominator always use the same radix.
10590
10591 @node Floats, Complex Numbers, Fractions, Data Types
10592 @section Floats
10593
10594 @noindent
10595 @cindex Floating-point numbers
10596 A floating-point number or @dfn{float} is a number stored in scientific
10597 notation. The number of significant digits in the fractional part is
10598 governed by the current floating precision (@pxref{Precision}). The
10599 range of acceptable values is from
10600 @texline @math{10^{-3999999}}
10601 @infoline @expr{10^-3999999}
10602 (inclusive) to
10603 @texline @math{10^{4000000}}
10604 @infoline @expr{10^4000000}
10605 (exclusive), plus the corresponding negative values and zero.
10606
10607 Calculations that would exceed the allowable range of values (such
10608 as @samp{exp(exp(20))}) are left in symbolic form by Calc. The
10609 messages ``floating-point overflow'' or ``floating-point underflow''
10610 indicate that during the calculation a number would have been produced
10611 that was too large or too close to zero, respectively, to be represented
10612 by Calc. This does not necessarily mean the final result would have
10613 overflowed, just that an overflow occurred while computing the result.
10614 (In fact, it could report an underflow even though the final result
10615 would have overflowed!)
10616
10617 If a rational number and a float are mixed in a calculation, the result
10618 will in general be expressed as a float. Commands that require an integer
10619 value (such as @kbd{k g} [@code{gcd}]) will also accept integer-valued
10620 floats, i.e., floating-point numbers with nothing after the decimal point.
10621
10622 Floats are identified by the presence of a decimal point and/or an
10623 exponent. In general a float consists of an optional sign, digits
10624 including an optional decimal point, and an optional exponent consisting
10625 of an @samp{e}, an optional sign, and up to seven exponent digits.
10626 For example, @samp{23.5e-2} is 23.5 times ten to the minus-second power,
10627 or 0.235.
10628
10629 Floating-point numbers are normally displayed in decimal notation with
10630 all significant figures shown. Exceedingly large or small numbers are
10631 displayed in scientific notation. Various other display options are
10632 available. @xref{Float Formats}.
10633
10634 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
10635 Floating-point numbers are stored in decimal, not binary. The result
10636 of each operation is rounded to the nearest value representable in the
10637 number of significant digits specified by the current precision,
10638 rounding away from zero in the case of a tie. Thus (in the default
10639 display mode) what you see is exactly what you get. Some operations such
10640 as square roots and transcendental functions are performed with several
10641 digits of extra precision and then rounded down, in an effort to make the
10642 final result accurate to the full requested precision. However,
10643 accuracy is not rigorously guaranteed. If you suspect the validity of a
10644 result, try doing the same calculation in a higher precision. The
10645 Calculator's arithmetic is not intended to be IEEE-conformant in any
10646 way.
10647
10648 While floats are always @emph{stored} in decimal, they can be entered
10649 and displayed in any radix just like integers and fractions. Since a
10650 float that is entered in a radix other that 10 will be converted to
10651 decimal, the number that Calc stores may not be exactly the number that
10652 was entered, it will be the closest decimal approximation given the
10653 current precision. The notation @samp{@var{radix}#@var{ddd}.@var{ddd}}
10654 is a floating-point number whose digits are in the specified radix.
10655 Note that the @samp{.} is more aptly referred to as a ``radix point''
10656 than as a decimal point in this case. The number @samp{8#123.4567} is
10657 defined as @samp{8#1234567 * 8^-4}. If the radix is 14 or less, you can
10658 use @samp{e} notation to write a non-decimal number in scientific
10659 notation. The exponent is written in decimal, and is considered to be a
10660 power of the radix: @samp{8#1234567e-4}. If the radix is 15 or above,
10661 the letter @samp{e} is a digit, so scientific notation must be written
10662 out, e.g., @samp{16#123.4567*16^2}. The first two exercises of the
10663 Modes Tutorial explore some of the properties of non-decimal floats.
10664
10665 @node Complex Numbers, Infinities, Floats, Data Types
10666 @section Complex Numbers
10667
10668 @noindent
10669 @cindex Complex numbers
10670 There are two supported formats for complex numbers: rectangular and
10671 polar. The default format is rectangular, displayed in the form
10672 @samp{(@var{real},@var{imag})} where @var{real} is the real part and
10673 @var{imag} is the imaginary part, each of which may be any real number.
10674 Rectangular complex numbers can also be displayed in @samp{@var{a}+@var{b}i}
10675 notation; @pxref{Complex Formats}.
10676
10677 Polar complex numbers are displayed in the form
10678 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'
10679 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'
10680 where @var{r} is the nonnegative magnitude and
10681 @texline @math{\theta}
10682 @infoline @var{theta}
10683 is the argument or phase angle. The range of
10684 @texline @math{\theta}
10685 @infoline @var{theta}
10686 depends on the current angular mode (@pxref{Angular Modes}); it is
10687 generally between @mathit{-180} and @mathit{+180} degrees or the equivalent range
10688 in radians.
10689
10690 Complex numbers are entered in stages using incomplete objects.
10691 @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10692
10693 Operations on rectangular complex numbers yield rectangular complex
10694 results, and similarly for polar complex numbers. Where the two types
10695 are mixed, or where new complex numbers arise (as for the square root of
10696 a negative real), the current @dfn{Polar mode} is used to determine the
10697 type. @xref{Polar Mode}.
10698
10699 A complex result in which the imaginary part is zero (or the phase angle
10700 is 0 or 180 degrees or @cpi{} radians) is automatically converted to a real
10701 number.
10702
10703 @node Infinities, Vectors and Matrices, Complex Numbers, Data Types
10704 @section Infinities
10705
10706 @noindent
10707 @cindex Infinity
10708 @cindex @code{inf} variable
10709 @cindex @code{uinf} variable
10710 @cindex @code{nan} variable
10711 @vindex inf
10712 @vindex uinf
10713 @vindex nan
10714 The word @code{inf} represents the mathematical concept of @dfn{infinity}.
10715 Calc actually has three slightly different infinity-like values:
10716 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan}. These are just regular
10717 variable names (@pxref{Variables}); you should avoid using these
10718 names for your own variables because Calc gives them special
10719 treatment. Infinities, like all variable names, are normally
10720 entered using algebraic entry.
10721
10722 Mathematically speaking, it is not rigorously correct to treat
10723 ``infinity'' as if it were a number, but mathematicians often do
10724 so informally. When they say that @samp{1 / inf = 0}, what they
10725 really mean is that @expr{1 / x}, as @expr{x} becomes larger and
10726 larger, becomes arbitrarily close to zero. So you can imagine
10727 that if @expr{x} got ``all the way to infinity,'' then @expr{1 / x}
10728 would go all the way to zero. Similarly, when they say that
10729 @samp{exp(inf) = inf}, they mean that
10730 @texline @math{e^x}
10731 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
10732 grows without bound as @expr{x} grows. The symbol @samp{-inf} likewise
10733 stands for an infinitely negative real value; for example, we say that
10734 @samp{exp(-inf) = 0}. You can have an infinity pointing in any
10735 direction on the complex plane: @samp{sqrt(-inf) = i inf}.
10736
10737 The same concept of limits can be used to define @expr{1 / 0}. We
10738 really want the value that @expr{1 / x} approaches as @expr{x}
10739 approaches zero. But if all we have is @expr{1 / 0}, we can't
10740 tell which direction @expr{x} was coming from. If @expr{x} was
10741 positive and decreasing toward zero, then we should say that
10742 @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. But if @expr{x} was negative and increasing
10743 toward zero, the answer is @samp{1 / 0 = -inf}. In fact, @expr{x}
10744 could be an imaginary number, giving the answer @samp{i inf} or
10745 @samp{-i inf}. Calc uses the special symbol @samp{uinf} to mean
10746 @dfn{undirected infinity}, i.e., a value which is infinitely
10747 large but with an unknown sign (or direction on the complex plane).
10748
10749 Calc actually has three modes that say how infinities are handled.
10750 Normally, infinities never arise from calculations that didn't
10751 already have them. Thus, @expr{1 / 0} is treated simply as an
10752 error and left unevaluated. The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode})
10753 command (@pxref{Infinite Mode}) enables a mode in which
10754 @expr{1 / 0} evaluates to @code{uinf} instead. There is also
10755 an alternative type of infinite mode which says to treat zeros
10756 as if they were positive, so that @samp{1 / 0 = inf}. While this
10757 is less mathematically correct, it may be the answer you want in
10758 some cases.
10759
10760 Since all infinities are ``as large'' as all others, Calc simplifies,
10761 e.g., @samp{5 inf} to @samp{inf}. Another example is
10762 @samp{5 - inf = -inf}, where the @samp{-inf} is so large that
10763 adding a finite number like five to it does not affect it.
10764 Note that @samp{a - inf} also results in @samp{-inf}; Calc assumes
10765 that variables like @code{a} always stand for finite quantities.
10766 Just to show that infinities really are all the same size,
10767 note that @samp{sqrt(inf) = inf^2 = exp(inf) = inf} in Calc's
10768 notation.
10769
10770 It's not so easy to define certain formulas like @samp{0 * inf} and
10771 @samp{inf / inf}. Depending on where these zeros and infinities
10772 came from, the answer could be literally anything. The latter
10773 formula could be the limit of @expr{x / x} (giving a result of one),
10774 or @expr{2 x / x} (giving two), or @expr{x^2 / x} (giving @code{inf}),
10775 or @expr{x / x^2} (giving zero). Calc uses the symbol @code{nan}
10776 to represent such an @dfn{indeterminate} value. (The name ``nan''
10777 comes from analogy with the ``NAN'' concept of IEEE standard
10778 arithmetic; it stands for ``Not A Number.'' This is somewhat of a
10779 misnomer, since @code{nan} @emph{does} stand for some number or
10780 infinity, it's just that @emph{which} number it stands for
10781 cannot be determined.) In Calc's notation, @samp{0 * inf = nan}
10782 and @samp{inf / inf = nan}. A few other common indeterminate
10783 expressions are @samp{inf - inf} and @samp{inf ^ 0}. Also,
10784 @samp{0 / 0 = nan} if you have turned on Infinite mode
10785 (as described above).
10786
10787 Infinities are especially useful as parts of @dfn{intervals}.
10788 @xref{Interval Forms}.
10789
10790 @node Vectors and Matrices, Strings, Infinities, Data Types
10791 @section Vectors and Matrices
10792
10793 @noindent
10794 @cindex Vectors
10795 @cindex Plain vectors
10796 @cindex Matrices
10797 The @dfn{vector} data type is flexible and general. A vector is simply a
10798 list of zero or more data objects. When these objects are numbers, the
10799 whole is a vector in the mathematical sense. When these objects are
10800 themselves vectors of equal (nonzero) length, the whole is a @dfn{matrix}.
10801 A vector which is not a matrix is referred to here as a @dfn{plain vector}.
10802
10803 A vector is displayed as a list of values separated by commas and enclosed
10804 in square brackets: @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Thus the following is a 2 row by
10805 3 column matrix: @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}. Vectors, like complex
10806 numbers, are entered as incomplete objects. @xref{Incomplete Objects}.
10807 During algebraic entry, vectors are entered all at once in the usual
10808 brackets-and-commas form. Matrices may be entered algebraically as nested
10809 vectors, or using the shortcut notation @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3; 4, 5, 6]}},
10810 with rows separated by semicolons. The commas may usually be omitted
10811 when entering vectors: @samp{[1 2 3]}. Curly braces may be used in
10812 place of brackets: @samp{@{1, 2, 3@}}, but the commas are required in
10813 this case.
10814
10815 Traditional vector and matrix arithmetic is also supported;
10816 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic} and @pxref{Matrix Functions}.
10817 Many other operations are applied to vectors element-wise. For example,
10818 the complex conjugate of a vector is a vector of the complex conjugates
10819 of its elements.
10820
10821 @ignore
10822 @starindex
10823 @end ignore
10824 @tindex vec
10825 Algebraic functions for building vectors include @samp{vec(a, b, c)}
10826 to build @samp{[a, b, c]}, @samp{cvec(a, n, m)} to build an
10827 @texline @math{n\times m}
10828 @infoline @var{n}x@var{m}
10829 matrix of @samp{a}s, and @samp{index(n)} to build a vector of integers
10830 from 1 to @samp{n}.
10831
10832 @node Strings, HMS Forms, Vectors and Matrices, Data Types
10833 @section Strings
10834
10835 @noindent
10836 @kindex "
10837 @cindex Strings
10838 @cindex Character strings
10839 Character strings are not a special data type in the Calculator.
10840 Rather, a string is represented simply as a vector all of whose
10841 elements are integers in the range 0 to 255 (ASCII codes). You can
10842 enter a string at any time by pressing the @kbd{"} key. Quotation
10843 marks and backslashes are written @samp{\"} and @samp{\\}, respectively,
10844 inside strings. Other notations introduced by backslashes are:
10845
10846 @example
10847 @group
10848 \a 7 \^@@ 0
10849 \b 8 \^a-z 1-26
10850 \e 27 \^[ 27
10851 \f 12 \^\\ 28
10852 \n 10 \^] 29
10853 \r 13 \^^ 30
10854 \t 9 \^_ 31
10855 \^? 127
10856 @end group
10857 @end example
10858
10859 @noindent
10860 Finally, a backslash followed by three octal digits produces any
10861 character from its ASCII code.
10862
10863 @kindex d "
10864 @pindex calc-display-strings
10865 Strings are normally displayed in vector-of-integers form. The
10866 @w{@kbd{d "}} (@code{calc-display-strings}) command toggles a mode in
10867 which any vectors of small integers are displayed as quoted strings
10868 instead.
10869
10870 The backslash notations shown above are also used for displaying
10871 strings. Characters 128 and above are not translated by Calc; unless
10872 you have an Emacs modified for 8-bit fonts, these will show up in
10873 backslash-octal-digits notation. For characters below 32, and
10874 for character 127, Calc uses the backslash-letter combination if
10875 there is one, or otherwise uses a @samp{\^} sequence.
10876
10877 The only Calc feature that uses strings is @dfn{compositions};
10878 @pxref{Compositions}. Strings also provide a convenient
10879 way to do conversions between ASCII characters and integers.
10880
10881 @ignore
10882 @starindex
10883 @end ignore
10884 @tindex string
10885 There is a @code{string} function which provides a different display
10886 format for strings. Basically, @samp{string(@var{s})}, where @var{s}
10887 is a vector of integers in the proper range, is displayed as the
10888 corresponding string of characters with no surrounding quotation
10889 marks or other modifications. Thus @samp{string("ABC")} (or
10890 @samp{string([65 66 67])}) will look like @samp{ABC} on the stack.
10891 This happens regardless of whether @w{@kbd{d "}} has been used. The
10892 only way to turn it off is to use @kbd{d U} (unformatted language
10893 mode) which will display @samp{string("ABC")} instead.
10894
10895 Control characters are displayed somewhat differently by @code{string}.
10896 Characters below 32, and character 127, are shown using @samp{^} notation
10897 (same as shown above, but without the backslash). The quote and
10898 backslash characters are left alone, as are characters 128 and above.
10899
10900 @ignore
10901 @starindex
10902 @end ignore
10903 @tindex bstring
10904 The @code{bstring} function is just like @code{string} except that
10905 the resulting string is breakable across multiple lines if it doesn't
10906 fit all on one line. Potential break points occur at every space
10907 character in the string.
10908
10909 @node HMS Forms, Date Forms, Strings, Data Types
10910 @section HMS Forms
10911
10912 @noindent
10913 @cindex Hours-minutes-seconds forms
10914 @cindex Degrees-minutes-seconds forms
10915 @dfn{HMS} stands for Hours-Minutes-Seconds; when used as an angular
10916 argument, the interpretation is Degrees-Minutes-Seconds. All functions
10917 that operate on angles accept HMS forms. These are interpreted as
10918 degrees regardless of the current angular mode. It is also possible to
10919 use HMS as the angular mode so that calculated angles are expressed in
10920 degrees, minutes, and seconds.
10921
10922 @kindex @@
10923 @ignore
10924 @mindex @null
10925 @end ignore
10926 @kindex ' (HMS forms)
10927 @ignore
10928 @mindex @null
10929 @end ignore
10930 @kindex " (HMS forms)
10931 @ignore
10932 @mindex @null
10933 @end ignore
10934 @kindex h (HMS forms)
10935 @ignore
10936 @mindex @null
10937 @end ignore
10938 @kindex o (HMS forms)
10939 @ignore
10940 @mindex @null
10941 @end ignore
10942 @kindex m (HMS forms)
10943 @ignore
10944 @mindex @null
10945 @end ignore
10946 @kindex s (HMS forms)
10947 The default format for HMS values is
10948 @samp{@var{hours}@@ @var{mins}' @var{secs}"}. During entry, the letters
10949 @samp{h} (for ``hours'') or
10950 @samp{o} (approximating the ``degrees'' symbol) are accepted as well as
10951 @samp{@@}, @samp{m} is accepted in place of @samp{'}, and @samp{s} is
10952 accepted in place of @samp{"}.
10953 The @var{hours} value is an integer (or integer-valued float).
10954 The @var{mins} value is an integer or integer-valued float between 0 and 59.
10955 The @var{secs} value is a real number between 0 (inclusive) and 60
10956 (exclusive). A positive HMS form is interpreted as @var{hours} +
10957 @var{mins}/60 + @var{secs}/3600. A negative HMS form is interpreted
10958 as @mathit{- @var{hours}} @mathit{-} @var{mins}/60 @mathit{-} @var{secs}/3600.
10959 Display format for HMS forms is quite flexible. @xref{HMS Formats}.
10960
10961 HMS forms can be added and subtracted. When they are added to numbers,
10962 the numbers are interpreted according to the current angular mode. HMS
10963 forms can also be multiplied and divided by real numbers. Dividing
10964 two HMS forms produces a real-valued ratio of the two angles.
10965
10966 @pindex calc-time
10967 @cindex Time of day
10968 Just for kicks, @kbd{M-x calc-time} pushes the current time of day on
10969 the stack as an HMS form.
10970
10971 @node Date Forms, Modulo Forms, HMS Forms, Data Types
10972 @section Date Forms
10973
10974 @noindent
10975 @cindex Date forms
10976 A @dfn{date form} represents a date and possibly an associated time.
10977 Simple date arithmetic is supported: Adding a number to a date
10978 produces a new date shifted by that many days; adding an HMS form to
10979 a date shifts it by that many hours. Subtracting two date forms
10980 computes the number of days between them (represented as a simple
10981 number). Many other operations, such as multiplying two date forms,
10982 are nonsensical and are not allowed by Calc.
10983
10984 Date forms are entered and displayed enclosed in @samp{< >} brackets.
10985 The default format is, e.g., @samp{<Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates,
10986 or @samp{<3:32:20pm Wed Jan 9, 1991>} for dates with times.
10987 Input is flexible; date forms can be entered in any of the usual
10988 notations for dates and times. @xref{Date Formats}.
10989
10990 Date forms are stored internally as numbers, specifically the number
10991 of days since midnight on the morning of December 31 of the year 1 BC@.
10992 If the internal number is an integer, the form represents a date only;
10993 if the internal number is a fraction or float, the form represents
10994 a date and time. For example, @samp{<6:00am Thu Jan 10, 1991>}
10995 is represented by the number 726842.25. The standard precision of
10996 12 decimal digits is enough to ensure that a (reasonable) date and
10997 time can be stored without roundoff error.
10998
10999 If the current precision is greater than 12, date forms will keep
11000 additional digits in the seconds position. For example, if the
11001 precision is 15, the seconds will keep three digits after the
11002 decimal point. Decreasing the precision below 12 may cause the
11003 time part of a date form to become inaccurate. This can also happen
11004 if astronomically high years are used, though this will not be an
11005 issue in everyday (or even everymillennium) use. Note that date
11006 forms without times are stored as exact integers, so roundoff is
11007 never an issue for them.
11008
11009 You can use the @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) and @kbd{v u}
11010 (@code{calc-unpack}) commands to get at the numerical representation
11011 of a date form. @xref{Packing and Unpacking}.
11012
11013 Date forms can go arbitrarily far into the future or past. Negative
11014 year numbers represent years BC@. There is no ``year 0''; the day
11015 before @samp{<Mon Jan 1, +1>} is @samp{<Sun Dec 31, -1>}. These are
11016 days 1 and 0 respectively in Calc's internal numbering scheme. The
11017 Gregorian calendar is used for all dates, including dates before the
11018 Gregorian calendar was invented (although that can be configured; see
11019 below). Thus Calc's use of the day number @mathit{-10000} to
11020 represent August 15, 28 BC should be taken with a grain of salt.
11021
11022 @cindex Julian calendar
11023 @cindex Gregorian calendar
11024 Some historical background: The Julian calendar was created by
11025 Julius Caesar in the year 46 BC as an attempt to fix the confusion
11026 caused by the irregular Roman calendar that was used before that time.
11027 The Julian calendar introduced an extra day in all years divisible by
11028 four. After some initial confusion, the calendar was adopted around
11029 the year we call 8 AD@. Some centuries later it became
11030 apparent that the Julian year of 365.25 days was itself not quite
11031 right. In 1582 Pope Gregory XIII introduced the Gregorian calendar,
11032 which added the new rule that years divisible by 100, but not by 400,
11033 were not to be considered leap years despite being divisible by four.
11034 Many countries delayed adoption of the Gregorian calendar
11035 because of religious differences. For example, Great Britain and the
11036 British colonies switched to the Gregorian calendar in September
11037 1752, when the Julian calendar was eleven days behind the
11038 Gregorian calendar. That year in Britain, the day after September 2
11039 was September 14. To take another example, Russia did not adopt the
11040 Gregorian calendar until 1918, and that year in Russia the day after
11041 January 31 was February 14. Calc's reckoning therefore matches English
11042 practice starting in 1752 and Russian practice starting in 1918, but
11043 disagrees with earlier dates in both countries.
11044
11045 When the Julian calendar was introduced, it had January 1 as the first
11046 day of the year. By the Middle Ages, many European countries
11047 had changed the beginning of a new year to a different date, often to
11048 a religious festival. Almost all countries reverted to using January 1
11049 as the beginning of the year by the time they adopted the Gregorian
11050 calendar.
11051
11052 Some calendars attempt to mimic the historical situation by using the
11053 Gregorian calendar for recent dates and the Julian calendar for older
11054 dates. The @code{cal} program in most Unix implementations does this,
11055 for example. While January 1 wasn't always the beginning of a calendar
11056 year, these hybrid calendars still use January 1 as the beginning of
11057 the year even for older dates. The customizable variable
11058 @code{calc-gregorian-switch} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}) can be set to
11059 have Calc's date forms switch from the Julian to Gregorian calendar at
11060 any specified date.
11061
11062 Today's timekeepers introduce an occasional ``leap second''.
11063 These do not occur regularly and Calc does not take these minor
11064 effects into account. (If it did, it would have to report a
11065 non-integer number of days between, say,
11066 @samp{<12:00am Mon Jan 1, 1900>} and
11067 @samp{<12:00am Sat Jan 1, 2000>}.)
11068
11069 @cindex Julian day counting
11070 Another day counting system in common use is, confusingly, also called
11071 ``Julian.'' Julian days go from noon to noon. The Julian day number
11072 is the numbers of days since 12:00 noon (GMT) on November 24, 4714 BC
11073 in the Gregorian calendar (i.e., January 1, 4713 BC in the Julian
11074 calendar). In Calc's scheme (in GMT) the Julian day origin is
11075 @mathit{-1721422.5}, because Calc starts at midnight instead of noon.
11076 Thus to convert a Calc date code obtained by unpacking a
11077 date form into a Julian day number, simply add 1721422.5 after
11078 compensating for the time zone difference. The built-in @kbd{t J}
11079 command performs this conversion for you.
11080
11081 The Julian day number is based on the Julian cycle, which was invented
11082 in 1583 by Joseph Justus Scaliger. Scaliger named it the Julian cycle
11083 since it involves the Julian calendar, but some have suggested that
11084 Scaliger named it in honor of his father, Julius Caesar Scaliger. The
11085 Julian cycle is based on three other cycles: the indiction cycle, the
11086 Metonic cycle, and the solar cycle. The indiction cycle is a 15 year
11087 cycle originally used by the Romans for tax purposes but later used to
11088 date medieval documents. The Metonic cycle is a 19 year cycle; 19
11089 years is close to being a common multiple of a solar year and a lunar
11090 month, and so every 19 years the phases of the moon will occur on the
11091 same days of the year. The solar cycle is a 28 year cycle; the Julian
11092 calendar repeats itself every 28 years. The smallest time period
11093 which contains multiples of all three cycles is the least common
11094 multiple of 15 years, 19 years and 28 years, which (since they're
11095 pairwise relatively prime) is
11096 @texline @math{15\times 19\times 28 = 7980} years.
11097 @infoline 15*19*28 = 7980 years.
11098 This is the length of a Julian cycle. Working backwards, the previous
11099 year in which all three cycles began was 4713 BC, and so Scaliger
11100 chose that year as the beginning of a Julian cycle. Since at the time
11101 there were no historical records from before 4713 BC, using this year
11102 as a starting point had the advantage of avoiding negative year
11103 numbers. In 1849, the astronomer John Herschel (son of William
11104 Herschel) suggested using the number of days since the beginning of
11105 the Julian cycle as an astronomical dating system; this idea was taken
11106 up by other astronomers. (At the time, noon was the start of the
11107 astronomical day. Herschel originally suggested counting the days
11108 since Jan 1, 4713 BC at noon Alexandria time; this was later amended to
11109 noon GMT@.) Julian day numbering is largely used in astronomy.
11110
11111 @cindex Unix time format
11112 The Unix operating system measures time as an integer number of
11113 seconds since midnight, Jan 1, 1970. To convert a Calc date
11114 value into a Unix time stamp, first subtract 719164 (the code
11115 for @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}), then multiply by 86400 (the number of
11116 seconds in a day) and press @kbd{R} to round to the nearest
11117 integer. If you have a date form, you can simply subtract the
11118 day @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>} instead of unpacking and subtracting
11119 719164. Likewise, divide by 86400 and add @samp{<Jan 1, 1970>}
11120 to convert from Unix time to a Calc date form. (Note that
11121 Unix normally maintains the time in the GMT time zone; you may
11122 need to subtract five hours to get New York time, or eight hours
11123 for California time. The same is usually true of Julian day
11124 counts.) The built-in @kbd{t U} command performs these
11125 conversions.
11126
11127 @node Modulo Forms, Error Forms, Date Forms, Data Types
11128 @section Modulo Forms
11129
11130 @noindent
11131 @cindex Modulo forms
11132 A @dfn{modulo form} is a real number which is taken modulo (i.e., within
11133 an integer multiple of) some value @var{M}. Arithmetic modulo @var{M}
11134 often arises in number theory. Modulo forms are written
11135 `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}',
11136 where @var{a} and @var{M} are real numbers or HMS forms, and
11137 @texline @math{0 \le a < M}.
11138 @infoline @expr{0 <= a < @var{M}}.
11139 In many applications @expr{a} and @expr{M} will be
11140 integers but this is not required.
11141
11142 @ignore
11143 @mindex M
11144 @end ignore
11145 @kindex M (modulo forms)
11146 @ignore
11147 @mindex mod
11148 @end ignore
11149 @tindex mod (operator)
11150 To create a modulo form during numeric entry, press the shift-@kbd{M}
11151 key to enter the word @samp{mod}. As a special convenience, pressing
11152 shift-@kbd{M} a second time automatically enters the value of @expr{M}
11153 that was most recently used before. During algebraic entry, either
11154 type @samp{mod} by hand or press @kbd{M-m} (that's @kbd{@key{META}-m}).
11155 Once again, pressing this a second time enters the current modulo.
11156
11157 Modulo forms are not to be confused with the modulo operator @samp{%}.
11158 The expression @samp{27 % 10} means to compute 27 modulo 10 to produce
11159 the result 7. Further computations treat this 7 as just a regular integer.
11160 The expression @samp{27 mod 10} produces the result @samp{7 mod 10};
11161 further computations with this value are again reduced modulo 10 so that
11162 the result always lies in the desired range.
11163
11164 When two modulo forms with identical @expr{M}'s are added or multiplied,
11165 the Calculator simply adds or multiplies the values, then reduces modulo
11166 @expr{M}. If one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number,
11167 the plain number is treated like a compatible modulo form. It is also
11168 possible to raise modulo forms to powers; the result is the value raised
11169 to the power, then reduced modulo @expr{M}. (When all values involved
11170 are integers, this calculation is done much more efficiently than
11171 actually computing the power and then reducing.)
11172
11173 @cindex Modulo division
11174 Two modulo forms `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}' and `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'
11175 can be divided if @expr{a}, @expr{b}, and @expr{M} are all
11176 integers. The result is the modulo form which, when multiplied by
11177 `@var{b} @tfn{mod} @var{M}', produces `@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}'. If
11178 there is no solution to this equation (which can happen only when
11179 @expr{M} is non-prime), or if any of the arguments are non-integers, the
11180 division is left in symbolic form. Other operations, such as square
11181 roots, are not yet supported for modulo forms. (Note that, although
11182 @w{`@tfn{(}@var{a} @tfn{mod} @var{M}@tfn{)^.5}'} will compute a ``modulo square root''
11183 in the sense of reducing
11184 @texline @math{\sqrt a}
11185 @infoline @expr{sqrt(a)}
11186 modulo @expr{M}, this is not a useful definition from the
11187 number-theoretical point of view.)
11188
11189 It is possible to mix HMS forms and modulo forms. For example, an
11190 HMS form modulo 24 could be used to manipulate clock times; an HMS
11191 form modulo 360 would be suitable for angles. Making the modulo @expr{M}
11192 also be an HMS form eliminates troubles that would arise if the angular
11193 mode were inadvertently set to Radians, in which case
11194 @w{@samp{2@@ 0' 0" mod 24}} would be interpreted as two degrees modulo
11195 24 radians!
11196
11197 Modulo forms cannot have variables or formulas for components. If you
11198 enter the formula @samp{(x + 2) mod 5}, Calc propagates the modulus
11199 to each of the coefficients: @samp{(1 mod 5) x + (2 mod 5)}.
11200
11201 You can use @kbd{v p} and @kbd{%} to modify modulo forms.
11202 @xref{Packing and Unpacking}. @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
11203
11204 @ignore
11205 @starindex
11206 @end ignore
11207 @tindex makemod
11208 The algebraic function @samp{makemod(a, m)} builds the modulo form
11209 @w{@samp{a mod m}}.
11210
11211 @node Error Forms, Interval Forms, Modulo Forms, Data Types
11212 @section Error Forms
11213
11214 @noindent
11215 @cindex Error forms
11216 @cindex Standard deviations
11217 An @dfn{error form} is a number with an associated standard
11218 deviation, as in @samp{2.3 +/- 0.12}. The notation
11219 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11220 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} sigma'
11221 stands for an uncertain value which follows
11222 a normal or Gaussian distribution of mean @expr{x} and standard
11223 deviation or ``error''
11224 @texline @math{\sigma}.
11225 @infoline @expr{sigma}.
11226 Both the mean and the error can be either numbers or
11227 formulas. Generally these are real numbers but the mean may also be
11228 complex. If the error is negative or complex, it is changed to its
11229 absolute value. An error form with zero error is converted to a
11230 regular number by the Calculator.
11231
11232 All arithmetic and transcendental functions accept error forms as input.
11233 Operations on the mean-value part work just like operations on regular
11234 numbers. The error part for any function @expr{f(x)} (such as
11235 @texline @math{\sin x}
11236 @infoline @expr{sin(x)})
11237 is defined by the error of @expr{x} times the derivative of @expr{f}
11238 evaluated at the mean value of @expr{x}. For a two-argument function
11239 @expr{f(x,y)} (such as addition) the error is the square root of the sum
11240 of the squares of the errors due to @expr{x} and @expr{y}.
11241 @tex
11242 $$ \eqalign{
11243 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma)
11244 &= f(x) \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma \left| {df(x) \over dx} \right| \cr
11245 f(x \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_x, y \hbox{\code{ +/- }} \sigma_y)
11246 &= f(x,y) \hbox{\code{ +/- }}
11247 \sqrt{\left(\sigma_x \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial x}
11248 \right| \right)^2
11249 +\left(\sigma_y \left| {\partial f(x,y) \over \partial y}
11250 \right| \right)^2 } \cr
11251 } $$
11252 @end tex
11253 Note that this
11254 definition assumes the errors in @expr{x} and @expr{y} are uncorrelated.
11255 A side effect of this definition is that @samp{(2 +/- 1) * (2 +/- 1)}
11256 is not the same as @samp{(2 +/- 1)^2}; the former represents the product
11257 of two independent values which happen to have the same probability
11258 distributions, and the latter is the product of one random value with itself.
11259 The former will produce an answer with less error, since on the average
11260 the two independent errors can be expected to cancel out.
11261
11262 Consult a good text on error analysis for a discussion of the proper use
11263 of standard deviations. Actual errors often are neither Gaussian-distributed
11264 nor uncorrelated, and the above formulas are valid only when errors
11265 are small. As an example, the error arising from
11266 @texline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}@tfn{)}'
11267 @infoline `@tfn{sin(}@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}@tfn{)}'
11268 is
11269 @texline `@math{\sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11270 @infoline `@var{sigma} @tfn{abs(cos(}@var{x}@tfn{))}'.
11271 When @expr{x} is close to zero,
11272 @texline @math{\cos x}
11273 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11274 is close to one so the error in the sine is close to
11275 @texline @math{\sigma};
11276 @infoline @expr{sigma};
11277 this makes sense, since
11278 @texline @math{\sin x}
11279 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11280 is approximately @expr{x} near zero, so a given error in @expr{x} will
11281 produce about the same error in the sine. Likewise, near 90 degrees
11282 @texline @math{\cos x}
11283 @infoline @expr{cos(x)}
11284 is nearly zero and so the computed error is
11285 small: The sine curve is nearly flat in that region, so an error in @expr{x}
11286 has relatively little effect on the value of
11287 @texline @math{\sin x}.
11288 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}.
11289 However, consider @samp{sin(90 +/- 1000)}. The cosine of 90 is zero, so
11290 Calc will report zero error! We get an obviously wrong result because
11291 we have violated the small-error approximation underlying the error
11292 analysis. If the error in @expr{x} had been small, the error in
11293 @texline @math{\sin x}
11294 @infoline @expr{sin(x)}
11295 would indeed have been negligible.
11296
11297 @ignore
11298 @mindex p
11299 @end ignore
11300 @kindex p (error forms)
11301 @tindex +/-
11302 To enter an error form during regular numeric entry, use the @kbd{p}
11303 (``plus-or-minus'') key to type the @samp{+/-} symbol. (If you try actually
11304 typing @samp{+/-} the @kbd{+} key will be interpreted as the Calculator's
11305 @kbd{+} command!) Within an algebraic formula, you can press @kbd{M-+} to
11306 type the @samp{+/-} symbol, or type it out by hand.
11307
11308 Error forms and complex numbers can be mixed; the formulas shown above
11309 are used for complex numbers, too; note that if the error part evaluates
11310 to a complex number its absolute value (or the square root of the sum of
11311 the squares of the absolute values of the two error contributions) is
11312 used. Mathematically, this corresponds to a radially symmetric Gaussian
11313 distribution of numbers on the complex plane. However, note that Calc
11314 considers an error form with real components to represent a real number,
11315 not a complex distribution around a real mean.
11316
11317 Error forms may also be composed of HMS forms. For best results, both
11318 the mean and the error should be HMS forms if either one is.
11319
11320 @ignore
11321 @starindex
11322 @end ignore
11323 @tindex sdev
11324 The algebraic function @samp{sdev(a, b)} builds the error form @samp{a +/- b}.
11325
11326 @node Interval Forms, Incomplete Objects, Error Forms, Data Types
11327 @section Interval Forms
11328
11329 @noindent
11330 @cindex Interval forms
11331 An @dfn{interval} is a subset of consecutive real numbers. For example,
11332 the interval @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} represents all the numbers from 2 to 4,
11333 inclusive. If you multiply it by the interval @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]} you
11334 obtain @samp{[1 ..@: 8]}. This calculation represents the fact that if
11335 you multiply some number in the range @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} by some other
11336 number in the range @samp{[0.5 ..@: 2]}, your result will lie in the range
11337 from 1 to 8. Interval arithmetic is used to get a worst-case estimate
11338 of the possible range of values a computation will produce, given the
11339 set of possible values of the input.
11340
11341 @ifnottex
11342 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including @dfn{closed}
11343 intervals of the type shown above, @dfn{open} intervals such as
11344 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11345 @emph{exclusive}, and @dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11346 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11347 terms,
11348 @samp{[2 ..@: 4]} means @expr{2 <= x <= 4}, whereas
11349 @samp{[2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 <= x < 4},
11350 @samp{(2 ..@: 4]} represents @expr{2 < x <= 4}, and
11351 @samp{(2 ..@: 4)} represents @expr{2 < x < 4}.
11352 @end ifnottex
11353 @tex
11354 Calc supports several varieties of intervals, including \dfn{closed}
11355 intervals of the type shown above, \dfn{open} intervals such as
11356 \samp{(2 ..\: 4)}, which represents the range of numbers from 2 to 4
11357 \emph{exclusive}, and \dfn{semi-open} intervals in which one end
11358 uses a round parenthesis and the other a square bracket. In mathematical
11359 terms,
11360 $$ \eqalign{
11361 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x \le 4 \cr
11362 [2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 \le x < 4 \cr
11363 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4] &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x \le 4 \cr
11364 (2 \hbox{\cite{..}} 4) &\quad\hbox{means}\quad 2 < x < 4 \cr
11365 } $$
11366 @end tex
11367
11368 The lower and upper limits of an interval must be either real numbers
11369 (or HMS or date forms), or symbolic expressions which are assumed to be
11370 real-valued, or @samp{-inf} and @samp{inf}. In general the lower limit
11371 must be less than the upper limit. A closed interval containing only
11372 one value, @samp{[3 ..@: 3]}, is converted to a plain number (3)
11373 automatically. An interval containing no values at all (such as
11374 @samp{[3 ..@: 2]} or @samp{[2 ..@: 2)}) can be represented but is not
11375 guaranteed to behave well when used in arithmetic. Note that the
11376 interval @samp{[3 .. inf)} represents all real numbers greater than
11377 or equal to 3, and @samp{(-inf .. inf)} represents all real numbers.
11378 In fact, @samp{[-inf .. inf]} represents all real numbers including
11379 the real infinities.
11380
11381 Intervals are entered in the notation shown here, either as algebraic
11382 formulas, or using incomplete forms. (@xref{Incomplete Objects}.)
11383 In algebraic formulas, multiple periods in a row are collected from
11384 left to right, so that @samp{1...1e2} is interpreted as @samp{1.0 ..@: 1e2}
11385 rather than @samp{1 ..@: 0.1e2}. Add spaces or zeros if you want to
11386 get the other interpretation. If you omit the lower or upper limit,
11387 a default of @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf} (respectively) is furnished.
11388
11389 Infinite mode also affects operations on intervals
11390 (@pxref{Infinities}). Calc will always introduce an open infinity,
11391 as in @samp{1 / (0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf)}. But closed infinities,
11392 @w{@samp{1 / [0 .. 2] = [0.5 .. inf]}}, arise only in Infinite mode;
11393 otherwise they are left unevaluated. Note that the ``direction'' of
11394 a zero is not an issue in this case since the zero is always assumed
11395 to be continuous with the rest of the interval. For intervals that
11396 contain zero inside them Calc is forced to give the result,
11397 @samp{1 / (-2 .. 2) = [-inf .. inf]}.
11398
11399 While it may seem that intervals and error forms are similar, they are
11400 based on entirely different concepts of inexact quantities. An error
11401 form
11402 @texline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @math{\sigma}'
11403 @infoline `@var{x} @tfn{+/-} @var{sigma}'
11404 means a variable is random, and its value could
11405 be anything but is ``probably'' within one
11406 @texline @math{\sigma}
11407 @infoline @var{sigma}
11408 of the mean value @expr{x}. An interval
11409 `@tfn{[}@var{a} @tfn{..@:} @var{b}@tfn{]}' means a
11410 variable's value is unknown, but guaranteed to lie in the specified
11411 range. Error forms are statistical or ``average case'' approximations;
11412 interval arithmetic tends to produce ``worst case'' bounds on an
11413 answer.
11414
11415 Intervals may not contain complex numbers, but they may contain
11416 HMS forms or date forms.
11417
11418 @xref{Set Operations}, for commands that interpret interval forms
11419 as subsets of the set of real numbers.
11420
11421 @ignore
11422 @starindex
11423 @end ignore
11424 @tindex intv
11425 The algebraic function @samp{intv(n, a, b)} builds an interval form
11426 from @samp{a} to @samp{b}; @samp{n} is an integer code which must
11427 be 0 for @samp{(..)}, 1 for @samp{(..]}, 2 for @samp{[..)}, or
11428 3 for @samp{[..]}.
11429
11430 Please note that in fully rigorous interval arithmetic, care would be
11431 taken to make sure that the computation of the lower bound rounds toward
11432 minus infinity, while upper bound computations round toward plus
11433 infinity. Calc's arithmetic always uses a round-to-nearest mode,
11434 which means that roundoff errors could creep into an interval
11435 calculation to produce intervals slightly smaller than they ought to
11436 be. For example, entering @samp{[1..2]} and pressing @kbd{Q 2 ^}
11437 should yield the interval @samp{[1..2]} again, but in fact it yields the
11438 (slightly too small) interval @samp{[1..1.9999999]} due to roundoff
11439 error.
11440
11441 @node Incomplete Objects, Variables, Interval Forms, Data Types
11442 @section Incomplete Objects
11443
11444 @noindent
11445 @ignore
11446 @mindex [ ]
11447 @end ignore
11448 @kindex [
11449 @ignore
11450 @mindex ( )
11451 @end ignore
11452 @kindex (
11453 @kindex ,
11454 @ignore
11455 @mindex @null
11456 @end ignore
11457 @kindex ]
11458 @ignore
11459 @mindex @null
11460 @end ignore
11461 @kindex )
11462 @cindex Incomplete vectors
11463 @cindex Incomplete complex numbers
11464 @cindex Incomplete interval forms
11465 When @kbd{(} or @kbd{[} is typed to begin entering a complex number or
11466 vector, respectively, the effect is to push an @dfn{incomplete} complex
11467 number or vector onto the stack. The @kbd{,} key adds the value(s) at
11468 the top of the stack onto the current incomplete object. The @kbd{)}
11469 and @kbd{]} keys ``close'' the incomplete object after adding any values
11470 on the top of the stack in front of the incomplete object.
11471
11472 As a result, the sequence of keystrokes @kbd{[ 2 , 3 @key{RET} 2 * , 9 ]}
11473 pushes the vector @samp{[2, 6, 9]} onto the stack. Likewise, @kbd{( 1 , 2 Q )}
11474 pushes the complex number @samp{(1, 1.414)} (approximately).
11475
11476 If several values lie on the stack in front of the incomplete object,
11477 all are collected and appended to the object. Thus the @kbd{,} key
11478 is redundant: @kbd{[ 2 @key{RET} 3 @key{RET} 2 * 9 ]}. Some people
11479 prefer the equivalent @key{SPC} key to @key{RET}.
11480
11481 As a special case, typing @kbd{,} immediately after @kbd{(}, @kbd{[}, or
11482 @kbd{,} adds a zero or duplicates the preceding value in the list being
11483 formed. Typing @key{DEL} during incomplete entry removes the last item
11484 from the list.
11485
11486 @kindex ;
11487 The @kbd{;} key is used in the same way as @kbd{,} to create polar complex
11488 numbers: @kbd{( 1 ; 2 )}. When entering a vector, @kbd{;} is useful for
11489 creating a matrix. In particular, @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ; 3 , 4 ; 5 , 6 ] ]} is
11490 equivalent to @kbd{[ [ 1 , 2 ] , [ 3 , 4 ] , [ 5 , 6 ] ]}.
11491
11492 @kindex ..
11493 @pindex calc-dots
11494 Incomplete entry is also used to enter intervals. For example,
11495 @kbd{[ 2 ..@: 4 )} enters a semi-open interval. Note that when you type
11496 the first period, it will be interpreted as a decimal point, but when
11497 you type a second period immediately afterward, it is re-interpreted as
11498 part of the interval symbol. Typing @kbd{..} corresponds to executing
11499 the @code{calc-dots} command.
11500
11501 If you find incomplete entry distracting, you may wish to enter vectors
11502 and complex numbers as algebraic formulas by pressing the apostrophe key.
11503
11504 @node Variables, Formulas, Incomplete Objects, Data Types
11505 @section Variables
11506
11507 @noindent
11508 @cindex Variables, in formulas
11509 A @dfn{variable} is somewhere between a storage register on a conventional
11510 calculator, and a variable in a programming language. (In fact, a Calc
11511 variable is really just an Emacs Lisp variable that contains a Calc number
11512 or formula.) A variable's name is normally composed of letters and digits.
11513 Calc also allows apostrophes and @code{#} signs in variable names.
11514 (The Calc variable @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp variable
11515 @code{var-foo}, but unless you access the variable from within Emacs
11516 Lisp, you don't need to worry about it. Variable names in algebraic
11517 formulas implicitly have @samp{var-} prefixed to their names. The
11518 @samp{#} character in variable names used in algebraic formulas
11519 corresponds to a dash @samp{-} in the Lisp variable name. If the name
11520 contains any dashes, the prefix @samp{var-} is @emph{not} automatically
11521 added. Thus the two formulas @samp{foo + 1} and @samp{var#foo + 1} both
11522 refer to the same variable.)
11523
11524 In a command that takes a variable name, you can either type the full
11525 name of a variable, or type a single digit to use one of the special
11526 convenience variables @code{q0} through @code{q9}. For example,
11527 @kbd{3 s s 2} stores the number 3 in variable @code{q2}, and
11528 @w{@kbd{3 s s foo @key{RET}}} stores that number in variable
11529 @code{foo}.
11530
11531 To push a variable itself (as opposed to the variable's value) on the
11532 stack, enter its name as an algebraic expression using the apostrophe
11533 (@key{'}) key.
11534
11535 @kindex =
11536 @pindex calc-evaluate
11537 @cindex Evaluation of variables in a formula
11538 @cindex Variables, evaluation
11539 @cindex Formulas, evaluation
11540 The @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) key ``evaluates'' a formula by
11541 replacing all variables in the formula which have been given values by a
11542 @code{calc-store} or @code{calc-let} command by their stored values.
11543 Other variables are left alone. Thus a variable that has not been
11544 stored acts like an abstract variable in algebra; a variable that has
11545 been stored acts more like a register in a traditional calculator.
11546 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{=} evaluates the top
11547 @var{n} stack entries; with a negative argument, @kbd{=} evaluates
11548 the @var{n}th stack entry.
11549
11550 @cindex @code{e} variable
11551 @cindex @code{pi} variable
11552 @cindex @code{i} variable
11553 @cindex @code{phi} variable
11554 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
11555 @vindex e
11556 @vindex pi
11557 @vindex i
11558 @vindex phi
11559 @vindex gamma
11560 A few variables are called @dfn{special constants}. Their names are
11561 @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi}, and @samp{gamma}.
11562 (@xref{Scientific Functions}.) When they are evaluated with @kbd{=},
11563 their values are calculated if necessary according to the current precision
11564 or complex polar mode. If you wish to use these symbols for other purposes,
11565 simply undefine or redefine them using @code{calc-store}.
11566
11567 The variables @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} stand for
11568 infinite or indeterminate values. It's best not to use them as
11569 regular variables, since Calc uses special algebraic rules when
11570 it manipulates them. Calc displays a warning message if you store
11571 a value into any of these special variables.
11572
11573 @xref{Store and Recall}, for a discussion of commands dealing with variables.
11574
11575 @node Formulas, , Variables, Data Types
11576 @section Formulas
11577
11578 @noindent
11579 @cindex Formulas
11580 @cindex Expressions
11581 @cindex Operators in formulas
11582 @cindex Precedence of operators
11583 When you press the apostrophe key you may enter any expression or formula
11584 in algebraic form. (Calc uses the terms ``expression'' and ``formula''
11585 interchangeably.) An expression is built up of numbers, variable names,
11586 and function calls, combined with various arithmetic operators.
11587 Parentheses may
11588 be used to indicate grouping. Spaces are ignored within formulas, except
11589 that spaces are not permitted within variable names or numbers.
11590 Arithmetic operators, in order from highest to lowest precedence, and
11591 with their equivalent function names, are:
11592
11593 @samp{_} [@code{subscr}] (subscripts);
11594
11595 postfix @samp{%} [@code{percent}] (as in @samp{25% = 0.25});
11596
11597 prefix @samp{!} [@code{lnot}] (logical ``not,'' as in @samp{!x});
11598
11599 @samp{+/-} [@code{sdev}] (the standard deviation symbol) and
11600 @samp{mod} [@code{makemod}] (the symbol for modulo forms);
11601
11602 postfix @samp{!} [@code{fact}] (factorial, as in @samp{n!})
11603 and postfix @samp{!!} [@code{dfact}] (double factorial);
11604
11605 @samp{^} [@code{pow}] (raised-to-the-power-of);
11606
11607 prefix @samp{+} and @samp{-} [@code{neg}] (as in @samp{-x});
11608
11609 @samp{*} [@code{mul}];
11610
11611 @samp{/} [@code{div}], @samp{%} [@code{mod}] (modulo), and
11612 @samp{\} [@code{idiv}] (integer division);
11613
11614 infix @samp{+} [@code{add}] and @samp{-} [@code{sub}] (as in @samp{x-y});
11615
11616 @samp{|} [@code{vconcat}] (vector concatenation);
11617
11618 relations @samp{=} [@code{eq}], @samp{!=} [@code{neq}], @samp{<} [@code{lt}],
11619 @samp{>} [@code{gt}], @samp{<=} [@code{leq}], and @samp{>=} [@code{geq}];
11620
11621 @samp{&&} [@code{land}] (logical ``and'');
11622
11623 @samp{||} [@code{lor}] (logical ``or'');
11624
11625 the C-style ``if'' operator @samp{a?b:c} [@code{if}];
11626
11627 @samp{!!!} [@code{pnot}] (rewrite pattern ``not'');
11628
11629 @samp{&&&} [@code{pand}] (rewrite pattern ``and'');
11630
11631 @samp{|||} [@code{por}] (rewrite pattern ``or'');
11632
11633 @samp{:=} [@code{assign}] (for assignments and rewrite rules);
11634
11635 @samp{::} [@code{condition}] (rewrite pattern condition);
11636
11637 @samp{=>} [@code{evalto}].
11638
11639 Note that, unlike in usual computer notation, multiplication binds more
11640 strongly than division: @samp{a*b/c*d} is equivalent to
11641 @texline @math{a b \over c d}.
11642 @infoline @expr{(a*b)/(c*d)}.
11643
11644 @cindex Multiplication, implicit
11645 @cindex Implicit multiplication
11646 The multiplication sign @samp{*} may be omitted in many cases. In particular,
11647 if the righthand side is a number, variable name, or parenthesized
11648 expression, the @samp{*} may be omitted. Implicit multiplication has the
11649 same precedence as the explicit @samp{*} operator. The one exception to
11650 the rule is that a variable name followed by a parenthesized expression,
11651 as in @samp{f(x)},
11652 is interpreted as a function call, not an implicit @samp{*}. In many
11653 cases you must use a space if you omit the @samp{*}: @samp{2a} is the
11654 same as @samp{2*a}, and @samp{a b} is the same as @samp{a*b}, but @samp{ab}
11655 is a variable called @code{ab}, @emph{not} the product of @samp{a} and
11656 @samp{b}! Also note that @samp{f (x)} is still a function call.
11657
11658 @cindex Implicit comma in vectors
11659 The rules are slightly different for vectors written with square brackets.
11660 In vectors, the space character is interpreted (like the comma) as a
11661 separator of elements of the vector. Thus @w{@samp{[ 2a b+c d ]}} is
11662 equivalent to @samp{[2*a, b+c, d]}, whereas @samp{2a b+c d} is equivalent
11663 to @samp{2*a*b + c*d}.
11664 Note that spaces around the brackets, and around explicit commas, are
11665 ignored. To force spaces to be interpreted as multiplication you can
11666 enclose a formula in parentheses as in @samp{[(a b) 2(c d)]}, which is
11667 interpreted as @samp{[a*b, 2*c*d]}. An implicit comma is also inserted
11668 between @samp{][}, as in the matrix @samp{[[1 2][3 4]]}.
11669
11670 Vectors that contain commas (not embedded within nested parentheses or
11671 brackets) do not treat spaces specially: @samp{[a b, 2 c d]} is a vector
11672 of two elements. Also, if it would be an error to treat spaces as
11673 separators, but not otherwise, then Calc will ignore spaces:
11674 @w{@samp{[a - b]}} is a vector of one element, but @w{@samp{[a -b]}} is
11675 a vector of two elements. Finally, vectors entered with curly braces
11676 instead of square brackets do not give spaces any special treatment.
11677 When Calc displays a vector that does not contain any commas, it will
11678 insert parentheses if necessary to make the meaning clear:
11679 @w{@samp{[(a b)]}}.
11680
11681 The expression @samp{5%-2} is ambiguous; is this five-percent minus two,
11682 or five modulo minus-two? Calc always interprets the leftmost symbol as
11683 an infix operator preferentially (modulo, in this case), so you would
11684 need to write @samp{(5%)-2} to get the former interpretation.
11685
11686 @cindex Function call notation
11687 A function call is, e.g., @samp{sin(1+x)}. (The Calc algebraic function
11688 @code{foo} corresponds to the Emacs Lisp function @code{calcFunc-foo},
11689 but unless you access the function from within Emacs Lisp, you don't
11690 need to worry about it.) Most mathematical Calculator commands like
11691 @code{calc-sin} have function equivalents like @code{sin}.
11692 If no Lisp function is defined for a function called by a formula, the
11693 call is left as it is during algebraic manipulation: @samp{f(x+y)} is
11694 left alone. Beware that many innocent-looking short names like @code{in}
11695 and @code{re} have predefined meanings which could surprise you; however,
11696 single letters or single letters followed by digits are always safe to
11697 use for your own function names. @xref{Function Index}.
11698
11699 In the documentation for particular commands, the notation @kbd{H S}
11700 (@code{calc-sinh}) [@code{sinh}] means that the key sequence @kbd{H S}, the
11701 command @kbd{M-x calc-sinh}, and the algebraic function @code{sinh(x)} all
11702 represent the same operation.
11703
11704 Commands that interpret (``parse'') text as algebraic formulas include
11705 algebraic entry (@kbd{'}), editing commands like @kbd{`} which parse
11706 the contents of the editing buffer when you finish, the @kbd{C-x * g}
11707 and @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} commands, the @kbd{C-y} command, the X window system
11708 ``paste'' mouse operation, and Embedded mode. All of these operations
11709 use the same rules for parsing formulas; in particular, language modes
11710 (@pxref{Language Modes}) affect them all in the same way.
11711
11712 When you read a large amount of text into the Calculator (say a vector
11713 which represents a big set of rewrite rules; @pxref{Rewrite Rules}),
11714 you may wish to include comments in the text. Calc's formula parser
11715 ignores the symbol @samp{%%} and anything following it on a line:
11716
11717 @example
11718 [ a + b, %% the sum of "a" and "b"
11719 c + d,
11720 %% last line is coming up:
11721 e + f ]
11722 @end example
11723
11724 @noindent
11725 This is parsed exactly the same as @samp{[ a + b, c + d, e + f ]}.
11726
11727 @xref{Syntax Tables}, for a way to create your own operators and other
11728 input notations. @xref{Compositions}, for a way to create new display
11729 formats.
11730
11731 @xref{Algebra}, for commands for manipulating formulas symbolically.
11732
11733 @node Stack and Trail, Mode Settings, Data Types, Top
11734 @chapter Stack and Trail Commands
11735
11736 @noindent
11737 This chapter describes the Calc commands for manipulating objects on the
11738 stack and in the trail buffer. (These commands operate on objects of any
11739 type, such as numbers, vectors, formulas, and incomplete objects.)
11740
11741 @menu
11742 * Stack Manipulation::
11743 * Editing Stack Entries::
11744 * Trail Commands::
11745 * Keep Arguments::
11746 @end menu
11747
11748 @node Stack Manipulation, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail, Stack and Trail
11749 @section Stack Manipulation Commands
11750
11751 @noindent
11752 @kindex @key{RET}
11753 @kindex @key{SPC}
11754 @pindex calc-enter
11755 @cindex Duplicating stack entries
11756 To duplicate the top object on the stack, press @key{RET} or @key{SPC}
11757 (two equivalent keys for the @code{calc-enter} command).
11758 Given a positive numeric prefix argument, these commands duplicate
11759 several elements at the top of the stack.
11760 Given a negative argument,
11761 these commands duplicate the specified element of the stack.
11762 Given an argument of zero, they duplicate the entire stack.
11763 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11764 @key{RET} creates @samp{10 20 30 30},
11765 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20 30},
11766 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 20}, and
11767 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{RET}} creates @samp{10 20 30 10 20 30}.
11768
11769 @kindex @key{LFD}
11770 @pindex calc-over
11771 The @key{LFD} (@code{calc-over}) command (on a key marked Line-Feed if you
11772 have it, else on @kbd{C-j}) is like @code{calc-enter}
11773 except that the sign of the numeric prefix argument is interpreted
11774 oppositely. Also, with no prefix argument the default argument is 2.
11775 Thus with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack, @key{LFD} and @kbd{C-u 2 @key{LFD}}
11776 are both equivalent to @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{RET}}, producing
11777 @samp{10 20 30 20}.
11778
11779 @kindex @key{DEL}
11780 @kindex C-d
11781 @pindex calc-pop
11782 @cindex Removing stack entries
11783 @cindex Deleting stack entries
11784 To remove the top element from the stack, press @key{DEL} (@code{calc-pop}).
11785 The @kbd{C-d} key is a synonym for @key{DEL}.
11786 (If the top element is an incomplete object with at least one element, the
11787 last element is removed from it.) Given a positive numeric prefix argument,
11788 several elements are removed. Given a negative argument, the specified
11789 element of the stack is deleted. Given an argument of zero, the entire
11790 stack is emptied.
11791 For example, with @samp{10 20 30} on the stack,
11792 @key{DEL} leaves @samp{10 20},
11793 @kbd{C-u 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10},
11794 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{DEL}} leaves @samp{10 30}, and
11795 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{DEL}} leaves an empty stack.
11796
11797 @kindex M-@key{DEL}
11798 @pindex calc-pop-above
11799 The @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} (@code{calc-pop-above}) command is to @key{DEL} what
11800 @key{LFD} is to @key{RET}: It interprets the sign of the numeric
11801 prefix argument in the opposite way, and the default argument is 2.
11802 Thus @kbd{M-@key{DEL}} by itself removes the second-from-top stack element,
11803 leaving the first, third, fourth, and so on; @kbd{M-3 M-@key{DEL}} deletes
11804 the third stack element.
11805
11806 The above commands do not depend on the location of the cursor.
11807 If the customizable variable @code{calc-context-sensitive-enter} is
11808 non-@code{nil} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), these commands will become
11809 context sensitive. For example, instead of duplicating the top of the stack,
11810 @key{RET} will copy the element at the cursor to the top of the
11811 stack. With a positive numeric prefix, a copy of the element at the
11812 cursor and the appropriate number of preceding elements will be placed
11813 at the top of the stack. A negative prefix will still duplicate the
11814 specified element of the stack regardless of the cursor position.
11815 Similarly, @key{DEL} will remove the corresponding elements from the
11816 stack.
11817
11818 @kindex @key{TAB}
11819 @pindex calc-roll-down
11820 To exchange the top two elements of the stack, press @key{TAB}
11821 (@code{calc-roll-down}). Given a positive numeric prefix argument, the
11822 specified number of elements at the top of the stack are rotated downward.
11823 Given a negative argument, the entire stack is rotated downward the specified
11824 number of times. Given an argument of zero, the entire stack is reversed
11825 top-for-bottom.
11826 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11827 @key{TAB} creates @samp{10 20 30 50 40},
11828 @kbd{C-u 3 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 50 30 40},
11829 @kbd{C-u - 2 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{40 50 10 20 30}, and
11830 @kbd{C-u 0 @key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11831
11832 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
11833 @pindex calc-roll-up
11834 The command @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} (@code{calc-roll-up}) is analogous to @key{TAB}
11835 except that it rotates upward instead of downward. Also, the default
11836 with no prefix argument is to rotate the top 3 elements.
11837 For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack,
11838 @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 20 40 50 30},
11839 @kbd{C-u 4 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{10 30 40 50 20},
11840 @kbd{C-u - 2 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{30 40 50 10 20}, and
11841 @kbd{C-u 0 M-@key{TAB}} creates @samp{50 40 30 20 10}.
11842
11843 A good way to view the operation of @key{TAB} and @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} is in
11844 terms of moving a particular element to a new position in the stack.
11845 With a positive argument @var{n}, @key{TAB} moves the top stack
11846 element down to level @var{n}, making room for it by pulling all the
11847 intervening stack elements toward the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} moves the
11848 element at level @var{n} up to the top. (Compare with @key{LFD},
11849 which copies instead of moving the element in level @var{n}.)
11850
11851 With a negative argument @mathit{-@var{n}}, @key{TAB} rotates the stack
11852 to move the object in level @var{n} to the deepest place in the
11853 stack, and the object in level @mathit{@var{n}+1} to the top. @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}
11854 rotates the deepest stack element to be in level @var{n}, also
11855 putting the top stack element in level @mathit{@var{n}+1}.
11856
11857 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for a way to apply these commands to
11858 any portion of a vector or formula on the stack.
11859
11860 @kindex C-xC-t
11861 @pindex calc-transpose-lines
11862 @cindex Moving stack entries
11863 The command @kbd{C-x C-t} (@code{calc-transpose-lines}) will transpose
11864 the stack object determined by the point with the stack object at the
11865 next higher level. For example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the
11866 stack and the point on the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-x C-t}
11867 creates @samp{10 20 40 30 50}. More generally, @kbd{C-x C-t} acts on
11868 the stack objects determined by the current point (and mark) similar
11869 to how the text-mode command @code{transpose-lines} acts on
11870 lines. With argument @var{n}, @kbd{C-x C-t} will move the stack object
11871 at the level above the current point and move it past N other objects;
11872 for example, with @samp{10 20 30 40 50} on the stack and the point on
11873 the line containing @samp{30}, @kbd{C-u 2 C-x C-t} creates
11874 @samp{10 40 20 30 50}. With an argument of 0, @kbd{C-x C-t} will switch
11875 the stack objects at the levels determined by the point and the mark.
11876
11877 @node Editing Stack Entries, Trail Commands, Stack Manipulation, Stack and Trail
11878 @section Editing Stack Entries
11879
11880 @noindent
11881 @kindex `
11882 @pindex calc-edit
11883 @pindex calc-edit-finish
11884 @cindex Editing the stack with Emacs
11885 The @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command creates a temporary buffer
11886 (@file{*Calc Edit*}) for editing the top-of-stack value using regular
11887 Emacs commands. Note that @kbd{`} is a backquote, not a quote. With a
11888 numeric prefix argument, it edits the specified number of stack entries
11889 at once. (An argument of zero edits the entire stack; a negative
11890 argument edits one specific stack entry.)
11891
11892 When you are done editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish and return
11893 to Calc. The @key{RET} and @key{LFD} keys also work to finish most
11894 sorts of editing, though in some cases Calc leaves @key{RET} with its
11895 usual meaning (``insert a newline'') if it's a situation where you
11896 might want to insert new lines into the editing buffer.
11897
11898 When you finish editing, the Calculator parses the lines of text in
11899 the @file{*Calc Edit*} buffer as numbers or formulas, replaces the
11900 original stack elements in the original buffer with these new values,
11901 then kills the @file{*Calc Edit*} buffer. The original Calculator buffer
11902 continues to exist during editing, but for best results you should be
11903 careful not to change it until you have finished the edit. You can
11904 also cancel the edit by killing the buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
11905
11906 The formula is normally reevaluated as it is put onto the stack.
11907 For example, editing @samp{a + 2} to @samp{3 + 2} and pressing
11908 @kbd{C-c C-c} will push 5 on the stack. If you use @key{LFD} to
11909 finish, Calc will put the result on the stack without evaluating it.
11910
11911 If you give a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c},
11912 Calc will not kill the @file{*Calc Edit*} buffer. You can switch
11913 back to that buffer and continue editing if you wish. However, you
11914 should understand that if you initiated the edit with @kbd{`}, the
11915 @kbd{C-c C-c} operation will be programmed to replace the top of the
11916 stack with the new edited value, and it will do this even if you have
11917 rearranged the stack in the meanwhile. This is not so much of a problem
11918 with other editing commands, though, such as @kbd{s e}
11919 (@code{calc-edit-variable}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}).
11920
11921 If the @code{calc-edit} command involves more than one stack entry,
11922 each line of the @file{*Calc Edit*} buffer is interpreted as a
11923 separate formula. Otherwise, the entire buffer is interpreted as
11924 one formula, with line breaks ignored. (You can use @kbd{C-o} or
11925 @kbd{C-q C-j} to insert a newline in the buffer without pressing @key{RET}.)
11926
11927 The @kbd{`} key also works during numeric or algebraic entry. The
11928 text entered so far is moved to the @file{*Calc Edit*} buffer for
11929 more extensive editing than is convenient in the minibuffer.
11930
11931 @node Trail Commands, Keep Arguments, Editing Stack Entries, Stack and Trail
11932 @section Trail Commands
11933
11934 @noindent
11935 @cindex Trail buffer
11936 The commands for manipulating the Calc Trail buffer are two-key sequences
11937 beginning with the @kbd{t} prefix.
11938
11939 @kindex t d
11940 @pindex calc-trail-display
11941 The @kbd{t d} (@code{calc-trail-display}) command turns display of the
11942 trail on and off. Normally the trail display is toggled on if it was off,
11943 off if it was on. With a numeric prefix of zero, this command always
11944 turns the trail off; with a prefix of one, it always turns the trail on.
11945 The other trail-manipulation commands described here automatically turn
11946 the trail on. Note that when the trail is off values are still recorded
11947 there; they are simply not displayed. To set Emacs to turn the trail
11948 off by default, type @kbd{t d} and then save the mode settings with
11949 @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}).
11950
11951 @kindex t i
11952 @pindex calc-trail-in
11953 @kindex t o
11954 @pindex calc-trail-out
11955 The @kbd{t i} (@code{calc-trail-in}) and @kbd{t o}
11956 (@code{calc-trail-out}) commands switch the cursor into and out of the
11957 Calc Trail window. In practice they are rarely used, since the commands
11958 shown below are a more convenient way to move around in the
11959 trail, and they work ``by remote control'' when the cursor is still
11960 in the Calculator window.
11961
11962 @cindex Trail pointer
11963 There is a @dfn{trail pointer} which selects some entry of the trail at
11964 any given time. The trail pointer looks like a @samp{>} symbol right
11965 before the selected number. The following commands operate on the
11966 trail pointer in various ways.
11967
11968 @kindex t y
11969 @pindex calc-trail-yank
11970 @cindex Retrieving previous results
11971 The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command reads the selected value in
11972 the trail and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. It allows you to
11973 re-use any previously computed value without retyping. With a numeric
11974 prefix argument @var{n}, it yanks the value @var{n} lines above the current
11975 trail pointer.
11976
11977 @kindex t <
11978 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-left
11979 @kindex t >
11980 @pindex calc-trail-scroll-right
11981 The @kbd{t <} (@code{calc-trail-scroll-left}) and @kbd{t >}
11982 (@code{calc-trail-scroll-right}) commands horizontally scroll the trail
11983 window left or right by one half of its width.
11984
11985 @kindex t n
11986 @pindex calc-trail-next
11987 @kindex t p
11988 @pindex calc-trail-previous
11989 @kindex t f
11990 @pindex calc-trail-forward
11991 @kindex t b
11992 @pindex calc-trail-backward
11993 The @kbd{t n} (@code{calc-trail-next}) and @kbd{t p}
11994 (@code{calc-trail-previous)} commands move the trail pointer down or up
11995 one line. The @kbd{t f} (@code{calc-trail-forward}) and @kbd{t b}
11996 (@code{calc-trail-backward}) commands move the trail pointer down or up
11997 one screenful at a time. All of these commands accept numeric prefix
11998 arguments to move several lines or screenfuls at a time.
11999
12000 @kindex t [
12001 @pindex calc-trail-first
12002 @kindex t ]
12003 @pindex calc-trail-last
12004 @kindex t h
12005 @pindex calc-trail-here
12006 The @kbd{t [} (@code{calc-trail-first}) and @kbd{t ]}
12007 (@code{calc-trail-last}) commands move the trail pointer to the first or
12008 last line of the trail. The @kbd{t h} (@code{calc-trail-here}) command
12009 moves the trail pointer to the cursor position; unlike the other trail
12010 commands, @kbd{t h} works only when Calc Trail is the selected window.
12011
12012 @kindex t s
12013 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-forward
12014 @kindex t r
12015 @pindex calc-trail-isearch-backward
12016 @ifnottex
12017 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12018 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) commands perform an incremental
12019 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12020 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12021 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12022 it was when the search began.
12023 @end ifnottex
12024 @tex
12025 The @kbd{t s} (@code{calc-trail-isearch-forward}) and @kbd{t r}
12026 (@code{calc-trail-isearch-backward}) com\-mands perform an incremental
12027 search forward or backward through the trail. You can press @key{RET}
12028 to terminate the search; the trail pointer moves to the current line.
12029 If you cancel the search with @kbd{C-g}, the trail pointer stays where
12030 it was when the search began.
12031 @end tex
12032
12033 @kindex t m
12034 @pindex calc-trail-marker
12035 The @kbd{t m} (@code{calc-trail-marker}) command allows you to enter a
12036 line of text of your own choosing into the trail. The text is inserted
12037 after the line containing the trail pointer; this usually means it is
12038 added to the end of the trail. Trail markers are useful mainly as the
12039 targets for later incremental searches in the trail.
12040
12041 @kindex t k
12042 @pindex calc-trail-kill
12043 The @kbd{t k} (@code{calc-trail-kill}) command removes the selected line
12044 from the trail. The line is saved in the Emacs kill ring suitable for
12045 yanking into another buffer, but it is not easy to yank the text back
12046 into the trail buffer. With a numeric prefix argument, this command
12047 kills the @var{n} lines below or above the selected one.
12048
12049 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command is described
12050 elsewhere; @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
12051
12052 @node Keep Arguments, , Trail Commands, Stack and Trail
12053 @section Keep Arguments
12054
12055 @noindent
12056 @kindex K
12057 @pindex calc-keep-args
12058 The @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args}) command acts like a prefix for
12059 the following command. It prevents that command from removing its
12060 arguments from the stack. For example, after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 +},
12061 the stack contains the sole number 5, but after @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K +},
12062 the stack contains the arguments and the result: @samp{2 3 5}.
12063
12064 With the exception of keyboard macros, this works for all commands that
12065 take arguments off the stack. (To avoid potentially unpleasant behavior,
12066 a @kbd{K} prefix before a keyboard macro will be ignored. A @kbd{K}
12067 prefix called @emph{within} the keyboard macro will still take effect.)
12068 As another example, @kbd{K a s} simplifies a formula, pushing the
12069 simplified version of the formula onto the stack after the original
12070 formula (rather than replacing the original formula). Note that you
12071 could get the same effect by typing @kbd{@key{RET} a s}, copying the
12072 formula and then simplifying the copy. One difference is that for a very
12073 large formula the time taken to format the intermediate copy in
12074 @kbd{@key{RET} a s} could be noticeable; @kbd{K a s} would avoid this
12075 extra work.
12076
12077 Even stack manipulation commands are affected. @key{TAB} works by
12078 popping two values and pushing them back in the opposite order,
12079 so @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 K @key{TAB}} produces @samp{2 3 3 2}.
12080
12081 A few Calc commands provide other ways of doing the same thing.
12082 For example, @kbd{' sin($)} replaces the number on the stack with
12083 its sine using algebraic entry; to push the sine and keep the
12084 original argument you could use either @kbd{' sin($1)} or
12085 @kbd{K ' sin($)}. @xref{Algebraic Entry}. Also, the @kbd{s s}
12086 command is effectively the same as @kbd{K s t}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
12087
12088 If you execute a command and then decide you really wanted to keep
12089 the argument, you can press @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
12090 This command pushes the last arguments that were popped by any command
12091 onto the stack. Note that the order of things on the stack will be
12092 different than with @kbd{K}: @kbd{2 @key{RET} 3 + M-@key{RET}} leaves
12093 @samp{5 2 3} on the stack instead of @samp{2 3 5}. @xref{Undo}.
12094
12095 @node Mode Settings, Arithmetic, Stack and Trail, Top
12096 @chapter Mode Settings
12097
12098 @noindent
12099 This chapter describes commands that set modes in the Calculator.
12100 They do not affect the contents of the stack, although they may change
12101 the @emph{appearance} or @emph{interpretation} of the stack's contents.
12102
12103 @menu
12104 * General Mode Commands::
12105 * Precision::
12106 * Inverse and Hyperbolic::
12107 * Calculation Modes::
12108 * Simplification Modes::
12109 * Declarations::
12110 * Display Modes::
12111 * Language Modes::
12112 * Modes Variable::
12113 * Calc Mode Line::
12114 @end menu
12115
12116 @node General Mode Commands, Precision, Mode Settings, Mode Settings
12117 @section General Mode Commands
12118
12119 @noindent
12120 @kindex m m
12121 @pindex calc-save-modes
12122 @cindex Continuous memory
12123 @cindex Saving mode settings
12124 @cindex Permanent mode settings
12125 @cindex Calc init file, mode settings
12126 You can save all of the current mode settings in your Calc init file
12127 (the file given by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
12128 @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}) with the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes})
12129 command. This will cause Emacs to reestablish these modes each time
12130 it starts up. The modes saved in the file include everything
12131 controlled by the @kbd{m} and @kbd{d} prefix keys, the current
12132 precision and binary word size, whether or not the trail is displayed,
12133 the current height of the Calc window, and more. The current
12134 interface (used when you type @kbd{C-x * *}) is also saved. If there
12135 were already saved mode settings in the file, they are replaced.
12136 Otherwise, the new mode information is appended to the end of the
12137 file.
12138
12139 @kindex m R
12140 @pindex calc-mode-record-mode
12141 The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command tells Calc to
12142 record all the mode settings (as if by pressing @kbd{m m}) every
12143 time a mode setting changes. If the modes are saved this way, then this
12144 ``automatic mode recording'' mode is also saved.
12145 Type @kbd{m R} again to disable this method of recording the mode
12146 settings. To turn it off permanently, the @kbd{m m} command will also be
12147 necessary. (If Embedded mode is enabled, other options for recording
12148 the modes are available; @pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
12149
12150 @kindex m F
12151 @pindex calc-settings-file-name
12152 The @kbd{m F} (@code{calc-settings-file-name}) command allows you to
12153 choose a different file than the current value of @code{calc-settings-file}
12154 for @kbd{m m}, @kbd{Z P}, and similar commands to save permanent information.
12155 You are prompted for a file name. All Calc modes are then reset to
12156 their default values, then settings from the file you named are loaded
12157 if this file exists, and this file becomes the one that Calc will
12158 use in the future for commands like @kbd{m m}. The default settings
12159 file name is @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}. You can see the current file name by
12160 giving a blank response to the @kbd{m F} prompt. See also the
12161 discussion of the @code{calc-settings-file} variable; @pxref{Customizing Calc}.
12162
12163 If the file name you give is your user init file (typically
12164 @file{~/.emacs}), @kbd{m F} will not automatically load the new file. This
12165 is because your user init file may contain other things you don't want
12166 to reread. You can give
12167 a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{m F} to force it to read the
12168 file no matter what. Conversely, an argument of @mathit{-1} tells
12169 @kbd{m F} @emph{not} to read the new file. An argument of 2 or @mathit{-2}
12170 tells @kbd{m F} not to reset the modes to their defaults beforehand,
12171 which is useful if you intend your new file to have a variant of the
12172 modes present in the file you were using before.
12173
12174 @kindex m x
12175 @pindex calc-always-load-extensions
12176 The @kbd{m x} (@code{calc-always-load-extensions}) command enables a mode
12177 in which the first use of Calc loads the entire program, including all
12178 extensions modules. Otherwise, the extensions modules will not be loaded
12179 until the various advanced Calc features are used. Since this mode only
12180 has effect when Calc is first loaded, @kbd{m x} is usually followed by
12181 @kbd{m m} to make the mode-setting permanent. To load all of Calc just
12182 once, rather than always in the future, you can press @kbd{C-x * L}.
12183
12184 @kindex m S
12185 @pindex calc-shift-prefix
12186 The @kbd{m S} (@code{calc-shift-prefix}) command enables a mode in which
12187 all of Calc's letter prefix keys may be typed shifted as well as unshifted.
12188 If you are typing, say, @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) quite often
12189 you might find it easier to turn this mode on so that you can type
12190 @kbd{A S} instead. When this mode is enabled, the commands that used to
12191 be on those single shifted letters (e.g., @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs})) can
12192 now be invoked by pressing the shifted letter twice: @kbd{A A}. Note
12193 that the @kbd{v} prefix key always works both shifted and unshifted, and
12194 the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z} prefix keys are always distinct. Also, the @kbd{h}
12195 prefix is not affected by this mode. Press @kbd{m S} again to disable
12196 shifted-prefix mode.
12197
12198 @node Precision, Inverse and Hyperbolic, General Mode Commands, Mode Settings
12199 @section Precision
12200
12201 @noindent
12202 @kindex p
12203 @pindex calc-precision
12204 @cindex Precision of calculations
12205 The @kbd{p} (@code{calc-precision}) command controls the precision to
12206 which floating-point calculations are carried. The precision must be
12207 at least 3 digits and may be arbitrarily high, within the limits of
12208 memory and time. This affects only floats: Integer and rational
12209 calculations are always carried out with as many digits as necessary.
12210
12211 The @kbd{p} key prompts for the current precision. If you wish you
12212 can instead give the precision as a numeric prefix argument.
12213
12214 Many internal calculations are carried to one or two digits higher
12215 precision than normal. Results are rounded down afterward to the
12216 current precision. Unless a special display mode has been selected,
12217 floats are always displayed with their full stored precision, i.e.,
12218 what you see is what you get. Reducing the current precision does not
12219 round values already on the stack, but those values will be rounded
12220 down before being used in any calculation. The @kbd{c 0} through
12221 @kbd{c 9} commands (@pxref{Conversions}) can be used to round an
12222 existing value to a new precision.
12223
12224 @cindex Accuracy of calculations
12225 It is important to distinguish the concepts of @dfn{precision} and
12226 @dfn{accuracy}. In the normal usage of these words, the number
12227 123.4567 has a precision of 7 digits but an accuracy of 4 digits.
12228 The precision is the total number of digits not counting leading
12229 or trailing zeros (regardless of the position of the decimal point).
12230 The accuracy is simply the number of digits after the decimal point
12231 (again not counting trailing zeros). In Calc you control the precision,
12232 not the accuracy of computations. If you were to set the accuracy
12233 instead, then calculations like @samp{exp(100)} would generate many
12234 more digits than you would typically need, while @samp{exp(-100)} would
12235 probably round to zero! In Calc, both these computations give you
12236 exactly 12 (or the requested number of) significant digits.
12237
12238 The only Calc features that deal with accuracy instead of precision
12239 are fixed-point display mode for floats (@kbd{d f}; @pxref{Float Formats}),
12240 and the rounding functions like @code{floor} and @code{round}
12241 (@pxref{Integer Truncation}). Also, @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}
12242 deal with both precision and accuracy depending on the magnitudes
12243 of the numbers involved.
12244
12245 If you need to work with a particular fixed accuracy (say, dollars and
12246 cents with two digits after the decimal point), one solution is to work
12247 with integers and an ``implied'' decimal point. For example, $8.99
12248 divided by 6 would be entered @kbd{899 @key{RET} 6 /}, yielding 149.833
12249 (actually $1.49833 with our implied decimal point); pressing @kbd{R}
12250 would round this to 150 cents, i.e., $1.50.
12251
12252 @xref{Floats}, for still more on floating-point precision and related
12253 issues.
12254
12255 @node Inverse and Hyperbolic, Calculation Modes, Precision, Mode Settings
12256 @section Inverse and Hyperbolic Flags
12257
12258 @noindent
12259 @kindex I
12260 @pindex calc-inverse
12261 There is no single-key equivalent to the @code{calc-arcsin} function.
12262 Instead, you must first press @kbd{I} (@code{calc-inverse}) to set
12263 the @dfn{Inverse Flag}, then press @kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}).
12264 The @kbd{I} key actually toggles the Inverse Flag. When this flag
12265 is set, the word @samp{Inv} appears in the mode line.
12266
12267 @kindex H
12268 @pindex calc-hyperbolic
12269 Likewise, the @kbd{H} key (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) sets or clears the
12270 Hyperbolic Flag, which transforms @code{calc-sin} into @code{calc-sinh}.
12271 If both of these flags are set at once, the effect will be
12272 @code{calc-arcsinh}. (The Hyperbolic flag is also used by some
12273 non-trigonometric commands; for example @kbd{H L} computes a base-10,
12274 instead of base-@mathit{e}, logarithm.)
12275
12276 Command names like @code{calc-arcsin} are provided for completeness, and
12277 may be executed with @kbd{x} or @kbd{M-x}. Their effect is simply to
12278 toggle the Inverse and/or Hyperbolic flags and then execute the
12279 corresponding base command (@code{calc-sin} in this case).
12280
12281 @kindex O
12282 @pindex calc-option
12283 The @kbd{O} key (@code{calc-option}) sets another flag, the
12284 @dfn{Option Flag}, which also can alter the subsequent Calc command in
12285 various ways.
12286
12287 The Inverse, Hyperbolic and Option flags apply only to the next
12288 Calculator command, after which they are automatically cleared. (They
12289 are also cleared if the next keystroke is not a Calc command.) Digits
12290 you type after @kbd{I}, @kbd{H} or @kbd{O} (or @kbd{K}) are treated as
12291 prefix arguments for the next command, not as numeric entries. The
12292 same is true of @kbd{C-u}, but not of the minus sign (@kbd{K -} means
12293 to subtract and keep arguments).
12294
12295 Another Calc prefix flag, @kbd{K} (keep-arguments), is discussed
12296 elsewhere. @xref{Keep Arguments}.
12297
12298 @node Calculation Modes, Simplification Modes, Inverse and Hyperbolic, Mode Settings
12299 @section Calculation Modes
12300
12301 @noindent
12302 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with
12303 the @kbd{m} prefix. (That's the letter @kbd{m}, not the @key{META} key.)
12304 The @samp{m a} (@code{calc-algebraic-mode}) command is described elsewhere
12305 (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
12306
12307 @menu
12308 * Angular Modes::
12309 * Polar Mode::
12310 * Fraction Mode::
12311 * Infinite Mode::
12312 * Symbolic Mode::
12313 * Matrix Mode::
12314 * Automatic Recomputation::
12315 * Working Message::
12316 @end menu
12317
12318 @node Angular Modes, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes, Calculation Modes
12319 @subsection Angular Modes
12320
12321 @noindent
12322 @cindex Angular mode
12323 The Calculator supports three notations for angles: radians, degrees,
12324 and degrees-minutes-seconds. When a number is presented to a function
12325 like @code{sin} that requires an angle, the current angular mode is
12326 used to interpret the number as either radians or degrees. If an HMS
12327 form is presented to @code{sin}, it is always interpreted as
12328 degrees-minutes-seconds.
12329
12330 Functions that compute angles produce a number in radians, a number in
12331 degrees, or an HMS form depending on the current angular mode. If the
12332 result is a complex number and the current mode is HMS, the number is
12333 instead expressed in degrees. (Complex-number calculations would
12334 normally be done in Radians mode, though. Complex numbers are converted
12335 to degrees by calculating the complex result in radians and then
12336 multiplying by 180 over @cpi{}.)
12337
12338 @kindex m r
12339 @pindex calc-radians-mode
12340 @kindex m d
12341 @pindex calc-degrees-mode
12342 @kindex m h
12343 @pindex calc-hms-mode
12344 The @kbd{m r} (@code{calc-radians-mode}), @kbd{m d} (@code{calc-degrees-mode}),
12345 and @kbd{m h} (@code{calc-hms-mode}) commands control the angular mode.
12346 The current angular mode is displayed on the Emacs mode line.
12347 The default angular mode is Degrees.
12348
12349 @node Polar Mode, Fraction Mode, Angular Modes, Calculation Modes
12350 @subsection Polar Mode
12351
12352 @noindent
12353 @cindex Polar mode
12354 The Calculator normally ``prefers'' rectangular complex numbers in the
12355 sense that rectangular form is used when the proper form can not be
12356 decided from the input. This might happen by multiplying a rectangular
12357 number by a polar one, by taking the square root of a negative real
12358 number, or by entering @kbd{( 2 @key{SPC} 3 )}.
12359
12360 @kindex m p
12361 @pindex calc-polar-mode
12362 The @kbd{m p} (@code{calc-polar-mode}) command toggles complex-number
12363 preference between rectangular and polar forms. In Polar mode, all
12364 of the above example situations would produce polar complex numbers.
12365
12366 @node Fraction Mode, Infinite Mode, Polar Mode, Calculation Modes
12367 @subsection Fraction Mode
12368
12369 @noindent
12370 @cindex Fraction mode
12371 @cindex Division of integers
12372 Division of two integers normally yields a floating-point number if the
12373 result cannot be expressed as an integer. In some cases you would
12374 rather get an exact fractional answer. One way to accomplish this is
12375 to use the @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command, which
12376 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fraction:
12377 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 :} produces @expr{3:2} even though
12378 @kbd{6 @key{RET} 4 /} produces @expr{1.5}.
12379
12380 @kindex m f
12381 @pindex calc-frac-mode
12382 To set the Calculator to produce fractional results for normal integer
12383 divisions, use the @kbd{m f} (@code{calc-frac-mode}) command.
12384 For example, @expr{8/4} produces @expr{2} in either mode,
12385 but @expr{6/4} produces @expr{3:2} in Fraction mode, @expr{1.5} in
12386 Float mode.
12387
12388 At any time you can use @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) to convert a
12389 fraction to a float, or @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) to convert a
12390 float to a fraction. @xref{Conversions}.
12391
12392 @node Infinite Mode, Symbolic Mode, Fraction Mode, Calculation Modes
12393 @subsection Infinite Mode
12394
12395 @noindent
12396 @cindex Infinite mode
12397 The Calculator normally treats results like @expr{1 / 0} as errors;
12398 formulas like this are left in unsimplified form. But Calc can be
12399 put into a mode where such calculations instead produce ``infinite''
12400 results.
12401
12402 @kindex m i
12403 @pindex calc-infinite-mode
12404 The @kbd{m i} (@code{calc-infinite-mode}) command turns this mode
12405 on and off. When the mode is off, infinities do not arise except
12406 in calculations that already had infinities as inputs. (One exception
12407 is that infinite open intervals like @samp{[0 .. inf)} can be
12408 generated; however, intervals closed at infinity (@samp{[0 .. inf]})
12409 will not be generated when Infinite mode is off.)
12410
12411 With Infinite mode turned on, @samp{1 / 0} will generate @code{uinf},
12412 an undirected infinity. @xref{Infinities}, for a discussion of the
12413 difference between @code{inf} and @code{uinf}. Also, @expr{0 / 0}
12414 evaluates to @code{nan}, the ``indeterminate'' symbol. Various other
12415 functions can also return infinities in this mode; for example,
12416 @samp{ln(0) = -inf}, and @samp{gamma(-7) = uinf}. Once again,
12417 note that @samp{exp(inf) = inf} regardless of Infinite mode because
12418 this calculation has infinity as an input.
12419
12420 @cindex Positive Infinite mode
12421 The @kbd{m i} command with a numeric prefix argument of zero,
12422 i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 m i}, turns on a Positive Infinite mode in
12423 which zero is treated as positive instead of being directionless.
12424 Thus, @samp{1 / 0 = inf} and @samp{-1 / 0 = -inf} in this mode.
12425 Note that zero never actually has a sign in Calc; there are no
12426 separate representations for @mathit{+0} and @mathit{-0}. Positive
12427 Infinite mode merely changes the interpretation given to the
12428 single symbol, @samp{0}. One consequence of this is that, while
12429 you might expect @samp{1 / -0 = -inf}, actually @samp{1 / -0}
12430 is equivalent to @samp{1 / 0}, which is equal to positive @code{inf}.
12431
12432 @node Symbolic Mode, Matrix Mode, Infinite Mode, Calculation Modes
12433 @subsection Symbolic Mode
12434
12435 @noindent
12436 @cindex Symbolic mode
12437 @cindex Inexact results
12438 Calculations are normally performed numerically wherever possible.
12439 For example, the @code{calc-sqrt} command, or @code{sqrt} function in an
12440 algebraic expression, produces a numeric answer if the argument is a
12441 number or a symbolic expression if the argument is an expression:
12442 @kbd{2 Q} pushes 1.4142 but @kbd{@key{'} x+1 @key{RET} Q} pushes @samp{sqrt(x+1)}.
12443
12444 @kindex m s
12445 @pindex calc-symbolic-mode
12446 In @dfn{Symbolic mode}, controlled by the @kbd{m s} (@code{calc-symbolic-mode})
12447 command, functions which would produce inexact, irrational results are
12448 left in symbolic form. Thus @kbd{16 Q} pushes 4, but @kbd{2 Q} pushes
12449 @samp{sqrt(2)}.
12450
12451 @kindex N
12452 @pindex calc-eval-num
12453 The shift-@kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) command evaluates numerically
12454 the expression at the top of the stack, by temporarily disabling
12455 @code{calc-symbolic-mode} and executing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
12456 Given a numeric prefix argument, it also
12457 sets the floating-point precision to the specified value for the duration
12458 of the command.
12459
12460 To evaluate a formula numerically without expanding the variables it
12461 contains, you can use the key sequence @kbd{m s a v m s} (this uses
12462 @code{calc-alg-evaluate}, which resimplifies but doesn't evaluate
12463 variables.)
12464
12465 @node Matrix Mode, Automatic Recomputation, Symbolic Mode, Calculation Modes
12466 @subsection Matrix and Scalar Modes
12467
12468 @noindent
12469 @cindex Matrix mode
12470 @cindex Scalar mode
12471 Calc sometimes makes assumptions during algebraic manipulation that
12472 are awkward or incorrect when vectors and matrices are involved.
12473 Calc has two modes, @dfn{Matrix mode} and @dfn{Scalar mode}, which
12474 modify its behavior around vectors in useful ways.
12475
12476 @kindex m v
12477 @pindex calc-matrix-mode
12478 Press @kbd{m v} (@code{calc-matrix-mode}) once to enter Matrix mode.
12479 In this mode, all objects are assumed to be matrices unless provably
12480 otherwise. One major effect is that Calc will no longer consider
12481 multiplication to be commutative. (Recall that in matrix arithmetic,
12482 @samp{A*B} is not the same as @samp{B*A}.) This assumption affects
12483 rewrite rules and algebraic simplification. Another effect of this
12484 mode is that calculations that would normally produce constants like
12485 0 and 1 (e.g., @expr{a - a} and @expr{a / a}, respectively) will now
12486 produce function calls that represent ``generic'' zero or identity
12487 matrices: @samp{idn(0)}, @samp{idn(1)}. The @code{idn} function
12488 @samp{idn(@var{a},@var{n})} returns @var{a} times an @var{n}x@var{n}
12489 identity matrix; if @var{n} is omitted, it doesn't know what
12490 dimension to use and so the @code{idn} call remains in symbolic
12491 form. However, if this generic identity matrix is later combined
12492 with a matrix whose size is known, it will be converted into
12493 a true identity matrix of the appropriate size. On the other hand,
12494 if it is combined with a scalar (as in @samp{idn(1) + 2}), Calc
12495 will assume it really was a scalar after all and produce, e.g., 3.
12496
12497 Press @kbd{m v} a second time to get Scalar mode. Here, objects are
12498 assumed @emph{not} to be vectors or matrices unless provably so.
12499 For example, normally adding a variable to a vector, as in
12500 @samp{[x, y, z] + a}, will leave the sum in symbolic form because
12501 as far as Calc knows, @samp{a} could represent either a number or
12502 another 3-vector. In Scalar mode, @samp{a} is assumed to be a
12503 non-vector, and the addition is evaluated to @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]}.
12504
12505 Press @kbd{m v} a third time to return to the normal mode of operation.
12506
12507 If you press @kbd{m v} with a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, you
12508 get a special ``dimensioned'' Matrix mode in which matrices of
12509 unknown size are assumed to be @var{n}x@var{n} square matrices.
12510 Then, the function call @samp{idn(1)} will expand into an actual
12511 matrix rather than representing a ``generic'' matrix. Simply typing
12512 @kbd{C-u m v} will get you a square Matrix mode, in which matrices of
12513 unknown size are assumed to be square matrices of unspecified size.
12514
12515 @cindex Declaring scalar variables
12516 Of course these modes are approximations to the true state of
12517 affairs, which is probably that some quantities will be matrices
12518 and others will be scalars. One solution is to ``declare''
12519 certain variables or functions to be scalar-valued.
12520 @xref{Declarations}, to see how to make declarations in Calc.
12521
12522 There is nothing stopping you from declaring a variable to be
12523 scalar and then storing a matrix in it; however, if you do, the
12524 results you get from Calc may not be valid. Suppose you let Calc
12525 get the result @samp{[x+a, y+a, z+a]} shown above, and then stored
12526 @samp{[1, 2, 3]} in @samp{a}. The result would not be the same as
12527 for @samp{[x, y, z] + [1, 2, 3]}, but that's because you have broken
12528 your earlier promise to Calc that @samp{a} would be scalar.
12529
12530 Another way to mix scalars and matrices is to use selections
12531 (@pxref{Selecting Subformulas}). Use Matrix mode when operating on
12532 your formula normally; then, to apply Scalar mode to a certain part
12533 of the formula without affecting the rest just select that part,
12534 change into Scalar mode and press @kbd{=} to resimplify the part
12535 under this mode, then change back to Matrix mode before deselecting.
12536
12537 @node Automatic Recomputation, Working Message, Matrix Mode, Calculation Modes
12538 @subsection Automatic Recomputation
12539
12540 @noindent
12541 The @dfn{evaluates-to} operator, @samp{=>}, has the special
12542 property that any @samp{=>} formulas on the stack are recomputed
12543 whenever variable values or mode settings that might affect them
12544 are changed. @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}.
12545
12546 @kindex m C
12547 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
12548 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns this
12549 automatic recomputation on and off. If you turn it off, Calc will
12550 not update @samp{=>} operators on the stack (nor those in the
12551 attached Embedded mode buffer, if there is one). They will not
12552 be updated unless you explicitly do so by pressing @kbd{=} or until
12553 you press @kbd{m C} to turn recomputation back on. (While automatic
12554 recomputation is off, you can think of @kbd{m C m C} as a command
12555 to update all @samp{=>} operators while leaving recomputation off.)
12556
12557 To update @samp{=>} operators in an Embedded buffer while
12558 automatic recomputation is off, use @w{@kbd{C-x * u}}.
12559 @xref{Embedded Mode}.
12560
12561 @node Working Message, , Automatic Recomputation, Calculation Modes
12562 @subsection Working Messages
12563
12564 @noindent
12565 @cindex Performance
12566 @cindex Working messages
12567 Since the Calculator is written entirely in Emacs Lisp, which is not
12568 designed for heavy numerical work, many operations are quite slow.
12569 The Calculator normally displays the message @samp{Working...} in the
12570 echo area during any command that may be slow. In addition, iterative
12571 operations such as square roots and trigonometric functions display the
12572 intermediate result at each step. Both of these types of messages can
12573 be disabled if you find them distracting.
12574
12575 @kindex m w
12576 @pindex calc-working
12577 Type @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) with a numeric prefix of 0 to
12578 disable all ``working'' messages. Use a numeric prefix of 1 to enable
12579 only the plain @samp{Working...} message. Use a numeric prefix of 2 to
12580 see intermediate results as well. With no numeric prefix this displays
12581 the current mode.
12582
12583 While it may seem that the ``working'' messages will slow Calc down
12584 considerably, experiments have shown that their impact is actually
12585 quite small. But if your terminal is slow you may find that it helps
12586 to turn the messages off.
12587
12588 @node Simplification Modes, Declarations, Calculation Modes, Mode Settings
12589 @section Simplification Modes
12590
12591 @noindent
12592 The current @dfn{simplification mode} controls how numbers and formulas
12593 are ``normalized'' when being taken from or pushed onto the stack.
12594 Some normalizations are unavoidable, such as rounding floating-point
12595 results to the current precision, and reducing fractions to simplest
12596 form. Others, such as simplifying a formula like @expr{a+a} (or @expr{2+3}),
12597 are done automatically but can be turned off when necessary.
12598
12599 When you press a key like @kbd{+} when @expr{2} and @expr{3} are on the
12600 stack, Calc pops these numbers, normalizes them, creates the formula
12601 @expr{2+3}, normalizes it, and pushes the result. Of course the standard
12602 rules for normalizing @expr{2+3} will produce the result @expr{5}.
12603
12604 Simplification mode commands consist of the lower-case @kbd{m} prefix key
12605 followed by a shifted letter.
12606
12607 @kindex m O
12608 @pindex calc-no-simplify-mode
12609 The @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) command turns off all optional
12610 simplifications. These would leave a formula like @expr{2+3} alone. In
12611 fact, nothing except simple numbers are ever affected by normalization
12612 in this mode. Explicit simplification commands, such as @kbd{=} or
12613 @kbd{a s}, can still be given to simplify any formulas.
12614 @xref{Algebraic Definitions}, for a sample use of
12615 No-Simplification mode.
12616
12617
12618 @kindex m N
12619 @pindex calc-num-simplify-mode
12620 The @kbd{m N} (@code{calc-num-simplify-mode}) command turns off simplification
12621 of any formulas except those for which all arguments are constants. For
12622 example, @expr{1+2} is simplified to @expr{3}, and @expr{a+(2-2)} is
12623 simplified to @expr{a+0} but no further, since one argument of the sum
12624 is not a constant. Unfortunately, @expr{(a+2)-2} is @emph{not} simplified
12625 because the top-level @samp{-} operator's arguments are not both
12626 constant numbers (one of them is the formula @expr{a+2}).
12627 A constant is a number or other numeric object (such as a constant
12628 error form or modulo form), or a vector all of whose
12629 elements are constant.
12630
12631 @kindex m I
12632 @pindex calc-basic-simplify-mode
12633 The @kbd{m I} (@code{calc-basic-simplify-mode}) command does some basic
12634 simplifications for all formulas. This includes many easy and
12635 fast algebraic simplifications such as @expr{a+0} to @expr{a}, and
12636 @expr{a + 2 a} to @expr{3 a}, as well as evaluating functions like
12637 @expr{@tfn{deriv}(x^2, x)} to @expr{2 x}.
12638
12639 @kindex m B
12640 @pindex calc-bin-simplify-mode
12641 The @kbd{m B} (@code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}) mode applies the basic
12642 simplifications to a result and then, if the result is an integer,
12643 uses the @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip}) command to clip the integer according
12644 to the current binary word size. @xref{Binary Functions}. Real numbers
12645 are rounded to the nearest integer and then clipped; other kinds of
12646 results (after the basic simplifications) are left alone.
12647
12648 @kindex m A
12649 @pindex calc-alg-simplify-mode
12650 The @kbd{m A} (@code{calc-alg-simplify-mode}) mode does standard
12651 algebraic simplifications. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
12652
12653 @kindex m E
12654 @pindex calc-ext-simplify-mode
12655 The @kbd{m E} (@code{calc-ext-simplify-mode}) mode does ``extended'', or
12656 ``unsafe'', algebraic simplification. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
12657
12658 @kindex m U
12659 @pindex calc-units-simplify-mode
12660 The @kbd{m U} (@code{calc-units-simplify-mode}) mode does units
12661 simplification. @xref{Simplification of Units}. These include the
12662 algebraic simplifications, plus variable names which
12663 are identifiable as unit names (like @samp{mm} for ``millimeters'')
12664 are simplified with their unit definitions in mind.
12665
12666 A common technique is to set the simplification mode down to the lowest
12667 amount of simplification you will allow to be applied automatically, then
12668 use manual commands like @kbd{a s} and @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) to
12669 perform higher types of simplifications on demand.
12670 @node Declarations, Display Modes, Simplification Modes, Mode Settings
12671 @section Declarations
12672
12673 @noindent
12674 A @dfn{declaration} is a statement you make that promises you will
12675 use a certain variable or function in a restricted way. This may
12676 give Calc the freedom to do things that it couldn't do if it had to
12677 take the fully general situation into account.
12678
12679 @menu
12680 * Declaration Basics::
12681 * Kinds of Declarations::
12682 * Functions for Declarations::
12683 @end menu
12684
12685 @node Declaration Basics, Kinds of Declarations, Declarations, Declarations
12686 @subsection Declaration Basics
12687
12688 @noindent
12689 @kindex s d
12690 @pindex calc-declare-variable
12691 The @kbd{s d} (@code{calc-declare-variable}) command is the easiest
12692 way to make a declaration for a variable. This command prompts for
12693 the variable name, then prompts for the declaration. The default
12694 at the declaration prompt is the previous declaration, if any.
12695 You can edit this declaration, or press @kbd{C-k} to erase it and
12696 type a new declaration. (Or, erase it and press @key{RET} to clear
12697 the declaration, effectively ``undeclaring'' the variable.)
12698
12699 A declaration is in general a vector of @dfn{type symbols} and
12700 @dfn{range} values. If there is only one type symbol or range value,
12701 you can write it directly rather than enclosing it in a vector.
12702 For example, @kbd{s d foo @key{RET} real @key{RET}} declares @code{foo} to
12703 be a real number, and @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} [int, const, [1..6]] @key{RET}}
12704 declares @code{bar} to be a constant integer between 1 and 6.
12705 (Actually, you can omit the outermost brackets and Calc will
12706 provide them for you: @kbd{s d bar @key{RET} int, const, [1..6] @key{RET}}.)
12707
12708 @cindex @code{Decls} variable
12709 @vindex Decls
12710 Declarations in Calc are kept in a special variable called @code{Decls}.
12711 This variable encodes the set of all outstanding declarations in
12712 the form of a matrix. Each row has two elements: A variable or
12713 vector of variables declared by that row, and the declaration
12714 specifier as described above. You can use the @kbd{s D} command to
12715 edit this variable if you wish to see all the declarations at once.
12716 @xref{Operations on Variables}, for a description of this command
12717 and the @kbd{s p} command that allows you to save your declarations
12718 permanently if you wish.
12719
12720 Items being declared can also be function calls. The arguments in
12721 the call are ignored; the effect is to say that this function returns
12722 values of the declared type for any valid arguments. The @kbd{s d}
12723 command declares only variables, so if you wish to make a function
12724 declaration you will have to edit the @code{Decls} matrix yourself.
12725
12726 For example, the declaration matrix
12727
12728 @smallexample
12729 @group
12730 [ [ foo, real ]
12731 [ [j, k, n], int ]
12732 [ f(1,2,3), [0 .. inf) ] ]
12733 @end group
12734 @end smallexample
12735
12736 @noindent
12737 declares that @code{foo} represents a real number, @code{j}, @code{k}
12738 and @code{n} represent integers, and the function @code{f} always
12739 returns a real number in the interval shown.
12740
12741 @vindex All
12742 If there is a declaration for the variable @code{All}, then that
12743 declaration applies to all variables that are not otherwise declared.
12744 It does not apply to function names. For example, using the row
12745 @samp{[All, real]} says that all your variables are real unless they
12746 are explicitly declared without @code{real} in some other row.
12747 The @kbd{s d} command declares @code{All} if you give a blank
12748 response to the variable-name prompt.
12749
12750 @node Kinds of Declarations, Functions for Declarations, Declaration Basics, Declarations
12751 @subsection Kinds of Declarations
12752
12753 @noindent
12754 The type-specifier part of a declaration (that is, the second prompt
12755 in the @kbd{s d} command) can be a type symbol, an interval, or a
12756 vector consisting of zero or more type symbols followed by zero or
12757 more intervals or numbers that represent the set of possible values
12758 for the variable.
12759
12760 @smallexample
12761 @group
12762 [ [ a, [1, 2, 3, 4, 5] ]
12763 [ b, [1 .. 5] ]
12764 [ c, [int, 1 .. 5] ] ]
12765 @end group
12766 @end smallexample
12767
12768 Here @code{a} is declared to contain one of the five integers shown;
12769 @code{b} is any number in the interval from 1 to 5 (any real number
12770 since we haven't specified), and @code{c} is any integer in that
12771 interval. Thus the declarations for @code{a} and @code{c} are
12772 nearly equivalent (see below).
12773
12774 The type-specifier can be the empty vector @samp{[]} to say that
12775 nothing is known about a given variable's value. This is the same
12776 as not declaring the variable at all except that it overrides any
12777 @code{All} declaration which would otherwise apply.
12778
12779 The initial value of @code{Decls} is the empty vector @samp{[]}.
12780 If @code{Decls} has no stored value or if the value stored in it
12781 is not valid, it is ignored and there are no declarations as far
12782 as Calc is concerned. (The @kbd{s d} command will replace such a
12783 malformed value with a fresh empty matrix, @samp{[]}, before recording
12784 the new declaration.) Unrecognized type symbols are ignored.
12785
12786 The following type symbols describe what sorts of numbers will be
12787 stored in a variable:
12788
12789 @table @code
12790 @item int
12791 Integers.
12792 @item numint
12793 Numerical integers. (Integers or integer-valued floats.)
12794 @item frac
12795 Fractions. (Rational numbers which are not integers.)
12796 @item rat
12797 Rational numbers. (Either integers or fractions.)
12798 @item float
12799 Floating-point numbers.
12800 @item real
12801 Real numbers. (Integers, fractions, or floats. Actually,
12802 intervals and error forms with real components also count as
12803 reals here.)
12804 @item pos
12805 Positive real numbers. (Strictly greater than zero.)
12806 @item nonneg
12807 Nonnegative real numbers. (Greater than or equal to zero.)
12808 @item number
12809 Numbers. (Real or complex.)
12810 @end table
12811
12812 Calc uses this information to determine when certain simplifications
12813 of formulas are safe. For example, @samp{(x^y)^z} cannot be
12814 simplified to @samp{x^(y z)} in general; for example,
12815 @samp{((-3)^2)^1:2} is 3, but @samp{(-3)^(2*1:2) = (-3)^1} is @mathit{-3}.
12816 However, this simplification @emph{is} safe if @code{z} is known
12817 to be an integer, or if @code{x} is known to be a nonnegative
12818 real number. If you have given declarations that allow Calc to
12819 deduce either of these facts, Calc will perform this simplification
12820 of the formula.
12821
12822 Calc can apply a certain amount of logic when using declarations.
12823 For example, @samp{(x^y)^(2n+1)} will be simplified if @code{n}
12824 has been declared @code{int}; Calc knows that an integer times an
12825 integer, plus an integer, must always be an integer. (In fact,
12826 Calc would simplify @samp{(-x)^(2n+1)} to @samp{-(x^(2n+1))} since
12827 it is able to determine that @samp{2n+1} must be an odd integer.)
12828
12829 Similarly, @samp{(abs(x)^y)^z} will be simplified to @samp{abs(x)^(y z)}
12830 because Calc knows that the @code{abs} function always returns a
12831 nonnegative real. If you had a @code{myabs} function that also had
12832 this property, you could get Calc to recognize it by adding the row
12833 @samp{[myabs(), nonneg]} to the @code{Decls} matrix.
12834
12835 One instance of this simplification is @samp{sqrt(x^2)} (since the
12836 @code{sqrt} function is effectively a one-half power). Normally
12837 Calc leaves this formula alone. After the command
12838 @kbd{s d x @key{RET} real @key{RET}}, however, it can simplify the formula to
12839 @samp{abs(x)}. And after @kbd{s d x @key{RET} nonneg @key{RET}}, Calc can
12840 simplify this formula all the way to @samp{x}.
12841
12842 If there are any intervals or real numbers in the type specifier,
12843 they comprise the set of possible values that the variable or
12844 function being declared can have. In particular, the type symbol
12845 @code{real} is effectively the same as the range @samp{[-inf .. inf]}
12846 (note that infinity is included in the range of possible values);
12847 @code{pos} is the same as @samp{(0 .. inf]}, and @code{nonneg} is
12848 the same as @samp{[0 .. inf]}. Saying @samp{[real, [-5 .. 5]]} is
12849 redundant because the fact that the variable is real can be
12850 deduced just from the interval, but @samp{[int, [-5 .. 5]]} and
12851 @samp{[rat, [-5 .. 5]]} are useful combinations.
12852
12853 Note that the vector of intervals or numbers is in the same format
12854 used by Calc's set-manipulation commands. @xref{Set Operations}.
12855
12856 The type specifier @samp{[1, 2, 3]} is equivalent to
12857 @samp{[numint, 1, 2, 3]}, @emph{not} to @samp{[int, 1, 2, 3]}.
12858 In other words, the range of possible values means only that
12859 the variable's value must be numerically equal to a number in
12860 that range, but not that it must be equal in type as well.
12861 Calc's set operations act the same way; @samp{in(2, [1., 2., 3.])}
12862 and @samp{in(1.5, [1:2, 3:2, 5:2])} both report ``true.''
12863
12864 If you use a conflicting combination of type specifiers, the
12865 results are unpredictable. An example is @samp{[pos, [0 .. 5]]},
12866 where the interval does not lie in the range described by the
12867 type symbol.
12868
12869 ``Real'' declarations mostly affect simplifications involving powers
12870 like the one described above. Another case where they are used
12871 is in the @kbd{a P} command which returns a list of all roots of a
12872 polynomial; if the variable has been declared real, only the real
12873 roots (if any) will be included in the list.
12874
12875 ``Integer'' declarations are used for simplifications which are valid
12876 only when certain values are integers (such as @samp{(x^y)^z}
12877 shown above).
12878
12879 Calc's algebraic simplifications also make use of declarations when
12880 simplifying equations and inequalities. They will cancel @code{x}
12881 from both sides of @samp{a x = b x} only if it is sure @code{x}
12882 is non-zero, say, because it has a @code{pos} declaration.
12883 To declare specifically that @code{x} is real and non-zero,
12884 use @samp{[[-inf .. 0), (0 .. inf]]}. (There is no way in the
12885 current notation to say that @code{x} is nonzero but not necessarily
12886 real.) The @kbd{a e} command does ``unsafe'' simplifications,
12887 including canceling @samp{x} from the equation when @samp{x} is
12888 not known to be nonzero.
12889
12890 Another set of type symbols distinguish between scalars and vectors.
12891
12892 @table @code
12893 @item scalar
12894 The value is not a vector.
12895 @item vector
12896 The value is a vector.
12897 @item matrix
12898 The value is a matrix (a rectangular vector of vectors).
12899 @item sqmatrix
12900 The value is a square matrix.
12901 @end table
12902
12903 These type symbols can be combined with the other type symbols
12904 described above; @samp{[int, matrix]} describes an object which
12905 is a matrix of integers.
12906
12907 Scalar/vector declarations are used to determine whether certain
12908 algebraic operations are safe. For example, @samp{[a, b, c] + x}
12909 is normally not simplified to @samp{[a + x, b + x, c + x]}, but
12910 it will be if @code{x} has been declared @code{scalar}. On the
12911 other hand, multiplication is usually assumed to be commutative,
12912 but the terms in @samp{x y} will never be exchanged if both @code{x}
12913 and @code{y} are known to be vectors or matrices. (Calc currently
12914 never distinguishes between @code{vector} and @code{matrix}
12915 declarations.)
12916
12917 @xref{Matrix Mode}, for a discussion of Matrix mode and
12918 Scalar mode, which are similar to declaring @samp{[All, matrix]}
12919 or @samp{[All, scalar]} but much more convenient.
12920
12921 One more type symbol that is recognized is used with the @kbd{H a d}
12922 command for taking total derivatives of a formula. @xref{Calculus}.
12923
12924 @table @code
12925 @item const
12926 The value is a constant with respect to other variables.
12927 @end table
12928
12929 Calc does not check the declarations for a variable when you store
12930 a value in it. However, storing @mathit{-3.5} in a variable that has
12931 been declared @code{pos}, @code{int}, or @code{matrix} may have
12932 unexpected effects; Calc may evaluate @samp{sqrt(x^2)} to @expr{3.5}
12933 if it substitutes the value first, or to @expr{-3.5} if @code{x}
12934 was declared @code{pos} and the formula @samp{sqrt(x^2)} is
12935 simplified to @samp{x} before the value is substituted. Before
12936 using a variable for a new purpose, it is best to use @kbd{s d}
12937 or @kbd{s D} to check to make sure you don't still have an old
12938 declaration for the variable that will conflict with its new meaning.
12939
12940 @node Functions for Declarations, , Kinds of Declarations, Declarations
12941 @subsection Functions for Declarations
12942
12943 @noindent
12944 Calc has a set of functions for accessing the current declarations
12945 in a convenient manner. These functions return 1 if the argument
12946 can be shown to have the specified property, or 0 if the argument
12947 can be shown @emph{not} to have that property; otherwise they are
12948 left unevaluated. These functions are suitable for use with rewrite
12949 rules (@pxref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}) or programming constructs
12950 (@pxref{Conditionals in Macros}). They can be entered only using
12951 algebraic notation. @xref{Logical Operations}, for functions
12952 that perform other tests not related to declarations.
12953
12954 For example, @samp{dint(17)} returns 1 because 17 is an integer, as
12955 do @samp{dint(n)} and @samp{dint(2 n - 3)} if @code{n} has been declared
12956 @code{int}, but @samp{dint(2.5)} and @samp{dint(n + 0.5)} return 0.
12957 Calc consults knowledge of its own built-in functions as well as your
12958 own declarations: @samp{dint(floor(x))} returns 1.
12959
12960 @ignore
12961 @starindex
12962 @end ignore
12963 @tindex dint
12964 @ignore
12965 @starindex
12966 @end ignore
12967 @tindex dnumint
12968 @ignore
12969 @starindex
12970 @end ignore
12971 @tindex dnatnum
12972 The @code{dint} function checks if its argument is an integer.
12973 The @code{dnatnum} function checks if its argument is a natural
12974 number, i.e., a nonnegative integer. The @code{dnumint} function
12975 checks if its argument is numerically an integer, i.e., either an
12976 integer or an integer-valued float. Note that these and the other
12977 data type functions also accept vectors or matrices composed of
12978 suitable elements, and that real infinities @samp{inf} and @samp{-inf}
12979 are considered to be integers for the purposes of these functions.
12980
12981 @ignore
12982 @starindex
12983 @end ignore
12984 @tindex drat
12985 The @code{drat} function checks if its argument is rational, i.e.,
12986 an integer or fraction. Infinities count as rational, but intervals
12987 and error forms do not.
12988
12989 @ignore
12990 @starindex
12991 @end ignore
12992 @tindex dreal
12993 The @code{dreal} function checks if its argument is real. This
12994 includes integers, fractions, floats, real error forms, and intervals.
12995
12996 @ignore
12997 @starindex
12998 @end ignore
12999 @tindex dimag
13000 The @code{dimag} function checks if its argument is imaginary,
13001 i.e., is mathematically equal to a real number times @expr{i}.
13002
13003 @ignore
13004 @starindex
13005 @end ignore
13006 @tindex dpos
13007 @ignore
13008 @starindex
13009 @end ignore
13010 @tindex dneg
13011 @ignore
13012 @starindex
13013 @end ignore
13014 @tindex dnonneg
13015 The @code{dpos} function checks for positive (but nonzero) reals.
13016 The @code{dneg} function checks for negative reals. The @code{dnonneg}
13017 function checks for nonnegative reals, i.e., reals greater than or
13018 equal to zero. Note that Calc's algebraic simplifications, which are
13019 effectively applied to all conditions in rewrite rules, can simplify
13020 an expression like @expr{x > 0} to 1 or 0 using @code{dpos}.
13021 So the actual functions @code{dpos}, @code{dneg}, and @code{dnonneg}
13022 are rarely necessary.
13023
13024 @ignore
13025 @starindex
13026 @end ignore
13027 @tindex dnonzero
13028 The @code{dnonzero} function checks that its argument is nonzero.
13029 This includes all nonzero real or complex numbers, all intervals that
13030 do not include zero, all nonzero modulo forms, vectors all of whose
13031 elements are nonzero, and variables or formulas whose values can be
13032 deduced to be nonzero. It does not include error forms, since they
13033 represent values which could be anything including zero. (This is
13034 also the set of objects considered ``true'' in conditional contexts.)
13035
13036 @ignore
13037 @starindex
13038 @end ignore
13039 @tindex deven
13040 @ignore
13041 @starindex
13042 @end ignore
13043 @tindex dodd
13044 The @code{deven} function returns 1 if its argument is known to be
13045 an even integer (or integer-valued float); it returns 0 if its argument
13046 is known not to be even (because it is known to be odd or a non-integer).
13047 Calc's algebraic simplifications use this to simplify a test of the form
13048 @samp{x % 2 = 0}. There is also an analogous @code{dodd} function.
13049
13050 @ignore
13051 @starindex
13052 @end ignore
13053 @tindex drange
13054 The @code{drange} function returns a set (an interval or a vector
13055 of intervals and/or numbers; @pxref{Set Operations}) that describes
13056 the set of possible values of its argument. If the argument is
13057 a variable or a function with a declaration, the range is copied
13058 from the declaration. Otherwise, the possible signs of the
13059 expression are determined using a method similar to @code{dpos},
13060 etc., and a suitable set like @samp{[0 .. inf]} is returned. If
13061 the expression is not provably real, the @code{drange} function
13062 remains unevaluated.
13063
13064 @ignore
13065 @starindex
13066 @end ignore
13067 @tindex dscalar
13068 The @code{dscalar} function returns 1 if its argument is provably
13069 scalar, or 0 if its argument is provably non-scalar. It is left
13070 unevaluated if this cannot be determined. (If Matrix mode or Scalar
13071 mode is in effect, this function returns 1 or 0, respectively,
13072 if it has no other information.) When Calc interprets a condition
13073 (say, in a rewrite rule) it considers an unevaluated formula to be
13074 ``false.'' Thus, @samp{dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a} is
13075 provably scalar, and @samp{!dscalar(a)} is ``true'' only if @code{a}
13076 is provably non-scalar; both are ``false'' if there is insufficient
13077 information to tell.
13078
13079 @node Display Modes, Language Modes, Declarations, Mode Settings
13080 @section Display Modes
13081
13082 @noindent
13083 The commands in this section are two-key sequences beginning with the
13084 @kbd{d} prefix. The @kbd{d l} (@code{calc-line-numbering}) and @kbd{d b}
13085 (@code{calc-line-breaking}) commands are described elsewhere;
13086 @pxref{Stack Basics} and @pxref{Normal Language Modes}, respectively.
13087 Display formats for vectors and matrices are also covered elsewhere;
13088 @pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}.
13089
13090 One thing all display modes have in common is their treatment of the
13091 @kbd{H} prefix. This prefix causes any mode command that would normally
13092 refresh the stack to leave the stack display alone. The word ``Dirty''
13093 will appear in the mode line when Calc thinks the stack display may not
13094 reflect the latest mode settings.
13095
13096 @kindex d @key{RET}
13097 @pindex calc-refresh-top
13098 The @kbd{d @key{RET}} (@code{calc-refresh-top}) command reformats the
13099 top stack entry according to all the current modes. Positive prefix
13100 arguments reformat the top @var{n} entries; negative prefix arguments
13101 reformat the specified entry, and a prefix of zero is equivalent to
13102 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}), which reformats the entire stack.
13103 For example, @kbd{H d s M-2 d @key{RET}} changes to scientific notation
13104 but reformats only the top two stack entries in the new mode.
13105
13106 The @kbd{I} prefix has another effect on the display modes. The mode
13107 is set only temporarily; the top stack entry is reformatted according
13108 to that mode, then the original mode setting is restored. In other
13109 words, @kbd{I d s} is equivalent to @kbd{H d s d @key{RET} H d (@var{old mode})}.
13110
13111 @menu
13112 * Radix Modes::
13113 * Grouping Digits::
13114 * Float Formats::
13115 * Complex Formats::
13116 * Fraction Formats::
13117 * HMS Formats::
13118 * Date Formats::
13119 * Truncating the Stack::
13120 * Justification::
13121 * Labels::
13122 @end menu
13123
13124 @node Radix Modes, Grouping Digits, Display Modes, Display Modes
13125 @subsection Radix Modes
13126
13127 @noindent
13128 @cindex Radix display
13129 @cindex Non-decimal numbers
13130 @cindex Decimal and non-decimal numbers
13131 Calc normally displays numbers in decimal (@dfn{base-10} or @dfn{radix-10})
13132 notation. Calc can actually display in any radix from two (binary) to 36.
13133 When the radix is above 10, the letters @code{A} to @code{Z} are used as
13134 digits. When entering such a number, letter keys are interpreted as
13135 potential digits rather than terminating numeric entry mode.
13136
13137 @kindex d 2
13138 @kindex d 8
13139 @kindex d 6
13140 @kindex d 0
13141 @cindex Hexadecimal integers
13142 @cindex Octal integers
13143 The key sequences @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, @kbd{d 6}, and @kbd{d 0} select
13144 binary, octal, hexadecimal, and decimal as the current display radix,
13145 respectively. Numbers can always be entered in any radix, though the
13146 current radix is used as a default if you press @kbd{#} without any initial
13147 digits. A number entered without a @kbd{#} is @emph{always} interpreted
13148 as decimal.
13149
13150 @kindex d r
13151 @pindex calc-radix
13152 To set the radix generally, use @kbd{d r} (@code{calc-radix}) and enter
13153 an integer from 2 to 36. You can specify the radix as a numeric prefix
13154 argument; otherwise you will be prompted for it.
13155
13156 @kindex d z
13157 @pindex calc-leading-zeros
13158 @cindex Leading zeros
13159 Integers normally are displayed with however many digits are necessary to
13160 represent the integer and no more. The @kbd{d z} (@code{calc-leading-zeros})
13161 command causes integers to be padded out with leading zeros according to the
13162 current binary word size. (@xref{Binary Functions}, for a discussion of
13163 word size.) If the absolute value of the word size is @expr{w}, all integers
13164 are displayed with at least enough digits to represent
13165 @texline @math{2^w-1}
13166 @infoline @expr{(2^w)-1}
13167 in the current radix. (Larger integers will still be displayed in their
13168 entirety.)
13169
13170 @cindex Two's complements
13171 Calc can display @expr{w}-bit integers using two's complement
13172 notation, although this is most useful with the binary, octal and
13173 hexadecimal display modes. This option is selected by using the
13174 @kbd{O} option prefix before setting the display radix, and a negative word
13175 size might be appropriate (@pxref{Binary Functions}). In two's
13176 complement notation, the integers in the (nearly) symmetric interval
13177 from
13178 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13179 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13180 to
13181 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1}
13182 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1}
13183 are represented by the integers from @expr{0} to @expr{2^w-1}:
13184 the integers from @expr{0} to
13185 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1}
13186 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1}
13187 are represented by themselves and the integers from
13188 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13189 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13190 to @expr{-1} are represented by the integers from
13191 @texline @math{2^{w-1}}
13192 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)}
13193 to @expr{2^w-1} (the integer @expr{k} is represented by @expr{k+2^w}).
13194 Calc will display a two's complement integer by the radix (either
13195 @expr{2}, @expr{8} or @expr{16}), two @kbd{#} symbols, and then its
13196 representation (including any leading zeros necessary to include all
13197 @expr{w} bits). In a two's complement display mode, numbers that
13198 are not displayed in two's complement notation (i.e., that aren't
13199 integers from
13200 @texline @math{-2^{w-1}}
13201 @infoline @expr{-2^(w-1)}
13202 to
13203 @c (
13204 @texline @math{2^{w-1}-1})
13205 @infoline @expr{2^(w-1)-1})
13206 will be represented using Calc's usual notation (in the appropriate
13207 radix).
13208
13209 @node Grouping Digits, Float Formats, Radix Modes, Display Modes
13210 @subsection Grouping Digits
13211
13212 @noindent
13213 @kindex d g
13214 @pindex calc-group-digits
13215 @cindex Grouping digits
13216 @cindex Digit grouping
13217 Long numbers can be hard to read if they have too many digits. For
13218 example, the factorial of 30 is 33 digits long! Press @kbd{d g}
13219 (@code{calc-group-digits}) to enable @dfn{Grouping} mode, in which digits
13220 are displayed in clumps of 3 or 4 (depending on the current radix)
13221 separated by commas.
13222
13223 The @kbd{d g} command toggles grouping on and off.
13224 With a numeric prefix of 0, this command displays the current state of
13225 the grouping flag; with an argument of minus one it disables grouping;
13226 with a positive argument @expr{N} it enables grouping on every @expr{N}
13227 digits. For floating-point numbers, grouping normally occurs only
13228 before the decimal point. A negative prefix argument @expr{-N} enables
13229 grouping every @expr{N} digits both before and after the decimal point.
13230
13231 @kindex d ,
13232 @pindex calc-group-char
13233 The @kbd{d ,} (@code{calc-group-char}) command allows you to choose any
13234 character as the grouping separator. The default is the comma character.
13235 If you find it difficult to read vectors of large integers grouped with
13236 commas, you may wish to use spaces or some other character instead.
13237 This command takes the next character you type, whatever it is, and
13238 uses it as the digit separator. As a special case, @kbd{d , \} selects
13239 @samp{\,} (@TeX{}'s thin-space symbol) as the digit separator.
13240
13241 Please note that grouped numbers will not generally be parsed correctly
13242 if re-read in textual form, say by the use of @kbd{C-x * y} and @kbd{C-x * g}.
13243 (@xref{Kill and Yank}, for details on these commands.) One exception is
13244 the @samp{\,} separator, which doesn't interfere with parsing because it
13245 is ignored by @TeX{} language mode.
13246
13247 @node Float Formats, Complex Formats, Grouping Digits, Display Modes
13248 @subsection Float Formats
13249
13250 @noindent
13251 Floating-point quantities are normally displayed in standard decimal
13252 form, with scientific notation used if the exponent is especially high
13253 or low. All significant digits are normally displayed. The commands
13254 in this section allow you to choose among several alternative display
13255 formats for floats.
13256
13257 @kindex d n
13258 @pindex calc-normal-notation
13259 The @kbd{d n} (@code{calc-normal-notation}) command selects the normal
13260 display format. All significant figures in a number are displayed.
13261 With a positive numeric prefix, numbers are rounded if necessary to
13262 that number of significant digits. With a negative numerix prefix,
13263 the specified number of significant digits less than the current
13264 precision is used. (Thus @kbd{C-u -2 d n} displays 10 digits if the
13265 current precision is 12.)
13266
13267 @kindex d f
13268 @pindex calc-fix-notation
13269 The @kbd{d f} (@code{calc-fix-notation}) command selects fixed-point
13270 notation. The numeric argument is the number of digits after the
13271 decimal point, zero or more. This format will relax into scientific
13272 notation if a nonzero number would otherwise have been rounded all the
13273 way to zero. Specifying a negative number of digits is the same as
13274 for a positive number, except that small nonzero numbers will be rounded
13275 to zero rather than switching to scientific notation.
13276
13277 @kindex d s
13278 @pindex calc-sci-notation
13279 @cindex Scientific notation, display of
13280 The @kbd{d s} (@code{calc-sci-notation}) command selects scientific
13281 notation. A positive argument sets the number of significant figures
13282 displayed, of which one will be before and the rest after the decimal
13283 point. A negative argument works the same as for @kbd{d n} format.
13284 The default is to display all significant digits.
13285
13286 @kindex d e
13287 @pindex calc-eng-notation
13288 @cindex Engineering notation, display of
13289 The @kbd{d e} (@code{calc-eng-notation}) command selects engineering
13290 notation. This is similar to scientific notation except that the
13291 exponent is rounded down to a multiple of three, with from one to three
13292 digits before the decimal point. An optional numeric prefix sets the
13293 number of significant digits to display, as for @kbd{d s}.
13294
13295 It is important to distinguish between the current @emph{precision} and
13296 the current @emph{display format}. After the commands @kbd{C-u 10 p}
13297 and @kbd{C-u 6 d n} the Calculator computes all results to ten
13298 significant figures but displays only six. (In fact, intermediate
13299 calculations are often carried to one or two more significant figures,
13300 but values placed on the stack will be rounded down to ten figures.)
13301 Numbers are never actually rounded to the display precision for storage,
13302 except by commands like @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-x * y} which operate on the
13303 actual displayed text in the Calculator buffer.
13304
13305 @kindex d .
13306 @pindex calc-point-char
13307 The @kbd{d .} (@code{calc-point-char}) command selects the character used
13308 as a decimal point. Normally this is a period; users in some countries
13309 may wish to change this to a comma. Note that this is only a display
13310 style; on entry, periods must always be used to denote floating-point
13311 numbers, and commas to separate elements in a list.
13312
13313 @node Complex Formats, Fraction Formats, Float Formats, Display Modes
13314 @subsection Complex Formats
13315
13316 @noindent
13317 @kindex d c
13318 @pindex calc-complex-notation
13319 There are three supported notations for complex numbers in rectangular
13320 form. The default is as a pair of real numbers enclosed in parentheses
13321 and separated by a comma: @samp{(a,b)}. The @kbd{d c}
13322 (@code{calc-complex-notation}) command selects this style.
13323
13324 @kindex d i
13325 @pindex calc-i-notation
13326 @kindex d j
13327 @pindex calc-j-notation
13328 The other notations are @kbd{d i} (@code{calc-i-notation}), in which
13329 numbers are displayed in @samp{a+bi} form, and @kbd{d j}
13330 (@code{calc-j-notation}) which displays the form @samp{a+bj} preferred
13331 in some disciplines.
13332
13333 @cindex @code{i} variable
13334 @vindex i
13335 Complex numbers are normally entered in @samp{(a,b)} format.
13336 If you enter @samp{2+3i} as an algebraic formula, it will be stored as
13337 the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i}. However, if you use @kbd{=} to evaluate
13338 this formula and you have not changed the variable @samp{i}, the @samp{i}
13339 will be interpreted as @samp{(0,1)} and the formula will be simplified
13340 to @samp{(2,3)}. Other commands (like @code{calc-sin}) will @emph{not}
13341 interpret the formula @samp{2 + 3 * i} as a complex number.
13342 @xref{Variables}, under ``special constants.''
13343
13344 @node Fraction Formats, HMS Formats, Complex Formats, Display Modes
13345 @subsection Fraction Formats
13346
13347 @noindent
13348 @kindex d o
13349 @pindex calc-over-notation
13350 Display of fractional numbers is controlled by the @kbd{d o}
13351 (@code{calc-over-notation}) command. By default, a number like
13352 eight thirds is displayed in the form @samp{8:3}. The @kbd{d o} command
13353 prompts for a one- or two-character format. If you give one character,
13354 that character is used as the fraction separator. Common separators are
13355 @samp{:} and @samp{/}. (During input of numbers, the @kbd{:} key must be
13356 used regardless of the display format; in particular, the @kbd{/} is used
13357 for RPN-style division, @emph{not} for entering fractions.)
13358
13359 If you give two characters, fractions use ``integer-plus-fractional-part''
13360 notation. For example, the format @samp{+/} would display eight thirds
13361 as @samp{2+2/3}. If two colons are present in a number being entered,
13362 the number is interpreted in this form (so that the entries @kbd{2:2:3}
13363 and @kbd{8:3} are equivalent).
13364
13365 It is also possible to follow the one- or two-character format with
13366 a number. For example: @samp{:10} or @samp{+/3}. In this case,
13367 Calc adjusts all fractions that are displayed to have the specified
13368 denominator, if possible. Otherwise it adjusts the denominator to
13369 be a multiple of the specified value. For example, in @samp{:6} mode
13370 the fraction @expr{1:6} will be unaffected, but @expr{2:3} will be
13371 displayed as @expr{4:6}, @expr{1:2} will be displayed as @expr{3:6},
13372 and @expr{1:8} will be displayed as @expr{3:24}. Integers are also
13373 affected by this mode: 3 is displayed as @expr{18:6}. Note that the
13374 format @samp{:1} writes fractions the same as @samp{:}, but it writes
13375 integers as @expr{n:1}.
13376
13377 The fraction format does not affect the way fractions or integers are
13378 stored, only the way they appear on the screen. The fraction format
13379 never affects floats.
13380
13381 @node HMS Formats, Date Formats, Fraction Formats, Display Modes
13382 @subsection HMS Formats
13383
13384 @noindent
13385 @kindex d h
13386 @pindex calc-hms-notation
13387 The @kbd{d h} (@code{calc-hms-notation}) command controls the display of
13388 HMS (hours-minutes-seconds) forms. It prompts for a string which
13389 consists basically of an ``hours'' marker, optional punctuation, a
13390 ``minutes'' marker, more optional punctuation, and a ``seconds'' marker.
13391 Punctuation is zero or more spaces, commas, or semicolons. The hours
13392 marker is one or more non-punctuation characters. The minutes and
13393 seconds markers must be single non-punctuation characters.
13394
13395 The default HMS format is @samp{@@ ' "}, producing HMS values of the form
13396 @samp{23@@ 30' 15.75"}. The format @samp{deg, ms} would display this same
13397 value as @samp{23deg, 30m15.75s}. During numeric entry, the @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}
13398 keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{@@} regardless of display format.
13399 The @kbd{m} and @kbd{s} keys are recognized as synonyms for @kbd{'} and
13400 @kbd{"}, respectively, but only if an @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or @kbd{o}) has
13401 already been typed; otherwise, they have their usual meanings
13402 (@kbd{m-} prefix and @kbd{s-} prefix). Thus, @kbd{5 "}, @kbd{0 @@ 5 "}, and
13403 @kbd{0 h 5 s} are some of the ways to enter the quantity ``five seconds.''
13404 The @kbd{'} key is recognized as ``minutes'' only if @kbd{@@} (or @kbd{h} or
13405 @kbd{o}) has already been pressed; otherwise it means to switch to algebraic
13406 entry.
13407
13408 @node Date Formats, Truncating the Stack, HMS Formats, Display Modes
13409 @subsection Date Formats
13410
13411 @noindent
13412 @kindex d d
13413 @pindex calc-date-notation
13414 The @kbd{d d} (@code{calc-date-notation}) command controls the display
13415 of date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). It prompts for a string which
13416 contains letters that represent the various parts of a date and time.
13417 To show which parts should be omitted when the form represents a pure
13418 date with no time, parts of the string can be enclosed in @samp{< >}
13419 marks. If you don't include @samp{< >} markers in the format, Calc
13420 guesses at which parts, if any, should be omitted when formatting
13421 pure dates.
13422
13423 The default format is: @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY}.
13424 An example string in this format is @samp{3:32pm Wed Jan 9, 1991}.
13425 If you enter a blank format string, this default format is
13426 reestablished.
13427
13428 Calc uses @samp{< >} notation for nameless functions as well as for
13429 dates. @xref{Specifying Operators}. To avoid confusion with nameless
13430 functions, your date formats should avoid using the @samp{#} character.
13431
13432 @menu
13433 * ISO 8601::
13434 * Date Formatting Codes::
13435 * Free-Form Dates::
13436 * Standard Date Formats::
13437 @end menu
13438
13439 @node ISO 8601, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats, Date Formats
13440 @subsubsection ISO 8601
13441
13442 @noindent
13443 @cindex ISO 8601
13444 The same date can be written down in different formats and Calc tries
13445 to allow you to choose your preferred format. Some common formats are
13446 ambiguous, however; for example, 10/11/2012 means October 11,
13447 2012 in the United States but it means November 10, 2012 in
13448 Europe. To help avoid such ambiguities, the International Organization
13449 for Standardization (ISO) provides the ISO 8601 standard, which
13450 provides three different but easily distinguishable and unambiguous
13451 ways to represent a date.
13452
13453 The ISO 8601 calendar date representation is
13454
13455 @example
13456 @var{YYYY}-@var{MM}-@var{DD}
13457 @end example
13458
13459 @noindent
13460 where @var{YYYY} is the four digit year, @var{MM} is the two-digit month
13461 number (01 for January to 12 for December), and @var{DD} is the
13462 two-digit day of the month (01 to 31). (Note that @var{YYYY} does not
13463 correspond to Calc's date formatting code, which will be introduced
13464 later.) The year, which should be padded with zeros to ensure it has at
13465 least four digits, is the Gregorian year, except that the year before
13466 0001 (1 AD) is the year 0000 (1 BC). The date October 11, 2012 is
13467 written 2012-10-11 in this representation and November 10, 2012 is
13468 written 2012-11-10.
13469
13470 The ISO 8601 ordinal date representation is
13471
13472 @example
13473 @var{YYYY}-@var{DDD}
13474 @end example
13475
13476 @noindent
13477 where @var{YYYY} is the year, as above, and @var{DDD} is the day of the year.
13478 The date December 31, 2011 is written 2011-365 in this representation
13479 and January 1, 2012 is written 2012-001.
13480
13481 The ISO 8601 week date representation is
13482
13483 @example
13484 @var{YYYY}-W@var{ww}-@var{D}
13485 @end example
13486
13487 @noindent
13488 where @var{YYYY} is the ISO week-numbering year, @var{ww} is the two
13489 digit week number (preceded by a literal ``W''), and @var{D} is the day
13490 of the week (1 for Monday through 7 for Sunday). The ISO week-numbering
13491 year is based on the Gregorian year but can differ slightly. The first
13492 week of an ISO week-numbering year is the week with the Gregorian year's
13493 first Thursday in it (equivalently, the week containing January 4);
13494 any day of that week (Monday through Sunday) is part of the same ISO
13495 week-numbering year, any day from the previous week is part of the
13496 previous year. For example, January 4, 2013 is on a Friday, and so
13497 the first week for the ISO week-numbering year 2013 starts on
13498 Monday, December 31, 2012. The day December 31, 2012 is then part of the
13499 Gregorian year 2012 but ISO week-numbering year 2013. In the week
13500 date representation, this week goes from 2013-W01-1 (December 31,
13501 2012) to 2013-W01-7 (January 6, 2013).
13502
13503 All three ISO 8601 representations arrange the numbers from most
13504 significant to least significant; as well as being unambiguous
13505 representations, they are easy to sort since chronological order in
13506 this formats corresponds to lexicographical order. The hyphens are
13507 sometimes omitted.
13508
13509 The ISO 8601 standard uses a 24 hour clock; a particular time is
13510 represented by @var{hh}:@var{mm}:@var{ss} where @var{hh} is the
13511 two-digit hour (from 00 to 24), @var{mm} is the two-digit minute (from
13512 00 to 59) and @var{ss} is the two-digit second. The seconds or minutes
13513 and seconds can be omitted, and decimals can be added. If a date with a
13514 time is represented, they should be separated by a literal ``T'', so noon
13515 on December 13, 2012 can be represented as 2012-12-13T12:00.
13516
13517 @node Date Formatting Codes, Free-Form Dates, ISO 8601, Date Formats
13518 @subsubsection Date Formatting Codes
13519
13520 @noindent
13521 When displaying a date, the current date format is used. All
13522 characters except for letters and @samp{<} and @samp{>} are
13523 copied literally when dates are formatted. The portion between
13524 @samp{< >} markers is omitted for pure dates, or included for
13525 date/time forms. Letters are interpreted according to the table
13526 below.
13527
13528 When dates are read in during algebraic entry, Calc first tries to
13529 match the input string to the current format either with or without
13530 the time part. The punctuation characters (including spaces) must
13531 match exactly; letter fields must correspond to suitable text in
13532 the input. If this doesn't work, Calc checks if the input is a
13533 simple number; if so, the number is interpreted as a number of days
13534 since Dec 31, 1 BC@. Otherwise, Calc tries a much more relaxed and
13535 flexible algorithm which is described in the next section.
13536
13537 Weekday names are ignored during reading.
13538
13539 Two-digit year numbers are interpreted as lying in the range
13540 from 1941 to 2039. Years outside that range are always
13541 entered and displayed in full. Year numbers with a leading
13542 @samp{+} sign are always interpreted exactly, allowing the
13543 entry and display of the years 1 through 99 AD.
13544
13545 Here is a complete list of the formatting codes for dates:
13546
13547 @table @asis
13548 @item Y
13549 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13550 @item YY
13551 Year: ``91'' for 1991, ``07'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13552 @item BY
13553 Year: ``91'' for 1991, `` 7'' for 2007, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13554 @item YYY
13555 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``23'' for 23 AD.
13556 @item YYYY
13557 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``+23'' for 23 AD.
13558 @item ZYYY
13559 Year: ``1991'' for 1991, ``0023'' for 23 AD, ``0000'' for 1 BC.
13560 @item IYYY
13561 Year: ISO 8601 week-numbering year.
13562 @item aa
13563 Year: ``ad'' or blank.
13564 @item AA
13565 Year: ``AD'' or blank.
13566 @item aaa
13567 Year: ``ad '' or blank. (Note trailing space.)
13568 @item AAA
13569 Year: ``AD '' or blank.
13570 @item aaaa
13571 Year: ``a.d.@:'' or blank.
13572 @item AAAA
13573 Year: ``A.D.'' or blank.
13574 @item bb
13575 Year: ``bc'' or blank.
13576 @item BB
13577 Year: ``BC'' or blank.
13578 @item bbb
13579 Year: `` bc'' or blank. (Note leading space.)
13580 @item BBB
13581 Year: `` BC'' or blank.
13582 @item bbbb
13583 Year: ``b.c.@:'' or blank.
13584 @item BBBB
13585 Year: ``B.C.'' or blank.
13586 @item M
13587 Month: ``8'' for August.
13588 @item MM
13589 Month: ``08'' for August.
13590 @item BM
13591 Month: `` 8'' for August.
13592 @item MMM
13593 Month: ``AUG'' for August.
13594 @item Mmm
13595 Month: ``Aug'' for August.
13596 @item mmm
13597 Month: ``aug'' for August.
13598 @item MMMM
13599 Month: ``AUGUST'' for August.
13600 @item Mmmm
13601 Month: ``August'' for August.
13602 @item D
13603 Day: ``7'' for 7th day of month.
13604 @item DD
13605 Day: ``07'' for 7th day of month.
13606 @item BD
13607 Day: `` 7'' for 7th day of month.
13608 @item W
13609 Weekday: ``0'' for Sunday, ``6'' for Saturday.
13610 @item w
13611 Weekday: ``1'' for Monday, ``7'' for Sunday.
13612 @item WWW
13613 Weekday: ``SUN'' for Sunday.
13614 @item Www
13615 Weekday: ``Sun'' for Sunday.
13616 @item www
13617 Weekday: ``sun'' for Sunday.
13618 @item WWWW
13619 Weekday: ``SUNDAY'' for Sunday.
13620 @item Wwww
13621 Weekday: ``Sunday'' for Sunday.
13622 @item Iww
13623 Week number: ISO 8601 week number, ``W01'' for week 1.
13624 @item d
13625 Day of year: ``34'' for Feb. 3.
13626 @item ddd
13627 Day of year: ``034'' for Feb. 3.
13628 @item bdd
13629 Day of year: `` 34'' for Feb. 3.
13630 @item T
13631 Letter: Literal ``T''.
13632 @item h
13633 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13634 @item hh
13635 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13636 @item bh
13637 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM; ``17'' for 5 PM.
13638 @item H
13639 Hour: ``5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13640 @item HH
13641 Hour: ``05'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13642 @item BH
13643 Hour: `` 5'' for 5 AM and 5 PM.
13644 @item p
13645 AM/PM: ``a'' or ``p''.
13646 @item P
13647 AM/PM: ``A'' or ``P''.
13648 @item pp
13649 AM/PM: ``am'' or ``pm''.
13650 @item PP
13651 AM/PM: ``AM'' or ``PM''.
13652 @item pppp
13653 AM/PM: ``a.m.@:'' or ``p.m.''.
13654 @item PPPP
13655 AM/PM: ``A.M.'' or ``P.M.''.
13656 @item m
13657 Minutes: ``7'' for 7.
13658 @item mm
13659 Minutes: ``07'' for 7.
13660 @item bm
13661 Minutes: `` 7'' for 7.
13662 @item s
13663 Seconds: ``7'' for 7; ``7.23'' for 7.23.
13664 @item ss
13665 Seconds: ``07'' for 7; ``07.23'' for 7.23.
13666 @item bs
13667 Seconds: `` 7'' for 7; `` 7.23'' for 7.23.
13668 @item SS
13669 Optional seconds: ``07'' for 7; blank for 0.
13670 @item BS
13671 Optional seconds: `` 7'' for 7; blank for 0.
13672 @item N
13673 Numeric date/time: ``726842.25'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13674 @item n
13675 Numeric date: ``726842'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13676 @item J
13677 Julian date/time: ``2448265.75'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13678 @item j
13679 Julian date: ``2448266'' for any time on Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13680 @item U
13681 Unix time: ``663400800'' for 6:00am Wed Jan 9, 1991.
13682 @item X
13683 Brackets suppression. An ``X'' at the front of the format
13684 causes the surrounding @w{@samp{< >}} delimiters to be omitted
13685 when formatting dates. Note that the brackets are still
13686 required for algebraic entry.
13687 @end table
13688
13689 If ``SS'' or ``BS'' (optional seconds) is preceded by a colon, the
13690 colon is also omitted if the seconds part is zero.
13691
13692 If ``bb,'' ``bbb'' or ``bbbb'' or their upper-case equivalents
13693 appear in the format, then negative year numbers are displayed
13694 without a minus sign. Note that ``aa'' and ``bb'' are mutually
13695 exclusive. Some typical usages would be @samp{YYYY AABB};
13696 @samp{AAAYYYYBBB}; @samp{YYYYBBB}.
13697
13698 The formats ``YY,'' ``YYYY,'' ``MM,'' ``DD,'' ``ddd,'' ``hh,'' ``HH,''
13699 ``mm,'' ``ss,'' and ``SS'' actually match any number of digits during
13700 reading unless several of these codes are strung together with no
13701 punctuation in between, in which case the input must have exactly as
13702 many digits as there are letters in the format.
13703
13704 The ``j,'' ``J,'' and ``U'' formats do not make any time zone
13705 adjustment. They effectively use @samp{julian(x,0)} and
13706 @samp{unixtime(x,0)} to make the conversion; @pxref{Date Arithmetic}.
13707
13708 @node Free-Form Dates, Standard Date Formats, Date Formatting Codes, Date Formats
13709 @subsubsection Free-Form Dates
13710
13711 @noindent
13712 When reading a date form during algebraic entry, Calc falls back
13713 on the algorithm described here if the input does not exactly
13714 match the current date format. This algorithm generally
13715 ``does the right thing'' and you don't have to worry about it,
13716 but it is described here in full detail for the curious.
13717
13718 Calc does not distinguish between upper- and lower-case letters
13719 while interpreting dates.
13720
13721 First, the time portion, if present, is located somewhere in the
13722 text and then removed. The remaining text is then interpreted as
13723 the date.
13724
13725 A time is of the form @samp{hh:mm:ss}, possibly with the seconds
13726 part omitted and possibly with an AM/PM indicator added to indicate
13727 12-hour time. If the AM/PM is present, the minutes may also be
13728 omitted. The AM/PM part may be any of the words @samp{am},
13729 @samp{pm}, @samp{noon}, or @samp{midnight}; each of these may be
13730 abbreviated to one letter, and the alternate forms @samp{a.m.},
13731 @samp{p.m.}, and @samp{mid} are also understood. Obviously
13732 @samp{noon} and @samp{midnight} are allowed only on 12:00:00.
13733 The words @samp{noon}, @samp{mid}, and @samp{midnight} are also
13734 recognized with no number attached. Midnight will represent the
13735 beginning of a day.
13736
13737 If there is no AM/PM indicator, the time is interpreted in 24-hour
13738 format.
13739
13740 When reading the date portion, Calc first checks to see if it is an
13741 ISO 8601 week-numbering date; if the string contains an integer
13742 representing the year, a ``W'' followed by two digits for the week
13743 number, and an integer from 1 to 7 representing the weekday (in that
13744 order), then all other characters are ignored and this information
13745 determines the date. Otherwise, all words and numbers are isolated
13746 from the string; other characters are ignored. All words must be
13747 either month names or day-of-week names (the latter of which are
13748 ignored). Names can be written in full or as three-letter
13749 abbreviations.
13750
13751 Large numbers, or numbers with @samp{+} or @samp{-} signs,
13752 are interpreted as years. If one of the other numbers is
13753 greater than 12, then that must be the day and the remaining
13754 number in the input is therefore the month. Otherwise, Calc
13755 assumes the month, day and year are in the same order that they
13756 appear in the current date format. If the year is omitted, the
13757 current year is taken from the system clock.
13758
13759 If there are too many or too few numbers, or any unrecognizable
13760 words, then the input is rejected.
13761
13762 If there are any large numbers (of five digits or more) other than
13763 the year, they are ignored on the assumption that they are something
13764 like Julian dates that were included along with the traditional
13765 date components when the date was formatted.
13766
13767 One of the words @samp{ad}, @samp{a.d.}, @samp{bc}, or @samp{b.c.}
13768 may optionally be used; the latter two are equivalent to a
13769 minus sign on the year value.
13770
13771 If you always enter a four-digit year, and use a name instead
13772 of a number for the month, there is no danger of ambiguity.
13773
13774 @node Standard Date Formats, , Free-Form Dates, Date Formats
13775 @subsubsection Standard Date Formats
13776
13777 @noindent
13778 There are actually ten standard date formats, numbered 0 through 9.
13779 Entering a blank line at the @kbd{d d} command's prompt gives
13780 you format number 1, Calc's usual format. You can enter any digit
13781 to select the other formats.
13782
13783 To create your own standard date formats, give a numeric prefix
13784 argument from 0 to 9 to the @w{@kbd{d d}} command. The format you
13785 enter will be recorded as the new standard format of that
13786 number, as well as becoming the new current date format.
13787 You can save your formats permanently with the @w{@kbd{m m}}
13788 command (@pxref{Mode Settings}).
13789
13790 @table @asis
13791 @item 0
13792 @samp{N} (Numerical format)
13793 @item 1
13794 @samp{<H:mm:SSpp >Www Mmm D, YYYY} (American format)
13795 @item 2
13796 @samp{D Mmm YYYY<, h:mm:SS>} (European format)
13797 @item 3
13798 @samp{Www Mmm BD< hh:mm:ss> YYYY} (Unix written date format)
13799 @item 4
13800 @samp{M/D/Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American slashed format)
13801 @item 5
13802 @samp{D.M.Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dotted format)
13803 @item 6
13804 @samp{M-D-Y< H:mm:SSpp>} (American dashed format)
13805 @item 7
13806 @samp{D-M-Y< h:mm:SS>} (European dashed format)
13807 @item 8
13808 @samp{j<, h:mm:ss>} (Julian day plus time)
13809 @item 9
13810 @samp{YYddd< hh:mm:ss>} (Year-day format)
13811 @item 10
13812 @samp{ZYYY-MM-DD Www< hh:mm>} (Org mode format)
13813 @item 11
13814 @samp{IYYY-Iww-w<Thh:mm:ss>} (ISO 8601 week numbering format)
13815 @end table
13816
13817 @node Truncating the Stack, Justification, Date Formats, Display Modes
13818 @subsection Truncating the Stack
13819
13820 @noindent
13821 @kindex d t
13822 @pindex calc-truncate-stack
13823 @cindex Truncating the stack
13824 @cindex Narrowing the stack
13825 The @kbd{d t} (@code{calc-truncate-stack}) command moves the @samp{.}@:
13826 line that marks the top-of-stack up or down in the Calculator buffer.
13827 The number right above that line is considered to the be at the top of
13828 the stack. Any numbers below that line are ``hidden'' from all stack
13829 operations (although still visible to the user). This is similar to the
13830 Emacs ``narrowing'' feature, except that the values below the @samp{.}
13831 are @emph{visible}, just temporarily frozen. This feature allows you to
13832 keep several independent calculations running at once in different parts
13833 of the stack, or to apply a certain command to an element buried deep in
13834 the stack.
13835
13836 Pressing @kbd{d t} by itself moves the @samp{.} to the line the cursor
13837 is on. Thus, this line and all those below it become hidden. To un-hide
13838 these lines, move down to the end of the buffer and press @w{@kbd{d t}}.
13839 With a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{n}, @kbd{d t} hides the
13840 bottom @expr{n} values in the buffer. With a negative argument, it hides
13841 all but the top @expr{n} values. With an argument of zero, it hides zero
13842 values, i.e., moves the @samp{.} all the way down to the bottom.
13843
13844 @kindex d [
13845 @pindex calc-truncate-up
13846 @kindex d ]
13847 @pindex calc-truncate-down
13848 The @kbd{d [} (@code{calc-truncate-up}) and @kbd{d ]}
13849 (@code{calc-truncate-down}) commands move the @samp{.} up or down one
13850 line at a time (or several lines with a prefix argument).
13851
13852 @node Justification, Labels, Truncating the Stack, Display Modes
13853 @subsection Justification
13854
13855 @noindent
13856 @kindex d <
13857 @pindex calc-left-justify
13858 @kindex d =
13859 @pindex calc-center-justify
13860 @kindex d >
13861 @pindex calc-right-justify
13862 Values on the stack are normally left-justified in the window. You can
13863 control this arrangement by typing @kbd{d <} (@code{calc-left-justify}),
13864 @kbd{d >} (@code{calc-right-justify}), or @kbd{d =}
13865 (@code{calc-center-justify}). For example, in Right-Justification mode,
13866 stack entries are displayed flush-right against the right edge of the
13867 window.
13868
13869 If you change the width of the Calculator window you may have to type
13870 @kbd{d @key{SPC}} (@code{calc-refresh}) to re-align right-justified or centered
13871 text.
13872
13873 Right-justification is especially useful together with fixed-point
13874 notation (see @code{d f}; @code{calc-fix-notation}). With these modes
13875 together, the decimal points on numbers will always line up.
13876
13877 With a numeric prefix argument, the justification commands give you
13878 a little extra control over the display. The argument specifies the
13879 horizontal ``origin'' of a display line. It is also possible to
13880 specify a maximum line width using the @kbd{d b} command (@pxref{Normal
13881 Language Modes}). For reference, the precise rules for formatting and
13882 breaking lines are given below. Notice that the interaction between
13883 origin and line width is slightly different in each justification
13884 mode.
13885
13886 In Left-Justified mode, the line is indented by a number of spaces
13887 given by the origin (default zero). If the result is longer than the
13888 maximum line width, if given, or too wide to fit in the Calc window
13889 otherwise, then it is broken into lines which will fit; each broken
13890 line is indented to the origin.
13891
13892 In Right-Justified mode, lines are shifted right so that the rightmost
13893 character is just before the origin, or just before the current
13894 window width if no origin was specified. If the line is too long
13895 for this, then it is broken; the current line width is used, if
13896 specified, or else the origin is used as a width if that is
13897 specified, or else the line is broken to fit in the window.
13898
13899 In Centering mode, the origin is the column number of the center of
13900 each stack entry. If a line width is specified, lines will not be
13901 allowed to go past that width; Calc will either indent less or
13902 break the lines if necessary. If no origin is specified, half the
13903 line width or Calc window width is used.
13904
13905 Note that, in each case, if line numbering is enabled the display
13906 is indented an additional four spaces to make room for the line
13907 number. The width of the line number is taken into account when
13908 positioning according to the current Calc window width, but not
13909 when positioning by explicit origins and widths. In the latter
13910 case, the display is formatted as specified, and then uniformly
13911 shifted over four spaces to fit the line numbers.
13912
13913 @node Labels, , Justification, Display Modes
13914 @subsection Labels
13915
13916 @noindent
13917 @kindex d @{
13918 @pindex calc-left-label
13919 The @kbd{d @{} (@code{calc-left-label}) command prompts for a string,
13920 then displays that string to the left of every stack entry. If the
13921 entries are left-justified (@pxref{Justification}), then they will
13922 appear immediately after the label (unless you specified an origin
13923 greater than the length of the label). If the entries are centered
13924 or right-justified, the label appears on the far left and does not
13925 affect the horizontal position of the stack entry.
13926
13927 Give a blank string (with @kbd{d @{ @key{RET}}) to turn the label off.
13928
13929 @kindex d @}
13930 @pindex calc-right-label
13931 The @kbd{d @}} (@code{calc-right-label}) command similarly adds a
13932 label on the righthand side. It does not affect positioning of
13933 the stack entries unless they are right-justified. Also, if both
13934 a line width and an origin are given in Right-Justified mode, the
13935 stack entry is justified to the origin and the righthand label is
13936 justified to the line width.
13937
13938 One application of labels would be to add equation numbers to
13939 formulas you are manipulating in Calc and then copying into a
13940 document (possibly using Embedded mode). The equations would
13941 typically be centered, and the equation numbers would be on the
13942 left or right as you prefer.
13943
13944 @node Language Modes, Modes Variable, Display Modes, Mode Settings
13945 @section Language Modes
13946
13947 @noindent
13948 The commands in this section change Calc to use a different notation for
13949 entry and display of formulas, corresponding to the conventions of some
13950 other common language such as Pascal or @LaTeX{}. Objects displayed on the
13951 stack or yanked from the Calculator to an editing buffer will be formatted
13952 in the current language; objects entered in algebraic entry or yanked from
13953 another buffer will be interpreted according to the current language.
13954
13955 The current language has no effect on things written to or read from the
13956 trail buffer, nor does it affect numeric entry. Only algebraic entry is
13957 affected. You can make even algebraic entry ignore the current language
13958 and use the standard notation by giving a numeric prefix, e.g., @kbd{C-u '}.
13959
13960 For example, suppose the formula @samp{2*a[1] + atan(a[2])} occurs in a C
13961 program; elsewhere in the program you need the derivatives of this formula
13962 with respect to @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}. First, type @kbd{d C}
13963 to switch to C notation. Now use @code{C-u C-x * g} to grab the formula
13964 into the Calculator, @kbd{a d a[1] @key{RET}} to differentiate with respect
13965 to the first variable, and @kbd{C-x * y} to yank the formula for the derivative
13966 back into your C program. Press @kbd{U} to undo the differentiation and
13967 repeat with @kbd{a d a[2] @key{RET}} for the other derivative.
13968
13969 Without being switched into C mode first, Calc would have misinterpreted
13970 the brackets in @samp{a[1]} and @samp{a[2]}, would not have known that
13971 @code{atan} was equivalent to Calc's built-in @code{arctan} function,
13972 and would have written the formula back with notations (like implicit
13973 multiplication) which would not have been valid for a C program.
13974
13975 As another example, suppose you are maintaining a C program and a @LaTeX{}
13976 document, each of which needs a copy of the same formula. You can grab the
13977 formula from the program in C mode, switch to @LaTeX{} mode, and yank the
13978 formula into the document in @LaTeX{} math-mode format.
13979
13980 Language modes are selected by typing the letter @kbd{d} followed by a
13981 shifted letter key.
13982
13983 @menu
13984 * Normal Language Modes::
13985 * C FORTRAN Pascal::
13986 * TeX and LaTeX Language Modes::
13987 * Eqn Language Mode::
13988 * Yacas Language Mode::
13989 * Maxima Language Mode::
13990 * Giac Language Mode::
13991 * Mathematica Language Mode::
13992 * Maple Language Mode::
13993 * Compositions::
13994 * Syntax Tables::
13995 @end menu
13996
13997 @node Normal Language Modes, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes, Language Modes
13998 @subsection Normal Language Modes
13999
14000 @noindent
14001 @kindex d N
14002 @pindex calc-normal-language
14003 The @kbd{d N} (@code{calc-normal-language}) command selects the usual
14004 notation for Calc formulas, as described in the rest of this manual.
14005 Matrices are displayed in a multi-line tabular format, but all other
14006 objects are written in linear form, as they would be typed from the
14007 keyboard.
14008
14009 @kindex d O
14010 @pindex calc-flat-language
14011 @cindex Matrix display
14012 The @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) command selects a language
14013 identical with the normal one, except that matrices are written in
14014 one-line form along with everything else. In some applications this
14015 form may be more suitable for yanking data into other buffers.
14016
14017 @kindex d b
14018 @pindex calc-line-breaking
14019 @cindex Line breaking
14020 @cindex Breaking up long lines
14021 Even in one-line mode, long formulas or vectors will still be split
14022 across multiple lines if they exceed the width of the Calculator window.
14023 The @kbd{d b} (@code{calc-line-breaking}) command turns this line-breaking
14024 feature on and off. (It works independently of the current language.)
14025 If you give a numeric prefix argument of five or greater to the @kbd{d b}
14026 command, that argument will specify the line width used when breaking
14027 long lines.
14028
14029 @kindex d B
14030 @pindex calc-big-language
14031 The @kbd{d B} (@code{calc-big-language}) command selects a language
14032 which uses textual approximations to various mathematical notations,
14033 such as powers, quotients, and square roots:
14034
14035 @example
14036 ____________
14037 | a + 1 2
14038 | ----- + c
14039 \| b
14040 @end example
14041
14042 @noindent
14043 in place of @samp{sqrt((a+1)/b + c^2)}.
14044
14045 Subscripts like @samp{a_i} are displayed as actual subscripts in Big
14046 mode. Double subscripts, @samp{a_i_j} (@samp{subscr(subscr(a, i), j)})
14047 are displayed as @samp{a} with subscripts separated by commas:
14048 @samp{i, j}. They must still be entered in the usual underscore
14049 notation.
14050
14051 One slight ambiguity of Big notation is that
14052
14053 @example
14054 3
14055 - -
14056 4
14057 @end example
14058
14059 @noindent
14060 can represent either the negative rational number @expr{-3:4}, or the
14061 actual expression @samp{-(3/4)}; but the latter formula would normally
14062 never be displayed because it would immediately be evaluated to
14063 @expr{-3:4} or @expr{-0.75}, so this ambiguity is not a problem in
14064 typical use.
14065
14066 Non-decimal numbers are displayed with subscripts. Thus there is no
14067 way to tell the difference between @samp{16#C2} and @samp{C2_16},
14068 though generally you will know which interpretation is correct.
14069 Logarithms @samp{log(x,b)} and @samp{log10(x)} also use subscripts
14070 in Big mode.
14071
14072 In Big mode, stack entries often take up several lines. To aid
14073 readability, stack entries are separated by a blank line in this mode.
14074 You may find it useful to expand the Calc window's height using
14075 @kbd{C-x ^} (@code{enlarge-window}) or to make the Calc window the only
14076 one on the screen with @kbd{C-x 1} (@code{delete-other-windows}).
14077
14078 Long lines are currently not rearranged to fit the window width in
14079 Big mode, so you may need to use the @kbd{<} and @kbd{>} keys
14080 to scroll across a wide formula. For really big formulas, you may
14081 even need to use @kbd{@{} and @kbd{@}} to scroll up and down.
14082
14083 @kindex d U
14084 @pindex calc-unformatted-language
14085 The @kbd{d U} (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) command altogether disables
14086 the use of operator notation in formulas. In this mode, the formula
14087 shown above would be displayed:
14088
14089 @example
14090 sqrt(add(div(add(a, 1), b), pow(c, 2)))
14091 @end example
14092
14093 These four modes differ only in display format, not in the format
14094 expected for algebraic entry. The standard Calc operators work in
14095 all four modes, and unformatted notation works in any language mode
14096 (except that Mathematica mode expects square brackets instead of
14097 parentheses).
14098
14099 @node C FORTRAN Pascal, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Normal Language Modes, Language Modes
14100 @subsection C, FORTRAN, and Pascal Modes
14101
14102 @noindent
14103 @kindex d C
14104 @pindex calc-c-language
14105 @cindex C language
14106 The @kbd{d C} (@code{calc-c-language}) command selects the conventions
14107 of the C language for display and entry of formulas. This differs from
14108 the normal language mode in a variety of (mostly minor) ways. In
14109 particular, C language operators and operator precedences are used in
14110 place of Calc's usual ones. For example, @samp{a^b} means @samp{xor(a,b)}
14111 in C mode; a value raised to a power is written as a function call,
14112 @samp{pow(a,b)}.
14113
14114 In C mode, vectors and matrices use curly braces instead of brackets.
14115 Octal and hexadecimal values are written with leading @samp{0} or @samp{0x}
14116 rather than using the @samp{#} symbol. Array subscripting is
14117 translated into @code{subscr} calls, so that @samp{a[i]} in C
14118 mode is the same as @samp{a_i} in Normal mode. Assignments
14119 turn into the @code{assign} function, which Calc normally displays
14120 using the @samp{:=} symbol.
14121
14122 The variables @code{pi} and @code{e} would be displayed @samp{pi}
14123 and @samp{e} in Normal mode, but in C mode they are displayed as
14124 @samp{M_PI} and @samp{M_E}, corresponding to the names of constants
14125 typically provided in the @file{<math.h>} header. Functions whose
14126 names are different in C are translated automatically for entry and
14127 display purposes. For example, entering @samp{asin(x)} will push the
14128 formula @samp{arcsin(x)} onto the stack; this formula will be displayed
14129 as @samp{asin(x)} as long as C mode is in effect.
14130
14131 @kindex d P
14132 @pindex calc-pascal-language
14133 @cindex Pascal language
14134 The @kbd{d P} (@code{calc-pascal-language}) command selects Pascal
14135 conventions. Like C mode, Pascal mode interprets array brackets and uses
14136 a different table of operators. Hexadecimal numbers are entered and
14137 displayed with a preceding dollar sign. (Thus the regular meaning of
14138 @kbd{$2} during algebraic entry does not work in Pascal mode, though
14139 @kbd{$} (and @kbd{$$}, etc.)@: not followed by digits works the same as
14140 always.) No special provisions are made for other non-decimal numbers,
14141 vectors, and so on, since there is no universally accepted standard way
14142 of handling these in Pascal.
14143
14144 @kindex d F
14145 @pindex calc-fortran-language
14146 @cindex FORTRAN language
14147 The @kbd{d F} (@code{calc-fortran-language}) command selects FORTRAN
14148 conventions. Various function names are transformed into FORTRAN
14149 equivalents. Vectors are written as @samp{/1, 2, 3/}, and may be
14150 entered this way or using square brackets. Since FORTRAN uses round
14151 parentheses for both function calls and array subscripts, Calc displays
14152 both in the same way; @samp{a(i)} is interpreted as a function call
14153 upon reading, and subscripts must be entered as @samp{subscr(a, i)}.
14154 If the variable @code{a} has been declared to have type
14155 @code{vector} or @code{matrix}, however, then @samp{a(i)} will be
14156 parsed as a subscript. (@xref{Declarations}.) Usually it doesn't
14157 matter, though; if you enter the subscript expression @samp{a(i)} and
14158 Calc interprets it as a function call, you'll never know the difference
14159 unless you switch to another language mode or replace @code{a} with an
14160 actual vector (or unless @code{a} happens to be the name of a built-in
14161 function!).
14162
14163 Underscores are allowed in variable and function names in all of these
14164 language modes. The underscore here is equivalent to the @samp{#} in
14165 Normal mode, or to hyphens in the underlying Emacs Lisp variable names.
14166
14167 FORTRAN and Pascal modes normally do not adjust the case of letters in
14168 formulas. Most built-in Calc names use lower-case letters. If you use a
14169 positive numeric prefix argument with @kbd{d P} or @kbd{d F}, these
14170 modes will use upper-case letters exclusively for display, and will
14171 convert to lower-case on input. With a negative prefix, these modes
14172 convert to lower-case for display and input.
14173
14174 @node TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Eqn Language Mode, C FORTRAN Pascal, Language Modes
14175 @subsection @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} Language Modes
14176
14177 @noindent
14178 @kindex d T
14179 @pindex calc-tex-language
14180 @cindex TeX language
14181 @kindex d L
14182 @pindex calc-latex-language
14183 @cindex LaTeX language
14184 The @kbd{d T} (@code{calc-tex-language}) command selects the conventions
14185 of ``math mode'' in Donald Knuth's @TeX{} typesetting language,
14186 and the @kbd{d L} (@code{calc-latex-language}) command selects the
14187 conventions of ``math mode'' in @LaTeX{}, a typesetting language that
14188 uses @TeX{} as its formatting engine. Calc's @LaTeX{} language mode can
14189 read any formula that the @TeX{} language mode can, although @LaTeX{}
14190 mode may display it differently.
14191
14192 Formulas are entered and displayed in the appropriate notation;
14193 @texline @math{\sin(a/b)}
14194 @infoline @expr{sin(a/b)}
14195 will appear as @samp{\sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)} in @TeX{} mode and
14196 @samp{\sin\left(\frac@{a@}@{b@}\right)} in @LaTeX{} mode.
14197 Math formulas are often enclosed by @samp{$ $} signs in @TeX{} and
14198 @LaTeX{}; these should be omitted when interfacing with Calc. To Calc,
14199 the @samp{$} sign has the same meaning it always does in algebraic
14200 formulas (a reference to an existing entry on the stack).
14201
14202 Complex numbers are displayed as in @samp{3 + 4i}. Fractions and
14203 quotients are written using @code{\over} in @TeX{} mode (as in
14204 @code{@{a \over b@}}) and @code{\frac} in @LaTeX{} mode (as in
14205 @code{\frac@{a@}@{b@}}); binomial coefficients are written with
14206 @code{\choose} in @TeX{} mode (as in @code{@{a \choose b@}}) and
14207 @code{\binom} in @LaTeX{} mode (as in @code{\binom@{a@}@{b@}}).
14208 Interval forms are written with @code{\ldots}, and error forms are
14209 written with @code{\pm}. Absolute values are written as in
14210 @samp{|x + 1|}, and the floor and ceiling functions are written with
14211 @code{\lfloor}, @code{\rfloor}, etc. The words @code{\left} and
14212 @code{\right} are ignored when reading formulas in @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}
14213 modes. Both @code{inf} and @code{uinf} are written as @code{\infty};
14214 when read, @code{\infty} always translates to @code{inf}.
14215
14216 Function calls are written the usual way, with the function name followed
14217 by the arguments in parentheses. However, functions for which @TeX{}
14218 and @LaTeX{} have special names (like @code{\sin}) will use curly braces
14219 instead of parentheses for very simple arguments. During input, curly
14220 braces and parentheses work equally well for grouping, but when the
14221 document is formatted the curly braces will be invisible. Thus the
14222 printed result is
14223 @texline @math{\sin{2 x}}
14224 @infoline @expr{sin 2x}
14225 but
14226 @texline @math{\sin(2 + x)}.
14227 @infoline @expr{sin(2 + x)}.
14228
14229 The @TeX{} specific unit names (@pxref{Predefined Units}) will not use
14230 the @samp{tex} prefix; the unit name for a @TeX{} point will be
14231 @samp{pt} instead of @samp{texpt}, for example.
14232
14233 Function and variable names not treated specially by @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}
14234 are simply written out as-is, which will cause them to come out in
14235 italic letters in the printed document. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or
14236 @kbd{d L} with a positive numeric prefix argument, names of more than
14237 one character will instead be enclosed in a protective commands that
14238 will prevent them from being typeset in the math italics; they will be
14239 written @samp{\hbox@{@var{name}@}} in @TeX{} mode and
14240 @samp{\text@{@var{name}@}} in @LaTeX{} mode. The
14241 @samp{\hbox@{ @}} and @samp{\text@{ @}} notations are ignored during
14242 reading. If you use a negative prefix argument, such function names are
14243 written @samp{\@var{name}}, and function names that begin with @code{\} during
14244 reading have the @code{\} removed. (Note that in this mode, long
14245 variable names are still written with @code{\hbox} or @code{\text}.
14246 However, you can always make an actual variable name like @code{\bar} in
14247 any @TeX{} mode.)
14248
14249 During reading, text of the form @samp{\matrix@{ ...@: @}} is replaced
14250 by @samp{[ ...@: ]}. The same also applies to @code{\pmatrix} and
14251 @code{\bmatrix}. In @LaTeX{} mode this also applies to
14252 @samp{\begin@{matrix@} ... \end@{matrix@}},
14253 @samp{\begin@{bmatrix@} ... \end@{bmatrix@}},
14254 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} ... \end@{pmatrix@}}, as well as
14255 @samp{\begin@{smallmatrix@} ... \end@{smallmatrix@}}.
14256 The symbol @samp{&} is interpreted as a comma,
14257 and the symbols @samp{\cr} and @samp{\\} are interpreted as semicolons.
14258 During output, matrices are displayed in @samp{\matrix@{ a & b \\ c & d@}}
14259 format in @TeX{} mode and in
14260 @samp{\begin@{pmatrix@} a & b \\ c & d \end@{pmatrix@}} format in
14261 @LaTeX{} mode; you may need to edit this afterwards to change to your
14262 preferred matrix form. If you invoke @kbd{d T} or @kbd{d L} with an
14263 argument of 2 or -2, then matrices will be displayed in two-dimensional
14264 form, such as
14265
14266 @example
14267 \begin@{pmatrix@}
14268 a & b \\
14269 c & d
14270 \end@{pmatrix@}
14271 @end example
14272
14273 @noindent
14274 This may be convenient for isolated matrices, but could lead to
14275 expressions being displayed like
14276
14277 @example
14278 \begin@{pmatrix@} \times x
14279 a & b \\
14280 c & d
14281 \end@{pmatrix@}
14282 @end example
14283
14284 @noindent
14285 While this wouldn't bother Calc, it is incorrect @LaTeX{}.
14286 (Similarly for @TeX{}.)
14287
14288 Accents like @code{\tilde} and @code{\bar} translate into function
14289 calls internally (@samp{tilde(x)}, @samp{bar(x)}). The @code{\underline}
14290 sequence is treated as an accent. The @code{\vec} accent corresponds
14291 to the function name @code{Vec}, because @code{vec} is the name of
14292 a built-in Calc function. The following table shows the accents
14293 in Calc, @TeX{}, @LaTeX{} and @dfn{eqn} (described in the next section):
14294
14295 @ignore
14296 @iftex
14297 @begingroup
14298 @let@calcindexershow=@calcindexernoshow @c Suppress marginal notes
14299 @let@calcindexersh=@calcindexernoshow
14300 @end iftex
14301 @starindex
14302 @end ignore
14303 @tindex acute
14304 @ignore
14305 @starindex
14306 @end ignore
14307 @tindex Acute
14308 @ignore
14309 @starindex
14310 @end ignore
14311 @tindex bar
14312 @ignore
14313 @starindex
14314 @end ignore
14315 @tindex Bar
14316 @ignore
14317 @starindex
14318 @end ignore
14319 @tindex breve
14320 @ignore
14321 @starindex
14322 @end ignore
14323 @tindex Breve
14324 @ignore
14325 @starindex
14326 @end ignore
14327 @tindex check
14328 @ignore
14329 @starindex
14330 @end ignore
14331 @tindex Check
14332 @ignore
14333 @starindex
14334 @end ignore
14335 @tindex dddot
14336 @ignore
14337 @starindex
14338 @end ignore
14339 @tindex ddddot
14340 @ignore
14341 @starindex
14342 @end ignore
14343 @tindex dot
14344 @ignore
14345 @starindex
14346 @end ignore
14347 @tindex Dot
14348 @ignore
14349 @starindex
14350 @end ignore
14351 @tindex dotdot
14352 @ignore
14353 @starindex
14354 @end ignore
14355 @tindex DotDot
14356 @ignore
14357 @starindex
14358 @end ignore
14359 @tindex dyad
14360 @ignore
14361 @starindex
14362 @end ignore
14363 @tindex grave
14364 @ignore
14365 @starindex
14366 @end ignore
14367 @tindex Grave
14368 @ignore
14369 @starindex
14370 @end ignore
14371 @tindex hat
14372 @ignore
14373 @starindex
14374 @end ignore
14375 @tindex Hat
14376 @ignore
14377 @starindex
14378 @end ignore
14379 @tindex Prime
14380 @ignore
14381 @starindex
14382 @end ignore
14383 @tindex tilde
14384 @ignore
14385 @starindex
14386 @end ignore
14387 @tindex Tilde
14388 @ignore
14389 @starindex
14390 @end ignore
14391 @tindex under
14392 @ignore
14393 @starindex
14394 @end ignore
14395 @tindex Vec
14396 @ignore
14397 @starindex
14398 @end ignore
14399 @tindex VEC
14400 @ignore
14401 @iftex
14402 @endgroup
14403 @end iftex
14404 @end ignore
14405 @example
14406 Calc TeX LaTeX eqn
14407 ---- --- ----- ---
14408 acute \acute \acute
14409 Acute \Acute
14410 bar \bar \bar bar
14411 Bar \Bar
14412 breve \breve \breve
14413 Breve \Breve
14414 check \check \check
14415 Check \Check
14416 dddot \dddot
14417 ddddot \ddddot
14418 dot \dot \dot dot
14419 Dot \Dot
14420 dotdot \ddot \ddot dotdot
14421 DotDot \Ddot
14422 dyad dyad
14423 grave \grave \grave
14424 Grave \Grave
14425 hat \hat \hat hat
14426 Hat \Hat
14427 Prime prime
14428 tilde \tilde \tilde tilde
14429 Tilde \Tilde
14430 under \underline \underline under
14431 Vec \vec \vec vec
14432 VEC \Vec
14433 @end example
14434
14435 The @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operator appears as a @code{\to} symbol:
14436 @samp{@{@var{a} \to @var{b}@}}. @TeX{} defines @code{\to} as an
14437 alias for @code{\rightarrow}. However, if the @samp{=>} is the
14438 top-level expression being formatted, a slightly different notation
14439 is used: @samp{\evalto @var{a} \to @var{b}}. The @code{\evalto}
14440 word is ignored by Calc's input routines, and is undefined in @TeX{}.
14441 You will typically want to include one of the following definitions
14442 at the top of a @TeX{} file that uses @code{\evalto}:
14443
14444 @example
14445 \def\evalto@{@}
14446 \def\evalto#1\to@{@}
14447 @end example
14448
14449 The first definition formats evaluates-to operators in the usual
14450 way. The second causes only the @var{b} part to appear in the
14451 printed document; the @var{a} part and the arrow are hidden.
14452 Another definition you may wish to use is @samp{\let\to=\Rightarrow}
14453 which causes @code{\to} to appear more like Calc's @samp{=>} symbol.
14454 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a discussion of @code{evalto}.
14455
14456 The complete set of @TeX{} control sequences that are ignored during
14457 reading is:
14458
14459 @example
14460 \hbox \mbox \text \left \right
14461 \, \> \: \; \! \quad \qquad \hfil \hfill
14462 \displaystyle \textstyle \dsize \tsize
14463 \scriptstyle \scriptscriptstyle \ssize \ssize
14464 \rm \bf \it \sl \roman \bold \italic \slanted
14465 \cal \mit \Cal \Bbb \frak \goth
14466 \evalto
14467 @end example
14468
14469 Note that, because these symbols are ignored, reading a @TeX{} or
14470 @LaTeX{} formula into Calc and writing it back out may lose spacing and
14471 font information.
14472
14473 Also, the ``discretionary multiplication sign'' @samp{\*} is read
14474 the same as @samp{*}.
14475
14476 @ifnottex
14477 The @TeX{} version of this manual includes some printed examples at the
14478 end of this section.
14479 @end ifnottex
14480 @iftex
14481 Here are some examples of how various Calc formulas are formatted in @TeX{}:
14482
14483 @example
14484 @group
14485 sin(a^2 / b_i)
14486 \sin\left( {a^2 \over b_i} \right)
14487 @end group
14488 @end example
14489 @tex
14490 $$ \sin\left( a^2 \over b_i \right) $$
14491 @end tex
14492 @sp 1
14493
14494 @example
14495 @group
14496 [(3, 4), 3:4, 3 +/- 4, [3 .. inf)]
14497 [3 + 4i, @{3 \over 4@}, 3 \pm 4, [3 \ldots \infty)]
14498 @end group
14499 @end example
14500 @tex
14501 $$ [3 + 4i, {3 \over 4}, 3 \pm 4, [ 3 \ldots \infty)] $$
14502 @end tex
14503 @sp 1
14504
14505 @example
14506 @group
14507 [abs(a), abs(a / b), floor(a), ceil(a / b)]
14508 [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14509 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil]
14510 @end group
14511 @end example
14512 @tex
14513 $$ [|a|, \left| a \over b \right|,
14514 \lfloor a \rfloor, \left\lceil a \over b \right\rceil] $$
14515 @end tex
14516 @sp 1
14517
14518 @example
14519 @group
14520 [sin(a), sin(2 a), sin(2 + a), sin(a / b)]
14521 [\sin@{a@}, \sin@{2 a@}, \sin(2 + a),
14522 \sin\left( @{a \over b@} \right)]
14523 @end group
14524 @end example
14525 @tex
14526 $$ [\sin{a}, \sin{2 a}, \sin(2 + a), \sin\left( {a \over b} \right)] $$
14527 @end tex
14528 @sp 2
14529
14530 First with plain @kbd{d T}, then with @kbd{C-u d T}, then finally with
14531 @kbd{C-u - d T} (using the example definition
14532 @samp{\def\foo#1@{\tilde F(#1)@}}:
14533
14534 @example
14535 @group
14536 [f(a), foo(bar), sin(pi)]
14537 [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}]
14538 [f(a), \hbox@{foo@}(\hbox@{bar@}), \sin@{\pi@}]
14539 [f(a), \foo@{\hbox@{bar@}@}, \sin@{\pi@}]
14540 @end group
14541 @end example
14542 @tex
14543 $$ [f(a), foo(bar), \sin{\pi}] $$
14544 $$ [f(a), \hbox{foo}(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14545 $$ [f(a), \tilde F(\hbox{bar}), \sin{\pi}] $$
14546 @end tex
14547 @sp 2
14548
14549 First with @samp{\def\evalto@{@}}, then with @samp{\def\evalto#1\to@{@}}:
14550
14551 @example
14552 @group
14553 2 + 3 => 5
14554 \evalto 2 + 3 \to 5
14555 @end group
14556 @end example
14557 @tex
14558 $$ 2 + 3 \to 5 $$
14559 $$ 5 $$
14560 @end tex
14561 @sp 2
14562
14563 First with standard @code{\to}, then with @samp{\let\to\Rightarrow}:
14564
14565 @example
14566 @group
14567 [2 + 3 => 5, a / 2 => (b + c) / 2]
14568 [@{2 + 3 \to 5@}, @{@{a \over 2@} \to @{b + c \over 2@}@}]
14569 @end group
14570 @end example
14571 @tex
14572 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$
14573 {\let\to\Rightarrow
14574 $$ [{2 + 3 \to 5}, {{a \over 2} \to {b + c \over 2}}] $$}
14575 @end tex
14576 @sp 2
14577
14578 Matrices normally, then changing @code{\matrix} to @code{\pmatrix}:
14579
14580 @example
14581 @group
14582 [ [ a / b, 0 ], [ 0, 2^(x + 1) ] ]
14583 \matrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14584 \pmatrix@{ @{a \over b@} & 0 \\ 0 & 2^@{(x + 1)@} @}
14585 @end group
14586 @end example
14587 @tex
14588 $$ \matrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14589 $$ \pmatrix{ {a \over b} & 0 \cr 0 & 2^{(x + 1)} } $$
14590 @end tex
14591 @sp 2
14592 @end iftex
14593
14594 @node Eqn Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, TeX and LaTeX Language Modes, Language Modes
14595 @subsection Eqn Language Mode
14596
14597 @noindent
14598 @kindex d E
14599 @pindex calc-eqn-language
14600 @dfn{Eqn} is another popular formatter for math formulas. It is
14601 designed for use with the TROFF text formatter, and comes standard
14602 with many versions of Unix. The @kbd{d E} (@code{calc-eqn-language})
14603 command selects @dfn{eqn} notation.
14604
14605 The @dfn{eqn} language's main idiosyncrasy is that whitespace plays
14606 a significant part in the parsing of the language. For example,
14607 @samp{sqrt x+1 + y} treats @samp{x+1} as the argument of the
14608 @code{sqrt} operator. @dfn{Eqn} also understands more conventional
14609 grouping using curly braces: @samp{sqrt@{x+1@} + y}. Braces are
14610 required only when the argument contains spaces.
14611
14612 In Calc's @dfn{eqn} mode, however, curly braces are required to
14613 delimit arguments of operators like @code{sqrt}. The first of the
14614 above examples would treat only the @samp{x} as the argument of
14615 @code{sqrt}, and in fact @samp{sin x+1} would be interpreted as
14616 @samp{sin * x + 1}, because @code{sin} is not a special operator
14617 in the @dfn{eqn} language. If you always surround the argument
14618 with curly braces, Calc will never misunderstand.
14619
14620 Calc also understands parentheses as grouping characters. Another
14621 peculiarity of @dfn{eqn}'s syntax makes it advisable to separate
14622 words with spaces from any surrounding characters that aren't curly
14623 braces, so Calc writes @samp{sin ( x + y )} in @dfn{eqn} mode.
14624 (The spaces around @code{sin} are important to make @dfn{eqn}
14625 recognize that @code{sin} should be typeset in a roman font, and
14626 the spaces around @code{x} and @code{y} are a good idea just in
14627 case the @dfn{eqn} document has defined special meanings for these
14628 names, too.)
14629
14630 Powers and subscripts are written with the @code{sub} and @code{sup}
14631 operators, respectively. Note that the caret symbol @samp{^} is
14632 treated the same as a space in @dfn{eqn} mode, as is the @samp{~}
14633 symbol (these are used to introduce spaces of various widths into
14634 the typeset output of @dfn{eqn}).
14635
14636 As in @LaTeX{} mode, Calc's formatter omits parentheses around the
14637 arguments of functions like @code{ln} and @code{sin} if they are
14638 ``simple-looking''; in this case Calc surrounds the argument with
14639 braces, separated by a @samp{~} from the function name: @samp{sin~@{x@}}.
14640
14641 Font change codes (like @samp{roman @var{x}}) and positioning codes
14642 (like @samp{~} and @samp{down @var{n} @var{x}}) are ignored by the
14643 @dfn{eqn} reader. Also ignored are the words @code{left}, @code{right},
14644 @code{mark}, and @code{lineup}. Quotation marks in @dfn{eqn} mode input
14645 are treated the same as curly braces: @samp{sqrt "1+x"} is equivalent to
14646 @samp{sqrt @{1+x@}}; this is only an approximation to the true meaning
14647 of quotes in @dfn{eqn}, but it is good enough for most uses.
14648
14649 Accent codes (@samp{@var{x} dot}) are handled by treating them as
14650 function calls (@samp{dot(@var{x})}) internally.
14651 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a table of these accent
14652 functions. The @code{prime} accent is treated specially if it occurs on
14653 a variable or function name: @samp{f prime prime @w{( x prime )}} is
14654 stored internally as @samp{f'@w{'}(x')}. For example, taking the
14655 derivative of @samp{f(2 x)} with @kbd{a d x} will produce @samp{2 f'(2
14656 x)}, which @dfn{eqn} mode will display as @samp{2 f prime ( 2 x )}.
14657
14658 Assignments are written with the @samp{<-} (left-arrow) symbol,
14659 and @code{evalto} operators are written with @samp{->} or
14660 @samp{evalto ... ->} (@pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for a discussion
14661 of this). The regular Calc symbols @samp{:=} and @samp{=>} are also
14662 recognized for these operators during reading.
14663
14664 Vectors in @dfn{eqn} mode use regular Calc square brackets, but
14665 matrices are formatted as @samp{matrix @{ ccol @{ a above b @} ... @}}.
14666 The words @code{lcol} and @code{rcol} are recognized as synonyms
14667 for @code{ccol} during input, and are generated instead of @code{ccol}
14668 if the matrix justification mode so specifies.
14669
14670 @node Yacas Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Eqn Language Mode, Language Modes
14671 @subsection Yacas Language Mode
14672
14673 @noindent
14674 @kindex d Y
14675 @pindex calc-yacas-language
14676 @cindex Yacas language
14677 The @kbd{d Y} (@code{calc-yacas-language}) command selects the
14678 conventions of Yacas, a free computer algebra system. While the
14679 operators and functions in Yacas are similar to those of Calc, the names
14680 of built-in functions in Yacas are capitalized. The Calc formula
14681 @samp{sin(2 x)}, for example, is entered and displayed @samp{Sin(2 x)}
14682 in Yacas mode, and `@samp{arcsin(x^2)} is @samp{ArcSin(x^2)} in Yacas
14683 mode. Complex numbers are written are written @samp{3 + 4 I}.
14684 The standard special constants are written @code{Pi}, @code{E},
14685 @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio} and @code{Gamma}. @code{Infinity}
14686 represents both @code{inf} and @code{uinf}, and @code{Undefined}
14687 represents @code{nan}.
14688
14689 Certain operators on functions, such as @code{D} for differentiation
14690 and @code{Integrate} for integration, take a prefix form in Yacas. For
14691 example, the derivative of @w{@samp{e^x sin(x)}} can be computed with
14692 @w{@samp{D(x) Exp(x)*Sin(x)}}.
14693
14694 Other notable differences between Yacas and standard Calc expressions
14695 are that vectors and matrices use curly braces in Yacas, and subscripts
14696 use square brackets. If, for example, @samp{A} represents the list
14697 @samp{@{a,2,c,4@}}, then @samp{A[3]} would equal @samp{c}.
14698
14699
14700 @node Maxima Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Yacas Language Mode, Language Modes
14701 @subsection Maxima Language Mode
14702
14703 @noindent
14704 @kindex d X
14705 @pindex calc-maxima-language
14706 @cindex Maxima language
14707 The @kbd{d X} (@code{calc-maxima-language}) command selects the
14708 conventions of Maxima, another free computer algebra system. The
14709 function names in Maxima are similar, but not always identical, to Calc.
14710 For example, instead of @samp{arcsin(x)}, Maxima will use
14711 @samp{asin(x)}. Complex numbers are written @samp{3 + 4 %i}. The
14712 standard special constants are written @code{%pi}, @code{%e},
14713 @code{%i}, @code{%phi} and @code{%gamma}. In Maxima, @code{inf} means
14714 the same as in Calc, but @code{infinity} represents Calc's @code{uinf}.
14715
14716 Underscores as well as percent signs are allowed in function and
14717 variable names in Maxima mode. The underscore again is equivalent to
14718 the @samp{#} in Normal mode, and the percent sign is equivalent to
14719 @samp{o'o}.
14720
14721 Maxima uses square brackets for lists and vectors, and matrices are
14722 written as calls to the function @code{matrix}, given the row vectors of
14723 the matrix as arguments. Square brackets are also used as subscripts.
14724
14725 @node Giac Language Mode, Mathematica Language Mode, Maxima Language Mode, Language Modes
14726 @subsection Giac Language Mode
14727
14728 @noindent
14729 @kindex d A
14730 @pindex calc-giac-language
14731 @cindex Giac language
14732 The @kbd{d A} (@code{calc-giac-language}) command selects the
14733 conventions of Giac, another free computer algebra system. The function
14734 names in Giac are similar to Maxima. Complex numbers are written
14735 @samp{3 + 4 i}. The standard special constants in Giac are the same as
14736 in Calc, except that @code{infinity} represents both Calc's @code{inf}
14737 and @code{uinf}.
14738
14739 Underscores are allowed in function and variable names in Giac mode.
14740 Brackets are used for subscripts. In Giac, indexing of lists begins at
14741 0, instead of 1 as in Calc. So if @samp{A} represents the list
14742 @samp{[a,2,c,4]}, then @samp{A[2]} would equal @samp{c}. In general,
14743 @samp{A[n]} in Giac mode corresponds to @samp{A_(n+1)} in Normal mode.
14744
14745 The Giac interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} has no surrounding brackets;
14746 Calc reads @samp{2 .. 3} as the closed interval @samp{[2 .. 3]} and
14747 writes any kind of interval as @samp{2 .. 3}. This means you cannot see
14748 the difference between an open and a closed interval while in Giac mode.
14749
14750 @node Mathematica Language Mode, Maple Language Mode, Giac Language Mode, Language Modes
14751 @subsection Mathematica Language Mode
14752
14753 @noindent
14754 @kindex d M
14755 @pindex calc-mathematica-language
14756 @cindex Mathematica language
14757 The @kbd{d M} (@code{calc-mathematica-language}) command selects the
14758 conventions of Mathematica. Notable differences in Mathematica mode
14759 are that the names of built-in functions are capitalized, and function
14760 calls use square brackets instead of parentheses. Thus the Calc
14761 formula @samp{sin(2 x)} is entered and displayed @w{@samp{Sin[2 x]}} in
14762 Mathematica mode.
14763
14764 Vectors and matrices use curly braces in Mathematica. Complex numbers
14765 are written @samp{3 + 4 I}. The standard special constants in Calc are
14766 written @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, @code{GoldenRatio}, @code{EulerGamma},
14767 @code{Infinity}, @code{ComplexInfinity}, and @code{Indeterminate} in
14768 Mathematica mode.
14769 Non-decimal numbers are written, e.g., @samp{16^^7fff}. Floating-point
14770 numbers in scientific notation are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14771 Subscripts use double square brackets: @samp{a[[i]]}.
14772
14773 @node Maple Language Mode, Compositions, Mathematica Language Mode, Language Modes
14774 @subsection Maple Language Mode
14775
14776 @noindent
14777 @kindex d W
14778 @pindex calc-maple-language
14779 @cindex Maple language
14780 The @kbd{d W} (@code{calc-maple-language}) command selects the
14781 conventions of Maple.
14782
14783 Maple's language is much like C@. Underscores are allowed in symbol
14784 names; square brackets are used for subscripts; explicit @samp{*}s for
14785 multiplications are required. Use either @samp{^} or @samp{**} to
14786 denote powers.
14787
14788 Maple uses square brackets for lists and curly braces for sets. Calc
14789 interprets both notations as vectors, and displays vectors with square
14790 brackets. This means Maple sets will be converted to lists when they
14791 pass through Calc. As a special case, matrices are written as calls
14792 to the function @code{matrix}, given a list of lists as the argument,
14793 and can be read in this form or with all-capitals @code{MATRIX}.
14794
14795 The Maple interval notation @samp{2 .. 3} is like Giac's interval
14796 notation, and is handled the same by Calc.
14797
14798 Maple writes complex numbers as @samp{3 + 4*I}. Its special constants
14799 are @code{Pi}, @code{E}, @code{I}, and @code{infinity} (all three of
14800 @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} display as @code{infinity}).
14801 Floating-point numbers are written @samp{1.23*10.^3}.
14802
14803 Among things not currently handled by Calc's Maple mode are the
14804 various quote symbols, procedures and functional operators, and
14805 inert (@samp{&}) operators.
14806
14807 @node Compositions, Syntax Tables, Maple Language Mode, Language Modes
14808 @subsection Compositions
14809
14810 @noindent
14811 @cindex Compositions
14812 There are several @dfn{composition functions} which allow you to get
14813 displays in a variety of formats similar to those in Big language
14814 mode. Most of these functions do not evaluate to anything; they are
14815 placeholders which are left in symbolic form by Calc's evaluator but
14816 are recognized by Calc's display formatting routines.
14817
14818 Two of these, @code{string} and @code{bstring}, are described elsewhere.
14819 @xref{Strings}. For example, @samp{string("ABC")} is displayed as
14820 @samp{ABC}. When viewed on the stack it will be indistinguishable from
14821 the variable @code{ABC}, but internally it will be stored as
14822 @samp{string([65, 66, 67])} and can still be manipulated this way; for
14823 example, the selection and vector commands @kbd{j 1 v v j u} would
14824 select the vector portion of this object and reverse the elements, then
14825 deselect to reveal a string whose characters had been reversed.
14826
14827 The composition functions do the same thing in all language modes
14828 (although their components will of course be formatted in the current
14829 language mode). The one exception is Unformatted mode (@kbd{d U}),
14830 which does not give the composition functions any special treatment.
14831 The functions are discussed here because of their relationship to
14832 the language modes.
14833
14834 @menu
14835 * Composition Basics::
14836 * Horizontal Compositions::
14837 * Vertical Compositions::
14838 * Other Compositions::
14839 * Information about Compositions::
14840 * User-Defined Compositions::
14841 @end menu
14842
14843 @node Composition Basics, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions, Compositions
14844 @subsubsection Composition Basics
14845
14846 @noindent
14847 Compositions are generally formed by stacking formulas together
14848 horizontally or vertically in various ways. Those formulas are
14849 themselves compositions. @TeX{} users will find this analogous
14850 to @TeX{}'s ``boxes.'' Each multi-line composition has a
14851 @dfn{baseline}; horizontal compositions use the baselines to
14852 decide how formulas should be positioned relative to one another.
14853 For example, in the Big mode formula
14854
14855 @example
14856 @group
14857 2
14858 a + b
14859 17 + ------
14860 c
14861 @end group
14862 @end example
14863
14864 @noindent
14865 the second term of the sum is four lines tall and has line three as
14866 its baseline. Thus when the term is combined with 17, line three
14867 is placed on the same level as the baseline of 17.
14868
14869 @tex
14870 \bigskip
14871 @end tex
14872
14873 Another important composition concept is @dfn{precedence}. This is
14874 an integer that represents the binding strength of various operators.
14875 For example, @samp{*} has higher precedence (195) than @samp{+} (180),
14876 which means that @samp{(a * b) + c} will be formatted without the
14877 parentheses, but @samp{a * (b + c)} will keep the parentheses.
14878
14879 The operator table used by normal and Big language modes has the
14880 following precedences:
14881
14882 @example
14883 _ 1200 @r{(subscripts)}
14884 % 1100 @r{(as in n}%@r{)}
14885 ! 1000 @r{(as in }!@r{n)}
14886 mod 400
14887 +/- 300
14888 !! 210 @r{(as in n}!!@r{)}
14889 ! 210 @r{(as in n}!@r{)}
14890 ^ 200
14891 - 197 @r{(as in }-@r{n)}
14892 * 195 @r{(or implicit multiplication)}
14893 / % \ 190
14894 + - 180 @r{(as in a}+@r{b)}
14895 | 170
14896 < = 160 @r{(and other relations)}
14897 && 110
14898 || 100
14899 ? : 90
14900 !!! 85
14901 &&& 80
14902 ||| 75
14903 := 50
14904 :: 45
14905 => 40
14906 @end example
14907
14908 The general rule is that if an operator with precedence @expr{n}
14909 occurs as an argument to an operator with precedence @expr{m}, then
14910 the argument is enclosed in parentheses if @expr{n < m}. Top-level
14911 expressions and expressions which are function arguments, vector
14912 components, etc., are formatted with precedence zero (so that they
14913 normally never get additional parentheses).
14914
14915 For binary left-associative operators like @samp{+}, the righthand
14916 argument is actually formatted with one-higher precedence than shown
14917 in the table. This makes sure @samp{(a + b) + c} omits the parentheses,
14918 but the unnatural form @samp{a + (b + c)} keeps its parentheses.
14919 Right-associative operators like @samp{^} format the lefthand argument
14920 with one-higher precedence.
14921
14922 @ignore
14923 @starindex
14924 @end ignore
14925 @tindex cprec
14926 The @code{cprec} function formats an expression with an arbitrary
14927 precedence. For example, @samp{cprec(abc, 185)} will combine into
14928 sums and products as follows: @samp{7 + abc}, @samp{7 (abc)} (because
14929 this @code{cprec} form has higher precedence than addition, but lower
14930 precedence than multiplication).
14931
14932 @tex
14933 \bigskip
14934 @end tex
14935
14936 A final composition issue is @dfn{line breaking}. Calc uses two
14937 different strategies for ``flat'' and ``non-flat'' compositions.
14938 A non-flat composition is anything that appears on multiple lines
14939 (not counting line breaking). Examples would be matrices and Big
14940 mode powers and quotients. Non-flat compositions are displayed
14941 exactly as specified. If they come out wider than the current
14942 window, you must use horizontal scrolling (@kbd{<} and @kbd{>}) to
14943 view them.
14944
14945 Flat compositions, on the other hand, will be broken across several
14946 lines if they are too wide to fit the window. Certain points in a
14947 composition are noted internally as @dfn{break points}. Calc's
14948 general strategy is to fill each line as much as possible, then to
14949 move down to the next line starting at the first break point that
14950 didn't fit. However, the line breaker understands the hierarchical
14951 structure of formulas. It will not break an ``inner'' formula if
14952 it can use an earlier break point from an ``outer'' formula instead.
14953 For example, a vector of sums might be formatted as:
14954
14955 @example
14956 @group
14957 [ a + b + c, d + e + f,
14958 g + h + i, j + k + l, m ]
14959 @end group
14960 @end example
14961
14962 @noindent
14963 If the @samp{m} can fit, then so, it seems, could the @samp{g}.
14964 But Calc prefers to break at the comma since the comma is part
14965 of a ``more outer'' formula. Calc would break at a plus sign
14966 only if it had to, say, if the very first sum in the vector had
14967 itself been too large to fit.
14968
14969 Of the composition functions described below, only @code{choriz}
14970 generates break points. The @code{bstring} function (@pxref{Strings})
14971 also generates breakable items: A break point is added after every
14972 space (or group of spaces) except for spaces at the very beginning or
14973 end of the string.
14974
14975 Composition functions themselves count as levels in the formula
14976 hierarchy, so a @code{choriz} that is a component of a larger
14977 @code{choriz} will be less likely to be broken. As a special case,
14978 if a @code{bstring} occurs as a component of a @code{choriz} or
14979 @code{choriz}-like object (such as a vector or a list of arguments
14980 in a function call), then the break points in that @code{bstring}
14981 will be on the same level as the break points of the surrounding
14982 object.
14983
14984 @node Horizontal Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Composition Basics, Compositions
14985 @subsubsection Horizontal Compositions
14986
14987 @noindent
14988 @ignore
14989 @starindex
14990 @end ignore
14991 @tindex choriz
14992 The @code{choriz} function takes a vector of objects and composes
14993 them horizontally. For example, @samp{choriz([17, a b/c, d])} formats
14994 as @w{@samp{17a b / cd}} in Normal language mode, or as
14995
14996 @example
14997 @group
14998 a b
14999 17---d
15000 c
15001 @end group
15002 @end example
15003
15004 @noindent
15005 in Big language mode. This is actually one case of the general
15006 function @samp{choriz(@var{vec}, @var{sep}, @var{prec})}, where
15007 either or both of @var{sep} and @var{prec} may be omitted.
15008 @var{Prec} gives the @dfn{precedence} to use when formatting
15009 each of the components of @var{vec}. The default precedence is
15010 the precedence from the surrounding environment.
15011
15012 @var{Sep} is a string (i.e., a vector of character codes as might
15013 be entered with @code{" "} notation) which should separate components
15014 of the composition. Also, if @var{sep} is given, the line breaker
15015 will allow lines to be broken after each occurrence of @var{sep}.
15016 If @var{sep} is omitted, the composition will not be breakable
15017 (unless any of its component compositions are breakable).
15018
15019 For example, @samp{2 choriz([a, b c, d = e], " + ", 180)} is
15020 formatted as @samp{2 a + b c + (d = e)}. To get the @code{choriz}
15021 to have precedence 180 ``outwards'' as well as ``inwards,''
15022 enclose it in a @code{cprec} form: @samp{2 cprec(choriz(...), 180)}
15023 formats as @samp{2 (a + b c + (d = e))}.
15024
15025 The baseline of a horizontal composition is the same as the
15026 baselines of the component compositions, which are all aligned.
15027
15028 @node Vertical Compositions, Other Compositions, Horizontal Compositions, Compositions
15029 @subsubsection Vertical Compositions
15030
15031 @noindent
15032 @ignore
15033 @starindex
15034 @end ignore
15035 @tindex cvert
15036 The @code{cvert} function makes a vertical composition. Each
15037 component of the vector is centered in a column. The baseline of
15038 the result is by default the top line of the resulting composition.
15039 For example, @samp{f(cvert([a, bb, ccc]), cvert([a^2 + 1, b^2]))}
15040 formats in Big mode as
15041
15042 @example
15043 @group
15044 f( a , 2 )
15045 bb a + 1
15046 ccc 2
15047 b
15048 @end group
15049 @end example
15050
15051 @ignore
15052 @starindex
15053 @end ignore
15054 @tindex cbase
15055 There are several special composition functions that work only as
15056 components of a vertical composition. The @code{cbase} function
15057 controls the baseline of the vertical composition; the baseline
15058 will be the same as the baseline of whatever component is enclosed
15059 in @code{cbase}. Thus @samp{f(cvert([a, cbase(bb), ccc]),
15060 cvert([a^2 + 1, cbase(b^2)]))} displays as
15061
15062 @example
15063 @group
15064 2
15065 a + 1
15066 a 2
15067 f(bb , b )
15068 ccc
15069 @end group
15070 @end example
15071
15072 @ignore
15073 @starindex
15074 @end ignore
15075 @tindex ctbase
15076 @ignore
15077 @starindex
15078 @end ignore
15079 @tindex cbbase
15080 There are also @code{ctbase} and @code{cbbase} functions which
15081 make the baseline of the vertical composition equal to the top
15082 or bottom line (rather than the baseline) of that component.
15083 Thus @samp{cvert([cbase(a / b)]) + cvert([ctbase(a / b)]) +
15084 cvert([cbbase(a / b)])} gives
15085
15086 @example
15087 @group
15088 a
15089 a -
15090 - + a + b
15091 b -
15092 b
15093 @end group
15094 @end example
15095
15096 There should be only one @code{cbase}, @code{ctbase}, or @code{cbbase}
15097 function in a given vertical composition. These functions can also
15098 be written with no arguments: @samp{ctbase()} is a zero-height object
15099 which means the baseline is the top line of the following item, and
15100 @samp{cbbase()} means the baseline is the bottom line of the preceding
15101 item.
15102
15103 @ignore
15104 @starindex
15105 @end ignore
15106 @tindex crule
15107 The @code{crule} function builds a ``rule,'' or horizontal line,
15108 across a vertical composition. By itself @samp{crule()} uses @samp{-}
15109 characters to build the rule. You can specify any other character,
15110 e.g., @samp{crule("=")}. The argument must be a character code or
15111 vector of exactly one character code. It is repeated to match the
15112 width of the widest item in the stack. For example, a quotient
15113 with a thick line is @samp{cvert([a + 1, cbase(crule("=")), b^2])}:
15114
15115 @example
15116 @group
15117 a + 1
15118 =====
15119 2
15120 b
15121 @end group
15122 @end example
15123
15124 @ignore
15125 @starindex
15126 @end ignore
15127 @tindex clvert
15128 @ignore
15129 @starindex
15130 @end ignore
15131 @tindex crvert
15132 Finally, the functions @code{clvert} and @code{crvert} act exactly
15133 like @code{cvert} except that the items are left- or right-justified
15134 in the stack. Thus @samp{clvert([a, bb, ccc]) + crvert([a, bb, ccc])}
15135 gives:
15136
15137 @example
15138 @group
15139 a + a
15140 bb bb
15141 ccc ccc
15142 @end group
15143 @end example
15144
15145 Like @code{choriz}, the vertical compositions accept a second argument
15146 which gives the precedence to use when formatting the components.
15147 Vertical compositions do not support separator strings.
15148
15149 @node Other Compositions, Information about Compositions, Vertical Compositions, Compositions
15150 @subsubsection Other Compositions
15151
15152 @noindent
15153 @ignore
15154 @starindex
15155 @end ignore
15156 @tindex csup
15157 The @code{csup} function builds a superscripted expression. For
15158 example, @samp{csup(a, b)} looks the same as @samp{a^b} does in Big
15159 language mode. This is essentially a horizontal composition of
15160 @samp{a} and @samp{b}, where @samp{b} is shifted up so that its
15161 bottom line is one above the baseline.
15162
15163 @ignore
15164 @starindex
15165 @end ignore
15166 @tindex csub
15167 Likewise, the @code{csub} function builds a subscripted expression.
15168 This shifts @samp{b} down so that its top line is one below the
15169 bottom line of @samp{a} (note that this is not quite analogous to
15170 @code{csup}). Other arrangements can be obtained by using
15171 @code{choriz} and @code{cvert} directly.
15172
15173 @ignore
15174 @starindex
15175 @end ignore
15176 @tindex cflat
15177 The @code{cflat} function formats its argument in ``flat'' mode,
15178 as obtained by @samp{d O}, if the current language mode is normal
15179 or Big. It has no effect in other language modes. For example,
15180 @samp{a^(b/c)} is formatted by Big mode like @samp{csup(a, cflat(b/c))}
15181 to improve its readability.
15182
15183 @ignore
15184 @starindex
15185 @end ignore
15186 @tindex cspace
15187 The @code{cspace} function creates horizontal space. For example,
15188 @samp{cspace(4)} is effectively the same as @samp{string(" ")}.
15189 A second string (i.e., vector of characters) argument is repeated
15190 instead of the space character. For example, @samp{cspace(4, "ab")}
15191 looks like @samp{abababab}. If the second argument is not a string,
15192 it is formatted in the normal way and then several copies of that
15193 are composed together: @samp{cspace(4, a^2)} yields
15194
15195 @example
15196 @group
15197 2 2 2 2
15198 a a a a
15199 @end group
15200 @end example
15201
15202 @noindent
15203 If the number argument is zero, this is a zero-width object.
15204
15205 @ignore
15206 @starindex
15207 @end ignore
15208 @tindex cvspace
15209 The @code{cvspace} function creates vertical space, or a vertical
15210 stack of copies of a certain string or formatted object. The
15211 baseline is the center line of the resulting stack. A numerical
15212 argument of zero will produce an object which contributes zero
15213 height if used in a vertical composition.
15214
15215 @ignore
15216 @starindex
15217 @end ignore
15218 @tindex ctspace
15219 @ignore
15220 @starindex
15221 @end ignore
15222 @tindex cbspace
15223 There are also @code{ctspace} and @code{cbspace} functions which
15224 create vertical space with the baseline the same as the baseline
15225 of the top or bottom copy, respectively, of the second argument.
15226 Thus @samp{cvspace(2, a/b) + ctspace(2, a/b) + cbspace(2, a/b)}
15227 displays as:
15228
15229 @example
15230 @group
15231 a
15232 -
15233 a b
15234 - a a
15235 b + - + -
15236 a b b
15237 - a
15238 b -
15239 b
15240 @end group
15241 @end example
15242
15243 @node Information about Compositions, User-Defined Compositions, Other Compositions, Compositions
15244 @subsubsection Information about Compositions
15245
15246 @noindent
15247 The functions in this section are actual functions; they compose their
15248 arguments according to the current language and other display modes,
15249 then return a certain measurement of the composition as an integer.
15250
15251 @ignore
15252 @starindex
15253 @end ignore
15254 @tindex cwidth
15255 The @code{cwidth} function measures the width, in characters, of a
15256 composition. For example, @samp{cwidth(a + b)} is 5, and
15257 @samp{cwidth(a / b)} is 5 in Normal mode, 1 in Big mode, and 11 in
15258 @TeX{} mode (for @samp{@{a \over b@}}). The argument may involve
15259 the composition functions described in this section.
15260
15261 @ignore
15262 @starindex
15263 @end ignore
15264 @tindex cheight
15265 The @code{cheight} function measures the height of a composition.
15266 This is the total number of lines in the argument's printed form.
15267
15268 @ignore
15269 @starindex
15270 @end ignore
15271 @tindex cascent
15272 @ignore
15273 @starindex
15274 @end ignore
15275 @tindex cdescent
15276 The functions @code{cascent} and @code{cdescent} measure the amount
15277 of the height that is above (and including) the baseline, or below
15278 the baseline, respectively. Thus @samp{cascent(@var{x}) + cdescent(@var{x})}
15279 always equals @samp{cheight(@var{x})}. For a one-line formula like
15280 @samp{a + b}, @code{cascent} returns 1 and @code{cdescent} returns 0.
15281 For @samp{a / b} in Big mode, @code{cascent} returns 2 and @code{cdescent}
15282 returns 1. The only formula for which @code{cascent} will return zero
15283 is @samp{cvspace(0)} or equivalents.
15284
15285 @node User-Defined Compositions, , Information about Compositions, Compositions
15286 @subsubsection User-Defined Compositions
15287
15288 @noindent
15289 @kindex Z C
15290 @pindex calc-user-define-composition
15291 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command lets you
15292 define the display format for any algebraic function. You provide a
15293 formula containing a certain number of argument variables on the stack.
15294 Any time Calc formats a call to the specified function in the current
15295 language mode and with that number of arguments, Calc effectively
15296 replaces the function call with that formula with the arguments
15297 replaced.
15298
15299 Calc builds the default argument list by sorting all the variable names
15300 that appear in the formula into alphabetical order. You can edit this
15301 argument list before pressing @key{RET} if you wish. Any variables in
15302 the formula that do not appear in the argument list will be displayed
15303 literally; any arguments that do not appear in the formula will not
15304 affect the display at all.
15305
15306 You can define formats for built-in functions, for functions you have
15307 defined with @kbd{Z F} (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}), or for functions
15308 which have no definitions but are being used as purely syntactic objects.
15309 You can define different formats for each language mode, and for each
15310 number of arguments, using a succession of @kbd{Z C} commands. When
15311 Calc formats a function call, it first searches for a format defined
15312 for the current language mode (and number of arguments); if there is
15313 none, it uses the format defined for the Normal language mode. If
15314 neither format exists, Calc uses its built-in standard format for that
15315 function (usually just @samp{@var{func}(@var{args})}).
15316
15317 If you execute @kbd{Z C} with the number 0 on the stack instead of a
15318 formula, any defined formats for the function in the current language
15319 mode will be removed. The function will revert to its standard format.
15320
15321 For example, the default format for the binomial coefficient function
15322 @samp{choose(n, m)} in the Big language mode is
15323
15324 @example
15325 @group
15326 n
15327 ( )
15328 m
15329 @end group
15330 @end example
15331
15332 @noindent
15333 You might prefer the notation,
15334
15335 @example
15336 @group
15337 C
15338 n m
15339 @end group
15340 @end example
15341
15342 @noindent
15343 To define this notation, first make sure you are in Big mode,
15344 then put the formula
15345
15346 @smallexample
15347 choriz([cvert([cvspace(1), n]), C, cvert([cvspace(1), m])])
15348 @end smallexample
15349
15350 @noindent
15351 on the stack and type @kbd{Z C}. Answer the first prompt with
15352 @code{choose}. The second prompt will be the default argument list
15353 of @samp{(C m n)}. Edit this list to be @samp{(n m)} and press
15354 @key{RET}. Now, try it out: For example, turn simplification
15355 off with @kbd{m O} and enter @samp{choose(a,b) + choose(7,3)}
15356 as an algebraic entry.
15357
15358 @example
15359 @group
15360 C + C
15361 a b 7 3
15362 @end group
15363 @end example
15364
15365 As another example, let's define the usual notation for Stirling
15366 numbers of the first kind, @samp{stir1(n, m)}. This is just like
15367 the regular format for binomial coefficients but with square brackets
15368 instead of parentheses.
15369
15370 @smallexample
15371 choriz([string("["), cvert([n, cbase(cvspace(1)), m]), string("]")])
15372 @end smallexample
15373
15374 Now type @kbd{Z C stir1 @key{RET}}, edit the argument list to
15375 @samp{(n m)}, and type @key{RET}.
15376
15377 The formula provided to @kbd{Z C} usually will involve composition
15378 functions, but it doesn't have to. Putting the formula @samp{a + b + c}
15379 onto the stack and typing @kbd{Z C foo @key{RET} @key{RET}} would define
15380 the function @samp{foo(x,y,z)} to display like @samp{x + y + z}.
15381 This ``sum'' will act exactly like a real sum for all formatting
15382 purposes (it will be parenthesized the same, and so on). However
15383 it will be computationally unrelated to a sum. For example, the
15384 formula @samp{2 * foo(1, 2, 3)} will display as @samp{2 (1 + 2 + 3)}.
15385 Operator precedences have caused the ``sum'' to be written in
15386 parentheses, but the arguments have not actually been summed.
15387 (Generally a display format like this would be undesirable, since
15388 it can easily be confused with a real sum.)
15389
15390 The special function @code{eval} can be used inside a @kbd{Z C}
15391 composition formula to cause all or part of the formula to be
15392 evaluated at display time. For example, if the formula is
15393 @samp{a + eval(b + c)}, then @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} will be displayed
15394 as @samp{1 + 5}. Evaluation will use the default simplifications,
15395 regardless of the current simplification mode. There are also
15396 @code{evalsimp} and @code{evalextsimp} which simplify as if by
15397 @kbd{a s} and @kbd{a e} (respectively). Note that these ``functions''
15398 operate only in the context of composition formulas (and also in
15399 rewrite rules, where they serve a similar purpose; @pxref{Rewrite
15400 Rules}). On the stack, a call to @code{eval} will be left in
15401 symbolic form.
15402
15403 It is not a good idea to use @code{eval} except as a last resort.
15404 It can cause the display of formulas to be extremely slow. For
15405 example, while @samp{eval(a + b)} might seem quite fast and simple,
15406 there are several situations where it could be slow. For example,
15407 @samp{a} and/or @samp{b} could be polar complex numbers, in which
15408 case doing the sum requires trigonometry. Or, @samp{a} could be
15409 the factorial @samp{fact(100)} which is unevaluated because you
15410 have typed @kbd{m O}; @code{eval} will evaluate it anyway to
15411 produce a large, unwieldy integer.
15412
15413 You can save your display formats permanently using the @kbd{Z P}
15414 command (@pxref{Creating User Keys}).
15415
15416 @node Syntax Tables, , Compositions, Language Modes
15417 @subsection Syntax Tables
15418
15419 @noindent
15420 @cindex Syntax tables
15421 @cindex Parsing formulas, customized
15422 Syntax tables do for input what compositions do for output: They
15423 allow you to teach custom notations to Calc's formula parser.
15424 Calc keeps a separate syntax table for each language mode.
15425
15426 (Note that the Calc ``syntax tables'' discussed here are completely
15427 unrelated to the syntax tables described in the Emacs manual.)
15428
15429 @kindex Z S
15430 @pindex calc-edit-user-syntax
15431 The @kbd{Z S} (@code{calc-edit-user-syntax}) command edits the
15432 syntax table for the current language mode. If you want your
15433 syntax to work in any language, define it in the Normal language
15434 mode. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing the syntax table, or
15435 @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @kbd{m m} command saves all
15436 the syntax tables along with the other mode settings;
15437 @pxref{General Mode Commands}.
15438
15439 @menu
15440 * Syntax Table Basics::
15441 * Precedence in Syntax Tables::
15442 * Advanced Syntax Patterns::
15443 * Conditional Syntax Rules::
15444 @end menu
15445
15446 @node Syntax Table Basics, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15447 @subsubsection Syntax Table Basics
15448
15449 @noindent
15450 @dfn{Parsing} is the process of converting a raw string of characters,
15451 such as you would type in during algebraic entry, into a Calc formula.
15452 Calc's parser works in two stages. First, the input is broken down
15453 into @dfn{tokens}, such as words, numbers, and punctuation symbols
15454 like @samp{+}, @samp{:=}, and @samp{+/-}. Space between tokens is
15455 ignored (except when it serves to separate adjacent words). Next,
15456 the parser matches this string of tokens against various built-in
15457 syntactic patterns, such as ``an expression followed by @samp{+}
15458 followed by another expression'' or ``a name followed by @samp{(},
15459 zero or more expressions separated by commas, and @samp{)}.''
15460
15461 A @dfn{syntax table} is a list of user-defined @dfn{syntax rules},
15462 which allow you to specify new patterns to define your own
15463 favorite input notations. Calc's parser always checks the syntax
15464 table for the current language mode, then the table for the Normal
15465 language mode, before it uses its built-in rules to parse an
15466 algebraic formula you have entered. Each syntax rule should go on
15467 its own line; it consists of a @dfn{pattern}, a @samp{:=} symbol,
15468 and a Calc formula with an optional @dfn{condition}. (Syntax rules
15469 resemble algebraic rewrite rules, but the notation for patterns is
15470 completely different.)
15471
15472 A syntax pattern is a list of tokens, separated by spaces.
15473 Except for a few special symbols, tokens in syntax patterns are
15474 matched literally, from left to right. For example, the rule,
15475
15476 @example
15477 foo ( ) := 2+3
15478 @end example
15479
15480 @noindent
15481 would cause Calc to parse the formula @samp{4+foo()*5} as if it
15482 were @samp{4+(2+3)*5}. Notice that the parentheses were written
15483 as two separate tokens in the rule. As a result, the rule works
15484 for both @samp{foo()} and @w{@samp{foo ( )}}. If we had written
15485 the rule as @samp{foo () := 2+3}, then Calc would treat @samp{()}
15486 as a single, indivisible token, so that @w{@samp{foo( )}} would
15487 not be recognized by the rule. (It would be parsed as a regular
15488 zero-argument function call instead.) In fact, this rule would
15489 also make trouble for the rest of Calc's parser: An unrelated
15490 formula like @samp{bar()} would now be tokenized into @samp{bar ()}
15491 instead of @samp{bar ( )}, so that the standard parser for function
15492 calls would no longer recognize it!
15493
15494 While it is possible to make a token with a mixture of letters
15495 and punctuation symbols, this is not recommended. It is better to
15496 break it into several tokens, as we did with @samp{foo()} above.
15497
15498 The symbol @samp{#} in a syntax pattern matches any Calc expression.
15499 On the righthand side, the things that matched the @samp{#}s can
15500 be referred to as @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, and so on (where @samp{#1}
15501 matches the leftmost @samp{#} in the pattern). For example, these
15502 rules match a user-defined function, prefix operator, infix operator,
15503 and postfix operator, respectively:
15504
15505 @example
15506 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15507 foo # := myprefix(#1)
15508 # foo # := myinfix(#1,#2)
15509 # foo := mypostfix(#1)
15510 @end example
15511
15512 Thus @samp{foo(3)} will parse as @samp{myfunc(3)}, and @samp{2+3 foo}
15513 will parse as @samp{mypostfix(2+3)}.
15514
15515 It is important to write the first two rules in the order shown,
15516 because Calc tries rules in order from first to last. If the
15517 pattern @samp{foo #} came first, it would match anything that could
15518 match the @samp{foo ( # )} rule, since an expression in parentheses
15519 is itself a valid expression. Thus the @w{@samp{foo ( # )}} rule would
15520 never get to match anything. Likewise, the last two rules must be
15521 written in the order shown or else @samp{3 foo 4} will be parsed as
15522 @samp{mypostfix(3) * 4}. (Of course, the best way to avoid these
15523 ambiguities is not to use the same symbol in more than one way at
15524 the same time! In case you're not convinced, try the following
15525 exercise: How will the above rules parse the input @samp{foo(3,4)},
15526 if at all? Work it out for yourself, then try it in Calc and see.)
15527
15528 Calc is quite flexible about what sorts of patterns are allowed.
15529 The only rule is that every pattern must begin with a literal
15530 token (like @samp{foo} in the first two patterns above), or with
15531 a @samp{#} followed by a literal token (as in the last two
15532 patterns). After that, any mixture is allowed, although putting
15533 two @samp{#}s in a row will not be very useful since two
15534 expressions with nothing between them will be parsed as one
15535 expression that uses implicit multiplication.
15536
15537 As a more practical example, Maple uses the notation
15538 @samp{sum(a(i), i=1..10)} for sums, which Calc's Maple mode doesn't
15539 recognize at present. To handle this syntax, we simply add the
15540 rule,
15541
15542 @example
15543 sum ( # , # = # .. # ) := sum(#1,#2,#3,#4)
15544 @end example
15545
15546 @noindent
15547 to the Maple mode syntax table. As another example, C mode can't
15548 read assignment operators like @samp{++} and @samp{*=}. We can
15549 define these operators quite easily:
15550
15551 @example
15552 # *= # := muleq(#1,#2)
15553 # ++ := postinc(#1)
15554 ++ # := preinc(#1)
15555 @end example
15556
15557 @noindent
15558 To complete the job, we would use corresponding composition functions
15559 and @kbd{Z C} to cause these functions to display in their respective
15560 Maple and C notations. (Note that the C example ignores issues of
15561 operator precedence, which are discussed in the next section.)
15562
15563 You can enclose any token in quotes to prevent its usual
15564 interpretation in syntax patterns:
15565
15566 @example
15567 # ":=" # := becomes(#1,#2)
15568 @end example
15569
15570 Quotes also allow you to include spaces in a token, although once
15571 again it is generally better to use two tokens than one token with
15572 an embedded space. To include an actual quotation mark in a quoted
15573 token, precede it with a backslash. (This also works to include
15574 backslashes in tokens.)
15575
15576 @example
15577 # "bad token" # "/\"\\" # := silly(#1,#2,#3)
15578 @end example
15579
15580 @noindent
15581 This will parse @samp{3 bad token 4 /"\ 5} to @samp{silly(3,4,5)}.
15582
15583 The token @kbd{#} has a predefined meaning in Calc's formula parser;
15584 it is not valid to use @samp{"#"} in a syntax rule. However, longer
15585 tokens that include the @samp{#} character are allowed. Also, while
15586 @samp{"$"} and @samp{"\""} are allowed as tokens, their presence in
15587 the syntax table will prevent those characters from working in their
15588 usual ways (referring to stack entries and quoting strings,
15589 respectively).
15590
15591 Finally, the notation @samp{%%} anywhere in a syntax table causes
15592 the rest of the line to be ignored as a comment.
15593
15594 @node Precedence in Syntax Tables, Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Table Basics, Syntax Tables
15595 @subsubsection Precedence
15596
15597 @noindent
15598 Different operators are generally assigned different @dfn{precedences}.
15599 By default, an operator defined by a rule like
15600
15601 @example
15602 # foo # := foo(#1,#2)
15603 @end example
15604
15605 @noindent
15606 will have an extremely low precedence, so that @samp{2*3+4 foo 5 == 6}
15607 will be parsed as @samp{(2*3+4) foo (5 == 6)}. To change the
15608 precedence of an operator, use the notation @samp{#/@var{p}} in
15609 place of @samp{#}, where @var{p} is an integer precedence level.
15610 For example, 185 lies between the precedences for @samp{+} and
15611 @samp{*}, so if we change this rule to
15612
15613 @example
15614 #/185 foo #/186 := foo(#1,#2)
15615 @end example
15616
15617 @noindent
15618 then @samp{2+3 foo 4*5} will be parsed as @samp{2+(3 foo (4*5))}.
15619 Also, because we've given the righthand expression slightly higher
15620 precedence, our new operator will be left-associative:
15621 @samp{1 foo 2 foo 3} will be parsed as @samp{(1 foo 2) foo 3}.
15622 By raising the precedence of the lefthand expression instead, we
15623 can create a right-associative operator.
15624
15625 @xref{Composition Basics}, for a table of precedences of the
15626 standard Calc operators. For the precedences of operators in other
15627 language modes, look in the Calc source file @file{calc-lang.el}.
15628
15629 @node Advanced Syntax Patterns, Conditional Syntax Rules, Precedence in Syntax Tables, Syntax Tables
15630 @subsubsection Advanced Syntax Patterns
15631
15632 @noindent
15633 To match a function with a variable number of arguments, you could
15634 write
15635
15636 @example
15637 foo ( # ) := myfunc(#1)
15638 foo ( # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2)
15639 foo ( # , # , # ) := myfunc(#1,#2,#3)
15640 @end example
15641
15642 @noindent
15643 but this isn't very elegant. To match variable numbers of items,
15644 Calc uses some notations inspired regular expressions and the
15645 ``extended BNF'' style used by some language designers.
15646
15647 @example
15648 foo ( @{ # @}*, ) := apply(myfunc,#1)
15649 @end example
15650
15651 The token @samp{@{} introduces a repeated or optional portion.
15652 One of the three tokens @samp{@}*}, @samp{@}+}, or @samp{@}?}
15653 ends the portion. These will match zero or more, one or more,
15654 or zero or one copies of the enclosed pattern, respectively.
15655 In addition, @samp{@}*} and @samp{@}+} can be followed by a
15656 separator token (with no space in between, as shown above).
15657 Thus @samp{@{ # @}*,} matches nothing, or one expression, or
15658 several expressions separated by commas.
15659
15660 A complete @samp{@{ ... @}} item matches as a vector of the
15661 items that matched inside it. For example, the above rule will
15662 match @samp{foo(1,2,3)} to get @samp{apply(myfunc,[1,2,3])}.
15663 The Calc @code{apply} function takes a function name and a vector
15664 of arguments and builds a call to the function with those
15665 arguments, so the net result is the formula @samp{myfunc(1,2,3)}.
15666
15667 If the body of a @samp{@{ ... @}} contains several @samp{#}s
15668 (or nested @samp{@{ ... @}} constructs), then the items will be
15669 strung together into the resulting vector. If the body
15670 does not contain anything but literal tokens, the result will
15671 always be an empty vector.
15672
15673 @example
15674 foo ( @{ # , # @}+, ) := bar(#1)
15675 foo ( @{ @{ # @}*, @}*; ) := matrix(#1)
15676 @end example
15677
15678 @noindent
15679 will parse @samp{foo(1, 2, 3, 4)} as @samp{bar([1, 2, 3, 4])}, and
15680 @samp{foo(1, 2; 3, 4)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2], [3, 4]])}. Also, after
15681 some thought it's easy to see how this pair of rules will parse
15682 @samp{foo(1, 2, 3)} as @samp{matrix([[1, 2, 3]])}, since the first
15683 rule will only match an even number of arguments. The rule
15684
15685 @example
15686 foo ( # @{ , # , # @}? ) := bar(#1,#2)
15687 @end example
15688
15689 @noindent
15690 will parse @samp{foo(2,3,4)} as @samp{bar(2,[3,4])}, and
15691 @samp{foo(2)} as @samp{bar(2,[])}.
15692
15693 The notation @samp{@{ ... @}?.} (note the trailing period) works
15694 just the same as regular @samp{@{ ... @}?}, except that it does not
15695 count as an argument; the following two rules are equivalent:
15696
15697 @example
15698 foo ( # , @{ also @}? # ) := bar(#1,#3)
15699 foo ( # , @{ also @}?. # ) := bar(#1,#2)
15700 @end example
15701
15702 @noindent
15703 Note that in the first case the optional text counts as @samp{#2},
15704 which will always be an empty vector, but in the second case no
15705 empty vector is produced.
15706
15707 Another variant is @samp{@{ ... @}?$}, which means the body is
15708 optional only at the end of the input formula. All built-in syntax
15709 rules in Calc use this for closing delimiters, so that during
15710 algebraic entry you can type @kbd{[sqrt(2), sqrt(3 @key{RET}}, omitting
15711 the closing parenthesis and bracket. Calc does this automatically
15712 for trailing @samp{)}, @samp{]}, and @samp{>} tokens in syntax
15713 rules, but you can use @samp{@{ ... @}?$} explicitly to get
15714 this effect with any token (such as @samp{"@}"} or @samp{end}).
15715 Like @samp{@{ ... @}?.}, this notation does not count as an
15716 argument. Conversely, you can use quotes, as in @samp{")"}, to
15717 prevent a closing-delimiter token from being automatically treated
15718 as optional.
15719
15720 Calc's parser does not have full backtracking, which means some
15721 patterns will not work as you might expect:
15722
15723 @example
15724 foo ( @{ # , @}? # , # ) := bar(#1,#2,#3)
15725 @end example
15726
15727 @noindent
15728 Here we are trying to make the first argument optional, so that
15729 @samp{foo(2,3)} parses as @samp{bar([],2,3)}. Unfortunately, Calc
15730 first tries to match @samp{2,} against the optional part of the
15731 pattern, finds a match, and so goes ahead to match the rest of the
15732 pattern. Later on it will fail to match the second comma, but it
15733 doesn't know how to go back and try the other alternative at that
15734 point. One way to get around this would be to use two rules:
15735
15736 @example
15737 foo ( # , # , # ) := bar([#1],#2,#3)
15738 foo ( # , # ) := bar([],#1,#2)
15739 @end example
15740
15741 More precisely, when Calc wants to match an optional or repeated
15742 part of a pattern, it scans forward attempting to match that part.
15743 If it reaches the end of the optional part without failing, it
15744 ``finalizes'' its choice and proceeds. If it fails, though, it
15745 backs up and tries the other alternative. Thus Calc has ``partial''
15746 backtracking. A fully backtracking parser would go on to make sure
15747 the rest of the pattern matched before finalizing the choice.
15748
15749 @node Conditional Syntax Rules, , Advanced Syntax Patterns, Syntax Tables
15750 @subsubsection Conditional Syntax Rules
15751
15752 @noindent
15753 It is possible to attach a @dfn{condition} to a syntax rule. For
15754 example, the rules
15755
15756 @example
15757 foo ( # ) := ifoo(#1) :: integer(#1)
15758 foo ( # ) := gfoo(#1)
15759 @end example
15760
15761 @noindent
15762 will parse @samp{foo(3)} as @samp{ifoo(3)}, but will parse
15763 @samp{foo(3.5)} and @samp{foo(x)} as calls to @code{gfoo}. Any
15764 number of conditions may be attached; all must be true for the
15765 rule to succeed. A condition is ``true'' if it evaluates to a
15766 nonzero number. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a list of Calc
15767 functions like @code{integer} that perform logical tests.
15768
15769 The exact sequence of events is as follows: When Calc tries a
15770 rule, it first matches the pattern as usual. It then substitutes
15771 @samp{#1}, @samp{#2}, etc., in the conditions, if any. Next, the
15772 conditions are simplified and evaluated in order from left to right,
15773 using the algebraic simplifications (@pxref{Simplifying Formulas}).
15774 Each result is true if it is a nonzero number, or an expression
15775 that can be proven to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}). If the
15776 results of all conditions are true, the expression (such as
15777 @samp{ifoo(#1)}) has its @samp{#}s substituted, and that is the
15778 result of the parse. If the result of any condition is false, Calc
15779 goes on to try the next rule in the syntax table.
15780
15781 Syntax rules also support @code{let} conditions, which operate in
15782 exactly the same way as they do in algebraic rewrite rules.
15783 @xref{Other Features of Rewrite Rules}, for details. A @code{let}
15784 condition is always true, but as a side effect it defines a
15785 variable which can be used in later conditions, and also in the
15786 expression after the @samp{:=} sign:
15787
15788 @example
15789 foo ( # ) := hifoo(x) :: let(x := #1 + 0.5) :: dnumint(x)
15790 @end example
15791
15792 @noindent
15793 The @code{dnumint} function tests if a value is numerically an
15794 integer, i.e., either a true integer or an integer-valued float.
15795 This rule will parse @code{foo} with a half-integer argument,
15796 like @samp{foo(3.5)}, to a call like @samp{hifoo(4.)}.
15797
15798 The lefthand side of a syntax rule @code{let} must be a simple
15799 variable, not the arbitrary pattern that is allowed in rewrite
15800 rules.
15801
15802 The @code{matches} function is also treated specially in syntax
15803 rule conditions (again, in the same way as in rewrite rules).
15804 @xref{Matching Commands}. If the matching pattern contains
15805 meta-variables, then those meta-variables may be used in later
15806 conditions and in the result expression. The arguments to
15807 @code{matches} are not evaluated in this situation.
15808
15809 @example
15810 sum ( # , # ) := sum(#1,a,b,c) :: matches(#2, a=[b..c])
15811 @end example
15812
15813 @noindent
15814 This is another way to implement the Maple mode @code{sum} notation.
15815 In this approach, we allow @samp{#2} to equal the whole expression
15816 @samp{i=1..10}. Then, we use @code{matches} to break it apart into
15817 its components. If the expression turns out not to match the pattern,
15818 the syntax rule will fail. Note that @kbd{Z S} always uses Calc's
15819 Normal language mode for editing expressions in syntax rules, so we
15820 must use regular Calc notation for the interval @samp{[b..c]} that
15821 will correspond to the Maple mode interval @samp{1..10}.
15822
15823 @node Modes Variable, Calc Mode Line, Language Modes, Mode Settings
15824 @section The @code{Modes} Variable
15825
15826 @noindent
15827 @kindex m g
15828 @pindex calc-get-modes
15829 The @kbd{m g} (@code{calc-get-modes}) command pushes onto the stack
15830 a vector of numbers that describes the various mode settings that
15831 are in effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it pushes only the
15832 @var{n}th mode, i.e., the @var{n}th element of this vector. Keyboard
15833 macros can use the @kbd{m g} command to modify their behavior based
15834 on the current mode settings.
15835
15836 @cindex @code{Modes} variable
15837 @vindex Modes
15838 The modes vector is also available in the special variable
15839 @code{Modes}. In other words, @kbd{m g} is like @kbd{s r Modes @key{RET}}.
15840 It will not work to store into this variable; in fact, if you do,
15841 @code{Modes} will cease to track the current modes. (The @kbd{m g}
15842 command will continue to work, however.)
15843
15844 In general, each number in this vector is suitable as a numeric
15845 prefix argument to the associated mode-setting command. (Recall
15846 that the @kbd{~} key takes a number from the stack and gives it as
15847 a numeric prefix to the next command.)
15848
15849 The elements of the modes vector are as follows:
15850
15851 @enumerate
15852 @item
15853 Current precision. Default is 12; associated command is @kbd{p}.
15854
15855 @item
15856 Binary word size. Default is 32; associated command is @kbd{b w}.
15857
15858 @item
15859 Stack size (not counting the value about to be pushed by @kbd{m g}).
15860 This is zero if @kbd{m g} is executed with an empty stack.
15861
15862 @item
15863 Number radix. Default is 10; command is @kbd{d r}.
15864
15865 @item
15866 Floating-point format. This is the number of digits, plus the
15867 constant 0 for normal notation, 10000 for scientific notation,
15868 20000 for engineering notation, or 30000 for fixed-point notation.
15869 These codes are acceptable as prefix arguments to the @kbd{d n}
15870 command, but note that this may lose information: For example,
15871 @kbd{d s} and @kbd{C-u 12 d s} have similar (but not quite
15872 identical) effects if the current precision is 12, but they both
15873 produce a code of 10012, which will be treated by @kbd{d n} as
15874 @kbd{C-u 12 d s}. If the precision then changes, the float format
15875 will still be frozen at 12 significant figures.
15876
15877 @item
15878 Angular mode. Default is 1 (degrees). Other values are 2 (radians)
15879 and 3 (HMS). The @kbd{m d} command accepts these prefixes.
15880
15881 @item
15882 Symbolic mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m s}.
15883
15884 @item
15885 Fraction mode. Value is 0 or 1; default is 0. Command is @kbd{m f}.
15886
15887 @item
15888 Polar mode. Value is 0 (rectangular) or 1 (polar); default is 0.
15889 Command is @kbd{m p}.
15890
15891 @item
15892 Matrix/Scalar mode. Default value is @mathit{-1}. Value is 0 for Scalar
15893 mode, @mathit{-2} for Matrix mode, @mathit{-3} for square Matrix mode,
15894 or @var{N} for
15895 @texline @math{N\times N}
15896 @infoline @var{N}x@var{N}
15897 Matrix mode. Command is @kbd{m v}.
15898
15899 @item
15900 Simplification mode. Default is 1. Value is @mathit{-1} for off (@kbd{m O}),
15901 0 for @kbd{m N}, 2 for @kbd{m B}, 3 for @kbd{m A}, 4 for @kbd{m E},
15902 or 5 for @w{@kbd{m U}}. The @kbd{m D} command accepts these prefixes.
15903
15904 @item
15905 Infinite mode. Default is @mathit{-1} (off). Value is 1 if the mode is on,
15906 or 0 if the mode is on with positive zeros. Command is @kbd{m i}.
15907 @end enumerate
15908
15909 For example, the sequence @kbd{M-1 m g @key{RET} 2 + ~ p} increases the
15910 precision by two, leaving a copy of the old precision on the stack.
15911 Later, @kbd{~ p} will restore the original precision using that
15912 stack value. (This sequence might be especially useful inside a
15913 keyboard macro.)
15914
15915 As another example, @kbd{M-3 m g 1 - ~ @key{DEL}} deletes all but the
15916 oldest (bottommost) stack entry.
15917
15918 Yet another example: The HP-48 ``round'' command rounds a number
15919 to the current displayed precision. You could roughly emulate this
15920 in Calc with the sequence @kbd{M-5 m g 10000 % ~ c c}. (This
15921 would not work for fixed-point mode, but it wouldn't be hard to
15922 do a full emulation with the help of the @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z ]}
15923 programming commands. @xref{Conditionals in Macros}.)
15924
15925 @node Calc Mode Line, , Modes Variable, Mode Settings
15926 @section The Calc Mode Line
15927
15928 @noindent
15929 @cindex Mode line indicators
15930 This section is a summary of all symbols that can appear on the
15931 Calc mode line, the highlighted bar that appears under the Calc
15932 stack window (or under an editing window in Embedded mode).
15933
15934 The basic mode line format is:
15935
15936 @example
15937 --%*-Calc: 12 Deg @var{other modes} (Calculator)
15938 @end example
15939
15940 The @samp{%*} indicates that the buffer is ``read-only''; it shows that
15941 regular Emacs commands are not allowed to edit the stack buffer
15942 as if it were text.
15943
15944 The word @samp{Calc:} changes to @samp{CalcEmbed:} if Embedded mode
15945 is enabled. The words after this describe the various Calc modes
15946 that are in effect.
15947
15948 The first mode is always the current precision, an integer.
15949 The second mode is always the angular mode, either @code{Deg},
15950 @code{Rad}, or @code{Hms}.
15951
15952 Here is a complete list of the remaining symbols that can appear
15953 on the mode line:
15954
15955 @table @code
15956 @item Alg
15957 Algebraic mode (@kbd{m a}; @pxref{Algebraic Entry}).
15958
15959 @item Alg[(
15960 Incomplete algebraic mode (@kbd{C-u m a}).
15961
15962 @item Alg*
15963 Total algebraic mode (@kbd{m t}).
15964
15965 @item Symb
15966 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}).
15967
15968 @item Matrix
15969 Matrix mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15970
15971 @item Matrix@var{n}
15972 Dimensioned Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u @var{n} m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15973
15974 @item SqMatrix
15975 Square Matrix mode (@kbd{C-u m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15976
15977 @item Scalar
15978 Scalar mode (@kbd{m v}; @pxref{Matrix Mode}).
15979
15980 @item Polar
15981 Polar complex mode (@kbd{m p}; @pxref{Polar Mode}).
15982
15983 @item Frac
15984 Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}; @pxref{Fraction Mode}).
15985
15986 @item Inf
15987 Infinite mode (@kbd{m i}; @pxref{Infinite Mode}).
15988
15989 @item +Inf
15990 Positive Infinite mode (@kbd{C-u 0 m i}).
15991
15992 @item NoSimp
15993 Default simplifications off (@kbd{m O}; @pxref{Simplification Modes}).
15994
15995 @item NumSimp
15996 Default simplifications for numeric arguments only (@kbd{m N}).
15997
15998 @item BinSimp@var{w}
15999 Binary-integer simplification mode; word size @var{w} (@kbd{m B}, @kbd{b w}).
16000
16001 @item BasicSimp
16002 Basic simplification mode (@kbd{m I}).
16003
16004 @item ExtSimp
16005 Extended algebraic simplification mode (@kbd{m E}).
16006
16007 @item UnitSimp
16008 Units simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
16009
16010 @item Bin
16011 Current radix is 2 (@kbd{d 2}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
16012
16013 @item Oct
16014 Current radix is 8 (@kbd{d 8}).
16015
16016 @item Hex
16017 Current radix is 16 (@kbd{d 6}).
16018
16019 @item Radix@var{n}
16020 Current radix is @var{n} (@kbd{d r}).
16021
16022 @item Zero
16023 Leading zeros (@kbd{d z}; @pxref{Radix Modes}).
16024
16025 @item Big
16026 Big language mode (@kbd{d B}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
16027
16028 @item Flat
16029 One-line normal language mode (@kbd{d O}).
16030
16031 @item Unform
16032 Unformatted language mode (@kbd{d U}).
16033
16034 @item C
16035 C language mode (@kbd{d C}; @pxref{C FORTRAN Pascal}).
16036
16037 @item Pascal
16038 Pascal language mode (@kbd{d P}).
16039
16040 @item Fortran
16041 FORTRAN language mode (@kbd{d F}).
16042
16043 @item TeX
16044 @TeX{} language mode (@kbd{d T}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
16045
16046 @item LaTeX
16047 @LaTeX{} language mode (@kbd{d L}; @pxref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}).
16048
16049 @item Eqn
16050 @dfn{Eqn} language mode (@kbd{d E}; @pxref{Eqn Language Mode}).
16051
16052 @item Math
16053 Mathematica language mode (@kbd{d M}; @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}).
16054
16055 @item Maple
16056 Maple language mode (@kbd{d W}; @pxref{Maple Language Mode}).
16057
16058 @item Norm@var{n}
16059 Normal float mode with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d n}; @pxref{Float Formats}).
16060
16061 @item Fix@var{n}
16062 Fixed point mode with @var{n} digits after the point (@kbd{d f}).
16063
16064 @item Sci
16065 Scientific notation mode (@kbd{d s}).
16066
16067 @item Sci@var{n}
16068 Scientific notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d s}).
16069
16070 @item Eng
16071 Engineering notation mode (@kbd{d e}).
16072
16073 @item Eng@var{n}
16074 Engineering notation with @var{n} digits (@kbd{d e}).
16075
16076 @item Left@var{n}
16077 Left-justified display indented by @var{n} (@kbd{d <}; @pxref{Justification}).
16078
16079 @item Right
16080 Right-justified display (@kbd{d >}).
16081
16082 @item Right@var{n}
16083 Right-justified display with width @var{n} (@kbd{d >}).
16084
16085 @item Center
16086 Centered display (@kbd{d =}).
16087
16088 @item Center@var{n}
16089 Centered display with center column @var{n} (@kbd{d =}).
16090
16091 @item Wid@var{n}
16092 Line breaking with width @var{n} (@kbd{d b}; @pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
16093
16094 @item Wide
16095 No line breaking (@kbd{d b}).
16096
16097 @item Break
16098 Selections show deep structure (@kbd{j b}; @pxref{Making Selections}).
16099
16100 @item Save
16101 Record modes in @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el} (@kbd{m R}; @pxref{General Mode Commands}).
16102
16103 @item Local
16104 Record modes in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16105
16106 @item LocEdit
16107 Record modes as editing-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16108
16109 @item LocPerm
16110 Record modes as permanent-only in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16111
16112 @item Global
16113 Record modes as global in Embedded buffer (@kbd{m R}).
16114
16115 @item Manual
16116 Automatic recomputation turned off (@kbd{m C}; @pxref{Automatic
16117 Recomputation}).
16118
16119 @item Graph
16120 GNUPLOT process is alive in background (@pxref{Graphics}).
16121
16122 @item Sel
16123 Top-of-stack has a selection (Embedded only; @pxref{Making Selections}).
16124
16125 @item Dirty
16126 The stack display may not be up-to-date (@pxref{Display Modes}).
16127
16128 @item Inv
16129 ``Inverse'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{I}; @pxref{Inverse and Hyperbolic}).
16130
16131 @item Hyp
16132 ``Hyperbolic'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{H}).
16133
16134 @item Keep
16135 ``Keep-arguments'' prefix was pressed (@kbd{K}).
16136
16137 @item Narrow
16138 Stack is truncated (@kbd{d t}; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}).
16139 @end table
16140
16141 In addition, the symbols @code{Active} and @code{~Active} can appear
16142 as minor modes on an Embedded buffer's mode line. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
16143
16144 @node Arithmetic, Scientific Functions, Mode Settings, Top
16145 @chapter Arithmetic Functions
16146
16147 @noindent
16148 This chapter describes the Calc commands for doing simple calculations
16149 on numbers, such as addition, absolute value, and square roots. These
16150 commands work by removing the top one or two values from the stack,
16151 performing the desired operation, and pushing the result back onto the
16152 stack. If the operation cannot be performed, the result pushed is a
16153 formula instead of a number, such as @samp{2/0} (because division by zero
16154 is invalid) or @samp{sqrt(x)} (because the argument @samp{x} is a formula).
16155
16156 Most of the commands described here can be invoked by a single keystroke.
16157 Some of the more obscure ones are two-letter sequences beginning with
16158 the @kbd{f} (``functions'') prefix key.
16159
16160 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
16161 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
16162 interpret a prefix argument.
16163
16164 @menu
16165 * Basic Arithmetic::
16166 * Integer Truncation::
16167 * Complex Number Functions::
16168 * Conversions::
16169 * Date Arithmetic::
16170 * Financial Functions::
16171 * Binary Functions::
16172 @end menu
16173
16174 @node Basic Arithmetic, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16175 @section Basic Arithmetic
16176
16177 @noindent
16178 @kindex +
16179 @pindex calc-plus
16180 @ignore
16181 @mindex @null
16182 @end ignore
16183 @tindex +
16184 The @kbd{+} (@code{calc-plus}) command adds two numbers. The numbers may
16185 be any of the standard Calc data types. The resulting sum is pushed back
16186 onto the stack.
16187
16188 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are vectors or matrices (of matching dimensions),
16189 the result is a vector or matrix sum. If one argument is a vector and the
16190 other a scalar (i.e., a non-vector), the scalar is added to each of the
16191 elements of the vector to form a new vector. If the scalar is not a
16192 number, the operation is left in symbolic form: Suppose you added @samp{x}
16193 to the vector @samp{[1,2]}. You may want the result @samp{[1+x,2+x]}, or
16194 you may plan to substitute a 2-vector for @samp{x} in the future. Since
16195 the Calculator can't tell which interpretation you want, it makes the
16196 safest assumption. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, for a way to add @samp{x}
16197 to every element of a vector.
16198
16199 If either argument of @kbd{+} is a complex number, the result will in general
16200 be complex. If one argument is in rectangular form and the other polar,
16201 the current Polar mode determines the form of the result. If Symbolic
16202 mode is enabled, the sum may be left as a formula if the necessary
16203 conversions for polar addition are non-trivial.
16204
16205 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are HMS forms, the forms are added according to
16206 the usual conventions of hours-minutes-seconds notation. If one argument
16207 is an HMS form and the other is a number, that number is converted from
16208 degrees or radians (depending on the current Angular mode) to HMS format
16209 and then the two HMS forms are added.
16210
16211 If one argument of @kbd{+} is a date form, the other can be either a
16212 real number, which advances the date by a certain number of days, or
16213 an HMS form, which advances the date by a certain amount of time.
16214 Subtracting two date forms yields the number of days between them.
16215 Adding two date forms is meaningless, but Calc interprets it as the
16216 subtraction of one date form and the negative of the other. (The
16217 negative of a date form can be understood by remembering that dates
16218 are stored as the number of days before or after Jan 1, 1 AD.)
16219
16220 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are error forms, the result is an error form
16221 with an appropriately computed standard deviation. If one argument is an
16222 error form and the other is a number, the number is taken to have zero error.
16223 Error forms may have symbolic formulas as their mean and/or error parts;
16224 adding these will produce a symbolic error form result. However, adding an
16225 error form to a plain symbolic formula (as in @samp{(a +/- b) + c}) will not
16226 work, for the same reasons just mentioned for vectors. Instead you must
16227 write @samp{(a +/- b) + (c +/- 0)}.
16228
16229 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are modulo forms with equal values of @expr{M},
16230 or if one argument is a modulo form and the other a plain number, the
16231 result is a modulo form which represents the sum, modulo @expr{M}, of
16232 the two values.
16233
16234 If both arguments of @kbd{+} are intervals, the result is an interval
16235 which describes all possible sums of the possible input values. If
16236 one argument is a plain number, it is treated as the interval
16237 @w{@samp{[x ..@: x]}}.
16238
16239 If one argument of @kbd{+} is an infinity and the other is not, the
16240 result is that same infinity. If both arguments are infinite and in
16241 the same direction, the result is the same infinity, but if they are
16242 infinite in different directions the result is @code{nan}.
16243
16244 @kindex -
16245 @pindex calc-minus
16246 @ignore
16247 @mindex @null
16248 @end ignore
16249 @tindex -
16250 The @kbd{-} (@code{calc-minus}) command subtracts two values. The top
16251 number on the stack is subtracted from the one behind it, so that the
16252 computation @kbd{5 @key{RET} 2 -} produces 3, not @mathit{-3}. All options
16253 available for @kbd{+} are available for @kbd{-} as well.
16254
16255 @kindex *
16256 @pindex calc-times
16257 @ignore
16258 @mindex @null
16259 @end ignore
16260 @tindex *
16261 The @kbd{*} (@code{calc-times}) command multiplies two numbers. If one
16262 argument is a vector and the other a scalar, the scalar is multiplied by
16263 the elements of the vector to produce a new vector. If both arguments
16264 are vectors, the interpretation depends on the dimensions of the
16265 vectors: If both arguments are matrices, a matrix multiplication is
16266 done. If one argument is a matrix and the other a plain vector, the
16267 vector is interpreted as a row vector or column vector, whichever is
16268 dimensionally correct. If both arguments are plain vectors, the result
16269 is a single scalar number which is the dot product of the two vectors.
16270
16271 If one argument of @kbd{*} is an HMS form and the other a number, the
16272 HMS form is multiplied by that amount. It is an error to multiply two
16273 HMS forms together, or to attempt any multiplication involving date
16274 forms. Error forms, modulo forms, and intervals can be multiplied;
16275 see the comments for addition of those forms. When two error forms
16276 or intervals are multiplied they are considered to be statistically
16277 independent; thus, @samp{[-2 ..@: 3] * [-2 ..@: 3]} is @samp{[-6 ..@: 9]},
16278 whereas @w{@samp{[-2 ..@: 3] ^ 2}} is @samp{[0 ..@: 9]}.
16279
16280 @kindex /
16281 @pindex calc-divide
16282 @ignore
16283 @mindex @null
16284 @end ignore
16285 @tindex /
16286 The @kbd{/} (@code{calc-divide}) command divides two numbers.
16287
16288 When combining multiplication and division in an algebraic formula, it
16289 is good style to use parentheses to distinguish between possible
16290 interpretations; the expression @samp{a/b*c} should be written
16291 @samp{(a/b)*c} or @samp{a/(b*c)}, as appropriate. Without the
16292 parentheses, Calc will interpret @samp{a/b*c} as @samp{a/(b*c)}, since
16293 in algebraic entry Calc gives division a lower precedence than
16294 multiplication. (This is not standard across all computer languages, and
16295 Calc may change the precedence depending on the language mode being used.
16296 @xref{Language Modes}.) This default ordering can be changed by setting
16297 the customizable variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} to
16298 @code{nil} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}); this will give multiplication and
16299 division equal precedences. Note that Calc's default choice of
16300 precedence allows @samp{a b / c d} to be used as a shortcut for
16301 @smallexample
16302 @group
16303 a b
16304 ---.
16305 c d
16306 @end group
16307 @end smallexample
16308
16309 When dividing a scalar @expr{B} by a square matrix @expr{A}, the
16310 computation performed is @expr{B} times the inverse of @expr{A}. This
16311 also occurs if @expr{B} is itself a vector or matrix, in which case the
16312 effect is to solve the set of linear equations represented by @expr{B}.
16313 If @expr{B} is a matrix with the same number of rows as @expr{A}, or a
16314 plain vector (which is interpreted here as a column vector), then the
16315 equation @expr{A X = B} is solved for the vector or matrix @expr{X}.
16316 Otherwise, if @expr{B} is a non-square matrix with the same number of
16317 @emph{columns} as @expr{A}, the equation @expr{X A = B} is solved. If
16318 you wish a vector @expr{B} to be interpreted as a row vector to be
16319 solved as @expr{X A = B}, make it into a one-row matrix with @kbd{C-u 1
16320 v p} first. To force a left-handed solution with a square matrix
16321 @expr{B}, transpose @expr{A} and @expr{B} before dividing, then
16322 transpose the result.
16323
16324 HMS forms can be divided by real numbers or by other HMS forms. Error
16325 forms can be divided in any combination of ways. Modulo forms where both
16326 values and the modulo are integers can be divided to get an integer modulo
16327 form result. Intervals can be divided; dividing by an interval that
16328 encompasses zero or has zero as a limit will result in an infinite
16329 interval.
16330
16331 @kindex ^
16332 @pindex calc-power
16333 @ignore
16334 @mindex @null
16335 @end ignore
16336 @tindex ^
16337 The @kbd{^} (@code{calc-power}) command raises a number to a power. If
16338 the power is an integer, an exact result is computed using repeated
16339 multiplications. For non-integer powers, Calc uses Newton's method or
16340 logarithms and exponentials. Square matrices can be raised to integer
16341 powers. If either argument is an error (or interval or modulo) form,
16342 the result is also an error (or interval or modulo) form.
16343
16344 @kindex I ^
16345 @tindex nroot
16346 If you press the @kbd{I} (inverse) key first, the @kbd{I ^} command
16347 computes an Nth root: @kbd{125 @key{RET} 3 I ^} computes the number 5.
16348 (This is entirely equivalent to @kbd{125 @key{RET} 1:3 ^}.)
16349
16350 @kindex \
16351 @pindex calc-idiv
16352 @tindex idiv
16353 @ignore
16354 @mindex @null
16355 @end ignore
16356 @tindex \
16357 The @kbd{\} (@code{calc-idiv}) command divides two numbers on the stack
16358 to produce an integer result. It is equivalent to dividing with
16359 @key{/}, then rounding down with @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}), only a bit
16360 more convenient and efficient. Also, since it is an all-integer
16361 operation when the arguments are integers, it avoids problems that
16362 @kbd{/ F} would have with floating-point roundoff.
16363
16364 @kindex %
16365 @pindex calc-mod
16366 @ignore
16367 @mindex @null
16368 @end ignore
16369 @tindex %
16370 The @kbd{%} (@code{calc-mod}) command performs a ``modulo'' (or ``remainder'')
16371 operation. Mathematically, @samp{a%b = a - (a\b)*b}, and is defined
16372 for all real numbers @expr{a} and @expr{b} (except @expr{b=0}). For
16373 positive @expr{b}, the result will always be between 0 (inclusive) and
16374 @expr{b} (exclusive). Modulo does not work for HMS forms and error forms.
16375 If @expr{a} is a modulo form, its modulo is changed to @expr{b}, which
16376 must be positive real number.
16377
16378 @kindex :
16379 @pindex calc-fdiv
16380 @tindex fdiv
16381 The @kbd{:} (@code{calc-fdiv}) [@code{fdiv}] command
16382 divides the two integers on the top of the stack to produce a fractional
16383 result. This is a convenient shorthand for enabling Fraction mode (with
16384 @kbd{m f}) temporarily and using @samp{/}. Note that during numeric entry
16385 the @kbd{:} key is interpreted as a fraction separator, so to divide 8 by 6
16386 you would have to type @kbd{8 @key{RET} 6 @key{RET} :}. (Of course, in
16387 this case, it would be much easier simply to enter the fraction directly
16388 as @kbd{8:6 @key{RET}}!)
16389
16390 @kindex n
16391 @pindex calc-change-sign
16392 The @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the number on the top
16393 of the stack. It works on numbers, vectors and matrices, HMS forms, date
16394 forms, error forms, intervals, and modulo forms.
16395
16396 @kindex A
16397 @pindex calc-abs
16398 @tindex abs
16399 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the absolute
16400 value of a number. The result of @code{abs} is always a nonnegative
16401 real number: With a complex argument, it computes the complex magnitude.
16402 With a vector or matrix argument, it computes the Frobenius norm, i.e.,
16403 the square root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
16404 elements. The absolute value of an error form is defined by replacing
16405 the mean part with its absolute value and leaving the error part the same.
16406 The absolute value of a modulo form is undefined. The absolute value of
16407 an interval is defined in the obvious way.
16408
16409 @kindex f A
16410 @pindex calc-abssqr
16411 @tindex abssqr
16412 The @kbd{f A} (@code{calc-abssqr}) [@code{abssqr}] command computes the
16413 absolute value squared of a number, vector or matrix, or error form.
16414
16415 @kindex f s
16416 @pindex calc-sign
16417 @tindex sign
16418 The @kbd{f s} (@code{calc-sign}) [@code{sign}] command returns 1 if its
16419 argument is positive, @mathit{-1} if its argument is negative, or 0 if its
16420 argument is zero. In algebraic form, you can also write @samp{sign(a,x)}
16421 which evaluates to @samp{x * sign(a)}, i.e., either @samp{x}, @samp{-x}, or
16422 zero depending on the sign of @samp{a}.
16423
16424 @kindex &
16425 @pindex calc-inv
16426 @tindex inv
16427 @cindex Reciprocal
16428 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
16429 reciprocal of a number, i.e., @expr{1 / x}. Operating on a square
16430 matrix, it computes the inverse of that matrix.
16431
16432 @kindex Q
16433 @pindex calc-sqrt
16434 @tindex sqrt
16435 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] command computes the square
16436 root of a number. For a negative real argument, the result will be a
16437 complex number whose form is determined by the current Polar mode.
16438
16439 @kindex f h
16440 @pindex calc-hypot
16441 @tindex hypot
16442 The @kbd{f h} (@code{calc-hypot}) [@code{hypot}] command computes the square
16443 root of the sum of the squares of two numbers. That is, @samp{hypot(a,b)}
16444 is the length of the hypotenuse of a right triangle with sides @expr{a}
16445 and @expr{b}. If the arguments are complex numbers, their squared
16446 magnitudes are used.
16447
16448 @kindex f Q
16449 @pindex calc-isqrt
16450 @tindex isqrt
16451 The @kbd{f Q} (@code{calc-isqrt}) [@code{isqrt}] command computes the
16452 integer square root of an integer. This is the true square root of the
16453 number, rounded down to an integer. For example, @samp{isqrt(10)}
16454 produces 3. Note that, like @kbd{\} [@code{idiv}], this uses exact
16455 integer arithmetic throughout to avoid roundoff problems. If the input
16456 is a floating-point number or other non-integer value, this is exactly
16457 the same as @samp{floor(sqrt(x))}.
16458
16459 @kindex f n
16460 @kindex f x
16461 @pindex calc-min
16462 @tindex min
16463 @pindex calc-max
16464 @tindex max
16465 The @kbd{f n} (@code{calc-min}) [@code{min}] and @kbd{f x} (@code{calc-max})
16466 [@code{max}] commands take the minimum or maximum of two real numbers,
16467 respectively. These commands also work on HMS forms, date forms,
16468 intervals, and infinities. (In algebraic expressions, these functions
16469 take any number of arguments and return the maximum or minimum among
16470 all the arguments.)
16471
16472 @kindex f M
16473 @kindex f X
16474 @pindex calc-mant-part
16475 @tindex mant
16476 @pindex calc-xpon-part
16477 @tindex xpon
16478 The @kbd{f M} (@code{calc-mant-part}) [@code{mant}] function extracts
16479 the ``mantissa'' part @expr{m} of its floating-point argument; @kbd{f X}
16480 (@code{calc-xpon-part}) [@code{xpon}] extracts the ``exponent'' part
16481 @expr{e}. The original number is equal to
16482 @texline @math{m \times 10^e},
16483 @infoline @expr{m * 10^e},
16484 where @expr{m} is in the interval @samp{[1.0 ..@: 10.0)} except that
16485 @expr{m=e=0} if the original number is zero. For integers
16486 and fractions, @code{mant} returns the number unchanged and @code{xpon}
16487 returns zero. The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command can also be
16488 used to ``unpack'' a floating-point number; this produces an integer
16489 mantissa and exponent, with the constraint that the mantissa is not
16490 a multiple of ten (again except for the @expr{m=e=0} case).
16491
16492 @kindex f S
16493 @pindex calc-scale-float
16494 @tindex scf
16495 The @kbd{f S} (@code{calc-scale-float}) [@code{scf}] function scales a number
16496 by a given power of ten. Thus, @samp{scf(mant(x), xpon(x)) = x} for any
16497 real @samp{x}. The second argument must be an integer, but the first
16498 may actually be any numeric value. For example, @samp{scf(5,-2) = 0.05}
16499 or @samp{1:20} depending on the current Fraction mode.
16500
16501 @kindex f [
16502 @kindex f ]
16503 @pindex calc-decrement
16504 @pindex calc-increment
16505 @tindex decr
16506 @tindex incr
16507 The @kbd{f [} (@code{calc-decrement}) [@code{decr}] and @kbd{f ]}
16508 (@code{calc-increment}) [@code{incr}] functions decrease or increase
16509 a number by one unit. For integers, the effect is obvious. For
16510 floating-point numbers, the change is by one unit in the last place.
16511 For example, incrementing @samp{12.3456} when the current precision
16512 is 6 digits yields @samp{12.3457}. If the current precision had been
16513 8 digits, the result would have been @samp{12.345601}. Incrementing
16514 @samp{0.0} produces
16515 @texline @math{10^{-p}},
16516 @infoline @expr{10^-p},
16517 where @expr{p} is the current
16518 precision. These operations are defined only on integers and floats.
16519 With numeric prefix arguments, they change the number by @expr{n} units.
16520
16521 Note that incrementing followed by decrementing, or vice-versa, will
16522 almost but not quite always cancel out. Suppose the precision is
16523 6 digits and the number @samp{9.99999} is on the stack. Incrementing
16524 will produce @samp{10.0000}; decrementing will produce @samp{9.9999}.
16525 One digit has been dropped. This is an unavoidable consequence of the
16526 way floating-point numbers work.
16527
16528 Incrementing a date/time form adjusts it by a certain number of seconds.
16529 Incrementing a pure date form adjusts it by a certain number of days.
16530
16531 @node Integer Truncation, Complex Number Functions, Basic Arithmetic, Arithmetic
16532 @section Integer Truncation
16533
16534 @noindent
16535 There are four commands for truncating a real number to an integer,
16536 differing mainly in their treatment of negative numbers. All of these
16537 commands have the property that if the argument is an integer, the result
16538 is the same integer. An integer-valued floating-point argument is converted
16539 to integer form.
16540
16541 If you press @kbd{H} (@code{calc-hyperbolic}) first, the result will be
16542 expressed as an integer-valued floating-point number.
16543
16544 @cindex Integer part of a number
16545 @kindex F
16546 @pindex calc-floor
16547 @tindex floor
16548 @tindex ffloor
16549 @ignore
16550 @mindex @null
16551 @end ignore
16552 @kindex H F
16553 The @kbd{F} (@code{calc-floor}) [@code{floor} or @code{ffloor}] command
16554 truncates a real number to the next lower integer, i.e., toward minus
16555 infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 F} produces 3, but @kbd{_3.6 F} produces
16556 @mathit{-4}.
16557
16558 @kindex I F
16559 @pindex calc-ceiling
16560 @tindex ceil
16561 @tindex fceil
16562 @ignore
16563 @mindex @null
16564 @end ignore
16565 @kindex H I F
16566 The @kbd{I F} (@code{calc-ceiling}) [@code{ceil} or @code{fceil}]
16567 command truncates toward positive infinity. Thus @kbd{3.6 I F} produces
16568 4, and @kbd{_3.6 I F} produces @mathit{-3}.
16569
16570 @kindex R
16571 @pindex calc-round
16572 @tindex round
16573 @tindex fround
16574 @ignore
16575 @mindex @null
16576 @end ignore
16577 @kindex H R
16578 The @kbd{R} (@code{calc-round}) [@code{round} or @code{fround}] command
16579 rounds to the nearest integer. When the fractional part is .5 exactly,
16580 this command rounds away from zero. (All other rounding in the
16581 Calculator uses this convention as well.) Thus @kbd{3.5 R} produces 4
16582 but @kbd{3.4 R} produces 3; @kbd{_3.5 R} produces @mathit{-4}.
16583
16584 @kindex I R
16585 @pindex calc-trunc
16586 @tindex trunc
16587 @tindex ftrunc
16588 @ignore
16589 @mindex @null
16590 @end ignore
16591 @kindex H I R
16592 The @kbd{I R} (@code{calc-trunc}) [@code{trunc} or @code{ftrunc}]
16593 command truncates toward zero. In other words, it ``chops off''
16594 everything after the decimal point. Thus @kbd{3.6 I R} produces 3 and
16595 @kbd{_3.6 I R} produces @mathit{-3}.
16596
16597 These functions may not be applied meaningfully to error forms, but they
16598 do work for intervals. As a convenience, applying @code{floor} to a
16599 modulo form floors the value part of the form. Applied to a vector,
16600 these functions operate on all elements of the vector one by one.
16601 Applied to a date form, they operate on the internal numerical
16602 representation of dates, converting a date/time form into a pure date.
16603
16604 @ignore
16605 @starindex
16606 @end ignore
16607 @tindex rounde
16608 @ignore
16609 @starindex
16610 @end ignore
16611 @tindex roundu
16612 @ignore
16613 @starindex
16614 @end ignore
16615 @tindex frounde
16616 @ignore
16617 @starindex
16618 @end ignore
16619 @tindex froundu
16620 There are two more rounding functions which can only be entered in
16621 algebraic notation. The @code{roundu} function is like @code{round}
16622 except that it rounds up, toward plus infinity, when the fractional
16623 part is .5. This distinction matters only for negative arguments.
16624 Also, @code{rounde} rounds to an even number in the case of a tie,
16625 rounding up or down as necessary. For example, @samp{rounde(3.5)} and
16626 @samp{rounde(4.5)} both return 4, but @samp{rounde(5.5)} returns 6.
16627 The advantage of round-to-even is that the net error due to rounding
16628 after a long calculation tends to cancel out to zero. An important
16629 subtle point here is that the number being fed to @code{rounde} will
16630 already have been rounded to the current precision before @code{rounde}
16631 begins. For example, @samp{rounde(2.500001)} with a current precision
16632 of 6 will incorrectly, or at least surprisingly, yield 2 because the
16633 argument will first have been rounded down to @expr{2.5} (which
16634 @code{rounde} sees as an exact tie between 2 and 3).
16635
16636 Each of these functions, when written in algebraic formulas, allows
16637 a second argument which specifies the number of digits after the
16638 decimal point to keep. For example, @samp{round(123.4567, 2)} will
16639 produce the answer 123.46, and @samp{round(123.4567, -1)} will
16640 produce 120 (i.e., the cutoff is one digit to the @emph{left} of
16641 the decimal point). A second argument of zero is equivalent to
16642 no second argument at all.
16643
16644 @cindex Fractional part of a number
16645 To compute the fractional part of a number (i.e., the amount which, when
16646 added to `@tfn{floor(}@var{n}@tfn{)}', will produce @var{n}) just take @var{n}
16647 modulo 1 using the @code{%} command.
16648
16649 Note also the @kbd{\} (integer quotient), @kbd{f I} (integer logarithm),
16650 and @kbd{f Q} (integer square root) commands, which are analogous to
16651 @kbd{/}, @kbd{B}, and @kbd{Q}, respectively, except that they take integer
16652 arguments and return the result rounded down to an integer.
16653
16654 @node Complex Number Functions, Conversions, Integer Truncation, Arithmetic
16655 @section Complex Number Functions
16656
16657 @noindent
16658 @kindex J
16659 @pindex calc-conj
16660 @tindex conj
16661 The @kbd{J} (@code{calc-conj}) [@code{conj}] command computes the
16662 complex conjugate of a number. For complex number @expr{a+bi}, the
16663 complex conjugate is @expr{a-bi}. If the argument is a real number,
16664 this command leaves it the same. If the argument is a vector or matrix,
16665 this command replaces each element by its complex conjugate.
16666
16667 @kindex G
16668 @pindex calc-argument
16669 @tindex arg
16670 The @kbd{G} (@code{calc-argument}) [@code{arg}] command computes the
16671 ``argument'' or polar angle of a complex number. For a number in polar
16672 notation, this is simply the second component of the pair
16673 @texline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@math{\theta}@tfn{)}'.
16674 @infoline `@tfn{(}@var{r}@tfn{;}@var{theta}@tfn{)}'.
16675 The result is expressed according to the current angular mode and will
16676 be in the range @mathit{-180} degrees (exclusive) to @mathit{+180} degrees
16677 (inclusive), or the equivalent range in radians.
16678
16679 @pindex calc-imaginary
16680 The @code{calc-imaginary} command multiplies the number on the
16681 top of the stack by the imaginary number @expr{i = (0,1)}. This
16682 command is not normally bound to a key in Calc, but it is available
16683 on the @key{IMAG} button in Keypad mode.
16684
16685 @kindex f r
16686 @pindex calc-re
16687 @tindex re
16688 The @kbd{f r} (@code{calc-re}) [@code{re}] command replaces a complex number
16689 by its real part. This command has no effect on real numbers. (As an
16690 added convenience, @code{re} applied to a modulo form extracts
16691 the value part.)
16692
16693 @kindex f i
16694 @pindex calc-im
16695 @tindex im
16696 The @kbd{f i} (@code{calc-im}) [@code{im}] command replaces a complex number
16697 by its imaginary part; real numbers are converted to zero. With a vector
16698 or matrix argument, these functions operate element-wise.
16699
16700 @ignore
16701 @mindex v p
16702 @end ignore
16703 @kindex v p (complex)
16704 @kindex V p (complex)
16705 @pindex calc-pack
16706 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) command can pack the top two numbers on
16707 the stack into a composite object such as a complex number. With
16708 a prefix argument of @mathit{-1}, it produces a rectangular complex number;
16709 with an argument of @mathit{-2}, it produces a polar complex number.
16710 (Also, @pxref{Building Vectors}.)
16711
16712 @ignore
16713 @mindex v u
16714 @end ignore
16715 @kindex v u (complex)
16716 @kindex V u (complex)
16717 @pindex calc-unpack
16718 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the complex number
16719 (or other composite object) on the top of the stack and unpacks it
16720 into its separate components.
16721
16722 @node Conversions, Date Arithmetic, Complex Number Functions, Arithmetic
16723 @section Conversions
16724
16725 @noindent
16726 The commands described in this section convert numbers from one form
16727 to another; they are two-key sequences beginning with the letter @kbd{c}.
16728
16729 @kindex c f
16730 @pindex calc-float
16731 @tindex pfloat
16732 The @kbd{c f} (@code{calc-float}) [@code{pfloat}] command converts the
16733 number on the top of the stack to floating-point form. For example,
16734 @expr{23} is converted to @expr{23.0}, @expr{3:2} is converted to
16735 @expr{1.5}, and @expr{2.3} is left the same. If the value is a composite
16736 object such as a complex number or vector, each of the components is
16737 converted to floating-point. If the value is a formula, all numbers
16738 in the formula are converted to floating-point. Note that depending
16739 on the current floating-point precision, conversion to floating-point
16740 format may lose information.
16741
16742 As a special exception, integers which appear as powers or subscripts
16743 are not floated by @kbd{c f}. If you really want to float a power,
16744 you can use a @kbd{j s} command to select the power followed by @kbd{c f}.
16745 Because @kbd{c f} cannot examine the formula outside of the selection,
16746 it does not notice that the thing being floated is a power.
16747 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}.
16748
16749 The normal @kbd{c f} command is ``pervasive'' in the sense that it
16750 applies to all numbers throughout the formula. The @code{pfloat}
16751 algebraic function never stays around in a formula; @samp{pfloat(a + 1)}
16752 changes to @samp{a + 1.0} as soon as it is evaluated.
16753
16754 @kindex H c f
16755 @tindex float
16756 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c f} [@code{float}] operates
16757 only on the number or vector of numbers at the top level of its
16758 argument. Thus, @samp{float(1)} is 1.0, but @samp{float(a + 1)}
16759 is left unevaluated because its argument is not a number.
16760
16761 You should use @kbd{H c f} if you wish to guarantee that the final
16762 value, once all the variables have been assigned, is a float; you
16763 would use @kbd{c f} if you wish to do the conversion on the numbers
16764 that appear right now.
16765
16766 @kindex c F
16767 @pindex calc-fraction
16768 @tindex pfrac
16769 The @kbd{c F} (@code{calc-fraction}) [@code{pfrac}] command converts a
16770 floating-point number into a fractional approximation. By default, it
16771 produces a fraction whose decimal representation is the same as the
16772 input number, to within the current precision. You can also give a
16773 numeric prefix argument to specify a tolerance, either directly, or,
16774 if the prefix argument is zero, by using the number on top of the stack
16775 as the tolerance. If the tolerance is a positive integer, the fraction
16776 is correct to within that many significant figures. If the tolerance is
16777 a non-positive integer, it specifies how many digits fewer than the current
16778 precision to use. If the tolerance is a floating-point number, the
16779 fraction is correct to within that absolute amount.
16780
16781 @kindex H c F
16782 @tindex frac
16783 The @code{pfrac} function is pervasive, like @code{pfloat}.
16784 There is also a non-pervasive version, @kbd{H c F} [@code{frac}],
16785 which is analogous to @kbd{H c f} discussed above.
16786
16787 @kindex c d
16788 @pindex calc-to-degrees
16789 @tindex deg
16790 The @kbd{c d} (@code{calc-to-degrees}) [@code{deg}] command converts a
16791 number into degrees form. The value on the top of the stack may be an
16792 HMS form (interpreted as degrees-minutes-seconds), or a real number which
16793 will be interpreted in radians regardless of the current angular mode.
16794
16795 @kindex c r
16796 @pindex calc-to-radians
16797 @tindex rad
16798 The @kbd{c r} (@code{calc-to-radians}) [@code{rad}] command converts an
16799 HMS form or angle in degrees into an angle in radians.
16800
16801 @kindex c h
16802 @pindex calc-to-hms
16803 @tindex hms
16804 The @kbd{c h} (@code{calc-to-hms}) [@code{hms}] command converts a real
16805 number, interpreted according to the current angular mode, to an HMS
16806 form describing the same angle. In algebraic notation, the @code{hms}
16807 function also accepts three arguments: @samp{hms(@var{h}, @var{m}, @var{s})}.
16808 (The three-argument version is independent of the current angular mode.)
16809
16810 @pindex calc-from-hms
16811 The @code{calc-from-hms} command converts the HMS form on the top of the
16812 stack into a real number according to the current angular mode.
16813
16814 @kindex c p
16815 @kindex I c p
16816 @pindex calc-polar
16817 @tindex polar
16818 @tindex rect
16819 The @kbd{c p} (@code{calc-polar}) command converts the complex number on
16820 the top of the stack from polar to rectangular form, or from rectangular
16821 to polar form, whichever is appropriate. Real numbers are left the same.
16822 This command is equivalent to the @code{rect} or @code{polar}
16823 functions in algebraic formulas, depending on the direction of
16824 conversion. (It uses @code{polar}, except that if the argument is
16825 already a polar complex number, it uses @code{rect} instead. The
16826 @kbd{I c p} command always uses @code{rect}.)
16827
16828 @kindex c c
16829 @pindex calc-clean
16830 @tindex pclean
16831 The @kbd{c c} (@code{calc-clean}) [@code{pclean}] command ``cleans'' the
16832 number on the top of the stack. Floating point numbers are re-rounded
16833 according to the current precision. Polar numbers whose angular
16834 components have strayed from the @mathit{-180} to @mathit{+180} degree range
16835 are normalized. (Note that results will be undesirable if the current
16836 angular mode is different from the one under which the number was
16837 produced!) Integers and fractions are generally unaffected by this
16838 operation. Vectors and formulas are cleaned by cleaning each component
16839 number (i.e., pervasively).
16840
16841 If the simplification mode is set below basic simplification, it is raised
16842 for the purposes of this command. Thus, @kbd{c c} applies the basic
16843 simplifications even if their automatic application is disabled.
16844 @xref{Simplification Modes}.
16845
16846 @cindex Roundoff errors, correcting
16847 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{c c} sets the floating-point precision
16848 to that value for the duration of the command. A positive prefix (of at
16849 least 3) sets the precision to the specified value; a negative or zero
16850 prefix decreases the precision by the specified amount.
16851
16852 @kindex c 0-9
16853 @pindex calc-clean-num
16854 The keystroke sequences @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} are equivalent
16855 to @kbd{c c} with the corresponding negative prefix argument. If roundoff
16856 errors have changed 2.0 into 1.999999, typing @kbd{c 1} to clip off one
16857 decimal place often conveniently does the trick.
16858
16859 The @kbd{c c} command with a numeric prefix argument, and the @kbd{c 0}
16860 through @kbd{c 9} commands, also ``clip'' very small floating-point
16861 numbers to zero. If the exponent is less than or equal to the negative
16862 of the specified precision, the number is changed to 0.0. For example,
16863 if the current precision is 12, then @kbd{c 2} changes the vector
16864 @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 1e-10, 1e-11]} to @samp{[1e-8, 1e-9, 0, 0]}.
16865 Numbers this small generally arise from roundoff noise.
16866
16867 If the numbers you are using really are legitimately this small,
16868 you should avoid using the @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9} commands.
16869 (The plain @kbd{c c} command rounds to the current precision but
16870 does not clip small numbers.)
16871
16872 One more property of @kbd{c 0} through @kbd{c 9}, and of @kbd{c c} with
16873 a prefix argument, is that integer-valued floats are converted to
16874 plain integers, so that @kbd{c 1} on @samp{[1., 1.5, 2., 2.5, 3.]}
16875 produces @samp{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3]}. This is not done for huge
16876 numbers (@samp{1e100} is technically an integer-valued float, but
16877 you wouldn't want it automatically converted to a 100-digit integer).
16878
16879 @kindex H c 0-9
16880 @kindex H c c
16881 @tindex clean
16882 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H c c} and @kbd{H c 0} through @kbd{H c 9}
16883 operate non-pervasively [@code{clean}].
16884
16885 @node Date Arithmetic, Financial Functions, Conversions, Arithmetic
16886 @section Date Arithmetic
16887
16888 @noindent
16889 @cindex Date arithmetic, additional functions
16890 The commands described in this section perform various conversions
16891 and calculations involving date forms (@pxref{Date Forms}). They
16892 use the @kbd{t} (for time/date) prefix key followed by shifted
16893 letters.
16894
16895 The simplest date arithmetic is done using the regular @kbd{+} and @kbd{-}
16896 commands. In particular, adding a number to a date form advances the
16897 date form by a certain number of days; adding an HMS form to a date
16898 form advances the date by a certain amount of time; and subtracting two
16899 date forms produces a difference measured in days. The commands
16900 described here provide additional, more specialized operations on dates.
16901
16902 Many of these commands accept a numeric prefix argument; if you give
16903 plain @kbd{C-u} as the prefix, these commands will instead take the
16904 additional argument from the top of the stack.
16905
16906 @menu
16907 * Date Conversions::
16908 * Date Functions::
16909 * Time Zones::
16910 * Business Days::
16911 @end menu
16912
16913 @node Date Conversions, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic, Date Arithmetic
16914 @subsection Date Conversions
16915
16916 @noindent
16917 @kindex t D
16918 @pindex calc-date
16919 @tindex date
16920 The @kbd{t D} (@code{calc-date}) [@code{date}] command converts a
16921 date form into a number, measured in days since Jan 1, 1 AD@. The
16922 result will be an integer if @var{date} is a pure date form, or a
16923 fraction or float if @var{date} is a date/time form. Or, if its
16924 argument is a number, it converts this number into a date form.
16925
16926 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{t D} takes that many objects
16927 (up to six) from the top of the stack and interprets them in one
16928 of the following ways:
16929
16930 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day})} function
16931 builds a pure date form out of the specified year, month, and
16932 day, which must all be integers. @var{Year} is a year number,
16933 such as 1991 (@emph{not} the same as 91!). @var{Month} must be
16934 an integer in the range 1 to 12; @var{day} must be in the range
16935 1 to 31. If the specified month has fewer than 31 days and
16936 @var{day} is too large, the equivalent day in the following
16937 month will be used.
16938
16939 The @samp{date(@var{month}, @var{day})} function builds a
16940 pure date form using the current year, as determined by the
16941 real-time clock.
16942
16943 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hms})}
16944 function builds a date/time form using an @var{hms} form.
16945
16946 The @samp{date(@var{year}, @var{month}, @var{day}, @var{hour},
16947 @var{minute}, @var{second})} function builds a date/time form.
16948 @var{hour} should be an integer in the range 0 to 23;
16949 @var{minute} should be an integer in the range 0 to 59;
16950 @var{second} should be any real number in the range @samp{[0 .. 60)}.
16951 The last two arguments default to zero if omitted.
16952
16953 @kindex t J
16954 @pindex calc-julian
16955 @tindex julian
16956 @cindex Julian day counts, conversions
16957 The @kbd{t J} (@code{calc-julian}) [@code{julian}] command converts
16958 a date form into a Julian day count, which is the number of days
16959 since noon (GMT) on Jan 1, 4713 BC@. A pure date is converted to an
16960 integer Julian count representing noon of that day. A date/time form
16961 is converted to an exact floating-point Julian count, adjusted to
16962 interpret the date form in the current time zone but the Julian
16963 day count in Greenwich Mean Time. A numeric prefix argument allows
16964 you to specify the time zone; @pxref{Time Zones}. Use a prefix of
16965 zero to suppress the time zone adjustment. Note that pure date forms
16966 are never time-zone adjusted.
16967
16968 This command can also do the opposite conversion, from a Julian day
16969 count (either an integer day, or a floating-point day and time in
16970 the GMT zone), into a pure date form or a date/time form in the
16971 current or specified time zone.
16972
16973 @kindex t U
16974 @pindex calc-unix-time
16975 @tindex unixtime
16976 @cindex Unix time format, conversions
16977 The @kbd{t U} (@code{calc-unix-time}) [@code{unixtime}] command
16978 converts a date form into a Unix time value, which is the number of
16979 seconds since midnight on Jan 1, 1970, or vice-versa. The numeric result
16980 will be an integer if the current precision is 12 or less; for higher
16981 precision, the result may be a float with (@var{precision}@minus{}12)
16982 digits after the decimal. Just as for @kbd{t J}, the numeric time
16983 is interpreted in the GMT time zone and the date form is interpreted
16984 in the current or specified zone. Some systems use Unix-like
16985 numbering but with the local time zone; give a prefix of zero to
16986 suppress the adjustment if so.
16987
16988 @kindex t C
16989 @pindex calc-convert-time-zones
16990 @tindex tzconv
16991 @cindex Time Zones, converting between
16992 The @kbd{t C} (@code{calc-convert-time-zones}) [@code{tzconv}]
16993 command converts a date form from one time zone to another. You
16994 are prompted for each time zone name in turn; you can answer with
16995 any suitable Calc time zone expression (@pxref{Time Zones}).
16996 If you answer either prompt with a blank line, the local time
16997 zone is used for that prompt. You can also answer the first
16998 prompt with @kbd{$} to take the two time zone names from the
16999 stack (and the date to be converted from the third stack level).
17000
17001 @node Date Functions, Business Days, Date Conversions, Date Arithmetic
17002 @subsection Date Functions
17003
17004 @noindent
17005 @kindex t N
17006 @pindex calc-now
17007 @tindex now
17008 The @kbd{t N} (@code{calc-now}) [@code{now}] command pushes the
17009 current date and time on the stack as a date form. The time is
17010 reported in terms of the specified time zone; with no numeric prefix
17011 argument, @kbd{t N} reports for the current time zone.
17012
17013 @kindex t P
17014 @pindex calc-date-part
17015 The @kbd{t P} (@code{calc-date-part}) command extracts one part
17016 of a date form. The prefix argument specifies the part; with no
17017 argument, this command prompts for a part code from 1 to 9.
17018 The various part codes are described in the following paragraphs.
17019
17020 @tindex year
17021 The @kbd{M-1 t P} [@code{year}] function extracts the year number
17022 from a date form as an integer, e.g., 1991. This and the
17023 following functions will also accept a real number for an
17024 argument, which is interpreted as a standard Calc day number.
17025 Note that this function will never return zero, since the year
17026 1 BC immediately precedes the year 1 AD.
17027
17028 @tindex month
17029 The @kbd{M-2 t P} [@code{month}] function extracts the month number
17030 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 12.
17031
17032 @tindex day
17033 The @kbd{M-3 t P} [@code{day}] function extracts the day number
17034 from a date form as an integer in the range 1 to 31.
17035
17036 @tindex hour
17037 The @kbd{M-4 t P} [@code{hour}] function extracts the hour from
17038 a date form as an integer in the range 0 (midnight) to 23. Note
17039 that 24-hour time is always used. This returns zero for a pure
17040 date form. This function (and the following two) also accept
17041 HMS forms as input.
17042
17043 @tindex minute
17044 The @kbd{M-5 t P} [@code{minute}] function extracts the minute
17045 from a date form as an integer in the range 0 to 59.
17046
17047 @tindex second
17048 The @kbd{M-6 t P} [@code{second}] function extracts the second
17049 from a date form. If the current precision is 12 or less,
17050 the result is an integer in the range 0 to 59. For higher
17051 precision, the result may instead be a floating-point number.
17052
17053 @tindex weekday
17054 The @kbd{M-7 t P} [@code{weekday}] function extracts the weekday
17055 number from a date form as an integer in the range 0 (Sunday)
17056 to 6 (Saturday).
17057
17058 @tindex yearday
17059 The @kbd{M-8 t P} [@code{yearday}] function extracts the day-of-year
17060 number from a date form as an integer in the range 1 (January 1)
17061 to 366 (December 31 of a leap year).
17062
17063 @tindex time
17064 The @kbd{M-9 t P} [@code{time}] function extracts the time portion
17065 of a date form as an HMS form. This returns @samp{0@@ 0' 0"}
17066 for a pure date form.
17067
17068 @kindex t M
17069 @pindex calc-new-month
17070 @tindex newmonth
17071 The @kbd{t M} (@code{calc-new-month}) [@code{newmonth}] command
17072 computes a new date form that represents the first day of the month
17073 specified by the input date. The result is always a pure date
17074 form; only the year and month numbers of the input are retained.
17075 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n} in the range from 1 to 31,
17076 @kbd{t M} computes the @var{n}th day of the month. (If @var{n}
17077 is greater than the actual number of days in the month, or if
17078 @var{n} is zero, the last day of the month is used.)
17079
17080 @kindex t Y
17081 @pindex calc-new-year
17082 @tindex newyear
17083 The @kbd{t Y} (@code{calc-new-year}) [@code{newyear}] command
17084 computes a new pure date form that represents the first day of
17085 the year specified by the input. The month, day, and time
17086 of the input date form are lost. With a numeric prefix argument
17087 @var{n} in the range from 1 to 366, @kbd{t Y} computes the
17088 @var{n}th day of the year (366 is treated as 365 in non-leap
17089 years). A prefix argument of 0 computes the last day of the
17090 year (December 31). A negative prefix argument from @mathit{-1} to
17091 @mathit{-12} computes the first day of the @var{n}th month of the year.
17092
17093 @kindex t W
17094 @pindex calc-new-week
17095 @tindex newweek
17096 The @kbd{t W} (@code{calc-new-week}) [@code{newweek}] command
17097 computes a new pure date form that represents the Sunday on or before
17098 the input date. With a numeric prefix argument, it can be made to
17099 use any day of the week as the starting day; the argument must be in
17100 the range from 0 (Sunday) to 6 (Saturday). This function always
17101 subtracts between 0 and 6 days from the input date.
17102
17103 Here's an example use of @code{newweek}: Find the date of the next
17104 Wednesday after a given date. Using @kbd{M-3 t W} or @samp{newweek(d, 3)}
17105 will give you the @emph{preceding} Wednesday, so @samp{newweek(d+7, 3)}
17106 will give you the following Wednesday. A further look at the definition
17107 of @code{newweek} shows that if the input date is itself a Wednesday,
17108 this formula will return the Wednesday one week in the future. An
17109 exercise for the reader is to modify this formula to yield the same day
17110 if the input is already a Wednesday. Another interesting exercise is
17111 to preserve the time-of-day portion of the input (@code{newweek} resets
17112 the time to midnight; hint: how can @code{newweek} be defined in terms
17113 of the @code{weekday} function?).
17114
17115 @ignore
17116 @starindex
17117 @end ignore
17118 @tindex pwday
17119 The @samp{pwday(@var{date})} function (not on any key) computes the
17120 day-of-month number of the Sunday on or before @var{date}. With
17121 two arguments, @samp{pwday(@var{date}, @var{day})} computes the day
17122 number of the Sunday on or before day number @var{day} of the month
17123 specified by @var{date}. The @var{day} must be in the range from
17124 7 to 31; if the day number is greater than the actual number of days
17125 in the month, the true number of days is used instead. Thus
17126 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 7)} finds the first Sunday of the month, and
17127 @samp{pwday(@var{date}, 31)} finds the last Sunday of the month.
17128 With a third @var{weekday} argument, @code{pwday} can be made to look
17129 for any day of the week instead of Sunday.
17130
17131 @kindex t I
17132 @pindex calc-inc-month
17133 @tindex incmonth
17134 The @kbd{t I} (@code{calc-inc-month}) [@code{incmonth}] command
17135 increases a date form by one month, or by an arbitrary number of
17136 months specified by a numeric prefix argument. The time portion,
17137 if any, of the date form stays the same. The day also stays the
17138 same, except that if the new month has fewer days the day
17139 number may be reduced to lie in the valid range. For example,
17140 @samp{incmonth(<Jan 31, 1991>)} produces @samp{<Feb 28, 1991>}.
17141 Because of this, @kbd{t I t I} and @kbd{M-2 t I} do not always give
17142 the same results (@samp{<Mar 28, 1991>} versus @samp{<Mar 31, 1991>}
17143 in this case).
17144
17145 @ignore
17146 @starindex
17147 @end ignore
17148 @tindex incyear
17149 The @samp{incyear(@var{date}, @var{step})} function increases
17150 a date form by the specified number of years, which may be
17151 any positive or negative integer. Note that @samp{incyear(d, n)}
17152 is equivalent to @w{@samp{incmonth(d, 12*n)}}, but these do not have
17153 simple equivalents in terms of day arithmetic because
17154 months and years have varying lengths. If the @var{step}
17155 argument is omitted, 1 year is assumed. There is no keyboard
17156 command for this function; use @kbd{C-u 12 t I} instead.
17157
17158 There is no @code{newday} function at all because @kbd{F} [@code{floor}]
17159 serves this purpose. Similarly, instead of @code{incday} and
17160 @code{incweek} simply use @expr{d + n} or @expr{d + 7 n}.
17161
17162 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}, for the @kbd{f ]} [@code{incr}] command
17163 which can adjust a date/time form by a certain number of seconds.
17164
17165 @node Business Days, Time Zones, Date Functions, Date Arithmetic
17166 @subsection Business Days
17167
17168 @noindent
17169 Often time is measured in ``business days'' or ``working days,''
17170 where weekends and holidays are skipped. Calc's normal date
17171 arithmetic functions use calendar days, so that subtracting two
17172 consecutive Mondays will yield a difference of 7 days. By contrast,
17173 subtracting two consecutive Mondays would yield 5 business days
17174 (assuming two-day weekends and the absence of holidays).
17175
17176 @kindex t +
17177 @kindex t -
17178 @tindex badd
17179 @tindex bsub
17180 @pindex calc-business-days-plus
17181 @pindex calc-business-days-minus
17182 The @kbd{t +} (@code{calc-business-days-plus}) [@code{badd}]
17183 and @kbd{t -} (@code{calc-business-days-minus}) [@code{bsub}]
17184 commands perform arithmetic using business days. For @kbd{t +},
17185 one argument must be a date form and the other must be a real
17186 number (positive or negative). If the number is not an integer,
17187 then a certain amount of time is added as well as a number of
17188 days; for example, adding 0.5 business days to a time in Friday
17189 evening will produce a time in Monday morning. It is also
17190 possible to add an HMS form; adding @samp{12@@ 0' 0"} also adds
17191 half a business day. For @kbd{t -}, the arguments are either a
17192 date form and a number or HMS form, or two date forms, in which
17193 case the result is the number of business days between the two
17194 dates.
17195
17196 @cindex @code{Holidays} variable
17197 @vindex Holidays
17198 By default, Calc considers any day that is not a Saturday or
17199 Sunday to be a business day. You can define any number of
17200 additional holidays by editing the variable @code{Holidays}.
17201 (There is an @w{@kbd{s H}} convenience command for editing this
17202 variable.) Initially, @code{Holidays} contains the vector
17203 @samp{[sat, sun]}. Entries in the @code{Holidays} vector may
17204 be any of the following kinds of objects:
17205
17206 @itemize @bullet
17207 @item
17208 Date forms (pure dates, not date/time forms). These specify
17209 particular days which are to be treated as holidays.
17210
17211 @item
17212 Intervals of date forms. These specify a range of days, all of
17213 which are holidays (e.g., Christmas week). @xref{Interval Forms}.
17214
17215 @item
17216 Nested vectors of date forms. Each date form in the vector is
17217 considered to be a holiday.
17218
17219 @item
17220 Any Calc formula which evaluates to one of the above three things.
17221 If the formula involves the variable @expr{y}, it stands for a
17222 yearly repeating holiday; @expr{y} will take on various year
17223 numbers like 1992. For example, @samp{date(y, 12, 25)} specifies
17224 Christmas day, and @samp{newweek(date(y, 11, 7), 4) + 21} specifies
17225 Thanksgiving (which is held on the fourth Thursday of November).
17226 If the formula involves the variable @expr{m}, that variable
17227 takes on month numbers from 1 to 12: @samp{date(y, m, 15)} is
17228 a holiday that takes place on the 15th of every month.
17229
17230 @item
17231 A weekday name, such as @code{sat} or @code{sun}. This is really
17232 a variable whose name is a three-letter, lower-case day name.
17233
17234 @item
17235 An interval of year numbers (integers). This specifies the span of
17236 years over which this holiday list is to be considered valid. Any
17237 business-day arithmetic that goes outside this range will result
17238 in an error message. Use this if you are including an explicit
17239 list of holidays, rather than a formula to generate them, and you
17240 want to make sure you don't accidentally go beyond the last point
17241 where the holidays you entered are complete. If there is no
17242 limiting interval in the @code{Holidays} vector, the default
17243 @samp{[1 .. 2737]} is used. (This is the absolute range of years
17244 for which Calc's business-day algorithms will operate.)
17245
17246 @item
17247 An interval of HMS forms. This specifies the span of hours that
17248 are to be considered one business day. For example, if this
17249 range is @samp{[9@@ 0' 0" .. 17@@ 0' 0"]} (i.e., 9am to 5pm), then
17250 the business day is only eight hours long, so that @kbd{1.5 t +}
17251 on @samp{<4:00pm Fri Dec 13, 1991>} will add one business day and
17252 four business hours to produce @samp{<12:00pm Tue Dec 17, 1991>}.
17253 Likewise, @kbd{t -} will now express differences in time as
17254 fractions of an eight-hour day. Times before 9am will be treated
17255 as 9am by business date arithmetic, and times at or after 5pm will
17256 be treated as 4:59:59pm. If there is no HMS interval in @code{Holidays},
17257 the full 24-hour day @samp{[0@ 0' 0" .. 24@ 0' 0"]} is assumed.
17258 (Regardless of the type of bounds you specify, the interval is
17259 treated as inclusive on the low end and exclusive on the high end,
17260 so that the work day goes from 9am up to, but not including, 5pm.)
17261 @end itemize
17262
17263 If the @code{Holidays} vector is empty, then @kbd{t +} and
17264 @kbd{t -} will act just like @kbd{+} and @kbd{-} because there will
17265 then be no difference between business days and calendar days.
17266
17267 Calc expands the intervals and formulas you give into a complete
17268 list of holidays for internal use. This is done mainly to make
17269 sure it can detect multiple holidays. (For example,
17270 @samp{<Jan 1, 1989>} is both New Year's Day and a Sunday, but
17271 Calc's algorithms take care to count it only once when figuring
17272 the number of holidays between two dates.)
17273
17274 Since the complete list of holidays for all the years from 1 to
17275 2737 would be huge, Calc actually computes only the part of the
17276 list between the smallest and largest years that have been involved
17277 in business-day calculations so far. Normally, you won't have to
17278 worry about this. Keep in mind, however, that if you do one
17279 calculation for 1992, and another for 1792, even if both involve
17280 only a small range of years, Calc will still work out all the
17281 holidays that fall in that 200-year span.
17282
17283 If you add a (positive) number of days to a date form that falls on a
17284 weekend or holiday, the date form is treated as if it were the most
17285 recent business day. (Thus adding one business day to a Friday,
17286 Saturday, or Sunday will all yield the following Monday.) If you
17287 subtract a number of days from a weekend or holiday, the date is
17288 effectively on the following business day. (So subtracting one business
17289 day from Saturday, Sunday, or Monday yields the preceding Friday.) The
17290 difference between two dates one or both of which fall on holidays
17291 equals the number of actual business days between them. These
17292 conventions are consistent in the sense that, if you add @var{n}
17293 business days to any date, the difference between the result and the
17294 original date will come out to @var{n} business days. (It can't be
17295 completely consistent though; a subtraction followed by an addition
17296 might come out a bit differently, since @kbd{t +} is incapable of
17297 producing a date that falls on a weekend or holiday.)
17298
17299 @ignore
17300 @starindex
17301 @end ignore
17302 @tindex holiday
17303 There is a @code{holiday} function, not on any keys, that takes
17304 any date form and returns 1 if that date falls on a weekend or
17305 holiday, as defined in @code{Holidays}, or 0 if the date is a
17306 business day.
17307
17308 @node Time Zones, , Business Days, Date Arithmetic
17309 @subsection Time Zones
17310
17311 @noindent
17312 @cindex Time zones
17313 @cindex Daylight saving time
17314 Time zones and daylight saving time are a complicated business.
17315 The conversions to and from Julian and Unix-style dates automatically
17316 compute the correct time zone and daylight saving adjustment to use,
17317 provided they can figure out this information. This section describes
17318 Calc's time zone adjustment algorithm in detail, in case you want to
17319 do conversions in different time zones or in case Calc's algorithms
17320 can't determine the right correction to use.
17321
17322 Adjustments for time zones and daylight saving time are done by
17323 @kbd{t U}, @kbd{t J}, @kbd{t N}, and @kbd{t C}, but not by any other
17324 commands. In particular, @samp{<may 1 1991> - <apr 1 1991>} evaluates
17325 to exactly 30 days even though there is a daylight-saving
17326 transition in between. This is also true for Julian pure dates:
17327 @samp{julian(<may 1 1991>) - julian(<apr 1 1991>)}. But Julian
17328 and Unix date/times will adjust for daylight saving time: using Calc's
17329 default daylight saving time rule (see the explanation below),
17330 @samp{julian(<12am may 1 1991>) - julian(<12am apr 1 1991>)}
17331 evaluates to @samp{29.95833} (that's 29 days and 23 hours)
17332 because one hour was lost when daylight saving commenced on
17333 April 7, 1991.
17334
17335 In brief, the idiom @samp{julian(@var{date1}) - julian(@var{date2})}
17336 computes the actual number of 24-hour periods between two dates, whereas
17337 @samp{@var{date1} - @var{date2}} computes the number of calendar
17338 days between two dates without taking daylight saving into account.
17339
17340 @pindex calc-time-zone
17341 @ignore
17342 @starindex
17343 @end ignore
17344 @tindex tzone
17345 The @code{calc-time-zone} [@code{tzone}] command converts the time
17346 zone specified by its numeric prefix argument into a number of
17347 seconds difference from Greenwich mean time (GMT). If the argument
17348 is a number, the result is simply that value multiplied by 3600.
17349 Typical arguments for North America are 5 (Eastern) or 8 (Pacific). If
17350 Daylight Saving time is in effect, one hour should be subtracted from
17351 the normal difference.
17352
17353 If you give a prefix of plain @kbd{C-u}, @code{calc-time-zone} (like other
17354 date arithmetic commands that include a time zone argument) takes the
17355 zone argument from the top of the stack. (In the case of @kbd{t J}
17356 and @kbd{t U}, the normal argument is then taken from the second-to-top
17357 stack position.) This allows you to give a non-integer time zone
17358 adjustment. The time-zone argument can also be an HMS form, or
17359 it can be a variable which is a time zone name in upper- or lower-case.
17360 For example @samp{tzone(PST) = tzone(8)} and @samp{tzone(pdt) = tzone(7)}
17361 (for Pacific standard and daylight saving times, respectively).
17362
17363 North American and European time zone names are defined as follows;
17364 note that for each time zone there is one name for standard time,
17365 another for daylight saving time, and a third for ``generalized'' time
17366 in which the daylight saving adjustment is computed from context.
17367
17368 @smallexample
17369 @group
17370 YST PST MST CST EST AST NST GMT WET MET MEZ
17371 9 8 7 6 5 4 3.5 0 -1 -2 -2
17372
17373 YDT PDT MDT CDT EDT ADT NDT BST WETDST METDST MESZ
17374 8 7 6 5 4 3 2.5 -1 -2 -3 -3
17375
17376 YGT PGT MGT CGT EGT AGT NGT BGT WEGT MEGT MEGZ
17377 9/8 8/7 7/6 6/5 5/4 4/3 3.5/2.5 0/-1 -1/-2 -2/-3 -2/-3
17378 @end group
17379 @end smallexample
17380
17381 @vindex math-tzone-names
17382 To define time zone names that do not appear in the above table,
17383 you must modify the Lisp variable @code{math-tzone-names}. This
17384 is a list of lists describing the different time zone names; its
17385 structure is best explained by an example. The three entries for
17386 Pacific Time look like this:
17387
17388 @smallexample
17389 @group
17390 ( ( "PST" 8 0 ) ; Name as an upper-case string, then standard
17391 ( "PDT" 8 -1 ) ; adjustment, then daylight saving adjustment.
17392 ( "PGT" 8 "PST" "PDT" ) ) ; Generalized time zone.
17393 @end group
17394 @end smallexample
17395
17396 @cindex @code{TimeZone} variable
17397 @vindex TimeZone
17398 With no arguments, @code{calc-time-zone} or @samp{tzone()} will by
17399 default get the time zone and daylight saving information from the
17400 calendar (@pxref{Daylight Saving,Calendar/Diary,The Calendar and the Diary,
17401 emacs,The GNU Emacs Manual}). To use a different time zone, or if the
17402 calendar does not give the desired result, you can set the Calc variable
17403 @code{TimeZone} (which is by default @code{nil}) to an appropriate
17404 time zone name. (The easiest way to do this is to edit the
17405 @code{TimeZone} variable using Calc's @kbd{s T} command, then use the
17406 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save the value of
17407 @code{TimeZone} permanently.)
17408 If the time zone given by @code{TimeZone} is a generalized time zone,
17409 e.g., @code{EGT}, Calc examines the date being converted to tell whether
17410 to use standard or daylight saving time. But if the current time zone
17411 is explicit, e.g., @code{EST} or @code{EDT}, then that adjustment is
17412 used exactly and Calc's daylight saving algorithm is not consulted.
17413 The special time zone name @code{local}
17414 is equivalent to no argument; i.e., it uses the information obtained
17415 from the calendar.
17416
17417 The @kbd{t J} and @code{t U} commands with no numeric prefix
17418 arguments do the same thing as @samp{tzone()}; namely, use the
17419 information from the calendar if @code{TimeZone} is @code{nil},
17420 otherwise use the time zone given by @code{TimeZone}.
17421
17422 @vindex math-daylight-savings-hook
17423 @findex math-std-daylight-savings
17424 When Calc computes the daylight saving information itself (i.e., when
17425 the @code{TimeZone} variable is set), it will by default consider
17426 daylight saving time to begin at 2 a.m.@: on the second Sunday of March
17427 (for years from 2007 on) or on the last Sunday in April (for years
17428 before 2007), and to end at 2 a.m.@: on the first Sunday of
17429 November. (for years from 2007 on) or the last Sunday in October (for
17430 years before 2007). These are the rules that have been in effect in
17431 much of North America since 1966 and take into account the rule change
17432 that began in 2007. If you are in a country that uses different rules
17433 for computing daylight saving time, you have two choices: Write your own
17434 daylight saving hook, or control time zones explicitly by setting the
17435 @code{TimeZone} variable and/or always giving a time-zone argument for
17436 the conversion functions.
17437
17438 The Lisp variable @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} holds the
17439 name of a function that is used to compute the daylight saving
17440 adjustment for a given date. The default is
17441 @code{math-std-daylight-savings}, which computes an adjustment
17442 (either 0 or @mathit{-1}) using the North American rules given above.
17443
17444 The daylight saving hook function is called with four arguments:
17445 The date, as a floating-point number in standard Calc format;
17446 a six-element list of the date decomposed into year, month, day,
17447 hour, minute, and second, respectively; a string which contains
17448 the generalized time zone name in upper-case, e.g., @code{"WEGT"};
17449 and a special adjustment to be applied to the hour value when
17450 converting into a generalized time zone (see below).
17451
17452 @findex math-prev-weekday-in-month
17453 The Lisp function @code{math-prev-weekday-in-month} is useful for
17454 daylight saving computations. This is an internal version of
17455 the user-level @code{pwday} function described in the previous
17456 section. It takes four arguments: The floating-point date value,
17457 the corresponding six-element date list, the day-of-month number,
17458 and the weekday number (0--6).
17459
17460 The default daylight saving hook ignores the time zone name, but a
17461 more sophisticated hook could use different algorithms for different
17462 time zones. It would also be possible to use different algorithms
17463 depending on the year number, but the default hook always uses the
17464 algorithm for 1987 and later. Here is a listing of the default
17465 daylight saving hook:
17466
17467 @smallexample
17468 (defun math-std-daylight-savings (date dt zone bump)
17469 (cond ((< (nth 1 dt) 4) 0)
17470 ((= (nth 1 dt) 4)
17471 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 7 0)))
17472 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) 0)
17473 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17474 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 3 bump)) -1 0))
17475 (t -1))))
17476 ((< (nth 1 dt) 10) -1)
17477 ((= (nth 1 dt) 10)
17478 (let ((sunday (math-prev-weekday-in-month date dt 31 0)))
17479 (cond ((< (nth 2 dt) sunday) -1)
17480 ((= (nth 2 dt) sunday)
17481 (if (>= (nth 3 dt) (+ 2 bump)) 0 -1))
17482 (t 0))))
17483 (t 0))
17484 )
17485 @end smallexample
17486
17487 @noindent
17488 The @code{bump} parameter is equal to zero when Calc is converting
17489 from a date form in a generalized time zone into a GMT date value.
17490 It is @mathit{-1} when Calc is converting in the other direction. The
17491 adjustments shown above ensure that the conversion behaves correctly
17492 and reasonably around the 2 a.m.@: transition in each direction.
17493
17494 There is a ``missing'' hour between 2 a.m.@: and 3 a.m.@: at the
17495 beginning of daylight saving time; converting a date/time form that
17496 falls in this hour results in a time value for the following hour,
17497 from 3 a.m.@: to 4 a.m. At the end of daylight saving time, the
17498 hour from 1 a.m.@: to 2 a.m.@: repeats itself; converting a date/time
17499 form that falls in this hour results in a time value for the first
17500 manifestation of that time (@emph{not} the one that occurs one hour
17501 later).
17502
17503 If @code{math-daylight-savings-hook} is @code{nil}, then the
17504 daylight saving adjustment is always taken to be zero.
17505
17506 In algebraic formulas, @samp{tzone(@var{zone}, @var{date})}
17507 computes the time zone adjustment for a given zone name at a
17508 given date. The @var{date} is ignored unless @var{zone} is a
17509 generalized time zone. If @var{date} is a date form, the
17510 daylight saving computation is applied to it as it appears.
17511 If @var{date} is a numeric date value, it is adjusted for the
17512 daylight-saving version of @var{zone} before being given to
17513 the daylight saving hook. This odd-sounding rule ensures
17514 that the daylight-saving computation is always done in
17515 local time, not in the GMT time that a numeric @var{date}
17516 is typically represented in.
17517
17518 @ignore
17519 @starindex
17520 @end ignore
17521 @tindex dsadj
17522 The @samp{dsadj(@var{date}, @var{zone})} function computes the
17523 daylight saving adjustment that is appropriate for @var{date} in
17524 time zone @var{zone}. If @var{zone} is explicitly in or not in
17525 daylight saving time (e.g., @code{PDT} or @code{PST}) the
17526 @var{date} is ignored. If @var{zone} is a generalized time zone,
17527 the algorithms described above are used. If @var{zone} is omitted,
17528 the computation is done for the current time zone.
17529
17530 @node Financial Functions, Binary Functions, Date Arithmetic, Arithmetic
17531 @section Financial Functions
17532
17533 @noindent
17534 Calc's financial or business functions use the @kbd{b} prefix
17535 key followed by a shifted letter. (The @kbd{b} prefix followed by
17536 a lower-case letter is used for operations on binary numbers.)
17537
17538 Note that the rate and the number of intervals given to these
17539 functions must be on the same time scale, e.g., both months or
17540 both years. Mixing an annual interest rate with a time expressed
17541 in months will give you very wrong answers!
17542
17543 It is wise to compute these functions to a higher precision than
17544 you really need, just to make sure your answer is correct to the
17545 last penny; also, you may wish to check the definitions at the end
17546 of this section to make sure the functions have the meaning you expect.
17547
17548 @menu
17549 * Percentages::
17550 * Future Value::
17551 * Present Value::
17552 * Related Financial Functions::
17553 * Depreciation Functions::
17554 * Definitions of Financial Functions::
17555 @end menu
17556
17557 @node Percentages, Future Value, Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17558 @subsection Percentages
17559
17560 @kindex M-%
17561 @pindex calc-percent
17562 @tindex %
17563 @tindex percent
17564 The @kbd{M-%} (@code{calc-percent}) command takes a percentage value,
17565 say 5.4, and converts it to an equivalent actual number. For example,
17566 @kbd{5.4 M-%} enters 0.054 on the stack. (That's the @key{META} or
17567 @key{ESC} key combined with @kbd{%}.)
17568
17569 Actually, @kbd{M-%} creates a formula of the form @samp{5.4%}.
17570 You can enter @samp{5.4%} yourself during algebraic entry. The
17571 @samp{%} operator simply means, ``the preceding value divided by
17572 100.'' The @samp{%} operator has very high precedence, so that
17573 @samp{1+8%} is interpreted as @samp{1+(8%)}, not as @samp{(1+8)%}.
17574 (The @samp{%} operator is just a postfix notation for the
17575 @code{percent} function, just like @samp{20!} is the notation for
17576 @samp{fact(20)}, or twenty-factorial.)
17577
17578 The formula @samp{5.4%} would normally evaluate immediately to
17579 0.054, but the @kbd{M-%} command suppresses evaluation as it puts
17580 the formula onto the stack. However, the next Calc command that
17581 uses the formula @samp{5.4%} will evaluate it as its first step.
17582 The net effect is that you get to look at @samp{5.4%} on the stack,
17583 but Calc commands see it as @samp{0.054}, which is what they expect.
17584
17585 In particular, @samp{5.4%} and @samp{0.054} are suitable values
17586 for the @var{rate} arguments of the various financial functions,
17587 but the number @samp{5.4} is probably @emph{not} suitable---it
17588 represents a rate of 540 percent!
17589
17590 The key sequence @kbd{M-% *} effectively means ``percent-of.''
17591 For example, @kbd{68 @key{RET} 25 M-% *} computes 17, which is 25% of
17592 68 (and also 68% of 25, which comes out to the same thing).
17593
17594 @kindex c %
17595 @pindex calc-convert-percent
17596 The @kbd{c %} (@code{calc-convert-percent}) command converts the
17597 value on the top of the stack from numeric to percentage form.
17598 For example, if 0.08 is on the stack, @kbd{c %} converts it to
17599 @samp{8%}. The quantity is the same, it's just represented
17600 differently. (Contrast this with @kbd{M-%}, which would convert
17601 this number to @samp{0.08%}.) The @kbd{=} key is a convenient way
17602 to convert a formula like @samp{8%} back to numeric form, 0.08.
17603
17604 To compute what percentage one quantity is of another quantity,
17605 use @kbd{/ c %}. For example, @w{@kbd{17 @key{RET} 68 / c %}} displays
17606 @samp{25%}.
17607
17608 @kindex b %
17609 @pindex calc-percent-change
17610 @tindex relch
17611 The @kbd{b %} (@code{calc-percent-change}) [@code{relch}] command
17612 calculates the percentage change from one number to another.
17613 For example, @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} produces the answer @samp{25%},
17614 since 50 is 25% larger than 40. A negative result represents a
17615 decrease: @kbd{50 @key{RET} 40 b %} produces @samp{-20%}, since 40 is
17616 20% smaller than 50. (The answers are different in magnitude
17617 because, in the first case, we're increasing by 25% of 40, but
17618 in the second case, we're decreasing by 20% of 50.) The effect
17619 of @kbd{40 @key{RET} 50 b %} is to compute @expr{(50-40)/40}, converting
17620 the answer to percentage form as if by @kbd{c %}.
17621
17622 @node Future Value, Present Value, Percentages, Financial Functions
17623 @subsection Future Value
17624
17625 @noindent
17626 @kindex b F
17627 @pindex calc-fin-fv
17628 @tindex fv
17629 The @kbd{b F} (@code{calc-fin-fv}) [@code{fv}] command computes
17630 the future value of an investment. It takes three arguments
17631 from the stack: @samp{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17632 If you give payments of @var{payment} every year for @var{n}
17633 years, and the money you have paid earns interest at @var{rate} per
17634 year, then this function tells you what your investment would be
17635 worth at the end of the period. (The actual interval doesn't
17636 have to be years, as long as @var{n} and @var{rate} are expressed
17637 in terms of the same intervals.) This function assumes payments
17638 occur at the @emph{end} of each interval.
17639
17640 @kindex I b F
17641 @tindex fvb
17642 The @kbd{I b F} [@code{fvb}] command does the same computation,
17643 but assuming your payments are at the beginning of each interval.
17644 Suppose you plan to deposit $1000 per year in a savings account
17645 earning 5.4% interest, starting right now. How much will be
17646 in the account after five years? @code{fvb(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5870.73}.
17647 Thus you will have earned $870 worth of interest over the years.
17648 Using the stack, this calculation would have been
17649 @kbd{5.4 M-% 5 @key{RET} 1000 I b F}. Note that the rate is expressed
17650 as a number between 0 and 1, @emph{not} as a percentage.
17651
17652 @kindex H b F
17653 @tindex fvl
17654 The @kbd{H b F} [@code{fvl}] command computes the future value
17655 of an initial lump sum investment. Suppose you could deposit
17656 those five thousand dollars in the bank right now; how much would
17657 they be worth in five years? @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 5000) = 6503.89}.
17658
17659 The algebraic functions @code{fv} and @code{fvb} accept an optional
17660 fourth argument, which is used as an initial lump sum in the sense
17661 of @code{fvl}. In other words, @code{fv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17662 @var{payment}, @var{initial}) = fv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})
17663 + fvl(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{initial})}.
17664
17665 To illustrate the relationships between these functions, we could
17666 do the @code{fvb} calculation ``by hand'' using @code{fvl}. The
17667 final balance will be the sum of the contributions of our five
17668 deposits at various times. The first deposit earns interest for
17669 five years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 1300.78}. The second
17670 deposit only earns interest for four years: @code{fvl(5.4%, 4, 1000) =
17671 1234.13}. And so on down to the last deposit, which earns one
17672 year's interest: @code{fvl(5.4%, 1, 1000) = 1054.00}. The sum of
17673 these five values is, sure enough, $5870.73, just as was computed
17674 by @code{fvb} directly.
17675
17676 What does @code{fv(5.4%, 5, 1000) = 5569.96} mean? The payments
17677 are now at the ends of the periods. The end of one year is the same
17678 as the beginning of the next, so what this really means is that we've
17679 lost the payment at year zero (which contributed $1300.78), but we're
17680 now counting the payment at year five (which, since it didn't have
17681 a chance to earn interest, counts as $1000). Indeed, @expr{5569.96 =
17682 5870.73 - 1300.78 + 1000} (give or take a bit of roundoff error).
17683
17684 @node Present Value, Related Financial Functions, Future Value, Financial Functions
17685 @subsection Present Value
17686
17687 @noindent
17688 @kindex b P
17689 @pindex calc-fin-pv
17690 @tindex pv
17691 The @kbd{b P} (@code{calc-fin-pv}) [@code{pv}] command computes
17692 the present value of an investment. Like @code{fv}, it takes
17693 three arguments: @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment})}.
17694 It computes the present value of a series of regular payments.
17695 Suppose you have the chance to make an investment that will
17696 pay $2000 per year over the next four years; as you receive
17697 these payments you can put them in the bank at 9% interest.
17698 You want to know whether it is better to make the investment, or
17699 to keep the money in the bank where it earns 9% interest right
17700 from the start. The calculation @code{pv(9%, 4, 2000)} gives the
17701 result 6479.44. If your initial investment must be less than this,
17702 say, $6000, then the investment is worthwhile. But if you had to
17703 put up $7000, then it would be better just to leave it in the bank.
17704
17705 Here is the interpretation of the result of @code{pv}: You are
17706 trying to compare the return from the investment you are
17707 considering, which is @code{fv(9%, 4, 2000) = 9146.26}, with
17708 the return from leaving the money in the bank, which is
17709 @code{fvl(9%, 4, @var{x})} where @var{x} is the amount of money
17710 you would have to put up in advance. The @code{pv} function
17711 finds the break-even point, @expr{x = 6479.44}, at which
17712 @code{fvl(9%, 4, 6479.44)} is also equal to 9146.26. This is
17713 the largest amount you should be willing to invest.
17714
17715 @kindex I b P
17716 @tindex pvb
17717 The @kbd{I b P} [@code{pvb}] command solves the same problem,
17718 but with payments occurring at the beginning of each interval.
17719 It has the same relationship to @code{fvb} as @code{pv} has
17720 to @code{fv}. For example @code{pvb(9%, 4, 2000) = 7062.59},
17721 a larger number than @code{pv} produced because we get to start
17722 earning interest on the return from our investment sooner.
17723
17724 @kindex H b P
17725 @tindex pvl
17726 The @kbd{H b P} [@code{pvl}] command computes the present value of
17727 an investment that will pay off in one lump sum at the end of the
17728 period. For example, if we get our $8000 all at the end of the
17729 four years, @code{pvl(9%, 4, 8000) = 5667.40}. This is much
17730 less than @code{pv} reported, because we don't earn any interest
17731 on the return from this investment. Note that @code{pvl} and
17732 @code{fvl} are simple inverses: @code{fvl(9%, 4, 5667.40) = 8000}.
17733
17734 You can give an optional fourth lump-sum argument to @code{pv}
17735 and @code{pvb}; this is handled in exactly the same way as the
17736 fourth argument for @code{fv} and @code{fvb}.
17737
17738 @kindex b N
17739 @pindex calc-fin-npv
17740 @tindex npv
17741 The @kbd{b N} (@code{calc-fin-npv}) [@code{npv}] command computes
17742 the net present value of a series of irregular investments.
17743 The first argument is the interest rate. The second argument is
17744 a vector which represents the expected return from the investment
17745 at the end of each interval. For example, if the rate represents
17746 a yearly interest rate, then the vector elements are the return
17747 from the first year, second year, and so on.
17748
17749 Thus, @code{npv(9%, [2000,2000,2000,2000]) = pv(9%, 4, 2000) = 6479.44}.
17750 Obviously this function is more interesting when the payments are
17751 not all the same!
17752
17753 The @code{npv} function can actually have two or more arguments.
17754 Multiple arguments are interpreted in the same way as for the
17755 vector statistical functions like @code{vsum}.
17756 @xref{Single-Variable Statistics}. Basically, if there are several
17757 payment arguments, each either a vector or a plain number, all these
17758 values are collected left-to-right into the complete list of payments.
17759 A numeric prefix argument on the @kbd{b N} command says how many
17760 payment values or vectors to take from the stack.
17761
17762 @kindex I b N
17763 @tindex npvb
17764 The @kbd{I b N} [@code{npvb}] command computes the net present
17765 value where payments occur at the beginning of each interval
17766 rather than at the end.
17767
17768 @node Related Financial Functions, Depreciation Functions, Present Value, Financial Functions
17769 @subsection Related Financial Functions
17770
17771 @noindent
17772 The functions in this section are basically inverses of the
17773 present value functions with respect to the various arguments.
17774
17775 @kindex b M
17776 @pindex calc-fin-pmt
17777 @tindex pmt
17778 The @kbd{b M} (@code{calc-fin-pmt}) [@code{pmt}] command computes
17779 the amount of periodic payment necessary to amortize a loan.
17780 Thus @code{pmt(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{amount})} equals the
17781 value of @var{payment} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17782 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}.
17783
17784 @kindex I b M
17785 @tindex pmtb
17786 The @kbd{I b M} [@code{pmtb}] command does the same computation
17787 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. Like @code{pv} and
17788 @code{pvb}, these functions can also take a fourth argument which
17789 represents an initial lump-sum investment.
17790
17791 @kindex H b M
17792 The @kbd{H b M} key just invokes the @code{fvl} function, which is
17793 the inverse of @code{pvl}. There is no explicit @code{pmtl} function.
17794
17795 @kindex b #
17796 @pindex calc-fin-nper
17797 @tindex nper
17798 The @kbd{b #} (@code{calc-fin-nper}) [@code{nper}] command computes
17799 the number of regular payments necessary to amortize a loan.
17800 Thus @code{nper(@var{rate}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} equals
17801 the value of @var{n} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n},
17802 @var{payment}) = @var{amount}}. If @var{payment} is too small
17803 ever to amortize a loan for @var{amount} at interest rate @var{rate},
17804 the @code{nper} function is left in symbolic form.
17805
17806 @kindex I b #
17807 @tindex nperb
17808 The @kbd{I b #} [@code{nperb}] command does the same computation
17809 but using @code{pvb} instead of @code{pv}. You can give a fourth
17810 lump-sum argument to these functions, but the computation will be
17811 rather slow in the four-argument case.
17812
17813 @kindex H b #
17814 @tindex nperl
17815 The @kbd{H b #} [@code{nperl}] command does the same computation
17816 using @code{pvl}. By exchanging @var{payment} and @var{amount} you
17817 can also get the solution for @code{fvl}. For example,
17818 @code{nperl(8%, 2000, 1000) = 9.006}, so if you place $1000 in a
17819 bank account earning 8%, it will take nine years to grow to $2000.
17820
17821 @kindex b T
17822 @pindex calc-fin-rate
17823 @tindex rate
17824 The @kbd{b T} (@code{calc-fin-rate}) [@code{rate}] command computes
17825 the rate of return on an investment. This is also an inverse of @code{pv}:
17826 @code{rate(@var{n}, @var{payment}, @var{amount})} computes the value of
17827 @var{rate} such that @code{pv(@var{rate}, @var{n}, @var{payment}) =
17828 @var{amount}}. The result is expressed as a formula like @samp{6.3%}.
17829
17830 @kindex I b T
17831 @kindex H b T
17832 @tindex rateb
17833 @tindex ratel
17834 The @kbd{I b T} [@code{rateb}] and @kbd{H b T} [@code{ratel}]
17835 commands solve the analogous equations with @code{pvb} or @code{pvl}
17836 in place of @code{pv}. Also, @code{rate} and @code{rateb} can
17837 accept an optional fourth argument just like @code{pv} and @code{pvb}.
17838 To redo the above example from a different perspective,
17839 @code{ratel(9, 2000, 1000) = 8.00597%}, which says you will need an
17840 interest rate of 8% in order to double your account in nine years.
17841
17842 @kindex b I
17843 @pindex calc-fin-irr
17844 @tindex irr
17845 The @kbd{b I} (@code{calc-fin-irr}) [@code{irr}] command is the
17846 analogous function to @code{rate} but for net present value.
17847 Its argument is a vector of payments. Thus @code{irr(@var{payments})}
17848 computes the @var{rate} such that @code{npv(@var{rate}, @var{payments}) = 0};
17849 this rate is known as the @dfn{internal rate of return}.
17850
17851 @kindex I b I
17852 @tindex irrb
17853 The @kbd{I b I} [@code{irrb}] command computes the internal rate of
17854 return assuming payments occur at the beginning of each period.
17855
17856 @node Depreciation Functions, Definitions of Financial Functions, Related Financial Functions, Financial Functions
17857 @subsection Depreciation Functions
17858
17859 @noindent
17860 The functions in this section calculate @dfn{depreciation}, which is
17861 the amount of value that a possession loses over time. These functions
17862 are characterized by three parameters: @var{cost}, the original cost
17863 of the asset; @var{salvage}, the value the asset will have at the end
17864 of its expected ``useful life''; and @var{life}, the number of years
17865 (or other periods) of the expected useful life.
17866
17867 There are several methods for calculating depreciation that differ in
17868 the way they spread the depreciation over the lifetime of the asset.
17869
17870 @kindex b S
17871 @pindex calc-fin-sln
17872 @tindex sln
17873 The @kbd{b S} (@code{calc-fin-sln}) [@code{sln}] command computes the
17874 ``straight-line'' depreciation. In this method, the asset depreciates
17875 by the same amount every year (or period). For example,
17876 @samp{sln(12000, 2000, 5)} returns 2000. The asset costs $12000
17877 initially and will be worth $2000 after five years; it loses $2000
17878 per year.
17879
17880 @kindex b Y
17881 @pindex calc-fin-syd
17882 @tindex syd
17883 The @kbd{b Y} (@code{calc-fin-syd}) [@code{syd}] command computes the
17884 accelerated ``sum-of-years'-digits'' depreciation. Here the depreciation
17885 is higher during the early years of the asset's life. Since the
17886 depreciation is different each year, @kbd{b Y} takes a fourth @var{period}
17887 parameter which specifies which year is requested, from 1 to @var{life}.
17888 If @var{period} is outside this range, the @code{syd} function will
17889 return zero.
17890
17891 @kindex b D
17892 @pindex calc-fin-ddb
17893 @tindex ddb
17894 The @kbd{b D} (@code{calc-fin-ddb}) [@code{ddb}] command computes an
17895 accelerated depreciation using the double-declining balance method.
17896 It also takes a fourth @var{period} parameter.
17897
17898 For symmetry, the @code{sln} function will accept a @var{period}
17899 parameter as well, although it will ignore its value except that the
17900 return value will as usual be zero if @var{period} is out of range.
17901
17902 For example, pushing the vector @expr{[1,2,3,4,5]} (perhaps with @kbd{v x 5})
17903 and then mapping @kbd{V M ' [sln(12000,2000,5,$), syd(12000,2000,5,$),
17904 ddb(12000,2000,5,$)] @key{RET}} produces a matrix that allows us to compare
17905 the three depreciation methods:
17906
17907 @example
17908 @group
17909 [ [ 2000, 3333, 4800 ]
17910 [ 2000, 2667, 2880 ]
17911 [ 2000, 2000, 1728 ]
17912 [ 2000, 1333, 592 ]
17913 [ 2000, 667, 0 ] ]
17914 @end group
17915 @end example
17916
17917 @noindent
17918 (Values have been rounded to nearest integers in this figure.)
17919 We see that @code{sln} depreciates by the same amount each year,
17920 @kbd{syd} depreciates more at the beginning and less at the end,
17921 and @kbd{ddb} weights the depreciation even more toward the beginning.
17922
17923 Summing columns with @kbd{V R : +} yields @expr{[10000, 10000, 10000]};
17924 the total depreciation in any method is (by definition) the
17925 difference between the cost and the salvage value.
17926
17927 @node Definitions of Financial Functions, , Depreciation Functions, Financial Functions
17928 @subsection Definitions
17929
17930 @noindent
17931 For your reference, here are the actual formulas used to compute
17932 Calc's financial functions.
17933
17934 Calc will not evaluate a financial function unless the @var{rate} or
17935 @var{n} argument is known. However, @var{payment} or @var{amount} can
17936 be a variable. Calc expands these functions according to the
17937 formulas below for symbolic arguments only when you use the @kbd{a "}
17938 (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command, or when taking derivatives or
17939 integrals or solving equations involving the functions.
17940
17941 @ifnottex
17942 These formulas are shown using the conventions of Big display
17943 mode (@kbd{d B}); for example, the formula for @code{fv} written
17944 linearly is @samp{pmt * ((1 + rate)^n) - 1) / rate}.
17945
17946 @example
17947 n
17948 (1 + rate) - 1
17949 fv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ---------------
17950 rate
17951
17952 n
17953 ((1 + rate) - 1) (1 + rate)
17954 fvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------------------
17955 rate
17956
17957 n
17958 fvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17959
17960 -n
17961 1 - (1 + rate)
17962 pv(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * ----------------
17963 rate
17964
17965 -n
17966 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17967 pvb(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * -----------------------------
17968 rate
17969
17970 -n
17971 pvl(rate, n, pmt) = pmt * (1 + rate)
17972
17973 -1 -2 -3
17974 npv(rate, [a, b, c]) = a*(1 + rate) + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17975
17976 -1 -2
17977 npvb(rate, [a, b, c]) = a + b*(1 + rate) + c*(1 + rate)
17978
17979 -n
17980 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17981 pmt(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17982 -n
17983 1 - (1 + rate)
17984
17985 -n
17986 (amt - x * (1 + rate) ) * rate
17987 pmtb(rate, n, amt, x) = -------------------------------
17988 -n
17989 (1 - (1 + rate) ) (1 + rate)
17990
17991 amt * rate
17992 nper(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ------------, 1 + rate)
17993 pmt
17994
17995 amt * rate
17996 nperb(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(1 - ---------------, 1 + rate)
17997 pmt * (1 + rate)
17998
17999 amt
18000 nperl(rate, pmt, amt) = - log(---, 1 + rate)
18001 pmt
18002
18003 1/n
18004 pmt
18005 ratel(n, pmt, amt) = ------ - 1
18006 1/n
18007 amt
18008
18009 cost - salv
18010 sln(cost, salv, life) = -----------
18011 life
18012
18013 (cost - salv) * (life - per + 1)
18014 syd(cost, salv, life, per) = --------------------------------
18015 life * (life + 1) / 2
18016
18017 book * 2
18018 ddb(cost, salv, life, per) = --------, book = cost - depreciation so far
18019 life
18020 @end example
18021 @end ifnottex
18022 @tex
18023 $$ \code{fv}(r, n, p) = p { (1 + r)^n - 1 \over r } $$
18024 $$ \code{fvb}(r, n, p) = p { ((1 + r)^n - 1) (1 + r) \over r } $$
18025 $$ \code{fvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^n $$
18026 $$ \code{pv}(r, n, p) = p { 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} \over r } $$
18027 $$ \code{pvb}(r, n, p) = p { (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) \over r } $$
18028 $$ \code{pvl}(r, n, p) = p (1 + r)^{-n} $$
18029 $$ \code{npv}(r, [a,b,c]) = a (1 + r)^{-1} + b (1 + r)^{-2} + c (1 + r)^{-3} $$
18030 $$ \code{npvb}(r, [a,b,c]) = a + b (1 + r)^{-1} + c (1 + r)^{-2} $$
18031 $$ \code{pmt}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over 1 - (1 + r)^{-n} }$$
18032 $$ \code{pmtb}(r, n, a, x) = { (a - x (1 + r)^{-n}) r \over
18033 (1 - (1 + r)^{-n}) (1 + r) } $$
18034 $$ \code{nper}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p }, 1 + r) $$
18035 $$ \code{nperb}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}(1 - { a r \over p (1 + r) }, 1 + r) $$
18036 $$ \code{nperl}(r, p, a) = -\code{log}({a \over p}, 1 + r) $$
18037 $$ \code{ratel}(n, p, a) = { p^{1/n} \over a^{1/n} } - 1 $$
18038 $$ \code{sln}(c, s, l) = { c - s \over l } $$
18039 $$ \code{syd}(c, s, l, p) = { (c - s) (l - p + 1) \over l (l+1) / 2 } $$
18040 $$ \code{ddb}(c, s, l, p) = { 2 (c - \hbox{depreciation so far}) \over l } $$
18041 @end tex
18042
18043 @noindent
18044 In @code{pmt} and @code{pmtb}, @expr{x=0} if omitted.
18045
18046 These functions accept any numeric objects, including error forms,
18047 intervals, and even (though not very usefully) complex numbers. The
18048 above formulas specify exactly the behavior of these functions with
18049 all sorts of inputs.
18050
18051 Note that if the first argument to the @code{log} in @code{nper} is
18052 negative, @code{nper} leaves itself in symbolic form rather than
18053 returning a (financially meaningless) complex number.
18054
18055 @samp{rate(num, pmt, amt)} solves the equation
18056 @samp{pv(rate, num, pmt) = amt} for @samp{rate} using @kbd{H a R}
18057 (@code{calc-find-root}), with the interval @samp{[.01% .. 100%]}
18058 for an initial guess. The @code{rateb} function is the same except
18059 that it uses @code{pvb}. Note that @code{ratel} can be solved
18060 directly; its formula is shown in the above list.
18061
18062 Similarly, @samp{irr(pmts)} solves the equation @samp{npv(rate, pmts) = 0}
18063 for @samp{rate}.
18064
18065 If you give a fourth argument to @code{nper} or @code{nperb}, Calc
18066 will also use @kbd{H a R} to solve the equation using an initial
18067 guess interval of @samp{[0 .. 100]}.
18068
18069 A fourth argument to @code{fv} simply sums the two components
18070 calculated from the above formulas for @code{fv} and @code{fvl}.
18071 The same is true of @code{fvb}, @code{pv}, and @code{pvb}.
18072
18073 The @kbd{ddb} function is computed iteratively; the ``book'' value
18074 starts out equal to @var{cost}, and decreases according to the above
18075 formula for the specified number of periods. If the book value
18076 would decrease below @var{salvage}, it only decreases to @var{salvage}
18077 and the depreciation is zero for all subsequent periods. The @code{ddb}
18078 function returns the amount the book value decreased in the specified
18079 period.
18080
18081 @node Binary Functions, , Financial Functions, Arithmetic
18082 @section Binary Number Functions
18083
18084 @noindent
18085 The commands in this chapter all use two-letter sequences beginning with
18086 the @kbd{b} prefix.
18087
18088 @cindex Binary numbers
18089 The ``binary'' operations actually work regardless of the currently
18090 displayed radix, although their results make the most sense in a radix
18091 like 2, 8, or 16 (as obtained by the @kbd{d 2}, @kbd{d 8}, or @w{@kbd{d 6}}
18092 commands, respectively). You may also wish to enable display of leading
18093 zeros with @kbd{d z}. @xref{Radix Modes}.
18094
18095 @cindex Word size for binary operations
18096 The Calculator maintains a current @dfn{word size} @expr{w}, an
18097 arbitrary positive or negative integer. For a positive word size, all
18098 of the binary operations described here operate modulo @expr{2^w}. In
18099 particular, negative arguments are converted to positive integers modulo
18100 @expr{2^w} by all binary functions.
18101
18102 If the word size is negative, binary operations produce twos-complement
18103 integers from
18104 @texline @math{-2^{-w-1}}
18105 @infoline @expr{-(2^(-w-1))}
18106 to
18107 @texline @math{2^{-w-1}-1}
18108 @infoline @expr{2^(-w-1)-1}
18109 inclusive. Either mode accepts inputs in any range; the sign of
18110 @expr{w} affects only the results produced.
18111
18112 @kindex b c
18113 @pindex calc-clip
18114 @tindex clip
18115 The @kbd{b c} (@code{calc-clip})
18116 [@code{clip}] command can be used to clip a number by reducing it modulo
18117 @expr{2^w}. The commands described in this chapter automatically clip
18118 their results to the current word size. Note that other operations like
18119 addition do not use the current word size, since integer addition
18120 generally is not ``binary.'' (However, @pxref{Simplification Modes},
18121 @code{calc-bin-simplify-mode}.) For example, with a word size of 8
18122 bits @kbd{b c} converts a number to the range 0 to 255; with a word
18123 size of @mathit{-8} @kbd{b c} converts to the range @mathit{-128} to 127.
18124
18125 @kindex b w
18126 @pindex calc-word-size
18127 The default word size is 32 bits. All operations except the shifts and
18128 rotates allow you to specify a different word size for that one
18129 operation by giving a numeric prefix argument: @kbd{C-u 8 b c} clips the
18130 top of stack to the range 0 to 255 regardless of the current word size.
18131 To set the word size permanently, use @kbd{b w} (@code{calc-word-size}).
18132 This command displays a prompt with the current word size; press @key{RET}
18133 immediately to keep this word size, or type a new word size at the prompt.
18134
18135 When the binary operations are written in symbolic form, they take an
18136 optional second (or third) word-size parameter. When a formula like
18137 @samp{and(a,b)} is finally evaluated, the word size current at that time
18138 will be used, but when @samp{and(a,b,-8)} is evaluated, a word size of
18139 @mathit{-8} will always be used. A symbolic binary function will be left
18140 in symbolic form unless the all of its argument(s) are integers or
18141 integer-valued floats.
18142
18143 If either or both arguments are modulo forms for which @expr{M} is a
18144 power of two, that power of two is taken as the word size unless a
18145 numeric prefix argument overrides it. The current word size is never
18146 consulted when modulo-power-of-two forms are involved.
18147
18148 @kindex b a
18149 @pindex calc-and
18150 @tindex and
18151 The @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}) [@code{and}] command computes the bitwise
18152 AND of the two numbers on the top of the stack. In other words, for each
18153 of the @expr{w} binary digits of the two numbers (pairwise), the corresponding
18154 bit of the result is 1 if and only if both input bits are 1:
18155 @samp{and(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1000}.
18156
18157 @kindex b o
18158 @pindex calc-or
18159 @tindex or
18160 The @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}) [@code{or}] command computes the bitwise
18161 inclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if either of the input bits, or
18162 both, are 1: @samp{or(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#1110}.
18163
18164 @kindex b x
18165 @pindex calc-xor
18166 @tindex xor
18167 The @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}) [@code{xor}] command computes the bitwise
18168 exclusive OR of two numbers. A bit is 1 if exactly one of the input bits
18169 is 1: @samp{xor(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0110}.
18170
18171 @kindex b d
18172 @pindex calc-diff
18173 @tindex diff
18174 The @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}) [@code{diff}] command computes the bitwise
18175 difference of two numbers; this is defined by @samp{diff(a,b) = and(a,not(b))},
18176 so that @samp{diff(2#1100, 2#1010) = 2#0100}.
18177
18178 @kindex b n
18179 @pindex calc-not
18180 @tindex not
18181 The @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}) [@code{not}] command computes the bitwise
18182 NOT of a number. A bit is 1 if the input bit is 0 and vice-versa.
18183
18184 @kindex b l
18185 @pindex calc-lshift-binary
18186 @tindex lsh
18187 The @kbd{b l} (@code{calc-lshift-binary}) [@code{lsh}] command shifts a
18188 number left by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18189 prefix argument. A negative prefix argument performs a logical right shift,
18190 in which zeros are shifted in on the left. In symbolic form, @samp{lsh(a)}
18191 is short for @samp{lsh(a,1)}, which in turn is short for @samp{lsh(a,n,w)}.
18192 Bits shifted ``off the end,'' according to the current word size, are lost.
18193
18194 @kindex H b l
18195 @kindex H b r
18196 @ignore
18197 @mindex @idots
18198 @end ignore
18199 @kindex H b L
18200 @ignore
18201 @mindex @null
18202 @end ignore
18203 @kindex H b R
18204 @ignore
18205 @mindex @null
18206 @end ignore
18207 @kindex H b t
18208 The @kbd{H b l} command also does a left shift, but it takes two arguments
18209 from the stack (the value to shift, and, at top-of-stack, the number of
18210 bits to shift). This version interprets the prefix argument just like
18211 the regular binary operations, i.e., as a word size. The Hyperbolic flag
18212 has a similar effect on the rest of the binary shift and rotate commands.
18213
18214 @kindex b r
18215 @pindex calc-rshift-binary
18216 @tindex rsh
18217 The @kbd{b r} (@code{calc-rshift-binary}) [@code{rsh}] command shifts a
18218 number right by one bit, or by the number of bits specified in the numeric
18219 prefix argument: @samp{rsh(a,n) = lsh(a,-n)}.
18220
18221 @kindex b L
18222 @pindex calc-lshift-arith
18223 @tindex ash
18224 The @kbd{b L} (@code{calc-lshift-arith}) [@code{ash}] command shifts a
18225 number left. It is analogous to @code{lsh}, except that if the shift
18226 is rightward (the prefix argument is negative), an arithmetic shift
18227 is performed as described below.
18228
18229 @kindex b R
18230 @pindex calc-rshift-arith
18231 @tindex rash
18232 The @kbd{b R} (@code{calc-rshift-arith}) [@code{rash}] command performs
18233 an ``arithmetic'' shift to the right, in which the leftmost bit (according
18234 to the current word size) is duplicated rather than shifting in zeros.
18235 This corresponds to dividing by a power of two where the input is interpreted
18236 as a signed, twos-complement number. (The distinction between the @samp{rsh}
18237 and @samp{rash} operations is totally independent from whether the word
18238 size is positive or negative.) With a negative prefix argument, this
18239 performs a standard left shift.
18240
18241 @kindex b t
18242 @pindex calc-rotate-binary
18243 @tindex rot
18244 The @kbd{b t} (@code{calc-rotate-binary}) [@code{rot}] command rotates a
18245 number one bit to the left. The leftmost bit (according to the current
18246 word size) is dropped off the left and shifted in on the right. With a
18247 numeric prefix argument, the number is rotated that many bits to the left
18248 or right.
18249
18250 @xref{Set Operations}, for the @kbd{b p} and @kbd{b u} commands that
18251 pack and unpack binary integers into sets. (For example, @kbd{b u}
18252 unpacks the number @samp{2#11001} to the set of bit-numbers
18253 @samp{[0, 3, 4]}.) Type @kbd{b u V #} to count the number of ``1''
18254 bits in a binary integer.
18255
18256 Another interesting use of the set representation of binary integers
18257 is to reverse the bits in, say, a 32-bit integer. Type @kbd{b u} to
18258 unpack; type @kbd{31 @key{TAB} -} to replace each bit-number in the set
18259 with 31 minus that bit-number; type @kbd{b p} to pack the set back
18260 into a binary integer.
18261
18262 @node Scientific Functions, Matrix Functions, Arithmetic, Top
18263 @chapter Scientific Functions
18264
18265 @noindent
18266 The functions described here perform trigonometric and other transcendental
18267 calculations. They generally produce floating-point answers correct to the
18268 full current precision. The @kbd{H} (Hyperbolic) and @kbd{I} (Inverse)
18269 flag keys must be used to get some of these functions from the keyboard.
18270
18271 @kindex P
18272 @pindex calc-pi
18273 @cindex @code{pi} variable
18274 @vindex pi
18275 @kindex H P
18276 @cindex @code{e} variable
18277 @vindex e
18278 @kindex I P
18279 @cindex @code{gamma} variable
18280 @vindex gamma
18281 @cindex Gamma constant, Euler's
18282 @cindex Euler's gamma constant
18283 @kindex H I P
18284 @cindex @code{phi} variable
18285 @cindex Phi, golden ratio
18286 @cindex Golden ratio
18287 One miscellaneous command is shift-@kbd{P} (@code{calc-pi}), which pushes
18288 the value of @cpi{} (at the current precision) onto the stack. With the
18289 Hyperbolic flag, it pushes the value @expr{e}, the base of natural logarithms.
18290 With the Inverse flag, it pushes Euler's constant
18291 @texline @math{\gamma}
18292 @infoline @expr{gamma}
18293 (about 0.5772). With both Inverse and Hyperbolic, it
18294 pushes the ``golden ratio''
18295 @texline @math{\phi}
18296 @infoline @expr{phi}
18297 (about 1.618). (At present, Euler's constant is not available
18298 to unlimited precision; Calc knows only the first 100 digits.)
18299 In Symbolic mode, these commands push the
18300 actual variables @samp{pi}, @samp{e}, @samp{gamma}, and @samp{phi},
18301 respectively, instead of their values; @pxref{Symbolic Mode}.
18302
18303 @ignore
18304 @mindex Q
18305 @end ignore
18306 @ignore
18307 @mindex I Q
18308 @end ignore
18309 @kindex I Q
18310 @tindex sqr
18311 The @kbd{Q} (@code{calc-sqrt}) [@code{sqrt}] function is described elsewhere;
18312 @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}. With the Inverse flag [@code{sqr}], this command
18313 computes the square of the argument.
18314
18315 @xref{Prefix Arguments}, for a discussion of the effect of numeric
18316 prefix arguments on commands in this chapter which do not otherwise
18317 interpret a prefix argument.
18318
18319 @menu
18320 * Logarithmic Functions::
18321 * Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions::
18322 * Advanced Math Functions::
18323 * Branch Cuts::
18324 * Random Numbers::
18325 * Combinatorial Functions::
18326 * Probability Distribution Functions::
18327 @end menu
18328
18329 @node Logarithmic Functions, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions, Scientific Functions
18330 @section Logarithmic Functions
18331
18332 @noindent
18333 @kindex L
18334 @pindex calc-ln
18335 @tindex ln
18336 @ignore
18337 @mindex @null
18338 @end ignore
18339 @kindex I E
18340 The shift-@kbd{L} (@code{calc-ln}) [@code{ln}] command computes the natural
18341 logarithm of the real or complex number on the top of the stack. With
18342 the Inverse flag it computes the exponential function instead, although
18343 this is redundant with the @kbd{E} command.
18344
18345 @kindex E
18346 @pindex calc-exp
18347 @tindex exp
18348 @ignore
18349 @mindex @null
18350 @end ignore
18351 @kindex I L
18352 The shift-@kbd{E} (@code{calc-exp}) [@code{exp}] command computes the
18353 exponential, i.e., @expr{e} raised to the power of the number on the stack.
18354 The meanings of the Inverse and Hyperbolic flags follow from those for
18355 the @code{calc-ln} command.
18356
18357 @kindex H L
18358 @kindex H E
18359 @pindex calc-log10
18360 @tindex log10
18361 @tindex exp10
18362 @ignore
18363 @mindex @null
18364 @end ignore
18365 @kindex H I L
18366 @ignore
18367 @mindex @null
18368 @end ignore
18369 @kindex H I E
18370 The @kbd{H L} (@code{calc-log10}) [@code{log10}] command computes the common
18371 (base-10) logarithm of a number. (With the Inverse flag [@code{exp10}],
18372 it raises ten to a given power.) Note that the common logarithm of a
18373 complex number is computed by taking the natural logarithm and dividing
18374 by
18375 @texline @math{\ln10}.
18376 @infoline @expr{ln(10)}.
18377
18378 @kindex B
18379 @kindex I B
18380 @pindex calc-log
18381 @tindex log
18382 @tindex alog
18383 The @kbd{B} (@code{calc-log}) [@code{log}] command computes a logarithm
18384 to any base. For example, @kbd{1024 @key{RET} 2 B} produces 10, since
18385 @texline @math{2^{10} = 1024}.
18386 @infoline @expr{2^10 = 1024}.
18387 In certain cases like @samp{log(3,9)}, the result
18388 will be either @expr{1:2} or @expr{0.5} depending on the current Fraction
18389 mode setting. With the Inverse flag [@code{alog}], this command is
18390 similar to @kbd{^} except that the order of the arguments is reversed.
18391
18392 @kindex f I
18393 @pindex calc-ilog
18394 @tindex ilog
18395 The @kbd{f I} (@code{calc-ilog}) [@code{ilog}] command computes the
18396 integer logarithm of a number to any base. The number and the base must
18397 themselves be positive integers. This is the true logarithm, rounded
18398 down to an integer. Thus @kbd{ilog(x,10)} is 3 for all @expr{x} in the
18399 range from 1000 to 9999. If both arguments are positive integers, exact
18400 integer arithmetic is used; otherwise, this is equivalent to
18401 @samp{floor(log(x,b))}.
18402
18403 @kindex f E
18404 @pindex calc-expm1
18405 @tindex expm1
18406 The @kbd{f E} (@code{calc-expm1}) [@code{expm1}] command computes
18407 @texline @math{e^x - 1},
18408 @infoline @expr{exp(x)-1},
18409 but using an algorithm that produces a more accurate
18410 answer when the result is close to zero, i.e., when
18411 @texline @math{e^x}
18412 @infoline @expr{exp(x)}
18413 is close to one.
18414
18415 @kindex f L
18416 @pindex calc-lnp1
18417 @tindex lnp1
18418 The @kbd{f L} (@code{calc-lnp1}) [@code{lnp1}] command computes
18419 @texline @math{\ln(x+1)},
18420 @infoline @expr{ln(x+1)},
18421 producing a more accurate answer when @expr{x} is close to zero.
18422
18423 @node Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Advanced Math Functions, Logarithmic Functions, Scientific Functions
18424 @section Trigonometric/Hyperbolic Functions
18425
18426 @noindent
18427 @kindex S
18428 @pindex calc-sin
18429 @tindex sin
18430 The shift-@kbd{S} (@code{calc-sin}) [@code{sin}] command computes the sine
18431 of an angle or complex number. If the input is an HMS form, it is interpreted
18432 as degrees-minutes-seconds; otherwise, the input is interpreted according
18433 to the current angular mode. It is best to use Radians mode when operating
18434 on complex numbers.
18435
18436 Calc's ``units'' mechanism includes angular units like @code{deg},
18437 @code{rad}, and @code{grad}. While @samp{sin(45 deg)} is not evaluated
18438 all the time, the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command will
18439 simplify @samp{sin(45 deg)} by taking the sine of 45 degrees, regardless
18440 of the current angular mode. @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
18441
18442 Also, the symbolic variable @code{pi} is not ordinarily recognized in
18443 arguments to trigonometric functions, as in @samp{sin(3 pi / 4)}, but
18444 the default algebraic simplifications recognize many such
18445 formulas when the current angular mode is Radians @emph{and} Symbolic
18446 mode is enabled; this example would be replaced by @samp{sqrt(2) / 2}.
18447 @xref{Symbolic Mode}. Beware, this simplification occurs even if you
18448 have stored a different value in the variable @samp{pi}; this is one
18449 reason why changing built-in variables is a bad idea. Arguments of
18450 the form @expr{x} plus a multiple of @cpiover{2} are also simplified.
18451 Calc includes similar formulas for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
18452
18453 Calc's algebraic simplifications know all angles which are integer multiples of
18454 @cpiover{12}, @cpiover{10}, or @cpiover{8} radians. In Degrees mode,
18455 analogous simplifications occur for integer multiples of 15 or 18
18456 degrees, and for arguments plus multiples of 90 degrees.
18457
18458 @kindex I S
18459 @pindex calc-arcsin
18460 @tindex arcsin
18461 With the Inverse flag, @code{calc-sin} computes an arcsine. This is also
18462 available as the @code{calc-arcsin} command or @code{arcsin} algebraic
18463 function. The returned argument is converted to degrees, radians, or HMS
18464 notation depending on the current angular mode.
18465
18466 @kindex H S
18467 @pindex calc-sinh
18468 @tindex sinh
18469 @kindex H I S
18470 @pindex calc-arcsinh
18471 @tindex arcsinh
18472 With the Hyperbolic flag, @code{calc-sin} computes the hyperbolic
18473 sine, also available as @code{calc-sinh} [@code{sinh}]. With the
18474 Hyperbolic and Inverse flags, it computes the hyperbolic arcsine
18475 (@code{calc-arcsinh}) [@code{arcsinh}].
18476
18477 @kindex C
18478 @pindex calc-cos
18479 @tindex cos
18480 @ignore
18481 @mindex @idots
18482 @end ignore
18483 @kindex I C
18484 @pindex calc-arccos
18485 @ignore
18486 @mindex @null
18487 @end ignore
18488 @tindex arccos
18489 @ignore
18490 @mindex @null
18491 @end ignore
18492 @kindex H C
18493 @pindex calc-cosh
18494 @ignore
18495 @mindex @null
18496 @end ignore
18497 @tindex cosh
18498 @ignore
18499 @mindex @null
18500 @end ignore
18501 @kindex H I C
18502 @pindex calc-arccosh
18503 @ignore
18504 @mindex @null
18505 @end ignore
18506 @tindex arccosh
18507 @ignore
18508 @mindex @null
18509 @end ignore
18510 @kindex T
18511 @pindex calc-tan
18512 @ignore
18513 @mindex @null
18514 @end ignore
18515 @tindex tan
18516 @ignore
18517 @mindex @null
18518 @end ignore
18519 @kindex I T
18520 @pindex calc-arctan
18521 @ignore
18522 @mindex @null
18523 @end ignore
18524 @tindex arctan
18525 @ignore
18526 @mindex @null
18527 @end ignore
18528 @kindex H T
18529 @pindex calc-tanh
18530 @ignore
18531 @mindex @null
18532 @end ignore
18533 @tindex tanh
18534 @ignore
18535 @mindex @null
18536 @end ignore
18537 @kindex H I T
18538 @pindex calc-arctanh
18539 @ignore
18540 @mindex @null
18541 @end ignore
18542 @tindex arctanh
18543 The shift-@kbd{C} (@code{calc-cos}) [@code{cos}] command computes the cosine
18544 of an angle or complex number, and shift-@kbd{T} (@code{calc-tan}) [@code{tan}]
18545 computes the tangent, along with all the various inverse and hyperbolic
18546 variants of these functions.
18547
18548 @kindex f T
18549 @pindex calc-arctan2
18550 @tindex arctan2
18551 The @kbd{f T} (@code{calc-arctan2}) [@code{arctan2}] command takes two
18552 numbers from the stack and computes the arc tangent of their ratio. The
18553 result is in the full range from @mathit{-180} (exclusive) to @mathit{+180}
18554 (inclusive) degrees, or the analogous range in radians. A similar
18555 result would be obtained with @kbd{/} followed by @kbd{I T}, but the
18556 value would only be in the range from @mathit{-90} to @mathit{+90} degrees
18557 since the division loses information about the signs of the two
18558 components, and an error might result from an explicit division by zero
18559 which @code{arctan2} would avoid. By (arbitrary) definition,
18560 @samp{arctan2(0,0)=0}.
18561
18562 @pindex calc-sincos
18563 @ignore
18564 @starindex
18565 @end ignore
18566 @tindex sincos
18567 @ignore
18568 @starindex
18569 @end ignore
18570 @ignore
18571 @mindex arc@idots
18572 @end ignore
18573 @tindex arcsincos
18574 The @code{calc-sincos} [@code{sincos}] command computes the sine and
18575 cosine of a number, returning them as a vector of the form
18576 @samp{[@var{cos}, @var{sin}]}.
18577 With the Inverse flag [@code{arcsincos}], this command takes a two-element
18578 vector as an argument and computes @code{arctan2} of the elements.
18579 (This command does not accept the Hyperbolic flag.)
18580
18581 @pindex calc-sec
18582 @tindex sec
18583 @pindex calc-csc
18584 @tindex csc
18585 @pindex calc-cot
18586 @tindex cot
18587 @pindex calc-sech
18588 @tindex sech
18589 @pindex calc-csch
18590 @tindex csch
18591 @pindex calc-coth
18592 @tindex coth
18593 The remaining trigonometric functions, @code{calc-sec} [@code{sec}],
18594 @code{calc-csc} [@code{csc}] and @code{calc-cot} [@code{cot}], are also
18595 available. With the Hyperbolic flag, these compute their hyperbolic
18596 counterparts, which are also available separately as @code{calc-sech}
18597 [@code{sech}], @code{calc-csch} [@code{csch}] and @code{calc-coth}
18598 [@code{coth}]. (These commands do not accept the Inverse flag.)
18599
18600 @node Advanced Math Functions, Branch Cuts, Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions, Scientific Functions
18601 @section Advanced Mathematical Functions
18602
18603 @noindent
18604 Calc can compute a variety of less common functions that arise in
18605 various branches of mathematics. All of the functions described in
18606 this section allow arbitrary complex arguments and, except as noted,
18607 will work to arbitrarily large precision. They can not at present
18608 handle error forms or intervals as arguments.
18609
18610 NOTE: These functions are still experimental. In particular, their
18611 accuracy is not guaranteed in all domains. It is advisable to set the
18612 current precision comfortably higher than you actually need when
18613 using these functions. Also, these functions may be impractically
18614 slow for some values of the arguments.
18615
18616 @kindex f g
18617 @pindex calc-gamma
18618 @tindex gamma
18619 The @kbd{f g} (@code{calc-gamma}) [@code{gamma}] command computes the Euler
18620 gamma function. For positive integer arguments, this is related to the
18621 factorial function: @samp{gamma(n+1) = fact(n)}. For general complex
18622 arguments the gamma function can be defined by the following definite
18623 integral:
18624 @texline @math{\Gamma(a) = \int_0^\infty t^{a-1} e^t dt}.
18625 @infoline @expr{gamma(a) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, inf)}.
18626 (The actual implementation uses far more efficient computational methods.)
18627
18628 @kindex f G
18629 @tindex gammaP
18630 @ignore
18631 @mindex @idots
18632 @end ignore
18633 @kindex I f G
18634 @ignore
18635 @mindex @null
18636 @end ignore
18637 @kindex H f G
18638 @ignore
18639 @mindex @null
18640 @end ignore
18641 @kindex H I f G
18642 @pindex calc-inc-gamma
18643 @ignore
18644 @mindex @null
18645 @end ignore
18646 @tindex gammaQ
18647 @ignore
18648 @mindex @null
18649 @end ignore
18650 @tindex gammag
18651 @ignore
18652 @mindex @null
18653 @end ignore
18654 @tindex gammaG
18655 The @kbd{f G} (@code{calc-inc-gamma}) [@code{gammaP}] command computes
18656 the incomplete gamma function, denoted @samp{P(a,x)}. This is defined by
18657 the integral,
18658 @texline @math{P(a,x) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} e^t dt \right) / \Gamma(a)}.
18659 @infoline @expr{gammaP(a,x) = integ(t^(a-1) exp(t), t, 0, x) / gamma(a)}.
18660 This implies that @samp{gammaP(a,inf) = 1} for any @expr{a} (see the
18661 definition of the normal gamma function).
18662
18663 Several other varieties of incomplete gamma function are defined.
18664 The complement of @expr{P(a,x)}, called @expr{Q(a,x) = 1-P(a,x)} by
18665 some authors, is computed by the @kbd{I f G} [@code{gammaQ}] command.
18666 You can think of this as taking the other half of the integral, from
18667 @expr{x} to infinity.
18668
18669 @ifnottex
18670 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define @expr{P(a,x)}
18671 and @expr{Q(a,x)} but without the normalizing @expr{1/gamma(a)}
18672 factor are called @expr{g(a,x)} and @expr{G(a,x)}, respectively
18673 (where @expr{g} and @expr{G} represent the lower- and upper-case Greek
18674 letter gamma). You can obtain these using the @kbd{H f G} [@code{gammag}]
18675 and @kbd{H I f G} [@code{gammaG}] commands.
18676 @end ifnottex
18677 @tex
18678 The functions corresponding to the integrals that define $P(a,x)$
18679 and $Q(a,x)$ but without the normalizing $1/\Gamma(a)$
18680 factor are called $\gamma(a,x)$ and $\Gamma(a,x)$, respectively.
18681 You can obtain these using the \kbd{H f G} [\code{gammag}] and
18682 \kbd{I H f G} [\code{gammaG}] commands.
18683 @end tex
18684
18685 @kindex f b
18686 @pindex calc-beta
18687 @tindex beta
18688 The @kbd{f b} (@code{calc-beta}) [@code{beta}] command computes the
18689 Euler beta function, which is defined in terms of the gamma function as
18690 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \Gamma(a) \Gamma(b) / \Gamma(a+b)},
18691 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = gamma(a) gamma(b) / gamma(a+b)},
18692 or by
18693 @texline @math{B(a,b) = \int_0^1 t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt}.
18694 @infoline @expr{beta(a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, 1)}.
18695
18696 @kindex f B
18697 @kindex H f B
18698 @pindex calc-inc-beta
18699 @tindex betaI
18700 @tindex betaB
18701 The @kbd{f B} (@code{calc-inc-beta}) [@code{betaI}] command computes
18702 the incomplete beta function @expr{I(x,a,b)}. It is defined by
18703 @texline @math{I(x,a,b) = \left( \int_0^x t^{a-1} (1-t)^{b-1} dt \right) / B(a,b)}.
18704 @infoline @expr{betaI(x,a,b) = integ(t^(a-1) (1-t)^(b-1), t, 0, x) / beta(a,b)}.
18705 Once again, the @kbd{H} (hyperbolic) prefix gives the corresponding
18706 un-normalized version [@code{betaB}].
18707
18708 @kindex f e
18709 @kindex I f e
18710 @pindex calc-erf
18711 @tindex erf
18712 @tindex erfc
18713 The @kbd{f e} (@code{calc-erf}) [@code{erf}] command computes the
18714 error function
18715 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) = {2 \over \sqrt{\pi}} \int_0^x e^{-t^2} dt}.
18716 @infoline @expr{erf(x) = 2 integ(exp(-(t^2)), t, 0, x) / sqrt(pi)}.
18717 The complementary error function @kbd{I f e} (@code{calc-erfc}) [@code{erfc}]
18718 is the corresponding integral from @samp{x} to infinity; the sum
18719 @texline @math{\hbox{erf}(x) + \hbox{erfc}(x) = 1}.
18720 @infoline @expr{erf(x) + erfc(x) = 1}.
18721
18722 @kindex f j
18723 @kindex f y
18724 @pindex calc-bessel-J
18725 @pindex calc-bessel-Y
18726 @tindex besJ
18727 @tindex besY
18728 The @kbd{f j} (@code{calc-bessel-J}) [@code{besJ}] and @kbd{f y}
18729 (@code{calc-bessel-Y}) [@code{besY}] commands compute the Bessel
18730 functions of the first and second kinds, respectively.
18731 In @samp{besJ(n,x)} and @samp{besY(n,x)} the ``order'' parameter
18732 @expr{n} is often an integer, but is not required to be one.
18733 Calc's implementation of the Bessel functions currently limits the
18734 precision to 8 digits, and may not be exact even to that precision.
18735 Use with care!
18736
18737 @node Branch Cuts, Random Numbers, Advanced Math Functions, Scientific Functions
18738 @section Branch Cuts and Principal Values
18739
18740 @noindent
18741 @cindex Branch cuts
18742 @cindex Principal values
18743 All of the logarithmic, trigonometric, and other scientific functions are
18744 defined for complex numbers as well as for reals.
18745 This section describes the values
18746 returned in cases where the general result is a family of possible values.
18747 Calc follows section 12.5.3 of Steele's @dfn{Common Lisp, the Language},
18748 second edition, in these matters. This section will describe each
18749 function briefly; for a more detailed discussion (including some nifty
18750 diagrams), consult Steele's book.
18751
18752 Note that the branch cuts for @code{arctan} and @code{arctanh} were
18753 changed between the first and second editions of Steele. Recent
18754 versions of Calc follow the second edition.
18755
18756 The new branch cuts exactly match those of the HP-28/48 calculators.
18757 They also match those of Mathematica 1.2, except that Mathematica's
18758 @code{arctan} cut is always in the right half of the complex plane,
18759 and its @code{arctanh} cut is always in the top half of the plane.
18760 Calc's cuts are continuous with quadrants I and III for @code{arctan},
18761 or II and IV for @code{arctanh}.
18762
18763 Note: The current implementations of these functions with complex arguments
18764 are designed with proper behavior around the branch cuts in mind, @emph{not}
18765 efficiency or accuracy. You may need to increase the floating precision
18766 and wait a while to get suitable answers from them.
18767
18768 For @samp{sqrt(a+bi)}: When @expr{a<0} and @expr{b} is small but positive
18769 or zero, the result is close to the @expr{+i} axis. For @expr{b} small and
18770 negative, the result is close to the @expr{-i} axis. The result always lies
18771 in the right half of the complex plane.
18772
18773 For @samp{ln(a+bi)}: The real part is defined as @samp{ln(abs(a+bi))}.
18774 The imaginary part is defined as @samp{arg(a+bi) = arctan2(b,a)}.
18775 Thus the branch cuts for @code{sqrt} and @code{ln} both lie on the
18776 negative real axis.
18777
18778 The following table describes these branch cuts in another way.
18779 If the real and imaginary parts of @expr{z} are as shown, then
18780 the real and imaginary parts of @expr{f(z)} will be as shown.
18781 Here @code{eps} stands for a small positive value; each
18782 occurrence of @code{eps} may stand for a different small value.
18783
18784 @smallexample
18785 z sqrt(z) ln(z)
18786 ----------------------------------------
18787 +, 0 +, 0 any, 0
18788 -, 0 0, + any, pi
18789 -, +eps +eps, + +eps, +
18790 -, -eps +eps, - +eps, -
18791 @end smallexample
18792
18793 For @samp{z1^z2}: This is defined by @samp{exp(ln(z1)*z2)}.
18794 One interesting consequence of this is that @samp{(-8)^1:3} does
18795 not evaluate to @mathit{-2} as you might expect, but to the complex
18796 number @expr{(1., 1.732)}. Both of these are valid cube roots
18797 of @mathit{-8} (as is @expr{(1., -1.732)}); Calc chooses a perhaps
18798 less-obvious root for the sake of mathematical consistency.
18799
18800 For @samp{arcsin(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(i*z + sqrt(1-z^2))}.
18801 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18802
18803 For @samp{arccos(z)}: This is defined by @samp{-i*ln(z + i*sqrt(1-z^2))},
18804 or equivalently by @samp{pi/2 - arcsin(z)}. The branch cuts are on
18805 the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18806
18807 For @samp{arctan(z)}: This is defined by
18808 @samp{(ln(1+i*z) - ln(1-i*z)) / (2*i)}. The branch cuts are on the
18809 imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and above @expr{i}.
18810
18811 For @samp{arcsinh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{ln(z + sqrt(1+z^2))}.
18812 The branch cuts are on the imaginary axis, below @expr{-i} and
18813 above @expr{i}.
18814
18815 For @samp{arccosh(z)}: This is defined by
18816 @samp{ln(z + (z+1)*sqrt((z-1)/(z+1)))}. The branch cut is on the
18817 real axis less than 1.
18818
18819 For @samp{arctanh(z)}: This is defined by @samp{(ln(1+z) - ln(1-z)) / 2}.
18820 The branch cuts are on the real axis, less than @mathit{-1} and greater than 1.
18821
18822 The following tables for @code{arcsin}, @code{arccos}, and
18823 @code{arctan} assume the current angular mode is Radians. The
18824 hyperbolic functions operate independently of the angular mode.
18825
18826 @smallexample
18827 z arcsin(z) arccos(z)
18828 -------------------------------------------------------
18829 (-1..1), 0 (-pi/2..pi/2), 0 (0..pi), 0
18830 (-1..1), +eps (-pi/2..pi/2), +eps (0..pi), -eps
18831 (-1..1), -eps (-pi/2..pi/2), -eps (0..pi), +eps
18832 <-1, 0 -pi/2, + pi, -
18833 <-1, +eps -pi/2 + eps, + pi - eps, -
18834 <-1, -eps -pi/2 + eps, - pi - eps, +
18835 >1, 0 pi/2, - 0, +
18836 >1, +eps pi/2 - eps, + +eps, -
18837 >1, -eps pi/2 - eps, - +eps, +
18838 @end smallexample
18839
18840 @smallexample
18841 z arccosh(z) arctanh(z)
18842 -----------------------------------------------------
18843 (-1..1), 0 0, (0..pi) any, 0
18844 (-1..1), +eps +eps, (0..pi) any, +eps
18845 (-1..1), -eps +eps, (-pi..0) any, -eps
18846 <-1, 0 +, pi -, pi/2
18847 <-1, +eps +, pi - eps -, pi/2 - eps
18848 <-1, -eps +, -pi + eps -, -pi/2 + eps
18849 >1, 0 +, 0 +, -pi/2
18850 >1, +eps +, +eps +, pi/2 - eps
18851 >1, -eps +, -eps +, -pi/2 + eps
18852 @end smallexample
18853
18854 @smallexample
18855 z arcsinh(z) arctan(z)
18856 -----------------------------------------------------
18857 0, (-1..1) 0, (-pi/2..pi/2) 0, any
18858 0, <-1 -, -pi/2 -pi/2, -
18859 +eps, <-1 +, -pi/2 + eps pi/2 - eps, -
18860 -eps, <-1 -, -pi/2 + eps -pi/2 + eps, -
18861 0, >1 +, pi/2 pi/2, +
18862 +eps, >1 +, pi/2 - eps pi/2 - eps, +
18863 -eps, >1 -, pi/2 - eps -pi/2 + eps, +
18864 @end smallexample
18865
18866 Finally, the following identities help to illustrate the relationship
18867 between the complex trigonometric and hyperbolic functions. They
18868 are valid everywhere, including on the branch cuts.
18869
18870 @smallexample
18871 sin(i*z) = i*sinh(z) arcsin(i*z) = i*arcsinh(z)
18872 cos(i*z) = cosh(z) arcsinh(i*z) = i*arcsin(z)
18873 tan(i*z) = i*tanh(z) arctan(i*z) = i*arctanh(z)
18874 sinh(i*z) = i*sin(z) cosh(i*z) = cos(z)
18875 @end smallexample
18876
18877 The ``advanced math'' functions (gamma, Bessel, etc.@:) are also defined
18878 for general complex arguments, but their branch cuts and principal values
18879 are not rigorously specified at present.
18880
18881 @node Random Numbers, Combinatorial Functions, Branch Cuts, Scientific Functions
18882 @section Random Numbers
18883
18884 @noindent
18885 @kindex k r
18886 @pindex calc-random
18887 @tindex random
18888 The @kbd{k r} (@code{calc-random}) [@code{random}] command produces
18889 random numbers of various sorts.
18890
18891 Given a positive numeric prefix argument @expr{M}, it produces a random
18892 integer @expr{N} in the range
18893 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}.
18894 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}.
18895 Each possible value @expr{N} appears with equal probability.
18896
18897 With no numeric prefix argument, the @kbd{k r} command takes its argument
18898 from the stack instead. Once again, if this is a positive integer @expr{M}
18899 the result is a random integer less than @expr{M}. However, note that
18900 while numeric prefix arguments are limited to six digits or so, an @expr{M}
18901 taken from the stack can be arbitrarily large. If @expr{M} is negative,
18902 the result is a random integer in the range
18903 @texline @math{M < N \le 0}.
18904 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0}.
18905
18906 If the value on the stack is a floating-point number @expr{M}, the result
18907 is a random floating-point number @expr{N} in the range
18908 @texline @math{0 \le N < M}
18909 @infoline @expr{0 <= N < M}
18910 or
18911 @texline @math{M < N \le 0},
18912 @infoline @expr{M < N <= 0},
18913 according to the sign of @expr{M}.
18914
18915 If @expr{M} is zero, the result is a Gaussian-distributed random real
18916 number; the distribution has a mean of zero and a standard deviation
18917 of one. The algorithm used generates random numbers in pairs; thus,
18918 every other call to this function will be especially fast.
18919
18920 If @expr{M} is an error form
18921 @texline @math{m} @code{+/-} @math{\sigma}
18922 @infoline @samp{m +/- s}
18923 where @var{m} and
18924 @texline @math{\sigma}
18925 @infoline @var{s}
18926 are both real numbers, the result uses a Gaussian distribution with mean
18927 @var{m} and standard deviation
18928 @texline @math{\sigma}.
18929 @infoline @var{s}.
18930
18931 If @expr{M} is an interval form, the lower and upper bounds specify the
18932 acceptable limits of the random numbers. If both bounds are integers,
18933 the result is a random integer in the specified range. If either bound
18934 is floating-point, the result is a random real number in the specified
18935 range. If the interval is open at either end, the result will be sure
18936 not to equal that end value. (This makes a big difference for integer
18937 intervals, but for floating-point intervals it's relatively minor:
18938 with a precision of 6, @samp{random([1.0..2.0))} will return any of one
18939 million numbers from 1.00000 to 1.99999; @samp{random([1.0..2.0])} may
18940 additionally return 2.00000, but the probability of this happening is
18941 extremely small.)
18942
18943 If @expr{M} is a vector, the result is one element taken at random from
18944 the vector. All elements of the vector are given equal probabilities.
18945
18946 @vindex RandSeed
18947 The sequence of numbers produced by @kbd{k r} is completely random by
18948 default, i.e., the sequence is seeded each time you start Calc using
18949 the current time and other information. You can get a reproducible
18950 sequence by storing a particular ``seed value'' in the Calc variable
18951 @code{RandSeed}. Any integer will do for a seed; integers of from 1
18952 to 12 digits are good. If you later store a different integer into
18953 @code{RandSeed}, Calc will switch to a different pseudo-random
18954 sequence. If you ``unstore'' @code{RandSeed}, Calc will re-seed itself
18955 from the current time. If you store the same integer that you used
18956 before back into @code{RandSeed}, you will get the exact same sequence
18957 of random numbers as before.
18958
18959 @pindex calc-rrandom
18960 The @code{calc-rrandom} command (not on any key) produces a random real
18961 number between zero and one. It is equivalent to @samp{random(1.0)}.
18962
18963 @kindex k a
18964 @pindex calc-random-again
18965 The @kbd{k a} (@code{calc-random-again}) command produces another random
18966 number, re-using the most recent value of @expr{M}. With a numeric
18967 prefix argument @var{n}, it produces @var{n} more random numbers using
18968 that value of @expr{M}.
18969
18970 @kindex k h
18971 @pindex calc-shuffle
18972 @tindex shuffle
18973 The @kbd{k h} (@code{calc-shuffle}) command produces a vector of several
18974 random values with no duplicates. The value on the top of the stack
18975 specifies the set from which the random values are drawn, and may be any
18976 of the @expr{M} formats described above. The numeric prefix argument
18977 gives the length of the desired list. (If you do not provide a numeric
18978 prefix argument, the length of the list is taken from the top of the
18979 stack, and @expr{M} from second-to-top.)
18980
18981 If @expr{M} is a floating-point number, zero, or an error form (so
18982 that the random values are being drawn from the set of real numbers)
18983 there is little practical difference between using @kbd{k h} and using
18984 @kbd{k r} several times. But if the set of possible values consists
18985 of just a few integers, or the elements of a vector, then there is
18986 a very real chance that multiple @kbd{k r}'s will produce the same
18987 number more than once. The @kbd{k h} command produces a vector whose
18988 elements are always distinct. (Actually, there is a slight exception:
18989 If @expr{M} is a vector, no given vector element will be drawn more
18990 than once, but if several elements of @expr{M} are equal, they may
18991 each make it into the result vector.)
18992
18993 One use of @kbd{k h} is to rearrange a list at random. This happens
18994 if the prefix argument is equal to the number of values in the list:
18995 @kbd{[1, 1.5, 2, 2.5, 3] 5 k h} might produce the permuted list
18996 @samp{[2.5, 1, 1.5, 3, 2]}. As a convenient feature, if the argument
18997 @var{n} is negative it is replaced by the size of the set represented
18998 by @expr{M}. Naturally, this is allowed only when @expr{M} specifies
18999 a small discrete set of possibilities.
19000
19001 To do the equivalent of @kbd{k h} but with duplications allowed,
19002 given @expr{M} on the stack and with @var{n} just entered as a numeric
19003 prefix, use @kbd{v b} to build a vector of copies of @expr{M}, then use
19004 @kbd{V M k r} to ``map'' the normal @kbd{k r} function over the
19005 elements of this vector. @xref{Matrix Functions}.
19006
19007 @menu
19008 * Random Number Generator:: (Complete description of Calc's algorithm)
19009 @end menu
19010
19011 @node Random Number Generator, , Random Numbers, Random Numbers
19012 @subsection Random Number Generator
19013
19014 Calc's random number generator uses several methods to ensure that
19015 the numbers it produces are highly random. Knuth's @emph{Art of
19016 Computer Programming}, Volume II, contains a thorough description
19017 of the theory of random number generators and their measurement and
19018 characterization.
19019
19020 If @code{RandSeed} has no stored value, Calc calls Emacs's built-in
19021 @code{random} function to get a stream of random numbers, which it
19022 then treats in various ways to avoid problems inherent in the simple
19023 random number generators that many systems use to implement @code{random}.
19024
19025 When Calc's random number generator is first invoked, it ``seeds''
19026 the low-level random sequence using the time of day, so that the
19027 random number sequence will be different every time you use Calc.
19028
19029 Since Emacs Lisp doesn't specify the range of values that will be
19030 returned by its @code{random} function, Calc exercises the function
19031 several times to estimate the range. When Calc subsequently uses
19032 the @code{random} function, it takes only 10 bits of the result
19033 near the most-significant end. (It avoids at least the bottom
19034 four bits, preferably more, and also tries to avoid the top two
19035 bits.) This strategy works well with the linear congruential
19036 generators that are typically used to implement @code{random}.
19037
19038 If @code{RandSeed} contains an integer, Calc uses this integer to
19039 seed an ``additive congruential'' method (Knuth's algorithm 3.2.2A,
19040 computing
19041 @texline @math{X_{n-55} - X_{n-24}}.
19042 @infoline @expr{X_n-55 - X_n-24}).
19043 This method expands the seed
19044 value into a large table which is maintained internally; the variable
19045 @code{RandSeed} is changed from, e.g., 42 to the vector @expr{[42]}
19046 to indicate that the seed has been absorbed into this table. When
19047 @code{RandSeed} contains a vector, @kbd{k r} and related commands
19048 continue to use the same internal table as last time. There is no
19049 way to extract the complete state of the random number generator
19050 so that you can restart it from any point; you can only restart it
19051 from the same initial seed value. A simple way to restart from the
19052 same seed is to type @kbd{s r RandSeed} to get the seed vector,
19053 @kbd{v u} to unpack it back into a number, then @kbd{s t RandSeed}
19054 to reseed the generator with that number.
19055
19056 Calc uses a ``shuffling'' method as described in algorithm 3.2.2B
19057 of Knuth. It fills a table with 13 random 10-bit numbers. Then,
19058 to generate a new random number, it uses the previous number to
19059 index into the table, picks the value it finds there as the new
19060 random number, then replaces that table entry with a new value
19061 obtained from a call to the base random number generator (either
19062 the additive congruential generator or the @code{random} function
19063 supplied by the system). If there are any flaws in the base
19064 generator, shuffling will tend to even them out. But if the system
19065 provides an excellent @code{random} function, shuffling will not
19066 damage its randomness.
19067
19068 To create a random integer of a certain number of digits, Calc
19069 builds the integer three decimal digits at a time. For each group
19070 of three digits, Calc calls its 10-bit shuffling random number generator
19071 (which returns a value from 0 to 1023); if the random value is 1000
19072 or more, Calc throws it out and tries again until it gets a suitable
19073 value.
19074
19075 To create a random floating-point number with precision @var{p}, Calc
19076 simply creates a random @var{p}-digit integer and multiplies by
19077 @texline @math{10^{-p}}.
19078 @infoline @expr{10^-p}.
19079 The resulting random numbers should be very clean, but note
19080 that relatively small numbers will have few significant random digits.
19081 In other words, with a precision of 12, you will occasionally get
19082 numbers on the order of
19083 @texline @math{10^{-9}}
19084 @infoline @expr{10^-9}
19085 or
19086 @texline @math{10^{-10}},
19087 @infoline @expr{10^-10},
19088 but those numbers will only have two or three random digits since they
19089 correspond to small integers times
19090 @texline @math{10^{-12}}.
19091 @infoline @expr{10^-12}.
19092
19093 To create a random integer in the interval @samp{[0 .. @var{m})}, Calc
19094 counts the digits in @var{m}, creates a random integer with three
19095 additional digits, then reduces modulo @var{m}. Unless @var{m} is a
19096 power of ten the resulting values will be very slightly biased toward
19097 the lower numbers, but this bias will be less than 0.1%. (For example,
19098 if @var{m} is 42, Calc will reduce a random integer less than 100000
19099 modulo 42 to get a result less than 42. It is easy to show that the
19100 numbers 40 and 41 will be only 2380/2381 as likely to result from this
19101 modulo operation as numbers 39 and below.) If @var{m} is a power of
19102 ten, however, the numbers should be completely unbiased.
19103
19104 The Gaussian random numbers generated by @samp{random(0.0)} use the
19105 ``polar'' method described in Knuth section 3.4.1C@. This method
19106 generates a pair of Gaussian random numbers at a time, so only every
19107 other call to @samp{random(0.0)} will require significant calculations.
19108
19109 @node Combinatorial Functions, Probability Distribution Functions, Random Numbers, Scientific Functions
19110 @section Combinatorial Functions
19111
19112 @noindent
19113 Commands relating to combinatorics and number theory begin with the
19114 @kbd{k} key prefix.
19115
19116 @kindex k g
19117 @pindex calc-gcd
19118 @tindex gcd
19119 The @kbd{k g} (@code{calc-gcd}) [@code{gcd}] command computes the
19120 Greatest Common Divisor of two integers. It also accepts fractions;
19121 the GCD of two fractions is defined by taking the GCD of the
19122 numerators, and the LCM of the denominators. This definition is
19123 consistent with the idea that @samp{a / gcd(a,x)} should yield an
19124 integer for any @samp{a} and @samp{x}. For other types of arguments,
19125 the operation is left in symbolic form.
19126
19127 @kindex k l
19128 @pindex calc-lcm
19129 @tindex lcm
19130 The @kbd{k l} (@code{calc-lcm}) [@code{lcm}] command computes the
19131 Least Common Multiple of two integers or fractions. The product of
19132 the LCM and GCD of two numbers is equal to the product of the
19133 numbers.
19134
19135 @kindex k E
19136 @pindex calc-extended-gcd
19137 @tindex egcd
19138 The @kbd{k E} (@code{calc-extended-gcd}) [@code{egcd}] command computes
19139 the GCD of two integers @expr{x} and @expr{y} and returns a vector
19140 @expr{[g, a, b]} where
19141 @texline @math{g = \gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19142 @infoline @expr{g = gcd(x,y) = a x + b y}.
19143
19144 @kindex !
19145 @pindex calc-factorial
19146 @tindex fact
19147 @ignore
19148 @mindex @null
19149 @end ignore
19150 @tindex !
19151 The @kbd{!} (@code{calc-factorial}) [@code{fact}] command computes the
19152 factorial of the number at the top of the stack. If the number is an
19153 integer, the result is an exact integer. If the number is an
19154 integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point approximation. If
19155 the number is a non-integral real number, the generalized factorial is used,
19156 as defined by the Euler Gamma function. Please note that computation of
19157 large factorials can be slow; using floating-point format will help
19158 since fewer digits must be maintained. The same is true of many of
19159 the commands in this section.
19160
19161 @kindex k d
19162 @pindex calc-double-factorial
19163 @tindex dfact
19164 @ignore
19165 @mindex @null
19166 @end ignore
19167 @tindex !!
19168 The @kbd{k d} (@code{calc-double-factorial}) [@code{dfact}] command
19169 computes the ``double factorial'' of an integer. For an even integer,
19170 this is the product of even integers from 2 to @expr{N}. For an odd
19171 integer, this is the product of odd integers from 3 to @expr{N}. If
19172 the argument is an integer-valued float, the result is a floating-point
19173 approximation. This function is undefined for negative even integers.
19174 The notation @expr{N!!} is also recognized for double factorials.
19175
19176 @kindex k c
19177 @pindex calc-choose
19178 @tindex choose
19179 The @kbd{k c} (@code{calc-choose}) [@code{choose}] command computes the
19180 binomial coefficient @expr{N}-choose-@expr{M}, where @expr{M} is the number
19181 on the top of the stack and @expr{N} is second-to-top. If both arguments
19182 are integers, the result is an exact integer. Otherwise, the result is a
19183 floating-point approximation. The binomial coefficient is defined for all
19184 real numbers by
19185 @texline @math{N! \over M! (N-M)!\,}.
19186 @infoline @expr{N! / M! (N-M)!}.
19187
19188 @kindex H k c
19189 @pindex calc-perm
19190 @tindex perm
19191 @ifnottex
19192 The @kbd{H k c} (@code{calc-perm}) [@code{perm}] command computes the
19193 number-of-permutations function @expr{N! / (N-M)!}.
19194 @end ifnottex
19195 @tex
19196 The \kbd{H k c} (\code{calc-perm}) [\code{perm}] command computes the
19197 number-of-perm\-utations function $N! \over (N-M)!\,$.
19198 @end tex
19199
19200 @kindex k b
19201 @kindex H k b
19202 @pindex calc-bernoulli-number
19203 @tindex bern
19204 The @kbd{k b} (@code{calc-bernoulli-number}) [@code{bern}] command
19205 computes a given Bernoulli number. The value at the top of the stack
19206 is a nonnegative integer @expr{n} that specifies which Bernoulli number
19207 is desired. The @kbd{H k b} command computes a Bernoulli polynomial,
19208 taking @expr{n} from the second-to-top position and @expr{x} from the
19209 top of the stack. If @expr{x} is a variable or formula the result is
19210 a polynomial in @expr{x}; if @expr{x} is a number the result is a number.
19211
19212 @kindex k e
19213 @kindex H k e
19214 @pindex calc-euler-number
19215 @tindex euler
19216 The @kbd{k e} (@code{calc-euler-number}) [@code{euler}] command similarly
19217 computes an Euler number, and @w{@kbd{H k e}} computes an Euler polynomial.
19218 Bernoulli and Euler numbers occur in the Taylor expansions of several
19219 functions.
19220
19221 @kindex k s
19222 @kindex H k s
19223 @pindex calc-stirling-number
19224 @tindex stir1
19225 @tindex stir2
19226 The @kbd{k s} (@code{calc-stirling-number}) [@code{stir1}] command
19227 computes a Stirling number of the first
19228 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brack m},
19229 @infoline kind,
19230 given two integers @expr{n} and @expr{m} on the stack. The @kbd{H k s}
19231 [@code{stir2}] command computes a Stirling number of the second
19232 @texline kind@tie{}@math{n \brace m}.
19233 @infoline kind.
19234 These are the number of @expr{m}-cycle permutations of @expr{n} objects,
19235 and the number of ways to partition @expr{n} objects into @expr{m}
19236 non-empty sets, respectively.
19237
19238 @kindex k p
19239 @pindex calc-prime-test
19240 @cindex Primes
19241 The @kbd{k p} (@code{calc-prime-test}) command checks if the integer on
19242 the top of the stack is prime. For integers less than eight million, the
19243 answer is always exact and reasonably fast. For larger integers, a
19244 probabilistic method is used (see Knuth vol. II, section 4.5.4, algorithm P).
19245 The number is first checked against small prime factors (up to 13). Then,
19246 any number of iterations of the algorithm are performed. Each step either
19247 discovers that the number is non-prime, or substantially increases the
19248 certainty that the number is prime. After a few steps, the chance that
19249 a number was mistakenly described as prime will be less than one percent.
19250 (Indeed, this is a worst-case estimate of the probability; in practice
19251 even a single iteration is quite reliable.) After the @kbd{k p} command,
19252 the number will be reported as definitely prime or non-prime if possible,
19253 or otherwise ``probably'' prime with a certain probability of error.
19254
19255 @ignore
19256 @starindex
19257 @end ignore
19258 @tindex prime
19259 The normal @kbd{k p} command performs one iteration of the primality
19260 test. Pressing @kbd{k p} repeatedly for the same integer will perform
19261 additional iterations. Also, @kbd{k p} with a numeric prefix performs
19262 the specified number of iterations. There is also an algebraic function
19263 @samp{prime(n)} or @samp{prime(n,iters)} which returns 1 if @expr{n}
19264 is (probably) prime and 0 if not.
19265
19266 @kindex k f
19267 @pindex calc-prime-factors
19268 @tindex prfac
19269 The @kbd{k f} (@code{calc-prime-factors}) [@code{prfac}] command
19270 attempts to decompose an integer into its prime factors. For numbers up
19271 to 25 million, the answer is exact although it may take some time. The
19272 result is a vector of the prime factors in increasing order. For larger
19273 inputs, prime factors above 5000 may not be found, in which case the
19274 last number in the vector will be an unfactored integer greater than 25
19275 million (with a warning message). For negative integers, the first
19276 element of the list will be @mathit{-1}. For inputs @mathit{-1}, @mathit{0}, and
19277 @mathit{1}, the result is a list of the same number.
19278
19279 @kindex k n
19280 @pindex calc-next-prime
19281 @ignore
19282 @mindex nextpr@idots
19283 @end ignore
19284 @tindex nextprime
19285 The @kbd{k n} (@code{calc-next-prime}) [@code{nextprime}] command finds
19286 the next prime above a given number. Essentially, it searches by calling
19287 @code{calc-prime-test} on successive integers until it finds one that
19288 passes the test. This is quite fast for integers less than eight million,
19289 but once the probabilistic test comes into play the search may be rather
19290 slow. Ordinarily this command stops for any prime that passes one iteration
19291 of the primality test. With a numeric prefix argument, a number must pass
19292 the specified number of iterations before the search stops. (This only
19293 matters when searching above eight million.) You can always use additional
19294 @kbd{k p} commands to increase your certainty that the number is indeed
19295 prime.
19296
19297 @kindex I k n
19298 @pindex calc-prev-prime
19299 @ignore
19300 @mindex prevpr@idots
19301 @end ignore
19302 @tindex prevprime
19303 The @kbd{I k n} (@code{calc-prev-prime}) [@code{prevprime}] command
19304 analogously finds the next prime less than a given number.
19305
19306 @kindex k t
19307 @pindex calc-totient
19308 @tindex totient
19309 The @kbd{k t} (@code{calc-totient}) [@code{totient}] command computes the
19310 Euler ``totient''
19311 @texline function@tie{}@math{\phi(n)},
19312 @infoline function,
19313 the number of integers less than @expr{n} which
19314 are relatively prime to @expr{n}.
19315
19316 @kindex k m
19317 @pindex calc-moebius
19318 @tindex moebius
19319 The @kbd{k m} (@code{calc-moebius}) [@code{moebius}] command computes the
19320 @texline M@"obius @math{\mu}
19321 @infoline Moebius ``mu''
19322 function. If the input number is a product of @expr{k}
19323 distinct factors, this is @expr{(-1)^k}. If the input number has any
19324 duplicate factors (i.e., can be divided by the same prime more than once),
19325 the result is zero.
19326
19327 @node Probability Distribution Functions, , Combinatorial Functions, Scientific Functions
19328 @section Probability Distribution Functions
19329
19330 @noindent
19331 The functions in this section compute various probability distributions.
19332 For continuous distributions, this is the integral of the probability
19333 density function from @expr{x} to infinity. (These are the ``upper
19334 tail'' distribution functions; there are also corresponding ``lower
19335 tail'' functions which integrate from minus infinity to @expr{x}.)
19336 For discrete distributions, the upper tail function gives the sum
19337 from @expr{x} to infinity; the lower tail function gives the sum
19338 from minus infinity up to, but not including,@w{ }@expr{x}.
19339
19340 To integrate from @expr{x} to @expr{y}, just use the distribution
19341 function twice and subtract. For example, the probability that a
19342 Gaussian random variable with mean 2 and standard deviation 1 will
19343 lie in the range from 2.5 to 2.8 is @samp{utpn(2.5,2,1) - utpn(2.8,2,1)}
19344 (``the probability that it is greater than 2.5, but not greater than 2.8''),
19345 or equivalently @samp{ltpn(2.8,2,1) - ltpn(2.5,2,1)}.
19346
19347 @kindex k B
19348 @kindex I k B
19349 @pindex calc-utpb
19350 @tindex utpb
19351 @tindex ltpb
19352 The @kbd{k B} (@code{calc-utpb}) [@code{utpb}] function uses the
19353 binomial distribution. Push the parameters @var{n}, @var{p}, and
19354 then @var{x} onto the stack; the result (@samp{utpb(x,n,p)}) is the
19355 probability that an event will occur @var{x} or more times out
19356 of @var{n} trials, if its probability of occurring in any given
19357 trial is @var{p}. The @kbd{I k B} [@code{ltpb}] function is
19358 the probability that the event will occur fewer than @var{x} times.
19359
19360 The other probability distribution functions similarly take the
19361 form @kbd{k @var{X}} (@code{calc-utp@var{x}}) [@code{utp@var{x}}]
19362 and @kbd{I k @var{X}} [@code{ltp@var{x}}], for various letters
19363 @var{x}. The arguments to the algebraic functions are the value of
19364 the random variable first, then whatever other parameters define the
19365 distribution. Note these are among the few Calc functions where the
19366 order of the arguments in algebraic form differs from the order of
19367 arguments as found on the stack. (The random variable comes last on
19368 the stack, so that you can type, e.g., @kbd{2 @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 2.5
19369 k N M-@key{RET} @key{DEL} 2.8 k N -}, using @kbd{M-@key{RET} @key{DEL}} to
19370 recover the original arguments but substitute a new value for @expr{x}.)
19371
19372 @kindex k C
19373 @pindex calc-utpc
19374 @tindex utpc
19375 @ignore
19376 @mindex @idots
19377 @end ignore
19378 @kindex I k C
19379 @ignore
19380 @mindex @null
19381 @end ignore
19382 @tindex ltpc
19383 The @samp{utpc(x,v)} function uses the chi-square distribution with
19384 @texline @math{\nu}
19385 @infoline @expr{v}
19386 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a model is
19387 correct if its chi-square statistic is @expr{x}.
19388
19389 @kindex k F
19390 @pindex calc-utpf
19391 @tindex utpf
19392 @ignore
19393 @mindex @idots
19394 @end ignore
19395 @kindex I k F
19396 @ignore
19397 @mindex @null
19398 @end ignore
19399 @tindex ltpf
19400 The @samp{utpf(F,v1,v2)} function uses the F distribution, used in
19401 various statistical tests. The parameters
19402 @texline @math{\nu_1}
19403 @infoline @expr{v1}
19404 and
19405 @texline @math{\nu_2}
19406 @infoline @expr{v2}
19407 are the degrees of freedom in the numerator and denominator,
19408 respectively, used in computing the statistic @expr{F}.
19409
19410 @kindex k N
19411 @pindex calc-utpn
19412 @tindex utpn
19413 @ignore
19414 @mindex @idots
19415 @end ignore
19416 @kindex I k N
19417 @ignore
19418 @mindex @null
19419 @end ignore
19420 @tindex ltpn
19421 The @samp{utpn(x,m,s)} function uses a normal (Gaussian) distribution
19422 with mean @expr{m} and standard deviation
19423 @texline @math{\sigma}.
19424 @infoline @expr{s}.
19425 It is the probability that such a normal-distributed random variable
19426 would exceed @expr{x}.
19427
19428 @kindex k P
19429 @pindex calc-utpp
19430 @tindex utpp
19431 @ignore
19432 @mindex @idots
19433 @end ignore
19434 @kindex I k P
19435 @ignore
19436 @mindex @null
19437 @end ignore
19438 @tindex ltpp
19439 The @samp{utpp(n,x)} function uses a Poisson distribution with
19440 mean @expr{x}. It is the probability that @expr{n} or more such
19441 Poisson random events will occur.
19442
19443 @kindex k T
19444 @pindex calc-ltpt
19445 @tindex utpt
19446 @ignore
19447 @mindex @idots
19448 @end ignore
19449 @kindex I k T
19450 @ignore
19451 @mindex @null
19452 @end ignore
19453 @tindex ltpt
19454 The @samp{utpt(t,v)} function uses the Student's ``t'' distribution
19455 with
19456 @texline @math{\nu}
19457 @infoline @expr{v}
19458 degrees of freedom. It is the probability that a
19459 t-distributed random variable will be greater than @expr{t}.
19460 (Note: This computes the distribution function
19461 @texline @math{A(t|\nu)}
19462 @infoline @expr{A(t|v)}
19463 where
19464 @texline @math{A(0|\nu) = 1}
19465 @infoline @expr{A(0|v) = 1}
19466 and
19467 @texline @math{A(\infty|\nu) \to 0}.
19468 @infoline @expr{A(inf|v) -> 0}.
19469 The @code{UTPT} operation on the HP-48 uses a different definition which
19470 returns half of Calc's value: @samp{UTPT(t,v) = .5*utpt(t,v)}.)
19471
19472 While Calc does not provide inverses of the probability distribution
19473 functions, the @kbd{a R} command can be used to solve for the inverse.
19474 Since the distribution functions are monotonic, @kbd{a R} is guaranteed
19475 to be able to find a solution given any initial guess.
19476 @xref{Numerical Solutions}.
19477
19478 @node Matrix Functions, Algebra, Scientific Functions, Top
19479 @chapter Vector/Matrix Functions
19480
19481 @noindent
19482 Many of the commands described here begin with the @kbd{v} prefix.
19483 (For convenience, the shift-@kbd{V} prefix is equivalent to @kbd{v}.)
19484 The commands usually apply to both plain vectors and matrices; some
19485 apply only to matrices or only to square matrices. If the argument
19486 has the wrong dimensions the operation is left in symbolic form.
19487
19488 Vectors are entered and displayed using @samp{[a,b,c]} notation.
19489 Matrices are vectors of which all elements are vectors of equal length.
19490 (Though none of the standard Calc commands use this concept, a
19491 three-dimensional matrix or rank-3 tensor could be defined as a
19492 vector of matrices, and so on.)
19493
19494 @menu
19495 * Packing and Unpacking::
19496 * Building Vectors::
19497 * Extracting Elements::
19498 * Manipulating Vectors::
19499 * Vector and Matrix Arithmetic::
19500 * Set Operations::
19501 * Statistical Operations::
19502 * Reducing and Mapping::
19503 * Vector and Matrix Formats::
19504 @end menu
19505
19506 @node Packing and Unpacking, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions, Matrix Functions
19507 @section Packing and Unpacking
19508
19509 @noindent
19510 Calc's ``pack'' and ``unpack'' commands collect stack entries to build
19511 composite objects such as vectors and complex numbers. They are
19512 described in this chapter because they are most often used to build
19513 vectors.
19514
19515 @kindex v p
19516 @kindex V p
19517 @pindex calc-pack
19518 The @kbd{v p} (@code{calc-pack}) [@code{pack}] command collects several
19519 elements from the stack into a matrix, complex number, HMS form, error
19520 form, etc. It uses a numeric prefix argument to specify the kind of
19521 object to be built; this argument is referred to as the ``packing mode.''
19522 If the packing mode is a nonnegative integer, a vector of that
19523 length is created. For example, @kbd{C-u 5 v p} will pop the top
19524 five stack elements and push back a single vector of those five
19525 elements. (@kbd{C-u 0 v p} simply creates an empty vector.)
19526
19527 The same effect can be had by pressing @kbd{[} to push an incomplete
19528 vector on the stack, using @key{TAB} (@code{calc-roll-down}) to sneak
19529 the incomplete object up past a certain number of elements, and
19530 then pressing @kbd{]} to complete the vector.
19531
19532 Negative packing modes create other kinds of composite objects:
19533
19534 @table @cite
19535 @item -1
19536 Two values are collected to build a complex number. For example,
19537 @kbd{5 @key{RET} 7 C-u -1 v p} creates the complex number
19538 @expr{(5, 7)}. The result is always a rectangular complex
19539 number. The two input values must both be real numbers,
19540 i.e., integers, fractions, or floats. If they are not, Calc
19541 will instead build a formula like @samp{a + (0, 1) b}. (The
19542 other packing modes also create a symbolic answer if the
19543 components are not suitable.)
19544
19545 @item -2
19546 Two values are collected to build a polar complex number.
19547 The first is the magnitude; the second is the phase expressed
19548 in either degrees or radians according to the current angular
19549 mode.
19550
19551 @item -3
19552 Three values are collected into an HMS form. The first
19553 two values (hours and minutes) must be integers or
19554 integer-valued floats. The third value may be any real
19555 number.
19556
19557 @item -4
19558 Two values are collected into an error form. The inputs
19559 may be real numbers or formulas.
19560
19561 @item -5
19562 Two values are collected into a modulo form. The inputs
19563 must be real numbers.
19564
19565 @item -6
19566 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b]}.
19567 The inputs may be real numbers, HMS or date forms, or formulas.
19568
19569 @item -7
19570 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{[a .. b)}.
19571
19572 @item -8
19573 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b]}.
19574
19575 @item -9
19576 Two values are collected into the interval @samp{(a .. b)}.
19577
19578 @item -10
19579 Two integer values are collected into a fraction.
19580
19581 @item -11
19582 Two values are collected into a floating-point number.
19583 The first is the mantissa; the second, which must be an
19584 integer, is the exponent. The result is the mantissa
19585 times ten to the power of the exponent.
19586
19587 @item -12
19588 This is treated the same as @mathit{-11} by the @kbd{v p} command.
19589 When unpacking, @mathit{-12} specifies that a floating-point mantissa
19590 is desired.
19591
19592 @item -13
19593 A real number is converted into a date form.
19594
19595 @item -14
19596 Three numbers (year, month, day) are packed into a pure date form.
19597
19598 @item -15
19599 Six numbers are packed into a date/time form.
19600 @end table
19601
19602 With any of the two-input negative packing modes, either or both
19603 of the inputs may be vectors. If both are vectors of the same
19604 length, the result is another vector made by packing corresponding
19605 elements of the input vectors. If one input is a vector and the
19606 other is a plain number, the number is packed along with each vector
19607 element to produce a new vector. For example, @kbd{C-u -4 v p}
19608 could be used to convert a vector of numbers and a vector of errors
19609 into a single vector of error forms; @kbd{C-u -5 v p} could convert
19610 a vector of numbers and a single number @var{M} into a vector of
19611 numbers modulo @var{M}.
19612
19613 If you don't give a prefix argument to @kbd{v p}, it takes
19614 the packing mode from the top of the stack. The elements to
19615 be packed then begin at stack level 2. Thus
19616 @kbd{1 @key{RET} 2 @key{RET} 4 n v p} is another way to
19617 enter the error form @samp{1 +/- 2}.
19618
19619 If the packing mode taken from the stack is a vector, the result is a
19620 matrix with the dimensions specified by the elements of the vector,
19621 which must each be integers. For example, if the packing mode is
19622 @samp{[2, 3]}, then six numbers will be taken from the stack and
19623 returned in the form @samp{[@w{[a, b, c]}, [d, e, f]]}.
19624
19625 If any elements of the vector are negative, other kinds of
19626 packing are done at that level as described above. For
19627 example, @samp{[2, 3, -4]} takes 12 objects and creates a
19628 @texline @math{2\times3}
19629 @infoline 2x3
19630 matrix of error forms: @samp{[[a +/- b, c +/- d ... ]]}.
19631 Also, @samp{[-4, -10]} will convert four integers into an
19632 error form consisting of two fractions: @samp{a:b +/- c:d}.
19633
19634 @ignore
19635 @starindex
19636 @end ignore
19637 @tindex pack
19638 There is an equivalent algebraic function,
19639 @samp{pack(@var{mode}, @var{items})} where @var{mode} is a
19640 packing mode (an integer or a vector of integers) and @var{items}
19641 is a vector of objects to be packed (re-packed, really) according
19642 to that mode. For example, @samp{pack([3, -4], [a,b,c,d,e,f])}
19643 yields @samp{[a +/- b, @w{c +/- d}, e +/- f]}. The function is
19644 left in symbolic form if the packing mode is invalid, or if the
19645 number of data items does not match the number of items required
19646 by the mode.
19647
19648 @kindex v u
19649 @kindex V u
19650 @pindex calc-unpack
19651 The @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) command takes the vector, complex
19652 number, HMS form, or other composite object on the top of the stack and
19653 ``unpacks'' it, pushing each of its elements onto the stack as separate
19654 objects. Thus, it is the ``inverse'' of @kbd{v p}. If the value
19655 at the top of the stack is a formula, @kbd{v u} unpacks it by pushing
19656 each of the arguments of the top-level operator onto the stack.
19657
19658 You can optionally give a numeric prefix argument to @kbd{v u}
19659 to specify an explicit (un)packing mode. If the packing mode is
19660 negative and the input is actually a vector or matrix, the result
19661 will be two or more similar vectors or matrices of the elements.
19662 For example, given the vector @samp{[@w{a +/- b}, c^2, d +/- 7]},
19663 the result of @kbd{C-u -4 v u} will be the two vectors
19664 @samp{[a, c^2, d]} and @w{@samp{[b, 0, 7]}}.
19665
19666 Note that the prefix argument can have an effect even when the input is
19667 not a vector. For example, if the input is the number @mathit{-5}, then
19668 @kbd{c-u -1 v u} yields @mathit{-5} and 0 (the components of @mathit{-5}
19669 when viewed as a rectangular complex number); @kbd{C-u -2 v u} yields 5
19670 and 180 (assuming Degrees mode); and @kbd{C-u -10 v u} yields @mathit{-5}
19671 and 1 (the numerator and denominator of @mathit{-5}, viewed as a rational
19672 number). Plain @kbd{v u} with this input would complain that the input
19673 is not a composite object.
19674
19675 Unpacking mode @mathit{-11} converts a float into an integer mantissa and
19676 an integer exponent, where the mantissa is not divisible by 10
19677 (except that 0.0 is represented by a mantissa and exponent of 0).
19678 Unpacking mode @mathit{-12} converts a float into a floating-point mantissa
19679 and integer exponent, where the mantissa (for non-zero numbers)
19680 is guaranteed to lie in the range [1 .. 10). In both cases,
19681 the mantissa is shifted left or right (and the exponent adjusted
19682 to compensate) in order to satisfy these constraints.
19683
19684 Positive unpacking modes are treated differently than for @kbd{v p}.
19685 A mode of 1 is much like plain @kbd{v u} with no prefix argument,
19686 except that in addition to the components of the input object,
19687 a suitable packing mode to re-pack the object is also pushed.
19688 Thus, @kbd{C-u 1 v u} followed by @kbd{v p} will re-build the
19689 original object.
19690
19691 A mode of 2 unpacks two levels of the object; the resulting
19692 re-packing mode will be a vector of length 2. This might be used
19693 to unpack a matrix, say, or a vector of error forms. Higher
19694 unpacking modes unpack the input even more deeply.
19695
19696 @ignore
19697 @starindex
19698 @end ignore
19699 @tindex unpack
19700 There are two algebraic functions analogous to @kbd{v u}.
19701 The @samp{unpack(@var{mode}, @var{item})} function unpacks the
19702 @var{item} using the given @var{mode}, returning the result as
19703 a vector of components. Here the @var{mode} must be an
19704 integer, not a vector. For example, @samp{unpack(-4, a +/- b)}
19705 returns @samp{[a, b]}, as does @samp{unpack(1, a +/- b)}.
19706
19707 @ignore
19708 @starindex
19709 @end ignore
19710 @tindex unpackt
19711 The @code{unpackt} function is like @code{unpack} but instead
19712 of returning a simple vector of items, it returns a vector of
19713 two things: The mode, and the vector of items. For example,
19714 @samp{unpackt(1, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[-4, [2:3, 1:4]]},
19715 and @samp{unpackt(2, 2:3 +/- 1:4)} returns @samp{[[-4, -10], [2, 3, 1, 4]]}.
19716 The identity for re-building the original object is
19717 @samp{apply(pack, unpackt(@var{n}, @var{x})) = @var{x}}. (The
19718 @code{apply} function builds a function call given the function
19719 name and a vector of arguments.)
19720
19721 @cindex Numerator of a fraction, extracting
19722 Subscript notation is a useful way to extract a particular part
19723 of an object. For example, to get the numerator of a rational
19724 number, you can use @samp{unpack(-10, @var{x})_1}.
19725
19726 @node Building Vectors, Extracting Elements, Packing and Unpacking, Matrix Functions
19727 @section Building Vectors
19728
19729 @noindent
19730 Vectors and matrices can be added,
19731 subtracted, multiplied, and divided; @pxref{Basic Arithmetic}.
19732
19733 @kindex |
19734 @pindex calc-concat
19735 @ignore
19736 @mindex @null
19737 @end ignore
19738 @tindex |
19739 The @kbd{|} (@code{calc-concat}) [@code{vconcat}] command ``concatenates'' two vectors
19740 into one. For example, after @kbd{@w{[ 1 , 2 ]} [ 3 , 4 ] |}, the stack
19741 will contain the single vector @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]}. If the arguments
19742 are matrices, the rows of the first matrix are concatenated with the
19743 rows of the second. (In other words, two matrices are just two vectors
19744 of row-vectors as far as @kbd{|} is concerned.)
19745
19746 If either argument to @kbd{|} is a scalar (a non-vector), it is treated
19747 like a one-element vector for purposes of concatenation: @kbd{1 [ 2 , 3 ] |}
19748 produces the vector @samp{[1, 2, 3]}. Likewise, if one argument is a
19749 matrix and the other is a plain vector, the vector is treated as a
19750 one-row matrix.
19751
19752 @kindex H |
19753 @tindex append
19754 The @kbd{H |} (@code{calc-append}) [@code{append}] command concatenates
19755 two vectors without any special cases. Both inputs must be vectors.
19756 Whether or not they are matrices is not taken into account. If either
19757 argument is a scalar, the @code{append} function is left in symbolic form.
19758 See also @code{cons} and @code{rcons} below.
19759
19760 @kindex I |
19761 @kindex H I |
19762 The @kbd{I |} and @kbd{H I |} commands are similar, but they use their
19763 two stack arguments in the opposite order. Thus @kbd{I |} is equivalent
19764 to @kbd{@key{TAB} |}, but possibly more convenient and also a bit faster.
19765
19766 @kindex v d
19767 @kindex V d
19768 @pindex calc-diag
19769 @tindex diag
19770 The @kbd{v d} (@code{calc-diag}) [@code{diag}] function builds a diagonal
19771 square matrix. The optional numeric prefix gives the number of rows
19772 and columns in the matrix. If the value at the top of the stack is a
19773 vector, the elements of the vector are used as the diagonal elements; the
19774 prefix, if specified, must match the size of the vector. If the value on
19775 the stack is a scalar, it is used for each element on the diagonal, and
19776 the prefix argument is required.
19777
19778 To build a constant square matrix, e.g., a
19779 @texline @math{3\times3}
19780 @infoline 3x3
19781 matrix filled with ones, use @kbd{0 M-3 v d 1 +}, i.e., build a zero
19782 matrix first and then add a constant value to that matrix. (Another
19783 alternative would be to use @kbd{v b} and @kbd{v a}; see below.)
19784
19785 @kindex v i
19786 @kindex V i
19787 @pindex calc-ident
19788 @tindex idn
19789 The @kbd{v i} (@code{calc-ident}) [@code{idn}] function builds an identity
19790 matrix of the specified size. It is a convenient form of @kbd{v d}
19791 where the diagonal element is always one. If no prefix argument is given,
19792 this command prompts for one.
19793
19794 In algebraic notation, @samp{idn(a,n)} acts much like @samp{diag(a,n)},
19795 except that @expr{a} is required to be a scalar (non-vector) quantity.
19796 If @expr{n} is omitted, @samp{idn(a)} represents @expr{a} times an
19797 identity matrix of unknown size. Calc can operate algebraically on
19798 such generic identity matrices, and if one is combined with a matrix
19799 whose size is known, it is converted automatically to an identity
19800 matrix of a suitable matching size. The @kbd{v i} command with an
19801 argument of zero creates a generic identity matrix, @samp{idn(1)}.
19802 Note that in dimensioned Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), generic
19803 identity matrices are immediately expanded to the current default
19804 dimensions.
19805
19806 @kindex v x
19807 @kindex V x
19808 @pindex calc-index
19809 @tindex index
19810 The @kbd{v x} (@code{calc-index}) [@code{index}] function builds a vector
19811 of consecutive integers from 1 to @var{n}, where @var{n} is the numeric
19812 prefix argument. If you do not provide a prefix argument, you will be
19813 prompted to enter a suitable number. If @var{n} is negative, the result
19814 is a vector of negative integers from @var{n} to @mathit{-1}.
19815
19816 With a prefix argument of just @kbd{C-u}, the @kbd{v x} command takes
19817 three values from the stack: @var{n}, @var{start}, and @var{incr} (with
19818 @var{incr} at top-of-stack). Counting starts at @var{start} and increases
19819 by @var{incr} for successive vector elements. If @var{start} or @var{n}
19820 is in floating-point format, the resulting vector elements will also be
19821 floats. Note that @var{start} and @var{incr} may in fact be any kind
19822 of numbers or formulas.
19823
19824 When @var{start} and @var{incr} are specified, a negative @var{n} has a
19825 different interpretation: It causes a geometric instead of arithmetic
19826 sequence to be generated. For example, @samp{index(-3, a, b)} produces
19827 @samp{[a, a b, a b^2]}. If you omit @var{incr} in the algebraic form,
19828 @samp{index(@var{n}, @var{start})}, the default value for @var{incr}
19829 is one for positive @var{n} or two for negative @var{n}.
19830
19831 @kindex v b
19832 @kindex V b
19833 @pindex calc-build-vector
19834 @tindex cvec
19835 The @kbd{v b} (@code{calc-build-vector}) [@code{cvec}] function builds a
19836 vector of @var{n} copies of the value on the top of the stack, where @var{n}
19837 is the numeric prefix argument. In algebraic formulas, @samp{cvec(x,n,m)}
19838 can also be used to build an @var{n}-by-@var{m} matrix of copies of @var{x}.
19839 (Interactively, just use @kbd{v b} twice: once to build a row, then again
19840 to build a matrix of copies of that row.)
19841
19842 @kindex v h
19843 @kindex V h
19844 @kindex I v h
19845 @kindex I V h
19846 @pindex calc-head
19847 @pindex calc-tail
19848 @tindex head
19849 @tindex tail
19850 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) [@code{head}] function returns the first
19851 element of a vector. The @kbd{I v h} (@code{calc-tail}) [@code{tail}]
19852 function returns the vector with its first element removed. In both
19853 cases, the argument must be a non-empty vector.
19854
19855 @kindex v k
19856 @kindex V k
19857 @pindex calc-cons
19858 @tindex cons
19859 The @kbd{v k} (@code{calc-cons}) [@code{cons}] function takes a value @var{h}
19860 and a vector @var{t} from the stack, and produces the vector whose head is
19861 @var{h} and whose tail is @var{t}. This is similar to @kbd{|}, except
19862 if @var{h} is itself a vector, @kbd{|} will concatenate the two vectors
19863 whereas @code{cons} will insert @var{h} at the front of the vector @var{t}.
19864
19865 @kindex H v h
19866 @kindex H V h
19867 @tindex rhead
19868 @ignore
19869 @mindex @idots
19870 @end ignore
19871 @kindex H I v h
19872 @kindex H I V h
19873 @ignore
19874 @mindex @null
19875 @end ignore
19876 @kindex H v k
19877 @kindex H V k
19878 @ignore
19879 @mindex @null
19880 @end ignore
19881 @tindex rtail
19882 @ignore
19883 @mindex @null
19884 @end ignore
19885 @tindex rcons
19886 Each of these three functions also accepts the Hyperbolic flag [@code{rhead},
19887 @code{rtail}, @code{rcons}] in which case @var{t} instead represents
19888 the @emph{last} single element of the vector, with @var{h}
19889 representing the remainder of the vector. Thus the vector
19890 @samp{[a, b, c, d] = cons(a, [b, c, d]) = rcons([a, b, c], d)}.
19891 Also, @samp{head([a, b, c, d]) = a}, @samp{tail([a, b, c, d]) = [b, c, d]},
19892 @samp{rhead([a, b, c, d]) = [a, b, c]}, and @samp{rtail([a, b, c, d]) = d}.
19893
19894 @node Extracting Elements, Manipulating Vectors, Building Vectors, Matrix Functions
19895 @section Extracting Vector Elements
19896
19897 @noindent
19898 @kindex v r
19899 @kindex V r
19900 @pindex calc-mrow
19901 @tindex mrow
19902 The @kbd{v r} (@code{calc-mrow}) [@code{mrow}] command extracts one row of
19903 the matrix on the top of the stack, or one element of the plain vector on
19904 the top of the stack. The row or element is specified by the numeric
19905 prefix argument; the default is to prompt for the row or element number.
19906 The matrix or vector is replaced by the specified row or element in the
19907 form of a vector or scalar, respectively.
19908
19909 @cindex Permutations, applying
19910 With a prefix argument of @kbd{C-u} only, @kbd{v r} takes the index of
19911 the element or row from the top of the stack, and the vector or matrix
19912 from the second-to-top position. If the index is itself a vector of
19913 integers, the result is a vector of the corresponding elements of the
19914 input vector, or a matrix of the corresponding rows of the input matrix.
19915 This command can be used to obtain any permutation of a vector.
19916
19917 With @kbd{C-u}, if the index is an interval form with integer components,
19918 it is interpreted as a range of indices and the corresponding subvector or
19919 submatrix is returned.
19920
19921 @cindex Subscript notation
19922 @kindex a _
19923 @pindex calc-subscript
19924 @tindex subscr
19925 @tindex _
19926 Subscript notation in algebraic formulas (@samp{a_b}) stands for the
19927 Calc function @code{subscr}, which is synonymous with @code{mrow}.
19928 Thus, @samp{[x, y, z]_k} produces @expr{x}, @expr{y}, or @expr{z} if
19929 @expr{k} is one, two, or three, respectively. A double subscript
19930 (@samp{M_i_j}, equivalent to @samp{subscr(subscr(M, i), j)}) will
19931 access the element at row @expr{i}, column @expr{j} of a matrix.
19932 The @kbd{a _} (@code{calc-subscript}) command creates a subscript
19933 formula @samp{a_b} out of two stack entries. (It is on the @kbd{a}
19934 ``algebra'' prefix because subscripted variables are often used
19935 purely as an algebraic notation.)
19936
19937 @tindex mrrow
19938 Given a negative prefix argument, @kbd{v r} instead deletes one row or
19939 element from the matrix or vector on the top of the stack. Thus
19940 @kbd{C-u 2 v r} replaces a matrix with its second row, but @kbd{C-u -2 v r}
19941 replaces the matrix with the same matrix with its second row removed.
19942 In algebraic form this function is called @code{mrrow}.
19943
19944 @tindex getdiag
19945 Given a prefix argument of zero, @kbd{v r} extracts the diagonal elements
19946 of a square matrix in the form of a vector. In algebraic form this
19947 function is called @code{getdiag}.
19948
19949 @kindex v c
19950 @kindex V c
19951 @pindex calc-mcol
19952 @tindex mcol
19953 @tindex mrcol
19954 The @kbd{v c} (@code{calc-mcol}) [@code{mcol} or @code{mrcol}] command is
19955 the analogous operation on columns of a matrix. Given a plain vector
19956 it extracts (or removes) one element, just like @kbd{v r}. If the
19957 index in @kbd{C-u v c} is an interval or vector and the argument is a
19958 matrix, the result is a submatrix with only the specified columns
19959 retained (and possibly permuted in the case of a vector index).
19960
19961 To extract a matrix element at a given row and column, use @kbd{v r} to
19962 extract the row as a vector, then @kbd{v c} to extract the column element
19963 from that vector. In algebraic formulas, it is often more convenient to
19964 use subscript notation: @samp{m_i_j} gives row @expr{i}, column @expr{j}
19965 of matrix @expr{m}.
19966
19967 @kindex v s
19968 @kindex V s
19969 @pindex calc-subvector
19970 @tindex subvec
19971 The @kbd{v s} (@code{calc-subvector}) [@code{subvec}] command extracts
19972 a subvector of a vector. The arguments are the vector, the starting
19973 index, and the ending index, with the ending index in the top-of-stack
19974 position. The starting index indicates the first element of the vector
19975 to take. The ending index indicates the first element @emph{past} the
19976 range to be taken. Thus, @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)} produces
19977 the subvector @samp{[b, c]}. You could get the same result using
19978 @samp{mrow([a, b, c, d, e], @w{[2 .. 4)})}.
19979
19980 If either the start or the end index is zero or negative, it is
19981 interpreted as relative to the end of the vector. Thus
19982 @samp{subvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, -2)} also produces @samp{[b, c]}. In
19983 the algebraic form, the end index can be omitted in which case it
19984 is taken as zero, i.e., elements from the starting element to the
19985 end of the vector are used. The infinity symbol, @code{inf}, also
19986 has this effect when used as the ending index.
19987
19988 @kindex I v s
19989 @kindex I V s
19990 @tindex rsubvec
19991 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I v s} [@code{rsubvec}] removes a subvector
19992 from a vector. The arguments are interpreted the same as for the
19993 normal @kbd{v s} command. Thus, @samp{rsubvec([a, b, c, d, e], 2, 4)}
19994 produces @samp{[a, d, e]}. It is always true that @code{subvec} and
19995 @code{rsubvec} return complementary parts of the input vector.
19996
19997 @xref{Selecting Subformulas}, for an alternative way to operate on
19998 vectors one element at a time.
19999
20000 @node Manipulating Vectors, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Extracting Elements, Matrix Functions
20001 @section Manipulating Vectors
20002
20003 @noindent
20004 @kindex v l
20005 @kindex V l
20006 @pindex calc-vlength
20007 @tindex vlen
20008 The @kbd{v l} (@code{calc-vlength}) [@code{vlen}] command computes the
20009 length of a vector. The length of a non-vector is considered to be zero.
20010 Note that matrices are just vectors of vectors for the purposes of this
20011 command.
20012
20013 @kindex H v l
20014 @kindex H V l
20015 @tindex mdims
20016 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v l} [@code{mdims}] computes a vector
20017 of the dimensions of a vector, matrix, or higher-order object. For
20018 example, @samp{mdims([[a,b,c],[d,e,f]])} returns @samp{[2, 3]} since
20019 its argument is a
20020 @texline @math{2\times3}
20021 @infoline 2x3
20022 matrix.
20023
20024 @kindex v f
20025 @kindex V f
20026 @pindex calc-vector-find
20027 @tindex find
20028 The @kbd{v f} (@code{calc-vector-find}) [@code{find}] command searches
20029 along a vector for the first element equal to a given target. The target
20030 is on the top of the stack; the vector is in the second-to-top position.
20031 If a match is found, the result is the index of the matching element.
20032 Otherwise, the result is zero. The numeric prefix argument, if given,
20033 allows you to select any starting index for the search.
20034
20035 @kindex v a
20036 @kindex V a
20037 @pindex calc-arrange-vector
20038 @tindex arrange
20039 @cindex Arranging a matrix
20040 @cindex Reshaping a matrix
20041 @cindex Flattening a matrix
20042 The @kbd{v a} (@code{calc-arrange-vector}) [@code{arrange}] command
20043 rearranges a vector to have a certain number of columns and rows. The
20044 numeric prefix argument specifies the number of columns; if you do not
20045 provide an argument, you will be prompted for the number of columns.
20046 The vector or matrix on the top of the stack is @dfn{flattened} into a
20047 plain vector. If the number of columns is nonzero, this vector is
20048 then formed into a matrix by taking successive groups of @var{n} elements.
20049 If the number of columns does not evenly divide the number of elements
20050 in the vector, the last row will be short and the result will not be
20051 suitable for use as a matrix. For example, with the matrix
20052 @samp{[[1, 2], @w{[3, 4]}]} on the stack, @kbd{v a 4} produces
20053 @samp{[[1, 2, 3, 4]]} (a
20054 @texline @math{1\times4}
20055 @infoline 1x4
20056 matrix), @kbd{v a 1} produces @samp{[[1], [2], [3], [4]]} (a
20057 @texline @math{4\times1}
20058 @infoline 4x1
20059 matrix), @kbd{v a 2} produces @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4]]} (the original
20060 @texline @math{2\times2}
20061 @infoline 2x2
20062 matrix), @w{@kbd{v a 3}} produces @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4]]} (not a
20063 matrix), and @kbd{v a 0} produces the flattened list
20064 @samp{[1, 2, @w{3, 4}]}.
20065
20066 @cindex Sorting data
20067 @kindex v S
20068 @kindex V S
20069 @kindex I v S
20070 @kindex I V S
20071 @pindex calc-sort
20072 @tindex sort
20073 @tindex rsort
20074 The @kbd{V S} (@code{calc-sort}) [@code{sort}] command sorts the elements of
20075 a vector into increasing order. Real numbers, real infinities, and
20076 constant interval forms come first in this ordering; next come other
20077 kinds of numbers, then variables (in alphabetical order), then finally
20078 come formulas and other kinds of objects; these are sorted according
20079 to a kind of lexicographic ordering with the useful property that
20080 one vector is less or greater than another if the first corresponding
20081 unequal elements are less or greater, respectively. Since quoted strings
20082 are stored by Calc internally as vectors of ASCII character codes
20083 (@pxref{Strings}), this means vectors of strings are also sorted into
20084 alphabetical order by this command.
20085
20086 The @kbd{I V S} [@code{rsort}] command sorts a vector into decreasing order.
20087
20088 @cindex Permutation, inverse of
20089 @cindex Inverse of permutation
20090 @cindex Index tables
20091 @cindex Rank tables
20092 @kindex v G
20093 @kindex V G
20094 @kindex I v G
20095 @kindex I V G
20096 @pindex calc-grade
20097 @tindex grade
20098 @tindex rgrade
20099 The @kbd{V G} (@code{calc-grade}) [@code{grade}, @code{rgrade}] command
20100 produces an index table or permutation vector which, if applied to the
20101 input vector (as the index of @kbd{C-u v r}, say), would sort the vector.
20102 A permutation vector is just a vector of integers from 1 to @var{n}, where
20103 each integer occurs exactly once. One application of this is to sort a
20104 matrix of data rows using one column as the sort key; extract that column,
20105 grade it with @kbd{V G}, then use the result to reorder the original matrix
20106 with @kbd{C-u v r}. Another interesting property of the @code{V G} command
20107 is that, if the input is itself a permutation vector, the result will
20108 be the inverse of the permutation. The inverse of an index table is
20109 a rank table, whose @var{k}th element says where the @var{k}th original
20110 vector element will rest when the vector is sorted. To get a rank
20111 table, just use @kbd{V G V G}.
20112
20113 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I V G} produces an index table that would
20114 sort the input into decreasing order. Note that @kbd{V S} and @kbd{V G}
20115 use a ``stable'' sorting algorithm, i.e., any two elements which are equal
20116 will not be moved out of their original order. Generally there is no way
20117 to tell with @kbd{V S}, since two elements which are equal look the same,
20118 but with @kbd{V G} this can be an important issue. In the matrix-of-rows
20119 example, suppose you have names and telephone numbers as two columns and
20120 you wish to sort by phone number primarily, and by name when the numbers
20121 are equal. You can sort the data matrix by names first, and then again
20122 by phone numbers. Because the sort is stable, any two rows with equal
20123 phone numbers will remain sorted by name even after the second sort.
20124
20125 @cindex Histograms
20126 @kindex v H
20127 @kindex V H
20128 @pindex calc-histogram
20129 @ignore
20130 @mindex histo@idots
20131 @end ignore
20132 @tindex histogram
20133 The @kbd{V H} (@code{calc-histogram}) [@code{histogram}] command builds a
20134 histogram of a vector of numbers. Vector elements are assumed to be
20135 integers or real numbers in the range [0..@var{n}) for some ``number of
20136 bins'' @var{n}, which is the numeric prefix argument given to the
20137 command. The result is a vector of @var{n} counts of how many times
20138 each value appeared in the original vector. Non-integers in the input
20139 are rounded down to integers. Any vector elements outside the specified
20140 range are ignored. (You can tell if elements have been ignored by noting
20141 that the counts in the result vector don't add up to the length of the
20142 input vector.)
20143
20144 If no prefix is given, then you will be prompted for a vector which
20145 will be used to determine the bins. (If a positive integer is given at
20146 this prompt, it will be still treated as if it were given as a
20147 prefix.) Each bin will consist of the interval of numbers closest to
20148 the corresponding number of this new vector; if the vector
20149 @expr{[a, b, c, ...]} is entered at the prompt, the bins will be
20150 @expr{(-inf, (a+b)/2]}, @expr{((a+b)/2, (b+c)/2]}, etc. The result of
20151 this command will be a vector counting how many elements of the
20152 original vector are in each bin.
20153
20154 The result will then be a vector with the same length as this new vector;
20155 each element of the new vector will be replaced by the number of
20156 elements of the original vector which are closest to it.
20157
20158 @kindex H v H
20159 @kindex H V H
20160 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H V H} pulls two vectors from the stack.
20161 The second-to-top vector is the list of numbers as before. The top
20162 vector is an equal-sized list of ``weights'' to attach to the elements
20163 of the data vector. For example, if the first data element is 4.2 and
20164 the first weight is 10, then 10 will be added to bin 4 of the result
20165 vector. Without the hyperbolic flag, every element has a weight of one.
20166
20167 @kindex v t
20168 @kindex V t
20169 @pindex calc-transpose
20170 @tindex trn
20171 The @kbd{v t} (@code{calc-transpose}) [@code{trn}] command computes
20172 the transpose of the matrix at the top of the stack. If the argument
20173 is a plain vector, it is treated as a row vector and transposed into
20174 a one-column matrix.
20175
20176 @kindex v v
20177 @kindex V v
20178 @pindex calc-reverse-vector
20179 @tindex rev
20180 The @kbd{v v} (@code{calc-reverse-vector}) [@code{rev}] command reverses
20181 a vector end-for-end. Given a matrix, it reverses the order of the rows.
20182 (To reverse the columns instead, just use @kbd{v t v v v t}. The same
20183 principle can be used to apply other vector commands to the columns of
20184 a matrix.)
20185
20186 @kindex v m
20187 @kindex V m
20188 @pindex calc-mask-vector
20189 @tindex vmask
20190 The @kbd{v m} (@code{calc-mask-vector}) [@code{vmask}] command uses
20191 one vector as a mask to extract elements of another vector. The mask
20192 is in the second-to-top position; the target vector is on the top of
20193 the stack. These vectors must have the same length. The result is
20194 the same as the target vector, but with all elements which correspond
20195 to zeros in the mask vector deleted. Thus, for example,
20196 @samp{vmask([1, 0, 1, 0, 1], [a, b, c, d, e])} produces @samp{[a, c, e]}.
20197 @xref{Logical Operations}.
20198
20199 @kindex v e
20200 @kindex V e
20201 @pindex calc-expand-vector
20202 @tindex vexp
20203 The @kbd{v e} (@code{calc-expand-vector}) [@code{vexp}] command
20204 expands a vector according to another mask vector. The result is a
20205 vector the same length as the mask, but with nonzero elements replaced
20206 by successive elements from the target vector. The length of the target
20207 vector is normally the number of nonzero elements in the mask. If the
20208 target vector is longer, its last few elements are lost. If the target
20209 vector is shorter, the last few nonzero mask elements are left
20210 unreplaced in the result. Thus @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b])}
20211 produces @samp{[a, 0, b, 0, 7]}.
20212
20213 @kindex H v e
20214 @kindex H V e
20215 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H v e} takes a filler value from the
20216 top of the stack; the mask and target vectors come from the third and
20217 second elements of the stack. This filler is used where the mask is
20218 zero: @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 0, 7], [a, b], z)} produces
20219 @samp{[a, z, c, z, 7]}. If the filler value is itself a vector,
20220 then successive values are taken from it, so that the effect is to
20221 interleave two vectors according to the mask:
20222 @samp{vexp([2, 0, 3, 7, 0, 0], [a, b], [x, y])} produces
20223 @samp{[a, x, b, 7, y, 0]}.
20224
20225 Another variation on the masking idea is to combine @samp{[a, b, c, d, e]}
20226 with the mask @samp{[1, 0, 1, 0, 1]} to produce @samp{[a, 0, c, 0, e]}.
20227 You can accomplish this with @kbd{V M a &}, mapping the logical ``and''
20228 operation across the two vectors. @xref{Logical Operations}. Note that
20229 the @code{? :} operation also discussed there allows other types of
20230 masking using vectors.
20231
20232 @node Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Set Operations, Manipulating Vectors, Matrix Functions
20233 @section Vector and Matrix Arithmetic
20234
20235 @noindent
20236 Basic arithmetic operations like addition and multiplication are defined
20237 for vectors and matrices as well as for numbers. Division of matrices, in
20238 the sense of multiplying by the inverse, is supported. (Division by a
20239 matrix actually uses LU-decomposition for greater accuracy and speed.)
20240 @xref{Basic Arithmetic}.
20241
20242 The following functions are applied element-wise if their arguments are
20243 vectors or matrices: @code{change-sign}, @code{conj}, @code{arg},
20244 @code{re}, @code{im}, @code{polar}, @code{rect}, @code{clean},
20245 @code{float}, @code{frac}. @xref{Function Index}.
20246
20247 @kindex v J
20248 @kindex V J
20249 @pindex calc-conj-transpose
20250 @tindex ctrn
20251 The @kbd{V J} (@code{calc-conj-transpose}) [@code{ctrn}] command computes
20252 the conjugate transpose of its argument, i.e., @samp{conj(trn(x))}.
20253
20254 @ignore
20255 @mindex A
20256 @end ignore
20257 @kindex A (vectors)
20258 @pindex calc-abs (vectors)
20259 @ignore
20260 @mindex abs
20261 @end ignore
20262 @tindex abs (vectors)
20263 The @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) [@code{abs}] command computes the
20264 Frobenius norm of a vector or matrix argument. This is the square
20265 root of the sum of the squares of the absolute values of the
20266 elements of the vector or matrix. If the vector is interpreted as
20267 a point in two- or three-dimensional space, this is the distance
20268 from that point to the origin.
20269
20270 @kindex v n
20271 @kindex V n
20272 @pindex calc-rnorm
20273 @tindex rnorm
20274 The @kbd{v n} (@code{calc-rnorm}) [@code{rnorm}] command computes the
20275 infinity-norm of a vector, or the row norm of a matrix. For a plain
20276 vector, this is the maximum of the absolute values of the elements. For
20277 a matrix, this is the maximum of the row-absolute-value-sums, i.e., of
20278 the sums of the absolute values of the elements along the various rows.
20279
20280 @kindex v N
20281 @kindex V N
20282 @pindex calc-cnorm
20283 @tindex cnorm
20284 The @kbd{V N} (@code{calc-cnorm}) [@code{cnorm}] command computes
20285 the one-norm of a vector, or column norm of a matrix. For a plain
20286 vector, this is the sum of the absolute values of the elements.
20287 For a matrix, this is the maximum of the column-absolute-value-sums.
20288 General @expr{k}-norms for @expr{k} other than one or infinity are
20289 not provided. However, the 2-norm (or Frobenius norm) is provided for
20290 vectors by the @kbd{A} (@code{calc-abs}) command.
20291
20292 @kindex v C
20293 @kindex V C
20294 @pindex calc-cross
20295 @tindex cross
20296 The @kbd{V C} (@code{calc-cross}) [@code{cross}] command computes the
20297 right-handed cross product of two vectors, each of which must have
20298 exactly three elements.
20299
20300 @ignore
20301 @mindex &
20302 @end ignore
20303 @kindex & (matrices)
20304 @pindex calc-inv (matrices)
20305 @ignore
20306 @mindex inv
20307 @end ignore
20308 @tindex inv (matrices)
20309 The @kbd{&} (@code{calc-inv}) [@code{inv}] command computes the
20310 inverse of a square matrix. If the matrix is singular, the inverse
20311 operation is left in symbolic form. Matrix inverses are recorded so
20312 that once an inverse (or determinant) of a particular matrix has been
20313 computed, the inverse and determinant of the matrix can be recomputed
20314 quickly in the future.
20315
20316 If the argument to @kbd{&} is a plain number @expr{x}, this
20317 command simply computes @expr{1/x}. This is okay, because the
20318 @samp{/} operator also does a matrix inversion when dividing one
20319 by a matrix.
20320
20321 @kindex v D
20322 @kindex V D
20323 @pindex calc-mdet
20324 @tindex det
20325 The @kbd{V D} (@code{calc-mdet}) [@code{det}] command computes the
20326 determinant of a square matrix.
20327
20328 @kindex v L
20329 @kindex V L
20330 @pindex calc-mlud
20331 @tindex lud
20332 The @kbd{V L} (@code{calc-mlud}) [@code{lud}] command computes the
20333 LU decomposition of a matrix. The result is a list of three matrices
20334 which, when multiplied together left-to-right, form the original matrix.
20335 The first is a permutation matrix that arises from pivoting in the
20336 algorithm, the second is lower-triangular with ones on the diagonal,
20337 and the third is upper-triangular.
20338
20339 @kindex v T
20340 @kindex V T
20341 @pindex calc-mtrace
20342 @tindex tr
20343 The @kbd{V T} (@code{calc-mtrace}) [@code{tr}] command computes the
20344 trace of a square matrix. This is defined as the sum of the diagonal
20345 elements of the matrix.
20346
20347 @kindex v K
20348 @kindex V K
20349 @pindex calc-kron
20350 @tindex kron
20351 The @kbd{V K} (@code{calc-kron}) [@code{kron}] command computes
20352 the Kronecker product of two matrices.
20353
20354 @node Set Operations, Statistical Operations, Vector and Matrix Arithmetic, Matrix Functions
20355 @section Set Operations using Vectors
20356
20357 @noindent
20358 @cindex Sets, as vectors
20359 Calc includes several commands which interpret vectors as @dfn{sets} of
20360 objects. A set is a collection of objects; any given object can appear
20361 only once in the set. Calc stores sets as vectors of objects in
20362 sorted order. Objects in a Calc set can be any of the usual things,
20363 such as numbers, variables, or formulas. Two set elements are considered
20364 equal if they are identical, except that numerically equal numbers like
20365 the integer 4 and the float 4.0 are considered equal even though they
20366 are not ``identical.'' Variables are treated like plain symbols without
20367 attached values by the set operations; subtracting the set @samp{[b]}
20368 from @samp{[a, b]} always yields the set @samp{[a]} even though if
20369 the variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} both equaled 17, you might
20370 expect the answer @samp{[]}.
20371
20372 If a set contains interval forms, then it is assumed to be a set of
20373 real numbers. In this case, all set operations require the elements
20374 of the set to be only things that are allowed in intervals: Real
20375 numbers, plus and minus infinity, HMS forms, and date forms. If
20376 there are variables or other non-real objects present in a real set,
20377 all set operations on it will be left in unevaluated form.
20378
20379 If the input to a set operation is a plain number or interval form
20380 @var{a}, it is treated like the one-element vector @samp{[@var{a}]}.
20381 The result is always a vector, except that if the set consists of a
20382 single interval, the interval itself is returned instead.
20383
20384 @xref{Logical Operations}, for the @code{in} function which tests if
20385 a certain value is a member of a given set. To test if the set @expr{A}
20386 is a subset of the set @expr{B}, use @samp{vdiff(A, B) = []}.
20387
20388 @kindex v +
20389 @kindex V +
20390 @pindex calc-remove-duplicates
20391 @tindex rdup
20392 The @kbd{V +} (@code{calc-remove-duplicates}) [@code{rdup}] command
20393 converts an arbitrary vector into set notation. It works by sorting
20394 the vector as if by @kbd{V S}, then removing duplicates. (For example,
20395 @kbd{[a, 5, 4, a, 4.0]} is sorted to @samp{[4, 4.0, 5, a, a]} and then
20396 reduced to @samp{[4, 5, a]}). Overlapping intervals are merged as
20397 necessary. You rarely need to use @kbd{V +} explicitly, since all the
20398 other set-based commands apply @kbd{V +} to their inputs before using
20399 them.
20400
20401 @kindex v V
20402 @kindex V V
20403 @pindex calc-set-union
20404 @tindex vunion
20405 The @kbd{V V} (@code{calc-set-union}) [@code{vunion}] command computes
20406 the union of two sets. An object is in the union of two sets if and
20407 only if it is in either (or both) of the input sets. (You could
20408 accomplish the same thing by concatenating the sets with @kbd{|},
20409 then using @kbd{V +}.)
20410
20411 @kindex v ^
20412 @kindex V ^
20413 @pindex calc-set-intersect
20414 @tindex vint
20415 The @kbd{V ^} (@code{calc-set-intersect}) [@code{vint}] command computes
20416 the intersection of two sets. An object is in the intersection if
20417 and only if it is in both of the input sets. Thus if the input
20418 sets are disjoint, i.e., if they share no common elements, the result
20419 will be the empty vector @samp{[]}. Note that the characters @kbd{V}
20420 and @kbd{^} were chosen to be close to the conventional mathematical
20421 notation for set
20422 @texline union@tie{}(@math{A \cup B})
20423 @infoline union
20424 and
20425 @texline intersection@tie{}(@math{A \cap B}).
20426 @infoline intersection.
20427
20428 @kindex v -
20429 @kindex V -
20430 @pindex calc-set-difference
20431 @tindex vdiff
20432 The @kbd{V -} (@code{calc-set-difference}) [@code{vdiff}] command computes
20433 the difference between two sets. An object is in the difference
20434 @expr{A - B} if and only if it is in @expr{A} but not in @expr{B}.
20435 Thus subtracting @samp{[y,z]} from a set will remove the elements
20436 @samp{y} and @samp{z} if they are present. You can also think of this
20437 as a general @dfn{set complement} operator; if @expr{A} is the set of
20438 all possible values, then @expr{A - B} is the ``complement'' of @expr{B}.
20439 Obviously this is only practical if the set of all possible values in
20440 your problem is small enough to list in a Calc vector (or simple
20441 enough to express in a few intervals).
20442
20443 @kindex v X
20444 @kindex V X
20445 @pindex calc-set-xor
20446 @tindex vxor
20447 The @kbd{V X} (@code{calc-set-xor}) [@code{vxor}] command computes
20448 the ``exclusive-or,'' or ``symmetric difference'' of two sets.
20449 An object is in the symmetric difference of two sets if and only
20450 if it is in one, but @emph{not} both, of the sets. Objects that
20451 occur in both sets ``cancel out.''
20452
20453 @kindex v ~
20454 @kindex V ~
20455 @pindex calc-set-complement
20456 @tindex vcompl
20457 The @kbd{V ~} (@code{calc-set-complement}) [@code{vcompl}] command
20458 computes the complement of a set with respect to the real numbers.
20459 Thus @samp{vcompl(x)} is equivalent to @samp{vdiff([-inf .. inf], x)}.
20460 For example, @samp{vcompl([2, (3 .. 4]])} evaluates to
20461 @samp{[[-inf .. 2), (2 .. 3], (4 .. inf]]}.
20462
20463 @kindex v F
20464 @kindex V F
20465 @pindex calc-set-floor
20466 @tindex vfloor
20467 The @kbd{V F} (@code{calc-set-floor}) [@code{vfloor}] command
20468 reinterprets a set as a set of integers. Any non-integer values,
20469 and intervals that do not enclose any integers, are removed. Open
20470 intervals are converted to equivalent closed intervals. Successive
20471 integers are converted into intervals of integers. For example, the
20472 complement of the set @samp{[2, 6, 7, 8]} is messy, but if you wanted
20473 the complement with respect to the set of integers you could type
20474 @kbd{V ~ V F} to get @samp{[[-inf .. 1], [3 .. 5], [9 .. inf]]}.
20475
20476 @kindex v E
20477 @kindex V E
20478 @pindex calc-set-enumerate
20479 @tindex venum
20480 The @kbd{V E} (@code{calc-set-enumerate}) [@code{venum}] command
20481 converts a set of integers into an explicit vector. Intervals in
20482 the set are expanded out to lists of all integers encompassed by
20483 the intervals. This only works for finite sets (i.e., sets which
20484 do not involve @samp{-inf} or @samp{inf}).
20485
20486 @kindex v :
20487 @kindex V :
20488 @pindex calc-set-span
20489 @tindex vspan
20490 The @kbd{V :} (@code{calc-set-span}) [@code{vspan}] command converts any
20491 set of reals into an interval form that encompasses all its elements.
20492 The lower limit will be the smallest element in the set; the upper
20493 limit will be the largest element. For an empty set, @samp{vspan([])}
20494 returns the empty interval @w{@samp{[0 .. 0)}}.
20495
20496 @kindex v #
20497 @kindex V #
20498 @pindex calc-set-cardinality
20499 @tindex vcard
20500 The @kbd{V #} (@code{calc-set-cardinality}) [@code{vcard}] command counts
20501 the number of integers in a set. The result is the length of the vector
20502 that would be produced by @kbd{V E}, although the computation is much
20503 more efficient than actually producing that vector.
20504
20505 @cindex Sets, as binary numbers
20506 Another representation for sets that may be more appropriate in some
20507 cases is binary numbers. If you are dealing with sets of integers
20508 in the range 0 to 49, you can use a 50-bit binary number where a
20509 particular bit is 1 if the corresponding element is in the set.
20510 @xref{Binary Functions}, for a list of commands that operate on
20511 binary numbers. Note that many of the above set operations have
20512 direct equivalents in binary arithmetic: @kbd{b o} (@code{calc-or}),
20513 @kbd{b a} (@code{calc-and}), @kbd{b d} (@code{calc-diff}),
20514 @kbd{b x} (@code{calc-xor}), and @kbd{b n} (@code{calc-not}),
20515 respectively. You can use whatever representation for sets is most
20516 convenient to you.
20517
20518 @kindex b p
20519 @kindex b u
20520 @pindex calc-pack-bits
20521 @pindex calc-unpack-bits
20522 @tindex vpack
20523 @tindex vunpack
20524 The @kbd{b u} (@code{calc-unpack-bits}) [@code{vunpack}] command
20525 converts an integer that represents a set in binary into a set
20526 in vector/interval notation. For example, @samp{vunpack(67)}
20527 returns @samp{[[0 .. 1], 6]}. If the input is negative, the set
20528 it represents is semi-infinite: @samp{vunpack(-4) = [2 .. inf)}.
20529 Use @kbd{V E} afterwards to expand intervals to individual
20530 values if you wish. Note that this command uses the @kbd{b}
20531 (binary) prefix key.
20532
20533 The @kbd{b p} (@code{calc-pack-bits}) [@code{vpack}] command
20534 converts the other way, from a vector or interval representing
20535 a set of nonnegative integers into a binary integer describing
20536 the same set. The set may include positive infinity, but must
20537 not include any negative numbers. The input is interpreted as a
20538 set of integers in the sense of @kbd{V F} (@code{vfloor}). Beware
20539 that a simple input like @samp{[100]} can result in a huge integer
20540 representation
20541 @texline (@math{2^{100}}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20542 @infoline (@expr{2^100}, a 31-digit integer, in this case).
20543
20544 @node Statistical Operations, Reducing and Mapping, Set Operations, Matrix Functions
20545 @section Statistical Operations on Vectors
20546
20547 @noindent
20548 @cindex Statistical functions
20549 The commands in this section take vectors as arguments and compute
20550 various statistical measures on the data stored in the vectors. The
20551 references used in the definitions of these functions are Bevington's
20552 @emph{Data Reduction and Error Analysis for the Physical Sciences},
20553 and @emph{Numerical Recipes} by Press, Flannery, Teukolsky and
20554 Vetterling.
20555
20556 The statistical commands use the @kbd{u} prefix key followed by
20557 a shifted letter or other character.
20558
20559 @xref{Manipulating Vectors}, for a description of @kbd{V H}
20560 (@code{calc-histogram}).
20561
20562 @xref{Curve Fitting}, for the @kbd{a F} command for doing
20563 least-squares fits to statistical data.
20564
20565 @xref{Probability Distribution Functions}, for several common
20566 probability distribution functions.
20567
20568 @menu
20569 * Single-Variable Statistics::
20570 * Paired-Sample Statistics::
20571 @end menu
20572
20573 @node Single-Variable Statistics, Paired-Sample Statistics, Statistical Operations, Statistical Operations
20574 @subsection Single-Variable Statistics
20575
20576 @noindent
20577 These functions do various statistical computations on single
20578 vectors. Given a numeric prefix argument, they actually pop
20579 @var{n} objects from the stack and combine them into a data
20580 vector. Each object may be either a number or a vector; if a
20581 vector, any sub-vectors inside it are ``flattened'' as if by
20582 @kbd{v a 0}; @pxref{Manipulating Vectors}. By default one object
20583 is popped, which (in order to be useful) is usually a vector.
20584
20585 If an argument is a variable name, and the value stored in that
20586 variable is a vector, then the stored vector is used. This method
20587 has the advantage that if your data vector is large, you can avoid
20588 the slow process of manipulating it directly on the stack.
20589
20590 These functions are left in symbolic form if any of their arguments
20591 are not numbers or vectors, e.g., if an argument is a formula, or
20592 a non-vector variable. However, formulas embedded within vector
20593 arguments are accepted; the result is a symbolic representation
20594 of the computation, based on the assumption that the formula does
20595 not itself represent a vector. All varieties of numbers such as
20596 error forms and interval forms are acceptable.
20597
20598 Some of the functions in this section also accept a single error form
20599 or interval as an argument. They then describe a property of the
20600 normal or uniform (respectively) statistical distribution described
20601 by the argument. The arguments are interpreted in the same way as
20602 the @var{M} argument of the random number function @kbd{k r}. In
20603 particular, an interval with integer limits is considered an integer
20604 distribution, so that @samp{[2 .. 6)} is the same as @samp{[2 .. 5]}.
20605 An interval with at least one floating-point limit is a continuous
20606 distribution: @samp{[2.0 .. 6.0)} is @emph{not} the same as
20607 @samp{[2.0 .. 5.0]}!
20608
20609 @kindex u #
20610 @pindex calc-vector-count
20611 @tindex vcount
20612 The @kbd{u #} (@code{calc-vector-count}) [@code{vcount}] command
20613 computes the number of data values represented by the inputs.
20614 For example, @samp{vcount(1, [2, 3], [[4, 5], [], x, y])} returns 7.
20615 If the argument is a single vector with no sub-vectors, this
20616 simply computes the length of the vector.
20617
20618 @kindex u +
20619 @kindex u *
20620 @pindex calc-vector-sum
20621 @pindex calc-vector-prod
20622 @tindex vsum
20623 @tindex vprod
20624 @cindex Summations (statistical)
20625 The @kbd{u +} (@code{calc-vector-sum}) [@code{vsum}] command
20626 computes the sum of the data values. The @kbd{u *}
20627 (@code{calc-vector-prod}) [@code{vprod}] command computes the
20628 product of the data values. If the input is a single flat vector,
20629 these are the same as @kbd{V R +} and @kbd{V R *}
20630 (@pxref{Reducing and Mapping}).
20631
20632 @kindex u X
20633 @kindex u N
20634 @pindex calc-vector-max
20635 @pindex calc-vector-min
20636 @tindex vmax
20637 @tindex vmin
20638 The @kbd{u X} (@code{calc-vector-max}) [@code{vmax}] command
20639 computes the maximum of the data values, and the @kbd{u N}
20640 (@code{calc-vector-min}) [@code{vmin}] command computes the minimum.
20641 If the argument is an interval, this finds the minimum or maximum
20642 value in the interval. (Note that @samp{vmax([2..6)) = 5} as
20643 described above.) If the argument is an error form, this returns
20644 plus or minus infinity.
20645
20646 @kindex u M
20647 @pindex calc-vector-mean
20648 @tindex vmean
20649 @cindex Mean of data values
20650 The @kbd{u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean}) [@code{vmean}] command
20651 computes the average (arithmetic mean) of the data values.
20652 If the inputs are error forms
20653 @texline @math{x \pm \sigma},
20654 @infoline @samp{x +/- s},
20655 this is the weighted mean of the @expr{x} values with weights
20656 @texline @math{1 /\sigma^2}.
20657 @infoline @expr{1 / s^2}.
20658 @tex
20659 $$ \mu = { \displaystyle \sum { x_i \over \sigma_i^2 } \over
20660 \displaystyle \sum { 1 \over \sigma_i^2 } } $$
20661 @end tex
20662 If the inputs are not error forms, this is simply the sum of the
20663 values divided by the count of the values.
20664
20665 Note that a plain number can be considered an error form with
20666 error
20667 @texline @math{\sigma = 0}.
20668 @infoline @expr{s = 0}.
20669 If the input to @kbd{u M} is a mixture of
20670 plain numbers and error forms, the result is the mean of the
20671 plain numbers, ignoring all values with non-zero errors. (By the
20672 above definitions it's clear that a plain number effectively
20673 has an infinite weight, next to which an error form with a finite
20674 weight is completely negligible.)
20675
20676 This function also works for distributions (error forms or
20677 intervals). The mean of an error form `@var{a} @tfn{+/-} @var{b}' is simply
20678 @expr{a}. The mean of an interval is the mean of the minimum
20679 and maximum values of the interval.
20680
20681 @kindex I u M
20682 @pindex calc-vector-mean-error
20683 @tindex vmeane
20684 The @kbd{I u M} (@code{calc-vector-mean-error}) [@code{vmeane}]
20685 command computes the mean of the data points expressed as an
20686 error form. This includes the estimated error associated with
20687 the mean. If the inputs are error forms, the error is the square
20688 root of the reciprocal of the sum of the reciprocals of the squares
20689 of the input errors. (I.e., the variance is the reciprocal of the
20690 sum of the reciprocals of the variances.)
20691 @tex
20692 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {1 \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}} $$
20693 @end tex
20694 If the inputs are plain
20695 numbers, the error is equal to the standard deviation of the values
20696 divided by the square root of the number of values. (This works
20697 out to be equivalent to calculating the standard deviation and
20698 then assuming each value's error is equal to this standard
20699 deviation.)
20700 @tex
20701 $$ \sigma_\mu^2 = {\sigma^2 \over N} $$
20702 @end tex
20703
20704 @kindex H u M
20705 @pindex calc-vector-median
20706 @tindex vmedian
20707 @cindex Median of data values
20708 The @kbd{H u M} (@code{calc-vector-median}) [@code{vmedian}]
20709 command computes the median of the data values. The values are
20710 first sorted into numerical order; the median is the middle
20711 value after sorting. (If the number of data values is even,
20712 the median is taken to be the average of the two middle values.)
20713 The median function is different from the other functions in
20714 this section in that the arguments must all be real numbers;
20715 variables are not accepted even when nested inside vectors.
20716 (Otherwise it is not possible to sort the data values.) If
20717 any of the input values are error forms, their error parts are
20718 ignored.
20719
20720 The median function also accepts distributions. For both normal
20721 (error form) and uniform (interval) distributions, the median is
20722 the same as the mean.
20723
20724 @kindex H I u M
20725 @pindex calc-vector-harmonic-mean
20726 @tindex vhmean
20727 @cindex Harmonic mean
20728 The @kbd{H I u M} (@code{calc-vector-harmonic-mean}) [@code{vhmean}]
20729 command computes the harmonic mean of the data values. This is
20730 defined as the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals
20731 of the values.
20732 @tex
20733 $$ { N \over \displaystyle \sum {1 \over x_i} } $$
20734 @end tex
20735
20736 @kindex u G
20737 @pindex calc-vector-geometric-mean
20738 @tindex vgmean
20739 @cindex Geometric mean
20740 The @kbd{u G} (@code{calc-vector-geometric-mean}) [@code{vgmean}]
20741 command computes the geometric mean of the data values. This
20742 is the @var{n}th root of the product of the values. This is also
20743 equal to the @code{exp} of the arithmetic mean of the logarithms
20744 of the data values.
20745 @tex
20746 $$ \exp \left ( \sum { \ln x_i } \right ) =
20747 \left ( \prod { x_i } \right)^{1 / N} $$
20748 @end tex
20749
20750 @kindex H u G
20751 @tindex agmean
20752 The @kbd{H u G} [@code{agmean}] command computes the ``arithmetic-geometric
20753 mean'' of two numbers taken from the stack. This is computed by
20754 replacing the two numbers with their arithmetic mean and geometric
20755 mean, then repeating until the two values converge.
20756 @tex
20757 $$ a_{i+1} = { a_i + b_i \over 2 } , \qquad b_{i+1} = \sqrt{a_i b_i} $$
20758 @end tex
20759
20760 @c @cindex Root-mean-square
20761 @c Another commonly used mean, the RMS (root-mean-square), can be computed
20762 @c for a vector of numbers simply by using the @kbd{A} command.
20763
20764 @kindex u S
20765 @pindex calc-vector-sdev
20766 @tindex vsdev
20767 @cindex Standard deviation
20768 @cindex Sample statistics
20769 The @kbd{u S} (@code{calc-vector-sdev}) [@code{vsdev}] command
20770 computes the standard
20771 @texline deviation@tie{}@math{\sigma}
20772 @infoline deviation
20773 of the data values. If the values are error forms, the errors are used
20774 as weights just as for @kbd{u M}. This is the @emph{sample} standard
20775 deviation, whose value is the square root of the sum of the squares of
20776 the differences between the values and the mean of the @expr{N} values,
20777 divided by @expr{N-1}.
20778 @tex
20779 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N - 1} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20780 @end tex
20781
20782 This function also applies to distributions. The standard deviation
20783 of a single error form is simply the error part. The standard deviation
20784 of a continuous interval happens to equal the difference between the
20785 limits, divided by
20786 @texline @math{\sqrt{12}}.
20787 @infoline @expr{sqrt(12)}.
20788 The standard deviation of an integer interval is the same as the
20789 standard deviation of a vector of those integers.
20790
20791 @kindex I u S
20792 @pindex calc-vector-pop-sdev
20793 @tindex vpsdev
20794 @cindex Population statistics
20795 The @kbd{I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-sdev}) [@code{vpsdev}]
20796 command computes the @emph{population} standard deviation.
20797 It is defined by the same formula as above but dividing
20798 by @expr{N} instead of by @expr{N-1}. The population standard
20799 deviation is used when the input represents the entire set of
20800 data values in the distribution; the sample standard deviation
20801 is used when the input represents a sample of the set of all
20802 data values, so that the mean computed from the input is itself
20803 only an estimate of the true mean.
20804 @tex
20805 $$ \sigma^2 = {1 \over N} \sum (x_i - \mu)^2 $$
20806 @end tex
20807
20808 For error forms and continuous intervals, @code{vpsdev} works
20809 exactly like @code{vsdev}. For integer intervals, it computes the
20810 population standard deviation of the equivalent vector of integers.
20811
20812 @kindex H u S
20813 @kindex H I u S
20814 @pindex calc-vector-variance
20815 @pindex calc-vector-pop-variance
20816 @tindex vvar
20817 @tindex vpvar
20818 @cindex Variance of data values
20819 The @kbd{H u S} (@code{calc-vector-variance}) [@code{vvar}] and
20820 @kbd{H I u S} (@code{calc-vector-pop-variance}) [@code{vpvar}]
20821 commands compute the variance of the data values. The variance
20822 is the
20823 @texline square@tie{}@math{\sigma^2}
20824 @infoline square
20825 of the standard deviation, i.e., the sum of the
20826 squares of the deviations of the data values from the mean.
20827 (This definition also applies when the argument is a distribution.)
20828
20829 @ignore
20830 @starindex
20831 @end ignore
20832 @tindex vflat
20833 The @code{vflat} algebraic function returns a vector of its
20834 arguments, interpreted in the same way as the other functions
20835 in this section. For example, @samp{vflat(1, [2, [3, 4]], 5)}
20836 returns @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
20837
20838 @node Paired-Sample Statistics, , Single-Variable Statistics, Statistical Operations
20839 @subsection Paired-Sample Statistics
20840
20841 @noindent
20842 The functions in this section take two arguments, which must be
20843 vectors of equal size. The vectors are each flattened in the same
20844 way as by the single-variable statistical functions. Given a numeric
20845 prefix argument of 1, these functions instead take one object from
20846 the stack, which must be an
20847 @texline @math{N\times2}
20848 @infoline Nx2
20849 matrix of data values. Once again, variable names can be used in place
20850 of actual vectors and matrices.
20851
20852 @kindex u C
20853 @pindex calc-vector-covariance
20854 @tindex vcov
20855 @cindex Covariance
20856 The @kbd{u C} (@code{calc-vector-covariance}) [@code{vcov}] command
20857 computes the sample covariance of two vectors. The covariance
20858 of vectors @var{x} and @var{y} is the sum of the products of the
20859 differences between the elements of @var{x} and the mean of @var{x}
20860 times the differences between the corresponding elements of @var{y}
20861 and the mean of @var{y}, all divided by @expr{N-1}. Note that
20862 the variance of a vector is just the covariance of the vector
20863 with itself. Once again, if the inputs are error forms the
20864 errors are used as weight factors. If both @var{x} and @var{y}
20865 are composed of error forms, the error for a given data point
20866 is taken as the square root of the sum of the squares of the two
20867 input errors.
20868 @tex
20869 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 = {1 \over N-1} \sum (x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) $$
20870 $$ \sigma_{x\!y}^2 =
20871 {\displaystyle {1 \over N-1}
20872 \sum {(x_i - \mu_x) (y_i - \mu_y) \over \sigma_i^2}
20873 \over \displaystyle {1 \over N} \sum {1 \over \sigma_i^2}}
20874 $$
20875 @end tex
20876
20877 @kindex I u C
20878 @pindex calc-vector-pop-covariance
20879 @tindex vpcov
20880 The @kbd{I u C} (@code{calc-vector-pop-covariance}) [@code{vpcov}]
20881 command computes the population covariance, which is the same as the
20882 sample covariance computed by @kbd{u C} except dividing by @expr{N}
20883 instead of @expr{N-1}.
20884
20885 @kindex H u C
20886 @pindex calc-vector-correlation
20887 @tindex vcorr
20888 @cindex Correlation coefficient
20889 @cindex Linear correlation
20890 The @kbd{H u C} (@code{calc-vector-correlation}) [@code{vcorr}]
20891 command computes the linear correlation coefficient of two vectors.
20892 This is defined by the covariance of the vectors divided by the
20893 product of their standard deviations. (There is no difference
20894 between sample or population statistics here.)
20895 @tex
20896 $$ r_{x\!y} = { \sigma_{x\!y}^2 \over \sigma_x^2 \sigma_y^2 } $$
20897 @end tex
20898
20899 @node Reducing and Mapping, Vector and Matrix Formats, Statistical Operations, Matrix Functions
20900 @section Reducing and Mapping Vectors
20901
20902 @noindent
20903 The commands in this section allow for more general operations on the
20904 elements of vectors.
20905
20906 @kindex v A
20907 @kindex V A
20908 @pindex calc-apply
20909 @tindex apply
20910 The simplest of these operations is @kbd{V A} (@code{calc-apply})
20911 [@code{apply}], which applies a given operator to the elements of a vector.
20912 For example, applying the hypothetical function @code{f} to the vector
20913 @w{@samp{[1, 2, 3]}} would produce the function call @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20914 Applying the @code{+} function to the vector @samp{[a, b]} gives
20915 @samp{a + b}. Applying @code{+} to the vector @samp{[a, b, c]} is an
20916 error, since the @code{+} function expects exactly two arguments.
20917
20918 While @kbd{V A} is useful in some cases, you will usually find that either
20919 @kbd{V R} or @kbd{V M}, described below, is closer to what you want.
20920
20921 @menu
20922 * Specifying Operators::
20923 * Mapping::
20924 * Reducing::
20925 * Nesting and Fixed Points::
20926 * Generalized Products::
20927 @end menu
20928
20929 @node Specifying Operators, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
20930 @subsection Specifying Operators
20931
20932 @noindent
20933 Commands in this section (like @kbd{V A}) prompt you to press the key
20934 corresponding to the desired operator. Press @kbd{?} for a partial
20935 list of the available operators. Generally, an operator is any key or
20936 sequence of keys that would normally take one or more arguments from
20937 the stack and replace them with a result. For example, @kbd{V A H C}
20938 uses the hyperbolic cosine operator, @code{cosh}. (Since @code{cosh}
20939 expects one argument, @kbd{V A H C} requires a vector with a single
20940 element as its argument.)
20941
20942 You can press @kbd{x} at the operator prompt to select any algebraic
20943 function by name to use as the operator. This includes functions you
20944 have defined yourself using the @kbd{Z F} command. (@xref{Algebraic
20945 Definitions}.) If you give a name for which no function has been
20946 defined, the result is left in symbolic form, as in @samp{f(1, 2, 3)}.
20947 Calc will prompt for the number of arguments the function takes if it
20948 can't figure it out on its own (say, because you named a function that
20949 is currently undefined). It is also possible to type a digit key before
20950 the function name to specify the number of arguments, e.g.,
20951 @kbd{V M 3 x f @key{RET}} calls @code{f} with three arguments even if it
20952 looks like it ought to have only two. This technique may be necessary
20953 if the function allows a variable number of arguments. For example,
20954 the @kbd{v e} [@code{vexp}] function accepts two or three arguments;
20955 if you want to map with the three-argument version, you will have to
20956 type @kbd{V M 3 v e}.
20957
20958 It is also possible to apply any formula to a vector by treating that
20959 formula as a function. When prompted for the operator to use, press
20960 @kbd{'} (the apostrophe) and type your formula as an algebraic entry.
20961 You will then be prompted for the argument list, which defaults to a
20962 list of all variables that appear in the formula, sorted into alphabetic
20963 order. For example, suppose you enter the formula @w{@samp{x + 2y^x}}.
20964 The default argument list would be @samp{(x y)}, which means that if
20965 this function is applied to the arguments @samp{[3, 10]} the result will
20966 be @samp{3 + 2*10^3}. (If you plan to use a certain formula in this
20967 way often, you might consider defining it as a function with @kbd{Z F}.)
20968
20969 Another way to specify the arguments to the formula you enter is with
20970 @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on. For example, @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$}
20971 has the same effect as the previous example. The argument list is
20972 automatically taken to be @samp{($$ $)}. (The order of the arguments
20973 may seem backwards, but it is analogous to the way normal algebraic
20974 entry interacts with the stack.)
20975
20976 If you press @kbd{$} at the operator prompt, the effect is similar to
20977 the apostrophe except that the relevant formula is taken from top-of-stack
20978 instead. The actual vector arguments of the @kbd{V A $} or related command
20979 then start at the second-to-top stack position. You will still be
20980 prompted for an argument list.
20981
20982 @cindex Nameless functions
20983 @cindex Generic functions
20984 A function can be written without a name using the notation @samp{<#1 - #2>},
20985 which means ``a function of two arguments that computes the first
20986 argument minus the second argument.'' The symbols @samp{#1} and @samp{#2}
20987 are placeholders for the arguments. You can use any names for these
20988 placeholders if you wish, by including an argument list followed by a
20989 colon: @samp{<x, y : x - y>}. When you type @kbd{V A ' $$ + 2$^$$ @key{RET}},
20990 Calc builds the nameless function @samp{<#1 + 2 #2^#1>} as the function
20991 to map across the vectors. When you type @kbd{V A ' x + 2y^x @key{RET} @key{RET}},
20992 Calc builds the nameless function @w{@samp{<x, y : x + 2 y^x>}}. In both
20993 cases, Calc also writes the nameless function to the Trail so that you
20994 can get it back later if you wish.
20995
20996 If there is only one argument, you can write @samp{#} in place of @samp{#1}.
20997 (Note that @samp{< >} notation is also used for date forms. Calc tells
20998 that @samp{<@var{stuff}>} is a nameless function by the presence of
20999 @samp{#} signs inside @var{stuff}, or by the fact that @var{stuff}
21000 begins with a list of variables followed by a colon.)
21001
21002 You can type a nameless function directly to @kbd{V A '}, or put one on
21003 the stack and use it with @w{@kbd{V A $}}. Calc will not prompt for an
21004 argument list in this case, since the nameless function specifies the
21005 argument list as well as the function itself. In @kbd{V A '}, you can
21006 omit the @samp{< >} marks if you use @samp{#} notation for the arguments,
21007 so that @kbd{V A ' #1+#2 @key{RET}} is the same as @kbd{V A ' <#1+#2> @key{RET}},
21008 which in turn is the same as @kbd{V A ' $$+$ @key{RET}}.
21009
21010 @cindex Lambda expressions
21011 @ignore
21012 @starindex
21013 @end ignore
21014 @tindex lambda
21015 The internal format for @samp{<x, y : x + y>} is @samp{lambda(x, y, x + y)}.
21016 (The word @code{lambda} derives from Lisp notation and the theory of
21017 functions.) The internal format for @samp{<#1 + #2>} is @samp{lambda(ArgA,
21018 ArgB, ArgA + ArgB)}. Note that there is no actual Calc function called
21019 @code{lambda}; the whole point is that the @code{lambda} expression is
21020 used in its symbolic form, not evaluated for an answer until it is applied
21021 to specific arguments by a command like @kbd{V A} or @kbd{V M}.
21022
21023 (Actually, @code{lambda} does have one special property: Its arguments
21024 are never evaluated; for example, putting @samp{<(2/3) #>} on the stack
21025 will not simplify the @samp{2/3} until the nameless function is actually
21026 called.)
21027
21028 @tindex add
21029 @tindex sub
21030 @ignore
21031 @mindex @idots
21032 @end ignore
21033 @tindex mul
21034 @ignore
21035 @mindex @null
21036 @end ignore
21037 @tindex div
21038 @ignore
21039 @mindex @null
21040 @end ignore
21041 @tindex pow
21042 @ignore
21043 @mindex @null
21044 @end ignore
21045 @tindex neg
21046 @ignore
21047 @mindex @null
21048 @end ignore
21049 @tindex mod
21050 @ignore
21051 @mindex @null
21052 @end ignore
21053 @tindex vconcat
21054 As usual, commands like @kbd{V A} have algebraic function name equivalents.
21055 For example, @kbd{V A k g} with an argument of @samp{v} is equivalent to
21056 @samp{apply(gcd, v)}. The first argument specifies the operator name,
21057 and is either a variable whose name is the same as the function name,
21058 or a nameless function like @samp{<#^3+1>}. Operators that are normally
21059 written as algebraic symbols have the names @code{add}, @code{sub},
21060 @code{mul}, @code{div}, @code{pow}, @code{neg}, @code{mod}, and
21061 @code{vconcat}.
21062
21063 @ignore
21064 @starindex
21065 @end ignore
21066 @tindex call
21067 The @code{call} function builds a function call out of several arguments:
21068 @samp{call(gcd, x, y)} is the same as @samp{apply(gcd, [x, y])}, which
21069 in turn is the same as @samp{gcd(x, y)}. The first argument of @code{call},
21070 like the other functions described here, may be either a variable naming a
21071 function, or a nameless function (@samp{call(<#1+2#2>, x, y)} is the same
21072 as @samp{x + 2y}).
21073
21074 (Experts will notice that it's not quite proper to use a variable to name
21075 a function, since the name @code{gcd} corresponds to the Lisp variable
21076 @code{var-gcd} but to the Lisp function @code{calcFunc-gcd}. Calc
21077 automatically makes this translation, so you don't have to worry
21078 about it.)
21079
21080 @node Mapping, Reducing, Specifying Operators, Reducing and Mapping
21081 @subsection Mapping
21082
21083 @noindent
21084 @kindex v M
21085 @kindex V M
21086 @pindex calc-map
21087 @tindex map
21088 The @kbd{V M} (@code{calc-map}) [@code{map}] command applies a given
21089 operator elementwise to one or more vectors. For example, mapping
21090 @code{A} [@code{abs}] produces a vector of the absolute values of the
21091 elements in the input vector. Mapping @code{+} pops two vectors from
21092 the stack, which must be of equal length, and produces a vector of the
21093 pairwise sums of the elements. If either argument is a non-vector, it
21094 is duplicated for each element of the other vector. For example,
21095 @kbd{[1,2,3] 2 V M ^} squares the elements of the specified vector.
21096 With the 2 listed first, it would have computed a vector of powers of
21097 two. Mapping a user-defined function pops as many arguments from the
21098 stack as the function requires. If you give an undefined name, you will
21099 be prompted for the number of arguments to use.
21100
21101 If any argument to @kbd{V M} is a matrix, the operator is normally mapped
21102 across all elements of the matrix. For example, given the matrix
21103 @expr{[[1, -2, 3], [-4, 5, -6]]}, @kbd{V M A} takes six absolute values to
21104 produce another
21105 @texline @math{3\times2}
21106 @infoline 3x2
21107 matrix, @expr{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5, 6]]}.
21108
21109 @tindex mapr
21110 The command @kbd{V M _} [@code{mapr}] (i.e., type an underscore at the
21111 operator prompt) maps by rows instead. For example, @kbd{V M _ A} views
21112 the above matrix as a vector of two 3-element row vectors. It produces
21113 a new vector which contains the absolute values of those row vectors,
21114 namely @expr{[3.74, 8.77]}. (Recall, the absolute value of a vector is
21115 defined as the square root of the sum of the squares of the elements.)
21116 Some operators accept vectors and return new vectors; for example,
21117 @kbd{v v} reverses a vector, so @kbd{V M _ v v} would reverse each row
21118 of the matrix to get a new matrix, @expr{[[3, -2, 1], [-6, 5, -4]]}.
21119
21120 Sometimes a vector of vectors (representing, say, strings, sets, or lists)
21121 happens to look like a matrix. If so, remember to use @kbd{V M _} if you
21122 want to map a function across the whole strings or sets rather than across
21123 their individual elements.
21124
21125 @tindex mapc
21126 The command @kbd{V M :} [@code{mapc}] maps by columns. Basically, it
21127 transposes the input matrix, maps by rows, and then, if the result is a
21128 matrix, transposes again. For example, @kbd{V M : A} takes the absolute
21129 values of the three columns of the matrix, treating each as a 2-vector,
21130 and @kbd{V M : v v} reverses the columns to get the matrix
21131 @expr{[[-4, 5, -6], [1, -2, 3]]}.
21132
21133 (The symbols @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} were chosen because they had row-like
21134 and column-like appearances, and were not already taken by useful
21135 operators. Also, they appear shifted on most keyboards so they are easy
21136 to type after @kbd{V M}.)
21137
21138 The @kbd{_} and @kbd{:} modifiers have no effect on arguments that are
21139 not matrices (so if none of the arguments are matrices, they have no
21140 effect at all). If some of the arguments are matrices and others are
21141 plain numbers, the plain numbers are held constant for all rows of the
21142 matrix (so that @kbd{2 V M _ ^} squares every row of a matrix; squaring
21143 a vector takes a dot product of the vector with itself).
21144
21145 If some of the arguments are vectors with the same lengths as the
21146 rows (for @kbd{V M _}) or columns (for @kbd{V M :}) of the matrix
21147 arguments, those vectors are also held constant for every row or
21148 column.
21149
21150 Sometimes it is useful to specify another mapping command as the operator
21151 to use with @kbd{V M}. For example, @kbd{V M _ V A +} applies @kbd{V A +}
21152 to each row of the input matrix, which in turn adds the two values on that
21153 row. If you give another vector-operator command as the operator for
21154 @kbd{V M}, it automatically uses map-by-rows mode if you don't specify
21155 otherwise; thus @kbd{V M V A +} is equivalent to @kbd{V M _ V A +}. (If
21156 you really want to map-by-elements another mapping command, you can use
21157 a triple-nested mapping command: @kbd{V M V M V A +} means to map
21158 @kbd{V M V A +} over the rows of the matrix; in turn, @kbd{V A +} is
21159 mapped over the elements of each row.)
21160
21161 @tindex mapa
21162 @tindex mapd
21163 Previous versions of Calc had ``map across'' and ``map down'' modes
21164 that are now considered obsolete; the old ``map across'' is now simply
21165 @kbd{V M V A}, and ``map down'' is now @kbd{V M : V A}. The algebraic
21166 functions @code{mapa} and @code{mapd} are still supported, though.
21167 Note also that, while the old mapping modes were persistent (once you
21168 set the mode, it would apply to later mapping commands until you reset
21169 it), the new @kbd{:} and @kbd{_} modifiers apply only to the current
21170 mapping command. The default @kbd{V M} always means map-by-elements.
21171
21172 @xref{Algebraic Manipulation}, for the @kbd{a M} command, which is like
21173 @kbd{V M} but for equations and inequalities instead of vectors.
21174 @xref{Storing Variables}, for the @kbd{s m} command which modifies a
21175 variable's stored value using a @kbd{V M}-like operator.
21176
21177 @node Reducing, Nesting and Fixed Points, Mapping, Reducing and Mapping
21178 @subsection Reducing
21179
21180 @noindent
21181 @kindex v R
21182 @kindex V R
21183 @pindex calc-reduce
21184 @tindex reduce
21185 The @kbd{V R} (@code{calc-reduce}) [@code{reduce}] command applies a given
21186 binary operator across all the elements of a vector. A binary operator is
21187 a function such as @code{+} or @code{max} which takes two arguments. For
21188 example, reducing @code{+} over a vector computes the sum of the elements
21189 of the vector. Reducing @code{-} computes the first element minus each of
21190 the remaining elements. Reducing @code{max} computes the maximum element
21191 and so on. In general, reducing @code{f} over the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]}
21192 produces @samp{f(f(f(a, b), c), d)}.
21193
21194 @kindex I v R
21195 @kindex I V R
21196 @tindex rreduce
21197 The @kbd{I V R} [@code{rreduce}] command is similar to @kbd{V R} except
21198 that works from right to left through the vector. For example, plain
21199 @kbd{V R -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces @samp{a - b - c - d}
21200 but @kbd{I V R -} on the same vector produces @samp{a - (b - (c - d))},
21201 or @samp{a - b + c - d}. This ``alternating sum'' occurs frequently
21202 in power series expansions.
21203
21204 @kindex v U
21205 @kindex V U
21206 @tindex accum
21207 The @kbd{V U} (@code{calc-accumulate}) [@code{accum}] command does an
21208 accumulation operation. Here Calc does the corresponding reduction
21209 operation, but instead of producing only the final result, it produces
21210 a vector of all the intermediate results. Accumulating @code{+} over
21211 the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the vector
21212 @samp{[a, a + b, a + b + c, a + b + c + d]}.
21213
21214 @kindex I v U
21215 @kindex I V U
21216 @tindex raccum
21217 The @kbd{I V U} [@code{raccum}] command does a right-to-left accumulation.
21218 For example, @kbd{I V U -} on the vector @samp{[a, b, c, d]} produces the
21219 vector @samp{[a - b + c - d, b - c + d, c - d, d]}.
21220
21221 @tindex reducea
21222 @tindex rreducea
21223 @tindex reduced
21224 @tindex rreduced
21225 As for @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R} normally reduces a matrix elementwise. For
21226 example, given the matrix @expr{[[a, b, c], [d, e, f]]}, @kbd{V R +} will
21227 compute @expr{a + b + c + d + e + f}. You can type @kbd{V R _} or
21228 @kbd{V R :} to modify this behavior. The @kbd{V R _} [@code{reducea}]
21229 command reduces ``across'' the matrix; it reduces each row of the matrix
21230 as a vector, then collects the results. Thus @kbd{V R _ +} of this
21231 matrix would produce @expr{[a + b + c, d + e + f]}. Similarly, @kbd{V R :}
21232 [@code{reduced}] reduces down; @kbd{V R : +} would produce @expr{[a + d,
21233 b + e, c + f]}.
21234
21235 @tindex reducer
21236 @tindex rreducer
21237 There is a third ``by rows'' mode for reduction that is occasionally
21238 useful; @kbd{V R =} [@code{reducer}] simply reduces the operator over
21239 the rows of the matrix themselves. Thus @kbd{V R = +} on the above
21240 matrix would get the same result as @kbd{V R : +}, since adding two
21241 row vectors is equivalent to adding their elements. But @kbd{V R = *}
21242 would multiply the two rows (to get a single number, their dot product),
21243 while @kbd{V R : *} would produce a vector of the products of the columns.
21244
21245 These three matrix reduction modes work with @kbd{V R} and @kbd{I V R},
21246 but they are not currently supported with @kbd{V U} or @kbd{I V U}.
21247
21248 @tindex reducec
21249 @tindex rreducec
21250 The obsolete reduce-by-columns function, @code{reducec}, is still
21251 supported but there is no way to get it through the @kbd{V R} command.
21252
21253 The commands @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are equivalent to typing
21254 @kbd{C-x * r} to grab a rectangle of data into Calc, and then typing
21255 @kbd{V R : +} or @kbd{V R _ +}, respectively, to sum the columns or
21256 rows of the matrix. @xref{Grabbing From Buffers}.
21257
21258 @node Nesting and Fixed Points, Generalized Products, Reducing, Reducing and Mapping
21259 @subsection Nesting and Fixed Points
21260
21261 @noindent
21262 @kindex H v R
21263 @kindex H V R
21264 @tindex nest
21265 The @kbd{H V R} [@code{nest}] command applies a function to a given
21266 argument repeatedly. It takes two values, @samp{a} and @samp{n}, from
21267 the stack, where @samp{n} must be an integer. It then applies the
21268 function nested @samp{n} times; if the function is @samp{f} and @samp{n}
21269 is 3, the result is @samp{f(f(f(a)))}. The number @samp{n} may be
21270 negative if Calc knows an inverse for the function @samp{f}; for
21271 example, @samp{nest(sin, a, -2)} returns @samp{arcsin(arcsin(a))}.
21272
21273 @kindex H v U
21274 @kindex H V U
21275 @tindex anest
21276 The @kbd{H V U} [@code{anest}] command is an accumulating version of
21277 @code{nest}: It returns a vector of @samp{n+1} values, e.g.,
21278 @samp{[a, f(a), f(f(a)), f(f(f(a)))]}. If @samp{n} is negative and
21279 @samp{F} is the inverse of @samp{f}, then the result is of the
21280 form @samp{[a, F(a), F(F(a)), F(F(F(a)))]}.
21281
21282 @kindex H I v R
21283 @kindex H I V R
21284 @tindex fixp
21285 @cindex Fixed points
21286 The @kbd{H I V R} [@code{fixp}] command is like @kbd{H V R}, except
21287 that it takes only an @samp{a} value from the stack; the function is
21288 applied until it reaches a ``fixed point,'' i.e., until the result
21289 no longer changes.
21290
21291 @kindex H I v U
21292 @kindex H I V U
21293 @tindex afixp
21294 The @kbd{H I V U} [@code{afixp}] command is an accumulating @code{fixp}.
21295 The first element of the return vector will be the initial value @samp{a};
21296 the last element will be the final result that would have been returned
21297 by @code{fixp}.
21298
21299 For example, 0.739085 is a fixed point of the cosine function (in radians):
21300 @samp{cos(0.739085) = 0.739085}. You can find this value by putting, say,
21301 1.0 on the stack and typing @kbd{H I V U C}. (We use the accumulating
21302 version so we can see the intermediate results: @samp{[1, 0.540302, 0.857553,
21303 0.65329, ...]}. With a precision of six, this command will take 36 steps
21304 to converge to 0.739085.)
21305
21306 Newton's method for finding roots is a classic example of iteration
21307 to a fixed point. To find the square root of five starting with an
21308 initial guess, Newton's method would look for a fixed point of the
21309 function @samp{(x + 5/x) / 2}. Putting a guess of 1 on the stack
21310 and typing @kbd{H I V R ' ($ + 5/$)/2 @key{RET}} quickly yields the result
21311 2.23607. This is equivalent to using the @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root})
21312 command to find a root of the equation @samp{x^2 = 5}.
21313
21314 These examples used numbers for @samp{a} values. Calc keeps applying
21315 the function until two successive results are equal to within the
21316 current precision. For complex numbers, both the real parts and the
21317 imaginary parts must be equal to within the current precision. If
21318 @samp{a} is a formula (say, a variable name), then the function is
21319 applied until two successive results are exactly the same formula.
21320 It is up to you to ensure that the function will eventually converge;
21321 if it doesn't, you may have to press @kbd{C-g} to stop the Calculator.
21322
21323 The algebraic @code{fixp} function takes two optional arguments, @samp{n}
21324 and @samp{tol}. The first is the maximum number of steps to be allowed,
21325 and must be either an integer or the symbol @samp{inf} (infinity, the
21326 default). The second is a convergence tolerance. If a tolerance is
21327 specified, all results during the calculation must be numbers, not
21328 formulas, and the iteration stops when the magnitude of the difference
21329 between two successive results is less than or equal to the tolerance.
21330 (This implies that a tolerance of zero iterates until the results are
21331 exactly equal.)
21332
21333 Putting it all together, @samp{fixp(<(# + A/#)/2>, B, 20, 1e-10)}
21334 computes the square root of @samp{A} given the initial guess @samp{B},
21335 stopping when the result is correct within the specified tolerance, or
21336 when 20 steps have been taken, whichever is sooner.
21337
21338 @node Generalized Products, , Nesting and Fixed Points, Reducing and Mapping
21339 @subsection Generalized Products
21340
21341 @kindex v O
21342 @kindex V O
21343 @pindex calc-outer-product
21344 @tindex outer
21345 The @kbd{V O} (@code{calc-outer-product}) [@code{outer}] command applies
21346 a given binary operator to all possible pairs of elements from two
21347 vectors, to produce a matrix. For example, @kbd{V O *} with @samp{[a, b]}
21348 and @samp{[x, y, z]} on the stack produces a multiplication table:
21349 @samp{[[a x, a y, a z], [b x, b y, b z]]}. Element @var{r},@var{c} of
21350 the result matrix is obtained by applying the operator to element @var{r}
21351 of the lefthand vector and element @var{c} of the righthand vector.
21352
21353 @kindex v I
21354 @kindex V I
21355 @pindex calc-inner-product
21356 @tindex inner
21357 The @kbd{V I} (@code{calc-inner-product}) [@code{inner}] command computes
21358 the generalized inner product of two vectors or matrices, given a
21359 ``multiplicative'' operator and an ``additive'' operator. These can each
21360 actually be any binary operators; if they are @samp{*} and @samp{+},
21361 respectively, the result is a standard matrix multiplication. Element
21362 @var{r},@var{c} of the result matrix is obtained by mapping the
21363 multiplicative operator across row @var{r} of the lefthand matrix and
21364 column @var{c} of the righthand matrix, and then reducing with the additive
21365 operator. Just as for the standard @kbd{*} command, this can also do a
21366 vector-matrix or matrix-vector inner product, or a vector-vector
21367 generalized dot product.
21368
21369 Since @kbd{V I} requires two operators, it prompts twice. In each case,
21370 you can use any of the usual methods for entering the operator. If you
21371 use @kbd{$} twice to take both operator formulas from the stack, the
21372 first (multiplicative) operator is taken from the top of the stack
21373 and the second (additive) operator is taken from second-to-top.
21374
21375 @node Vector and Matrix Formats, , Reducing and Mapping, Matrix Functions
21376 @section Vector and Matrix Display Formats
21377
21378 @noindent
21379 Commands for controlling vector and matrix display use the @kbd{v} prefix
21380 instead of the usual @kbd{d} prefix. But they are display modes; in
21381 particular, they are influenced by the @kbd{I} and @kbd{H} prefix keys
21382 in the same way (@pxref{Display Modes}). Matrix display is also
21383 influenced by the @kbd{d O} (@code{calc-flat-language}) mode;
21384 @pxref{Normal Language Modes}.
21385
21386 @kindex v <
21387 @kindex V <
21388 @pindex calc-matrix-left-justify
21389 @kindex v =
21390 @kindex V =
21391 @pindex calc-matrix-center-justify
21392 @kindex v >
21393 @kindex V >
21394 @pindex calc-matrix-right-justify
21395 The commands @kbd{v <} (@code{calc-matrix-left-justify}), @kbd{v >}
21396 (@code{calc-matrix-right-justify}), and @w{@kbd{v =}}
21397 (@code{calc-matrix-center-justify}) control whether matrix elements
21398 are justified to the left, right, or center of their columns.
21399
21400 @kindex v [
21401 @kindex V [
21402 @pindex calc-vector-brackets
21403 @kindex v @{
21404 @kindex V @{
21405 @pindex calc-vector-braces
21406 @kindex v (
21407 @kindex V (
21408 @pindex calc-vector-parens
21409 The @kbd{v [} (@code{calc-vector-brackets}) command turns the square
21410 brackets that surround vectors and matrices displayed in the stack on
21411 and off. The @kbd{v @{} (@code{calc-vector-braces}) and @kbd{v (}
21412 (@code{calc-vector-parens}) commands use curly braces or parentheses,
21413 respectively, instead of square brackets. For example, @kbd{v @{} might
21414 be used in preparation for yanking a matrix into a buffer running
21415 Mathematica. (In fact, the Mathematica language mode uses this mode;
21416 @pxref{Mathematica Language Mode}.) Note that, regardless of the
21417 display mode, either brackets or braces may be used to enter vectors,
21418 and parentheses may never be used for this purpose.
21419
21420 @kindex V ]
21421 @kindex v ]
21422 @kindex V )
21423 @kindex v )
21424 @kindex V @}
21425 @kindex v @}
21426 @pindex calc-matrix-brackets
21427 The @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) command controls the
21428 ``big'' style display of matrices, for matrices which have more than
21429 one row. It prompts for a string of code letters; currently
21430 implemented letters are @code{R}, which enables brackets on each row
21431 of the matrix; @code{O}, which enables outer brackets in opposite
21432 corners of the matrix; and @code{C}, which enables commas or
21433 semicolons at the ends of all rows but the last. The default format
21434 is @samp{RO}. (Before Calc 2.00, the format was fixed at @samp{ROC}.)
21435 Here are some example matrices:
21436
21437 @example
21438 @group
21439 [ [ 123, 0, 0 ] [ [ 123, 0, 0 ],
21440 [ 0, 123, 0 ] [ 0, 123, 0 ],
21441 [ 0, 0, 123 ] ] [ 0, 0, 123 ] ]
21442
21443 RO ROC
21444
21445 @end group
21446 @end example
21447 @noindent
21448 @example
21449 @group
21450 [ 123, 0, 0 [ 123, 0, 0 ;
21451 0, 123, 0 0, 123, 0 ;
21452 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123 ]
21453
21454 O OC
21455
21456 @end group
21457 @end example
21458 @noindent
21459 @example
21460 @group
21461 [ 123, 0, 0 ] 123, 0, 0
21462 [ 0, 123, 0 ] 0, 123, 0
21463 [ 0, 0, 123 ] 0, 0, 123
21464
21465 R @r{blank}
21466 @end group
21467 @end example
21468
21469 @noindent
21470 Note that of the formats shown here, @samp{RO}, @samp{ROC}, and
21471 @samp{OC} are all recognized as matrices during reading, while
21472 the others are useful for display only.
21473
21474 @kindex v ,
21475 @kindex V ,
21476 @pindex calc-vector-commas
21477 The @kbd{v ,} (@code{calc-vector-commas}) command turns commas on and
21478 off in vector and matrix display.
21479
21480 In vectors of length one, and in all vectors when commas have been
21481 turned off, Calc adds extra parentheses around formulas that might
21482 otherwise be ambiguous. For example, @samp{[a b]} could be a vector
21483 of the one formula @samp{a b}, or it could be a vector of two
21484 variables with commas turned off. Calc will display the former
21485 case as @samp{[(a b)]}. You can disable these extra parentheses
21486 (to make the output less cluttered at the expense of allowing some
21487 ambiguity) by adding the letter @code{P} to the control string you
21488 give to @kbd{v ]} (as described above).
21489
21490 @kindex v .
21491 @kindex V .
21492 @pindex calc-full-vectors
21493 The @kbd{v .} (@code{calc-full-vectors}) command turns abbreviated
21494 display of long vectors on and off. In this mode, vectors of six
21495 or more elements, or matrices of six or more rows or columns, will
21496 be displayed in an abbreviated form that displays only the first
21497 three elements and the last element: @samp{[a, b, c, ..., z]}.
21498 When very large vectors are involved this will substantially
21499 improve Calc's display speed.
21500
21501 @kindex t .
21502 @pindex calc-full-trail-vectors
21503 The @kbd{t .} (@code{calc-full-trail-vectors}) command controls a
21504 similar mode for recording vectors in the Trail. If you turn on
21505 this mode, vectors of six or more elements and matrices of six or
21506 more rows or columns will be abbreviated when they are put in the
21507 Trail. The @kbd{t y} (@code{calc-trail-yank}) command will be
21508 unable to recover those vectors. If you are working with very
21509 large vectors, this mode will improve the speed of all operations
21510 that involve the trail.
21511
21512 @kindex v /
21513 @kindex V /
21514 @pindex calc-break-vectors
21515 The @kbd{v /} (@code{calc-break-vectors}) command turns multi-line
21516 vector display on and off. Normally, matrices are displayed with one
21517 row per line but all other types of vectors are displayed in a single
21518 line. This mode causes all vectors, whether matrices or not, to be
21519 displayed with a single element per line. Sub-vectors within the
21520 vectors will still use the normal linear form.
21521
21522 @node Algebra, Units, Matrix Functions, Top
21523 @chapter Algebra
21524
21525 @noindent
21526 This section covers the Calc features that help you work with
21527 algebraic formulas. First, the general sub-formula selection
21528 mechanism is described; this works in conjunction with any Calc
21529 commands. Then, commands for specific algebraic operations are
21530 described. Finally, the flexible @dfn{rewrite rule} mechanism
21531 is discussed.
21532
21533 The algebraic commands use the @kbd{a} key prefix; selection
21534 commands use the @kbd{j} (for ``just a letter that wasn't used
21535 for anything else'') prefix.
21536
21537 @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, to see how to manipulate formulas
21538 using regular Emacs editing commands.
21539
21540 When doing algebraic work, you may find several of the Calculator's
21541 modes to be helpful, including Algebraic Simplification mode (@kbd{m A})
21542 or No-Simplification mode (@kbd{m O}),
21543 Algebraic entry mode (@kbd{m a}), Fraction mode (@kbd{m f}), and
21544 Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}). @xref{Mode Settings}, for discussions
21545 of these modes. You may also wish to select Big display mode (@kbd{d B}).
21546 @xref{Normal Language Modes}.
21547
21548 @menu
21549 * Selecting Subformulas::
21550 * Algebraic Manipulation::
21551 * Simplifying Formulas::
21552 * Polynomials::
21553 * Calculus::
21554 * Solving Equations::
21555 * Numerical Solutions::
21556 * Curve Fitting::
21557 * Summations::
21558 * Logical Operations::
21559 * Rewrite Rules::
21560 @end menu
21561
21562 @node Selecting Subformulas, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra, Algebra
21563 @section Selecting Sub-Formulas
21564
21565 @noindent
21566 @cindex Selections
21567 @cindex Sub-formulas
21568 @cindex Parts of formulas
21569 When working with an algebraic formula it is often necessary to
21570 manipulate a portion of the formula rather than the formula as a
21571 whole. Calc allows you to ``select'' a portion of any formula on
21572 the stack. Commands which would normally operate on that stack
21573 entry will now operate only on the sub-formula, leaving the
21574 surrounding part of the stack entry alone.
21575
21576 One common non-algebraic use for selection involves vectors. To work
21577 on one element of a vector in-place, simply select that element as a
21578 ``sub-formula'' of the vector.
21579
21580 @menu
21581 * Making Selections::
21582 * Changing Selections::
21583 * Displaying Selections::
21584 * Operating on Selections::
21585 * Rearranging with Selections::
21586 @end menu
21587
21588 @node Making Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas, Selecting Subformulas
21589 @subsection Making Selections
21590
21591 @noindent
21592 @kindex j s
21593 @pindex calc-select-here
21594 To select a sub-formula, move the Emacs cursor to any character in that
21595 sub-formula, and press @w{@kbd{j s}} (@code{calc-select-here}). Calc will
21596 highlight the smallest portion of the formula that contains that
21597 character. By default the sub-formula is highlighted by blanking out
21598 all of the rest of the formula with dots. Selection works in any
21599 display mode but is perhaps easiest in Big mode (@kbd{d B}).
21600 Suppose you enter the following formula:
21601
21602 @smallexample
21603 @group
21604 3 ___
21605 (a + b) + V c
21606 1: ---------------
21607 2 x + 1
21608 @end group
21609 @end smallexample
21610
21611 @noindent
21612 (by typing @kbd{' ((a+b)^3 + sqrt(c)) / (2x+1)}). If you move the
21613 cursor to the letter @samp{b} and press @w{@kbd{j s}}, the display changes
21614 to
21615
21616 @smallexample
21617 @group
21618 . ...
21619 .. . b. . . .
21620 1* ...............
21621 . . . .
21622 @end group
21623 @end smallexample
21624
21625 @noindent
21626 Every character not part of the sub-formula @samp{b} has been changed
21627 to a dot. (If the customizable variable
21628 @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is non-@code{nil}, then the characters
21629 not part of the sub-formula are de-emphasized by using a less
21630 noticeable face instead of using dots. @pxref{Displaying Selections}.)
21631 The @samp{*} next to the line number is to remind you that
21632 the formula has a portion of it selected. (In this case, it's very
21633 obvious, but it might not always be. If Embedded mode is enabled,
21634 the word @samp{Sel} also appears in the mode line because the stack
21635 may not be visible. @pxref{Embedded Mode}.)
21636
21637 If you had instead placed the cursor on the parenthesis immediately to
21638 the right of the @samp{b}, the selection would have been:
21639
21640 @smallexample
21641 @group
21642 . ...
21643 (a + b) . . .
21644 1* ...............
21645 . . . .
21646 @end group
21647 @end smallexample
21648
21649 @noindent
21650 The portion selected is always large enough to be considered a complete
21651 formula all by itself, so selecting the parenthesis selects the whole
21652 formula that it encloses. Putting the cursor on the @samp{+} sign
21653 would have had the same effect.
21654
21655 (Strictly speaking, the Emacs cursor is really the manifestation of
21656 the Emacs ``point,'' which is a position @emph{between} two characters
21657 in the buffer. So purists would say that Calc selects the smallest
21658 sub-formula which contains the character to the right of ``point.'')
21659
21660 If you supply a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, the selection is
21661 expanded to the @var{n}th enclosing sub-formula. Thus, positioning
21662 the cursor on the @samp{b} and typing @kbd{C-u 1 j s} will select
21663 @samp{a + b}; typing @kbd{C-u 2 j s} will select @samp{(a + b)^3},
21664 and so on.
21665
21666 If the cursor is not on any part of the formula, or if you give a
21667 numeric prefix that is too large, the entire formula is selected.
21668
21669 If the cursor is on the @samp{.} line that marks the top of the stack
21670 (i.e., its normal ``rest position''), this command selects the entire
21671 formula at stack level 1. Most selection commands similarly operate
21672 on the formula at the top of the stack if you haven't positioned the
21673 cursor on any stack entry.
21674
21675 @kindex j a
21676 @pindex calc-select-additional
21677 The @kbd{j a} (@code{calc-select-additional}) command enlarges the
21678 current selection to encompass the cursor. To select the smallest
21679 sub-formula defined by two different points, move to the first and
21680 press @kbd{j s}, then move to the other and press @kbd{j a}. This
21681 is roughly analogous to using @kbd{C-@@} (@code{set-mark-command}) to
21682 select the two ends of a region of text during normal Emacs editing.
21683
21684 @kindex j o
21685 @pindex calc-select-once
21686 The @kbd{j o} (@code{calc-select-once}) command selects a formula in
21687 exactly the same way as @kbd{j s}, except that the selection will
21688 last only as long as the next command that uses it. For example,
21689 @kbd{j o 1 +} is a handy way to add one to the sub-formula indicated
21690 by the cursor.
21691
21692 (A somewhat more precise definition: The @kbd{j o} command sets a flag
21693 such that the next command involving selected stack entries will clear
21694 the selections on those stack entries afterwards. All other selection
21695 commands except @kbd{j a} and @kbd{j O} clear this flag.)
21696
21697 @kindex j S
21698 @kindex j O
21699 @pindex calc-select-here-maybe
21700 @pindex calc-select-once-maybe
21701 The @kbd{j S} (@code{calc-select-here-maybe}) and @kbd{j O}
21702 (@code{calc-select-once-maybe}) commands are equivalent to @kbd{j s}
21703 and @kbd{j o}, respectively, except that if the formula already
21704 has a selection they have no effect. This is analogous to the
21705 behavior of some commands such as @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection};
21706 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}) and is mainly intended to be
21707 used in keyboard macros that implement your own selection-oriented
21708 commands.
21709
21710 Selection of sub-formulas normally treats associative terms like
21711 @samp{a + b - c + d} and @samp{x * y * z} as single levels of the formula.
21712 If you place the cursor anywhere inside @samp{a + b - c + d} except
21713 on one of the variable names and use @kbd{j s}, you will select the
21714 entire four-term sum.
21715
21716 @kindex j b
21717 @pindex calc-break-selections
21718 The @kbd{j b} (@code{calc-break-selections}) command controls a mode
21719 in which the ``deep structure'' of these associative formulas shows
21720 through. Calc actually stores the above formulas as
21721 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d} and @samp{x * (y * z)}. (Note that for certain
21722 obscure reasons, by default Calc treats multiplication as
21723 right-associative.) Once you have enabled @kbd{j b} mode, selecting
21724 with the cursor on the @samp{-} sign would only select the @samp{a + b -
21725 c} portion, which makes sense when the deep structure of the sum is
21726 considered. There is no way to select the @samp{b - c + d} portion;
21727 although this might initially look like just as legitimate a sub-formula
21728 as @samp{a + b - c}, the deep structure shows that it isn't. The @kbd{d
21729 U} command can be used to view the deep structure of any formula
21730 (@pxref{Normal Language Modes}).
21731
21732 When @kbd{j b} mode has not been enabled, the deep structure is
21733 generally hidden by the selection commands---what you see is what
21734 you get.
21735
21736 @kindex j u
21737 @pindex calc-unselect
21738 The @kbd{j u} (@code{calc-unselect}) command unselects the formula
21739 that the cursor is on. If there was no selection in the formula,
21740 this command has no effect. With a numeric prefix argument, it
21741 unselects the @var{n}th stack element rather than using the cursor
21742 position.
21743
21744 @kindex j c
21745 @pindex calc-clear-selections
21746 The @kbd{j c} (@code{calc-clear-selections}) command unselects all
21747 stack elements.
21748
21749 @node Changing Selections, Displaying Selections, Making Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21750 @subsection Changing Selections
21751
21752 @noindent
21753 @kindex j m
21754 @pindex calc-select-more
21755 Once you have selected a sub-formula, you can expand it using the
21756 @w{@kbd{j m}} (@code{calc-select-more}) command. If @samp{a + b} is
21757 selected, pressing @w{@kbd{j m}} repeatedly works as follows:
21758
21759 @smallexample
21760 @group
21761 3 ... 3 ___ 3 ___
21762 (a + b) . . . (a + b) + V c (a + b) + V c
21763 1* ............... 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21764 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21765 @end group
21766 @end smallexample
21767
21768 @noindent
21769 In the last example, the entire formula is selected. This is roughly
21770 the same as having no selection at all, but because there are subtle
21771 differences the @samp{*} character is still there on the line number.
21772
21773 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, @kbd{j m} expands @var{n}
21774 times (or until the entire formula is selected). Note that @kbd{j s}
21775 with argument @var{n} is equivalent to plain @kbd{j s} followed by
21776 @kbd{j m} with argument @var{n}. If @w{@kbd{j m}} is used when there
21777 is no current selection, it is equivalent to @w{@kbd{j s}}.
21778
21779 Even though @kbd{j m} does not explicitly use the location of the
21780 cursor within the formula, it nevertheless uses the cursor to determine
21781 which stack element to operate on. As usual, @kbd{j m} when the cursor
21782 is not on any stack element operates on the top stack element.
21783
21784 @kindex j l
21785 @pindex calc-select-less
21786 The @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) command reduces the current
21787 selection around the cursor position. That is, it selects the
21788 immediate sub-formula of the current selection which contains the
21789 cursor, the opposite of @kbd{j m}. If the cursor is not inside the
21790 current selection, the command de-selects the formula.
21791
21792 @kindex j 1-9
21793 @pindex calc-select-part
21794 The @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} (@code{calc-select-part}) commands
21795 select the @var{n}th sub-formula of the current selection. They are
21796 like @kbd{j l} (@code{calc-select-less}) except they use counting
21797 rather than the cursor position to decide which sub-formula to select.
21798 For example, if the current selection is @kbd{a + b + c} or
21799 @kbd{f(a, b, c)} or @kbd{[a, b, c]}, then @kbd{j 1} selects @samp{a},
21800 @kbd{j 2} selects @samp{b}, and @kbd{j 3} selects @samp{c}; in each of
21801 these cases, @kbd{j 4} through @kbd{j 9} would be errors.
21802
21803 If there is no current selection, @kbd{j 1} through @kbd{j 9} select
21804 the @var{n}th top-level sub-formula. (In other words, they act as if
21805 the entire stack entry were selected first.) To select the @var{n}th
21806 sub-formula where @var{n} is greater than nine, you must instead invoke
21807 @w{@kbd{j 1}} with @var{n} as a numeric prefix argument.
21808
21809 @kindex j n
21810 @kindex j p
21811 @pindex calc-select-next
21812 @pindex calc-select-previous
21813 The @kbd{j n} (@code{calc-select-next}) and @kbd{j p}
21814 (@code{calc-select-previous}) commands change the current selection
21815 to the next or previous sub-formula at the same level. For example,
21816 if @samp{b} is selected in @w{@samp{2 + a*b*c + x}}, then @kbd{j n}
21817 selects @samp{c}. Further @kbd{j n} commands would be in error because,
21818 even though there is something to the right of @samp{c} (namely, @samp{x}),
21819 it is not at the same level; in this case, it is not a term of the
21820 same product as @samp{b} and @samp{c}. However, @kbd{j m} (to select
21821 the whole product @samp{a*b*c} as a term of the sum) followed by
21822 @w{@kbd{j n}} would successfully select the @samp{x}.
21823
21824 Similarly, @kbd{j p} moves the selection from the @samp{b} in this
21825 sample formula to the @samp{a}. Both commands accept numeric prefix
21826 arguments to move several steps at a time.
21827
21828 It is interesting to compare Calc's selection commands with the
21829 Emacs Info system's commands for navigating through hierarchically
21830 organized documentation. Calc's @kbd{j n} command is completely
21831 analogous to Info's @kbd{n} command. Likewise, @kbd{j p} maps to
21832 @kbd{p}, @kbd{j 2} maps to @kbd{2}, and Info's @kbd{u} is like @kbd{j m}.
21833 (Note that @kbd{j u} stands for @code{calc-unselect}, not ``up''.)
21834 The Info @kbd{m} command is somewhat similar to Calc's @kbd{j s} and
21835 @kbd{j l}; in each case, you can jump directly to a sub-component
21836 of the hierarchy simply by pointing to it with the cursor.
21837
21838 @node Displaying Selections, Operating on Selections, Changing Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21839 @subsection Displaying Selections
21840
21841 @noindent
21842 @kindex j d
21843 @pindex calc-show-selections
21844 @vindex calc-highlight-selections-with-faces
21845 @vindex calc-selected-face
21846 @vindex calc-nonselected-face
21847 The @kbd{j d} (@code{calc-show-selections}) command controls how
21848 selected sub-formulas are displayed. One of the alternatives is
21849 illustrated in the above examples; if we press @kbd{j d} we switch
21850 to the other style in which the selected portion itself is obscured
21851 by @samp{#} signs:
21852
21853 @smallexample
21854 @group
21855 3 ... # ___
21856 (a + b) . . . ## # ## + V c
21857 1* ............... 1* ---------------
21858 . . . . 2 x + 1
21859 @end group
21860 @end smallexample
21861 If the customizable variable
21862 @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is non-@code{nil}, then the
21863 non-selected portion of the formula will be de-emphasized by using a
21864 less noticeable face (@code{calc-nonselected-face}) instead of dots
21865 and the selected sub-formula will be highlighted by using a more
21866 noticeable face (@code{calc-selected-face}) instead of @samp{#}
21867 signs. (@pxref{Customizing Calc}.)
21868
21869 @node Operating on Selections, Rearranging with Selections, Displaying Selections, Selecting Subformulas
21870 @subsection Operating on Selections
21871
21872 @noindent
21873 Once a selection is made, all Calc commands that manipulate items
21874 on the stack will operate on the selected portions of the items
21875 instead. (Note that several stack elements may have selections
21876 at once, though there can be only one selection at a time in any
21877 given stack element.)
21878
21879 @kindex j e
21880 @pindex calc-enable-selections
21881 The @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command disables the
21882 effect that selections have on Calc commands. The current selections
21883 still exist, but Calc commands operate on whole stack elements anyway.
21884 This mode can be identified by the fact that the @samp{*} markers on
21885 the line numbers are gone, even though selections are visible. To
21886 reactivate the selections, press @kbd{j e} again.
21887
21888 To extract a sub-formula as a new formula, simply select the
21889 sub-formula and press @key{RET}. This normally duplicates the top
21890 stack element; here it duplicates only the selected portion of that
21891 element.
21892
21893 To replace a sub-formula with something different, you can enter the
21894 new value onto the stack and press @key{TAB}. This normally exchanges
21895 the top two stack elements; here it swaps the value you entered into
21896 the selected portion of the formula, returning the old selected
21897 portion to the top of the stack.
21898
21899 @smallexample
21900 @group
21901 3 ... ... ___
21902 (a + b) . . . 17 x y . . . 17 x y + V c
21903 2* ............... 2* ............. 2: -------------
21904 . . . . . . . . 2 x + 1
21905
21906 3 3
21907 1: 17 x y 1: (a + b) 1: (a + b)
21908 @end group
21909 @end smallexample
21910
21911 In this example we select a sub-formula of our original example,
21912 enter a new formula, @key{TAB} it into place, then deselect to see
21913 the complete, edited formula.
21914
21915 If you want to swap whole formulas around even though they contain
21916 selections, just use @kbd{j e} before and after.
21917
21918 @kindex j '
21919 @pindex calc-enter-selection
21920 The @kbd{j '} (@code{calc-enter-selection}) command is another way
21921 to replace a selected sub-formula. This command does an algebraic
21922 entry just like the regular @kbd{'} key. When you press @key{RET},
21923 the formula you type replaces the original selection. You can use
21924 the @samp{$} symbol in the formula to refer to the original
21925 selection. If there is no selection in the formula under the cursor,
21926 the cursor is used to make a temporary selection for the purposes of
21927 the command. Thus, to change a term of a formula, all you have to
21928 do is move the Emacs cursor to that term and press @kbd{j '}.
21929
21930 @kindex j `
21931 @pindex calc-edit-selection
21932 The @kbd{j `} (@code{calc-edit-selection}) command is a similar
21933 analogue of the @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}) command. It edits the
21934 selected sub-formula in a separate buffer. If there is no
21935 selection, it edits the sub-formula indicated by the cursor.
21936
21937 To delete a sub-formula, press @key{DEL}. This generally replaces
21938 the sub-formula with the constant zero, but in a few suitable contexts
21939 it uses the constant one instead. The @key{DEL} key automatically
21940 deselects and re-simplifies the entire formula afterwards. Thus:
21941
21942 @smallexample
21943 @group
21944 ###
21945 17 x y + # # 17 x y 17 # y 17 y
21946 1* ------------- 1: ------- 1* ------- 1: -------
21947 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1 2 x + 1
21948 @end group
21949 @end smallexample
21950
21951 In this example, we first delete the @samp{sqrt(c)} term; Calc
21952 accomplishes this by replacing @samp{sqrt(c)} with zero and
21953 resimplifying. We then delete the @kbd{x} in the numerator;
21954 since this is part of a product, Calc replaces it with @samp{1}
21955 and resimplifies.
21956
21957 If you select an element of a vector and press @key{DEL}, that
21958 element is deleted from the vector. If you delete one side of
21959 an equation or inequality, only the opposite side remains.
21960
21961 @kindex j @key{DEL}
21962 @pindex calc-del-selection
21963 The @kbd{j @key{DEL}} (@code{calc-del-selection}) command is like
21964 @key{DEL} but with the auto-selecting behavior of @kbd{j '} and
21965 @kbd{j `}. It deletes the selected portion of the formula
21966 indicated by the cursor, or, in the absence of a selection, it
21967 deletes the sub-formula indicated by the cursor position.
21968
21969 @kindex j @key{RET}
21970 @pindex calc-grab-selection
21971 (There is also an auto-selecting @kbd{j @key{RET}} (@code{calc-copy-selection})
21972 command.)
21973
21974 Normal arithmetic operations also apply to sub-formulas. Here we
21975 select the denominator, press @kbd{5 -} to subtract five from the
21976 denominator, press @kbd{n} to negate the denominator, then
21977 press @kbd{Q} to take the square root.
21978
21979 @smallexample
21980 @group
21981 .. . .. . .. . .. .
21982 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ....... 1* ..........
21983 2 x + 1 2 x - 4 4 - 2 x _________
21984 V 4 - 2 x
21985 @end group
21986 @end smallexample
21987
21988 Certain types of operations on selections are not allowed. For
21989 example, for an arithmetic function like @kbd{-} no more than one of
21990 the arguments may be a selected sub-formula. (As the above example
21991 shows, the result of the subtraction is spliced back into the argument
21992 which had the selection; if there were more than one selection involved,
21993 this would not be well-defined.) If you try to subtract two selections,
21994 the command will abort with an error message.
21995
21996 Operations on sub-formulas sometimes leave the formula as a whole
21997 in an ``un-natural'' state. Consider negating the @samp{2 x} term
21998 of our sample formula by selecting it and pressing @kbd{n}
21999 (@code{calc-change-sign}).
22000
22001 @smallexample
22002 @group
22003 .. . .. .
22004 1* .......... 1* ...........
22005 ......... ..........
22006 . . . 2 x . . . -2 x
22007 @end group
22008 @end smallexample
22009
22010 Unselecting the sub-formula reveals that the minus sign, which would
22011 normally have canceled out with the subtraction automatically, has
22012 not been able to do so because the subtraction was not part of the
22013 selected portion. Pressing @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}) or doing
22014 any other mathematical operation on the whole formula will cause it
22015 to be simplified.
22016
22017 @smallexample
22018 @group
22019 17 y 17 y
22020 1: ----------- 1: ----------
22021 __________ _________
22022 V 4 - -2 x V 4 + 2 x
22023 @end group
22024 @end smallexample
22025
22026 @node Rearranging with Selections, , Operating on Selections, Selecting Subformulas
22027 @subsection Rearranging Formulas using Selections
22028
22029 @noindent
22030 @kindex j R
22031 @pindex calc-commute-right
22032 The @kbd{j R} (@code{calc-commute-right}) command moves the selected
22033 sub-formula to the right in its surrounding formula. Generally the
22034 selection is one term of a sum or product; the sum or product is
22035 rearranged according to the commutative laws of algebra.
22036
22037 As with @kbd{j '} and @kbd{j @key{DEL}}, the term under the cursor is used
22038 if there is no selection in the current formula. All commands described
22039 in this section share this property. In this example, we place the
22040 cursor on the @samp{a} and type @kbd{j R}, then repeat.
22041
22042 @smallexample
22043 1: a + b - c 1: b + a - c 1: b - c + a
22044 @end smallexample
22045
22046 @noindent
22047 Note that in the final step above, the @samp{a} is switched with
22048 the @samp{c} but the signs are adjusted accordingly. When moving
22049 terms of sums and products, @kbd{j R} will never change the
22050 mathematical meaning of the formula.
22051
22052 The selected term may also be an element of a vector or an argument
22053 of a function. The term is exchanged with the one to its right.
22054 In this case, the ``meaning'' of the vector or function may of
22055 course be drastically changed.
22056
22057 @smallexample
22058 1: [a, b, c] 1: [b, a, c] 1: [b, c, a]
22059
22060 1: f(a, b, c) 1: f(b, a, c) 1: f(b, c, a)
22061 @end smallexample
22062
22063 @kindex j L
22064 @pindex calc-commute-left
22065 The @kbd{j L} (@code{calc-commute-left}) command is like @kbd{j R}
22066 except that it swaps the selected term with the one to its left.
22067
22068 With numeric prefix arguments, these commands move the selected
22069 term several steps at a time. It is an error to try to move a
22070 term left or right past the end of its enclosing formula.
22071 With numeric prefix arguments of zero, these commands move the
22072 selected term as far as possible in the given direction.
22073
22074 @kindex j D
22075 @pindex calc-sel-distribute
22076 The @kbd{j D} (@code{calc-sel-distribute}) command mixes the selected
22077 sum or product into the surrounding formula using the distributive
22078 law. For example, in @samp{a * (b - c)} with the @samp{b - c}
22079 selected, the result is @samp{a b - a c}. This also distributes
22080 products or quotients into surrounding powers, and can also do
22081 transformations like @samp{exp(a + b)} to @samp{exp(a) exp(b)},
22082 where @samp{a + b} is the selected term, and @samp{ln(a ^ b)}
22083 to @samp{ln(a) b}, where @samp{a ^ b} is the selected term.
22084
22085 For multiple-term sums or products, @kbd{j D} takes off one term
22086 at a time: @samp{a * (b + c - d)} goes to @samp{a * (c - d) + a b}
22087 with the @samp{c - d} selected so that you can type @kbd{j D}
22088 repeatedly to expand completely. The @kbd{j D} command allows a
22089 numeric prefix argument which specifies the maximum number of
22090 times to expand at once; the default is one time only.
22091
22092 @vindex DistribRules
22093 The @kbd{j D} command is implemented using rewrite rules.
22094 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}. The rules are stored in
22095 the Calc variable @code{DistribRules}. A convenient way to view
22096 these rules is to use @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) which
22097 displays and edits the stored value of a variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c}
22098 to return from editing mode; be careful not to make any actual changes
22099 or else you will affect the behavior of future @kbd{j D} commands!
22100
22101 To extend @kbd{j D} to handle new cases, just edit @code{DistribRules}
22102 as described above. You can then use the @kbd{s p} command to save
22103 this variable's value permanently for future Calc sessions.
22104 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
22105
22106 @kindex j M
22107 @pindex calc-sel-merge
22108 @vindex MergeRules
22109 The @kbd{j M} (@code{calc-sel-merge}) command is the complement
22110 of @kbd{j D}; given @samp{a b - a c} with either @samp{a b} or
22111 @samp{a c} selected, the result is @samp{a * (b - c)}. Once
22112 again, @kbd{j M} can also merge calls to functions like @code{exp}
22113 and @code{ln}; examine the variable @code{MergeRules} to see all
22114 the relevant rules.
22115
22116 @kindex j C
22117 @pindex calc-sel-commute
22118 @vindex CommuteRules
22119 The @kbd{j C} (@code{calc-sel-commute}) command swaps the arguments
22120 of the selected sum, product, or equation. It always behaves as
22121 if @kbd{j b} mode were in effect, i.e., the sum @samp{a + b + c} is
22122 treated as the nested sums @samp{(a + b) + c} by this command.
22123 If you put the cursor on the first @samp{+}, the result is
22124 @samp{(b + a) + c}; if you put the cursor on the second @samp{+}, the
22125 result is @samp{c + (a + b)} (which the default simplifications
22126 will rearrange to @samp{(c + a) + b}). The relevant rules are stored
22127 in the variable @code{CommuteRules}.
22128
22129 You may need to turn default simplifications off (with the @kbd{m O}
22130 command) in order to get the full benefit of @kbd{j C}. For example,
22131 commuting @samp{a - b} produces @samp{-b + a}, but the default
22132 simplifications will ``simplify'' this right back to @samp{a - b} if
22133 you don't turn them off. The same is true of some of the other
22134 manipulations described in this section.
22135
22136 @kindex j N
22137 @pindex calc-sel-negate
22138 @vindex NegateRules
22139 The @kbd{j N} (@code{calc-sel-negate}) command replaces the selected
22140 term with the negative of that term, then adjusts the surrounding
22141 formula in order to preserve the meaning. For example, given
22142 @samp{exp(a - b)} where @samp{a - b} is selected, the result is
22143 @samp{1 / exp(b - a)}. By contrast, selecting a term and using the
22144 regular @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}) command negates the
22145 term without adjusting the surroundings, thus changing the meaning
22146 of the formula as a whole. The rules variable is @code{NegateRules}.
22147
22148 @kindex j &
22149 @pindex calc-sel-invert
22150 @vindex InvertRules
22151 The @kbd{j &} (@code{calc-sel-invert}) command is similar to @kbd{j N}
22152 except it takes the reciprocal of the selected term. For example,
22153 given @samp{a - ln(b)} with @samp{b} selected, the result is
22154 @samp{a + ln(1/b)}. The rules variable is @code{InvertRules}.
22155
22156 @kindex j E
22157 @pindex calc-sel-jump-equals
22158 @vindex JumpRules
22159 The @kbd{j E} (@code{calc-sel-jump-equals}) command moves the
22160 selected term from one side of an equation to the other. Given
22161 @samp{a + b = c + d} with @samp{c} selected, the result is
22162 @samp{a + b - c = d}. This command also works if the selected
22163 term is part of a @samp{*}, @samp{/}, or @samp{^} formula. The
22164 relevant rules variable is @code{JumpRules}.
22165
22166 @kindex j I
22167 @kindex H j I
22168 @pindex calc-sel-isolate
22169 The @kbd{j I} (@code{calc-sel-isolate}) command isolates the
22170 selected term on its side of an equation. It uses the @kbd{a S}
22171 (@code{calc-solve-for}) command to solve the equation, and the
22172 Hyperbolic flag affects it in the same way. @xref{Solving Equations}.
22173 When it applies, @kbd{j I} is often easier to use than @kbd{j E}.
22174 It understands more rules of algebra, and works for inequalities
22175 as well as equations.
22176
22177 @kindex j *
22178 @kindex j /
22179 @pindex calc-sel-mult-both-sides
22180 @pindex calc-sel-div-both-sides
22181 The @kbd{j *} (@code{calc-sel-mult-both-sides}) command prompts for a
22182 formula using algebraic entry, then multiplies both sides of the
22183 selected quotient or equation by that formula. It performs the
22184 default algebraic simplifications before re-forming the
22185 quotient or equation. You can suppress this simplification by
22186 providing a prefix argument: @kbd{C-u j *}. There is also a @kbd{j /}
22187 (@code{calc-sel-div-both-sides}) which is similar to @kbd{j *} but
22188 dividing instead of multiplying by the factor you enter.
22189
22190 If the selection is a quotient with numerator 1, then Calc's default
22191 simplifications would normally cancel the new factors. To prevent
22192 this, when the @kbd{j *} command is used on a selection whose numerator is
22193 1 or -1, the denominator is expanded at the top level using the
22194 distributive law (as if using the @kbd{C-u 1 a x} command). Suppose the
22195 formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (a + 1)} and you wish to multiplying the
22196 top and bottom by @samp{a - 1}. Calc's default simplifications would
22197 normally change the result @samp{(a - 1) /(a + 1) (a - 1)} back
22198 to the original form by cancellation; when @kbd{j *} is used, Calc
22199 expands the denominator to @samp{a (a - 1) + a - 1} to prevent this.
22200
22201 If you wish the @kbd{j *} command to completely expand the denominator
22202 of a quotient you can call it with a zero prefix: @kbd{C-u 0 j *}. For
22203 example, if the formula on the stack is @samp{1 / (sqrt(a) + 1)}, you may
22204 wish to eliminate the square root in the denominator by multiplying
22205 the top and bottom by @samp{sqrt(a) - 1}. If you did this simply by using
22206 a simple @kbd{j *} command, you would get
22207 @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/ (sqrt(a) (sqrt(a) - 1) + sqrt(a) - 1)}. Instead,
22208 you would probably want to use @kbd{C-u 0 j *}, which would expand the
22209 bottom and give you the desired result @samp{(sqrt(a)-1)/(a-1)}. More
22210 generally, if @kbd{j *} is called with an argument of a positive
22211 integer @var{n}, then the denominator of the expression will be
22212 expanded @var{n} times (as if with the @kbd{C-u @var{n} a x} command).
22213
22214 If the selection is an inequality, @kbd{j *} and @kbd{j /} will
22215 accept any factor, but will warn unless they can prove the factor
22216 is either positive or negative. (In the latter case the direction
22217 of the inequality will be switched appropriately.) @xref{Declarations},
22218 for ways to inform Calc that a given variable is positive or
22219 negative. If Calc can't tell for sure what the sign of the factor
22220 will be, it will assume it is positive and display a warning
22221 message.
22222
22223 For selections that are not quotients, equations, or inequalities,
22224 these commands pull out a multiplicative factor: They divide (or
22225 multiply) by the entered formula, simplify, then multiply (or divide)
22226 back by the formula.
22227
22228 @kindex j +
22229 @kindex j -
22230 @pindex calc-sel-add-both-sides
22231 @pindex calc-sel-sub-both-sides
22232 The @kbd{j +} (@code{calc-sel-add-both-sides}) and @kbd{j -}
22233 (@code{calc-sel-sub-both-sides}) commands analogously add to or
22234 subtract from both sides of an equation or inequality. For other
22235 types of selections, they extract an additive factor. A numeric
22236 prefix argument suppresses simplification of the intermediate
22237 results.
22238
22239 @kindex j U
22240 @pindex calc-sel-unpack
22241 The @kbd{j U} (@code{calc-sel-unpack}) command replaces the
22242 selected function call with its argument. For example, given
22243 @samp{a + sin(x^2)} with @samp{sin(x^2)} selected, the result
22244 is @samp{a + x^2}. (The @samp{x^2} will remain selected; if you
22245 wanted to change the @code{sin} to @code{cos}, just press @kbd{C}
22246 now to take the cosine of the selected part.)
22247
22248 @kindex j v
22249 @pindex calc-sel-evaluate
22250 The @kbd{j v} (@code{calc-sel-evaluate}) command performs the
22251 basic simplifications on the selected sub-formula.
22252 These simplifications would normally be done automatically
22253 on all results, but may have been partially inhibited by
22254 previous selection-related operations, or turned off altogether
22255 by the @kbd{m O} command. This command is just an auto-selecting
22256 version of the @w{@kbd{a v}} command (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}).
22257
22258 With a numeric prefix argument of 2, @kbd{C-u 2 j v} applies
22259 the default algebraic simplifications to the selected
22260 sub-formula. With a prefix argument of 3 or more, e.g., @kbd{C-u j v}
22261 applies the @kbd{a e} (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) command.
22262 @xref{Simplifying Formulas}. With a negative prefix argument
22263 it simplifies at the top level only, just as with @kbd{a v}.
22264 Here the ``top'' level refers to the top level of the selected
22265 sub-formula.
22266
22267 @kindex j "
22268 @pindex calc-sel-expand-formula
22269 The @kbd{j "} (@code{calc-sel-expand-formula}) command is to @kbd{a "}
22270 (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}) what @kbd{j v} is to @kbd{a v}.
22271
22272 You can use the @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command
22273 to define other algebraic operations on sub-formulas. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22274
22275 @node Algebraic Manipulation, Simplifying Formulas, Selecting Subformulas, Algebra
22276 @section Algebraic Manipulation
22277
22278 @noindent
22279 The commands in this section perform general-purpose algebraic
22280 manipulations. They work on the whole formula at the top of the
22281 stack (unless, of course, you have made a selection in that
22282 formula).
22283
22284 Many algebra commands prompt for a variable name or formula. If you
22285 answer the prompt with a blank line, the variable or formula is taken
22286 from top-of-stack, and the normal argument for the command is taken
22287 from the second-to-top stack level.
22288
22289 @kindex a v
22290 @pindex calc-alg-evaluate
22291 The @kbd{a v} (@code{calc-alg-evaluate}) command performs the normal
22292 default simplifications on a formula; for example, @samp{a - -b} is
22293 changed to @samp{a + b}. These simplifications are normally done
22294 automatically on all Calc results, so this command is useful only if
22295 you have turned default simplifications off with an @kbd{m O}
22296 command. @xref{Simplification Modes}.
22297
22298 It is often more convenient to type @kbd{=}, which is like @kbd{a v}
22299 but which also substitutes stored values for variables in the formula.
22300 Use @kbd{a v} if you want the variables to ignore their stored values.
22301
22302 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 2 to @kbd{a v}, it simplifies
22303 using Calc's algebraic simplifications; @pxref{Simplifying Formulas}.
22304 If you give a numeric prefix of 3 or more, it uses Extended
22305 Simplification mode (@kbd{a e}).
22306
22307 If you give a negative prefix argument @mathit{-1}, @mathit{-2}, or @mathit{-3},
22308 it simplifies in the corresponding mode but only works on the top-level
22309 function call of the formula. For example, @samp{(2 + 3) * (2 + 3)} will
22310 simplify to @samp{(2 + 3)^2}, without simplifying the sub-formulas
22311 @samp{2 + 3}. As another example, typing @kbd{V R +} to sum the vector
22312 @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4]} produces the formula @samp{reduce(add, [1, 2, 3, 4])}
22313 in No-Simplify mode. Using @kbd{a v} will evaluate this all the way to
22314 10; using @kbd{C-u - a v} will evaluate it only to @samp{1 + 2 + 3 + 4}.
22315 (@xref{Reducing and Mapping}.)
22316
22317 @tindex evalv
22318 @tindex evalvn
22319 The @kbd{=} command corresponds to the @code{evalv} function, and
22320 the related @kbd{N} command, which is like @kbd{=} but temporarily
22321 disables Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s}) during the evaluation, corresponds
22322 to the @code{evalvn} function. (These commands interpret their prefix
22323 arguments differently than @kbd{a v}; @kbd{=} treats the prefix as
22324 the number of stack elements to evaluate at once, and @kbd{N} treats
22325 it as a temporary different working precision.)
22326
22327 The @code{evalvn} function can take an alternate working precision
22328 as an optional second argument. This argument can be either an
22329 integer, to set the precision absolutely, or a vector containing
22330 a single integer, to adjust the precision relative to the current
22331 precision. Note that @code{evalvn} with a larger than current
22332 precision will do the calculation at this higher precision, but the
22333 result will as usual be rounded back down to the current precision
22334 afterward. For example, @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415)} at a precision
22335 of 12 will return @samp{9.265359e-5}; @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, 30)}
22336 will return @samp{9.26535897932e-5} (computing a 25-digit result which
22337 is then rounded down to 12); and @samp{evalvn(pi - 3.1415, [-2])}
22338 will return @samp{9.2654e-5}.
22339
22340 @kindex a "
22341 @pindex calc-expand-formula
22342 The @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}) command expands functions
22343 into their defining formulas wherever possible. For example,
22344 @samp{deg(x^2)} is changed to @samp{180 x^2 / pi}. Most functions,
22345 like @code{sin} and @code{gcd}, are not defined by simple formulas
22346 and so are unaffected by this command. One important class of
22347 functions which @emph{can} be expanded is the user-defined functions
22348 created by the @kbd{Z F} command. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
22349 Other functions which @kbd{a "} can expand include the probability
22350 distribution functions, most of the financial functions, and the
22351 hyperbolic and inverse hyperbolic functions. A numeric prefix argument
22352 affects @kbd{a "} in the same way as it does @kbd{a v}: A positive
22353 argument expands all functions in the formula and then simplifies in
22354 various ways; a negative argument expands and simplifies only the
22355 top-level function call.
22356
22357 @kindex a M
22358 @pindex calc-map-equation
22359 @tindex mapeq
22360 The @kbd{a M} (@code{calc-map-equation}) [@code{mapeq}] command applies
22361 a given function or operator to one or more equations. It is analogous
22362 to @kbd{V M}, which operates on vectors instead of equations.
22363 @pxref{Reducing and Mapping}. For example, @kbd{a M S} changes
22364 @samp{x = y+1} to @samp{sin(x) = sin(y+1)}, and @kbd{a M +} with
22365 @samp{x = y+1} and @expr{6} on the stack produces @samp{x+6 = y+7}.
22366 With two equations on the stack, @kbd{a M +} would add the lefthand
22367 sides together and the righthand sides together to get the two
22368 respective sides of a new equation.
22369
22370 Mapping also works on inequalities. Mapping two similar inequalities
22371 produces another inequality of the same type. Mapping an inequality
22372 with an equation produces an inequality of the same type. Mapping a
22373 @samp{<=} with a @samp{<} or @samp{!=} (not-equal) produces a @samp{<}.
22374 If inequalities with opposite direction (e.g., @samp{<} and @samp{>})
22375 are mapped, the direction of the second inequality is reversed to
22376 match the first: Using @kbd{a M +} on @samp{a < b} and @samp{a > 2}
22377 reverses the latter to get @samp{2 < a}, which then allows the
22378 combination @samp{a + 2 < b + a}, which the algebraic simplifications
22379 can reduce to @samp{2 < b}.
22380
22381 Using @kbd{a M *}, @kbd{a M /}, @kbd{a M n}, or @kbd{a M &} to negate
22382 or invert an inequality will reverse the direction of the inequality.
22383 Other adjustments to inequalities are @emph{not} done automatically;
22384 @kbd{a M S} will change @w{@samp{x < y}} to @samp{sin(x) < sin(y)} even
22385 though this is not true for all values of the variables.
22386
22387 @kindex H a M
22388 @tindex mapeqp
22389 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a M} [@code{mapeqp}] does a plain
22390 mapping operation without reversing the direction of any inequalities.
22391 Thus, @kbd{H a M &} would change @kbd{x > 2} to @kbd{1/x > 0.5}.
22392 (This change is mathematically incorrect, but perhaps you were
22393 fixing an inequality which was already incorrect.)
22394
22395 @kindex I a M
22396 @tindex mapeqr
22397 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a M} [@code{mapeqr}] always reverses
22398 the direction of the inequality. You might use @kbd{I a M C} to
22399 change @samp{x < y} to @samp{cos(x) > cos(y)} if you know you are
22400 working with small positive angles.
22401
22402 @kindex a b
22403 @pindex calc-substitute
22404 @tindex subst
22405 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) [@code{subst}] command substitutes
22406 all occurrences
22407 of some variable or sub-expression of an expression with a new
22408 sub-expression. For example, substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(y)}
22409 in @samp{2 sin(x)^2 + x sin(x) + sin(2 x)} produces
22410 @samp{2 cos(y)^2 + x cos(y) + @w{sin(2 x)}}.
22411 Note that this is a purely structural substitution; the lone @samp{x} and
22412 the @samp{sin(2 x)} stayed the same because they did not look like
22413 @samp{sin(x)}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a more general method for
22414 doing substitutions.
22415
22416 The @kbd{a b} command normally prompts for two formulas, the old
22417 one and the new one. If you enter a blank line for the first
22418 prompt, all three arguments are taken from the stack (new, then old,
22419 then target expression). If you type an old formula but then enter a
22420 blank line for the new one, the new formula is taken from top-of-stack
22421 and the target from second-to-top. If you answer both prompts, the
22422 target is taken from top-of-stack as usual.
22423
22424 Note that @kbd{a b} has no understanding of commutativity or
22425 associativity. The pattern @samp{x+y} will not match the formula
22426 @samp{y+x}. Also, @samp{y+z} will not match inside the formula @samp{x+y+z}
22427 because the @samp{+} operator is left-associative, so the ``deep
22428 structure'' of that formula is @samp{(x+y) + z}. Use @kbd{d U}
22429 (@code{calc-unformatted-language}) mode to see the true structure of
22430 a formula. The rewrite rule mechanism, discussed later, does not have
22431 these limitations.
22432
22433 As an algebraic function, @code{subst} takes three arguments:
22434 Target expression, old, new. Note that @code{subst} is always
22435 evaluated immediately, even if its arguments are variables, so if
22436 you wish to put a call to @code{subst} onto the stack you must
22437 turn the default simplifications off first (with @kbd{m O}).
22438
22439 @node Simplifying Formulas, Polynomials, Algebraic Manipulation, Algebra
22440 @section Simplifying Formulas
22441
22442 @noindent
22443 @kindex a s
22444 @kindex I a s
22445 @kindex H a s
22446 @pindex calc-simplify
22447 @tindex simplify
22448
22449 The sections below describe all the various kinds of
22450 simplifications Calc provides in full detail. None of Calc's
22451 simplification commands are designed to pull rabbits out of hats;
22452 they simply apply certain specific rules to put formulas into
22453 less redundant or more pleasing forms. Serious algebra in Calc
22454 must be done manually, usually with a combination of selections
22455 and rewrite rules. @xref{Rearranging with Selections}.
22456 @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
22457
22458 @xref{Simplification Modes}, for commands to control what level of
22459 simplification occurs automatically. Normally the algebraic
22460 simplifications described below occur. If you have turned on a
22461 simplification mode which does not do these algebraic simplifications,
22462 you can still apply them to a formula with the @kbd{a s}
22463 (@code{calc-simplify}) [@code{simplify}] command.
22464
22465 There are some simplifications that, while sometimes useful, are never
22466 done automatically. For example, the @kbd{I} prefix can be given to
22467 @kbd{a s}; the @kbd{I a s} command will change any trigonometric
22468 function to the appropriate combination of @samp{sin}s and @samp{cos}s
22469 before simplifying. This can be useful in simplifying even mildly
22470 complicated trigonometric expressions. For example, while the algebraic
22471 simplifications can reduce @samp{sin(x) csc(x)} to @samp{1}, they will not
22472 simplify @samp{sin(x)^2 csc(x)}. The command @kbd{I a s} can be used to
22473 simplify this latter expression; it will transform @samp{sin(x)^2
22474 csc(x)} into @samp{sin(x)}. However, @kbd{I a s} will also perform
22475 some ``simplifications'' which may not be desired; for example, it
22476 will transform @samp{tan(x)^2} into @samp{sin(x)^2 / cos(x)^2}. The
22477 Hyperbolic prefix @kbd{H} can be used similarly; the @kbd{H a s} will
22478 replace any hyperbolic functions in the formula with the appropriate
22479 combinations of @samp{sinh}s and @samp{cosh}s before simplifying.
22480
22481
22482 @menu
22483 * Basic Simplifications::
22484 * Algebraic Simplifications::
22485 * Unsafe Simplifications::
22486 * Simplification of Units::
22487 @end menu
22488
22489 @node Basic Simplifications, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas, Simplifying Formulas
22490 @subsection Basic Simplifications
22491
22492 @noindent
22493 @cindex Basic simplifications
22494 This section describes basic simplifications which Calc performs in many
22495 situations. For example, both binary simplifications and algebraic
22496 simplifications begin by performing these basic simplifications. You
22497 can type @kbd{m I} to restrict the simplifications done on the stack to
22498 these simplifications.
22499
22500 The most basic simplification is the evaluation of functions.
22501 For example, @expr{2 + 3} is evaluated to @expr{5}, and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)}
22502 is evaluated to @expr{3}. Evaluation does not occur if the arguments
22503 to a function are somehow of the wrong type @expr{@tfn{tan}([2,3,4])}),
22504 range (@expr{@tfn{tan}(90)}), or number (@expr{@tfn{tan}(3,5)}),
22505 or if the function name is not recognized (@expr{@tfn{f}(5)}), or if
22506 Symbolic mode (@pxref{Symbolic Mode}) prevents evaluation
22507 (@expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2)}).
22508
22509 Calc simplifies (evaluates) the arguments to a function before it
22510 simplifies the function itself. Thus @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(5+4)} is
22511 simplified to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(9)} before the @code{sqrt} function
22512 itself is applied. There are very few exceptions to this rule:
22513 @code{quote}, @code{lambda}, and @code{condition} (the @code{::}
22514 operator) do not evaluate their arguments, @code{if} (the @code{? :}
22515 operator) does not evaluate all of its arguments, and @code{evalto}
22516 does not evaluate its lefthand argument.
22517
22518 Most commands apply at least these basic simplifications to all
22519 arguments they take from the stack, perform a particular operation,
22520 then simplify the result before pushing it back on the stack. In the
22521 common special case of regular arithmetic commands like @kbd{+} and
22522 @kbd{Q} [@code{sqrt}], the arguments are simply popped from the stack
22523 and collected into a suitable function call, which is then simplified
22524 (the arguments being simplified first as part of the process, as
22525 described above).
22526
22527 Even the basic set of simplifications are too numerous to describe
22528 completely here, but this section will describe the ones that apply to the
22529 major arithmetic operators. This list will be rather technical in
22530 nature, and will probably be interesting to you only if you are
22531 a serious user of Calc's algebra facilities.
22532
22533 @tex
22534 \bigskip
22535 @end tex
22536
22537 As well as the simplifications described here, if you have stored
22538 any rewrite rules in the variable @code{EvalRules} then these rules
22539 will also be applied before any of the basic simplifications.
22540 @xref{Automatic Rewrites}, for details.
22541
22542 @tex
22543 \bigskip
22544 @end tex
22545
22546 And now, on with the basic simplifications:
22547
22548 Arithmetic operators like @kbd{+} and @kbd{*} always take two
22549 arguments in Calc's internal form. Sums and products of three or
22550 more terms are arranged by the associative law of algebra into
22551 a left-associative form for sums, @expr{((a + b) + c) + d}, and
22552 (by default) a right-associative form for products,
22553 @expr{a * (b * (c * d))}. Formulas like @expr{(a + b) + (c + d)} are
22554 rearranged to left-associative form, though this rarely matters since
22555 Calc's algebra commands are designed to hide the inner structure of sums
22556 and products as much as possible. Sums and products in their proper
22557 associative form will be written without parentheses in the examples
22558 below.
22559
22560 Sums and products are @emph{not} rearranged according to the
22561 commutative law (@expr{a + b} to @expr{b + a}) except in a few
22562 special cases described below. Some algebra programs always
22563 rearrange terms into a canonical order, which enables them to
22564 see that @expr{a b + b a} can be simplified to @expr{2 a b}.
22565 If you are using Basic Simplification mode, Calc assumes you have put
22566 the terms into the order you want and generally leaves that order alone,
22567 with the consequence that formulas like the above will only be
22568 simplified if you explicitly give the @kbd{a s} command.
22569 @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
22570
22571 Differences @expr{a - b} are treated like sums @expr{a + (-b)}
22572 for purposes of simplification; one of the default simplifications
22573 is to rewrite @expr{a + (-b)} or @expr{(-b) + a}, where @expr{-b}
22574 represents a ``negative-looking'' term, into @expr{a - b} form.
22575 ``Negative-looking'' means negative numbers, negated formulas like
22576 @expr{-x}, and products or quotients in which either term is
22577 negative-looking.
22578
22579 Other simplifications involving negation are @expr{-(-x)} to @expr{x};
22580 @expr{-(a b)} or @expr{-(a/b)} where either @expr{a} or @expr{b} is
22581 negative-looking, simplified by negating that term, or else where
22582 @expr{a} or @expr{b} is any number, by negating that number;
22583 @expr{-(a + b)} to @expr{-a - b}, and @expr{-(b - a)} to @expr{a - b}.
22584 (This, and rewriting @expr{(-b) + a} to @expr{a - b}, are the only
22585 cases where the order of terms in a sum is changed by the default
22586 simplifications.)
22587
22588 The distributive law is used to simplify sums in some cases:
22589 @expr{a x + b x} to @expr{(a + b) x}, where @expr{a} represents
22590 a number or an implicit 1 or @mathit{-1} (as in @expr{x} or @expr{-x})
22591 and similarly for @expr{b}. Use the @kbd{a c}, @w{@kbd{a f}}, or
22592 @kbd{j M} commands to merge sums with non-numeric coefficients
22593 using the distributive law.
22594
22595 The distributive law is only used for sums of two terms, or
22596 for adjacent terms in a larger sum. Thus @expr{a + b + b + c}
22597 is simplified to @expr{a + 2 b + c}, but @expr{a + b + c + b}
22598 is not simplified. The reason is that comparing all terms of a
22599 sum with one another would require time proportional to the
22600 square of the number of terms; Calc omits potentially slow
22601 operations like this in basic simplification mode.
22602
22603 Finally, @expr{a + 0} and @expr{0 + a} are simplified to @expr{a}.
22604 A consequence of the above rules is that @expr{0 - a} is simplified
22605 to @expr{-a}.
22606
22607 @tex
22608 \bigskip
22609 @end tex
22610
22611 The products @expr{1 a} and @expr{a 1} are simplified to @expr{a};
22612 @expr{(-1) a} and @expr{a (-1)} are simplified to @expr{-a};
22613 @expr{0 a} and @expr{a 0} are simplified to @expr{0}, except that
22614 in Matrix mode where @expr{a} is not provably scalar the result
22615 is the generic zero matrix @samp{idn(0)}, and that if @expr{a} is
22616 infinite the result is @samp{nan}.
22617
22618 Also, @expr{(-a) b} and @expr{a (-b)} are simplified to @expr{-(a b)},
22619 where this occurs for negated formulas but not for regular negative
22620 numbers.
22621
22622 Products are commuted only to move numbers to the front:
22623 @expr{a b 2} is commuted to @expr{2 a b}.
22624
22625 The product @expr{a (b + c)} is distributed over the sum only if
22626 @expr{a} and at least one of @expr{b} and @expr{c} are numbers:
22627 @expr{2 (x + 3)} goes to @expr{2 x + 6}. The formula
22628 @expr{(-a) (b - c)}, where @expr{-a} is a negative number, is
22629 rewritten to @expr{a (c - b)}.
22630
22631 The distributive law of products and powers is used for adjacent
22632 terms of the product: @expr{x^a x^b} goes to
22633 @texline @math{x^{a+b}}
22634 @infoline @expr{x^(a+b)}
22635 where @expr{a} is a number, or an implicit 1 (as in @expr{x}),
22636 or the implicit one-half of @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)}, and similarly for
22637 @expr{b}. The result is written using @samp{sqrt} or @samp{1/sqrt}
22638 if the sum of the powers is @expr{1/2} or @expr{-1/2}, respectively.
22639 If the sum of the powers is zero, the product is simplified to
22640 @expr{1} or to @samp{idn(1)} if Matrix mode is enabled.
22641
22642 The product of a negative power times anything but another negative
22643 power is changed to use division:
22644 @texline @math{x^{-2} y}
22645 @infoline @expr{x^(-2) y}
22646 goes to @expr{y / x^2} unless Matrix mode is
22647 in effect and neither @expr{x} nor @expr{y} are scalar (in which
22648 case it is considered unsafe to rearrange the order of the terms).
22649
22650 Finally, @expr{a (b/c)} is rewritten to @expr{(a b)/c}, and also
22651 @expr{(a/b) c} is changed to @expr{(a c)/b} unless in Matrix mode.
22652
22653 @tex
22654 \bigskip
22655 @end tex
22656
22657 Simplifications for quotients are analogous to those for products.
22658 The quotient @expr{0 / x} is simplified to @expr{0}, with the same
22659 exceptions that were noted for @expr{0 x}. Likewise, @expr{x / 1}
22660 and @expr{x / (-1)} are simplified to @expr{x} and @expr{-x},
22661 respectively.
22662
22663 The quotient @expr{x / 0} is left unsimplified or changed to an
22664 infinite quantity, as directed by the current infinite mode.
22665 @xref{Infinite Mode}.
22666
22667 The expression
22668 @texline @math{a / b^{-c}}
22669 @infoline @expr{a / b^(-c)}
22670 is changed to @expr{a b^c}, where @expr{-c} is any negative-looking
22671 power. Also, @expr{1 / b^c} is changed to
22672 @texline @math{b^{-c}}
22673 @infoline @expr{b^(-c)}
22674 for any power @expr{c}.
22675
22676 Also, @expr{(-a) / b} and @expr{a / (-b)} go to @expr{-(a/b)};
22677 @expr{(a/b) / c} goes to @expr{a / (b c)}; and @expr{a / (b/c)}
22678 goes to @expr{(a c) / b} unless Matrix mode prevents this
22679 rearrangement. Similarly, @expr{a / (b:c)} is simplified to
22680 @expr{(c:b) a} for any fraction @expr{b:c}.
22681
22682 The distributive law is applied to @expr{(a + b) / c} only if
22683 @expr{c} and at least one of @expr{a} and @expr{b} are numbers.
22684 Quotients of powers and square roots are distributed just as
22685 described for multiplication.
22686
22687 Quotients of products cancel only in the leading terms of the
22688 numerator and denominator. In other words, @expr{a x b / a y b}
22689 is canceled to @expr{x b / y b} but not to @expr{x / y}. Once
22690 again this is because full cancellation can be slow; use @kbd{a s}
22691 to cancel all terms of the quotient.
22692
22693 Quotients of negative-looking values are simplified according
22694 to @expr{(-a) / (-b)} to @expr{a / b}, @expr{(-a) / (b - c)}
22695 to @expr{a / (c - b)}, and @expr{(a - b) / (-c)} to @expr{(b - a) / c}.
22696
22697 @tex
22698 \bigskip
22699 @end tex
22700
22701 The formula @expr{x^0} is simplified to @expr{1}, or to @samp{idn(1)}
22702 in Matrix mode. The formula @expr{0^x} is simplified to @expr{0}
22703 unless @expr{x} is a negative number, complex number or zero.
22704 If @expr{x} is negative, complex or @expr{0.0}, @expr{0^x} is an
22705 infinity or an unsimplified formula according to the current infinite
22706 mode. The expression @expr{0^0} is simplified to @expr{1}.
22707
22708 Powers of products or quotients @expr{(a b)^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c}
22709 are distributed to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{a^c / b^c} only if @expr{c}
22710 is an integer, or if either @expr{a} or @expr{b} are nonnegative
22711 real numbers. Powers of powers @expr{(a^b)^c} are simplified to
22712 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
22713 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
22714 only when @expr{c} is an integer and @expr{b c} also
22715 evaluates to an integer. Without these restrictions these simplifications
22716 would not be safe because of problems with principal values.
22717 (In other words,
22718 @texline @math{((-3)^{1/2})^2}
22719 @infoline @expr{((-3)^1:2)^2}
22720 is safe to simplify, but
22721 @texline @math{((-3)^2)^{1/2}}
22722 @infoline @expr{((-3)^2)^1:2}
22723 is not.) @xref{Declarations}, for ways to inform Calc that your
22724 variables satisfy these requirements.
22725
22726 As a special case of this rule, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^n} is simplified to
22727 @texline @math{x^{n/2}}
22728 @infoline @expr{x^(n/2)}
22729 only for even integers @expr{n}.
22730
22731 If @expr{a} is known to be real, @expr{b} is an even integer, and
22732 @expr{c} is a half- or quarter-integer, then @expr{(a^b)^c} is
22733 simplified to @expr{@tfn{abs}(a^(b c))}.
22734
22735 Also, @expr{(-a)^b} is simplified to @expr{a^b} if @expr{b} is an
22736 even integer, or to @expr{-(a^b)} if @expr{b} is an odd integer,
22737 for any negative-looking expression @expr{-a}.
22738
22739 Square roots @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)} generally act like one-half powers
22740 @texline @math{x^{1:2}}
22741 @infoline @expr{x^1:2}
22742 for the purposes of the above-listed simplifications.
22743
22744 Also, note that
22745 @texline @math{1 / x^{1:2}}
22746 @infoline @expr{1 / x^1:2}
22747 is changed to
22748 @texline @math{x^{-1:2}},
22749 @infoline @expr{x^(-1:2)},
22750 but @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(x)} is left alone.
22751
22752 @tex
22753 \bigskip
22754 @end tex
22755
22756 Generic identity matrices (@pxref{Matrix Mode}) are simplified by the
22757 following rules: @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + b} to @expr{a + b} if @expr{b}
22758 is provably scalar, or expanded out if @expr{b} is a matrix;
22759 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) + @tfn{idn}(b)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a + b)};
22760 @expr{-@tfn{idn}(a)} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(-a)}; @expr{a @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22761 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)} if @expr{a} is provably scalar, or to @expr{a b}
22762 if @expr{a} is provably non-scalar; @expr{@tfn{idn}(a) @tfn{idn}(b)} to
22763 @expr{@tfn{idn}(a b)}; analogous simplifications for quotients involving
22764 @code{idn}; and @expr{@tfn{idn}(a)^n} to @expr{@tfn{idn}(a^n)} where
22765 @expr{n} is an integer.
22766
22767 @tex
22768 \bigskip
22769 @end tex
22770
22771 The @code{floor} function and other integer truncation functions
22772 vanish if the argument is provably integer-valued, so that
22773 @expr{@tfn{floor}(@tfn{round}(x))} simplifies to @expr{@tfn{round}(x)}.
22774 Also, combinations of @code{float}, @code{floor} and its friends,
22775 and @code{ffloor} and its friends, are simplified in appropriate
22776 ways. @xref{Integer Truncation}.
22777
22778 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(-x)} changes to @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}.
22779 The expression @expr{@tfn{abs}(@tfn{abs}(x))} changes to
22780 @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)}; in fact, @expr{@tfn{abs}(x)} changes to @expr{x} or
22781 @expr{-x} if @expr{x} is provably nonnegative or nonpositive
22782 (@pxref{Declarations}).
22783
22784 While most functions do not recognize the variable @code{i} as an
22785 imaginary number, the @code{arg} function does handle the two cases
22786 @expr{@tfn{arg}(@tfn{i})} and @expr{@tfn{arg}(-@tfn{i})} just for convenience.
22787
22788 The expression @expr{@tfn{conj}(@tfn{conj}(x))} simplifies to @expr{x}.
22789 Various other expressions involving @code{conj}, @code{re}, and
22790 @code{im} are simplified, especially if some of the arguments are
22791 provably real or involve the constant @code{i}. For example,
22792 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a + b i)} is changed to
22793 @expr{@tfn{conj}(a) - @tfn{conj}(b) i}, or to @expr{a - b i} if @expr{a}
22794 and @expr{b} are known to be real.
22795
22796 Functions like @code{sin} and @code{arctan} generally don't have
22797 any default simplifications beyond simply evaluating the functions
22798 for suitable numeric arguments and infinity. The algebraic
22799 simplifications described in the next section do provide some
22800 simplifications for these functions, though.
22801
22802 One important simplification that does occur is that
22803 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e})} is simplified to 1, and @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)} is
22804 simplified to @expr{x} for any @expr{x}. This occurs even if you have
22805 stored a different value in the Calc variable @samp{e}; but this would
22806 be a bad idea in any case if you were also using natural logarithms!
22807
22808 Among the logical functions, @tfn{!(@var{a} <= @var{b})} changes to
22809 @tfn{@var{a} > @var{b}} and so on. Equations and inequalities where both sides
22810 are either negative-looking or zero are simplified by negating both sides
22811 and reversing the inequality. While it might seem reasonable to simplify
22812 @expr{!!x} to @expr{x}, this would not be valid in general because
22813 @expr{!!2} is 1, not 2.
22814
22815 Most other Calc functions have few if any basic simplifications
22816 defined, aside of course from evaluation when the arguments are
22817 suitable numbers.
22818
22819 @node Algebraic Simplifications, Unsafe Simplifications, Basic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
22820 @subsection Algebraic Simplifications
22821
22822 @noindent
22823 @cindex Algebraic simplifications
22824 @kindex a s
22825 @kindex m A
22826 This section describes all simplifications that are performed by
22827 the algebraic simplification mode, which is the default simplification
22828 mode. If you have switched to a different simplification mode, you can
22829 switch back with the @kbd{m A} command. Even in other simplification
22830 modes, the @kbd{a s} command will use these algebraic simplifications to
22831 simplify the formula.
22832
22833 There is a variable, @code{AlgSimpRules}, in which you can put rewrites
22834 to be applied. Its use is analogous to @code{EvalRules},
22835 but without the special restrictions. Basically, the simplifier does
22836 @samp{@w{a r} AlgSimpRules} with an infinite repeat count on the whole
22837 expression being simplified, then it traverses the expression applying
22838 the built-in rules described below. If the result is different from
22839 the original expression, the process repeats with the basic
22840 simplifications (including @code{EvalRules}), then @code{AlgSimpRules},
22841 then the built-in simplifications, and so on.
22842
22843 @tex
22844 \bigskip
22845 @end tex
22846
22847 Sums are simplified in two ways. Constant terms are commuted to the
22848 end of the sum, so that @expr{a + 2 + b} changes to @expr{a + b + 2}.
22849 The only exception is that a constant will not be commuted away
22850 from the first position of a difference, i.e., @expr{2 - x} is not
22851 commuted to @expr{-x + 2}.
22852
22853 Also, terms of sums are combined by the distributive law, as in
22854 @expr{x + y + 2 x} to @expr{y + 3 x}. This always occurs for
22855 adjacent terms, but Calc's algebraic simplifications compare all pairs
22856 of terms including non-adjacent ones.
22857
22858 @tex
22859 \bigskip
22860 @end tex
22861
22862 Products are sorted into a canonical order using the commutative
22863 law. For example, @expr{b c a} is commuted to @expr{a b c}.
22864 This allows easier comparison of products; for example, the basic
22865 simplifications will not change @expr{x y + y x} to @expr{2 x y},
22866 but the algebraic simplifications; it first rewrites the sum to
22867 @expr{x y + x y} which can then be recognized as a sum of identical
22868 terms.
22869
22870 The canonical ordering used to sort terms of products has the
22871 property that real-valued numbers, interval forms and infinities
22872 come first, and are sorted into increasing order. The @kbd{V S}
22873 command uses the same ordering when sorting a vector.
22874
22875 Sorting of terms of products is inhibited when Matrix mode is
22876 turned on; in this case, Calc will never exchange the order of
22877 two terms unless it knows at least one of the terms is a scalar.
22878
22879 Products of powers are distributed by comparing all pairs of
22880 terms, using the same method that the default simplifications
22881 use for adjacent terms of products.
22882
22883 Even though sums are not sorted, the commutative law is still
22884 taken into account when terms of a product are being compared.
22885 Thus @expr{(x + y) (y + x)} will be simplified to @expr{(x + y)^2}.
22886 A subtle point is that @expr{(x - y) (y - x)} will @emph{not}
22887 be simplified to @expr{-(x - y)^2}; Calc does not notice that
22888 one term can be written as a constant times the other, even if
22889 that constant is @mathit{-1}.
22890
22891 A fraction times any expression, @expr{(a:b) x}, is changed to
22892 a quotient involving integers: @expr{a x / b}. This is not
22893 done for floating-point numbers like @expr{0.5}, however. This
22894 is one reason why you may find it convenient to turn Fraction mode
22895 on while doing algebra; @pxref{Fraction Mode}.
22896
22897 @tex
22898 \bigskip
22899 @end tex
22900
22901 Quotients are simplified by comparing all terms in the numerator
22902 with all terms in the denominator for possible cancellation using
22903 the distributive law. For example, @expr{a x^2 b / c x^3 d} will
22904 cancel @expr{x^2} from the top and bottom to get @expr{a b / c x d}.
22905 (The terms in the denominator will then be rearranged to @expr{c d x}
22906 as described above.) If there is any common integer or fractional
22907 factor in the numerator and denominator, it is canceled out;
22908 for example, @expr{(4 x + 6) / 8 x} simplifies to @expr{(2 x + 3) / 4 x}.
22909
22910 Non-constant common factors are not found even by algebraic
22911 simplifications. To cancel the factor @expr{a} in
22912 @expr{(a x + a) / a^2} you could first use @kbd{j M} on the product
22913 @expr{a x} to Merge the numerator to @expr{a (1+x)}, which can then be
22914 simplified successfully.
22915
22916 @tex
22917 \bigskip
22918 @end tex
22919
22920 Integer powers of the variable @code{i} are simplified according
22921 to the identity @expr{i^2 = -1}. If you store a new value other
22922 than the complex number @expr{(0,1)} in @code{i}, this simplification
22923 will no longer occur. This is not done by the basic
22924 simplifications; in case someone (unwisely) wants to use the name
22925 @code{i} for a variable unrelated to complex numbers, they can use
22926 basic simplification mode.
22927
22928 Square roots of integer or rational arguments are simplified in
22929 several ways. (Note that these will be left unevaluated only in
22930 Symbolic mode.) First, square integer or rational factors are
22931 pulled out so that @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(8)} is rewritten as
22932 @texline @math{2\,@tfn{sqrt}(2)}.
22933 @infoline @expr{2 sqrt(2)}.
22934 Conceptually speaking this implies factoring the argument into primes
22935 and moving pairs of primes out of the square root, but for reasons of
22936 efficiency Calc only looks for primes up to 29.
22937
22938 Square roots in the denominator of a quotient are moved to the
22939 numerator: @expr{1 / @tfn{sqrt}(3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(3) / 3}.
22940 The same effect occurs for the square root of a fraction:
22941 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(2:3)} changes to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(6) / 3}.
22942
22943 @tex
22944 \bigskip
22945 @end tex
22946
22947 The @code{%} (modulo) operator is simplified in several ways
22948 when the modulus @expr{M} is a positive real number. First, if
22949 the argument is of the form @expr{x + n} for some real number
22950 @expr{n}, then @expr{n} is itself reduced modulo @expr{M}. For
22951 example, @samp{(x - 23) % 10} is simplified to @samp{(x + 7) % 10}.
22952
22953 If the argument is multiplied by a constant, and this constant
22954 has a common integer divisor with the modulus, then this factor is
22955 canceled out. For example, @samp{12 x % 15} is changed to
22956 @samp{3 (4 x % 5)} by factoring out 3. Also, @samp{(12 x + 1) % 15}
22957 is changed to @samp{3 ((4 x + 1:3) % 5)}. While these forms may
22958 not seem ``simpler,'' they allow Calc to discover useful information
22959 about modulo forms in the presence of declarations.
22960
22961 If the modulus is 1, then Calc can use @code{int} declarations to
22962 evaluate the expression. For example, the idiom @samp{x % 2} is
22963 often used to check whether a number is odd or even. As described
22964 above, @w{@samp{2 n % 2}} and @samp{(2 n + 1) % 2} are simplified to
22965 @samp{2 (n % 1)} and @samp{2 ((n + 1:2) % 1)}, respectively; Calc
22966 can simplify these to 0 and 1 (respectively) if @code{n} has been
22967 declared to be an integer.
22968
22969 @tex
22970 \bigskip
22971 @end tex
22972
22973 Trigonometric functions are simplified in several ways. Whenever a
22974 products of two trigonometric functions can be replaced by a single
22975 function, the replacement is made; for example,
22976 @expr{@tfn{tan}(x) @tfn{cos}(x)} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{sin}(x)}.
22977 Reciprocals of trigonometric functions are replaced by their reciprocal
22978 function; for example, @expr{1/@tfn{sec}(x)} is simplified to
22979 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. The corresponding simplifications for the
22980 hyperbolic functions are also handled.
22981
22982 Trigonometric functions of their inverse functions are
22983 simplified. The expression @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arcsin}(x))} is
22984 simplified to @expr{x}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22985 Trigonometric functions of inverses of different trigonometric
22986 functions can also be simplified, as in @expr{@tfn{sin}(@tfn{arccos}(x))}
22987 to @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - x^2)}.
22988
22989 If the argument to @code{sin} is negative-looking, it is simplified to
22990 @expr{-@tfn{sin}(x)}, and similarly for @code{cos} and @code{tan}.
22991 Finally, certain special values of the argument are recognized;
22992 @pxref{Trigonometric and Hyperbolic Functions}.
22993
22994 Hyperbolic functions of their inverses and of negative-looking
22995 arguments are also handled, as are exponentials of inverse
22996 hyperbolic functions.
22997
22998 No simplifications for inverse trigonometric and hyperbolic
22999 functions are known, except for negative arguments of @code{arcsin},
23000 @code{arctan}, @code{arcsinh}, and @code{arctanh}. Note that
23001 @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} can @emph{not} safely change to
23002 @expr{x}, since this only correct within an integer multiple of
23003 @texline @math{2 \pi}
23004 @infoline @expr{2 pi}
23005 radians or 360 degrees. However, @expr{@tfn{arcsinh}(@tfn{sinh}(x))} is
23006 simplified to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
23007
23008 Several simplifications that apply to logarithms and exponentials
23009 are that @expr{@tfn{exp}(@tfn{ln}(x))},
23010 @texline @tfn{e}@math{^{\ln(x)}},
23011 @infoline @expr{e^@tfn{ln}(x)},
23012 and
23013 @texline @math{10^{{\rm log10}(x)}}
23014 @infoline @expr{10^@tfn{log10}(x)}
23015 all reduce to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))}, etc., can
23016 reduce to @expr{x} if @expr{x} is provably real. The form
23017 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)^y} is simplified to @expr{@tfn{exp}(x y)}. If @expr{x}
23018 is a suitable multiple of
23019 @texline @math{\pi i}
23020 @infoline @expr{pi i}
23021 (as described above for the trigonometric functions), then
23022 @expr{@tfn{exp}(x)} or @expr{e^x} will be expanded. Finally,
23023 @expr{@tfn{ln}(x)} is simplified to a form involving @code{pi} and
23024 @code{i} where @expr{x} is provably negative, positive imaginary, or
23025 negative imaginary.
23026
23027 The error functions @code{erf} and @code{erfc} are simplified when
23028 their arguments are negative-looking or are calls to the @code{conj}
23029 function.
23030
23031 @tex
23032 \bigskip
23033 @end tex
23034
23035 Equations and inequalities are simplified by canceling factors
23036 of products, quotients, or sums on both sides. Inequalities
23037 change sign if a negative multiplicative factor is canceled.
23038 Non-constant multiplicative factors as in @expr{a b = a c} are
23039 canceled from equations only if they are provably nonzero (generally
23040 because they were declared so; @pxref{Declarations}). Factors
23041 are canceled from inequalities only if they are nonzero and their
23042 sign is known.
23043
23044 Simplification also replaces an equation or inequality with
23045 1 or 0 (``true'' or ``false'') if it can through the use of
23046 declarations. If @expr{x} is declared to be an integer greater
23047 than 5, then @expr{x < 3}, @expr{x = 3}, and @expr{x = 7.5} are
23048 all simplified to 0, but @expr{x > 3} is simplified to 1.
23049 By a similar analysis, @expr{abs(x) >= 0} is simplified to 1,
23050 as is @expr{x^2 >= 0} if @expr{x} is known to be real.
23051
23052 @node Unsafe Simplifications, Simplification of Units, Algebraic Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
23053 @subsection ``Unsafe'' Simplifications
23054
23055 @noindent
23056 @cindex Unsafe simplifications
23057 @cindex Extended simplification
23058 @kindex a e
23059 @kindex m E
23060 @pindex calc-simplify-extended
23061 @ignore
23062 @mindex esimpl@idots
23063 @end ignore
23064 @tindex esimplify
23065 Calc is capable of performing some simplifications which may sometimes
23066 be desired but which are not ``safe'' in all cases. The @kbd{a e}
23067 (@code{calc-simplify-extended}) [@code{esimplify}] command
23068 applies the algebraic simplifications as well as these extended, or
23069 ``unsafe'', simplifications. Use this only if you know the values in
23070 your formula lie in the restricted ranges for which these
23071 simplifications are valid. You can use Extended Simplification mode
23072 (@kbd{m E}) to have these simplifications done automatically.
23073
23074 The symbolic integrator uses these extended simplifications; one effect
23075 of this is that the integrator's results must be used with caution.
23076 Where an integral table will often attach conditions like ``for positive
23077 @expr{a} only,'' Calc (like most other symbolic integration programs)
23078 will simply produce an unqualified result.
23079
23080 Because @kbd{a e}'s simplifications are unsafe, it is sometimes better
23081 to type @kbd{C-u -3 a v}, which does extended simplification only
23082 on the top level of the formula without affecting the sub-formulas.
23083 In fact, @kbd{C-u -3 j v} allows you to target extended simplification
23084 to any specific part of a formula.
23085
23086 The variable @code{ExtSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied when
23087 the extended simplifications are used. These are applied in addition to
23088 @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. (The @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
23089 step described above is simply followed by an @kbd{a r ExtSimpRules} step.)
23090
23091 Following is a complete list of the ``unsafe'' simplifications.
23092
23093 @tex
23094 \bigskip
23095 @end tex
23096
23097 Inverse trigonometric or hyperbolic functions, called with their
23098 corresponding non-inverse functions as arguments, are simplified.
23099 For example, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{sin}(x))} changes
23100 to @expr{x}. Also, @expr{@tfn{arcsin}(@tfn{cos}(x))} and
23101 @expr{@tfn{arccos}(@tfn{sin}(x))} both change to @expr{@tfn{pi}/2 - x}.
23102 These simplifications are unsafe because they are valid only for
23103 values of @expr{x} in a certain range; outside that range, values
23104 are folded down to the 360-degree range that the inverse trigonometric
23105 functions always produce.
23106
23107 Powers of powers @expr{(x^a)^b} are simplified to
23108 @texline @math{x^{a b}}
23109 @infoline @expr{x^(a b)}
23110 for all @expr{a} and @expr{b}. These results will be valid only
23111 in a restricted range of @expr{x}; for example, in
23112 @texline @math{(x^2)^{1:2}}
23113 @infoline @expr{(x^2)^1:2}
23114 the powers cancel to get @expr{x}, which is valid for positive values
23115 of @expr{x} but not for negative or complex values.
23116
23117 Similarly, @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x^a)} and @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(x)^a} are both
23118 simplified (possibly unsafely) to
23119 @texline @math{x^{a/2}}.
23120 @infoline @expr{x^(a/2)}.
23121
23122 Forms like @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(1 - sin(x)^2)} are simplified to, e.g.,
23123 @expr{@tfn{cos}(x)}. Calc has identities of this sort for @code{sin},
23124 @code{cos}, @code{tan}, @code{sinh}, and @code{cosh}.
23125
23126 Arguments of square roots are partially factored to look for
23127 squared terms that can be extracted. For example,
23128 @expr{@tfn{sqrt}(a^2 b^3 + a^3 b^2)} simplifies to
23129 @expr{a b @tfn{sqrt}(a+b)}.
23130
23131 The simplifications of @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{exp}(x))},
23132 @expr{@tfn{ln}(@tfn{e}^x)}, and @expr{@tfn{log10}(10^x)} to @expr{x} are also
23133 unsafe because of problems with principal values (although these
23134 simplifications are safe if @expr{x} is known to be real).
23135
23136 Common factors are canceled from products on both sides of an
23137 equation, even if those factors may be zero: @expr{a x / b x}
23138 to @expr{a / b}. Such factors are never canceled from
23139 inequalities: Even the extended simplifications are not bold enough to
23140 reduce @expr{a x < b x} to @expr{a < b} (or @expr{a > b}, depending
23141 on whether you believe @expr{x} is positive or negative).
23142 The @kbd{a M /} command can be used to divide a factor out of
23143 both sides of an inequality.
23144
23145 @node Simplification of Units, , Unsafe Simplifications, Simplifying Formulas
23146 @subsection Simplification of Units
23147
23148 @noindent
23149 The simplifications described in this section (as well as the algebraic
23150 simplifications) are applied when units need to be simplified. They can
23151 be applied using the @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) command, or
23152 will be done automatically in Units Simplification mode (@kbd{m U}).
23153 @xref{Basic Operations on Units}.
23154
23155 The variable @code{UnitSimpRules} contains rewrites to be applied by
23156 units simplifications. These are applied in addition to @code{EvalRules}
23157 and @code{AlgSimpRules}.
23158
23159 Scalar mode is automatically put into effect when simplifying units.
23160 @xref{Matrix Mode}.
23161
23162 Sums @expr{a + b} involving units are simplified by extracting the
23163 units of @expr{a} as if by the @kbd{u x} command (call the result
23164 @expr{u_a}), then simplifying the expression @expr{b / u_a}
23165 using @kbd{u b} and @kbd{u s}. If the result has units then the sum
23166 is inconsistent and is left alone. Otherwise, it is rewritten
23167 in terms of the units @expr{u_a}.
23168
23169 If units auto-ranging mode is enabled, products or quotients in
23170 which the first argument is a number which is out of range for the
23171 leading unit are modified accordingly.
23172
23173 When canceling and combining units in products and quotients,
23174 Calc accounts for unit names that differ only in the prefix letter.
23175 For example, @samp{2 km m} is simplified to @samp{2000 m^2}.
23176 However, compatible but different units like @code{ft} and @code{in}
23177 are not combined in this way.
23178
23179 Quotients @expr{a / b} are simplified in three additional ways. First,
23180 if @expr{b} is a number or a product beginning with a number, Calc
23181 computes the reciprocal of this number and moves it to the numerator.
23182
23183 Second, for each pair of unit names from the numerator and denominator
23184 of a quotient, if the units are compatible (e.g., they are both
23185 units of area) then they are replaced by the ratio between those
23186 units. For example, in @samp{3 s in N / kg cm} the units
23187 @samp{in / cm} will be replaced by @expr{2.54}.
23188
23189 Third, if the units in the quotient exactly cancel out, so that
23190 a @kbd{u b} command on the quotient would produce a dimensionless
23191 number for an answer, then the quotient simplifies to that number.
23192
23193 For powers and square roots, the ``unsafe'' simplifications
23194 @expr{(a b)^c} to @expr{a^c b^c}, @expr{(a/b)^c} to @expr{a^c / b^c},
23195 and @expr{(a^b)^c} to
23196 @texline @math{a^{b c}}
23197 @infoline @expr{a^(b c)}
23198 are done if the powers are real numbers. (These are safe in the context
23199 of units because all numbers involved can reasonably be assumed to be
23200 real.)
23201
23202 Also, if a unit name is raised to a fractional power, and the
23203 base units in that unit name all occur to powers which are a
23204 multiple of the denominator of the power, then the unit name
23205 is expanded out into its base units, which can then be simplified
23206 according to the previous paragraph. For example, @samp{acre^1.5}
23207 is simplified by noting that @expr{1.5 = 3:2}, that @samp{acre}
23208 is defined in terms of @samp{m^2}, and that the 2 in the power of
23209 @code{m} is a multiple of 2 in @expr{3:2}. Thus, @code{acre^1.5} is
23210 replaced by approximately
23211 @texline @math{(4046 m^2)^{1.5}}
23212 @infoline @expr{(4046 m^2)^1.5},
23213 which is then changed to
23214 @texline @math{4046^{1.5} \, (m^2)^{1.5}},
23215 @infoline @expr{4046^1.5 (m^2)^1.5},
23216 then to @expr{257440 m^3}.
23217
23218 The functions @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{clean}, @code{abs},
23219 as well as @code{floor} and the other integer truncation functions,
23220 applied to unit names or products or quotients involving units, are
23221 simplified. For example, @samp{round(1.6 in)} is changed to
23222 @samp{round(1.6) round(in)}; the lefthand term evaluates to 2,
23223 and the righthand term simplifies to @code{in}.
23224
23225 The functions @code{sin}, @code{cos}, and @code{tan} with arguments
23226 that have angular units like @code{rad} or @code{arcmin} are
23227 simplified by converting to base units (radians), then evaluating
23228 with the angular mode temporarily set to radians.
23229
23230 @node Polynomials, Calculus, Simplifying Formulas, Algebra
23231 @section Polynomials
23232
23233 A @dfn{polynomial} is a sum of terms which are coefficients times
23234 various powers of a ``base'' variable. For example, @expr{2 x^2 + 3 x - 4}
23235 is a polynomial in @expr{x}. Some formulas can be considered
23236 polynomials in several different variables: @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2}
23237 is a polynomial in both @expr{x} and @expr{y}. Polynomial coefficients
23238 are often numbers, but they may in general be any formulas not
23239 involving the base variable.
23240
23241 @kindex a f
23242 @pindex calc-factor
23243 @tindex factor
23244 The @kbd{a f} (@code{calc-factor}) [@code{factor}] command factors a
23245 polynomial into a product of terms. For example, the polynomial
23246 @expr{x^3 + 2 x^2 + x} is factored into @samp{x*(x+1)^2}. As another
23247 example, @expr{a c + b d + b c + a d} is factored into the product
23248 @expr{(a + b) (c + d)}.
23249
23250 Calc currently has three algorithms for factoring. Formulas which are
23251 linear in several variables, such as the second example above, are
23252 merged according to the distributive law. Formulas which are
23253 polynomials in a single variable, with constant integer or fractional
23254 coefficients, are factored into irreducible linear and/or quadratic
23255 terms. The first example above factors into three linear terms
23256 (@expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, and @expr{x+1} again). Finally, formulas
23257 which do not fit the above criteria are handled by the algebraic
23258 rewrite mechanism.
23259
23260 Calc's polynomial factorization algorithm works by using the general
23261 root-finding command (@w{@kbd{a P}}) to solve for the roots of the
23262 polynomial. It then looks for roots which are rational numbers
23263 or complex-conjugate pairs, and converts these into linear and
23264 quadratic terms, respectively. Because it uses floating-point
23265 arithmetic, it may be unable to find terms that involve large
23266 integers (whose number of digits approaches the current precision).
23267 Also, irreducible factors of degree higher than quadratic are not
23268 found, and polynomials in more than one variable are not treated.
23269 (A more robust factorization algorithm may be included in a future
23270 version of Calc.)
23271
23272 @vindex FactorRules
23273 @ignore
23274 @starindex
23275 @end ignore
23276 @tindex thecoefs
23277 @ignore
23278 @starindex
23279 @end ignore
23280 @ignore
23281 @mindex @idots
23282 @end ignore
23283 @tindex thefactors
23284 The rewrite-based factorization method uses rules stored in the variable
23285 @code{FactorRules}. @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of the
23286 operation of rewrite rules. The default @code{FactorRules} are able
23287 to factor quadratic forms symbolically into two linear terms,
23288 @expr{(a x + b) (c x + d)}. You can edit these rules to include other
23289 cases if you wish. To use the rules, Calc builds the formula
23290 @samp{thecoefs(x, [a, b, c, ...])} where @code{x} is the polynomial
23291 base variable and @code{a}, @code{b}, etc., are polynomial coefficients
23292 (which may be numbers or formulas). The constant term is written first,
23293 i.e., in the @code{a} position. When the rules complete, they should have
23294 changed the formula into the form @samp{thefactors(x, [f1, f2, f3, ...])}
23295 where each @code{fi} should be a factored term, e.g., @samp{x - ai}.
23296 Calc then multiplies these terms together to get the complete
23297 factored form of the polynomial. If the rules do not change the
23298 @code{thecoefs} call to a @code{thefactors} call, @kbd{a f} leaves the
23299 polynomial alone on the assumption that it is unfactorable. (Note that
23300 the function names @code{thecoefs} and @code{thefactors} are used only
23301 as placeholders; there are no actual Calc functions by those names.)
23302
23303 @kindex H a f
23304 @tindex factors
23305 The @kbd{H a f} [@code{factors}] command also factors a polynomial,
23306 but it returns a list of factors instead of an expression which is the
23307 product of the factors. Each factor is represented by a sub-vector
23308 of the factor, and the power with which it appears. For example,
23309 @expr{x^5 + x^4 - 33 x^3 + 63 x^2} factors to @expr{(x + 7) x^2 (x - 3)^2}
23310 in @kbd{a f}, or to @expr{[ [x, 2], [x+7, 1], [x-3, 2] ]} in @kbd{H a f}.
23311 If there is an overall numeric factor, it always comes first in the list.
23312 The functions @code{factor} and @code{factors} allow a second argument
23313 when written in algebraic form; @samp{factor(x,v)} factors @expr{x} with
23314 respect to the specific variable @expr{v}. The default is to factor with
23315 respect to all the variables that appear in @expr{x}.
23316
23317 @kindex a c
23318 @pindex calc-collect
23319 @tindex collect
23320 The @kbd{a c} (@code{calc-collect}) [@code{collect}] command rearranges a
23321 formula as a
23322 polynomial in a given variable, ordered in decreasing powers of that
23323 variable. For example, given @expr{1 + 2 x + 3 y + 4 x y^2} on
23324 the stack, @kbd{a c x} would produce @expr{(2 + 4 y^2) x + (1 + 3 y)},
23325 and @kbd{a c y} would produce @expr{(4 x) y^2 + 3 y + (1 + 2 x)}.
23326 The polynomial will be expanded out using the distributive law as
23327 necessary: Collecting @expr{x} in @expr{(x - 1)^3} produces
23328 @expr{x^3 - 3 x^2 + 3 x - 1}. Terms not involving @expr{x} will
23329 not be expanded.
23330
23331 The ``variable'' you specify at the prompt can actually be any
23332 expression: @kbd{a c ln(x+1)} will collect together all terms multiplied
23333 by @samp{ln(x+1)} or integer powers thereof. If @samp{x} also appears
23334 in the formula in a context other than @samp{ln(x+1)}, @kbd{a c} will
23335 treat those occurrences as unrelated to @samp{ln(x+1)}, i.e., as constants.
23336
23337 @kindex a x
23338 @pindex calc-expand
23339 @tindex expand
23340 The @kbd{a x} (@code{calc-expand}) [@code{expand}] command expands an
23341 expression by applying the distributive law everywhere. It applies to
23342 products, quotients, and powers involving sums. By default, it fully
23343 distributes all parts of the expression. With a numeric prefix argument,
23344 the distributive law is applied only the specified number of times, then
23345 the partially expanded expression is left on the stack.
23346
23347 The @kbd{a x} and @kbd{j D} commands are somewhat redundant. Use
23348 @kbd{a x} if you want to expand all products of sums in your formula.
23349 Use @kbd{j D} if you want to expand a particular specified term of
23350 the formula. There is an exactly analogous correspondence between
23351 @kbd{a f} and @kbd{j M}. (The @kbd{j D} and @kbd{j M} commands
23352 also know many other kinds of expansions, such as
23353 @samp{exp(a + b) = exp(a) exp(b)}, which @kbd{a x} and @kbd{a f}
23354 do not do.)
23355
23356 Calc's automatic simplifications will sometimes reverse a partial
23357 expansion. For example, the first step in expanding @expr{(x+1)^3} is
23358 to write @expr{(x+1) (x+1)^2}. If @kbd{a x} stops there and tries
23359 to put this formula onto the stack, though, Calc will automatically
23360 simplify it back to @expr{(x+1)^3} form. The solution is to turn
23361 simplification off first (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), or to run
23362 @kbd{a x} without a numeric prefix argument so that it expands all
23363 the way in one step.
23364
23365 @kindex a a
23366 @pindex calc-apart
23367 @tindex apart
23368 The @kbd{a a} (@code{calc-apart}) [@code{apart}] command expands a
23369 rational function by partial fractions. A rational function is the
23370 quotient of two polynomials; @code{apart} pulls this apart into a
23371 sum of rational functions with simple denominators. In algebraic
23372 notation, the @code{apart} function allows a second argument that
23373 specifies which variable to use as the ``base''; by default, Calc
23374 chooses the base variable automatically.
23375
23376 @kindex a n
23377 @pindex calc-normalize-rat
23378 @tindex nrat
23379 The @kbd{a n} (@code{calc-normalize-rat}) [@code{nrat}] command
23380 attempts to arrange a formula into a quotient of two polynomials.
23381 For example, given @expr{1 + (a + b/c) / d}, the result would be
23382 @expr{(b + a c + c d) / c d}. The quotient is reduced, so that
23383 @kbd{a n} will simplify @expr{(x^2 + 2x + 1) / (x^2 - 1)} by dividing
23384 out the common factor @expr{x + 1}, yielding @expr{(x + 1) / (x - 1)}.
23385
23386 @kindex a \
23387 @pindex calc-poly-div
23388 @tindex pdiv
23389 The @kbd{a \} (@code{calc-poly-div}) [@code{pdiv}] command divides
23390 two polynomials @expr{u} and @expr{v}, yielding a new polynomial
23391 @expr{q}. If several variables occur in the inputs, the inputs are
23392 considered multivariate polynomials. (Calc divides by the variable
23393 with the largest power in @expr{u} first, or, in the case of equal
23394 powers, chooses the variables in alphabetical order.) For example,
23395 dividing @expr{x^2 + 3 x + 2} by @expr{x + 2} yields @expr{x + 1}.
23396 The remainder from the division, if any, is reported at the bottom
23397 of the screen and is also placed in the Trail along with the quotient.
23398
23399 Using @code{pdiv} in algebraic notation, you can specify the particular
23400 variable to be used as the base: @code{pdiv(@var{a},@var{b},@var{x})}.
23401 If @code{pdiv} is given only two arguments (as is always the case with
23402 the @kbd{a \} command), then it does a multivariate division as outlined
23403 above.
23404
23405 @kindex a %
23406 @pindex calc-poly-rem
23407 @tindex prem
23408 The @kbd{a %} (@code{calc-poly-rem}) [@code{prem}] command divides
23409 two polynomials and keeps the remainder @expr{r}. The quotient
23410 @expr{q} is discarded. For any formulas @expr{a} and @expr{b}, the
23411 results of @kbd{a \} and @kbd{a %} satisfy @expr{a = q b + r}.
23412 (This is analogous to plain @kbd{\} and @kbd{%}, which compute the
23413 integer quotient and remainder from dividing two numbers.)
23414
23415 @kindex a /
23416 @kindex H a /
23417 @pindex calc-poly-div-rem
23418 @tindex pdivrem
23419 @tindex pdivide
23420 The @kbd{a /} (@code{calc-poly-div-rem}) [@code{pdivrem}] command
23421 divides two polynomials and reports both the quotient and the
23422 remainder as a vector @expr{[q, r]}. The @kbd{H a /} [@code{pdivide}]
23423 command divides two polynomials and constructs the formula
23424 @expr{q + r/b} on the stack. (Naturally if the remainder is zero,
23425 this will immediately simplify to @expr{q}.)
23426
23427 @kindex a g
23428 @pindex calc-poly-gcd
23429 @tindex pgcd
23430 The @kbd{a g} (@code{calc-poly-gcd}) [@code{pgcd}] command computes
23431 the greatest common divisor of two polynomials. (The GCD actually
23432 is unique only to within a constant multiplier; Calc attempts to
23433 choose a GCD which will be unsurprising.) For example, the @kbd{a n}
23434 command uses @kbd{a g} to take the GCD of the numerator and denominator
23435 of a quotient, then divides each by the result using @kbd{a \}. (The
23436 definition of GCD ensures that this division can take place without
23437 leaving a remainder.)
23438
23439 While the polynomials used in operations like @kbd{a /} and @kbd{a g}
23440 often have integer coefficients, this is not required. Calc can also
23441 deal with polynomials over the rationals or floating-point reals.
23442 Polynomials with modulo-form coefficients are also useful in many
23443 applications; if you enter @samp{(x^2 + 3 x - 1) mod 5}, Calc
23444 automatically transforms this into a polynomial over the field of
23445 integers mod 5: @samp{(1 mod 5) x^2 + (3 mod 5) x + (4 mod 5)}.
23446
23447 Congratulations and thanks go to Ove Ewerlid
23448 (@code{ewerlid@@mizar.DoCS.UU.SE}), who contributed many of the
23449 polynomial routines used in the above commands.
23450
23451 @xref{Decomposing Polynomials}, for several useful functions for
23452 extracting the individual coefficients of a polynomial.
23453
23454 @node Calculus, Solving Equations, Polynomials, Algebra
23455 @section Calculus
23456
23457 @noindent
23458 The following calculus commands do not automatically simplify their
23459 inputs or outputs using @code{calc-simplify}. You may find it helps
23460 to do this by hand by typing @kbd{a s} or @kbd{a e}. It may also help
23461 to use @kbd{a x} and/or @kbd{a c} to arrange a result in the most
23462 readable way.
23463
23464 @menu
23465 * Differentiation::
23466 * Integration::
23467 * Customizing the Integrator::
23468 * Numerical Integration::
23469 * Taylor Series::
23470 @end menu
23471
23472 @node Differentiation, Integration, Calculus, Calculus
23473 @subsection Differentiation
23474
23475 @noindent
23476 @kindex a d
23477 @kindex H a d
23478 @pindex calc-derivative
23479 @tindex deriv
23480 @tindex tderiv
23481 The @kbd{a d} (@code{calc-derivative}) [@code{deriv}] command computes
23482 the derivative of the expression on the top of the stack with respect to
23483 some variable, which it will prompt you to enter. Normally, variables
23484 in the formula other than the specified differentiation variable are
23485 considered constant, i.e., @samp{deriv(y,x)} is reduced to zero. With
23486 the Hyperbolic flag, the @code{tderiv} (total derivative) operation is used
23487 instead, in which derivatives of variables are not reduced to zero
23488 unless those variables are known to be ``constant,'' i.e., independent
23489 of any other variables. (The built-in special variables like @code{pi}
23490 are considered constant, as are variables that have been declared
23491 @code{const}; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23492
23493 With a numeric prefix argument @var{n}, this command computes the
23494 @var{n}th derivative.
23495
23496 When working with trigonometric functions, it is best to switch to
23497 Radians mode first (with @w{@kbd{m r}}). The derivative of @samp{sin(x)}
23498 in degrees is @samp{(pi/180) cos(x)}, probably not the expected
23499 answer!
23500
23501 If you use the @code{deriv} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23502 you can write @samp{deriv(f,x,x0)} which represents the derivative
23503 of @expr{f} with respect to @expr{x}, evaluated at the point
23504 @texline @math{x=x_0}.
23505 @infoline @expr{x=x0}.
23506
23507 If the formula being differentiated contains functions which Calc does
23508 not know, the derivatives of those functions are produced by adding
23509 primes (apostrophe characters). For example, @samp{deriv(f(2x), x)}
23510 produces @samp{2 f'(2 x)}, where the function @code{f'} represents the
23511 derivative of @code{f}.
23512
23513 For functions you have defined with the @kbd{Z F} command, Calc expands
23514 the functions according to their defining formulas unless you have
23515 also defined @code{f'} suitably. For example, suppose we define
23516 @samp{sinc(x) = sin(x)/x} using @kbd{Z F}. If we then differentiate
23517 the formula @samp{sinc(2 x)}, the formula will be expanded to
23518 @samp{sin(2 x) / (2 x)} and differentiated. However, if we also
23519 define @samp{sinc'(x) = dsinc(x)}, say, then Calc will write the
23520 result as @samp{2 dsinc(2 x)}. @xref{Algebraic Definitions}.
23521
23522 For multi-argument functions @samp{f(x,y,z)}, the derivative with respect
23523 to the first argument is written @samp{f'(x,y,z)}; derivatives with
23524 respect to the other arguments are @samp{f'2(x,y,z)} and @samp{f'3(x,y,z)}.
23525 Various higher-order derivatives can be formed in the obvious way, e.g.,
23526 @samp{f'@var{}'(x)} (the second derivative of @code{f}) or
23527 @samp{f'@var{}'2'3(x,y,z)} (@code{f} differentiated with respect to each
23528 argument once).
23529
23530 @node Integration, Customizing the Integrator, Differentiation, Calculus
23531 @subsection Integration
23532
23533 @noindent
23534 @kindex a i
23535 @pindex calc-integral
23536 @tindex integ
23537 The @kbd{a i} (@code{calc-integral}) [@code{integ}] command computes the
23538 indefinite integral of the expression on the top of the stack with
23539 respect to a prompted-for variable. The integrator is not guaranteed to
23540 work for all integrable functions, but it is able to integrate several
23541 large classes of formulas. In particular, any polynomial or rational
23542 function (a polynomial divided by a polynomial) is acceptable.
23543 (Rational functions don't have to be in explicit quotient form, however;
23544 @texline @math{x/(1+x^{-2})}
23545 @infoline @expr{x/(1+x^-2)}
23546 is not strictly a quotient of polynomials, but it is equivalent to
23547 @expr{x^3/(x^2+1)}, which is.) Also, square roots of terms involving
23548 @expr{x} and @expr{x^2} may appear in rational functions being
23549 integrated. Finally, rational functions involving trigonometric or
23550 hyperbolic functions can be integrated.
23551
23552 With an argument (@kbd{C-u a i}), this command will compute the definite
23553 integral of the expression on top of the stack. In this case, the
23554 command will again prompt for an integration variable, then prompt for a
23555 lower limit and an upper limit.
23556
23557 @ifnottex
23558 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23559 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23560 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23561 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23562 integral from @code{a} to @code{b}.
23563 @end ifnottex
23564 @tex
23565 If you use the @code{integ} function directly in an algebraic formula,
23566 you can also write @samp{integ(f,x,v)} which expresses the resulting
23567 indefinite integral in terms of variable @code{v} instead of @code{x}.
23568 With four arguments, @samp{integ(f(x),x,a,b)} represents a definite
23569 integral $\int_a^b f(x) \, dx$.
23570 @end tex
23571
23572 Please note that the current implementation of Calc's integrator sometimes
23573 produces results that are significantly more complex than they need to
23574 be. For example, the integral Calc finds for
23575 @texline @math{1/(x+\sqrt{x^2+1})}
23576 @infoline @expr{1/(x+sqrt(x^2+1))}
23577 is several times more complicated than the answer Mathematica
23578 returns for the same input, although the two forms are numerically
23579 equivalent. Also, any indefinite integral should be considered to have
23580 an arbitrary constant of integration added to it, although Calc does not
23581 write an explicit constant of integration in its result. For example,
23582 Calc's solution for
23583 @texline @math{1/(1+\tan x)}
23584 @infoline @expr{1/(1+tan(x))}
23585 differs from the solution given in the @emph{CRC Math Tables} by a
23586 constant factor of
23587 @texline @math{\pi i / 2}
23588 @infoline @expr{pi i / 2},
23589 due to a different choice of constant of integration.
23590
23591 The Calculator remembers all the integrals it has done. If conditions
23592 change in a way that would invalidate the old integrals, say, a switch
23593 from Degrees to Radians mode, then they will be thrown out. If you
23594 suspect this is not happening when it should, use the
23595 @code{calc-flush-caches} command; @pxref{Caches}.
23596
23597 @vindex IntegLimit
23598 Calc normally will pursue integration by substitution or integration by
23599 parts up to 3 nested times before abandoning an approach as fruitless.
23600 If the integrator is taking too long, you can lower this limit by storing
23601 a number (like 2) in the variable @code{IntegLimit}. (The @kbd{s I}
23602 command is a convenient way to edit @code{IntegLimit}.) If this variable
23603 has no stored value or does not contain a nonnegative integer, a limit
23604 of 3 is used. The lower this limit is, the greater the chance that Calc
23605 will be unable to integrate a function it could otherwise handle. Raising
23606 this limit allows the Calculator to solve more integrals, though the time
23607 it takes may grow exponentially. You can monitor the integrator's actions
23608 by creating an Emacs buffer called @file{*Trace*}. If such a buffer
23609 exists, the @kbd{a i} command will write a log of its actions there.
23610
23611 If you want to manipulate integrals in a purely symbolic way, you can
23612 set the integration nesting limit to 0 to prevent all but fast
23613 table-lookup solutions of integrals. You might then wish to define
23614 rewrite rules for integration by parts, various kinds of substitutions,
23615 and so on. @xref{Rewrite Rules}.
23616
23617 @node Customizing the Integrator, Numerical Integration, Integration, Calculus
23618 @subsection Customizing the Integrator
23619
23620 @noindent
23621 @vindex IntegRules
23622 Calc has two built-in rewrite rules called @code{IntegRules} and
23623 @code{IntegAfterRules} which you can edit to define new integration
23624 methods. @xref{Rewrite Rules}. At each step of the integration process,
23625 Calc wraps the current integrand in a call to the fictitious function
23626 @samp{integtry(@var{expr},@var{var})}, where @var{expr} is the
23627 integrand and @var{var} is the integration variable. If your rules
23628 rewrite this to be a plain formula (not a call to @code{integtry}), then
23629 Calc will use this formula as the integral of @var{expr}. For example,
23630 the rule @samp{integtry(mysin(x),x) := -mycos(x)} would define a rule to
23631 integrate a function @code{mysin} that acts like the sine function.
23632 Then, putting @samp{4 mysin(2y+1)} on the stack and typing @kbd{a i y}
23633 will produce the integral @samp{-2 mycos(2y+1)}. Note that Calc has
23634 automatically made various transformations on the integral to allow it
23635 to use your rule; integral tables generally give rules for
23636 @samp{mysin(a x + b)}, but you don't need to use this much generality
23637 in your @code{IntegRules}.
23638
23639 @cindex Exponential integral Ei(x)
23640 @ignore
23641 @starindex
23642 @end ignore
23643 @tindex Ei
23644 As a more serious example, the expression @samp{exp(x)/x} cannot be
23645 integrated in terms of the standard functions, so the ``exponential
23646 integral'' function
23647 @texline @math{{\rm Ei}(x)}
23648 @infoline @expr{Ei(x)}
23649 was invented to describe it.
23650 We can get Calc to do this integral in terms of a made-up @code{Ei}
23651 function by adding the rule @samp{[integtry(exp(x)/x, x) := Ei(x)]}
23652 to @code{IntegRules}. Now entering @samp{exp(2x)/x} on the stack
23653 and typing @kbd{a i x} yields @samp{Ei(2 x)}. This new rule will
23654 work with Calc's various built-in integration methods (such as
23655 integration by substitution) to solve a variety of other problems
23656 involving @code{Ei}: For example, now Calc will also be able to
23657 integrate @samp{exp(exp(x))} and @samp{ln(ln(x))} (to get @samp{Ei(exp(x))}
23658 and @samp{x ln(ln(x)) - Ei(ln(x))}, respectively).
23659
23660 Your rule may do further integration by calling @code{integ}. For
23661 example, @samp{integtry(twice(u),x) := twice(integ(u))} allows Calc
23662 to integrate @samp{twice(sin(x))} to get @samp{twice(-cos(x))}.
23663 Note that @code{integ} was called with only one argument. This notation
23664 is allowed only within @code{IntegRules}; it means ``integrate this
23665 with respect to the same integration variable.'' If Calc is unable
23666 to integrate @code{u}, the integration that invoked @code{IntegRules}
23667 also fails. Thus integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} fails, returning the
23668 unevaluated integral @samp{integ(twice(f(x)), x)}. It is still valid
23669 to call @code{integ} with two or more arguments, however; in this case,
23670 if @code{u} is not integrable, @code{twice} itself will still be
23671 integrated: If the above rule is changed to @samp{... := twice(integ(u,x))},
23672 then integrating @samp{twice(f(x))} will yield @samp{twice(integ(f(x),x))}.
23673
23674 If a rule instead produces the formula @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr},
23675 @var{svar})}, either replacing the top-level @code{integtry} call or
23676 nested anywhere inside the expression, then Calc will apply the
23677 substitution @samp{@var{u} = @var{sexpr}(@var{svar})} to try to
23678 integrate the original @var{expr}. For example, the rule
23679 @samp{sqrt(a) := integsubst(sqrt(x),x)} says that if Calc ever finds
23680 a square root in the integrand, it should attempt the substitution
23681 @samp{u = sqrt(x)}. (This particular rule is unnecessary because
23682 Calc always tries ``obvious'' substitutions where @var{sexpr} actually
23683 appears in the integrand.) The variable @var{svar} may be the same
23684 as the @var{var} that appeared in the call to @code{integtry}, but
23685 it need not be.
23686
23687 When integrating according to an @code{integsubst}, Calc uses the
23688 equation solver to find the inverse of @var{sexpr} (if the integrand
23689 refers to @var{var} anywhere except in subexpressions that exactly
23690 match @var{sexpr}). It uses the differentiator to find the derivative
23691 of @var{sexpr} and/or its inverse (it has two methods that use one
23692 derivative or the other). You can also specify these items by adding
23693 extra arguments to the @code{integsubst} your rules construct; the
23694 general form is @samp{integsubst(@var{sexpr}, @var{svar}, @var{sinv},
23695 @var{sprime})}, where @var{sinv} is the inverse of @var{sexpr} (still
23696 written as a function of @var{svar}), and @var{sprime} is the
23697 derivative of @var{sexpr} with respect to @var{svar}. If you don't
23698 specify these things, and Calc is not able to work them out on its
23699 own with the information it knows, then your substitution rule will
23700 work only in very specific, simple cases.
23701
23702 Calc applies @code{IntegRules} as if by @kbd{C-u 1 a r IntegRules};
23703 in other words, Calc stops rewriting as soon as any rule in your rule
23704 set succeeds. (If it weren't for this, the @samp{integsubst(sqrt(x),x)}
23705 example above would keep on adding layers of @code{integsubst} calls
23706 forever!)
23707
23708 @vindex IntegSimpRules
23709 Another set of rules, stored in @code{IntegSimpRules}, are applied
23710 every time the integrator uses algebraic simplifications to simplify an
23711 intermediate result. For example, putting the rule
23712 @samp{twice(x) := 2 x} into @code{IntegSimpRules} would tell Calc to
23713 convert the @code{twice} function into a form it knows whenever
23714 integration is attempted.
23715
23716 One more way to influence the integrator is to define a function with
23717 the @kbd{Z F} command (@pxref{Algebraic Definitions}). Calc's
23718 integrator automatically expands such functions according to their
23719 defining formulas, even if you originally asked for the function to
23720 be left unevaluated for symbolic arguments. (Certain other Calc
23721 systems, such as the differentiator and the equation solver, also
23722 do this.)
23723
23724 @vindex IntegAfterRules
23725 Sometimes Calc is able to find a solution to your integral, but it
23726 expresses the result in a way that is unnecessarily complicated. If
23727 this happens, you can either use @code{integsubst} as described
23728 above to try to hint at a more direct path to the desired result, or
23729 you can use @code{IntegAfterRules}. This is an extra rule set that
23730 runs after the main integrator returns its result; basically, Calc does
23731 an @kbd{a r IntegAfterRules} on the result before showing it to you.
23732 (It also does algebraic simplifications, without @code{IntegSimpRules},
23733 after that to further simplify the result.) For example, Calc's integrator
23734 sometimes produces expressions of the form @samp{ln(1+x) - ln(1-x)};
23735 the default @code{IntegAfterRules} rewrite this into the more readable
23736 form @samp{2 arctanh(x)}. Note that, unlike @code{IntegRules},
23737 @code{IntegSimpRules} and @code{IntegAfterRules} are applied any number
23738 of times until no further changes are possible. Rewriting by
23739 @code{IntegAfterRules} occurs only after the main integrator has
23740 finished, not at every step as for @code{IntegRules} and
23741 @code{IntegSimpRules}.
23742
23743 @node Numerical Integration, Taylor Series, Customizing the Integrator, Calculus
23744 @subsection Numerical Integration
23745
23746 @noindent
23747 @kindex a I
23748 @pindex calc-num-integral
23749 @tindex ninteg
23750 If you want a purely numerical answer to an integration problem, you can
23751 use the @kbd{a I} (@code{calc-num-integral}) [@code{ninteg}] command. This
23752 command prompts for an integration variable, a lower limit, and an
23753 upper limit. Except for the integration variable, all other variables
23754 that appear in the integrand formula must have stored values. (A stored
23755 value, if any, for the integration variable itself is ignored.)
23756
23757 Numerical integration works by evaluating your formula at many points in
23758 the specified interval. Calc uses an ``open Romberg'' method; this means
23759 that it does not evaluate the formula actually at the endpoints (so that
23760 it is safe to integrate @samp{sin(x)/x} from zero, for example). Also,
23761 the Romberg method works especially well when the function being
23762 integrated is fairly smooth. If the function is not smooth, Calc will
23763 have to evaluate it at quite a few points before it can accurately
23764 determine the value of the integral.
23765
23766 Integration is much faster when the current precision is small. It is
23767 best to set the precision to the smallest acceptable number of digits
23768 before you use @kbd{a I}. If Calc appears to be taking too long, press
23769 @kbd{C-g} to halt it and try a lower precision. If Calc still appears
23770 to need hundreds of evaluations, check to make sure your function is
23771 well-behaved in the specified interval.
23772
23773 It is possible for the lower integration limit to be @samp{-inf} (minus
23774 infinity). Likewise, the upper limit may be plus infinity. Calc
23775 internally transforms the integral into an equivalent one with finite
23776 limits. However, integration to or across singularities is not supported:
23777 The integral of @samp{1/sqrt(x)} from 0 to 1 exists (it can be found
23778 by Calc's symbolic integrator, for example), but @kbd{a I} will fail
23779 because the integrand goes to infinity at one of the endpoints.
23780
23781 @node Taylor Series, , Numerical Integration, Calculus
23782 @subsection Taylor Series
23783
23784 @noindent
23785 @kindex a t
23786 @pindex calc-taylor
23787 @tindex taylor
23788 The @kbd{a t} (@code{calc-taylor}) [@code{taylor}] command computes a
23789 power series expansion or Taylor series of a function. You specify the
23790 variable and the desired number of terms. You may give an expression of
23791 the form @samp{@var{var} = @var{a}} or @samp{@var{var} - @var{a}} instead
23792 of just a variable to produce a Taylor expansion about the point @var{a}.
23793 You may specify the number of terms with a numeric prefix argument;
23794 otherwise the command will prompt you for the number of terms. Note that
23795 many series expansions have coefficients of zero for some terms, so you
23796 may appear to get fewer terms than you asked for.
23797
23798 If the @kbd{a i} command is unable to find a symbolic integral for a
23799 function, you can get an approximation by integrating the function's
23800 Taylor series.
23801
23802 @node Solving Equations, Numerical Solutions, Calculus, Algebra
23803 @section Solving Equations
23804
23805 @noindent
23806 @kindex a S
23807 @pindex calc-solve-for
23808 @tindex solve
23809 @cindex Equations, solving
23810 @cindex Solving equations
23811 The @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) [@code{solve}] command rearranges
23812 an equation to solve for a specific variable. An equation is an
23813 expression of the form @expr{L = R}. For example, the command @kbd{a S x}
23814 will rearrange @expr{y = 3x + 6} to the form, @expr{x = y/3 - 2}. If the
23815 input is not an equation, it is treated like an equation of the
23816 form @expr{X = 0}.
23817
23818 This command also works for inequalities, as in @expr{y < 3x + 6}.
23819 Some inequalities cannot be solved where the analogous equation could
23820 be; for example, solving
23821 @texline @math{a < b \, c}
23822 @infoline @expr{a < b c}
23823 for @expr{b} is impossible
23824 without knowing the sign of @expr{c}. In this case, @kbd{a S} will
23825 produce the result
23826 @texline @math{b \mathbin{\hbox{\code{!=}}} a/c}
23827 @infoline @expr{b != a/c}
23828 (using the not-equal-to operator) to signify that the direction of the
23829 inequality is now unknown. The inequality
23830 @texline @math{a \le b \, c}
23831 @infoline @expr{a <= b c}
23832 is not even partially solved. @xref{Declarations}, for a way to tell
23833 Calc that the signs of the variables in a formula are in fact known.
23834
23835 Two useful commands for working with the result of @kbd{a S} are
23836 @kbd{a .} (@pxref{Logical Operations}), which converts @expr{x = y/3 - 2}
23837 to @expr{y/3 - 2}, and @kbd{s l} (@pxref{Let Command}) which evaluates
23838 another formula with @expr{x} set equal to @expr{y/3 - 2}.
23839
23840 @menu
23841 * Multiple Solutions::
23842 * Solving Systems of Equations::
23843 * Decomposing Polynomials::
23844 @end menu
23845
23846 @node Multiple Solutions, Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations, Solving Equations
23847 @subsection Multiple Solutions
23848
23849 @noindent
23850 @kindex H a S
23851 @tindex fsolve
23852 Some equations have more than one solution. The Hyperbolic flag
23853 (@code{H a S}) [@code{fsolve}] tells the solver to report the fully
23854 general family of solutions. It will invent variables @code{n1},
23855 @code{n2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary integers, and
23856 @code{s1}, @code{s2}, @dots{}, which represent independent arbitrary
23857 signs (either @mathit{+1} or @mathit{-1}). If you don't use the Hyperbolic
23858 flag, Calc will use zero in place of all arbitrary integers, and plus
23859 one in place of all arbitrary signs. Note that variables like @code{n1}
23860 and @code{s1} are not given any special interpretation in Calc except by
23861 the equation solver itself. As usual, you can use the @w{@kbd{s l}}
23862 (@code{calc-let}) command to obtain solutions for various actual values
23863 of these variables.
23864
23865 For example, @kbd{' x^2 = y @key{RET} H a S x @key{RET}} solves to
23866 get @samp{x = s1 sqrt(y)}, indicating that the two solutions to the
23867 equation are @samp{sqrt(y)} and @samp{-sqrt(y)}. Another way to
23868 think about it is that the square-root operation is really a
23869 two-valued function; since every Calc function must return a
23870 single result, @code{sqrt} chooses to return the positive result.
23871 Then @kbd{H a S} doctors this result using @code{s1} to indicate
23872 the full set of possible values of the mathematical square-root.
23873
23874 There is a similar phenomenon going the other direction: Suppose
23875 we solve @samp{sqrt(y) = x} for @code{y}. Calc squares both sides
23876 to get @samp{y = x^2}. This is correct, except that it introduces
23877 some dubious solutions. Consider solving @samp{sqrt(y) = -3}:
23878 Calc will report @expr{y = 9} as a valid solution, which is true
23879 in the mathematical sense of square-root, but false (there is no
23880 solution) for the actual Calc positive-valued @code{sqrt}. This
23881 happens for both @kbd{a S} and @kbd{H a S}.
23882
23883 @cindex @code{GenCount} variable
23884 @vindex GenCount
23885 @ignore
23886 @starindex
23887 @end ignore
23888 @tindex an
23889 @ignore
23890 @starindex
23891 @end ignore
23892 @tindex as
23893 If you store a positive integer in the Calc variable @code{GenCount},
23894 then Calc will generate formulas of the form @samp{as(@var{n})} for
23895 arbitrary signs, and @samp{an(@var{n})} for arbitrary integers,
23896 where @var{n} represents successive values taken by incrementing
23897 @code{GenCount} by one. While the normal arbitrary sign and
23898 integer symbols start over at @code{s1} and @code{n1} with each
23899 new Calc command, the @code{GenCount} approach will give each
23900 arbitrary value a name that is unique throughout the entire Calc
23901 session. Also, the arbitrary values are function calls instead
23902 of variables, which is advantageous in some cases. For example,
23903 you can make a rewrite rule that recognizes all arbitrary signs
23904 using a pattern like @samp{as(n)}. The @kbd{s l} command only works
23905 on variables, but you can use the @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
23906 command to substitute actual values for function calls like @samp{as(3)}.
23907
23908 The @kbd{s G} (@code{calc-edit-GenCount}) command is a convenient
23909 way to create or edit this variable. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish.
23910
23911 If you have not stored a value in @code{GenCount}, or if the value
23912 in that variable is not a positive integer, the regular
23913 @code{s1}/@code{n1} notation is used.
23914
23915 @kindex I a S
23916 @kindex H I a S
23917 @tindex finv
23918 @tindex ffinv
23919 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a S} [@code{finv}] treats the expression
23920 on top of the stack as a function of the specified variable and solves
23921 to find the inverse function, written in terms of the same variable.
23922 For example, @kbd{I a S x} inverts @expr{2x + 6} to @expr{x/2 - 3}.
23923 You can use both Inverse and Hyperbolic [@code{ffinv}] to obtain a
23924 fully general inverse, as described above.
23925
23926 @kindex a P
23927 @pindex calc-poly-roots
23928 @tindex roots
23929 Some equations, specifically polynomials, have a known, finite number
23930 of solutions. The @kbd{a P} (@code{calc-poly-roots}) [@code{roots}]
23931 command uses @kbd{H a S} to solve an equation in general form, then, for
23932 all arbitrary-sign variables like @code{s1}, and all arbitrary-integer
23933 variables like @code{n1} for which @code{n1} only usefully varies over
23934 a finite range, it expands these variables out to all their possible
23935 values. The results are collected into a vector, which is returned.
23936 For example, @samp{roots(x^4 = 1, x)} returns the four solutions
23937 @samp{[1, -1, (0, 1), (0, -1)]}. Generally an @var{n}th degree
23938 polynomial will always have @var{n} roots on the complex plane.
23939 (If you have given a @code{real} declaration for the solution
23940 variable, then only the real-valued solutions, if any, will be
23941 reported; @pxref{Declarations}.)
23942
23943 Note that because @kbd{a P} uses @kbd{H a S}, it is able to deliver
23944 symbolic solutions if the polynomial has symbolic coefficients. Also
23945 note that Calc's solver is not able to get exact symbolic solutions
23946 to all polynomials. Polynomials containing powers up to @expr{x^4}
23947 can always be solved exactly; polynomials of higher degree sometimes
23948 can be: @expr{x^6 + x^3 + 1} is converted to @expr{(x^3)^2 + (x^3) + 1},
23949 which can be solved for @expr{x^3} using the quadratic equation, and then
23950 for @expr{x} by taking cube roots. But in many cases, like
23951 @expr{x^6 + x + 1}, Calc does not know how to rewrite the polynomial
23952 into a form it can solve. The @kbd{a P} command can still deliver a
23953 list of numerical roots, however, provided that Symbolic mode (@kbd{m s})
23954 is not turned on. (If you work with Symbolic mode on, recall that the
23955 @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) key is a handy way to reevaluate the
23956 formula on the stack with Symbolic mode temporarily off.) Naturally,
23957 @kbd{a P} can only provide numerical roots if the polynomial coefficients
23958 are all numbers (real or complex).
23959
23960 @node Solving Systems of Equations, Decomposing Polynomials, Multiple Solutions, Solving Equations
23961 @subsection Solving Systems of Equations
23962
23963 @noindent
23964 @cindex Systems of equations, symbolic
23965 You can also use the commands described above to solve systems of
23966 simultaneous equations. Just create a vector of equations, then
23967 specify a vector of variables for which to solve. (You can omit
23968 the surrounding brackets when entering the vector of variables
23969 at the prompt.)
23970
23971 For example, putting @samp{[x + y = a, x - y = b]} on the stack
23972 and typing @kbd{a S x,y @key{RET}} produces the vector of solutions
23973 @samp{[x = a - (a-b)/2, y = (a-b)/2]}. The result vector will
23974 have the same length as the variables vector, and the variables
23975 will be listed in the same order there. Note that the solutions
23976 are not always simplified as far as possible; the solution for
23977 @expr{x} here could be improved by an application of the @kbd{a n}
23978 command.
23979
23980 Calc's algorithm works by trying to eliminate one variable at a
23981 time by solving one of the equations for that variable and then
23982 substituting into the other equations. Calc will try all the
23983 possibilities, but you can speed things up by noting that Calc
23984 first tries to eliminate the first variable with the first
23985 equation, then the second variable with the second equation,
23986 and so on. It also helps to put the simpler (e.g., more linear)
23987 equations toward the front of the list. Calc's algorithm will
23988 solve any system of linear equations, and also many kinds of
23989 nonlinear systems.
23990
23991 @ignore
23992 @starindex
23993 @end ignore
23994 @tindex elim
23995 Normally there will be as many variables as equations. If you
23996 give fewer variables than equations (an ``over-determined'' system
23997 of equations), Calc will find a partial solution. For example,
23998 typing @kbd{a S y @key{RET}} with the above system of equations
23999 would produce @samp{[y = a - x]}. There are now several ways to
24000 express this solution in terms of the original variables; Calc uses
24001 the first one that it finds. You can control the choice by adding
24002 variable specifiers of the form @samp{elim(@var{v})} to the
24003 variables list. This says that @var{v} should be eliminated from
24004 the equations; the variable will not appear at all in the solution.
24005 For example, typing @kbd{a S y,elim(x)} would yield
24006 @samp{[y = a - (b+a)/2]}.
24007
24008 If the variables list contains only @code{elim} specifiers,
24009 Calc simply eliminates those variables from the equations
24010 and then returns the resulting set of equations. For example,
24011 @kbd{a S elim(x)} produces @samp{[a - 2 y = b]}. Every variable
24012 eliminated will reduce the number of equations in the system
24013 by one.
24014
24015 Again, @kbd{a S} gives you one solution to the system of
24016 equations. If there are several solutions, you can use @kbd{H a S}
24017 to get a general family of solutions, or, if there is a finite
24018 number of solutions, you can use @kbd{a P} to get a list. (In
24019 the latter case, the result will take the form of a matrix where
24020 the rows are different solutions and the columns correspond to the
24021 variables you requested.)
24022
24023 Another way to deal with certain kinds of overdetermined systems of
24024 equations is the @kbd{a F} command, which does least-squares fitting
24025 to satisfy the equations. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
24026
24027 @node Decomposing Polynomials, , Solving Systems of Equations, Solving Equations
24028 @subsection Decomposing Polynomials
24029
24030 @noindent
24031 @ignore
24032 @starindex
24033 @end ignore
24034 @tindex poly
24035 The @code{poly} function takes a polynomial and a variable as
24036 arguments, and returns a vector of polynomial coefficients (constant
24037 coefficient first). For example, @samp{poly(x^3 + 2 x, x)} returns
24038 @expr{[0, 2, 0, 1]}. If the input is not a polynomial in @expr{x},
24039 the call to @code{poly} is left in symbolic form. If the input does
24040 not involve the variable @expr{x}, the input is returned in a list
24041 of length one, representing a polynomial with only a constant
24042 coefficient. The call @samp{poly(x, x)} returns the vector @expr{[0, 1]}.
24043 The last element of the returned vector is guaranteed to be nonzero;
24044 note that @samp{poly(0, x)} returns the empty vector @expr{[]}.
24045 Note also that @expr{x} may actually be any formula; for example,
24046 @samp{poly(sin(x)^2 - sin(x) + 3, sin(x))} returns @expr{[3, -1, 1]}.
24047
24048 @cindex Coefficients of polynomial
24049 @cindex Degree of polynomial
24050 To get the @expr{x^k} coefficient of polynomial @expr{p}, use
24051 @samp{poly(p, x)_(k+1)}. To get the degree of polynomial @expr{p},
24052 use @samp{vlen(poly(p, x)) - 1}. For example, @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)}
24053 returns @samp{[1, 4, 6, 4, 1]}, so @samp{poly((x+1)^4, x)_(2+1)}
24054 gives the @expr{x^2} coefficient of this polynomial, 6.
24055
24056 @ignore
24057 @starindex
24058 @end ignore
24059 @tindex gpoly
24060 One important feature of the solver is its ability to recognize
24061 formulas which are ``essentially'' polynomials. This ability is
24062 made available to the user through the @code{gpoly} function, which
24063 is used just like @code{poly}: @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var})}.
24064 If @var{expr} is a polynomial in some term which includes @var{var}, then
24065 this function will return a vector @samp{[@var{x}, @var{c}, @var{a}]}
24066 where @var{x} is the term that depends on @var{var}, @var{c} is a
24067 vector of polynomial coefficients (like the one returned by @code{poly}),
24068 and @var{a} is a multiplier which is usually 1. Basically,
24069 @samp{@var{expr} = @var{a}*(@var{c}_1 + @var{c}_2 @var{x} +
24070 @var{c}_3 @var{x}^2 + ...)}. The last element of @var{c} is
24071 guaranteed to be non-zero, and @var{c} will not equal @samp{[1]}
24072 (i.e., the trivial decomposition @var{expr} = @var{x} is not
24073 considered a polynomial). One side effect is that @samp{gpoly(x, x)}
24074 and @samp{gpoly(6, x)}, both of which might be expected to recognize
24075 their arguments as polynomials, will not because the decomposition
24076 is considered trivial.
24077
24078 For example, @samp{gpoly((x-2)^2, x)} returns @samp{[x, [4, -4, 1], 1]},
24079 since the expanded form of this polynomial is @expr{4 - 4 x + x^2}.
24080
24081 The term @var{x} may itself be a polynomial in @var{var}. This is
24082 done to reduce the size of the @var{c} vector. For example,
24083 @samp{gpoly(x^4 + x^2 - 1, x)} returns @samp{[x^2, [-1, 1, 1], 1]},
24084 since a quadratic polynomial in @expr{x^2} is easier to solve than
24085 a quartic polynomial in @expr{x}.
24086
24087 A few more examples of the kinds of polynomials @code{gpoly} can
24088 discover:
24089
24090 @smallexample
24091 sin(x) - 1 [sin(x), [-1, 1], 1]
24092 x + 1/x - 1 [x, [1, -1, 1], 1/x]
24093 x + 1/x [x^2, [1, 1], 1/x]
24094 x^3 + 2 x [x^2, [2, 1], x]
24095 x + x^2:3 + sqrt(x) [x^1:6, [1, 1, 0, 1], x^1:2]
24096 x^(2a) + 2 x^a + 5 [x^a, [5, 2, 1], 1]
24097 (exp(-x) + exp(x)) / 2 [e^(2 x), [0.5, 0.5], e^-x]
24098 @end smallexample
24099
24100 The @code{poly} and @code{gpoly} functions accept a third integer argument
24101 which specifies the largest degree of polynomial that is acceptable.
24102 If this is @expr{n}, then only @var{c} vectors of length @expr{n+1}
24103 or less will be returned. Otherwise, the @code{poly} or @code{gpoly}
24104 call will remain in symbolic form. For example, the equation solver
24105 can handle quartics and smaller polynomials, so it calls
24106 @samp{gpoly(@var{expr}, @var{var}, 4)} to discover whether @var{expr}
24107 can be treated by its linear, quadratic, cubic, or quartic formulas.
24108
24109 @ignore
24110 @starindex
24111 @end ignore
24112 @tindex pdeg
24113 The @code{pdeg} function computes the degree of a polynomial;
24114 @samp{pdeg(p,x)} is the highest power of @code{x} that appears in
24115 @code{p}. This is the same as @samp{vlen(poly(p,x))-1}, but is
24116 much more efficient. If @code{p} is constant with respect to @code{x},
24117 then @samp{pdeg(p,x) = 0}. If @code{p} is not a polynomial in @code{x}
24118 (e.g., @samp{pdeg(2 cos(x), x)}, the function remains unevaluated.
24119 It is possible to omit the second argument @code{x}, in which case
24120 @samp{pdeg(p)} returns the highest total degree of any term of the
24121 polynomial, counting all variables that appear in @code{p}. Note
24122 that @code{pdeg(c) = pdeg(c,x) = 0} for any nonzero constant @code{c};
24123 the degree of the constant zero is considered to be @code{-inf}
24124 (minus infinity).
24125
24126 @ignore
24127 @starindex
24128 @end ignore
24129 @tindex plead
24130 The @code{plead} function finds the leading term of a polynomial.
24131 Thus @samp{plead(p,x)} is equivalent to @samp{poly(p,x)_vlen(poly(p,x))},
24132 though again more efficient. In particular, @samp{plead((2x+1)^10, x)}
24133 returns 1024 without expanding out the list of coefficients. The
24134 value of @code{plead(p,x)} will be zero only if @expr{p = 0}.
24135
24136 @ignore
24137 @starindex
24138 @end ignore
24139 @tindex pcont
24140 The @code{pcont} function finds the @dfn{content} of a polynomial. This
24141 is the greatest common divisor of all the coefficients of the polynomial.
24142 With two arguments, @code{pcont(p,x)} effectively uses @samp{poly(p,x)}
24143 to get a list of coefficients, then uses @code{pgcd} (the polynomial
24144 GCD function) to combine these into an answer. For example,
24145 @samp{pcont(4 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y, x)} is @samp{2 y}. The content is
24146 basically the ``biggest'' polynomial that can be divided into @code{p}
24147 exactly. The sign of the content is the same as the sign of the leading
24148 coefficient.
24149
24150 With only one argument, @samp{pcont(p)} computes the numerical
24151 content of the polynomial, i.e., the @code{gcd} of the numerical
24152 coefficients of all the terms in the formula. Note that @code{gcd}
24153 is defined on rational numbers as well as integers; it computes
24154 the @code{gcd} of the numerators and the @code{lcm} of the
24155 denominators. Thus @samp{pcont(4:3 x y^2 + 6 x^2 y)} returns 2:3.
24156 Dividing the polynomial by this number will clear all the
24157 denominators, as well as dividing by any common content in the
24158 numerators. The numerical content of a polynomial is negative only
24159 if all the coefficients in the polynomial are negative.
24160
24161 @ignore
24162 @starindex
24163 @end ignore
24164 @tindex pprim
24165 The @code{pprim} function finds the @dfn{primitive part} of a
24166 polynomial, which is simply the polynomial divided (using @code{pdiv}
24167 if necessary) by its content. If the input polynomial has rational
24168 coefficients, the result will have integer coefficients in simplest
24169 terms.
24170
24171 @node Numerical Solutions, Curve Fitting, Solving Equations, Algebra
24172 @section Numerical Solutions
24173
24174 @noindent
24175 Not all equations can be solved symbolically. The commands in this
24176 section use numerical algorithms that can find a solution to a specific
24177 instance of an equation to any desired accuracy. Note that the
24178 numerical commands are slower than their algebraic cousins; it is a
24179 good idea to try @kbd{a S} before resorting to these commands.
24180
24181 (@xref{Curve Fitting}, for some other, more specialized, operations
24182 on numerical data.)
24183
24184 @menu
24185 * Root Finding::
24186 * Minimization::
24187 * Numerical Systems of Equations::
24188 @end menu
24189
24190 @node Root Finding, Minimization, Numerical Solutions, Numerical Solutions
24191 @subsection Root Finding
24192
24193 @noindent
24194 @kindex a R
24195 @pindex calc-find-root
24196 @tindex root
24197 @cindex Newton's method
24198 @cindex Roots of equations
24199 @cindex Numerical root-finding
24200 The @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}) [@code{root}] command finds a
24201 numerical solution (or @dfn{root}) of an equation. (This command treats
24202 inequalities the same as equations. If the input is any other kind
24203 of formula, it is interpreted as an equation of the form @expr{X = 0}.)
24204
24205 The @kbd{a R} command requires an initial guess on the top of the
24206 stack, and a formula in the second-to-top position. It prompts for a
24207 solution variable, which must appear in the formula. All other variables
24208 that appear in the formula must have assigned values, i.e., when
24209 a value is assigned to the solution variable and the formula is
24210 evaluated with @kbd{=}, it should evaluate to a number. Any assigned
24211 value for the solution variable itself is ignored and unaffected by
24212 this command.
24213
24214 When the command completes, the initial guess is replaced on the stack
24215 by a vector of two numbers: The value of the solution variable that
24216 solves the equation, and the difference between the lefthand and
24217 righthand sides of the equation at that value. Ordinarily, the second
24218 number will be zero or very nearly zero. (Note that Calc uses a
24219 slightly higher precision while finding the root, and thus the second
24220 number may be slightly different from the value you would compute from
24221 the equation yourself.)
24222
24223 The @kbd{v h} (@code{calc-head}) command is a handy way to extract
24224 the first element of the result vector, discarding the error term.
24225
24226 The initial guess can be a real number, in which case Calc searches
24227 for a real solution near that number, or a complex number, in which
24228 case Calc searches the whole complex plane near that number for a
24229 solution, or it can be an interval form which restricts the search
24230 to real numbers inside that interval.
24231
24232 Calc tries to use @kbd{a d} to take the derivative of the equation.
24233 If this succeeds, it uses Newton's method. If the equation is not
24234 differentiable Calc uses a bisection method. (If Newton's method
24235 appears to be going astray, Calc switches over to bisection if it
24236 can, or otherwise gives up. In this case it may help to try again
24237 with a slightly different initial guess.) If the initial guess is a
24238 complex number, the function must be differentiable.
24239
24240 If the formula (or the difference between the sides of an equation)
24241 is negative at one end of the interval you specify and positive at
24242 the other end, the root finder is guaranteed to find a root.
24243 Otherwise, Calc subdivides the interval into small parts looking for
24244 positive and negative values to bracket the root. When your guess is
24245 an interval, Calc will not look outside that interval for a root.
24246
24247 @kindex H a R
24248 @tindex wroot
24249 The @kbd{H a R} [@code{wroot}] command is similar to @kbd{a R}, except
24250 that if the initial guess is an interval for which the function has
24251 the same sign at both ends, then rather than subdividing the interval
24252 Calc attempts to widen it to enclose a root. Use this mode if
24253 you are not sure if the function has a root in your interval.
24254
24255 If the function is not differentiable, and you give a simple number
24256 instead of an interval as your initial guess, Calc uses this widening
24257 process even if you did not type the Hyperbolic flag. (If the function
24258 @emph{is} differentiable, Calc uses Newton's method which does not
24259 require a bounding interval in order to work.)
24260
24261 If Calc leaves the @code{root} or @code{wroot} function in symbolic
24262 form on the stack, it will normally display an explanation for why
24263 no root was found. If you miss this explanation, press @kbd{w}
24264 (@code{calc-why}) to get it back.
24265
24266 @node Minimization, Numerical Systems of Equations, Root Finding, Numerical Solutions
24267 @subsection Minimization
24268
24269 @noindent
24270 @kindex a N
24271 @kindex H a N
24272 @kindex a X
24273 @kindex H a X
24274 @pindex calc-find-minimum
24275 @pindex calc-find-maximum
24276 @tindex minimize
24277 @tindex maximize
24278 @cindex Minimization, numerical
24279 The @kbd{a N} (@code{calc-find-minimum}) [@code{minimize}] command
24280 finds a minimum value for a formula. It is very similar in operation
24281 to @kbd{a R} (@code{calc-find-root}): You give the formula and an initial
24282 guess on the stack, and are prompted for the name of a variable. The guess
24283 may be either a number near the desired minimum, or an interval enclosing
24284 the desired minimum. The function returns a vector containing the
24285 value of the variable which minimizes the formula's value, along
24286 with the minimum value itself.
24287
24288 Note that this command looks for a @emph{local} minimum. Many functions
24289 have more than one minimum; some, like
24290 @texline @math{x \sin x},
24291 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)},
24292 have infinitely many. In fact, there is no easy way to define the
24293 ``global'' minimum of
24294 @texline @math{x \sin x}
24295 @infoline @expr{x sin(x)}
24296 but Calc can still locate any particular local minimum
24297 for you. Calc basically goes downhill from the initial guess until it
24298 finds a point at which the function's value is greater both to the left
24299 and to the right. Calc does not use derivatives when minimizing a function.
24300
24301 If your initial guess is an interval and it looks like the minimum
24302 occurs at one or the other endpoint of the interval, Calc will return
24303 that endpoint only if that endpoint is closed; thus, minimizing @expr{17 x}
24304 over @expr{[2..3]} will return @expr{[2, 38]}, but minimizing over
24305 @expr{(2..3]} would report no minimum found. In general, you should
24306 use closed intervals to find literally the minimum value in that
24307 range of @expr{x}, or open intervals to find the local minimum, if
24308 any, that happens to lie in that range.
24309
24310 Most functions are smooth and flat near their minimum values. Because
24311 of this flatness, if the current precision is, say, 12 digits, the
24312 variable can only be determined meaningfully to about six digits. Thus
24313 you should set the precision to twice as many digits as you need in your
24314 answer.
24315
24316 @ignore
24317 @mindex wmin@idots
24318 @end ignore
24319 @tindex wminimize
24320 @ignore
24321 @mindex wmax@idots
24322 @end ignore
24323 @tindex wmaximize
24324 The @kbd{H a N} [@code{wminimize}] command, analogously to @kbd{H a R},
24325 expands the guess interval to enclose a minimum rather than requiring
24326 that the minimum lie inside the interval you supply.
24327
24328 The @kbd{a X} (@code{calc-find-maximum}) [@code{maximize}] and
24329 @kbd{H a X} [@code{wmaximize}] commands effectively minimize the
24330 negative of the formula you supply.
24331
24332 The formula must evaluate to a real number at all points inside the
24333 interval (or near the initial guess if the guess is a number). If
24334 the initial guess is a complex number the variable will be minimized
24335 over the complex numbers; if it is real or an interval it will
24336 be minimized over the reals.
24337
24338 @node Numerical Systems of Equations, , Minimization, Numerical Solutions
24339 @subsection Systems of Equations
24340
24341 @noindent
24342 @cindex Systems of equations, numerical
24343 The @kbd{a R} command can also solve systems of equations. In this
24344 case, the equation should instead be a vector of equations, the
24345 guess should instead be a vector of numbers (intervals are not
24346 supported), and the variable should be a vector of variables. You
24347 can omit the brackets while entering the list of variables. Each
24348 equation must be differentiable by each variable for this mode to
24349 work. The result will be a vector of two vectors: The variable
24350 values that solved the system of equations, and the differences
24351 between the sides of the equations with those variable values.
24352 There must be the same number of equations as variables. Since
24353 only plain numbers are allowed as guesses, the Hyperbolic flag has
24354 no effect when solving a system of equations.
24355
24356 It is also possible to minimize over many variables with @kbd{a N}
24357 (or maximize with @kbd{a X}). Once again the variable name should
24358 be replaced by a vector of variables, and the initial guess should
24359 be an equal-sized vector of initial guesses. But, unlike the case of
24360 multidimensional @kbd{a R}, the formula being minimized should
24361 still be a single formula, @emph{not} a vector. Beware that
24362 multidimensional minimization is currently @emph{very} slow.
24363
24364 @node Curve Fitting, Summations, Numerical Solutions, Algebra
24365 @section Curve Fitting
24366
24367 @noindent
24368 The @kbd{a F} command fits a set of data to a @dfn{model formula},
24369 such as @expr{y = m x + b} where @expr{m} and @expr{b} are parameters
24370 to be determined. For a typical set of measured data there will be
24371 no single @expr{m} and @expr{b} that exactly fit the data; in this
24372 case, Calc chooses values of the parameters that provide the closest
24373 possible fit. The model formula can be entered in various ways after
24374 the key sequence @kbd{a F} is pressed.
24375
24376 If the letter @kbd{P} is pressed after @kbd{a F} but before the model
24377 description is entered, the data as well as the model formula will be
24378 plotted after the formula is determined. This will be indicated by a
24379 ``P'' in the minibuffer after the help message.
24380
24381 @menu
24382 * Linear Fits::
24383 * Polynomial and Multilinear Fits::
24384 * Error Estimates for Fits::
24385 * Standard Nonlinear Models::
24386 * Curve Fitting Details::
24387 * Interpolation::
24388 @end menu
24389
24390 @node Linear Fits, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting, Curve Fitting
24391 @subsection Linear Fits
24392
24393 @noindent
24394 @kindex a F
24395 @pindex calc-curve-fit
24396 @tindex fit
24397 @cindex Linear regression
24398 @cindex Least-squares fits
24399 The @kbd{a F} (@code{calc-curve-fit}) [@code{fit}] command attempts
24400 to fit a set of data (@expr{x} and @expr{y} vectors of numbers) to a
24401 straight line, polynomial, or other function of @expr{x}. For the
24402 moment we will consider only the case of fitting to a line, and we
24403 will ignore the issue of whether or not the model was in fact a good
24404 fit for the data.
24405
24406 In a standard linear least-squares fit, we have a set of @expr{(x,y)}
24407 data points that we wish to fit to the model @expr{y = m x + b}
24408 by adjusting the parameters @expr{m} and @expr{b} to make the @expr{y}
24409 values calculated from the formula be as close as possible to the actual
24410 @expr{y} values in the data set. (In a polynomial fit, the model is
24411 instead, say, @expr{y = a x^3 + b x^2 + c x + d}. In a multilinear fit,
24412 we have data points of the form @expr{(x_1,x_2,x_3,y)} and our model is
24413 @expr{y = a x_1 + b x_2 + c x_3 + d}. These will be discussed later.)
24414
24415 In the model formula, variables like @expr{x} and @expr{x_2} are called
24416 the @dfn{independent variables}, and @expr{y} is the @dfn{dependent
24417 variable}. Variables like @expr{m}, @expr{a}, and @expr{b} are called
24418 the @dfn{parameters} of the model.
24419
24420 The @kbd{a F} command takes the data set to be fitted from the stack.
24421 By default, it expects the data in the form of a matrix. For example,
24422 for a linear or polynomial fit, this would be a
24423 @texline @math{2\times N}
24424 @infoline 2xN
24425 matrix where the first row is a list of @expr{x} values and the second
24426 row has the corresponding @expr{y} values. For the multilinear fit
24427 shown above, the matrix would have four rows (@expr{x_1}, @expr{x_2},
24428 @expr{x_3}, and @expr{y}, respectively).
24429
24430 If you happen to have an
24431 @texline @math{N\times2}
24432 @infoline Nx2
24433 matrix instead of a
24434 @texline @math{2\times N}
24435 @infoline 2xN
24436 matrix, just press @kbd{v t} first to transpose the matrix.
24437
24438 After you type @kbd{a F}, Calc prompts you to select a model. For a
24439 linear fit, press the digit @kbd{1}.
24440
24441 Calc then prompts for you to name the variables. By default it chooses
24442 high letters like @expr{x} and @expr{y} for independent variables and
24443 low letters like @expr{a} and @expr{b} for parameters. (The dependent
24444 variable doesn't need a name.) The two kinds of variables are separated
24445 by a semicolon. Since you generally care more about the names of the
24446 independent variables than of the parameters, Calc also allows you to
24447 name only those and let the parameters use default names.
24448
24449 For example, suppose the data matrix
24450
24451 @ifnottex
24452 @example
24453 @group
24454 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24455 [ 5, 7, 9, 11, 13 ] ]
24456 @end group
24457 @end example
24458 @end ifnottex
24459 @tex
24460 \beforedisplay
24461 $$ \pmatrix{ 1 & 2 & 3 & 4 & 5 \cr
24462 5 & 7 & 9 & 11 & 13 }
24463 $$
24464 \afterdisplay
24465 @end tex
24466
24467 @noindent
24468 is on the stack and we wish to do a simple linear fit. Type
24469 @kbd{a F}, then @kbd{1} for the model, then @key{RET} to use
24470 the default names. The result will be the formula @expr{3. + 2. x}
24471 on the stack. Calc has created the model expression @kbd{a + b x},
24472 then found the optimal values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} to fit the
24473 data. (In this case, it was able to find an exact fit.) Calc then
24474 substituted those values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} in the model
24475 formula.
24476
24477 The @kbd{a F} command puts two entries in the trail. One is, as
24478 always, a copy of the result that went to the stack; the other is
24479 a vector of the actual parameter values, written as equations:
24480 @expr{[a = 3, b = 2]}, in case you'd rather read them in a list
24481 than pick them out of the formula. (You can type @kbd{t y}
24482 to move this vector to the stack; see @ref{Trail Commands}.
24483
24484 Specifying a different independent variable name will affect the
24485 resulting formula: @kbd{a F 1 k @key{RET}} produces @kbd{3 + 2 k}.
24486 Changing the parameter names (say, @kbd{a F 1 k;b,m @key{RET}}) will affect
24487 the equations that go into the trail.
24488
24489 @tex
24490 \bigskip
24491 @end tex
24492
24493 To see what happens when the fit is not exact, we could change
24494 the number 13 in the data matrix to 14 and try the fit again.
24495 The result is:
24496
24497 @example
24498 2.6 + 2.2 x
24499 @end example
24500
24501 Evaluating this formula, say with @kbd{v x 5 @key{RET} @key{TAB} V M $ @key{RET}}, shows
24502 a reasonably close match to the y-values in the data.
24503
24504 @example
24505 [4.8, 7., 9.2, 11.4, 13.6]
24506 @end example
24507
24508 Since there is no line which passes through all the @var{n} data points,
24509 Calc has chosen a line that best approximates the data points using
24510 the method of least squares. The idea is to define the @dfn{chi-square}
24511 error measure
24512
24513 @ifnottex
24514 @example
24515 chi^2 = sum((y_i - (a + b x_i))^2, i, 1, N)
24516 @end example
24517 @end ifnottex
24518 @tex
24519 \beforedisplay
24520 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N (y_i - (a + b x_i))^2 $$
24521 \afterdisplay
24522 @end tex
24523
24524 @noindent
24525 which is clearly zero if @expr{a + b x} exactly fits all data points,
24526 and increases as various @expr{a + b x_i} values fail to match the
24527 corresponding @expr{y_i} values. There are several reasons why the
24528 summand is squared, one of them being to ensure that
24529 @texline @math{\chi^2 \ge 0}.
24530 @infoline @expr{chi^2 >= 0}.
24531 Least-squares fitting simply chooses the values of @expr{a} and @expr{b}
24532 for which the error
24533 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24534 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24535 is as small as possible.
24536
24537 Other kinds of models do the same thing but with a different model
24538 formula in place of @expr{a + b x_i}.
24539
24540 @tex
24541 \bigskip
24542 @end tex
24543
24544 A numeric prefix argument causes the @kbd{a F} command to take the
24545 data in some other form than one big matrix. A positive argument @var{n}
24546 will take @var{N} items from the stack, corresponding to the @var{n} rows
24547 of a data matrix. In the linear case, @var{n} must be 2 since there
24548 is always one independent variable and one dependent variable.
24549
24550 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} is a compromise; Calc takes two
24551 items from the stack, an @var{n}-row matrix of @expr{x} values, and a
24552 vector of @expr{y} values. If there is only one independent variable,
24553 the @expr{x} values can be either a one-row matrix or a plain vector,
24554 in which case the @kbd{C-u} prefix is the same as a @w{@kbd{C-u 2}} prefix.
24555
24556 @node Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Error Estimates for Fits, Linear Fits, Curve Fitting
24557 @subsection Polynomial and Multilinear Fits
24558
24559 @noindent
24560 To fit the data to higher-order polynomials, just type one of the
24561 digits @kbd{2} through @kbd{9} when prompted for a model. For example,
24562 we could fit the original data matrix from the previous section
24563 (with 13, not 14) to a parabola instead of a line by typing
24564 @kbd{a F 2 @key{RET}}.
24565
24566 @example
24567 2.00000000001 x - 1.5e-12 x^2 + 2.99999999999
24568 @end example
24569
24570 Note that since the constant and linear terms are enough to fit the
24571 data exactly, it's no surprise that Calc chose a tiny contribution
24572 for @expr{x^2}. (The fact that it's not exactly zero is due only
24573 to roundoff error. Since our data are exact integers, we could get
24574 an exact answer by typing @kbd{m f} first to get Fraction mode.
24575 Then the @expr{x^2} term would vanish altogether. Usually, though,
24576 the data being fitted will be approximate floats so Fraction mode
24577 won't help.)
24578
24579 Doing the @kbd{a F 2} fit on the data set with 14 instead of 13
24580 gives a much larger @expr{x^2} contribution, as Calc bends the
24581 line slightly to improve the fit.
24582
24583 @example
24584 0.142857142855 x^2 + 1.34285714287 x + 3.59999999998
24585 @end example
24586
24587 An important result from the theory of polynomial fitting is that it
24588 is always possible to fit @var{n} data points exactly using a polynomial
24589 of degree @mathit{@var{n}-1}, sometimes called an @dfn{interpolating polynomial}.
24590 Using the modified (14) data matrix, a model number of 4 gives
24591 a polynomial that exactly matches all five data points:
24592
24593 @example
24594 0.04167 x^4 - 0.4167 x^3 + 1.458 x^2 - 0.08333 x + 4.
24595 @end example
24596
24597 The actual coefficients we get with a precision of 12, like
24598 @expr{0.0416666663588}, clearly suffer from loss of precision.
24599 It is a good idea to increase the working precision to several
24600 digits beyond what you need when you do a fitting operation.
24601 Or, if your data are exact, use Fraction mode to get exact
24602 results.
24603
24604 You can type @kbd{i} instead of a digit at the model prompt to fit
24605 the data exactly to a polynomial. This just counts the number of
24606 columns of the data matrix to choose the degree of the polynomial
24607 automatically.
24608
24609 Fitting data ``exactly'' to high-degree polynomials is not always
24610 a good idea, though. High-degree polynomials have a tendency to
24611 wiggle uncontrollably in between the fitting data points. Also,
24612 if the exact-fit polynomial is going to be used to interpolate or
24613 extrapolate the data, it is numerically better to use the @kbd{a p}
24614 command described below. @xref{Interpolation}.
24615
24616 @tex
24617 \bigskip
24618 @end tex
24619
24620 Another generalization of the linear model is to assume the
24621 @expr{y} values are a sum of linear contributions from several
24622 @expr{x} values. This is a @dfn{multilinear} fit, and it is also
24623 selected by the @kbd{1} digit key. (Calc decides whether the fit
24624 is linear or multilinear by counting the rows in the data matrix.)
24625
24626 Given the data matrix,
24627
24628 @example
24629 @group
24630 [ [ 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ]
24631 [ 7, 2, 3, 5, 2 ]
24632 [ 14.5, 15, 18.5, 22.5, 24 ] ]
24633 @end group
24634 @end example
24635
24636 @noindent
24637 the command @kbd{a F 1 @key{RET}} will call the first row @expr{x} and the
24638 second row @expr{y}, and will fit the values in the third row to the
24639 model @expr{a + b x + c y}.
24640
24641 @example
24642 8. + 3. x + 0.5 y
24643 @end example
24644
24645 Calc can do multilinear fits with any number of independent variables
24646 (i.e., with any number of data rows).
24647
24648 @tex
24649 \bigskip
24650 @end tex
24651
24652 Yet another variation is @dfn{homogeneous} linear models, in which
24653 the constant term is known to be zero. In the linear case, this
24654 means the model formula is simply @expr{a x}; in the multilinear
24655 case, the model might be @expr{a x + b y + c z}; and in the polynomial
24656 case, the model could be @expr{a x + b x^2 + c x^3}. You can get
24657 a homogeneous linear or multilinear model by pressing the letter
24658 @kbd{h} followed by a regular model key, like @kbd{1} or @kbd{2}.
24659 This will be indicated by an ``h'' in the minibuffer after the help
24660 message.
24661
24662 It is certainly possible to have other constrained linear models,
24663 like @expr{2.3 + a x} or @expr{a - 4 x}. While there is no single
24664 key to select models like these, a later section shows how to enter
24665 any desired model by hand. In the first case, for example, you
24666 would enter @kbd{a F ' 2.3 + a x}.
24667
24668 Another class of models that will work but must be entered by hand
24669 are multinomial fits, e.g., @expr{a + b x + c y + d x^2 + e y^2 + f x y}.
24670
24671 @node Error Estimates for Fits, Standard Nonlinear Models, Polynomial and Multilinear Fits, Curve Fitting
24672 @subsection Error Estimates for Fits
24673
24674 @noindent
24675 @kindex H a F
24676 @tindex efit
24677 With the Hyperbolic flag, @kbd{H a F} [@code{efit}] performs the same
24678 fitting operation as @kbd{a F}, but reports the coefficients as error
24679 forms instead of plain numbers. Fitting our two data matrices (first
24680 with 13, then with 14) to a line with @kbd{H a F} gives the results,
24681
24682 @example
24683 3. + 2. x
24684 2.6 +/- 0.382970843103 + 2.2 +/- 0.115470053838 x
24685 @end example
24686
24687 In the first case the estimated errors are zero because the linear
24688 fit is perfect. In the second case, the errors are nonzero but
24689 moderately small, because the data are still very close to linear.
24690
24691 It is also possible for the @emph{input} to a fitting operation to
24692 contain error forms. The data values must either all include errors
24693 or all be plain numbers. Error forms can go anywhere but generally
24694 go on the numbers in the last row of the data matrix. If the last
24695 row contains error forms
24696 @texline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@math{\sigma_i}',
24697 @infoline `@var{y_i}@w{ @tfn{+/-} }@var{sigma_i}',
24698 then the
24699 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24700 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24701 statistic is now,
24702
24703 @ifnottex
24704 @example
24705 chi^2 = sum(((y_i - (a + b x_i)) / sigma_i)^2, i, 1, N)
24706 @end example
24707 @end ifnottex
24708 @tex
24709 \beforedisplay
24710 $$ \chi^2 = \sum_{i=1}^N \left(y_i - (a + b x_i) \over \sigma_i\right)^2 $$
24711 \afterdisplay
24712 @end tex
24713
24714 @noindent
24715 so that data points with larger error estimates contribute less to
24716 the fitting operation.
24717
24718 If there are error forms on other rows of the data matrix, all the
24719 errors for a given data point are combined; the square root of the
24720 sum of the squares of the errors forms the
24721 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24722 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24723 used for the data point.
24724
24725 Both @kbd{a F} and @kbd{H a F} can accept error forms in the input
24726 matrix, although if you are concerned about error analysis you will
24727 probably use @kbd{H a F} so that the output also contains error
24728 estimates.
24729
24730 If the input contains error forms but all the
24731 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
24732 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
24733 values are the same, it is easy to see that the resulting fitted model
24734 will be the same as if the input did not have error forms at all
24735 @texline (@math{\chi^2}
24736 @infoline (@expr{chi^2}
24737 is simply scaled uniformly by
24738 @texline @math{1 / \sigma^2},
24739 @infoline @expr{1 / sigma^2},
24740 which doesn't affect where it has a minimum). But there @emph{will} be
24741 a difference in the estimated errors of the coefficients reported by
24742 @kbd{H a F}.
24743
24744 Consult any text on statistical modeling of data for a discussion
24745 of where these error estimates come from and how they should be
24746 interpreted.
24747
24748 @tex
24749 \bigskip
24750 @end tex
24751
24752 @kindex I a F
24753 @tindex xfit
24754 With the Inverse flag, @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] produces even more
24755 information. The result is a vector of six items:
24756
24757 @enumerate
24758 @item
24759 The model formula with error forms for its coefficients or
24760 parameters. This is the result that @kbd{H a F} would have
24761 produced.
24762
24763 @item
24764 A vector of ``raw'' parameter values for the model. These are the
24765 polynomial coefficients or other parameters as plain numbers, in the
24766 same order as the parameters appeared in the final prompt of the
24767 @kbd{I a F} command. For polynomials of degree @expr{d}, this vector
24768 will have length @expr{M = d+1} with the constant term first.
24769
24770 @item
24771 The covariance matrix @expr{C} computed from the fit. This is
24772 an @var{m}x@var{m} symmetric matrix; the diagonal elements
24773 @texline @math{C_{jj}}
24774 @infoline @expr{C_j_j}
24775 are the variances
24776 @texline @math{\sigma_j^2}
24777 @infoline @expr{sigma_j^2}
24778 of the parameters. The other elements are covariances
24779 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2}
24780 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2}
24781 that describe the correlation between pairs of parameters. (A related
24782 set of numbers, the @dfn{linear correlation coefficients}
24783 @texline @math{r_{ij}},
24784 @infoline @expr{r_i_j},
24785 are defined as
24786 @texline @math{\sigma_{ij}^2 / \sigma_i \, \sigma_j}.)
24787 @infoline @expr{sigma_i_j^2 / sigma_i sigma_j}.)
24788
24789 @item
24790 A vector of @expr{M} ``parameter filter'' functions whose
24791 meanings are described below. If no filters are necessary this
24792 will instead be an empty vector; this is always the case for the
24793 polynomial and multilinear fits described so far.
24794
24795 @item
24796 The value of
24797 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24798 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24799 for the fit, calculated by the formulas shown above. This gives a
24800 measure of the quality of the fit; statisticians consider
24801 @texline @math{\chi^2 \approx N - M}
24802 @infoline @expr{chi^2 = N - M}
24803 to indicate a moderately good fit (where again @expr{N} is the number of
24804 data points and @expr{M} is the number of parameters).
24805
24806 @item
24807 A measure of goodness of fit expressed as a probability @expr{Q}.
24808 This is computed from the @code{utpc} probability distribution
24809 function using
24810 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24811 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24812 with @expr{N - M} degrees of freedom. A
24813 value of 0.5 implies a good fit; some texts recommend that often
24814 @expr{Q = 0.1} or even 0.001 can signify an acceptable fit. In
24815 particular,
24816 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24817 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24818 statistics assume the errors in your inputs
24819 follow a normal (Gaussian) distribution; if they don't, you may
24820 have to accept smaller values of @expr{Q}.
24821
24822 The @expr{Q} value is computed only if the input included error
24823 estimates. Otherwise, Calc will report the symbol @code{nan}
24824 for @expr{Q}. The reason is that in this case the
24825 @texline @math{\chi^2}
24826 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
24827 value has effectively been used to estimate the original errors
24828 in the input, and thus there is no redundant information left
24829 over to use for a confidence test.
24830 @end enumerate
24831
24832 @node Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting Details, Error Estimates for Fits, Curve Fitting
24833 @subsection Standard Nonlinear Models
24834
24835 @noindent
24836 The @kbd{a F} command also accepts other kinds of models besides
24837 lines and polynomials. Some common models have quick single-key
24838 abbreviations; others must be entered by hand as algebraic formulas.
24839
24840 Here is a complete list of the standard models recognized by @kbd{a F}:
24841
24842 @table @kbd
24843 @item 1
24844 Linear or multilinear. @mathit{a + b x + c y + d z}.
24845 @item 2-9
24846 Polynomials. @mathit{a + b x + c x^2 + d x^3}.
24847 @item e
24848 Exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{exp}@mathit{(c y)}.
24849 @item E
24850 Base-10 exponential. @mathit{a} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(b x)} @tfn{10^}@mathit{(c y)}.
24851 @item x
24852 Exponential (alternate notation). @tfn{exp}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24853 @item X
24854 Base-10 exponential (alternate). @tfn{10^}@mathit{(a + b x + c y)}.
24855 @item l
24856 Logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{ln}@mathit{(y)}.
24857 @item L
24858 Base-10 logarithmic. @mathit{a + b} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(x) + c} @tfn{log10}@mathit{(y)}.
24859 @item ^
24860 General exponential. @mathit{a b^x c^y}.
24861 @item p
24862 Power law. @mathit{a x^b y^c}.
24863 @item q
24864 Quadratic. @mathit{a + b (x-c)^2 + d (x-e)^2}.
24865 @item g
24866 Gaussian.
24867 @texline @math{{a \over b \sqrt{2 \pi}} \exp\left( -{1 \over 2} \left( x - c \over b \right)^2 \right)}.
24868 @infoline @mathit{(a / b sqrt(2 pi)) exp(-0.5*((x-c)/b)^2)}.
24869 @item s
24870 Logistic @emph{s} curve.
24871 @texline @math{a/(1+e^{b(x-c)})}.
24872 @infoline @mathit{a/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))}.
24873 @item b
24874 Logistic bell curve.
24875 @texline @math{ae^{b(x-c)}/(1+e^{b(x-c)})^2}.
24876 @infoline @mathit{a exp(b (x - c))/(1 + exp(b (x - c)))^2}.
24877 @item o
24878 Hubbert linearization.
24879 @texline @math{{y \over x} = a(1-x/b)}.
24880 @infoline @mathit{(y/x) = a (1 - x/b)}.
24881 @end table
24882
24883 All of these models are used in the usual way; just press the appropriate
24884 letter at the model prompt, and choose variable names if you wish. The
24885 result will be a formula as shown in the above table, with the best-fit
24886 values of the parameters substituted. (You may find it easier to read
24887 the parameter values from the vector that is placed in the trail.)
24888
24889 All models except Gaussian, logistics, Hubbert and polynomials can
24890 generalize as shown to any number of independent variables. Also, all
24891 the built-in models except for the logistic and Hubbert curves have an
24892 additive or multiplicative parameter shown as @expr{a} in the above table
24893 which can be replaced by zero or one, as appropriate, by typing @kbd{h}
24894 before the model key.
24895
24896 Note that many of these models are essentially equivalent, but express
24897 the parameters slightly differently. For example, @expr{a b^x} and
24898 the other two exponential models are all algebraic rearrangements of
24899 each other. Also, the ``quadratic'' model is just a degree-2 polynomial
24900 with the parameters expressed differently. Use whichever form best
24901 matches the problem.
24902
24903 The HP-28/48 calculators support four different models for curve
24904 fitting, called @code{LIN}, @code{LOG}, @code{EXP}, and @code{PWR}.
24905 These correspond to Calc models @samp{a + b x}, @samp{a + b ln(x)},
24906 @samp{a exp(b x)}, and @samp{a x^b}, respectively. In each case,
24907 @expr{a} is what the HP-48 identifies as the ``intercept,'' and
24908 @expr{b} is what it calls the ``slope.''
24909
24910 @tex
24911 \bigskip
24912 @end tex
24913
24914 If the model you want doesn't appear on this list, press @kbd{'}
24915 (the apostrophe key) at the model prompt to enter any algebraic
24916 formula, such as @kbd{m x - b}, as the model. (Not all models
24917 will work, though---see the next section for details.)
24918
24919 The model can also be an equation like @expr{y = m x + b}.
24920 In this case, Calc thinks of all the rows of the data matrix on
24921 equal terms; this model effectively has two parameters
24922 (@expr{m} and @expr{b}) and two independent variables (@expr{x}
24923 and @expr{y}), with no ``dependent'' variables. Model equations
24924 do not need to take this @expr{y =} form. For example, the
24925 implicit line equation @expr{a x + b y = 1} works fine as a
24926 model.
24927
24928 When you enter a model, Calc makes an alphabetical list of all
24929 the variables that appear in the model. These are used for the
24930 default parameters, independent variables, and dependent variable
24931 (in that order). If you enter a plain formula (not an equation),
24932 Calc assumes the dependent variable does not appear in the formula
24933 and thus does not need a name.
24934
24935 For example, if the model formula has the variables @expr{a,mu,sigma,t,x},
24936 and the data matrix has three rows (meaning two independent variables),
24937 Calc will use @expr{a,mu,sigma} as the default parameters, and the
24938 data rows will be named @expr{t} and @expr{x}, respectively. If you
24939 enter an equation instead of a plain formula, Calc will use @expr{a,mu}
24940 as the parameters, and @expr{sigma,t,x} as the three independent
24941 variables.
24942
24943 You can, of course, override these choices by entering something
24944 different at the prompt. If you leave some variables out of the list,
24945 those variables must have stored values and those stored values will
24946 be used as constants in the model. (Stored values for the parameters
24947 and independent variables are ignored by the @kbd{a F} command.)
24948 If you list only independent variables, all the remaining variables
24949 in the model formula will become parameters.
24950
24951 If there are @kbd{$} signs in the model you type, they will stand
24952 for parameters and all other variables (in alphabetical order)
24953 will be independent. Use @kbd{$} for one parameter, @kbd{$$} for
24954 another, and so on. Thus @kbd{$ x + $$} is another way to describe
24955 a linear model.
24956
24957 If you type a @kbd{$} instead of @kbd{'} at the model prompt itself,
24958 Calc will take the model formula from the stack. (The data must then
24959 appear at the second stack level.) The same conventions are used to
24960 choose which variables in the formula are independent by default and
24961 which are parameters.
24962
24963 Models taken from the stack can also be expressed as vectors of
24964 two or three elements, @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}]} or
24965 @expr{[@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}]}. Each of @var{vars}
24966 and @var{params} may be either a variable or a vector of variables.
24967 (If @var{params} is omitted, all variables in @var{model} except
24968 those listed as @var{vars} are parameters.)
24969
24970 When you enter a model manually with @kbd{'}, Calc puts a 3-vector
24971 describing the model in the trail so you can get it back if you wish.
24972
24973 @tex
24974 \bigskip
24975 @end tex
24976
24977 @vindex Model1
24978 @vindex Model2
24979 Finally, you can store a model in one of the Calc variables
24980 @code{Model1} or @code{Model2}, then use this model by typing
24981 @kbd{a F u} or @kbd{a F U} (respectively). The value stored in
24982 the variable can be any of the formats that @kbd{a F $} would
24983 accept for a model on the stack.
24984
24985 @tex
24986 \bigskip
24987 @end tex
24988
24989 Calc uses the principal values of inverse functions like @code{ln}
24990 and @code{arcsin} when doing fits. For example, when you enter
24991 the model @samp{y = sin(a t + b)} Calc actually uses the easier
24992 form @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b}. The @code{arcsin} function always
24993 returns results in the range from @mathit{-90} to 90 degrees (or the
24994 equivalent range in radians). Suppose you had data that you
24995 believed to represent roughly three oscillations of a sine wave,
24996 so that the argument of the sine might go from zero to
24997 @texline @math{3\times360}
24998 @infoline @mathit{3*360}
24999 degrees.
25000 The above model would appear to be a good way to determine the
25001 true frequency and phase of the sine wave, but in practice it
25002 would fail utterly. The righthand side of the actual model
25003 @samp{arcsin(y) = a t + b} will grow smoothly with @expr{t}, but
25004 the lefthand side will bounce back and forth between @mathit{-90} and 90.
25005 No values of @expr{a} and @expr{b} can make the two sides match,
25006 even approximately.
25007
25008 There is no good solution to this problem at present. You could
25009 restrict your data to small enough ranges so that the above problem
25010 doesn't occur (i.e., not straddling any peaks in the sine wave).
25011 Or, in this case, you could use a totally different method such as
25012 Fourier analysis, which is beyond the scope of the @kbd{a F} command.
25013 (Unfortunately, Calc does not currently have any facilities for
25014 taking Fourier and related transforms.)
25015
25016 @node Curve Fitting Details, Interpolation, Standard Nonlinear Models, Curve Fitting
25017 @subsection Curve Fitting Details
25018
25019 @noindent
25020 Calc's internal least-squares fitter can only handle multilinear
25021 models. More precisely, it can handle any model of the form
25022 @expr{a f(x,y,z) + b g(x,y,z) + c h(x,y,z)}, where @expr{a,b,c}
25023 are the parameters and @expr{x,y,z} are the independent variables
25024 (of course there can be any number of each, not just three).
25025
25026 In a simple multilinear or polynomial fit, it is easy to see how
25027 to convert the model into this form. For example, if the model
25028 is @expr{a + b x + c x^2}, then @expr{f(x) = 1}, @expr{g(x) = x},
25029 and @expr{h(x) = x^2} are suitable functions.
25030
25031 For most other models, Calc uses a variety of algebraic manipulations
25032 to try to put the problem into the form
25033
25034 @smallexample
25035 Y(x,y,z) = A(a,b,c) F(x,y,z) + B(a,b,c) G(x,y,z) + C(a,b,c) H(x,y,z)
25036 @end smallexample
25037
25038 @noindent
25039 where @expr{Y,A,B,C,F,G,H} are arbitrary functions. It computes
25040 @expr{Y}, @expr{F}, @expr{G}, and @expr{H} for all the data points,
25041 does a standard linear fit to find the values of @expr{A}, @expr{B},
25042 and @expr{C}, then uses the equation solver to solve for @expr{a,b,c}
25043 in terms of @expr{A,B,C}.
25044
25045 A remarkable number of models can be cast into this general form.
25046 We'll look at two examples here to see how it works. The power-law
25047 model @expr{y = a x^b} with two independent variables and two parameters
25048 can be rewritten as follows:
25049
25050 @example
25051 y = a x^b
25052 y = a exp(b ln(x))
25053 y = exp(ln(a) + b ln(x))
25054 ln(y) = ln(a) + b ln(x)
25055 @end example
25056
25057 @noindent
25058 which matches the desired form with
25059 @texline @math{Y = \ln(y)},
25060 @infoline @expr{Y = ln(y)},
25061 @texline @math{A = \ln(a)},
25062 @infoline @expr{A = ln(a)},
25063 @expr{F = 1}, @expr{B = b}, and
25064 @texline @math{G = \ln(x)}.
25065 @infoline @expr{G = ln(x)}.
25066 Calc thus computes the logarithms of your @expr{y} and @expr{x} values,
25067 does a linear fit for @expr{A} and @expr{B}, then solves to get
25068 @texline @math{a = \exp(A)}
25069 @infoline @expr{a = exp(A)}
25070 and @expr{b = B}.
25071
25072 Another interesting example is the ``quadratic'' model, which can
25073 be handled by expanding according to the distributive law.
25074
25075 @example
25076 y = a + b*(x - c)^2
25077 y = a + b c^2 - 2 b c x + b x^2
25078 @end example
25079
25080 @noindent
25081 which matches with @expr{Y = y}, @expr{A = a + b c^2}, @expr{F = 1},
25082 @expr{B = -2 b c}, @expr{G = x} (the @mathit{-2} factor could just as easily
25083 have been put into @expr{G} instead of @expr{B}), @expr{C = b}, and
25084 @expr{H = x^2}.
25085
25086 The Gaussian model looks quite complicated, but a closer examination
25087 shows that it's actually similar to the quadratic model but with an
25088 exponential that can be brought to the top and moved into @expr{Y}.
25089
25090 The logistic models cannot be put into general linear form. For these
25091 models, and the Hubbert linearization, Calc computes a rough
25092 approximation for the parameters, then uses the Levenberg-Marquardt
25093 iterative method to refine the approximations.
25094
25095 Another model that cannot be put into general linear
25096 form is a Gaussian with a constant background added on, i.e.,
25097 @expr{d} + the regular Gaussian formula. If you have a model like
25098 this, your best bet is to replace enough of your parameters with
25099 constants to make the model linearizable, then adjust the constants
25100 manually by doing a series of fits. You can compare the fits by
25101 graphing them, by examining the goodness-of-fit measures returned by
25102 @kbd{I a F}, or by some other method suitable to your application.
25103 Note that some models can be linearized in several ways. The
25104 Gaussian-plus-@var{d} model can be linearized by setting @expr{d}
25105 (the background) to a constant, or by setting @expr{b} (the standard
25106 deviation) and @expr{c} (the mean) to constants.
25107
25108 To fit a model with constants substituted for some parameters, just
25109 store suitable values in those parameter variables, then omit them
25110 from the list of parameters when you answer the variables prompt.
25111
25112 @tex
25113 \bigskip
25114 @end tex
25115
25116 A last desperate step would be to use the general-purpose
25117 @code{minimize} function rather than @code{fit}. After all, both
25118 functions solve the problem of minimizing an expression (the
25119 @texline @math{\chi^2}
25120 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
25121 sum) by adjusting certain parameters in the expression. The @kbd{a F}
25122 command is able to use a vastly more efficient algorithm due to its
25123 special knowledge about linear chi-square sums, but the @kbd{a N}
25124 command can do the same thing by brute force.
25125
25126 A compromise would be to pick out a few parameters without which the
25127 fit is linearizable, and use @code{minimize} on a call to @code{fit}
25128 which efficiently takes care of the rest of the parameters. The thing
25129 to be minimized would be the value of
25130 @texline @math{\chi^2}
25131 @infoline @expr{chi^2}
25132 returned as the fifth result of the @code{xfit} function:
25133
25134 @smallexample
25135 minimize(xfit(gaus(a,b,c,d,x), x, [a,b,c], data)_5, d, guess)
25136 @end smallexample
25137
25138 @noindent
25139 where @code{gaus} represents the Gaussian model with background,
25140 @code{data} represents the data matrix, and @code{guess} represents
25141 the initial guess for @expr{d} that @code{minimize} requires.
25142 This operation will only be, shall we say, extraordinarily slow
25143 rather than astronomically slow (as would be the case if @code{minimize}
25144 were used by itself to solve the problem).
25145
25146 @tex
25147 \bigskip
25148 @end tex
25149
25150 The @kbd{I a F} [@code{xfit}] command is somewhat trickier when
25151 nonlinear models are used. The second item in the result is the
25152 vector of ``raw'' parameters @expr{A}, @expr{B}, @expr{C}. The
25153 covariance matrix is written in terms of those raw parameters.
25154 The fifth item is a vector of @dfn{filter} expressions. This
25155 is the empty vector @samp{[]} if the raw parameters were the same
25156 as the requested parameters, i.e., if @expr{A = a}, @expr{B = b},
25157 and so on (which is always true if the model is already linear
25158 in the parameters as written, e.g., for polynomial fits). If the
25159 parameters had to be rearranged, the fifth item is instead a vector
25160 of one formula per parameter in the original model. The raw
25161 parameters are expressed in these ``filter'' formulas as
25162 @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)} for @expr{B},
25163 and so on.
25164
25165 When Calc needs to modify the model to return the result, it replaces
25166 @samp{fitdummy(1)} in all the filters with the first item in the raw
25167 parameters list, and so on for the other raw parameters, then
25168 evaluates the resulting filter formulas to get the actual parameter
25169 values to be substituted into the original model. In the case of
25170 @kbd{H a F} and @kbd{I a F} where the parameters must be error forms,
25171 Calc uses the square roots of the diagonal entries of the covariance
25172 matrix as error values for the raw parameters, then lets Calc's
25173 standard error-form arithmetic take it from there.
25174
25175 If you use @kbd{I a F} with a nonlinear model, be sure to remember
25176 that the covariance matrix is in terms of the raw parameters,
25177 @emph{not} the actual requested parameters. It's up to you to
25178 figure out how to interpret the covariances in the presence of
25179 nontrivial filter functions.
25180
25181 Things are also complicated when the input contains error forms.
25182 Suppose there are three independent and dependent variables, @expr{x},
25183 @expr{y}, and @expr{z}, one or more of which are error forms in the
25184 data. Calc combines all the error values by taking the square root
25185 of the sum of the squares of the errors. It then changes @expr{x}
25186 and @expr{y} to be plain numbers, and makes @expr{z} into an error
25187 form with this combined error. The @expr{Y(x,y,z)} part of the
25188 linearized model is evaluated, and the result should be an error
25189 form. The error part of that result is used for
25190 @texline @math{\sigma_i}
25191 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}
25192 for the data point. If for some reason @expr{Y(x,y,z)} does not return
25193 an error form, the combined error from @expr{z} is used directly for
25194 @texline @math{\sigma_i}.
25195 @infoline @expr{sigma_i}.
25196 Finally, @expr{z} is also stripped of its error
25197 for use in computing @expr{F(x,y,z)}, @expr{G(x,y,z)} and so on;
25198 the righthand side of the linearized model is computed in regular
25199 arithmetic with no error forms.
25200
25201 (While these rules may seem complicated, they are designed to do
25202 the most reasonable thing in the typical case that @expr{Y(x,y,z)}
25203 depends only on the dependent variable @expr{z}, and in fact is
25204 often simply equal to @expr{z}. For common cases like polynomials
25205 and multilinear models, the combined error is simply used as the
25206 @texline @math{\sigma}
25207 @infoline @expr{sigma}
25208 for the data point with no further ado.)
25209
25210 @tex
25211 \bigskip
25212 @end tex
25213
25214 @vindex FitRules
25215 It may be the case that the model you wish to use is linearizable,
25216 but Calc's built-in rules are unable to figure it out. Calc uses
25217 its algebraic rewrite mechanism to linearize a model. The rewrite
25218 rules are kept in the variable @code{FitRules}. You can edit this
25219 variable using the @kbd{s e FitRules} command; in fact, there is
25220 a special @kbd{s F} command just for editing @code{FitRules}.
25221 @xref{Operations on Variables}.
25222
25223 @xref{Rewrite Rules}, for a discussion of rewrite rules.
25224
25225 @ignore
25226 @starindex
25227 @end ignore
25228 @tindex fitvar
25229 @ignore
25230 @starindex
25231 @end ignore
25232 @ignore
25233 @mindex @idots
25234 @end ignore
25235 @tindex fitparam
25236 @ignore
25237 @starindex
25238 @end ignore
25239 @ignore
25240 @mindex @null
25241 @end ignore
25242 @tindex fitmodel
25243 @ignore
25244 @starindex
25245 @end ignore
25246 @ignore
25247 @mindex @null
25248 @end ignore
25249 @tindex fitsystem
25250 @ignore
25251 @starindex
25252 @end ignore
25253 @ignore
25254 @mindex @null
25255 @end ignore
25256 @tindex fitdummy
25257 Calc uses @code{FitRules} as follows. First, it converts the model
25258 to an equation if necessary and encloses the model equation in a
25259 call to the function @code{fitmodel} (which is not actually a defined
25260 function in Calc; it is only used as a placeholder by the rewrite rules).
25261 Parameter variables are renamed to function calls @samp{fitparam(1)},
25262 @samp{fitparam(2)}, and so on, and independent variables are renamed
25263 to @samp{fitvar(1)}, @samp{fitvar(2)}, etc. The dependent variable
25264 is the highest-numbered @code{fitvar}. For example, the power law
25265 model @expr{a x^b} is converted to @expr{y = a x^b}, then to
25266
25267 @smallexample
25268 @group
25269 fitmodel(fitvar(2) = fitparam(1) fitvar(1)^fitparam(2))
25270 @end group
25271 @end smallexample
25272
25273 Calc then applies the rewrites as if by @samp{C-u 0 a r FitRules}.
25274 (The zero prefix means that rewriting should continue until no further
25275 changes are possible.)
25276
25277 When rewriting is complete, the @code{fitmodel} call should have
25278 been replaced by a @code{fitsystem} call that looks like this:
25279
25280 @example
25281 fitsystem(@var{Y}, @var{FGH}, @var{abc})
25282 @end example
25283
25284 @noindent
25285 where @var{Y} is a formula that describes the function @expr{Y(x,y,z)},
25286 @var{FGH} is the vector of formulas @expr{[F(x,y,z), G(x,y,z), H(x,y,z)]},
25287 and @var{abc} is the vector of parameter filters which refer to the
25288 raw parameters as @samp{fitdummy(1)} for @expr{A}, @samp{fitdummy(2)}
25289 for @expr{B}, etc. While the number of raw parameters (the length of
25290 the @var{FGH} vector) is usually the same as the number of original
25291 parameters (the length of the @var{abc} vector), this is not required.
25292
25293 The power law model eventually boils down to
25294
25295 @smallexample
25296 @group
25297 fitsystem(ln(fitvar(2)),
25298 [1, ln(fitvar(1))],
25299 [exp(fitdummy(1)), fitdummy(2)])
25300 @end group
25301 @end smallexample
25302
25303 The actual implementation of @code{FitRules} is complicated; it
25304 proceeds in four phases. First, common rearrangements are done
25305 to try to bring linear terms together and to isolate functions like
25306 @code{exp} and @code{ln} either all the way ``out'' (so that they
25307 can be put into @var{Y}) or all the way ``in'' (so that they can
25308 be put into @var{abc} or @var{FGH}). In particular, all
25309 non-constant powers are converted to logs-and-exponentials form,
25310 and the distributive law is used to expand products of sums.
25311 Quotients are rewritten to use the @samp{fitinv} function, where
25312 @samp{fitinv(x)} represents @expr{1/x} while the @code{FitRules}
25313 are operating. (The use of @code{fitinv} makes recognition of
25314 linear-looking forms easier.) If you modify @code{FitRules}, you
25315 will probably only need to modify the rules for this phase.
25316
25317 Phase two, whose rules can actually also apply during phases one
25318 and three, first rewrites @code{fitmodel} to a two-argument
25319 form @samp{fitmodel(@var{Y}, @var{model})}, where @var{Y} is
25320 initially zero and @var{model} has been changed from @expr{a=b}
25321 to @expr{a-b} form. It then tries to peel off invertible functions
25322 from the outside of @var{model} and put them into @var{Y} instead,
25323 calling the equation solver to invert the functions. Finally, when
25324 this is no longer possible, the @code{fitmodel} is changed to a
25325 four-argument @code{fitsystem}, where the fourth argument is
25326 @var{model} and the @var{FGH} and @var{abc} vectors are initially
25327 empty. (The last vector is really @var{ABC}, corresponding to
25328 raw parameters, for now.)
25329
25330 Phase three converts a sum of items in the @var{model} to a sum
25331 of @samp{fitpart(@var{a}, @var{b}, @var{c})} terms which represent
25332 terms @samp{@var{a}*@var{b}*@var{c}} of the sum, where @var{a}
25333 is all factors that do not involve any variables, @var{b} is all
25334 factors that involve only parameters, and @var{c} is the factors
25335 that involve only independent variables. (If this decomposition
25336 is not possible, the rule set will not complete and Calc will
25337 complain that the model is too complex.) Then @code{fitpart}s
25338 with equal @var{b} or @var{c} components are merged back together
25339 using the distributive law in order to minimize the number of
25340 raw parameters needed.
25341
25342 Phase four moves the @code{fitpart} terms into the @var{FGH} and
25343 @var{ABC} vectors. Also, some of the algebraic expansions that
25344 were done in phase 1 are undone now to make the formulas more
25345 computationally efficient. Finally, it calls the solver one more
25346 time to convert the @var{ABC} vector to an @var{abc} vector, and
25347 removes the fourth @var{model} argument (which by now will be zero)
25348 to obtain the three-argument @code{fitsystem} that the linear
25349 least-squares solver wants to see.
25350
25351 @ignore
25352 @starindex
25353 @end ignore
25354 @ignore
25355 @mindex hasfit@idots
25356 @end ignore
25357 @tindex hasfitparams
25358 @ignore
25359 @starindex
25360 @end ignore
25361 @ignore
25362 @mindex @null
25363 @end ignore
25364 @tindex hasfitvars
25365 Two functions which are useful in connection with @code{FitRules}
25366 are @samp{hasfitparams(x)} and @samp{hasfitvars(x)}, which check
25367 whether @expr{x} refers to any parameters or independent variables,
25368 respectively. Specifically, these functions return ``true'' if the
25369 argument contains any @code{fitparam} (or @code{fitvar}) function
25370 calls, and ``false'' otherwise. (Recall that ``true'' means a
25371 nonzero number, and ``false'' means zero. The actual nonzero number
25372 returned is the largest @var{n} from all the @samp{fitparam(@var{n})}s
25373 or @samp{fitvar(@var{n})}s, respectively, that appear in the formula.)
25374
25375 @tex
25376 \bigskip
25377 @end tex
25378
25379 The @code{fit} function in algebraic notation normally takes four
25380 arguments, @samp{fit(@var{model}, @var{vars}, @var{params}, @var{data})},
25381 where @var{model} is the model formula as it would be typed after
25382 @kbd{a F '}, @var{vars} is the independent variable or a vector of
25383 independent variables, @var{params} likewise gives the parameter(s),
25384 and @var{data} is the data matrix. Note that the length of @var{vars}
25385 must be equal to the number of rows in @var{data} if @var{model} is
25386 an equation, or one less than the number of rows if @var{model} is
25387 a plain formula. (Actually, a name for the dependent variable is
25388 allowed but will be ignored in the plain-formula case.)
25389
25390 If @var{params} is omitted, the parameters are all variables in
25391 @var{model} except those that appear in @var{vars}. If @var{vars}
25392 is also omitted, Calc sorts all the variables that appear in
25393 @var{model} alphabetically and uses the higher ones for @var{vars}
25394 and the lower ones for @var{params}.
25395
25396 Alternatively, @samp{fit(@var{modelvec}, @var{data})} is allowed
25397 where @var{modelvec} is a 2- or 3-vector describing the model
25398 and variables, as discussed previously.
25399
25400 If Calc is unable to do the fit, the @code{fit} function is left
25401 in symbolic form, ordinarily with an explanatory message. The
25402 message will be ``Model expression is too complex'' if the
25403 linearizer was unable to put the model into the required form.
25404
25405 The @code{efit} (corresponding to @kbd{H a F}) and @code{xfit}
25406 (for @kbd{I a F}) functions are completely analogous.
25407
25408 @node Interpolation, , Curve Fitting Details, Curve Fitting
25409 @subsection Polynomial Interpolation
25410
25411 @kindex a p
25412 @pindex calc-poly-interp
25413 @tindex polint
25414 The @kbd{a p} (@code{calc-poly-interp}) [@code{polint}] command does
25415 a polynomial interpolation at a particular @expr{x} value. It takes
25416 two arguments from the stack: A data matrix of the sort used by
25417 @kbd{a F}, and a single number which represents the desired @expr{x}
25418 value. Calc effectively does an exact polynomial fit as if by @kbd{a F i},
25419 then substitutes the @expr{x} value into the result in order to get an
25420 approximate @expr{y} value based on the fit. (Calc does not actually
25421 use @kbd{a F i}, however; it uses a direct method which is both more
25422 efficient and more numerically stable.)
25423
25424 The result of @kbd{a p} is actually a vector of two values: The @expr{y}
25425 value approximation, and an error measure @expr{dy} that reflects Calc's
25426 estimation of the probable error of the approximation at that value of
25427 @expr{x}. If the input @expr{x} is equal to any of the @expr{x} values
25428 in the data matrix, the output @expr{y} will be the corresponding @expr{y}
25429 value from the matrix, and the output @expr{dy} will be exactly zero.
25430
25431 A prefix argument of 2 causes @kbd{a p} to take separate x- and
25432 y-vectors from the stack instead of one data matrix.
25433
25434 If @expr{x} is a vector of numbers, @kbd{a p} will return a matrix of
25435 interpolated results for each of those @expr{x} values. (The matrix will
25436 have two columns, the @expr{y} values and the @expr{dy} values.)
25437 If @expr{x} is a formula instead of a number, the @code{polint} function
25438 remains in symbolic form; use the @kbd{a "} command to expand it out to
25439 a formula that describes the fit in symbolic terms.
25440
25441 In all cases, the @kbd{a p} command leaves the data vectors or matrix
25442 on the stack. Only the @expr{x} value is replaced by the result.
25443
25444 @kindex H a p
25445 @tindex ratint
25446 The @kbd{H a p} [@code{ratint}] command does a rational function
25447 interpolation. It is used exactly like @kbd{a p}, except that it
25448 uses as its model the quotient of two polynomials. If there are
25449 @expr{N} data points, the numerator and denominator polynomials will
25450 each have degree @expr{N/2} (if @expr{N} is odd, the denominator will
25451 have degree one higher than the numerator).
25452
25453 Rational approximations have the advantage that they can accurately
25454 describe functions that have poles (points at which the function's value
25455 goes to infinity, so that the denominator polynomial of the approximation
25456 goes to zero). If @expr{x} corresponds to a pole of the fitted rational
25457 function, then the result will be a division by zero. If Infinite mode
25458 is enabled, the result will be @samp{[uinf, uinf]}.
25459
25460 There is no way to get the actual coefficients of the rational function
25461 used by @kbd{H a p}. (The algorithm never generates these coefficients
25462 explicitly, and quotients of polynomials are beyond @w{@kbd{a F}}'s
25463 capabilities to fit.)
25464
25465 @node Summations, Logical Operations, Curve Fitting, Algebra
25466 @section Summations
25467
25468 @noindent
25469 @cindex Summation of a series
25470 @kindex a +
25471 @pindex calc-summation
25472 @tindex sum
25473 The @kbd{a +} (@code{calc-summation}) [@code{sum}] command computes
25474 the sum of a formula over a certain range of index values. The formula
25475 is taken from the top of the stack; the command prompts for the
25476 name of the summation index variable, the lower limit of the
25477 sum (any formula), and the upper limit of the sum. If you
25478 enter a blank line at any of these prompts, that prompt and
25479 any later ones are answered by reading additional elements from
25480 the stack. Thus, @kbd{' k^2 @key{RET} ' k @key{RET} 1 @key{RET} 5 @key{RET} a + @key{RET}}
25481 produces the result 55.
25482 @tex
25483 $$ \sum_{k=1}^5 k^2 = 55 $$
25484 @end tex
25485
25486 The choice of index variable is arbitrary, but it's best not to
25487 use a variable with a stored value. In particular, while
25488 @code{i} is often a favorite index variable, it should be avoided
25489 in Calc because @code{i} has the imaginary constant @expr{(0, 1)}
25490 as a value. If you pressed @kbd{=} on a sum over @code{i}, it would
25491 be changed to a nonsensical sum over the ``variable'' @expr{(0, 1)}!
25492 If you really want to use @code{i} as an index variable, use
25493 @w{@kbd{s u i @key{RET}}} first to ``unstore'' this variable.
25494 (@xref{Storing Variables}.)
25495
25496 A numeric prefix argument steps the index by that amount rather
25497 than by one. Thus @kbd{' a_k @key{RET} C-u -2 a + k @key{RET} 10 @key{RET} 0 @key{RET}}
25498 yields @samp{a_10 + a_8 + a_6 + a_4 + a_2 + a_0}. A prefix
25499 argument of plain @kbd{C-u} causes @kbd{a +} to prompt for the
25500 step value, in which case you can enter any formula or enter
25501 a blank line to take the step value from the stack. With the
25502 @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{a +} can take up to five arguments from
25503 the stack: The formula, the variable, the lower limit, the
25504 upper limit, and (at the top of the stack), the step value.
25505
25506 Calc knows how to do certain sums in closed form. For example,
25507 @samp{sum(6 k^2, k, 1, n) = @w{2 n^3} + 3 n^2 + n}. In particular,
25508 this is possible if the formula being summed is polynomial or
25509 exponential in the index variable. Sums of logarithms are
25510 transformed into logarithms of products. Sums of trigonometric
25511 and hyperbolic functions are transformed to sums of exponentials
25512 and then done in closed form. Also, of course, sums in which the
25513 lower and upper limits are both numbers can always be evaluated
25514 just by grinding them out, although Calc will use closed forms
25515 whenever it can for the sake of efficiency.
25516
25517 The notation for sums in algebraic formulas is
25518 @samp{sum(@var{expr}, @var{var}, @var{low}, @var{high}, @var{step})}.
25519 If @var{step} is omitted, it defaults to one. If @var{high} is
25520 omitted, @var{low} is actually the upper limit and the lower limit
25521 is one. If @var{low} is also omitted, the limits are @samp{-inf}
25522 and @samp{inf}, respectively.
25523
25524 Infinite sums can sometimes be evaluated: @samp{sum(.5^k, k, 1, inf)}
25525 returns @expr{1}. This is done by evaluating the sum in closed
25526 form (to @samp{1. - 0.5^n} in this case), then evaluating this
25527 formula with @code{n} set to @code{inf}. Calc's usual rules
25528 for ``infinite'' arithmetic can find the answer from there. If
25529 infinite arithmetic yields a @samp{nan}, or if the sum cannot be
25530 solved in closed form, Calc leaves the @code{sum} function in
25531 symbolic form. @xref{Infinities}.
25532
25533 As a special feature, if the limits are infinite (or omitted, as
25534 described above) but the formula includes vectors subscripted by
25535 expressions that involve the iteration variable, Calc narrows
25536 the limits to include only the range of integers which result in
25537 valid subscripts for the vector. For example, the sum
25538 @samp{sum(k [a,b,c,d,e,f,g]_(2k),k)} evaluates to @samp{b + 2 d + 3 f}.
25539
25540 The limits of a sum do not need to be integers. For example,
25541 @samp{sum(a_k, k, 0, 2 n, n)} produces @samp{a_0 + a_n + a_(2 n)}.
25542 Calc computes the number of iterations using the formula
25543 @samp{1 + (@var{high} - @var{low}) / @var{step}}, which must,
25544 after algebraic simplification, evaluate to an integer.
25545
25546 If the number of iterations according to the above formula does
25547 not come out to an integer, the sum is invalid and will be left
25548 in symbolic form. However, closed forms are still supplied, and
25549 you are on your honor not to misuse the resulting formulas by
25550 substituting mismatched bounds into them. For example,
25551 @samp{sum(k, k, 1, 10, 2)} is invalid, but Calc will go ahead and
25552 evaluate the closed form solution for the limits 1 and 10 to get
25553 the rather dubious answer, 29.25.
25554
25555 If the lower limit is greater than the upper limit (assuming a
25556 positive step size), the result is generally zero. However,
25557 Calc only guarantees a zero result when the upper limit is
25558 exactly one step less than the lower limit, i.e., if the number
25559 of iterations is @mathit{-1}. Thus @samp{sum(f(k), k, n, n-1)} is zero
25560 but the sum from @samp{n} to @samp{n-2} may report a nonzero value
25561 if Calc used a closed form solution.
25562
25563 Calc's logical predicates like @expr{a < b} return 1 for ``true''
25564 and 0 for ``false.'' @xref{Logical Operations}. This can be
25565 used to advantage for building conditional sums. For example,
25566 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k, 1, 20)} is the sum of the squares of all
25567 prime numbers from 1 to 20; the @code{prime} predicate returns 1 if
25568 its argument is prime and 0 otherwise. You can read this expression
25569 as ``the sum of @expr{k^2}, where @expr{k} is prime.'' Indeed,
25570 @samp{sum(prime(k)*k^2, k)} would represent the sum of @emph{all} primes
25571 squared, since the limits default to plus and minus infinity, but
25572 there are no such sums that Calc's built-in rules can do in
25573 closed form.
25574
25575 As another example, @samp{sum((k != k_0) * f(k), k, 1, n)} is the
25576 sum of @expr{f(k)} for all @expr{k} from 1 to @expr{n}, excluding
25577 one value @expr{k_0}. Slightly more tricky is the summand
25578 @samp{(k != k_0) / (k - k_0)}, which is an attempt to describe
25579 the sum of all @expr{1/(k-k_0)} except at @expr{k = k_0}, where
25580 this would be a division by zero. But at @expr{k = k_0}, this
25581 formula works out to the indeterminate form @expr{0 / 0}, which
25582 Calc will not assume is zero. Better would be to use
25583 @samp{(k != k_0) ? 1/(k-k_0) : 0}; the @samp{? :} operator does
25584 an ``if-then-else'' test: This expression says, ``if
25585 @texline @math{k \ne k_0},
25586 @infoline @expr{k != k_0},
25587 then @expr{1/(k-k_0)}, else zero.'' Now the formula @expr{1/(k-k_0)}
25588 will not even be evaluated by Calc when @expr{k = k_0}.
25589
25590 @cindex Alternating sums
25591 @kindex a -
25592 @pindex calc-alt-summation
25593 @tindex asum
25594 The @kbd{a -} (@code{calc-alt-summation}) [@code{asum}] command
25595 computes an alternating sum. Successive terms of the sequence
25596 are given alternating signs, with the first term (corresponding
25597 to the lower index value) being positive. Alternating sums
25598 are converted to normal sums with an extra term of the form
25599 @samp{(-1)^(k-@var{low})}. This formula is adjusted appropriately
25600 if the step value is other than one. For example, the Taylor
25601 series for the sine function is @samp{asum(x^k / k!, k, 1, inf, 2)}.
25602 (Calc cannot evaluate this infinite series, but it can approximate
25603 it if you replace @code{inf} with any particular odd number.)
25604 Calc converts this series to a regular sum with a step of one,
25605 namely @samp{sum((-1)^k x^(2k+1) / (2k+1)!, k, 0, inf)}.
25606
25607 @cindex Product of a sequence
25608 @kindex a *
25609 @pindex calc-product
25610 @tindex prod
25611 The @kbd{a *} (@code{calc-product}) [@code{prod}] command is
25612 the analogous way to take a product of many terms. Calc also knows
25613 some closed forms for products, such as @samp{prod(k, k, 1, n) = n!}.
25614 Conditional products can be written @samp{prod(k^prime(k), k, 1, n)}
25615 or @samp{prod(prime(k) ? k : 1, k, 1, n)}.
25616
25617 @kindex a T
25618 @pindex calc-tabulate
25619 @tindex table
25620 The @kbd{a T} (@code{calc-tabulate}) [@code{table}] command
25621 evaluates a formula at a series of iterated index values, just
25622 like @code{sum} and @code{prod}, but its result is simply a
25623 vector of the results. For example, @samp{table(a_i, i, 1, 7, 2)}
25624 produces @samp{[a_1, a_3, a_5, a_7]}.
25625
25626 @node Logical Operations, Rewrite Rules, Summations, Algebra
25627 @section Logical Operations
25628
25629 @noindent
25630 The following commands and algebraic functions return true/false values,
25631 where 1 represents ``true'' and 0 represents ``false.'' In cases where
25632 a truth value is required (such as for the condition part of a rewrite
25633 rule, or as the condition for a @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} control structure), any
25634 nonzero value is accepted to mean ``true.'' (Specifically, anything
25635 for which @code{dnonzero} returns 1 is ``true,'' and anything for
25636 which @code{dnonzero} returns 0 or cannot decide is assumed ``false.''
25637 Note that this means that @w{@kbd{Z [ Z ]}} will execute the ``then''
25638 portion if its condition is provably true, but it will execute the
25639 ``else'' portion for any condition like @expr{a = b} that is not
25640 provably true, even if it might be true. Algebraic functions that
25641 have conditions as arguments, like @code{? :} and @code{&&}, remain
25642 unevaluated if the condition is neither provably true nor provably
25643 false. @xref{Declarations}.)
25644
25645 @kindex a =
25646 @pindex calc-equal-to
25647 @tindex eq
25648 @tindex =
25649 @tindex ==
25650 The @kbd{a =} (@code{calc-equal-to}) command, or @samp{eq(a,b)} function
25651 (which can also be written @samp{a = b} or @samp{a == b} in an algebraic
25652 formula) is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are equal, either because they
25653 are identical expressions, or because they are numbers which are
25654 numerically equal. (Thus the integer 1 is considered equal to the float
25655 1.0.) If the equality of @expr{a} and @expr{b} cannot be determined,
25656 the comparison is left in symbolic form. Note that as a command, this
25657 operation pops two values from the stack and pushes back either a 1 or
25658 a 0, or a formula @samp{a = b} if the values' equality cannot be determined.
25659
25660 Many Calc commands use @samp{=} formulas to represent @dfn{equations}.
25661 For example, the @kbd{a S} (@code{calc-solve-for}) command rearranges
25662 an equation to solve for a given variable. The @kbd{a M}
25663 (@code{calc-map-equation}) command can be used to apply any
25664 function to both sides of an equation; for example, @kbd{2 a M *}
25665 multiplies both sides of the equation by two. Note that just
25666 @kbd{2 *} would not do the same thing; it would produce the formula
25667 @samp{2 (a = b)} which represents 2 if the equality is true or
25668 zero if not.
25669
25670 The @code{eq} function with more than two arguments (e.g., @kbd{C-u 3 a =}
25671 or @samp{a = b = c}) tests if all of its arguments are equal. In
25672 algebraic notation, the @samp{=} operator is unusual in that it is
25673 neither left- nor right-associative: @samp{a = b = c} is not the
25674 same as @samp{(a = b) = c} or @samp{a = (b = c)} (which each compare
25675 one variable with the 1 or 0 that results from comparing two other
25676 variables).
25677
25678 @kindex a #
25679 @pindex calc-not-equal-to
25680 @tindex neq
25681 @tindex !=
25682 The @kbd{a #} (@code{calc-not-equal-to}) command, or @samp{neq(a,b)} or
25683 @samp{a != b} function, is true if @expr{a} and @expr{b} are not equal.
25684 This also works with more than two arguments; @samp{a != b != c != d}
25685 tests that all four of @expr{a}, @expr{b}, @expr{c}, and @expr{d} are
25686 distinct numbers.
25687
25688 @kindex a <
25689 @tindex lt
25690 @ignore
25691 @mindex @idots
25692 @end ignore
25693 @kindex a >
25694 @ignore
25695 @mindex @null
25696 @end ignore
25697 @kindex a [
25698 @ignore
25699 @mindex @null
25700 @end ignore
25701 @kindex a ]
25702 @pindex calc-less-than
25703 @pindex calc-greater-than
25704 @pindex calc-less-equal
25705 @pindex calc-greater-equal
25706 @ignore
25707 @mindex @null
25708 @end ignore
25709 @tindex gt
25710 @ignore
25711 @mindex @null
25712 @end ignore
25713 @tindex leq
25714 @ignore
25715 @mindex @null
25716 @end ignore
25717 @tindex geq
25718 @ignore
25719 @mindex @null
25720 @end ignore
25721 @tindex <
25722 @ignore
25723 @mindex @null
25724 @end ignore
25725 @tindex >
25726 @ignore
25727 @mindex @null
25728 @end ignore
25729 @tindex <=
25730 @ignore
25731 @mindex @null
25732 @end ignore
25733 @tindex >=
25734 The @kbd{a <} (@code{calc-less-than}) [@samp{lt(a,b)} or @samp{a < b}]
25735 operation is true if @expr{a} is less than @expr{b}. Similar functions
25736 are @kbd{a >} (@code{calc-greater-than}) [@samp{gt(a,b)} or @samp{a > b}],
25737 @kbd{a [} (@code{calc-less-equal}) [@samp{leq(a,b)} or @samp{a <= b}], and
25738 @kbd{a ]} (@code{calc-greater-equal}) [@samp{geq(a,b)} or @samp{a >= b}].
25739
25740 While the inequality functions like @code{lt} do not accept more
25741 than two arguments, the syntax @w{@samp{a <= b < c}} is translated to an
25742 equivalent expression involving intervals: @samp{b in [a .. c)}.
25743 (See the description of @code{in} below.) All four combinations
25744 of @samp{<} and @samp{<=} are allowed, or any of the four combinations
25745 of @samp{>} and @samp{>=}. Four-argument constructions like
25746 @samp{a < b < c < d}, and mixtures like @w{@samp{a < b = c}} that
25747 involve both equations and inequalities, are not allowed.
25748
25749 @kindex a .
25750 @pindex calc-remove-equal
25751 @tindex rmeq
25752 The @kbd{a .} (@code{calc-remove-equal}) [@code{rmeq}] command extracts
25753 the righthand side of the equation or inequality on the top of the
25754 stack. It also works elementwise on vectors. For example, if
25755 @samp{[x = 2.34, y = z / 2]} is on the stack, then @kbd{a .} produces
25756 @samp{[2.34, z / 2]}. As a special case, if the righthand side is a
25757 variable and the lefthand side is a number (as in @samp{2.34 = x}), then
25758 Calc keeps the lefthand side instead. Finally, this command works with
25759 assignments @samp{x := 2.34} as well as equations, always taking the
25760 righthand side, and for @samp{=>} (evaluates-to) operators, always
25761 taking the lefthand side.
25762
25763 @kindex a &
25764 @pindex calc-logical-and
25765 @tindex land
25766 @tindex &&
25767 The @kbd{a &} (@code{calc-logical-and}) [@samp{land(a,b)} or @samp{a && b}]
25768 function is true if both of its arguments are true, i.e., are
25769 non-zero numbers. In this case, the result will be either @expr{a} or
25770 @expr{b}, chosen arbitrarily. If either argument is zero, the result is
25771 zero. Otherwise, the formula is left in symbolic form.
25772
25773 @kindex a |
25774 @pindex calc-logical-or
25775 @tindex lor
25776 @tindex ||
25777 The @kbd{a |} (@code{calc-logical-or}) [@samp{lor(a,b)} or @samp{a || b}]
25778 function is true if either or both of its arguments are true (nonzero).
25779 The result is whichever argument was nonzero, choosing arbitrarily if both
25780 are nonzero. If both @expr{a} and @expr{b} are zero, the result is
25781 zero.
25782
25783 @kindex a !
25784 @pindex calc-logical-not
25785 @tindex lnot
25786 @tindex !
25787 The @kbd{a !} (@code{calc-logical-not}) [@samp{lnot(a)} or @samp{!@: a}]
25788 function is true if @expr{a} is false (zero), or false if @expr{a} is
25789 true (nonzero). It is left in symbolic form if @expr{a} is not a
25790 number.
25791
25792 @kindex a :
25793 @pindex calc-logical-if
25794 @tindex if
25795 @ignore
25796 @mindex ? :
25797 @end ignore
25798 @tindex ?
25799 @ignore
25800 @mindex @null
25801 @end ignore
25802 @tindex :
25803 @cindex Arguments, not evaluated
25804 The @kbd{a :} (@code{calc-logical-if}) [@samp{if(a,b,c)} or @samp{a ? b :@: c}]
25805 function is equal to either @expr{b} or @expr{c} if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25806 number or zero, respectively. If @expr{a} is not a number, the test is
25807 left in symbolic form and neither @expr{b} nor @expr{c} is evaluated in
25808 any way. In algebraic formulas, this is one of the few Calc functions
25809 whose arguments are not automatically evaluated when the function itself
25810 is evaluated. The others are @code{lambda}, @code{quote}, and
25811 @code{condition}.
25812
25813 One minor surprise to watch out for is that the formula @samp{a?3:4}
25814 will not work because the @samp{3:4} is parsed as a fraction instead of
25815 as three separate symbols. Type something like @samp{a ? 3 : 4} or
25816 @samp{a?(3):4} instead.
25817
25818 As a special case, if @expr{a} evaluates to a vector, then both @expr{b}
25819 and @expr{c} are evaluated; the result is a vector of the same length
25820 as @expr{a} whose elements are chosen from corresponding elements of
25821 @expr{b} and @expr{c} according to whether each element of @expr{a}
25822 is zero or nonzero. Each of @expr{b} and @expr{c} must be either a
25823 vector of the same length as @expr{a}, or a non-vector which is matched
25824 with all elements of @expr{a}.
25825
25826 @kindex a @{
25827 @pindex calc-in-set
25828 @tindex in
25829 The @kbd{a @{} (@code{calc-in-set}) [@samp{in(a,b)}] function is true if
25830 the number @expr{a} is in the set of numbers represented by @expr{b}.
25831 If @expr{b} is an interval form, @expr{a} must be one of the values
25832 encompassed by the interval. If @expr{b} is a vector, @expr{a} must be
25833 equal to one of the elements of the vector. (If any vector elements are
25834 intervals, @expr{a} must be in any of the intervals.) If @expr{b} is a
25835 plain number, @expr{a} must be numerically equal to @expr{b}.
25836 @xref{Set Operations}, for a group of commands that manipulate sets
25837 of this sort.
25838
25839 @ignore
25840 @starindex
25841 @end ignore
25842 @tindex typeof
25843 The @samp{typeof(a)} function produces an integer or variable which
25844 characterizes @expr{a}. If @expr{a} is a number, vector, or variable,
25845 the result will be one of the following numbers:
25846
25847 @example
25848 1 Integer
25849 2 Fraction
25850 3 Floating-point number
25851 4 HMS form
25852 5 Rectangular complex number
25853 6 Polar complex number
25854 7 Error form
25855 8 Interval form
25856 9 Modulo form
25857 10 Date-only form
25858 11 Date/time form
25859 12 Infinity (inf, uinf, or nan)
25860 100 Variable
25861 101 Vector (but not a matrix)
25862 102 Matrix
25863 @end example
25864
25865 Otherwise, @expr{a} is a formula, and the result is a variable which
25866 represents the name of the top-level function call.
25867
25868 @ignore
25869 @starindex
25870 @end ignore
25871 @tindex integer
25872 @ignore
25873 @starindex
25874 @end ignore
25875 @tindex real
25876 @ignore
25877 @starindex
25878 @end ignore
25879 @tindex constant
25880 The @samp{integer(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is an integer.
25881 The @samp{real(a)} function
25882 is true if @expr{a} is a real number, either integer, fraction, or
25883 float. The @samp{constant(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} is
25884 any of the objects for which @code{typeof} would produce an integer
25885 code result except for variables, and provided that the components of
25886 an object like a vector or error form are themselves constant.
25887 Note that infinities do not satisfy any of these tests, nor do
25888 special constants like @code{pi} and @code{e}.
25889
25890 @xref{Declarations}, for a set of similar functions that recognize
25891 formulas as well as actual numbers. For example, @samp{dint(floor(x))}
25892 is true because @samp{floor(x)} is provably integer-valued, but
25893 @samp{integer(floor(x))} does not because @samp{floor(x)} is not
25894 literally an integer constant.
25895
25896 @ignore
25897 @starindex
25898 @end ignore
25899 @tindex refers
25900 The @samp{refers(a,b)} function is true if the variable (or sub-expression)
25901 @expr{b} appears in @expr{a}, or false otherwise. Unlike the other
25902 tests described here, this function returns a definite ``no'' answer
25903 even if its arguments are still in symbolic form. The only case where
25904 @code{refers} will be left unevaluated is if @expr{a} is a plain
25905 variable (different from @expr{b}).
25906
25907 @ignore
25908 @starindex
25909 @end ignore
25910 @tindex negative
25911 The @samp{negative(a)} function returns true if @expr{a} ``looks'' negative,
25912 because it is a negative number, because it is of the form @expr{-x},
25913 or because it is a product or quotient with a term that looks negative.
25914 This is most useful in rewrite rules. Beware that @samp{negative(a)}
25915 evaluates to 1 or 0 for @emph{any} argument @expr{a}, so it can only
25916 be stored in a formula if the default simplifications are turned off
25917 first with @kbd{m O} (or if it appears in an unevaluated context such
25918 as a rewrite rule condition).
25919
25920 @ignore
25921 @starindex
25922 @end ignore
25923 @tindex variable
25924 The @samp{variable(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a variable,
25925 or false if not. If @expr{a} is a function call, this test is left
25926 in symbolic form. Built-in variables like @code{pi} and @code{inf}
25927 are considered variables like any others by this test.
25928
25929 @ignore
25930 @starindex
25931 @end ignore
25932 @tindex nonvar
25933 The @samp{nonvar(a)} function is true if @expr{a} is a non-variable.
25934 If its argument is a variable it is left unsimplified; it never
25935 actually returns zero. However, since Calc's condition-testing
25936 commands consider ``false'' anything not provably true, this is
25937 often good enough.
25938
25939 @ignore
25940 @starindex
25941 @end ignore
25942 @tindex lin
25943 @ignore
25944 @starindex
25945 @end ignore
25946 @tindex linnt
25947 @ignore
25948 @starindex
25949 @end ignore
25950 @tindex islin
25951 @ignore
25952 @starindex
25953 @end ignore
25954 @tindex islinnt
25955 @cindex Linearity testing
25956 The functions @code{lin}, @code{linnt}, @code{islin}, and @code{islinnt}
25957 check if an expression is ``linear,'' i.e., can be written in the form
25958 @expr{a + b x} for some constants @expr{a} and @expr{b}, and some
25959 variable or subformula @expr{x}. The function @samp{islin(f,x)} checks
25960 if formula @expr{f} is linear in @expr{x}, returning 1 if so. For
25961 example, @samp{islin(x,x)}, @samp{islin(-x,x)}, @samp{islin(3,x)}, and
25962 @samp{islin(x y / 3 - 2, x)} all return 1. The @samp{lin(f,x)} function
25963 is similar, except that instead of returning 1 it returns the vector
25964 @expr{[a, b, x]}. For the above examples, this vector would be
25965 @expr{[0, 1, x]}, @expr{[0, -1, x]}, @expr{[3, 0, x]}, and
25966 @expr{[-2, y/3, x]}, respectively. Both @code{lin} and @code{islin}
25967 generally remain unevaluated for expressions which are not linear,
25968 e.g., @samp{lin(2 x^2, x)} and @samp{lin(sin(x), x)}. The second
25969 argument can also be a formula; @samp{islin(2 + 3 sin(x), sin(x))}
25970 returns true.
25971
25972 The @code{linnt} and @code{islinnt} functions perform a similar check,
25973 but require a ``non-trivial'' linear form, which means that the
25974 @expr{b} coefficient must be non-zero. For example, @samp{lin(2,x)}
25975 returns @expr{[2, 0, x]} and @samp{lin(y,x)} returns @expr{[y, 0, x]},
25976 but @samp{linnt(2,x)} and @samp{linnt(y,x)} are left unevaluated
25977 (in other words, these formulas are considered to be only ``trivially''
25978 linear in @expr{x}).
25979
25980 All four linearity-testing functions allow you to omit the second
25981 argument, in which case the input may be linear in any non-constant
25982 formula. Here, the @expr{a=0}, @expr{b=1} case is also considered
25983 trivial, and only constant values for @expr{a} and @expr{b} are
25984 recognized. Thus, @samp{lin(2 x y)} returns @expr{[0, 2, x y]},
25985 @samp{lin(2 - x y)} returns @expr{[2, -1, x y]}, and @samp{lin(x y)}
25986 returns @expr{[0, 1, x y]}. The @code{linnt} function would allow the
25987 first two cases but not the third. Also, neither @code{lin} nor
25988 @code{linnt} accept plain constants as linear in the one-argument
25989 case: @samp{islin(2,x)} is true, but @samp{islin(2)} is false.
25990
25991 @ignore
25992 @starindex
25993 @end ignore
25994 @tindex istrue
25995 The @samp{istrue(a)} function returns 1 if @expr{a} is a nonzero
25996 number or provably nonzero formula, or 0 if @expr{a} is anything else.
25997 Calls to @code{istrue} can only be manipulated if @kbd{m O} mode is
25998 used to make sure they are not evaluated prematurely. (Note that
25999 declarations are used when deciding whether a formula is true;
26000 @code{istrue} returns 1 when @code{dnonzero} would return 1, and
26001 it returns 0 when @code{dnonzero} would return 0 or leave itself
26002 in symbolic form.)
26003
26004 @node Rewrite Rules, , Logical Operations, Algebra
26005 @section Rewrite Rules
26006
26007 @noindent
26008 @cindex Rewrite rules
26009 @cindex Transformations
26010 @cindex Pattern matching
26011 @kindex a r
26012 @pindex calc-rewrite
26013 @tindex rewrite
26014 The @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) [@code{rewrite}] command makes
26015 substitutions in a formula according to a specified pattern or patterns
26016 known as @dfn{rewrite rules}. Whereas @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute})
26017 matches literally, so that substituting @samp{sin(x)} with @samp{cos(x)}
26018 matches only the @code{sin} function applied to the variable @code{x},
26019 rewrite rules match general kinds of formulas; rewriting using the rule
26020 @samp{sin(x) := cos(x)} matches @code{sin} of any argument and replaces
26021 it with @code{cos} of that same argument. The only significance of the
26022 name @code{x} is that the same name is used on both sides of the rule.
26023
26024 Rewrite rules rearrange formulas already in Calc's memory.
26025 @xref{Syntax Tables}, to read about @dfn{syntax rules}, which are
26026 similar to algebraic rewrite rules but operate when new algebraic
26027 entries are being parsed, converting strings of characters into
26028 Calc formulas.
26029
26030 @menu
26031 * Entering Rewrite Rules::
26032 * Basic Rewrite Rules::
26033 * Conditional Rewrite Rules::
26034 * Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules::
26035 * Other Features of Rewrite Rules::
26036 * Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules::
26037 * Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules::
26038 * Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules::
26039 * Selections with Rewrite Rules::
26040 * Matching Commands::
26041 * Automatic Rewrites::
26042 * Debugging Rewrites::
26043 * Examples of Rewrite Rules::
26044 @end menu
26045
26046 @node Entering Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26047 @subsection Entering Rewrite Rules
26048
26049 @noindent
26050 Rewrite rules normally use the ``assignment'' operator
26051 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}.
26052 This operator is equivalent to the function call @samp{assign(old, new)}.
26053 The @code{assign} function is undefined by itself in Calc, so an
26054 assignment formula such as a rewrite rule will be left alone by ordinary
26055 Calc commands. But certain commands, like the rewrite system, interpret
26056 assignments in special ways.
26057
26058 For example, the rule @samp{sin(x)^2 := 1-cos(x)^2} says to replace
26059 every occurrence of the sine of something, squared, with one minus the
26060 square of the cosine of that same thing. All by itself as a formula
26061 on the stack it does nothing, but when given to the @kbd{a r} command
26062 it turns that command into a sine-squared-to-cosine-squared converter.
26063
26064 To specify a set of rules to be applied all at once, make a vector of
26065 rules.
26066
26067 When @kbd{a r} prompts you to enter the rewrite rules, you can answer
26068 in several ways:
26069
26070 @enumerate
26071 @item
26072 With a rule: @kbd{f(x) := g(x) @key{RET}}.
26073 @item
26074 With a vector of rules: @kbd{[f1(x) := g1(x), f2(x) := g2(x)] @key{RET}}.
26075 (You can omit the enclosing square brackets if you wish.)
26076 @item
26077 With the name of a variable that contains the rule or rules vector:
26078 @kbd{myrules @key{RET}}.
26079 @item
26080 With any formula except a rule, a vector, or a variable name; this
26081 will be interpreted as the @var{old} half of a rewrite rule,
26082 and you will be prompted a second time for the @var{new} half:
26083 @kbd{f(x) @key{RET} g(x) @key{RET}}.
26084 @item
26085 With a blank line, in which case the rule, rules vector, or variable
26086 will be taken from the top of the stack (and the formula to be
26087 rewritten will come from the second-to-top position).
26088 @end enumerate
26089
26090 If you enter the rules directly (as opposed to using rules stored
26091 in a variable), those rules will be put into the Trail so that you
26092 can retrieve them later. @xref{Trail Commands}.
26093
26094 It is most convenient to store rules you use often in a variable and
26095 invoke them by giving the variable name. The @kbd{s e}
26096 (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command is an easy way to create or edit a
26097 rule set stored in a variable. You may also wish to use @kbd{s p}
26098 (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) to save your rules permanently;
26099 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
26100
26101 Rewrite rules are compiled into a special internal form for faster
26102 matching. If you enter a rule set directly it must be recompiled
26103 every time. If you store the rules in a variable and refer to them
26104 through that variable, they will be compiled once and saved away
26105 along with the variable for later reference. This is another good
26106 reason to store your rules in a variable.
26107
26108 Calc also accepts an obsolete notation for rules, as vectors
26109 @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}]}. But because it is easily confused with a
26110 vector of two rules, the use of this notation is no longer recommended.
26111
26112 @node Basic Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Entering Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26113 @subsection Basic Rewrite Rules
26114
26115 @noindent
26116 To match a particular formula @expr{x} with a particular rewrite rule
26117 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new}}, Calc compares the structure of @expr{x} with
26118 the structure of @var{old}. Variables that appear in @var{old} are
26119 treated as @dfn{meta-variables}; the corresponding positions in @expr{x}
26120 may contain any sub-formulas. For example, the pattern @samp{f(x,y)}
26121 would match the expression @samp{f(12, a+1)} with the meta-variable
26122 @samp{x} corresponding to 12 and with @samp{y} corresponding to
26123 @samp{a+1}. However, this pattern would not match @samp{f(12)} or
26124 @samp{g(12, a+1)}, since there is no assignment of the meta-variables
26125 that will make the pattern match these expressions. Notice that if
26126 the pattern is a single meta-variable, it will match any expression.
26127
26128 If a given meta-variable appears more than once in @var{old}, the
26129 corresponding sub-formulas of @expr{x} must be identical. Thus
26130 the pattern @samp{f(x,x)} would match @samp{f(12, 12)} and
26131 @samp{f(a+1, a+1)} but not @samp{f(12, a+1)} or @samp{f(a+b, b+a)}.
26132 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for a way to match the latter.)
26133
26134 Things other than variables must match exactly between the pattern
26135 and the target formula. To match a particular variable exactly, use
26136 the pseudo-function @samp{quote(v)} in the pattern. For example, the
26137 pattern @samp{x+quote(y)} matches @samp{x+y}, @samp{2+y}, or
26138 @samp{sin(a)+y}.
26139
26140 The special variable names @samp{e}, @samp{pi}, @samp{i}, @samp{phi},
26141 @samp{gamma}, @samp{inf}, @samp{uinf}, and @samp{nan} always match
26142 literally. Thus the pattern @samp{sin(d + e + f)} acts exactly like
26143 @samp{sin(d + quote(e) + f)}.
26144
26145 If the @var{old} pattern is found to match a given formula, that
26146 formula is replaced by @var{new}, where any occurrences in @var{new}
26147 of meta-variables from the pattern are replaced with the sub-formulas
26148 that they matched. Thus, applying the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x)}
26149 to @samp{f(12, a+1)} would produce @samp{g(a+13, 12)}.
26150
26151 The normal @kbd{a r} command applies rewrite rules over and over
26152 throughout the target formula until no further changes are possible
26153 (up to a limit of 100 times). Use @kbd{C-u 1 a r} to make only one
26154 change at a time.
26155
26156 @node Conditional Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Basic Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26157 @subsection Conditional Rewrite Rules
26158
26159 @noindent
26160 A rewrite rule can also be @dfn{conditional}, written in the form
26161 @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}}. (There is also the obsolete
26162 form @samp{[@var{old}, @var{new}, @var{cond}]}.) If a @var{cond} part
26163 is present in the
26164 rule, this is an additional condition that must be satisfied before
26165 the rule is accepted. Once @var{old} has been successfully matched
26166 to the target expression, @var{cond} is evaluated (with all the
26167 meta-variables substituted for the values they matched) and simplified
26168 with Calc's algebraic simplifications. If the result is a nonzero
26169 number or any other object known to be nonzero (@pxref{Declarations}),
26170 the rule is accepted. If the result is zero or if it is a symbolic
26171 formula that is not known to be nonzero, the rule is rejected.
26172 @xref{Logical Operations}, for a number of functions that return
26173 1 or 0 according to the results of various tests.
26174
26175 For example, the formula @samp{n > 0} simplifies to 1 or 0 if @expr{n}
26176 is replaced by a positive or nonpositive number, respectively (or if
26177 @expr{n} has been declared to be positive or nonpositive). Thus,
26178 the rule @samp{f(x,y) := g(y+x,x) :: x+y > 0} would apply to
26179 @samp{f(0, 4)} but not to @samp{f(-3, 2)} or @samp{f(12, a+1)}
26180 (assuming no outstanding declarations for @expr{a}). In the case of
26181 @samp{f(-3, 2)}, the condition can be shown not to be satisfied; in
26182 the case of @samp{f(12, a+1)}, the condition merely cannot be shown
26183 to be satisfied, but that is enough to reject the rule.
26184
26185 While Calc will use declarations to reason about variables in the
26186 formula being rewritten, declarations do not apply to meta-variables.
26187 For example, the rule @samp{f(a) := g(a+1)} will match for any values
26188 of @samp{a}, such as complex numbers, vectors, or formulas, even if
26189 @samp{a} has been declared to be real or scalar. If you want the
26190 meta-variable @samp{a} to match only literal real numbers, use
26191 @samp{f(a) := g(a+1) :: real(a)}. If you want @samp{a} to match only
26192 reals and formulas which are provably real, use @samp{dreal(a)} as
26193 the condition.
26194
26195 The @samp{::} operator is a shorthand for the @code{condition}
26196 function; @samp{@var{old} := @var{new} :: @var{cond}} is equivalent to
26197 the formula @samp{condition(assign(@var{old}, @var{new}), @var{cond})}.
26198
26199 If you have several conditions, you can use @samp{... :: c1 :: c2 :: c3}
26200 or @samp{... :: c1 && c2 && c3}. The two are entirely equivalent.
26201
26202 It is also possible to embed conditions inside the pattern:
26203 @samp{f(x :: x>0, y) := g(y+x, x)}. This is purely a notational
26204 convenience, though; where a condition appears in a rule has no
26205 effect on when it is tested. The rewrite-rule compiler automatically
26206 decides when it is best to test each condition while a rule is being
26207 matched.
26208
26209 Certain conditions are handled as special cases by the rewrite rule
26210 system and are tested very efficiently: Where @expr{x} is any
26211 meta-variable, these conditions are @samp{integer(x)}, @samp{real(x)},
26212 @samp{constant(x)}, @samp{negative(x)}, @samp{x >= y} where @expr{y}
26213 is either a constant or another meta-variable and @samp{>=} may be
26214 replaced by any of the six relational operators, and @samp{x % a = b}
26215 where @expr{a} and @expr{b} are constants. Other conditions, like
26216 @samp{x >= y+1} or @samp{dreal(x)}, will be less efficient to check
26217 since Calc must bring the whole evaluator and simplifier into play.
26218
26219 An interesting property of @samp{::} is that neither of its arguments
26220 will be touched by Calc's default simplifications. This is important
26221 because conditions often are expressions that cannot safely be
26222 evaluated early. For example, the @code{typeof} function never
26223 remains in symbolic form; entering @samp{typeof(a)} will put the
26224 number 100 (the type code for variables like @samp{a}) on the stack.
26225 But putting the condition @samp{... :: typeof(a) = 6} on the stack
26226 is safe since @samp{::} prevents the @code{typeof} from being
26227 evaluated until the condition is actually used by the rewrite system.
26228
26229 Since @samp{::} protects its lefthand side, too, you can use a dummy
26230 condition to protect a rule that must itself not evaluate early.
26231 For example, it's not safe to put @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x])} on
26232 the stack because it will immediately evaluate to @samp{a(f,x) := f(x)},
26233 where the meta-variable-ness of @code{f} on the righthand side has been
26234 lost. But @samp{a(f,x) := apply(f, [x]) :: 1} is safe, and of course
26235 the condition @samp{1} is always true (nonzero) so it has no effect on
26236 the functioning of the rule. (The rewrite compiler will ensure that
26237 it doesn't even impact the speed of matching the rule.)
26238
26239 @node Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Conditional Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26240 @subsection Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules
26241
26242 @noindent
26243 The rewrite mechanism understands the algebraic properties of functions
26244 like @samp{+} and @samp{*}. In particular, pattern matching takes
26245 the associativity and commutativity of the following functions into
26246 account:
26247
26248 @smallexample
26249 + - * = != && || and or xor vint vunion vxor gcd lcm max min beta
26250 @end smallexample
26251
26252 For example, the rewrite rule:
26253
26254 @example
26255 a x + b x := (a + b) x
26256 @end example
26257
26258 @noindent
26259 will match formulas of the form,
26260
26261 @example
26262 a x + b x, x a + x b, a x + x b, x a + b x
26263 @end example
26264
26265 Rewrites also understand the relationship between the @samp{+} and @samp{-}
26266 operators. The above rewrite rule will also match the formulas,
26267
26268 @example
26269 a x - b x, x a - x b, a x - x b, x a - b x
26270 @end example
26271
26272 @noindent
26273 by matching @samp{b} in the pattern to @samp{-b} from the formula.
26274
26275 Applied to a sum of many terms like @samp{r + a x + s + b x + t}, this
26276 pattern will check all pairs of terms for possible matches. The rewrite
26277 will take whichever suitable pair it discovers first.
26278
26279 In general, a pattern using an associative operator like @samp{a + b}
26280 will try @var{2 n} different ways to match a sum of @var{n} terms
26281 like @samp{x + y + z - w}. First, @samp{a} is matched against each
26282 of @samp{x}, @samp{y}, @samp{z}, and @samp{-w} in turn, with @samp{b}
26283 being matched to the remainders @samp{y + z - w}, @samp{x + z - w}, etc.
26284 If none of these succeed, then @samp{b} is matched against each of the
26285 four terms with @samp{a} matching the remainder. Half-and-half matches,
26286 like @samp{(x + y) + (z - w)}, are not tried.
26287
26288 Note that @samp{*} is not commutative when applied to matrices, but
26289 rewrite rules pretend that it is. If you type @kbd{m v} to enable
26290 Matrix mode (@pxref{Matrix Mode}), rewrite rules will match @samp{*}
26291 literally, ignoring its usual commutativity property. (In the
26292 current implementation, the associativity also vanishes---it is as
26293 if the pattern had been enclosed in a @code{plain} marker; see below.)
26294 If you are applying rewrites to formulas with matrices, it's best to
26295 enable Matrix mode first to prevent algebraically incorrect rewrites
26296 from occurring.
26297
26298 The pattern @samp{-x} will actually match any expression. For example,
26299 the rule
26300
26301 @example
26302 f(-x) := -f(x)
26303 @end example
26304
26305 @noindent
26306 will rewrite @samp{f(a)} to @samp{-f(-a)}. To avoid this, either use
26307 a @code{plain} marker as described below, or add a @samp{negative(x)}
26308 condition. The @code{negative} function is true if its argument
26309 ``looks'' negative, for example, because it is a negative number or
26310 because it is a formula like @samp{-x}. The new rule using this
26311 condition is:
26312
26313 @example
26314 f(x) := -f(-x) :: negative(x) @r{or, equivalently,}
26315 f(-x) := -f(x) :: negative(-x)
26316 @end example
26317
26318 In the same way, the pattern @samp{x - y} will match the sum @samp{a + b}
26319 by matching @samp{y} to @samp{-b}.
26320
26321 The pattern @samp{a b} will also match the formula @samp{x/y} if
26322 @samp{y} is a number. Thus the rule @samp{a x + @w{b x} := (a+b) x}
26323 will also convert @samp{a x + x / 2} to @samp{(a + 0.5) x} (or
26324 @samp{(a + 1:2) x}, depending on the current fraction mode).
26325
26326 Calc will @emph{not} take other liberties with @samp{*}, @samp{/}, and
26327 @samp{^}. For example, the pattern @samp{f(a b)} will not match
26328 @samp{f(x^2)}, and @samp{f(a + b)} will not match @samp{f(2 x)}, even
26329 though conceivably these patterns could match with @samp{a = b = x}.
26330 Nor will @samp{f(a b)} match @samp{f(x / y)} if @samp{y} is not a
26331 constant, even though it could be considered to match with @samp{a = x}
26332 and @samp{b = 1/y}. The reasons are partly for efficiency, and partly
26333 because while few mathematical operations are substantively different
26334 for addition and subtraction, often it is preferable to treat the cases
26335 of multiplication, division, and integer powers separately.
26336
26337 Even more subtle is the rule set
26338
26339 @example
26340 [ f(a) + f(b) := f(a + b), -f(a) := f(-a) ]
26341 @end example
26342
26343 @noindent
26344 attempting to match @samp{f(x) - f(y)}. You might think that Calc
26345 will view this subtraction as @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))} and then apply
26346 the above two rules in turn, but actually this will not work because
26347 Calc only does this when considering rules for @samp{+} (like the
26348 first rule in this set). So it will see first that @samp{f(x) + (-f(y))}
26349 does not match @samp{f(a) + f(b)} for any assignments of the
26350 meta-variables, and then it will see that @samp{f(x) - f(y)} does
26351 not match @samp{-f(a)} for any assignment of @samp{a}. Because Calc
26352 tries only one rule at a time, it will not be able to rewrite
26353 @samp{f(x) - f(y)} with this rule set. An explicit @samp{f(a) - f(b)}
26354 rule will have to be added.
26355
26356 Another thing patterns will @emph{not} do is break up complex numbers.
26357 The pattern @samp{myconj(a + @w{b i)} := a - b i} will work for formulas
26358 involving the special constant @samp{i} (such as @samp{3 - 4 i}), but
26359 it will not match actual complex numbers like @samp{(3, -4)}. A version
26360 of the above rule for complex numbers would be
26361
26362 @example
26363 myconj(a) := re(a) - im(a) (0,1) :: im(a) != 0
26364 @end example
26365
26366 @noindent
26367 (Because the @code{re} and @code{im} functions understand the properties
26368 of the special constant @samp{i}, this rule will also work for
26369 @samp{3 - 4 i}. In fact, this particular rule would probably be better
26370 without the @samp{im(a) != 0} condition, since if @samp{im(a) = 0} the
26371 righthand side of the rule will still give the correct answer for the
26372 conjugate of a real number.)
26373
26374 It is also possible to specify optional arguments in patterns. The rule
26375
26376 @example
26377 opt(a) x + opt(b) (x^opt(c) + opt(d)) := f(a, b, c, d)
26378 @end example
26379
26380 @noindent
26381 will match the formula
26382
26383 @example
26384 5 (x^2 - 4) + 3 x
26385 @end example
26386
26387 @noindent
26388 in a fairly straightforward manner, but it will also match reduced
26389 formulas like
26390
26391 @example
26392 x + x^2, 2(x + 1) - x, x + x
26393 @end example
26394
26395 @noindent
26396 producing, respectively,
26397
26398 @example
26399 f(1, 1, 2, 0), f(-1, 2, 1, 1), f(1, 1, 1, 0)
26400 @end example
26401
26402 (The latter two formulas can be entered only if default simplifications
26403 have been turned off with @kbd{m O}.)
26404
26405 The default value for a term of a sum is zero. The default value
26406 for a part of a product, for a power, or for the denominator of a
26407 quotient, is one. Also, @samp{-x} matches the pattern @samp{opt(a) b}
26408 with @samp{a = -1}.
26409
26410 In particular, the distributive-law rule can be refined to
26411
26412 @example
26413 opt(a) x + opt(b) x := (a + b) x
26414 @end example
26415
26416 @noindent
26417 so that it will convert, e.g., @samp{a x - x}, to @samp{(a - 1) x}.
26418
26419 The pattern @samp{opt(a) + opt(b) x} matches almost any formulas which
26420 are linear in @samp{x}. You can also use the @code{lin} and @code{islin}
26421 functions with rewrite conditions to test for this; @pxref{Logical
26422 Operations}. These functions are not as convenient to use in rewrite
26423 rules, but they recognize more kinds of formulas as linear:
26424 @samp{x/z} is considered linear with @expr{b = 1/z} by @code{lin},
26425 but it will not match the above pattern because that pattern calls
26426 for a multiplication, not a division.
26427
26428 As another example, the obvious rule to replace @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2}
26429 by 1,
26430
26431 @example
26432 sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2 := 1
26433 @end example
26434
26435 @noindent
26436 misses many cases because the sine and cosine may both be multiplied by
26437 an equal factor. Here's a more successful rule:
26438
26439 @example
26440 opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a
26441 @end example
26442
26443 Note that this rule will @emph{not} match @samp{sin(x)^2 + 6 cos(x)^2}
26444 because one @expr{a} would have ``matched'' 1 while the other matched 6.
26445
26446 Calc automatically converts a rule like
26447
26448 @example
26449 f(x-1, x) := g(x)
26450 @end example
26451
26452 @noindent
26453 into the form
26454
26455 @example
26456 f(temp, x) := g(x) :: temp = x-1
26457 @end example
26458
26459 @noindent
26460 (where @code{temp} stands for a new, invented meta-variable that
26461 doesn't actually have a name). This modified rule will successfully
26462 match @samp{f(6, 7)}, binding @samp{temp} and @samp{x} to 6 and 7,
26463 respectively, then verifying that they differ by one even though
26464 @samp{6} does not superficially look like @samp{x-1}.
26465
26466 However, Calc does not solve equations to interpret a rule. The
26467 following rule,
26468
26469 @example
26470 f(x-1, x+1) := g(x)
26471 @end example
26472
26473 @noindent
26474 will not work. That is, it will match @samp{f(a - 1 + b, a + 1 + b)}
26475 but not @samp{f(6, 8)}. Calc always interprets at least one occurrence
26476 of a variable by literal matching. If the variable appears ``isolated''
26477 then Calc is smart enough to use it for literal matching. But in this
26478 last example, Calc is forced to rewrite the rule to @samp{f(x-1, temp)
26479 := g(x) :: temp = x+1} where the @samp{x-1} term must correspond to an
26480 actual ``something-minus-one'' in the target formula.
26481
26482 A successful way to write this would be @samp{f(x, x+2) := g(x+1)}.
26483 You could make this resemble the original form more closely by using
26484 @code{let} notation, which is described in the next section:
26485
26486 @example
26487 f(xm1, x+1) := g(x) :: let(x := xm1+1)
26488 @end example
26489
26490 Calc does this rewriting or ``conditionalizing'' for any sub-pattern
26491 which involves only the functions in the following list, operating
26492 only on constants and meta-variables which have already been matched
26493 elsewhere in the pattern. When matching a function call, Calc is
26494 careful to match arguments which are plain variables before arguments
26495 which are calls to any of the functions below, so that a pattern like
26496 @samp{f(x-1, x)} can be conditionalized even though the isolated
26497 @samp{x} comes after the @samp{x-1}.
26498
26499 @smallexample
26500 + - * / \ % ^ abs sign round rounde roundu trunc floor ceil
26501 max min re im conj arg
26502 @end smallexample
26503
26504 You can suppress all of the special treatments described in this
26505 section by surrounding a function call with a @code{plain} marker.
26506 This marker causes the function call which is its argument to be
26507 matched literally, without regard to commutativity, associativity,
26508 negation, or conditionalization. When you use @code{plain}, the
26509 ``deep structure'' of the formula being matched can show through.
26510 For example,
26511
26512 @example
26513 plain(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26514 @end example
26515
26516 @noindent
26517 will match only literal subtractions. However, the @code{plain}
26518 marker does not affect its arguments' arguments. In this case,
26519 commutativity and associativity is still considered while matching
26520 the @w{@samp{a b}} sub-pattern, so the whole pattern will match
26521 @samp{x - y x} as well as @samp{x - x y}. We could go still
26522 further and use
26523
26524 @example
26525 plain(a - plain(a b)) := f(a, b)
26526 @end example
26527
26528 @noindent
26529 which would do a completely strict match for the pattern.
26530
26531 By contrast, the @code{quote} marker means that not only the
26532 function name but also the arguments must be literally the same.
26533 The above pattern will match @samp{x - x y} but
26534
26535 @example
26536 quote(a - a b) := f(a, b)
26537 @end example
26538
26539 @noindent
26540 will match only the single formula @samp{a - a b}. Also,
26541
26542 @example
26543 quote(a - quote(a b)) := f(a, b)
26544 @end example
26545
26546 @noindent
26547 will match only @samp{a - quote(a b)}---probably not the desired
26548 effect!
26549
26550 A certain amount of algebra is also done when substituting the
26551 meta-variables on the righthand side of a rule. For example,
26552 in the rule
26553
26554 @example
26555 a + f(b) := f(a + b)
26556 @end example
26557
26558 @noindent
26559 matching @samp{f(x) - y} would produce @samp{f((-y) + x)} if
26560 taken literally, but the rewrite mechanism will simplify the
26561 righthand side to @samp{f(x - y)} automatically. (Of course,
26562 the default simplifications would do this anyway, so this
26563 special simplification is only noticeable if you have turned the
26564 default simplifications off.) This rewriting is done only when
26565 a meta-variable expands to a ``negative-looking'' expression.
26566 If this simplification is not desirable, you can use a @code{plain}
26567 marker on the righthand side:
26568
26569 @example
26570 a + f(b) := f(plain(a + b))
26571 @end example
26572
26573 @noindent
26574 In this example, we are still allowing the pattern-matcher to
26575 use all the algebra it can muster, but the righthand side will
26576 always simplify to a literal addition like @samp{f((-y) + x)}.
26577
26578 @node Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Algebraic Properties of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26579 @subsection Other Features of Rewrite Rules
26580
26581 @noindent
26582 Certain ``function names'' serve as markers in rewrite rules.
26583 Here is a complete list of these markers. First are listed the
26584 markers that work inside a pattern; then come the markers that
26585 work in the righthand side of a rule.
26586
26587 @ignore
26588 @starindex
26589 @end ignore
26590 @tindex import
26591 One kind of marker, @samp{import(x)}, takes the place of a whole
26592 rule. Here @expr{x} is the name of a variable containing another
26593 rule set; those rules are ``spliced into'' the rule set that
26594 imports them. For example, if @samp{[f(a+b) := f(a) + f(b),
26595 f(a b) := a f(b) :: real(a)]} is stored in variable @samp{linearF},
26596 then the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 0, import(linearF)]} will apply
26597 all three rules. It is possible to modify the imported rules
26598 slightly: @samp{import(x, v1, x1, v2, x2, @dots{})} imports
26599 the rule set @expr{x} with all occurrences of
26600 @texline @math{v_1},
26601 @infoline @expr{v1},
26602 as either a variable name or a function name, replaced with
26603 @texline @math{x_1}
26604 @infoline @expr{x1}
26605 and so on. (If
26606 @texline @math{v_1}
26607 @infoline @expr{v1}
26608 is used as a function name, then
26609 @texline @math{x_1}
26610 @infoline @expr{x1}
26611 must be either a function name itself or a @w{@samp{< >}} nameless
26612 function; @pxref{Specifying Operators}.) For example, @samp{[g(0) := 0,
26613 import(linearF, f, g)]} applies the linearity rules to the function
26614 @samp{g} instead of @samp{f}. Imports can be nested, but the
26615 import-with-renaming feature may fail to rename sub-imports properly.
26616
26617 The special functions allowed in patterns are:
26618
26619 @table @samp
26620 @item quote(x)
26621 @ignore
26622 @starindex
26623 @end ignore
26624 @tindex quote
26625 This pattern matches exactly @expr{x}; variable names in @expr{x} are
26626 not interpreted as meta-variables. The only flexibility is that
26627 numbers are compared for numeric equality, so that the pattern
26628 @samp{f(quote(12))} will match both @samp{f(12)} and @samp{f(12.0)}.
26629 (Numbers are always treated this way by the rewrite mechanism:
26630 The rule @samp{f(x,x) := g(x)} will match @samp{f(12, 12.0)}.
26631 The rewrite may produce either @samp{g(12)} or @samp{g(12.0)}
26632 as a result in this case.)
26633
26634 @item plain(x)
26635 @ignore
26636 @starindex
26637 @end ignore
26638 @tindex plain
26639 Here @expr{x} must be a function call @samp{f(x1,x2,@dots{})}. This
26640 pattern matches a call to function @expr{f} with the specified
26641 argument patterns. No special knowledge of the properties of the
26642 function @expr{f} is used in this case; @samp{+} is not commutative or
26643 associative. Unlike @code{quote}, the arguments @samp{x1,x2,@dots{}}
26644 are treated as patterns. If you wish them to be treated ``plainly''
26645 as well, you must enclose them with more @code{plain} markers:
26646 @samp{plain(plain(@w{-a}) + plain(b c))}.
26647
26648 @item opt(x,def)
26649 @ignore
26650 @starindex
26651 @end ignore
26652 @tindex opt
26653 Here @expr{x} must be a variable name. This must appear as an
26654 argument to a function or an element of a vector; it specifies that
26655 the argument or element is optional.
26656 As an argument to @samp{+}, @samp{-}, @samp{*}, @samp{&&}, or @samp{||},
26657 or as the second argument to @samp{/} or @samp{^}, the value @var{def}
26658 may be omitted. The pattern @samp{x + opt(y)} matches a sum by
26659 binding one summand to @expr{x} and the other to @expr{y}, and it
26660 matches anything else by binding the whole expression to @expr{x} and
26661 zero to @expr{y}. The other operators above work similarly.
26662
26663 For general miscellaneous functions, the default value @code{def}
26664 must be specified. Optional arguments are dropped starting with
26665 the rightmost one during matching. For example, the pattern
26666 @samp{f(opt(a,0), b, opt(c,b))} will match @samp{f(b)}, @samp{f(a,b)},
26667 or @samp{f(a,b,c)}. Default values of zero and @expr{b} are
26668 supplied in this example for the omitted arguments. Note that
26669 the literal variable @expr{b} will be the default in the latter
26670 case, @emph{not} the value that matched the meta-variable @expr{b}.
26671 In other words, the default @var{def} is effectively quoted.
26672
26673 @item condition(x,c)
26674 @ignore
26675 @starindex
26676 @end ignore
26677 @tindex condition
26678 @tindex ::
26679 This matches the pattern @expr{x}, with the attached condition
26680 @expr{c}. It is the same as @samp{x :: c}.
26681
26682 @item pand(x,y)
26683 @ignore
26684 @starindex
26685 @end ignore
26686 @tindex pand
26687 @tindex &&&
26688 This matches anything that matches both pattern @expr{x} and
26689 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @samp{x &&& y}.
26690 @pxref{Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules}.
26691
26692 @item por(x,y)
26693 @ignore
26694 @starindex
26695 @end ignore
26696 @tindex por
26697 @tindex |||
26698 This matches anything that matches either pattern @expr{x} or
26699 pattern @expr{y}. It is the same as @w{@samp{x ||| y}}.
26700
26701 @item pnot(x)
26702 @ignore
26703 @starindex
26704 @end ignore
26705 @tindex pnot
26706 @tindex !!!
26707 This matches anything that does not match pattern @expr{x}.
26708 It is the same as @samp{!!! x}.
26709
26710 @item cons(h,t)
26711 @ignore
26712 @mindex cons
26713 @end ignore
26714 @tindex cons (rewrites)
26715 This matches any vector of one or more elements. The first
26716 element is matched to @expr{h}; a vector of the remaining
26717 elements is matched to @expr{t}. Note that vectors of fixed
26718 length can also be matched as actual vectors: The rule
26719 @samp{cons(a,cons(b,[])) := cons(a+b,[])} is equivalent
26720 to the rule @samp{[a,b] := [a+b]}.
26721
26722 @item rcons(t,h)
26723 @ignore
26724 @mindex rcons
26725 @end ignore
26726 @tindex rcons (rewrites)
26727 This is like @code{cons}, except that the @emph{last} element
26728 is matched to @expr{h}, with the remaining elements matched
26729 to @expr{t}.
26730
26731 @item apply(f,args)
26732 @ignore
26733 @mindex apply
26734 @end ignore
26735 @tindex apply (rewrites)
26736 This matches any function call. The name of the function, in
26737 the form of a variable, is matched to @expr{f}. The arguments
26738 of the function, as a vector of zero or more objects, are
26739 matched to @samp{args}. Constants, variables, and vectors
26740 do @emph{not} match an @code{apply} pattern. For example,
26741 @samp{apply(f,x)} matches any function call, @samp{apply(quote(f),x)}
26742 matches any call to the function @samp{f}, @samp{apply(f,[a,b])}
26743 matches any function call with exactly two arguments, and
26744 @samp{apply(quote(f), cons(a,cons(b,x)))} matches any call
26745 to the function @samp{f} with two or more arguments. Another
26746 way to implement the latter, if the rest of the rule does not
26747 need to refer to the first two arguments of @samp{f} by name,
26748 would be @samp{apply(quote(f), x :: vlen(x) >= 2)}.
26749 Here's a more interesting sample use of @code{apply}:
26750
26751 @example
26752 apply(f,[x+n]) := n + apply(f,[x])
26753 :: in(f, [floor,ceil,round,trunc]) :: integer(n)
26754 @end example
26755
26756 Note, however, that this will be slower to match than a rule
26757 set with four separate rules. The reason is that Calc sorts
26758 the rules of a rule set according to top-level function name;
26759 if the top-level function is @code{apply}, Calc must try the
26760 rule for every single formula and sub-formula. If the top-level
26761 function in the pattern is, say, @code{floor}, then Calc invokes
26762 the rule only for sub-formulas which are calls to @code{floor}.
26763
26764 Formulas normally written with operators like @code{+} are still
26765 considered function calls: @code{apply(f,x)} matches @samp{a+b}
26766 with @samp{f = add}, @samp{x = [a,b]}.
26767
26768 You must use @code{apply} for meta-variables with function names
26769 on both sides of a rewrite rule: @samp{apply(f, [x]) := f(x+1)}
26770 is @emph{not} correct, because it rewrites @samp{spam(6)} into
26771 @samp{f(7)}. The righthand side should be @samp{apply(f, [x+1])}.
26772 Also note that you will have to use No-Simplify mode (@kbd{m O})
26773 when entering this rule so that the @code{apply} isn't
26774 evaluated immediately to get the new rule @samp{f(x) := f(x+1)}.
26775 Or, use @kbd{s e} to enter the rule without going through the stack,
26776 or enter the rule as @samp{apply(f, [x]) := apply(f, [x+1]) @w{:: 1}}.
26777 @xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}.
26778
26779 @item select(x)
26780 @ignore
26781 @starindex
26782 @end ignore
26783 @tindex select
26784 This is used for applying rules to formulas with selections;
26785 @pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26786 @end table
26787
26788 Special functions for the righthand sides of rules are:
26789
26790 @table @samp
26791 @item quote(x)
26792 The notation @samp{quote(x)} is changed to @samp{x} when the
26793 righthand side is used. As far as the rewrite rule is concerned,
26794 @code{quote} is invisible. However, @code{quote} has the special
26795 property in Calc that its argument is not evaluated. Thus,
26796 while it will not work to put the rule @samp{t(a) := typeof(a)}
26797 on the stack because @samp{typeof(a)} is evaluated immediately
26798 to produce @samp{t(a) := 100}, you can use @code{quote} to
26799 protect the righthand side: @samp{t(a) := quote(typeof(a))}.
26800 (@xref{Conditional Rewrite Rules}, for another trick for
26801 protecting rules from evaluation.)
26802
26803 @item plain(x)
26804 Special properties of and simplifications for the function call
26805 @expr{x} are not used. One interesting case where @code{plain}
26806 is useful is the rule, @samp{q(x) := quote(x)}, trying to expand a
26807 shorthand notation for the @code{quote} function. This rule will
26808 not work as shown; instead of replacing @samp{q(foo)} with
26809 @samp{quote(foo)}, it will replace it with @samp{foo}! The correct
26810 rule would be @samp{q(x) := plain(quote(x))}.
26811
26812 @item cons(h,t)
26813 Where @expr{t} is a vector, this is converted into an expanded
26814 vector during rewrite processing. Note that @code{cons} is a regular
26815 Calc function which normally does this anyway; the only way @code{cons}
26816 is treated specially by rewrites is that @code{cons} on the righthand
26817 side of a rule will be evaluated even if default simplifications
26818 have been turned off.
26819
26820 @item rcons(t,h)
26821 Analogous to @code{cons} except putting @expr{h} at the @emph{end} of
26822 the vector @expr{t}.
26823
26824 @item apply(f,args)
26825 Where @expr{f} is a variable and @var{args} is a vector, this
26826 is converted to a function call. Once again, note that @code{apply}
26827 is also a regular Calc function.
26828
26829 @item eval(x)
26830 @ignore
26831 @starindex
26832 @end ignore
26833 @tindex eval
26834 The formula @expr{x} is handled in the usual way, then the
26835 default simplifications are applied to it even if they have
26836 been turned off normally. This allows you to treat any function
26837 similarly to the way @code{cons} and @code{apply} are always
26838 treated. However, there is a slight difference: @samp{cons(2+3, [])}
26839 with default simplifications off will be converted to @samp{[2+3]},
26840 whereas @samp{eval(cons(2+3, []))} will be converted to @samp{[5]}.
26841
26842 @item evalsimp(x)
26843 @ignore
26844 @starindex
26845 @end ignore
26846 @tindex evalsimp
26847 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the usual
26848 way, then algebraically simplified.
26849
26850 @item evalextsimp(x)
26851 @ignore
26852 @starindex
26853 @end ignore
26854 @tindex evalextsimp
26855 The formula @expr{x} has meta-variables substituted in the normal
26856 way, then ``extendedly'' simplified as if by the @kbd{a e} command.
26857
26858 @item select(x)
26859 @xref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}.
26860 @end table
26861
26862 There are also some special functions you can use in conditions.
26863
26864 @table @samp
26865 @item let(v := x)
26866 @ignore
26867 @starindex
26868 @end ignore
26869 @tindex let
26870 The expression @expr{x} is evaluated with meta-variables substituted.
26871 The algebraic simplifications are @emph{not} applied by
26872 default, but @expr{x} can include calls to @code{evalsimp} or
26873 @code{evalextsimp} as described above to invoke higher levels
26874 of simplification. The result of @expr{x} is then bound to the
26875 meta-variable @expr{v}. As usual, if this meta-variable has already
26876 been matched to something else the two values must be equal; if the
26877 meta-variable is new then it is bound to the result of the expression.
26878 This variable can then appear in later conditions, and on the righthand
26879 side of the rule.
26880 In fact, @expr{v} may be any pattern in which case the result of
26881 evaluating @expr{x} is matched to that pattern, binding any
26882 meta-variables that appear in that pattern. Note that @code{let}
26883 can only appear by itself as a condition, or as one term of an
26884 @samp{&&} which is a whole condition: It cannot be inside
26885 an @samp{||} term or otherwise buried.
26886
26887 The alternate, equivalent form @samp{let(v, x)} is also recognized.
26888 Note that the use of @samp{:=} by @code{let}, while still being
26889 assignment-like in character, is unrelated to the use of @samp{:=}
26890 in the main part of a rewrite rule.
26891
26892 As an example, @samp{f(a) := g(ia) :: let(ia := 1/a) :: constant(ia)}
26893 replaces @samp{f(a)} with @samp{g} of the inverse of @samp{a}, if
26894 that inverse exists and is constant. For example, if @samp{a} is a
26895 singular matrix the operation @samp{1/a} is left unsimplified and
26896 @samp{constant(ia)} fails, but if @samp{a} is an invertible matrix
26897 then the rule succeeds. Without @code{let} there would be no way
26898 to express this rule that didn't have to invert the matrix twice.
26899 Note that, because the meta-variable @samp{ia} is otherwise unbound
26900 in this rule, the @code{let} condition itself always ``succeeds''
26901 because no matter what @samp{1/a} evaluates to, it can successfully
26902 be bound to @code{ia}.
26903
26904 Here's another example, for integrating cosines of linear
26905 terms: @samp{myint(cos(y),x) := sin(y)/b :: let([a,b,x] := lin(y,x))}.
26906 The @code{lin} function returns a 3-vector if its argument is linear,
26907 or leaves itself unevaluated if not. But an unevaluated @code{lin}
26908 call will not match the 3-vector on the lefthand side of the @code{let},
26909 so this @code{let} both verifies that @code{y} is linear, and binds
26910 the coefficients @code{a} and @code{b} for use elsewhere in the rule.
26911 (It would have been possible to use @samp{sin(a x + b)/b} for the
26912 righthand side instead, but using @samp{sin(y)/b} avoids gratuitous
26913 rearrangement of the argument of the sine.)
26914
26915 @ignore
26916 @starindex
26917 @end ignore
26918 @tindex ierf
26919 Similarly, here is a rule that implements an inverse-@code{erf}
26920 function. It uses @code{root} to search for a solution. If
26921 @code{root} succeeds, it will return a vector of two numbers
26922 where the first number is the desired solution. If no solution
26923 is found, @code{root} remains in symbolic form. So we use
26924 @code{let} to check that the result was indeed a vector.
26925
26926 @example
26927 ierf(x) := y :: let([y,z] := root(erf(a) = x, a, .5))
26928 @end example
26929
26930 @item matches(v,p)
26931 The meta-variable @var{v}, which must already have been matched
26932 to something elsewhere in the rule, is compared against pattern
26933 @var{p}. Since @code{matches} is a standard Calc function, it
26934 can appear anywhere in a condition. But if it appears alone or
26935 as a term of a top-level @samp{&&}, then you get the special
26936 extra feature that meta-variables which are bound to things
26937 inside @var{p} can be used elsewhere in the surrounding rewrite
26938 rule.
26939
26940 The only real difference between @samp{let(p := v)} and
26941 @samp{matches(v, p)} is that the former evaluates @samp{v} using
26942 the default simplifications, while the latter does not.
26943
26944 @item remember
26945 @vindex remember
26946 This is actually a variable, not a function. If @code{remember}
26947 appears as a condition in a rule, then when that rule succeeds
26948 the original expression and rewritten expression are added to the
26949 front of the rule set that contained the rule. If the rule set
26950 was not stored in a variable, @code{remember} is ignored. The
26951 lefthand side is enclosed in @code{quote} in the added rule if it
26952 contains any variables.
26953
26954 For example, the rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: remember} applied
26955 to @samp{f(7)} will add the rule @samp{f(7) := 7 f(6)} to the front
26956 of the rule set. The rule set @code{EvalRules} works slightly
26957 differently: There, the evaluation of @samp{f(6)} will complete before
26958 the result is added to the rule set, in this case as @samp{f(7) := 5040}.
26959 Thus @code{remember} is most useful inside @code{EvalRules}.
26960
26961 It is up to you to ensure that the optimization performed by
26962 @code{remember} is safe. For example, the rule @samp{foo(n) := n
26963 :: evalv(eatfoo) > 0 :: remember} is a bad idea (@code{evalv} is
26964 the function equivalent of the @kbd{=} command); if the variable
26965 @code{eatfoo} ever contains 1, rules like @samp{foo(7) := 7} will
26966 be added to the rule set and will continue to operate even if
26967 @code{eatfoo} is later changed to 0.
26968
26969 @item remember(c)
26970 @ignore
26971 @starindex
26972 @end ignore
26973 @tindex remember
26974 Remember the match as described above, but only if condition @expr{c}
26975 is true. For example, @samp{remember(n % 4 = 0)} in the above factorial
26976 rule remembers only every fourth result. Note that @samp{remember(1)}
26977 is equivalent to @samp{remember}, and @samp{remember(0)} has no effect.
26978 @end table
26979
26980 @node Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Other Features of Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
26981 @subsection Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules
26982
26983 @noindent
26984 There are three operators, @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!},
26985 that combine rewrite patterns to make larger patterns. The
26986 combinations are ``and,'' ``or,'' and ``not,'' respectively, and
26987 these operators are the pattern equivalents of @samp{&&}, @samp{||}
26988 and @samp{!} (which operate on zero-or-nonzero logical values).
26989
26990 Note that @samp{&&&}, @samp{|||}, and @samp{!!!} are left in symbolic
26991 form by all regular Calc features; they have special meaning only in
26992 the context of rewrite rule patterns.
26993
26994 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} &&& @var{p2}} matches anything that
26995 matches both @var{p1} and @var{p2}. One especially useful case is
26996 when one of @var{p1} or @var{p2} is a meta-variable. For example,
26997 here is a rule that operates on error forms:
26998
26999 @example
27000 f(x &&& a +/- b, x) := g(x)
27001 @end example
27002
27003 This does the same thing, but is arguably simpler than, the rule
27004
27005 @example
27006 f(a +/- b, a +/- b) := g(a +/- b)
27007 @end example
27008
27009 @ignore
27010 @starindex
27011 @end ignore
27012 @tindex ends
27013 Here's another interesting example:
27014
27015 @example
27016 ends(cons(a, x) &&& rcons(y, b)) := [a, b]
27017 @end example
27018
27019 @noindent
27020 which effectively clips out the middle of a vector leaving just
27021 the first and last elements. This rule will change a one-element
27022 vector @samp{[a]} to @samp{[a, a]}. The similar rule
27023
27024 @example
27025 ends(cons(a, rcons(y, b))) := [a, b]
27026 @end example
27027
27028 @noindent
27029 would do the same thing except that it would fail to match a
27030 one-element vector.
27031
27032 @tex
27033 \bigskip
27034 @end tex
27035
27036 The pattern @samp{@var{p1} ||| @var{p2}} matches anything that
27037 matches either @var{p1} or @var{p2}. Calc first tries matching
27038 against @var{p1}; if that fails, it goes on to try @var{p2}.
27039
27040 @ignore
27041 @starindex
27042 @end ignore
27043 @tindex curve
27044 A simple example of @samp{|||} is
27045
27046 @example
27047 curve(inf ||| -inf) := 0
27048 @end example
27049
27050 @noindent
27051 which converts both @samp{curve(inf)} and @samp{curve(-inf)} to zero.
27052
27053 Here is a larger example:
27054
27055 @example
27056 log(a, b) ||| (ln(a) :: let(b := e)) := mylog(a, b)
27057 @end example
27058
27059 This matches both generalized and natural logarithms in a single rule.
27060 Note that the @samp{::} term must be enclosed in parentheses because
27061 that operator has lower precedence than @samp{|||} or @samp{:=}.
27062
27063 (In practice this rule would probably include a third alternative,
27064 omitted here for brevity, to take care of @code{log10}.)
27065
27066 While Calc generally treats interior conditions exactly the same as
27067 conditions on the outside of a rule, it does guarantee that if all the
27068 variables in the condition are special names like @code{e}, or already
27069 bound in the pattern to which the condition is attached (say, if
27070 @samp{a} had appeared in this condition), then Calc will process this
27071 condition right after matching the pattern to the left of the @samp{::}.
27072 Thus, we know that @samp{b} will be bound to @samp{e} only if the
27073 @code{ln} branch of the @samp{|||} was taken.
27074
27075 Note that this rule was careful to bind the same set of meta-variables
27076 on both sides of the @samp{|||}. Calc does not check this, but if
27077 you bind a certain meta-variable only in one branch and then use that
27078 meta-variable elsewhere in the rule, results are unpredictable:
27079
27080 @example
27081 f(a,b) ||| g(b) := h(a,b)
27082 @end example
27083
27084 Here if the pattern matches @samp{g(17)}, Calc makes no promises about
27085 the value that will be substituted for @samp{a} on the righthand side.
27086
27087 @tex
27088 \bigskip
27089 @end tex
27090
27091 The pattern @samp{!!! @var{pat}} matches anything that does not
27092 match @var{pat}. Any meta-variables that are bound while matching
27093 @var{pat} remain unbound outside of @var{pat}.
27094
27095 For example,
27096
27097 @example
27098 f(x &&& !!! a +/- b, !!![]) := g(x)
27099 @end example
27100
27101 @noindent
27102 converts @code{f} whose first argument is anything @emph{except} an
27103 error form, and whose second argument is not the empty vector, into
27104 a similar call to @code{g} (but without the second argument).
27105
27106 If we know that the second argument will be a vector (empty or not),
27107 then an equivalent rule would be:
27108
27109 @example
27110 f(x, y) := g(x) :: typeof(x) != 7 :: vlen(y) > 0
27111 @end example
27112
27113 @noindent
27114 where of course 7 is the @code{typeof} code for error forms.
27115 Another final condition, that works for any kind of @samp{y},
27116 would be @samp{!istrue(y == [])}. (The @code{istrue} function
27117 returns an explicit 0 if its argument was left in symbolic form;
27118 plain @samp{!(y == [])} or @samp{y != []} would not work to replace
27119 @samp{!!![]} since these would be left unsimplified, and thus cause
27120 the rule to fail, if @samp{y} was something like a variable name.)
27121
27122 It is possible for a @samp{!!!} to refer to meta-variables bound
27123 elsewhere in the pattern. For example,
27124
27125 @example
27126 f(a, !!!a) := g(a)
27127 @end example
27128
27129 @noindent
27130 matches any call to @code{f} with different arguments, changing
27131 this to @code{g} with only the first argument.
27132
27133 If a function call is to be matched and one of the argument patterns
27134 contains a @samp{!!!} somewhere inside it, that argument will be
27135 matched last. Thus
27136
27137 @example
27138 f(!!!a, a) := g(a)
27139 @end example
27140
27141 @noindent
27142 will be careful to bind @samp{a} to the second argument of @code{f}
27143 before testing the first argument. If Calc had tried to match the
27144 first argument of @code{f} first, the results would have been
27145 disastrous: since @code{a} was unbound so far, the pattern @samp{a}
27146 would have matched anything at all, and the pattern @samp{!!!a}
27147 therefore would @emph{not} have matched anything at all!
27148
27149 @node Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Composing Patterns in Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27150 @subsection Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules
27151
27152 @noindent
27153 When @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite}) is used, it takes an expression from
27154 the top of the stack and attempts to match any of the specified rules
27155 to any part of the expression, starting with the whole expression
27156 and then, if that fails, trying deeper and deeper sub-expressions.
27157 For each part of the expression, the rules are tried in the order
27158 they appear in the rules vector. The first rule to match the first
27159 sub-expression wins; it replaces the matched sub-expression according
27160 to the @var{new} part of the rule.
27161
27162 Often, the rule set will match and change the formula several times.
27163 The top-level formula is first matched and substituted repeatedly until
27164 it no longer matches the pattern; then, sub-formulas are tried, and
27165 so on. Once every part of the formula has gotten its chance, the
27166 rewrite mechanism starts over again with the top-level formula
27167 (in case a substitution of one of its arguments has caused it again
27168 to match). This continues until no further matches can be made
27169 anywhere in the formula.
27170
27171 It is possible for a rule set to get into an infinite loop. The
27172 most obvious case, replacing a formula with itself, is not a problem
27173 because a rule is not considered to ``succeed'' unless the righthand
27174 side actually comes out to something different than the original
27175 formula or sub-formula that was matched. But if you accidentally
27176 had both @samp{ln(a b) := ln(a) + ln(b)} and the reverse
27177 @samp{ln(a) + ln(b) := ln(a b)} in your rule set, Calc would
27178 run forever switching a formula back and forth between the two
27179 forms.
27180
27181 To avoid disaster, Calc normally stops after 100 changes have been
27182 made to the formula. This will be enough for most multiple rewrites,
27183 but it will keep an endless loop of rewrites from locking up the
27184 computer forever. (On most systems, you can also type @kbd{C-g} to
27185 halt any Emacs command prematurely.)
27186
27187 To change this limit, give a positive numeric prefix argument.
27188 In particular, @kbd{M-1 a r} applies only one rewrite at a time,
27189 useful when you are first testing your rule (or just if repeated
27190 rewriting is not what is called for by your application).
27191
27192 @ignore
27193 @starindex
27194 @end ignore
27195 @ignore
27196 @mindex iter@idots
27197 @end ignore
27198 @tindex iterations
27199 You can also put a ``function call'' @samp{iterations(@var{n})}
27200 in place of a rule anywhere in your rules vector (but usually at
27201 the top). Then, @var{n} will be used instead of 100 as the default
27202 number of iterations for this rule set. You can use
27203 @samp{iterations(inf)} if you want no iteration limit by default.
27204 A prefix argument will override the @code{iterations} limit in the
27205 rule set.
27206
27207 @example
27208 [ iterations(1),
27209 f(x) := f(x+1) ]
27210 @end example
27211
27212 More precisely, the limit controls the number of ``iterations,''
27213 where each iteration is a successful matching of a rule pattern whose
27214 righthand side, after substituting meta-variables and applying the
27215 default simplifications, is different from the original sub-formula
27216 that was matched.
27217
27218 A prefix argument of zero sets the limit to infinity. Use with caution!
27219
27220 Given a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{a r} will match and
27221 substitute the top-level expression up to that many times, but
27222 will not attempt to match the rules to any sub-expressions.
27223
27224 In a formula, @code{rewrite(@var{expr}, @var{rules}, @var{n})}
27225 does a rewriting operation. Here @var{expr} is the expression
27226 being rewritten, @var{rules} is the rule, vector of rules, or
27227 variable containing the rules, and @var{n} is the optional
27228 iteration limit, which may be a positive integer, a negative
27229 integer, or @samp{inf} or @samp{-inf}. If @var{n} is omitted
27230 the @code{iterations} value from the rule set is used; if both
27231 are omitted, 100 is used.
27232
27233 @node Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27234 @subsection Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules
27235
27236 @noindent
27237 It is possible to separate a rewrite rule set into several @dfn{phases}.
27238 During each phase, certain rules will be enabled while certain others
27239 will be disabled. A @dfn{phase schedule} controls the order in which
27240 phases occur during the rewriting process.
27241
27242 @ignore
27243 @starindex
27244 @end ignore
27245 @tindex phase
27246 @vindex all
27247 If a call to the marker function @code{phase} appears in the rules
27248 vector in place of a rule, all rules following that point will be
27249 members of the phase(s) identified in the arguments to @code{phase}.
27250 Phases are given integer numbers. The markers @samp{phase()} and
27251 @samp{phase(all)} both mean the following rules belong to all phases;
27252 this is the default at the start of the rule set.
27253
27254 If you do not explicitly schedule the phases, Calc sorts all phase
27255 numbers that appear in the rule set and executes the phases in
27256 ascending order. For example, the rule set
27257
27258 @example
27259 @group
27260 [ f0(x) := g0(x),
27261 phase(1),
27262 f1(x) := g1(x),
27263 phase(2),
27264 f2(x) := g2(x),
27265 phase(3),
27266 f3(x) := g3(x),
27267 phase(1,2),
27268 f4(x) := g4(x) ]
27269 @end group
27270 @end example
27271
27272 @noindent
27273 has three phases, 1 through 3. Phase 1 consists of the @code{f0},
27274 @code{f1}, and @code{f4} rules (in that order). Phase 2 consists of
27275 @code{f0}, @code{f2}, and @code{f4}. Phase 3 consists of @code{f0}
27276 and @code{f3}.
27277
27278 When Calc rewrites a formula using this rule set, it first rewrites
27279 the formula using only the phase 1 rules until no further changes are
27280 possible. Then it switches to the phase 2 rule set and continues
27281 until no further changes occur, then finally rewrites with phase 3.
27282 When no more phase 3 rules apply, rewriting finishes. (This is
27283 assuming @kbd{a r} with a large enough prefix argument to allow the
27284 rewriting to run to completion; the sequence just described stops
27285 early if the number of iterations specified in the prefix argument,
27286 100 by default, is reached.)
27287
27288 During each phase, Calc descends through the nested levels of the
27289 formula as described previously. (@xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite
27290 Rules}.) Rewriting starts at the top of the formula, then works its
27291 way down to the parts, then goes back to the top and works down again.
27292 The phase 2 rules do not begin until no phase 1 rules apply anywhere
27293 in the formula.
27294
27295 @ignore
27296 @starindex
27297 @end ignore
27298 @tindex schedule
27299 A @code{schedule} marker appearing in the rule set (anywhere, but
27300 conventionally at the top) changes the default schedule of phases.
27301 In the simplest case, @code{schedule} has a sequence of phase numbers
27302 for arguments; each phase number is invoked in turn until the
27303 arguments to @code{schedule} are exhausted. Thus adding
27304 @samp{schedule(3,2,1)} at the top of the above rule set would
27305 reverse the order of the phases; @samp{schedule(1,2,3)} would have
27306 no effect since this is the default schedule; and @samp{schedule(1,2,1,3)}
27307 would give phase 1 a second chance after phase 2 has completed, before
27308 moving on to phase 3.
27309
27310 Any argument to @code{schedule} can instead be a vector of phase
27311 numbers (or even of sub-vectors). Then the sub-sequence of phases
27312 described by the vector are tried repeatedly until no change occurs
27313 in any phase in the sequence. For example, @samp{schedule([1, 2], 3)}
27314 tries phase 1, then phase 2, then, if either phase made any changes
27315 to the formula, repeats these two phases until they can make no
27316 further progress. Finally, it goes on to phase 3 for finishing
27317 touches.
27318
27319 Also, items in @code{schedule} can be variable names as well as
27320 numbers. A variable name is interpreted as the name of a function
27321 to call on the whole formula. For example, @samp{schedule(1, simplify)}
27322 says to apply the phase-1 rules (presumably, all of them), then to
27323 call @code{simplify} which is the function name equivalent of @kbd{a s}.
27324 Likewise, @samp{schedule([1, simplify])} says to alternate between
27325 phase 1 and @kbd{a s} until no further changes occur.
27326
27327 Phases can be used purely to improve efficiency; if it is known that
27328 a certain group of rules will apply only at the beginning of rewriting,
27329 and a certain other group will apply only at the end, then rewriting
27330 will be faster if these groups are identified as separate phases.
27331 Once the phase 1 rules are done, Calc can put them aside and no longer
27332 spend any time on them while it works on phase 2.
27333
27334 There are also some problems that can only be solved with several
27335 rewrite phases. For a real-world example of a multi-phase rule set,
27336 examine the set @code{FitRules}, which is used by the curve-fitting
27337 command to convert a model expression to linear form.
27338 @xref{Curve Fitting Details}. This set is divided into four phases.
27339 The first phase rewrites certain kinds of expressions to be more
27340 easily linearizable, but less computationally efficient. After the
27341 linear components have been picked out, the final phase includes the
27342 opposite rewrites to put each component back into an efficient form.
27343 If both sets of rules were included in one big phase, Calc could get
27344 into an infinite loop going back and forth between the two forms.
27345
27346 Elsewhere in @code{FitRules}, the components are first isolated,
27347 then recombined where possible to reduce the complexity of the linear
27348 fit, then finally packaged one component at a time into vectors.
27349 If the packaging rules were allowed to begin before the recombining
27350 rules were finished, some components might be put away into vectors
27351 before they had a chance to recombine. By putting these rules in
27352 two separate phases, this problem is neatly avoided.
27353
27354 @node Selections with Rewrite Rules, Matching Commands, Multi-Phase Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27355 @subsection Selections with Rewrite Rules
27356
27357 @noindent
27358 If a sub-formula of the current formula is selected (as by @kbd{j s};
27359 @pxref{Selecting Subformulas}), the @kbd{a r} (@code{calc-rewrite})
27360 command applies only to that sub-formula. Together with a negative
27361 prefix argument, you can use this fact to apply a rewrite to one
27362 specific part of a formula without affecting any other parts.
27363
27364 @kindex j r
27365 @pindex calc-rewrite-selection
27366 The @kbd{j r} (@code{calc-rewrite-selection}) command allows more
27367 sophisticated operations on selections. This command prompts for
27368 the rules in the same way as @kbd{a r}, but it then applies those
27369 rules to the whole formula in question even though a sub-formula
27370 of it has been selected. However, the selected sub-formula will
27371 first have been surrounded by a @samp{select( )} function call.
27372 (Calc's evaluator does not understand the function name @code{select};
27373 this is only a tag used by the @kbd{j r} command.)
27374
27375 For example, suppose the formula on the stack is @samp{2 (a + b)^2}
27376 and the sub-formula @samp{a + b} is selected. This formula will
27377 be rewritten to @samp{2 select(a + b)^2} and then the rewrite
27378 rules will be applied in the usual way. The rewrite rules can
27379 include references to @code{select} to tell where in the pattern
27380 the selected sub-formula should appear.
27381
27382 If there is still exactly one @samp{select( )} function call in
27383 the formula after rewriting is done, it indicates which part of
27384 the formula should be selected afterwards. Otherwise, the
27385 formula will be unselected.
27386
27387 You can make @kbd{j r} act much like @kbd{a r} by enclosing both parts
27388 of the rewrite rule with @samp{select()}. However, @kbd{j r}
27389 allows you to use the current selection in more flexible ways.
27390 Suppose you wished to make a rule which removed the exponent from
27391 the selected term; the rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} would
27392 work. In the above example, it would rewrite @samp{2 select(a + b)^2}
27393 to @samp{2 select(a + b)}. This would then be returned to the
27394 stack as @samp{2 (a + b)} with the @samp{a + b} selected.
27395
27396 The @kbd{j r} command uses one iteration by default, unlike
27397 @kbd{a r} which defaults to 100 iterations. A numeric prefix
27398 argument affects @kbd{j r} in the same way as @kbd{a r}.
27399 @xref{Nested Formulas with Rewrite Rules}.
27400
27401 As with other selection commands, @kbd{j r} operates on the stack
27402 entry that contains the cursor. (If the cursor is on the top-of-stack
27403 @samp{.} marker, it works as if the cursor were on the formula
27404 at stack level 1.)
27405
27406 If you don't specify a set of rules, the rules are taken from the
27407 top of the stack, just as with @kbd{a r}. In this case, the
27408 cursor must indicate stack entry 2 or above as the formula to be
27409 rewritten (otherwise the same formula would be used as both the
27410 target and the rewrite rules).
27411
27412 If the indicated formula has no selection, the cursor position within
27413 the formula temporarily selects a sub-formula for the purposes of this
27414 command. If the cursor is not on any sub-formula (e.g., it is in
27415 the line-number area to the left of the formula), the @samp{select( )}
27416 markers are ignored by the rewrite mechanism and the rules are allowed
27417 to apply anywhere in the formula.
27418
27419 As a special feature, the normal @kbd{a r} command also ignores
27420 @samp{select( )} calls in rewrite rules. For example, if you used the
27421 above rule @samp{select(a)^x := select(a)} with @kbd{a r}, it would apply
27422 the rule as if it were @samp{a^x := a}. Thus, you can write general
27423 purpose rules with @samp{select( )} hints inside them so that they
27424 will ``do the right thing'' in both @kbd{a r} and @kbd{j r},
27425 both with and without selections.
27426
27427 @node Matching Commands, Automatic Rewrites, Selections with Rewrite Rules, Rewrite Rules
27428 @subsection Matching Commands
27429
27430 @noindent
27431 @kindex a m
27432 @pindex calc-match
27433 @tindex match
27434 The @kbd{a m} (@code{calc-match}) [@code{match}] function takes a
27435 vector of formulas and a rewrite-rule-style pattern, and produces
27436 a vector of all formulas which match the pattern. The command
27437 prompts you to enter the pattern; as for @kbd{a r}, you can enter
27438 a single pattern (i.e., a formula with meta-variables), or a
27439 vector of patterns, or a variable which contains patterns, or
27440 you can give a blank response in which case the patterns are taken
27441 from the top of the stack. The pattern set will be compiled once
27442 and saved if it is stored in a variable. If there are several
27443 patterns in the set, vector elements are kept if they match any
27444 of the patterns.
27445
27446 For example, @samp{match(a+b, [x, x+y, x-y, 7, x+y+z])}
27447 will return @samp{[x+y, x-y, x+y+z]}.
27448
27449 The @code{import} mechanism is not available for pattern sets.
27450
27451 The @kbd{a m} command can also be used to extract all vector elements
27452 which satisfy any condition: The pattern @samp{x :: x>0} will select
27453 all the positive vector elements.
27454
27455 @kindex I a m
27456 @tindex matchnot
27457 With the Inverse flag [@code{matchnot}], this command extracts all
27458 vector elements which do @emph{not} match the given pattern.
27459
27460 @ignore
27461 @starindex
27462 @end ignore
27463 @tindex matches
27464 There is also a function @samp{matches(@var{x}, @var{p})} which
27465 evaluates to 1 if expression @var{x} matches pattern @var{p}, or
27466 to 0 otherwise. This is sometimes useful for including into the
27467 conditional clauses of other rewrite rules.
27468
27469 @ignore
27470 @starindex
27471 @end ignore
27472 @tindex vmatches
27473 The function @code{vmatches} is just like @code{matches}, except
27474 that if the match succeeds it returns a vector of assignments to
27475 the meta-variables instead of the number 1. For example,
27476 @samp{vmatches(f(1,2), f(a,b))} returns @samp{[a := 1, b := 2]}.
27477 If the match fails, the function returns the number 0.
27478
27479 @node Automatic Rewrites, Debugging Rewrites, Matching Commands, Rewrite Rules
27480 @subsection Automatic Rewrites
27481
27482 @noindent
27483 @cindex @code{EvalRules} variable
27484 @vindex EvalRules
27485 It is possible to get Calc to apply a set of rewrite rules on all
27486 results, effectively adding to the built-in set of default
27487 simplifications. To do this, simply store your rule set in the
27488 variable @code{EvalRules}. There is a convenient @kbd{s E} command
27489 for editing @code{EvalRules}; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
27490
27491 For example, suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out
27492 to @samp{sin(b) cos(a) + cos(b) sin(a)} wherever it appears, and
27493 similarly for @samp{cos(a + b)}. The corresponding rewrite rule
27494 set would be,
27495
27496 @smallexample
27497 @group
27498 [ sin(a + b) := cos(a) sin(b) + sin(a) cos(b),
27499 cos(a + b) := cos(a) cos(b) - sin(a) sin(b) ]
27500 @end group
27501 @end smallexample
27502
27503 To apply these manually, you could put them in a variable called
27504 @code{trigexp} and then use @kbd{a r trigexp} every time you wanted
27505 to expand trig functions. But if instead you store them in the
27506 variable @code{EvalRules}, they will automatically be applied to all
27507 sines and cosines of sums. Then, with @samp{2 x} and @samp{45} on
27508 the stack, typing @kbd{+ S} will (assuming Degrees mode) result in
27509 @samp{0.7071 sin(2 x) + 0.7071 cos(2 x)} automatically.
27510
27511 As each level of a formula is evaluated, the rules from
27512 @code{EvalRules} are applied before the default simplifications.
27513 Rewriting continues until no further @code{EvalRules} apply.
27514 Note that this is different from the usual order of application of
27515 rewrite rules: @code{EvalRules} works from the bottom up, simplifying
27516 the arguments to a function before the function itself, while @kbd{a r}
27517 applies rules from the top down.
27518
27519 Because the @code{EvalRules} are tried first, you can use them to
27520 override the normal behavior of any built-in Calc function.
27521
27522 It is important not to write a rule that will get into an infinite
27523 loop. For example, the rule set @samp{[f(0) := 1, f(n) := n f(n-1)]}
27524 appears to be a good definition of a factorial function, but it is
27525 unsafe. Imagine what happens if @samp{f(2.5)} is simplified. Calc
27526 will continue to subtract 1 from this argument forever without reaching
27527 zero. A safer second rule would be @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0}.
27528 Another dangerous rule is @samp{g(x, y) := g(y, x)}. Rewriting
27529 @samp{g(2, 4)}, this would bounce back and forth between that and
27530 @samp{g(4, 2)} forever. If an infinite loop in @code{EvalRules}
27531 occurs, Emacs will eventually stop with a ``Computation got stuck
27532 or ran too long'' message.
27533
27534 Another subtle difference between @code{EvalRules} and regular rewrites
27535 concerns rules that rewrite a formula into an identical formula. For
27536 example, @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} ``fails to match'' when @expr{n} is
27537 already an integer. But in @code{EvalRules} this case is detected only
27538 if the righthand side literally becomes the original formula before any
27539 further simplification. This means that @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n))} will
27540 get into an infinite loop if it occurs in @code{EvalRules}. Calc will
27541 replace @samp{f(6)} with @samp{f(floor(6))}, which is different from
27542 @samp{f(6)}, so it will consider the rule to have matched and will
27543 continue simplifying that formula; first the argument is simplified
27544 to get @samp{f(6)}, then the rule matches again to get @samp{f(floor(6))}
27545 again, ad infinitum. A much safer rule would check its argument first,
27546 say, with @samp{f(n) := f(floor(n)) :: !dint(n)}.
27547
27548 (What really happens is that the rewrite mechanism substitutes the
27549 meta-variables in the righthand side of a rule, compares to see if the
27550 result is the same as the original formula and fails if so, then uses
27551 the default simplifications to simplify the result and compares again
27552 (and again fails if the formula has simplified back to its original
27553 form). The only special wrinkle for the @code{EvalRules} is that the
27554 same rules will come back into play when the default simplifications
27555 are used. What Calc wants to do is build @samp{f(floor(6))}, see that
27556 this is different from the original formula, simplify to @samp{f(6)},
27557 see that this is the same as the original formula, and thus halt the
27558 rewriting. But while simplifying, @samp{f(6)} will again trigger
27559 the same @code{EvalRules} rule and Calc will get into a loop inside
27560 the rewrite mechanism itself.)
27561
27562 The @code{phase}, @code{schedule}, and @code{iterations} markers do
27563 not work in @code{EvalRules}. If the rule set is divided into phases,
27564 only the phase 1 rules are applied, and the schedule is ignored.
27565 The rules are always repeated as many times as possible.
27566
27567 The @code{EvalRules} are applied to all function calls in a formula,
27568 but not to numbers (and other number-like objects like error forms),
27569 nor to vectors or individual variable names. (Though they will apply
27570 to @emph{components} of vectors and error forms when appropriate.) You
27571 might try to make a variable @code{phihat} which automatically expands
27572 to its definition without the need to press @kbd{=} by writing the
27573 rule @samp{quote(phihat) := (1-sqrt(5))/2}, but unfortunately this rule
27574 will not work as part of @code{EvalRules}.
27575
27576 Finally, another limitation is that Calc sometimes calls its built-in
27577 functions directly rather than going through the default simplifications.
27578 When it does this, @code{EvalRules} will not be able to override those
27579 functions. For example, when you take the absolute value of the complex
27580 number @expr{(2, 3)}, Calc computes @samp{sqrt(2*2 + 3*3)} by calling
27581 the multiplication, addition, and square root functions directly rather
27582 than applying the default simplifications to this formula. So an
27583 @code{EvalRules} rule that (perversely) rewrites @samp{sqrt(13) := 6}
27584 would not apply. (However, if you put Calc into Symbolic mode so that
27585 @samp{sqrt(13)} will be left in symbolic form by the built-in square
27586 root function, your rule will be able to apply. But if the complex
27587 number were @expr{(3,4)}, so that @samp{sqrt(25)} must be calculated,
27588 then Symbolic mode will not help because @samp{sqrt(25)} can be
27589 evaluated exactly to 5.)
27590
27591 One subtle restriction that normally only manifests itself with
27592 @code{EvalRules} is that while a given rewrite rule is in the process
27593 of being checked, that same rule cannot be recursively applied. Calc
27594 effectively removes the rule from its rule set while checking the rule,
27595 then puts it back once the match succeeds or fails. (The technical
27596 reason for this is that compiled pattern programs are not reentrant.)
27597 For example, consider the rule @samp{foo(x) := x :: foo(x/2) > 0}
27598 attempting to match @samp{foo(8)}. This rule will be inactive while
27599 the condition @samp{foo(4) > 0} is checked, even though it might be
27600 an integral part of evaluating that condition. Note that this is not
27601 a problem for the more usual recursive type of rule, such as
27602 @samp{foo(x) := foo(x/2)}, because there the rule has succeeded and
27603 been reactivated by the time the righthand side is evaluated.
27604
27605 If @code{EvalRules} has no stored value (its default state), or if
27606 anything but a vector is stored in it, then it is ignored.
27607
27608 Even though Calc's rewrite mechanism is designed to compare rewrite
27609 rules to formulas as quickly as possible, storing rules in
27610 @code{EvalRules} may make Calc run substantially slower. This is
27611 particularly true of rules where the top-level call is a commonly used
27612 function, or is not fixed. The rule @samp{f(n) := n f(n-1) :: n>0} will
27613 only activate the rewrite mechanism for calls to the function @code{f},
27614 but @samp{lg(n) + lg(m) := lg(n m)} will check every @samp{+} operator.
27615
27616 @smallexample
27617 apply(f, [a*b]) := apply(f, [a]) + apply(f, [b]) :: in(f, [ln, log10])
27618 @end smallexample
27619
27620 @noindent
27621 may seem more ``efficient'' than two separate rules for @code{ln} and
27622 @code{log10}, but actually it is vastly less efficient because rules
27623 with @code{apply} as the top-level pattern must be tested against
27624 @emph{every} function call that is simplified.
27625
27626 @cindex @code{AlgSimpRules} variable
27627 @vindex AlgSimpRules
27628 Suppose you want @samp{sin(a + b)} to be expanded out not all the time,
27629 but only when algebraic simplifications are used to simplify the
27630 formula. The variable @code{AlgSimpRules} holds rules for this purpose.
27631 The @kbd{a s} command will apply @code{EvalRules} and
27632 @code{AlgSimpRules} to the formula, as well as all of its built-in
27633 simplifications.
27634
27635 Most of the special limitations for @code{EvalRules} don't apply to
27636 @code{AlgSimpRules}. Calc simply does an @kbd{a r AlgSimpRules}
27637 command with an infinite repeat count as the first step of algebraic
27638 simplifications. It then applies its own built-in simplifications
27639 throughout the formula, and then repeats these two steps (along with
27640 applying the default simplifications) until no further changes are
27641 possible.
27642
27643 @cindex @code{ExtSimpRules} variable
27644 @cindex @code{UnitSimpRules} variable
27645 @vindex ExtSimpRules
27646 @vindex UnitSimpRules
27647 There are also @code{ExtSimpRules} and @code{UnitSimpRules} variables
27648 that are used by @kbd{a e} and @kbd{u s}, respectively; these commands
27649 also apply @code{EvalRules} and @code{AlgSimpRules}. The variable
27650 @code{IntegSimpRules} contains simplification rules that are used
27651 only during integration by @kbd{a i}.
27652
27653 @node Debugging Rewrites, Examples of Rewrite Rules, Automatic Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27654 @subsection Debugging Rewrites
27655
27656 @noindent
27657 If a buffer named @file{*Trace*} exists, the rewrite mechanism will
27658 record some useful information there as it operates. The original
27659 formula is written there, as is the result of each successful rewrite,
27660 and the final result of the rewriting. All phase changes are also
27661 noted.
27662
27663 Calc always appends to @file{*Trace*}. You must empty this buffer
27664 yourself periodically if it is in danger of growing unwieldy.
27665
27666 Note that the rewriting mechanism is substantially slower when the
27667 @file{*Trace*} buffer exists, even if the buffer is not visible on
27668 the screen. Once you are done, you will probably want to kill this
27669 buffer (with @kbd{C-x k *Trace* @key{RET}}). If you leave it in
27670 existence and forget about it, all your future rewrite commands will
27671 be needlessly slow.
27672
27673 @node Examples of Rewrite Rules, , Debugging Rewrites, Rewrite Rules
27674 @subsection Examples of Rewrite Rules
27675
27676 @noindent
27677 Returning to the example of substituting the pattern
27678 @samp{sin(x)^2 + cos(x)^2} with 1, we saw that the rule
27679 @samp{opt(a) sin(x)^2 + opt(a) cos(x)^2 := a} does a good job of
27680 finding suitable cases. Another solution would be to use the rule
27681 @samp{cos(x)^2 := 1 - sin(x)^2}, followed by algebraic simplification
27682 if necessary. This rule will be the most effective way to do the job,
27683 but at the expense of making some changes that you might not desire.
27684
27685 Another algebraic rewrite rule is @samp{exp(x+y) := exp(x) exp(y)}.
27686 To make this work with the @w{@kbd{j r}} command so that it can be
27687 easily targeted to a particular exponential in a large formula,
27688 you might wish to write the rule as @samp{select(exp(x+y)) :=
27689 select(exp(x) exp(y))}. The @samp{select} markers will be
27690 ignored by the regular @kbd{a r} command
27691 (@pxref{Selections with Rewrite Rules}).
27692
27693 A surprisingly useful rewrite rule is @samp{a/(b-c) := a*(b+c)/(b^2-c^2)}.
27694 This will simplify the formula whenever @expr{b} and/or @expr{c} can
27695 be made simpler by squaring. For example, applying this rule to
27696 @samp{2 / (sqrt(2) + 3)} yields @samp{6:7 - 2:7 sqrt(2)} (assuming
27697 Symbolic mode has been enabled to keep the square root from being
27698 evaluated to a floating-point approximation). This rule is also
27699 useful when working with symbolic complex numbers, e.g.,
27700 @samp{(a + b i) / (c + d i)}.
27701
27702 As another example, we could define our own ``triangular numbers'' function
27703 with the rules @samp{[tri(0) := 0, tri(n) := n + tri(n-1) :: n>0]}. Enter
27704 this vector and store it in a variable: @kbd{@w{s t} trirules}. Now, given
27705 a suitable formula like @samp{tri(5)} on the stack, type @samp{a r trirules}
27706 to apply these rules repeatedly. After six applications, @kbd{a r} will
27707 stop with 15 on the stack. Once these rules are debugged, it would probably
27708 be most useful to add them to @code{EvalRules} so that Calc will evaluate
27709 the new @code{tri} function automatically. We could then use @kbd{Z K} on
27710 the keyboard macro @kbd{' tri($) @key{RET}} to make a command that applies
27711 @code{tri} to the value on the top of the stack. @xref{Programming}.
27712
27713 @cindex Quaternions
27714 The following rule set, contributed by
27715 @texline Fran\c cois
27716 @infoline Francois
27717 Pinard, implements @dfn{quaternions}, a generalization of the concept of
27718 complex numbers. Quaternions have four components, and are here
27719 represented by function calls @samp{quat(@var{w}, [@var{x}, @var{y},
27720 @var{z}])} with ``real part'' @var{w} and the three ``imaginary'' parts
27721 collected into a vector. Various arithmetical operations on quaternions
27722 are supported. To use these rules, either add them to @code{EvalRules},
27723 or create a command based on @kbd{a r} for simplifying quaternion
27724 formulas. A convenient way to enter quaternions would be a command
27725 defined by a keyboard macro containing: @kbd{' quat($$$$, [$$$, $$, $])
27726 @key{RET}}.
27727
27728 @smallexample
27729 [ quat(w, x, y, z) := quat(w, [x, y, z]),
27730 quat(w, [0, 0, 0]) := w,
27731 abs(quat(w, v)) := hypot(w, v),
27732 -quat(w, v) := quat(-w, -v),
27733 r + quat(w, v) := quat(r + w, v) :: real(r),
27734 r - quat(w, v) := quat(r - w, -v) :: real(r),
27735 quat(w1, v1) + quat(w2, v2) := quat(w1 + w2, v1 + v2),
27736 r * quat(w, v) := quat(r * w, r * v) :: real(r),
27737 plain(quat(w1, v1) * quat(w2, v2))
27738 := quat(w1 * w2 - v1 * v2, w1 * v2 + w2 * v1 + cross(v1, v2)),
27739 quat(w1, v1) / r := quat(w1 / r, v1 / r) :: real(r),
27740 z / quat(w, v) := z * quatinv(quat(w, v)),
27741 quatinv(quat(w, v)) := quat(w, -v) / (w^2 + v^2),
27742 quatsqr(quat(w, v)) := quat(w^2 - v^2, 2 * w * v),
27743 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^(k / 2))
27744 :: integer(k) :: k > 0 :: k % 2 = 0,
27745 quat(w, v)^k := quatsqr(quat(w, v)^((k - 1) / 2)) * quat(w, v)
27746 :: integer(k) :: k > 2,
27747 quat(w, v)^-k := quatinv(quat(w, v)^k) :: integer(k) :: k > 0 ]
27748 @end smallexample
27749
27750 Quaternions, like matrices, have non-commutative multiplication.
27751 In other words, @expr{q1 * q2 = q2 * q1} is not necessarily true if
27752 @expr{q1} and @expr{q2} are @code{quat} forms. The @samp{quat*quat}
27753 rule above uses @code{plain} to prevent Calc from rearranging the
27754 product. It may also be wise to add the line @samp{[quat(), matrix]}
27755 to the @code{Decls} matrix, to ensure that Calc's other algebraic
27756 operations will not rearrange a quaternion product. @xref{Declarations}.
27757
27758 These rules also accept a four-argument @code{quat} form, converting
27759 it to the preferred form in the first rule. If you would rather see
27760 results in the four-argument form, just append the two items
27761 @samp{phase(2), quat(w, [x, y, z]) := quat(w, x, y, z)} to the end
27762 of the rule set. (But remember that multi-phase rule sets don't work
27763 in @code{EvalRules}.)
27764
27765 @node Units, Store and Recall, Algebra, Top
27766 @chapter Operating on Units
27767
27768 @noindent
27769 One special interpretation of algebraic formulas is as numbers with units.
27770 For example, the formula @samp{5 m / s^2} can be read ``five meters
27771 per second squared.'' The commands in this chapter help you
27772 manipulate units expressions in this form. Units-related commands
27773 begin with the @kbd{u} prefix key.
27774
27775 @menu
27776 * Basic Operations on Units::
27777 * The Units Table::
27778 * Predefined Units::
27779 * User-Defined Units::
27780 * Logarithmic Units::
27781 * Musical Notes::
27782 @end menu
27783
27784 @node Basic Operations on Units, The Units Table, Units, Units
27785 @section Basic Operations on Units
27786
27787 @noindent
27788 A @dfn{units expression} is a formula which is basically a number
27789 multiplied and/or divided by one or more @dfn{unit names}, which may
27790 optionally be raised to integer powers. Actually, the value part need not
27791 be a number; any product or quotient involving unit names is a units
27792 expression. Many of the units commands will also accept any formula,
27793 where the command applies to all units expressions which appear in the
27794 formula.
27795
27796 A unit name is a variable whose name appears in the @dfn{unit table},
27797 or a variable whose name is a prefix character like @samp{k} (for ``kilo'')
27798 or @samp{u} (for ``micro'') followed by a name in the unit table.
27799 A substantial table of built-in units is provided with Calc;
27800 @pxref{Predefined Units}. You can also define your own unit names;
27801 @pxref{User-Defined Units}.
27802
27803 Note that if the value part of a units expression is exactly @samp{1},
27804 it will be removed by the Calculator's automatic algebra routines: The
27805 formula @samp{1 mm} is ``simplified'' to @samp{mm}. This is only a
27806 display anomaly, however; @samp{mm} will work just fine as a
27807 representation of one millimeter.
27808
27809 You may find that Algebraic mode (@pxref{Algebraic Entry}) makes working
27810 with units expressions easier. Otherwise, you will have to remember
27811 to hit the apostrophe key every time you wish to enter units.
27812
27813 @kindex u s
27814 @pindex calc-simplify-units
27815 @ignore
27816 @mindex usimpl@idots
27817 @end ignore
27818 @tindex usimplify
27819 The @kbd{u s} (@code{calc-simplify-units}) [@code{usimplify}] command
27820 simplifies a units
27821 expression. It uses Calc's algebraic simplifications to simplify the
27822 expression first as a regular algebraic formula; it then looks for
27823 features that can be further simplified by converting one object's units
27824 to be compatible with another's. For example, @samp{5 m + 23 mm} will
27825 simplify to @samp{5.023 m}. When different but compatible units are
27826 added, the righthand term's units are converted to match those of the
27827 lefthand term. @xref{Simplification Modes}, for a way to have this done
27828 automatically at all times.
27829
27830 Units simplification also handles quotients of two units with the same
27831 dimensionality, as in @w{@samp{2 in s/L cm}} to @samp{5.08 s/L}; fractional
27832 powers of unit expressions, as in @samp{sqrt(9 mm^2)} to @samp{3 mm} and
27833 @samp{sqrt(9 acre)} to a quantity in meters; and @code{floor},
27834 @code{ceil}, @code{round}, @code{rounde}, @code{roundu}, @code{trunc},
27835 @code{float}, @code{frac}, @code{abs}, and @code{clean}
27836 applied to units expressions, in which case
27837 the operation in question is applied only to the numeric part of the
27838 expression. Finally, trigonometric functions of quantities with units
27839 of angle are evaluated, regardless of the current angular mode.
27840
27841 @kindex u c
27842 @pindex calc-convert-units
27843 The @kbd{u c} (@code{calc-convert-units}) command converts a units
27844 expression to new, compatible units. For example, given the units
27845 expression @samp{55 mph}, typing @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces
27846 @samp{24.5872 m/s}. If you have previously converted a units expression
27847 with the same type of units (in this case, distance over time), you will
27848 be offered the previous choice of new units as a default. Continuing
27849 the above example, entering the units expression @samp{100 km/hr} and
27850 typing @kbd{u c @key{RET}} (without specifying new units) produces
27851 @samp{27.7777777778 m/s}.
27852
27853 @kindex u t
27854 @pindex calc-convert-temperature
27855 @cindex Temperature conversion
27856 The @kbd{u c} command treats temperature units (like @samp{degC} and
27857 @samp{K}) as relative temperatures. For example, @kbd{u c} converts
27858 @samp{10 degC} to @samp{18 degF}: A change of 10 degrees Celsius
27859 corresponds to a change of 18 degrees Fahrenheit. To convert absolute
27860 temperatures, you can use the @kbd{u t}
27861 (@code{calc-convert-temperature}) command. The value on the stack
27862 must be a simple units expression with units of temperature only.
27863 This command would convert @samp{10 degC} to @samp{50 degF}, the
27864 equivalent temperature on the Fahrenheit scale.
27865
27866 While many of Calc's conversion factors are exact, some are necessarily
27867 approximate. If Calc is in fraction mode (@pxref{Fraction Mode}), then
27868 unit conversions will try to give exact, rational conversions, but it
27869 isn't always possible. Given @samp{55 mph} in fraction mode, typing
27870 @kbd{u c m/s @key{RET}} produces @samp{15367:625 m/s}, for example,
27871 while typing @kbd{u c au/yr @key{RET}} produces
27872 @samp{5.18665819999e-3 au/yr}.
27873
27874 If the units you request are inconsistent with the original units, the
27875 number will be converted into your units times whatever ``remainder''
27876 units are left over. (This can be disabled; @pxref{Customizing Calc}.)
27877 For example, converting @samp{55 mph} into acres
27878 produces @samp{6.08e-3 acre / m s}. (Recall that multiplication binds
27879 more strongly than division in Calc formulas, so the units here are
27880 acres per meter-second.) Remainder units are expressed in terms of
27881 ``fundamental'' units like @samp{m} and @samp{s}, regardless of the
27882 input units.
27883
27884 One special exception is that if you specify a single unit name, and
27885 a compatible unit appears somewhere in the units expression, then
27886 that compatible unit will be converted to the new unit and the
27887 remaining units in the expression will be left alone. For example,
27888 given the input @samp{980 cm/s^2}, the command @kbd{u c ms} will
27889 change the @samp{s} to @samp{ms} to get @samp{9.8e-4 cm/ms^2}.
27890 The ``remainder unit'' @samp{cm} is left alone rather than being
27891 changed to the base unit @samp{m}.
27892
27893 You can use explicit unit conversion instead of the @kbd{u s} command
27894 to gain more control over the units of the result of an expression.
27895 For example, given @samp{5 m + 23 mm}, you can type @kbd{u c m} or
27896 @kbd{u c mm} to express the result in either meters or millimeters.
27897 (For that matter, you could type @kbd{u c fath} to express the result
27898 in fathoms, if you preferred!)
27899
27900 In place of a specific set of units, you can also enter one of the
27901 units system names @code{si}, @code{mks} (equivalent), or @code{cgs}.
27902 For example, @kbd{u c si @key{RET}} converts the expression into
27903 International System of Units (SI) base units. Also, @kbd{u c base}
27904 converts to Calc's base units, which are the same as @code{si} units
27905 except that @code{base} uses @samp{g} as the fundamental unit of mass
27906 whereas @code{si} uses @samp{kg}.
27907
27908 @cindex Composite units
27909 The @kbd{u c} command also accepts @dfn{composite units}, which
27910 are expressed as the sum of several compatible unit names. For
27911 example, converting @samp{30.5 in} to units @samp{mi+ft+in} (miles,
27912 feet, and inches) produces @samp{2 ft + 6.5 in}. Calc first
27913 sorts the unit names into order of decreasing relative size.
27914 It then accounts for as much of the input quantity as it can
27915 using an integer number times the largest unit, then moves on
27916 to the next smaller unit, and so on. Only the smallest unit
27917 may have a non-integer amount attached in the result. A few
27918 standard unit names exist for common combinations, such as
27919 @code{mfi} for @samp{mi+ft+in}, and @code{tpo} for @samp{ton+lb+oz}.
27920 Composite units are expanded as if by @kbd{a x}, so that
27921 @samp{(ft+in)/hr} is first converted to @samp{ft/hr+in/hr}.
27922
27923 If the value on the stack does not contain any units, @kbd{u c} will
27924 prompt first for the old units which this value should be considered
27925 to have, then for the new units. (If the value on the stack can be
27926 simplified so that it doesn't contain any units, like @samp{ft/in} can
27927 be simplified to 12, then @kbd{u c} will still prompt for both old
27928 units and new units. Assuming the old and new units you give are
27929 consistent with each other, the result also will not contain any
27930 units. For example, @kbd{@w{u c} cm @key{RET} in @key{RET}} converts
27931 the number 2 on the stack to 5.08.
27932
27933 @kindex u b
27934 @pindex calc-base-units
27935 The @kbd{u b} (@code{calc-base-units}) command is shorthand for
27936 @kbd{u c base}; it converts the units expression on the top of the
27937 stack into @code{base} units. If @kbd{u s} does not simplify a
27938 units expression as far as you would like, try @kbd{u b}.
27939
27940 Like the @kbd{u c} command, the @kbd{u b} command treats temperature
27941 units as relative temperatures.
27942
27943 @kindex u r
27944 @pindex calc-remove-units
27945 @kindex u x
27946 @pindex calc-extract-units
27947 The @kbd{u r} (@code{calc-remove-units}) command removes units from the
27948 formula at the top of the stack. The @kbd{u x}
27949 (@code{calc-extract-units}) command extracts only the units portion of a
27950 formula. These commands essentially replace every term of the formula
27951 that does or doesn't (respectively) look like a unit name by the
27952 constant 1, then resimplify the formula.
27953
27954 @kindex u a
27955 @pindex calc-autorange-units
27956 The @kbd{u a} (@code{calc-autorange-units}) command turns on and off a
27957 mode in which unit prefixes like @code{k} (``kilo'') are automatically
27958 applied to keep the numeric part of a units expression in a reasonable
27959 range. This mode affects @kbd{u s} and all units conversion commands
27960 except @kbd{u b}. For example, with autoranging on, @samp{12345 Hz}
27961 will be simplified to @samp{12.345 kHz}. Autoranging is useful for
27962 some kinds of units (like @code{Hz} and @code{m}), but is probably
27963 undesirable for non-metric units like @code{ft} and @code{tbsp}.
27964 (Composite units are more appropriate for those; see above.)
27965
27966 Autoranging always applies the prefix to the leftmost unit name.
27967 Calc chooses the largest prefix that causes the number to be greater
27968 than or equal to 1.0. Thus an increasing sequence of adjusted times
27969 would be @samp{1 ms, 10 ms, 100 ms, 1 s, 10 s, 100 s, 1 ks}.
27970 Generally the rule of thumb is that the number will be adjusted
27971 to be in the interval @samp{[1 .. 1000)}, although there are several
27972 exceptions to this rule. First, if the unit has a power then this
27973 is not possible; @samp{0.1 s^2} simplifies to @samp{100000 ms^2}.
27974 Second, the ``centi-'' prefix is allowed to form @code{cm} (centimeters),
27975 but will not apply to other units. The ``deci-,'' ``deka-,'' and
27976 ``hecto-'' prefixes are never used. Thus the allowable interval is
27977 @samp{[1 .. 10)} for millimeters and @samp{[1 .. 100)} for centimeters.
27978 Finally, a prefix will not be added to a unit if the resulting name
27979 is also the actual name of another unit; @samp{1e-15 t} would normally
27980 be considered a ``femto-ton,'' but it is written as @samp{1000 at}
27981 (1000 atto-tons) instead because @code{ft} would be confused with feet.
27982
27983 @node The Units Table, Predefined Units, Basic Operations on Units, Units
27984 @section The Units Table
27985
27986 @noindent
27987 @kindex u v
27988 @pindex calc-enter-units-table
27989 The @kbd{u v} (@code{calc-enter-units-table}) command displays the units table
27990 in another buffer called @file{*Units Table*}. Each entry in this table
27991 gives the unit name as it would appear in an expression, the definition
27992 of the unit in terms of simpler units, and a full name or description of
27993 the unit. Fundamental units are defined as themselves; these are the
27994 units produced by the @kbd{u b} command. The fundamental units are
27995 meters, seconds, grams, kelvins, amperes, candelas, moles, radians,
27996 and steradians.
27997
27998 The Units Table buffer also displays the Unit Prefix Table. Note that
27999 two prefixes, ``kilo'' and ``hecto,'' accept either upper- or lower-case
28000 prefix letters. @samp{Meg} is also accepted as a synonym for the @samp{M}
28001 prefix. Whenever a unit name can be interpreted as either a built-in name
28002 or a prefix followed by another built-in name, the former interpretation
28003 wins. For example, @samp{2 pt} means two pints, not two pico-tons.
28004
28005 The Units Table buffer, once created, is not rebuilt unless you define
28006 new units. To force the buffer to be rebuilt, give any numeric prefix
28007 argument to @kbd{u v}.
28008
28009 @kindex u V
28010 @pindex calc-view-units-table
28011 The @kbd{u V} (@code{calc-view-units-table}) command is like @kbd{u v} except
28012 that the cursor is not moved into the Units Table buffer. You can
28013 type @kbd{u V} again to remove the Units Table from the display. To
28014 return from the Units Table buffer after a @kbd{u v}, type @kbd{C-x * c}
28015 again or use the regular Emacs @w{@kbd{C-x o}} (@code{other-window})
28016 command. You can also kill the buffer with @kbd{C-x k} if you wish;
28017 the actual units table is safely stored inside the Calculator.
28018
28019 @kindex u g
28020 @pindex calc-get-unit-definition
28021 The @kbd{u g} (@code{calc-get-unit-definition}) command retrieves a unit's
28022 defining expression and pushes it onto the Calculator stack. For example,
28023 @kbd{u g in} will produce the expression @samp{2.54 cm}. This is the
28024 same definition for the unit that would appear in the Units Table buffer.
28025 Note that this command works only for actual unit names; @kbd{u g km}
28026 will report that no such unit exists, for example, because @code{km} is
28027 really the unit @code{m} with a @code{k} (``kilo'') prefix. To see a
28028 definition of a unit in terms of base units, it is easier to push the
28029 unit name on the stack and then reduce it to base units with @kbd{u b}.
28030
28031 @kindex u e
28032 @pindex calc-explain-units
28033 The @kbd{u e} (@code{calc-explain-units}) command displays an English
28034 description of the units of the expression on the stack. For example,
28035 for the expression @samp{62 km^2 g / s^2 mol K}, the description is
28036 ``Square-Kilometer Gram per (Second-squared Mole Degree-Kelvin).'' This
28037 command uses the English descriptions that appear in the righthand
28038 column of the Units Table.
28039
28040 @node Predefined Units, User-Defined Units, The Units Table, Units
28041 @section Predefined Units
28042
28043 @noindent
28044 The definitions of many units have changed over the years. For example,
28045 the meter was originally defined in 1791 as one ten-millionth of the
28046 distance from the equator to the north pole. In order to be more
28047 precise, the definition was adjusted several times, and now a meter is
28048 defined as the distance that light will travel in a vacuum in
28049 1/299792458 of a second; consequently, the speed of light in a
28050 vacuum is exactly 299792458 m/s. Many other units have been
28051 redefined in terms of fundamental physical processes; a second, for
28052 example, is currently defined as 9192631770 periods of a certain
28053 radiation related to the cesium-133 atom. The only SI unit that is not
28054 based on a fundamental physical process (although there are efforts to
28055 change this) is the kilogram, which was originally defined as the mass
28056 of one liter of water, but is now defined as the mass of the
28057 international prototype of the kilogram (IPK), a cylinder of platinum-iridium
28058 kept at the Bureau international des poids et mesures in S@`evres,
28059 France. (There are several copies of the IPK throughout the world.)
28060 The British imperial units, once defined in terms of physical objects,
28061 were redefined in 1963 in terms of SI units. The US customary units,
28062 which were the same as British units until the British imperial system
28063 was created in 1824, were also defined in terms of the SI units in 1893.
28064 Because of these redefinitions, conversions between metric, British
28065 Imperial, and US customary units can often be done precisely.
28066
28067 Since the exact definitions of many kinds of units have evolved over the
28068 years, and since certain countries sometimes have local differences in
28069 their definitions, it is a good idea to examine Calc's definition of a
28070 unit before depending on its exact value. For example, there are three
28071 different units for gallons, corresponding to the US (@code{gal}),
28072 Canadian (@code{galC}), and British (@code{galUK}) definitions. Also,
28073 note that @code{oz} is a standard ounce of mass, @code{ozt} is a Troy
28074 ounce, and @code{ozfl} is a fluid ounce.
28075
28076 The temperature units corresponding to degrees Kelvin and Centigrade
28077 (Celsius) are the same in this table, since most units commands treat
28078 temperatures as being relative. The @code{calc-convert-temperature}
28079 command has special rules for handling the different absolute magnitudes
28080 of the various temperature scales.
28081
28082 The unit of volume ``liters'' can be referred to by either the lower-case
28083 @code{l} or the upper-case @code{L}.
28084
28085 The unit @code{A} stands for Amperes; the name @code{Ang} is used
28086 @tex
28087 for \AA ngstroms.
28088 @end tex
28089 @ifnottex
28090 for Angstroms.
28091 @end ifnottex
28092
28093 The unit @code{pt} stands for pints; the name @code{point} stands for
28094 a typographical point, defined by @samp{72 point = 1 in}. This is
28095 slightly different than the point defined by the American Typefounder's
28096 Association in 1886, but the point used by Calc has become standard
28097 largely due to its use by the PostScript page description language.
28098 There is also @code{texpt}, which stands for a printer's point as
28099 defined by the @TeX{} typesetting system: @samp{72.27 texpt = 1 in}.
28100 Other units used by @TeX{} are available; they are @code{texpc} (a pica),
28101 @code{texbp} (a ``big point'', equal to a standard point which is larger
28102 than the point used by @TeX{}), @code{texdd} (a Didot point),
28103 @code{texcc} (a Cicero) and @code{texsp} (a scaled @TeX{} point,
28104 all dimensions representable in @TeX{} are multiples of this value).
28105
28106 When Calc is using the @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} language mode (@pxref{TeX
28107 and LaTeX Language Modes}), the @TeX{} specific unit names will not
28108 use the @samp{tex} prefix; the unit name for a @TeX{} point will be
28109 @samp{pt} instead of @samp{texpt}, for example. To avoid conflicts,
28110 the unit names for pint and parsec will simply be @samp{pint} and
28111 @samp{parsec} instead of @samp{pt} and @samp{pc}.
28112
28113
28114 The unit @code{e} stands for the elementary (electron) unit of charge;
28115 because algebra command could mistake this for the special constant
28116 @expr{e}, Calc provides the alternate unit name @code{ech} which is
28117 preferable to @code{e}.
28118
28119 The name @code{g} stands for one gram of mass; there is also @code{gf},
28120 one gram of force. (Likewise for @kbd{lb}, pounds, and @kbd{lbf}.)
28121 Meanwhile, one ``@expr{g}'' of acceleration is denoted @code{ga}.
28122
28123 The unit @code{ton} is a U.S. ton of @samp{2000 lb}, and @code{t} is
28124 a metric ton of @samp{1000 kg}.
28125
28126 The names @code{s} (or @code{sec}) and @code{min} refer to units of
28127 time; @code{arcsec} and @code{arcmin} are units of angle.
28128
28129 Some ``units'' are really physical constants; for example, @code{c}
28130 represents the speed of light, and @code{h} represents Planck's
28131 constant. You can use these just like other units: converting
28132 @samp{.5 c} to @samp{m/s} expresses one-half the speed of light in
28133 meters per second. You can also use this merely as a handy reference;
28134 the @kbd{u g} command gets the definition of one of these constants
28135 in its normal terms, and @kbd{u b} expresses the definition in base
28136 units.
28137
28138 Two units, @code{pi} and @code{alpha} (the fine structure constant,
28139 approximately @mathit{1/137}) are dimensionless. The units simplification
28140 commands simply treat these names as equivalent to their corresponding
28141 values. However you can, for example, use @kbd{u c} to convert a pure
28142 number into multiples of the fine structure constant, or @kbd{u b} to
28143 convert this back into a pure number. (When @kbd{u c} prompts for the
28144 ``old units,'' just enter a blank line to signify that the value
28145 really is unitless.)
28146
28147 @c Describe angular units, luminosity vs. steradians problem.
28148
28149 @node User-Defined Units, Logarithmic Units, Predefined Units, Units
28150 @section User-Defined Units
28151
28152 @noindent
28153 Calc provides ways to get quick access to your selected ``favorite''
28154 units, as well as ways to define your own new units.
28155
28156 @kindex u 0-9
28157 @pindex calc-quick-units
28158 @vindex Units
28159 @cindex @code{Units} variable
28160 @cindex Quick units
28161 To select your favorite units, store a vector of unit names or
28162 expressions in the Calc variable @code{Units}. The @kbd{u 1}
28163 through @kbd{u 9} commands (@code{calc-quick-units}) provide access
28164 to these units. If the value on the top of the stack is a plain
28165 number (with no units attached), then @kbd{u 1} gives it the
28166 specified units. (Basically, it multiplies the number by the
28167 first item in the @code{Units} vector.) If the number on the
28168 stack @emph{does} have units, then @kbd{u 1} converts that number
28169 to the new units. For example, suppose the vector @samp{[in, ft]}
28170 is stored in @code{Units}. Then @kbd{30 u 1} will create the
28171 expression @samp{30 in}, and @kbd{u 2} will convert that expression
28172 to @samp{2.5 ft}.
28173
28174 The @kbd{u 0} command accesses the tenth element of @code{Units}.
28175 Only ten quick units may be defined at a time. If the @code{Units}
28176 variable has no stored value (the default), or if its value is not
28177 a vector, then the quick-units commands will not function. The
28178 @kbd{s U} command is a convenient way to edit the @code{Units}
28179 variable; @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
28180
28181 @kindex u d
28182 @pindex calc-define-unit
28183 @cindex User-defined units
28184 The @kbd{u d} (@code{calc-define-unit}) command records the units
28185 expression on the top of the stack as the definition for a new,
28186 user-defined unit. For example, putting @samp{16.5 ft} on the stack and
28187 typing @kbd{u d rod} defines the new unit @samp{rod} to be equivalent to
28188 16.5 feet. The unit conversion and simplification commands will now
28189 treat @code{rod} just like any other unit of length. You will also be
28190 prompted for an optional English description of the unit, which will
28191 appear in the Units Table. If you wish the definition of this unit to
28192 be displayed in a special way in the Units Table buffer (such as with an
28193 asterisk to indicate an approximate value), then you can call this
28194 command with an argument, @kbd{C-u u d}; you will then also be prompted
28195 for a string that will be used to display the definition.
28196
28197 @kindex u u
28198 @pindex calc-undefine-unit
28199 The @kbd{u u} (@code{calc-undefine-unit}) command removes a user-defined
28200 unit. It is not possible to remove one of the predefined units,
28201 however.
28202
28203 If you define a unit with an existing unit name, your new definition
28204 will replace the original definition of that unit. If the unit was a
28205 predefined unit, the old definition will not be replaced, only
28206 ``shadowed.'' The built-in definition will reappear if you later use
28207 @kbd{u u} to remove the shadowing definition.
28208
28209 To create a new fundamental unit, use either 1 or the unit name itself
28210 as the defining expression. Otherwise the expression can involve any
28211 other units that you like (except for composite units like @samp{mfi}).
28212 You can create a new composite unit with a sum of other units as the
28213 defining expression. The next unit operation like @kbd{u c} or @kbd{u v}
28214 will rebuild the internal unit table incorporating your modifications.
28215 Note that erroneous definitions (such as two units defined in terms of
28216 each other) will not be detected until the unit table is next rebuilt;
28217 @kbd{u v} is a convenient way to force this to happen.
28218
28219 Temperature units are treated specially inside the Calculator; it is not
28220 possible to create user-defined temperature units.
28221
28222 @kindex u p
28223 @pindex calc-permanent-units
28224 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined units
28225 The @kbd{u p} (@code{calc-permanent-units}) command stores the user-defined
28226 units in your Calc init file (the file given by the variable
28227 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), so that the
28228 units will still be available in subsequent Emacs sessions. If there
28229 was already a set of user-defined units in your Calc init file, it
28230 is replaced by the new set. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to
28231 tell Calc to use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28232
28233 @node Logarithmic Units, Musical Notes, User-Defined Units, Units
28234 @section Logarithmic Units
28235
28236 The units @code{dB} (decibels) and @code{Np} (nepers) are logarithmic
28237 units which are manipulated differently than standard units. Calc
28238 provides commands to work with these logarithmic units.
28239
28240 Decibels and nepers are used to measure power quantities as well as
28241 field quantities (quantities whose squares are proportional to power);
28242 these two types of quantities are handled slightly different from each
28243 other. By default the Calc commands work as if power quantities are
28244 being used; with the @kbd{H} prefix the Calc commands work as if field
28245 quantities are being used.
28246
28247 The decibel level of a power
28248 @infoline @math{P1},
28249 @texline @math{P_1},
28250 relative to a reference power
28251 @infoline @math{P0},
28252 @texline @math{P_0},
28253 is defined to be
28254 @infoline @math{10 log10(P1/P0) dB}.
28255 @texline @math{10 \log_{10}(P_{1}/P_{0}) {\rm dB}}.
28256 (The factor of 10 is because a decibel, as its name implies, is
28257 one-tenth of a bel. The bel, named after Alexander Graham Bell, was
28258 considered to be too large of a unit and was effectively replaced by
28259 the decibel.) If @math{F} is a field quantity with power
28260 @math{P=k F^2}, then a reference quantity of
28261 @infoline @math{F0}
28262 @texline @math{F_0}
28263 would correspond to a power of
28264 @infoline @math{P0=k F0^2}.
28265 @texline @math{P_{0}=kF_{0}^2}.
28266 If
28267 @infoline @math{P1=k F1^2},
28268 @texline @math{P_{1}=kF_{1}^2},
28269 then
28270
28271 @ifnottex
28272 @example
28273 10 log10(P1/P0) = 10 log10(F1^2/F0^2) = 20 log10(F1/F0).
28274 @end example
28275 @end ifnottex
28276 @tex
28277 $$ 10 \log_{10}(P_1/P_0) = 10 \log_{10}(F_1^2/F_0^2) = 20
28278 \log_{10}(F_1/F_0)$$
28279 @end tex
28280
28281 @noindent
28282 In order to get the same decibel level regardless of whether a field
28283 quantity or the corresponding power quantity is used, the decibel
28284 level of a field quantity
28285 @infoline @math{F1},
28286 @texline @math{F_1},
28287 relative to a reference
28288 @infoline @math{F0},
28289 @texline @math{F_0},
28290 is defined as
28291 @infoline @math{20 log10(F1/F0) dB}.
28292 @texline @math{20 \log_{10}(F_{1}/F_{0}) {\rm dB}}.
28293 For example, the decibel value of a sound pressure level of
28294 @infoline @math{60 uPa}
28295 @texline @math{60 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28296 relative to
28297 @infoline @math{20 uPa}
28298 @texline @math{20 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28299 (the threshold of human hearing) is
28300 @infoline @math{20 log10(60 uPa/ 20 uPa) dB = 20 log10(3) dB},
28301 @texline @math{20 \log_{10}(60 \mu{\rm Pa}/20 \mu{\rm Pa}) {\rm dB} = 20 \log_{10}(3) {\rm dB}},
28302 which is about
28303 @infoline @math{9.54 dB}.
28304 @texline @math{9.54 {\rm dB}}.
28305 Note that in taking the ratio, the original units cancel and so these
28306 logarithmic units are dimensionless.
28307
28308 Nepers (named after John Napier, who is credited with inventing the
28309 logarithm) are similar to bels except they use natural logarithms instead
28310 of common logarithms. The neper level of a power
28311 @infoline @math{P1},
28312 @texline @math{P_1},
28313 relative to a reference power
28314 @infoline @math{P0},
28315 @texline @math{P_0},
28316 is
28317 @infoline @math{(1/2) ln(P1/P0) Np}.
28318 @texline @math{(1/2) \ln(P_1/P_0) {\rm Np}}.
28319 The neper level of a field
28320 @infoline @math{F1},
28321 @texline @math{F_1},
28322 relative to a reference field
28323 @infoline @math{F0},
28324 @texline @math{F_0},
28325 is
28326 @infoline @math{ln(F1/F0) Np}.
28327 @texline @math{\ln(F_1/F_0) {\rm Np}}.
28328
28329 @vindex calc-lu-power-reference
28330 @vindex calc-lu-field-reference
28331 For power quantities, Calc uses
28332 @infoline @math{1 mW}
28333 @texline @math{1 {\rm mW}}
28334 as the default reference quantity; this default can be changed by changing
28335 the value of the customizable variable
28336 @code{calc-lu-power-reference} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
28337 For field quantities, Calc uses
28338 @infoline @math{20 uPa}
28339 @texline @math{20 \mu{\rm Pa}}
28340 as the default reference quantity; this is the value used in acoustics
28341 which is where decibels are commonly encountered. This default can be
28342 changed by changing the value of the customizable variable
28343 @code{calc-lu-field-reference} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). A
28344 non-default reference quantity will be read from the stack if the
28345 capital @kbd{O} prefix is used.
28346
28347 @kindex l q
28348 @pindex calc-lu-quant
28349 @tindex lupquant
28350 @tindex lufquant
28351 The @kbd{l q} (@code{calc-lu-quant}) [@code{lupquant}]
28352 command computes the power quantity corresponding to a given number of
28353 logarithmic units. With the capital @kbd{O} prefix, @kbd{O l q}, the
28354 reference level will be read from the top of the stack. (In an
28355 algebraic formula, @code{lupquant} can be given an optional second
28356 argument which will be used for the reference level.) For example,
28357 @code{20 dB @key{RET} l q} will return @code{100 mW};
28358 @code{20 dB @key{RET} 4 W @key{RET} O l q} will return @code{400 W}.
28359 The @kbd{H l q} [@code{lufquant}] command behaves like @kbd{l q} but
28360 computes field quantities instead of power quantities.
28361
28362 @kindex l d
28363 @pindex calc-db
28364 @tindex dbpower
28365 @tindex dbfield
28366 @kindex l n
28367 @pindex calc-np
28368 @tindex nppower
28369 @tindex npfield
28370 The @kbd{l d} (@code{calc-db}) [@code{dbpower}] command will compute
28371 the decibel level of a power quantity using the default reference
28372 level; @kbd{H l d} [@code{dbfield}] will compute the decibel level of
28373 a field quantity. The commands @kbd{l n} (@code{calc-np})
28374 [@code{nppower}] and @kbd{H l n} [@code{npfield}] will similarly
28375 compute neper levels. With the capital @kbd{O} prefix these commands
28376 will read a reference level from the stack; in an algebraic formula
28377 the reference level can be given as an optional second argument.
28378
28379 @kindex l +
28380 @pindex calc-lu-plus
28381 @tindex lupadd
28382 @tindex lufadd
28383 @kindex l -
28384 @pindex calc-lu-minus
28385 @tindex lupsub
28386 @tindex lufsub
28387 @kindex l *
28388 @pindex calc-lu-times
28389 @tindex lupmul
28390 @tindex lufmul
28391 @kindex l /
28392 @pindex calc-lu-divide
28393 @tindex lupdiv
28394 @tindex lufdiv
28395 The sum of two power or field quantities doesn't correspond to the sum
28396 of the corresponding decibel or neper levels. If the powers
28397 corresponding to decibel levels
28398 @infoline @math{D1}
28399 @texline @math{D_1}
28400 and
28401 @infoline @math{D2}
28402 @texline @math{D_2}
28403 are added, the corresponding decibel level ``sum'' will be
28404
28405 @ifnottex
28406 @example
28407 10 log10(10^(D1/10) + 10^(D2/10)) dB.
28408 @end example
28409 @end ifnottex
28410 @tex
28411 $$ 10 \log_{10}(10^{D_1/10} + 10^{D_2/10}) {\rm dB}.$$
28412 @end tex
28413
28414 @noindent
28415 When field quantities are combined, it often means the corresponding
28416 powers are added and so the above formula might be used. In
28417 acoustics, for example, the sound pressure level is a field quantity
28418 and so the decibels are often defined using the field formula, but the
28419 sound pressure levels are combined as the sound power levels, and so
28420 the above formula should be used. If two field quantities themselves
28421 are added, the new decibel level will be
28422
28423 @ifnottex
28424 @example
28425 20 log10(10^(D1/20) + 10^(D2/20)) dB.
28426 @end example
28427 @end ifnottex
28428 @tex
28429 $$ 20 \log_{10}(10^{D_1/20} + 10^{D_2/20}) {\rm dB}.$$
28430 @end tex
28431
28432 @noindent
28433 If the power corresponding to @math{D} dB is multiplied by a number @math{N},
28434 then the corresponding decibel level will be
28435
28436 @ifnottex
28437 @example
28438 D + 10 log10(N) dB,
28439 @end example
28440 @end ifnottex
28441 @tex
28442 $$ D + 10 \log_{10}(N) {\rm dB},$$
28443 @end tex
28444
28445 @noindent
28446 if a field quantity is multiplied by @math{N} the corresponding decibel level
28447 will be
28448
28449 @ifnottex
28450 @example
28451 D + 20 log10(N) dB.
28452 @end example
28453 @end ifnottex
28454 @tex
28455 $$ D + 20 \log_{10}(N) {\rm dB}.$$
28456 @end tex
28457
28458 @noindent
28459 There are similar formulas for combining nepers. The @kbd{l +}
28460 (@code{calc-lu-plus}) [@code{lupadd}] command will ``add'' two
28461 logarithmic unit power levels this way; with the @kbd{H} prefix,
28462 @kbd{H l +} [@code{lufadd}] will add logarithmic unit field levels.
28463 Similarly, logarithmic units can be ``subtracted'' with @kbd{l -}
28464 (@code{calc-lu-minus}) [@code{lupsub}] or @kbd{H l -} [@code{lufsub}].
28465 The @kbd{l *} (@code{calc-lu-times}) [@code{lupmul}] and @kbd{H l *}
28466 [@code{lufmul}] commands will ``multiply'' a logarithmic unit by a
28467 number; the @kbd{l /} (@code{calc-lu-divide}) [@code{lupdiv}] and
28468 @kbd{H l /} [@code{lufdiv}] commands will ``divide'' a logarithmic
28469 unit by a number. Note that the reference quantities don't play a role
28470 in this arithmetic.
28471
28472 @node Musical Notes, , Logarithmic Units, Units
28473 @section Musical Notes
28474
28475 Calc can convert between musical notes and their associated
28476 frequencies. Notes can be given using either scientific pitch
28477 notation or midi numbers. Since these note systems are basically
28478 logarithmic scales, Calc uses the @kbd{l} prefix for functions
28479 operating on notes.
28480
28481 Scientific pitch notation refers to a note by giving a letter
28482 A through G, possibly followed by a flat or sharp) with a subscript
28483 indicating an octave number. Each octave starts with C and ends with
28484 B and
28485 @c increasing each note by a semitone will result
28486 @c in the sequence @expr{C}, @expr{C} sharp, @expr{D}, @expr{E} flat, @expr{E},
28487 @c @expr{F}, @expr{F} sharp, @expr{G}, @expr{A} flat, @expr{A}, @expr{B}
28488 @c flat and @expr{B}.
28489 the octave numbered 0 was chosen to correspond to the lowest
28490 audible frequency. Using this system, middle C (about 261.625 Hz)
28491 corresponds to the note @expr{C} in octave 4 and is denoted
28492 @expr{C_4}. Any frequency can be described by giving a note plus an
28493 offset in cents (where a cent is a ratio of frequencies so that a
28494 semitone consists of 100 cents).
28495
28496 The midi note number system assigns numbers to notes so that
28497 @expr{C_(-1)} corresponds to the midi note number 0 and @expr{G_9}
28498 corresponds to the midi note number 127. A midi controller can have
28499 up to 128 keys and each midi note number from 0 to 127 corresponds to
28500 a possible key.
28501
28502 @kindex l s
28503 @pindex calc-spn
28504 @tindex spn
28505 The @kbd{l s} (@code{calc-spn}) [@code{spn}] command converts either
28506 a frequency or a midi number to scientific pitch notation. For
28507 example, @code{500 Hz} gets converted to
28508 @code{B_4 + 21.3094853649 cents} and @code{84} to @code{C_6}.
28509
28510
28511 @kindex l m
28512 @pindex calc-midi
28513 @tindex midi
28514 The @kbd{l m} (@code{calc-midi}) [@code{midi}] command converts either
28515 a frequency or a note given in scientific pitch notation to the
28516 corresponding midi number. For example, @code{C_6} gets converted to 84
28517 and @code{440 Hz} to 69.
28518
28519 @kindex l f
28520 @pindex calc-freq
28521 @tindex freq
28522 The @kbd{l f} (@code{calc-freq}) [@code{freq}] command converts either
28523 either a midi number or a note given in scientific pitch notation to
28524 the corresponding frequency. For example, @code{Asharp_2 + 30 cents}
28525 gets converted to @code{118.578040134 Hz} and @code{55} to
28526 @code{195.99771799 Hz}.
28527
28528 Since the frequencies of notes are not usually given exactly (and are
28529 typically irrational), the customizable variable
28530 @code{calc-note-threshold} determines how close (in cents) a frequency
28531 needs to be to a note to be recognized as that note
28532 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}). This variable has a default value of
28533 @code{1}. For example, middle @var{C} is approximately
28534 @expr{261.625565302 Hz}; this frequency is often shortened to
28535 @expr{261.625 Hz}. Without @code{calc-note-threshold} (or a value of
28536 @expr{0}), Calc would convert @code{261.625 Hz} to scientific pitch
28537 notation @code{B_3 + 99.9962592773 cents}; with the default value of
28538 @code{1}, Calc converts @code{261.625 Hz} to @code{C_4}.
28539
28540
28541
28542 @node Store and Recall, Graphics, Units, Top
28543 @chapter Storing and Recalling
28544
28545 @noindent
28546 Calculator variables are really just Lisp variables that contain numbers
28547 or formulas in a form that Calc can understand. The commands in this
28548 section allow you to manipulate variables conveniently. Commands related
28549 to variables use the @kbd{s} prefix key.
28550
28551 @menu
28552 * Storing Variables::
28553 * Recalling Variables::
28554 * Operations on Variables::
28555 * Let Command::
28556 * Evaluates-To Operator::
28557 @end menu
28558
28559 @node Storing Variables, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall, Store and Recall
28560 @section Storing Variables
28561
28562 @noindent
28563 @kindex s s
28564 @pindex calc-store
28565 @cindex Storing variables
28566 @cindex Quick variables
28567 @vindex q0
28568 @vindex q9
28569 The @kbd{s s} (@code{calc-store}) command stores the value at the top of
28570 the stack into a specified variable. It prompts you to enter the
28571 name of the variable. If you press a single digit, the value is stored
28572 immediately in one of the ``quick'' variables @code{q0} through
28573 @code{q9}. Or you can enter any variable name.
28574
28575 @kindex s t
28576 @pindex calc-store-into
28577 The @kbd{s s} command leaves the stored value on the stack. There is
28578 also an @kbd{s t} (@code{calc-store-into}) command, which removes a
28579 value from the stack and stores it in a variable.
28580
28581 If the top of stack value is an equation @samp{a = 7} or assignment
28582 @samp{a := 7} with a variable on the lefthand side, then Calc will
28583 assign that variable with that value by default, i.e., if you type
28584 @kbd{s s @key{RET}} or @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. In this example, the
28585 value 7 would be stored in the variable @samp{a}. (If you do type
28586 a variable name at the prompt, the top-of-stack value is stored in
28587 its entirety, even if it is an equation: @samp{s s b @key{RET}}
28588 with @samp{a := 7} on the stack stores @samp{a := 7} in @code{b}.)
28589
28590 In fact, the top of stack value can be a vector of equations or
28591 assignments with different variables on their lefthand sides; the
28592 default will be to store all the variables with their corresponding
28593 righthand sides simultaneously.
28594
28595 It is also possible to type an equation or assignment directly at
28596 the prompt for the @kbd{s s} or @kbd{s t} command: @kbd{s s foo = 7}.
28597 In this case the expression to the right of the @kbd{=} or @kbd{:=}
28598 symbol is evaluated as if by the @kbd{=} command, and that value is
28599 stored in the variable. No value is taken from the stack; @kbd{s s}
28600 and @kbd{s t} are equivalent when used in this way.
28601
28602 @kindex s 0-9
28603 @kindex t 0-9
28604 The prefix keys @kbd{s} and @kbd{t} may be followed immediately by a
28605 digit; @kbd{s 9} is equivalent to @kbd{s s 9}, and @kbd{t 9} is
28606 equivalent to @kbd{s t 9}. (The @kbd{t} prefix is otherwise used
28607 for trail and time/date commands.)
28608
28609 @kindex s +
28610 @kindex s -
28611 @ignore
28612 @mindex @idots
28613 @end ignore
28614 @kindex s *
28615 @ignore
28616 @mindex @null
28617 @end ignore
28618 @kindex s /
28619 @ignore
28620 @mindex @null
28621 @end ignore
28622 @kindex s ^
28623 @ignore
28624 @mindex @null
28625 @end ignore
28626 @kindex s |
28627 @ignore
28628 @mindex @null
28629 @end ignore
28630 @kindex s n
28631 @ignore
28632 @mindex @null
28633 @end ignore
28634 @kindex s &
28635 @ignore
28636 @mindex @null
28637 @end ignore
28638 @kindex s [
28639 @ignore
28640 @mindex @null
28641 @end ignore
28642 @kindex s ]
28643 @pindex calc-store-plus
28644 @pindex calc-store-minus
28645 @pindex calc-store-times
28646 @pindex calc-store-div
28647 @pindex calc-store-power
28648 @pindex calc-store-concat
28649 @pindex calc-store-neg
28650 @pindex calc-store-inv
28651 @pindex calc-store-decr
28652 @pindex calc-store-incr
28653 There are also several ``arithmetic store'' commands. For example,
28654 @kbd{s +} removes a value from the stack and adds it to the specified
28655 variable. The other arithmetic stores are @kbd{s -}, @kbd{s *}, @kbd{s /},
28656 @kbd{s ^}, and @w{@kbd{s |}} (vector concatenation), plus @kbd{s n} and
28657 @kbd{s &} which negate or invert the value in a variable, and @w{@kbd{s [}}
28658 and @kbd{s ]} which decrease or increase a variable by one.
28659
28660 All the arithmetic stores accept the Inverse prefix to reverse the
28661 order of the operands. If @expr{v} represents the contents of the
28662 variable, and @expr{a} is the value drawn from the stack, then regular
28663 @w{@kbd{s -}} assigns
28664 @texline @math{v \coloneq v - a},
28665 @infoline @expr{v := v - a},
28666 but @kbd{I s -} assigns
28667 @texline @math{v \coloneq a - v}.
28668 @infoline @expr{v := a - v}.
28669 While @kbd{I s *} might seem pointless, it is
28670 useful if matrix multiplication is involved. Actually, all the
28671 arithmetic stores use formulas designed to behave usefully both
28672 forwards and backwards:
28673
28674 @example
28675 @group
28676 s + v := v + a v := a + v
28677 s - v := v - a v := a - v
28678 s * v := v * a v := a * v
28679 s / v := v / a v := a / v
28680 s ^ v := v ^ a v := a ^ v
28681 s | v := v | a v := a | v
28682 s n v := v / (-1) v := (-1) / v
28683 s & v := v ^ (-1) v := (-1) ^ v
28684 s [ v := v - 1 v := 1 - v
28685 s ] v := v - (-1) v := (-1) - v
28686 @end group
28687 @end example
28688
28689 In the last four cases, a numeric prefix argument will be used in
28690 place of the number one. (For example, @kbd{M-2 s ]} increases
28691 a variable by 2, and @kbd{M-2 I s ]} replaces a variable by
28692 minus-two minus the variable.
28693
28694 The first six arithmetic stores can also be typed @kbd{s t +}, @kbd{s t -},
28695 etc. The commands @kbd{s s +}, @kbd{s s -}, and so on are analogous
28696 arithmetic stores that don't remove the value @expr{a} from the stack.
28697
28698 All arithmetic stores report the new value of the variable in the
28699 Trail for your information. They signal an error if the variable
28700 previously had no stored value. If default simplifications have been
28701 turned off, the arithmetic stores temporarily turn them on for numeric
28702 arguments only (i.e., they temporarily do an @kbd{m N} command).
28703 @xref{Simplification Modes}. Large vectors put in the trail by
28704 these commands always use abbreviated (@kbd{t .}) mode.
28705
28706 @kindex s m
28707 @pindex calc-store-map
28708 The @kbd{s m} command is a general way to adjust a variable's value
28709 using any Calc function. It is a ``mapping'' command analogous to
28710 @kbd{V M}, @kbd{V R}, etc. @xref{Reducing and Mapping}, to see
28711 how to specify a function for a mapping command. Basically,
28712 all you do is type the Calc command key that would invoke that
28713 function normally. For example, @kbd{s m n} applies the @kbd{n}
28714 key to negate the contents of the variable, so @kbd{s m n} is
28715 equivalent to @kbd{s n}. Also, @kbd{s m Q} takes the square root
28716 of the value stored in a variable, @kbd{s m v v} uses @kbd{v v} to
28717 reverse the vector stored in the variable, and @kbd{s m H I S}
28718 takes the hyperbolic arcsine of the variable contents.
28719
28720 If the mapping function takes two or more arguments, the additional
28721 arguments are taken from the stack; the old value of the variable
28722 is provided as the first argument. Thus @kbd{s m -} with @expr{a}
28723 on the stack computes @expr{v - a}, just like @kbd{s -}. With the
28724 Inverse prefix, the variable's original value becomes the @emph{last}
28725 argument instead of the first. Thus @kbd{I s m -} is also
28726 equivalent to @kbd{I s -}.
28727
28728 @kindex s x
28729 @pindex calc-store-exchange
28730 The @kbd{s x} (@code{calc-store-exchange}) command exchanges the value
28731 of a variable with the value on the top of the stack. Naturally, the
28732 variable must already have a stored value for this to work.
28733
28734 You can type an equation or assignment at the @kbd{s x} prompt. The
28735 command @kbd{s x a=6} takes no values from the stack; instead, it
28736 pushes the old value of @samp{a} on the stack and stores @samp{a = 6}.
28737
28738 @kindex s u
28739 @pindex calc-unstore
28740 @cindex Void variables
28741 @cindex Un-storing variables
28742 Until you store something in them, most variables are ``void,'' that is,
28743 they contain no value at all. If they appear in an algebraic formula
28744 they will be left alone even if you press @kbd{=} (@code{calc-evaluate}).
28745 The @kbd{s u} (@code{calc-unstore}) command returns a variable to the
28746 void state.
28747
28748 @kindex s c
28749 @pindex calc-copy-variable
28750 The @kbd{s c} (@code{calc-copy-variable}) command copies the stored
28751 value of one variable to another. One way it differs from a simple
28752 @kbd{s r} followed by an @kbd{s t} (aside from saving keystrokes) is
28753 that the value never goes on the stack and thus is never rounded,
28754 evaluated, or simplified in any way; it is not even rounded down to the
28755 current precision.
28756
28757 The only variables with predefined values are the ``special constants''
28758 @code{pi}, @code{e}, @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}. You are free
28759 to unstore these variables or to store new values into them if you like,
28760 although some of the algebraic-manipulation functions may assume these
28761 variables represent their standard values. Calc displays a warning if
28762 you change the value of one of these variables, or of one of the other
28763 special variables @code{inf}, @code{uinf}, and @code{nan} (which are
28764 normally void).
28765
28766 Note that @code{pi} doesn't actually have 3.14159265359 stored in it,
28767 but rather a special magic value that evaluates to @cpi{} at the current
28768 precision. Likewise @code{e}, @code{i}, and @code{phi} evaluate
28769 according to the current precision or polar mode. If you recall a value
28770 from @code{pi} and store it back, this magic property will be lost. The
28771 magic property is preserved, however, when a variable is copied with
28772 @kbd{s c}.
28773
28774 @kindex s k
28775 @pindex calc-copy-special-constant
28776 If one of the ``special constants'' is redefined (or undefined) so that
28777 it no longer has its magic property, the property can be restored with
28778 @kbd{s k} (@code{calc-copy-special-constant}). This command will prompt
28779 for a special constant and a variable to store it in, and so a special
28780 constant can be stored in any variable. Here, the special constant that
28781 you enter doesn't depend on the value of the corresponding variable;
28782 @code{pi} will represent 3.14159@dots{} regardless of what is currently
28783 stored in the Calc variable @code{pi}. If one of the other special
28784 variables, @code{inf}, @code{uinf} or @code{nan}, is given a value, its
28785 original behavior can be restored by voiding it with @kbd{s u}.
28786
28787 @node Recalling Variables, Operations on Variables, Storing Variables, Store and Recall
28788 @section Recalling Variables
28789
28790 @noindent
28791 @kindex s r
28792 @pindex calc-recall
28793 @cindex Recalling variables
28794 The most straightforward way to extract the stored value from a variable
28795 is to use the @kbd{s r} (@code{calc-recall}) command. This command prompts
28796 for a variable name (similarly to @code{calc-store}), looks up the value
28797 of the specified variable, and pushes that value onto the stack. It is
28798 an error to try to recall a void variable.
28799
28800 It is also possible to recall the value from a variable by evaluating a
28801 formula containing that variable. For example, @kbd{' a @key{RET} =} is
28802 the same as @kbd{s r a @key{RET}} except that if the variable is void, the
28803 former will simply leave the formula @samp{a} on the stack whereas the
28804 latter will produce an error message.
28805
28806 @kindex r 0-9
28807 The @kbd{r} prefix may be followed by a digit, so that @kbd{r 9} is
28808 equivalent to @kbd{s r 9}.
28809
28810 @node Operations on Variables, Let Command, Recalling Variables, Store and Recall
28811 @section Other Operations on Variables
28812
28813 @noindent
28814 @kindex s e
28815 @pindex calc-edit-variable
28816 The @kbd{s e} (@code{calc-edit-variable}) command edits the stored
28817 value of a variable without ever putting that value on the stack
28818 or simplifying or evaluating the value. It prompts for the name of
28819 the variable to edit. If the variable has no stored value, the
28820 editing buffer will start out empty. If the editing buffer is
28821 empty when you press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish, the variable will
28822 be made void. @xref{Editing Stack Entries}, for a general
28823 description of editing.
28824
28825 The @kbd{s e} command is especially useful for creating and editing
28826 rewrite rules which are stored in variables. Sometimes these rules
28827 contain formulas which must not be evaluated until the rules are
28828 actually used. (For example, they may refer to @samp{deriv(x,y)},
28829 where @code{x} will someday become some expression involving @code{y};
28830 if you let Calc evaluate the rule while you are defining it, Calc will
28831 replace @samp{deriv(x,y)} with 0 because the formula @code{x} does
28832 not itself refer to @code{y}.) By contrast, recalling the variable,
28833 editing with @kbd{`}, and storing will evaluate the variable's value
28834 as a side effect of putting the value on the stack.
28835
28836 @kindex s A
28837 @kindex s D
28838 @ignore
28839 @mindex @idots
28840 @end ignore
28841 @kindex s E
28842 @ignore
28843 @mindex @null
28844 @end ignore
28845 @kindex s F
28846 @ignore
28847 @mindex @null
28848 @end ignore
28849 @kindex s G
28850 @ignore
28851 @mindex @null
28852 @end ignore
28853 @kindex s H
28854 @ignore
28855 @mindex @null
28856 @end ignore
28857 @kindex s I
28858 @ignore
28859 @mindex @null
28860 @end ignore
28861 @kindex s L
28862 @ignore
28863 @mindex @null
28864 @end ignore
28865 @kindex s P
28866 @ignore
28867 @mindex @null
28868 @end ignore
28869 @kindex s R
28870 @ignore
28871 @mindex @null
28872 @end ignore
28873 @kindex s T
28874 @ignore
28875 @mindex @null
28876 @end ignore
28877 @kindex s U
28878 @ignore
28879 @mindex @null
28880 @end ignore
28881 @kindex s X
28882 @pindex calc-store-AlgSimpRules
28883 @pindex calc-store-Decls
28884 @pindex calc-store-EvalRules
28885 @pindex calc-store-FitRules
28886 @pindex calc-store-GenCount
28887 @pindex calc-store-Holidays
28888 @pindex calc-store-IntegLimit
28889 @pindex calc-store-LineStyles
28890 @pindex calc-store-PointStyles
28891 @pindex calc-store-PlotRejects
28892 @pindex calc-store-TimeZone
28893 @pindex calc-store-Units
28894 @pindex calc-store-ExtSimpRules
28895 There are several special-purpose variable-editing commands that
28896 use the @kbd{s} prefix followed by a shifted letter:
28897
28898 @table @kbd
28899 @item s A
28900 Edit @code{AlgSimpRules}. @xref{Algebraic Simplifications}.
28901 @item s D
28902 Edit @code{Decls}. @xref{Declarations}.
28903 @item s E
28904 Edit @code{EvalRules}. @xref{Basic Simplifications}.
28905 @item s F
28906 Edit @code{FitRules}. @xref{Curve Fitting}.
28907 @item s G
28908 Edit @code{GenCount}. @xref{Solving Equations}.
28909 @item s H
28910 Edit @code{Holidays}. @xref{Business Days}.
28911 @item s I
28912 Edit @code{IntegLimit}. @xref{Calculus}.
28913 @item s L
28914 Edit @code{LineStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28915 @item s P
28916 Edit @code{PointStyles}. @xref{Graphics}.
28917 @item s R
28918 Edit @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Graphics}.
28919 @item s T
28920 Edit @code{TimeZone}. @xref{Time Zones}.
28921 @item s U
28922 Edit @code{Units}. @xref{User-Defined Units}.
28923 @item s X
28924 Edit @code{ExtSimpRules}. @xref{Unsafe Simplifications}.
28925 @end table
28926
28927 These commands are just versions of @kbd{s e} that use fixed variable
28928 names rather than prompting for the variable name.
28929
28930 @kindex s p
28931 @pindex calc-permanent-variable
28932 @cindex Storing variables
28933 @cindex Permanent variables
28934 @cindex Calc init file, variables
28935 The @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command saves a
28936 variable's value permanently in your Calc init file (the file given by
28937 the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), so
28938 that its value will still be available in future Emacs sessions. You
28939 can re-execute @w{@kbd{s p}} later on to update the saved value, but the
28940 only way to remove a saved variable is to edit your calc init file
28941 by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
28942 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
28943
28944 If you do not specify the name of a variable to save (i.e.,
28945 @kbd{s p @key{RET}}), all Calc variables with defined values
28946 are saved except for the special constants @code{pi}, @code{e},
28947 @code{i}, @code{phi}, and @code{gamma}; the variables @code{TimeZone}
28948 and @code{PlotRejects};
28949 @code{FitRules}, @code{DistribRules}, and other built-in rewrite
28950 rules; and @code{PlotData@var{n}} variables generated
28951 by the graphics commands. (You can still save these variables by
28952 explicitly naming them in an @kbd{s p} command.)
28953
28954 @kindex s i
28955 @pindex calc-insert-variables
28956 The @kbd{s i} (@code{calc-insert-variables}) command writes
28957 the values of all Calc variables into a specified buffer.
28958 The variables are written with the prefix @code{var-} in the form of
28959 Lisp @code{setq} commands
28960 which store the values in string form. You can place these commands
28961 in your Calc init file (or @file{.emacs}) if you wish, though in this case it
28962 would be easier to use @kbd{s p @key{RET}}. (Note that @kbd{s i}
28963 omits the same set of variables as @w{@kbd{s p @key{RET}}}; the difference
28964 is that @kbd{s i} will store the variables in any buffer, and it also
28965 stores in a more human-readable format.)
28966
28967 @node Let Command, Evaluates-To Operator, Operations on Variables, Store and Recall
28968 @section The Let Command
28969
28970 @noindent
28971 @kindex s l
28972 @pindex calc-let
28973 @cindex Variables, temporary assignment
28974 @cindex Temporary assignment to variables
28975 If you have an expression like @samp{a+b^2} on the stack and you wish to
28976 compute its value where @expr{b=3}, you can simply store 3 in @expr{b} and
28977 then press @kbd{=} to reevaluate the formula. This has the side-effect
28978 of leaving the stored value of 3 in @expr{b} for future operations.
28979
28980 The @kbd{s l} (@code{calc-let}) command evaluates a formula under a
28981 @emph{temporary} assignment of a variable. It stores the value on the
28982 top of the stack into the specified variable, then evaluates the
28983 second-to-top stack entry, then restores the original value (or lack of one)
28984 in the variable. Thus after @kbd{'@w{ }a+b^2 @key{RET} 3 s l b @key{RET}},
28985 the stack will contain the formula @samp{a + 9}. The subsequent command
28986 @kbd{@w{5 s l a} @key{RET}} will replace this formula with the number 14.
28987 The variables @samp{a} and @samp{b} are not permanently affected in any way
28988 by these commands.
28989
28990 The value on the top of the stack may be an equation or assignment, or
28991 a vector of equations or assignments, in which case the default will be
28992 analogous to the case of @kbd{s t @key{RET}}. @xref{Storing Variables}.
28993
28994 Also, you can answer the variable-name prompt with an equation or
28995 assignment: @kbd{s l b=3 @key{RET}} is the same as storing 3 on the stack
28996 and typing @kbd{s l b @key{RET}}.
28997
28998 The @kbd{a b} (@code{calc-substitute}) command is another way to substitute
28999 a variable with a value in a formula. It does an actual substitution
29000 rather than temporarily assigning the variable and evaluating. For
29001 example, letting @expr{n=2} in @samp{f(n pi)} with @kbd{a b} will
29002 produce @samp{f(2 pi)}, whereas @kbd{s l} would give @samp{f(6.28)}
29003 since the evaluation step will also evaluate @code{pi}.
29004
29005 @node Evaluates-To Operator, , Let Command, Store and Recall
29006 @section The Evaluates-To Operator
29007
29008 @noindent
29009 @tindex evalto
29010 @tindex =>
29011 @cindex Evaluates-to operator
29012 @cindex @samp{=>} operator
29013 The special algebraic symbol @samp{=>} is known as the @dfn{evaluates-to
29014 operator}. (It will show up as an @code{evalto} function call in
29015 other language modes like Pascal and @LaTeX{}.) This is a binary
29016 operator, that is, it has a lefthand and a righthand argument,
29017 although it can be entered with the righthand argument omitted.
29018
29019 A formula like @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}} is evaluated by Calc as
29020 follows: First, @var{a} is not simplified or modified in any
29021 way. The previous value of argument @var{b} is thrown away; the
29022 formula @var{a} is then copied and evaluated as if by the @kbd{=}
29023 command according to all current modes and stored variable values,
29024 and the result is installed as the new value of @var{b}.
29025
29026 For example, suppose you enter the algebraic formula @samp{2 + 3 => 17}.
29027 The number 17 is ignored, and the lefthand argument is left in its
29028 unevaluated form; the result is the formula @samp{2 + 3 => 5}.
29029
29030 @kindex s =
29031 @pindex calc-evalto
29032 You can enter an @samp{=>} formula either directly using algebraic
29033 entry (in which case the righthand side may be omitted since it is
29034 going to be replaced right away anyhow), or by using the @kbd{s =}
29035 (@code{calc-evalto}) command, which takes @var{a} from the stack
29036 and replaces it with @samp{@var{a} => @var{b}}.
29037
29038 Calc keeps track of all @samp{=>} operators on the stack, and
29039 recomputes them whenever anything changes that might affect their
29040 values, i.e., a mode setting or variable value. This occurs only
29041 if the @samp{=>} operator is at the top level of the formula, or
29042 if it is part of a top-level vector. In other words, pushing
29043 @samp{2 + (a => 17)} will change the 17 to the actual value of
29044 @samp{a} when you enter the formula, but the result will not be
29045 dynamically updated when @samp{a} is changed later because the
29046 @samp{=>} operator is buried inside a sum. However, a vector
29047 of @samp{=>} operators will be recomputed, since it is convenient
29048 to push a vector like @samp{[a =>, b =>, c =>]} on the stack to
29049 make a concise display of all the variables in your problem.
29050 (Another way to do this would be to use @samp{[a, b, c] =>},
29051 which provides a slightly different format of display. You
29052 can use whichever you find easiest to read.)
29053
29054 @kindex m C
29055 @pindex calc-auto-recompute
29056 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command allows you to
29057 turn this automatic recomputation on or off. If you turn
29058 recomputation off, you must explicitly recompute an @samp{=>}
29059 operator on the stack in one of the usual ways, such as by
29060 pressing @kbd{=}. Turning recomputation off temporarily can save
29061 a lot of time if you will be changing several modes or variables
29062 before you look at the @samp{=>} entries again.
29063
29064 Most commands are not especially useful with @samp{=>} operators
29065 as arguments. For example, given @samp{x + 2 => 17}, it won't
29066 work to type @kbd{1 +} to get @samp{x + 3 => 18}. If you want
29067 to operate on the lefthand side of the @samp{=>} operator on
29068 the top of the stack, type @kbd{j 1} (that's the digit ``one'')
29069 to select the lefthand side, execute your commands, then type
29070 @kbd{j u} to unselect.
29071
29072 All current modes apply when an @samp{=>} operator is computed,
29073 including the current simplification mode. Recall that the
29074 formula @samp{arcsin(sin(x))} will not be handled by Calc's algebraic
29075 simplifications, but Calc's unsafe simplifications will reduce it to
29076 @samp{x}. If you enter @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) =>} normally, the result
29077 will be @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => arcsin(sin(x))}. If you change to
29078 Extended Simplification mode, the result will be
29079 @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => x}. However, just pressing @kbd{a e}
29080 once will have no effect on @samp{arcsin(sin(x)) => arcsin(sin(x))},
29081 because the righthand side depends only on the lefthand side
29082 and the current mode settings, and the lefthand side is not
29083 affected by commands like @kbd{a e}.
29084
29085 The ``let'' command (@kbd{s l}) has an interesting interaction
29086 with the @samp{=>} operator. The @kbd{s l} command evaluates the
29087 second-to-top stack entry with the top stack entry supplying
29088 a temporary value for a given variable. As you might expect,
29089 if that stack entry is an @samp{=>} operator its righthand
29090 side will temporarily show this value for the variable. In
29091 fact, all @samp{=>}s on the stack will be updated if they refer
29092 to that variable. But this change is temporary in the sense
29093 that the next command that causes Calc to look at those stack
29094 entries will make them revert to the old variable value.
29095
29096 @smallexample
29097 @group
29098 2: a => a 2: a => 17 2: a => a
29099 1: a + 1 => a + 1 1: a + 1 => 18 1: a + 1 => a + 1
29100 . . .
29101
29102 17 s l a @key{RET} p 8 @key{RET}
29103 @end group
29104 @end smallexample
29105
29106 Here the @kbd{p 8} command changes the current precision,
29107 thus causing the @samp{=>} forms to be recomputed after the
29108 influence of the ``let'' is gone. The @kbd{d @key{SPC}} command
29109 (@code{calc-refresh}) is a handy way to force the @samp{=>}
29110 operators on the stack to be recomputed without any other
29111 side effects.
29112
29113 @kindex s :
29114 @pindex calc-assign
29115 @tindex assign
29116 @tindex :=
29117 Embedded mode also uses @samp{=>} operators. In Embedded mode,
29118 the lefthand side of an @samp{=>} operator can refer to variables
29119 assigned elsewhere in the file by @samp{:=} operators. The
29120 assignment operator @samp{a := 17} does not actually do anything
29121 by itself. But Embedded mode recognizes it and marks it as a sort
29122 of file-local definition of the variable. You can enter @samp{:=}
29123 operators in Algebraic mode, or by using the @kbd{s :}
29124 (@code{calc-assign}) [@code{assign}] command which takes a variable
29125 and value from the stack and replaces them with an assignment.
29126
29127 @xref{TeX and LaTeX Language Modes}, for the way @samp{=>} appears in
29128 @TeX{} language output. The @dfn{eqn} mode gives similar
29129 treatment to @samp{=>}.
29130
29131 @node Graphics, Kill and Yank, Store and Recall, Top
29132 @chapter Graphics
29133
29134 @noindent
29135 The commands for graphing data begin with the @kbd{g} prefix key. Calc
29136 uses GNUPLOT 2.0 or later to do graphics. These commands will only work
29137 if GNUPLOT is available on your system. (While GNUPLOT sounds like
29138 a relative of GNU Emacs, it is actually completely unrelated.
29139 However, it is free software. It can be obtained from
29140 @samp{http://www.gnuplot.info}.)
29141
29142 @vindex calc-gnuplot-name
29143 If you have GNUPLOT installed on your system but Calc is unable to
29144 find it, you may need to set the @code{calc-gnuplot-name} variable in
29145 your Calc init file or @file{.emacs}. You may also need to set some
29146 Lisp variables to show Calc how to run GNUPLOT on your system; these
29147 are described under @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} below. If you are using
29148 the X window system or MS-Windows, Calc will configure GNUPLOT for you
29149 automatically. If you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later and you are using a
29150 Unix or GNU system without X, Calc will configure GNUPLOT to display
29151 graphs using simple character graphics that will work on any
29152 Posix-compatible terminal.
29153
29154 @menu
29155 * Basic Graphics::
29156 * Three Dimensional Graphics::
29157 * Managing Curves::
29158 * Graphics Options::
29159 * Devices::
29160 @end menu
29161
29162 @node Basic Graphics, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics, Graphics
29163 @section Basic Graphics
29164
29165 @noindent
29166 @kindex g f
29167 @pindex calc-graph-fast
29168 The easiest graphics command is @kbd{g f} (@code{calc-graph-fast}).
29169 This command takes two vectors of equal length from the stack.
29170 The vector at the top of the stack represents the ``y'' values of
29171 the various data points. The vector in the second-to-top position
29172 represents the corresponding ``x'' values. This command runs
29173 GNUPLOT (if it has not already been started by previous graphing
29174 commands) and displays the set of data points. The points will
29175 be connected by lines, and there will also be some kind of symbol
29176 to indicate the points themselves.
29177
29178 The ``x'' entry may instead be an interval form, in which case suitable
29179 ``x'' values are interpolated between the minimum and maximum values of
29180 the interval (whether the interval is open or closed is ignored).
29181
29182 The ``x'' entry may also be a number, in which case Calc uses the
29183 sequence of ``x'' values @expr{x}, @expr{x+1}, @expr{x+2}, etc.
29184 (Generally the number 0 or 1 would be used for @expr{x} in this case.)
29185
29186 The ``y'' entry may be any formula instead of a vector. Calc effectively
29187 uses @kbd{N} (@code{calc-eval-num}) to evaluate variables in the formula;
29188 the result of this must be a formula in a single (unassigned) variable.
29189 The formula is plotted with this variable taking on the various ``x''
29190 values. Graphs of formulas by default use lines without symbols at the
29191 computed data points. Note that if neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is a vector,
29192 Calc guesses at a reasonable number of data points to use. See the
29193 @kbd{g N} command below. (The ``x'' values must be either a vector
29194 or an interval if ``y'' is a formula.)
29195
29196 @ignore
29197 @starindex
29198 @end ignore
29199 @tindex xy
29200 If ``y'' is (or evaluates to) a formula of the form
29201 @samp{xy(@var{x}, @var{y})} then the result is a
29202 parametric plot. The two arguments of the fictitious @code{xy} function
29203 are used as the ``x'' and ``y'' coordinates of the curve, respectively.
29204 In this case the ``x'' vector or interval you specified is not directly
29205 visible in the graph. For example, if ``x'' is the interval @samp{[0..360]}
29206 and ``y'' is the formula @samp{xy(sin(t), cos(t))}, the resulting graph
29207 will be a circle.
29208
29209 Also, ``x'' and ``y'' may each be variable names, in which case Calc
29210 looks for suitable vectors, intervals, or formulas stored in those
29211 variables.
29212
29213 The ``x'' and ``y'' values for the data points (as pulled from the vectors,
29214 calculated from the formulas, or interpolated from the intervals) should
29215 be real numbers (integers, fractions, or floats). One exception to this
29216 is that the ``y'' entry can consist of a vector of numbers combined with
29217 error forms, in which case the points will be plotted with the
29218 appropriate error bars. Other than this, if either the ``x''
29219 value or the ``y'' value of a given data point is not a real number, that
29220 data point will be omitted from the graph. The points on either side
29221 of the invalid point will @emph{not} be connected by a line.
29222
29223 See the documentation for @kbd{g a} below for a description of the way
29224 numeric prefix arguments affect @kbd{g f}.
29225
29226 @cindex @code{PlotRejects} variable
29227 @vindex PlotRejects
29228 If you store an empty vector in the variable @code{PlotRejects}
29229 (i.e., @kbd{[ ] s t PlotRejects}), Calc will append information to
29230 this vector for every data point which was rejected because its
29231 ``x'' or ``y'' values were not real numbers. The result will be
29232 a matrix where each row holds the curve number, data point number,
29233 ``x'' value, and ``y'' value for a rejected data point.
29234 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a handy way to keep tabs on the
29235 current value of @code{PlotRejects}. @xref{Operations on Variables},
29236 for the @kbd{s R} command which is another easy way to examine
29237 @code{PlotRejects}.
29238
29239 @kindex g c
29240 @pindex calc-graph-clear
29241 To clear the graphics display, type @kbd{g c} (@code{calc-graph-clear}).
29242 If the GNUPLOT output device is an X window, the window will go away.
29243 Effects on other kinds of output devices will vary. You don't need
29244 to use @kbd{g c} if you don't want to---if you give another @kbd{g f}
29245 or @kbd{g p} command later on, it will reuse the existing graphics
29246 window if there is one.
29247
29248 @node Three Dimensional Graphics, Managing Curves, Basic Graphics, Graphics
29249 @section Three-Dimensional Graphics
29250
29251 @kindex g F
29252 @pindex calc-graph-fast-3d
29253 The @kbd{g F} (@code{calc-graph-fast-3d}) command makes a three-dimensional
29254 graph. It works only if you have GNUPLOT 3.0 or later; with GNUPLOT 2.0,
29255 you will see a GNUPLOT error message if you try this command.
29256
29257 The @kbd{g F} command takes three values from the stack, called ``x'',
29258 ``y'', and ``z'', respectively. As was the case for 2D graphs, there
29259 are several options for these values.
29260
29261 In the first case, ``x'' and ``y'' are each vectors (not necessarily of
29262 the same length); either or both may instead be interval forms. The
29263 ``z'' value must be a matrix with the same number of rows as elements
29264 in ``x'', and the same number of columns as elements in ``y''. The
29265 result is a surface plot where
29266 @texline @math{z_{ij}}
29267 @infoline @expr{z_ij}
29268 is the height of the point
29269 at coordinate @expr{(x_i, y_j)} on the surface. The 3D graph will
29270 be displayed from a certain default viewpoint; you can change this
29271 viewpoint by adding a @samp{set view} to the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29272 buffer as described later. See the GNUPLOT documentation for a
29273 description of the @samp{set view} command.
29274
29275 Each point in the matrix will be displayed as a dot in the graph,
29276 and these points will be connected by a grid of lines (@dfn{isolines}).
29277
29278 In the second case, ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' are all vectors of equal
29279 length. The resulting graph displays a 3D line instead of a surface,
29280 where the coordinates of points along the line are successive triplets
29281 of values from the input vectors.
29282
29283 In the third case, ``x'' and ``y'' are vectors or interval forms, and
29284 ``z'' is any formula involving two variables (not counting variables
29285 with assigned values). These variables are sorted into alphabetical
29286 order; the first takes on values from ``x'' and the second takes on
29287 values from ``y'' to form a matrix of results that are graphed as a
29288 3D surface.
29289
29290 @ignore
29291 @starindex
29292 @end ignore
29293 @tindex xyz
29294 If the ``z'' formula evaluates to a call to the fictitious function
29295 @samp{xyz(@var{x}, @var{y}, @var{z})}, then the result is a
29296 ``parametric surface.'' In this case, the axes of the graph are
29297 taken from the @var{x} and @var{y} values in these calls, and the
29298 ``x'' and ``y'' values from the input vectors or intervals are used only
29299 to specify the range of inputs to the formula. For example, plotting
29300 @samp{[0..360], [0..180], xyz(sin(x)*sin(y), cos(x)*sin(y), cos(y))}
29301 will draw a sphere. (Since the default resolution for 3D plots is
29302 5 steps in each of ``x'' and ``y'', this will draw a very crude
29303 sphere. You could use the @kbd{g N} command, described below, to
29304 increase this resolution, or specify the ``x'' and ``y'' values as
29305 vectors with more than 5 elements.
29306
29307 It is also possible to have a function in a regular @kbd{g f} plot
29308 evaluate to an @code{xyz} call. Since @kbd{g f} plots a line, not
29309 a surface, the result will be a 3D parametric line. For example,
29310 @samp{[[0..720], xyz(sin(x), cos(x), x)]} will plot two turns of a
29311 helix (a three-dimensional spiral).
29312
29313 As for @kbd{g f}, each of ``x'', ``y'', and ``z'' may instead be
29314 variables containing the relevant data.
29315
29316 @node Managing Curves, Graphics Options, Three Dimensional Graphics, Graphics
29317 @section Managing Curves
29318
29319 @noindent
29320 The @kbd{g f} command is really shorthand for the following commands:
29321 @kbd{C-u g d g a g p}. Likewise, @w{@kbd{g F}} is shorthand for
29322 @kbd{C-u g d g A g p}. You can gain more control over your graph
29323 by using these commands directly.
29324
29325 @kindex g a
29326 @pindex calc-graph-add
29327 The @kbd{g a} (@code{calc-graph-add}) command adds the ``curve''
29328 represented by the two values on the top of the stack to the current
29329 graph. You can have any number of curves in the same graph. When
29330 you give the @kbd{g p} command, all the curves will be drawn superimposed
29331 on the same axes.
29332
29333 The @kbd{g a} command (and many others that affect the current graph)
29334 will cause a special buffer, @file{*Gnuplot Commands*}, to be displayed
29335 in another window. This buffer is a template of the commands that will
29336 be sent to GNUPLOT when it is time to draw the graph. The first
29337 @kbd{g a} command adds a @code{plot} command to this buffer. Succeeding
29338 @kbd{g a} commands add extra curves onto that @code{plot} command.
29339 Other graph-related commands put other GNUPLOT commands into this
29340 buffer. In normal usage you never need to work with this buffer
29341 directly, but you can if you wish. The only constraint is that there
29342 must be only one @code{plot} command, and it must be the last command
29343 in the buffer. If you want to save and later restore a complete graph
29344 configuration, you can use regular Emacs commands to save and restore
29345 the contents of the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29346
29347 @vindex PlotData1
29348 @vindex PlotData2
29349 If the values on the stack are not variable names, @kbd{g a} will invent
29350 variable names for them (of the form @samp{PlotData@var{n}}) and store
29351 the values in those variables. The ``x'' and ``y'' variables are what
29352 go into the @code{plot} command in the template. If you add a curve
29353 that uses a certain variable and then later change that variable, you
29354 can replot the graph without having to delete and re-add the curve.
29355 That's because the variable name, not the vector, interval or formula
29356 itself, is what was added by @kbd{g a}.
29357
29358 A numeric prefix argument on @kbd{g a} or @kbd{g f} changes the way
29359 stack entries are interpreted as curves. With a positive prefix
29360 argument @expr{n}, the top @expr{n} stack entries are ``y'' values
29361 for @expr{n} different curves which share a common ``x'' value in
29362 the @expr{n+1}st stack entry. (Thus @kbd{g a} with no prefix
29363 argument is equivalent to @kbd{C-u 1 g a}.)
29364
29365 A prefix of zero or plain @kbd{C-u} means to take two stack entries,
29366 ``x'' and ``y'' as usual, but to interpret ``y'' as a vector of
29367 ``y'' values for several curves that share a common ``x''.
29368
29369 A negative prefix argument tells Calc to read @expr{n} vectors from
29370 the stack; each vector @expr{[x, y]} describes an independent curve.
29371 This is the only form of @kbd{g a} that creates several curves at once
29372 that don't have common ``x'' values. (Of course, the range of ``x''
29373 values covered by all the curves ought to be roughly the same if
29374 they are to look nice on the same graph.)
29375
29376 For example, to plot
29377 @texline @math{\sin n x}
29378 @infoline @expr{sin(n x)}
29379 for integers @expr{n}
29380 from 1 to 5, you could use @kbd{v x} to create a vector of integers
29381 (@expr{n}), then @kbd{V M '} or @kbd{V M $} to map @samp{sin(n x)}
29382 across this vector. The resulting vector of formulas is suitable
29383 for use as the ``y'' argument to a @kbd{C-u g a} or @kbd{C-u g f}
29384 command.
29385
29386 @kindex g A
29387 @pindex calc-graph-add-3d
29388 The @kbd{g A} (@code{calc-graph-add-3d}) command adds a 3D curve
29389 to the graph. It is not valid to intermix 2D and 3D curves in a
29390 single graph. This command takes three arguments, ``x'', ``y'',
29391 and ``z'', from the stack. With a positive prefix @expr{n}, it
29392 takes @expr{n+2} arguments (common ``x'' and ``y'', plus @expr{n}
29393 separate ``z''s). With a zero prefix, it takes three stack entries
29394 but the ``z'' entry is a vector of curve values. With a negative
29395 prefix @expr{-n}, it takes @expr{n} vectors of the form @expr{[x, y, z]}.
29396 The @kbd{g A} command works by adding a @code{splot} (surface-plot)
29397 command to the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29398
29399 (Although @kbd{g a} adds a 2D @code{plot} command to the
29400 @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer, Calc changes this to @code{splot}
29401 before sending it to GNUPLOT if it notices that the data points are
29402 evaluating to @code{xyz} calls. It will not work to mix 2D and 3D
29403 @kbd{g a} curves in a single graph, although Calc does not currently
29404 check for this.)
29405
29406 @kindex g d
29407 @pindex calc-graph-delete
29408 The @kbd{g d} (@code{calc-graph-delete}) command deletes the most
29409 recently added curve from the graph. It has no effect if there are
29410 no curves in the graph. With a numeric prefix argument of any kind,
29411 it deletes all of the curves from the graph.
29412
29413 @kindex g H
29414 @pindex calc-graph-hide
29415 The @kbd{g H} (@code{calc-graph-hide}) command ``hides'' or ``unhides''
29416 the most recently added curve. A hidden curve will not appear in
29417 the actual plot, but information about it such as its name and line and
29418 point styles will be retained.
29419
29420 @kindex g j
29421 @pindex calc-graph-juggle
29422 The @kbd{g j} (@code{calc-graph-juggle}) command moves the curve
29423 at the end of the list (the ``most recently added curve'') to the
29424 front of the list. The next-most-recent curve is thus exposed for
29425 @w{@kbd{g d}} or similar commands to use. With @kbd{g j} you can work
29426 with any curve in the graph even though curve-related commands only
29427 affect the last curve in the list.
29428
29429 @kindex g p
29430 @pindex calc-graph-plot
29431 The @kbd{g p} (@code{calc-graph-plot}) command uses GNUPLOT to draw
29432 the graph described in the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Any
29433 GNUPLOT parameters which are not defined by commands in this buffer
29434 are reset to their default values. The variables named in the @code{plot}
29435 command are written to a temporary data file and the variable names
29436 are then replaced by the file name in the template. The resulting
29437 plotting commands are fed to the GNUPLOT program. See the documentation
29438 for the GNUPLOT program for more specific information. All temporary
29439 files are removed when Emacs or GNUPLOT exits.
29440
29441 If you give a formula for ``y'', Calc will remember all the values that
29442 it calculates for the formula so that later plots can reuse these values.
29443 Calc throws out these saved values when you change any circumstances
29444 that may affect the data, such as switching from Degrees to Radians
29445 mode, or changing the value of a parameter in the formula. You can
29446 force Calc to recompute the data from scratch by giving a negative
29447 numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}.
29448
29449 Calc uses a fairly rough step size when graphing formulas over intervals.
29450 This is to ensure quick response. You can ``refine'' a plot by giving
29451 a positive numeric prefix argument to @kbd{g p}. Calc goes through
29452 the data points it has computed and saved from previous plots of the
29453 function, and computes and inserts a new data point midway between
29454 each of the existing points. You can refine a plot any number of times,
29455 but beware that the amount of calculation involved doubles each time.
29456
29457 Calc does not remember computed values for 3D graphs. This means the
29458 numerix prefix argument, if any, to @kbd{g p} is effectively ignored if
29459 the current graph is three-dimensional.
29460
29461 @kindex g P
29462 @pindex calc-graph-print
29463 The @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}) command is like @kbd{g p},
29464 except that it sends the output to a printer instead of to the
29465 screen. More precisely, @kbd{g p} looks for @samp{set terminal}
29466 or @samp{set output} commands in the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer;
29467 lacking these it uses the default settings. However, @kbd{g P}
29468 ignores @samp{set terminal} and @samp{set output} commands and
29469 uses a different set of default values. All of these values are
29470 controlled by the @kbd{g D} and @kbd{g O} commands discussed below.
29471 Provided everything is set up properly, @kbd{g p} will plot to
29472 the screen unless you have specified otherwise and @kbd{g P} will
29473 always plot to the printer.
29474
29475 @node Graphics Options, Devices, Managing Curves, Graphics
29476 @section Graphics Options
29477
29478 @noindent
29479 @kindex g g
29480 @pindex calc-graph-grid
29481 The @kbd{g g} (@code{calc-graph-grid}) command turns the ``grid''
29482 on and off. It is off by default; tick marks appear only at the
29483 edges of the graph. With the grid turned on, dotted lines appear
29484 across the graph at each tick mark. Note that this command only
29485 changes the setting in @file{*Gnuplot Commands*}; to see the effects
29486 of the change you must give another @kbd{g p} command.
29487
29488 @kindex g b
29489 @pindex calc-graph-border
29490 The @kbd{g b} (@code{calc-graph-border}) command turns the border
29491 (the box that surrounds the graph) on and off. It is on by default.
29492 This command will only work with GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29493
29494 @kindex g k
29495 @pindex calc-graph-key
29496 The @kbd{g k} (@code{calc-graph-key}) command turns the ``key''
29497 on and off. The key is a chart in the corner of the graph that
29498 shows the correspondence between curves and line styles. It is
29499 off by default, and is only really useful if you have several
29500 curves on the same graph.
29501
29502 @kindex g N
29503 @pindex calc-graph-num-points
29504 The @kbd{g N} (@code{calc-graph-num-points}) command allows you
29505 to select the number of data points in the graph. This only affects
29506 curves where neither ``x'' nor ``y'' is specified as a vector.
29507 Enter a blank line to revert to the default value (initially 15).
29508 With no prefix argument, this command affects only the current graph.
29509 With a positive prefix argument this command changes or, if you enter
29510 a blank line, displays the default number of points used for all
29511 graphs created by @kbd{g a} that don't specify the resolution explicitly.
29512 With a negative prefix argument, this command changes or displays
29513 the default value (initially 5) used for 3D graphs created by @kbd{g A}.
29514 Note that a 3D setting of 5 means that a total of @expr{5^2 = 25} points
29515 will be computed for the surface.
29516
29517 Data values in the graph of a function are normally computed to a
29518 precision of five digits, regardless of the current precision at the
29519 time. This is usually more than adequate, but there are cases where
29520 it will not be. For example, plotting @expr{1 + x} with @expr{x} in the
29521 interval @samp{[0 ..@: 1e-6]} will round all the data points down
29522 to 1.0! Putting the command @samp{set precision @var{n}} in the
29523 @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer will cause the data to be computed
29524 at precision @var{n} instead of 5. Since this is such a rare case,
29525 there is no keystroke-based command to set the precision.
29526
29527 @kindex g h
29528 @pindex calc-graph-header
29529 The @kbd{g h} (@code{calc-graph-header}) command sets the title
29530 for the graph. This will show up centered above the graph.
29531 The default title is blank (no title).
29532
29533 @kindex g n
29534 @pindex calc-graph-name
29535 The @kbd{g n} (@code{calc-graph-name}) command sets the title of an
29536 individual curve. Like the other curve-manipulating commands, it
29537 affects the most recently added curve, i.e., the last curve on the
29538 list in the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. To set the title of
29539 the other curves you must first juggle them to the end of the list
29540 with @kbd{g j}, or edit the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer by hand.
29541 Curve titles appear in the key; if the key is turned off they are
29542 not used.
29543
29544 @kindex g t
29545 @kindex g T
29546 @pindex calc-graph-title-x
29547 @pindex calc-graph-title-y
29548 The @kbd{g t} (@code{calc-graph-title-x}) and @kbd{g T}
29549 (@code{calc-graph-title-y}) commands set the titles on the ``x''
29550 and ``y'' axes, respectively. These titles appear next to the
29551 tick marks on the left and bottom edges of the graph, respectively.
29552 Calc does not have commands to control the tick marks themselves,
29553 but you can edit them into the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer if
29554 you wish. See the GNUPLOT documentation for details.
29555
29556 @kindex g r
29557 @kindex g R
29558 @pindex calc-graph-range-x
29559 @pindex calc-graph-range-y
29560 The @kbd{g r} (@code{calc-graph-range-x}) and @kbd{g R}
29561 (@code{calc-graph-range-y}) commands set the range of values on the
29562 ``x'' and ``y'' axes, respectively. You are prompted to enter a
29563 suitable range. This should be either a pair of numbers of the
29564 form, @samp{@var{min}:@var{max}}, or a blank line to revert to the
29565 default behavior of setting the range based on the range of values
29566 in the data, or @samp{$} to take the range from the top of the stack.
29567 Ranges on the stack can be represented as either interval forms or
29568 vectors: @samp{[@var{min} ..@: @var{max}]} or @samp{[@var{min}, @var{max}]}.
29569
29570 @kindex g l
29571 @kindex g L
29572 @pindex calc-graph-log-x
29573 @pindex calc-graph-log-y
29574 The @kbd{g l} (@code{calc-graph-log-x}) and @kbd{g L} (@code{calc-graph-log-y})
29575 commands allow you to set either or both of the axes of the graph to
29576 be logarithmic instead of linear.
29577
29578 @kindex g C-l
29579 @kindex g C-r
29580 @kindex g C-t
29581 @pindex calc-graph-log-z
29582 @pindex calc-graph-range-z
29583 @pindex calc-graph-title-z
29584 For 3D plots, @kbd{g C-t}, @kbd{g C-r}, and @kbd{g C-l} (those are
29585 letters with the Control key held down) are the corresponding commands
29586 for the ``z'' axis.
29587
29588 @kindex g z
29589 @kindex g Z
29590 @pindex calc-graph-zero-x
29591 @pindex calc-graph-zero-y
29592 The @kbd{g z} (@code{calc-graph-zero-x}) and @kbd{g Z}
29593 (@code{calc-graph-zero-y}) commands control whether a dotted line is
29594 drawn to indicate the ``x'' and/or ``y'' zero axes. (These are the same
29595 dotted lines that would be drawn there anyway if you used @kbd{g g} to
29596 turn the ``grid'' feature on.) Zero-axis lines are on by default, and
29597 may be turned off only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions. They are
29598 not available for 3D plots.
29599
29600 @kindex g s
29601 @pindex calc-graph-line-style
29602 The @kbd{g s} (@code{calc-graph-line-style}) command turns the connecting
29603 lines on or off for the most recently added curve, and optionally selects
29604 the style of lines to be used for that curve. Plain @kbd{g s} simply
29605 toggles the lines on and off. With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g s}
29606 turns lines on and sets a particular line style. Line style numbers
29607 start at one and their meanings vary depending on the output device.
29608 GNUPLOT guarantees that there will be at least six different line styles
29609 available for any device.
29610
29611 @kindex g S
29612 @pindex calc-graph-point-style
29613 The @kbd{g S} (@code{calc-graph-point-style}) command similarly turns
29614 the symbols at the data points on or off, or sets the point style.
29615 If you turn both lines and points off, the data points will show as
29616 tiny dots. If the ``y'' values being plotted contain error forms and
29617 the connecting lines are turned off, then this command will also turn
29618 the error bars on or off.
29619
29620 @cindex @code{LineStyles} variable
29621 @cindex @code{PointStyles} variable
29622 @vindex LineStyles
29623 @vindex PointStyles
29624 Another way to specify curve styles is with the @code{LineStyles} and
29625 @code{PointStyles} variables. These variables initially have no stored
29626 values, but if you store a vector of integers in one of these variables,
29627 the @kbd{g a} and @kbd{g f} commands will use those style numbers
29628 instead of the defaults for new curves that are added to the graph.
29629 An entry should be a positive integer for a specific style, or 0 to let
29630 the style be chosen automatically, or @mathit{-1} to turn off lines or points
29631 altogether. If there are more curves than elements in the vector, the
29632 last few curves will continue to have the default styles. Of course,
29633 you can later use @kbd{g s} and @kbd{g S} to change any of these styles.
29634
29635 For example, @kbd{'[2 -1 3] @key{RET} s t LineStyles} causes the first curve
29636 to have lines in style number 2, the second curve to have no connecting
29637 lines, and the third curve to have lines in style 3. Point styles will
29638 still be assigned automatically, but you could store another vector in
29639 @code{PointStyles} to define them, too.
29640
29641 @node Devices, , Graphics Options, Graphics
29642 @section Graphical Devices
29643
29644 @noindent
29645 @kindex g D
29646 @pindex calc-graph-device
29647 The @kbd{g D} (@code{calc-graph-device}) command sets the device name
29648 (or ``terminal name'' in GNUPLOT lingo) to be used by @kbd{g p} commands
29649 on this graph. It does not affect the permanent default device name.
29650 If you enter a blank name, the device name reverts to the default.
29651 Enter @samp{?} to see a list of supported devices.
29652
29653 With a positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} instead sets
29654 the default device name, used by all plots in the future which do
29655 not override it with a plain @kbd{g D} command. If you enter a
29656 blank line this command shows you the current default. The special
29657 name @code{default} signifies that Calc should choose @code{x11} if
29658 the X window system is in use (as indicated by the presence of a
29659 @code{DISPLAY} environment variable), @code{windows} on MS-Windows, or
29660 otherwise @code{dumb} under GNUPLOT 3.0 and later, or
29661 @code{postscript} under GNUPLOT 2.0. This is the initial default
29662 value.
29663
29664 The @code{dumb} device is an interface to ``dumb terminals,'' i.e.,
29665 terminals with no special graphics facilities. It writes a crude
29666 picture of the graph composed of characters like @code{-} and @code{|}
29667 to a buffer called @file{*Gnuplot Trail*}, which Calc then displays.
29668 The graph is made the same size as the Emacs screen, which on most
29669 dumb terminals will be
29670 @texline @math{80\times24}
29671 @infoline 80x24
29672 characters. The graph is displayed in
29673 an Emacs ``recursive edit''; type @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-c C-c} to exit
29674 the recursive edit and return to Calc. Note that the @code{dumb}
29675 device is present only in GNUPLOT 3.0 and later versions.
29676
29677 The word @code{dumb} may be followed by two numbers separated by
29678 spaces. These are the desired width and height of the graph in
29679 characters. Also, the device name @code{big} is like @code{dumb}
29680 but creates a graph four times the width and height of the Emacs
29681 screen. You will then have to scroll around to view the entire
29682 graph. In the @file{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer, @key{SPC}, @key{DEL},
29683 @kbd{<}, and @kbd{>} are defined to scroll by one screenful in each
29684 of the four directions.
29685
29686 With a negative numeric prefix argument, @kbd{g D} sets or displays
29687 the device name used by @kbd{g P} (@code{calc-graph-print}). This
29688 is initially @code{postscript}. If you don't have a PostScript
29689 printer, you may decide once again to use @code{dumb} to create a
29690 plot on any text-only printer.
29691
29692 @kindex g O
29693 @pindex calc-graph-output
29694 The @kbd{g O} (@code{calc-graph-output}) command sets the name of the
29695 output file used by GNUPLOT@. For some devices, notably @code{x11} and
29696 @code{windows}, there is no output file and this information is not
29697 used. Many other ``devices'' are really file formats like
29698 @code{postscript}; in these cases the output in the desired format
29699 goes into the file you name with @kbd{g O}. Type @kbd{g O stdout
29700 @key{RET}} to set GNUPLOT to write to its standard output stream,
29701 i.e., to @file{*Gnuplot Trail*}. This is the default setting.
29702
29703 Another special output name is @code{tty}, which means that GNUPLOT
29704 is going to write graphics commands directly to its standard output,
29705 which you wish Emacs to pass through to your terminal. Tektronix
29706 graphics terminals, among other devices, operate this way. Calc does
29707 this by telling GNUPLOT to write to a temporary file, then running a
29708 sub-shell executing the command @samp{cat tempfile >/dev/tty}. On
29709 typical Unix systems, this will copy the temporary file directly to
29710 the terminal, bypassing Emacs entirely. You will have to type @kbd{C-l}
29711 to Emacs afterwards to refresh the screen.
29712
29713 Once again, @kbd{g O} with a positive or negative prefix argument
29714 sets the default or printer output file names, respectively. In each
29715 case you can specify @code{auto}, which causes Calc to invent a temporary
29716 file name for each @kbd{g p} (or @kbd{g P}) command. This temporary file
29717 will be deleted once it has been displayed or printed. If the output file
29718 name is not @code{auto}, the file is not automatically deleted.
29719
29720 The default and printer devices and output files can be saved
29721 permanently by the @kbd{m m} (@code{calc-save-modes}) command. The
29722 default number of data points (see @kbd{g N}) and the X geometry
29723 (see @kbd{g X}) are also saved. Other graph information is @emph{not}
29724 saved; you can save a graph's configuration simply by saving the contents
29725 of the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer.
29726
29727 @vindex calc-gnuplot-plot-command
29728 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-device
29729 @vindex calc-gnuplot-default-output
29730 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-command
29731 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-device
29732 @vindex calc-gnuplot-print-output
29733 You may wish to configure the default and
29734 printer devices and output files for the whole system. The relevant
29735 Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-default-device} and @code{-output},
29736 and @code{calc-gnuplot-print-device} and @code{-output}. The output
29737 file names must be either strings as described above, or Lisp
29738 expressions which are evaluated on the fly to get the output file names.
29739
29740 Other important Lisp variables are @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
29741 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command}, which give the system commands to
29742 display or print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
29743 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
29744 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
29745 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
29746 to display or print the output. These variables are customizable
29747 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
29748
29749 @kindex g x
29750 @pindex calc-graph-display
29751 The @kbd{g x} (@code{calc-graph-display}) command lets you specify
29752 on which X window system display your graphs should be drawn. Enter
29753 a blank line to see the current display name. This command has no
29754 effect unless the current device is @code{x11}.
29755
29756 @kindex g X
29757 @pindex calc-graph-geometry
29758 The @kbd{g X} (@code{calc-graph-geometry}) command is a similar
29759 command for specifying the position and size of the X window.
29760 The normal value is @code{default}, which generally means your
29761 window manager will let you place the window interactively.
29762 Entering @samp{800x500+0+0} would create an 800-by-500 pixel
29763 window in the upper-left corner of the screen. This command has no
29764 effect if the current device is @code{windows}.
29765
29766 The buffer called @file{*Gnuplot Trail*} holds a transcript of the
29767 session with GNUPLOT@. This shows the commands Calc has ``typed'' to
29768 GNUPLOT and the responses it has received. Calc tries to notice when an
29769 error message has appeared here and display the buffer for you when
29770 this happens. You can check this buffer yourself if you suspect
29771 something has gone wrong@footnote{
29772 On MS-Windows, due to the peculiarities of how the Windows version of
29773 GNUPLOT (called @command{wgnuplot}) works, the GNUPLOT responses are
29774 not communicated back to Calc. Instead, you need to look them up in
29775 the GNUPLOT command window that is displayed as in normal interactive
29776 usage of GNUPLOT.
29777 }.
29778
29779 @kindex g C
29780 @pindex calc-graph-command
29781 The @kbd{g C} (@code{calc-graph-command}) command prompts you to
29782 enter any line of text, then simply sends that line to the current
29783 GNUPLOT process. The @file{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer looks deceptively
29784 like a Shell buffer but you can't type commands in it yourself.
29785 Instead, you must use @kbd{g C} for this purpose.
29786
29787 @kindex g v
29788 @kindex g V
29789 @pindex calc-graph-view-commands
29790 @pindex calc-graph-view-trail
29791 The @kbd{g v} (@code{calc-graph-view-commands}) and @kbd{g V}
29792 (@code{calc-graph-view-trail}) commands display the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*}
29793 and @file{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffers, respectively, in another window.
29794 This happens automatically when Calc thinks there is something you
29795 will want to see in either of these buffers. If you type @kbd{g v}
29796 or @kbd{g V} when the relevant buffer is already displayed, the
29797 buffer is hidden again. (Note that on MS-Windows, the @file{*Gnuplot
29798 Trail*} buffer will usually show nothing of interest, because
29799 GNUPLOT's responses are not communicated back to Calc.)
29800
29801 One reason to use @kbd{g v} is to add your own commands to the
29802 @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer. Press @kbd{g v}, then use
29803 @kbd{C-x o} to switch into that window. For example, GNUPLOT has
29804 @samp{set label} and @samp{set arrow} commands that allow you to
29805 annotate your plots. Since Calc doesn't understand these commands,
29806 you have to add them to the @file{*Gnuplot Commands*} buffer
29807 yourself, then use @w{@kbd{g p}} to replot using these new commands. Note
29808 that your commands must appear @emph{before} the @code{plot} command.
29809 To get help on any GNUPLOT feature, type, e.g., @kbd{g C help set label}.
29810 You may have to type @kbd{g C @key{RET}} a few times to clear the
29811 ``press return for more'' or ``subtopic of @dots{}'' requests.
29812 Note that Calc always sends commands (like @samp{set nolabel}) to
29813 reset all plotting parameters to the defaults before each plot, so
29814 to delete a label all you need to do is delete the @samp{set label}
29815 line you added (or comment it out with @samp{#}) and then replot
29816 with @kbd{g p}.
29817
29818 @kindex g q
29819 @pindex calc-graph-quit
29820 You can use @kbd{g q} (@code{calc-graph-quit}) to kill the GNUPLOT
29821 process that is running. The next graphing command you give will
29822 start a fresh GNUPLOT process. The word @samp{Graph} appears in
29823 the Calc window's mode line whenever a GNUPLOT process is currently
29824 running. The GNUPLOT process is automatically killed when you
29825 exit Emacs if you haven't killed it manually by then.
29826
29827 @kindex g K
29828 @pindex calc-graph-kill
29829 The @kbd{g K} (@code{calc-graph-kill}) command is like @kbd{g q}
29830 except that it also views the @file{*Gnuplot Trail*} buffer so that
29831 you can see the process being killed. This is better if you are
29832 killing GNUPLOT because you think it has gotten stuck.
29833
29834 @node Kill and Yank, Keypad Mode, Graphics, Top
29835 @chapter Kill and Yank Functions
29836
29837 @noindent
29838 The commands in this chapter move information between the Calculator and
29839 other Emacs editing buffers.
29840
29841 In many cases Embedded mode is an easier and more natural way to
29842 work with Calc from a regular editing buffer. @xref{Embedded Mode}.
29843
29844 @menu
29845 * Killing From Stack::
29846 * Yanking Into Stack::
29847 * Saving Into Registers::
29848 * Inserting From Registers::
29849 * Grabbing From Buffers::
29850 * Yanking Into Buffers::
29851 * X Cut and Paste::
29852 @end menu
29853
29854 @node Killing From Stack, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank, Kill and Yank
29855 @section Killing from the Stack
29856
29857 @noindent
29858 @kindex C-k
29859 @pindex calc-kill
29860 @kindex M-k
29861 @pindex calc-copy-as-kill
29862 @kindex C-w
29863 @pindex calc-kill-region
29864 @kindex M-w
29865 @pindex calc-copy-region-as-kill
29866 @kindex M-C-w
29867 @cindex Kill ring
29868 @dfn{Kill} commands are Emacs commands that insert text into the ``kill
29869 ring,'' from which it can later be ``yanked'' by a @kbd{C-y} command.
29870 Three common kill commands in normal Emacs are @kbd{C-k}, which kills
29871 one line, @kbd{C-w}, which kills the region between mark and point, and
29872 @kbd{M-w}, which puts the region into the kill ring without actually
29873 deleting it. All of these commands work in the Calculator, too,
29874 although in the Calculator they operate on whole stack entries, so they
29875 ``round up'' the specified region to encompass full lines. (To copy
29876 only parts of lines, the @kbd{M-C-w} command in the Calculator will copy
29877 the region to the kill ring without any ``rounding up'', just like the
29878 @kbd{M-w} command in normal Emacs.) Also, @kbd{M-k} has been provided
29879 to complete the set; it puts the current line into the kill ring without
29880 deleting anything.
29881
29882 The kill commands are unusual in that they pay attention to the location
29883 of the cursor in the Calculator buffer. If the cursor is on or below
29884 the bottom line, the kill commands operate on the top of the stack.
29885 Otherwise, they operate on whatever stack element the cursor is on. The
29886 text is copied into the kill ring exactly as it appears on the screen,
29887 including line numbers if they are enabled.
29888
29889 A numeric prefix argument to @kbd{C-k} or @kbd{M-k} affects the number
29890 of lines killed. A positive argument kills the current line and @expr{n-1}
29891 lines below it. A negative argument kills the @expr{-n} lines above the
29892 current line. Again this mirrors the behavior of the standard Emacs
29893 @kbd{C-k} command. Although a whole line is always deleted, @kbd{C-k}
29894 with no argument copies only the number itself into the kill ring, whereas
29895 @kbd{C-k} with a prefix argument of 1 copies the number with its trailing
29896 newline.
29897
29898 @node Yanking Into Stack, Saving Into Registers, Killing From Stack, Kill and Yank
29899 @section Yanking into the Stack
29900
29901 @noindent
29902 @kindex C-y
29903 @pindex calc-yank
29904 The @kbd{C-y} command yanks the most recently killed text back into the
29905 Calculator. It pushes this value onto the top of the stack regardless of
29906 the cursor position. In general it re-parses the killed text as a number
29907 or formula (or a list of these separated by commas or newlines). However if
29908 the thing being yanked is something that was just killed from the Calculator
29909 itself, its full internal structure is yanked. For example, if you have
29910 set the floating-point display mode to show only four significant digits,
29911 then killing and re-yanking 3.14159 (which displays as 3.142) will yank the
29912 full 3.14159, even though yanking it into any other buffer would yank the
29913 number in its displayed form, 3.142. (Since the default display modes
29914 show all objects to their full precision, this feature normally makes no
29915 difference.)
29916
29917 @node Saving Into Registers, Inserting From Registers, Yanking Into Stack, Kill and Yank
29918 @section Saving into Registers
29919
29920 @noindent
29921 @kindex r s
29922 @pindex calc-copy-to-register
29923 @pindex calc-prepend-to-register
29924 @pindex calc-append-to-register
29925 @cindex Registers
29926 An alternative to killing and yanking stack entries is using
29927 registers in Calc. Saving stack entries in registers is like
29928 saving text in normal Emacs registers; although, like Calc's kill
29929 commands, register commands always operate on whole stack
29930 entries.
29931
29932 Registers in Calc are places to store stack entries for later use;
29933 each register is indexed by a single character. To store the current
29934 region (rounded up, of course, to include full stack entries) into a
29935 register, use the command @kbd{r s} (@code{calc-copy-to-register}).
29936 You will then be prompted for a register to use, the next character
29937 you type will be the index for the register. To store the region in
29938 register @var{r}, the full command will be @kbd{r s @var{r}}. With an
29939 argument, @kbd{C-u r s @var{r}}, the region being copied to the
29940 register will be deleted from the Calc buffer.
29941
29942 It is possible to add additional stack entries to a register. The
29943 command @kbd{M-x calc-append-to-register} will prompt for a register,
29944 then add the stack entries in the region to the end of the register
29945 contents. The command @kbd{M-x calc-prepend-to-register} will
29946 similarly prompt for a register and add the stack entries in the
29947 region to the beginning of the register contents. Both commands take
29948 @kbd{C-u} arguments, which will cause the region to be deleted after being
29949 added to the register.
29950
29951 @node Inserting From Registers, Grabbing From Buffers, Saving Into Registers, Kill and Yank
29952 @section Inserting from Registers
29953 @noindent
29954 @kindex r i
29955 @pindex calc-insert-register
29956 The command @kbd{r i} (@code{calc-insert-register}) will prompt for a
29957 register, then insert the contents of that register into the
29958 Calculator. If the contents of the register were placed there from
29959 within Calc, then the full internal structure of the contents will be
29960 inserted into the Calculator, otherwise whatever text is in the
29961 register is reparsed and then inserted into the Calculator.
29962
29963 @node Grabbing From Buffers, Yanking Into Buffers, Inserting From Registers, Kill and Yank
29964 @section Grabbing from Other Buffers
29965
29966 @noindent
29967 @kindex C-x * g
29968 @pindex calc-grab-region
29969 The @kbd{C-x * g} (@code{calc-grab-region}) command takes the text between
29970 point and mark in the current buffer and attempts to parse it as a
29971 vector of values. Basically, it wraps the text in vector brackets
29972 @samp{[ ]} unless the text already is enclosed in vector brackets,
29973 then reads the text as if it were an algebraic entry. The contents
29974 of the vector may be numbers, formulas, or any other Calc objects.
29975 If the @kbd{C-x * g} command works successfully, it does an automatic
29976 @kbd{C-x * c} to enter the Calculator buffer.
29977
29978 A numeric prefix argument grabs the specified number of lines around
29979 point, ignoring the mark. A positive prefix grabs from point to the
29980 @expr{n}th following newline (so that @kbd{M-1 C-x * g} grabs from point
29981 to the end of the current line); a negative prefix grabs from point
29982 back to the @expr{n+1}st preceding newline. In these cases the text
29983 that is grabbed is exactly the same as the text that @kbd{C-k} would
29984 delete given that prefix argument.
29985
29986 A prefix of zero grabs the current line; point may be anywhere on the
29987 line.
29988
29989 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix interprets the region between point and mark
29990 as a single number or formula rather than a vector. For example,
29991 @kbd{C-x * g} on the text @samp{2 a b} produces the vector of three
29992 values @samp{[2, a, b]}, but @kbd{C-u C-x * g} on the same region
29993 reads a formula which is a product of three things: @samp{2 a b}.
29994 (The text @samp{a + b}, on the other hand, will be grabbed as a
29995 vector of one element by plain @kbd{C-x * g} because the interpretation
29996 @samp{[a, +, b]} would be a syntax error.)
29997
29998 If a different language has been specified (@pxref{Language Modes}),
29999 the grabbed text will be interpreted according to that language.
30000
30001 @kindex C-x * r
30002 @pindex calc-grab-rectangle
30003 The @kbd{C-x * r} (@code{calc-grab-rectangle}) command takes the text between
30004 point and mark and attempts to parse it as a matrix. If point and mark
30005 are both in the leftmost column, the lines in between are parsed in their
30006 entirety. Otherwise, point and mark define the corners of a rectangle
30007 whose contents are parsed.
30008
30009 Each line of the grabbed area becomes a row of the matrix. The result
30010 will actually be a vector of vectors, which Calc will treat as a matrix
30011 only if every row contains the same number of values.
30012
30013 If a line contains a portion surrounded by square brackets (or curly
30014 braces), that portion is interpreted as a vector which becomes a row
30015 of the matrix. Any text surrounding the bracketed portion on the line
30016 is ignored.
30017
30018 Otherwise, the entire line is interpreted as a row vector as if it
30019 were surrounded by square brackets. Leading line numbers (in the
30020 format used in the Calc stack buffer) are ignored. If you wish to
30021 force this interpretation (even if the line contains bracketed
30022 portions), give a negative numeric prefix argument to the
30023 @kbd{C-x * r} command.
30024
30025 If you give a numeric prefix argument of zero or plain @kbd{C-u}, each
30026 line is instead interpreted as a single formula which is converted into
30027 a one-element vector. Thus the result of @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will be a
30028 one-column matrix. For example, suppose one line of the data is the
30029 expression @samp{2 a}. A plain @w{@kbd{C-x * r}} will interpret this as
30030 @samp{[2 a]}, which in turn is read as a two-element vector that forms
30031 one row of the matrix. But a @kbd{C-u C-x * r} will interpret this row
30032 as @samp{[2*a]}.
30033
30034 If you give a positive numeric prefix argument @var{n}, then each line
30035 will be split up into columns of width @var{n}; each column is parsed
30036 separately as a matrix element. If a line contained
30037 @w{@samp{2 +/- 3 4 +/- 5}}, then grabbing with a prefix argument of 8
30038 would correctly split the line into two error forms.
30039
30040 @xref{Matrix Functions}, to see how to pull the matrix apart into its
30041 constituent rows and columns. (If it is a
30042 @texline @math{1\times1}
30043 @infoline 1x1
30044 matrix, just hit @kbd{v u} (@code{calc-unpack}) twice.)
30045
30046 @kindex C-x * :
30047 @kindex C-x * _
30048 @pindex calc-grab-sum-across
30049 @pindex calc-grab-sum-down
30050 @cindex Summing rows and columns of data
30051 The @kbd{C-x * :} (@code{calc-grab-sum-down}) command is a handy way to
30052 grab a rectangle of data and sum its columns. It is equivalent to
30053 typing @kbd{C-x * r}, followed by @kbd{V R : +} (the vector reduction
30054 command that sums the columns of a matrix; @pxref{Reducing}). The
30055 result of the command will be a vector of numbers, one for each column
30056 in the input data. The @kbd{C-x * _} (@code{calc-grab-sum-across}) command
30057 similarly grabs a rectangle and sums its rows by executing @w{@kbd{V R _ +}}.
30058
30059 As well as being more convenient, @kbd{C-x * :} and @kbd{C-x * _} are also
30060 much faster because they don't actually place the grabbed vector on
30061 the stack. In a @kbd{C-x * r V R : +} sequence, formatting the vector
30062 for display on the stack takes a large fraction of the total time
30063 (unless you have planned ahead and used @kbd{v .} and @kbd{t .} modes).
30064
30065 For example, suppose we have a column of numbers in a file which we
30066 wish to sum. Go to one corner of the column and press @kbd{C-@@} to
30067 set the mark; go to the other corner and type @kbd{C-x * :}. Since there
30068 is only one column, the result will be a vector of one number, the sum.
30069 (You can type @kbd{v u} to unpack this vector into a plain number if
30070 you want to do further arithmetic with it.)
30071
30072 To compute the product of the column of numbers, we would have to do
30073 it ``by hand'' since there's no special grab-and-multiply command.
30074 Use @kbd{C-x * r} to grab the column of numbers into the calculator in
30075 the form of a column matrix. The statistics command @kbd{u *} is a
30076 handy way to find the product of a vector or matrix of numbers.
30077 @xref{Statistical Operations}. Another approach would be to use
30078 an explicit column reduction command, @kbd{V R : *}.
30079
30080 @node Yanking Into Buffers, X Cut and Paste, Grabbing From Buffers, Kill and Yank
30081 @section Yanking into Other Buffers
30082
30083 @noindent
30084 @kindex y
30085 @pindex calc-copy-to-buffer
30086 The plain @kbd{y} (@code{calc-copy-to-buffer}) command inserts the number
30087 at the top of the stack into the most recently used normal editing buffer.
30088 (More specifically, this is the most recently used buffer which is displayed
30089 in a window and whose name does not begin with @samp{*}. If there is no
30090 such buffer, this is the most recently used buffer except for Calculator
30091 and Calc Trail buffers.) The number is inserted exactly as it appears and
30092 without a newline. (If line-numbering is enabled, the line number is
30093 normally not included.) The number is @emph{not} removed from the stack.
30094
30095 With a prefix argument, @kbd{y} inserts several numbers, one per line.
30096 A positive argument inserts the specified number of values from the top
30097 of the stack. A negative argument inserts the @expr{n}th value from the
30098 top of the stack. An argument of zero inserts the entire stack. Note
30099 that @kbd{y} with an argument of 1 is slightly different from @kbd{y}
30100 with no argument; the former always copies full lines, whereas the
30101 latter strips off the trailing newline.
30102
30103 With a lone @kbd{C-u} as a prefix argument, @kbd{y} @emph{replaces} the
30104 region in the other buffer with the yanked text, then quits the
30105 Calculator, leaving you in that buffer. A typical use would be to use
30106 @kbd{C-x * g} to read a region of data into the Calculator, operate on the
30107 data to produce a new matrix, then type @kbd{C-u y} to replace the
30108 original data with the new data. One might wish to alter the matrix
30109 display style (@pxref{Vector and Matrix Formats}) or change the current
30110 display language (@pxref{Language Modes}) before doing this. Also, note
30111 that this command replaces a linear region of text (as grabbed by
30112 @kbd{C-x * g}), not a rectangle (as grabbed by @kbd{C-x * r}).
30113
30114 If the editing buffer is in overwrite (as opposed to insert) mode,
30115 and the @kbd{C-u} prefix was not used, then the yanked number will
30116 overwrite the characters following point rather than being inserted
30117 before those characters. The usual conventions of overwrite mode
30118 are observed; for example, characters will be inserted at the end of
30119 a line rather than overflowing onto the next line. Yanking a multi-line
30120 object such as a matrix in overwrite mode overwrites the next @var{n}
30121 lines in the buffer, lengthening or shortening each line as necessary.
30122 Finally, if the thing being yanked is a simple integer or floating-point
30123 number (like @samp{-1.2345e-3}) and the characters following point also
30124 make up such a number, then Calc will replace that number with the new
30125 number, lengthening or shortening as necessary. The concept of
30126 ``overwrite mode'' has thus been generalized from overwriting characters
30127 to overwriting one complete number with another.
30128
30129 @kindex C-x * y
30130 The @kbd{C-x * y} key sequence is equivalent to @kbd{y} except that
30131 it can be typed anywhere, not just in Calc. This provides an easy
30132 way to guarantee that Calc knows which editing buffer you want to use!
30133
30134 @node X Cut and Paste, , Yanking Into Buffers, Kill and Yank
30135 @section X Cut and Paste
30136
30137 @noindent
30138 If you are using Emacs with the X window system, there is an easier
30139 way to move small amounts of data into and out of the calculator:
30140 Use the mouse-oriented cut and paste facilities of X.
30141
30142 The default bindings for a three-button mouse cause the left button
30143 to move the Emacs cursor to the given place, the right button to
30144 select the text between the cursor and the clicked location, and
30145 the middle button to yank the selection into the buffer at the
30146 clicked location. So, if you have a Calc window and an editing
30147 window on your Emacs screen, you can use left-click/right-click
30148 to select a number, vector, or formula from one window, then
30149 middle-click to paste that value into the other window. When you
30150 paste text into the Calc window, Calc interprets it as an algebraic
30151 entry. It doesn't matter where you click in the Calc window; the
30152 new value is always pushed onto the top of the stack.
30153
30154 The @code{xterm} program that is typically used for general-purpose
30155 shell windows in X interprets the mouse buttons in the same way.
30156 So you can use the mouse to move data between Calc and any other
30157 Unix program. One nice feature of @code{xterm} is that a double
30158 left-click selects one word, and a triple left-click selects a
30159 whole line. So you can usually transfer a single number into Calc
30160 just by double-clicking on it in the shell, then middle-clicking
30161 in the Calc window.
30162
30163 @node Keypad Mode, Embedded Mode, Kill and Yank, Top
30164 @chapter Keypad Mode
30165
30166 @noindent
30167 @kindex C-x * k
30168 @pindex calc-keypad
30169 The @kbd{C-x * k} (@code{calc-keypad}) command starts the Calculator
30170 and displays a picture of a calculator-style keypad. If you are using
30171 the X window system, you can click on any of the ``keys'' in the
30172 keypad using the left mouse button to operate the calculator.
30173 The original window remains the selected window; in Keypad mode
30174 you can type in your file while simultaneously performing
30175 calculations with the mouse.
30176
30177 @pindex full-calc-keypad
30178 If you have used @kbd{C-x * b} first, @kbd{C-x * k} instead invokes
30179 the @code{full-calc-keypad} command, which takes over the whole
30180 Emacs screen and displays the keypad, the Calc stack, and the Calc
30181 trail all at once. This mode would normally be used when running
30182 Calc standalone (@pxref{Standalone Operation}).
30183
30184 If you aren't using the X window system, you must switch into
30185 the @file{*Calc Keypad*} window, place the cursor on the desired
30186 ``key,'' and type @key{SPC} or @key{RET}. If you think this
30187 is easier than using Calc normally, go right ahead.
30188
30189 Calc commands are more or less the same in Keypad mode. Certain
30190 keypad keys differ slightly from the corresponding normal Calc
30191 keystrokes; all such deviations are described below.
30192
30193 Keypad mode includes many more commands than will fit on the keypad
30194 at once. Click the right mouse button [@code{calc-keypad-menu}]
30195 to switch to the next menu. The bottom five rows of the keypad
30196 stay the same; the top three rows change to a new set of commands.
30197 To return to earlier menus, click the middle mouse button
30198 [@code{calc-keypad-menu-back}] or simply advance through the menus
30199 until you wrap around. Typing @key{TAB} inside the keypad window
30200 is equivalent to clicking the right mouse button there.
30201
30202 You can always click the @key{EXEC} button and type any normal
30203 Calc key sequence. This is equivalent to switching into the
30204 Calc buffer, typing the keys, then switching back to your
30205 original buffer.
30206
30207 @menu
30208 * Keypad Main Menu::
30209 * Keypad Functions Menu::
30210 * Keypad Binary Menu::
30211 * Keypad Vectors Menu::
30212 * Keypad Modes Menu::
30213 @end menu
30214
30215 @node Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode, Keypad Mode
30216 @section Main Menu
30217
30218 @smallexample
30219 @group
30220 |----+----+--Calc---+----+----1
30221 |FLR |CEIL|RND |TRNC|CLN2|FLT |
30222 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30223 | LN |EXP | |ABS |IDIV|MOD |
30224 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30225 |SIN |COS |TAN |SQRT|y^x |1/x |
30226 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30227 | ENTER |+/- |EEX |UNDO| <- |
30228 |-----+---+-+--+--+-+---++----|
30229 | INV | 7 | 8 | 9 | / |
30230 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30231 | HYP | 4 | 5 | 6 | * |
30232 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30233 |EXEC | 1 | 2 | 3 | - |
30234 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----|
30235 | OFF | 0 | . | PI | + |
30236 |-----+-----+-----+-----+-----+
30237 @end group
30238 @end smallexample
30239
30240 @noindent
30241 This is the menu that appears the first time you start Keypad mode.
30242 It will show up in a vertical window on the right side of your screen.
30243 Above this menu is the traditional Calc stack display. On a 24-line
30244 screen you will be able to see the top three stack entries.
30245
30246 The ten digit keys, decimal point, and @key{EEX} key are used for
30247 entering numbers in the obvious way. @key{EEX} begins entry of an
30248 exponent in scientific notation. Just as with regular Calc, the
30249 number is pushed onto the stack as soon as you press @key{ENTER}
30250 or any other function key.
30251
30252 The @key{+/-} key corresponds to normal Calc's @kbd{n} key. During
30253 numeric entry it changes the sign of the number or of the exponent.
30254 At other times it changes the sign of the number on the top of the
30255 stack.
30256
30257 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys modify other keys. As well as
30258 having the effects described elsewhere in this manual, Keypad mode
30259 defines several other ``inverse'' operations. These are described
30260 below and in the following sections.
30261
30262 The @key{ENTER} key finishes the current numeric entry, or otherwise
30263 duplicates the top entry on the stack.
30264
30265 The @key{UNDO} key undoes the most recent Calc operation.
30266 @kbd{INV UNDO} is the ``redo'' command, and @kbd{HYP UNDO} is
30267 ``last arguments'' (@kbd{M-@key{RET}}).
30268
30269 The @key{<-} key acts as a ``backspace'' during numeric entry.
30270 At other times it removes the top stack entry. @kbd{INV <-}
30271 clears the entire stack. @kbd{HYP <-} takes an integer from
30272 the stack, then removes that many additional stack elements.
30273
30274 The @key{EXEC} key prompts you to enter any keystroke sequence
30275 that would normally work in Calc mode. This can include a
30276 numeric prefix if you wish. It is also possible simply to
30277 switch into the Calc window and type commands in it; there is
30278 nothing ``magic'' about this window when Keypad mode is active.
30279
30280 The other keys in this display perform their obvious calculator
30281 functions. @key{CLN2} rounds the top-of-stack by temporarily
30282 reducing the precision by 2 digits. @key{FLT} converts an
30283 integer or fraction on the top of the stack to floating-point.
30284
30285 The @key{INV} and @key{HYP} keys combined with several of these keys
30286 give you access to some common functions even if the appropriate menu
30287 is not displayed. Obviously you don't need to learn these keys
30288 unless you find yourself wasting time switching among the menus.
30289
30290 @table @kbd
30291 @item INV +/-
30292 is the same as @key{1/x}.
30293 @item INV +
30294 is the same as @key{SQRT}.
30295 @item INV -
30296 is the same as @key{CONJ}.
30297 @item INV *
30298 is the same as @key{y^x}.
30299 @item INV /
30300 is the same as @key{INV y^x} (the @expr{x}th root of @expr{y}).
30301 @item HYP/INV 1
30302 are the same as @key{SIN} / @kbd{INV SIN}.
30303 @item HYP/INV 2
30304 are the same as @key{COS} / @kbd{INV COS}.
30305 @item HYP/INV 3
30306 are the same as @key{TAN} / @kbd{INV TAN}.
30307 @item INV/HYP 4
30308 are the same as @key{LN} / @kbd{HYP LN}.
30309 @item INV/HYP 5
30310 are the same as @key{EXP} / @kbd{HYP EXP}.
30311 @item INV 6
30312 is the same as @key{ABS}.
30313 @item INV 7
30314 is the same as @key{RND} (@code{calc-round}).
30315 @item INV 8
30316 is the same as @key{CLN2}.
30317 @item INV 9
30318 is the same as @key{FLT} (@code{calc-float}).
30319 @item INV 0
30320 is the same as @key{IMAG}.
30321 @item INV .
30322 is the same as @key{PREC}.
30323 @item INV ENTER
30324 is the same as @key{SWAP}.
30325 @item HYP ENTER
30326 is the same as @key{RLL3}.
30327 @item INV HYP ENTER
30328 is the same as @key{OVER}.
30329 @item HYP +/-
30330 packs the top two stack entries as an error form.
30331 @item HYP EEX
30332 packs the top two stack entries as a modulo form.
30333 @item INV EEX
30334 creates an interval form; this removes an integer which is one
30335 of 0 @samp{[]}, 1 @samp{[)}, 2 @samp{(]} or 3 @samp{()}, followed
30336 by the two limits of the interval.
30337 @end table
30338
30339 The @kbd{OFF} key turns Calc off; typing @kbd{C-x * k} or @kbd{C-x * *}
30340 again has the same effect. This is analogous to typing @kbd{q} or
30341 hitting @kbd{C-x * c} again in the normal calculator. If Calc is
30342 running standalone (the @code{full-calc-keypad} command appeared in the
30343 command line that started Emacs), then @kbd{OFF} is replaced with
30344 @kbd{EXIT}; clicking on this actually exits Emacs itself.
30345
30346 @node Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Main Menu, Keypad Mode
30347 @section Functions Menu
30348
30349 @smallexample
30350 @group
30351 |----+----+----+----+----+----2
30352 |IGAM|BETA|IBET|ERF |BESJ|BESY|
30353 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30354 |IMAG|CONJ| RE |ATN2|RAND|RAGN|
30355 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30356 |GCD |FACT|DFCT|BNOM|PERM|NXTP|
30357 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30358 @end group
30359 @end smallexample
30360
30361 @noindent
30362 This menu provides various operations from the @kbd{f} and @kbd{k}
30363 prefix keys.
30364
30365 @key{IMAG} multiplies the number on the stack by the imaginary
30366 number @expr{i = (0, 1)}.
30367
30368 @key{RE} extracts the real part a complex number. @kbd{INV RE}
30369 extracts the imaginary part.
30370
30371 @key{RAND} takes a number from the top of the stack and computes
30372 a random number greater than or equal to zero but less than that
30373 number. (@xref{Random Numbers}.) @key{RAGN} is the ``random
30374 again'' command; it computes another random number using the
30375 same limit as last time.
30376
30377 @key{INV GCD} computes the LCM (least common multiple) function.
30378
30379 @key{INV FACT} is the gamma function.
30380 @texline @math{\Gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
30381 @infoline @expr{gamma(x) = (x-1)!}.
30382
30383 @key{PERM} is the number-of-permutations function, which is on the
30384 @kbd{H k c} key in normal Calc.
30385
30386 @key{NXTP} finds the next prime after a number. @kbd{INV NXTP}
30387 finds the previous prime.
30388
30389 @node Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Functions Menu, Keypad Mode
30390 @section Binary Menu
30391
30392 @smallexample
30393 @group
30394 |----+----+----+----+----+----3
30395 |AND | OR |XOR |NOT |LSH |RSH |
30396 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30397 |DEC |HEX |OCT |BIN |WSIZ|ARSH|
30398 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30399 | A | B | C | D | E | F |
30400 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30401 @end group
30402 @end smallexample
30403
30404 @noindent
30405 The keys in this menu perform operations on binary integers.
30406 Note that both logical and arithmetic right-shifts are provided.
30407 @key{INV LSH} rotates one bit to the left.
30408
30409 The ``difference'' function (normally on @kbd{b d}) is on @key{INV AND}.
30410 The ``clip'' function (normally on @w{@kbd{b c}}) is on @key{INV NOT}.
30411
30412 The @key{DEC}, @key{HEX}, @key{OCT}, and @key{BIN} keys select the
30413 current radix for display and entry of numbers: Decimal, hexadecimal,
30414 octal, or binary. The six letter keys @key{A} through @key{F} are used
30415 for entering hexadecimal numbers.
30416
30417 The @key{WSIZ} key displays the current word size for binary operations
30418 and allows you to enter a new word size. You can respond to the prompt
30419 using either the keyboard or the digits and @key{ENTER} from the keypad.
30420 The initial word size is 32 bits.
30421
30422 @node Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Modes Menu, Keypad Binary Menu, Keypad Mode
30423 @section Vectors Menu
30424
30425 @smallexample
30426 @group
30427 |----+----+----+----+----+----4
30428 |SUM |PROD|MAX |MAP*|MAP^|MAP$|
30429 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30430 |MINV|MDET|MTRN|IDNT|CRSS|"x" |
30431 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30432 |PACK|UNPK|INDX|BLD |LEN |... |
30433 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30434 @end group
30435 @end smallexample
30436
30437 @noindent
30438 The keys in this menu operate on vectors and matrices.
30439
30440 @key{PACK} removes an integer @var{n} from the top of the stack;
30441 the next @var{n} stack elements are removed and packed into a vector,
30442 which is replaced onto the stack. Thus the sequence
30443 @kbd{1 ENTER 3 ENTER 5 ENTER 3 PACK} enters the vector
30444 @samp{[1, 3, 5]} onto the stack. To enter a matrix, build each row
30445 on the stack as a vector, then use a final @key{PACK} to collect the
30446 rows into a matrix.
30447
30448 @key{UNPK} unpacks the vector on the stack, pushing each of its
30449 components separately.
30450
30451 @key{INDX} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds a vector of
30452 integers from 1 to @var{n}. @kbd{INV INDX} takes three numbers
30453 from the stack: The vector size @var{n}, the starting number,
30454 and the increment. @kbd{BLD} takes an integer @var{n} and any
30455 value @var{x} and builds a vector of @var{n} copies of @var{x}.
30456
30457 @key{IDNT} removes an integer @var{n}, then builds an @var{n}-by-@var{n}
30458 identity matrix.
30459
30460 @key{LEN} replaces a vector by its length, an integer.
30461
30462 @key{...} turns on or off ``abbreviated'' display mode for large vectors.
30463
30464 @key{MINV}, @key{MDET}, @key{MTRN}, and @key{CROSS} are the matrix
30465 inverse, determinant, and transpose, and vector cross product.
30466
30467 @key{SUM} replaces a vector by the sum of its elements. It is
30468 equivalent to @kbd{u +} in normal Calc (@pxref{Statistical Operations}).
30469 @key{PROD} computes the product of the elements of a vector, and
30470 @key{MAX} computes the maximum of all the elements of a vector.
30471
30472 @key{INV SUM} computes the alternating sum of the first element
30473 minus the second, plus the third, minus the fourth, and so on.
30474 @key{INV MAX} computes the minimum of the vector elements.
30475
30476 @key{HYP SUM} computes the mean of the vector elements.
30477 @key{HYP PROD} computes the sample standard deviation.
30478 @key{HYP MAX} computes the median.
30479
30480 @key{MAP*} multiplies two vectors elementwise. It is equivalent
30481 to the @kbd{V M *} command. @key{MAP^} computes powers elementwise.
30482 The arguments must be vectors of equal length, or one must be a vector
30483 and the other must be a plain number. For example, @kbd{2 MAP^} squares
30484 all the elements of a vector.
30485
30486 @key{MAP$} maps the formula on the top of the stack across the
30487 vector in the second-to-top position. If the formula contains
30488 several variables, Calc takes that many vectors starting at the
30489 second-to-top position and matches them to the variables in
30490 alphabetical order. The result is a vector of the same size as
30491 the input vectors, whose elements are the formula evaluated with
30492 the variables set to the various sets of numbers in those vectors.
30493 For example, you could simulate @key{MAP^} using @key{MAP$} with
30494 the formula @samp{x^y}.
30495
30496 The @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable name @expr{x} onto the
30497 stack. To build the formula @expr{x^2 + 6}, you would use the
30498 key sequence @kbd{"x" 2 y^x 6 +}. This formula would then be
30499 suitable for use with the @key{MAP$} key described above.
30500 With @key{INV}, @key{HYP}, or @key{INV} and @key{HYP}, the
30501 @kbd{"x"} key pushes the variable names @expr{y}, @expr{z}, and
30502 @expr{t}, respectively.
30503
30504 @node Keypad Modes Menu, , Keypad Vectors Menu, Keypad Mode
30505 @section Modes Menu
30506
30507 @smallexample
30508 @group
30509 |----+----+----+----+----+----5
30510 |FLT |FIX |SCI |ENG |GRP | |
30511 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30512 |RAD |DEG |FRAC|POLR|SYMB|PREC|
30513 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30514 |SWAP|RLL3|RLL4|OVER|STO |RCL |
30515 |----+----+----+----+----+----|
30516 @end group
30517 @end smallexample
30518
30519 @noindent
30520 The keys in this menu manipulate modes, variables, and the stack.
30521
30522 The @key{FLT}, @key{FIX}, @key{SCI}, and @key{ENG} keys select
30523 floating-point, fixed-point, scientific, or engineering notation.
30524 @key{FIX} displays two digits after the decimal by default; the
30525 others display full precision. With the @key{INV} prefix, these
30526 keys pop a number-of-digits argument from the stack.
30527
30528 The @key{GRP} key turns grouping of digits with commas on or off.
30529 @kbd{INV GRP} enables grouping to the right of the decimal point as
30530 well as to the left.
30531
30532 The @key{RAD} and @key{DEG} keys switch between radians and degrees
30533 for trigonometric functions.
30534
30535 The @key{FRAC} key turns Fraction mode on or off. This affects
30536 whether commands like @kbd{/} with integer arguments produce
30537 fractional or floating-point results.
30538
30539 The @key{POLR} key turns Polar mode on or off, determining whether
30540 polar or rectangular complex numbers are used by default.
30541
30542 The @key{SYMB} key turns Symbolic mode on or off, in which
30543 operations that would produce inexact floating-point results
30544 are left unevaluated as algebraic formulas.
30545
30546 The @key{PREC} key selects the current precision. Answer with
30547 the keyboard or with the keypad digit and @key{ENTER} keys.
30548
30549 The @key{SWAP} key exchanges the top two stack elements.
30550 The @key{RLL3} key rotates the top three stack elements upwards.
30551 The @key{RLL4} key rotates the top four stack elements upwards.
30552 The @key{OVER} key duplicates the second-to-top stack element.
30553
30554 The @key{STO} and @key{RCL} keys are analogous to @kbd{s t} and
30555 @kbd{s r} in regular Calc. @xref{Store and Recall}. Click the
30556 @key{STO} or @key{RCL} key, then one of the ten digits. (Named
30557 variables are not available in Keypad mode.) You can also use,
30558 for example, @kbd{STO + 3} to add to register 3.
30559
30560 @node Embedded Mode, Programming, Keypad Mode, Top
30561 @chapter Embedded Mode
30562
30563 @noindent
30564 Embedded mode in Calc provides an alternative to copying numbers
30565 and formulas back and forth between editing buffers and the Calc
30566 stack. In Embedded mode, your editing buffer becomes temporarily
30567 linked to the stack and this copying is taken care of automatically.
30568
30569 @menu
30570 * Basic Embedded Mode::
30571 * More About Embedded Mode::
30572 * Assignments in Embedded Mode::
30573 * Mode Settings in Embedded Mode::
30574 * Customizing Embedded Mode::
30575 @end menu
30576
30577 @node Basic Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30578 @section Basic Embedded Mode
30579
30580 @noindent
30581 @kindex C-x * e
30582 @pindex calc-embedded
30583 To enter Embedded mode, position the Emacs point (cursor) on a
30584 formula in any buffer and press @kbd{C-x * e} (@code{calc-embedded}).
30585 Note that @kbd{C-x * e} is not to be used in the Calc stack buffer
30586 like most Calc commands, but rather in regular editing buffers that
30587 are visiting your own files.
30588
30589 Calc will try to guess an appropriate language based on the major mode
30590 of the editing buffer. (@xref{Language Modes}.) If the current buffer is
30591 in @code{latex-mode}, for example, Calc will set its language to @LaTeX{}.
30592 Similarly, Calc will use @TeX{} language for @code{tex-mode},
30593 @code{plain-tex-mode} and @code{context-mode}, C language for
30594 @code{c-mode} and @code{c++-mode}, FORTRAN language for
30595 @code{fortran-mode} and @code{f90-mode}, Pascal for @code{pascal-mode},
30596 and eqn for @code{nroff-mode} (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
30597 These can be overridden with Calc's mode
30598 changing commands (@pxref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}). If no
30599 suitable language is available, Calc will continue with its current language.
30600
30601 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
30602 nearest opening and closing @dfn{formula delimiters}. The simplest
30603 delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that Embedded mode
30604 understands are:
30605
30606 @enumerate
30607 @item
30608 The @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
30609 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
30610 @item
30611 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
30612 @item
30613 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
30614 @item
30615 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
30616 @item
30617 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
30618 @end enumerate
30619
30620 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to make Calc recognize
30621 your own favorite delimiters. Delimiters like @samp{$ $} can appear
30622 on their own separate lines or in-line with the formula.
30623
30624 If you give a positive or negative numeric prefix argument, Calc
30625 instead uses the current point as one end of the formula, and includes
30626 that many lines forward or backward (respectively, including the current
30627 line). Explicit delimiters are not necessary in this case.
30628
30629 With a prefix argument of zero, Calc uses the current region (delimited
30630 by point and mark) instead of formula delimiters. With a prefix
30631 argument of @kbd{C-u} only, Calc uses the current line as the formula.
30632
30633 @kindex C-x * w
30634 @pindex calc-embedded-word
30635 The @kbd{C-x * w} (@code{calc-embedded-word}) command will start Embedded
30636 mode on the current ``word''; in this case Calc will scan for the first
30637 non-numeric character (i.e., the first character that is not a digit,
30638 sign, decimal point, or upper- or lower-case @samp{e}) forward and
30639 backward to delimit the formula.
30640
30641 When you enable Embedded mode for a formula, Calc reads the text
30642 between the delimiters and tries to interpret it as a Calc formula.
30643 Calc can generally identify @TeX{} formulas and
30644 Big-style formulas even if the language mode is wrong. If Calc
30645 can't make sense of the formula, it beeps and refuses to enter
30646 Embedded mode. But if the current language is wrong, Calc can
30647 sometimes parse the formula successfully (but incorrectly);
30648 for example, the C expression @samp{atan(a[1])} can be parsed
30649 in Normal language mode, but the @code{atan} won't correspond to
30650 the built-in @code{arctan} function, and the @samp{a[1]} will be
30651 interpreted as @samp{a} times the vector @samp{[1]}!
30652
30653 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} or @kbd{C-x * w} to activate an embedded
30654 formula which is blank, say with the cursor on the space between
30655 the two delimiters @samp{$ $}, Calc will immediately prompt for
30656 an algebraic entry.
30657
30658 Only one formula in one buffer can be enabled at a time. If you
30659 move to another area of the current buffer and give Calc commands,
30660 Calc turns Embedded mode off for the old formula and then tries
30661 to restart Embedded mode at the new position. Other buffers are
30662 not affected by Embedded mode.
30663
30664 When Embedded mode begins, Calc pushes the current formula onto
30665 the stack. No Calc stack window is created; however, Calc copies
30666 the top-of-stack position into the original buffer at all times.
30667 You can create a Calc window by hand with @kbd{C-x * o} if you
30668 find you need to see the entire stack.
30669
30670 For example, typing @kbd{C-x * e} while somewhere in the formula
30671 @samp{n>2} in the following line enables Embedded mode on that
30672 inequality:
30673
30674 @example
30675 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n>2$.
30676 @end example
30677
30678 @noindent
30679 The formula @expr{n>2} will be pushed onto the Calc stack, and
30680 the top of stack will be copied back into the editing buffer.
30681 This means that spaces will appear around the @samp{>} symbol
30682 to match Calc's usual display style:
30683
30684 @example
30685 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $n > 2$.
30686 @end example
30687
30688 @noindent
30689 No spaces have appeared around the @samp{+} sign because it's
30690 in a different formula, one which we have not yet touched with
30691 Embedded mode.
30692
30693 Now that Embedded mode is enabled, keys you type in this buffer
30694 are interpreted as Calc commands. At this point we might use
30695 the ``commute'' command @kbd{j C} to reverse the inequality.
30696 This is a selection-based command for which we first need to
30697 move the cursor onto the operator (@samp{>} in this case) that
30698 needs to be commuted.
30699
30700 @example
30701 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $2 < n$.
30702 @end example
30703
30704 The @kbd{C-x * o} command is a useful way to open a Calc window
30705 without actually selecting that window. Giving this command
30706 verifies that @samp{2 < n} is also on the Calc stack. Typing
30707 @kbd{17 @key{RET}} would produce:
30708
30709 @example
30710 We define $F_n = F_(n-1)+F_(n-2)$ for all $17$.
30711 @end example
30712
30713 @noindent
30714 with @samp{2 < n} and @samp{17} on the stack; typing @key{TAB}
30715 at this point will exchange the two stack values and restore
30716 @samp{2 < n} to the embedded formula. Even though you can't
30717 normally see the stack in Embedded mode, it is still there and
30718 it still operates in the same way. But, as with old-fashioned
30719 RPN calculators, you can only see the value at the top of the
30720 stack at any given time (unless you use @kbd{C-x * o}).
30721
30722 Typing @kbd{C-x * e} again turns Embedded mode off. The Calc
30723 window reveals that the formula @w{@samp{2 < n}} is automatically
30724 removed from the stack, but the @samp{17} is not. Entering
30725 Embedded mode always pushes one thing onto the stack, and
30726 leaving Embedded mode always removes one thing. Anything else
30727 that happens on the stack is entirely your business as far as
30728 Embedded mode is concerned.
30729
30730 If you press @kbd{C-x * e} in the wrong place by accident, it is
30731 possible that Calc will be able to parse the nearby text as a
30732 formula and will mangle that text in an attempt to redisplay it
30733 ``properly'' in the current language mode. If this happens,
30734 press @kbd{C-x * e} again to exit Embedded mode, then give the
30735 regular Emacs ``undo'' command (@kbd{C-_} or @kbd{C-x u}) to put
30736 the text back the way it was before Calc edited it. Note that Calc's
30737 own Undo command (typed before you turn Embedded mode back off)
30738 will not do you any good, because as far as Calc is concerned
30739 you haven't done anything with this formula yet.
30740
30741 @node More About Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Basic Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30742 @section More About Embedded Mode
30743
30744 @noindent
30745 When Embedded mode ``activates'' a formula, i.e., when it examines
30746 the formula for the first time since the buffer was created or
30747 loaded, Calc tries to sense the language in which the formula was
30748 written. If the formula contains any @LaTeX{}-like @samp{\} sequences,
30749 it is parsed (i.e., read) in @LaTeX{} mode. If the formula appears to
30750 be written in multi-line Big mode, it is parsed in Big mode. Otherwise,
30751 it is parsed according to the current language mode.
30752
30753 Note that Calc does not change the current language mode according
30754 the formula it reads in. Even though it can read a @LaTeX{} formula when
30755 not in @LaTeX{} mode, it will immediately rewrite this formula using
30756 whatever language mode is in effect.
30757
30758 @tex
30759 \bigskip
30760 @end tex
30761
30762 @kindex d p
30763 @pindex calc-show-plain
30764 Calc's parser is unable to read certain kinds of formulas. For
30765 example, with @kbd{v ]} (@code{calc-matrix-brackets}) you can
30766 specify matrix display styles which the parser is unable to
30767 recognize as matrices. The @kbd{d p} (@code{calc-show-plain})
30768 command turns on a mode in which a ``plain'' version of a
30769 formula is placed in front of the fully-formatted version.
30770 When Calc reads a formula that has such a plain version in
30771 front, it reads the plain version and ignores the formatted
30772 version.
30773
30774 Plain formulas are preceded and followed by @samp{%%%} signs
30775 by default. This notation has the advantage that the @samp{%}
30776 character begins a comment in @TeX{} and @LaTeX{}, so if your formula is
30777 embedded in a @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} document its plain version will be
30778 invisible in the final printed copy. Certain major modes have different
30779 delimiters to ensure that the ``plain'' version will be
30780 in a comment for those modes, also.
30781 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode} to see how to change the ``plain''
30782 formula delimiters.
30783
30784 There are several notations which Calc's parser for ``big''
30785 formatted formulas can't yet recognize. In particular, it can't
30786 read the large symbols for @code{sum}, @code{prod}, and @code{integ},
30787 and it can't handle @samp{=>} with the righthand argument omitted.
30788 Also, Calc won't recognize special formats you have defined with
30789 the @kbd{Z C} command (@pxref{User-Defined Compositions}). In
30790 these cases it is important to use ``plain'' mode to make sure
30791 Calc will be able to read your formula later.
30792
30793 Another example where ``plain'' mode is important is if you have
30794 specified a float mode with few digits of precision. Normally
30795 any digits that are computed but not displayed will simply be
30796 lost when you save and re-load your embedded buffer, but ``plain''
30797 mode allows you to make sure that the complete number is present
30798 in the file as well as the rounded-down number.
30799
30800 @tex
30801 \bigskip
30802 @end tex
30803
30804 Embedded buffers remember active formulas for as long as they
30805 exist in Emacs memory. Suppose you have an embedded formula
30806 which is @cpi{} to the normal 12 decimal places, and then
30807 type @w{@kbd{C-u 5 d n}} to display only five decimal places.
30808 If you then type @kbd{d n}, all 12 places reappear because the
30809 full number is still there on the Calc stack. More surprisingly,
30810 even if you exit Embedded mode and later re-enter it for that
30811 formula, typing @kbd{d n} will restore all 12 places because
30812 each buffer remembers all its active formulas. However, if you
30813 save the buffer in a file and reload it in a new Emacs session,
30814 all non-displayed digits will have been lost unless you used
30815 ``plain'' mode.
30816
30817 @tex
30818 \bigskip
30819 @end tex
30820
30821 In some applications of Embedded mode, you will want to have a
30822 sequence of copies of a formula that show its evolution as you
30823 work on it. For example, you might want to have a sequence
30824 like this in your file (elaborating here on the example from
30825 the ``Getting Started'' chapter):
30826
30827 @smallexample
30828 The derivative of
30829
30830 ln(ln(x))
30831
30832 is
30833
30834 @r{(the derivative of }ln(ln(x))@r{)}
30835
30836 whose value at x = 2 is
30837
30838 @r{(the value)}
30839
30840 and at x = 3 is
30841
30842 @r{(the value)}
30843 @end smallexample
30844
30845 @kindex C-x * d
30846 @pindex calc-embedded-duplicate
30847 The @kbd{C-x * d} (@code{calc-embedded-duplicate}) command is a
30848 handy way to make sequences like this. If you type @kbd{C-x * d},
30849 the formula under the cursor (which may or may not have Embedded
30850 mode enabled for it at the time) is copied immediately below and
30851 Embedded mode is then enabled for that copy.
30852
30853 For this example, you would start with just
30854
30855 @smallexample
30856 The derivative of
30857
30858 ln(ln(x))
30859 @end smallexample
30860
30861 @noindent
30862 and press @kbd{C-x * d} with the cursor on this formula. The result
30863 is
30864
30865 @smallexample
30866 The derivative of
30867
30868 ln(ln(x))
30869
30870
30871 ln(ln(x))
30872 @end smallexample
30873
30874 @noindent
30875 with the second copy of the formula enabled in Embedded mode.
30876 You can now press @kbd{a d x @key{RET}} to take the derivative, and
30877 @kbd{C-x * d C-x * d} to make two more copies of the derivative.
30878 To complete the computations, type @kbd{3 s l x @key{RET}} to evaluate
30879 the last formula, then move up to the second-to-last formula
30880 and type @kbd{2 s l x @key{RET}}.
30881
30882 Finally, you would want to press @kbd{C-x * e} to exit Embedded
30883 mode, then go up and insert the necessary text in between the
30884 various formulas and numbers.
30885
30886 @tex
30887 \bigskip
30888 @end tex
30889
30890 @kindex C-x * f
30891 @kindex C-x * '
30892 @pindex calc-embedded-new-formula
30893 The @kbd{C-x * f} (@code{calc-embedded-new-formula}) command
30894 creates a new embedded formula at the current point. It inserts
30895 some default delimiters, which are usually just blank lines,
30896 and then does an algebraic entry to get the formula (which is
30897 then enabled for Embedded mode). This is just shorthand for
30898 typing the delimiters yourself, positioning the cursor between
30899 the new delimiters, and pressing @kbd{C-x * e}. The key sequence
30900 @kbd{C-x * '} is equivalent to @kbd{C-x * f}.
30901
30902 @kindex C-x * n
30903 @kindex C-x * p
30904 @pindex calc-embedded-next
30905 @pindex calc-embedded-previous
30906 The @kbd{C-x * n} (@code{calc-embedded-next}) and @kbd{C-x * p}
30907 (@code{calc-embedded-previous}) commands move the cursor to the
30908 next or previous active embedded formula in the buffer. They
30909 can take positive or negative prefix arguments to move by several
30910 formulas. Note that these commands do not actually examine the
30911 text of the buffer looking for formulas; they only see formulas
30912 which have previously been activated in Embedded mode. In fact,
30913 @kbd{C-x * n} and @kbd{C-x * p} are a useful way to tell which
30914 embedded formulas are currently active. Also, note that these
30915 commands do not enable Embedded mode on the next or previous
30916 formula, they just move the cursor.
30917
30918 @kindex C-x * `
30919 @pindex calc-embedded-edit
30920 The @kbd{C-x * `} (@code{calc-embedded-edit}) command edits the
30921 embedded formula at the current point as if by @kbd{`} (@code{calc-edit}).
30922 Embedded mode does not have to be enabled for this to work. Press
30923 @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish the edit, or @kbd{C-x k} to cancel.
30924
30925 @node Assignments in Embedded Mode, Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, More About Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
30926 @section Assignments in Embedded Mode
30927
30928 @noindent
30929 The @samp{:=} (assignment) and @samp{=>} (``evaluates-to'') operators
30930 are especially useful in Embedded mode. They allow you to make
30931 a definition in one formula, then refer to that definition in
30932 other formulas embedded in the same buffer.
30933
30934 An embedded formula which is an assignment to a variable, as in
30935
30936 @example
30937 foo := 5
30938 @end example
30939
30940 @noindent
30941 records @expr{5} as the stored value of @code{foo} for the
30942 purposes of Embedded mode operations in the current buffer. It
30943 does @emph{not} actually store @expr{5} as the ``global'' value
30944 of @code{foo}, however. Regular Calc operations, and Embedded
30945 formulas in other buffers, will not see this assignment.
30946
30947 One way to use this assigned value is simply to create an
30948 Embedded formula elsewhere that refers to @code{foo}, and to press
30949 @kbd{=} in that formula. However, this permanently replaces the
30950 @code{foo} in the formula with its current value. More interesting
30951 is to use @samp{=>} elsewhere:
30952
30953 @example
30954 foo + 7 => 12
30955 @end example
30956
30957 @xref{Evaluates-To Operator}, for a general discussion of @samp{=>}.
30958
30959 If you move back and change the assignment to @code{foo}, any
30960 @samp{=>} formulas which refer to it are automatically updated.
30961
30962 @example
30963 foo := 17
30964
30965 foo + 7 => 24
30966 @end example
30967
30968 The obvious question then is, @emph{how} can one easily change the
30969 assignment to @code{foo}? If you simply select the formula in
30970 Embedded mode and type 17, the assignment itself will be replaced
30971 by the 17. The effect on the other formula will be that the
30972 variable @code{foo} becomes unassigned:
30973
30974 @example
30975 17
30976
30977 foo + 7 => foo + 7
30978 @end example
30979
30980 The right thing to do is first to use a selection command (@kbd{j 2}
30981 will do the trick) to select the righthand side of the assignment.
30982 Then, @kbd{17 @key{TAB} @key{DEL}} will swap the 17 into place (@pxref{Selecting
30983 Subformulas}, to see how this works).
30984
30985 @kindex C-x * j
30986 @pindex calc-embedded-select
30987 The @kbd{C-x * j} (@code{calc-embedded-select}) command provides an
30988 easy way to operate on assignments. It is just like @kbd{C-x * e},
30989 except that if the enabled formula is an assignment, it uses
30990 @kbd{j 2} to select the righthand side. If the enabled formula
30991 is an evaluates-to, it uses @kbd{j 1} to select the lefthand side.
30992 A formula can also be a combination of both:
30993
30994 @example
30995 bar := foo + 3 => 20
30996 @end example
30997
30998 @noindent
30999 in which case @kbd{C-x * j} will select the middle part (@samp{foo + 3}).
31000
31001 The formula is automatically deselected when you leave Embedded
31002 mode.
31003
31004 @kindex C-x * u
31005 @pindex calc-embedded-update-formula
31006 Another way to change the assignment to @code{foo} would simply be
31007 to edit the number using regular Emacs editing rather than Embedded
31008 mode. Then, we have to find a way to get Embedded mode to notice
31009 the change. The @kbd{C-x * u} (@code{calc-embedded-update-formula})
31010 command is a convenient way to do this.
31011
31012 @example
31013 foo := 6
31014
31015 foo + 7 => 13
31016 @end example
31017
31018 Pressing @kbd{C-x * u} is much like pressing @kbd{C-x * e = C-x * e}, that
31019 is, temporarily enabling Embedded mode for the formula under the
31020 cursor and then evaluating it with @kbd{=}. But @kbd{C-x * u} does
31021 not actually use @kbd{C-x * e}, and in fact another formula somewhere
31022 else can be enabled in Embedded mode while you use @kbd{C-x * u} and
31023 that formula will not be disturbed.
31024
31025 With a numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * u} updates all active
31026 @samp{=>} formulas in the buffer. Formulas which have not yet
31027 been activated in Embedded mode, and formulas which do not have
31028 @samp{=>} as their top-level operator, are not affected by this.
31029 (This is useful only if you have used @kbd{m C}; see below.)
31030
31031 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, @kbd{C-u C-x * u} updates only in the
31032 region between mark and point rather than in the whole buffer.
31033
31034 @kbd{C-x * u} is also a handy way to activate a formula, such as an
31035 @samp{=>} formula that has freshly been typed in or loaded from a
31036 file.
31037
31038 @kindex C-x * a
31039 @pindex calc-embedded-activate
31040 The @kbd{C-x * a} (@code{calc-embedded-activate}) command scans
31041 through the current buffer and activates all embedded formulas
31042 that contain @samp{:=} or @samp{=>} symbols. This does not mean
31043 that Embedded mode is actually turned on, but only that the
31044 formulas' positions are registered with Embedded mode so that
31045 the @samp{=>} values can be properly updated as assignments are
31046 changed.
31047
31048 It is a good idea to type @kbd{C-x * a} right after loading a file
31049 that uses embedded @samp{=>} operators. Emacs includes a nifty
31050 ``buffer-local variables'' feature that you can use to do this
31051 automatically. The idea is to place near the end of your file
31052 a few lines that look like this:
31053
31054 @example
31055 --- Local Variables: ---
31056 --- eval:(calc-embedded-activate) ---
31057 --- End: ---
31058 @end example
31059
31060 @noindent
31061 where the leading and trailing @samp{---} can be replaced by
31062 any suitable strings (which must be the same on all three lines)
31063 or omitted altogether; in a @TeX{} or @LaTeX{} file, @samp{%} would be a good
31064 leading string and no trailing string would be necessary. In a
31065 C program, @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} would be good leading and
31066 trailing strings.
31067
31068 When Emacs loads a file into memory, it checks for a Local Variables
31069 section like this one at the end of the file. If it finds this
31070 section, it does the specified things (in this case, running
31071 @kbd{C-x * a} automatically) before editing of the file begins.
31072 The Local Variables section must be within 3000 characters of the
31073 end of the file for Emacs to find it, and it must be in the last
31074 page of the file if the file has any page separators.
31075 @xref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the
31076 Emacs manual}.
31077
31078 Note that @kbd{C-x * a} does not update the formulas it finds.
31079 To do this, type, say, @kbd{M-1 C-x * u} after @w{@kbd{C-x * a}}.
31080 Generally this should not be a problem, though, because the
31081 formulas will have been up-to-date already when the file was
31082 saved.
31083
31084 Normally, @kbd{C-x * a} activates all the formulas it finds, but
31085 any previous active formulas remain active as well. With a
31086 positive numeric prefix argument, @kbd{C-x * a} first deactivates
31087 all current active formulas, then actives the ones it finds in
31088 its scan of the buffer. With a negative prefix argument,
31089 @kbd{C-x * a} simply deactivates all formulas.
31090
31091 Embedded mode has two symbols, @samp{Active} and @samp{~Active},
31092 which it puts next to the major mode name in a buffer's mode line.
31093 It puts @samp{Active} if it has reason to believe that all
31094 formulas in the buffer are active, because you have typed @kbd{C-x * a}
31095 and Calc has not since had to deactivate any formulas (which can
31096 happen if Calc goes to update an @samp{=>} formula somewhere because
31097 a variable changed, and finds that the formula is no longer there
31098 due to some kind of editing outside of Embedded mode). Calc puts
31099 @samp{~Active} in the mode line if some, but probably not all,
31100 formulas in the buffer are active. This happens if you activate
31101 a few formulas one at a time but never use @kbd{C-x * a}, or if you
31102 used @kbd{C-x * a} but then Calc had to deactivate a formula
31103 because it lost track of it. If neither of these symbols appears
31104 in the mode line, no embedded formulas are active in the buffer
31105 (e.g., before Embedded mode has been used, or after a @kbd{M-- C-x * a}).
31106
31107 Embedded formulas can refer to assignments both before and after them
31108 in the buffer. If there are several assignments to a variable, the
31109 nearest preceding assignment is used if there is one, otherwise the
31110 following assignment is used.
31111
31112 @example
31113 x => 1
31114
31115 x := 1
31116
31117 x => 1
31118
31119 x := 2
31120
31121 x => 2
31122 @end example
31123
31124 As well as simple variables, you can also assign to subscript
31125 expressions of the form @samp{@var{var}_@var{number}} (as in
31126 @code{x_0}), or @samp{@var{var}_@var{var}} (as in @code{x_max}).
31127 Assignments to other kinds of objects can be represented by Calc,
31128 but the automatic linkage between assignments and references works
31129 only for plain variables and these two kinds of subscript expressions.
31130
31131 If there are no assignments to a given variable, the global
31132 stored value for the variable is used (@pxref{Storing Variables}),
31133 or, if no value is stored, the variable is left in symbolic form.
31134 Note that global stored values will be lost when the file is saved
31135 and loaded in a later Emacs session, unless you have used the
31136 @kbd{s p} (@code{calc-permanent-variable}) command to save them;
31137 @pxref{Operations on Variables}.
31138
31139 The @kbd{m C} (@code{calc-auto-recompute}) command turns automatic
31140 recomputation of @samp{=>} forms on and off. If you turn automatic
31141 recomputation off, you will have to use @kbd{C-x * u} to update these
31142 formulas manually after an assignment has been changed. If you
31143 plan to change several assignments at once, it may be more efficient
31144 to type @kbd{m C}, change all the assignments, then use @kbd{M-1 C-x * u}
31145 to update the entire buffer afterwards. The @kbd{m C} command also
31146 controls @samp{=>} formulas on the stack; @pxref{Evaluates-To
31147 Operator}. When you turn automatic recomputation back on, the
31148 stack will be updated but the Embedded buffer will not; you must
31149 use @kbd{C-x * u} to update the buffer by hand.
31150
31151 @node Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Customizing Embedded Mode, Assignments in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
31152 @section Mode Settings in Embedded Mode
31153
31154 @kindex m e
31155 @pindex calc-embedded-preserve-modes
31156 @noindent
31157 The mode settings can be changed while Calc is in embedded mode, but
31158 by default they will revert to their original values when embedded mode
31159 is ended. However, the modes saved when the mode-recording mode is
31160 @code{Save} (see below) and the modes in effect when the @kbd{m e}
31161 (@code{calc-embedded-preserve-modes}) command is given
31162 will be preserved when embedded mode is ended.
31163
31164 Embedded mode has a rather complicated mechanism for handling mode
31165 settings in Embedded formulas. It is possible to put annotations
31166 in the file that specify mode settings either global to the entire
31167 file or local to a particular formula or formulas. In the latter
31168 case, different modes can be specified for use when a formula
31169 is the enabled Embedded mode formula.
31170
31171 When you give any mode-setting command, like @kbd{m f} (for Fraction
31172 mode) or @kbd{d s} (for scientific notation), Embedded mode adds
31173 a line like the following one to the file just before the opening
31174 delimiter of the formula.
31175
31176 @example
31177 % [calc-mode: fractions: t]
31178 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31179 @end example
31180
31181 When Calc interprets an embedded formula, it scans the text before
31182 the formula for mode-setting annotations like these and sets the
31183 Calc buffer to match these modes. Modes not explicitly described
31184 in the file are not changed. Calc scans all the way to the top of
31185 the file, or up to a line of the form
31186
31187 @example
31188 % [calc-defaults]
31189 @end example
31190
31191 @noindent
31192 which you can insert at strategic places in the file if this backward
31193 scan is getting too slow, or just to provide a barrier between one
31194 ``zone'' of mode settings and another.
31195
31196 If the file contains several annotations for the same mode, the
31197 closest one before the formula is used. Annotations after the
31198 formula are never used (except for global annotations, described
31199 below).
31200
31201 The scan does not look for the leading @samp{% }, only for the
31202 square brackets and the text they enclose. In fact, the leading
31203 characters are different for different major modes. You can edit the
31204 mode annotations to a style that works better in context if you wish.
31205 @xref{Customizing Embedded Mode}, to see how to change the style
31206 that Calc uses when it generates the annotations. You can write
31207 mode annotations into the file yourself if you know the syntax;
31208 the easiest way to find the syntax for a given mode is to let
31209 Calc write the annotation for it once and see what it does.
31210
31211 If you give a mode-changing command for a mode that already has
31212 a suitable annotation just above the current formula, Calc will
31213 modify that annotation rather than generating a new, conflicting
31214 one.
31215
31216 Mode annotations have three parts, separated by colons. (Spaces
31217 after the colons are optional.) The first identifies the kind
31218 of mode setting, the second is a name for the mode itself, and
31219 the third is the value in the form of a Lisp symbol, number,
31220 or list. Annotations with unrecognizable text in the first or
31221 second parts are ignored. The third part is not checked to make
31222 sure the value is of a valid type or range; if you write an
31223 annotation by hand, be sure to give a proper value or results
31224 will be unpredictable. Mode-setting annotations are case-sensitive.
31225
31226 While Embedded mode is enabled, the word @code{Local} appears in
31227 the mode line. This is to show that mode setting commands generate
31228 annotations that are ``local'' to the current formula or set of
31229 formulas. The @kbd{m R} (@code{calc-mode-record-mode}) command
31230 causes Calc to generate different kinds of annotations. Pressing
31231 @kbd{m R} repeatedly cycles through the possible modes.
31232
31233 @code{LocEdit} and @code{LocPerm} modes generate annotations
31234 that look like this, respectively:
31235
31236 @example
31237 % [calc-edit-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31238 % [calc-perm-mode: float-format: (sci 5)]
31239 @end example
31240
31241 The first kind of annotation will be used only while a formula
31242 is enabled in Embedded mode. The second kind will be used only
31243 when the formula is @emph{not} enabled. (Whether the formula
31244 is ``active'' or not, i.e., whether Calc has seen this formula
31245 yet, is not relevant here.)
31246
31247 @code{Global} mode generates an annotation like this at the end
31248 of the file:
31249
31250 @example
31251 % [calc-global-mode: fractions t]
31252 @end example
31253
31254 Global mode annotations affect all formulas throughout the file,
31255 and may appear anywhere in the file. This allows you to tuck your
31256 mode annotations somewhere out of the way, say, on a new page of
31257 the file, as long as those mode settings are suitable for all
31258 formulas in the file.
31259
31260 Enabling a formula with @kbd{C-x * e} causes a fresh scan for local
31261 mode annotations; you will have to use this after adding annotations
31262 above a formula by hand to get the formula to notice them. Updating
31263 a formula with @kbd{C-x * u} will also re-scan the local modes, but
31264 global modes are only re-scanned by @kbd{C-x * a}.
31265
31266 Another way that modes can get out of date is if you add a local
31267 mode annotation to a formula that has another formula after it.
31268 In this example, we have used the @kbd{d s} command while the
31269 first of the two embedded formulas is active. But the second
31270 formula has not changed its style to match, even though by the
31271 rules of reading annotations the @samp{(sci 0)} applies to it, too.
31272
31273 @example
31274 % [calc-mode: float-format: (sci 0)]
31275 1.23e2
31276
31277 456.
31278 @end example
31279
31280 We would have to go down to the other formula and press @kbd{C-x * u}
31281 on it in order to get it to notice the new annotation.
31282
31283 Two more mode-recording modes selectable by @kbd{m R} are available
31284 which are also available outside of Embedded mode.
31285 (@pxref{General Mode Commands}.) They are @code{Save}, in which mode
31286 settings are recorded permanently in your Calc init file (the file given
31287 by the variable @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el})
31288 rather than by annotating the current document, and no-recording
31289 mode (where there is no symbol like @code{Save} or @code{Local} in
31290 the mode line), in which mode-changing commands do not leave any
31291 annotations at all.
31292
31293 When Embedded mode is not enabled, mode-recording modes except
31294 for @code{Save} have no effect.
31295
31296 @node Customizing Embedded Mode, , Mode Settings in Embedded Mode, Embedded Mode
31297 @section Customizing Embedded Mode
31298
31299 @noindent
31300 You can modify Embedded mode's behavior by setting various Lisp
31301 variables described here. These variables are customizable
31302 (@pxref{Customizing Calc}), or you can use @kbd{M-x set-variable}
31303 or @kbd{M-x edit-options} to adjust a variable on the fly.
31304 (Another possibility would be to use a file-local variable annotation at
31305 the end of the file;
31306 @pxref{File Variables, , Local Variables in Files, emacs, the Emacs manual}.)
31307 Many of the variables given mentioned here can be set to depend on the
31308 major mode of the editing buffer (@pxref{Customizing Calc}).
31309
31310 @vindex calc-embedded-open-formula
31311 The @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} variable holds a regular
31312 expression for the opening delimiter of a formula. @xref{Regexp Search,
31313 , Regular Expression Search, emacs, the Emacs manual}, to see
31314 how regular expressions work. Basically, a regular expression is a
31315 pattern that Calc can search for. A regular expression that considers
31316 blank lines, @samp{$}, and @samp{$$} to be opening delimiters is
31317 @code{"\\`\\|^\n\\|\\$\\$?"}. Just in case the meaning of this
31318 regular expression is not completely plain, let's go through it
31319 in detail.
31320
31321 The surrounding @samp{" "} marks quote the text between them as a
31322 Lisp string. If you left them off, @code{set-variable} or
31323 @code{edit-options} would try to read the regular expression as a
31324 Lisp program.
31325
31326 The most obvious property of this regular expression is that it
31327 contains indecently many backslashes. There are actually two levels
31328 of backslash usage going on here. First, when Lisp reads a quoted
31329 string, all pairs of characters beginning with a backslash are
31330 interpreted as special characters. Here, @code{\n} changes to a
31331 new-line character, and @code{\\} changes to a single backslash.
31332 So the actual regular expression seen by Calc is
31333 @samp{\`\|^ @r{(newline)} \|\$\$?}.
31334
31335 Regular expressions also consider pairs beginning with backslash
31336 to have special meanings. Sometimes the backslash is used to quote
31337 a character that otherwise would have a special meaning in a regular
31338 expression, like @samp{$}, which normally means ``end-of-line,''
31339 or @samp{?}, which means that the preceding item is optional. So
31340 @samp{\$\$?} matches either one or two dollar signs.
31341
31342 The other codes in this regular expression are @samp{^}, which matches
31343 ``beginning-of-line,'' @samp{\|}, which means ``or,'' and @samp{\`},
31344 which matches ``beginning-of-buffer.'' So the whole pattern means
31345 that a formula begins at the beginning of the buffer, or on a newline
31346 that occurs at the beginning of a line (i.e., a blank line), or at
31347 one or two dollar signs.
31348
31349 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} looks just
31350 like this example, with several more alternatives added on to
31351 recognize various other common kinds of delimiters.
31352
31353 By the way, the reason to use @samp{^\n} rather than @samp{^$}
31354 or @samp{\n\n}, which also would appear to match blank lines,
31355 is that the former expression actually ``consumes'' only one
31356 newline character as @emph{part of} the delimiter, whereas the
31357 latter expressions consume zero or two newlines, respectively.
31358 The former choice gives the most natural behavior when Calc
31359 must operate on a whole formula including its delimiters.
31360
31361 See the Emacs manual for complete details on regular expressions.
31362 But just for your convenience, here is a list of all characters
31363 which must be quoted with backslash (like @samp{\$}) to avoid
31364 some special interpretation: @samp{. * + ? [ ] ^ $ \}. (Note
31365 the backslash in this list; for example, to match @samp{\[} you
31366 must use @code{"\\\\\\["}. An exercise for the reader is to
31367 account for each of these six backslashes!)
31368
31369 @vindex calc-embedded-close-formula
31370 The @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} variable holds a regular
31371 expression for the closing delimiter of a formula. A closing
31372 regular expression to match the above example would be
31373 @code{"\\'\\|\n$\\|\\$\\$?"}. This is almost the same as the
31374 other one, except it now uses @samp{\'} (``end-of-buffer'') and
31375 @samp{\n$} (newline occurring at end of line, yet another way
31376 of describing a blank line that is more appropriate for this
31377 case).
31378
31379 @vindex calc-embedded-word-regexp
31380 The @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} variable holds a regular expression
31381 used to define an expression to look for (a ``word'') when you type
31382 @kbd{C-x * w} to enable Embedded mode.
31383
31384 @vindex calc-embedded-open-plain
31385 The @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} variable is a string which
31386 begins a ``plain'' formula written in front of the formatted
31387 formula when @kbd{d p} mode is turned on. Note that this is an
31388 actual string, not a regular expression, because Calc must be able
31389 to write this string into a buffer as well as to recognize it.
31390 The default string is @code{"%%% "} (note the trailing space), but may
31391 be different for certain major modes.
31392
31393 @vindex calc-embedded-close-plain
31394 The @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} variable is a string which
31395 ends a ``plain'' formula. The default is @code{" %%%\n"}, but may be
31396 different for different major modes. Without
31397 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
31398 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
31399
31400 @vindex calc-embedded-open-new-formula
31401 The @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} variable is a string
31402 which is inserted at the front of a new formula when you type
31403 @kbd{C-x * f}. Its default value is @code{"\n\n"}. If this
31404 string begins with a newline character and the @kbd{C-x * f} is
31405 typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip this
31406 first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in
31407 the file.
31408
31409 @vindex calc-embedded-close-new-formula
31410 The @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} variable is the corresponding
31411 string which is inserted at the end of a new formula. Its default
31412 value is also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by
31413 @w{@kbd{C-x * f}} if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if
31414 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed on a blank line, both a leading opening
31415 newline and a trailing closing newline are omitted.)
31416
31417 @vindex calc-embedded-announce-formula
31418 The @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} variable is a regular
31419 expression which is sure to be followed by an embedded formula.
31420 The @kbd{C-x * a} command searches for this pattern as well as for
31421 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=} operators. Note that @kbd{C-x * a} will
31422 not activate just anything surrounded by formula delimiters; after
31423 all, blank lines are considered formula delimiters by default!
31424 But if your language includes a delimiter which can only occur
31425 actually in front of a formula, you can take advantage of it here.
31426 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, but may be
31427 different for different major modes.
31428 This pattern will check for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of
31429 lines beginning with @samp{%} and a space. This last is important to
31430 make Calc consider mode annotations part of the pattern, so that the
31431 formula's opening delimiter really is sure to follow the pattern.
31432
31433 @vindex calc-embedded-open-mode
31434 The @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} variable is a string (not a
31435 regular expression) which should precede a mode annotation.
31436 Calc never scans for this string; Calc always looks for the
31437 annotation itself. But this is the string that is inserted before
31438 the opening bracket when Calc adds an annotation on its own.
31439 The default is @code{"% "}, but may be different for different major
31440 modes.
31441
31442 @vindex calc-embedded-close-mode
31443 The @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} variable is a string which
31444 follows a mode annotation written by Calc. Its default value
31445 is simply a newline, @code{"\n"}, but may be different for different
31446 major modes. If you change this, it is a good idea still to end with a
31447 newline so that mode annotations will appear on lines by themselves.
31448
31449 @node Programming, Copying, Embedded Mode, Top
31450 @chapter Programming
31451
31452 @noindent
31453 There are several ways to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator, depending
31454 on the nature of the problem you need to solve.
31455
31456 @enumerate
31457 @item
31458 @dfn{Keyboard macros} allow you to record a sequence of keystrokes
31459 and play them back at a later time. This is just the standard Emacs
31460 keyboard macro mechanism, dressed up with a few more features such
31461 as loops and conditionals.
31462
31463 @item
31464 @dfn{Algebraic definitions} allow you to use any formula to define a
31465 new function. This function can then be used in algebraic formulas or
31466 as an interactive command.
31467
31468 @item
31469 @dfn{Rewrite rules} are discussed in the section on algebra commands.
31470 @xref{Rewrite Rules}. If you put your rewrite rules in the variable
31471 @code{EvalRules}, they will be applied automatically to all Calc
31472 results in just the same way as an internal ``rule'' is applied to
31473 evaluate @samp{sqrt(9)} to 3 and so on. @xref{Automatic Rewrites}.
31474
31475 @item
31476 @dfn{Lisp} is the programming language that Calc (and most of Emacs)
31477 is written in. If the above techniques aren't powerful enough, you
31478 can write Lisp functions to do anything that built-in Calc commands
31479 can do. Lisp code is also somewhat faster than keyboard macros or
31480 rewrite rules.
31481 @end enumerate
31482
31483 @kindex z
31484 Programming features are available through the @kbd{z} and @kbd{Z}
31485 prefix keys. New commands that you define are two-key sequences
31486 beginning with @kbd{z}. Commands for managing these definitions
31487 use the shift-@kbd{Z} prefix. (The @kbd{Z T} (@code{calc-timing})
31488 command is described elsewhere; @pxref{Troubleshooting Commands}.
31489 The @kbd{Z C} (@code{calc-user-define-composition}) command is also
31490 described elsewhere; @pxref{User-Defined Compositions}.)
31491
31492 @menu
31493 * Creating User Keys::
31494 * Keyboard Macros::
31495 * Invocation Macros::
31496 * Algebraic Definitions::
31497 * Lisp Definitions::
31498 @end menu
31499
31500 @node Creating User Keys, Keyboard Macros, Programming, Programming
31501 @section Creating User Keys
31502
31503 @noindent
31504 @kindex Z D
31505 @pindex calc-user-define
31506 Any Calculator command may be bound to a key using the @kbd{Z D}
31507 (@code{calc-user-define}) command. Actually, it is bound to a two-key
31508 sequence beginning with the lower-case @kbd{z} prefix.
31509
31510 The @kbd{Z D} command first prompts for the key to define. For example,
31511 press @kbd{Z D a} to define the new key sequence @kbd{z a}. You are then
31512 prompted for the name of the Calculator command that this key should
31513 run. For example, the @code{calc-sincos} command is not normally
31514 available on a key. Typing @kbd{Z D s sincos @key{RET}} programs the
31515 @kbd{z s} key sequence to run @code{calc-sincos}. This definition will remain
31516 in effect for the rest of this Emacs session, or until you redefine
31517 @kbd{z s} to be something else.
31518
31519 You can actually bind any Emacs command to a @kbd{z} key sequence by
31520 backspacing over the @samp{calc-} when you are prompted for the command name.
31521
31522 As with any other prefix key, you can type @kbd{z ?} to see a list of
31523 all the two-key sequences you have defined that start with @kbd{z}.
31524 Initially, no @kbd{z} sequences (except @kbd{z ?} itself) are defined.
31525
31526 User keys are typically letters, but may in fact be any key.
31527 (@key{META}-keys are not permitted, nor are a terminal's special
31528 function keys which generate multi-character sequences when pressed.)
31529 You can define different commands on the shifted and unshifted versions
31530 of a letter if you wish.
31531
31532 @kindex Z U
31533 @pindex calc-user-undefine
31534 The @kbd{Z U} (@code{calc-user-undefine}) command unbinds a user key.
31535 For example, the key sequence @kbd{Z U s} will undefine the @code{sincos}
31536 key we defined above.
31537
31538 @kindex Z P
31539 @pindex calc-user-define-permanent
31540 @cindex Storing user definitions
31541 @cindex Permanent user definitions
31542 @cindex Calc init file, user-defined commands
31543 The @kbd{Z P} (@code{calc-user-define-permanent}) command makes a key
31544 binding permanent so that it will remain in effect even in future Emacs
31545 sessions. (It does this by adding a suitable bit of Lisp code into
31546 your Calc init file; that is, the file given by the variable
31547 @code{calc-settings-file}, typically @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}.) For example,
31548 @kbd{Z P s} would register our @code{sincos} command permanently. If
31549 you later wish to unregister this command you must edit your Calc init
31550 file by hand. (@xref{General Mode Commands}, for a way to tell Calc to
31551 use a different file for the Calc init file.)
31552
31553 The @kbd{Z P} command also saves the user definition, if any, for the
31554 command bound to the key. After @kbd{Z F} and @kbd{Z C}, a given user
31555 key could invoke a command, which in turn calls an algebraic function,
31556 which might have one or more special display formats. A single @kbd{Z P}
31557 command will save all of these definitions.
31558 To save an algebraic function, type @kbd{'} (the apostrophe)
31559 when prompted for a key, and type the function name. To save a command
31560 without its key binding, type @kbd{M-x} and enter a function name. (The
31561 @samp{calc-} prefix will automatically be inserted for you.)
31562 (If the command you give implies a function, the function will be saved,
31563 and if the function has any display formats, those will be saved, but
31564 not the other way around: Saving a function will not save any commands
31565 or key bindings associated with the function.)
31566
31567 @kindex Z E
31568 @pindex calc-user-define-edit
31569 @cindex Editing user definitions
31570 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command edits the definition
31571 of a user key. This works for keys that have been defined by either
31572 keyboard macros or formulas; further details are contained in the relevant
31573 following sections.
31574
31575 @node Keyboard Macros, Invocation Macros, Creating User Keys, Programming
31576 @section Programming with Keyboard Macros
31577
31578 @noindent
31579 @kindex X
31580 @cindex Programming with keyboard macros
31581 @cindex Keyboard macros
31582 The easiest way to ``program'' the Emacs Calculator is to use standard
31583 keyboard macros. Press @w{@kbd{C-x (}} to begin recording a macro. From
31584 this point on, keystrokes you type will be saved away as well as
31585 performing their usual functions. Press @kbd{C-x )} to end recording.
31586 Press shift-@kbd{X} (or the standard Emacs key sequence @kbd{C-x e}) to
31587 execute your keyboard macro by replaying the recorded keystrokes.
31588 @xref{Keyboard Macros, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for further
31589 information.
31590
31591 When you use @kbd{X} to invoke a keyboard macro, the entire macro is
31592 treated as a single command by the undo and trail features. The stack
31593 display buffer is not updated during macro execution, but is instead
31594 fixed up once the macro completes. Thus, commands defined with keyboard
31595 macros are convenient and efficient. The @kbd{C-x e} command, on the
31596 other hand, invokes the keyboard macro with no special treatment: Each
31597 command in the macro will record its own undo information and trail entry,
31598 and update the stack buffer accordingly. If your macro uses features
31599 outside of Calc's control to operate on the contents of the Calc stack
31600 buffer, or if it includes Undo, Redo, or last-arguments commands, you
31601 must use @kbd{C-x e} to make sure the buffer and undo list are up-to-date
31602 at all times. You could also consider using @kbd{K} (@code{calc-keep-args})
31603 instead of @kbd{M-@key{RET}} (@code{calc-last-args}).
31604
31605 Calc extends the standard Emacs keyboard macros in several ways.
31606 Keyboard macros can be used to create user-defined commands. Keyboard
31607 macros can include conditional and iteration structures, somewhat
31608 analogous to those provided by a traditional programmable calculator.
31609
31610 @menu
31611 * Naming Keyboard Macros::
31612 * Conditionals in Macros::
31613 * Loops in Macros::
31614 * Local Values in Macros::
31615 * Queries in Macros::
31616 @end menu
31617
31618 @node Naming Keyboard Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31619 @subsection Naming Keyboard Macros
31620
31621 @noindent
31622 @kindex Z K
31623 @pindex calc-user-define-kbd-macro
31624 Once you have defined a keyboard macro, you can bind it to a @kbd{z}
31625 key sequence with the @kbd{Z K} (@code{calc-user-define-kbd-macro}) command.
31626 This command prompts first for a key, then for a command name. For
31627 example, if you type @kbd{C-x ( n @key{TAB} n @key{TAB} C-x )} you will
31628 define a keyboard macro which negates the top two numbers on the stack
31629 (@key{TAB} swaps the top two stack elements). Now you can type
31630 @kbd{Z K n @key{RET}} to define this keyboard macro onto the @kbd{z n} key
31631 sequence. The default command name (if you answer the second prompt with
31632 just the @key{RET} key as in this example) will be something like
31633 @samp{calc-User-n}. The keyboard macro will now be available as both
31634 @kbd{z n} and @kbd{M-x calc-User-n}. You can backspace and enter a more
31635 descriptive command name if you wish.
31636
31637 Macros defined by @kbd{Z K} act like single commands; they are executed
31638 in the same way as by the @kbd{X} key. If you wish to define the macro
31639 as a standard no-frills Emacs macro (to be executed as if by @kbd{C-x e}),
31640 give a negative prefix argument to @kbd{Z K}.
31641
31642 Once you have bound your keyboard macro to a key, you can use
31643 @kbd{Z P} to register it permanently with Emacs. @xref{Creating User Keys}.
31644
31645 @cindex Keyboard macros, editing
31646 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
31647 been defined by a keyboard macro tries to use the @code{edmacro} package
31648 edit the macro. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and update
31649 the definition stored on the key, or, to cancel the edit, kill the
31650 buffer with @kbd{C-x k}.
31651 The special characters @code{RET}, @code{LFD}, @code{TAB}, @code{SPC},
31652 @code{DEL}, and @code{NUL} must be entered as these three character
31653 sequences, written in all uppercase, as must the prefixes @code{C-} and
31654 @code{M-}. Spaces and line breaks are ignored. Other characters are
31655 copied verbatim into the keyboard macro. Basically, the notation is the
31656 same as is used in all of this manual's examples, except that the manual
31657 takes some liberties with spaces: When we say @kbd{' [1 2 3] @key{RET}},
31658 we take it for granted that it is clear we really mean
31659 @kbd{' [1 @key{SPC} 2 @key{SPC} 3] @key{RET}}.
31660
31661 @kindex C-x * m
31662 @pindex read-kbd-macro
31663 The @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) command reads an Emacs ``region''
31664 of spelled-out keystrokes and defines it as the current keyboard macro.
31665 It is a convenient way to define a keyboard macro that has been stored
31666 in a file, or to define a macro without executing it at the same time.
31667
31668 @node Conditionals in Macros, Loops in Macros, Naming Keyboard Macros, Keyboard Macros
31669 @subsection Conditionals in Keyboard Macros
31670
31671 @noindent
31672 @kindex Z [
31673 @kindex Z ]
31674 @pindex calc-kbd-if
31675 @pindex calc-kbd-else
31676 @pindex calc-kbd-else-if
31677 @pindex calc-kbd-end-if
31678 @cindex Conditional structures
31679 The @kbd{Z [} (@code{calc-kbd-if}) and @kbd{Z ]} (@code{calc-kbd-end-if})
31680 commands allow you to put simple tests in a keyboard macro. When Calc
31681 sees the @kbd{Z [}, it pops an object from the stack and, if the object is
31682 a non-zero value, continues executing keystrokes. But if the object is
31683 zero, or if it is not provably nonzero, Calc skips ahead to the matching
31684 @kbd{Z ]} keystroke. @xref{Logical Operations}, for a set of commands for
31685 performing tests which conveniently produce 1 for true and 0 for false.
31686
31687 For example, @kbd{@key{RET} 0 a < Z [ n Z ]} implements an absolute-value
31688 function in the form of a keyboard macro. This macro duplicates the
31689 number on the top of the stack, pushes zero and compares using @kbd{a <}
31690 (@code{calc-less-than}), then, if the number was less than zero,
31691 executes @kbd{n} (@code{calc-change-sign}). Otherwise, the change-sign
31692 command is skipped.
31693
31694 To program this macro, type @kbd{C-x (}, type the above sequence of
31695 keystrokes, then type @kbd{C-x )}. Note that the keystrokes will be
31696 executed while you are making the definition as well as when you later
31697 re-execute the macro by typing @kbd{X}. Thus you should make sure a
31698 suitable number is on the stack before defining the macro so that you
31699 don't get a stack-underflow error during the definition process.
31700
31701 Conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. However, there should be exactly
31702 one @kbd{Z ]} for each @kbd{Z [} in a keyboard macro.
31703
31704 @kindex Z :
31705 The @kbd{Z :} (@code{calc-kbd-else}) command allows you to choose between
31706 two keystroke sequences. The general format is @kbd{@var{cond} Z [
31707 @var{then-part} Z : @var{else-part} Z ]}. If @var{cond} is true
31708 (i.e., if the top of stack contains a non-zero number after @var{cond}
31709 has been executed), the @var{then-part} will be executed and the
31710 @var{else-part} will be skipped. Otherwise, the @var{then-part} will
31711 be skipped and the @var{else-part} will be executed.
31712
31713 @kindex Z |
31714 The @kbd{Z |} (@code{calc-kbd-else-if}) command allows you to choose
31715 between any number of alternatives. For example,
31716 @kbd{@var{cond1} Z [ @var{part1} Z : @var{cond2} Z | @var{part2} Z :
31717 @var{part3} Z ]} will execute @var{part1} if @var{cond1} is true,
31718 otherwise it will execute @var{part2} if @var{cond2} is true, otherwise
31719 it will execute @var{part3}.
31720
31721 More precisely, @kbd{Z [} pops a number and conditionally skips to the
31722 next matching @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]} key. @w{@kbd{Z ]}} has no effect when
31723 actually executed. @kbd{Z :} skips to the next matching @kbd{Z ]}.
31724 @kbd{Z |} pops a number and conditionally skips to the next matching
31725 @kbd{Z :} or @kbd{Z ]}; thus, @kbd{Z [} and @kbd{Z |} are functionally
31726 equivalent except that @kbd{Z [} participates in nesting but @kbd{Z |}
31727 does not.
31728
31729 Calc's conditional and looping constructs work by scanning the
31730 keyboard macro for occurrences of character sequences like @samp{Z:}
31731 and @samp{Z]}. One side-effect of this is that if you use these
31732 constructs you must be careful that these character pairs do not
31733 occur by accident in other parts of the macros. Since Calc rarely
31734 uses shift-@kbd{Z} for any purpose except as a prefix character, this
31735 is not likely to be a problem. Another side-effect is that it will
31736 not work to define your own custom key bindings for these commands.
31737 Only the standard shift-@kbd{Z} bindings will work correctly.
31738
31739 @kindex Z C-g
31740 If Calc gets stuck while skipping characters during the definition of a
31741 macro, type @kbd{Z C-g} to cancel the definition. (Typing plain @kbd{C-g}
31742 actually adds a @kbd{C-g} keystroke to the macro.)
31743
31744 @node Loops in Macros, Local Values in Macros, Conditionals in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31745 @subsection Loops in Keyboard Macros
31746
31747 @noindent
31748 @kindex Z <
31749 @kindex Z >
31750 @pindex calc-kbd-repeat
31751 @pindex calc-kbd-end-repeat
31752 @cindex Looping structures
31753 @cindex Iterative structures
31754 The @kbd{Z <} (@code{calc-kbd-repeat}) and @kbd{Z >}
31755 (@code{calc-kbd-end-repeat}) commands pop a number from the stack,
31756 which must be an integer, then repeat the keystrokes between the brackets
31757 the specified number of times. If the integer is zero or negative, the
31758 body is skipped altogether. For example, @kbd{1 @key{TAB} Z < 2 * Z >}
31759 computes two to a nonnegative integer power. First, we push 1 on the
31760 stack and then swap the integer argument back to the top. The @kbd{Z <}
31761 pops that argument leaving the 1 back on top of the stack. Then, we
31762 repeat a multiply-by-two step however many times.
31763
31764 Once again, the keyboard macro is executed as it is being entered.
31765 In this case it is especially important to set up reasonable initial
31766 conditions before making the definition: Suppose the integer 1000 just
31767 happened to be sitting on the stack before we typed the above definition!
31768 Another approach is to enter a harmless dummy definition for the macro,
31769 then go back and edit in the real one with a @kbd{Z E} command. Yet
31770 another approach is to type the macro as written-out keystroke names
31771 in a buffer, then use @kbd{C-x * m} (@code{read-kbd-macro}) to read the
31772 macro.
31773
31774 @kindex Z /
31775 @pindex calc-break
31776 The @kbd{Z /} (@code{calc-kbd-break}) command allows you to break out
31777 of a keyboard macro loop prematurely. It pops an object from the stack;
31778 if that object is true (a non-zero number), control jumps out of the
31779 innermost enclosing @kbd{Z <} @dots{} @kbd{Z >} loop and continues
31780 after the @kbd{Z >}. If the object is false, the @kbd{Z /} has no
31781 effect. Thus @kbd{@var{cond} Z /} is similar to @samp{if (@var{cond}) break;}
31782 in the C language.
31783
31784 @kindex Z (
31785 @kindex Z )
31786 @pindex calc-kbd-for
31787 @pindex calc-kbd-end-for
31788 The @kbd{Z (} (@code{calc-kbd-for}) and @kbd{Z )} (@code{calc-kbd-end-for})
31789 commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and @kbd{Z >}, except that they make the
31790 value of the counter available inside the loop. The general layout is
31791 @kbd{@var{init} @var{final} Z ( @var{body} @var{step} Z )}. The @kbd{Z (}
31792 command pops initial and final values from the stack. It then creates
31793 a temporary internal counter and initializes it with the value @var{init}.
31794 The @kbd{Z (} command then repeatedly pushes the counter value onto the
31795 stack and executes @var{body} and @var{step}, adding @var{step} to the
31796 counter each time until the loop finishes.
31797
31798 @cindex Summations (by keyboard macros)
31799 By default, the loop finishes when the counter becomes greater than (or
31800 less than) @var{final}, assuming @var{initial} is less than (greater
31801 than) @var{final}. If @var{initial} is equal to @var{final}, the body
31802 executes exactly once. The body of the loop always executes at least
31803 once. For example, @kbd{0 1 10 Z ( 2 ^ + 1 Z )} computes the sum of the
31804 squares of the integers from 1 to 10, in steps of 1.
31805
31806 If you give a numeric prefix argument of 1 to @kbd{Z (}, the loop is
31807 forced to use upward-counting conventions. In this case, if @var{initial}
31808 is greater than @var{final} the body will not be executed at all.
31809 Note that @var{step} may still be negative in this loop; the prefix
31810 argument merely constrains the loop-finished test. Likewise, a prefix
31811 argument of @mathit{-1} forces downward-counting conventions.
31812
31813 @kindex Z @{
31814 @kindex Z @}
31815 @pindex calc-kbd-loop
31816 @pindex calc-kbd-end-loop
31817 The @kbd{Z @{} (@code{calc-kbd-loop}) and @kbd{Z @}}
31818 (@code{calc-kbd-end-loop}) commands are similar to @kbd{Z <} and
31819 @kbd{Z >}, except that they do not pop a count from the stack---they
31820 effectively create an infinite loop. Every @kbd{Z @{} @dots{} @kbd{Z @}}
31821 loop ought to include at least one @kbd{Z /} to make sure the loop
31822 doesn't run forever. (If any error message occurs which causes Emacs
31823 to beep, the keyboard macro will also be halted; this is a standard
31824 feature of Emacs. You can also generally press @kbd{C-g} to halt a
31825 running keyboard macro, although not all versions of Unix support
31826 this feature.)
31827
31828 The conditional and looping constructs are not actually tied to
31829 keyboard macros, but they are most often used in that context.
31830 For example, the keystrokes @kbd{10 Z < 23 @key{RET} Z >} push
31831 ten copies of 23 onto the stack. This can be typed ``live'' just
31832 as easily as in a macro definition.
31833
31834 @xref{Conditionals in Macros}, for some additional notes about
31835 conditional and looping commands.
31836
31837 @node Local Values in Macros, Queries in Macros, Loops in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31838 @subsection Local Values in Macros
31839
31840 @noindent
31841 @cindex Local variables
31842 @cindex Restoring saved modes
31843 Keyboard macros sometimes want to operate under known conditions
31844 without affecting surrounding conditions. For example, a keyboard
31845 macro may wish to turn on Fraction mode, or set a particular
31846 precision, independent of the user's normal setting for those
31847 modes.
31848
31849 @kindex Z `
31850 @kindex Z '
31851 @pindex calc-kbd-push
31852 @pindex calc-kbd-pop
31853 Macros also sometimes need to use local variables. Assignments to
31854 local variables inside the macro should not affect any variables
31855 outside the macro. The @kbd{Z `} (@code{calc-kbd-push}) and @kbd{Z '}
31856 (@code{calc-kbd-pop}) commands give you both of these capabilities.
31857
31858 When you type @kbd{Z `} (with a backquote or accent grave character),
31859 the values of various mode settings are saved away. The ten ``quick''
31860 variables @code{q0} through @code{q9} are also saved. When
31861 you type @w{@kbd{Z '}} (with an apostrophe), these values are restored.
31862 Pairs of @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} commands may be nested.
31863
31864 If a keyboard macro halts due to an error in between a @kbd{Z `} and
31865 a @kbd{Z '}, the saved values will be restored correctly even though
31866 the macro never reaches the @kbd{Z '} command. Thus you can use
31867 @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} without having to worry about what happens
31868 in exceptional conditions.
31869
31870 If you type @kbd{Z `} ``live'' (not in a keyboard macro), Calc puts
31871 you into a ``recursive edit.'' You can tell you are in a recursive
31872 edit because there will be extra square brackets in the mode line,
31873 as in @samp{[(Calculator)]}. These brackets will go away when you
31874 type the matching @kbd{Z '} command. The modes and quick variables
31875 will be saved and restored in just the same way as if actual keyboard
31876 macros were involved.
31877
31878 The modes saved by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '} are the current precision
31879 and binary word size, the angular mode (Deg, Rad, or HMS), the
31880 simplification mode, Algebraic mode, Symbolic mode, Infinite mode,
31881 Matrix or Scalar mode, Fraction mode, and the current complex mode
31882 (Polar or Rectangular). The ten ``quick'' variables' values (or lack
31883 thereof) are also saved.
31884
31885 Most mode-setting commands act as toggles, but with a numeric prefix
31886 they force the mode either on (positive prefix) or off (negative
31887 or zero prefix). Since you don't know what the environment might
31888 be when you invoke your macro, it's best to use prefix arguments
31889 for all mode-setting commands inside the macro.
31890
31891 In fact, @kbd{C-u Z `} is like @kbd{Z `} except that it sets the modes
31892 listed above to their default values. As usual, the matching @kbd{Z '}
31893 will restore the modes to their settings from before the @kbd{C-u Z `}.
31894 Also, @w{@kbd{Z `}} with a negative prefix argument resets the algebraic mode
31895 to its default (off) but leaves the other modes the same as they were
31896 outside the construct.
31897
31898 The contents of the stack and trail, values of non-quick variables, and
31899 other settings such as the language mode and the various display modes,
31900 are @emph{not} affected by @kbd{Z `} and @kbd{Z '}.
31901
31902 @node Queries in Macros, , Local Values in Macros, Keyboard Macros
31903 @subsection Queries in Keyboard Macros
31904
31905 @c @noindent
31906 @c @kindex Z =
31907 @c @pindex calc-kbd-report
31908 @c The @kbd{Z =} (@code{calc-kbd-report}) command displays an informative
31909 @c message including the value on the top of the stack. You are prompted
31910 @c to enter a string. That string, along with the top-of-stack value,
31911 @c is displayed unless @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) has been used
31912 @c to turn such messages off.
31913
31914 @noindent
31915 @kindex Z #
31916 @pindex calc-kbd-query
31917 The @kbd{Z #} (@code{calc-kbd-query}) command prompts for an algebraic
31918 entry which takes its input from the keyboard, even during macro
31919 execution. All the normal conventions of algebraic input, including the
31920 use of @kbd{$} characters, are supported. The prompt message itself is
31921 taken from the top of the stack, and so must be entered (as a string)
31922 before the @kbd{Z #} command. (Recall, as a string it can be entered by
31923 pressing the @kbd{"} key and will appear as a vector when it is put on
31924 the stack. The prompt message is only put on the stack to provide a
31925 prompt for the @kbd{Z #} command; it will not play any role in any
31926 subsequent calculations.) This command allows your keyboard macros to
31927 accept numbers or formulas as interactive input.
31928
31929 As an example,
31930 @kbd{2 @key{RET} "Power: " @key{RET} Z # 3 @key{RET} ^} will prompt for
31931 input with ``Power: '' in the minibuffer, then return 2 to the provided
31932 power. (The response to the prompt that's given, 3 in this example,
31933 will not be part of the macro.)
31934
31935 @xref{Keyboard Macro Query, , , emacs, the Emacs Manual}, for a description of
31936 @kbd{C-x q} (@code{kbd-macro-query}), the standard Emacs way to accept
31937 keyboard input during a keyboard macro. In particular, you can use
31938 @kbd{C-x q} to enter a recursive edit, which allows the user to perform
31939 any Calculator operations interactively before pressing @kbd{C-M-c} to
31940 return control to the keyboard macro.
31941
31942 @node Invocation Macros, Algebraic Definitions, Keyboard Macros, Programming
31943 @section Invocation Macros
31944
31945 @kindex C-x * z
31946 @kindex Z I
31947 @pindex calc-user-invocation
31948 @pindex calc-user-define-invocation
31949 Calc provides one special keyboard macro, called up by @kbd{C-x * z}
31950 (@code{calc-user-invocation}), that is intended to allow you to define
31951 your own special way of starting Calc. To define this ``invocation
31952 macro,'' create the macro in the usual way with @kbd{C-x (} and
31953 @kbd{C-x )}, then type @kbd{Z I} (@code{calc-user-define-invocation}).
31954 There is only one invocation macro, so you don't need to type any
31955 additional letters after @kbd{Z I}. From now on, you can type
31956 @kbd{C-x * z} at any time to execute your invocation macro.
31957
31958 For example, suppose you find yourself often grabbing rectangles of
31959 numbers into Calc and multiplying their columns. You can do this
31960 by typing @kbd{C-x * r} to grab, and @kbd{V R : *} to multiply columns.
31961 To make this into an invocation macro, just type @kbd{C-x ( C-x * r
31962 V R : * C-x )}, then @kbd{Z I}. Then, to multiply a rectangle of data,
31963 just mark the data in its buffer in the usual way and type @kbd{C-x * z}.
31964
31965 Invocation macros are treated like regular Emacs keyboard macros;
31966 all the special features described above for @kbd{Z K}-style macros
31967 do not apply. @kbd{C-x * z} is just like @kbd{C-x e}, except that it
31968 uses the macro that was last stored by @kbd{Z I}. (In fact, the
31969 macro does not even have to have anything to do with Calc!)
31970
31971 The @kbd{m m} command saves the last invocation macro defined by
31972 @kbd{Z I} along with all the other Calc mode settings.
31973 @xref{General Mode Commands}.
31974
31975 @node Algebraic Definitions, Lisp Definitions, Invocation Macros, Programming
31976 @section Programming with Formulas
31977
31978 @noindent
31979 @kindex Z F
31980 @pindex calc-user-define-formula
31981 @cindex Programming with algebraic formulas
31982 Another way to create a new Calculator command uses algebraic formulas.
31983 The @kbd{Z F} (@code{calc-user-define-formula}) command stores the
31984 formula at the top of the stack as the definition for a key. This
31985 command prompts for five things: The key, the command name, the function
31986 name, the argument list, and the behavior of the command when given
31987 non-numeric arguments.
31988
31989 For example, suppose we type @kbd{' a+2b @key{RET}} to push the formula
31990 @samp{a + 2*b} onto the stack. We now type @kbd{Z F m} to define this
31991 formula on the @kbd{z m} key sequence. The next prompt is for a command
31992 name, beginning with @samp{calc-}, which should be the long (@kbd{M-x}) form
31993 for the new command. If you simply press @key{RET}, a default name like
31994 @code{calc-User-m} will be constructed. In our example, suppose we enter
31995 @kbd{spam @key{RET}} to define the new command as @code{calc-spam}.
31996
31997 If you want to give the formula a long-style name only, you can press
31998 @key{SPC} or @key{RET} when asked which single key to use. For example
31999 @kbd{Z F @key{RET} spam @key{RET}} defines the new command as
32000 @kbd{M-x calc-spam}, with no keyboard equivalent.
32001
32002 The third prompt is for an algebraic function name. The default is to
32003 use the same name as the command name but without the @samp{calc-}
32004 prefix. (If this is of the form @samp{User-m}, the hyphen is removed so
32005 it won't be taken for a minus sign in algebraic formulas.)
32006 This is the name you will use if you want to enter your
32007 new function in an algebraic formula. Suppose we enter @kbd{yow @key{RET}}.
32008 Then the new function can be invoked by pushing two numbers on the
32009 stack and typing @kbd{z m} or @kbd{x spam}, or by entering the algebraic
32010 formula @samp{yow(x,y)}.
32011
32012 The fourth prompt is for the function's argument list. This is used to
32013 associate values on the stack with the variables that appear in the formula.
32014 The default is a list of all variables which appear in the formula, sorted
32015 into alphabetical order. In our case, the default would be @samp{(a b)}.
32016 This means that, when the user types @kbd{z m}, the Calculator will remove
32017 two numbers from the stack, substitute these numbers for @samp{a} and
32018 @samp{b} (respectively) in the formula, then simplify the formula and
32019 push the result on the stack. In other words, @kbd{10 @key{RET} 100 z m}
32020 would replace the 10 and 100 on the stack with the number 210, which is
32021 @expr{a + 2 b} with @expr{a=10} and @expr{b=100}. Likewise, the formula
32022 @samp{yow(10, 100)} will be evaluated by substituting @expr{a=10} and
32023 @expr{b=100} in the definition.
32024
32025 You can rearrange the order of the names before pressing @key{RET} to
32026 control which stack positions go to which variables in the formula. If
32027 you remove a variable from the argument list, that variable will be left
32028 in symbolic form by the command. Thus using an argument list of @samp{(b)}
32029 for our function would cause @kbd{10 z m} to replace the 10 on the stack
32030 with the formula @samp{a + 20}. If we had used an argument list of
32031 @samp{(b a)}, the result with inputs 10 and 100 would have been 120.
32032
32033 You can also put a nameless function on the stack instead of just a
32034 formula, as in @samp{<a, b : a + 2 b>}. @xref{Specifying Operators}.
32035 In this example, the command will be defined by the formula @samp{a + 2 b}
32036 using the argument list @samp{(a b)}.
32037
32038 The final prompt is a y-or-n question concerning what to do if symbolic
32039 arguments are given to your function. If you answer @kbd{y}, then
32040 executing @kbd{z m} (using the original argument list @samp{(a b)}) with
32041 arguments @expr{10} and @expr{x} will leave the function in symbolic
32042 form, i.e., @samp{yow(10,x)}. On the other hand, if you answer @kbd{n},
32043 then the formula will always be expanded, even for non-constant
32044 arguments: @samp{10 + 2 x}. If you never plan to feed algebraic
32045 formulas to your new function, it doesn't matter how you answer this
32046 question.
32047
32048 If you answered @kbd{y} to this question you can still cause a function
32049 call to be expanded by typing @kbd{a "} (@code{calc-expand-formula}).
32050 Also, Calc will expand the function if necessary when you take a
32051 derivative or integral or solve an equation involving the function.
32052
32053 @kindex Z G
32054 @pindex calc-get-user-defn
32055 Once you have defined a formula on a key, you can retrieve this formula
32056 with the @kbd{Z G} (@code{calc-user-define-get-defn}) command. Press a
32057 key, and this command pushes the formula that was used to define that
32058 key onto the stack. Actually, it pushes a nameless function that
32059 specifies both the argument list and the defining formula. You will get
32060 an error message if the key is undefined, or if the key was not defined
32061 by a @kbd{Z F} command.
32062
32063 The @kbd{Z E} (@code{calc-user-define-edit}) command on a key that has
32064 been defined by a formula uses a variant of the @code{calc-edit} command
32065 to edit the defining formula. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} to finish editing and
32066 store the new formula back in the definition, or kill the buffer with
32067 @kbd{C-x k} to
32068 cancel the edit. (The argument list and other properties of the
32069 definition are unchanged; to adjust the argument list, you can use
32070 @kbd{Z G} to grab the function onto the stack, edit with @kbd{`}, and
32071 then re-execute the @kbd{Z F} command.)
32072
32073 As usual, the @kbd{Z P} command records your definition permanently.
32074 In this case it will permanently record all three of the relevant
32075 definitions: the key, the command, and the function.
32076
32077 You may find it useful to turn off the default simplifications with
32078 @kbd{m O} (@code{calc-no-simplify-mode}) when entering a formula to be
32079 used as a function definition. For example, the formula @samp{deriv(a^2,v)}
32080 which might be used to define a new function @samp{dsqr(a,v)} will be
32081 ``simplified'' to 0 immediately upon entry since @code{deriv} considers
32082 @expr{a} to be constant with respect to @expr{v}. Turning off
32083 default simplifications cures this problem: The definition will be stored
32084 in symbolic form without ever activating the @code{deriv} function. Press
32085 @kbd{m D} to turn the default simplifications back on afterwards.
32086
32087 @node Lisp Definitions, , Algebraic Definitions, Programming
32088 @section Programming with Lisp
32089
32090 @noindent
32091 The Calculator can be programmed quite extensively in Lisp. All you
32092 do is write a normal Lisp function definition, but with @code{defmath}
32093 in place of @code{defun}. This has the same form as @code{defun}, but it
32094 automagically replaces calls to standard Lisp functions like @code{+} and
32095 @code{zerop} with calls to the corresponding functions in Calc's own library.
32096 Thus you can write natural-looking Lisp code which operates on all of the
32097 standard Calculator data types. You can then use @kbd{Z D} if you wish to
32098 bind your new command to a @kbd{z}-prefix key sequence. The @kbd{Z E} command
32099 will not edit a Lisp-based definition.
32100
32101 Emacs Lisp is described in the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. This section
32102 assumes a familiarity with Lisp programming concepts; if you do not know
32103 Lisp, you may find keyboard macros or rewrite rules to be an easier way
32104 to program the Calculator.
32105
32106 This section first discusses ways to write commands, functions, or
32107 small programs to be executed inside of Calc. Then it discusses how
32108 your own separate programs are able to call Calc from the outside.
32109 Finally, there is a list of internal Calc functions and data structures
32110 for the true Lisp enthusiast.
32111
32112 @menu
32113 * Defining Functions::
32114 * Defining Simple Commands::
32115 * Defining Stack Commands::
32116 * Argument Qualifiers::
32117 * Example Definitions::
32118
32119 * Calling Calc from Your Programs::
32120 * Internals::
32121 @end menu
32122
32123 @node Defining Functions, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32124 @subsection Defining New Functions
32125
32126 @noindent
32127 @findex defmath
32128 The @code{defmath} function (actually a Lisp macro) is like @code{defun}
32129 except that code in the body of the definition can make use of the full
32130 range of Calculator data types. The prefix @samp{calcFunc-} is added
32131 to the specified name to get the actual Lisp function name. As a simple
32132 example,
32133
32134 @example
32135 (defmath myfact (n)
32136 (if (> n 0)
32137 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32138 1))
32139 @end example
32140
32141 @noindent
32142 This actually expands to the code,
32143
32144 @example
32145 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
32146 (if (math-posp n)
32147 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
32148 1))
32149 @end example
32150
32151 @noindent
32152 This function can be used in algebraic expressions, e.g., @samp{myfact(5)}.
32153
32154 The @samp{myfact} function as it is defined above has the bug that an
32155 expression @samp{myfact(a+b)} will be simplified to 1 because the
32156 formula @samp{a+b} is not considered to be @code{posp}. A robust
32157 factorial function would be written along the following lines:
32158
32159 @smallexample
32160 (defmath myfact (n)
32161 (if (> n 0)
32162 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32163 (if (= n 0)
32164 1
32165 nil))) ; this could be simplified as: (and (= n 0) 1)
32166 @end smallexample
32167
32168 If a function returns @code{nil}, it is left unsimplified by the Calculator
32169 (except that its arguments will be simplified). Thus, @samp{myfact(a+1+2)}
32170 will be simplified to @samp{myfact(a+3)} but no further. Beware that every
32171 time the Calculator reexamines this formula it will attempt to resimplify
32172 it, so your function ought to detect the returning-@code{nil} case as
32173 efficiently as possible.
32174
32175 The following standard Lisp functions are treated by @code{defmath}:
32176 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^} or
32177 @code{expt}, @code{=}, @code{<}, @code{>}, @code{<=}, @code{>=},
32178 @code{/=}, @code{1+}, @code{1-}, @code{logand}, @code{logior}, @code{logxor},
32179 @code{logandc2}, @code{lognot}. Also, @code{~=} is an abbreviation for
32180 @code{math-nearly-equal}, which is useful in implementing Taylor series.
32181
32182 For other functions @var{func}, if a function by the name
32183 @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if a function by the
32184 name @samp{math-@var{func}} exists it is used, otherwise if @var{func} itself
32185 is defined as a function it is used, otherwise @samp{calcFunc-@var{func}} is
32186 used on the assumption that this is a to-be-defined math function. Also, if
32187 the function name is quoted as in @samp{('integerp a)} the function name is
32188 always used exactly as written (but not quoted).
32189
32190 Variable names have @samp{var-} prepended to them unless they appear in
32191 the function's argument list or in an enclosing @code{let}, @code{let*},
32192 @code{for}, or @code{foreach} form,
32193 or their names already contain a @samp{-} character. Thus a reference to
32194 @samp{foo} is the same as a reference to @samp{var-foo}.
32195
32196 A few other Lisp extensions are available in @code{defmath} definitions:
32197
32198 @itemize @bullet
32199 @item
32200 The @code{elt} function accepts any number of index variables.
32201 Note that Calc vectors are stored as Lisp lists whose first
32202 element is the symbol @code{vec}; thus, @samp{(elt v 2)} yields
32203 the second element of vector @code{v}, and @samp{(elt m i j)}
32204 yields one element of a Calc matrix.
32205
32206 @item
32207 The @code{setq} function has been extended to act like the Common
32208 Lisp @code{setf} function. (The name @code{setf} is recognized as
32209 a synonym of @code{setq}.) Specifically, the first argument of
32210 @code{setq} can be an @code{nth}, @code{elt}, @code{car}, or @code{cdr} form,
32211 in which case the effect is to store into the specified
32212 element of a list. Thus, @samp{(setq (elt m i j) x)} stores @expr{x}
32213 into one element of a matrix.
32214
32215 @item
32216 A @code{for} looping construct is available. For example,
32217 @samp{(for ((i 0 10)) body)} executes @code{body} once for each
32218 binding of @expr{i} from zero to 10. This is like a @code{let}
32219 form in that @expr{i} is temporarily bound to the loop count
32220 without disturbing its value outside the @code{for} construct.
32221 Nested loops, as in @samp{(for ((i 0 10) (j 0 (1- i) 2)) body)},
32222 are also available. For each value of @expr{i} from zero to 10,
32223 @expr{j} counts from 0 to @expr{i-1} in steps of two. Note that
32224 @code{for} has the same general outline as @code{let*}, except
32225 that each element of the header is a list of three or four
32226 things, not just two.
32227
32228 @item
32229 The @code{foreach} construct loops over elements of a list.
32230 For example, @samp{(foreach ((x (cdr v))) body)} executes
32231 @code{body} with @expr{x} bound to each element of Calc vector
32232 @expr{v} in turn. The purpose of @code{cdr} here is to skip over
32233 the initial @code{vec} symbol in the vector.
32234
32235 @item
32236 The @code{break} function breaks out of the innermost enclosing
32237 @code{while}, @code{for}, or @code{foreach} loop. If given a
32238 value, as in @samp{(break x)}, this value is returned by the
32239 loop. (Lisp loops otherwise always return @code{nil}.)
32240
32241 @item
32242 The @code{return} function prematurely returns from the enclosing
32243 function. For example, @samp{(return (+ x y))} returns @expr{x+y}
32244 as the value of a function. You can use @code{return} anywhere
32245 inside the body of the function.
32246 @end itemize
32247
32248 Non-integer numbers (and extremely large integers) cannot be included
32249 directly into a @code{defmath} definition. This is because the Lisp
32250 reader will fail to parse them long before @code{defmath} ever gets control.
32251 Instead, use the notation, @samp{:"3.1415"}. In fact, any algebraic
32252 formula can go between the quotes. For example,
32253
32254 @smallexample
32255 (defmath sqexp (x) ; sqexp(x) == sqrt(exp(x)) == exp(x*0.5)
32256 (and (numberp x)
32257 (exp :"x * 0.5")))
32258 @end smallexample
32259
32260 expands to
32261
32262 @smallexample
32263 (defun calcFunc-sqexp (x)
32264 (and (math-numberp x)
32265 (calcFunc-exp (math-mul x '(float 5 -1)))))
32266 @end smallexample
32267
32268 Note the use of @code{numberp} as a guard to ensure that the argument is
32269 a number first, returning @code{nil} if not. The exponential function
32270 could itself have been included in the expression, if we had preferred:
32271 @samp{:"exp(x * 0.5)"}. As another example, the multiplication-and-recursion
32272 step of @code{myfact} could have been written
32273
32274 @example
32275 :"n * myfact(n-1)"
32276 @end example
32277
32278 A good place to put your @code{defmath} commands is your Calc init file
32279 (the file given by @code{calc-settings-file}, typically
32280 @file{~/.emacs.d/calc.el}), which will not be loaded until Calc starts.
32281 If a file named @file{.emacs} exists in your home directory, Emacs reads
32282 and executes the Lisp forms in this file as it starts up. While it may
32283 seem reasonable to put your favorite @code{defmath} commands there,
32284 this has the unfortunate side-effect that parts of the Calculator must be
32285 loaded in to process the @code{defmath} commands whether or not you will
32286 actually use the Calculator! If you want to put the @code{defmath}
32287 commands there (for example, if you redefine @code{calc-settings-file}
32288 to be @file{.emacs}), a better effect can be had by writing
32289
32290 @example
32291 (put 'calc-define 'thing '(progn
32292 (defmath ... )
32293 (defmath ... )
32294 ))
32295 @end example
32296
32297 @noindent
32298 @vindex calc-define
32299 The @code{put} function adds a @dfn{property} to a symbol. Each Lisp
32300 symbol has a list of properties associated with it. Here we add a
32301 property with a name of @code{thing} and a @samp{(progn ...)} form as
32302 its value. When Calc starts up, and at the start of every Calc command,
32303 the property list for the symbol @code{calc-define} is checked and the
32304 values of any properties found are evaluated as Lisp forms. The
32305 properties are removed as they are evaluated. The property names
32306 (like @code{thing}) are not used; you should choose something like the
32307 name of your project so as not to conflict with other properties.
32308
32309 The net effect is that you can put the above code in your @file{.emacs}
32310 file and it will not be executed until Calc is loaded. Or, you can put
32311 that same code in another file which you load by hand either before or
32312 after Calc itself is loaded.
32313
32314 The properties of @code{calc-define} are evaluated in the same order
32315 that they were added. They can assume that the Calc modules @file{calc.el},
32316 @file{calc-ext.el}, and @file{calc-macs.el} have been fully loaded, and
32317 that the @file{*Calculator*} buffer will be the current buffer.
32318
32319 If your @code{calc-define} property only defines algebraic functions,
32320 you can be sure that it will have been evaluated before Calc tries to
32321 call your function, even if the file defining the property is loaded
32322 after Calc is loaded. But if the property defines commands or key
32323 sequences, it may not be evaluated soon enough. (Suppose it defines the
32324 new command @code{tweak-calc}; the user can load your file, then type
32325 @kbd{M-x tweak-calc} before Calc has had chance to do anything.) To
32326 protect against this situation, you can put
32327
32328 @example
32329 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32330 @end example
32331
32332 @findex calc-check-defines
32333 @noindent
32334 at the end of your file. The @code{calc-check-defines} function is what
32335 looks for and evaluates properties on @code{calc-define}; @code{run-hooks}
32336 has the advantage that it is quietly ignored if @code{calc-check-defines}
32337 is not yet defined because Calc has not yet been loaded.
32338
32339 Examples of things that ought to be enclosed in a @code{calc-define}
32340 property are @code{defmath} calls, @code{define-key} calls that modify
32341 the Calc key map, and any calls that redefine things defined inside Calc.
32342 Ordinary @code{defun}s need not be enclosed with @code{calc-define}.
32343
32344 @node Defining Simple Commands, Defining Stack Commands, Defining Functions, Lisp Definitions
32345 @subsection Defining New Simple Commands
32346
32347 @noindent
32348 @findex interactive
32349 If a @code{defmath} form contains an @code{interactive} clause, it defines
32350 a Calculator command. Actually such a @code{defmath} results in @emph{two}
32351 function definitions: One, a @samp{calcFunc-} function as was just described,
32352 with the @code{interactive} clause removed. Two, a @samp{calc-} function
32353 with a suitable @code{interactive} clause and some sort of wrapper to make
32354 the command work in the Calc environment.
32355
32356 In the simple case, the @code{interactive} clause has the same form as
32357 for normal Emacs Lisp commands:
32358
32359 @smallexample
32360 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
32361 "Increase precision by DELTA." ; This is the "documentation string"
32362 (interactive "p") ; Register this as a M-x-able command
32363 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32364 @end smallexample
32365
32366 This expands to the pair of definitions,
32367
32368 @smallexample
32369 (defun calc-increase-precision (delta)
32370 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32371 (interactive "p")
32372 (calc-wrapper
32373 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta))))
32374
32375 (defun calcFunc-increase-precision (delta)
32376 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32377 (setq calc-internal-prec (math-add calc-internal-prec delta)))
32378 @end smallexample
32379
32380 @noindent
32381 where in this case the latter function would never really be used! Note
32382 that since the Calculator stores small integers as plain Lisp integers,
32383 the @code{math-add} function will work just as well as the native
32384 @code{+} even when the intent is to operate on native Lisp integers.
32385
32386 @findex calc-wrapper
32387 The @samp{calc-wrapper} call invokes a macro which surrounds the body of
32388 the function with code that looks roughly like this:
32389
32390 @smallexample
32391 (let ((calc-command-flags nil))
32392 (unwind-protect
32393 (save-current-buffer
32394 (calc-select-buffer)
32395 @emph{body of function}
32396 @emph{renumber stack}
32397 @emph{clear} Working @emph{message})
32398 @emph{realign cursor and window}
32399 @emph{clear Inverse, Hyperbolic, and Keep Args flags}
32400 @emph{update Emacs mode line}))
32401 @end smallexample
32402
32403 @findex calc-select-buffer
32404 The @code{calc-select-buffer} function selects the @file{*Calculator*}
32405 buffer if necessary, say, because the command was invoked from inside
32406 the @file{*Calc Trail*} window.
32407
32408 @findex calc-set-command-flag
32409 You can call, for example, @code{(calc-set-command-flag 'no-align)} to
32410 set the above-mentioned command flags. Calc routines recognize the
32411 following command flags:
32412
32413 @table @code
32414 @item renum-stack
32415 Stack line numbers @samp{1:}, @samp{2:}, and so on must be renumbered
32416 after this command completes. This is set by routines like
32417 @code{calc-push}.
32418
32419 @item clear-message
32420 Calc should call @samp{(message "")} if this command completes normally
32421 (to clear a ``Working@dots{}'' message out of the echo area).
32422
32423 @item no-align
32424 Do not move the cursor back to the @samp{.} top-of-stack marker.
32425
32426 @item position-point
32427 Use the variables @code{calc-position-point-line} and
32428 @code{calc-position-point-column} to position the cursor after
32429 this command finishes.
32430
32431 @item keep-flags
32432 Do not clear @code{calc-inverse-flag}, @code{calc-hyperbolic-flag},
32433 and @code{calc-keep-args-flag} at the end of this command.
32434
32435 @item do-edit
32436 Switch to buffer @file{*Calc Edit*} after this command.
32437
32438 @item hold-trail
32439 Do not move trail pointer to end of trail when something is recorded
32440 there.
32441 @end table
32442
32443 @kindex Y
32444 @kindex Y ?
32445 @vindex calc-Y-help-msgs
32446 Calc reserves a special prefix key, shift-@kbd{Y}, for user-written
32447 extensions to Calc. There are no built-in commands that work with
32448 this prefix key; you must call @code{define-key} from Lisp (probably
32449 from inside a @code{calc-define} property) to add to it. Initially only
32450 @kbd{Y ?} is defined; it takes help messages from a list of strings
32451 (initially @code{nil}) in the variable @code{calc-Y-help-msgs}. All
32452 other undefined keys except for @kbd{Y} are reserved for use by
32453 future versions of Calc.
32454
32455 If you are writing a Calc enhancement which you expect to give to
32456 others, it is best to minimize the number of @kbd{Y}-key sequences
32457 you use. In fact, if you have more than one key sequence you should
32458 consider defining three-key sequences with a @kbd{Y}, then a key that
32459 stands for your package, then a third key for the particular command
32460 within your package.
32461
32462 Users may wish to install several Calc enhancements, and it is possible
32463 that several enhancements will choose to use the same key. In the
32464 example below, a variable @code{inc-prec-base-key} has been defined
32465 to contain the key that identifies the @code{inc-prec} package. Its
32466 value is initially @code{"P"}, but a user can change this variable
32467 if necessary without having to modify the file.
32468
32469 Here is a complete file, @file{inc-prec.el}, which makes a @kbd{Y P I}
32470 command that increases the precision, and a @kbd{Y P D} command that
32471 decreases the precision.
32472
32473 @smallexample
32474 ;;; Increase and decrease Calc precision. Dave Gillespie, 5/31/91.
32475 ;; (Include copyright or copyleft stuff here.)
32476
32477 (defvar inc-prec-base-key "P"
32478 "Base key for inc-prec.el commands.")
32479
32480 (put 'calc-define 'inc-prec '(progn
32481
32482 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sI" inc-prec-base-key)
32483 'increase-precision)
32484 (define-key calc-mode-map (format "Y%sD" inc-prec-base-key)
32485 'decrease-precision)
32486
32487 (setq calc-Y-help-msgs
32488 (cons (format "%s + Inc-prec, Dec-prec" inc-prec-base-key)
32489 calc-Y-help-msgs))
32490
32491 (defmath increase-precision (delta)
32492 "Increase precision by DELTA."
32493 (interactive "p")
32494 (setq calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec delta)))
32495
32496 (defmath decrease-precision (delta)
32497 "Decrease precision by DELTA."
32498 (interactive "p")
32499 (setq calc-internal-prec (- calc-internal-prec delta)))
32500
32501 )) ; end of calc-define property
32502
32503 (run-hooks 'calc-check-defines)
32504 @end smallexample
32505
32506 @node Defining Stack Commands, Argument Qualifiers, Defining Simple Commands, Lisp Definitions
32507 @subsection Defining New Stack-Based Commands
32508
32509 @noindent
32510 To define a new computational command which takes and/or leaves arguments
32511 on the stack, a special form of @code{interactive} clause is used.
32512
32513 @example
32514 (interactive @var{num} @var{tag})
32515 @end example
32516
32517 @noindent
32518 where @var{num} is an integer, and @var{tag} is a string. The effect is
32519 to pop @var{num} values off the stack, resimplify them by calling
32520 @code{calc-normalize}, and hand them to your function according to the
32521 function's argument list. Your function may include @code{&optional} and
32522 @code{&rest} parameters, so long as calling the function with @var{num}
32523 parameters is valid.
32524
32525 Your function must return either a number or a formula in a form
32526 acceptable to Calc, or a list of such numbers or formulas. These value(s)
32527 are pushed onto the stack when the function completes. They are also
32528 recorded in the Calc Trail buffer on a line beginning with @var{tag},
32529 a string of (normally) four characters or less. If you omit @var{tag}
32530 or use @code{nil} as a tag, the result is not recorded in the trail.
32531
32532 As an example, the definition
32533
32534 @smallexample
32535 (defmath myfact (n)
32536 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32537 (interactive 1 "fact")
32538 (if (> n 0)
32539 (* n (myfact (1- n)))
32540 (and (= n 0) 1)))
32541 @end smallexample
32542
32543 @noindent
32544 is a version of the factorial function shown previously which can be used
32545 as a command as well as an algebraic function. It expands to
32546
32547 @smallexample
32548 (defun calc-myfact ()
32549 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32550 (interactive)
32551 (calc-slow-wrapper
32552 (calc-enter-result 1 "fact"
32553 (cons 'calcFunc-myfact (calc-top-list-n 1)))))
32554
32555 (defun calcFunc-myfact (n)
32556 "Compute the factorial of the integer at the top of the stack."
32557 (if (math-posp n)
32558 (math-mul n (calcFunc-myfact (math-add n -1)))
32559 (and (math-zerop n) 1)))
32560 @end smallexample
32561
32562 @findex calc-slow-wrapper
32563 The @code{calc-slow-wrapper} function is a version of @code{calc-wrapper}
32564 that automatically puts up a @samp{Working...} message before the
32565 computation begins. (This message can be turned off by the user
32566 with an @kbd{m w} (@code{calc-working}) command.)
32567
32568 @findex calc-top-list-n
32569 The @code{calc-top-list-n} function returns a list of the specified number
32570 of values from the top of the stack. It resimplifies each value by
32571 calling @code{calc-normalize}. If its argument is zero it returns an
32572 empty list. It does not actually remove these values from the stack.
32573
32574 @findex calc-enter-result
32575 The @code{calc-enter-result} function takes an integer @var{num} and string
32576 @var{tag} as described above, plus a third argument which is either a
32577 Calculator data object or a list of such objects. These objects are
32578 resimplified and pushed onto the stack after popping the specified number
32579 of values from the stack. If @var{tag} is non-@code{nil}, the values
32580 being pushed are also recorded in the trail.
32581
32582 Note that if @code{calcFunc-myfact} returns @code{nil} this represents
32583 ``leave the function in symbolic form.'' To return an actual empty list,
32584 in the sense that @code{calc-enter-result} will push zero elements back
32585 onto the stack, you should return the special value @samp{'(nil)}, a list
32586 containing the single symbol @code{nil}.
32587
32588 The @code{interactive} declaration can actually contain a limited
32589 Emacs-style code string as well which comes just before @var{num} and
32590 @var{tag}. Currently the only Emacs code supported is @samp{"p"}, as in
32591
32592 @example
32593 (defmath foo (a b &optional c)
32594 (interactive "p" 2 "foo")
32595 @var{body})
32596 @end example
32597
32598 In this example, the command @code{calc-foo} will evaluate the expression
32599 @samp{foo(a,b)} if executed with no argument, or @samp{foo(a,b,n)} if
32600 executed with a numeric prefix argument of @expr{n}.
32601
32602 The other code string allowed is @samp{"m"} (unrelated to the usual @samp{"m"}
32603 code as used with @code{defun}). It uses the numeric prefix argument as the
32604 number of objects to remove from the stack and pass to the function.
32605 In this case, the integer @var{num} serves as a default number of
32606 arguments to be used when no prefix is supplied.
32607
32608 @node Argument Qualifiers, Example Definitions, Defining Stack Commands, Lisp Definitions
32609 @subsection Argument Qualifiers
32610
32611 @noindent
32612 Anywhere a parameter name can appear in the parameter list you can also use
32613 an @dfn{argument qualifier}. Thus the general form of a definition is:
32614
32615 @example
32616 (defmath @var{name} (@var{param} @var{param...}
32617 &optional @var{param} @var{param...}
32618 &rest @var{param})
32619 @var{body})
32620 @end example
32621
32622 @noindent
32623 where each @var{param} is either a symbol or a list of the form
32624
32625 @example
32626 (@var{qual} @var{param})
32627 @end example
32628
32629 The following qualifiers are recognized:
32630
32631 @table @samp
32632 @item complete
32633 @findex complete
32634 The argument must not be an incomplete vector, interval, or complex number.
32635 (This is rarely needed since the Calculator itself will never call your
32636 function with an incomplete argument. But there is nothing stopping your
32637 own Lisp code from calling your function with an incomplete argument.)
32638
32639 @item integer
32640 @findex integer
32641 The argument must be an integer. If it is an integer-valued float
32642 it will be accepted but converted to integer form. Non-integers and
32643 formulas are rejected.
32644
32645 @item natnum
32646 @findex natnum
32647 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must be non-negative.
32648
32649 @item fixnum
32650 @findex fixnum
32651 Like @samp{integer}, but the argument must fit into a native Lisp integer,
32652 which on most systems means less than 2^23 in absolute value. The
32653 argument is converted into Lisp-integer form if necessary.
32654
32655 @item float
32656 @findex float
32657 The argument is converted to floating-point format if it is a number or
32658 vector. If it is a formula it is left alone. (The argument is never
32659 actually rejected by this qualifier.)
32660
32661 @item @var{pred}
32662 The argument must satisfy predicate @var{pred}, which is one of the
32663 standard Calculator predicates. @xref{Predicates}.
32664
32665 @item not-@var{pred}
32666 The argument must @emph{not} satisfy predicate @var{pred}.
32667 @end table
32668
32669 For example,
32670
32671 @example
32672 (defmath foo (a (constp (not-matrixp b)) &optional (float c)
32673 &rest (integer d))
32674 @var{body})
32675 @end example
32676
32677 @noindent
32678 expands to
32679
32680 @example
32681 (defun calcFunc-foo (a b &optional c &rest d)
32682 (and (math-matrixp b)
32683 (math-reject-arg b 'not-matrixp))
32684 (or (math-constp b)
32685 (math-reject-arg b 'constp))
32686 (and c (setq c (math-check-float c)))
32687 (setq d (mapcar 'math-check-integer d))
32688 @var{body})
32689 @end example
32690
32691 @noindent
32692 which performs the necessary checks and conversions before executing the
32693 body of the function.
32694
32695 @node Example Definitions, Calling Calc from Your Programs, Argument Qualifiers, Lisp Definitions
32696 @subsection Example Definitions
32697
32698 @noindent
32699 This section includes some Lisp programming examples on a larger scale.
32700 These programs make use of some of the Calculator's internal functions;
32701 @pxref{Internals}.
32702
32703 @menu
32704 * Bit Counting Example::
32705 * Sine Example::
32706 @end menu
32707
32708 @node Bit Counting Example, Sine Example, Example Definitions, Example Definitions
32709 @subsubsection Bit-Counting
32710
32711 @noindent
32712 @ignore
32713 @starindex
32714 @end ignore
32715 @tindex bcount
32716 Calc does not include a built-in function for counting the number of
32717 ``one'' bits in a binary integer. It's easy to invent one using @kbd{b u}
32718 to convert the integer to a set, and @kbd{V #} to count the elements of
32719 that set; let's write a function that counts the bits without having to
32720 create an intermediate set.
32721
32722 @smallexample
32723 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32724 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32725 (let ((count 0))
32726 (while (> n 0)
32727 (if (oddp n)
32728 (setq count (1+ count)))
32729 (setq n (lsh n -1)))
32730 count))
32731 @end smallexample
32732
32733 @noindent
32734 When this is expanded by @code{defmath}, it will become the following
32735 Emacs Lisp function:
32736
32737 @smallexample
32738 (defun calcFunc-bcount (n)
32739 (setq n (math-check-natnum n))
32740 (let ((count 0))
32741 (while (math-posp n)
32742 (if (math-oddp n)
32743 (setq count (math-add count 1)))
32744 (setq n (calcFunc-lsh n -1)))
32745 count))
32746 @end smallexample
32747
32748 If the input numbers are large, this function involves a fair amount
32749 of arithmetic. A binary right shift is essentially a division by two;
32750 recall that Calc stores integers in decimal form so bit shifts must
32751 involve actual division.
32752
32753 To gain a bit more efficiency, we could divide the integer into
32754 @var{n}-bit chunks, each of which can be handled quickly because
32755 they fit into Lisp integers. It turns out that Calc's arithmetic
32756 routines are especially fast when dividing by an integer less than
32757 1000, so we can set @var{n = 9} bits and use repeated division by 512:
32758
32759 @smallexample
32760 (defmath bcount ((natnum n))
32761 (interactive 1 "bcnt")
32762 (let ((count 0))
32763 (while (not (fixnump n))
32764 (let ((qr (idivmod n 512)))
32765 (setq count (+ count (bcount-fixnum (cdr qr)))
32766 n (car qr))))
32767 (+ count (bcount-fixnum n))))
32768
32769 (defun bcount-fixnum (n)
32770 (let ((count 0))
32771 (while (> n 0)
32772 (setq count (+ count (logand n 1))
32773 n (lsh n -1)))
32774 count))
32775 @end smallexample
32776
32777 @noindent
32778 Note that the second function uses @code{defun}, not @code{defmath}.
32779 Because this function deals only with native Lisp integers (``fixnums''),
32780 it can use the actual Emacs @code{+} and related functions rather
32781 than the slower but more general Calc equivalents which @code{defmath}
32782 uses.
32783
32784 The @code{idivmod} function does an integer division, returning both
32785 the quotient and the remainder at once. Again, note that while it
32786 might seem that @samp{(logand n 511)} and @samp{(lsh n -9)} are
32787 more efficient ways to split off the bottom nine bits of @code{n},
32788 actually they are less efficient because each operation is really
32789 a division by 512 in disguise; @code{idivmod} allows us to do the
32790 same thing with a single division by 512.
32791
32792 @node Sine Example, , Bit Counting Example, Example Definitions
32793 @subsubsection The Sine Function
32794
32795 @noindent
32796 @ignore
32797 @starindex
32798 @end ignore
32799 @tindex mysin
32800 A somewhat limited sine function could be defined as follows, using the
32801 well-known Taylor series expansion for
32802 @texline @math{\sin x}:
32803 @infoline @samp{sin(x)}:
32804
32805 @smallexample
32806 (defmath mysin ((float (anglep x)))
32807 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32808 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32809 (let ((sum x) ; Initial term of Taylor expansion of sin.
32810 newsum
32811 (nfact 1) ; "nfact" equals "n" factorial at all times.
32812 (xnegsqr :"-(x^2)")) ; "xnegsqr" equals -x^2.
32813 (for ((n 3 100 2)) ; Upper limit of 100 is a good precaution.
32814 (working "mysin" sum) ; Display "Working" message, if enabled.
32815 (setq nfact (* nfact (1- n) n)
32816 x (* x xnegsqr)
32817 newsum (+ sum (/ x nfact)))
32818 (if (~= newsum sum) ; If newsum is "nearly equal to" sum,
32819 (break)) ; then we are done.
32820 (setq sum newsum))
32821 sum))
32822 @end smallexample
32823
32824 The actual @code{sin} function in Calc works by first reducing the problem
32825 to a sine or cosine of a nonnegative number less than @cpiover{4}. This
32826 ensures that the Taylor series will converge quickly. Also, the calculation
32827 is carried out with two extra digits of precision to guard against cumulative
32828 round-off in @samp{sum}. Finally, complex arguments are allowed and handled
32829 by a separate algorithm.
32830
32831 @smallexample
32832 (defmath mysin ((float (scalarp x)))
32833 (interactive 1 "mysn")
32834 (setq x (to-radians x)) ; Convert from current angular mode.
32835 (with-extra-prec 2 ; Evaluate with extra precision.
32836 (cond ((complexp x)
32837 (mysin-complex x))
32838 ((< x 0)
32839 (- (mysin-raw (- x))) ; Always call mysin-raw with x >= 0.
32840 (t (mysin-raw x))))))
32841
32842 (defmath mysin-raw (x)
32843 (cond ((>= x 7)
32844 (mysin-raw (% x (two-pi)))) ; Now x < 7.
32845 ((> x (pi-over-2))
32846 (- (mysin-raw (- x (pi))))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/2.
32847 ((> x (pi-over-4))
32848 (mycos-raw (- x (pi-over-2)))) ; Now -pi/2 <= x <= pi/4.
32849 ((< x (- (pi-over-4)))
32850 (- (mycos-raw (+ x (pi-over-2))))) ; Now -pi/4 <= x <= pi/4,
32851 (t (mysin-series x)))) ; so the series will be efficient.
32852 @end smallexample
32853
32854 @noindent
32855 where @code{mysin-complex} is an appropriate function to handle complex
32856 numbers, @code{mysin-series} is the routine to compute the sine Taylor
32857 series as before, and @code{mycos-raw} is a function analogous to
32858 @code{mysin-raw} for cosines.
32859
32860 The strategy is to ensure that @expr{x} is nonnegative before calling
32861 @code{mysin-raw}. This function then recursively reduces its argument
32862 to a suitable range, namely, plus-or-minus @cpiover{4}. Note that each
32863 test, and particularly the first comparison against 7, is designed so
32864 that small roundoff errors cannot produce an infinite loop. (Suppose
32865 we compared with @samp{(two-pi)} instead; if due to roundoff problems
32866 the modulo operator ever returned @samp{(two-pi)} exactly, an infinite
32867 recursion could result!) We use modulo only for arguments that will
32868 clearly get reduced, knowing that the next rule will catch any reductions
32869 that this rule misses.
32870
32871 If a program is being written for general use, it is important to code
32872 it carefully as shown in this second example. For quick-and-dirty programs,
32873 when you know that your own use of the sine function will never encounter
32874 a large argument, a simpler program like the first one shown is fine.
32875
32876 @node Calling Calc from Your Programs, Internals, Example Definitions, Lisp Definitions
32877 @subsection Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs
32878
32879 @noindent
32880 A later section (@pxref{Internals}) gives a full description of
32881 Calc's internal Lisp functions. It's not hard to call Calc from
32882 inside your programs, but the number of these functions can be daunting.
32883 So Calc provides one special ``programmer-friendly'' function called
32884 @code{calc-eval} that can be made to do just about everything you
32885 need. It's not as fast as the low-level Calc functions, but it's
32886 much simpler to use!
32887
32888 It may seem that @code{calc-eval} itself has a daunting number of
32889 options, but they all stem from one simple operation.
32890
32891 In its simplest manifestation, @samp{(calc-eval "1+2")} parses the
32892 string @code{"1+2"} as if it were a Calc algebraic entry and returns
32893 the result formatted as a string: @code{"3"}.
32894
32895 Since @code{calc-eval} is on the list of recommended @code{autoload}
32896 functions, you don't need to make any special preparations to load
32897 Calc before calling @code{calc-eval} the first time. Calc will be
32898 loaded and initialized for you.
32899
32900 All the Calc modes that are currently in effect will be used when
32901 evaluating the expression and formatting the result.
32902
32903 @ifinfo
32904 @example
32905
32906 @end example
32907 @end ifinfo
32908 @subsubsection Additional Arguments to @code{calc-eval}
32909
32910 @noindent
32911 If the input string parses to a list of expressions, Calc returns
32912 the results separated by @code{", "}. You can specify a different
32913 separator by giving a second string argument to @code{calc-eval}:
32914 @samp{(calc-eval "1+2,3+4" ";")} returns @code{"3;7"}.
32915
32916 The ``separator'' can also be any of several Lisp symbols which
32917 request other behaviors from @code{calc-eval}. These are discussed
32918 one by one below.
32919
32920 You can give additional arguments to be substituted for
32921 @samp{$}, @samp{$$}, and so on in the main expression. For
32922 example, @samp{(calc-eval "$/$$" nil "7" "1+1")} evaluates the
32923 expression @code{"7/(1+1)"} to yield the result @code{"3.5"}
32924 (assuming Fraction mode is not in effect). Note the @code{nil}
32925 used as a placeholder for the item-separator argument.
32926
32927 @ifinfo
32928 @example
32929
32930 @end example
32931 @end ifinfo
32932 @subsubsection Error Handling
32933
32934 @noindent
32935 If @code{calc-eval} encounters an error, it returns a list containing
32936 the character position of the error, plus a suitable message as a
32937 string. Note that @samp{1 / 0} is @emph{not} an error by Calc's
32938 standards; it simply returns the string @code{"1 / 0"} which is the
32939 division left in symbolic form. But @samp{(calc-eval "1/")} will
32940 return the list @samp{(2 "Expected a number")}.
32941
32942 If you bind the variable @code{calc-eval-error} to @code{t}
32943 using a @code{let} form surrounding the call to @code{calc-eval},
32944 errors instead call the Emacs @code{error} function which aborts
32945 to the Emacs command loop with a beep and an error message.
32946
32947 If you bind this variable to the symbol @code{string}, error messages
32948 are returned as strings instead of lists. The character position is
32949 ignored.
32950
32951 As a courtesy to other Lisp code which may be using Calc, be sure
32952 to bind @code{calc-eval-error} using @code{let} rather than changing
32953 it permanently with @code{setq}.
32954
32955 @ifinfo
32956 @example
32957
32958 @end example
32959 @end ifinfo
32960 @subsubsection Numbers Only
32961
32962 @noindent
32963 Sometimes it is preferable to treat @samp{1 / 0} as an error
32964 rather than returning a symbolic result. If you pass the symbol
32965 @code{num} as the second argument to @code{calc-eval}, results
32966 that are not constants are treated as errors. The error message
32967 reported is the first @code{calc-why} message if there is one,
32968 or otherwise ``Number expected.''
32969
32970 A result is ``constant'' if it is a number, vector, or other
32971 object that does not include variables or function calls. If it
32972 is a vector, the components must themselves be constants.
32973
32974 @ifinfo
32975 @example
32976
32977 @end example
32978 @end ifinfo
32979 @subsubsection Default Modes
32980
32981 @noindent
32982 If the first argument to @code{calc-eval} is a list whose first
32983 element is a formula string, then @code{calc-eval} sets all the
32984 various Calc modes to their default values while the formula is
32985 evaluated and formatted. For example, the precision is set to 12
32986 digits, digit grouping is turned off, and the Normal language
32987 mode is used.
32988
32989 This same principle applies to the other options discussed below.
32990 If the first argument would normally be @var{x}, then it can also
32991 be the list @samp{(@var{x})} to use the default mode settings.
32992
32993 If there are other elements in the list, they are taken as
32994 variable-name/value pairs which override the default mode
32995 settings. Look at the documentation at the front of the
32996 @file{calc.el} file to find the names of the Lisp variables for
32997 the various modes. The mode settings are restored to their
32998 original values when @code{calc-eval} is done.
32999
33000 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '("$+$$" calc-internal-prec 8) 'num a b)}
33001 computes the sum of two numbers, requiring a numeric result, and
33002 using default mode settings except that the precision is 8 instead
33003 of the default of 12.
33004
33005 It's usually best to use this form of @code{calc-eval} unless your
33006 program actually considers the interaction with Calc's mode settings
33007 to be a feature. This will avoid all sorts of potential ``gotchas'';
33008 consider what happens with @samp{(calc-eval "sqrt(2)" 'num)}
33009 when the user has left Calc in Symbolic mode or No-Simplify mode.
33010
33011 As another example, @samp{(equal (calc-eval '("$<$$") nil a b) "1")}
33012 checks if the number in string @expr{a} is less than the one in
33013 string @expr{b}. Without using a list, the integer 1 might
33014 come out in a variety of formats which would be hard to test for
33015 conveniently: @code{"1"}, @code{"8#1"}, @code{"00001"}. (But
33016 see ``Predicates'' mode, below.)
33017
33018 @ifinfo
33019 @example
33020
33021 @end example
33022 @end ifinfo
33023 @subsubsection Raw Numbers
33024
33025 @noindent
33026 Normally all input and output for @code{calc-eval} is done with strings.
33027 You can do arithmetic with, say, @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" nil a b)}
33028 in place of @samp{(+ a b)}, but this is very inefficient since the
33029 numbers must be converted to and from string format as they are passed
33030 from one @code{calc-eval} to the next.
33031
33032 If the separator is the symbol @code{raw}, the result will be returned
33033 as a raw Calc data structure rather than a string. You can read about
33034 how these objects look in the following sections, but usually you can
33035 treat them as ``black box'' objects with no important internal
33036 structure.
33037
33038 There is also a @code{rawnum} symbol, which is a combination of
33039 @code{raw} (returning a raw Calc object) and @code{num} (signaling
33040 an error if that object is not a constant).
33041
33042 You can pass a raw Calc object to @code{calc-eval} in place of a
33043 string, either as the formula itself or as one of the @samp{$}
33044 arguments. Thus @samp{(calc-eval "$+$$" 'raw a b)} is an
33045 addition function that operates on raw Calc objects. Of course
33046 in this case it would be easier to call the low-level @code{math-add}
33047 function in Calc, if you can remember its name.
33048
33049 In particular, note that a plain Lisp integer is acceptable to Calc
33050 as a raw object. (All Lisp integers are accepted on input, but
33051 integers of more than six decimal digits are converted to ``big-integer''
33052 form for output. @xref{Data Type Formats}.)
33053
33054 When it comes time to display the object, just use @samp{(calc-eval a)}
33055 to format it as a string.
33056
33057 It is an error if the input expression evaluates to a list of
33058 values. The separator symbol @code{list} is like @code{raw}
33059 except that it returns a list of one or more raw Calc objects.
33060
33061 Note that a Lisp string is not a valid Calc object, nor is a list
33062 containing a string. Thus you can still safely distinguish all the
33063 various kinds of error returns discussed above.
33064
33065 @ifinfo
33066 @example
33067
33068 @end example
33069 @end ifinfo
33070 @subsubsection Predicates
33071
33072 @noindent
33073 If the separator symbol is @code{pred}, the result of the formula is
33074 treated as a true/false value; @code{calc-eval} returns @code{t} or
33075 @code{nil}, respectively. A value is considered ``true'' if it is a
33076 non-zero number, or false if it is zero or if it is not a number.
33077
33078 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "$<$$" 'pred a b)} tests whether
33079 one value is less than another.
33080
33081 As usual, it is also possible for @code{calc-eval} to return one of
33082 the error indicators described above. Lisp will interpret such an
33083 indicator as ``true'' if you don't check for it explicitly. If you
33084 wish to have an error register as ``false'', use something like
33085 @samp{(eq (calc-eval ...) t)}.
33086
33087 @ifinfo
33088 @example
33089
33090 @end example
33091 @end ifinfo
33092 @subsubsection Variable Values
33093
33094 @noindent
33095 Variables in the formula passed to @code{calc-eval} are not normally
33096 replaced by their values. If you wish this, you can use the
33097 @code{evalv} function (@pxref{Algebraic Manipulation}). For example,
33098 if 4 is stored in Calc variable @code{a} (i.e., in Lisp variable
33099 @code{var-a}), then @samp{(calc-eval "a+pi")} will return the
33100 formula @code{"a + pi"}, but @samp{(calc-eval "evalv(a+pi)")}
33101 will return @code{"7.14159265359"}.
33102
33103 To store in a Calc variable, just use @code{setq} to store in the
33104 corresponding Lisp variable. (This is obtained by prepending
33105 @samp{var-} to the Calc variable name.) Calc routines will
33106 understand either string or raw form values stored in variables,
33107 although raw data objects are much more efficient. For example,
33108 to increment the Calc variable @code{a}:
33109
33110 @example
33111 (setq var-a (calc-eval "evalv(a+1)" 'raw))
33112 @end example
33113
33114 @ifinfo
33115 @example
33116
33117 @end example
33118 @end ifinfo
33119 @subsubsection Stack Access
33120
33121 @noindent
33122 If the separator symbol is @code{push}, the formula argument is
33123 evaluated (with possible @samp{$} expansions, as usual). The
33124 result is pushed onto the Calc stack. The return value is @code{nil}
33125 (unless there is an error from evaluating the formula, in which
33126 case the return value depends on @code{calc-eval-error} in the
33127 usual way).
33128
33129 If the separator symbol is @code{pop}, the first argument to
33130 @code{calc-eval} must be an integer instead of a string. That
33131 many values are popped from the stack and thrown away. A negative
33132 argument deletes the entry at that stack level. The return value
33133 is the number of elements remaining in the stack after popping;
33134 @samp{(calc-eval 0 'pop)} is a good way to measure the size of
33135 the stack.
33136
33137 If the separator symbol is @code{top}, the first argument to
33138 @code{calc-eval} must again be an integer. The value at that
33139 stack level is formatted as a string and returned. Thus
33140 @samp{(calc-eval 1 'top)} returns the top-of-stack value. If the
33141 integer is out of range, @code{nil} is returned.
33142
33143 The separator symbol @code{rawtop} is just like @code{top} except
33144 that the stack entry is returned as a raw Calc object instead of
33145 as a string.
33146
33147 In all of these cases the first argument can be made a list in
33148 order to force the default mode settings, as described above.
33149 Thus @samp{(calc-eval '(2 calc-number-radix 16) 'top)} returns the
33150 second-to-top stack entry, formatted as a string using the default
33151 instead of current display modes, except that the radix is
33152 hexadecimal instead of decimal.
33153
33154 It is, of course, polite to put the Calc stack back the way you
33155 found it when you are done, unless the user of your program is
33156 actually expecting it to affect the stack.
33157
33158 Note that you do not actually have to switch into the @file{*Calculator*}
33159 buffer in order to use @code{calc-eval}; it temporarily switches into
33160 the stack buffer if necessary.
33161
33162 @ifinfo
33163 @example
33164
33165 @end example
33166 @end ifinfo
33167 @subsubsection Keyboard Macros
33168
33169 @noindent
33170 If the separator symbol is @code{macro}, the first argument must be a
33171 string of characters which Calc can execute as a sequence of keystrokes.
33172 This switches into the Calc buffer for the duration of the macro.
33173 For example, @samp{(calc-eval "vx5\rVR+" 'macro)} pushes the
33174 vector @samp{[1,2,3,4,5]} on the stack and then replaces it
33175 with the sum of those numbers. Note that @samp{\r} is the Lisp
33176 notation for the carriage-return, @key{RET}, character.
33177
33178 If your keyboard macro wishes to pop the stack, @samp{\C-d} is
33179 safer than @samp{\177} (the @key{DEL} character) because some
33180 installations may have switched the meanings of @key{DEL} and
33181 @kbd{C-h}. Calc always interprets @kbd{C-d} as a synonym for
33182 ``pop-stack'' regardless of key mapping.
33183
33184 If you provide a third argument to @code{calc-eval}, evaluation
33185 of the keyboard macro will leave a record in the Trail using
33186 that argument as a tag string. Normally the Trail is unaffected.
33187
33188 The return value in this case is always @code{nil}.
33189
33190 @ifinfo
33191 @example
33192
33193 @end example
33194 @end ifinfo
33195 @subsubsection Lisp Evaluation
33196
33197 @noindent
33198 Finally, if the separator symbol is @code{eval}, then the Lisp
33199 @code{eval} function is called on the first argument, which must
33200 be a Lisp expression rather than a Calc formula. Remember to
33201 quote the expression so that it is not evaluated until inside
33202 @code{calc-eval}.
33203
33204 The difference from plain @code{eval} is that @code{calc-eval}
33205 switches to the Calc buffer before evaluating the expression.
33206 For example, @samp{(calc-eval '(setq calc-internal-prec 17) 'eval)}
33207 will correctly affect the buffer-local Calc precision variable.
33208
33209 An alternative would be @samp{(calc-eval '(calc-precision 17) 'eval)}.
33210 This is evaluating a call to the function that is normally invoked
33211 by the @kbd{p} key, giving it 17 as its ``numeric prefix argument.''
33212 Note that this function will leave a message in the echo area as
33213 a side effect. Also, all Calc functions switch to the Calc buffer
33214 automatically if not invoked from there, so the above call is
33215 also equivalent to @samp{(calc-precision 17)} by itself.
33216 In all cases, Calc uses @code{save-excursion} to switch back to
33217 your original buffer when it is done.
33218
33219 As usual the first argument can be a list that begins with a Lisp
33220 expression to use default instead of current mode settings.
33221
33222 The result of @code{calc-eval} in this usage is just the result
33223 returned by the evaluated Lisp expression.
33224
33225 @ifinfo
33226 @example
33227
33228 @end example
33229 @end ifinfo
33230 @subsubsection Example
33231
33232 @noindent
33233 @findex convert-temp
33234 Here is a sample Emacs command that uses @code{calc-eval}. Suppose
33235 you have a document with lots of references to temperatures on the
33236 Fahrenheit scale, say ``98.6 F'', and you wish to convert these
33237 references to Centigrade. The following command does this conversion.
33238 Place the Emacs cursor right after the letter ``F'' and invoke the
33239 command to change ``98.6 F'' to ``37 C''. Or, if the temperature is
33240 already in Centigrade form, the command changes it back to Fahrenheit.
33241
33242 @example
33243 (defun convert-temp ()
33244 (interactive)
33245 (save-excursion
33246 (re-search-backward "[^-.0-9]\\([-.0-9]+\\) *\\([FC]\\)")
33247 (let* ((top1 (match-beginning 1))
33248 (bot1 (match-end 1))
33249 (number (buffer-substring top1 bot1))
33250 (top2 (match-beginning 2))
33251 (bot2 (match-end 2))
33252 (type (buffer-substring top2 bot2)))
33253 (if (equal type "F")
33254 (setq type "C"
33255 number (calc-eval "($ - 32)*5/9" nil number))
33256 (setq type "F"
33257 number (calc-eval "$*9/5 + 32" nil number)))
33258 (goto-char top2)
33259 (delete-region top2 bot2)
33260 (insert-before-markers type)
33261 (goto-char top1)
33262 (delete-region top1 bot1)
33263 (if (string-match "\\.$" number) ; change "37." to "37"
33264 (setq number (substring number 0 -1)))
33265 (insert number))))
33266 @end example
33267
33268 Note the use of @code{insert-before-markers} when changing between
33269 ``F'' and ``C'', so that the character winds up before the cursor
33270 instead of after it.
33271
33272 @node Internals, , Calling Calc from Your Programs, Lisp Definitions
33273 @subsection Calculator Internals
33274
33275 @noindent
33276 This section describes the Lisp functions defined by the Calculator that
33277 may be of use to user-written Calculator programs (as described in the
33278 rest of this chapter). These functions are shown by their names as they
33279 conventionally appear in @code{defmath}. Their full Lisp names are
33280 generally gotten by prepending @samp{calcFunc-} or @samp{math-} to their
33281 apparent names. (Names that begin with @samp{calc-} are already in
33282 their full Lisp form.) You can use the actual full names instead if you
33283 prefer them, or if you are calling these functions from regular Lisp.
33284
33285 The functions described here are scattered throughout the various
33286 Calc component files. Note that @file{calc.el} includes @code{autoload}s
33287 for only a few component files; when Calc wants to call an advanced
33288 function it calls @samp{(calc-extensions)} first; this function
33289 autoloads @file{calc-ext.el}, which in turn autoloads all the functions
33290 in the remaining component files.
33291
33292 Because @code{defmath} itself uses the extensions, user-written code
33293 generally always executes with the extensions already loaded, so
33294 normally you can use any Calc function and be confident that it will
33295 be autoloaded for you when necessary. If you are doing something
33296 special, check carefully to make sure each function you are using is
33297 from @file{calc.el} or its components, and call @samp{(calc-extensions)}
33298 before using any function based in @file{calc-ext.el} if you can't
33299 prove this file will already be loaded.
33300
33301 @menu
33302 * Data Type Formats::
33303 * Interactive Lisp Functions::
33304 * Stack Lisp Functions::
33305 * Predicates::
33306 * Computational Lisp Functions::
33307 * Vector Lisp Functions::
33308 * Symbolic Lisp Functions::
33309 * Formatting Lisp Functions::
33310 * Hooks::
33311 @end menu
33312
33313 @node Data Type Formats, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals, Internals
33314 @subsubsection Data Type Formats
33315
33316 @noindent
33317 Integers are stored in either of two ways, depending on their magnitude.
33318 Integers less than one million in absolute value are stored as standard
33319 Lisp integers. This is the only storage format for Calc data objects
33320 which is not a Lisp list.
33321
33322 Large integers are stored as lists of the form @samp{(bigpos @var{d0}
33323 @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for sufficiently large positive integers
33324 (where ``sufficiently large'' depends on the machine), or
33325 @samp{(bigneg @var{d0} @var{d1} @var{d2} @dots{})} for negative
33326 integers. Each @var{d} is a base-@expr{10^n} ``digit'' (where again,
33327 @expr{n} depends on the machine), a Lisp integer from 0 to
33328 99@dots{}9. The least significant digit is @var{d0}; the last digit,
33329 @var{dn}, which is always nonzero, is the most significant digit. For
33330 example, the integer @mathit{-12345678} might be stored as
33331 @samp{(bigneg 678 345 12)}.
33332
33333 The distinction between small and large integers is entirely hidden from
33334 the user. In @code{defmath} definitions, the Lisp predicate @code{integerp}
33335 returns true for either kind of integer, and in general both big and small
33336 integers are accepted anywhere the word ``integer'' is used in this manual.
33337 If the distinction must be made, native Lisp integers are called @dfn{fixnums}
33338 and large integers are called @dfn{bignums}.
33339
33340 Fractions are stored as a list of the form, @samp{(frac @var{n} @var{d})}
33341 where @var{n} is an integer (big or small) numerator, @var{d} is an
33342 integer denominator greater than one, and @var{n} and @var{d} are relatively
33343 prime. Note that fractions where @var{d} is one are automatically converted
33344 to plain integers by all math routines; fractions where @var{d} is negative
33345 are normalized by negating the numerator and denominator.
33346
33347 Floating-point numbers are stored in the form, @samp{(float @var{mant}
33348 @var{exp})}, where @var{mant} (the ``mantissa'') is an integer less than
33349 @samp{10^@var{p}} in absolute value (@var{p} represents the current
33350 precision), and @var{exp} (the ``exponent'') is a fixnum. The value of
33351 the float is @samp{@var{mant} * 10^@var{exp}}. For example, the number
33352 @mathit{-3.14} is stored as @samp{(float -314 -2) = -314*10^-2}. Other constraints
33353 are that the number 0.0 is always stored as @samp{(float 0 0)}, and,
33354 except for the 0.0 case, the rightmost base-10 digit of @var{mant} is
33355 always nonzero. (If the rightmost digit is zero, the number is
33356 rearranged by dividing @var{mant} by ten and incrementing @var{exp}.)
33357
33358 Rectangular complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(cplx @var{re}
33359 @var{im})}, where @var{re} and @var{im} are each real numbers, either
33360 integers, fractions, or floats. The value is @samp{@var{re} + @var{im}i}.
33361 The @var{im} part is nonzero; complex numbers with zero imaginary
33362 components are converted to real numbers automatically.
33363
33364 Polar complex numbers are stored in the form @samp{(polar @var{r}
33365 @var{theta})}, where @var{r} is a positive real value and @var{theta}
33366 is a real value or HMS form representing an angle. This angle is
33367 usually normalized to lie in the interval @samp{(-180 ..@: 180)} degrees,
33368 or @samp{(-pi ..@: pi)} radians, according to the current angular mode.
33369 If the angle is 0 the value is converted to a real number automatically.
33370 (If the angle is 180 degrees, the value is usually also converted to a
33371 negative real number.)
33372
33373 Hours-minutes-seconds forms are stored as @samp{(hms @var{h} @var{m}
33374 @var{s})}, where @var{h} is an integer or an integer-valued float (i.e.,
33375 a float with @samp{@var{exp} >= 0}), @var{m} is an integer or integer-valued
33376 float in the range @w{@samp{[0 ..@: 60)}}, and @var{s} is any real number
33377 in the range @samp{[0 ..@: 60)}.
33378
33379 Date forms are stored as @samp{(date @var{n})}, where @var{n} is
33380 a real number that counts days since midnight on the morning of
33381 January 1, 1 AD@. If @var{n} is an integer, this is a pure date
33382 form. If @var{n} is a fraction or float, this is a date/time form.
33383
33384 Modulo forms are stored as @samp{(mod @var{n} @var{m})}, where @var{m} is a
33385 positive real number or HMS form, and @var{n} is a real number or HMS
33386 form in the range @samp{[0 ..@: @var{m})}.
33387
33388 Error forms are stored as @samp{(sdev @var{x} @var{sigma})}, where @var{x}
33389 is the mean value and @var{sigma} is the standard deviation. Each
33390 component is either a number, an HMS form, or a symbolic object
33391 (a variable or function call). If @var{sigma} is zero, the value is
33392 converted to a plain real number. If @var{sigma} is negative or
33393 complex, it is automatically normalized to be a positive real.
33394
33395 Interval forms are stored as @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{lo} @var{hi})},
33396 where @var{mask} is one of the integers 0, 1, 2, or 3, and @var{lo} and
33397 @var{hi} are real numbers, HMS forms, or symbolic objects. The @var{mask}
33398 is a binary integer where 1 represents the fact that the interval is
33399 closed on the high end, and 2 represents the fact that it is closed on
33400 the low end. (Thus 3 represents a fully closed interval.) The interval
33401 @w{@samp{(intv 3 @var{x} @var{x})}} is converted to the plain number @var{x};
33402 intervals @samp{(intv @var{mask} @var{x} @var{x})} for any other @var{mask}
33403 represent empty intervals. If @var{hi} is less than @var{lo}, the interval
33404 is converted to a standard empty interval by replacing @var{hi} with @var{lo}.
33405
33406 Vectors are stored as @samp{(vec @var{v1} @var{v2} @dots{})}, where @var{v1}
33407 is the first element of the vector, @var{v2} is the second, and so on.
33408 An empty vector is stored as @samp{(vec)}. A matrix is simply a vector
33409 where all @var{v}'s are themselves vectors of equal lengths. Note that
33410 Calc vectors are unrelated to the Emacs Lisp ``vector'' type, which is
33411 generally unused by Calc data structures.
33412
33413 Variables are stored as @samp{(var @var{name} @var{sym})}, where
33414 @var{name} is a Lisp symbol whose print name is used as the visible name
33415 of the variable, and @var{sym} is a Lisp symbol in which the variable's
33416 value is actually stored. Thus, @samp{(var pi var-pi)} represents the
33417 special constant @samp{pi}. Almost always, the form is @samp{(var
33418 @var{v} var-@var{v})}. If the variable name was entered with @code{#}
33419 signs (which are converted to hyphens internally), the form is
33420 @samp{(var @var{u} @var{v})}, where @var{u} is a symbol whose name
33421 contains @code{#} characters, and @var{v} is a symbol that contains
33422 @code{-} characters instead. The value of a variable is the Calc
33423 object stored in its @var{sym} symbol's value cell. If the symbol's
33424 value cell is void or if it contains @code{nil}, the variable has no
33425 value. Special constants have the form @samp{(special-const
33426 @var{value})} stored in their value cell, where @var{value} is a formula
33427 which is evaluated when the constant's value is requested. Variables
33428 which represent units are not stored in any special way; they are units
33429 only because their names appear in the units table. If the value
33430 cell contains a string, it is parsed to get the variable's value when
33431 the variable is used.
33432
33433 A Lisp list with any other symbol as the first element is a function call.
33434 The symbols @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, @code{^},
33435 and @code{|} represent special binary operators; these lists are always
33436 of the form @samp{(@var{op} @var{lhs} @var{rhs})} where @var{lhs} is the
33437 sub-formula on the lefthand side and @var{rhs} is the sub-formula on the
33438 right. The symbol @code{neg} represents unary negation; this list is always
33439 of the form @samp{(neg @var{arg})}. Any other symbol @var{func} represents a
33440 function that would be displayed in function-call notation; the symbol
33441 @var{func} is in general always of the form @samp{calcFunc-@var{name}}.
33442 The function cell of the symbol @var{func} should contain a Lisp function
33443 for evaluating a call to @var{func}. This function is passed the remaining
33444 elements of the list (themselves already evaluated) as arguments; such
33445 functions should return @code{nil} or call @code{reject-arg} to signify
33446 that they should be left in symbolic form, or they should return a Calc
33447 object which represents their value, or a list of such objects if they
33448 wish to return multiple values. (The latter case is allowed only for
33449 functions which are the outer-level call in an expression whose value is
33450 about to be pushed on the stack; this feature is considered obsolete
33451 and is not used by any built-in Calc functions.)
33452
33453 @node Interactive Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Data Type Formats, Internals
33454 @subsubsection Interactive Functions
33455
33456 @noindent
33457 The functions described here are used in implementing interactive Calc
33458 commands. Note that this list is not exhaustive! If there is an
33459 existing command that behaves similarly to the one you want to define,
33460 you may find helpful tricks by checking the source code for that command.
33461
33462 @defun calc-set-command-flag flag
33463 Set the command flag @var{flag}. This is generally a Lisp symbol, but
33464 may in fact be anything. The effect is to add @var{flag} to the list
33465 stored in the variable @code{calc-command-flags}, unless it is already
33466 there. @xref{Defining Simple Commands}.
33467 @end defun
33468
33469 @defun calc-clear-command-flag flag
33470 If @var{flag} appears among the list of currently-set command flags,
33471 remove it from that list.
33472 @end defun
33473
33474 @defun calc-record-undo rec
33475 Add the ``undo record'' @var{rec} to the list of steps to take if the
33476 current operation should need to be undone. Stack push and pop functions
33477 automatically call @code{calc-record-undo}, so the kinds of undo records
33478 you might need to create take the form @samp{(set @var{sym} @var{value})},
33479 which says that the Lisp variable @var{sym} was changed and had previously
33480 contained @var{value}; @samp{(store @var{var} @var{value})} which says that
33481 the Calc variable @var{var} (a string which is the name of the symbol that
33482 contains the variable's value) was stored and its previous value was
33483 @var{value} (either a Calc data object, or @code{nil} if the variable was
33484 previously void); or @samp{(eval @var{undo} @var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})},
33485 which means that to undo requires calling the function @samp{(@var{undo}
33486 @var{args} @dots{})} and, if the undo is later redone, calling
33487 @samp{(@var{redo} @var{args} @dots{})}.
33488 @end defun
33489
33490 @defun calc-record-why msg args
33491 Record the error or warning message @var{msg}, which is normally a string.
33492 This message will be replayed if the user types @kbd{w} (@code{calc-why});
33493 if the message string begins with a @samp{*}, it is considered important
33494 enough to display even if the user doesn't type @kbd{w}. If one or more
33495 @var{args} are present, the displayed message will be of the form,
33496 @samp{@var{msg}: @var{arg1}, @var{arg2}, @dots{}}, where the arguments are
33497 formatted on the assumption that they are either strings or Calc objects of
33498 some sort. If @var{msg} is a symbol, it is the name of a Calc predicate
33499 (such as @code{integerp} or @code{numvecp}) which the arguments did not
33500 satisfy; it is expanded to a suitable string such as ``Expected an
33501 integer.'' The @code{reject-arg} function calls @code{calc-record-why}
33502 automatically; @pxref{Predicates}.
33503 @end defun
33504
33505 @defun calc-is-inverse
33506 This predicate returns true if the current command is inverse,
33507 i.e., if the Inverse (@kbd{I} key) flag was set.
33508 @end defun
33509
33510 @defun calc-is-hyperbolic
33511 This predicate is the analogous function for the @kbd{H} key.
33512 @end defun
33513
33514 @node Stack Lisp Functions, Predicates, Interactive Lisp Functions, Internals
33515 @subsubsection Stack-Oriented Functions
33516
33517 @noindent
33518 The functions described here perform various operations on the Calc
33519 stack and trail. They are to be used in interactive Calc commands.
33520
33521 @defun calc-push-list vals n
33522 Push the Calc objects in list @var{vals} onto the stack at stack level
33523 @var{n}. If @var{n} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements
33524 are pushed at the top of the stack. If @var{n} is greater than 1, the
33525 elements will be inserted into the stack so that the last element will
33526 end up at level @var{n}, the next-to-last at level @var{n}+1, etc.
33527 The elements of @var{vals} are assumed to be valid Calc objects, and
33528 are not evaluated, rounded, or renormalized in any way. If @var{vals}
33529 is an empty list, nothing happens.
33530
33531 The stack elements are pushed without any sub-formula selections.
33532 You can give an optional third argument to this function, which must
33533 be a list the same size as @var{vals} of selections. Each selection
33534 must be @code{eq} to some sub-formula of the corresponding formula
33535 in @var{vals}, or @code{nil} if that formula should have no selection.
33536 @end defun
33537
33538 @defun calc-top-list n m
33539 Return a list of the @var{n} objects starting at level @var{m} of the
33540 stack. If @var{m} is omitted it defaults to 1, so that the elements are
33541 taken from the top of the stack. If @var{n} is omitted, it also
33542 defaults to 1, so that the top stack element (in the form of a
33543 one-element list) is returned. If @var{m} is greater than 1, the
33544 @var{m}th stack element will be at the end of the list, the @var{m}+1st
33545 element will be next-to-last, etc. If @var{n} or @var{m} are out of
33546 range, the command is aborted with a suitable error message. If @var{n}
33547 is zero, the function returns an empty list. The stack elements are not
33548 evaluated, rounded, or renormalized.
33549
33550 If any stack elements contain selections, and selections have not
33551 been disabled by the @kbd{j e} (@code{calc-enable-selections}) command,
33552 this function returns the selected portions rather than the entire
33553 stack elements. It can be given a third ``selection-mode'' argument
33554 which selects other behaviors. If it is the symbol @code{t}, then
33555 a selection in any of the requested stack elements produces an
33556 ``invalid operation on selections'' error. If it is the symbol @code{full},
33557 the whole stack entry is always returned regardless of selections.
33558 If it is the symbol @code{sel}, the selected portion is always returned,
33559 or @code{nil} if there is no selection. (This mode ignores the @kbd{j e}
33560 command.) If the symbol is @code{entry}, the complete stack entry in
33561 list form is returned; the first element of this list will be the whole
33562 formula, and the third element will be the selection (or @code{nil}).
33563 @end defun
33564
33565 @defun calc-pop-stack n m
33566 Remove the specified elements from the stack. The parameters @var{n}
33567 and @var{m} are defined the same as for @code{calc-top-list}. The return
33568 value of @code{calc-pop-stack} is uninteresting.
33569
33570 If there are any selected sub-formulas among the popped elements, and
33571 @kbd{j e} has not been used to disable selections, this produces an
33572 error without changing the stack. If you supply an optional third
33573 argument of @code{t}, the stack elements are popped even if they
33574 contain selections.
33575 @end defun
33576
33577 @defun calc-record-list vals tag
33578 This function records one or more results in the trail. The @var{vals}
33579 are a list of strings or Calc objects. The @var{tag} is the four-character
33580 tag string to identify the values. If @var{tag} is omitted, a blank tag
33581 will be used.
33582 @end defun
33583
33584 @defun calc-normalize n
33585 This function takes a Calc object and ``normalizes'' it. At the very
33586 least this involves re-rounding floating-point values according to the
33587 current precision and other similar jobs. Also, unless the user has
33588 selected No-Simplify mode (@pxref{Simplification Modes}), this involves
33589 actually evaluating a formula object by executing the function calls
33590 it contains, and possibly also doing algebraic simplification, etc.
33591 @end defun
33592
33593 @defun calc-top-list-n n m
33594 This function is identical to @code{calc-top-list}, except that it calls
33595 @code{calc-normalize} on the values that it takes from the stack. They
33596 are also passed through @code{check-complete}, so that incomplete
33597 objects will be rejected with an error message. All computational
33598 commands should use this in preference to @code{calc-top-list}; the only
33599 standard Calc commands that operate on the stack without normalizing
33600 are stack management commands like @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-roll-up}.
33601 This function accepts the same optional selection-mode argument as
33602 @code{calc-top-list}.
33603 @end defun
33604
33605 @defun calc-top-n m
33606 This function is a convenient form of @code{calc-top-list-n} in which only
33607 a single element of the stack is taken and returned, rather than a list
33608 of elements. This also accepts an optional selection-mode argument.
33609 @end defun
33610
33611 @defun calc-enter-result n tag vals
33612 This function is a convenient interface to most of the above functions.
33613 The @var{vals} argument should be either a single Calc object, or a list
33614 of Calc objects; the object or objects are normalized, and the top @var{n}
33615 stack entries are replaced by the normalized objects. If @var{tag} is
33616 non-@code{nil}, the normalized objects are also recorded in the trail.
33617 A typical stack-based computational command would take the form,
33618
33619 @smallexample
33620 (calc-enter-result @var{n} @var{tag} (cons 'calcFunc-@var{func}
33621 (calc-top-list-n @var{n})))
33622 @end smallexample
33623
33624 If any of the @var{n} stack elements replaced contain sub-formula
33625 selections, and selections have not been disabled by @kbd{j e},
33626 this function takes one of two courses of action. If @var{n} is
33627 equal to the number of elements in @var{vals}, then each element of
33628 @var{vals} is spliced into the corresponding selection; this is what
33629 happens when you use the @key{TAB} key, or when you use a unary
33630 arithmetic operation like @code{sqrt}. If @var{vals} has only one
33631 element but @var{n} is greater than one, there must be only one
33632 selection among the top @var{n} stack elements; the element from
33633 @var{vals} is spliced into that selection. This is what happens when
33634 you use a binary arithmetic operation like @kbd{+}. Any other
33635 combination of @var{n} and @var{vals} is an error when selections
33636 are present.
33637 @end defun
33638
33639 @defun calc-unary-op tag func arg
33640 This function implements a unary operator that allows a numeric prefix
33641 argument to apply the operator over many stack entries. If the prefix
33642 argument @var{arg} is @code{nil}, this uses @code{calc-enter-result}
33643 as outlined above. Otherwise, it maps the function over several stack
33644 elements; @pxref{Prefix Arguments}. For example,
33645
33646 @smallexample
33647 (defun calc-zeta (arg)
33648 (interactive "P")
33649 (calc-unary-op "zeta" 'calcFunc-zeta arg))
33650 @end smallexample
33651 @end defun
33652
33653 @defun calc-binary-op tag func arg ident unary
33654 This function implements a binary operator, analogously to
33655 @code{calc-unary-op}. The optional @var{ident} and @var{unary}
33656 arguments specify the behavior when the prefix argument is zero or
33657 one, respectively. If the prefix is zero, the value @var{ident}
33658 is pushed onto the stack, if specified, otherwise an error message
33659 is displayed. If the prefix is one, the unary function @var{unary}
33660 is applied to the top stack element, or, if @var{unary} is not
33661 specified, nothing happens. When the argument is two or more,
33662 the binary function @var{func} is reduced across the top @var{arg}
33663 stack elements; when the argument is negative, the function is
33664 mapped between the next-to-top @mathit{-@var{arg}} stack elements and the
33665 top element.
33666 @end defun
33667
33668 @defun calc-stack-size
33669 Return the number of elements on the stack as an integer. This count
33670 does not include elements that have been temporarily hidden by stack
33671 truncation; @pxref{Truncating the Stack}.
33672 @end defun
33673
33674 @defun calc-cursor-stack-index n
33675 Move the point to the @var{n}th stack entry. If @var{n} is zero, this
33676 will be the @samp{.} line. If @var{n} is from 1 to the current stack size,
33677 this will be the beginning of the first line of that stack entry's display.
33678 If line numbers are enabled, this will move to the first character of the
33679 line number, not the stack entry itself.
33680 @end defun
33681
33682 @defun calc-substack-height n
33683 Return the number of lines between the beginning of the @var{n}th stack
33684 entry and the bottom of the buffer. If @var{n} is zero, this
33685 will be one (assuming no stack truncation). If all stack entries are
33686 one line long (i.e., no matrices are displayed), the return value will
33687 be equal @var{n}+1 as long as @var{n} is in range. (Note that in Big
33688 mode, the return value includes the blank lines that separate stack
33689 entries.)
33690 @end defun
33691
33692 @defun calc-refresh
33693 Erase the @file{*Calculator*} buffer and reformat its contents from memory.
33694 This must be called after changing any parameter, such as the current
33695 display radix, which might change the appearance of existing stack
33696 entries. (During a keyboard macro invoked by the @kbd{X} key, refreshing
33697 is suppressed, but a flag is set so that the entire stack will be refreshed
33698 rather than just the top few elements when the macro finishes.)
33699 @end defun
33700
33701 @node Predicates, Computational Lisp Functions, Stack Lisp Functions, Internals
33702 @subsubsection Predicates
33703
33704 @noindent
33705 The functions described here are predicates, that is, they return a
33706 true/false value where @code{nil} means false and anything else means
33707 true. These predicates are expanded by @code{defmath}, for example,
33708 from @code{zerop} to @code{math-zerop}. In many cases they correspond
33709 to native Lisp functions by the same name, but are extended to cover
33710 the full range of Calc data types.
33711
33712 @defun zerop x
33713 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically zero, in any of the Calc data
33714 types. (Note that for some types, such as error forms and intervals,
33715 it never makes sense to return true.) In @code{defmath}, the expression
33716 @samp{(= x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-zerop x)},
33717 and @samp{(/= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-zerop x))}.
33718 @end defun
33719
33720 @defun negp x
33721 Returns true if @var{x} is negative. This accepts negative real numbers
33722 of various types, negative HMS and date forms, and intervals in which
33723 all included values are negative. In @code{defmath}, the expression
33724 @samp{(< x 0)} will automatically be converted to @samp{(math-negp x)},
33725 and @samp{(>= x 0)} will be converted to @samp{(not (math-negp x))}.
33726 @end defun
33727
33728 @defun posp x
33729 Returns true if @var{x} is positive (and non-zero). For complex
33730 numbers, none of these three predicates will return true.
33731 @end defun
33732
33733 @defun looks-negp x
33734 Returns true if @var{x} is ``negative-looking.'' This returns true if
33735 @var{x} is a negative number, or a formula with a leading minus sign
33736 such as @samp{-a/b}. In other words, this is an object which can be
33737 made simpler by calling @code{(- @var{x})}.
33738 @end defun
33739
33740 @defun integerp x
33741 Returns true if @var{x} is an integer of any size.
33742 @end defun
33743
33744 @defun fixnump x
33745 Returns true if @var{x} is a native Lisp integer.
33746 @end defun
33747
33748 @defun natnump x
33749 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative integer of any size.
33750 @end defun
33751
33752 @defun fixnatnump x
33753 Returns true if @var{x} is a nonnegative Lisp integer.
33754 @end defun
33755
33756 @defun num-integerp x
33757 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically an integer, i.e., either a
33758 true integer or a float with no significant digits to the right of
33759 the decimal point.
33760 @end defun
33761
33762 @defun messy-integerp x
33763 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically, but not literally, an integer.
33764 A value is @code{num-integerp} if it is @code{integerp} or
33765 @code{messy-integerp} (but it is never both at once).
33766 @end defun
33767
33768 @defun num-natnump x
33769 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically a nonnegative integer.
33770 @end defun
33771
33772 @defun evenp x
33773 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer.
33774 @end defun
33775
33776 @defun looks-evenp x
33777 Returns true if @var{x} is an even integer, or a formula with a leading
33778 multiplicative coefficient which is an even integer.
33779 @end defun
33780
33781 @defun oddp x
33782 Returns true if @var{x} is an odd integer.
33783 @end defun
33784
33785 @defun ratp x
33786 Returns true if @var{x} is a rational number, i.e., an integer or a
33787 fraction.
33788 @end defun
33789
33790 @defun realp x
33791 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number, i.e., an integer, fraction,
33792 or floating-point number.
33793 @end defun
33794
33795 @defun anglep x
33796 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or HMS form.
33797 @end defun
33798
33799 @defun floatp x
33800 Returns true if @var{x} is a float, or a complex number, error form,
33801 interval, date form, or modulo form in which at least one component
33802 is a float.
33803 @end defun
33804
33805 @defun complexp x
33806 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular or polar complex number
33807 (but not a real number).
33808 @end defun
33809
33810 @defun rect-complexp x
33811 Returns true if @var{x} is a rectangular complex number.
33812 @end defun
33813
33814 @defun polar-complexp x
33815 Returns true if @var{x} is a polar complex number.
33816 @end defun
33817
33818 @defun numberp x
33819 Returns true if @var{x} is a real number or a complex number.
33820 @end defun
33821
33822 @defun scalarp x
33823 Returns true if @var{x} is a real or complex number or an HMS form.
33824 @end defun
33825
33826 @defun vectorp x
33827 Returns true if @var{x} is a vector (this simply checks if its argument
33828 is a list whose first element is the symbol @code{vec}).
33829 @end defun
33830
33831 @defun numvecp x
33832 Returns true if @var{x} is a number or vector.
33833 @end defun
33834
33835 @defun matrixp x
33836 Returns true if @var{x} is a matrix, i.e., a vector of one or more vectors,
33837 all of the same size.
33838 @end defun
33839
33840 @defun square-matrixp x
33841 Returns true if @var{x} is a square matrix.
33842 @end defun
33843
33844 @defun objectp x
33845 Returns true if @var{x} is any numeric Calc object, including real and
33846 complex numbers, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
33847 modulo forms. (Note that error forms and intervals may include formulas
33848 as their components; see @code{constp} below.)
33849 @end defun
33850
33851 @defun objvecp x
33852 Returns true if @var{x} is an object or a vector. This also accepts
33853 incomplete objects, but it rejects variables and formulas (except as
33854 mentioned above for @code{objectp}).
33855 @end defun
33856
33857 @defun primp x
33858 Returns true if @var{x} is a ``primitive'' or ``atomic'' Calc object,
33859 i.e., one whose components cannot be regarded as sub-formulas. This
33860 includes variables, and all @code{objectp} types except error forms
33861 and intervals.
33862 @end defun
33863
33864 @defun constp x
33865 Returns true if @var{x} is constant, i.e., a real or complex number,
33866 HMS form, date form, or error form, interval, or vector all of whose
33867 components are @code{constp}.
33868 @end defun
33869
33870 @defun lessp x y
33871 Returns true if @var{x} is numerically less than @var{y}. Returns false
33872 if @var{x} is greater than or equal to @var{y}, or if the order is
33873 undefined or cannot be determined. Generally speaking, this works
33874 by checking whether @samp{@var{x} - @var{y}} is @code{negp}. In
33875 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(< x y)} will automatically be
33876 converted to @samp{(lessp x y)}; expressions involving @code{>}, @code{<=},
33877 and @code{>=} are similarly converted in terms of @code{lessp}.
33878 @end defun
33879
33880 @defun beforep x y
33881 Returns true if @var{x} comes before @var{y} in a canonical ordering
33882 of Calc objects. If @var{x} and @var{y} are both real numbers, this
33883 will be the same as @code{lessp}. But whereas @code{lessp} considers
33884 other types of objects to be unordered, @code{beforep} puts any two
33885 objects into a definite, consistent order. The @code{beforep}
33886 function is used by the @kbd{V S} vector-sorting command, and also
33887 by Calc's algebraic simplifications to put the terms of a product into
33888 canonical order: This allows @samp{x y + y x} to be simplified easily to
33889 @samp{2 x y}.
33890 @end defun
33891
33892 @defun equal x y
33893 This is the standard Lisp @code{equal} predicate; it returns true if
33894 @var{x} and @var{y} are structurally identical. This is the usual way
33895 to compare numbers for equality, but note that @code{equal} will treat
33896 0 and 0.0 as different.
33897 @end defun
33898
33899 @defun math-equal x y
33900 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y} are numerically equal, either because
33901 they are @code{equal}, or because their difference is @code{zerop}. In
33902 @code{defmath}, the expression @samp{(= x y)} will automatically be
33903 converted to @samp{(math-equal x y)}.
33904 @end defun
33905
33906 @defun equal-int x n
33907 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{n} are numerically equal, where @var{n}
33908 is a fixnum which is not a multiple of 10. This will automatically be
33909 used by @code{defmath} in place of the more general @code{math-equal}
33910 whenever possible.
33911 @end defun
33912
33913 @defun nearly-equal x y
33914 Returns true if @var{x} and @var{y}, as floating-point numbers, are
33915 equal except possibly in the last decimal place. For example,
33916 314.159 and 314.166 are considered nearly equal if the current
33917 precision is 6 (since they differ by 7 units), but not if the current
33918 precision is 7 (since they differ by 70 units). Most functions which
33919 use series expansions use @code{with-extra-prec} to evaluate the
33920 series with 2 extra digits of precision, then use @code{nearly-equal}
33921 to decide when the series has converged; this guards against cumulative
33922 error in the series evaluation without doing extra work which would be
33923 lost when the result is rounded back down to the current precision.
33924 In @code{defmath}, this can be written @samp{(~= @var{x} @var{y})}.
33925 The @var{x} and @var{y} can be numbers of any kind, including complex.
33926 @end defun
33927
33928 @defun nearly-zerop x y
33929 Returns true if @var{x} is nearly zero, compared to @var{y}. This
33930 checks whether @var{x} plus @var{y} would by be @code{nearly-equal}
33931 to @var{y} itself, to within the current precision, in other words,
33932 if adding @var{x} to @var{y} would have a negligible effect on @var{y}
33933 due to roundoff error. @var{X} may be a real or complex number, but
33934 @var{y} must be real.
33935 @end defun
33936
33937 @defun is-true x
33938 Return true if the formula @var{x} represents a true value in
33939 Calc, not Lisp, terms. It tests if @var{x} is a non-zero number
33940 or a provably non-zero formula.
33941 @end defun
33942
33943 @defun reject-arg val pred
33944 Abort the current function evaluation due to unacceptable argument values.
33945 This calls @samp{(calc-record-why @var{pred} @var{val})}, then signals a
33946 Lisp error which @code{normalize} will trap. The net effect is that the
33947 function call which led here will be left in symbolic form.
33948 @end defun
33949
33950 @defun inexact-value
33951 If Symbolic mode is enabled, this will signal an error that causes
33952 @code{normalize} to leave the formula in symbolic form, with the message
33953 ``Inexact result.'' (This function has no effect when not in Symbolic mode.)
33954 Note that if your function calls @samp{(sin 5)} in Symbolic mode, the
33955 @code{sin} function will call @code{inexact-value}, which will cause your
33956 function to be left unsimplified. You may instead wish to call
33957 @samp{(normalize (list 'calcFunc-sin 5))}, which in Symbolic mode will
33958 return the formula @samp{sin(5)} to your function.
33959 @end defun
33960
33961 @defun overflow
33962 This signals an error that will be reported as a floating-point overflow.
33963 @end defun
33964
33965 @defun underflow
33966 This signals a floating-point underflow.
33967 @end defun
33968
33969 @node Computational Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Predicates, Internals
33970 @subsubsection Computational Functions
33971
33972 @noindent
33973 The functions described here do the actual computational work of the
33974 Calculator. In addition to these, note that any function described in
33975 the main body of this manual may be called from Lisp; for example, if
33976 the documentation refers to the @code{calc-sqrt} [@code{sqrt}] command,
33977 this means @code{calc-sqrt} is an interactive stack-based square-root
33978 command and @code{sqrt} (which @code{defmath} expands to @code{calcFunc-sqrt})
33979 is the actual Lisp function for taking square roots.
33980
33981 The functions @code{math-add}, @code{math-sub}, @code{math-mul},
33982 @code{math-div}, @code{math-mod}, and @code{math-neg} are not included
33983 in this list, since @code{defmath} allows you to write native Lisp
33984 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}, and unary @code{-},
33985 respectively, instead.
33986
33987 @defun normalize val
33988 (Full form: @code{math-normalize}.)
33989 Reduce the value @var{val} to standard form. For example, if @var{val}
33990 is a fixnum, it will be converted to a bignum if it is too large, and
33991 if @var{val} is a bignum it will be normalized by clipping off trailing
33992 (i.e., most-significant) zero digits and converting to a fixnum if it is
33993 small. All the various data types are similarly converted to their standard
33994 forms. Variables are left alone, but function calls are actually evaluated
33995 in formulas. For example, normalizing @samp{(+ 2 (calcFunc-abs -4))} will
33996 return 6.
33997
33998 If a function call fails, because the function is void or has the wrong
33999 number of parameters, or because it returns @code{nil} or calls
34000 @code{reject-arg} or @code{inexact-result}, @code{normalize} returns
34001 the formula still in symbolic form.
34002
34003 If the current simplification mode is ``none'' or ``numeric arguments
34004 only,'' @code{normalize} will act appropriately. However, the more
34005 powerful simplification modes (like Algebraic Simplification) are
34006 not handled by @code{normalize}. They are handled by @code{calc-normalize},
34007 which calls @code{normalize} and possibly some other routines, such
34008 as @code{simplify} or @code{simplify-units}. Programs generally will
34009 never call @code{calc-normalize} except when popping or pushing values
34010 on the stack.
34011 @end defun
34012
34013 @defun evaluate-expr expr
34014 Replace all variables in @var{expr} that have values with their values,
34015 then use @code{normalize} to simplify the result. This is what happens
34016 when you press the @kbd{=} key interactively.
34017 @end defun
34018
34019 @defmac with-extra-prec n body
34020 Evaluate the Lisp forms in @var{body} with precision increased by @var{n}
34021 digits. This is a macro which expands to
34022
34023 @smallexample
34024 (math-normalize
34025 (let ((calc-internal-prec (+ calc-internal-prec @var{n})))
34026 @var{body}))
34027 @end smallexample
34028
34029 The surrounding call to @code{math-normalize} causes a floating-point
34030 result to be rounded down to the original precision afterwards. This
34031 is important because some arithmetic operations assume a number's
34032 mantissa contains no more digits than the current precision allows.
34033 @end defmac
34034
34035 @defun make-frac n d
34036 Build a fraction @samp{@var{n}:@var{d}}. This is equivalent to calling
34037 @samp{(normalize (list 'frac @var{n} @var{d}))}, but more efficient.
34038 @end defun
34039
34040 @defun make-float mant exp
34041 Build a floating-point value out of @var{mant} and @var{exp}, both
34042 of which are arbitrary integers. This function will return a
34043 properly normalized float value, or signal an overflow or underflow
34044 if @var{exp} is out of range.
34045 @end defun
34046
34047 @defun make-sdev x sigma
34048 Build an error form out of @var{x} and the absolute value of @var{sigma}.
34049 If @var{sigma} is zero, the result is the number @var{x} directly.
34050 If @var{sigma} is negative or complex, its absolute value is used.
34051 If @var{x} or @var{sigma} is not a valid type of object for use in
34052 error forms, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
34053 @end defun
34054
34055 @defun make-intv mask lo hi
34056 Build an interval form out of @var{mask} (which is assumed to be an
34057 integer from 0 to 3), and the limits @var{lo} and @var{hi}. If
34058 @var{lo} is greater than @var{hi}, an empty interval form is returned.
34059 This calls @code{reject-arg} if @var{lo} or @var{hi} is unsuitable.
34060 @end defun
34061
34062 @defun sort-intv mask lo hi
34063 Build an interval form, similar to @code{make-intv}, except that if
34064 @var{lo} is less than @var{hi} they are simply exchanged, and the
34065 bits of @var{mask} are swapped accordingly.
34066 @end defun
34067
34068 @defun make-mod n m
34069 Build a modulo form out of @var{n} and the modulus @var{m}. Since modulo
34070 forms do not allow formulas as their components, if @var{n} or @var{m}
34071 is not a real number or HMS form the result will be a formula which
34072 is a call to @code{makemod}, the algebraic version of this function.
34073 @end defun
34074
34075 @defun float x
34076 Convert @var{x} to floating-point form. Integers and fractions are
34077 converted to numerically equivalent floats; components of complex
34078 numbers, vectors, HMS forms, date forms, error forms, intervals, and
34079 modulo forms are recursively floated. If the argument is a variable
34080 or formula, this calls @code{reject-arg}.
34081 @end defun
34082
34083 @defun compare x y
34084 Compare the numbers @var{x} and @var{y}, and return @mathit{-1} if
34085 @samp{(lessp @var{x} @var{y})}, 1 if @samp{(lessp @var{y} @var{x})},
34086 0 if @samp{(math-equal @var{x} @var{y})}, or 2 if the order is
34087 undefined or cannot be determined.
34088 @end defun
34089
34090 @defun numdigs n
34091 Return the number of digits of integer @var{n}, effectively
34092 @samp{ceil(log10(@var{n}))}, but much more efficient. Zero is
34093 considered to have zero digits.
34094 @end defun
34095
34096 @defun scale-int x n
34097 Shift integer @var{x} left @var{n} decimal digits, or right @mathit{-@var{n}}
34098 digits with truncation toward zero.
34099 @end defun
34100
34101 @defun scale-rounding x n
34102 Like @code{scale-int}, except that a right shift rounds to the nearest
34103 integer rather than truncating.
34104 @end defun
34105
34106 @defun fixnum n
34107 Return the integer @var{n} as a fixnum, i.e., a native Lisp integer.
34108 If @var{n} is outside the permissible range for Lisp integers (usually
34109 24 binary bits) the result is undefined.
34110 @end defun
34111
34112 @defun sqr x
34113 Compute the square of @var{x}; short for @samp{(* @var{x} @var{x})}.
34114 @end defun
34115
34116 @defun quotient x y
34117 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return an integer quotient
34118 and discard the remainder. If @var{x} or @var{y} is negative, the
34119 direction of rounding is undefined.
34120 @end defun
34121
34122 @defun idiv x y
34123 Perform an integer division; if @var{x} and @var{y} are both nonnegative
34124 integers, this uses the @code{quotient} function, otherwise it computes
34125 @samp{floor(@var{x}/@var{y})}. Thus the result is well-defined but
34126 slower than for @code{quotient}.
34127 @end defun
34128
34129 @defun imod x y
34130 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return the integer remainder
34131 and discard the quotient. Like @code{quotient}, this works only for
34132 integer arguments and is not well-defined for negative arguments.
34133 For a more well-defined result, use @samp{(% @var{x} @var{y})}.
34134 @end defun
34135
34136 @defun idivmod x y
34137 Divide integer @var{x} by integer @var{y}; return a cons cell whose
34138 @code{car} is @samp{(quotient @var{x} @var{y})} and whose @code{cdr}
34139 is @samp{(imod @var{x} @var{y})}.
34140 @end defun
34141
34142 @defun pow x y
34143 Compute @var{x} to the power @var{y}. In @code{defmath} code, this can
34144 also be written @samp{(^ @var{x} @var{y})} or
34145 @w{@samp{(expt @var{x} @var{y})}}.
34146 @end defun
34147
34148 @defun abs-approx x
34149 Compute a fast approximation to the absolute value of @var{x}. For
34150 example, for a rectangular complex number the result is the sum of
34151 the absolute values of the components.
34152 @end defun
34153
34154 @findex e
34155 @findex gamma-const
34156 @findex ln-2
34157 @findex ln-10
34158 @findex phi
34159 @findex pi-over-2
34160 @findex pi-over-4
34161 @findex pi-over-180
34162 @findex sqrt-two-pi
34163 @findex sqrt-e
34164 @findex two-pi
34165 @defun pi
34166 The function @samp{(pi)} computes @samp{pi} to the current precision.
34167 Other related constant-generating functions are @code{two-pi},
34168 @code{pi-over-2}, @code{pi-over-4}, @code{pi-over-180}, @code{sqrt-two-pi},
34169 @code{e}, @code{sqrt-e}, @code{ln-2}, @code{ln-10}, @code{phi} and
34170 @code{gamma-const}. Each function returns a floating-point value in the
34171 current precision, and each uses caching so that all calls after the
34172 first are essentially free.
34173 @end defun
34174
34175 @defmac math-defcache @var{func} @var{initial} @var{form}
34176 This macro, usually used as a top-level call like @code{defun} or
34177 @code{defvar}, defines a new cached constant analogous to @code{pi}, etc.
34178 It defines a function @code{func} which returns the requested value;
34179 if @var{initial} is non-@code{nil} it must be a @samp{(float @dots{})}
34180 form which serves as an initial value for the cache. If @var{func}
34181 is called when the cache is empty or does not have enough digits to
34182 satisfy the current precision, the Lisp expression @var{form} is evaluated
34183 with the current precision increased by four, and the result minus its
34184 two least significant digits is stored in the cache. For example,
34185 calling @samp{(pi)} with a precision of 30 computes @samp{pi} to 34
34186 digits, rounds it down to 32 digits for future use, then rounds it
34187 again to 30 digits for use in the present request.
34188 @end defmac
34189
34190 @findex half-circle
34191 @findex quarter-circle
34192 @defun full-circle symb
34193 If the current angular mode is Degrees or HMS, this function returns the
34194 integer 360. In Radians mode, this function returns either the
34195 corresponding value in radians to the current precision, or the formula
34196 @samp{2*pi}, depending on the Symbolic mode. There are also similar
34197 function @code{half-circle} and @code{quarter-circle}.
34198 @end defun
34199
34200 @defun power-of-2 n
34201 Compute two to the integer power @var{n}, as a (potentially very large)
34202 integer. Powers of two are cached, so only the first call for a
34203 particular @var{n} is expensive.
34204 @end defun
34205
34206 @defun integer-log2 n
34207 Compute the base-2 logarithm of @var{n}, which must be an integer which
34208 is a power of two. If @var{n} is not a power of two, this function will
34209 return @code{nil}.
34210 @end defun
34211
34212 @defun div-mod a b m
34213 Divide @var{a} by @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. This returns @code{nil} if
34214 there is no solution, or if any of the arguments are not integers.
34215 @end defun
34216
34217 @defun pow-mod a b m
34218 Compute @var{a} to the power @var{b}, modulo @var{m}. If @var{a},
34219 @var{b}, and @var{m} are integers, this uses an especially efficient
34220 algorithm. Otherwise, it simply computes @samp{(% (^ a b) m)}.
34221 @end defun
34222
34223 @defun isqrt n
34224 Compute the integer square root of @var{n}. This is the square root
34225 of @var{n} rounded down toward zero, i.e., @samp{floor(sqrt(@var{n}))}.
34226 If @var{n} is itself an integer, the computation is especially efficient.
34227 @end defun
34228
34229 @defun to-hms a ang
34230 Convert the argument @var{a} into an HMS form. If @var{ang} is specified,
34231 it is the angular mode in which to interpret @var{a}, either @code{deg}
34232 or @code{rad}. Otherwise, the current angular mode is used. If @var{a}
34233 is already an HMS form it is returned as-is.
34234 @end defun
34235
34236 @defun from-hms a ang
34237 Convert the HMS form @var{a} into a real number. If @var{ang} is specified,
34238 it is the angular mode in which to express the result, otherwise the
34239 current angular mode is used. If @var{a} is already a real number, it
34240 is returned as-is.
34241 @end defun
34242
34243 @defun to-radians a
34244 Convert the number or HMS form @var{a} to radians from the current
34245 angular mode.
34246 @end defun
34247
34248 @defun from-radians a
34249 Convert the number @var{a} from radians to the current angular mode.
34250 If @var{a} is a formula, this returns the formula @samp{deg(@var{a})}.
34251 @end defun
34252
34253 @defun to-radians-2 a
34254 Like @code{to-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a degrees to
34255 radians conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*pi/180}.
34256 @end defun
34257
34258 @defun from-radians-2 a
34259 Like @code{from-radians}, except that in Symbolic mode a radians to
34260 degrees conversion yields a formula like @samp{@var{a}*180/pi}.
34261 @end defun
34262
34263 @defun random-digit
34264 Produce a random base-1000 digit in the range 0 to 999.
34265 @end defun
34266
34267 @defun random-digits n
34268 Produce a random @var{n}-digit integer; this will be an integer
34269 in the interval @samp{[0, 10^@var{n})}.
34270 @end defun
34271
34272 @defun random-float
34273 Produce a random float in the interval @samp{[0, 1)}.
34274 @end defun
34275
34276 @defun prime-test n iters
34277 Determine whether the integer @var{n} is prime. Return a list which has
34278 one of these forms: @samp{(nil @var{f})} means the number is non-prime
34279 because it was found to be divisible by @var{f}; @samp{(nil)} means it
34280 was found to be non-prime by table look-up (so no factors are known);
34281 @samp{(nil unknown)} means it is definitely non-prime but no factors
34282 are known because @var{n} was large enough that Fermat's probabilistic
34283 test had to be used; @samp{(t)} means the number is definitely prime;
34284 and @samp{(maybe @var{i} @var{p})} means that Fermat's test, after @var{i}
34285 iterations, is @var{p} percent sure that the number is prime. The
34286 @var{iters} parameter is the number of Fermat iterations to use, in the
34287 case that this is necessary. If @code{prime-test} returns ``maybe,''
34288 you can call it again with the same @var{n} to get a greater certainty;
34289 @code{prime-test} remembers where it left off.
34290 @end defun
34291
34292 @defun to-simple-fraction f
34293 If @var{f} is a floating-point number which can be represented exactly
34294 as a small rational number. return that number, else return @var{f}.
34295 For example, 0.75 would be converted to 3:4. This function is very
34296 fast.
34297 @end defun
34298
34299 @defun to-fraction f tol
34300 Find a rational approximation to floating-point number @var{f} to within
34301 a specified tolerance @var{tol}; this corresponds to the algebraic
34302 function @code{frac}, and can be rather slow.
34303 @end defun
34304
34305 @defun quarter-integer n
34306 If @var{n} is an integer or integer-valued float, this function
34307 returns zero. If @var{n} is a half-integer (i.e., an integer plus
34308 @mathit{1:2} or 0.5), it returns 2. If @var{n} is a quarter-integer,
34309 it returns 1 or 3. If @var{n} is anything else, this function
34310 returns @code{nil}.
34311 @end defun
34312
34313 @node Vector Lisp Functions, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Computational Lisp Functions, Internals
34314 @subsubsection Vector Functions
34315
34316 @noindent
34317 The functions described here perform various operations on vectors and
34318 matrices.
34319
34320 @defun math-concat x y
34321 Do a vector concatenation; this operation is written @samp{@var{x} | @var{y}}
34322 in a symbolic formula. @xref{Building Vectors}.
34323 @end defun
34324
34325 @defun vec-length v
34326 Return the length of vector @var{v}. If @var{v} is not a vector, the
34327 result is zero. If @var{v} is a matrix, this returns the number of
34328 rows in the matrix.
34329 @end defun
34330
34331 @defun mat-dimens m
34332 Determine the dimensions of vector or matrix @var{m}. If @var{m} is not
34333 a vector, the result is an empty list. If @var{m} is a plain vector
34334 but not a matrix, the result is a one-element list containing the length
34335 of the vector. If @var{m} is a matrix with @var{r} rows and @var{c} columns,
34336 the result is the list @samp{(@var{r} @var{c})}. Higher-order tensors
34337 produce lists of more than two dimensions. Note that the object
34338 @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} is a vector of vectors not all the same size,
34339 and is treated by this and other Calc routines as a plain vector of two
34340 elements.
34341 @end defun
34342
34343 @defun dimension-error
34344 Abort the current function with a message of ``Dimension error.''
34345 The Calculator will leave the function being evaluated in symbolic
34346 form; this is really just a special case of @code{reject-arg}.
34347 @end defun
34348
34349 @defun build-vector args
34350 Return a Calc vector with @var{args} as elements.
34351 For example, @samp{(build-vector 1 2 3)} returns the Calc vector
34352 @samp{[1, 2, 3]}, stored internally as the list @samp{(vec 1 2 3)}.
34353 @end defun
34354
34355 @defun make-vec obj dims
34356 Return a Calc vector or matrix all of whose elements are equal to
34357 @var{obj}. For example, @samp{(make-vec 27 3 4)} returns a 3x4 matrix
34358 filled with 27's.
34359 @end defun
34360
34361 @defun row-matrix v
34362 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a row matrix, i.e.,
34363 a matrix whose single row is @var{v}. If @var{v} is already a matrix,
34364 leave it alone.
34365 @end defun
34366
34367 @defun col-matrix v
34368 If @var{v} is a plain vector, convert it into a column matrix, i.e., a
34369 matrix with each element of @var{v} as a separate row. If @var{v} is
34370 already a matrix, leave it alone.
34371 @end defun
34372
34373 @defun map-vec f v
34374 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the Calc vector @var{v}. For example,
34375 @samp{(map-vec 'math-floor v)} returns a vector of the floored components
34376 of vector @var{v}.
34377 @end defun
34378
34379 @defun map-vec-2 f a b
34380 Map the Lisp function @var{f} over the two vectors @var{a} and @var{b}.
34381 If @var{a} and @var{b} are vectors of equal length, the result is a
34382 vector of the results of calling @samp{(@var{f} @var{ai} @var{bi})}
34383 for each pair of elements @var{ai} and @var{bi}. If either @var{a} or
34384 @var{b} is a scalar, it is matched with each value of the other vector.
34385 For example, @samp{(map-vec-2 'math-add v 1)} returns the vector @var{v}
34386 with each element increased by one. Note that using @samp{'+} would not
34387 work here, since @code{defmath} does not expand function names everywhere,
34388 just where they are in the function position of a Lisp expression.
34389 @end defun
34390
34391 @defun reduce-vec f v
34392 Reduce the function @var{f} over the vector @var{v}. For example, if
34393 @var{v} is @samp{[10, 20, 30, 40]}, this calls @samp{(f (f (f 10 20) 30) 40)}.
34394 If @var{v} is a matrix, this reduces over the rows of @var{v}.
34395 @end defun
34396
34397 @defun reduce-cols f m
34398 Reduce the function @var{f} over the columns of matrix @var{m}. For
34399 example, if @var{m} is @samp{[[1, 2], [3, 4], [5, 6]]}, the result
34400 is a vector of the two elements @samp{(f (f 1 3) 5)} and @samp{(f (f 2 4) 6)}.
34401 @end defun
34402
34403 @defun mat-row m n
34404 Return the @var{n}th row of matrix @var{m}. This is equivalent to
34405 @samp{(elt m n)}. For a slower but safer version, use @code{mrow}.
34406 (@xref{Extracting Elements}.)
34407 @end defun
34408
34409 @defun mat-col m n
34410 Return the @var{n}th column of matrix @var{m}, in the form of a vector.
34411 The arguments are not checked for correctness.
34412 @end defun
34413
34414 @defun mat-less-row m n
34415 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th row deleted. The
34416 number @var{n} must be in range from 1 to the number of rows in @var{m}.
34417 @end defun
34418
34419 @defun mat-less-col m n
34420 Return a copy of matrix @var{m} with its @var{n}th column deleted.
34421 @end defun
34422
34423 @defun transpose m
34424 Return the transpose of matrix @var{m}.
34425 @end defun
34426
34427 @defun flatten-vector v
34428 Flatten nested vector @var{v} into a vector of scalars. For example,
34429 if @var{v} is @samp{[[1, 2, 3], [4, 5]]} the result is @samp{[1, 2, 3, 4, 5]}.
34430 @end defun
34431
34432 @defun copy-matrix m
34433 If @var{m} is a matrix, return a copy of @var{m}. This maps
34434 @code{copy-sequence} over the rows of @var{m}; in Lisp terms, each
34435 element of the result matrix will be @code{eq} to the corresponding
34436 element of @var{m}, but none of the @code{cons} cells that make up
34437 the structure of the matrix will be @code{eq}. If @var{m} is a plain
34438 vector, this is the same as @code{copy-sequence}.
34439 @end defun
34440
34441 @defun swap-rows m r1 r2
34442 Exchange rows @var{r1} and @var{r2} of matrix @var{m} in-place. In
34443 other words, unlike most of the other functions described here, this
34444 function changes @var{m} itself rather than building up a new result
34445 matrix. The return value is @var{m}, i.e., @samp{(eq (swap-rows m 1 2) m)}
34446 is true, with the side effect of exchanging the first two rows of
34447 @var{m}.
34448 @end defun
34449
34450 @node Symbolic Lisp Functions, Formatting Lisp Functions, Vector Lisp Functions, Internals
34451 @subsubsection Symbolic Functions
34452
34453 @noindent
34454 The functions described here operate on symbolic formulas in the
34455 Calculator.
34456
34457 @defun calc-prepare-selection num
34458 Prepare a stack entry for selection operations. If @var{num} is
34459 omitted, the stack entry containing the cursor is used; otherwise,
34460 it is the number of the stack entry to use. This function stores
34461 useful information about the current stack entry into a set of
34462 variables. @code{calc-selection-cache-num} contains the number of
34463 the stack entry involved (equal to @var{num} if you specified it);
34464 @code{calc-selection-cache-entry} contains the stack entry as a
34465 list (such as @code{calc-top-list} would return with @code{entry}
34466 as the selection mode); and @code{calc-selection-cache-comp} contains
34467 a special ``tagged'' composition (@pxref{Formatting Lisp Functions})
34468 which allows Calc to relate cursor positions in the buffer with
34469 their corresponding sub-formulas.
34470
34471 A slight complication arises in the selection mechanism because
34472 formulas may contain small integers. For example, in the vector
34473 @samp{[1, 2, 1]} the first and last elements are @code{eq} to each
34474 other; selections are recorded as the actual Lisp object that
34475 appears somewhere in the tree of the whole formula, but storing
34476 @code{1} would falsely select both @code{1}'s in the vector. So
34477 @code{calc-prepare-selection} also checks the stack entry and
34478 replaces any plain integers with ``complex number'' lists of the form
34479 @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)}. This list will be displayed the same as a
34480 plain @var{n} and the change will be completely invisible to the
34481 user, but it will guarantee that no two sub-formulas of the stack
34482 entry will be @code{eq} to each other. Next time the stack entry
34483 is involved in a computation, @code{calc-normalize} will replace
34484 these lists with plain numbers again, again invisibly to the user.
34485 @end defun
34486
34487 @defun calc-encase-atoms x
34488 This modifies the formula @var{x} to ensure that each part of the
34489 formula is a unique atom, using the @samp{(cplx @var{n} 0)} trick
34490 described above. This function may use @code{setcar} to modify
34491 the formula in-place.
34492 @end defun
34493
34494 @defun calc-find-selected-part
34495 Find the smallest sub-formula of the current formula that contains
34496 the cursor. This assumes @code{calc-prepare-selection} has been
34497 called already. If the cursor is not actually on any part of the
34498 formula, this returns @code{nil}.
34499 @end defun
34500
34501 @defun calc-change-current-selection selection
34502 Change the currently prepared stack element's selection to
34503 @var{selection}, which should be @code{eq} to some sub-formula
34504 of the stack element, or @code{nil} to unselect the formula.
34505 The stack element's appearance in the Calc buffer is adjusted
34506 to reflect the new selection.
34507 @end defun
34508
34509 @defun calc-find-nth-part expr n
34510 Return the @var{n}th sub-formula of @var{expr}. This function is used
34511 by the selection commands, and (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) treats
34512 sums and products as flat many-element formulas. Thus if @var{expr}
34513 is @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, calling @code{calc-find-nth-part} with
34514 @var{n} equal to four will return @samp{d}.
34515 @end defun
34516
34517 @defun calc-find-parent-formula expr part
34518 Return the sub-formula of @var{expr} which immediately contains
34519 @var{part}. If @var{expr} is @samp{a*b + (c+1)*d} and @var{part}
34520 is @code{eq} to the @samp{c+1} term of @var{expr}, then this function
34521 will return @samp{(c+1)*d}. If @var{part} turns out not to be a
34522 sub-formula of @var{expr}, the function returns @code{nil}. If
34523 @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, the function returns @code{t}.
34524 This function does not take associativity into account.
34525 @end defun
34526
34527 @defun calc-find-assoc-parent-formula expr part
34528 This is the same as @code{calc-find-parent-formula}, except that
34529 (unless @kbd{j b} has been used) it continues widening the selection
34530 to contain a complete level of the formula. Given @samp{a} from
34531 @samp{((a + b) - c) + d}, @code{calc-find-parent-formula} will
34532 return @samp{a + b} but @code{calc-find-assoc-parent-formula} will
34533 return the whole expression.
34534 @end defun
34535
34536 @defun calc-grow-assoc-formula expr part
34537 This expands sub-formula @var{part} of @var{expr} to encompass a
34538 complete level of the formula. If @var{part} and its immediate
34539 parent are not compatible associative operators, or if @kbd{j b}
34540 has been used, this simply returns @var{part}.
34541 @end defun
34542
34543 @defun calc-find-sub-formula expr part
34544 This finds the immediate sub-formula of @var{expr} which contains
34545 @var{part}. It returns an index @var{n} such that
34546 @samp{(calc-find-nth-part @var{expr} @var{n})} would return @var{part}.
34547 If @var{part} is not a sub-formula of @var{expr}, it returns @code{nil}.
34548 If @var{part} is @code{eq} to @var{expr}, it returns @code{t}. This
34549 function does not take associativity into account.
34550 @end defun
34551
34552 @defun calc-replace-sub-formula expr old new
34553 This function returns a copy of formula @var{expr}, with the
34554 sub-formula that is @code{eq} to @var{old} replaced by @var{new}.
34555 @end defun
34556
34557 @defun simplify expr
34558 Simplify the expression @var{expr} by applying Calc's algebraic
34559 simplifications. This always returns a copy of the expression; the
34560 structure @var{expr} points to remains unchanged in memory.
34561
34562 More precisely, here is what @code{simplify} does: The expression is
34563 first normalized and evaluated by calling @code{normalize}. If any
34564 @code{AlgSimpRules} have been defined, they are then applied. Then
34565 the expression is traversed in a depth-first, bottom-up fashion; at
34566 each level, any simplifications that can be made are made until no
34567 further changes are possible. Once the entire formula has been
34568 traversed in this way, it is compared with the original formula (from
34569 before the call to @code{normalize}) and, if it has changed,
34570 the entire procedure is repeated (starting with @code{normalize})
34571 until no further changes occur. Usually only two iterations are
34572 needed: one to simplify the formula, and another to verify that no
34573 further simplifications were possible.
34574 @end defun
34575
34576 @defun simplify-extended expr
34577 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, with additional rules enabled that
34578 help do a more thorough job, while not being entirely ``safe'' in all
34579 circumstances. (For example, this mode will simplify @samp{sqrt(x^2)}
34580 to @samp{x}, which is only valid when @var{x} is positive.) This is
34581 implemented by temporarily binding the variable @code{math-living-dangerously}
34582 to @code{t} (using a @code{let} form) and calling @code{simplify}.
34583 Dangerous simplification rules are written to check this variable
34584 before taking any action.
34585 @end defun
34586
34587 @defun simplify-units expr
34588 Simplify the expression @var{expr}, treating variable names as units
34589 whenever possible. This works by binding the variable
34590 @code{math-simplifying-units} to @code{t} while calling @code{simplify}.
34591 @end defun
34592
34593 @defmac math-defsimplify funcs body
34594 Register a new simplification rule; this is normally called as a top-level
34595 form, like @code{defun} or @code{defmath}. If @var{funcs} is a symbol
34596 (like @code{+} or @code{calcFunc-sqrt}), this simplification rule is
34597 applied to the formulas which are calls to the specified function. Or,
34598 @var{funcs} can be a list of such symbols; the rule applies to all
34599 functions on the list. The @var{body} is written like the body of a
34600 function with a single argument called @code{expr}. The body will be
34601 executed with @code{expr} bound to a formula which is a call to one of
34602 the functions @var{funcs}. If the function body returns @code{nil}, or
34603 if it returns a result @code{equal} to the original @code{expr}, it is
34604 ignored and Calc goes on to try the next simplification rule that applies.
34605 If the function body returns something different, that new formula is
34606 substituted for @var{expr} in the original formula.
34607
34608 At each point in the formula, rules are tried in the order of the
34609 original calls to @code{math-defsimplify}; the search stops after the
34610 first rule that makes a change. Thus later rules for that same
34611 function will not have a chance to trigger until the next iteration
34612 of the main @code{simplify} loop.
34613
34614 Note that, since @code{defmath} is not being used here, @var{body} must
34615 be written in true Lisp code without the conveniences that @code{defmath}
34616 provides. If you prefer, you can have @var{body} simply call another
34617 function (defined with @code{defmath}) which does the real work.
34618
34619 The arguments of a function call will already have been simplified
34620 before any rules for the call itself are invoked. Since a new argument
34621 list is consed up when this happens, this means that the rule's body is
34622 allowed to rearrange the function's arguments destructively if that is
34623 convenient. Here is a typical example of a simplification rule:
34624
34625 @smallexample
34626 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-arcsinh
34627 (or (and (math-looks-negp (nth 1 expr))
34628 (math-neg (list 'calcFunc-arcsinh
34629 (math-neg (nth 1 expr)))))
34630 (and (eq (car-safe (nth 1 expr)) 'calcFunc-sinh)
34631 (or math-living-dangerously
34632 (math-known-realp (nth 1 (nth 1 expr))))
34633 (nth 1 (nth 1 expr)))))
34634 @end smallexample
34635
34636 This is really a pair of rules written with one @code{math-defsimplify}
34637 for convenience; the first replaces @samp{arcsinh(-x)} with
34638 @samp{-arcsinh(x)}, and the second, which is safe only for real @samp{x},
34639 replaces @samp{arcsinh(sinh(x))} with @samp{x}.
34640 @end defmac
34641
34642 @defun common-constant-factor expr
34643 Check @var{expr} to see if it is a sum of terms all multiplied by the
34644 same rational value. If so, return this value. If not, return @code{nil}.
34645 For example, if called on @samp{6x + 9y + 12z}, it would return 3, since
34646 3 is a common factor of all the terms.
34647 @end defun
34648
34649 @defun cancel-common-factor expr factor
34650 Assuming @var{expr} is a sum with @var{factor} as a common factor,
34651 divide each term of the sum by @var{factor}. This is done by
34652 destructively modifying parts of @var{expr}, on the assumption that
34653 it is being used by a simplification rule (where such things are
34654 allowed; see above). For example, consider this built-in rule for
34655 square roots:
34656
34657 @smallexample
34658 (math-defsimplify calcFunc-sqrt
34659 (let ((fac (math-common-constant-factor (nth 1 expr))))
34660 (and fac (not (eq fac 1))
34661 (math-mul (math-normalize (list 'calcFunc-sqrt fac))
34662 (math-normalize
34663 (list 'calcFunc-sqrt
34664 (math-cancel-common-factor
34665 (nth 1 expr) fac)))))))
34666 @end smallexample
34667 @end defun
34668
34669 @defun frac-gcd a b
34670 Compute a ``rational GCD'' of @var{a} and @var{b}, which must both be
34671 rational numbers. This is the fraction composed of the GCD of the
34672 numerators of @var{a} and @var{b}, over the GCD of the denominators.
34673 It is used by @code{common-constant-factor}. Note that the standard
34674 @code{gcd} function uses the LCM to combine the denominators.
34675 @end defun
34676
34677 @defun map-tree func expr many
34678 Try applying Lisp function @var{func} to various sub-expressions of
34679 @var{expr}. Initially, call @var{func} with @var{expr} itself as an
34680 argument. If this returns an expression which is not @code{equal} to
34681 @var{expr}, apply @var{func} again until eventually it does return
34682 @var{expr} with no changes. Then, if @var{expr} is a function call,
34683 recursively apply @var{func} to each of the arguments. This keeps going
34684 until no changes occur anywhere in the expression; this final expression
34685 is returned by @code{map-tree}. Note that, unlike simplification rules,
34686 @var{func} functions may @emph{not} make destructive changes to
34687 @var{expr}. If a third argument @var{many} is provided, it is an
34688 integer which says how many times @var{func} may be applied; the
34689 default, as described above, is infinitely many times.
34690 @end defun
34691
34692 @defun compile-rewrites rules
34693 Compile the rewrite rule set specified by @var{rules}, which should
34694 be a formula that is either a vector or a variable name. If the latter,
34695 the compiled rules are saved so that later @code{compile-rules} calls
34696 for that same variable can return immediately. If there are problems
34697 with the rules, this function calls @code{error} with a suitable
34698 message.
34699 @end defun
34700
34701 @defun apply-rewrites expr crules heads
34702 Apply the compiled rewrite rule set @var{crules} to the expression
34703 @var{expr}. This will make only one rewrite and only checks at the
34704 top level of the expression. The result @code{nil} if no rules
34705 matched, or if the only rules that matched did not actually change
34706 the expression. The @var{heads} argument is optional; if is given,
34707 it should be a list of all function names that (may) appear in
34708 @var{expr}. The rewrite compiler tags each rule with the
34709 rarest-looking function name in the rule; if you specify @var{heads},
34710 @code{apply-rewrites} can use this information to narrow its search
34711 down to just a few rules in the rule set.
34712 @end defun
34713
34714 @defun rewrite-heads expr
34715 Compute a @var{heads} list for @var{expr} suitable for use with
34716 @code{apply-rewrites}, as discussed above.
34717 @end defun
34718
34719 @defun rewrite expr rules many
34720 This is an all-in-one rewrite function. It compiles the rule set
34721 specified by @var{rules}, then uses @code{map-tree} to apply the
34722 rules throughout @var{expr} up to @var{many} (default infinity)
34723 times.
34724 @end defun
34725
34726 @defun match-patterns pat vec not-flag
34727 Given a Calc vector @var{vec} and an uncompiled pattern set or
34728 pattern set variable @var{pat}, this function returns a new vector
34729 of all elements of @var{vec} which do (or don't, if @var{not-flag} is
34730 non-@code{nil}) match any of the patterns in @var{pat}.
34731 @end defun
34732
34733 @defun deriv expr var value symb
34734 Compute the derivative of @var{expr} with respect to variable @var{var}
34735 (which may actually be any sub-expression). If @var{value} is specified,
34736 the derivative is evaluated at the value of @var{var}; otherwise, the
34737 derivative is left in terms of @var{var}. If the expression contains
34738 functions for which no derivative formula is known, new derivative
34739 functions are invented by adding primes to the names; @pxref{Calculus}.
34740 However, if @var{symb} is non-@code{nil}, the presence of nondifferentiable
34741 functions in @var{expr} instead cancels the whole differentiation, and
34742 @code{deriv} returns @code{nil} instead.
34743
34744 Derivatives of an @var{n}-argument function can be defined by
34745 adding a @code{math-derivative-@var{n}} property to the property list
34746 of the symbol for the function's derivative, which will be the
34747 function name followed by an apostrophe. The value of the property
34748 should be a Lisp function; it is called with the same arguments as the
34749 original function call that is being differentiated. It should return
34750 a formula for the derivative. For example, the derivative of @code{ln}
34751 is defined by
34752
34753 @smallexample
34754 (put 'calcFunc-ln\' 'math-derivative-1
34755 (function (lambda (u) (math-div 1 u))))
34756 @end smallexample
34757
34758 The two-argument @code{log} function has two derivatives,
34759 @smallexample
34760 (put 'calcFunc-log\' 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / dx
34761 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34762 (put 'calcFunc-log\'2 'math-derivative-2 ; d(log(x,b)) / db
34763 (function (lambda (x b) ... )))
34764 @end smallexample
34765 @end defun
34766
34767 @defun tderiv expr var value symb
34768 Compute the total derivative of @var{expr}. This is the same as
34769 @code{deriv}, except that variables other than @var{var} are not
34770 assumed to be constant with respect to @var{var}.
34771 @end defun
34772
34773 @defun integ expr var low high
34774 Compute the integral of @var{expr} with respect to @var{var}.
34775 @xref{Calculus}, for further details.
34776 @end defun
34777
34778 @defmac math-defintegral funcs body
34779 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of one argument;
34780 this macro is very similar in format to @code{math-defsimplify}.
34781 The main difference is that here @var{body} is the body of a function
34782 with a single argument @code{u} which is bound to the argument to the
34783 function being integrated, not the function call itself. Also, the
34784 variable of integration is available as @code{math-integ-var}. If
34785 evaluation of the integral requires doing further integrals, the body
34786 should call @samp{(math-integral @var{x})} to find the integral of
34787 @var{x} with respect to @code{math-integ-var}; this function returns
34788 @code{nil} if the integral could not be done. Some examples:
34789
34790 @smallexample
34791 (math-defintegral calcFunc-conj
34792 (let ((int (math-integral u)))
34793 (and int
34794 (list 'calcFunc-conj int))))
34795
34796 (math-defintegral calcFunc-cos
34797 (and (equal u math-integ-var)
34798 (math-from-radians-2 (list 'calcFunc-sin u))))
34799 @end smallexample
34800
34801 In the @code{cos} example, we define only the integral of @samp{cos(x) dx},
34802 relying on the general integration-by-substitution facility to handle
34803 cosines of more complicated arguments. An integration rule should return
34804 @code{nil} if it can't do the integral; if several rules are defined for
34805 the same function, they are tried in order until one returns a non-@code{nil}
34806 result.
34807 @end defmac
34808
34809 @defmac math-defintegral-2 funcs body
34810 Define a rule for integrating a function or functions of two arguments.
34811 This is exactly analogous to @code{math-defintegral}, except that @var{body}
34812 is written as the body of a function with two arguments, @var{u} and
34813 @var{v}.
34814 @end defmac
34815
34816 @defun solve-for lhs rhs var full
34817 Attempt to solve the equation @samp{@var{lhs} = @var{rhs}} by isolating
34818 the variable @var{var} on the lefthand side; return the resulting righthand
34819 side, or @code{nil} if the equation cannot be solved. The variable
34820 @var{var} must appear at least once in @var{lhs} or @var{rhs}. Note that
34821 the return value is a formula which does not contain @var{var}; this is
34822 different from the user-level @code{solve} and @code{finv} functions,
34823 which return a rearranged equation or a functional inverse, respectively.
34824 If @var{full} is non-@code{nil}, a full solution including dummy signs
34825 and dummy integers will be produced. User-defined inverses are provided
34826 as properties in a manner similar to derivatives:
34827
34828 @smallexample
34829 (put 'calcFunc-ln 'math-inverse
34830 (function (lambda (x) (list 'calcFunc-exp x))))
34831 @end smallexample
34832
34833 This function can call @samp{(math-solve-get-sign @var{x})} to create
34834 a new arbitrary sign variable, returning @var{x} times that sign, and
34835 @samp{(math-solve-get-int @var{x})} to create a new arbitrary integer
34836 variable multiplied by @var{x}. These functions simply return @var{x}
34837 if the caller requested a non-``full'' solution.
34838 @end defun
34839
34840 @defun solve-eqn expr var full
34841 This version of @code{solve-for} takes an expression which will
34842 typically be an equation or inequality. (If it is not, it will be
34843 interpreted as the equation @samp{@var{expr} = 0}.) It returns an
34844 equation or inequality, or @code{nil} if no solution could be found.
34845 @end defun
34846
34847 @defun solve-system exprs vars full
34848 This function solves a system of equations. Generally, @var{exprs}
34849 and @var{vars} will be vectors of equal length.
34850 @xref{Solving Systems of Equations}, for other options.
34851 @end defun
34852
34853 @defun expr-contains expr var
34854 Returns a non-@code{nil} value if @var{var} occurs as a subexpression
34855 of @var{expr}.
34856
34857 This function might seem at first to be identical to
34858 @code{calc-find-sub-formula}. The key difference is that
34859 @code{expr-contains} uses @code{equal} to test for matches, whereas
34860 @code{calc-find-sub-formula} uses @code{eq}. In the formula
34861 @samp{f(a, a)}, the two @samp{a}s will be @code{equal} but not
34862 @code{eq} to each other.
34863 @end defun
34864
34865 @defun expr-contains-count expr var
34866 Returns the number of occurrences of @var{var} as a subexpression
34867 of @var{expr}, or @code{nil} if there are no occurrences.
34868 @end defun
34869
34870 @defun expr-depends expr var
34871 Returns true if @var{expr} refers to any variable the occurs in @var{var}.
34872 In other words, it checks if @var{expr} and @var{var} have any variables
34873 in common.
34874 @end defun
34875
34876 @defun expr-contains-vars expr
34877 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables, or @code{nil} if @var{expr}
34878 contains only constants and functions with constant arguments.
34879 @end defun
34880
34881 @defun expr-subst expr old new
34882 Returns a copy of @var{expr}, with all occurrences of @var{old} replaced
34883 by @var{new}. This treats @code{lambda} forms specially with respect
34884 to the dummy argument variables, so that the effect is always to return
34885 @var{expr} evaluated at @var{old} = @var{new}.
34886 @end defun
34887
34888 @defun multi-subst expr old new
34889 This is like @code{expr-subst}, except that @var{old} and @var{new}
34890 are lists of expressions to be substituted simultaneously. If one
34891 list is shorter than the other, trailing elements of the longer list
34892 are ignored.
34893 @end defun
34894
34895 @defun expr-weight expr
34896 Returns the ``weight'' of @var{expr}, basically a count of the total
34897 number of objects and function calls that appear in @var{expr}. For
34898 ``primitive'' objects, this will be one.
34899 @end defun
34900
34901 @defun expr-height expr
34902 Returns the ``height'' of @var{expr}, which is the deepest level to
34903 which function calls are nested. (Note that @samp{@var{a} + @var{b}}
34904 counts as a function call.) For primitive objects, this returns zero.
34905 @end defun
34906
34907 @defun polynomial-p expr var
34908 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable (or sub-expression)
34909 @var{var}. If so, return the degree of the polynomial, that is, the
34910 highest power of @var{var} that appears in @var{expr}. For example,
34911 for @samp{(x^2 + 3)^3 + 4} this would return 6. This function returns
34912 @code{nil} unless @var{expr}, when expanded out by @kbd{a x}
34913 (@code{calc-expand}), would consist of a sum of terms in which @var{var}
34914 appears only raised to nonnegative integer powers. Note that if
34915 @var{var} does not occur in @var{expr}, then @var{expr} is considered
34916 a polynomial of degree 0.
34917 @end defun
34918
34919 @defun is-polynomial expr var degree loose
34920 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in variable or sub-expression
34921 @var{var}, and, if so, return a list representation of the polynomial
34922 where the elements of the list are coefficients of successive powers of
34923 @var{var}: @samp{@var{a} + @var{b} x + @var{c} x^3} would produce the
34924 list @samp{(@var{a} @var{b} 0 @var{c})}, and @samp{(x + 1)^2} would
34925 produce the list @samp{(1 2 1)}. The highest element of the list will
34926 be non-zero, with the special exception that if @var{expr} is the
34927 constant zero, the returned value will be @samp{(0)}. Return @code{nil}
34928 if @var{expr} is not a polynomial in @var{var}. If @var{degree} is
34929 specified, this will not consider polynomials of degree higher than that
34930 value. This is a good precaution because otherwise an input of
34931 @samp{(x+1)^1000} will cause a huge coefficient list to be built. If
34932 @var{loose} is non-@code{nil}, then a looser definition of a polynomial
34933 is used in which coefficients are no longer required not to depend on
34934 @var{var}, but are only required not to take the form of polynomials
34935 themselves. For example, @samp{sin(x) x^2 + cos(x)} is a loose
34936 polynomial with coefficients @samp{((calcFunc-cos x) 0 (calcFunc-sin
34937 x))}. The result will never be @code{nil} in loose mode, since any
34938 expression can be interpreted as a ``constant'' loose polynomial.
34939 @end defun
34940
34941 @defun polynomial-base expr pred
34942 Check if @var{expr} is a polynomial in any variable that occurs in it;
34943 if so, return that variable. (If @var{expr} is a multivariate polynomial,
34944 this chooses one variable arbitrarily.) If @var{pred} is specified, it should
34945 be a Lisp function which is called as @samp{(@var{pred} @var{subexpr})},
34946 and which should return true if @code{mpb-top-expr} (a global name for
34947 the original @var{expr}) is a suitable polynomial in @var{subexpr}.
34948 The default predicate uses @samp{(polynomial-p mpb-top-expr @var{subexpr})};
34949 you can use @var{pred} to specify additional conditions. Or, you could
34950 have @var{pred} build up a list of every suitable @var{subexpr} that
34951 is found.
34952 @end defun
34953
34954 @defun poly-simplify poly
34955 Simplify polynomial coefficient list @var{poly} by (destructively)
34956 clipping off trailing zeros.
34957 @end defun
34958
34959 @defun poly-mix a ac b bc
34960 Mix two polynomial lists @var{a} and @var{b} (in the form returned by
34961 @code{is-polynomial}) in a linear combination with coefficient expressions
34962 @var{ac} and @var{bc}. The result is a (not necessarily simplified)
34963 polynomial list representing @samp{@var{ac} @var{a} + @var{bc} @var{b}}.
34964 @end defun
34965
34966 @defun poly-mul a b
34967 Multiply two polynomial coefficient lists @var{a} and @var{b}. The
34968 result will be in simplified form if the inputs were simplified.
34969 @end defun
34970
34971 @defun build-polynomial-expr poly var
34972 Construct a Calc formula which represents the polynomial coefficient
34973 list @var{poly} applied to variable @var{var}. The @kbd{a c}
34974 (@code{calc-collect}) command uses @code{is-polynomial} to turn an
34975 expression into a coefficient list, then @code{build-polynomial-expr}
34976 to turn the list back into an expression in regular form.
34977 @end defun
34978
34979 @defun check-unit-name var
34980 Check if @var{var} is a variable which can be interpreted as a unit
34981 name. If so, return the units table entry for that unit. This
34982 will be a list whose first element is the unit name (not counting
34983 prefix characters) as a symbol and whose second element is the
34984 Calc expression which defines the unit. (Refer to the Calc sources
34985 for details on the remaining elements of this list.) If @var{var}
34986 is not a variable or is not a unit name, return @code{nil}.
34987 @end defun
34988
34989 @defun units-in-expr-p expr sub-exprs
34990 Return true if @var{expr} contains any variables which can be
34991 interpreted as units. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{t}, the entire
34992 expression is searched. If @var{sub-exprs} is @code{nil}, this
34993 checks whether @var{expr} is directly a units expression.
34994 @end defun
34995
34996 @defun single-units-in-expr-p expr
34997 Check whether @var{expr} contains exactly one units variable. If so,
34998 return the units table entry for the variable. If @var{expr} does
34999 not contain any units, return @code{nil}. If @var{expr} contains
35000 two or more units, return the symbol @code{wrong}.
35001 @end defun
35002
35003 @defun to-standard-units expr which
35004 Convert units expression @var{expr} to base units. If @var{which}
35005 is @code{nil}, use Calc's native base units. Otherwise, @var{which}
35006 can specify a units system, which is a list of two-element lists,
35007 where the first element is a Calc base symbol name and the second
35008 is an expression to substitute for it.
35009 @end defun
35010
35011 @defun remove-units expr
35012 Return a copy of @var{expr} with all units variables replaced by ones.
35013 This expression is generally normalized before use.
35014 @end defun
35015
35016 @defun extract-units expr
35017 Return a copy of @var{expr} with everything but units variables replaced
35018 by ones.
35019 @end defun
35020
35021 @node Formatting Lisp Functions, Hooks, Symbolic Lisp Functions, Internals
35022 @subsubsection I/O and Formatting Functions
35023
35024 @noindent
35025 The functions described here are responsible for parsing and formatting
35026 Calc numbers and formulas.
35027
35028 @defun calc-eval str sep arg1 arg2 @dots{}
35029 This is the simplest interface to the Calculator from another Lisp program.
35030 @xref{Calling Calc from Your Programs}.
35031 @end defun
35032
35033 @defun read-number str
35034 If string @var{str} contains a valid Calc number, either integer,
35035 fraction, float, or HMS form, this function parses and returns that
35036 number. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}.
35037 @end defun
35038
35039 @defun read-expr str
35040 Read an algebraic expression from string @var{str}. If @var{str} does
35041 not have the form of a valid expression, return a list of the form
35042 @samp{(error @var{pos} @var{msg})} where @var{pos} is an integer index
35043 into @var{str} of the general location of the error, and @var{msg} is
35044 a string describing the problem.
35045 @end defun
35046
35047 @defun read-exprs str
35048 Read a list of expressions separated by commas, and return it as a
35049 Lisp list. If an error occurs in any expressions, an error list as
35050 shown above is returned instead.
35051 @end defun
35052
35053 @defun calc-do-alg-entry initial prompt no-norm
35054 Read an algebraic formula or formulas using the minibuffer. All
35055 conventions of regular algebraic entry are observed. The return value
35056 is a list of Calc formulas; there will be more than one if the user
35057 entered a list of values separated by commas. The result is @code{nil}
35058 if the user presses Return with a blank line. If @var{initial} is
35059 given, it is a string which the minibuffer will initially contain.
35060 If @var{prompt} is given, it is the prompt string to use; the default
35061 is ``Algebraic:''. If @var{no-norm} is @code{t}, the formulas will
35062 be returned exactly as parsed; otherwise, they will be passed through
35063 @code{calc-normalize} first.
35064
35065 To support the use of @kbd{$} characters in the algebraic entry, use
35066 @code{let} to bind @code{calc-dollar-values} to a list of the values
35067 to be substituted for @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, and so on, and bind
35068 @code{calc-dollar-used} to 0. Upon return, @code{calc-dollar-used}
35069 will have been changed to the highest number of consecutive @kbd{$}s
35070 that actually appeared in the input.
35071 @end defun
35072
35073 @defun format-number a
35074 Convert the real or complex number or HMS form @var{a} to string form.
35075 @end defun
35076
35077 @defun format-flat-expr a prec
35078 Convert the arbitrary Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form,
35079 in the style used by the trail buffer and the @code{calc-edit} command.
35080 This is a simple format designed
35081 mostly to guarantee the string is of a form that can be re-parsed by
35082 @code{read-expr}. Most formatting modes, such as digit grouping,
35083 complex number format, and point character, are ignored to ensure the
35084 result will be re-readable. The @var{prec} parameter is normally 0; if
35085 you pass a large integer like 1000 instead, the expression will be
35086 surrounded by parentheses unless it is a plain number or variable name.
35087 @end defun
35088
35089 @defun format-nice-expr a width
35090 This is like @code{format-flat-expr} (with @var{prec} equal to 0),
35091 except that newlines will be inserted to keep lines down to the
35092 specified @var{width}, and vectors that look like matrices or rewrite
35093 rules are written in a pseudo-matrix format. The @code{calc-edit}
35094 command uses this when only one stack entry is being edited.
35095 @end defun
35096
35097 @defun format-value a width
35098 Convert the Calc number or formula @var{a} to string form, using the
35099 format seen in the stack buffer. Beware the string returned may
35100 not be re-readable by @code{read-expr}, for example, because of digit
35101 grouping. Multi-line objects like matrices produce strings that
35102 contain newline characters to separate the lines. The @var{w}
35103 parameter, if given, is the target window size for which to format
35104 the expressions. If @var{w} is omitted, the width of the Calculator
35105 window is used.
35106 @end defun
35107
35108 @defun compose-expr a prec
35109 Format the Calc number or formula @var{a} according to the current
35110 language mode, returning a ``composition.'' To learn about the
35111 structure of compositions, see the comments in the Calc source code.
35112 You can specify the format of a given type of function call by putting
35113 a @code{math-compose-@var{lang}} property on the function's symbol,
35114 whose value is a Lisp function that takes @var{a} and @var{prec} as
35115 arguments and returns a composition. Here @var{lang} is a language
35116 mode name, one of @code{normal}, @code{big}, @code{c}, @code{pascal},
35117 @code{fortran}, @code{tex}, @code{eqn}, @code{math}, or @code{maple}.
35118 In Big mode, Calc actually tries @code{math-compose-big} first, then
35119 tries @code{math-compose-normal}. If this property does not exist,
35120 or if the function returns @code{nil}, the function is written in the
35121 normal function-call notation for that language.
35122 @end defun
35123
35124 @defun composition-to-string c w
35125 Convert a composition structure returned by @code{compose-expr} into
35126 a string. Multi-line compositions convert to strings containing
35127 newline characters. The target window size is given by @var{w}.
35128 The @code{format-value} function basically calls @code{compose-expr}
35129 followed by @code{composition-to-string}.
35130 @end defun
35131
35132 @defun comp-width c
35133 Compute the width in characters of composition @var{c}.
35134 @end defun
35135
35136 @defun comp-height c
35137 Compute the height in lines of composition @var{c}.
35138 @end defun
35139
35140 @defun comp-ascent c
35141 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is on or
35142 above the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be one.
35143 @end defun
35144
35145 @defun comp-descent c
35146 Compute the portion of the height of composition @var{c} which is below
35147 the baseline. For a one-line composition, this will be zero.
35148 @end defun
35149
35150 @defun comp-first-char c
35151 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the first
35152 (leftmost) character of the composition as an integer. Otherwise,
35153 return @code{nil}.
35154 @end defun
35155
35156 @defun comp-last-char c
35157 If composition @var{c} is a ``flat'' composition, return the last
35158 (rightmost) character, otherwise return @code{nil}.
35159 @end defun
35160
35161 @comment @node Lisp Variables, Hooks, Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
35162 @comment @subsubsection Lisp Variables
35163 @comment
35164 @comment @noindent
35165 @comment (This section is currently unfinished.)
35166
35167 @node Hooks, , Formatting Lisp Functions, Internals
35168 @subsubsection Hooks
35169
35170 @noindent
35171 Hooks are variables which contain Lisp functions (or lists of functions)
35172 which are called at various times. Calc defines a number of hooks
35173 that help you to customize it in various ways. Calc uses the Lisp
35174 function @code{run-hooks} to invoke the hooks shown below. Several
35175 other customization-related variables are also described here.
35176
35177 @defvar calc-load-hook
35178 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc.el}, after the file has
35179 been loaded, before any functions in it have been called, but after
35180 @code{calc-mode-map} and similar variables have been set up.
35181 @end defvar
35182
35183 @defvar calc-ext-load-hook
35184 This hook is called at the end of @file{calc-ext.el}.
35185 @end defvar
35186
35187 @defvar calc-start-hook
35188 This hook is called as the last step in a @kbd{M-x calc} command.
35189 At this point, the Calc buffer has been created and initialized if
35190 necessary, the Calc window and trail window have been created,
35191 and the ``Welcome to Calc'' message has been displayed.
35192 @end defvar
35193
35194 @defvar calc-mode-hook
35195 This hook is called when the Calc buffer is being created. Usually
35196 this will only happen once per Emacs session. The hook is called
35197 after Emacs has switched to the new buffer, the mode-settings file
35198 has been read if necessary, and all other buffer-local variables
35199 have been set up. After this hook returns, Calc will perform a
35200 @code{calc-refresh} operation, set up the mode line display, then
35201 evaluate any deferred @code{calc-define} properties that have not
35202 been evaluated yet.
35203 @end defvar
35204
35205 @defvar calc-trail-mode-hook
35206 This hook is called when the Calc Trail buffer is being created.
35207 It is called as the very last step of setting up the Trail buffer.
35208 Like @code{calc-mode-hook}, this will normally happen only once
35209 per Emacs session.
35210 @end defvar
35211
35212 @defvar calc-end-hook
35213 This hook is called by @code{calc-quit}, generally because the user
35214 presses @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x * c} while in Calc. The Calc buffer will
35215 be the current buffer. The hook is called as the very first
35216 step, before the Calc window is destroyed.
35217 @end defvar
35218
35219 @defvar calc-window-hook
35220 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc window.
35221 Upon return, this new Calc window should be the current window.
35222 (The Calc buffer will already be the current buffer when the
35223 hook is called.) If the hook is not defined, Calc will
35224 generally use @code{split-window}, @code{set-window-buffer},
35225 and @code{select-window} to create the Calc window.
35226 @end defvar
35227
35228 @defvar calc-trail-window-hook
35229 If this hook is non-@code{nil}, it is called to create the Calc Trail
35230 window. The variable @code{calc-trail-buffer} will contain the buffer
35231 which the window should use. Unlike @code{calc-window-hook}, this hook
35232 must @emph{not} switch into the new window.
35233 @end defvar
35234
35235 @defvar calc-embedded-mode-hook
35236 This hook is called the first time that Embedded mode is entered.
35237 @end defvar
35238
35239 @defvar calc-embedded-new-buffer-hook
35240 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is entered in a
35241 new buffer.
35242 @end defvar
35243
35244 @defvar calc-embedded-new-formula-hook
35245 This hook is called each time that Embedded mode is enabled for a
35246 new formula.
35247 @end defvar
35248
35249 @defvar calc-edit-mode-hook
35250 This hook is called by @code{calc-edit} (and the other ``edit''
35251 commands) when the temporary editing buffer is being created.
35252 The buffer will have been selected and set up to be in
35253 @code{calc-edit-mode}, but will not yet have been filled with
35254 text. (In fact it may still have leftover text from a previous
35255 @code{calc-edit} command.)
35256 @end defvar
35257
35258 @defvar calc-mode-save-hook
35259 This hook is called by the @code{calc-save-modes} command,
35260 after Calc's own mode features have been inserted into the
35261 Calc init file and just before the ``End of mode settings''
35262 message is inserted.
35263 @end defvar
35264
35265 @defvar calc-reset-hook
35266 This hook is called after @kbd{C-x * 0} (@code{calc-reset}) has
35267 reset all modes. The Calc buffer will be the current buffer.
35268 @end defvar
35269
35270 @defvar calc-other-modes
35271 This variable contains a list of strings. The strings are
35272 concatenated at the end of the modes portion of the Calc
35273 mode line (after standard modes such as ``Deg'', ``Inv'' and
35274 ``Hyp''). Each string should be a short, single word followed
35275 by a space. The variable is @code{nil} by default.
35276 @end defvar
35277
35278 @defvar calc-mode-map
35279 This is the keymap that is used by Calc mode. The best time
35280 to adjust it is probably in a @code{calc-mode-hook}. If the
35281 Calc extensions package (@file{calc-ext.el}) has not yet been
35282 loaded, many of these keys will be bound to @code{calc-missing-key},
35283 which is a command that loads the extensions package and
35284 ``retypes'' the key. If your @code{calc-mode-hook} rebinds
35285 one of these keys, it will probably be overridden when the
35286 extensions are loaded.
35287 @end defvar
35288
35289 @defvar calc-digit-map
35290 This is the keymap that is used during numeric entry. Numeric
35291 entry uses the minibuffer, but this map binds every non-numeric
35292 key to @code{calcDigit-nondigit} which generally calls
35293 @code{exit-minibuffer} and ``retypes'' the key.
35294 @end defvar
35295
35296 @defvar calc-alg-ent-map
35297 This is the keymap that is used during algebraic entry. This is
35298 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-map}.
35299 @end defvar
35300
35301 @defvar calc-store-var-map
35302 This is the keymap that is used during entry of variable names for
35303 commands like @code{calc-store} and @code{calc-recall}. This is
35304 mostly a copy of @code{minibuffer-local-completion-map}.
35305 @end defvar
35306
35307 @defvar calc-edit-mode-map
35308 This is the (sparse) keymap used by @code{calc-edit} and other
35309 temporary editing commands. It binds @key{RET}, @key{LFD},
35310 and @kbd{C-c C-c} to @code{calc-edit-finish}.
35311 @end defvar
35312
35313 @defvar calc-mode-var-list
35314 This is a list of variables which are saved by @code{calc-save-modes}.
35315 Each entry is a list of two items, the variable (as a Lisp symbol)
35316 and its default value. When modes are being saved, each variable
35317 is compared with its default value (using @code{equal}) and any
35318 non-default variables are written out.
35319 @end defvar
35320
35321 @defvar calc-local-var-list
35322 This is a list of variables which should be buffer-local to the
35323 Calc buffer. Each entry is a variable name (as a Lisp symbol).
35324 These variables also have their default values manipulated by
35325 the @code{calc} and @code{calc-quit} commands; @pxref{Multiple Calculators}.
35326 Since @code{calc-mode-hook} is called after this list has been
35327 used the first time, your hook should add a variable to the
35328 list and also call @code{make-local-variable} itself.
35329 @end defvar
35330
35331 @node Copying, GNU Free Documentation License, Programming, Top
35332 @appendix GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE
35333 @include gpl.texi
35334
35335 @node GNU Free Documentation License, Customizing Calc, Copying, Top
35336 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
35337 @include doclicense.texi
35338
35339 @node Customizing Calc, Reporting Bugs, GNU Free Documentation License, Top
35340 @appendix Customizing Calc
35341
35342 The usual prefix for Calc is the key sequence @kbd{C-x *}. If you wish
35343 to use a different prefix, you can put
35344
35345 @example
35346 (global-set-key "NEWPREFIX" 'calc-dispatch)
35347 @end example
35348
35349 @noindent
35350 in your .emacs file.
35351 (@xref{Key Bindings,,Customizing Key Bindings,emacs,
35352 The GNU Emacs Manual}, for more information on binding keys.)
35353 A convenient way to start Calc is with @kbd{C-x * *}; to make it equally
35354 convenient for users who use a different prefix, the prefix can be
35355 followed by @kbd{=}, @kbd{&}, @kbd{#}, @kbd{\}, @kbd{/}, @kbd{+} or
35356 @kbd{-} as well as @kbd{*} to start Calc, and so in many cases the last
35357 character of the prefix can simply be typed twice.
35358
35359 Calc is controlled by many variables, most of which can be reset
35360 from within Calc. Some variables are less involved with actual
35361 calculation and can be set outside of Calc using Emacs's
35362 customization facilities. These variables are listed below.
35363 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-variable RET @var{variable-name} RET}
35364 will bring up a buffer in which the variable's value can be redefined.
35365 Typing @kbd{M-x customize-group RET calc RET} will bring up a buffer which
35366 contains all of Calc's customizable variables. (These variables can
35367 also be reset by putting the appropriate lines in your .emacs file;
35368 @xref{Init File, ,Init File, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}.)
35369
35370 Some of the customizable variables are regular expressions. A regular
35371 expression is basically a pattern that Calc can search for.
35372 See @ref{Regexp Search,, Regular Expression Search, emacs, The GNU Emacs Manual}
35373 to see how regular expressions work.
35374
35375 @defvar calc-settings-file
35376 The variable @code{calc-settings-file} holds the file name in
35377 which commands like @kbd{m m} and @kbd{Z P} store ``permanent''
35378 definitions.
35379 If @code{calc-settings-file} is not your user init file (typically
35380 @file{~/.emacs}) and if the variable @code{calc-loaded-settings-file} is
35381 @code{nil}, then Calc will automatically load your settings file (if it
35382 exists) the first time Calc is invoked.
35383
35384 The default value for this variable is @code{"~/.emacs.d/calc.el"}
35385 unless the file @file{~/.calc.el} exists, in which case the default
35386 value will be @code{"~/.calc.el"}.
35387 @end defvar
35388
35389 @defvar calc-gnuplot-name
35390 See @ref{Graphics}.@*
35391 The variable @code{calc-gnuplot-name} should be the name of the
35392 GNUPLOT program (a string). If you have GNUPLOT installed on your
35393 system but Calc is unable to find it, you may need to set this
35394 variable. You may also need to set some Lisp variables to show Calc how
35395 to run GNUPLOT on your system, see @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices} .
35396 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-name} is @code{"gnuplot"}.
35397 @end defvar
35398
35399 @defvar calc-gnuplot-plot-command
35400 @defvarx calc-gnuplot-print-command
35401 See @ref{Devices, ,Graphical Devices}.@*
35402 The variables @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} and
35403 @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} represent system commands to
35404 display and print the output of GNUPLOT, respectively. These may be
35405 @code{nil} if no command is necessary, or strings which can include
35406 @samp{%s} to signify the name of the file to be displayed or printed.
35407 Or, these variables may contain Lisp expressions which are evaluated
35408 to display or print the output.
35409
35410 The default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-plot-command} is @code{nil},
35411 and the default value of @code{calc-gnuplot-print-command} is
35412 @code{"lp %s"}.
35413 @end defvar
35414
35415 @defvar calc-language-alist
35416 See @ref{Basic Embedded Mode}.@*
35417 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} controls the languages that
35418 Calc will associate with major modes. When Calc embedded mode is
35419 enabled, it will try to use the current major mode to
35420 determine what language should be used. (This can be overridden using
35421 Calc's mode changing commands, @xref{Mode Settings in Embedded Mode}.)
35422 The variable @code{calc-language-alist} consists of a list of pairs of
35423 the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} . @var{LANGUAGE})}; for example,
35424 @code{(latex-mode . latex)} is one such pair. If Calc embedded is
35425 activated in a buffer whose major mode is @var{MAJOR-MODE}, it will set itself
35426 to use the language @var{LANGUAGE}.
35427
35428 The default value of @code{calc-language-alist} is
35429 @example
35430 ((latex-mode . latex)
35431 (tex-mode . tex)
35432 (plain-tex-mode . tex)
35433 (context-mode . tex)
35434 (nroff-mode . eqn)
35435 (pascal-mode . pascal)
35436 (c-mode . c)
35437 (c++-mode . c)
35438 (fortran-mode . fortran)
35439 (f90-mode . fortran))
35440 @end example
35441 @end defvar
35442
35443 @defvar calc-embedded-announce-formula
35444 @defvarx calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist
35445 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35446 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} helps determine
35447 what formulas @kbd{C-x * a} will activate in a buffer. It is a
35448 regular expression, and when activating embedded formulas with
35449 @kbd{C-x * a}, it will tell Calc that what follows is a formula to be
35450 activated. (Calc also uses other patterns to find formulas, such as
35451 @samp{=>} and @samp{:=}.)
35452
35453 The default pattern is @code{"%Embed\n\\(% .*\n\\)*"}, which checks
35454 for @samp{%Embed} followed by any number of lines beginning with
35455 @samp{%} and a space.
35456
35457 The variable @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist} is used to
35458 set @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula} to different regular
35459 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35460 It consists of a list of pairs of the form @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} .
35461 @var{REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35462 @example
35463 ((c++-mode . "//Embed\n\\(// .*\n\\)*")
35464 (c-mode . "/\\*Embed\\*/\n\\(/\\* .*\\*/\n\\)*")
35465 (f90-mode . "!Embed\n\\(! .*\n\\)*")
35466 (fortran-mode . "C Embed\n\\(C .*\n\\)*")
35467 (html-helper-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35468 (html-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35469 (nroff-mode . "\\\\\"Embed\n\\(\\\\\" .*\n\\)*")
35470 (pascal-mode . "@{Embed@}\n\\(@{.*@}\n\\)*")
35471 (sgml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35472 (xml-mode . "<!-- Embed -->\n\\(<!-- .* -->\n\\)*")
35473 (texinfo-mode . "@@c Embed\n\\(@@c .*\n\\)*"))
35474 @end example
35475 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35476 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35477 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35478 @end defvar
35479
35480 @defvar calc-embedded-open-formula
35481 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-formula
35482 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist
35483 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35484 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35485 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} control the region that Calc will
35486 activate as a formula when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x * e}.
35487 They are regular expressions;
35488 Calc normally scans backward and forward in the buffer for the
35489 nearest text matching these regular expressions to be the ``formula
35490 delimiters''.
35491
35492 The simplest delimiters are blank lines. Other delimiters that
35493 Embedded mode understands by default are:
35494 @enumerate
35495 @item
35496 The @TeX{} and @LaTeX{} math delimiters @samp{$ $}, @samp{$$ $$},
35497 @samp{\[ \]}, and @samp{\( \)};
35498 @item
35499 Lines beginning with @samp{\begin} and @samp{\end} (except matrix delimiters);
35500 @item
35501 Lines beginning with @samp{@@} (Texinfo delimiters).
35502 @item
35503 Lines beginning with @samp{.EQ} and @samp{.EN} (@dfn{eqn} delimiters);
35504 @item
35505 Lines containing a single @samp{%} or @samp{.\"} symbol and nothing else.
35506 @end enumerate
35507
35508 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-formula-alist} is used to
35509 set @code{calc-embedded-open-formula} and
35510 @code{calc-embedded-close-formula} to different regular
35511 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35512 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35513 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-FORMULA-REGEXP}
35514 @var{CLOSE-FORMULA-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35515 @code{nil}.
35516 @end defvar
35517
35518 @defvar calc-embedded-word-regexp
35519 @defvarx calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist
35520 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35521 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} determines the expression
35522 that Calc will activate when Embedded mode is entered with @kbd{C-x *
35523 w}. It is a regular expressions.
35524
35525 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} is
35526 @code{"[-+]?[0-9]+\\(\\.[0-9]+\\)?\\([eE][-+]?[0-9]+\\)?"}.
35527
35528 The variable @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp-alist} is used to
35529 set @code{calc-embedded-word-regexp} to a different regular
35530 expression depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35531 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35532 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{WORD-REGEXP})}, and its default value is
35533 @code{nil}.
35534 @end defvar
35535
35536 @defvar calc-embedded-open-plain
35537 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-plain
35538 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist
35539 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35540 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35541 @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} are used to delimit ``plain''
35542 formulas. Note that these are actual strings, not regular
35543 expressions, because Calc must be able to write these string into a
35544 buffer as well as to recognize them.
35545
35546 The default string for @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} is
35547 @code{"%%% "}, note the trailing space. The default string for
35548 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} is @code{" %%%\n"}, without
35549 the trailing newline here, the first line of a Big mode formula
35550 that followed might be shifted over with respect to the other lines.
35551
35552 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist} is used to
35553 set @code{calc-embedded-open-plain} and
35554 @code{calc-embedded-close-plain} to different strings
35555 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35556 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35557 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-PLAIN-STRING}
35558 @var{CLOSE-PLAIN-STRING})}, and its default value is
35559 @example
35560 ((c++-mode "// %% " " %%\n")
35561 (c-mode "/* %% " " %% */\n")
35562 (f90-mode "! %% " " %%\n")
35563 (fortran-mode "C %% " " %%\n")
35564 (html-helper-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35565 (html-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35566 (nroff-mode "\\\" %% " " %%\n")
35567 (pascal-mode "@{%% " " %%@}\n")
35568 (sgml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35569 (xml-mode "<!-- %% " " %% -->\n")
35570 (texinfo-mode "@@c %% " " %%\n"))
35571 @end example
35572 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}
35573 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35574 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}.
35575 @end defvar
35576
35577 @defvar calc-embedded-open-new-formula
35578 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-new-formula
35579 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist
35580 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35581 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35582 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} are strings which are
35583 inserted before and after a new formula when you type @kbd{C-x * f}.
35584
35585 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} is
35586 @code{"\n\n"}. If this string begins with a newline character and the
35587 @kbd{C-x * f} is typed at the beginning of a line, @kbd{C-x * f} will skip
35588 this first newline to avoid introducing unnecessary blank lines in the
35589 file. The default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} is
35590 also @code{"\n\n"}. The final newline is omitted by @w{@kbd{C-x * f}}
35591 if typed at the end of a line. (It follows that if @kbd{C-x * f} is
35592 typed on a blank line, both a leading opening newline and a trailing
35593 closing newline are omitted.)
35594
35595 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-new-formula-alist} is used to
35596 set @code{calc-embedded-open-new-formula} and
35597 @code{calc-embedded-close-new-formula} to different strings
35598 depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35599 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35600 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-NEW-FORMULA-STRING}
35601 @var{CLOSE-NEW-FORMULA-STRING})}, and its default value is
35602 @code{nil}.
35603 @end defvar
35604
35605 @defvar calc-embedded-open-mode
35606 @defvarx calc-embedded-close-mode
35607 @defvarx calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist
35608 See @ref{Customizing Embedded Mode}.@*
35609 The variables @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35610 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} are strings which Calc will place before
35611 and after any mode annotations that it inserts. Calc never scans for
35612 these strings; Calc always looks for the annotation itself, so it is not
35613 necessary to add them to user-written annotations.
35614
35615 The default value of @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} is @code{"% "}
35616 and the default value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} is
35617 @code{"\n"}.
35618 If you change the value of @code{calc-embedded-close-mode}, it is a good
35619 idea still to end with a newline so that mode annotations will appear on
35620 lines by themselves.
35621
35622 The variable @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist} is used to
35623 set @code{calc-embedded-open-mode} and
35624 @code{calc-embedded-close-mode} to different strings
35625 expressions depending on the major mode of the editing buffer.
35626 It consists of a list of lists of the form
35627 @code{(@var{MAJOR-MODE} @var{OPEN-MODE-STRING}
35628 @var{CLOSE-MODE-STRING})}, and its default value is
35629 @example
35630 ((c++-mode "// " "\n")
35631 (c-mode "/* " " */\n")
35632 (f90-mode "! " "\n")
35633 (fortran-mode "C " "\n")
35634 (html-helper-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35635 (html-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35636 (nroff-mode "\\\" " "\n")
35637 (pascal-mode "@{ " " @}\n")
35638 (sgml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35639 (xml-mode "<!-- " " -->\n")
35640 (texinfo-mode "@@c " "\n"))
35641 @end example
35642 Any major modes added to @code{calc-embedded-open-close-mode-alist}
35643 should also be added to @code{calc-embedded-announce-formula-alist}
35644 and @code{calc-embedded-open-close-plain-alist}.
35645 @end defvar
35646
35647 @defvar calc-lu-power-reference
35648 @defvarx calc-lu-field-reference
35649 See @ref{Logarithmic Units}.@*
35650 The variables @code{calc-lu-power-reference} and
35651 @code{calc-lu-field-reference} are unit expressions (written as
35652 strings) which Calc will use as reference quantities for logarithmic
35653 units.
35654
35655 The default value of @code{calc-lu-power-reference} is @code{"mW"}
35656 and the default value of @code{calc-lu-field-reference} is
35657 @code{"20 uPa"}.
35658 @end defvar
35659
35660 @defvar calc-note-threshold
35661 See @ref{Musical Notes}.@*
35662 The variable @code{calc-note-threshold} is a number (written as a
35663 string) which determines how close (in cents) a frequency needs to be
35664 to a note to be recognized as that note.
35665
35666 The default value of @code{calc-note-threshold} is 1.
35667 @end defvar
35668
35669 @defvar calc-highlight-selections-with-faces
35670 @defvarx calc-selected-face
35671 @defvarx calc-nonselected-face
35672 See @ref{Displaying Selections}.@*
35673 The variable @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces}
35674 determines how selected sub-formulas are distinguished.
35675 If @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is nil, then
35676 a selected sub-formula is distinguished either by changing every
35677 character not part of the sub-formula with a dot or by changing every
35678 character in the sub-formula with a @samp{#} sign.
35679 If @code{calc-highlight-selections-with-faces} is t,
35680 then a selected sub-formula is distinguished either by displaying the
35681 non-selected portion of the formula with @code{calc-nonselected-face}
35682 or by displaying the selected sub-formula with
35683 @code{calc-nonselected-face}.
35684 @end defvar
35685
35686 @defvar calc-multiplication-has-precedence
35687 The variable @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} determines
35688 whether multiplication has precedence over division in algebraic
35689 formulas in normal language modes. If
35690 @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is non-@code{nil}, then
35691 multiplication has precedence (and, for certain obscure reasons, is
35692 right associative), and so for example @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted
35693 as @samp{a/(b*c)}. If @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is
35694 @code{nil}, then multiplication has the same precedence as division
35695 (and, like division, is left associative), and so for example
35696 @samp{a/b*c} will be interpreted as @samp{(a/b)*c}. The default value
35697 of @code{calc-multiplication-has-precedence} is @code{t}.
35698 @end defvar
35699
35700 @defvar calc-ensure-consistent-units
35701 When converting units, the variable @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units}
35702 determines whether or not the target units need to be consistent with the
35703 original units. If @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} is @code{nil}, then
35704 the target units don't need to have the same dimensions as the original units;
35705 for example, converting @samp{100 ft/s} to @samp{m} will produce @samp{30.48 m/s}.
35706 If @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units} is non-@code{nil}, then the target units
35707 need to have the same dimensions as the original units; for example, converting
35708 @samp{100 ft/s} to @samp{m} will result in an error, since @samp{ft/s} and @samp{m}
35709 have different dimensions. The default value of @code{calc-ensure-consistent-units}
35710 is @code{nil}.
35711 @end defvar
35712
35713 @defvar calc-context-sensitive-enter
35714 The commands @code{calc-enter} and @code{calc-pop} will typically
35715 duplicate the top of the stack. If
35716 @code{calc-context-sensitive-enter} is non-@code{nil}, then the
35717 @code{calc-enter} will copy the element at the cursor to the
35718 top of the stack and @code{calc-pop} will delete the element at the
35719 cursor. The default value of @code{calc-context-sensitive-enter} is
35720 @code{nil}.
35721 @end defvar
35722
35723 @defvar calc-undo-length
35724 The variable @code{calc-undo-length} determines the number of undo
35725 steps that Calc will keep track of when @code{calc-quit} is called.
35726 If @code{calc-undo-length} is a non-negative integer, then this is the
35727 number of undo steps that will be preserved; if
35728 @code{calc-undo-length} has any other value, then all undo steps will
35729 be preserved. The default value of @code{calc-undo-length} is @expr{100}.
35730 @end defvar
35731
35732 @defvar calc-gregorian-switch
35733 See @ref{Date Forms}.@*
35734 The variable @code{calc-gregorian-switch} is either a list of integers
35735 @code{(@var{YEAR} @var{MONTH} @var{DAY})} or @code{nil}.
35736 If it is @code{nil}, then Calc's date forms always represent Gregorian dates.
35737 Otherwise, @code{calc-gregorian-switch} represents the date that the
35738 calendar switches from Julian dates to Gregorian dates;
35739 @code{(@var{YEAR} @var{MONTH} @var{DAY})} will be the first Gregorian
35740 date. The customization buffer will offer several standard dates to
35741 choose from, or the user can enter their own date.
35742
35743 The default value of @code{calc-gregorian-switch} is @code{nil}.
35744 @end defvar
35745
35746 @node Reporting Bugs, Summary, Customizing Calc, Top
35747 @appendix Reporting Bugs
35748
35749 @noindent
35750 If you find a bug in Calc, send e-mail to Jay Belanger,
35751
35752 @example
35753 jay.p.belanger@@gmail.com
35754 @end example
35755
35756 @noindent
35757 There is an automatic command @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug} which helps
35758 you to report bugs. This command prompts you for a brief subject
35759 line, then leaves you in a mail editing buffer. Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to
35760 send your mail. Make sure your subject line indicates that you are
35761 reporting a Calc bug; this command sends mail to the maintainer's
35762 regular mailbox.
35763
35764 If you have suggestions for additional features for Calc, please send
35765 them. Some have dared to suggest that Calc is already top-heavy with
35766 features; this obviously cannot be the case, so if you have ideas, send
35767 them right in.
35768
35769 At the front of the source file, @file{calc.el}, is a list of ideas for
35770 future work. If any enthusiastic souls wish to take it upon themselves
35771 to work on these, please send a message (using @kbd{M-x report-calc-bug})
35772 so any efforts can be coordinated.
35773
35774 The latest version of Calc is available from Savannah, in the Emacs
35775 repository. See @uref{http://savannah.gnu.org/projects/emacs}.
35776
35777 @c [summary]
35778 @node Summary, Key Index, Reporting Bugs, Top
35779 @appendix Calc Summary
35780
35781 @noindent
35782 This section includes a complete list of Calc keystroke commands.
35783 Each line lists the stack entries used by the command (top-of-stack
35784 last), the keystrokes themselves, the prompts asked by the command,
35785 and the result of the command (also with top-of-stack last).
35786 The result is expressed using the equivalent algebraic function.
35787 Commands which put no results on the stack show the full @kbd{M-x}
35788 command name in that position. Numbers preceding the result or
35789 command name refer to notes at the end.
35790
35791 Algebraic functions and @kbd{M-x} commands that don't have corresponding
35792 keystrokes are not listed in this summary.
35793 @xref{Command Index}. @xref{Function Index}.
35794
35795 @iftex
35796 @begingroup
35797 @tex
35798 \vskip-2\baselineskip \null
35799 \gdef\sumrow#1{\sumrowx#1\relax}%
35800 \gdef\sumrowx#1\:#2\:#3\:#4\:#5\:#6\relax{%
35801 \leavevmode%
35802 {\smallfonts
35803 \hbox to5em{\sl\hss#1}%
35804 \hbox to5em{\tt#2\hss}%
35805 \hbox to4em{\sl#3\hss}%
35806 \hbox to5em{\rm\hss#4}%
35807 \thinspace%
35808 {\tt#5}%
35809 {\sl#6}%
35810 }}%
35811 \gdef\sumlpar{{\rm(}}%
35812 \gdef\sumrpar{{\rm)}}%
35813 \gdef\sumcomma{{\rm,\thinspace}}%
35814 \gdef\sumexcl{{\rm!}}%
35815 \gdef\sumbreak{\vskip-2.5\baselineskip\goodbreak}%
35816 \gdef\minus#1{{\tt-}}%
35817 @end tex
35818 @let@:=@sumsep
35819 @let@r=@sumrow
35820 @catcode`@(=@active @let(=@sumlpar
35821 @catcode`@)=@active @let)=@sumrpar
35822 @catcode`@,=@active @let,=@sumcomma
35823 @catcode`@!=@active @let!=@sumexcl
35824 @end iftex
35825 @format
35826 @iftex
35827 @advance@baselineskip-2.5pt
35828 @let@c@sumbreak
35829 @end iftex
35830 @r{ @: C-x * a @: @: 33 @:calc-embedded-activate@:}
35831 @r{ @: C-x * b @: @: @:calc-big-or-small@:}
35832 @r{ @: C-x * c @: @: @:calc@:}
35833 @r{ @: C-x * d @: @: @:calc-embedded-duplicate@:}
35834 @r{ @: C-x * e @: @: 34 @:calc-embedded@:}
35835 @r{ @: C-x * f @:formula @: @:calc-embedded-new-formula@:}
35836 @r{ @: C-x * g @: @: 35 @:calc-grab-region@:}
35837 @r{ @: C-x * i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
35838 @r{ @: C-x * j @: @: @:calc-embedded-select@:}
35839 @r{ @: C-x * k @: @: @:calc-keypad@:}
35840 @r{ @: C-x * l @: @: @:calc-load-everything@:}
35841 @r{ @: C-x * m @: @: @:read-kbd-macro@:}
35842 @r{ @: C-x * n @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-next@:}
35843 @r{ @: C-x * o @: @: @:calc-other-window@:}
35844 @r{ @: C-x * p @: @: 4 @:calc-embedded-previous@:}
35845 @r{ @: C-x * q @:formula @: @:quick-calc@:}
35846 @r{ @: C-x * r @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-rectangle@:}
35847 @r{ @: C-x * s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
35848 @r{ @: C-x * t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
35849 @r{ @: C-x * u @: @: @:calc-embedded-update-formula@:}
35850 @r{ @: C-x * w @: @: @:calc-embedded-word@:}
35851 @r{ @: C-x * x @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35852 @r{ @: C-x * y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35853 @r{ @: C-x * z @: @: @:calc-user-invocation@:}
35854 @r{ @: C-x * : @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-down@:}
35855 @r{ @: C-x * _ @: @: 36 @:calc-grab-sum-across@:}
35856 @r{ @: C-x * ` @:editing @: 30 @:calc-embedded-edit@:}
35857 @r{ @: C-x * 0 @:(zero) @: @:calc-reset@:}
35858
35859 @c
35860 @r{ @: 0-9 @:number @: @:@:number}
35861 @r{ @: . @:number @: @:@:0.number}
35862 @r{ @: _ @:number @: @:-@:number}
35863 @r{ @: e @:number @: @:@:1e number}
35864 @r{ @: # @:number @: @:@:current-radix@tfn{#}number}
35865 @r{ @: P @:(in number) @: @:+/-@:}
35866 @r{ @: M @:(in number) @: @:mod@:}
35867 @r{ @: @@ ' " @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35868 @r{ @: h m s @: (in number)@: @:@:HMS form}
35869
35870 @c
35871 @r{ @: ' @:formula @: 37,46 @:@:formula}
35872 @r{ @: $ @:formula @: 37,46 @:$@:formula}
35873 @r{ @: " @:string @: 37,46 @:@:string}
35874
35875 @c
35876 @r{ a b@: + @: @: 2 @:add@:(a,b) a+b}
35877 @r{ a b@: - @: @: 2 @:sub@:(a,b) a@minus{}b}
35878 @r{ a b@: * @: @: 2 @:mul@:(a,b) a b, a*b}
35879 @r{ a b@: / @: @: 2 @:div@:(a,b) a/b}
35880 @r{ a b@: ^ @: @: 2 @:pow@:(a,b) a^b}
35881 @r{ a b@: I ^ @: @: 2 @:nroot@:(a,b) a^(1/b)}
35882 @r{ a b@: % @: @: 2 @:mod@:(a,b) a%b}
35883 @r{ a b@: \ @: @: 2 @:idiv@:(a,b) a\b}
35884 @r{ a b@: : @: @: 2 @:fdiv@:(a,b)}
35885 @r{ a b@: | @: @: 2 @:vconcat@:(a,b) a|b}
35886 @r{ a b@: I | @: @: @:vconcat@:(b,a) b|a}
35887 @r{ a b@: H | @: @: 2 @:append@:(a,b)}
35888 @r{ a b@: I H | @: @: @:append@:(b,a)}
35889 @r{ a@: & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(a) 1/a}
35890 @r{ a@: ! @: @: 1 @:fact@:(a) a!}
35891 @r{ a@: = @: @: 1 @:evalv@:(a)}
35892 @r{ a@: M-% @: @: @:percent@:(a) a%}
35893
35894 @c
35895 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35896 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{SPC} @: @: 1 @:@:... a a}
35897 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b a}
35898 @r{. a b c@: M-@summarykey{TAB} @: @: 3 @:@:... b c a}
35899 @r{... a b@: @summarykey{LFD} @: @: 1 @:@:... a b a}
35900 @r{ ... a@: @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35901 @r{... a b@: M-@summarykey{DEL} @: @: 1 @:@:... b}
35902 @r{ @: M-@summarykey{RET} @: @: 4 @:calc-last-args@:}
35903 @r{ a@: ` @:editing @: 1,30 @:calc-edit@:}
35904
35905 @c
35906 @r{ ... a@: C-d @: @: 1 @:@:...}
35907 @r{ @: C-k @: @: 27 @:calc-kill@:}
35908 @r{ @: C-w @: @: 27 @:calc-kill-region@:}
35909 @r{ @: C-y @: @: @:calc-yank@:}
35910 @r{ @: C-_ @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35911 @r{ @: M-k @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-as-kill@:}
35912 @r{ @: M-w @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-region-as-kill@:}
35913
35914 @c
35915 @r{ @: [ @: @: @:@:[...}
35916 @r{[.. a b@: ] @: @: @:@:[a,b]}
35917 @r{ @: ( @: @: @:@:(...}
35918 @r{(.. a b@: ) @: @: @:@:(a,b)}
35919 @r{ @: , @: @: @:@:vector or rect complex}
35920 @r{ @: ; @: @: @:@:matrix or polar complex}
35921 @r{ @: .. @: @: @:@:interval}
35922
35923 @c
35924 @r{ @: ~ @: @: @:calc-num-prefix@:}
35925 @r{ @: < @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-left@:}
35926 @r{ @: > @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-right@:}
35927 @r{ @: @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-down@:}
35928 @r{ @: @} @: @: 4 @:calc-scroll-up@:}
35929 @r{ @: ? @: @: @:calc-help@:}
35930
35931 @c
35932 @r{ a@: n @: @: 1 @:neg@:(a) @minus{}a}
35933 @r{ @: o @: @: 4 @:calc-realign@:}
35934 @r{ @: p @:precision @: 31 @:calc-precision@:}
35935 @r{ @: q @: @: @:calc-quit@:}
35936 @r{ @: w @: @: @:calc-why@:}
35937 @r{ @: x @:command @: @:M-x calc-@:command}
35938 @r{ a@: y @: @:1,28,49 @:calc-copy-to-buffer@:}
35939
35940 @c
35941 @r{ a@: A @: @: 1 @:abs@:(a)}
35942 @r{ a b@: B @: @: 2 @:log@:(a,b)}
35943 @r{ a b@: I B @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
35944 @r{ a@: C @: @: 1 @:cos@:(a)}
35945 @r{ a@: I C @: @: 1 @:arccos@:(a)}
35946 @r{ a@: H C @: @: 1 @:cosh@:(a)}
35947 @r{ a@: I H C @: @: 1 @:arccosh@:(a)}
35948 @r{ @: D @: @: 4 @:calc-redo@:}
35949 @r{ a@: E @: @: 1 @:exp@:(a)}
35950 @r{ a@: H E @: @: 1 @:exp10@:(a) 10.^a}
35951 @r{ a@: F @: @: 1,11 @:floor@:(a,d)}
35952 @r{ a@: I F @: @: 1,11 @:ceil@:(a,d)}
35953 @r{ a@: H F @: @: 1,11 @:ffloor@:(a,d)}
35954 @r{ a@: I H F @: @: 1,11 @:fceil@:(a,d)}
35955 @r{ a@: G @: @: 1 @:arg@:(a)}
35956 @r{ @: H @:command @: 32 @:@:Hyperbolic}
35957 @r{ @: I @:command @: 32 @:@:Inverse}
35958 @r{ a@: J @: @: 1 @:conj@:(a)}
35959 @r{ @: K @:command @: 32 @:@:Keep-args}
35960 @r{ a@: L @: @: 1 @:ln@:(a)}
35961 @r{ a@: H L @: @: 1 @:log10@:(a)}
35962 @r{ @: M @: @: @:calc-more-recursion-depth@:}
35963 @r{ @: I M @: @: @:calc-less-recursion-depth@:}
35964 @r{ a@: N @: @: 5 @:evalvn@:(a)}
35965 @r{ @: O @:command @: 32 @:@:Option}
35966 @r{ @: P @: @: @:@:pi}
35967 @r{ @: I P @: @: @:@:gamma}
35968 @r{ @: H P @: @: @:@:e}
35969 @r{ @: I H P @: @: @:@:phi}
35970 @r{ a@: Q @: @: 1 @:sqrt@:(a)}
35971 @r{ a@: I Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
35972 @r{ a@: R @: @: 1,11 @:round@:(a,d)}
35973 @r{ a@: I R @: @: 1,11 @:trunc@:(a,d)}
35974 @r{ a@: H R @: @: 1,11 @:fround@:(a,d)}
35975 @r{ a@: I H R @: @: 1,11 @:ftrunc@:(a,d)}
35976 @r{ a@: S @: @: 1 @:sin@:(a)}
35977 @r{ a@: I S @: @: 1 @:arcsin@:(a)}
35978 @r{ a@: H S @: @: 1 @:sinh@:(a)}
35979 @r{ a@: I H S @: @: 1 @:arcsinh@:(a)}
35980 @r{ a@: T @: @: 1 @:tan@:(a)}
35981 @r{ a@: I T @: @: 1 @:arctan@:(a)}
35982 @r{ a@: H T @: @: 1 @:tanh@:(a)}
35983 @r{ a@: I H T @: @: 1 @:arctanh@:(a)}
35984 @r{ @: U @: @: 4 @:calc-undo@:}
35985 @r{ @: X @: @: 4 @:calc-call-last-kbd-macro@:}
35986
35987 @c
35988 @r{ a b@: a = @: @: 2 @:eq@:(a,b) a=b}
35989 @r{ a b@: a # @: @: 2 @:neq@:(a,b) a!=b}
35990 @r{ a b@: a < @: @: 2 @:lt@:(a,b) a<b}
35991 @r{ a b@: a > @: @: 2 @:gt@:(a,b) a>b}
35992 @r{ a b@: a [ @: @: 2 @:leq@:(a,b) a<=b}
35993 @r{ a b@: a ] @: @: 2 @:geq@:(a,b) a>=b}
35994 @r{ a b@: a @{ @: @: 2 @:in@:(a,b)}
35995 @r{ a b@: a & @: @: 2,45 @:land@:(a,b) a&&b}
35996 @r{ a b@: a | @: @: 2,45 @:lor@:(a,b) a||b}
35997 @r{ a@: a ! @: @: 1,45 @:lnot@:(a) !a}
35998 @r{ a b c@: a : @: @: 45 @:if@:(a,b,c) a?b:c}
35999 @r{ a@: a . @: @: 1 @:rmeq@:(a)}
36000 @r{ a@: a " @: @: 7,8 @:calc-expand-formula@:}
36001
36002 @c
36003 @r{ a@: a + @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:sum@:(a,i,l,h)}
36004 @r{ a@: a - @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:asum@:(a,i,l,h)}
36005 @r{ a@: a * @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:prod@:(a,i,l,h)}
36006 @r{ a b@: a _ @: @: 2 @:subscr@:(a,b) a_b}
36007
36008 @c
36009 @r{ a b@: a \ @: @: 2 @:pdiv@:(a,b)}
36010 @r{ a b@: a % @: @: 2 @:prem@:(a,b)}
36011 @r{ a b@: a / @: @: 2 @:pdivrem@:(a,b) [q,r]}
36012 @r{ a b@: H a / @: @: 2 @:pdivide@:(a,b) q+r/b}
36013
36014 @c
36015 @r{ a@: a a @: @: 1 @:apart@:(a)}
36016 @r{ a@: a b @:old, new @: 38 @:subst@:(a,old,new)}
36017 @r{ a@: a c @:v @: 38 @:collect@:(a,v)}
36018 @r{ a@: a d @:v @: 4,38 @:deriv@:(a,v)}
36019 @r{ a@: H a d @:v @: 4,38 @:tderiv@:(a,v)}
36020 @r{ a@: a e @: @: @:esimplify@:(a)}
36021 @r{ a@: a f @: @: 1 @:factor@:(a)}
36022 @r{ a@: H a f @: @: 1 @:factors@:(a)}
36023 @r{ a b@: a g @: @: 2 @:pgcd@:(a,b)}
36024 @r{ a@: a i @:v @: 38 @:integ@:(a,v)}
36025 @r{ a@: a m @:pats @: 38 @:match@:(a,pats)}
36026 @r{ a@: I a m @:pats @: 38 @:matchnot@:(a,pats)}
36027 @r{ data x@: a p @: @: 28 @:polint@:(data,x)}
36028 @r{ data x@: H a p @: @: 28 @:ratint@:(data,x)}
36029 @r{ a@: a n @: @: 1 @:nrat@:(a)}
36030 @r{ a@: a r @:rules @:4,8,38 @:rewrite@:(a,rules,n)}
36031 @r{ a@: a s @: @: @:simplify@:(a)}
36032 @r{ a@: a t @:v, n @: 31,39 @:taylor@:(a,v,n)}
36033 @r{ a@: a v @: @: 7,8 @:calc-alg-evaluate@:}
36034 @r{ a@: a x @: @: 4,8 @:expand@:(a)}
36035
36036 @c
36037 @r{ data@: a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:fit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
36038 @r{ data@: I a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:xfit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
36039 @r{ data@: H a F @:model, vars @: 48 @:efit@:(m,iv,pv,data)}
36040 @r{ a@: a I @:v, l, h @: 38 @:ninteg@:(a,v,l,h)}
36041 @r{ a b@: a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeq@:(op,a,b)}
36042 @r{ a b@: I a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqr@:(op,a,b)}
36043 @r{ a b@: H a M @:op @: 22 @:mapeqp@:(op,a,b)}
36044 @r{ a g@: a N @:v @: 38 @:minimize@:(a,v,g)}
36045 @r{ a g@: H a N @:v @: 38 @:wminimize@:(a,v,g)}
36046 @r{ a@: a P @:v @: 38 @:roots@:(a,v)}
36047 @r{ a g@: a R @:v @: 38 @:root@:(a,v,g)}
36048 @r{ a g@: H a R @:v @: 38 @:wroot@:(a,v,g)}
36049 @r{ a@: a S @:v @: 38 @:solve@:(a,v)}
36050 @r{ a@: I a S @:v @: 38 @:finv@:(a,v)}
36051 @r{ a@: H a S @:v @: 38 @:fsolve@:(a,v)}
36052 @r{ a@: I H a S @:v @: 38 @:ffinv@:(a,v)}
36053 @r{ a@: a T @:i, l, h @: 6,38 @:table@:(a,i,l,h)}
36054 @r{ a g@: a X @:v @: 38 @:maximize@:(a,v,g)}
36055 @r{ a g@: H a X @:v @: 38 @:wmaximize@:(a,v,g)}
36056
36057 @c
36058 @r{ a b@: b a @: @: 9 @:and@:(a,b,w)}
36059 @r{ a@: b c @: @: 9 @:clip@:(a,w)}
36060 @r{ a b@: b d @: @: 9 @:diff@:(a,b,w)}
36061 @r{ a@: b l @: @: 10 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
36062 @r{ a n@: H b l @: @: 9 @:lsh@:(a,n,w)}
36063 @r{ a@: b n @: @: 9 @:not@:(a,w)}
36064 @r{ a b@: b o @: @: 9 @:or@:(a,b,w)}
36065 @r{ v@: b p @: @: 1 @:vpack@:(v)}
36066 @r{ a@: b r @: @: 10 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
36067 @r{ a n@: H b r @: @: 9 @:rsh@:(a,n,w)}
36068 @r{ a@: b t @: @: 10 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
36069 @r{ a n@: H b t @: @: 9 @:rot@:(a,n,w)}
36070 @r{ a@: b u @: @: 1 @:vunpack@:(a)}
36071 @r{ @: b w @:w @: 9,50 @:calc-word-size@:}
36072 @r{ a b@: b x @: @: 9 @:xor@:(a,b,w)}
36073
36074 @c
36075 @r{c s l p@: b D @: @: @:ddb@:(c,s,l,p)}
36076 @r{ r n p@: b F @: @: @:fv@:(r,n,p)}
36077 @r{ r n p@: I b F @: @: @:fvb@:(r,n,p)}
36078 @r{ r n p@: H b F @: @: @:fvl@:(r,n,p)}
36079 @r{ v@: b I @: @: 19 @:irr@:(v)}
36080 @r{ v@: I b I @: @: 19 @:irrb@:(v)}
36081 @r{ a@: b L @: @: 10 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
36082 @r{ a n@: H b L @: @: 9 @:ash@:(a,n,w)}
36083 @r{ r n a@: b M @: @: @:pmt@:(r,n,a)}
36084 @r{ r n a@: I b M @: @: @:pmtb@:(r,n,a)}
36085 @r{ r n a@: H b M @: @: @:pmtl@:(r,n,a)}
36086 @r{ r v@: b N @: @: 19 @:npv@:(r,v)}
36087 @r{ r v@: I b N @: @: 19 @:npvb@:(r,v)}
36088 @r{ r n p@: b P @: @: @:pv@:(r,n,p)}
36089 @r{ r n p@: I b P @: @: @:pvb@:(r,n,p)}
36090 @r{ r n p@: H b P @: @: @:pvl@:(r,n,p)}
36091 @r{ a@: b R @: @: 10 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
36092 @r{ a n@: H b R @: @: 9 @:rash@:(a,n,w)}
36093 @r{ c s l@: b S @: @: @:sln@:(c,s,l)}
36094 @r{ n p a@: b T @: @: @:rate@:(n,p,a)}
36095 @r{ n p a@: I b T @: @: @:rateb@:(n,p,a)}
36096 @r{ n p a@: H b T @: @: @:ratel@:(n,p,a)}
36097 @r{c s l p@: b Y @: @: @:syd@:(c,s,l,p)}
36098
36099 @r{ r p a@: b # @: @: @:nper@:(r,p,a)}
36100 @r{ r p a@: I b # @: @: @:nperb@:(r,p,a)}
36101 @r{ r p a@: H b # @: @: @:nperl@:(r,p,a)}
36102 @r{ a b@: b % @: @: @:relch@:(a,b)}
36103
36104 @c
36105 @r{ a@: c c @: @: 5 @:pclean@:(a,p)}
36106 @r{ a@: c 0-9 @: @: @:pclean@:(a,p)}
36107 @r{ a@: H c c @: @: 5 @:clean@:(a,p)}
36108 @r{ a@: H c 0-9 @: @: @:clean@:(a,p)}
36109 @r{ a@: c d @: @: 1 @:deg@:(a)}
36110 @r{ a@: c f @: @: 1 @:pfloat@:(a)}
36111 @r{ a@: H c f @: @: 1 @:float@:(a)}
36112 @r{ a@: c h @: @: 1 @:hms@:(a)}
36113 @r{ a@: c p @: @: @:polar@:(a)}
36114 @r{ a@: I c p @: @: @:rect@:(a)}
36115 @r{ a@: c r @: @: 1 @:rad@:(a)}
36116
36117 @c
36118 @r{ a@: c F @: @: 5 @:pfrac@:(a,p)}
36119 @r{ a@: H c F @: @: 5 @:frac@:(a,p)}
36120
36121 @c
36122 @r{ a@: c % @: @: @:percent@:(a*100)}
36123
36124 @c
36125 @r{ @: d . @:char @: 50 @:calc-point-char@:}
36126 @r{ @: d , @:char @: 50 @:calc-group-char@:}
36127 @r{ @: d < @: @: 13,50 @:calc-left-justify@:}
36128 @r{ @: d = @: @: 13,50 @:calc-center-justify@:}
36129 @r{ @: d > @: @: 13,50 @:calc-right-justify@:}
36130 @r{ @: d @{ @:label @: 50 @:calc-left-label@:}
36131 @r{ @: d @} @:label @: 50 @:calc-right-label@:}
36132 @r{ @: d [ @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-up@:}
36133 @r{ @: d ] @: @: 4 @:calc-truncate-down@:}
36134 @r{ @: d " @: @: 12,50 @:calc-display-strings@:}
36135 @r{ @: d @summarykey{SPC} @: @: @:calc-refresh@:}
36136 @r{ @: d @summarykey{RET} @: @: 1 @:calc-refresh-top@:}
36137
36138 @c
36139 @r{ @: d 0 @: @: 50 @:calc-decimal-radix@:}
36140 @r{ @: d 2 @: @: 50 @:calc-binary-radix@:}
36141 @r{ @: d 6 @: @: 50 @:calc-hex-radix@:}
36142 @r{ @: d 8 @: @: 50 @:calc-octal-radix@:}
36143
36144 @c
36145 @r{ @: d b @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-line-breaking@:}
36146 @r{ @: d c @: @: 50 @:calc-complex-notation@:}
36147 @r{ @: d d @:format @: 50 @:calc-date-notation@:}
36148 @r{ @: d e @: @: 5,50 @:calc-eng-notation@:}
36149 @r{ @: d f @:num @: 31,50 @:calc-fix-notation@:}
36150 @r{ @: d g @: @:12,13,50 @:calc-group-digits@:}
36151 @r{ @: d h @:format @: 50 @:calc-hms-notation@:}
36152 @r{ @: d i @: @: 50 @:calc-i-notation@:}
36153 @r{ @: d j @: @: 50 @:calc-j-notation@:}
36154 @r{ @: d l @: @: 12,50 @:calc-line-numbering@:}
36155 @r{ @: d n @: @: 5,50 @:calc-normal-notation@:}
36156 @r{ @: d o @:format @: 50 @:calc-over-notation@:}
36157 @r{ @: d p @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-plain@:}
36158 @r{ @: d r @:radix @: 31,50 @:calc-radix@:}
36159 @r{ @: d s @: @: 5,50 @:calc-sci-notation@:}
36160 @r{ @: d t @: @: 27 @:calc-truncate-stack@:}
36161 @r{ @: d w @: @: 12,13 @:calc-auto-why@:}
36162 @r{ @: d z @: @: 12,50 @:calc-leading-zeros@:}
36163
36164 @c
36165 @r{ @: d B @: @: 50 @:calc-big-language@:}
36166 @r{ @: d C @: @: 50 @:calc-c-language@:}
36167 @r{ @: d E @: @: 50 @:calc-eqn-language@:}
36168 @r{ @: d F @: @: 50 @:calc-fortran-language@:}
36169 @r{ @: d M @: @: 50 @:calc-mathematica-language@:}
36170 @r{ @: d N @: @: 50 @:calc-normal-language@:}
36171 @r{ @: d O @: @: 50 @:calc-flat-language@:}
36172 @r{ @: d P @: @: 50 @:calc-pascal-language@:}
36173 @r{ @: d T @: @: 50 @:calc-tex-language@:}
36174 @r{ @: d L @: @: 50 @:calc-latex-language@:}
36175 @r{ @: d U @: @: 50 @:calc-unformatted-language@:}
36176 @r{ @: d W @: @: 50 @:calc-maple-language@:}
36177
36178 @c
36179 @r{ a@: f [ @: @: 4 @:decr@:(a,n)}
36180 @r{ a@: f ] @: @: 4 @:incr@:(a,n)}
36181
36182 @c
36183 @r{ a b@: f b @: @: 2 @:beta@:(a,b)}
36184 @r{ a@: f e @: @: 1 @:erf@:(a)}
36185 @r{ a@: I f e @: @: 1 @:erfc@:(a)}
36186 @r{ a@: f g @: @: 1 @:gamma@:(a)}
36187 @r{ a b@: f h @: @: 2 @:hypot@:(a,b)}
36188 @r{ a@: f i @: @: 1 @:im@:(a)}
36189 @r{ n a@: f j @: @: 2 @:besJ@:(n,a)}
36190 @r{ a b@: f n @: @: 2 @:min@:(a,b)}
36191 @r{ a@: f r @: @: 1 @:re@:(a)}
36192 @r{ a@: f s @: @: 1 @:sign@:(a)}
36193 @r{ a b@: f x @: @: 2 @:max@:(a,b)}
36194 @r{ n a@: f y @: @: 2 @:besY@:(n,a)}
36195
36196 @c
36197 @r{ a@: f A @: @: 1 @:abssqr@:(a)}
36198 @r{ x a b@: f B @: @: @:betaI@:(x,a,b)}
36199 @r{ x a b@: H f B @: @: @:betaB@:(x,a,b)}
36200 @r{ a@: f E @: @: 1 @:expm1@:(a)}
36201 @r{ a x@: f G @: @: 2 @:gammaP@:(a,x)}
36202 @r{ a x@: I f G @: @: 2 @:gammaQ@:(a,x)}
36203 @r{ a x@: H f G @: @: 2 @:gammag@:(a,x)}
36204 @r{ a x@: I H f G @: @: 2 @:gammaG@:(a,x)}
36205 @r{ a b@: f I @: @: 2 @:ilog@:(a,b)}
36206 @r{ a b@: I f I @: @: 2 @:alog@:(a,b) b^a}
36207 @r{ a@: f L @: @: 1 @:lnp1@:(a)}
36208 @r{ a@: f M @: @: 1 @:mant@:(a)}
36209 @r{ a@: f Q @: @: 1 @:isqrt@:(a)}
36210 @r{ a@: I f Q @: @: 1 @:sqr@:(a) a^2}
36211 @r{ a n@: f S @: @: 2 @:scf@:(a,n)}
36212 @r{ y x@: f T @: @: @:arctan2@:(y,x)}
36213 @r{ a@: f X @: @: 1 @:xpon@:(a)}
36214
36215 @c
36216 @r{ x y@: g a @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add@:}
36217 @r{ @: g b @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-border@:}
36218 @r{ @: g c @: @: @:calc-graph-clear@:}
36219 @r{ @: g d @: @: 41 @:calc-graph-delete@:}
36220 @r{ x y@: g f @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast@:}
36221 @r{ @: g g @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-grid@:}
36222 @r{ @: g h @:title @: @:calc-graph-header@:}
36223 @r{ @: g j @: @: 4 @:calc-graph-juggle@:}
36224 @r{ @: g k @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-key@:}
36225 @r{ @: g l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-x@:}
36226 @r{ @: g n @:name @: @:calc-graph-name@:}
36227 @r{ @: g p @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-plot@:}
36228 @r{ @: g q @: @: @:calc-graph-quit@:}
36229 @r{ @: g r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-x@:}
36230 @r{ @: g s @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-line-style@:}
36231 @r{ @: g t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-x@:}
36232 @r{ @: g v @: @: @:calc-graph-view-commands@:}
36233 @r{ @: g x @:display @: @:calc-graph-display@:}
36234 @r{ @: g z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-x@:}
36235
36236 @c
36237 @r{ x y z@: g A @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-add-3d@:}
36238 @r{ @: g C @:command @: @:calc-graph-command@:}
36239 @r{ @: g D @:device @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-device@:}
36240 @r{ x y z@: g F @: @: 28,40 @:calc-graph-fast-3d@:}
36241 @r{ @: g H @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-hide@:}
36242 @r{ @: g K @: @: @:calc-graph-kill@:}
36243 @r{ @: g L @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-y@:}
36244 @r{ @: g N @:number @: 43,51 @:calc-graph-num-points@:}
36245 @r{ @: g O @:filename @: 43,44 @:calc-graph-output@:}
36246 @r{ @: g P @: @: 42 @:calc-graph-print@:}
36247 @r{ @: g R @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-y@:}
36248 @r{ @: g S @: @: 12,13 @:calc-graph-point-style@:}
36249 @r{ @: g T @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-y@:}
36250 @r{ @: g V @: @: @:calc-graph-view-trail@:}
36251 @r{ @: g X @:format @: @:calc-graph-geometry@:}
36252 @r{ @: g Z @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-zero-y@:}
36253
36254 @c
36255 @r{ @: g C-l @: @: 12 @:calc-graph-log-z@:}
36256 @r{ @: g C-r @:range @: @:calc-graph-range-z@:}
36257 @r{ @: g C-t @:title @: @:calc-graph-title-z@:}
36258
36259 @c
36260 @r{ @: h b @: @: @:calc-describe-bindings@:}
36261 @r{ @: h c @:key @: @:calc-describe-key-briefly@:}
36262 @r{ @: h f @:function @: @:calc-describe-function@:}
36263 @r{ @: h h @: @: @:calc-full-help@:}
36264 @r{ @: h i @: @: @:calc-info@:}
36265 @r{ @: h k @:key @: @:calc-describe-key@:}
36266 @r{ @: h n @: @: @:calc-view-news@:}
36267 @r{ @: h s @: @: @:calc-info-summary@:}
36268 @r{ @: h t @: @: @:calc-tutorial@:}
36269 @r{ @: h v @:var @: @:calc-describe-variable@:}
36270
36271 @c
36272 @r{ @: j 1-9 @: @: @:calc-select-part@:}
36273 @r{ @: j @summarykey{RET} @: @: 27 @:calc-copy-selection@:}
36274 @r{ @: j @summarykey{DEL} @: @: 27 @:calc-del-selection@:}
36275 @r{ @: j ' @:formula @: 27 @:calc-enter-selection@:}
36276 @r{ @: j ` @:editing @: 27,30 @:calc-edit-selection@:}
36277 @r{ @: j " @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-expand-formula@:}
36278
36279 @c
36280 @r{ @: j + @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-add-both-sides@:}
36281 @r{ @: j - @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-sub-both-sides@:}
36282 @r{ @: j * @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-mul-both-sides@:}
36283 @r{ @: j / @:formula @: 27 @:calc-sel-div-both-sides@:}
36284 @r{ @: j & @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-invert@:}
36285
36286 @c
36287 @r{ @: j a @: @: 27 @:calc-select-additional@:}
36288 @r{ @: j b @: @: 12 @:calc-break-selections@:}
36289 @r{ @: j c @: @: @:calc-clear-selections@:}
36290 @r{ @: j d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-show-selections@:}
36291 @r{ @: j e @: @: 12 @:calc-enable-selections@:}
36292 @r{ @: j l @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-less@:}
36293 @r{ @: j m @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-more@:}
36294 @r{ @: j n @: @: 4 @:calc-select-next@:}
36295 @r{ @: j o @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once@:}
36296 @r{ @: j p @: @: 4 @:calc-select-previous@:}
36297 @r{ @: j r @:rules @:4,8,27 @:calc-rewrite-selection@:}
36298 @r{ @: j s @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here@:}
36299 @r{ @: j u @: @: 27 @:calc-unselect@:}
36300 @r{ @: j v @: @: 7,27 @:calc-sel-evaluate@:}
36301
36302 @c
36303 @r{ @: j C @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-commute@:}
36304 @r{ @: j D @: @: 4,27 @:calc-sel-distribute@:}
36305 @r{ @: j E @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-jump-equals@:}
36306 @r{ @: j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@:}
36307 @r{ @: H j I @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-isolate@: (full)}
36308 @r{ @: j L @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-left@:}
36309 @r{ @: j M @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-merge@:}
36310 @r{ @: j N @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-negate@:}
36311 @r{ @: j O @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-once-maybe@:}
36312 @r{ @: j R @: @: 4,27 @:calc-commute-right@:}
36313 @r{ @: j S @: @: 4,27 @:calc-select-here-maybe@:}
36314 @r{ @: j U @: @: 27 @:calc-sel-unpack@:}
36315
36316 @c
36317 @r{ @: k a @: @: @:calc-random-again@:}
36318 @r{ n@: k b @: @: 1 @:bern@:(n)}
36319 @r{ n x@: H k b @: @: 2 @:bern@:(n,x)}
36320 @r{ n m@: k c @: @: 2 @:choose@:(n,m)}
36321 @r{ n m@: H k c @: @: 2 @:perm@:(n,m)}
36322 @r{ n@: k d @: @: 1 @:dfact@:(n) n!!}
36323 @r{ n@: k e @: @: 1 @:euler@:(n)}
36324 @r{ n x@: H k e @: @: 2 @:euler@:(n,x)}
36325 @r{ n@: k f @: @: 4 @:prfac@:(n)}
36326 @r{ n m@: k g @: @: 2 @:gcd@:(n,m)}
36327 @r{ m n@: k h @: @: 14 @:shuffle@:(n,m)}
36328 @r{ n m@: k l @: @: 2 @:lcm@:(n,m)}
36329 @r{ n@: k m @: @: 1 @:moebius@:(n)}
36330 @r{ n@: k n @: @: 4 @:nextprime@:(n)}
36331 @r{ n@: I k n @: @: 4 @:prevprime@:(n)}
36332 @r{ n@: k p @: @: 4,28 @:calc-prime-test@:}
36333 @r{ m@: k r @: @: 14 @:random@:(m)}
36334 @r{ n m@: k s @: @: 2 @:stir1@:(n,m)}
36335 @r{ n m@: H k s @: @: 2 @:stir2@:(n,m)}
36336 @r{ n@: k t @: @: 1 @:totient@:(n)}
36337
36338 @c
36339 @r{ n p x@: k B @: @: @:utpb@:(x,n,p)}
36340 @r{ n p x@: I k B @: @: @:ltpb@:(x,n,p)}
36341 @r{ v x@: k C @: @: @:utpc@:(x,v)}
36342 @r{ v x@: I k C @: @: @:ltpc@:(x,v)}
36343 @r{ n m@: k E @: @: @:egcd@:(n,m)}
36344 @r{v1 v2 x@: k F @: @: @:utpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
36345 @r{v1 v2 x@: I k F @: @: @:ltpf@:(x,v1,v2)}
36346 @r{ m s x@: k N @: @: @:utpn@:(x,m,s)}
36347 @r{ m s x@: I k N @: @: @:ltpn@:(x,m,s)}
36348 @r{ m x@: k P @: @: @:utpp@:(x,m)}
36349 @r{ m x@: I k P @: @: @:ltpp@:(x,m)}
36350 @r{ v x@: k T @: @: @:utpt@:(x,v)}
36351 @r{ v x@: I k T @: @: @:ltpt@:(x,v)}
36352
36353 @c
36354 @r{ a b@: l + @: @: @:lupadd@:(a,b)}
36355 @r{ a b@: H l + @: @: @:lufadd@:(a,b)}
36356 @r{ a b@: l - @: @: @:lupsub@:(a,b)}
36357 @r{ a b@: H l - @: @: @:lufsub@:(a,b)}
36358 @r{ a b@: l * @: @: @:lupmul@:(a,b)}
36359 @r{ a b@: H l * @: @: @:lufmul@:(a,b)}
36360 @r{ a b@: l / @: @: @:lupdiv@:(a,b)}
36361 @r{ a b@: H l / @: @: @:lufdiv@:(a,b)}
36362 @r{ a@: l d @: @: @:dbpower@:(a)}
36363 @r{ a b@: O l d @: @: @:dbpower@:(a,b)}
36364 @r{ a@: H l d @: @: @:dbfield@:(a)}
36365 @r{ a b@: O H l d @: @: @:dbfield@:(a,b)}
36366 @r{ a@: l n @: @: @:nppower@:(a)}
36367 @r{ a b@: O l n @: @: @:nppower@:(a,b)}
36368 @r{ a@: H l n @: @: @:npfield@:(a)}
36369 @r{ a b@: O H l n @: @: @:npfield@:(a,b)}
36370 @r{ a@: l q @: @: @:lupquant@:(a)}
36371 @r{ a b@: O l q @: @: @:lupquant@:(a,b)}
36372 @r{ a@: H l q @: @: @:lufquant@:(a)}
36373 @r{ a b@: O H l q @: @: @:lufquant@:(a,b)}
36374 @r{ a@: l s @: @: @:spn@:(a)}
36375 @r{ a@: l m @: @: @:midi@:(a)}
36376 @r{ a@: l f @: @: @:freq@:(a)}
36377
36378 @c
36379 @r{ @: m a @: @: 12,13 @:calc-algebraic-mode@:}
36380 @r{ @: m d @: @: @:calc-degrees-mode@:}
36381 @r{ @: m e @: @: @:calc-embedded-preserve-modes@:}
36382 @r{ @: m f @: @: 12 @:calc-frac-mode@:}
36383 @r{ @: m g @: @: 52 @:calc-get-modes@:}
36384 @r{ @: m h @: @: @:calc-hms-mode@:}
36385 @r{ @: m i @: @: 12,13 @:calc-infinite-mode@:}
36386 @r{ @: m m @: @: @:calc-save-modes@:}
36387 @r{ @: m p @: @: 12 @:calc-polar-mode@:}
36388 @r{ @: m r @: @: @:calc-radians-mode@:}
36389 @r{ @: m s @: @: 12 @:calc-symbolic-mode@:}
36390 @r{ @: m t @: @: 12 @:calc-total-algebraic-mode@:}
36391 @r{ @: m v @: @: 12,13 @:calc-matrix-mode@:}
36392 @r{ @: m w @: @: 13 @:calc-working@:}
36393 @r{ @: m x @: @: @:calc-always-load-extensions@:}
36394
36395 @c
36396 @r{ @: m A @: @: 12 @:calc-alg-simplify-mode@:}
36397 @r{ @: m B @: @: 12 @:calc-bin-simplify-mode@:}
36398 @r{ @: m C @: @: 12 @:calc-auto-recompute@:}
36399 @r{ @: m D @: @: @:calc-default-simplify-mode@:}
36400 @r{ @: m E @: @: 12 @:calc-ext-simplify-mode@:}
36401 @r{ @: m F @:filename @: 13 @:calc-settings-file-name@:}
36402 @r{ @: m N @: @: 12 @:calc-num-simplify-mode@:}
36403 @r{ @: m O @: @: 12 @:calc-no-simplify-mode@:}
36404 @r{ @: m R @: @: 12,13 @:calc-mode-record-mode@:}
36405 @r{ @: m S @: @: 12 @:calc-shift-prefix@:}
36406 @r{ @: m U @: @: 12 @:calc-units-simplify-mode@:}
36407
36408 @c
36409 @r{ @: r s @:register @: 27 @:calc-copy-to-register@:}
36410 @r{ @: r i @:register @: @:calc-insert-register@:}
36411
36412 @c
36413 @r{ @: s c @:var1, var2 @: 29 @:calc-copy-variable@:}
36414 @r{ @: s d @:var, decl @: @:calc-declare-variable@:}
36415 @r{ @: s e @:var, editing @: 29,30 @:calc-edit-variable@:}
36416 @r{ @: s i @:buffer @: @:calc-insert-variables@:}
36417 @r{ @: s k @:const, var @: 29 @:calc-copy-special-constant@:}
36418 @r{ a b@: s l @:var @: 29 @:@:a (letting var=b)}
36419 @r{ a ...@: s m @:op, var @: 22,29 @:calc-store-map@:}
36420 @r{ @: s n @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-neg@: (v/-1)}
36421 @r{ @: s p @:var @: 29 @:calc-permanent-variable@:}
36422 @r{ @: s r @:var @: 29 @:@:v (recalled value)}
36423 @r{ @: r 0-9 @: @: @:calc-recall-quick@:}
36424 @r{ a@: s s @:var @: 28,29 @:calc-store@:}
36425 @r{ a@: s 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-quick@:}
36426 @r{ a@: s t @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-into@:}
36427 @r{ a@: t 0-9 @: @: @:calc-store-into-quick@:}
36428 @r{ @: s u @:var @: 29 @:calc-unstore@:}
36429 @r{ a@: s x @:var @: 29 @:calc-store-exchange@:}
36430
36431 @c
36432 @r{ @: s A @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-AlgSimpRules@:}
36433 @r{ @: s D @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Decls@:}
36434 @r{ @: s E @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-EvalRules@:}
36435 @r{ @: s F @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-FitRules@:}
36436 @r{ @: s G @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-GenCount@:}
36437 @r{ @: s H @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Holidays@:}
36438 @r{ @: s I @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-IntegLimit@:}
36439 @r{ @: s L @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-LineStyles@:}
36440 @r{ @: s P @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PointStyles@:}
36441 @r{ @: s R @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-PlotRejects@:}
36442 @r{ @: s T @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-TimeZone@:}
36443 @r{ @: s U @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-Units@:}
36444 @r{ @: s X @:editing @: 30 @:calc-edit-ExtSimpRules@:}
36445
36446 @c
36447 @r{ a@: s + @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-plus@: (v+a)}
36448 @r{ a@: s - @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-minus@: (v-a)}
36449 @r{ a@: s * @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-times@: (v*a)}
36450 @r{ a@: s / @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-div@: (v/a)}
36451 @r{ a@: s ^ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-power@: (v^a)}
36452 @r{ a@: s | @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-concat@: (v|a)}
36453 @r{ @: s & @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-inv@: (v^-1)}
36454 @r{ @: s [ @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-decr@: (v-1)}
36455 @r{ @: s ] @:var @: 29,47 @:calc-store-incr@: (v-(-1))}
36456 @r{ a b@: s : @: @: 2 @:assign@:(a,b) a @tfn{:=} b}
36457 @r{ a@: s = @: @: 1 @:evalto@:(a,b) a @tfn{=>}}
36458
36459 @c
36460 @r{ @: t [ @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-first@:}
36461 @r{ @: t ] @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-last@:}
36462 @r{ @: t < @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-left@:}
36463 @r{ @: t > @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-scroll-right@:}
36464 @r{ @: t . @: @: 12 @:calc-full-trail-vectors@:}
36465
36466 @c
36467 @r{ @: t b @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-backward@:}
36468 @r{ @: t d @: @: 12,50 @:calc-trail-display@:}
36469 @r{ @: t f @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-forward@:}
36470 @r{ @: t h @: @: @:calc-trail-here@:}
36471 @r{ @: t i @: @: @:calc-trail-in@:}
36472 @r{ @: t k @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-kill@:}
36473 @r{ @: t m @:string @: @:calc-trail-marker@:}
36474 @r{ @: t n @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-next@:}
36475 @r{ @: t o @: @: @:calc-trail-out@:}
36476 @r{ @: t p @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-previous@:}
36477 @r{ @: t r @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-backward@:}
36478 @r{ @: t s @:string @: @:calc-trail-isearch-forward@:}
36479 @r{ @: t y @: @: 4 @:calc-trail-yank@:}
36480
36481 @c
36482 @r{ d@: t C @:oz, nz @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
36483 @r{d oz nz@: t C @:$ @: @:tzconv@:(d,oz,nz)}
36484 @r{ d@: t D @: @: 15 @:date@:(d)}
36485 @r{ d@: t I @: @: 4 @:incmonth@:(d,n)}
36486 @r{ d@: t J @: @: 16 @:julian@:(d,z)}
36487 @r{ d@: t M @: @: 17 @:newmonth@:(d,n)}
36488 @r{ @: t N @: @: 16 @:now@:(z)}
36489 @r{ d@: t P @:1 @: 31 @:year@:(d)}
36490 @r{ d@: t P @:2 @: 31 @:month@:(d)}
36491 @r{ d@: t P @:3 @: 31 @:day@:(d)}
36492 @r{ d@: t P @:4 @: 31 @:hour@:(d)}
36493 @r{ d@: t P @:5 @: 31 @:minute@:(d)}
36494 @r{ d@: t P @:6 @: 31 @:second@:(d)}
36495 @r{ d@: t P @:7 @: 31 @:weekday@:(d)}
36496 @r{ d@: t P @:8 @: 31 @:yearday@:(d)}
36497 @r{ d@: t P @:9 @: 31 @:time@:(d)}
36498 @r{ d@: t U @: @: 16 @:unixtime@:(d,z)}
36499 @r{ d@: t W @: @: 17 @:newweek@:(d,w)}
36500 @r{ d@: t Y @: @: 17 @:newyear@:(d,n)}
36501
36502 @c
36503 @r{ a b@: t + @: @: 2 @:badd@:(a,b)}
36504 @r{ a b@: t - @: @: 2 @:bsub@:(a,b)}
36505
36506 @c
36507 @r{ @: u a @: @: 12 @:calc-autorange-units@:}
36508 @r{ a@: u b @: @: @:calc-base-units@:}
36509 @r{ a@: u c @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-units@:}
36510 @r{ defn@: u d @:unit, descr @: @:calc-define-unit@:}
36511 @r{ @: u e @: @: @:calc-explain-units@:}
36512 @r{ @: u g @:unit @: @:calc-get-unit-definition@:}
36513 @r{ @: u p @: @: @:calc-permanent-units@:}
36514 @r{ a@: u r @: @: @:calc-remove-units@:}
36515 @r{ a@: u s @: @: @:usimplify@:(a)}
36516 @r{ a@: u t @:units @: 18 @:calc-convert-temperature@:}
36517 @r{ @: u u @:unit @: @:calc-undefine-unit@:}
36518 @r{ @: u v @: @: @:calc-enter-units-table@:}
36519 @r{ a@: u x @: @: @:calc-extract-units@:}
36520 @r{ a@: u 0-9 @: @: @:calc-quick-units@:}
36521
36522 @c
36523 @r{ v1 v2@: u C @: @: 20 @:vcov@:(v1,v2)}
36524 @r{ v1 v2@: I u C @: @: 20 @:vpcov@:(v1,v2)}
36525 @r{ v1 v2@: H u C @: @: 20 @:vcorr@:(v1,v2)}
36526 @r{ v@: u G @: @: 19 @:vgmean@:(v)}
36527 @r{ a b@: H u G @: @: 2 @:agmean@:(a,b)}
36528 @r{ v@: u M @: @: 19 @:vmean@:(v)}
36529 @r{ v@: I u M @: @: 19 @:vmeane@:(v)}
36530 @r{ v@: H u M @: @: 19 @:vmedian@:(v)}
36531 @r{ v@: I H u M @: @: 19 @:vhmean@:(v)}
36532 @r{ v@: u N @: @: 19 @:vmin@:(v)}
36533 @r{ v@: u S @: @: 19 @:vsdev@:(v)}
36534 @r{ v@: I u S @: @: 19 @:vpsdev@:(v)}
36535 @r{ v@: H u S @: @: 19 @:vvar@:(v)}
36536 @r{ v@: I H u S @: @: 19 @:vpvar@:(v)}
36537 @r{ @: u V @: @: @:calc-view-units-table@:}
36538 @r{ v@: u X @: @: 19 @:vmax@:(v)}
36539
36540 @c
36541 @r{ v@: u + @: @: 19 @:vsum@:(v)}
36542 @r{ v@: u * @: @: 19 @:vprod@:(v)}
36543 @r{ v@: u # @: @: 19 @:vcount@:(v)}
36544
36545 @c
36546 @r{ @: V ( @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-parens@:}
36547 @r{ @: V @{ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-braces@:}
36548 @r{ @: V [ @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-brackets@:}
36549 @r{ @: V ] @:ROCP @: 50 @:calc-matrix-brackets@:}
36550 @r{ @: V , @: @: 50 @:calc-vector-commas@:}
36551 @r{ @: V < @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-left-justify@:}
36552 @r{ @: V = @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-center-justify@:}
36553 @r{ @: V > @: @: 50 @:calc-matrix-right-justify@:}
36554 @r{ @: V / @: @: 12,50 @:calc-break-vectors@:}
36555 @r{ @: V . @: @: 12,50 @:calc-full-vectors@:}
36556
36557 @c
36558 @r{ s t@: V ^ @: @: 2 @:vint@:(s,t)}
36559 @r{ s t@: V - @: @: 2 @:vdiff@:(s,t)}
36560 @r{ s@: V ~ @: @: 1 @:vcompl@:(s)}
36561 @r{ s@: V # @: @: 1 @:vcard@:(s)}
36562 @r{ s@: V : @: @: 1 @:vspan@:(s)}
36563 @r{ s@: V + @: @: 1 @:rdup@:(s)}
36564
36565 @c
36566 @r{ m@: V & @: @: 1 @:inv@:(m) 1/m}
36567
36568 @c
36569 @r{ v@: v a @:n @: @:arrange@:(v,n)}
36570 @r{ a@: v b @:n @: @:cvec@:(a,n)}
36571 @r{ v@: v c @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mcol@:(v,n)}
36572 @r{ v@: v c @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrcol@:(v,-n)}
36573 @r{ m@: v c @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36574 @r{ v@: v d @: @: 25 @:diag@:(v,n)}
36575 @r{ v m@: v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m)}
36576 @r{ v m f@: H v e @: @: 2 @:vexp@:(v,m,f)}
36577 @r{ v a@: v f @: @: 26 @:find@:(v,a,n)}
36578 @r{ v@: v h @: @: 1 @:head@:(v)}
36579 @r{ v@: I v h @: @: 1 @:tail@:(v)}
36580 @r{ v@: H v h @: @: 1 @:rhead@:(v)}
36581 @r{ v@: I H v h @: @: 1 @:rtail@:(v)}
36582 @r{ @: v i @:n @: 31 @:idn@:(1,n)}
36583 @r{ @: v i @:0 @: 31 @:idn@:(1)}
36584 @r{ h t@: v k @: @: 2 @:cons@:(h,t)}
36585 @r{ h t@: H v k @: @: 2 @:rcons@:(h,t)}
36586 @r{ v@: v l @: @: 1 @:vlen@:(v)}
36587 @r{ v@: H v l @: @: 1 @:mdims@:(v)}
36588 @r{ v m@: v m @: @: 2 @:vmask@:(v,m)}
36589 @r{ v@: v n @: @: 1 @:rnorm@:(v)}
36590 @r{ a b c@: v p @: @: 24 @:calc-pack@:}
36591 @r{ v@: v r @:n >0 @: 21,31 @:mrow@:(v,n)}
36592 @r{ v@: v r @:n <0 @: 31 @:mrrow@:(v,-n)}
36593 @r{ m@: v r @:0 @: 31 @:getdiag@:(m)}
36594 @r{ v i j@: v s @: @: @:subvec@:(v,i,j)}
36595 @r{ v i j@: I v s @: @: @:rsubvec@:(v,i,j)}
36596 @r{ m@: v t @: @: 1 @:trn@:(m)}
36597 @r{ v@: v u @: @: 24 @:calc-unpack@:}
36598 @r{ v@: v v @: @: 1 @:rev@:(v)}
36599 @r{ @: v x @:n @: 31 @:index@:(n)}
36600 @r{ n s i@: C-u v x @: @: @:index@:(n,s,i)}
36601
36602 @c
36603 @r{ v@: V A @:op @: 22 @:apply@:(op,v)}
36604 @r{ v1 v2@: V C @: @: 2 @:cross@:(v1,v2)}
36605 @r{ m@: V D @: @: 1 @:det@:(m)}
36606 @r{ s@: V E @: @: 1 @:venum@:(s)}
36607 @r{ s@: V F @: @: 1 @:vfloor@:(s)}
36608 @r{ v@: V G @: @: @:grade@:(v)}
36609 @r{ v@: I V G @: @: @:rgrade@:(v)}
36610 @r{ v@: V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,n)}
36611 @r{ v w@: H V H @:n @: 31 @:histogram@:(v,w,n)}
36612 @r{ v1 v2@: V I @:mop aop @: 22 @:inner@:(mop,aop,v1,v2)}
36613 @r{ m@: V J @: @: 1 @:ctrn@:(m)}
36614 @r{ m1 m2@: V K @: @: @:kron@:(m1,m2)}
36615 @r{ m@: V L @: @: 1 @:lud@:(m)}
36616 @r{ v@: V M @:op @: 22,23 @:map@:(op,v)}
36617 @r{ v@: V N @: @: 1 @:cnorm@:(v)}
36618 @r{ v1 v2@: V O @:op @: 22 @:outer@:(op,v1,v2)}
36619 @r{ v@: V R @:op @: 22,23 @:reduce@:(op,v)}
36620 @r{ v@: I V R @:op @: 22,23 @:rreduce@:(op,v)}
36621 @r{ a n@: H V R @:op @: 22 @:nest@:(op,a,n)}
36622 @r{ a@: I H V R @:op @: 22 @:fixp@:(op,a)}
36623 @r{ v@: V S @: @: @:sort@:(v)}
36624 @r{ v@: I V S @: @: @:rsort@:(v)}
36625 @r{ m@: V T @: @: 1 @:tr@:(m)}
36626 @r{ v@: V U @:op @: 22 @:accum@:(op,v)}
36627 @r{ v@: I V U @:op @: 22 @:raccum@:(op,v)}
36628 @r{ a n@: H V U @:op @: 22 @:anest@:(op,a,n)}
36629 @r{ a@: I H V U @:op @: 22 @:afixp@:(op,a)}
36630 @r{ s t@: V V @: @: 2 @:vunion@:(s,t)}
36631 @r{ s t@: V X @: @: 2 @:vxor@:(s,t)}
36632
36633 @c
36634 @r{ @: Y @: @: @:@:user commands}
36635
36636 @c
36637 @r{ @: z @: @: @:@:user commands}
36638
36639 @c
36640 @r{ c@: Z [ @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-if@:}
36641 @r{ c@: Z | @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-else-if@:}
36642 @r{ @: Z : @: @: @:calc-kbd-else@:}
36643 @r{ @: Z ] @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-if@:}
36644
36645 @c
36646 @r{ @: Z @{ @: @: 4 @:calc-kbd-loop@:}
36647 @r{ c@: Z / @: @: 45 @:calc-kbd-break@:}
36648 @r{ @: Z @} @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-loop@:}
36649 @r{ n@: Z < @: @: @:calc-kbd-repeat@:}
36650 @r{ @: Z > @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-repeat@:}
36651 @r{ n m@: Z ( @: @: @:calc-kbd-for@:}
36652 @r{ s@: Z ) @: @: @:calc-kbd-end-for@:}
36653
36654 @c
36655 @r{ @: Z C-g @: @: @:@:cancel if/loop command}
36656
36657 @c
36658 @r{ @: Z ` @: @: @:calc-kbd-push@:}
36659 @r{ @: Z ' @: @: @:calc-kbd-pop@:}
36660 @r{ @: Z # @: @: @:calc-kbd-query@:}
36661
36662 @c
36663 @r{ comp@: Z C @:func, args @: 50 @:calc-user-define-composition@:}
36664 @r{ @: Z D @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define@:}
36665 @r{ @: Z E @:key, editing @: 30 @:calc-user-define-edit@:}
36666 @r{ defn@: Z F @:k, c, f, a, n@: 28 @:calc-user-define-formula@:}
36667 @r{ @: Z G @:key @: @:calc-get-user-defn@:}
36668 @r{ @: Z I @: @: @:calc-user-define-invocation@:}
36669 @r{ @: Z K @:key, command @: @:calc-user-define-kbd-macro@:}
36670 @r{ @: Z P @:key @: @:calc-user-define-permanent@:}
36671 @r{ @: Z S @: @: 30 @:calc-edit-user-syntax@:}
36672 @r{ @: Z T @: @: 12 @:calc-timing@:}
36673 @r{ @: Z U @:key @: @:calc-user-undefine@:}
36674
36675 @end format
36676
36677 @noindent
36678 NOTES
36679
36680 @enumerate
36681 @c 1
36682 @item
36683 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36684 Negative prefix arguments apply to the @expr{-n}th stack entry.
36685 A prefix of zero applies to the entire stack. (For @key{LFD} and
36686 @kbd{M-@key{DEL}}, the meaning of the sign is reversed.)
36687
36688 @c 2
36689 @item
36690 Positive prefix arguments apply to @expr{n} stack entries.
36691 Negative prefix arguments apply to the top stack entry
36692 and the next @expr{-n} stack entries.
36693
36694 @c 3
36695 @item
36696 Positive prefix arguments rotate top @expr{n} stack entries by one.
36697 Negative prefix arguments rotate the entire stack by @expr{-n}.
36698 A prefix of zero reverses the entire stack.
36699
36700 @c 4
36701 @item
36702 Prefix argument specifies a repeat count or distance.
36703
36704 @c 5
36705 @item
36706 Positive prefix arguments specify a precision @expr{p}.
36707 Negative prefix arguments reduce the current precision by @expr{-p}.
36708
36709 @c 6
36710 @item
36711 A prefix argument is interpreted as an additional step-size parameter.
36712 A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix means to prompt for the step size.
36713
36714 @c 7
36715 @item
36716 A prefix argument specifies simplification level and depth.
36717 1=Basic simplifications, 2=Algebraic simplifications, 3=Extended simplifications
36718
36719 @c 8
36720 @item
36721 A negative prefix operates only on the top level of the input formula.
36722
36723 @c 9
36724 @item
36725 Positive prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, unsigned.
36726 Negative prefix arguments specify a word size of @expr{w} bits, signed.
36727
36728 @c 10
36729 @item
36730 Prefix arguments specify the shift amount @expr{n}. The @expr{w} argument
36731 cannot be specified in the keyboard version of this command.
36732
36733 @c 11
36734 @item
36735 From the keyboard, @expr{d} is omitted and defaults to zero.
36736
36737 @c 12
36738 @item
36739 Mode is toggled; a positive prefix always sets the mode, and a negative
36740 prefix always clears the mode.
36741
36742 @c 13
36743 @item
36744 Some prefix argument values provide special variations of the mode.
36745
36746 @c 14
36747 @item
36748 A prefix argument, if any, is used for @expr{m} instead of taking
36749 @expr{m} from the stack. @expr{M} may take any of these values:
36750 @iftex
36751 {@advance@tableindent10pt
36752 @end iftex
36753 @table @asis
36754 @item Integer
36755 Random integer in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36756 @item Float
36757 Random floating-point number in the interval @expr{[0 .. m)}.
36758 @item 0.0
36759 Gaussian with mean 1 and standard deviation 0.
36760 @item Error form
36761 Gaussian with specified mean and standard deviation.
36762 @item Interval
36763 Random integer or floating-point number in that interval.
36764 @item Vector
36765 Random element from the vector.
36766 @end table
36767 @iftex
36768 }
36769 @end iftex
36770
36771 @c 15
36772 @item
36773 A prefix argument from 1 to 6 specifies number of date components
36774 to remove from the stack. @xref{Date Conversions}.
36775
36776 @c 16
36777 @item
36778 A prefix argument specifies a time zone; @kbd{C-u} says to take the
36779 time zone number or name from the top of the stack. @xref{Time Zones}.
36780
36781 @c 17
36782 @item
36783 A prefix argument specifies a day number (0--6, 0--31, or 0--366).
36784
36785 @c 18
36786 @item
36787 If the input has no units, you will be prompted for both the old and
36788 the new units.
36789
36790 @c 19
36791 @item
36792 With a prefix argument, collect that many stack entries to form the
36793 input data set. Each entry may be a single value or a vector of values.
36794
36795 @c 20
36796 @item
36797 With a prefix argument of 1, take a single
36798 @texline @var{n}@math{\times2}
36799 @infoline @mathit{@var{N}x2}
36800 matrix from the stack instead of two separate data vectors.
36801
36802 @c 21
36803 @item
36804 The row or column number @expr{n} may be given as a numeric prefix
36805 argument instead. A plain @kbd{C-u} prefix says to take @expr{n}
36806 from the top of the stack. If @expr{n} is a vector or interval,
36807 a subvector/submatrix of the input is created.
36808
36809 @c 22
36810 @item
36811 The @expr{op} prompt can be answered with the key sequence for the
36812 desired function, or with @kbd{x} or @kbd{z} followed by a function name,
36813 or with @kbd{$} to take a formula from the top of the stack, or with
36814 @kbd{'} and a typed formula. In the last two cases, the formula may
36815 be a nameless function like @samp{<#1+#2>} or @samp{<x, y : x+y>}, or it
36816 may include @kbd{$}, @kbd{$$}, etc. (where @kbd{$} will correspond to the
36817 last argument of the created function), or otherwise you will be
36818 prompted for an argument list. The number of vectors popped from the
36819 stack by @kbd{V M} depends on the number of arguments of the function.
36820
36821 @c 23
36822 @item
36823 One of the mapping direction keys @kbd{_} (horizontal, i.e., map
36824 by rows or reduce across), @kbd{:} (vertical, i.e., map by columns or
36825 reduce down), or @kbd{=} (map or reduce by rows) may be used before
36826 entering @expr{op}; these modify the function name by adding the letter
36827 @code{r} for ``rows,'' @code{c} for ``columns,'' @code{a} for ``across,''
36828 or @code{d} for ``down.''
36829
36830 @c 24
36831 @item
36832 The prefix argument specifies a packing mode. A nonnegative mode
36833 is the number of items (for @kbd{v p}) or the number of levels
36834 (for @kbd{v u}). A negative mode is as described below. With no
36835 prefix argument, the mode is taken from the top of the stack and
36836 may be an integer or a vector of integers.
36837 @iftex
36838 {@advance@tableindent-20pt
36839 @end iftex
36840 @table @cite
36841 @item -1
36842 (@var{2}) Rectangular complex number.
36843 @item -2
36844 (@var{2}) Polar complex number.
36845 @item -3
36846 (@var{3}) HMS form.
36847 @item -4
36848 (@var{2}) Error form.
36849 @item -5
36850 (@var{2}) Modulo form.
36851 @item -6
36852 (@var{2}) Closed interval.
36853 @item -7
36854 (@var{2}) Closed .. open interval.
36855 @item -8
36856 (@var{2}) Open .. closed interval.
36857 @item -9
36858 (@var{2}) Open interval.
36859 @item -10
36860 (@var{2}) Fraction.
36861 @item -11
36862 (@var{2}) Float with integer mantissa.
36863 @item -12
36864 (@var{2}) Float with mantissa in @expr{[1 .. 10)}.
36865 @item -13
36866 (@var{1}) Date form (using date numbers).
36867 @item -14
36868 (@var{3}) Date form (using year, month, day).
36869 @item -15
36870 (@var{6}) Date form (using year, month, day, hour, minute, second).
36871 @end table
36872 @iftex
36873 }
36874 @end iftex
36875
36876 @c 25
36877 @item
36878 A prefix argument specifies the size @expr{n} of the matrix. With no
36879 prefix argument, @expr{n} is omitted and the size is inferred from
36880 the input vector.
36881
36882 @c 26
36883 @item
36884 The prefix argument specifies the starting position @expr{n} (default 1).
36885
36886 @c 27
36887 @item
36888 Cursor position within stack buffer affects this command.
36889
36890 @c 28
36891 @item
36892 Arguments are not actually removed from the stack by this command.
36893
36894 @c 29
36895 @item
36896 Variable name may be a single digit or a full name.
36897
36898 @c 30
36899 @item
36900 Editing occurs in a separate buffer. Press @kbd{C-c C-c} (or
36901 @key{LFD}, or in some cases @key{RET}) to finish the edit, or kill the
36902 buffer with @kbd{C-x k} to cancel the edit. The @key{LFD} key prevents evaluation
36903 of the result of the edit.
36904
36905 @c 31
36906 @item
36907 The number prompted for can also be provided as a prefix argument.
36908
36909 @c 32
36910 @item
36911 Press this key a second time to cancel the prefix.
36912
36913 @c 33
36914 @item
36915 With a negative prefix, deactivate all formulas. With a positive
36916 prefix, deactivate and then reactivate from scratch.
36917
36918 @c 34
36919 @item
36920 Default is to scan for nearest formula delimiter symbols. With a
36921 prefix of zero, formula is delimited by mark and point. With a
36922 non-zero prefix, formula is delimited by scanning forward or
36923 backward by that many lines.
36924
36925 @c 35
36926 @item
36927 Parse the region between point and mark as a vector. A nonzero prefix
36928 parses @var{n} lines before or after point as a vector. A zero prefix
36929 parses the current line as a vector. A @kbd{C-u} prefix parses the
36930 region between point and mark as a single formula.
36931
36932 @c 36
36933 @item
36934 Parse the rectangle defined by point and mark as a matrix. A positive
36935 prefix @var{n} divides the rectangle into columns of width @var{n}.
36936 A zero or @kbd{C-u} prefix parses each line as one formula. A negative
36937 prefix suppresses special treatment of bracketed portions of a line.
36938
36939 @c 37
36940 @item
36941 A numeric prefix causes the current language mode to be ignored.
36942
36943 @c 38
36944 @item
36945 Responding to a prompt with a blank line answers that and all
36946 later prompts by popping additional stack entries.
36947
36948 @c 39
36949 @item
36950 Answer for @expr{v} may also be of the form @expr{v = v_0} or
36951 @expr{v - v_0}.
36952
36953 @c 40
36954 @item
36955 With a positive prefix argument, stack contains many @expr{y}'s and one
36956 common @expr{x}. With a zero prefix, stack contains a vector of
36957 @expr{y}s and a common @expr{x}. With a negative prefix, stack
36958 contains many @expr{[x,y]} vectors. (For 3D plots, substitute
36959 @expr{z} for @expr{y} and @expr{x,y} for @expr{x}.)
36960
36961 @c 41
36962 @item
36963 With any prefix argument, all curves in the graph are deleted.
36964
36965 @c 42
36966 @item
36967 With a positive prefix, refines an existing plot with more data points.
36968 With a negative prefix, forces recomputation of the plot data.
36969
36970 @c 43
36971 @item
36972 With any prefix argument, set the default value instead of the
36973 value for this graph.
36974
36975 @c 44
36976 @item
36977 With a negative prefix argument, set the value for the printer.
36978
36979 @c 45
36980 @item
36981 Condition is considered ``true'' if it is a nonzero real or complex
36982 number, or a formula whose value is known to be nonzero; it is ``false''
36983 otherwise.
36984
36985 @c 46
36986 @item
36987 Several formulas separated by commas are pushed as multiple stack
36988 entries. Trailing @kbd{)}, @kbd{]}, @kbd{@}}, @kbd{>}, and @kbd{"}
36989 delimiters may be omitted. The notation @kbd{$$$} refers to the value
36990 in stack level three, and causes the formula to replace the top three
36991 stack levels. The notation @kbd{$3} refers to stack level three without
36992 causing that value to be removed from the stack. Use @key{LFD} in place
36993 of @key{RET} to prevent evaluation; use @kbd{M-=} in place of @key{RET}
36994 to evaluate variables.
36995
36996 @c 47
36997 @item
36998 The variable is replaced by the formula shown on the right. The
36999 Inverse flag reverses the order of the operands, e.g., @kbd{I s - x}
37000 assigns
37001 @texline @math{x \coloneq a-x}.
37002 @infoline @expr{x := a-x}.
37003
37004 @c 48
37005 @item
37006 Press @kbd{?} repeatedly to see how to choose a model. Answer the
37007 variables prompt with @expr{iv} or @expr{iv;pv} to specify
37008 independent and parameter variables. A positive prefix argument
37009 takes @mathit{@var{n}+1} vectors from the stack; a zero prefix takes a matrix
37010 and a vector from the stack.
37011
37012 @c 49
37013 @item
37014 With a plain @kbd{C-u} prefix, replace the current region of the
37015 destination buffer with the yanked text instead of inserting.
37016
37017 @c 50
37018 @item
37019 All stack entries are reformatted; the @kbd{H} prefix inhibits this.
37020 The @kbd{I} prefix sets the mode temporarily, redraws the top stack
37021 entry, then restores the original setting of the mode.
37022
37023 @c 51
37024 @item
37025 A negative prefix sets the default 3D resolution instead of the
37026 default 2D resolution.
37027
37028 @c 52
37029 @item
37030 This grabs a vector of the form [@var{prec}, @var{wsize}, @var{ssize},
37031 @var{radix}, @var{flfmt}, @var{ang}, @var{frac}, @var{symb}, @var{polar},
37032 @var{matrix}, @var{simp}, @var{inf}]. A prefix argument from 1 to 12
37033 grabs the @var{n}th mode value only.
37034 @end enumerate
37035
37036 @iftex
37037 (Space is provided below for you to keep your own written notes.)
37038 @page
37039 @endgroup
37040 @end iftex
37041
37042
37043 @c [end-summary]
37044
37045 @node Key Index, Command Index, Summary, Top
37046 @unnumbered Index of Key Sequences
37047
37048 @printindex ky
37049
37050 @node Command Index, Function Index, Key Index, Top
37051 @unnumbered Index of Calculator Commands
37052
37053 Since all Calculator commands begin with the prefix @samp{calc-}, the
37054 @kbd{x} key has been provided as a variant of @kbd{M-x} which automatically
37055 types @samp{calc-} for you. Thus, @kbd{x last-args} is short for
37056 @kbd{M-x calc-last-args}.
37057
37058 @printindex pg
37059
37060 @node Function Index, Concept Index, Command Index, Top
37061 @unnumbered Index of Algebraic Functions
37062
37063 This is a list of built-in functions and operators usable in algebraic
37064 expressions. Their full Lisp names are derived by adding the prefix
37065 @samp{calcFunc-}, as in @code{calcFunc-sqrt}.
37066 @iftex
37067 All functions except those noted with ``*'' have corresponding
37068 Calc keystrokes and can also be found in the Calc Summary.
37069 @end iftex
37070
37071 @printindex tp
37072
37073 @node Concept Index, Variable Index, Function Index, Top
37074 @unnumbered Concept Index
37075
37076 @printindex cp
37077
37078 @node Variable Index, Lisp Function Index, Concept Index, Top
37079 @unnumbered Index of Variables
37080
37081 The variables in this list that do not contain dashes are accessible
37082 as Calc variables. Add a @samp{var-} prefix to get the name of the
37083 corresponding Lisp variable.
37084
37085 The remaining variables are Lisp variables suitable for @code{setq}ing
37086 in your Calc init file or @file{.emacs} file.
37087
37088 @printindex vr
37089
37090 @node Lisp Function Index, , Variable Index, Top
37091 @unnumbered Index of Lisp Math Functions
37092
37093 The following functions are meant to be used with @code{defmath}, not
37094 @code{defun} definitions. For names that do not start with @samp{calc-},
37095 the corresponding full Lisp name is derived by adding a prefix of
37096 @samp{math-}.
37097
37098 @printindex fn
37099
37100 @bye